2N3906 - Fairchild Semiconductor - Farnell Element 14

2N3906 - Fairchild Semiconductor - Farnell Element 14 - Revenir à l'accueil

 

 

Branding Farnell element14 (France)

 

Farnell Element 14 :

Miniature

Everything You Need To Know About Arduino

Miniature

Tutorial 01 for Arduino: Getting Acquainted with Arduino

Miniature

The Cube® 3D Printer

Miniature

What's easier- DIY Dentistry or our new our website features?

 

Miniature

Ben Heck's Getting Started with the BeagleBone Black Trailer

Miniature

Ben Heck's Home-Brew Solder Reflow Oven 2.0 Trailer

Miniature

Get Started with Pi Episode 3 - Online with Raspberry Pi

Miniature

Discover Simulink Promo -- Exclusive element14 Webinar

Miniature

Ben Heck's TV Proximity Sensor Trailer

Miniature

Ben Heck's PlayStation 4 Teardown Trailer

See the trailer for the next exciting episode of The Ben Heck show. Check back on Friday to be among the first to see the exclusive full show on element…

Miniature

Get Started with Pi Episode 4 - Your First Raspberry Pi Project

Connect your Raspberry Pi to a breadboard, download some code and create a push-button audio play project.

Miniature

Ben Heck Anti-Pickpocket Wallet Trailer

Miniature

Molex Earphones - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Tripp Lite Surge Protector - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Microchip ChipKIT Pi - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Beagle Bone Black - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

3M E26, LED Lamps - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

3M Colored Duct Tape - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Tenma Soldering Station - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Duratool Screwdriver Kit - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Cubify 3D Cube - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Bud Boardganizer - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Raspberry Pi Starter Kit - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Fluke 323 True-rms Clamp Meter - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Dymo RHINO 6000 Label Printer - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

3M LED Advanced Lights A-19 - The 14 Holiday Products of Newark element14 Promotion

Miniature

Innovative LPS Resistor Features Very High Power Dissipation

Miniature

Charge Injection Evaluation Board for DG508B Multiplexer Demo

Miniature

Ben Heck The Great Glue Gun Trailer Part 2

Miniature

Introducing element14 TV

Miniature

Ben Heck Time to Meet Your Maker Trailer

Miniature

Détecteur de composants

Miniature

Recherche intégrée

Miniature

Ben Builds an Accessibility Guitar Trailer Part 1

Miniature

Ben Builds an Accessibility Guitar - Part 2 Trailer

Miniature

PiFace Control and Display Introduction

Miniature

Flashmob Farnell

Miniature

Express Yourself in 3D with Cube 3D Printers from Newark element14

Miniature

Farnell YouTube Channel Move

Miniature

Farnell: Design with the best

Miniature

French Farnell Quest

Miniature

Altera - 3 Ways to Quickly Adapt to Changing Ethernet Protocols

Miniature

Cy-Net3 Network Module

Miniature

MC AT - Professional and Precision Series Thin Film Chip Resistors

Miniature

Solderless LED Connector

Miniature

PSA-T Series Spectrum Analyser: PSA1301T/ PSA2701T

Miniature

3-axis Universal Motion Controller For Stepper Motor Drivers: TMC429

Miniature

Voltage Level Translation

Puce électronique / Microchip :

Miniature

Microchip - 8-bit Wireless Development Kit

Miniature

Microchip - Introduction to mTouch Capacitive Touch Sensing Part 2 of 3

Miniature

Microchip - Introduction to mTouch Capacitive Touch Sensing Part 3 of 3

Miniature

Microchip - Introduction to mTouch Capacitive Touch Sensing Part 1 of 3

Sans fil - Wireless :

Miniature

Microchip - 8-bit Wireless Development Kit

Miniature

Wireless Power Solutions - Wurth Electronics, Texas Instruments, CadSoft and element14

Miniature

Analog Devices - Remote Water Quality Monitoring via a Low Power, Wireless Network

Texas instrument :

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Automotive LED Headlights

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Digital Power Solutions

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Industrial Sensor Solutions

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Wireless Pen Input Demo (Mobile World Congress)

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Industrial Automation System Components

Miniature

Texas Instruments - TMS320C66x - Industry's first 10-GHz fixed/floating point DSP

Miniature

Texas Instruments - TMS320C66x KeyStone Multicore Architecture

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Industrial Interfaces

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Concerto™ MCUs - Connectivity without compromise

Miniature

Texas Instruments - Stellaris Robot Chronos

Miniature

Texas Instruments - DRV8412-C2-KIT, Brushed DC and Stepper Motor Control Kit

Ordinateurs :

Miniature

Ask Ben Heck - Connect Raspberry Pi to Car Computer

Miniature

Ben's Portable Raspberry Pi Computer Trailer

Miniature

Ben's Raspberry Pi Portable Computer Trailer 2

Miniature

Ben Heck's Pocket Computer Trailer

Miniature

Ask Ben Heck - Atari Computer

Miniature

Ask Ben Heck - Using Computer Monitors for External Displays

Miniature

Raspberry Pi Partnership with BBC Computer Literacy Project - Answers from co-founder Eben Upton

Miniature

Installing RaspBMC on your Raspberry Pi with the Farnell element14 Accessory kit

Miniature

Raspberry Pi Served - Joey Hudy

Miniature

Happy Birthday Raspberry Pi

Miniature

Raspberry Pi board B product overview

Logiciels :

Miniature

Ask Ben Heck - Best Opensource or Free CAD Software

Miniature

Tektronix FPGAView™ software makes debugging of FPGAs faster than ever!

Miniature

Ask Ben Heck - Best Open-Source Schematic Capture and PCB Layout Software

Miniature

Introduction to Cadsoft EAGLE PCB Design Software in Chinese

Miniature

Altera - Developing Software for Embedded Systems on FPGAs

Tutoriels :

Miniature

Ben Heck The Great Glue Gun Trailer Part 1

Miniature

the knode tutorial - element14

Miniature

Ben's Autodesk 123D Tutorial Trailer

Miniature

Ben's CadSoft EAGLE Tutorial Trailer

Miniature

Ben Heck's Soldering Tutorial Trailer

Miniature

Ben Heck's AVR Dev Board tutorial

Miniature

Ben Heck's Pinball Tutorial Trailer

Miniature

Ben Heck's Interface Tutorial Trailer

Miniature

First Stage with Python and PiFace Digital

Miniature

Cypress - Getting Started with PSoC® 3 - Part 2

Miniature

Energy Harvesting Challenge

Miniature

New Features of CadSoft EAGLE v6

Autres documentations :
 Farnell-MSP430-Hardw..> 29-Jul-2014 10:36  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LM324-Texas-..> 29-Jul-2014 10:32  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LM386-Low-Vo..> 29-Jul-2014 10:32  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NE5532-Texas..> 29-Jul-2014 10:32  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Hex-Inverter..> 29-Jul-2014 10:31  875K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AT90USBKey-H..> 29-Jul-2014 10:31  902K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AT89C5131-Ha..> 29-Jul-2014 10:31  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MSP-EXP430F5..> 29-Jul-2014 10:31  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Explorer-16-..> 29-Jul-2014 10:31  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TMP006EVM-Us..> 29-Jul-2014 10:30  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Gertboard-Us..> 29-Jul-2014 10:30  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LMP91051-Use..> 29-Jul-2014 10:30  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Thermometre-..> 29-Jul-2014 10:30  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-user-manuel-..> 29-Jul-2014 10:29  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-fx-3650P-fx-..> 29-Jul-2014 10:29  1.5M

[TXT]

 Farnell-2-GBPS-Diffe..> 28-Jul-2014 17:42  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LMT88-2.4V-1..> 28-Jul-2014 17:42  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Octal-Genera..> 28-Jul-2014 17:42  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Dual-MOSFET-..> 28-Jul-2014 17:41  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TLV320AIC325..> 28-Jul-2014 17:41  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SN54LV4053A-..> 28-Jul-2014 17:20  5.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TAS1020B-USB..> 28-Jul-2014 17:19  6.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TPS40060-Wid..> 28-Jul-2014 17:19  6.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TL082-Wide-B..> 28-Jul-2014 17:16  6.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-RF-short-tra..> 28-Jul-2014 17:16  6.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-maxim-integr..> 28-Jul-2014 17:14  6.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TSV6390-TSV6..> 28-Jul-2014 17:14  6.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Fast-Charge-..> 28-Jul-2014 17:12  6.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NVE-datashee..> 28-Jul-2014 17:12  6.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Excalibur-Hi..> 28-Jul-2014 17:10  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Excalibur-Hi..> 28-Jul-2014 17:10  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-REF102-10V-P..> 28-Jul-2014 17:09  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TMS320F28055..> 28-Jul-2014 17:09  2.7M

[TXT]

 Farnell-MULTICOMP-Ra..> 22-Jul-2014 12:35  5.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-RASPBERRY-PI..> 22-Jul-2014 12:35  5.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Dremel-Exper..> 22-Jul-2014 12:34  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-STM32F103x8-..> 22-Jul-2014 12:33  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BD6xxx-PDF.htm  22-Jul-2014 12:33  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-L78S-STMicro..> 22-Jul-2014 12:32  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-RaspiCam-Doc..> 22-Jul-2014 12:32  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SB520-SB5100..> 22-Jul-2014 12:32  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-iServer-Micr..> 22-Jul-2014 12:32  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LUMINARY-MIC..> 22-Jul-2014 12:31  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TEXAS-INSTRU..> 22-Jul-2014 12:31  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TEXAS-INSTRU..> 22-Jul-2014 12:30  4.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CLASS 1-or-2..> 22-Jul-2014 12:30  4.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TEXAS-INSTRU..> 22-Jul-2014 12:29  4.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Evaluating-t..> 22-Jul-2014 12:28  4.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LM3S6952-Mic..> 22-Jul-2014 12:27  5.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Keyboard-Mou..> 22-Jul-2014 12:27  5.9M 

 [TXT] Farnell-Full-Datashe..> 15-Jul-2014 17:08 951K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-pmbta13_pmbt..> 15-Jul-2014 17:06  959K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-EE-SPX303N-4..> 15-Jul-2014 17:06  969K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Datasheet-NX..> 15-Jul-2014 17:06  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Datasheet-Fa..> 15-Jul-2014 17:05  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MIDAS-un-tra..> 15-Jul-2014 17:05  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SERIAL-TFT-M..> 15-Jul-2014 17:05  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MCOC1-Farnel..> 15-Jul-2014 17:05  1.0M

[TXT]

 Farnell-TMR-2-series..> 15-Jul-2014 16:48  787K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-DC-DC-Conver..> 15-Jul-2014 16:48  781K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Full-Datashe..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  803K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TMLM-Series-..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  810K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TEL-5-Series..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  814K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TXL-series-t..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  829K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TEP-150WI-Se..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  837K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AC-DC-Power-..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  845K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TIS-Instruct..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  845K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TOS-tracopow..> 15-Jul-2014 16:47  852K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TCL-DC-traco..> 15-Jul-2014 16:46  858K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TIS-series-t..> 15-Jul-2014 16:46  875K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TMR-2-Series..> 15-Jul-2014 16:46  897K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TMR-3-WI-Ser..> 15-Jul-2014 16:46  939K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TEN-8-WI-Ser..> 15-Jul-2014 16:46  939K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Full-Datashe..> 15-Jul-2014 16:46  947K
[TXT]

 Farnell-HIP4081A-Int..> 07-Jul-2014 19:47  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ISL6251-ISL6..> 07-Jul-2014 19:47  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-DG411-DG412-..> 07-Jul-2014 19:47  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-3367-ARALDIT..> 07-Jul-2014 19:46  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ICM7228-Inte..> 07-Jul-2014 19:46  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Data-Sheet-K..> 07-Jul-2014 19:46  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Silica-Gel-M..> 07-Jul-2014 19:46  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TKC2-Dusters..> 07-Jul-2014 19:46  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CRC-HANDCLEA..> 07-Jul-2014 19:46  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-760G-French-..> 07-Jul-2014 19:45  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Decapant-KF-..> 07-Jul-2014 19:45  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-1734-ARALDIT..> 07-Jul-2014 19:45  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Araldite-Fus..> 07-Jul-2014 19:45  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-fiche-de-don..> 07-Jul-2014 19:44  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-safety-data-..> 07-Jul-2014 19:44  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-A-4-Hardener..> 07-Jul-2014 19:44  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CC-Debugger-..> 07-Jul-2014 19:44  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MSP430-Hardw..> 07-Jul-2014 19:43  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SmartRF06-Ev..> 07-Jul-2014 19:43  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CC2531-USB-H..> 07-Jul-2014 19:43  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Alimentation..> 07-Jul-2014 19:43  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BK889B-PONT-..> 07-Jul-2014 19:42  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-User-Guide-M..> 07-Jul-2014 19:41  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-T672-3000-Se..> 07-Jul-2014 19:41  2.0M

 [TXT]Farnell-0050375063-D..> 18-Jul-2014 17:03 2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Mini-Fit-Jr-..> 18-Jul-2014 17:03  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-43031-0002-M..> 18-Jul-2014 17:03  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-0433751001-D..> 18-Jul-2014 17:02  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Cube-3D-Prin..> 18-Jul-2014 17:02  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MTX-Compact-..> 18-Jul-2014 17:01  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MTX-3250-MTX..> 18-Jul-2014 17:01  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ATtiny26-L-A..> 18-Jul-2014 17:00  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MCP3421-Micr..> 18-Jul-2014 17:00  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LM19-Texas-I..> 18-Jul-2014 17:00  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Data-Sheet-S..> 18-Jul-2014 17:00  1.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LMH6518-Texa..> 18-Jul-2014 16:59  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AD7719-Low-V..> 18-Jul-2014 16:59  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-DAC8143-Data..> 18-Jul-2014 16:59  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BGA7124-400-..> 18-Jul-2014 16:59  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SICK-OPTIC-E..> 18-Jul-2014 16:58  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LT3757-Linea..> 18-Jul-2014 16:58  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LT1961-Linea..> 18-Jul-2014 16:58  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PIC18F2420-2..> 18-Jul-2014 16:57  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-DS3231-DS-PD..> 18-Jul-2014 16:57  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-RDS-80-PDF.htm  18-Jul-2014 16:57  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AD8300-Data-..> 18-Jul-2014 16:56  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LT6233-Linea..> 18-Jul-2014 16:56  1.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MAX1365-MAX1..> 18-Jul-2014 16:56  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-XPSAF5130-PD..> 18-Jul-2014 16:56  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-DP83846A-DsP..> 18-Jul-2014 16:55  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Dremel-Exper..> 18-Jul-2014 16:55  1.6M

[TXT]

 Farnell-MCOC1-Farnel..> 16-Jul-2014 09:04  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SL3S1203_121..> 16-Jul-2014 09:04  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PN512-Full-N..> 16-Jul-2014 09:03  1.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SL3S4011_402..> 16-Jul-2014 09:03  1.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LPC408x-7x 3..> 16-Jul-2014 09:03  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PCF8574-PCF8..> 16-Jul-2014 09:03  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LPC81xM-32-b..> 16-Jul-2014 09:02  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LPC1769-68-6..> 16-Jul-2014 09:02  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Download-dat..> 16-Jul-2014 09:02  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LPC3220-30-4..> 16-Jul-2014 09:02  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LPC11U3x-32-..> 16-Jul-2014 09:01  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SL3ICS1002-1..> 16-Jul-2014 09:01  2.5M

[TXT]

 Farnell-T672-3000-Se..> 08-Jul-2014 18:59  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-tesa®pack63..> 08-Jul-2014 18:56  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Encodeur-USB..> 08-Jul-2014 18:56  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CC2530ZDK-Us..> 08-Jul-2014 18:55  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-2020-Manuel-..> 08-Jul-2014 18:55  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Synchronous-..> 08-Jul-2014 18:54  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Arithmetic-L..> 08-Jul-2014 18:54  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NA555-NE555-..> 08-Jul-2014 18:53  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-4-Bit-Magnit..> 08-Jul-2014 18:53  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LM555-Timer-..> 08-Jul-2014 18:53  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-L293d-Texas-..> 08-Jul-2014 18:53  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SN54HC244-SN..> 08-Jul-2014 18:52  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MAX232-MAX23..> 08-Jul-2014 18:52  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-High-precisi..> 08-Jul-2014 18:51  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SMU-Instrume..> 08-Jul-2014 18:51  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-900-Series-B..> 08-Jul-2014 18:50  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BA-Series-Oh..> 08-Jul-2014 18:50  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-UTS-Series-S..> 08-Jul-2014 18:49  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-270-Series-O..> 08-Jul-2014 18:49  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-UTS-Series-S..> 08-Jul-2014 18:49  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Tiva-C-Serie..> 08-Jul-2014 18:49  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-UTO-Souriau-..> 08-Jul-2014 18:48  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Clipper-Seri..> 08-Jul-2014 18:48  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SOURIAU-Cont..> 08-Jul-2014 18:47  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-851-Series-P..> 08-Jul-2014 18:47  3.0M

 [TXT] Farnell-SL59830-Inte..> 06-Jul-2014 10:07 1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ALF1210-PDF.htm 06-Jul-2014 10:06  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AD7171-16-Bi..> 06-Jul-2014 10:06  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Low-Noise-24..> 06-Jul-2014 10:05  1.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ESCON-Featur..> 06-Jul-2014 10:05  938K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-74LCX573-Fai..> 06-Jul-2014 10:05  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-1N4148WS-Fai..> 06-Jul-2014 10:04  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-FAN6756-Fair..> 06-Jul-2014 10:04  850K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Datasheet-Fa..> 06-Jul-2014 10:04  861K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ES1F-ES1J-fi..> 06-Jul-2014 10:04  867K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-QRE1113-Fair..> 06-Jul-2014 10:03  879K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-2N7002DW-Fai..> 06-Jul-2014 10:03  886K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-FDC2512-Fair..> 06-Jul-2014 10:03  886K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-FDV301N-Digi..> 06-Jul-2014 10:03  886K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-S1A-Fairchil..> 06-Jul-2014 10:03  896K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BAV99-Fairch..> 06-Jul-2014 10:03  896K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-74AC00-74ACT..> 06-Jul-2014 10:03  911K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NaPiOn-Panas..> 06-Jul-2014 10:02  911K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LQ-RELAYS-AL..> 06-Jul-2014 10:02  924K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ev-relays-ae..> 06-Jul-2014 10:02  926K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ESCON-Featur..> 06-Jul-2014 10:02  931K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Amplifier-In..> 06-Jul-2014 10:02  940K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Serial-File-..> 06-Jul-2014 10:02  941K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Both-the-Del..> 06-Jul-2014 10:01  948K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Videk-PDF.htm   06-Jul-2014 10:01  948K  

[TXT]

 Farnell-EPCOS-173438..> 04-Jul-2014 10:43  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Sensorless-C..> 04-Jul-2014 10:42  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-197.31-KB-Te..> 04-Jul-2014 10:42  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PIC12F609-61..> 04-Jul-2014 10:41  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PADO-semi-au..> 04-Jul-2014 10:41  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-03-iec-runds..> 04-Jul-2014 10:40  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ACC-Silicone..> 04-Jul-2014 10:40  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Series-TDS10..> 04-Jul-2014 10:39  4.0M 

[TXT]

 Farnell-03-iec-runds..> 04-Jul-2014 10:40  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-0430300011-D..> 14-Jun-2014 18:13  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-06-6544-8-PD..> 26-Mar-2014 17:56  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-3M-Polyimide..> 21-Mar-2014 08:09  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-3M-VolitionT..> 25-Mar-2014 08:18  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-10BQ060-PDF.htm 14-Jun-2014 09:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-10TPB47M-End..> 14-Jun-2014 18:16  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-12mm-Size-In..> 14-Jun-2014 09:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-24AA024-24LC..> 23-Jun-2014 10:26  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-50A-High-Pow..> 20-Mar-2014 17:31  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-197.31-KB-Te..> 04-Jul-2014 10:42  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-1907-2006-PD..> 26-Mar-2014 17:56  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-5910-PDF.htm    25-Mar-2014 08:15  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-6517b-Electr..> 29-Mar-2014 11:12  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-A-True-Syste..> 29-Mar-2014 11:13  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ACC-Silicone..> 04-Jul-2014 10:40  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AD524-PDF.htm   20-Mar-2014 17:33  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ADL6507-PDF.htm 14-Jun-2014 18:19  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ADSP-21362-A..> 20-Mar-2014 17:34  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ALF1210-PDF.htm 04-Jul-2014 10:39  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ALF1225-12-V..> 01-Apr-2014 07:40  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ALF2412-24-V..> 01-Apr-2014 07:39  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-AN10361-Phil..> 23-Jun-2014 10:29  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ARADUR-HY-13..> 26-Mar-2014 17:55  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ARALDITE-201..> 21-Mar-2014 08:12  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ARALDITE-CW-..> 26-Mar-2014 17:56  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ATMEL-8-bit-..> 19-Mar-2014 18:04  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ATMEL-8-bit-..> 11-Mar-2014 07:55  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ATmega640-VA..> 14-Jun-2014 09:49  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ATtiny20-PDF..> 25-Mar-2014 08:19  3.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ATtiny26-L-A..> 13-Jun-2014 18:40  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Alimentation..> 14-Jun-2014 18:24  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Alimentation..> 01-Apr-2014 07:42  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Amplificateu..> 29-Mar-2014 11:11  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-An-Improved-..> 14-Jun-2014 09:49  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Atmel-ATmega..> 19-Mar-2014 18:03  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Avvertenze-e..> 14-Jun-2014 18:20  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BC846DS-NXP-..> 13-Jun-2014 18:42  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BC847DS-NXP-..> 23-Jun-2014 10:24  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BF545A-BF545..> 23-Jun-2014 10:28  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BK2650A-BK26..> 29-Mar-2014 11:10  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BT151-650R-N..> 13-Jun-2014 18:40  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BTA204-800C-..> 13-Jun-2014 18:42  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BUJD203AX-NX..> 13-Jun-2014 18:41  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BYV29F-600-N..> 13-Jun-2014 18:42  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BYV79E-serie..> 10-Mar-2014 16:19  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-BZX384-serie..> 23-Jun-2014 10:29  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Battery-GBA-..> 14-Jun-2014 18:13  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-C.A-6150-C.A..> 14-Jun-2014 18:24  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-C.A 8332B-C...> 01-Apr-2014 07:40  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CC2560-Bluet..> 29-Mar-2014 11:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CD4536B-Type..> 14-Jun-2014 18:13  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CIRRUS-LOGIC..> 10-Mar-2014 17:20  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-CS5532-34-BS..> 01-Apr-2014 07:39  3.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Cannon-ZD-PD..> 11-Mar-2014 08:13  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Ceramic-tran..> 14-Jun-2014 18:19  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Circuit-Note..> 26-Mar-2014 18:00  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Circuit-Note..> 26-Mar-2014 18:00  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Cles-electro..> 21-Mar-2014 08:13  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Conception-d..> 11-Mar-2014 07:49  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Connectors-N..> 14-Jun-2014 18:12  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Construction..> 14-Jun-2014 18:25  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Controle-de-..> 11-Mar-2014 08:16  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Cordless-dri..> 14-Jun-2014 18:13  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Current-Tran..> 26-Mar-2014 17:58  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Current-Tran..> 26-Mar-2014 17:58  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Current-Tran..> 26-Mar-2014 17:59  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Current-Tran..> 26-Mar-2014 17:59  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-DC-Fan-type-..> 14-Jun-2014 09:48  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-DC-Fan-type-..> 14-Jun-2014 09:51  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Davum-TMC-PD..> 14-Jun-2014 18:27  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-De-la-puissa..> 29-Mar-2014 11:10  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Directive-re..> 25-Mar-2014 08:16  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Documentatio..> 14-Jun-2014 18:26  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Download-dat..> 13-Jun-2014 18:40  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ECO-Series-T..> 20-Mar-2014 08:14  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ELMA-PDF.htm    29-Mar-2014 11:13  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-EMC1182-PDF.htm 25-Mar-2014 08:17  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-EPCOS-173438..> 04-Jul-2014 10:43  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-EPCOS-Sample..> 11-Mar-2014 07:53  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ES2333-PDF.htm  11-Mar-2014 08:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Ed.081002-DA..> 19-Mar-2014 18:02  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-F28069-Picco..> 14-Jun-2014 18:14  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-F42202-PDF.htm  19-Mar-2014 18:00  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-FDS-ITW-Spra..> 14-Jun-2014 18:22  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-FICHE-DE-DON..> 10-Mar-2014 16:17  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Fastrack-Sup..> 23-Jun-2014 10:25  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Ferric-Chlor..> 29-Mar-2014 11:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Fiche-de-don..> 14-Jun-2014 09:47  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Fiche-de-don..> 14-Jun-2014 18:26  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Fluke-1730-E..> 14-Jun-2014 18:23  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-GALVA-A-FROI..> 26-Mar-2014 17:56  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-GALVA-MAT-Re..> 26-Mar-2014 17:57  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-GN-RELAYS-AG..> 20-Mar-2014 08:11  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-HC49-4H-Crys..> 14-Jun-2014 18:20  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-HFE1600-Data..> 14-Jun-2014 18:22  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-HI-70300-Sol..> 14-Jun-2014 18:27  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-HUNTSMAN-Adv..> 10-Mar-2014 16:17  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Haute-vitess..> 11-Mar-2014 08:17  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-IP4252CZ16-8..> 13-Jun-2014 18:41  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Instructions..> 19-Mar-2014 18:01  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-KSZ8851SNL-S..> 23-Jun-2014 10:28  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-L-efficacite..> 11-Mar-2014 07:52  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LCW-CQ7P.CC-..> 25-Mar-2014 08:19  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LME49725-Pow..> 14-Jun-2014 09:49  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LOCTITE-542-..> 25-Mar-2014 08:15  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LOCTITE-3463..> 25-Mar-2014 08:19  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-LUXEON-Guide..> 11-Mar-2014 07:52  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Leaded-Trans..> 23-Jun-2014 10:26  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Les-derniers..> 11-Mar-2014 07:50  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Loctite3455-..> 25-Mar-2014 08:16  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Low-cost-Enc..> 13-Jun-2014 18:42  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Lubrifiant-a..> 26-Mar-2014 18:00  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MC3510-PDF.htm  25-Mar-2014 08:17  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MC21605-PDF.htm 11-Mar-2014 08:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MCF532x-7x-E..> 29-Mar-2014 11:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MICREL-KSZ88..> 11-Mar-2014 07:54  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MICROCHIP-PI..> 19-Mar-2014 18:02  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MOLEX-39-00-..> 10-Mar-2014 17:19  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MOLEX-43020-..> 10-Mar-2014 17:21  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MOLEX-43160-..> 10-Mar-2014 17:21  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MOLEX-87439-..> 10-Mar-2014 17:21  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MPXV7002-Rev..> 20-Mar-2014 17:33  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-MX670-MX675-..> 14-Jun-2014 09:46  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Microchip-MC..> 13-Jun-2014 18:27  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Microship-PI..> 11-Mar-2014 07:53  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Midas-Active..> 14-Jun-2014 18:17  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Midas-MCCOG4..> 14-Jun-2014 18:11  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Miniature-Ci..> 26-Mar-2014 17:55  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Mistral-PDF.htm 14-Jun-2014 18:12  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Molex-83421-..> 14-Jun-2014 18:17  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Molex-COMMER..> 14-Jun-2014 18:16  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Molex-Crimp-..> 10-Mar-2014 16:27  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Multi-Functi..> 20-Mar-2014 17:38  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NTE_SEMICOND..> 11-Mar-2014 07:52  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-74VHC126..> 10-Mar-2014 16:17  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-BT136-60..> 11-Mar-2014 07:52  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-PBSS9110..> 10-Mar-2014 17:21  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-PCA9555 ..> 11-Mar-2014 07:54  2.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-PMBFJ620..> 10-Mar-2014 16:16  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-PSMN1R7-..> 10-Mar-2014 16:17  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-PSMN7R0-..> 10-Mar-2014 17:19  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-NXP-TEA1703T..> 11-Mar-2014 08:15  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Nilfi-sk-E-..> 14-Jun-2014 09:47  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Novembre-201..> 20-Mar-2014 17:38  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-OMRON-Master..> 10-Mar-2014 16:26  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-OSLON-SSL-Ce..> 19-Mar-2014 18:03  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-OXPCIE958-FB..> 13-Jun-2014 18:40  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PADO-semi-au..> 04-Jul-2014 10:41  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PBSS5160T-60..> 19-Mar-2014 18:03  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PDTA143X-ser..> 20-Mar-2014 08:12  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PDTB123TT-NX..> 13-Jun-2014 18:43  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PESD5V0F1BL-..> 13-Jun-2014 18:43  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PESD9X5.0L-P..> 13-Jun-2014 18:43  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PIC12F609-61..> 04-Jul-2014 10:41  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PIC18F2455-2..> 23-Jun-2014 10:27  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PIC24FJ256GB..> 14-Jun-2014 09:51  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PMBT3906-PNP..> 13-Jun-2014 18:44  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PMBT4403-PNP..> 23-Jun-2014 10:27  3.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PMEG4002EL-N..> 14-Jun-2014 18:18  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-PMEG4010CEH-..> 13-Jun-2014 18:43  1.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-15..> 23-Jun-2014 10:29  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-EC..> 20-Mar-2014 17:36  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-EZ..> 20-Mar-2014 08:10  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-Id..> 20-Mar-2014 17:35  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-Ne..> 20-Mar-2014 17:36  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-Ra..> 20-Mar-2014 17:37  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-TS..> 20-Mar-2014 08:12  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Panasonic-Y3..> 20-Mar-2014 08:11  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Pico-Spox-Wi..> 10-Mar-2014 16:16  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Pompes-Charg..> 24-Apr-2014 20:23  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Ponts-RLC-po..> 14-Jun-2014 18:23  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Portable-Ana..> 29-Mar-2014 11:16  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Premier-Farn..> 21-Mar-2014 08:11  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Produit-3430..> 14-Jun-2014 09:48  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Proskit-SS-3..> 10-Mar-2014 16:26  1.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Puissance-ut..> 11-Mar-2014 07:49  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Q48-PDF.htm     23-Jun-2014 10:29  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Radial-Lead-..> 20-Mar-2014 08:12  2.6M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Realiser-un-..> 11-Mar-2014 07:51  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Reglement-RE..> 21-Mar-2014 08:08  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Repartiteurs..> 14-Jun-2014 18:26  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-S-TRI-SWT860..> 21-Mar-2014 08:11  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SB175-Connec..> 11-Mar-2014 08:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SMBJ-Transil..> 29-Mar-2014 11:12  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SOT-23-Multi..> 11-Mar-2014 07:51  2.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SPLC780A1-16..> 14-Jun-2014 18:25  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SSC7102-Micr..> 23-Jun-2014 10:25  3.2M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-SVPE-series-..> 14-Jun-2014 18:15  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Sensorless-C..> 04-Jul-2014 10:42  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Septembre-20..> 20-Mar-2014 17:46  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Serie-PicoSc..> 19-Mar-2014 18:01  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Serie-Standa..> 14-Jun-2014 18:23  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Series-2600B..> 20-Mar-2014 17:30  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Series-TDS10..> 04-Jul-2014 10:39  4.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Signal-PCB-R..> 14-Jun-2014 18:11  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Strangkuhlko..> 21-Mar-2014 08:09  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Supercapacit..> 26-Mar-2014 17:57  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TDK-Lambda-H..> 14-Jun-2014 18:21  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-TEKTRONIX-DP..> 10-Mar-2014 17:20  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Tektronix-AC..> 13-Jun-2014 18:44  1.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Telemetres-l..> 20-Mar-2014 17:46  3.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-Termometros-..> 14-Jun-2014 18:14  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-The-essentia..> 10-Mar-2014 16:27  1.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-U2270B-PDF.htm  14-Jun-2014 18:15  3.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-USB-Buccanee..> 14-Jun-2014 09:48  2.5M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-USB1T11A-PDF..> 19-Mar-2014 18:03  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-V4N-PDF.htm     14-Jun-2014 18:11  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-WetTantalum-..> 11-Mar-2014 08:14  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-XPS-AC-Octop..> 14-Jun-2014 18:11  2.1M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-XPS-MC16-XPS..> 11-Mar-2014 08:15  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-YAGEO-DATA-S..> 11-Mar-2014 08:13  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ZigBee-ou-le..> 11-Mar-2014 07:50  2.4M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-celpac-SUL84..> 21-Mar-2014 08:11  3.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-china_rohs_o..> 21-Mar-2014 10:04  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-cree-Xlamp-X..> 20-Mar-2014 17:34  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-cree-Xlamp-X..> 20-Mar-2014 17:35  2.7M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-cree-Xlamp-X..> 20-Mar-2014 17:31  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-cree-Xlamp-m..> 20-Mar-2014 17:32  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-cree-Xlamp-m..> 20-Mar-2014 17:32  2.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-ir1150s_fr.p..> 29-Mar-2014 11:11  3.3M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-manual-bus-p..> 10-Mar-2014 16:29  1.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-propose-plus..> 11-Mar-2014 08:19  2.8M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-techfirst_se..> 21-Mar-2014 08:08  3.9M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-testo-205-20..> 20-Mar-2014 17:37  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-testo-470-Fo..> 20-Mar-2014 17:38  3.0M  

[TXT]

 Farnell-uC-OS-III-Br..> 10-Mar-2014 17:20  2.0M  

[TXT]

 Sefram-7866HD.pdf-PD..> 29-Mar-2014 11:46  472K  

[TXT]

 Sefram-CAT_ENREGISTR..> 29-Mar-2014 11:46  461K  

[TXT]

 Sefram-CAT_MESUREURS..> 29-Mar-2014 11:46  435K  

[TXT]

 Sefram-GUIDE_SIMPLIF..> 29-Mar-2014 11:46  481K  

[TXT]

 Sefram-GUIDE_SIMPLIF..> 29-Mar-2014 11:46  442K  

[TXT]

 Sefram-GUIDE_SIMPLIF..> 29-Mar-2014 11:46  422K  

[TXT]

 Sefram-SP270.pdf-PDF..> 29-Mar-2014 11:46  464K
LF to 2.5 GHz TruPwr™ Detector Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D Document Feedback Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other rights of third parties that may result from its use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A. Tel: 781.329.4700 ©2014 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Technical Support www.analog.com FEATURES Calibrated rms response Excellent temperature stability Up to 30 dB input range at 2.5 GHz 700 mV rms, 10 dBm, re 50 Ω maximum input ±0.25 dB linear response up to 2.5 GHz Single-supply operation: 2.7 V to 5.5 V Low power: 3.3 mW at 3 V supply Rapid power-down to less than 1 μA APPLICATIONS Measurement of CDMA, W-CDMA, QAM, other complex modulation waveforms RF transmitter or receiver power measurement GENERAL DESCRIPTION The AD8361 is a mean-responding power detector for use in high frequency receiver and transmitter signal chains, up to 2.5 GHz. It is very easy to apply. It requires a single supply only between 2.7 V and 5.5 V, a power supply decoupling capacitor, and an input coupling capacitor in most applications. The output is a linear-responding dc voltage with a conversion gain of 7.5 V/V rms. An external filter capacitor can be added to increase the averaging time constant. Figure 1. Output in the Three Reference Modes, Supply 3 V, Frequency 1.9 GHz (6-Lead SOT-23 Package Ground Reference Mode Only) FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAMS Figure 2. 8-Lead MSOP Figure 3. 6-Lead SOT-23 The AD8361 is intended for true power measurement of simple and complex waveforms. The device is particularly useful for measuring high crest-factor (high peak-to-rms ratio) signals, such as CDMA and W-CDMA. The AD8361 has three operating modes to accommodate a variety of analog-to-digital converter requirements: 1. Ground reference mode, in which the origin is zero. 2. Internal reference mode, which offsets the output 350 mV above ground. 3. Supply reference mode, which offsets the output to VS/7.5. The AD8361 is specified for operation from −40°C to +85°C and is available in 8-lead MSOP and 6-lead SOT-23 packages. It is fabricated on a proprietary high fT silicon bipolar process. RFIN (V rms) 3.0 1.6 0 0.1 0.5 0.20.30.4 2.6 2.2 2.0 1.8 2.8 2.4 V rms (Volts) 1.4 1.2 1.0 0.6 0.8 0.4 0.2 0.0 SUPPLY REFERENCE MODE INTERNAL REFERENCE MODE GROUND REFERENCE MODE 01088-C-001 RFIN IREF PWDN VPOS FLTR SREF VRMS COMM BAND-GAP REFERENCE ERROR AMP AD8361 INTERNAL FILTER ADD OFFSET TRANSCONDUCTANCE CELLS i i  7.5 BUFFER 2 2 01088-C-002 RFIN IREF PWDN VPOS FLTR VRMS COMM BAND-GAP REFERENCE ERROR AMP AD8361 INTERNAL FILTER TRANSCONDUCTANCE CELLS i i  7.5 BUFFER 2 2 01088-C-003 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 2 of 24 TABLE OF CONTENTS Features .............................................................................................. 1 Applications ....................................................................................... 1 General Description ......................................................................... 1 Functional Block Diagrams ............................................................. 1 Revision History ............................................................................... 2 Specifications ..................................................................................... 3 Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................ 4 ESD Caution .................................................................................. 4 Pin Configuration and Function Descriptions ............................. 5 Typical Performance Characteristics ..............................................6 Circuit Description......................................................................... 11 Applications ..................................................................................... 12 Output Reference Temperature Drift Compensation ........... 16 Evaluation Board ............................................................................ 21 Characterization Setups............................................................. 23 Outline Dimensions ....................................................................... 24 Ordering Guide .......................................................................... 24 REVISION HISTORY 3/14—Rev. C to Rev. D Changes to Ordering Guide .......................................................... 24 Updated Outline Dimensions ....................................................... 24 8/04—Data Sheet Changed from Rev. B to Rev. C Changed Trimpots to Trimmable Potentiometers ......... Universal Changes to Specifications ................................................................ 3 Changed Using the AD8361 Section Title to Applications ....... 12 Changes to Figure 43 ...................................................................... 14 Changes to Ordering Guide .......................................................... 24 Updated Outline Dimensions ....................................................... 24 2/01—Data Sheet Changed from Rev. A to Rev. B. Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 3 of 24 SPECIFICATIONS TA = 25°C, VS = 3 V, fRF = 900 MHz, ground reference output mode, unless otherwise noted. Table 1. Parameter Condition Min Typ Max Unit SIGNAL INPUT INTERFACE (Input RFIN) Frequency Range1 2.5 GHz Linear Response Upper Limit VS = 3 V 390 mV rms Equivalent dBm, re 50 Ω 4.9 dBm VS = 5 V 660 mV rms Equivalent dBm, re 50 Ω 9.4 dBm Input Impedance2 225||1 Ω||pF RMS CONVERSION (Input RFIN to Output V rms) Conversion Gain 7.5 V/V rms fRF = 100 MHz, VS = 5 V 6.5 8.5 V/V rms Dynamic Range Error Referred to Best Fit Line3 ±0.25 dB Error4 CW Input, −40°C < TA < +85°C 14 dB ±1 dB Error CW Input, −40°C < TA < +85°C 23 dB ±2 dB Error CW Input, −40°C < TA < +85°C 26 dB CW Input, VS = 5 V, −40°C < TA < +85°C 30 dB Intercept-Induced Dynamic Internal Reference Mode 1 dB Range Reduction5, 6 Supply Reference Mode, VS = 3.0 V 1 dB Supply Reference Mode, VS = 5.0 V 1.5 dB Deviation from CW Response 5.5 dB Peak-to-Average Ratio (IS95 Reverse Link) 0.2 dB 12 dB Peak-to-Average Ratio (W-CDMA 4 Channels) 1.0 dB 18 dB Peak-to-Average Ratio (W-CDMA 15 Channels) 1.2 dB OUTPUT INTERCEPT5 Inferred from Best Fit Line3 Ground Reference Mode (GRM) 0 V at SREF, VS at IREF 0 V fRF = 100 MHz, VS = 5 V −50 +150 mV Internal Reference Mode (IRM) 0 V at SREF, IREF Open 350 mV fRF = 100 MHz, VS = 5 V 300 500 mV Supply Reference Mode (SRM) 3 V at IREF, 3 V at SREF 400 mV VS at IREF, VS at SREF VS/7.5 V fRF = 100 MHz, VS = 5 V 590 750 mV POWER-DOWN INTERFACE PWDN HI Threshold 2.7 ≤ VS ≤ 5.5 V, −40°C < TA < +85°C VS − 0.5 V PWDN LO Threshold 2.7 ≤ VS ≤ 5.5 V, −40°C < TA < +85°C 0.1 V Power-Up Response Time 2 pF at FLTR Pin, 224 mV rms at RFIN 5 μs 100 nF at FLTR Pin, 224 mV rms at RFIN 320 μs PWDN Bias Current <1 μA POWER SUPPLIES Operating Range −40°C < TA < +85°C 2.7 5.5 V Quiescent Current 0 mV rms at RFIN, PWDN Input LO7 1.1 mA Power-Down Current GRM or IRM, 0 mV rms at RFIN, PWDN Input HI <1 μA SRM, 0 mV rms at RFIN, PWDN Input HI 10 × VS μA 1 Operation at arbitrarily low frequencies is possible; see Applications section. 2 Figure 17 and Figure 47 show impedance versus frequency for the MSOP and SOT-23, respectively. 3 Calculated using linear regression. 4 Compensated for output reference temperature drift; see Applications section. 5 SOT-23-6L operates in ground reference mode only. 6 The available output swing, and hence the dynamic range, is altered by both supply voltage and reference mode; see Figure 39 and Figure 40. 7 Supply current is input level dependent; see Figure 16. AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 4 of 24 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS Table 2. Parameter Rating Supply Voltage VS 5.5 V SREF, PWDN 0 V, VS IREF VS − 0.3 V, VS RFIN 1 V rms Equivalent Power, re 50 Ω 13 dBm Internal Power Dissipation1 200 mW 6-Lead SOT-23 170 mW 8-Lead MSOP 200 mW Maximum Junction Temperature 125°C Operating Temperature Range −40°C to +85°C Storage Temperature Range −65°C to +150°C Lead Temperature Range (Soldering 60 sec) 300°C 1 Specification is for the device in free air. 6-Lead SOT-23: θJA = 230°C/W; θJC = 92°C/W. 8-Lead MSOP: θJA = 200°C/W; θJC = 44°C/W. Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only; functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operational section of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. ESD CAUTION Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 5 of 24 PIN CONFIGURATION AND FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS Figure 4. 8-Lead MSOP Figure 5. 6-Lead SOT-23 Table 3. Pin Function Descriptions Pin No. MSOP Pin No. SOT-23 Mnemonic Description 1 6 VPOS Supply Voltage Pin. Operational range 2.7 V to 5.5 V. 2 N/A IREF Output Reference Control Pin. Internal reference mode enabled when pin is left open; otherwise, this pin should be tied to VPOS. Do not ground this pin. 3 5 RFIN Signal Input Pin. Must be driven from an ac-coupled source. The low frequency real input impedance is 225 Ω. 4 4 PWDN Power-Down Pin. For the device to operate as a detector, it needs a logical low input (less than 100 mV). When a logic high (greater than VS − 0.5 V) is applied, the device is turned off and the supply current goes to nearly zero (ground and internal reference mode less than 1 μA, supply reference mode VS divided by 100 kΩ). 5 2 COMM Device Ground Pin. 6 3 FLTR By placing a capacitor between this pin and VPOS, the corner frequency of the modulation filter is lowered. The on-chip filter is formed with 27 pF||2 kΩ for small input signals. 7 1 VRMS Output Pin. Near rail-to-rail voltage output with limited current drive capabilities. Expected load >10 kΩ to ground. 8 N/A SREF Supply Reference Control Pin. To enable supply reference mode, this pin must be connected to VPOS; otherwise, it should be connected to COMM (ground). VPOS 1 IREF 2 RFIN 3 PWDN 4 8 SREF 7 VRMS 6 FLTR 5 COMM AD8361 TOP VIEW (Not to Scale) 01088-C-004 VRMS 1 COMM 2 FLTR 3 6 VPOS 5 RFIN 4 PWDN AD8361 TOP VIEW (Not to Scale) 01088-C-005 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 6 of 24 TYPICAL PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS Figure 6. Output vs. Input Level, Frequencies 100 MHz, 900 MHz, 1900 MHz, and 2500 MHz, Supply 2.7 V, Ground Reference Mode, MSOP Figure 7. Output vs. Input Level, Supply 2.7 V, 3.0 V, 5.0 V, and 5.5 V, Frequency 900 MHz Figure 8. Output vs. Input Level with Different Waveforms Sine Wave (CW), IS95 Reverse Link, W-CDMA 4-Channel and W-CDMA 15-Channel, Supply 5.0 V Figure 9. Error from Linear Reference vs. Input Level, 3 Sigma to Either Side of Mean, Sine Wave, Supply 3.0 V, Frequency 900 MHz Figure 10. Error from Linear Reference vs. Input Level, 3 Sigma to Either Side of Mean, Sine Wave, Supply 5.0 V, Frequency 900 MHz Figure 11. Error from CW Linear Reference vs. Input with Different Waveforms Sine Wave (CW), IS95 Reverse Link, W-CDMA 4-Channel and W-CDMA 15-Channel, Supply 3.0 V, Frequency 900 MHz INPUT (V rms)2.82.60.800.50.10.20.30.42.01.41.21.02.42.21.61.8OUTPUT ( V)0.60.40.20.0900MHz100MHz1900MHz2.5GHz01088-C-006INPUT (V rms)5.51.500.50.10.20.30.44.03.02.52.05.04.53.5OUTPUT ( V)1.00.50.05.5V5.0V3.0V2.7V0.60.70.801088-C-007INPUT (V rms)5.01.500.50.10.20.30.44.03.02.52.04.53.5OUTPUT ( V)1.00.50.00.60.70.8CWIS95REVERSE LINKWCDMA4- AND 15-CHANNEL01088-C-008INPUT (V rms)3.02.5–1.00.4(+5dBm)0.011.50–0.52.00.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.5–2.0–2.5–3.00.1(–7dBm)0.02(–21dBm)MEAN±3 SIGMA01088-C-009INPUT (V rms)3.02.5–1.00.6(+8.6dBm)0.011.50–0.52.00.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.5–2.0–2.5–3.00.10.02MEAN±3 SIGMA(–7dBm)(–21dBm)01088-C-010INPUT ( V rms)3.02.5–1.01.00.010.11.50.0–0.52.00.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.5–2.0–2.5–3.00.020.60.2IS95REVERSE LINKCW15-CHANNEL4-CHANNEL01088-C-011 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 7 of 24 Figure 12. Error from CW Linear Reference vs. Input, 3 Sigma to Either Side of Mean, IS95 Reverse Link Signal, Supply 3.0 V, Frequency 900 MHz Figure 13. Error from CW Linear Reference vs. Input Level, 3 Sigma to Either Side of Mean, IS95 Reverse Link Signal, Supply 5.0 V, Frequency 900 MHz Figure 14. Output Delta from +25°C vs. Input Level, 3 Sigma to Either Side of Mean Sine Wave, Supply 3.0 V, Frequency 900 MHz, Temperature −40°C to +85°C Figure 15. Output Delta from +25°C vs. Input Level, 3 Sigma to Either Side of Mean Sine Wave, Supply 3.0 V, Frequency 1900 MHz, Temperature −40°C to +85°C Figure 16. Supply Current vs. Input Level, Supplies 3.0 V, and 5.0 V, Temperatures −40°C, +25°C, and +85°C Figure 17. Input Impedance vs. Frequency, Supply 3 V, Temperatures −40°C, +25°C, and +85°C, MSOP (See Applications for SOT-23 Data) 3.02.5–1.00.4(+5dBm)0.011.50–0.52.00.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.5–2.02.5–3.00.10.02MEAN±3 SIGMAINPUT (V rms)(–7dBm)(–21dBm)01088-C-012INPUT ( V rms)3.02.5–1.00.6(+8.6dBm)0.011.50–0.52.00.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.5–2.0–2.5–3.00.10.02MEAN±3 SIGMA(–7dBm)(–21dBm)01088-C-013INPUT ( V rms)3.02.5–1.00.4(+5dBm)0.011.50–0.52.00.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.5–2.0–2.5–3.00.10.02–40°C+85°C(–7dBm)(–21dBm)01088-C-014INPUT ( V rms)3.02.5–1.00.4(+5dBm)0.011.50–0.52.00.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.5–2.0–2.5–3.00.10.02(–7dBm)(–21dBm)–40°C+85°C01088-C-015INPUT (V rms)11300.50.10.20.30.486541097SUPPLY CURRENT ( mA)2100.60.70.8+85°C–40°C+25°CVS = 5VINPUT OUTOF RANGE+25°C+85°C–40°CVS = 3VINPUT OUTOF RANGE01088-C-016FREQUENCY (MHz)05001000250200150SHUNT RESISTANCE ( Ω)100500200025001.41.21.0SHUNT CAPACITANCE ( pF)0.80.60.41500+85°C+25°C–40°C+85°C+25°C–40°C1.61.801088-C-017 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 8 of 24 Figure 18. Output Reference Change vs. Temperature, Supply 3 V, Ground Reference Mode Figure 19. Output Reference Change vs. Temperature, Supply 3 V, Internal Reference Mode (MSOP Only) Figure 20. Output Reference Change vs. Temperature, Supply 3 V, Supply Reference Mode (MSOP Only) Figure 21. Conversion Gain Change vs. Temperature, Supply 3 V, Ground Reference Mode, Frequency 900 MHz Figure 22. Conversion Gain Change vs. Temperature, Supply 3 V, Internal Reference Mode, Frequency 900 MHz (MSOP Only) Figure 23. Conversion Gain Change vs. Temperature, Supply 3 V, Supply Reference Mode, Frequency 900 MHz (MSOP Only) TEMPERATURE (°C)–0.0240–40–200200.030.010.00–0.010.02INTERCEPT CHANGE ( V)–0.03–0.04–0.056080100MEAN±3 SIGMA01088-C-018TEMPERATURE (°C)–0.0140–40–200200.020.010.00INTERCEPT CHANGE ( V)–0.02–0.036080100MEAN±3 SIGMA01088-C-019TEMPERATURE (°C)–0.0240–40–200200.030.010.00–0.010.02INTERCEPT CHANGE ( V)–0.03–0.04–0.056080100MEAN±3 SIGMA01088-C-020TEMPERATURE (°C)0.0240–40–200200.120.080.060.040.10GAIN CHANGE ( V/V rms)0.00–0.02–0.046080100MEAN±3 SIGMA–0.060.140.160.1801088-C-021TEMPERATURE (°C)0.0240–40–200200.120.080.060.040.10GAIN CHANGE ( V/V rms)0.00–0.02–0.046080100MEAN±3 SIGMA–0.060.140.160.1801088-C-022TEMPERATURE (°C)0.0240–40–200200.120.080.060.040.10GAIN CHANGE ( V/V rms)0.00–0.02–0.046080100MEAN±3 SIGMA–0.060.140.160.1801088-C-023 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 9 of 24 Figure 24. Output Response to Modulated Pulse Input for Various RF Input Levels, Supply 3 V, Modulation Frequency 900 MHz, No Filter Capacitor Figure 25. Output Response to Modulated Pulse Input for Various RF Input Levels, Supply 3 V, Modulation Frequency 900 MHz, 0.01 μF Filter Capacitor Figure 26. Hardware Configuration for Output Response to Modulated Pulse Input Figure 27. Output Response Using Power-Down Mode for Various RF Input Levels, Supply 3 V, Frequency 900 MHz, No Filter Capacitor Figure 28. Output Response Using Power-Down Mode for Various RF Input Levels, Supply 3 V, Frequency 900 MHz, 0.01 μF Filter Capacitor Figure 29. Hardware Configuration for Output Response Using Power-Down Mode 67mV 370mV 270mV 25mV 5s PER HORIZONTAL DIVISION GATE PULSE FOR 900MHz RF TONE RF INPUT 500mV PER VERTICAL DIVISION 01088-C-024 67mV 370mV 25mV 500mV PER VERTICAL DIVISION 50s PER HORIZONTAL DIVISION RF INPUT GATEPULSEFOR 900MHzRFTONE 270mV 01088-C-025 R1 75 0.1F HPE3631A POWER SUPPLY C4 0.01F C2 100pF HP8648B SIGNAL GENERATOR C1 C3 TEK TDS784C SCOPE C5 100pF TEK P6204 FET PROBE 1 2 3 4 8 7 6 5 AD8361 VPOS IREF RFIN PWDN SREF VRMS FLTR COMM 01088-C-026 RF INPUT 67mV 370mV 270mV 25mV 500mV PER VERTICAL DIVISION PWDN INPUT 2s PER HORIZONTAL DIVISION 01088-C-027 67mV 370mV 270mV 25mV 500mV PER VERTICAL DIVISION PWDN INPUT RF INPUT 01088-C-028 20s PER HORIZONTAL DIVISION R1 75 0.1F HPE3631A POWER SUPPLY C4 0.01F C2 100pF HP8648B SIGNAL GENERATOR HP8110A SIGNAL GENERATOR C1 C3 TEK TDS784C SCOPE C5 100pF TEK P6204 FET PROBE 1 2 3 4 8 7 6 5 AD8361 VPOS IREF RFIN PWDN SREF VRMS FLTR COMM 01088-C-029 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 10 of 24 Figure 30. Conversion Gain Change vs. Frequency, Supply 3 V, Ground Reference Mode, Frequency 100 MHz to 2500 MHz, Representative Device Figure 31. Output Response to Gating on Power Supply, for Various RF Input Levels, Supply 3 V, Modulation Frequency 900 MHz, 0.01 μF Filter Capacitor Figure 32. Hardware Configuration for Output Response to Power Supply Gating Measurements Figure 33. Conversion Gain Distribution Frequency 100 MHz, Supply 5 V, Sample Size 3000 Figure 34. Output Reference, Internal Reference Mode, Supply 5 V, Sample Size 3000 (MSOP Only) Figure 35. Output Reference, Supply Reference Mode, Supply 5 V, Sample Size 3000 (MSOP Only) CARRIER FREQUENCY (MHz)7.87.66.210010007.26.66.47.46.87.0CONVERSION GAIN ( V/V rms)6.05.85.6VS= 3V01088-C-03067mV370mV270mV25mV500mV PERVERTICALDIVISIONSUPPLY20μs PER HORIZONTAL DIVISIONRFINPUT01088-C-031R175Ω732Ω50Ω0.1μFC40.01μFC2100pFHP8648BSIGNALGENERATORC1C3TEK TDS784CSCOPEC5100pFTEK P6204FET PROBE12348765AD8361VPOSIREFRFINPWDNSREFVRMSFLTRCOMM01088-C-032HP8110APULSEGENERATORAD811CONVERSION GAIN (V/V rms)7.66.97.07.216PERCENT7.47.81412108642001088-C-033IREF MODE INTERCEPT (V)0.400.320.340.36PERCENT0.380.441210864200.4201088-C-034SREF MODE INTERCEPT (V)0.720.640.660.68PERCENT0.700.761210864200.7401088-C-035 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 11 of 24 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION The AD8361 is an rms-responding (mean power) detector that provides an approach to the exact measurement of RF power that is basically independent of waveform. It achieves this function through the use of a proprietary technique in which the outputs of two identical squaring cells are balanced by the action of a high-gain error amplifier. The signal to be measured is applied to the input of the first squaring cell, which presents a nominal (LF) resistance of 225 Ω between the RFIN and COMM pins (connected to the ground plane). Because the input pin is at a bias voltage of about 0.8 V above ground, a coupling capacitor is required. By making this an external component, the measurement range may be extended to arbitrarily low frequencies. The AD8361 responds to the voltage, VIN, at its input by squaring this voltage to generate a current proportional to VIN squared. This is applied to an internal load resistor, across which a capacitor is connected. These form a low-pass filter, which extracts the mean of VIN squared. Although essentially voltage-responding, the associated input impedance calibrates this port in terms of equivalent power. Therefore, 1 mW corresponds to a voltage input of 447 mV rms. The Applications section shows how to match this input to 50 Ω. The voltage across the low-pass filter, whose frequency may be arbitrarily low, is applied to one input of an error-sensing amplifier. A second identical voltage-squaring cell is used to close a negative feedback loop around this error amplifier. This second cell is driven by a fraction of the quasi-dc output voltage of the AD8361. When the voltage at the input of the second squaring cell is equal to the rms value of VIN, the loop is in a stable state, and the output then represents the rms value of the input. The feedback ratio is nominally 0.133, making the rms-dc conversion gain ×7.5, that is rmsVVINOUT×=5.7 By completing the feedback path through a second squaring cell, identical to the one receiving the signal to be measured, several benefits arise. First, scaling effects in these cells cancel; thus, the overall calibration may be accurate, even though the open-loop response of the squaring cells taken separately need not be. Note that in implementing rms-dc conversion, no reference voltage enters into the closed-loop scaling. Second, the tracking in the responses of the dual cells remains very close over temperature, leading to excellent stability of calibration. The squaring cells have very wide bandwidth with an intrinsic response from dc to microwave. However, the dynamic range of such a system is fairly small, due in part to the much larger dynamic range at the output of the squaring cells. There are practical limitations to the accuracy of sensing very small error signals at the bottom end of the dynamic range, arising from small random offsets that limit the attainable accuracy at small inputs. On the other hand, the squaring cells in the AD8361 have a Class-AB aspect; the peak input is not limited by their quiescent bias condition but is determined mainly by the eventual loss of square-law conformance. Consequently, the top end of their response range occurs at a fairly large input level (approximately 700 mV rms) while preserving a reasonably accurate square-law response. The maximum usable range is, in practice, limited by the output swing. The rail-to-rail output stage can swing from a few millivolts above ground to less than 100 mV below the supply. An example of the output induced limit: given a gain of 7.5 and assuming a maximum output of 2.9 V with a 3 V supply, the maximum input is (2.9 V rms)/7.5 or 390 mV rms. Filtering An important aspect of rms-dc conversion is the need for averaging (the function is root-MEAN-square). For complex RF waveforms, such as those that occur in CDMA, the filtering provided by the on-chip, low-pass filter, although satisfactory for CW signals above 100 MHz, is inadequate when the signal has modulation components that extend down into the kilohertz region. For this reason, the FLTR pin is provided: a capacitor attached between this pin and VPOS can extend the averaging time to very low frequencies. Offset An offset voltage can be added to the output (when using the MSOP version) to allow the use of ADCs whose range does not extend down to ground. However, accuracy at the low end degrades because of the inherent error in this added voltage. This requires that the IREF (internal reference) pin be tied to VPOS and SREF (supply reference) to ground. In the IREF mode, the intercept is generated by an internal reference cell and is a fixed 350 mV, independent of the supply voltage. To enable this intercept, IREF should be open-circuited, and SREF should be grounded. In the SREF mode, the voltage is provided by the supply. To implement this mode, tie IREF to VPOS and SREF to VPOS. The offset is then proportional to the supply voltage and is 400 mV for a 3 V supply and 667 mV for a 5 V supply. AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 12 of 24 APPLICATIONS Basic Connections Figure 36 through Figure 38 show the basic connections for the AD8361’s MSOP version in its three operating modes. In all modes, the device is powered by a single supply of between 2.7 V and 5.5 V. The VPOS pin is decoupled using 100 pF and 0.01 μF capacitors. The quiescent current of 1.1 mA in operating mode can be reduced to 1 μA by pulling the PWDN pin up to VPOS. A 75 Ω external shunt resistance combines with the ac-coupled input to give an overall broadband input impedance near 50 Ω. Note that the coupling capacitor must be placed between the input and the shunt impedance. Input impedance and input coupling are discussed in more detail below. The input coupling capacitor combines with the internal input resistance (Figure 37) to provide a high-pass corner frequency given by the equation INCRCf××=π21dB3 With the 100 pF capacitor shown in Figure 36 through Figure 38, the high-pass corner frequency is about 8 MHz. Figure 36. Basic Connections for Ground Reference Mode Figure 37. Basic Connections for Internal Reference Mode Figure 38. Basic Connections for Supply Referenced Mode The output voltage is nominally 7.5 times the input rms voltage (a conversion gain of 7.5 V/V rms). Three modes of operation are set by the SREF and IREF pins. In addition to the ground reference mode shown in Figure 36, where the output voltage swings from around near ground to 4.9 V on a 5.0 V supply, two additional modes allow an offset voltage to be added to the output. In the internal reference mode (Figure 37), the output voltage swing is shifted upward by an internal reference voltage of 350 mV. In supply referenced mode (Figure 38), an offset voltage of VS/7.5 is added to the output voltage. Table 4 summarizes the connections, output transfer function, and minimum output voltage (i.e., zero signal) for each mode. Output Swing Figure 39 shows the output swing of the AD8361 for a 5 V supply voltage for each of the three modes. It is clear from Figure 39 that operating the device in either internal reference mode or supply referenced mode reduces the effective dynamic range as the output headroom decreases. The response for lower supply voltages is similar (in the supply referenced mode, the offset is smaller), but the dynamic range reduces further as headroom decreases. Figure 40 shows the response of the AD8361 to a CW input for various supply voltages. Figure 39. Output Swing for Ground, Internal, and Supply Referenced Mode, VPOS = 5 V (MSOP Only) 12348765AD8361VPOSIREFRFINPWDNSREFVRMSFLTRCOMMR175Ω0.01μFCC100pFCFLTR100pF+VS 2.7V– 5.5VRFINV rms01088-C-03612348765AD8361VPOSIREFRFINPWDNSREFVRMSFLTRCOMMR175Ω0.01μFCC100pFCFLTR100pF+VS 2.7V– 5.5VRFINV rms01088-C-03712348765AD8361VPOSIREFRFINPWDNSREFVRMSFLTRCOMMR175Ω0.01μFCC100pFCFLTR100pF+VS 2.7V– 5.5VRFINV rms01088-C-038INPUT (V rms)5.04.50.000.50.10.20.30.43.01.51.00.54.03.52.02.5OUTPUT ( V)SUPPLY REFINTERNAL REFGROUND REF0.60.70.801088-C-039 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 13 of 24 Figure 40. Output Swing for Supply Voltages of 2.7 V, 3.0 V, 5.0 V and 5.5 V (MSOP Only) Dynamic Range Because the AD8361 is a linear-responding device with a nominal transfer function of 7.5 V/V rms, the dynamic range in dB is not clear from plots such as Figure 39. As the input level is increased in constant dB steps, the output step size (per dB) also increases. Figure 41 shows the relationship between the output step size (i.e., mV/dB) and input voltage for a nominal transfer function of 7.5 V/V rms. Table 4. Connections and Nominal Transfer Function for Ground, Internal, and Supply Reference Modes Reference Mode IREF SREF Output Intercept (No Signal) Output Ground VPOS COMM Zero 7.5 VIN Internal OPEN COMM 0.350 V 7.5 VIN + 0.350 V Supply VPOS VPOS VS/7.5 7.5 VIN + VS/7.5 Figure 41. Idealized Output Step Size as a Function of Input Voltage Plots of output voltage versus input voltage result in a straight line. It may sometimes be more useful to plot the error on a logarithmic scale, as shown in Figure 42. The deviation of the plot for the ideal straight line characteristic is caused by output clipping at the high end and by signal offsets at the low end. It should however be noted that offsets at the low end can be either positive or negative, so this plot could also trend upwards at the low end. Figure 9, Figure 10, Figure 12, and Figure 13 show a ±3 sigma distribution of the device error for a large population of devices. Figure 42. Representative Unit, Error in dB vs. Input Level, VS = 2.7 V It is also apparent in Figure 42 that the error plot tends to shift to the right with increasing frequency. Because the input impedance decreases with frequency, the voltage actually applied to the input also tends to decrease (assuming a constant source impedance over frequency). The dynamic range is almost constant over frequency, but with a small decrease in conversion gain at high frequency. Input Coupling and Matching The input impedance of the AD8361 decreases with increasing frequency in both its resistive and capacitive components (Figure 17). The resistive component varies from 225 Ω at 100 MHz down to about 95 Ω at 2.5 GHz. A number of options exist for input matching. For operation at multiple frequencies, a 75 Ω shunt to ground, as shown in Figure 43, provides the best overall match. For use at a single frequency, a resistive or a reactive match can be used. By plotting the input impedance on a Smith Chart, the best value for a resistive match can be calculated. The VSWR can be held below 1.5 at frequencies up to 1 GHz, even as the input impedance varies from part to part. (Both input impedance and input capacitance can vary by up to ±20% around their nominal values.) At very high frequencies (i.e., 1.8 GHz to 2.5 GHz), a shunt resistor is not sufficient to reduce the VSWR below 1.5. Where VSWR is critical, remove the shunt component and insert an inductor in series with the coupling capacitor as shown in Figure 44. Table 5 gives recommended shunt resistor values for various frequencies and series inductor values for high frequencies. The coupling capacitor, CC, essentially acts as an ac-short and plays no intentional part in the matching. INPUT (V rms)5.51.500.50.10.20.30.44.03.02.52.05.04.53.5OUTPUT ( V)1.00.50.05.5V5.0V3.0V2.7V0.60.70.801088-C-040INPUT (mV)7002000500100200300400500400300600mV/dB100060070080001088-C-041INPUT (V rms)2.0–0.50.010.50.01.51.0ERROR ( dB)–1.0–1.5–2.01.01.9GHz2.5GHz900MHz100MHz100MHz0.02(–21dBm)0.1(–7dBm)0.4(+5dBm)01088-C-042 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 14 of 24 Figure 43. Input Coupling/Matching Options, Broadband Resistor Match Figure 44. Input Coupling/Matching Options, Series Inductor Match Figure 45. Input Coupling/Matching Options, Narrowband Reactive Match Figure 46. Input Coupling/Matching Options, Attenuating the Input Signal Table 5. Recommended Component Values for Resistive or Inductive Input Matching (Figure 43 and Figure 44) Frequency Matching Component 100 MHz 63.4 Ω Shunt 800 MHz 75 Ω Shunt 900 MHz 75 Ω Shunt 1800 MHz 150 Ω Shunt or 4.7 nH Series 1900 MHz 150 Ω Shunt or 4.7 nH Series 2500 MHz 150 Ω Shunt or 2.7 nH Series Alternatively, a reactive match can be implemented using a shunt inductor to ground and a series capacitor, as shown in Figure 45. A method for hand calculating the appropriate matching components is shown on page 12 of the AD8306 data sheet. Matching in this manner results in very small values for CM, especially at high frequencies. As a result, a stray capacitance as small as 1 pF can significantly degrade the quality of the match. The main advantage of a reactive match is the increase in sensitivity that results from the input voltage being gained up (by the square root of the impedance ratio) by the matching network. Table 6 shows the recommended values for reactive matching. Table 6. Recommended Values for a Reactive Input Matching (Figure 45) Frequency (MHz) CM (pF) LM (nH) 100 16 180 800 2 15 900 2 12 1800 1.5 4.7 1900 1.5 4.7 2500 1.5 3.3 Input Coupling Using a Series Resistor Figure 46 shows a technique for coupling the input signal into the AD8361 that may be applicable where the input signal is much larger than the input range of the AD8361. A series resistor combines with the input impedance of the AD8361 to attenuate the input signal. Because this series resistor forms a divider with the frequency dependent input impedance, the apparent gain changes greatly with frequency. However, this method has the advantage of very little power being tapped off in RF power transmission applications. If the resistor is large compared to the transmission line’s impedance, then the VSWR of the system is relatively unaffected. Figure 47. Input Impedance vs. Frequency, Supply 3 V, SOT-23 Selecting the Filter Capacitor The AD8361’s internal 27 pF filter capacitor is connected in parallel with an internal resistance that varies with signal level from 2 kΩ for small signals to 500 Ω for large signals. The resulting low-pass corner frequency between 3 MHz and 12 MHz provides adequate filtering for all frequencies above 240 MHz (i.e., 10 times the frequency at the output of the squarer, which is twice the input frequency). However, signals with high peak-to-average ratios, such as CDMA or W-CDMA signals, and low frequency components require additional filtering. TDMA signals, such as GSM, PDC, or PHS, have a peak-to average ratio that is close to that of a sinusoid, and the internal filter is adequate. AD8361 RFIN RFIN RSH 01088-C-043 CC AD8361 RFIN RFIN LM 01088-C-044 CC AD8361 RFIN RFIN 01088-C-045 CM CC LM AD8361 RFIN RFIN 01088-C-046 RSERIES CC FREQUENCY (MHz) 200 0 500 RESISTANCE () 100 0 250 150 50 1000 15002000250030003500 0.2 0.5 0.8 1.1 1.4 1.7 CAPACITANCE (pF) 01088-C-047 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 15 of 24 The filter capacitance of the AD8361 can be augmented by connecting a capacitor between Pin 6 (FLTR) and VPOS. Table 7 shows the effect of several capacitor values for various communications standards with high peak-to-average ratios along with the residual ripple at the output, in peak-to-peak and rms volts. Note that large filter capacitors increase the enable and pulse response times, as discussed below. Table 7. Effect of Waveform and CFILT on Residual AC Output Residual AC Waveform CFILT V dc mV p-p mV rms IS95 Reverse Link Open 0.5 550 100 1.0 1000 180 2.0 2000 360 0.01 μF 0.5 40 6 1.0 160 20 2.0 430 60 0.1 μF 0.5 20 3 1.0 40 6 2.0 110 18 IS95 8-Channel 0.01 μF 0.5 290 40 Forward Link 1.0 975 150 2.0 2600 430 0.1 μF 0.5 50 7 1.0 190 30 2.0 670 95 W-CDMA 15 0.01 μF 0.5 225 35 Channel 1.0 940 135 2.0 2500 390 0.1 μF 0.5 45 6 1.0 165 25 2.0 550 80 Operation at Low Frequencies Although the AD8361 is specified for operation up to 2.5 GHz, there is no lower limit on the operating frequency. It is only necessary to increase the input coupling capacitor to reduce the corner frequency of the input high-pass filter (use an input resistance of 225 Ω for frequencies below 100 MHz). It is also necessary to increase the filter capacitor so that the signal at the output of the squaring circuit is free of ripple. The corner frequency is set by the combination of the internal resistance of 2 kΩ and the external filter capacitance. Power Consumption, Enable and Power-On The quiescent current consumption of the AD8361 varies with the size of the input signal from about 1 mA for no signal up to 7 mA at an input level of 0.66 V rms (9.4 dBm, re 50 Ω). If the input is driven beyond this point, the supply current increases steeply (see Figure 16). There is little variation in quiescent current with power supply voltage. The AD8361 can be disabled either by pulling the PWDN (Pin 4) to VPOS or by simply turning off the power to the device. While turning off the device obviously eliminates the current consumption, disabling the device reduces the leakage current to less than 1 μA. Figure 27 and Figure 28 show the response of the output of the AD8361 to a pulse on the PWDN pin, with no capacitance and with a filter capacitance of 0.01 μF, respectively; the turn-on time is a function of the filter capacitor. Figure 31 shows a plot of the output response to the supply being turned on (i.e., PWDN is grounded and VPOS is pulsed) with a filter capacitor of 0.01 μF. Again, the turn-on time is strongly influenced by the size of the filter capacitor. If the input of the AD8361 is driven while the device is disabled (PWDN = VPOS), the leakage current of less than 1 μA increases as a function of input level. When the device is disabled, the output impedance increases to approximately 16 kΩ. Volts to dBm Conversion In many of the plots, the horizontal axis is scaled in both rms volts and dBm. In all cases, dBm are calculated relative to an impedance of 50 Ω. To convert between dBm and volts in a 50 Ω system, the following equations can be used. Figure 48 shows this conversion in graphical form. ()()()()222010logW0.001Ω5010logdBmrmsVrmsVPower== ()20/10log10logΩ50W0.00111dBmdBmrmsV−−=  ××= Figure 48. Conversion from dBm to rms Volts V rmsdBm+20+100–10–20–30–4010.10.010.00101088-C-048 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 16 of 24 Output Drive Capability and Buffering The AD8361 is capable of sourcing an output current of approximately 3 mA. If additional current is required, a simple buffering circuit can be used as shown in Figure 51. Similar circuits can be used to increase or decrease the nominal conversion gain of 7.5 V/V rms (Figure 49 and Figure 50). In Figure 50, the AD8031 buffers a resistive divider to give a slope of 3.75 V/V rms. In Figure 49, the op amp’s gain of two increases the slope to 15 V/V rms. Using other resistor values, the slope can be changed to an arbitrary value. The AD8031 rail-to-rail op amp, used in these example, can swing from 50 mV to 4.95 V on a single 5 V supply and operate at supply voltages down to 2.7 V. If high output current is required (>10 mA), the AD8051, which also has rail-to- rail capability, can be used down to a supply voltage of 3 V. It can deliver up to 45 mA of output current. Figure 49. Output Buffering Options, Slope of 15 V/V rms Figure 50. Output Buffering Options, Slope of 3.75 V/V rms Figure 51. Output Buffering Options, Slope of 7.5 V/V rms OUTPUT REFERENCE TEMPERATURE DRIFT COMPENSATION The error due to low temperature drift of the AD8361 can be reduced if the temperature is known. Many systems incorporate a temperature sensor; the output of the sensor is typically digitized, facilitating a software correction. Using this information, only a two-point calibration at ambient is required. The output voltage of the AD8361 at ambient (25°C) can be expressed by the equation     OUT VIN GAIN V where GAIN is the conversion gain in V/V rms and VOS is the extrapolated output voltage for an input level of 0 V. GAIN and VOS (also referred to as intercept and output reference) can be calculated at ambient using a simple two-point calibration by measuring the output voltages for two specific input levels. Calibration at roughly 35 mV rms (−16 dBm) and 250 mV rms (+1 dBm) is recommended for maximum linear dynamic range. However, alternative levels and ranges can be chosen to suit the application. GAIN and VOS are then calculated using the equations   IN2 IN1 OUT2 OUT1 V V V V GAIN      OS OUT1 VIN1 GAIN V V   Both GAIN and VOS drift over temperature. However, the drift of VOS has a bigger influence on the error relative to the output. This can be seen by inserting data from Figure 18 and Figure 21 (intercept drift and conversion gain) into the equation for VOUT. These plots are consistent with Figure 14 and Figure 15, which show that the error due to temperature drift decreases with increasing input level. This results from the offset error having a diminishing influence with increasing level on the overall measurement error. From Figure 18, the average intercept drift is 0.43 mV/°C from −40°C to +25°C and 0.17 mV/°C from +25°C to +85°C. For a less rigorous compensation scheme, the average drift over the complete temperature range can be calculated as       C /V0.000304 C 40C85 V 0.028V0.010 C /V                DRIFTVOS With the drift of VOS included, the equation for VOUT becomes VOUT = (GAIN × VIN) + VOS + DRIFTVOS × (TEMP − 25°C) 0.01F 100pF 0.01F AD8361 VOUT VPOS COMM PWDN 5k 5k 5V AD8031 15V/V rms 01088-C-049 0.01F 100pF 0.01F AD8361 VOUT VPOS COMM PWDN 5V 5k AD8031 3.75V/V rms 5k 10k 01088-C-050 0.01F 100pF 0.01F AD8361 VOUT VPOS COMM PWDN 5V AD8031 7.5V/V rms 01088-C-051 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 17 of 24 The equation can be rewritten to yield a temperature compensated value for VIN: ()()GAINTEMPDRIFTVVVVOSOSOUTINC25°−×−−= Figure 52 shows the output voltage and error (in dB) as a function of input level for a typical device (note that output voltage is plotted on a logarithmic scale). Figure 53 shows the error in the calculated input level after the temperature compensation algorithm has been applied. For a supply voltage of 5 V, the part exhibits a worst-case linearity error over temperature of approximately ±0.3 dB over a dynamic range of 35 dB. Figure 52. Typical Output Voltage and Error vs. Input Level, 800 MHz, VPOS = 5 V Figure 53. Error after Temperature Compensation of Output Reference,800 MHz, VPOS = 5 V Extended Frequency Characterization Although the AD8361 was originally intended as a power measurement and control device for cellular wireless applications, the AD8361 has useful performance at higher frequencies. Typical applications may include MMDS, LMDS, WLAN, and other noncellular activities. In order to characterize the AD8361 at frequencies greater than 2.5 GHz, a small collection of devices were tested. Dynamic range, conversion gain, and output intercept were measured at several frequencies over a temperature range of −30°C to +80°C. Both CW and 64 QAM modulated input wave forms were used in the characterization process in order to access varying peak-to-average waveform performance. The dynamic range of the device is calculated as the input power range over which the device remains within a permissible error margin to the ideal transfer function. Devices were tested over frequency and temperature. After identifying an acceptable error margin for a given application, the usable dynamic measurement range can be identified using the plots in Figure 54 through Figure 57. For instance, for a 1 dB error margin and a modulated carrier at 3 GHz, the usable dynamic range can be found by inspecting the 3 GHz plot of Figure 57. Note that the −30°C curve crosses the −1 dB error limit at −17 dBm. For a 5 V supply, the maximum input power should not exceed 6 dBm in order to avoid compression. The resultant usable dynamic range is therefore 6 dBm − (−17 dBm) or 23 dBm over a temperature range of −30°C to +80°C. Figure 54. Transfer Function and Error Plots Measured at 1.5 GHz for a 64 QAM Modulated Signal PIN (dBm)2.5–250–20–15–10–51.02.01.50.5ERROR ( dB)510+25°C–40°C0–0.5–1.0–1.5–2.0–2.50.1101.0VOUT ( V)+85°C01088-C-052PIN (dBm)–250–20–15–10–51.02.01.50.5ERROR ( dB)5100–0.5–1.0–1.5–2.0–2.5+25°C–40°C+85°C–3.0–3001088-C-053PIN (dBm)2.5–25ERROR ( dB)2.01.51.00.50–0.5–1.0–1.5–2.0–2.5–20–15–10–505101010.1VOUT ( V)+80°C+25°C–30°C01088-0-054 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 18 of 24 Figure 55. Transfer Function and Error Plots Measured at 2.5 GHz for a 64 QAM Modulated Signal Figure 56. Transfer Function and Error Plots Measured at 2.7 GHz for a 64 QAM Modulated Signal Figure 57. Transfer Function and Error Plots Measured at 3.0 GHz for a 64 QAM Modulated Signal Figure 58. Error from CW Linear Reference vs. Input Drive Level for CW and 64 QAM Modulated Signals at 3.0 GHz Figure 59. Conversion Gain vs. Frequency for a Typical Device, Supply 3 V, Ground Reference Mode The transfer functions and error for a CW input and a 64 QAM input waveform is shown in Figure 58. The error curve is generated from a linear reference based on the CW data. The increased crest factor of the 64 QAM modulation results in a decrease in output from the AD8361. This decrease in output is a result of the limited bandwidth and compression of the internal gain stages. This inaccuracy should be accounted for in systems where varying crest factor signals need to be measured. The conversion gain is defined as the slope of the output voltage vs. the input rms voltage. An ideal best fit curve can be found for the measured transfer function at a given supply voltage and temperature. The slope of the ideal curve is identified as the conversion gain for a particular device. The conversion gain relates the measurement sensitivity of the AD8361 to the rms input voltage of the RF waveform. The conversion gain was measured for a number of devices over a temperature range of −30°C to +80°C. The conversion gain for a typical device is shown in Figure 59. Although the conversion gain tends to decrease with increasing frequency, the AD8361 provides measurement capability at frequencies greater than 2.5 GHz. However, it is necessary to calibrate for a given application to PIN (dBm)2.5–25ERROR ( dB)2.01.51.00.50–0.5–1.0–1.5–2.0–2.5–20–15–10–505101010.1VOUT ( V)+80°C+25°C–30°C01088-C-055PIN (dBm)2.5–25ERROR ( dB)2.01.51.00.50–0.5–1.0–1.5–2.0–2.5–20–15–10–505101010.1VOUT ( V)+80°C+25°C–30°C01088-C-056PIN (dBm)2.5–25ERROR ( dB)2.01.51.00.50–0.5–1.0–1.5–2.0–2.5–20–15–10–550101010.1VOUT ( V)+80°C+25°C–30°C01088-C-057PIN (dBm)2.5–25ERROR ( dB)2.01.51.00.50–0.5–1.0–1.5–2.0–2.5–20–15–10–550101010.1VOUT ( V)CW64 QAM01088-C-058FREQUENCY (MHz)8.0100CONVERSION GAIN ( V/V rms)7.57.06.56.05.55.020040080012001600220025002700300001088-C-059 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 19 of 24 accommodate for the change in conversion gain at higher frequencies. Dynamic Range Extension for the AD8361 The accurate measurement range of the AD8361 is limited by internal dc offsets for small input signals and by square law conformance errors for large signals. The measurement range may be extended by using two devices operating at different signal levels and then choosing only the output of the device that provides accurate results at the prevailing input level. Figure 60 depicts an implementation of this idea. In this circuit, the selection of the output is made gradually over an input level range of about 3 dB in order to minimize the impact of imperfect matching of the transfer functions of the two AD8361s. Such a mismatch typically arises because of the variation of the gain of the RF preamplifier U1 and both the gain and slope variations of the AD8361s with temperature. One of the AD8361s (U2) has a net gain of about 14 dB preceding it and therefore operates most accurately at low input signal levels. This is referred to as the weak signal path. U4, on the other hand, does not have the added gain and provides accurate response at high levels. The output of U2 is attenuated by R1 in order to cancel the effect of U2’s preceding gain so that the slope of the transfer function (as seen at the slider of R1) is the same as that of U4 by itself. The circuit comprising U3, U5, and U6 is a crossfader, in which the relative gains of the two inputs are determined by the output currents of a fuzzy comparator made from Q1 and Q2. Assuming that the slider of R2 is at 2.5 V dc, the fuzzy comparator commands full weighting of the weak signal path when the output of U2 is below about 2.0 V dc, and full weighting of the strong signal path when the output of U3 exceeds about 3.0 V dc. U3 and U5 are OTAs (operational transconductance amplifiers). Figure 60. Range Extender Application 87651234AD83610.1μF5V100pF5V0.01μF68ΩU2ERA-320dBU1RFC270Ω12V6dBPAD6dBSPLITTERRFINPUT12V20kΩ1kΩ1kΩ5VR210kΩQ22N3906Q12N390616kΩR15kΩCA3080+12V–5VU320kΩCA3080+12V–5VU52356235620kΩ1MΩR310kΩ–5V+5V12kΩ87651234AD83610.1μF5V100pF5V0.01μF68ΩU4AD8205VU6238.2nF476VOUT100Ω01088-C-060 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 20 of 24 U6 provides feedback to linearize the inherent tanh transfer function of the OTAs. When one OTA or the other is fully selected, the feedback is very effective. The active OTA has zero differential input; the inactive one has a potentially large differential input, but this does not matter because the inactive OTA is not contributing to the output. However, when both OTAs are active to some extent, and the two signal inputs to the crossfader are different, it is impossible to have zero differential inputs on the OTAs. In this event, the crossfader admittedly generates distortion because of the nonlinear transfer function of the OTAs. Fortunately, in this application, the distortion is not very objectionable for two reasons: 1. The mismatch in input levels to the crossfader is never large enough to evoke very much distortion because the AD8361s are reasonably well-behaved. 2. The effect of the distortion in this case is merely to distort the otherwise nearly linear slope of the transition between the crossfader’s two inputs. Figure 61. Slope Adjustment This circuit has three trimmable potentiometers. The suggested setup procedure is as follows: 3. Preset R3 at midrange. 4. Set R2 so that its slider’s voltage is at the middle of the desired transition zone (about 2.5 V dc is recommended). 5. Set R1 so that the transfer function’s slopes are equal on both sides of the transition zone. This is perhaps best accomplished by making a plot of the overall transfer function (using linear voltage scales for both axes) to assess the match in slope between one side of the transition region and the other (see Figure 61). Note: it may be helpful to adjust R3 to remove any large misalignment in the transfer function in order to correctly perceive slope differences. 6. Finally (re)adjust R3 as required to remove any remaining misalignment in the transfer function (see Figure 62). Figure 62. Intercept Adjustment In principle, this method could be extended to three or more AD8361s in pursuit of even more measurement range. However, it is very important to pay close attention to the matter of not excessively overdriving the AD8361s in the weaker signal paths under strong signal conditions. Figure 63 shows the extended range transfer function at multiple temperatures. The discontinuity at approximately 0.2 V rms arises as a result of component temperature dependencies. Figure 64 shows the error in dB of the range extender circuit at ambient temperature. For a 1 dB error margin, the range extender circuit offers 38 dB of measurement range. Figure 63. Output vs. Drive Level over Temperature for a 1 GHz 64 QAM Modulated Signal Figure 64. Error from Linear Reference at 25°C for a 1 GHz 64 QAM Modulated Signal VOUTm1m2m1≠m2DIFFERINGSLOPES INDICATEMALADJUSTMENTOF R1RF INPUT LEVEL– V rmsTRANSITIONREGION01088-C-061VOUTRF INPUT LEVEL– V rmsTRANSITIONREGIONMISALIGNMENT INDICATESMALADJUSTMENT OF R301088-C-062DRIVE LEVEL (V rms)3.02.5001.00.2VOUT ( V)0.40.60.82.01.51.00.5REF LINE+80°C–30°C01088-C-063DRIVE LEVEL (dBm)5–32ERROR ( dB)43210–1–2–3–4–5–27–22–17–12–7–2381301088-C-064 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 21 of 24 EVALUATION BOARD Figure 65 and Figure 68 show the schematic of the AD8361 evaluation board. Note that uninstalled components are drawn in as dashed. The layout and silkscreen of the component side are shown in Figure 66, Figure 67, Figure 69, and Figure 70. The board is powered by a single supply in the 2.7 V to 5.5 V range. The power supply is decoupled by 100 pF and 0.01 μF capacitors. Additional decoupling, in the form of a series resistor or inductor in R6, can also be added. Table 8 details the various configuration options of the evaluation board. Table 8. Evaluation Board Configuration Options Component Function Default Condition TP1, TP2 Ground and Supply Vector Pins. Not Applicable SW1 Device Enable. When in Position A, the PWDN pin is connected to +VS and the AD8361 is in power-down mode. In Position B, the PWDN pin is grounded, putting the device in operating mode. SW1 = B SW2/SW3 Operating Mode. Selects either ground reference mode, internal reference mode or supply reference mode. See Table 4 for more details. SW2 = A, SW3 = B (Ground Reference Mode) C1, R2 Input Coupling. The 75 Ω resistor in Position R2 combines with the AD8361’s internal input impedance to give a broadband input impedance of around 50 Ω. For more precise matching at a particular frequency, R2 can be replaced by a different value (see Input Coupling and Matching and Figure 43 through Figure 46). Capacitor C1 ac couples the input signal and creates a high-pass input filter whose corner frequency is equal to approximately 8 MHz. C1 can be increased for operation at lower frequencies. If resistive attenuation is desired at the input, series resistor R1, which is nominally 0 Ω, can be replaced by an appropriate value. R2 = 75 Ω (Size 0402) C1 = 100 pF (Size 0402) C2, C3, R6 Power Supply Decoupling. The nominal supply decoupling of 0.01 μF and 100 pF. A series inductor or small resistor can be placed in R6 for additional decoupling. C2 = 0.01 μF (Size 0402) C3 = 100 pF (Size 0402) R6 = 0 Ω (Size 0402) C5 Filter Capacitor. The internal 50 pF averaging capacitor can be augmented by placing a capacitance in C5. C5 = 1 nF (Size 0603) C4, R5 Output Loading. Resistors and capacitors can be placed in C4 and R5 to load test V rms. C4 = R5 = Open (Size 0603) AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 22 of 24 Figure 65. Evaluation Board Schematic, MSOP Figure 66. Layout of Component Side, MSOP Figure 67. Silkscreen of Component Side, MSOP Figure 68. Evaluation Board Schematic, SOT-23 Figure 69. Layout of the Component Side, SOT-23 Figure 70. Silkscreen of the Component Side, SOT-23 12348765AD8361VPOSIREFRFINPWDNSREFVRMSFLTRCOMMC20.01μFC3100pFC1100pFC5RFINVrmsVPOSVSSW2VSSW3SW1ABAB1nFABTP2TP1VPOSVPOSR275ΩR40ΩR60ΩC4(OPEN)R5(OPEN)01088-C-06501088-C-06601088-C-067R275ΩR750ΩR40ΩC20.01μFC1100pFC3100pFC51nFJ2J3J1TP2C4(OPEN)R5(OPEN)AD8361VPOSRFINPWDNVRMSFLTRCOMMTP1SW1123VPOS12365401088-C-06801088-C-06901088-C-070 Data Sheet AD8361 Rev. D | Page 23 of 24 Problems caused by impedance mismatch may arise using the evaluation board to examine the AD8361 performance. One way to reduce these problems is to put a coaxial 3 dB attenuator on the RFIN SMA connector. Mismatches at the source, cable, and cable interconnection, as well as those occurring on the evaluation board, can cause these problems. A simple (and common) example of such a problem is triple travel due to mismatch at both the source and the evaluation board. Here the signal from the source reaches the evaluation board and mismatch causes a reflection. When that reflection reaches the source mismatch, it causes a new reflection, which travels back to the evaluation board, adding to the original signal incident at the board. The resultant voltage varies with both cable length and frequency dependence on the relative phase of the initial and reflected signals. Placing the 3 dB pad at the input of the board improves the match at the board and thus reduces the sensitivity to mismatches at the source. When such precautions are taken, measurements are less sensitive to cable length and other fixture issues. In an actual application when the distance between AD8361 and source is short and well defined, this 3 dB attenuator is not needed. CHARACTERIZATION SETUPS Equipment The primary characterization setup is shown in Figure 72. The signal source used was a Rohde & Schwarz SMIQ03B, version 3.90HX. The modulated waveforms used for IS95 reverse link, IS95 nine active channels forward (forward link 18 setting), and W-CDMA 4-channel and 15-channel were generated using the default settings coding and filtering. Signal levels were calibrated into a 50 Ω impedance. Analysis The conversion gain and output reference are derived using the coefficients of a linear regression performed on data collected in its central operating range (35 mV rms to 250 mV rms). This range was chosen to avoid areas of operation where offset distorts the linear response. Error is stated in two forms error from linear response to CW waveform and output delta from 2°C performance. The error from linear response to CW waveform is the difference in output from the ideal output defined by the conversion gain and output reference. This is a measure of both the linearity of the device response to both CW and modulated waveforms. The error in dB uses the conversion gain multiplied by the input as its reference. Error from linear response to CW waveform is not a measure of absolute accuracy, since it is calculated using the gain and output reference of each device. However, it does show the linearity and effect of modulation on the device response. Error from 25°C performance uses the performance of a given device and waveform type as the reference; it is predominantly a measure of output variation with temperature. Figure 71. Characterization Board Figure 72. Characterization Setup 1 2 3 4 8 7 6 5 AD8361 VPOS IREF RFIN PWDN SREF VRMS FLTR COMM C1 0.1F R1 75 RFIN C3 C4 0.1F C2 100pF IREF PWDN VPOS SREF VRMS 01088-C-071 AD8361 CHARACTERIZATION BOARD RFIN PRUP +VS SREF IREF VRMS SMIQ038B RF SIGNAL DC OUTPUT RF SOURCE IEEE BUS PC CONTROLLER DC MATRIX / DC SUPPLIES / DMM DC SOURCES 3dB ATTENUATOR 01088-C-072 AD8361 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 24 of 24 OUTLINE DIMENSIONS Figure 73. 8-Lead Mini Small Outline Package [MSOP] (RM-8) Dimensions shown in millimeters Figure 74. 6-Lead Small Outline Transistor Package [SOT-23] (RJ-6) Dimensions shown in millimeters ORDERING GUIDE Model1 Temperature Range Package Description Package Option Branding AD8361ARM −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, Tube RM-8 J3A AD8361ARM-REEL7 −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, 7" Tape and Reel RM-8 J3A AD8361ARMZ −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, Tube RM-8 J3A AD8361ARMZ-REEL −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, 13" Tape and Reel RM-8 J3A AD8361ARMZ-REEL7 −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, 7" Tape and Reel RM-8 J3A AD8361ARTZ-RL7 −40°C to +85°C 6-Lead SOT-23, 7" Tape and Reel RJ-6 Q0V AD8361-EVALZ Evaluation Board MSOP AD8361ART-EVAL Evaluation Board SOT-23-6L 1 Z = RoHS Compliant Part. COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MO-187-AA 6° 0° 0.80 0.55 0.40 4 8 1 5 0.65 BSC 0.40 0.25 1.10 MAX 3.20 3.00 2.80 COPLANARITY 0.10 0.23 0.09 3.20 3.00 2.80 5.15 4.90 4.65 PIN 1 IDENTIFIER 15° MAX 0.95 0.85 0.75 0.15 0.05 10-07-2009-B COMPLIANTTOJEDECSTANDARDSMO-178-AB 10° 4° 0° SEATING PLANE 1.90 BSC 0.95BSC 0.60 BSC 6 5 1 2 3 4 3.00 2.90 2.80 3.00 2.80 2.60 1.70 1.60 1.50 1.30 1.15 0.90 0.15MAX 0.05MIN 1.45MAX 0.95MIN 0.20MAX 0.08MIN 0.50MAX 0.30MIN 0.55 0.45 0.35 PIN1 INDICATOR 12-16-2008-A ©2014 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. D01088–0–3/14(D) Fast, Voltage-Out, DC to 440 MHz, 95 dB Logarithmic Amplifier AD8310 Rev. F Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other rights of third parties that may result from its use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A. Tel: 781.329.4700 www.analog.com Fax: 781.461.3113 ©2005–2010 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. FEATURES Multistage demodulating logarithmic amplifier Voltage output, rise time <15 ns High current capacity: 25 mA into grounded RL 95 dB dynamic range: −91 dBV to +4 dBV Single supply of 2.7 V min at 8 mA typ DC to 440 MHz operation, ±0.4 dB linearity Slope of +24 mV/dB, intercept of −108 dBV Highly stable scaling over temperature Fully differential dc-coupled signal path 100 ns power-up time, 1 mA sleep current APPLICATIONS Conversion of signal level to decibel form Transmitter antenna power measurement Receiver signal strength indication (RSSI) Low cost radar and sonar signal processing Network and spectrum analyzers Signal-level determination down to 20 Hz True-decibel ac mode for multimeters FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM Figure 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION The AD8310 is a complete, dc to 440 MHz demodulating logarithmic amplifier (log amp) with a very fast voltage mode output, capable of driving up to 25 mA into a grounded load in under 15 ns. It uses the progressive compression (successive detection) technique to provide a dynamic range of up to 95 dB to ±3 dB law conformance or 90 dB to a ±1 dB error bound up to 100 MHz. It is extremely stable and easy to use, requiring no significant external components. A single-supply voltage of 2.7 V to 5.5 V at 8 mA is needed, corresponding to a power consumption of only 24 mW at 3 V. A fast-acting CMOS-compatible enable pin is provided. Each of the six cascaded amplifier/limiter cells has a small-signal gain of 14.3 dB, with a −3 dB bandwidth of 900 MHz. A total of nine detector cells are used to provide a dynamic range that extends from −91 dBV (where 0 dBV is defined as the amplitude of a 1 V rms sine wave), an amplitude of about ±40 μV, up to +4 dBV (or ±2.2 V). The demodulated output is accurately scaled, with a log slope of 24 mV/dB and an intercept of −108 dBV. The scaling parameters are supply- and temperature-independent. The fully differential input offers a moderately high impedance (1 kΩ in parallel with about 1 pF). A simple network can match the input to 50 Ω and provide a power sensitivity of −78 dBm to +17 dBm. The logarithmic linearity is typically within ±0.4 dB up to 100 MHz over the central portion of the range, but it is somewhat greater at 440 MHz. There is no minimum frequency limit; the AD8310 can be used down to low audio frequencies. Special filtering features are provided to support this wide range. The output voltage runs from a noise-limited lower boundary of 400 mV to an upper limit within 200 mV of the supply voltage for light loads. The slope and intercept can be readily altered using external resistors. The output is tolerant of a wide variety of load conditions and is stable with capacitive loads of 100 pF. The AD8310 provides a unique combination of low cost, small size, low power consumption, high accuracy and stability, high dynamic range, a frequency range encompassing audio to UHF, fast response time, and good load-driving capabilities, making this product useful in numerous applications that require the reduction of a signal to its decibel equivalent. The AD8310 is available in the industrial temperature range of −40°C to +85°C in an 8-lead MSOP package. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 2 of 24 TABLE OF CONTENTS Features .............................................................................................. 1 Applications ....................................................................................... 1 Functional Block Diagram .............................................................. 1 General Description ......................................................................... 1 Revision History ............................................................................... 2 Specifications ..................................................................................... 3 Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................ 4 ESD Caution .................................................................................. 4 Pin Configuration and Function Descriptions ............................. 5 Typical Performance Characteristics ............................................. 6 Theory of Operation ........................................................................ 9 Progressive Compression ............................................................ 9 Slope and Intercept Calibration ................................................ 10 Offset Control ............................................................................. 10 Product Overview ........................................................................... 11 Enable Interface .......................................................................... 11 Input Interface ............................................................................ 11 Offset Interface ........................................................................... 12 Output Interface ......................................................................... 12 Using the AD8310 .......................................................................... 14 Basic Connections ...................................................................... 14 Transfer Function in Terms of Slope and Intercept ............... 15 dBV vs. dBm ............................................................................... 15 Input Matching ........................................................................... 15 Narrow-Band Matching ............................................................ 16 General Matching Procedure .................................................... 16 Slope and Intercept Adjustments ............................................. 17 Increasing the Slope to a Fixed Value ...................................... 17 Output Filtering .......................................................................... 18 Lowering the High-Pass Corner Frequency of the Offset Compensation Loop .................................................................. 18 Applications Information .............................................................. 19 Cable-Driving ............................................................................. 19 DC-Coupled Input ..................................................................... 19 Evaluation Board ............................................................................ 20 Die Information .............................................................................. 22 Outline Dimensions ....................................................................... 23 Ordering Guide .......................................................................... 23 REVISION HISTORY 6/10—Rev. E to Rev. F Added Die Information Section ................................................... 22 Updated Outline Dimensions ....................................................... 23 Changes to Ordering Guide .......................................................... 23 6/05—Rev. D to Rev. E Changes to Figure 6 .......................................................................... 6 Change to Basic Connections Section ......................................... 14 Changes to Equation 10 ................................................................. 17 Changes to Ordering Guide .......................................................... 22 10/04—Rev. C to Rev. D Format Updated .................................................................. Universal Typical Performance Characteristics Reordered .......................... 6 Changes to Figure 41 and Figure 42 ............................................. 20 7/03—Rev. B to Rev. C Replaced TPC 12 ............................................................................... 5 Change to DC-Coupled Input Section ........................................ 14 Replaced Figure 20 ......................................................................... 15 Updated Outline Dimensions ....................................................... 16 2/03—Rev. A to Rev. B Change to Evaluation Board Section ........................................... 15 Change to Table III ......................................................................... 16 Updated Outline Dimensions ....................................................... 16 1/00—Rev. 0 to Rev. A 10/99—Revision 0: Initial Version AD8310 Rev. F | Page 3 of 24 SPECIFICATIONS TA = 25°C, VS = 5 V, unless otherwise noted. Table 1. Parameter Test Conditions/Comments Min Typ Max Unit INPUT STAGE Inputs INHI, INLO Maximum Input1 Single-ended, p-p ±2.0 ±2.2 V 4 dBV Equivalent Power in 50 Ω Termination resistor of 52.3 Ω 17 dBm Differential drive, p-p 20 dBm Noise Floor Terminated 50 Ω source 1.28 nV/√Hz Equivalent Power in 50 Ω 440 MHz bandwidth −78 dBm Input Resistance From INHI to INLO 800 1000 1200 Ω Input Capacitance From INHI to INLO 1.4 pF DC Bias Voltage Either input 3.2 V LOGARITHMIC AMPLIFIER Output VOUT ±3 dB Error Dynamic Range From noise floor to maximum input 95 dB Transfer Slope 10 MHz ≤ f ≤ 200 MHz 22 24 26 mV/dB Overtemperature, −40°C < TA < +85°C 20 26 mV/dB Intercept (Log Offset)2 10 MHz ≤ f ≤ 200 MHz −115 −108 −99 dBV Equivalent dBm (re 50 Ω) −102 −95 −86 dBm Overtemperature, −40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C −120 −96 dBV Equivalent dBm (re 50 Ω) −107 −83 dBm Temperature sensitivity −0.04 dB/°C Linearity Error (Ripple) Input from −88 dBV (−75 dBm) to +2 dBV (+15 dBm) ±0.4 dB Output Voltage Input = −91 dBV (−78 dBm) 0.4 V Input = 9 dBV (22 dBm) 2.6 V Minimum Load Resistance, RL 100 Ω Maximum Sink Current 0.5 mA Output Resistance 0.05 Ω Video Bandwidth 25 MHz Rise Time (10% to 90%) Input level = −43 dBV (−30 dBm), RL ≥ 402 Ω, CL ≤ 68 pF 15 ns Input level = −3 dBV (+10 dBm), RL ≥ 402 Ω, CL ≤ 68 pF 20 ns Fall Time (90% to 10%) Input level = −43 dBV (−30 dBm), RL ≥ 402 Ω, CL ≤ 68 pF 30 ns Input level = −3 dBV (+10 dBm), RL ≥ 402 Ω, CL ≤ 68 pF 40 ns Output Settling Time to 1% Input level = −13 dBV (0 dBm), RL ≥ 402 Ω, CL ≤ 68 pF 40 ns POWER INTERFACES Supply Voltage, VPOS 2.7 5.5 V Quiescent Current Zero signal 6.5 8.0 9.5 mA Overtemperature −40°C < TA < +85°C 5.5 8.5 10 mA Disable Current 0.05 μA Logic Level to Enable Power High condition, −40°C < TA < +85°C 2.3 V Input Current When High 3 V at ENBL 35 μA Logic Level to Disable Power Low condition, −40°C < TA < +85°C 0.8 V 1 The input level is specified in dBV, because logarithmic amplifiers respond strictly to voltage, not power. 0 dBV corresponds to a sinusoidal single-frequency input of 1 V rms. A power level of 0 dBm (1 mW) in a 50 Ω termination corresponds to an input of 0.2236 V rms. Therefore, the relationship between dBV and dBm is a fixed offset of 13 dBm in the special case of a 50 Ω termination. 2 Guaranteed but not tested; limits are specified at six sigma levels. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 4 of 24 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS Table 2. Parameter Rating Supply Voltage, VS 7.5 V Input Power (re 50 Ω), Single-Ended 18 dBm Differential Drive 22 dBm Internal Power Dissipation 200 mW θJA 200°C/W Maximum Junction Temperature 125°C Operating Temperature Range −40°C to +85°C Storage Temperature Range −65°C to +150°C Lead Temperature (Soldering 60 sec) 300°C Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only; functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operational section of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. ESD CAUTION AD8310 Rev. F | Page 5 of 24 01084-002 PIN CONFIGURATION AND FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS INLO1INHI8 Figure 2. Pin Configuration Table 3. Pin Function Descriptions Pin No. Mnemonic Description 1 INLO One of Two Balanced Inputs. Biased roughly to VPOS/2. 2 COMM Common Pin. Usually grounded. 3 OFLT Offset Filter Access. Nominally at about 1.75 V. 4 VOUT Low Impedance Output Voltage. Carries a 25 mA maximum load. 5 VPOS Positive Supply. 2.7 V to 5.5 V at 8 mA quiescent current. 6 BFIN Buffer Input. Used to lower postdetection bandwidth. 7 ENBL CMOS Compatible Chip Enable. Active when high. 8 INHI Second of Two Balanced Inputs. Biased roughly to VPOS/2. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 6 of 24 TYPICAL PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS 3.00RSSI OUTPUT ( V)2.52.01.51.00.5TA = +85°CTA = +25°CTA =–40°C01084-011 Figure 3. RSSI Output vs. Input Level, 100 MHz Sine Input at TA = −40°C, +25°C, and +85°C, Single-Ended Input 3.0RSSI OUTPUT ( V)2.52.01.51.00.5010MHz50MHz100MHz Figure 4. RSSI Output vs. Input Level at TA = 25°C for Frequencies of 10 MHz, 50 MHz, and 100 MHz 3.00RSSI OUTPUT ( V)2.52.01.51.00.5200MHz300MHz440MHz Figure 5. RSSI Output vs. Input Level at TA = 25°C for Frequencies of 200 MHz, 300 MHz, and 440 MHz Figure 6. Log Linearity of RSSI Output vs. Input Level, 100 MHz Sine Input at TA = −40°C, +25°C, and +85°C Figure 7. Log Linearity of RSSI Output vs. Input Level at TA = 25°C for Frequencies of 10 MHz, 50 MHz, and 100 MHz Figure 8. Log Linearity of RSSI Output vs. Input Level at TA = 25°C for Frequencies of 200 MHz, 300 MHz, and 440 MHz AD8310 Rev. F | Page 7 of 24 500mV PERVERTICALDIVISIONVOUT100pF3300pFGROUND REFERENCE0.01μF Figure 9. Small-Signal AC Response of RSSI Output with External BFIN Capacitance of 100 pF, 3300 pF, and 0.01 μF GND REFERENCEINPUT 500mV PERVERTICALDIVISIONVOUT154Ω100Ω200Ω Figure 10. Large-Signal RSSI Pulse Response with CL = 100 pF and RL = 100 Ω, 154 Ω, and 200 Ω 100ns PERHORIZONTALDIVISIONGND REFERENCEINPUT500mV PERVERTICALDIVISIONVOUT Figure 12. Small-Signal RSSI Pulse Response with RL = 402 Ω and CL = 68 pF Figure 13. Large-Signal RSSI Pulse Response with RL = 100 Ω and CL = 33 pF, 68 pF, and 100 pF Figure 11. RSSI Pulse Response with RL = 402 Ω and CL = 68 pF, for Inputs Stepped from 0 dBV to −33 dBV, −23 dBV, −13 dBV, and −3 dBV 01084-008 Figure 14. Small-Signal RSSI Pulse Response with RL = 50 Ω and Back Termination of 50 Ω (Total Load = 100 Ω) AD8310 100SUPPLY CURRENT ( mA)1010.10.010.0010.0001TA = +85°CTA = +25°C Figure 18. Power-On/Off Response Time with RF Input of −83 dBV to −3 dBV Figure 15. Supply Current vs. Enable Voltage at TA = −40°C, +25°C, and +85°C 3029RSSI SLOPE ( mV/dB)24232226252827 Figure 16. RSSI Slope vs. Frequency Figure 19. RSSI Intercept vs. Frequency INTERCEPT (dBV)0–115–113 3010COUNT252015 3540NORMAL(23.6584,0.308728) Figure 17. Transfer Slope Distribution, VS = 5 V, Frequency = 100 MHz, 25°C –111–109–107–105–103–101–99–97 Figure 20. Intercept Distribution, VS = 5 V, Frequency = 100 MHz, 25°C AD8310 Rev. F | Page 9 of 24 THEORY OF OPERATION Logarithmic amplifiers perform a more complex operation than classical linear amplifiers, and their circuitry is significantly different. A good grasp of what log amps do and how they do it can help users avoid many pitfalls in their applications. For a complete discussion of the theory, see the AD8307 data sheet. The essential purpose of a log amp is not to amplify (though amplification is needed internally), but to compress a signal of wide dynamic range to its decibel equivalent. It is, therefore, a measurement device. An even better term might be logarithmic converter, because the function is to convert a signal from one domain of representation to another via a precise nonlinear transformation: ⎞⎛INV (1) where: VOUT is the output voltage. VY is the slope voltage. The logarithm is usually taken to base ten, in which case VY is also the volts-per-decade. VIN is the input voltage. VX is the intercept voltage. Log amps implicitly require two references (here VX and VY) that determine the scaling of the circuit. The accuracy of a log amp cannot be any better than the accuracy of its scaling references. In the AD8310, these are provided by a band gap reference. VOUT5VY4VY3VY2VYVY VOUT =0LOGVINVSHIFTLOWER INTERCEPTVIN=10–2VX–40dBcVIN=102VX+40dBcVIN=104VX+80dBcVIN =VX0dBc Figure 21. General Form of the Logarithmic Function While Equation 1, plotted in Figure 21, is fundamentally correct, a different formula is appropriate for specifying the calibration attributes or demodulating log amps like the AD8310, operating in RF applications with a sine wave input. (2) where: VOUT is the demodulated and filtered baseband (video or RSSI) output. VSLOPE is the logarithmic slope, now expressed in V/dB (25 mV/dB for the AD8310). PIN is the input power, expressed in dB relative to some reference power level. PO is the logarithmic intercept, expressed in dB relative to the same reference level. A widely used reference in RF systems is dB above 1 mW in 50 Ω, a level of 0 dBm. Note that the quantity (PIN − PO) is dB. The logarithmic function disappears from the formula, because the conversion has already been implicitly performed in stating the input in decibels. This is strictly a concession to popular convention. Log amps manifestly do not respond to power (tacitly, power absorbed at the input), but rather to input voltage. The input is specified in dBV (decibels with respect to 1 V rms) throughout this data sheet. This is more precise, although still incomplete, because the signal waveform is also involved. Many users specify RF signals in terms of power (usually in dBm/50 Ω), and this convention is used in this data sheet when specifying the performance of the AD8310. PROGRESSIVE COMPRESSION High speed, high dynamic-range log amps use a cascade of nonlinear amplifier cells to generate the logarithmic function as a series of contiguous segments, a type of piecewise linear technique. The AD8310 employs six cells in its main signal path, each having a small-signal gain of 14.3 dB (×5.2) and a −3 dB bandwidth of about 900 MHz. The overall gain is about 20,000 (86 dB), and the overall bandwidth of the chain is approximately 500 MHz, resulting in a gain-bandwidth product (GBW) of 10,000 GHz, about a million times that of a typical op amp. This very high GBW is essential to accurate operation under small-signal conditions and at high frequencies. The AD8310 exhibits a logarithmic response down to inputs as small as 40 μV at 440 MHz. Progressive compression log amps either provide a baseband video response or accept an RF input and demodulate this signal to develop an output that is essentially the envelope of the input represented on a logarithmic or decibel scale. The AD8310 is the latter kind. Demodulation is performed in a total of nine detector cells. Six are associated with the amplifier stages, and three are passive detectors that receive a progres-sively attenuated fraction of the full input. The maximum signal frequency can be 440 MHz, but, because all the gain stages are dc-coupled, operation at very low frequencies is possible. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 10 of 24 SLOPE AND INTERCEPT CALIBRATION All monolithic log amps from Analog Devices use precision design techniques to control the logarithmic slope and intercept. The primary source of this calibration is a pair of accurate voltage references that provide supply- and temperature-independent scaling. The slope is set to 24 mV/dB by the bias chosen for the detector cells and the subsequent gain of the postdetector output interface. With this slope, the full 95 dB dynamic range can be easily accommodated within the output swing capacity, when operating from a 2.7 V supply. Intercept positioning at −108 dBV (−95 dBm re 50 Ω) has likewise been chosen to provide an output centered in the available voltage range. Precise control of the slope and intercept results in a log amp with stable scaling parameters, making it a true measurement device as, for example, a calibrated received signal strength indicator (RSSI). In this application, the input waveform is invariably sinusoidal. The input level is correctly specified in dBV. It can alternatively be stated as an equivalent power, in dBm, but in this case, it is necessary to specify the impedance in which this power is presumed to be measured. In RF practice, it is common to assume a reference impedance of 50 Ω, in which 0 dBm (1 mW) corresponds to a sinusoidal amplitude of 316.2 mV (223.6 mV rms). However, the power metric is correct only when the input impedance is lowered to 50 Ω, either by a termination resistor added across INHI and INLO, or by the use of a narrow-band matching network. Note that log amps do not inherently respond to power, but to the voltage applied to their input. The AD8310 presents a nominal input impedance much higher than 50 Ω (typically 1 kΩ at low frequencies). A simple input matching network can considerably improve the power sensitivity of this type of log amp. This increases the voltage applied to the input and, therefore, alters the intercept. For a 50 Ω reactive match, the voltage gain is about 4.8, and the whole dynamic range moves down by 13.6 dB. The effective intercept is a function of wave-form. For example, a square-wave input reads 6 dB higher than a sine wave of the same amplitude, and a Gaussian noise input reads 0.5 dB higher than a sine wave of the same rms value. OFFSET CONTROL In a monolithic log amp, direct coupling is used between the stages for several reasons. First, it avoids the need for coupling capacitors, which typically have a chip area at least as large as that of a basic gain cell, considerably increasing die size. Second, the capacitor values predetermine the lowest frequency at which the log amp can operate. For moderate values, this can be as high as 30 MHz, limiting the application range. Third, the parasitic back-plate capacitance lowers the bandwidth of the cell, further limiting the scope of applications. However, the very high dc gain of a direct-coupled amplifier raises a practical issue. An offset voltage in the early stages of the chain is indistinguishable from a real signal. If it were as high as 400 μV, it would be 18 dB larger than the smallest ac signal (50 μV), potentially reducing the dynamic range by this amount. This problem can be averted by using a global feedback path from the last stage to the first, which corrects this offset in a similar fashion to the dc negative feedback applied around an op amp. The high frequency components of the feedback signal must, of course, be removed to prevent a reduction of the HF gain in the forward path. An on-chip filter capacitor of 33 pF provides sufficient suppres-sion of HF feedback to allow operation above 1 MHz. The −3 dB point in the high-pass response is at 2 MHz, but the usable range extends well below this frequency. To further lower the frequency range, an external capacitor can be added at OFLT (Pin 3). For example, 300 pF lowers it by a factor of 10. Operation at low audio frequencies requires a capacitor of about 1 μF. Note that this filter has no effect for input levels well above the offset voltage, where the frequency range would extend down to dc (for a signal applied directly to the input pins). The dc offset can optionally be nulled by adjusting the voltage on the OFLT pin (see the Applications Information section). AD8310 Rev. F | Page 11 of 24 PRODUCT OVERVIEW The AD8310 has six main amplifier/limiter stages. These six cells and their and associated gm styled full-wave detectors handle the lower two-thirds of the dynamic range. Three top-end detectors, placed at 14.3 dB taps on a passive attenuator, handle the upper third of the 95 dB range. The first amplifier stage provides a low noise spectral density (1.28 nV/√Hz). Biasing for these cells is provided by two references: one determines their gain, and the other is a band gap circuit that determines the logarithmic slope and stabilizes it against supply and temperature variations. The AD8310 can be enabled or disabled by a CMOS-compatible level at ENBL (Pin 7). The differential current-mode outputs of the nine detectors are summed and then converted to single-sided form, nominally scaled 2 μA/dB. The output voltage is developed by applying this current to a 3 kΩ load resistor followed by a high speed gain-of-four buffer amplifier, resulting in a logarithmic slope of 24 mV/dB (480 mV/decade) at VOUT (Pin 4). The unbuffered voltage can be accessed at BFIN (Pin 6), allowing certain functional modifications such as the addition of an external postdemodulation filter capacitor and the alteration or adjustment of slope and intercept. +–VPOSINHIINLOCOMM38mA1.0kΩBAND GAP REFERENCEAND BIASINGSIX 14.3dB 900MHzAMPLIFIER STAGESNINE DETECTOR CELLSSPACED 14.3dBINPUT-OFFSETCOMPENSATION LOOP22μA/dBMIRROR3kΩ3kΩ1kΩCOMMCOMMENBLBFINVOUTOFLTENABLEBUFFERINPUTOUTPUTOFFSETFILTERAD8310SUPPLY+INPUT–INPUTCOMMON Figure 22. Main Features of the AD8310 The last gain stage also includes an offset-sensing cell. This generates a bipolarity output current, if the main signal path exhibits an imbalance due to accumulated dc offsets. This current is integrated by an on-chip capacitor that can be increased in value by an off-chip component at OFLT (Pin 3). The resulting voltage is used to null the offset at the output of the first stage. Because it does not involve the signal input connections, whose ac-coupling capacitors otherwise introduce a second pole into the feedback path, the stability of the offset correction loop is assured. The AD8310 is built on an advanced, dielectrically isolated, complementary bipolar process. In the following interface diagrams shown in Figure 23 to Figure 26, resistors labeled as R are thin-film resistors that have a low temperature coefficient of resistance (TCR) and high linearity under large-signal conditions. Their absolute tolerance is typically within ±20%. Similarly, capacitors labeled as C have a typical tolerance of ±15% and essentially zero temperature or voltage sensitivity. Most interfaces have additional small junction capacitances associated with them, due to active devices or ESD protection, which might not be accurate or stable. Component numbering in these interface diagrams is local. ENABLE INTERFACE The chip-enable interface is shown in Figure 23. The currents in the diode-connected transistors control the turn-on and turn-off states of the band gap reference and the bias generator. They are a maximum of 100 μA when ENBL is taken to 5 V under worst-case conditions. For voltages below 1 V, the AD8310 is disabled and consumes a sleep current of less than 1 μA. When tied to the supply or a voltage above 2 V, it is fully enabled. The internal bias circuitry is very fast (typically <100 ns for either off or on). In practice, however, the latency period before the log amp exhibits its full dynamic range is more likely to be limited by factors relating to the use of ac coupling at the input or the settling of the offset-control loop (see the following sections). Figure 23. Enable Interface INPUT INTERFACE Figure 24 shows the essentials of the input interface. CP and CM are parasitic capacitances, and CD is the differential input capacitance, largely due to Q1 and Q2. In most applications, both input pins are ac-coupled. The S switches close when enable is asserted. When disabled, bias current IE is shut off and the inputs float; therefore, the coupling capacitors remain charged. If the log amp is disabled for long periods, small leakage currents discharge these capacitors. Then, if they are poorly matched, charging currents at power-up can generate a transient input voltage that can block the lower reaches of the dynamic range until it becomes much less than the signal. A single-sided signal can be applied via a blocking capacitor to either Pin 1 or Pin 8, with the other pin ac-coupled to ground. Under these conditions, the largest input signal that can be handled is 0 dBV (a sine amplitude of 1.4 V) when using a 3 V supply; a 5 dBV input (2.5 V amplitude) can be handled with a 5 V supply. When using a fully balanced drive, this maximum input level is permissible for supply voltages as low as 2.7 V. Above 10 MHz, this is easily achieved using an LC matching network. Such a network, having an inductor at the input, usefully eliminates the input transient noted above. AD8310 TOP-ENDDETECTORSCOMINHIINLOCPCDCMCOM4kΩ~3kΩ125Ω6kΩ6kΩ2kΩTYP 2.2V FOR3V SUPPLY,3.2V AT 5VSVPOSIE2.4mAQ1Q2 581 Figure 24. Signal Input Interface Occasionally, it might be desirable to use the dc-coupled potential of the AD8310 in baseband applications. The main challenge here is to present the signal at the elevated common-mode input level, which might require the use of low noise, low offset buffer amplifiers. In some cases, it might be possible to use dual supplies of ±3 V, which allow the input pins to operate at ground potential. The output, which is internally referenced to the COMM pin (now at −3 V), can be positioned back to ground level, with essentially no sensitivity to the particular value of the negative supply. OFFSET INTERFACE The input-referred dc offsets in the signal path are nulled via the interface associated with Pin 3, shown in Figure 25. Q1 and Q2 are the first-stage input transistors, having slightly unbalanced load resistors, resulting in a deliberate offset voltage of about 1.5 mV referred to the input pins. Q3 generates a small current to null this error, dependent on the voltage at the OFLT pin. When Q1 and Q2 are perfectly matched, this voltage is about 1.75 V. In practice, it can range from approximately 1 V to 2.5 V for an input-referred offset of ±1.5 mV. Figure 25. Offset Interface and Offset-Nulling Path In normal operation using an ac-coupled input signal, the OFLT pin should be left unconnected. The gm cell, which is gated off when the chip is disabled, converts a residual offset (sensed at a point near the end of the cascade of amplifiers) to a current. This is integrated by the on-chip capacitor, CHP, plus any added external capacitance, COFLT, to generate the voltage that is applied back to the input stage in the polarity needed to null the output offset. From a small-signal perspective, this feedback alters the response of the amplifier, which exhibits a zero in its ac transfer function, resulting in a closed-loop, high-pass −3 dB corner at about 2 MHz. An external capacitor lowers the high-pass corner to arbitrarily low frequencies; using 1 μF, the 3 dB corner is at 60 Hz. OUTPUT INTERFACE The nine detectors generate differential currents, having an average value that is dependent on the signal input level, plus a fluctuation at twice the input frequency. These are summed at nodes LGP and LGN in Figure 26. Further currents are added at these nodes to position the intercept by slightly raising the output for zero input and to provide temperature compensation. 0.2pF3kΩ VOUT4 Figure 26. Simplified Output Interface AD8310 Rev. F | Page 13 of 24 For zero-signal conditions, all the detector output currents are equal. For a finite input of either polarity, their difference is converted by the output interface to a single-sided unipolar current, nominally scaled 2 μA/dB (40 μA/decade), at the output pin BFIN. An on-chip resistor of ~3 kΩ, R1, converts this current to a voltage of 6 mV/dB. This is then amplified by a factor of 4 in the output buffer, which can drive a current of up to 25 mA in a grounded load resistor. The overall rise time of the AD8310 is less than 15 ns. There is also a delay time of about 6 ns when the log amp is driven by an RF burst, starting at zero amplitude. When driving capacitive loads, it is desirable to add a low value of load resistor to speed up the return to the baseline; the buffer is stable for loads of a least 100 pF. The output bandwidth can be lowered by adding a grounded capacitor at BFIN. The time-constant of the resulting single-pole filter is formed with the 3 kΩ internal load resistor (with a tolerance of 20%). Therefore, to set the −3 dB frequency to 20 kHz, use a capacitor of 2.7 nF. Using 2.7 μF, the filter corner is at 20 Hz. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 14 of 24 USING THE AD8310 The AD8310 has very high gain and bandwidth. Consequently, it is susceptible to all signals that appear at the input terminals within a very broad frequency range. Without the benefit of filtering, these are indistinguishable from the desired signal and have the effect of raising the apparent noise floor (that is, lowering the useful dynamic range). For example, while the signal of interest has an IF of 50 MHz, any of the following can easily be larger than the IF signal at the lower extremities of its dynamic range: a few hundred mV of 60 Hz hum picked up due to poor grounding techniques, spurious coupling from a digital clock source on the same PC board, local radio stations, and so on. Careful shielding and supply decoupling is, therefore, essential. A ground plane should be used to provide a low impedance connection to the common pin COMM, for the decoupling capacitor(s) used at VPOS, and for the output ground. BASIC CONNECTIONS Figure 27 shows the connections needed for most applications. A supply voltage between 2.7 V and 5.5 V is applied to VPOS and is decoupled using a 0.01 μF capacitor close to the pin. Optionally, a small series resistor can be placed in the power line to give additional filtering of power-supply noise. The ENBL input, which has a threshold of approximately 1.3 V (see Figure 15), should be tied to VPOS when this feature is not needed. VS(2.7V–5.5V)C20.01μF52.3Ω C10.01μFC40.01μFNCNCINHIENBLBFINVPOSINLOCOMMOFLTVOUTAD83104.7ΩOPTIONALVOUT (RSSI)SIGNALINPUT87651234 Figure 27. Basic Connections While the AD8310’s input can be driven differentially, the input signal is, in general, single-ended. C1 is tied to ground, and the input signal is coupled in through C2. Capacitor C1 and Capacitor C2 should have the same value to minimize start-up transients when the enable feature is used; otherwise, their values need not be equal. The 52.3 Ω resistor combines with the 1.1 kΩ input impedance of the AD8310 to yield a simple broadband 50 Ω input match. An input matching network can also be used (see the Input Matching section). The coupling time constant, 50 × CC/2, forms a high-pass corner with a 3 dB attenuation at fHP = 1/(π × 50 × CC), where C1 = C2 = CC. In high frequency applications, fHP should be as large as possible to minimize the coupling of unwanted low frequency signals. In low frequency applications, a simple RC network forming a low-pass filter should be added at the input for similar reasons. This should generally be placed at the generator side of the coupling capacitors, thereby lowering the required capacitance value for a given high-pass corner frequency. For applications in which the ground plane might not be an equi-potential (possibly due to noise in the ground plane), the low input of an unbalanced source should generally be ac-coupled through a separate connection of the low associated with the source. Furthermore, it is good practice in such situations to break the ground loop by inserting a small resistance to ground in the low side of the input connector (see Figure 28). Figure 28. Connections for Isolation of Source Ground from Device Ground Figure 29 shows the output vs. the input level for sine inputs at 10 MHz, 50 MHz, and 100 MHz. Figure 30 shows the logarith-mic conformance under the same conditions. Figure 29. Output vs. Input Level at 10 MHz, 50 MHz, and 100 MHz AD8310 Rev. F | Page 15 of 24 5ERROR ( dB)4–1–2–3–4203110MHz50MHz ±3dB DYNAMIC RANGE±1dB DYNAMIC RANGE Figure 30. Log Conformance Error vs. Input Level at 10 MHz, 50 MHz, and 100 MHz TRANSFER FUNCTION IN TERMS OF SLOPE AND INTERCEPT The transfer function of the AD8310 is characterized in terms of its slope and intercept. The logarithmic slope is defined as the change in the RSSI output voltage for a 1 dB change at the input. For the AD8310, slope is nominally 24 mV/dB. Therefore, a 10 dB change at the input results in a change at the output of approximately 240 mV. The plot of log conformance shows the range over which the device maintains its constant slope. The dynamic range of the log amp is defined as the range over which the slope remains within a certain error band, usually ±1 dB or ±3 dB. In Figure 30, for example, the ±1 dB dynamic range is approximately 95 dB (from +4 dBV to −91 dBV). The intercept is the point at which the extrapolated linear response would intersect the horizontal axis (see Figure 29). For the AD8310, the intercept is calibrated to be −108 dBV (−95 dBm). Using the slope and intercept, the output voltage can be calculated for any input level within the specified input range using the following equation: VOUT = VSLOPE × (PIN − PO) (3) where: VOUT is the demodulated and filtered RSSI output. VSLOPE is the logarithmic slope expressed in V/dB. PIN is the input signal expressed in dB relative to some reference level (either dBm or dBV in this case). PO is the logarithmic intercept expressed in dB relative to the same reference level. For example, for an input level of −33 dBV (−20 dBm), the output voltage is VOUT = 0.024 V/dB × (−33 dBV − (−108 dBV)) = 1.8 V (4) dBV vs. dBm The most widely used convention in RF systems is to specify power in dBm, decibels above 1 mW in 50 Ω. Specification of the log amp input level in terms of power is strictly a concession to popular convention. As mentioned previously, log amps do not respond to power (power absorbed at the input), but to the input voltage. The use of dBV, defined as decibels with respect to a 1 V rms sine wave, is more precise. However, this is still ambiguous, because waveform is also involved in the response of a log amp, which, for a complex input such as a CDMA signal, does not follow the rms value exactly. Because most users specify RF signals in terms of power (more specifically, in dBm/50 Ω) both dBV and dBm are used to specify the perform-ance of the AD8310, showing equivalent dBm levels for the special case of a 50 Ω environment. Values in dBV are converted to dBm re 50 Ω by adding 13 dB. Table 4. Correction for Signals with Differing Crest Factors Signal Type Correction Factor1 (dB) Sine wave 0 Square wave or dc −3.01 Triangular wave 0.9 GSM channel (all time slots on) 0.55 CDMA channel (forward link, nine channels on) 3.55 CDMA channel (reverse link) 0.5 PDC channel (all time slots on) 0.58 1 Add to the measured input level. INPUT MATCHING Where higher sensitivity is required, an input matching network is useful. Using a transformer to achieve the impedance trans-formation also eliminates the need for coupling capacitors, lowers the offset voltage generated directly at the input, and balances the drive amplitude to INLO and INHI. The choice of turns ratio depends somewhat on the frequency. At frequencies below 50 MHz, the reactance of the input capacitance is much higher than the real part of the input impedance. In this frequency range, a turns ratio of about 1:4.8 lowers the input impedance to 50 Ω, while raising the input voltage lowers the effect of the short-circuit noise voltage by the same factor. The intercept is also lowered by the turns ratio; for a 50 Ω match, it is reduced by 20 log10 (4.8) or 13.6 dB. The total noise is reduced by a somewhat smaller factor, because there is a small contribution from the input noise current. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 16 of 24 NARROW-BAND MATCHING Transformer coupling is useful in broadband applications. However, a magnetically coupled transformer might not be convenient in some situations. Table 5 lists narrow-band matching values. Table 5. Narrow-Band Matching Values fC (MHz) ZIN (Ω) C1 (pF) C2 (pF) LM (nH) Voltage Gain (dB) 10 45 160 150 3300 13.3 20 44 82 75 1600 13.4 50 46 30 27 680 13.4 100 50 15 13 270 13.4 150 57 10 8.2 220 13.2 200 57 7.5 6.8 150 12.8 250 50 6.2 5.6 100 12.3 500 54 3.9 3.3 39 10.9 10 103 100 91 5600 10.4 20 102 51 43 2700 10.4 50 99 22 18 1000 10.6 100 98 11 9.1 430 10.5 150 101 7.5 6.2 260 10.3 200 95 5.6 4.7 180 10.3 250 92 4.3 3.9 130 9.9 500 114 2.2 2.0 47 6.8 At high frequencies, it is often preferable to use a narrow-band matching network, as shown in Figure 31. This has several advan-tages. The same voltage gain is achieved, providing increased sensitivity, but a measure of selectivity is also introduced. The component count is low: two capacitors and an inexpensive chip inductor. Additionally, by making these capacitors unequal, the amplitudes at INP and INM can be equalized when driving from a single-sided source; that is, the network also serves as a balun. Figure 32 shows the response for a center frequency of 100 MHz; note the very high attenuation at low frequencies. The high fre-quency attenuation is due to the input capacitance of the log amp. C1 INHIAD8310SIGNALINPUTLM8 Figure 31. Reactive Matching Network Figure 32. Response of 100 MHz Matching Network GENERAL MATCHING PROCEDURE For other center frequencies and source impedances, the following steps can be used to calculate the basic matching parameters. Step 1: Tune Out CIN At a center frequency, fC, the shunt impedance of the input capacitance, CIN, can be made to disappear by resonating with a temporary inductor, LIN, whose value is given by (5) where CIN = 1.4 pF. For example, at fC = 100 MHz, LIN = 1.8 μH. Step 2: Calculate CO and LO Now, having a purely resistive input impedance, calculate the nominal coupling elements, CO and LO, using (6) For the AD8310, RIN is 1 kΩ. Therefore, if a match to 50 Ω is needed, at fC = 100 MHz, CO must be 7.12 pF and LO must be 356 nH. Step 3: Split CO into Two Parts To provide the desired fully balanced form of the network shown in Figure 31, two capacitors C1 and C2, each of nominally twice CO, can be used. This requires a value of 14.24 pF in this example. Under these conditions, the voltage amplitudes at INHI and INLO are similar. A somewhat better balance in the two drives can be achieved when C1 is made slightly larger than C2, which also allows a wider range of choices in selecting from standard values. For example, capacitors of C1 = 15 pF and C2 = 13 pF can be used, making CO = 6.96 pF. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 17 of 24 ( ) Step 4: Calculate LM The matching inductor required to provide both LIN and LO is the parallel combination of these. (7) With LIN = 1.8 μH and LO = 356 nH, the value of LM to complete this example of a match of 50 Ω at 100 MHz is 297.2 nH. The nearest standard value of 270 nH can be used with only a slight loss of matching accuracy. The voltage gain at resonance depends only on the ratio of impedances, as given by (8) SLOPE AND INTERCEPT ADJUSTMENTS Where system (that is, software) calibration is not available, the adjustments shown in Figure 33 can be used, either singly or in combination, to trim the absolute accuracy of the AD8310. The log slope can be raised or lowered by VR1; the values shown provide a calibration range of ±10% (22.6 mV/dB to 27.4 mV/dB), which includes full allowance for the variability in the value of the internal resistances. The adjustment can be made by alternately applying two fixed input levels, provided by an accurate signal generator, spaced over the central portion of the dynamic range, for example, −60 dBV and −20 dBV. Alternatively, an AM-modulated signal at about the center of the dynamic range can be used. For a modulation depth M, expressed as a fraction, the decibel range between the peaks and troughs over one cycle of the modulation period is given by (9) For example, using a generator output of −40 dBm with a 70% modulation depth (M = 0.7), the decibel range is 15 dB, because the signal varies from −47.5 dBm to −32.5 dBm. The log intercept is adjustable by VR2 over a −3 dB range with the component values shown. VR2 is adjusted while applying an accurately known CW signal, preferably near the lower end of the dynamic range, to minimize the effect of any residual uncertainty in the slope. For example, to position the intercept to −80 dBm, a test level of −65 dBm can be applied, and VR2 can be adjusted to produce a dc output of 15 dB above 0 at 24 mV/dB, which is 360 mV. 52.3 AD8310 Figure 33. Slope and Intercept Adjustments INCREASING THE SLOPE TO A FIXED VALUE It is also possible to increase the slope to a new fixed value and, therefore, to increase the change in output for each decibel of input change. A common example of this is the need to map the output swing of the AD8310 into the input range of an analog-to-digital converter (ADC) with a rail-to-rail input swing. Alternatively, a situation might arise when only a part of the total dynamic range is required (for example, just 20 dB) in an application where the nominal input level is more tightly constrained, and a higher sensitivity to a change in this level is required. Of course, the maximum output is limited by either the load resistance and the maximum output current rating of 25 mA or by the supply voltage (see the Specifications section). The slope can easily be raised by adding a resistor from VOUT to BFIN, as shown in Figure 34. This alters the gain of the output buffer, by means of stable positive feedback, from its normal value of 4 to an effective value that can be as high as 16, corresponding to a slope of 100 mV/dB. INHI 8765 Figure 34. Raising the Slope to 100 mV/dB The resistor, RSLOPE, is set according to the equation SlopeRSLOPEmV/dB241− = (10) AD8310 Rev. F | Page 18 of 24 OUTPUT FILTERING LOWERING THE HIGH-PASS CORNER FREQUENCY OF THE OFFSET COMPENSATION LOOP For applications in which maximum video bandwidth and, consequently, fast rise time are desired, it is essential that the BFIN pin be left unconnected and free of any stray capacitance. In normal operation using an ac-coupled input signal, the OFLT pin should be left unconnected. Input-referred dc offsets of about 1.5 mV in the signal path are nulled via an internal offset control loop. This loop has a high-pass −3 dB corner at about 2 MHz. In low frequency ac-coupled applications, it is necessary to lower this corner frequency to prevent input signals from being misinterpreted as offsets. An external capacitor on OFLT lowers the high-pass corner to arbitrarily low frequencies (Figure 36). For example, by using a 1 μF capacitor, the 3 dB corner is reduced to 60 Hz. The nominal output video bandwidth of 25 MHz can be reduced by connecting a ground-referenced capacitor (CFILT) to the BFIN pin, as shown in Figure 35. This is generally done to reduce out-put ripple (at twice the input frequency for a symmetric input waveform such as sinusoidal signals). +42μA/dB3kΩVOUTBFIN AD8310 Figure 35. Lowering the Postdemodulation Video Bandwidth CFILT is selected using the following equation: Figure 36. Lowering the High-Pass Corner Frequency of the Offset Control Loop (11) The corner frequency is set by the following equation: The video bandwidth should typically be set at a frequency equal to about one-tenth the minimum input frequency. This ensures that the output ripple of the demodulated log output, which is at twice the input frequency, is well filtered. In many log amp applications, it might be necessary to lower the corner frequency of the postdemodulation filtering to achieve low output ripple while maintaining a rapid response time to changes in signal level. An example of a 4-pole active filter is shown in the AD8307 data sheet. (12) where COFLT is the capacitor connected to OFLT. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 19 of 24 APPLICATIONS INFORMATION The AD8310 is highly versatile and easy to use. It needs only a few external components, most of which can be immediately accommodated using the simple connections shown in the Using the AD8310 section. A few examples of more specialized applications are provided in the following sections. See the AD8307 data sheet for more applications (note the slightly different pin configuration). CABLE-DRIVING For a supply voltage of 3 V or greater, the AD8310 can drive a grounded 100 Ω load to 2.5 V. If reverse-termination is required when driving a 50 Ω cable, it should be included in series with the output, as shown in Figure 37. The slope at the load is then 12 mV/dB. In some cases, it might be permissible to operate the cable without a termination at the far end, in which case the slope is not lowered. Where a further increase in slope is desirable, the scheme shown in Figure 34 can be used. AD8310VOUT50Ω50Ω Figure 37. Output Response of Cable-Driver Application DC-COUPLED INPUT It might occasionally be necessary to provide response to dc inputs. Because the AD8310 is internally dc-coupled, there is no reason why this cannot be done. However, its differential inputs must be positioned at least 2 V above the COM potential for proper biasing of the first stage. Usually, the source is a single-sided ground-referenced signal, so level-shifting and a single-ended-to-differential conversion must be provided to correctly drive the AD8310’s inputs. Figure 38 shows how a level-shift to midsupply (2.5 V in this example) and a single-ended-to-differential conversion can be accomplished using the AD8138 differential amplifier. The four 499 Ω resistors set up a gain of unity. An output common-mode (or bias) voltage of 2.5 is achieved by applying 2.5 V from a supply-referenced resistive divider to the VOCM pin of the AD8138. The differential outputs of the AD8138 directly drive the 1.1 kΩ input impedance of the AD8310. Figure 38. DC-Coupled Log Amp In this application the offset voltage of the AD8138 must be trimmed. The internal offset compensation circuitry of the AD8310 is disabled by applying a nominal voltage of ~1.9 V to the OFLT pin, so the trim on the AD8138 is effectively trimming the offsets of both devices. The trim is done by grounding the circuit’s input and slightly varying the gain resistors on the inverting input of the AD8138 (a 50 Ω potentiometer is used in this example) until the voltage on the AD8310’s output reaches a minimum. After trimming, the lower end of the dynamic range is limited by the broadband noise at the output of the AD8138, which is approximately 425 μV p-p. A differential low-pass filter can be added between the AD8138 and the AD8310 when the very fast pulse response of the circuit is not required. Figure 39. Transfer Function of DC-Coupled Log Amp Application AD8310 Rev. F | Page 20 of 24 EVALUATION BOARD An evaluation board is available that has been carefully laid out and tested to demonstrate the specified high speed performance of the AD8310. Figure 40 shows the schematic of the evaluation board, which follows the basic connections schematic shown in Figure 27. Connectors INHI, INLO, and VOUT are of the SMA type. Supply and ground are connected to the TP1 and TP2 vector pins. The layout and silkscreen for the component side of the board are shown in Figure 41 and Figure 42. Switches and component settings for different setups are described in Table 6. For ordering information, see the Ordering Guide. C20.01μFINHIENBLBFINVPOSINLOCOMMOFLTVOUTAD831012348765C40.01μFC10.01μFR352.3ΩSW1ABR40ΩR1INHIINLOTP2C7OPENW1W2R60Ω VOUTC5OPENC3OPENR50ΩTP1VPOSR2 Figure 40. Evaluation Board Schematic Figure 41. Layout of the Component Side of the Evaluation Board 01084-042 Figure 42. Component Side Silkscreen of the Evaluation Board AD8310 Rev. F | Page 21 of 24 Table 6. Evaluation Board Setup Options Component Function Default Condition TP1, TP2 Supply and Ground Vector Pins. Not applicable SW1 Device Enable. When in Position A, the ENBL pin is connected to +VS, and the AD8310 is in normal operating mode. When in Position B, the ENBL pin is connected to ground, putting the device into sleep mode. SW1 = A R1/R4 SMA Connector Grounds. Connects common of INHI and INLO SMA connectors to ground. They can be used to isolate the generator ground from the evaluation board ground. See Figure 28. R1 = R4 = 0 Ω C1, C2, R3 Input Interface. R3 (52.3 Ω) combines with the AD8310’s 1 kΩ input impedance to give an overall broadband input impedance of 50 Ω. C1, C2, and the AD8310’s input impedance combine to set a high-pass input corner of 32 kHz. Alternatively, R3, C1, and C2 can be replaced by an inductor and matching capacitors to form an input matching network. See the Input Matching section for details. R3 = 52.3 Ω, C1 = C2 = 0.01 μF C3 RSSI (Video) Bandwidth Adjust. The addition of C3 (farads) lowers the RSSI bandwidth of the AD8310’s output according to the following equation: CFILT = 1/(2π × 3 kΩ Video Bandwidth) − 2.1 pF C3 = open C4, C5, R5 Supply Decoupling. The normal supply decoupling of 0.01 μF (C4) can be augmented by a larger capacitor in C5. An inductor or small resistor can be placed in R5 for additional decoupling. C4 = 0.01 μF, C5 = open, R5 = 0 Ω R6 Output Source Impedance. In cable-driving applications, a resistor (typically 50 Ω or 75 Ω) can be placed in R6 to give the circuit a back-terminated output impedance. R6 = 0 Ω W1, W2, C6, R7 Output Loading. Resistors and capacitors can be placed in C6 and R7 to load-test VOUT. Jumper W1 and Jumper W2 are used to connect or disconnect the loads. C6 = R7 = open, W1 = W2 = installed C7 Offset Compensation Loop. A capacitor in C7 reduces the corner frequency of the offset control loop in low frequency applications. C7 = open AD8310 DIE INFORMATION Figure 43. Die Outline Dimensions Table 7. Die Pad Function Descriptions Pin No. Mnemonic Description 1 INLO One of Two Balanced Inputs. Biased roughly to VPOS/2. 2 COMM Common Pin. Usually grounded. 3 OFLT Offset Filter Access. Nominally at about 1.75 V. 4 VOUT Low Impedance Output Voltage. Carries a 25 mA maximum load. 5A, 5B VPOS Positive Supply. 2.7 V to 5.5 V at 8 mA quiescent current. 6 BFIN Buffer Input. Used to lower postdetection bandwidth. 7 ENBL CMOS Compatible Chip Enable. Active when high. 8 INHI Second of Two Balanced Inputs. Biased roughly to VPOS/2. AD8310 OUTLINE DIMENSIONS Figure 44. 8-Lead Mini Small Outline Package [MSOP] (RM-8) Dimensions shown in millimeters ORDERING GUIDE Model1 Temperature Range Package Description Package Option Branding AD8310ARM −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, Tube RM-8 J6A AD8310ARM-REEL7 −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, 7” Tape and Reel RM-8 J6A AD8310ARMZ −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, Tube RM-8 J6A AD8310ARMZ-REEL7 −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP, 7” Tape and Reel RM-8 J6A AD8310ACHIPS −40°C to +85°C Die AD8310-EVAL Evaluation Board 1 Z = RoHS Compliant Part. AD8310 Rev. F | Page 24 of 24 NOTES © 2005–2010 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. D01084–0–6/10(F) 3 2 1 20 19 9 10 11 12 13 4 5 6 7 8 18 17 16 15 14 Q NC G Q NC F Q Q NC E A Q NC B QC B A NC CLK CLR V Q D GND NC CC H Q NC − No internal connection 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 A B Q Q Q Q GND A B C D VCC Q Q Q Q CLR H G F E CLK SN54HC164, SN74HC164 www.ti.com SCLS115F –DECEMBER 1982–REVISED OCTOBER 2013 8-Bit Parallel-Out Serial Shift Registers Check for Samples: SN54HC164, SN74HC164 1FEATURES DESCRIPTION • Wide Operating Voltage Range of 2 V to 6 V These 8-bit shift registers feature AND-gated serial • Outputs Can Drive Up To 10 LSTTL Loads inputs and an asynchronous clear (CLR) input. The gated serial (A and B) inputs permit complete control • Low Power Consumption, 80-μA Max ICC over incoming data; a low at either input inhibits entry • Typical tpd= 20 ns of the new data and resets the first flip-flop to the low • ±4-mA Output Drive at 5 V level at the next clock (CLK) pulse. A high-level input enables the other input, which then determines the • Low Input Current of 1-μA Max state of the first flip-flop. Data at the serial inputs can • AND-Gated (Enable/Disable) Serial Inputs be changed while CLK is high or low, provided the • Fully Buffered Clock and Serial Inputs minimum setup time requirements are met. Clocking occurs on the low-to-high-level transition of CLK. • Direct Clear SN54HC164...J OR W PACKAGE SN74HC164...D, N, NS, OR PW PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) SN54HC164...FK PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) FUNCTION TABLE(1)(2) INPUTS OUTPUTS CLR CLK A B QA QB . . . QH L X X X L L L H L X X QA0 QB0 QH0 H ↑ H H H QAn QGn H ↑ L X L QAn QGn H ↑ X L L QAn QGn (1) QA0, QB0, QH0 = the level of QA, QB, or QH, respectively, before the indicated steady-state input conditions were established. (2) QAn, QGn = the level of QA or QG before the most recent ↑ transition of CLK: indicates a 1-bit shift. 1 Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet. PRODUCTION DATA information is current as of publication date. Copyright © 1982–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Products conform to specifications per the terms of the Texas Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not necessarily include testing of all parameters. CLK A B CLR QA QB QC QD QE QF QG QH Clear Clear Serial Inputs Outputs 9 A B CLR CLK Pin numbers shown are for the D, J, N, NS, PW, and W packages. C1 1D R 3 QA C1 1D R 4 QB C1 1D R 5 QC C1 1D R 6 QD C1 1D R 10 QE C1 1D R 11 QF C1 1D R 12 QG C1 1D R 13 QH 2 1 8 SN54HC164, SN74HC164 SCLS115F –DECEMBER 1982–REVISED OCTOBER 2013 www.ti.com LOGIC DIAGRAM (POSITIVE LOGIC) TYPICAL CLEAR, SHIFT, AND CLEAR SEQUENCE 2 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1982–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: SN54HC164 SN74HC164 SN54HC164, SN74HC164 www.ti.com SCLS115F –DECEMBER 1982–REVISED OCTOBER 2013 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted)(1) MIN MAX UNITS VCC Supply voltage range −0.5 7 V IIK Input clamp current VI < 0 or VI > VCC (2) ±20 mA IOK Output clamp current VO < 0 or VO > VCC (2) ±20 mA IO Continuous output current VO = 0 to VCC ±25 mA Continuous current through VCC or GND ±50 mA D package 86 N package 80 θJA (3) Package thermal impedance °C/W NS package 76 PW package 113 Tstg Storage temperature range –65 150 °C (1) Stresses beyond those listed under “absolute maximum ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under “recommended operating conditions” is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. (2) The input and output voltage ratings may be exceeded if the input and output current ratings are observed. (3) The package thermal impedance is calculated in accordance with JESD 51-7. RECOMMENDED OPERATING CONDITIONS(1) SN54HC164 SN74HC164 UNIT MIN NOM MAX MIN NOM MAX VCC Supply voltage 2 5 6 2 5 6 V VCC = 2 V 1.5 1.5 VIH High-level input voltage VCC = 4.5 V 3.15 3.15 V VCC = 6 V 4.2 4.2 VCC = 2 V 0.5 0.5 VIL Low-level input voltage VCC = 4.5 V 1.35 1.35 V VCC = 6 V 1.8 1.8 VI Input voltage 0 VCC 0 VCC V VO Output voltage 0 VCC 0 VCC V VCC = 2 V 1000 1000 Δt/Δv(2) Input transition rise/fall time VCC = 4.5 V 500 500 ns VCC = 6 V 400 400 TA Operating free-air temperature −55 125 −40 125 °C (1) All unused inputs of the device must be held at VCC or GND to ensure proper device operation. Refer to the TI application report, Implications of Slow or Floating CMOS Inputs, literature number SCBA004. (2) If this device is used in the threshold region (from VIL max = 0.5 V to VIH min = 1.5 V), there is a potential to go into the wrong state from induced grounding, causing double clocking. Operating with the inputs at tt = 1000 ns and VCC = 2 V does not damage the device; however, functionally, the CLK inputs are not ensured while in the shift, count, or toggle operating modes. Copyright © 1982–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 3 Product Folder Links: SN54HC164 SN74HC164 SN54HC164, SN74HC164 SCLS115F –DECEMBER 1982–REVISED OCTOBER 2013 www.ti.com ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS over recommended operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) SN54HC164 SN74HC164 Recommended TA = 25°C –55°C to 125°C –55°C to 85°C SN74HC164 PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC –55°C to 125°C UNIT MIN TYP MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX 2 V 1.9 1.998 1.9 1.9 1.9 IOH = −20 μA 4.5 V 4.4 4.499 4.4 4.4 4.4 VOH VI = VIH or VIL 6 V 5.9 5.999 5.9 5.9 5.9 V IOH = −4 mA 4.5 V 3.98 4.3 3.7 3.84 3.7 IOH = −5.2 mA 6 V 5.48 5.8 5.2 5.34 5.2 2 V 0.002 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 IOL = 20 μA 4.5 V 0.001 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 VOL VI = VIH or VIL 6 V 0.001 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 V IOL = 4 mA 4.5 V 0.17 0.26 0.4 0.33 0.4 IOL = 5.2 mA 6 V 0.15 0.26 0.4 0.33 0.4 II VI = VCC or 0 6 V ±0.1 ±100 ±1000 ±1000 ±1000 nA ICC VI = VCC or 0 IO = 0 6 V 8 160 80 160 μA Ci 2 V to 6 V 3 10 10 10 10 pF TIMING REQUIREMENTS over recommended operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) SN54HC164 SN74HC164 Recommended TA = 25°C –55°C to 125°C –55°C to 85°C SN74HC164 PARAMETER VCC –55°C to 125°C UNIT MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX 2 V 6 4.2 5 4.2 fclock Clock frequency 4.5 V 31 21 25 21 MHz 6 V 36 25 28 25 2 V 100 150 125 125 CLR low 4.5 V 20 30 25 25 Pulse 6 V 17 25 21 21 tw duration ns 2 V 80 120 100 120 CLK high or low 4.5 V 16 24 20 24 6 V 14 20 18 20 2 V 100 150 125 125 Data 4.5 V 20 30 25 25 Setup time 6 V 17 25 21 25 tsu before CLK↑ ns 2 V 100 150 125 125 CLR inactive 4.5 V 20 30 25 25 6 V 17 25 21 25 2 V 5 5 5 5 th Hold time, data after CLK↑ 4.5 V 5 5 5 5 ns 6 V 5 5 5 5 4 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1982–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: SN54HC164 SN74HC164 SN54HC164, SN74HC164 www.ti.com SCLS115F –DECEMBER 1982–REVISED OCTOBER 2013 SWITCHING CHARACTERISTICS over recommended operating free-air temperature range, CL = 50 pF (unless otherwise noted) (see Figure 1) SN54HC164 SN74HC164 Recommended PARAMETE FROM TO TA = 25°C SN74HC164 (OUTPUT VCC –55°C to 125°C –55°C to 85°C –55°C to 125°C UNIT R (INPUT) ) MIN TYP MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN MAX 2 V 6 10 4.2 5 4..2 fmax 4.5 V 31 54 21 25 21 MHz 6 V 36 62 25 28 25 2 V 140 205 295 255 255 tPHL CLR Any Q 4.5 V 28 41 59 51 51 6 V 24 35 51 46 46 ns 2 V 115 175 265 220 220 tpd CLK Any Q 4.5 V 23 35 53 44 44 6 V 20 30 45 38 38 2 V 38 75 110 95 110 tt 4.5 V 8 15 22 19 22 ns 6 V 6 13 19 16 19 OPERATING CHARACTERISTICS TA = 25°C PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS TYP UNIT Cpd Power dissipation capacitance No load 135 pF Copyright © 1982–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 5 Product Folder Links: SN54HC164 SN74HC164 VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS SETUP AND HOLD AND INPUT RISE AND FALL TIMES VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS PULSE DURATIONS tsu th 50% 50% 50% 10% 10% 90% 90% VCC VCC 0 V 0 V tr t Reference f Input Data Input 50% High-Level Pulse 50% VCC 0 V 50% 50% VCC 0 V t Low-Level w Pulse VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS PROPAGATION DELAY AND OUTPUT TRANSITION TIMES 50% 50% 50% 10% 10% 90% 90% VCC VOH VOL 0 V tr t Input f In-Phase Output 50% tPLH tPHL 50% 50% 10% 10% 90% 90% VOH VOL tf tr tPHL tPLH Out-of-Phase Output NOTES: A. CL includes probe and test-fixture capacitance. B. Phase relationships between waveforms were chosen arbitrarily. All input pulses are supplied by generators having the following characteristics: PRR ! 1 MHz, ZO = 50 !, tr = 6 ns, tf = 6 ns. C. For clock inputs, fmax is measured when the input duty cycle is 50%. D. The outputs are measured one at a time with one input transition per measurement. E. tPLH and tPHL are the same as tpd. Test Point From Output Under Test CL = 50 pF (see Note A) LOAD CIRCUIT SN54HC164, SN74HC164 SCLS115F –DECEMBER 1982–REVISED OCTOBER 2013 www.ti.com PARAMETER MEASUREMENT INFORMATION Figure 1. Load Circuit and Voltage Waveforms 6 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1982–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links: SN54HC164 SN74HC164 SN54HC164, SN74HC164 www.ti.com SCLS115F –DECEMBER 1982–REVISED OCTOBER 2013 REVISION HISTORY Changes from Revision E (November 2010) to Revision F Page • Updated document to new TI data sheet format - no specification changes. ...................................................................... 1 • Removed ordering information. ............................................................................................................................................ 1 • Updated operating temperature range. ................................................................................................................................. 3 Copyright © 1982–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 7 Product Folder Links: SN54HC164 SN74HC164 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 10-Jun-2014 Addendum-Page 1 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples 5962-8416201VCA ACTIVE CDIP J 14 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 5962-8416201VC A SNV54HC164J 5962-8416201VDA ACTIVE CFP W 14 25 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 5962-8416201VD A SNV54HC164W 84162012A ACTIVE LCCC FK 20 1 TBD POST-PLATE N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 84162012A SNJ54HC 164FK 8416201CA ACTIVE CDIP J 14 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 8416201CA SNJ54HC164J SN54HC164J ACTIVE CDIP J 14 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 SN54HC164J SN74HC164D ACTIVE SOIC D 14 50 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164DE4 ACTIVE SOIC D 14 50 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164DG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 14 50 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164DR ACTIVE SOIC D 14 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU | CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164DRG3 ACTIVE SOIC D 14 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164DRG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 14 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164DT ACTIVE SOIC D 14 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164N ACTIVE PDIP N 14 25 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU | CU SN N / A for Pkg Type -40 to 125 SN74HC164N SN74HC164N3 OBSOLETE PDIP N 14 TBD Call TI Call TI -40 to 125 SN74HC164NE3 PREVIEW PDIP N 14 25 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 SN74HC164N SN74HC164NE4 ACTIVE PDIP N 14 25 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU N / A for Pkg Type -40 to 125 SN74HC164N PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 10-Jun-2014 Addendum-Page 2 Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples SN74HC164NSR ACTIVE SO NS 14 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164PW ACTIVE TSSOP PW 14 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164PWG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 14 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164PWR ACTIVE TSSOP PW 14 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164PWRE4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 14 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164PWRG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 14 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164PWT ACTIVE TSSOP PW 14 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SN74HC164PWTG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 14 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 125 HC164 SNJ54HC164FK ACTIVE LCCC FK 20 1 TBD POST-PLATE N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 84162012A SNJ54HC 164FK SNJ54HC164J ACTIVE CDIP J 14 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 8416201CA SNJ54HC164J SNJ54HC164W ACTIVE CFP W 14 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 8416201DA SNJ54HC164W (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 10-Jun-2014 Addendum-Page 3 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. OTHER QUALIFIED VERSIONS OF SN54HC164, SN54HC164-SP, SN74HC164 : • Catalog: SN74HC164, SN54HC164 • Military: SN54HC164 • Space: SN54HC164-SP NOTE: Qualified Version Definitions: • Catalog - TI's standard catalog product • Military - QML certified for Military and Defense Applications • Space - Radiation tolerant, ceramic packaging and qualified for use in Space-based application TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Reel Diameter (mm) Reel Width W1 (mm) A0 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W (mm) Pin1 Quadrant SN74HC164DR SOIC D 14 2500 330.0 16.4 6.5 9.0 2.1 8.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164DR SOIC D 14 2500 330.0 16.4 6.5 9.0 2.1 8.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164DR SOIC D 14 2500 330.0 16.8 6.5 9.5 2.3 8.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164DRG3 SOIC D 14 2500 330.0 16.8 6.5 9.5 2.3 8.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164DRG4 SOIC D 14 2500 330.0 16.4 6.5 9.0 2.1 8.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164DRG4 SOIC D 14 2500 330.0 16.4 6.5 9.0 2.1 8.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164DT SOIC D 14 250 330.0 16.4 6.5 9.0 2.1 8.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164NSR SO NS 14 2000 330.0 16.4 8.2 10.5 2.5 12.0 16.0 Q1 SN74HC164PWR TSSOP PW 14 2000 330.0 12.4 6.9 5.6 1.6 8.0 12.0 Q1 SN74HC164PWT TSSOP PW 14 250 330.0 12.4 6.9 5.6 1.6 8.0 12.0 Q1 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 7-Apr-2014 Pack Materials-Page 1 *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) SN74HC164DR SOIC D 14 2500 367.0 367.0 38.0 SN74HC164DR SOIC D 14 2500 333.2 345.9 28.6 SN74HC164DR SOIC D 14 2500 364.0 364.0 27.0 SN74HC164DRG3 SOIC D 14 2500 364.0 364.0 27.0 SN74HC164DRG4 SOIC D 14 2500 333.2 345.9 28.6 SN74HC164DRG4 SOIC D 14 2500 367.0 367.0 38.0 SN74HC164DT SOIC D 14 250 367.0 367.0 38.0 SN74HC164NSR SO NS 14 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 SN74HC164PWR TSSOP PW 14 2000 367.0 367.0 35.0 SN74HC164PWT TSSOP PW 14 250 367.0 367.0 35.0 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 7-Apr-2014 Pack Materials-Page 2 IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 0.1 GHz to 2.5 GHz 70 dB Logarithmic Detector/Controller AD8313 Rev. D Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other rights of third parties that may result from its use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A. Tel: 781.329.4700 www.analog.com Fax: 781.326.8703 © 2004 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. FEATURES Wide bandwidth: 0.1 GHz to 2.5 GHz min High dynamic range: 70 dB to ±3.0 dB High accuracy: ±1.0 dB over 65 dB range (@ 1.9 GHz) Fast response: 40 ns full-scale typical Controller mode with error output Scaling stable over supply and temperature Wide supply range: 2.7 V to 5.5 V Low power: 40 mW at 3 V Power-down feature: 60 mW at 3 V Complete and easy to use APPLICATIONS RF transmitter power amplifier setpoint control and level monitoring Logarithmic amplifier for RSSI measurement cellular base stations, radio link, radar FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM +++++AD8313VOUTVSETCOMMPWDNGAINBIASBAND GAPREFERENCESLOPECONTROLINTERCEPTCONTROLEIGHT 8dB 3.5GHz AMPLIFIER STAGES8dB8dBVPOSINHIINLOVPOS8dB8dBNINE DETECTOR CELLSCINTLPI→VV→I1876523401085-C-001 Figure 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION The AD8313 is a complete multistage demodulating logarithmic amplifier that can accurately convert an RF signal at its differ-ential input to an equivalent decibel-scaled value at its dc output. The AD8313 maintains a high degree of log conformance for signal frequencies from 0.1 GHz to 2.5 GHz and is useful over the range of 10 MHz to 3.5 GHz. The nominal input dynamic range is –65 dBm to 0 dBm (re: 50 Ω), and the sensitivity can be increased by 6 dB or more with a narrow-band input impedance matching network or a balun. Application is straightforward, requiring only a single supply of 2.7 V to 5.5 V and the addition of a suitable input and supply decoupling. Operating on a 3 V supply, its 13.7 mA consumption (for TA = 25°C) is only 41 mW. A power-down feature is provided; the input is taken high to initiate a low current (20 μA) sleep mode, with a threshold at half the supply voltage. The AD8313 uses a cascade of eight amplifier/limiter cells, each having a nominal gain of 8 dB and a −3 dB bandwidth of 3.5 GHz. This produces a total midband gain of 64 dB. At each amplifier output, a detector (rectifier) cell is used to convert the RF signal to baseband form; a ninth detector cell is placed directly at the input of the AD8313. The current-mode outputs of these cells are summed to generate a piecewise linear approxi-mation to the logarithmic function. They are converted to a low impedance voltage-mode output by a transresistance stage, which also acts as a low-pass filter. When used as a log amplifier, scaling is determined by a separate feedback interface (a transconductance stage) that sets the slope to approximately 18 mV/dB; used as a controller, this stage accepts the setpoint input. The logarithmic intercept is positioned to nearly −100 dBm, and the output runs from about 0.45 V dc at −73 dBm input to 1.75 V dc at 0 dBm input. The scale and intercept are supply- and temperature-stable. The AD8313 is fabricated on Analog Devices’ advanced 25 GHz silicon bipolar IC process and is available in an 8-lead MSOP package. The operating temperature range is −40°C to +85°C. An evaluation board is available. INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)2.0–80OUTPUT VOLTAGE ( V DC)1.81.61.41.21.00.80.60.40.20–70–60–50–40–30–20–100FREQUENCY = 1.9GHz543210–1–2–3–4–5OUTPUT ERROR ( dB)01085-C-002 Figure 2. Typical Logarithmic Response and Error vs. Input Amplitude AD8313 Rev. D | Page 2 of 24 TABLE OF CONTENTS Specifications.....................................................................................3 Absolute Maximum Ratings............................................................6 ESD Caution..................................................................................6 Pin Configurations and Function Description.............................7 Typical Performance Characteristics.............................................8 Circuit Description.........................................................................11 Interfaces..........................................................................................13 Power-Down Interface, PWDN................................................13 Signal Inputs, INHI, INLO........................................................13 Logarithmic/Error Output, VOUT..........................................13 Setpoint Interface, VSET............................................................14 Applications.....................................................................................15 Basic Connections for Log (RSSI) Mode.................................15 Operating in Controller Mode.................................................15 Input Coupling...........................................................................16 Narrow-Band LC Matching Example at 100 MHz................16 Adjusting the Log Slope.............................................................18 Increasing Output Current........................................................19 Effect of Waveform Type on Intercept.....................................19 Evaluation Board............................................................................20 Schematic and Layout................................................................20 General Operation.....................................................................20 Using the AD8009 Operational Amplifier..............................20 Varying the Logarithmic Slope.................................................20 Operating in Controller Mode.................................................20 RF Burst Response.....................................................................20 Outline Dimensions.......................................................................24 Ordering Guide..........................................................................24 REVISION HISTORY 6/04—Data Sheet Changed from Rev. C to Rev. D Updated Evaluation Board Section..............................................21 2/03—Data Sheet changed from Rev. B to Rev. C TPCs and Figures Renumbered........................................Universal Edits to SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................2 Updated ESD CAUTION................................................................4 Updated OUTLINE DIMENSIONS..............................................7 8/99—Data Sheet changed from Rev. A to Rev. B 5/99—Data Sheet changed from Rev. 0 to Rev. A 8/98—Revision 0: Initial Version AD8313 Rev. D | Page 3 of 24 SPECIFICATIONS TA = 25°C, VS = 5 V1, RL 10 kΩ, unless otherwise noted. Table 1. Parameter Conditions Min2 Typ Max2 Unit SIGNAL INPUT INTERFACE Specified Frequency Range 0.1 2.5 GHz DC Common-Mode Voltage VPOS – 0.75 V Input Bias Currents 10 μA Input Impedance fRF < 100 MHz3 900||1.1 Ω||pF4 LOG (RSSI) MODE Sinusoidal, input termination configuration shown in Figure 29 100 MHz5 Nominal conditions ±3 dB Dynamic Range6 53.5 65 dB Range Center −31.5 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 56 dB Slope 17 19 21 mV/dB Intercept −96 −88 −80 dBm 2.7 V ≤ VS ≤ 5.5 V, −40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C ±3 dB Dynamic Range 51 64 dB Range Center −31 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 55 dB Slope 16 19 22 mV/dB Intercept −99 −89 −75 dBm Temperature Sensitivity PIN = −10 dBm −0.022 dB/°C 900 MHz5 Nominal conditions ±3 dB Dynamic Range 60 69 dB Range Center −32.5 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 62 dB Slope 15.5 18 20.5 mV/dB Intercept −105 −93 −81 dBm 2.7 V ≤ VS ≤ 5.5 V, –40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C ±3 dB Dynamic Range 55.5 68.5 dB Range Center –32.75 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 61 dB Slope 15 18 21 mV/dB Intercept –110 –95 –80 dBm Temperature Sensitivity PIN = –10 dBm –0.019 dB/°C 1.9 GHz7 Nominal conditions ±3 dB Dynamic Range 52 73 dB Range Center –36.5 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 62 dB Slope 15 17.5 20.5 mV/dB Intercept –115 –100 –85 dBm 2.7 V ≤ VS ≤ 5.5 V, –40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C ±3 dB Dynamic Range 50 73 dB Range Center –36.5 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 60 dB Slope 14 17.5 21.5 mV/dB Intercept –125 –101 –78 dBm Temperature Sensitivity PIN = –10 dBm –0.019 dB/°C AD8313 Rev. D | Page 4 of 24 Parameter Conditions Min2 Typ Max2 Unit 2.5 GHz7 Nominal conditions ±3 dB Dynamic Range 48 66 dB Range Center –34 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 46 dB Slope 16 20 25 mV/dB Intercept –111 –92 –72 dBm 2.7 V ≤ VS ≤ 5.5 V, –40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C ±3 dB Dynamic Range 47 68 dB Range Center –34.5 dBm ±1 dB Dynamic Range 46 dB Slope 14.5 20 25 mV/dB Intercept –128 –92 –56 dBm Temperature Sensitivity PIN =–10 dBm –0.040 dB/°C 3.5 GHz5 Nominal conditions ±3 dB Dynamic Range 43 dB ±1 dB Dynamic Range 35 dB Slope 24 mV/dB Intercept –65 dBm CONTROL MODE Controller Sensitivity f = 900 MHz 23 V/dB Low Frequency Gain VSET to VOUT8 84 dB Open-Loop Corner Frequency VSET to VOUT8 700 Hz Open-Loop Slew Rate f = 900 MHz 2.5 V/μs VSET Delay Time 150 ns VOUT INTERFACE Current Drive Capability Source Current 400 μA Sink Current 10 mA Minimum Output Voltage Open-loop 50 mV Maximum Output Voltage Open-loop VPOS – 0.1 V Output Noise Spectral Density PIN = –60 dBm, fSPOT = 100 Hz 2.0 μV/√Hz PIN = –60 dBm, fSPOT = 10 MHz 1.3 μV/√Hz Small Signal Response Time PIN = –60 dBm to –57 dBm, 10% to 90% 40 60 ns Large Signal Response Time PIN = No signal to 0 dBm; settled to 0.5 dB 110 160 ns VSET INTERFACE Input Voltage Range 0 VPOS V Input Impedance 18||1 kΩ||pF4 POWER-DOWN INTERFACE PWDN Threshold VPOS/2 V Power-Up Response Time Time delay following high to low transition until device meets full specifications. 1.8 μs PWDN Input Bias Current PWDN = 0 V 5 μA PWDN = VS <1 μA POWER SUPPLY Operating Range 2.7 5.5 V Powered-Up Current 13.7 15.5 mA 4.5 V ≤VS ≤ 5.5 V, –40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C 18.5 mA 2.7 V ≤VS ≤ 3.3 V, –40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C 18.5 mA Powered-Down Current 4.5 V ≤VS ≤ 5.5 V, –40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C 50 150 μA 2.7 V ≤VS ≤ 3.3 V, –40°C ≤ T ≤ +85°C 20 50 μA AD8313 Rev. D | Page 5 of 24 1 Except where otherwise noted; performance at VS = 3 V is equivalent to 5 V operation. 2 Minimum and maximum specified limits on parameters that are guaranteed but not tested are 6 sigma values. 3 Input impedance shown over frequency range in Figure 26. 4 Double vertical bars (||) denote “in parallel with.” 5 Linear regression calculation for error curve taken from –40 dBm to –10 dBm for all parameters. 6 Dynamic range refers to range over which the linearity error remains within the stated bound. 7 Linear regression calculation for error curve taken from –60 dBm to –5 dBm for 3 dB dynamic range. All other regressions taken from –40 dBm to –10 dBm. 8 AC response shown in Figure 12. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 6 of 24 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS Table 2. Supply Voltage VS 5.5 V VOUT, VSET, PWDN 0 V, VPOS Input Power Differential (re: 50 Ω, 5.5 V) 25 dBm Input Power Single-Ended (re: 50 Ω, 5.5 V) 19 dBm Internal Power Dissipation 200 mW θJA 200°C/W Maximum Junction Temperature 125°C Operating Temperature Range –40°C to +85°C Storage Temperature Range –65°C to +150°C Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only; functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operational section of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. ESD CAUTION ESD (electrostatic discharge) sensitive device. Electrostatic charges as high as 4000 V readily accumulate on the human body and test equipment and can discharge without detection. Although this product features proprietary ESD protection circuitry, permanent damage may occur on devices subjected to high energy electrostatic discharges. Therefore, proper ESD precautions are recommended to avoid performance degradation or loss of functionality. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 7 of 24 PIN CONFIGURATIONS AND FUNCTION DESCRIPTION VPOS1INHI2INLO3VPOS4VOUT8VSET7COMM6PWDN5AD8313TOP VIEW(Not to Scale)01085-C-003 Figure 3. Pin Configuration Table 3. Pin Function Descriptions Pin No. Mnemonic Description 1, 4 VPOS Positive Supply Voltage (VPOS), 2.7 V to 5.5 V. 2 INHI Noninverting Input. This input should be ac-coupled. 3 INLO Inverting Input. This input should be ac-coupled. 5 PWDN Connect Pin to Ground for Normal Operating Mode. Connect this pin to the supply for power-down mode. 6 COMM Device Common. 7 VSET Setpoint Input for Operation in Controller Mode. To operate in RSSI mode, short VSET and VOUT. 8 VOUT Logarithmic/Error Output. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 8 of 24 TYPICAL PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS TA = 25°C, VS = 5 V, RL input match shown in Figure 29, unless otherwise noted. INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)2.0–70VOUT ( V)1.81.61.41.21.00.80.60.40.20–60–50–40–30–20–100101.9GHz2.5GHz900MHz100MHz01085-C-004 Figure 4. VOUT vs. Input Amplitude INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)6–6–7010–60ERROR ( dB)–50–40–30–20–100420–2–4900MHz100MHz100MHz900MHz1.9GHz2.5GHz2.5GHz1.9GHz01085-C-005 Figure 5. Log Conformance vs. Input Amplitude INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)2.0–70VOUT ( V)1.81.61.41.21.00.80.60.40.20–60–50–40–30–20–10010543210–1–2–3–4–5ERROR ( dB)–40°C+25°C+85°CSLOPE AND INTERCEPT NORMALIZED AT +25°CAND APPLIED TO–40°C AND +85°C01085-C-006 Figure 6. VOUT and Log Conformance vs. Input Amplitude at 100 MHz for Multiple Temperatures INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)2.0–70VOUT ( V)1.81.61.41.21.00.80.60.40.20–60–50–40–30–20–10010543210–1–2–3–4–5ERROR ( dB)+25°C+85°C–40°CSLOPE AND INTERCEPT NORMALIZED AT +25°CAND APPLIED TO–40°C AND +85°C01-85-C-007 Figure 7. VOUT and Log Conformance vs. Input Amplitude at 900 MHz for Multiple Temperatures INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)2.0–70VOUT ( V)1.81.61.41.21.00.80.60.40.20–60–50–40–30–20–10010543210–1–2–3–4–5ERROR ( dB)–40°C+25°C+85°CSLOPE AND INTERCEPT NORMALIZED AT +25°CAND APPLIED TO–40°C AND +85°C01085-C-008 Figure 8. VOUT and Log Conformance vs. Input Amplitude at 1.9 GHz for Multiple Temperatures INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)2.0–70VOUT ( V)1.81.61.41.21.00.80.60.40.20–60–50–40–30–20–10010543210–1–2–3–4–5ERROR ( dB)–40°C+25°C+85°CSLOPE AND INTERCEPTNORMALIZED AT +25°C ANDAPPLIED TO–40°C AND +85°C01085-C-009 Figure 9. VOUT and Log Conformance vs. Input Amplitude at 2.5 GHz for Multiple Temperatures AD8313 Rev. D | Page 9 of 24 FREQUENCY (MHz)22211602500500SLOPE ( mV/dB)10001500200020191817–40°C+25°C+85°C01085-C-010 Figure 10. VOUT Slope vs. Frequency for Multiple Temperatures SUPPLY VOLTAGE (V)242.5SLOPE ( mV/dB)232221201918171615143.03.54.04.55.05.56.01.9GHz2.5GHz900MHz100MHzSPECIFIED OPERATING RANGE01085-C-011 Figure 11. VOUT Slope vs. Supply Voltage FREQUENCY (Hz)VSET TO VOUT GAIN (dB)1001k10k100k1M REF LEVEL = 92dBSCALE: 10dB/DIV01085-C-012 Figure 12. AC Response from VSET to VOUTFREQUENCY (MHz)–11002500500INTERCEPT ( dBm)100015002000–70–80–90–100+85°C–40°C+25°C01085-C-013 Figure 13. VOUT Intercept vs. Frequency for Multiple Temperatures SUPPLY VOLTAGE (V)–702.5INTERCEPT ( dBm)–75–80–85–90–95–100–105–1103.03.54.04.55.05.56.01.9GHz2.5GHz900MHz100MHzSPECIFIED OPERATING RANGE01085-C-014 Figure 14. VOUT Intercept vs. Supply Voltage FREQUENCY (Hz)100100.1μV/ Hz11k10k100k1M10M2GHz RF INPUTRF INPUT–70dBm–60dBm–55dBm–50dBm–45dBm–40dBm–35dBm–30dBm01085-C-015 Figure 15. VOUT Noise Spectral Density AD8313 Rev. D | Page 10 of 24 PWDN VOLTAGE (V)0100.00SUPPLY CURRENT ( mA)10.001.000.100.012134 5 40μAVPOS = +3VVPOS = +5V20μA13.7mA01085-C-016 Figure 16. Typical Supply Current vs. PWDN Voltage CH. 1 AND CH. 2: 1V/DIVCH. 3: 5V/DIVHORIZONTAL: 1μs/DIVVOUT @VS = +5.5VPWDNCH. 1 GNDCH. 2 GNDCH. 3 GNDVOUT @VS = +2.7V01085-C-017 Figure 17. PWDN Response Time CH. 1CH. 1 GNDCH. 2 GNDCH. 2CH. 1 AND CH. 2: 200mV/DIVAVERAGE: 50 SAMPLESVS = +5.5VVS = +2.7VHORIZONTAL: 50ns/DIVPULSED RF100MHz,–45dBm01085-C-019 Figure 18. Response Time, No Signal to –45 dBm CH.1&CH.2:500mV/DIVAVERAGE:50SAMPLESHORIZONTAL:50ns/DIVCH. 1 GNDCH. 2 GNDPULSED RF100MHz,0dBmCH.1CH.2VS = +5.5VVS = +2.7V01085-C-020 Figure 19. Response Time, No Signal to 0 dBm ________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________ HP8648BSIGNALGENERATORHP8112APULSEGENERATOR0.1μF54.9Ω0.01μF0.01μF10Ω10Ω0.1μF+VS+VSTEKTDS784CSCOPE87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD8313TEK P6205FET PROBETRIG0603 SIZE SURFACEMOUNT COMPONENTS ONA LOW LEAKAGE PC BOARDEXT TRIGOUTPIN = 0dBmRF OUT10MHz REF OUTPUT01085-C-018 Figure 20. Test Setup for PWDN Response Time 0.1μF54.9Ω0.01μF0.01μF10Ω10Ω0.1μF+VS+VSTEKTDS784CSCOPE87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD8313TEK P6205FET PROBETRIG0603 SIZE SURFACEMOUNT COMPONENTS ONA LOW LEAKAGE PC BOARD01085-C-021TRIGOUTEXT TRIGRF OUT10MHz REF OUTPUT–6dBRFSPLITTER–6dBHP8648BSIGNALGENERATORPULSEMODULATIONMODEPULSE MODE INOUTHP8112APULSEGENERATOR Figure 21. Test Setup for RSSI Mode Pulse Response AD8313 Rev. D | Page 11 of 24 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION The AD8313 is an 8-stage logarithmic amplifier, specifically designed for use in RF measurement and power amplifier control applications at frequencies up to 2.5 GHz. A block diagram is shown in Figure 22. For a detailed description of log amp theory and design principles, refer to the AD8307 data sheet. +++++AD8313VOUTVSETCOMMPWDNGAINBIASBAND GAPREFERENCESLOPECONTROLINTERCEPTCONTROLEIGHT 8dB 3.5GHz AMPLIFIER STAGES8dB8dBVPOSINHIINLOVPOS8dB8dBNINE DETECTOR CELLSCINTLPI→VV→I1876523401085-C-001 Figure 22. Block Diagram A fully differential design is used. Inputs INHI and INLO (Pins 2 and 3) are internally biased to approximately 0.75 V below the supply voltage, and present a low frequency impedance of nominally 900 Ω in parallel with 1.1 pF. The noise spectral density referred to the input is 0.6 nV/√Hz, equivalent to a voltage of 35 V rms in a 3.5 GHz bandwidth, or a noise power of −76 dBm re: 50 Ω. This sets the lower limit to the dynamic range; the Applications section shows how to increase the sensitivity by using a matching network or input transformer. However, the low end accuracy of the AD8313 is enhanced by specially shaping the demodulation transfer characteristic to partially compensate for errors due to internal noise. Each of the eight cascaded stages has a nominal voltage gain of 8 dB and a bandwidth of 3.5 GHz. Each stage is supported by precision biasing cells that determine this gain and stabilize it against supply and temperature variations. Since these stages are direct-coupled and the dc gain is high, an offset compensation loop is included. The first four stages and the biasing system are powered from Pin 4, while the later stages and the output inter-faces are powered from Pin 1. The biasing is controlled by a logic interface PWDN (Pin 5); this is grounded for normal operation, but may be taken high (to VS) to disable the chip. The threshold is at VPOS/2 and the biasing functions are enabled and disabled within 1.8 μs. Each amplifier stage has a detector cell associated with its output. These nonlinear cells perform an absolute value (full-wave rectification) function on the differential voltages along this backbone in a transconductance fashion; their outputs are in current-mode form and are thus easily summed. A ninth detector cell is added at the input of the AD8313. Since the midrange response of each of these nine detector stages is separated by 8 dB, the overall dynamic range is about 72 dB (Figure 23). The upper end of this range is determined by the capacity of the first detector cell, and occurs at approximately 0 dBm. The practical dynamic range is over 70 dB to the ±3 dB error points. However, some erosion of this range can occur at temperature and frequency extremes. Useful operation to over 3 GHz is possible, and the AD8313 remains serviceable at 10 MHz, needing only a small amount of additional ripple filtering. INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)2.0–80VOUT ( V)1.81.61.41.21.00.80.60.40.20–70–60–50–40–30–20–100543210–1–2–3–4–5ERROR ( dB)–90INTERCEPT =–100dBmSLOPE = 18mV/dB01085-c-023 Figure 23. Typical RSSI Response and Error vs. Input Power at 1.9 GHz The fluctuating current output generated by the detector cells, with a fundamental component at twice the signal frequency, is filtered first by a low-pass section inside each cell, and then by the output stage. The output stage converts these currents to a voltage, VOUT, at VOUT (Pin 8), which can swing rail-to-rail. The filter exhibits a 2-pole response with a corner at approximately 12 MHz and full-scale rise time (10% to 90%) of 40 ns. The residual output ripple at an input frequency of 100 MHz has an amplitude of under 1 mV. The output can drive a small resistive load; it can source currents of up to 400 μA, and sink up to 10 mA. The output is stable with any capacitive load, though settling time could be impaired. The low frequency incremental output impedance is approximately 0.2 Ω. In addition to its use as an RF power measurement device (that is, as a logarithmic amplifier), the AD8313 may also be used in controller applications by breaking the feedback path from VOUT to VSET (Pin 7), which determines the slope of the output (nominally 18 mV/dB). This pin becomes the setpoint input in controller modes. In this mode, the voltage VOUT remains close to ground (typically under 50 mV) until the decibel equivalent of the voltage VSET is reached at the input, when VOUT makes a rapid transition to a voltage close to VPOS (see the Operating in Controller Mode section). The logarithmic intercept is nominally positioned at −100 dBm (re: 50 Ω); this is effective in both the log amp mode and the controller mode. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 12 of 24 With Pins 7 and 8 connected (log amp mode), the output can be stated as )dBm100(+=INSLOPEOUTPVV where PIN is the input power stated in dBm when the source is directly terminated in 50 Ω. However, the input impedance of the AD8313 is much higher than 50 Ω, and the sensitivity of this device may be increased by about 12 dB by using some type of matching network (see below), which adds a voltage gain and lowers the intercept by the same amount. Dependence on the ref-erence impedance can be avoided by restating the expression as )V2.2/(log20μ×××=INSLOPEOUTVVV where VIN is the rms value of a sinusoidal input appearing across Pins 2 and 3; here, 2.2 μV corresponds to the intercept, expressed in voltage terms. For detailed information on the effect of signal waveform and metrics on the intercept positioning for a log amp, refer to the AD8307 data sheet. With Pins 7 and 8 disconnected (controller mode), the output can be stated as SETINSLOPESOUTVPVVV>→)100/(logwhen SETINSLOPEOUTVPVV<→)100/(logwhen0 when the input is stated in terms of the power of a sinusoidal signal across a net termination impedance of 50 Ω. The transition zone between high and low states is very narrow since the output stage behaves essentially as a fast integrator. The above equations can be restated as SETINSLOPESOUTVVVVV>μ→)V2.2/(logwhen SETINSLOPEOUTVVVV<μ→)V2.2/(logwhen0 Another use of the separate VOUT and VSET pins is in raising the load-driving current capability by including an external NPN emitter follower. More complete information about usage in these modes is provided in the Applications section. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 13 of 24 INTERFACES This section describes the signal and control interfaces and their behavior. On-chip resistances and capacitances exhibit variations of up to ±20%. These resistances are sometimes temperature-dependent, and the capacitances may be voltage-dependent. POWER-DOWN INTERFACE, PWDN The power-down threshold is accurately centered at the midpoint of the supply as shown in Figure 24. If Pin 5 is left unconnected or tied to the supply voltage (recommended), the bias enable current is shut off, and the current drawn from the supply is predominately through a nominal 300 kΩ chain (20 μA at 3 V). When grounded, the bias system is turned on. The threshold level is accurately at VPOS/2. When operating in the device ON state, the input bias current at the PWDN pin is approximately 5 μA for VPOS = 3 V. 5PWDNVPOS75kΩ6COMM150kΩ50kΩ150kΩTO BIASENABLE401085-C-024 Figure 24. Power-Down Threshold Circuitry SIGNAL INPUTS, INHI, INLO The simplest low frequency ac model for this interface consists of just a 900 Ω resistance, RIN, in shunt with a 1.1 pF input cap-acitance, CIN, connected across INHI and INLO. Figure 25 shows these distributed in the context of a more complete schematic. The input bias voltage shown is for the enabled chip; when disabled, it rises by a few hundred millivolts. If the input is coupled via capacitors, this change may cause a low level signal transient to be introduced, having a time constant formed by these capacitors and RIN. For this reason, large coupling capacitors should be well matched. This is not necessary when using the small capacitors found in many impedance transforming networks used at high frequencies. 1.25kΩCOMMVPOSINHIINLOVPOS0.5pF0.5pF0.7pF2.5kΩ2.5kΩ~0.75V(1ST DETECTOR)250Ω~1.4mA125Ω125Ω1.25kΩ1.24VGAIN BIASTO 2NDSTAGETO STAGES1 TO 4123401085-C-025 Figure 25. Input Interface Simplified Schematic For high frequency use, Figure 26 shows the input impedance plotted on a Smith chart. This measured result of a typical device includes a 191 mil 50 Ω trace and a 680 pF capacitor to ground from the INLO pin. 1.1pF900Ω1.9GHzFrequency100MHz900MHz1.9GHz2.5GHzR650552223+jX–j400–j135–j65–j432.5GHz900MHz100MHzAD8313 MEASURED01085-C-026 Figure 26. Typical Input Impedance LOGARITHMIC/ERROR OUTPUT, VOUT The rail-to-rail output interface is shown in Figure 27. VOUT can run from within about 50 mV of ground, to within about 100 mV of the supply voltage, and is short-circuit safe to either supply. However, the sourcing load current, ISOURCE, is limited to that which is provided by the PNP transistor, typically 400 μA. Larger load currents can be provided by adding an external NPN transistor (see the Applications section). The dc open-loop gain of this amplifier is high, and it may be regarded as an integrator having a capacitance of 2 pF (CINT) driven by the current-mode signal generated by the summed outputs of the nine detector stages, which is scaled approximately 4.0 μA/dB. COMMgmSTAGECINTLPLM10mAMAXVOUTCLBIASISOURCE400μAVPOSFROMSETPOINTSUMMEDDETECTOROUTPUTS68101085-C-027 Figure 27. Output Interface Circuitry Thus, for midscale RF input of about 3 mV, which is some 40 dB above the minimum detector output, this current is 160 μA, and the output changes by 8 V/μs. When VOUT is connected to VSET, the rise and fall times are approximately 40 ns (for RL ≥ 10 kΩ ). The nominal slew rate is 2.5 V/μs. The HF compensation tech-nique results in stable operation with a large capacitive load, CL, though the positive-going slew rate is then limited by ISOURCE/CL to 1 V/μs for CL = 400 pF. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 14 of 24 SETPOINT INTERFACE, VSET The setpoint interface is shown in Figure 28. The voltage, VSET, is divided by a factor of 3 in a resistive attenuator of 18 kΩ total resistance. The signal is converted to a current by the action of the op amp and the resistor R3 (1.5 kΩ), which balances the current generated by the summed output of the nine detector cells at the input to the previous cell. The logarithmic slope is nominally 3 μs × 4.0 μA/dB × 1.5 kΩ = 18 mV/dB. 8VSETVPOSR112kΩR26kΩ6COMM25μA25μAFDBKTO O/PSTAGE1R31.5kΩLP01085-C-028 Figure 28. Setpoint Interface Circuitry AD8313 Rev. D | Page 15 of 24 APPLICATIONS BASIC CONNECTIONS FOR LOG (RSSI) MODE Figure 29 shows the AD8313 connected in its basic measurement mode. A power supply between 2.7 V and 5.5 V is required. The power supply to each of the VPOS pins should be decoupled with a 0.1 μF surface-mount ceramic capacitor and a 10 Ω series resistor. The PWDN pin is shown as grounded. The AD8313 may be disabled by a logic high at this pin. When disabled, the chip current is reduced to about 20 μA from its normal value of 13.7 mA. The logic threshold is at VPOS/2, and the enable function occurs in about 1.8 μs. However, that additional settling time is generally needed at low input levels. While the input in this case is terminated with a simple 50 Ω broadband resistive match, there are many ways in which the input termi-nation can be accomplished. These are discussed in the Input Coupling section. VSET is connected to VOUT to establish a feedback path that controls the overall scaling of the logarithmic amplifier. The load resistance, RL, should not be lower than 5 kΩ so that the full-scale output of 1.75 V can be generated with the limited available current of 400 μA max. As stated in the Absolute Maximum Ratings table, an externally applied overvoltage on the VOUT pin, which is outside the range 0 V to VPOS, is sufficient to cause permanent damage to the device. If overvoltages are expected on the VOUT pin, a series resistor, RPROT, should be included as shown. A 500 Ω resistor is sufficient to protect against overvoltage up to ±5 V; 1000 Ω should be used if an overvoltage of up to ±15 V is expected. Since the output stage is meant to drive loads of no more than 400 μA, this resistor does not impact device perform-ance for higher impedance drive applications (higher output current applications are discussed in the Increasing Output Current section). 0.1μF53.6Ω680pF680pFR110ΩR210Ω0.1μF+VS+VS87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD8313RPROTRL= 1MΩ01085-C-029 Figure 29. Basic Connections for Log (RSSI) Mode OPERATING IN CONTROLLER MODE Figure 30 shows the basic connections for operation in controller mode. The link between VOUT and VSET is broken and a set-point is applied to VSET. Any difference between VSET and the equivalent input power to the AD8313 drives VOUT either to the supply rail or close to ground. If VSET is greater than the equivalent input power, VOUT is driven toward ground, and vice versa. 0.1μFR110ΩR310Ω0.1μF+VS+VS87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD8313RPROT01085-C-030 Figure 30. Basic Connections for Operation in the Controller Mode This mode of operation is useful in applications where the output power of an RF power amplifier (PA) is to be controlled by an analog AGC loop (Figure 31). In this mode, a setpoint voltage, proportional in dB to the desired output power, is applied to the VSET pin. A sample of the output power from the PA, via a directional coupler or other means, is fed to the input of the AD8313. SETPOINTCONTROL DACRFINVOUTVSETAD8313DIRECTIONALCOUPLERPOWERAMPLIFIERRF INENVELOPE OFTRANSMITTEDSIGNAL01085-C-031 Figure 31. Setpoint Controller Operation VOUT is applied to the gain control terminal of the power amplifier. The gain control transfer function of the power amplifier should be an inverse relationship, that is, increasing voltage decreases gain. A positive input step on VSET (indicating a demand for increased power from the PA) drives VOUT toward ground. This should be arranged to increase the gain of the PA. The loop settles when VOUT settles to a voltage that sets the input power to the AD8313 to the dB equivalent of VSET. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 16 of 24 INPUT COUPLING The signal can be coupled to the AD8313 in a variety of ways. In all cases, there must not be a dc path from the input pins to ground. Some of the possibilities include dual-input coupling capacitors, a flux-linked transformer, a printed circuit balun, direct drive from a directional coupler, or a narrow-band impedance matching network. Figure 32 shows a simple broadband resistive match. A termination resistor of 53.6 Ω combines with the internal input impedance of the AD8313 to give an overall resistive input impedance of approximately 50 Ω. It is preferable to place the termination resistor directly across the input pins, INHI to INLO, where it lowers the possible deleterious effects of dc offset voltages on the low end of the dynamic range. At low frequencies, this may not be quite as beneficial, since it requires larger coupling capacitors. The two 680 pF input coupling capacitors set the high-pass corner frequency of the network at 9.4 MHz. RMATCH53.6ΩC2680pFC1680pFCINRINAD831350Ω50ΩSOURCE01085-C-032 Figure 32. A Simple Broadband Resistive Input Termination The high-pass corner frequency can be set higher according to the equation 50213××π×=CfdB where: C2C1C2C1C××= In high frequency applications, the use of a transformer, balun, or matching network is advantageous. The impedance matching characteristics of these networks provide what is essentially a gain stage before the AD8313 that increases the device sensitivity. This gain effect is explored in the following matching example. Figure 33 and Figure 34 show device performance under these three input conditions at 900 MHz and 1.9 GHz. While the 900 MHz case clearly shows the effect of input matching by realigning the intercept as expected, little improvement is seen at 1.9 GHz. Clearly, if no improvement in sensitivity is required, a simple 50 Ω termination may be the best choice for a given design based on ease of use and cost of components. INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)–80–70–60–50–40–30–20–103210–1–2–3ERROR ( dB)TERMINATEDDR = 66dB–90100BALANCEDMATCHEDBALANCEDDR = 71dBMATCHEDDR = 69dB01085-C-033 Figure 33. Comparison of Terminated, Matched, and Balanced Input Drive at 900 MHz INPUT AMPLITUDE (dBm)–80–70–60–50–40–30–20–1003210–1–2–3ERROR ( dB)–9010TERMINATEDDR = 75dBBALANCEDBALANCEDDR = 75dBMATCHEDDR = 73dBMATCHEDTERMINATED01085-C-034 Figure 34. Comparison of Terminated, Matched, and Balanced Input Drive at 1.9 GHz NARROW-BAND LC MATCHING EXAMPLE AT 100 MHz While numerous software programs provide an easy way to calculate the values of matching components, a clear under-standing of the calculations involved is valuable. A low frequency (100 MHz) value has been used for this example because of the deleterious board effects at higher frequencies. RF layout simulation software is useful when board design at higher frequencies is required. A narrow-band LC match can be implemented either as a series-inductance/shunt-capacitance or as a series-capacitance/ shunt-inductance. However, the concurrent requirement that the AD8313 inputs, INHI and INLO, be ac-coupled, makes a series-capacitance/shunt-inductance type match more appropriate (Figure 35). AD8313 Rev. D | Page 17 of 24 LMATCHC2C1CINRINAD831350Ω50ΩSOURCE01085-C-035 Figure 35. Narrow-Band Reactive Match Typically, the AD8313 needs to be matched to 50 Ω. The input impedance of the AD8313 at 100 MHz can be read from the Smith chart (Figure 26) and corresponds to a resistive input impedance of 900 Ω in parallel with a capacitance of 1.1 pF. To make the matching process simpler, the AD8313 input cap-acitance, CIN, can be temporarily removed from the calculation by adding a virtual shunt inductor (L2), which resonates away CIN (Figure 36). This inductor is factored back into the calculation later. This allows the main calculation to be based on a simple resistive-to-resistive match, that is, 50 Ω to 900 Ω. The resonant frequency is defined by the equation INCL2×=ω1 therefore, H3.212μ=ω=INCL2 L1C2C1CINCMATCH=(C1× C2)(C1 + C2)RINAD831350Ω50ΩSOURCE01085-C-036L2TEMPORARYINDUCTANCELMATCH=(C1× C2)(C1 + C2) Figure 36. Input Matching Example With CIN and L2 temporarily out of the picture, the focus is now on matching a 50 Ω source resistance to a (purely resistive) load of 900 Ω and calculating values for CMATCH and L1. When MATCHINSCL1RR= the input looks purely resistive at a frequency given by MHz10021=×π=MATCH0CL1f Solving for CMATCH gives pF5.72110=π×=fRRCINSMATCH Solving for L1 gives nH6.33720=π=fRRL1INS Because L1 and L2 are parallel, they can be combined to give the final value for LMATCH, that is, nH294=+×=L2L1L2L1LMATCH C1 and C2 can be chosen in a number of ways. First, C2 can be set to a large value, for example, 1000 pF, so that it appears as an RF short. C1 would then be set equal to the calculated value of CMATCH. Alternatively, C1 and C2 can each be set to twice CMATCH so that the total series capacitance is equal to CMATCH. By making C1 and C2 slightly unequal (that is, select C2 to be about 10% less than C1) but keeping their series value the same, the ampli-tude of the signals on INHI and INLO can be equalized so that the AD8313 is driven in a more balanced manner. Any of the options detailed above can be used provided that the combined series value of C1 and C2, that is, C1 × C2/(C1 + C2) is equal to CMATCH. In all cases, the values of CMATCH and LMATCH must be chosen from standard values. At this point, these values need now be installed on the board and measured for performance at 100 MHz. Because of board and layout parasitics, the component values from the preceding example had to be tuned to the final values of CMATCH = 8.9 pF and LMATCH = 270 nH as shown in Table 4. Assuming a lossless matching network and noting conservation of power, the impedance transformation from RS to RIN (50 Ω to 900 Ω) has an associated voltage gain given by dB6.12log20dB=×=SINRRGain Because the AD8313 input responds to voltage and not to true power, the voltage gain of the matching network increases the effective input low-end power sensitivity by this amount. Thus, in this case, the dynamic range is shifted downward, that is, the 12.6 dB voltage gain shifts the 0 dBm to −65 dBm input range downward to −12.6 dBm to −77.6 dBm. However, because of network losses, this gain is not be fully realized in practice. Refer to Figure 33 and Figure 34 for an example of practical attainable voltage gains. Table 4 shows recommended values for the inductor and cap-acitors in Figure 35 for some selected RF frequencies in addition to the associated theoretical voltage gain. These values for a reactive match are optimal for the board layout detailed as Figure 45. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 18 of 24 As previously discussed, a modification of the board layout produces networks that may not perform as specified. At 2.5 GHz, a shunt inductor is sufficient to achieve proper matching. Con-sequently, C1 and C2 are set sufficiently high that they appear as RF shorts. Table 4. Recommended Values for C1, C2, and LMATCH in Figure 35 Freq. (MHz) CMATCH (pF) C1 (pF) C2 (pF) LMATCH (nH) Voltage Gain(dB) 100 8.9 22 15 270 12.6 1000 270 900 1.5 3 3 8.2 9.0 1.5 1000 8.2 1900 1.5 3 3 2.2 6.2 1.5 1000 2.2 2500 Large 390 390 2.2 3.2 Figure 37 shows the voltage response of the 100 MHz matching network. Note the high attenuation at lower frequencies typical of a high-pass network. FREQUENCY (MHz)1550VOLTAGE GAIN ( dB)1050–510020001085-C-037 Figure 37. Voltage Response of 100 MHz Narrow-Band Matching Network ADJUSTING THE LOG SLOPE Figure 38 shows how the log slope can be adjusted to an exact value. The idea is simple: the output at the VOUT pin is attenu-ated by the variable resistor R2 working against the internal 18 kΩ of input resistance at the VSET pin. When R2 is 0, the attenu-ation it introduces is 0, and thus the slope is the basic 18 mV/dB. Note that this value varies with frequency, (Figure 10). When R2 is set to its maximum value of 10 kΩ, the attenuation from VOUT to VSET is the ratio 18/(18 + 10), and the slope is raised to (28/18) × 18 mV, or 28 mV/dB. At about the midpoint, the nominal scale is 23 mV/dB. Thus, a 70 dB input range changes the output by 70 × 23 mV, or 1.6 V. 0.1μFR110ΩR310ΩR210kΩ0.1μF+VS+VS87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD831301085-C-03818–30mV/dB Figure 38. Adjusting the Log Slope As stated, the unadjusted log slope varies with frequency from 17 mV/dB to 20 mV/dB, as shown in Figure 10. By placing a resistor between VOUT and VSET, the slope can be adjusted to a convenient 20 mV/dB as shown in Figure 39. Table 5 shows the recommended values for this resistor, REXT. Also shown are values for REXT, which increase the slope to approximately 50 mV/dB. The corresponding voltage swings for a −65 dBm to 0 dBm input range are also shown in Table 6. 0.1μFR110ΩR310ΩREXT0.1μF+VS+VS87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD831301085-C-03920mV/dB Figure 39. Adjusting the Log Slope to a Fixed Value Table 5. Values for R in Figure 39EXT Frequency MHz REXT kV Slope mV/dB VOUT Swing for Pin −65 dBm to 0 dBm – V 100 0.953 20 0.44 to 1.74 900 2.00 20 0.58 to 1.88 1900 2.55 20 0.70 to 2.00 2500 0 20 0.54 to 1.84 100 29.4 50 1.10 to 4.35 900 32.4 50.4 1.46 to 4.74 1900 33.2 49.8 1.74 to 4.98 2500 26.7 49.7 1.34 to 4.57 The value for REXT is calculated by ()Ω×−=k18SlopeOriginalSlopeOriginalSlopeNewREXT The value for the Original Slope, at a particular frequency, can be read from Figure 10. The resulting output swing is calculated by simply inserting the New Slope value and the intercept at that frequency (Figure 10 and Figure 13) into the general equation for the AD8313’s output voltage: VOUT = Slope(PIN − Intercept) AD8313 Rev. D | Page 19 of 24 INCREASING OUTPUT CURRENT To drive a more substantial load, either a pull-up resistor or an emitter-follower can be used. In Figure 40, a 1 kΩ pull-up resistor is added at the output, which provides the load current necessary to drive a 1 kΩ load to 1.7 V for VS = 2.7 V. The pull-up resistor slightly lowers the intercept and the slope. As a result, the transfer function of the AD8313 is shifted upward (intercept shifts downward). 0.1μFR110ΩR310Ω0.1μF+VS+VS87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD831301085-C-0401kΩRL= 1kΩ+VS20mV/dB Figure 40. Increasing AD8313 Output Current Capability In Figure 41, an emitter-follower provides the current gain, when a 100 Ω load can readily be driven to full-scale output. While a high ß transistor such as the BC848BLT1 (min ß = 200) is recommended, a 2 kΩ pull-up resistor between VOUT and +VS can provide additional base current to the transistor. βMIN = 2000.1μFR110ΩR310Ω0.1μF+VS+VS+VS87651234VPOSVOUTINHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD831301085-C-041RL100ΩOUTPUT13kΩ10kΩBC848BLT1 Figure 41. Output Current Drive Boost Connection In addition to providing current gain, the resistor/potentiometer combination between VSET and the emitter of the transistor increases the log slope to as much as 45 mV/dB, at maximum resistance. This gives an output voltage of 4 V for a 0 dBm input. If no increase in the log slope is required, VSET can be connected directly to the emitter of the transistor. EFFECT OF WAVEFORM TYPE ON INTERCEPT Although specified for input levels in dBm (dB relative to 1 mW), the AD8313 responds to voltage and not to power. A direct consequence of this characteristic is that input signals of equal rms power but differing crest factors produce different results at the log amp’s output. Different signal waveforms vary the effective value of the log amp’s intercept upward or downward. Graphically, this looks like a vertical shift in the log amp’s transfer function. The device’s logarithmic slope, however, is in principle not affected. For example, if the AD8313 is being fed alternately from a continuous wave and from a single CDMA channel of the same rms power, the AD8313 output voltage differs by the equivalent of 3.55 dB (64 mV) over the complete dynamic range of the device (the output for a CDMA input being lower). Table 6 shows the correction factors that should be applied to measure the rms signal strength of a various signal types. A continuous wave input is used as a reference. To measure the rms power of a square wave, for example, the mV equivalent of the dB value given in the table (18 mV/dB × 3.01 dB) should be subtracted from the output voltage of the AD8313. Table 6. Shift in AD8313 Output for Signals with Differing Crest Factors Signal Type Correction Factor (Add to Output Reading) CW Sine Wave 0 dB Square Wave or DC −3.01 dB Triangular Wave +0.9 dB GSM Channel (All Time Slots On) +0.55 dB CDMA Channel +3.55 dB PDC Channel (All Time Slots On) +0.58 dB Gaussian Noise +2.51 dB AD8313 Rev. D | Page 20 of 24 EVALUATION BOARD SCHEMATIC AND LAYOUT Figure 44 shows the schematic of the AD8313 evaluation board. Note that uninstalled components are indicated as open. This board contains the AD8313 as well as the AD8009 current-feedback operational amplifier. This is a 4-layer board (top and bottom signal layers, ground, and power). The top layer silkscreen and layout are shown in Figure 42 and Figure 43. A detailed drawing of the recommended PCB footprint for the MSOP package and the pads for the matching components are shown in Figure 45. The vacant portions of the signal and power layers are filled out with ground plane for general noise suppression. To ensure a low impedance connection between the planes, there are multiple through-hole connections to the RF ground plane. While the ground planes on the power and signal planes are used as general-purpose ground returns, any RF grounds related to the input matching network (for example, C2) are returned directly to the RF internal ground plane. GENERAL OPERATION The AD8313 should be powered by a single supply in the range of 2.7 V to 5.5 V. The power supply to each AD8313 VPOS pin is decoupled by a 10 Ω resistor and a 0.1 μF capacitor. The AD8009 can run on either single or dual supplies, +5 V to ±6 V. Both the positive and negative supply traces are decoupled using a 0.1 μF capacitor. Pads are provided for a series resistor or inductor to provide additional supply filtering. The two signal inputs are ac-coupled using 680 pF high quality RF capacitors (C1, C2). A 53.6 Ω resistor across the differential signal inputs (INHI, INLO) combines with the internal 900 Ω input impedance to give a broadband input impedance of 50.6 Ω. This termination is not optimal from a noise perspective due to the Johnson noise of the 53.6 Ω resistor. Neither does it account for the AD8313’s reactive input impedance nor for the decrease over frequency of the resistive component of the input imped-ance. However, it does allow evaluation of the AD8313 over its complete frequency range without having to design multiple matching networks. For optimum performance, a narrow-band match can be implemented by replacing the 53.6 Ω resistor (labeled L/R) with an RF inductor and replacing the 680 pF capacitors with appropriate values. The Narrow-Band LC Matching Example at 100 MHz section includes a table of recommended values for selected frequencies and explains the method of calculation. Switch 1 is used to select between power-up and power-down modes. Connecting the PWDN pin to ground enables normal operation of the AD8313. In the opposite position, the PWDN pin can be driven externally (SMA connector labeled ENBL) to either device state, or it can be allowed to float to a disabled device state. The evaluation board comes with the AD8313 configured to operate in RSSI/measurement mode. This mode is set by the 0 Ω resistor (R11), which shorts the VOUT and VSET pins to each other. When using the AD8009, the AD8313 logarithmic output appears on the SMA connector labeled VOUT. Using only the AD8313, the log output can be measured at TP1 or the SMA connector labeled VSET. USING THE AD8009 OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIER The AD8313 can supply only 400 μA at VOUT. It is also sensitive to capacitive loading, which can cause inaccurate measurements, especially in applications where the AD8313 is used to measure the envelope of RF bursts. The AD8009 alleviates both of these issues. It is an ultrahigh speed current feedback amplifier capable of delivering over 175 mA of load current, with a slew rate of 5,500 V/μs, which results in a rise time of 545 ps, making it ideal as a pulse amplifier. The AD8009 is configured as a buffer amplifier with a gain of 1. Other gain options can be implemented by installing the appro-priate resistors at R10 and R12. Various output filtering and loading options are available using R5, R6, and C6. Note that some capacitive loads may cause the AD8009 to become unstable. It is recommended that a 42.2 Ω resistor be installed at R5 when driving a capacitive load. More details can be found in the AD8009 data sheet. VARYING THE LOGARITHMIC SLOPE The slope of the AD8313 can be increased from its nominal value of 18 mV/dB to a maximum of 40 mV/dB by removing R11, the 0 Ω resistor, which shorts VSET to VOUT. VSET and VOUT are now connected through the 20 kΩ potentiometer. The AD8009 must be configured for a gain of 1 to accurately vary the slope of the AD8313. OPERATING IN CONTROLLER MODE To put the AD8313 into controller mode, R7 and R11 should be removed, breaking the link between VOUT and VSET. The VSET pin can then be driven externally via the SMA connector labeled VSET. RF BURST RESPONSE The VOUT pin of the AD8313 is very sensitive to capacitive loading, as a result care must be taken when measuring the device’s response to RF bursts. For best possible response time measurements it is recommended that the AD8009 be used to buffer the output from the AD8313. No connection should be made to TP1, the added load will effect the response time. AD8313 Rev. D | Page 21 of 24 001085-C-048 Figure 42. Layout of Signal Layer 01085-C-049 Figure 43. Signal Layer Silkscreen AD8313 Rev. D | Page 22 of 24 VPS1VPS101085-C-046R210ΩEXT ENABLESW1R110Ω1234INHIINLOVPOSPWDNCOMMVSETAD83138765INHIVOUTEXT VSETAD8009VPOSVOUTC70.1μFC1680pFC2680pFC30.1μFC50.1μFR40ΩR12301ΩR50ΩR70ΩR30ΩR110ΩR90ΩR210ΩL/R53.6ΩVNEGVPS2INLOTP1Z1Z2R10OPENR6OPENR820kΩC6OPENABC40.1μF Figure 44. Evaluation Board Schematic Table 7. Evaluation Board Configuration Options Component Function Default VPS1, VPS2, GND, VNEG Supply Pins. VPS1 is the positive supply pin for the AD8313. VPS2 and VNEG are the positive and negative supply pins for the AD8009. If the AD8009 is being operated from a single supply, VNEG should be connected to GND. VPS1 and VPS2 are independent. GND is shared by both devices. Not Applicable Z1 AD8313 Logarithmic Amplifier. If the AD8313 is used in measurement mode, it is not necessary to power up the AD8009 op amp. The log output can be measured at TP1 or at the SMA connector labeled VSET. Installed Z1 AD8009 Operational Amplifier. Installed SW1 Device Enable. When in Position A, the PWDN pin is connected to ground and the AD8313 is in normal operating mode. In Position B, the PWDN pin is connected to an SMA connector labeled ENBL. A signal can be applied to this connector. SW1 = A R7, R8 Slope Adjust. The slope of the AD8313 can be increased from its nominal value of 18 mV/dB to a maximum of 40 mV/dB by removing R11, the 0 Ω resistor, which shorts VSET to VOUT, and installing a 0 Ω resistor at R7. The 20 kΩ potentiometer at R8 can then be used to change the slope. R7 = 0 Ω (Size 0603) R8 = installed Operating in Controller Mode. To put the AD8313 into controller mode, R7 and R11 should be removed, breaking the link between VOUT and VSET. The VSET pin can then be driven externally via the SMA connector labeled VSET. L/R, C1, C2, R9 Input Interface. The 52.3 Ω resistor in position L/R, along with C1 and C2, create a wideband 50 Ω input. Alternatively, the 52.3 Ω resistor can be replaced by an inductor to form an input matching network. See Input Coupling section for more details. Remove the 0 Ω resistor at R9 for differential drive applications. L/R = 53.6 Ω (Size 0603) C1 = C2 = 680 pF (Size 0603) R9 = 0 Ω (Size 0603) R10, R12 Op Amp Gain Adjust. The AD8009 is initially configured as a buffer; gain = 1. To increase the gain of the op amp, modify the resistor values R10 and R12. R10 = open (Size 0603) R12 = 301 Ω (Size 0603) R5, R6, C6 Op Amp Output Loading/Filtering. A variety of loading and filtering options are available for the AD8009. The robust output of the op amp is capable of driving low impedances such as 50 Ω or 75 Ω, configure R5 and R6 accordingly. See the AD8009 data sheet for more details. R5 = 0 Ω (Size 0603) R6 = open (Size 0603) C6 = open (Size 0603) R1, R2, R3, R4, C3, C4, C5, C7 Supply Decoupling. R1 = R2 = 10 Ω (Size 0603) R3 = R4 = 0 Ω (Size 0603) C3 = C4 = 0.1 μF (Size 0603) C5 = C7 = 0.1 μF (Size 0603) AD8313 Rev. D | Page 23 of 24 4854.490.6282027.57550201950354122464851.791.3511016126TRACE WIDTH15.4NOT CRITICAL DIMENSIONSUNIT = MILS01085-C-047 Figure 45. Detail of PCB Footprint for Package and Pads for Matching Network AD8313 Rev. D | Page 24 of 24 OUTLINE DIMENSIONS 0.800.600.408°0°4854.90BSCPIN 10.65 BSC3.00BSCSEATINGPLANE0.150.000.380.221.10 MAX3.00BSCCOPLANARITY0.100.230.08COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MO-187AA Figure 46 . 8-Lead MicroSOIC Package [MSOP] (RM-08) Dimensions shown in millimeters and (inches) ORDERING GUIDE Model Temperature Range Package Descriptions Package Option Branding AD8313ARM −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP RM-08 J1A AD8313ARM-REEL −40°C to +85°C 13" Tape and Reel RM-08 J1A AD8313ARM-REEL7 −40°C to +85°C 7" Tape and Reel RM-08 J1A AD8313ARMZ1 −40°C to +85°C 8-Lead MSOP AD8313ARMZ-REEL71 −40°C to +85°C 7" Tape and Reel AD8313-EVAL Evaluation Board 1 Z = Pb-free part. TUSB3410, TUSB3410I USB to Serial Port Controller January 2010 Connectivity Interface Solutions Data Manual SLLS519H Contents May 2008 SLLS519G iii Contents Section Page 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 1.1 Controller Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 1.2 Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 1.3 Revision History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 2 Main Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 2.1 USB Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 2.2 General Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 2.3 Enhanced UART Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 2.4 Terminal Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 3 Detailed Controller Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.1 Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.2 USB Interface Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.2.1 External Memory Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.2.2 Host Download Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.3 USB Data Movement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.4 Serial Port Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.5 Serial Port Data Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.5.1 RS-232 Data Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.5.2 RS-485 Data Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.5.3 IrDA Data Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 4 MCU Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 4.1 Miscellaneous Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 4.1.1 ROMS: ROM Shadow Configuration Register (Addr:FF90h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 4.1.2 Boot Operation (MCU Firmware Loading) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 4.1.3 WDCSR: Watchdog Timer, Control, and Status Register (Addr:FF93h) . . . . . . . . . 15 4.2 Buffers + I/O RAM Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 4.3 Endpoint Descriptor Block (EDB−1 to EDB−3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 4.3.1 OEPCNF_n: Output Endpoint Configuration (n = 1 to 3) (Base Addr: FF08h, FF10h, FF18h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 4.3.2 OEPBBAX_n: Output Endpoint X-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 1) . . . . 19 4.3.3 OEPBCTX_n: Output Endpoint X Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 4.3.4 OEPBBAY_n: Output Endpoint Y-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 5) . . . . 20 4.3.5 OEPBCTY_n: Output Endpoint Y-Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 6) . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 4.3.6 OEPSIZXY_n: Output Endpoint X-/Y-Buffer Size (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 7) . . . . . . . . . 21 4.3.7 IEPCNF_n: Input Endpoint Configuration (n = 1 to 3) (Base Addr: FF48h, FF50h, FF58h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 4.3.8 IEPBBAX_n: Input Endpoint X-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 1) . . . . . . 21 4.3.9 IEPBCTX_n: Input Endpoint X-Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 4.3.10 IEPBBAY_n: Input Endpoint Y-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 5) . . . . . . 22 4.3.11 IEPBCTY_n: Input Endpoint Y-Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 4.3.12 IEPSIZXY_n: Input Endpoint X-/Y-Buffer Size (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 4.4 Endpoint-0 Descriptor Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 4.4.1 IEPCNFG_0: Input Endpoint-0 Configuration Register (Addr:FF80h) . . . . . . . . . . . 23 4.4.2 IEPBCNT_0: Input Endpoint-0 Byte Count Register (Addr:FF81h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 4.4.3 OEPCNFG_0: Output Endpoint-0 Configuration Register (Addr:FF82h) . . . . . . . . . 24 4.4.4 OEPBCNT_0: Output Endpoint-0 Byte Count Register (Addr:FF83h) . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Contents iv SLLS519G May 2008 Section Page 5 USB Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 5.1 FUNADR: Function Address Register (Addr:FFFFh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 5.2 USBSTA: USB Status Register (Addr:FFFEh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 5.3 USBMSK: USB Interrupt Mask Register (Addr:FFFDh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 5.4 USBCTL: USB Control Register (Addr:FFFCh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 5.5 MODECNFG: Mode Configuration Register (Addr:FFFBh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 5.6 Vendor ID/Product ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 5.7 SERNUM7: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 7) (Addr:FFEFh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 5.8 SERNUM6: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 6) (Addr:FFEEh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 5.9 SERNUM5: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 5) (Addr:FFEDh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 5.10 SERNUM4: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 4) (Addr:FFECh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 5.11 SERNUM3: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 3) (Addr:FFEBh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 5.12 SERNUM2: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 2) (Addr:FFEAh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 5.13 SERNUM1: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 1) (Addr:FFE9h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 5.14 SERNUM0: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 0) (Addr:FFE8h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 5.15 Function Reset And Power-Up Reset Interconnect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 5.16 Pullup Resistor Connect/Disconnect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 6 DMA Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 6.1 DMA Controller Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 6.1.1 DMACDR1: DMA Channel Definition Register (UART Transmit Channel) (Addr:FFE0h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 6.1.2 DMACSR1: DMA Control And Status Register (UART Transmit Channel) (Addr:FFE1h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 6.1.3 DMACDR3: DMA Channel Definition Register (UART Receive Channel) (Addr:FFE4h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 6.1.4 DMACSR3: DMA Control And Status Register (UART Receive Channel) (Addr:FFE5h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 6.2 Bulk Data I/O Using the EDB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 6.2.1 IN Transaction (TUSB3410 to Host) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 6.2.2 OUT Transaction (Host to TUSB3410) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 7 UART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 7.1 UART Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 7.1.1 RDR: Receiver Data Register (Addr:FFA0h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 7.1.2 TDR: Transmitter Data Register (Addr:FFA1h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 7.1.3 LCR: Line Control Register (Addr:FFA2h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 7.1.4 FCRL: UART Flow Control Register (Addr:FFA3h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 7.1.5 Transmitter Flow Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 7.1.6 MCR: Modem-Control Register (Addr:FFA4h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 7.1.7 LSR: Line-Status Register (Addr:FFA5h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 7.1.8 MSR: Modem-Status Register (Addr:FFA6h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 7.1.9 DLL: Divisor Register Low Byte (Addr:FFA7h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 7.1.10 DLH: Divisor Register High Byte (Addr:FFA8h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 7.1.11 Baud-Rate Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 7.1.12 XON: Xon Register (Addr:FFA9h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 7.1.13 XOFF: Xoff Register (Addr:FFAAh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 7.1.14 MASK: UART Interrupt-Mask Register (Addr:FFABh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Contents May 2008 SLLS519G v Section Page 7.2 UART Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 7.2.1 Receiver Data Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 7.2.2 Hardware Flow Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 7.2.3 Auto RTS (Receiver Control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 7.2.4 Auto CTS (Transmitter Control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 7.2.5 Xon/Xoff Receiver Flow Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 7.2.6 Xon/Xoff Transmit Flow Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 8 Expanded GPIO Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 8.1 Input/Output and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 8.1.1 PUR_3: GPIO Pullup Register For Port 3 (Addr:FF9Eh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 9 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 9.1 8052 Interrupt and Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 9.1.1 8052 Standard Interrupt Enable (SIE) Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 9.1.2 Additional Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 9.1.3 VECINT: Vector Interrupt Register (Addr:FF92h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 9.1.4 Logical Interrupt Connection Diagram (Internal/External) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 10 I2C Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 10.1 I2C Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 10.1.1 I2CSTA: I2C Status and Control Register (Addr:FFF0h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 10.1.2 I2CADR: I2C Address Register (Addr:FFF3h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 10.1.3 I2CDAI: I2C Data-Input Register (Addr:FFF2h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 10.1.4 I2CDAO: I2C Data-Output Register (Addr:FFF1h) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 10.2 Random-Read Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 10.3 Current-Address Read Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 10.4 Sequential-Read Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 10.5 Byte-Write Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 10.6 Page-Write Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 11 TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 11.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 11.2 Bootcode Programming Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 11.3 Default Bootcode Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 11.3.1 Device Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 11.3.2 Configuration Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 11.3.3 Interface Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 11.3.4 Endpoint Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 11.3.5 String Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 11.4 External I2C Device Header Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 11.4.1 Product Signature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 11.4.2 Descriptor Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 11.5 Checksum in Descriptor Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 11.6 Header Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 11.6.1 TUSB3410 Bootcode Supported Descriptor Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 11.6.2 USB Descriptor Header . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 11.6.3 Autoexec Binary Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 11.7 USB Host Driver Downloading Header Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Contents vi SLLS519G May 2008 Section Page 11.8 Built-In Vendor Specific USB Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 11.8.1 Reboot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 11.8.2 Force Execute Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 11.8.3 External Memory Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 11.8.4 External Memory Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 11.8.5 I2C Memory Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 11.8.6 I2C Memory Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 11.8.7 Internal ROM Memory Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 11.9 Bootcode Programming Consideration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 11.9.1 USB Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 11.9.2 Hardware Reset Introduced by the Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 11.10 File Listings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 12 Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 12.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 12.2 Commercial Operating Condition (3.3 V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 12.3 Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 13 Application Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 13.1 Crystal Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 13.2 External Circuit Required for Reliable Bus Powered Suspend Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 13.3 Wakeup Timing (WAKEUP or RI/CP Transitions) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 13.4 Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 List of Illustrations May 2008 SLLS519G vii List of Illustrations Figure Title Page 1−1 Data Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 1−2 USB-to-Serial (Single Channel) Controller Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 3−1 RS-232 and IR Mode Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 3−2 USB-to-Serial Implementation (RS-232) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 3−3 RS-485 Bus Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 4−1 MCU Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 5−1 Reset Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 5−2 Pullup Resistor Connect/Disconnect Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 7−1 MSR and MCR Registers in Loop-Back Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 7−2 Receiver/Transmitter Data Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 7−3 Auto Flow Control Interconnect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 9−1 Internal Vector Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 11−1 Control Read Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 11−2 Control Write Transfer Without Data Stage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 13−1 Crystal Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 13−2 External Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 13−3 Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 List of Tables viii SLLS519G May 2008 List of Tables Table Title Page 2−1 Terminal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 4−1 ROM/RAM Size Definition Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 4−2 XDATA Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 4−3 Memory-Mapped Registers Summary (XDATA Range = FF80h ” FFFFh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 4−4 EDB Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 4−5 Endpoint Registers and Offsets in RAM (n = 1 to 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 4−6 Endpoint Registers Base Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 4−7 Input/Output EDB-0 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 6−1 DMA Controller Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 6−2 DMA IN-Termination Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 7−1 UART Registers Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 7−2 Transmitter Flow-Control Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 7−3 Receiver Flow-Control Possibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 7−4 DLL/DLH Values and Resulted Baud Rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 9−1 8052 Interrupt Location Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 9−2 Vector Interrupt Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 11−1 Device Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 11−2 Configuration Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 11−3 Interface Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 11−4 Output Endpoint1 Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 11−5 String Descriptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 11−6 USB Descriptors Header . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 11−7 Autoexec Binary Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 11−8 Host Driver Downloading Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 11−9 Bootcode Response to Control Read Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 11−10 Bootcode Response to Control Write Without Data Stage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 11−11 Vector Interrupt Values and Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Introduction SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 1 1 Introduction 1.1 Controller Description The TUSB3410 provides bridging between a USB port and an enhanced UART serial port. The TUSB3410 contains all the necessary logic to communicate with the host computer using the USB bus. It contains an 8052 microcontroller unit (MCU) with 16K bytes of RAM that can be loaded from the host or from the external on-board memory via an I2C bus. It also contains 10K bytes of ROM that allow the MCU to configure the USB port at boot time. The ROM code also contains an I2C boot loader. All device functions, such as the USB command decoding, UART setup, and error reporting, are managed by the internal MCU firmware under the auspices of the PC host. The TUSB3410 can be used to build an interface between a legacy serial peripheral device and a PC with USB ports, such as a legacy-free PC. Once configured, data flows from the host to the TUSB3410 via USB OUT commands and then out from the TUSB3410 on the SOUT line. Conversely, data flows into the TUSB3410 on the SIN line and then into the host via USB IN commands. Host (PC or On-The-Go Dual-Role Device) USB Out In TUSB3410 SOUT SIN Legacy Serial Peripheral Figure 1−1. Data Flow Introduction 2 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 8052 Core Clock Oscillator 12 MHz PLL and Dividers 10K × 8 ROM 8 8 2 × 16-Bit Timers 16K × 8 RAM 8 8 4 Port 3 2K × 8 SRAM 8 8 I2C Controller 8 UART−1 CPU-I/F Suspend/ Resume 8 UBM USB Buffer Manager 8 8 USB Serial Interface Engine USB TxR TDM Control Logic P3.4 P3.3 P3.1 P3.0 I2C Bus DP, DM 8 DMA-1 DMA-3 RTS CTS DTR DSR MUX IR Encoder SOUT/IR_SOUT MUX IR Decoder SIN/IR_SIN 24 MHz SIN SOUT Figure 1−2. USB-to-Serial (Single Channel) Controller Block Diagram Introduction SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 3 1.2 Ordering Information T PACKAGED DEVICES TA COMMENT 32-TERMINAL LQFP PACKAGE 32-TERMINAL QFN PACKAGE 40°C to 85°C TUSB3410 I VF TUSB3410 I RHB Industrial temperature range Shipped in trays −TUSB3410 I RHBR Industrial temperature range Tape and Reel Option 0°C to 70°C TUSB3410 VF TUSB3410 RHB Shipped in trays TUSB3410 RHBR Tape and Reel Option 1.3 Revision History Version Date Changes Mar−2002 Initial Release A Apr−2002 1. General grammatical corrections 2. Added Design−in warning on cover sheet 3. Removed references to Optional preprogrammed VID/PID Registers from Section 5.1.6 through 5.1.11. Renumber the remainder of Section 5.1 accordingly – option no longer supported. 4. Clarified GPIO pin availability B Jun−2002 1. Removed Design−in warning from cover sheet 2. Added Note 8 to Terminal Functions Table for GPIO Pins. 3. Removed Section 3.2.3 – Production Programming Mode – Mode no longer supported. 4. Added Clock Output Control description to section 5.1.5. 5. Removed Section 11.6.4 USB Descriptor with Binary Firmware 6. Added Icc Spec to Table 12.3 C Nov−2003 1. Added Industrial Temperature Option and Information 2. Added USB Logo to Cover D July 2005 1. General grammatical corrections 2. Numerous technical corrections F July 2007 1. Added ordering information for TUSB3410IRHBR and TUSB3410RHBR G May 2008 1. Added terminal assignments for RHB package H Jan 2010 1. Removed reference to 48-MHz in 13.4 Introduction 4 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Main Features SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 5 2 Main Features 2.1 USB Features • Fully compliant with USB 2.0 full speed specifications: TID #40340262 • Supports 12-Mbps USB data rate (full speed) • Supports USB suspend, resume, and remote wakeup operations • Supports two power source modes: − Bus-powered mode − Self-powered mode • Can support a total of three input and three output (interrupt, bulk) endpoints 2.2 General Features • Integrated 8052 microcontroller with − 256 × 8 RAM for internal data − 10K × 8 ROM (with USB and I2C boot loader) − 16K × 8 RAM for code space loadable from host or I2C port − 2K × 8 shared RAM used for data buffers and endpoint descriptor blocks (EDB) − Four GPIO terminals from 8052 port 3 − Master I2C controller for EEPROM device access − MCU operates at 24 MHz providing 2 MIPS operation − 128-ms watchdog timer • Built-in two-channel DMA controller for USB/UART bulk I/O • Operates from a 12-MHz crystal • Supports USB suspend and resume • Supports remote wake-up • Available in 32-terminal LQFP • 3.3-V operation with 1.8-V core operating voltage provided by on-chip 1.8-V voltage regulator 2.3 Enhanced UART Features • Software/hardware flow control: − Programmable Xon/Xoff characters − Programmable Auto-RTS/DTR and Auto-CTS/DSR • Automatic RS-485 bus transceiver control, with and without echo • Selectable IrDA mode for up to 115.2 kbps transfer • Software selectable baud rate from 50 to 921.6 k baud • Programmable serial-interface characteristics − 5-, 6-, 7-, or 8-bit characters − Even, odd, or no parity-bit generation and detection − 1-, 1.5-, or 2-stop bit generation Main Features 6 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 • Line break generation and detection • Internal test and loop-back capabilities • Modem-control functions (CTS, RTS, DSR, DTR, RI, and DCD) • Internal diagnostics capability − Loopback control for communications link-fault isolation − Break, parity, overrun, framing-error simulation 2.4 Terminal Assignment VF PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) 23 22 21 20 19 1 2 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RI/CP DCD DSR CTS WAKEUP SCL SDA RESET VCC X2 X1/CLKI GND P3.4 P3.3 P3.1 P3.0 24 18 3 4 5 6 7 8 17 TEST1 TEST0 CLKOUT DTR RTS SOUT/IR_SOUT GND SIN/IR_SIN VREGEN SUSPEND VCC VDD18 PUR DP DM GND RHB PACKAGE (BOTTOM VIEW) 1 2 3 4 6 7 8 24 23 22 21 19 18 17 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 VREGEN SUSPEND VCC VDD18 PUR DP DM GND TEST1 TEST0 CLKOUT SOUT/IR_SOUT GND SIN/IR_SIN DTR RTS RESET WAKEUP CTS DSR DCD RI SDA SCL /CP P3.0 P3.1 P3.3 P3.4 GND X1/CLKI X2 VCC 20 Main Features SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 7 Table 2−1. Terminal Functions TERMINAL I/O DESCRIPTION NAME NO. CLKOUT 22 O Clock output (controlled by bits 2 (CLKOUTEN) and 3(CLKSLCT) in the MODECNFG register (see Section 5.5 and Note 1) CTS 13 I UART: Clear to send (see Note 4) DCD 15 I UART: Data carrier detect (see Note 4) DM 7 I/O Upstream USB port differential data minus DP 6 I/O Upstream USB port differential data plus DSR 14 I UART: Data set ready (see Note 4) DTR 21 O UART: Data terminal ready (see Note 1) GND 8, 18, 28 GND Digital ground P3.0 32 I/O General-purpose I/O 0 (port 3, terminal 0) (see Notes 3, 5, and 8) P3.1 31 I/O General-purpose I/O 1 (port 3, terminal 1) (see Notes 3, 5, and 8) P3.3 30 I/O General-purpose I/O 3 (port 3, terminal 3) (see Notes 3, 5, and 8) P3.4 29 I/O General-purpose I/O 4 (port 3, terminal 4) (see Notes 3, 5, and 8) PUR 5 O Pull-up resistor connection (see Note 2) RESET 9 I Device master reset input (see Note 4) RI/CP 16 I UART: Ring indicator (see Note 4) RTS 20 O UART: Request to send (see Note 1) SCL 11 O Master I2C controller: clock signal (see Note 1) SDA 10 I/O Master I2C controller: data signal (see Notes 1 and 5) SIN/IR_SIN 17 I UART: Serial input data / IR Serial data input (see Note 6) SOUT/IR_SOUT 19 O UART: Serial output data / IR Serial data output (see Note 7) SUSPEND 2 O Suspend indicator terminal (see Note 3). When this terminal is asserted high, the device is in suspend mode. TEST0 23 I Test input (for factory test only) (see Note 5). This terminal must be tied to VCC through a 10-kΩ resistor. TEST1 24 I Test input (for factory test only) (see Note 5). This terminal must be tied to VCC through a 10-kΩ resistor. VCC 3, 25 PWR 3.3 V VDD18 4 PWR 1.8-V supply. An internal voltage regulator generates this supply voltage when terminal VREGEN is low. When VREGEN is high, 1.8 V must be supplied externally. VREGEN 1 I This active-low terminal is used to enable the 3.3-V to 1.8-V voltage regulator. WAKEUP 12 I Remote wake-up request terminal. When low, wakes up system (see Note 5) X1/CLKI 27 I 12-MHz crystal input or clock input X2 26 O 12-MHz crystal output NOTES: 1. 3-state CMOS output (±4-mA drive/sink) 2. 3-state CMOS output (±8-mA drive/sink) 3. 3-state CMOS output (±12-mA drive/sink) 4. TTL-compatible, hysteresis input 5. TTL-compatible, hysteresis input, with internal 100-μA active pullup resistor 6. TTL-compatible input without hysteresis, with internal 100-μA active pullup resistor 7. Normal or IR mode: 3-state CMOS output (±4-mA drive/sink) 8. The MCU treats the outputs as open drain types in that the output can be driven low continuously, but a high output is driven for two clock cycles and then the output is high impedance. Main Features 8 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Detailed Controller Description SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 9 3 Detailed Controller Description 3.1 Operating Modes The TUSB3410 controls its USB interface in response to USB commands, and this action is independent of the serial port mode selected. On the other hand, the serial port can be configured in three different modes. As with any interface device, data movement is the main function of the TUSB3410, but typically the initial configuration and error handling consume most of the support code. The following sections describe the various modes the device can be used in and the means of configuring the device. 3.2 USB Interface Configuration The TUSB3410 contains onboard ROM microcode, which enables the MCU to enumerate the device as a USB peripheral. The ROM microcode can also load application code into internal RAM from either external memory via the I2C bus or from the host via the USB. 3.2.1 External Memory Case After reset, the TUSB3410 is disconnected from the USB. Bit 7 (CONT) in the USBCTL register (see Section 5.4) is cleared. The TUSB3410 checks the I2C port for the existence of valid code; if it finds valid code, then it uploads the code from the external memory device into the RAM program space. Once loaded, the TUSB3410 connects to the USB by setting the CONT bit and enumeration and configuration are performed. This is the most likely use of the device. 3.2.2 Host Download Case If the valid code is not found at the I2C port, then the TUSB3410 connects to the USB by setting bit 7 (CONT) in the USBCTL register (see Section 5.4), and then an enumeration and default configuration are performed. The host can download additional microcode into RAM to tailor the application. Then, the MCU causes a disconnect and reconnect by clearing and setting the CONT bit, which causes the TUSB3410 to be re-enumerated with a new configuration. 3.3 USB Data Movement From the USB perspective, the TUSB3410 looks like a USB peripheral device. It uses endpoint 0 as its control endpoint, as do all USB peripherals. It also configures up to three input and three output endpoints, although most applications use one bulk input endpoint for data in, one bulk output endpoint for data out, and one interrupt endpoint for status updates. The USB configuration likely remains the same regardless of the serial port configuration. Most data is moved from the USB side to the UART side and from the UART side to the USB side using on-chip DMA transfers. Some special cases may use programmed I/O under control of the MCU. 3.4 Serial Port Setup The serial port requires a few control registers to be written to configure its operation. This configuration likely remains the same regardless of the data mode used. These registers include the line control register that controls the serial word format and the divisor registers that control the baud rate. These registers are usually controlled by the host application. 3.5 Serial Port Data Modes The serial port can be configured in three different, although similar, data modes: the RS-232 data mode, the RS-485 data mode, and the IrDA data mode. Similar to the USB mode, once configured for a specific application, it is unlikely that the mode would be changed. The different modes affect the timing of the serial input and output or the use of the control signals. However, the basic serial-to-parallel conversion of the receiver and parallel-to-serial conversion of the transmitter remain the same in all modes. Some features are available in all modes, but are only applicable in certain modes. For instance, software flow control via Xoff/Xon characters can be used in all modes, but would usually only be used in RS-232 or IrDA mode because the RS-485 mode is half-duplex communication. Similarly, hardware flow control via RTS/CTS (or DTR/DSR) handshaking is available in RS-232 or IrDA mode. However, this would probably be used only in RS-232 mode, since in IrDA mode only the SIN and SOUT paths are optically coupled. Detailed Controller Description 10 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 3.5.1 RS-232 Data Mode The default mode is called the RS-232 mode and is typically used for full duplex communication on SOUT and SIN. In this mode, the modem control outputs (RTS and DTR) communicate to a modem or are general outputs. The modem control inputs (CTS, DSR, DCD, and RI/CP) communicate to a modem or are general inputs. Alternatively, RTS and CTS (or DTR and DSR) can throttle the data flow on SOUT and SIN to prevent receive FIFO overruns. Finally, software flow control via Xoff/Xon characters can be used for the same purpose. This mode represents the most general-purpose applications, and the other modes are subsets of this mode. 3.5.2 RS-485 Data Mode The RS-485 mode is very similar to the RS-232 mode in that the SOUT and SIN formats remain the same. Since RS-485 is a bus architecture, it is inherently a single duplex communication system. The TUSB3410 in RS-485 mode controls the RTS and DTR signals such that either can enable an RS-485 driver or RS-485 receiver. When in RS-485 mode, the enable signals for transmitting are automatically asserted whenever the DMA is set up for outbound data. The receiver can be left enabled while the driver is enabled to allow an echo if desired, but when receive data is expected, the driver must be disabled. Note that this precludes use of hardware flow control, since this is a half-duplex operation, it would not be effective. Software flow control is supported, but may be of limited value. The RS-485 mode is enabled by setting bit 7 (485E) in the FCRL register (see Section 7.1.4), and bit 1 (RCVE) in the MCR register (see Section 7.1.6) allows the receiver to eavesdrop while in the RS-485 mode. 3.5.3 IrDA Data Mode The IrDA mode encodes SOUT and decodes SIN in the manner prescribed by the IrDA standard, up to 115.2 kbps. Connection to an external IrDA transceiver is required. Communications is usually full duplex. Generally, in an IrDA system, only the SOUT and SIN paths are connected so hardware flow control is usually not an option. Software flow control is supported. The IrDA mode is enabled by setting bit 6 (IREN) in the USBCTL register (see Section 5.4). The IR encoder and decoder circuitry work with the UART to change the serial bit stream into a series of pulses and back again. For every zero bit in the outbound serial stream, the encoder sends a low-to-high-to-low pulse with the duration of 3/16 of a bit frame at the middle of the bit time. For every one bit in the serial stream, the output remains low for the entire bit time. The decoding process consists of receiving the signal from the IrDA receiver and converting it into a series of zeroes and ones. As the converse to the encoder, the decoder converts a pulse to a zero bit and the lack of a pulse to a one bit. Detailed Controller Description SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 11 From UART MUX IR Encoder SOUT/IR_SOUT Terminal 1 0 IR_TX SOUT UART BaudOut Clock IREN (in USBCTL Register) MUX 1 0 SOFTSW (in MODECNFG Register) TXCNTL (in MODECNFG Register) MUX 1 0 CLKOUT CLKOUTEN Terminal (in MODECNFG Register) 3.556 MHz MUX 1 0 CLKSLCT (in MODECNFG Register) To UART Receiver IR Decoder IR_RX SIN/IR_SIN Terminal 3.3 V SOUT SIN Figure 3−1. RS-232 and IR Mode Select Detailed Controller Description 12 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 4 7 1 6 8 3 2 Transceivers DTR RTS DCD DSR CTS SOUT SIN P3.0 P3.1 P3.3 Serial Port GPIO Terminals for Other Onboard Control Function TUSB3410 12 MHz USB-0 DB9 Connector RI/CP P3.4 X1/CLKI X2 DP DM Figure 3−2. USB-to-Serial Implementation (RS-232) 12 MHz USB-0 RS-485 Transceiver RTS DTR SOUT SIN TUSB3410 RS-485 Bus 2-Bit Time 1-Bit Max Receiver is Disabled if RCVE = 0 SOUT DTR RTS X1/CLKI X2 DP DM Figure 3−3. RS-485 Bus Implementation MCU Memory Map SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 13 4 MCU Memory Map Figure 4−1 illustrates the MCU memory map under boot and normal operation. NOTE: The internal 256 bytes of RAM are not shown, since they are assumed to be in the standard 8052 location (0000h to 00FFh). The shaded areas represent the internal ROM/RAM. • When bit 0 (SDW) of the ROMS register is 0 (boot mode) The 10K ROM is mapped to address (0x0000−0x27FF) and is duplicated in location (0x8000−0xA7FF) in code space. The internal 16K RAM is mapped to address range (0x0000−0x3FFF) in data space. Buffers, MMR, and I/O are mapped to address range (0xF800−0xFFFF) in data space. • When bit 0 (SDW) is 1 (normal mode) The 10K ROM is mapped to (0x8000−0xA7FF) in code space. The internal 16K RAM is mapped to address range (0x0000−0x3FFF) in code space. Buffers, MMR, and I/O are mapped to address range (0xF800−0xFFFF) in data space. Normal Mode (SDW = 1) 0000h CODE XDATA 16K Code RAM Read Only 2K Data MMR 10K Boot ROM Boot Mode (SDW = 0) CODE XDATA 10K Boot ROM 2K Data MMR 10K Boot ROM (16K) Read/Write 27FFh 3FFFh 8000h A7FFh F800h FF7Fh FF80h FFFFh Figure 4−1. MCU Memory Map MCU Memory Map 14 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 4.1 Miscellaneous Registers 4.1.1 ROMS: ROM Shadow Configuration Register (Addr:FF90h) This register is used by the MCU to switch from boot mode to normal operation mode (boot mode is set on power-on reset only). In addition, this register provides the device revision number and the ROM/RAM configuration. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ROA S1 S0 RSVD RSVD RSVD RSVD SDW R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 SDW 0 This bit enables/disables boot ROM. (Shadow the ROM). SDW = 0 When clear, the MCU executes from the 10K boot ROM space. The boot ROM appears in two locations: 0000h and 8000h. The 16K RAM is mapped to XDATA space; therefore, a read/write operation is possible. This bit is set by the MCU after the RAM load is completed. The MCU cannot clear this bit; it is cleared on power-up reset or watchdog time-out reset. SDW = 1 When set by the MCU, the 10K boot ROM maps to location 8000h, and the 16K RAM is mapped to code space, starting at location 0000h. At this point, the MCU executes from RAM, and the write operation is disabled (no write operation is possible in code space). 4−1 RSVD No effect These bits are always read as 0000b. 6−5 S[1:0] No effect Code space size. These bits define the ROM or RAM code-space size (bit 7 (ROA) defines ROM or RAM). These bits are permanently set to 10b, indicating 16K bytes of code space, and are not affected by reset (see Table 4−1). 00 = 4K bytes code space size 01 = 8K bytes code space size 10 = 16K bytes code space size 11 = 32K bytes code space size 7 ROA No effect ROM or RAM version. This bit indicates whether the code space is RAM or ROM based. This bit is permanently set to 1, indicating the code space is RAM, and is not affected by reset (see Table 4−1). ROA = 0 Code space is ROM ROA = 1 Code space is RAM Table 4−1. ROM/RAM Size Definition Table ROMS REGISTER BOOT ROM RAM CODE ROM CODE ROA S1 S0 0 0 0 None None 4K 0 0 1 None None 8K 0 1 0 None None 16K (reserved) 1 1 1 None None 32K (reserved) 1 0 0 10K 4K None 1 0 1 10K 8K None 1† 1† 0† 10K† 16K† None† 1 1 1 10K 32K (reserved) None † This is the hardwired setting. 4.1.2 Boot Operation (MCU Firmware Loading) Since the code space is in RAM (with the exception of the boot ROM), the TUSB3410 firmware must be loaded from an external source. Two sources are available for booting: one from an external serial EEPROM connected to the I2C bus and the other from the host via the USB. On device reset, bit 0 (SDW) in the ROMS register (see Section 4.1.1) and bit 7 (CONT) in the USBCTL register (see Section 5.4) are cleared. This configures the memory space to boot mode (see Table 4−3) and keeps the device disconnected from the host. The first instruction is fetched from location 0000h (which is in the 10K ROM). The 16K RAM is mapped to XDATA space (location 0000h). The MCU executes a read from an external EEPROM and tests whether it contains the code (by testing for boot signature). If it contains the code, then the MCU reads from EEPROM MCU Memory Map SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 15 and writes to the 16K RAM in XDATA space. If it does not contain the code, then the MCU proceeds to boot from the USB. Once the code is loaded, the MCU sets the SDW bit to 1 in the ROMS register. This switches the memory map to normal mode; that is, the 16K RAM is mapped to code space, and the MCU starts executing from location 0000h. Once the switch is done, the MCU sets the CONT bit to 1 in the USBCTL register. This connects the device to the USB and results in normal USB device enumeration. 4.1.3 WDCSR: Watchdog Timer, Control, and Status Register (Addr:FF93h) A watchdog timer (WDT) with 1-ms clock is provided. If this register is not accessed for a period of 128 ms, then the WDT counter resets the MCU (see Figure 5−1). The watchdog timer is enabled by default and can be disabled by writing a pattern of 101010b into the WDD[5:0] bits. The 1-ms clock for the watchdog timer is generated from the SOF pulses. Therefore, in order for the watchdog timer to count, bit 7 (CONT) in the USBCTL register (see Section 5.4) must be set. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WDD0 WDR WDD5 WDD4 WDD3 WDD2 WDD1 WDT R/W R/C R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W W/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 WDT 0 MCU must write a 1 to this bit to prevent the watchdog timer from resetting the MCU. If the MCU does not write a 1 in a period of 128 ms, the watchdog timer resets the device. Writing a 0 has no effect on the watchdog timer. (The watchdog timer is a 7-bit counter using a 1-ms CLK.) This bit is read as 0. 5−1 WDD[5:1] 00000 These bits disable the watchdog timer. For the timer to be disabled these bits must be set to 10101b and bit 7 (WDD0) must also be set to 0. If any other pattern is present, then the watchdog timer is in operation. 6 WDR 0 Watchdog reset indication bit. This bit indicates if the reset occurred due to power-on reset or watchdog timer reset. WDR = 0 A power-up reset occurred WDR = 1 A watchdog time-out reset occurred. To clear this bit, the MCU must write a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 7 WDD0 1 This bit is one of the six disable bits for the watchdog timer. This bit must be cleared in order for the watchdog timer to be disabled. 4.2 Buffers + I/O RAM Map The address range from F800h to FFFFh (2K bytes) is reserved for data buffers, setup packet, endpoint descriptors block (EDB), and all I/O. There are 128 locations reserved for memory-mapped registers (MMR). Table 4−2 represents the XDATA space allocation and access restriction for the DMA, USB buffer manager (UBM), and MCU. Table 4−2. XDATA Space DESCRIPTION ADDRESS RANGE UBM ACCESS DMA ACCESS MCU ACCESS Internal MMRs (Memory-Mapped Registers) FFFFh−FF80h No (Only EDB-0) No (only data register and EDB-0) Yes EDB (Endpoint Descriptors Block) FF7Fh−FF08h Only for EDB update Only for EDB update Yes Setup Packet FF07h−FF00h Yes No Yes Input Endpoint-0 Buffer FEFFh−FEF8h Yes Yes Yes Output Endpoint-0 Buffer FEF7h−FEF0h Yes Yes Yes Data Buffers FEEFh−F800h Yes Yes Yes MCU Memory Map 16 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Table 4−3. Memory-Mapped Registers Summary (XDATA Range = FF80h → FFFFh) ADDRESS REGISTER DESCRIPTION FFFFh FUNADR Function address register FFFEh USBSTA USB status register FFFDh USBMSK USB interrupt mask register FFFCh USBCTL USB control register FFFBh MODECNFG Mode configuration register FFFAh−FFF4h Reserved FFF3h I2CADR I2C-port address register FFF2h I2CDATI I2C-port data input register FFF1h I2CDATO I2C-port data output register FFF0h I2CSTA I2C-port status register FFEFh SERNUM7 Serial number byte 7 register FFEEh SERNUM6 Serial number byte 6 register FFEDh SERNUM5 Serial number byte 5 register FFECh SERNUM4 Serial number byte 4 register FFEBh SERNUM3 Serial number byte 3 register FFEAh SERNUM2 Serial number byte 2 register FFE9h SERNUM1 Serial number byte 1 register FFE8h SERNUM0 Serial number byte 0 register FFE7h−FFE6h Reserved FFE5h DMACSR3 DMA-3: Control and status register FFE4h DMACDR3 DMA-3: Channel definition register FFE3h−FFE2h Reserved FFE1h DMACSR1 DMA-1: Control and status register FFE0h DMACDR1 DMA-1: Channel definition register FFDFh−FFACh Reserved FFABh MASK UART: Interrupt mask register FFAAh XOFF UART: Xoff register FFA9h XON UART: Xon register FFA8h DLH UART: Divisor high-byte register FFA7h DLL UART: Divisor low-byte register FFA6h MSR UART: Modem status register FFA5h LSR UART: Line status register FFA4h MCR UART: Modem control register FFA3h FCRL UART: Flow control register FFA2h LCR UART: Line control registers FFA1h TDR UART: Transmitter data registers FFA0h RDR UART: Receiver data registers FF9Eh PUR_3 GPIO: Pullup register for port 3 MCU Memory Map SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 17 Table 4−3. Memory-Mapped Registers Summary (XDATA Range = FF80h → FFFFh) (Continued) ADDRESS REGISTER DESCRIPTION FF9Dh−FF94h FF93h Reserved WDCSR Watchdog timer control and status register FF92h VECINT Vector interrupt register FF91h Reserved FF90h ROMS ROM shadow configuration register FF8Fh−FF84h Reserved FF83h OEPBCNT_0 Output endpoint_0: Byte count register FF82h OEPCNFG_0 Output endpoint_0: Configuration register FF81h IEPBCNT_0 Input endpoint_0: Byte count register FF80h IEPCNFG_0 Input endpoint_0: Configuration register Table 4−4. EDB Memory Locations ADDRESS REGISTER DESCRIPTION FF7Fh−FF60h Reserved FF5Fh IEPSIZXY_3 Input endpoint_3: X-Y buffer size FF5Eh IEPBCTY_3 Input endpoint_3: Y-byte count FF5Dh IEPBBAY_3 Input endpoint_3: Y-buffer base address FF5Ch − Reserved FF5Bh − Reserved FF5Ah IEPBCTX_3 Input endpoint_3: X-byte count FF59h IEPBBAX Input endpoint_3: X-buffer base address FF58h IEPCNF_3 Input endpoint_3: Configuration FF57h IEPSIZXY_2 Input endpoint_2: X-Y buffer size FF56h IEPBCTY_2 Input endpoint_2: Y-byte count FF55h IEPBBAY_2 Input endpoint_2: Y-buffer base address FF54h − Reserved FF53h − Reserved FF52h IEPBCTX_2 Input endpoint_2: X-byte count FF51h IEPBBAX_2 Input endpoint_2: X-buffer base address FF50h IEPCNF_2 Input endpoint_2: Configuration FF4Fh IEPSIZXY_1 Input endpoint_1: X-Y buffer size FF4Eh IEPBCTY_1 Input endpoint_1: Y-byte count FF4Dh IEPBBAY_1 Input endpoint_1: Y-buffer base address FF4Ch − Reserved FF4Bh − Reserved FF4Ah IEPBCTX_1 Input endpoint_1: X-byte count FF49h IEPBBAX_1 Input endpoint_1: X-buffer base address FF48h IEPCNF_1 Input endpoint_1: Configuration FF47h ↑ Reserved FF20h FF1Fh OEPSIZXY_3 Output endpoint_3: X-Y buffer size FF1Eh OEPBCTY_3 Output endpoint_3: Y-byte count FF1Dh OEPBBAY_3 Output endpoint_3: Y-buffer base address FF1Bh−FF1Ch − Reserved MCU Memory Map 18 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Table 4−4. EDB Memory Locations (Continued) ADDRESS REGISTER DESCRIPTION FF1Ah OEPBCTX_3 Output endpoint_3: X-byte count FF19h OEPBBAX_3 Output endpoint_3: X-buffer base address FF18h OEPCNF_3 Output endpoint_3: Configuration FF17h OEPSIZXY_2 Output endpoint_2: X-Y buffer size FF16h OEPBCTY_2 Output endpoint_2: Y-byte count FF15h OEPBBAY_2 Output endpoint_2: Y-buffer base address FF14h−FF13h − Reserved FF12h OEPBCTX_2 Output endpoint_2: X-byte count FF11h OEPBBAX_2 Output endpoint_2: X-buffer base address FF10h OEPCNF_2 Output endpoint_2: Configuration FF0Fh OEPSIZXY_1 Output endpoint_1: X-Y buffer size FF0Eh OEPBCTY_1 Output endpoint_1: Y-byte count FF0Dh OEPBBAY_1 Output endpoint_1: Y-buffer base address FF0Ch−FF0Bh − Reserved FF0Ah OEPBCTX_1 Output endpoint_1: X-byte count FF09h OEPBBAX_1 Output endpoint_1: X-buffer base address FF08h OEPCNF_1 Output endpoint_1: Configuration FF07h ↑ (8 bytes) Setup packet block FF00h FEFFh ↑ (8 bytes) Input endpoint_0 buffer FEF8h FEF7h ↑ (8 bytes) Output endpoint_0 buffer FEF0h FEEFh TOPBUFF Top of buffer space ↑ Buffer space F800h STABUFF Start of buffer space 4.3 Endpoint Descriptor Block (EDB−1 to EDB−3) Data transfers between the USB, the MCU, and external devices that are defined by an endpoint descriptor block (EDB). Three input and three output EDBs are provided. With the exception of EDB-0 (I/O endpoint-0), all EDBs are located in SRAM as per Table 4−3. Each EDB contains information describing the X- and Y-buffers. In addition, each EDB provides general status information. Table 4−5 describes the EDB entries for EDB−1 to EDB−3. EDB−0 registers are described in Table 4−6. MCU Memory Map SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 19 Table 4−5. Endpoint Registers and Offsets in RAM (n = 1 to 3) OFFSET ENTRY NAME DESCRIPTION 07 EPSIZXY_n I/O endpoint_n: X/Y-buffer size 06 EPBCTY_n I/O endpoint_n: Y-byte count 05 EPBBAY_n I/O endpoint_n: Y-buffer base address 04 SPARE Not used 03 SPARE Not used 02 EPBCTX_n I/O endpoint_n: X-byte count 01 EPBBAX_n I/O endpoint_n: X-buffer base address 00 EPCNF_n I/O endpoint_n: Configuration Table 4−6. Endpoint Registers Base Addresses BASE ADDRESS DESCRIPTION FF08h Output endpoint 1 FF10h Output endpoint 2 FF18h Output endpoint 3 FF48h Input endpoint 1 FF50h Input endpoint 2 FF58h Input endpoint 3 4.3.1 OEPCNF_n: Output Endpoint Configuration (n = 1 to 3) (Base Addr: FF08h, FF10h, FF18h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UBME ISO=0 TOGLE DBUF STALL USBIE RSV RSV R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 1−0 RSV x Reserved = 0 2 USBIE x USB interrupt enable on transaction completion. Set/cleared by the MCU. USBIE = 0 No interrupt on transaction completion USBIE = 1 Interrupt on transaction completion 3 STALL 0 USB stall condition indication. Set/cleared by the MCU. STALL = 0 STALL = 1 No stall USB stall condition. If set by the MCU, then a STALL handshake is initiated and the bit is cleared by the MCU. 4 DBUF x Double-buffer enable. Set/cleared by the MCU. DBUF = 0 Primary buffer only (X-buffer only) DBUF = 1 Toggle bit selects buffer 5 TOGLE x USB toggle bit. This bit reflects the toggle sequence bit of DATA0, DATA1. 6 ISO x ISO = 0 Nonisochronous transfer. This bit must be cleared by the MCU since only nonisochronous transfer is supported. 7 UBME x USB buffer manager (UBM) enable/disable bit. Set/cleared by the MCU. UBME = 0 UBM cannot use this endpoint UBME = 1 UBM can use this endpoint 4.3.2 OEPBBAX_n: Output Endpoint X-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 1) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 A[10:3] x A[10:3] of X-buffer base address (padded with 3 LSBs of zeros for a total of 11 bits). This value is set by the MCU. The UBM or DMA uses this value as the start-address of a given transaction. Note that the UBM or DMA does not change this value at the end of a transaction. MCU Memory Map 20 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 4.3.3 OEPBCTX_n: Output Endpoint X Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 2) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NAK C6 C5 C4 C3 C2 C1 C0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 6−0 C[6:0] x X-buffer byte count: X000.0000b Count = 0 X000.0001b Count = 1 byte : : X011.1111b Count = 63 bytes X100.0000b Count = 64 bytes Any value ≥ 100.0001b may result in unpredictable results. 7 NAK x NAK = 0 NAK = 1 No valid data in buffer. Ready for host OUT Buffer contains a valid packet from host (gives NAK response to Host OUT request) 4.3.4 OEPBBAY_n: Output Endpoint Y-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 5) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 A[10:3] x A[10:3] of Y-buffer base address (padded with 3 LSBs of zeros for a total of 11 bits). This value is set by the MCU. The UBM or DMA uses this value as the start-address of a given transaction. Furthermore, UBM or DMA does not change this value at the end of a transaction. 4.3.5 OEPBCTY_n: Output Endpoint Y-Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 6) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NAK C6 C5 C4 C3 C2 C1 C0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 6−0 C[6:0] x Y-byte count: X000.0000b Count = 0 X000.0001b Count = 1 byte : : X011.1111b Count = 63 bytes X100.0000b Count = 64 bytes Any value ≥ 100.0001b may result in unpredictable results. 7 NAK x NAK = 0 NAK = 1 No valid data in buffer. Ready for host OUT Buffer contains a valid packet from host (gives NAK response to Host OUT request) MCU Memory Map SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 21 4.3.6 OEPSIZXY_n: Output Endpoint X-/Y-Buffer Size (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 7) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSV S6 S5 S4 S3 S2 S1 S0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 6−0 S[6:0] x X- and Y-buffer size: 0000.0000b Size = 0 0000.0001b Size = 1 byte : : 0011.1111b Size = 63 bytes 0100.0000b Size = 64 bytes Any value ≥ 100.0001b may result in unpredictable results. 7 RSV x Reserved = 0 4.3.7 IEPCNF_n: Input Endpoint Configuration (n = 1 to 3) (Base Addr: FF48h, FF50h, FF58h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UBME ISO=0 TOGLE DBUF STALL USBIE RSV RSV R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 1−0 RSV x Reserved = 0 2 USBIE x USB interrupt enable on transaction completion USBIE = 0 No interrupt on transaction completion USBIE = 1 Interrupt on transaction completion 3 STALL 0 USB stall condition indication. Set by the UBM but can be set/cleared by the MCU STALL = 0 No stall STALL = 1 USB stall condition. If set by the MCU, then a STALL handshake is initiated and the bit is cleared automatically. 4 DBUF x Double buffer enable DBUF = 0 Primary buffer only (X-buffer only) DBUF = 1 Toggle bit selects buffer 5 TOGLE x USB toggle bit. This bit reflects the toggle sequence bit of DATA0, DATA1 6 ISO x ISO = 0 Nonisochronous transfer. This bit must be cleared by the MCU since only nonisochronous transfer is supported 7 UBME x UBM enable/disable bit. Set/cleared by the MCU UBME = 0 UBM cannot use this endpoint UBME = 1 UBM can use this endpoint 4.3.8 IEPBBAX_n: Input Endpoint X-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 1) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 A[10:3] x A[10:3] of X-buffer base address (padded with 3 LSBs of zeros for a total of 11 bits). This value is set by the MCU. The UBM or DMA uses this value as the start-address of a given transaction, but note that the UBM or DMA does not change this value at the end of a transaction. MCU Memory Map 22 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 4.3.9 IEPBCTX_n: Input Endpoint X-Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 2) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NAK C6 C5 C4 C3 C2 C1 C0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 6−0 C[6:0] x X-Buffer byte count: X000.0000b Count = 0 X000.0001b Count = 1 byte : : X011.1111b Count = 63 bytes X100.0000b Count = 64 bytes Any value ≥ 100.0001b may result in unpredictable results. 7 NAK x NAK = 0 NAK = 1 Buffer contains a valid packet for host-IN transaction Buffer is empty (gives NAK response to host-IN request) 4.3.10 IEPBBAY_n: Input Endpoint Y-Buffer Base Address (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 5) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 A[10:3] x A[10:3] of Y-buffer base address (padded with 3 LSBs of zeros for a total of 11 bits). This value is set by the MCU. The UBM or DMA uses this value as the start-address of a given transaction, but note that the UBM or DMA does not change this value at the end of a transaction. 4.3.11 IEPBCTY_n: Input Endpoint Y-Byte Count (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 6) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NAK C6 C5 C4 C3 C2 C1 C0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 6−0 C[6:0] x Y-Byte count: X000.0000b Count = 0 X000.0001b Count = 1 byte : : X011.1111b Count = 63 bytes X100.0000b Count = 64 bytes Any value ≥ 100.0001b may result in unpredictable results. 7 NAK x NAK = 0 NAK = 1 Buffer contains a valid packet for host-IN transaction Buffer is empty (gives NAK response to host-IN request) MCU Memory Map SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 23 4.3.12 IEPSIZXY_n: Input Endpoint X-/Y-Buffer Size (n = 1 to 3) (Offset 7) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSV S6 S5 S4 S3 S2 S1 S0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 6−0 S[6:0] x X- and Y-buffer size: 0000.0000b Size = 0 0000.0001b Size = 1 byte : : 0011.1111b Size = 63 bytes 0100.0000b Size = 64 bytes Any value ≥ 100.0001b may result in unpredictable results. 7 RSV x Reserved = 0 4.4 Endpoint-0 Descriptor Registers Unlike registers EDB-1 to EDB-3, which are defined as memory entries in SRAM, endpoint-0 is described by a set of four registers (two for output and two for input). The registers and their respective addresses, used for EDB-0 description, are defined in Table 4−7. EDB-0 has no buffer base-address register, since these addresses are hardwired to FEF8h and FEF0h. Note that the bit positions have been preserved to provide consistency with EDB-n (n = 1 to 3). Table 4−7. Input/Output EDB-0 Registers ADDRESS REGISTER NAME DESCRIPTION BUFFER BASE ADDRESS FF83h FF82h OEPBCNT_0 OEPCNFG_0 Output endpoint_0: Byte count register Output endpoint_0: Configuration register FEF0h FF81h FF80h IEPBCNT_0 IEPCNFG_0 Input endpoint_0: Byte count register Input endpoint_0: Configuration register FEF8h 4.4.1 IEPCNFG_0: Input Endpoint-0 Configuration Register (Addr:FF80h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UBME RSV TOGLE RSV STALL USBIE RSV RSV R/W R/O R/O R/O R/W R/W R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 1−0 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 2 USBIE 0 USB interrupt enable on transaction completion. Set/cleared by the MCU. USBIE = 0 No interrupt USBIE = 1 Interrupt on transaction completion 3 STALL 0 USB stall condition indication. Set/cleared by the MCU STALL = 0 No stall STALL = 1 USB stall condition. If set by the MCU, then a STALL handshake is initiated and the bit is cleared automatically by the next setup transaction. 4 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 5 TOGLE 0 USB toggle bit. This bit reflects the toggle sequence bit of DATA0, DATA1. 6 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 7 UBME 0 UBM enable/disable bit. Set/cleared by the MCU UBME = 0 UBM cannot use this endpoint UBME = 1 UBM can use this endpoint MCU Memory Map 24 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 4.4.2 IEPBCNT_0: Input Endpoint-0 Byte Count Register (Addr:FF81h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NAK RSV RSV RSV C3 C2 C1 C0 R/W R/O R/O R/O R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 3−0 C[3:0] 0h Byte count: 0000b Count = 0 : : 0111b Count = 7 1000b Count = 8 1001b to 1111b are reserved. (If used, they default to 8) 6−4 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 7 NAK 1 NAK = 0 NAK = 1 Buffer contains a valid packet for host-IN transaction Buffer is empty (gives NAK response to host-IN request) 4.4.3 OEPCNFG_0: Output Endpoint-0 Configuration Register (Addr:FF82h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 UBME RSV TOGLE RSV STALL USBIE RSV RSV R/W R/O R/O R/O R/W R/W R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 1−0 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 2 USBIE 0 USB interrupt enable on transaction completion. Set/cleared by the MCU. USBIE = 0 No interrupt on transaction completion USBIE = 1 Interrupt on transaction completion 3 STALL 0 USB stall condition indication. Set/cleared by the MCU STALL = 0 No stall STALL = 1 USB stall condition. If set by the MCU, a STALL handshake is initiated and the bit is cleared automatically. 4 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 5 TOGLE 0 USB \toggle bit. This bit reflects the toggle sequence bit of DATA0, DATA1. 6 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 7 UBME 0 UBM enable/disable bit. Set/cleared by the MCU UBME = 0 UBM cannot use this endpoint UBME = 1 UBM can use this endpoint 4.4.4 OEPBCNT_0: Output Endpoint-0 Byte Count Register (Addr:FF83h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 NAK RSV RSV RSV C3 C2 C1 C0 R/W R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 3−0 C[3:0] 0h Byte count: 0000b Count = 0 : : 0111b Count = 7 1000b Count = 8 1001b to 1111b are reserved 6−4 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 7 NAK 1 NAK =0 NAK = 1 No valid data in buffer. Ready for host OUT Buffer contains a valid packet from host (gives NAK response to host-OUT request). USB Registers SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 25 5 USB Registers 5.1 FUNADR: Function Address Register (Addr:FFFFh) This register contains the device function address. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSV FA6 FA5 FA4 FA3 FA2 FA1 FA0 R/O R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 6−0 FA[6:0] 0 These bits define the current device address assigned to the function. The MCU writes a value to this register because of the SET-ADDRESS host command. 7 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 5.2 USBSTA: USB Status Register (Addr:FFFEh) All bits in this register are set by the hardware and are cleared by the MCU when writing a 1 to the proper bit location (writing a 0 has no effect). In addition, each bit can generate an interrupt if its corresponding mask bit is set (R/C notation indicates read and clear only by the MCU). 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSTR SUSR RESR RSV URRI SETUP WAKEUP STPOW R/C R/C R/C R/O R/C R/C R/C R/C BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 STPOW 0 SETUP overwrite bit. Set by hardware when a setup packet is received while there is already a packet in the setup buffer. STPOW = 0 STPOW = 1 MCU can clear this bit by writing a 1 (writing 0 has no effect). SETUP overwrite 1 WAKEUP 0 Remote wakeup bit WAKEUP = 0 WAKEUP = 1 The MCU can clear this bit by writing a 1 (writing 0 has no effect). Remote wakeup request from WAKEUP terminal 2 SETUP 0 SETUP transaction received bit. As long as SETUP is 1, IN and OUT on endpoint-0 are NAKed, regardless of their real NAK bits value. SETUP = 0 SETUP = 1 MCU can clear this bit by writing a 1 (writing 0 has no effect). SETUP transaction received 3 URRI 0 UART RI (ring indicate) status bit – a rising edge causes this bit to be set. URRI = 0 URRI = 1 The MCU can clear this bit by writing a 1 (writing 0 has no effect). Ring detected, which is used to wake the chip up (bring it out of suspend). 4 RSV 0 Reserved 5 RESR 0 Function resume request bit RESR = 0 RESR = 1 The MCU can clear this bit by writing a 1 (writing 0 has no effect). Function resume is detected 6 SUSR 0 Function suspended request bit. This bit is set in response to a global or selective suspend condition. SUSR = 0 SUSR = 1 The MCU can clear this bit by writing a 1 (writing 0 has no effect). Function suspend is detected 7 RSTR 0 Function reset request bit. This bit is set in response to the USB host initiating a port reset. This bit is not affected by the USB function reset. RSTR = 0 RSTR = 1 The MCU can clear this bit by writing a 1 (writing 0 has no effect). Function reset is detected USB Registers 26 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 5.3 USBMSK: USB Interrupt Mask Register (Addr:FFFDh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSTR SUSR RESR RSV URRI SETUP WAKEUP STPOW R/W R/W R/W R/O R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 STPOW 0 SETUP overwrite interrupt-enable bit STPOW = 0 STPOW = 1 STPOW interrupt disabled STPOW interrupt enabled 1 WAKEUP 0 Remote wakeup interrupt enable bit WAKEUP = 0 WAKEUP = 1 WAKEUP interrupt disable WAKEUP interrupt enable 2 SETUP 0 SETUP interrupt enable bit SETUP = 0 SETUP = 1 SETUP interrupt disabled SETUP interrupt enabled 3 URRI 0 UART RI interrupt enable bit URRI = 0 URRI = 1 UART RI interrupt disable UART RI interrupt enable 4 RSV 0 Reserved 5 RESR 0 Function resume interrupt enable bit RESR = 0 RESR = 1 Function resume interrupt disabled Function resume interrupt enabled 6 SUSR 0 Function suspend interrupt enable SUSR = 0 SUSR = 1 Function suspend interrupt disabled Function suspend interrupt enabled 7 RSTR 0 Function reset interrupt bit. This bit is not affected by USB function reset. RSTR = 0 RSTR = 1 Function reset interrupt disabled Function reset interrupt enabled USB Registers SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 27 5.4 USBCTL: USB Control Register (Addr:FFFCh) Unlike the rest of the registers, this register is cleared by the power-up reset signal only. The USB reset cannot reset this register (see Figure 5−1). 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CONT IREN RWUP FRSTE RSV RSV SIR DIR R/W R/W R/C R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET 0 DIR 0 As a response to a setup packet, the MCU decodes the request and sets/clears this bit to reflect the data transfer direction. DIR = 0 DIR = 1 USB data-OUT transaction (from host to TUSB3410) USB data-IN transaction (from TUSB3410 to host) 1 SIR 0 SETUP interrupt-status bit. This bit is controlled by the MCU to indicate to the hardware when the SETUP interrupt is being serviced. SIR = 0 SIR = 1 SETUP interrupt is not served. The MCU clears this bit before exiting the SETUP interrupt routine. SETUP interrupt is in progress. The MCU sets this bit when servicing the SETUP interrupt. 2 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 3 RSV 0 This bit must always be written as 0. 4 FRSTE 1 Function reset-connection bit. This bit connects/disconnects the USB function reset to/from the MCU reset. FRSTE = 0 FRSTE = 1 Function reset is not connected to MCU reset Function reset is connected to MCU reset 5 RWUP 0 Device remote wakeup request. This bit is set by the MCU and is cleared automatically. RWUP = 0 RWUP = 1 Writing a 0 to this bit has no effect When MCU writes a 1, a remote-wakeup pulse is generated. 6 IREN 0 IR mode enable. This bit is set and cleared by firmware. IREN = 0 IREN = 1 IR encoder/decoder is disabled, UART mode is selected IR encoder/decoder is enabled, UART mode is deselected 7 CONT 0 Connect/disconnect bit CONT = 0 CONT = 1 Upstream port is disconnected. Pullup disabled. Upstream port is connected. Pullup enabled. 5.5 MODECNFG: Mode Configuration Register (Addr:FFFBh) This register is cleared by the power-up reset signal only. The USB reset cannot reset this register. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSV RSV RSV RSV CLKSLCT CLKOUTEN SOFTSW TXCNTL R/O R/O R/O R/O R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 TXCNTL 0 Transmit output control: Hardware or firmware switching select for 3-state serial output buffer. TXCNTL = 0 TXCNTL = 1 Hardware automatic switching is selected Firmware toggle switching is selected 1 SOFTSW 0 Soft switch: Firmware controllable 3-state output buffer enable for serial output terminal. SOFTSW = 0 SOFTSW = 1 Serial output buffer is enabled Serial output buffer is disabled 2 CLKOUTEN 0 Clock output enable: Enables/disables the clock output at CLKOUT terminal. CLKOUTEN = 0 CLKOUTEN = 1 Clock output is disabled. Device drives low at CLKOUT terminal. Clock output is enabled 3 CLKSLCT 0 Clock output source select: Selects between 3.556-MHz fixed clock or UART baud out clock as output clock source. CLKSLCT = 0 CLKSLCT = 1 UART baud out clock is selected as clock output Fixed 3.556-MHz free running clock is selected as clock output 4−7 RSV 0 Reserved USB Registers 28 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Clock Output Control Bit 2 (CLKOUTEN) in the MODECNFG register enables or disables the clock output at the CLKOUT terminal of the TUSB3410. The power up default of CLKOUT is disabled. Firmware can write a 1 to enable the clock output if needed. Bit 3 (CLKSLCT) in the MODECNFG register selects the output clock source from either a fixed 3.556-MHz free-running clock or the UART BaudOut clock. 5.6 Vendor ID/Product ID USB−IF and Microsoft WHQL certification requires that end equipment makers use their own unique vendor ID and product ID for each product (model). OEMs cannot use silicon vendor’s (for instance, TI’s default) VID/PID in their end products. A unique VID/PID combination will avoid potential driver conflicts and enable logo certification. See www.usb.org for more information. 5.7 SERNUM7: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 7) (Addr:FFEFh) Each TUSB3410 device has a unique 64-bit serial die id number, which is generated during manufacturing. The die id is incremented sequentially, however there is no assurance that numbers will not be skipped. The device serial number registers mirror this unique 64-bit serial die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM7) contains the most significant byte (byte 7) of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D63 D62 D61 D60 D59 D58 D57 D56 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[63:56] Device serial number byte 7 value Device serial number byte 7 value Procedure to load device serial number value in shared RAM: • After power-up reset, the boot code copies the predefined USB descriptors to shared RAM. As a result, the default serial number hard-coded in the boot code (0x00 hex) is copied to the shared RAM data space. • The boot code checks to see if an EEPROM is present on the I2C port. If an EEPROM is present and contains a valid device serial number as part of the USB device descriptor information stored in EEPROM, then the boot code overwrites the serial number value stored in shared RAM with the one found in EEPROM. Otherwise, the device serial number value stored in shared RAM remains unchanged. If firmware is stored in the EEPROM, then it is executed. This firmware can read the SERNUM7 through SERNUM0 registers and overwrite the serial number stored in RAM or store a custom number in RAM. • In summary, the serial number value in external EEPROM has the highest priority to be loaded into shared RAM data space. The serial number value stored in shared RAM is used as part of the valid device descriptor information during normal operation. USB Registers SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 29 5.8 SERNUM6: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 6) (Addr:FFEEh) The device serial number registers mirror the unique 64-bit die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM6) contains byte 6 of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D55 D54 D53 D52 D51 D50 D49 D48 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[55:48] Device serial number byte 6 value Device serial number byte 6 value NOTE: See the procedure described in the SERNUM7 register (see Section 5.7) to load the device serial number into shared RAM. 5.9 SERNUM5: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 5) (Addr:FFEDh) The device serial number registers mirror the unique 64-bit die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM5) contains byte 5 of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D47 D46 D45 D44 D43 D42 D41 D40 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[47:40] Device serial number byte 5 value Device serial number byte 5 value NOTE: See the procedure described in the SERNUM7 register (see Section 5.7) to load the device serial number into shared RAM. 5.10 SERNUM4: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 4) (Addr:FFECh) The device serial number registers mirror the unique 64-bit die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM4) contains byte 4 of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D39 D38 D37 D36 D35 D34 D33 D32 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[39:32] Device serial number byte 4 value Device serial number byte 4 value NOTE: See the procedure described in the SERNUM7 register (see Section 5.7) to load the device serial number into shared RAM. 5.11 SERNUM3: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 3) (Addr:FFEBh) The device serial number registers mirror the unique 64-bit die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM3) contains byte 3 of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D31 D30 D29 D28 D27 D26 D25 D24 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[31:24] Device serial number byte 3 value Device serial number byte 3 value NOTE: See the procedure described in the SERNUM7 register (see Section 5.7) to load the device serial number into shared RAM. USB Registers 30 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 5.12 SERNUM2: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 2) (Addr:FFEAh) The device serial number registers mirror the unique 64-bit die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM2) contains byte 2 of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D23 D22 D21 D20 D19 D18 D17 D16 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[23:16] 0 Device serial number byte 2 value NOTE: See the procedure described in the SERNUM7 register (see Section 5.7) to load the device serial number into shared RAM. 5.13 SERNUM1: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 1) (Addr:FFE9h) The device serial number registers mirror the unique 64-bit die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM1) contains byte 1 of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[15:8] Device serial number byte 1 value Device serial number byte 1 value NOTE: See the procedure described in the SERNUM7 register (see Section 5.7) to load the device serial number into shared RAM. 5.14 SERNUM0: Device Serial Number Register (Byte 0) (Addr:FFE8h) The device serial number registers mirror the unique 64-bit die id value. After power-up reset, this read-only register (SERNUM0) contains byte 0 of the complete 64-bit device serial number. This register cannot be reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] Device serial number byte 0 value Device serial number byte 0 value NOTE: See the procedure described in the SERNUM7 register (see Section 5.7) to load the device serial number into shared RAM. USB Registers SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 31 5.15 Function Reset And Power-Up Reset Interconnect Figure 5−1 represents the logical connection of the USB-function reset (USBR) signal and the power-up reset (RESET) terminal. The internal RESET signal is generated from the RESET terminal (PURS signal) or from the USB reset (USBR signal). The USBR can be enabled or disabled by bit 4 (FRSTE) in the USBCTL register (see Section 5.4) (on power up, FRSTE = 0). The internal RESET is used to reset all registers and logic, with the exception of the USBCTL and MODECNFG registers which are cleared by the PURS signal only. USBCTL Register MODECNFG Register PURS USBR RESET MCU FRSTE USB Function Reset To Internal MMRs RESET G2 WDD[5:0] WDT Reset Figure 5−1. Reset Diagram 5.16 Pullup Resistor Connect/Disconnect The TUSB3410 enumeration can be activated by the MCU (there is no need to disconnect the cable physically). Figure 5−2 represents the implementation of the TUSB3410 connect and disconnect from a USB up-stream port. When bit 7 (CONT) is 1 in the USBCTL register (see Section 5.4), the CMOS driver sources VDD to the pullup resistor (PUR terminal) presenting a normal connect condition to the USB host. When CONT is 0, the PUR terminal is driven low. In this state, the 1.5-kΩ resistor is connected to GND, resulting in the device disconnection state. The PUR driver is a CMOS driver that can provide (VDD − 0.1 V) minimum at 8-mA source current. HOST D+ D− 15 kΩ TUSB3410 1.5 kΩ CMOS PUR CONT Bit DP0 DM0 Figure 5−2. Pullup Resistor Connect/Disconnect Circuit USB Registers 32 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 DMA Controller SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 33 6 DMA Controller Table 6−1 outlines the DMA channels and their associated transfer directions. Two channels are provided for data transfer between the host and the UART. Table 6−1. DMA Controller Registers DMA CHANNEL TRANSFER DIRECTION COMMENTS DMA−1 Host to UART DMA writes to UART TDR register DMA−3 UART to host DMA reads from UART RDR register 6.1 DMA Controller Registers Each DMA channel can point to one of three EDBs (EDB-1 to EDB-3) and transfer data to/from the UART channel. The DMA can move data from a given out-point buffer (defined by the EDB) to the destination port. Similarly, the DMA can move data from a port to a given input-endpoint buffer. At the end of a block transfer, the DMA updates the byte count and bit 7 (NAK) in the EDB (see Section 4.3) when receiving. In addition, it uses bit 4 (XY) in the DMACDR register to switch automatically, without interrupting the MCU (the XY bit toggle is performed by the UBM). The DMA stops only when a time-out or error condition occurs. When the DMA is transmitting (from the X/Y buffer) it continues alternating between X/Y buffers until it detects a byte count smaller than the buffer size (buffer size is typically 64 bytes). At that point it completes the transfer and stops. DMA Controller 34 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 6.1.1 DMACDR1: DMA Channel Definition Register (UART Transmit Channel) (Addr:FFE0h) These registers define the EDB number that the DMA uses for data transfer to the UARTS. In addition, these registers define the data transfer direction and selects X or Y as the transaction buffer. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EN INE CNT XY T/R E2 E1 E0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/O R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 2−0 E[2:0] 0 Endpoint descriptor pointer. This field points to a set of EDB registers that is to be used for a given transfer. 3 T/R 0 This bit is always 1, indicating that the DMA data transfer is from SRAM to the UART TDR register (see Section 7.1.2). (The MCU cannot change this bit.) 4 XY 0 X/Y buffer select bit. XY = 0 XY = 1 Next buffer to transmit/receive is the X buffer Next buffer to transmit/receive is the Y buffer 5 CNT 0 DMA continuous transfer control bit. This bit defines the mode of the DMA transfer. This bit must always be written as 1. In this mode, the DMA and UBM alternate between the X- and Y-buffers. The DMA sets bit 4 (XY) and the UBM uses it for the transfer. The DMA alternates between the X-/Y-buffers and continues transmitting (from X-/Y-buffer) without MCU intervention. The DMA terminates, and interrupts the MCU, under the following conditions: 1. When the UBM byte count < buffer size (in EDB), the DMA transfers the partial packet and interrupt the MCU on completion. 2. Transaction timer expires. The DMA interrupts the MCU. 6 INE 0 DMA Interrupt enable/disable bit. This bit enables/disables the interrupt on transfer completion. INE = 0 Interrupt is disabled. In addition, bit 0 (PPKT) in the DMACSR1 register (see Section 6.1.2) does not clear bit 7 (EN) and the DMAC is not disabled. INE = 1 Enables the EN interrupt. When this bit is set, the DMA interrupts the MCU on a 1 to 0 transition of the bit 7 (EN). (When transfer is completed, EN = 0.) 7 EN 0 DMA channel enable bit. The MCU sets this bit to start the DMA transfer. When the transfer completes, or when it is terminated due to error, this bit is cleared. The 1 to 0 transition of this bit generates an interrupt (if the interrupt is enabled). EN = 0 DMA is halted. The DMA is halted when the byte count reaches zero or transaction time-out occurs. When halted, the DMA updates the byte count, sets NAK = 0 in the output endpoint byte count register, and interrupts the MCU (if bit 6 (INE) = 1). EN = 1 Setting this bit starts the DMA transfer. 6.1.2 DMACSR1: DMA Control And Status Register (UART Transmit Channel) (Addr:FFE1h) This register defines the transaction time-out value. In addition, it contains a completion code that reports any errors or a time-out condition. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PPKT R R R R R R R R/C BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 PPKT 0 Partial packet condition bit. This bit is set by the DMA and cleared by the MCU. PPKT = 0 No partial-packet condition PPKT = 1 Partial-packet condition detected. When INE = 0, this bit does not clear bit 7 (EN) in the DMACDR1 register; therefore, the DMAC stays enabled, ready for the next transaction. Clears when MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 7−1 − 0 These bits are read-only and return 0s when read. DMA Controller SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 35 6.1.3 DMACDR3: DMA Channel Definition Register (UART Receive Channel) (Addr:FFE4h) These registers define the EDB number that the DMA uses for data transfer from the UARTS. In addition, these registers define the data transfer direction and selects X or Y as the transaction buffer. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EN INE CNT XY T/R E2 E1 E0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/O R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 2−0 E[2:0] 0 Endpoint descriptor pointer. This field points to a set of EDB registers that are used for a given transfer. 3 T/R 1 This bit is always read as 1. This bit must be written as 0 to update the X/Y buffer bit (bit 4 in this register) which must only be performed in burst mode. 4 XY 0 X/Y buffer select bit. XY = 0 XY = 1 Next buffer to transmit/receive is X Next buffer to transmit/receive is Y 5 CNT 0 DMA continuous transfer control bit. This bit defines the mode of the DMA transfer. This bit must always be written as 1. In this mode, the DMA and UBM alternate between the X- and Y-buffers. The UBM sets bit 4 (XY) and the DMA uses it for the transfer. The DMA alternates between the X-/Y-buffers and continues receiving (to X-/Y-buffer) without MCU intervention. The DMA terminates the transfer and interrupts the MCU, under the following conditions: 1. Transaction time-out expired: DMA updates EDB and interrupts the MCU. UBM transfers the partial packet to the host. 2. UART receiver error condition: DMA updates EDB and does not interrupt the MCU. UBM transfers the partial packet to the host. 6 INE 0 DMA interrupt enable/disable bit. This bit enables/disables the interrupt on transfer completion. INE = 0 Interrupt is disabled. In addition, bit 0 (OVRUN) and bit 1 (TXFT) in the DMACSR3 register (see Section 6.1.4) do not clear bit 7 (EN) and the DMAC is not disabled. INE = 1 Enables the EN interrupt. When this bit is set, the DMA interrupts the MCU on a 1-to-0 transition of bit 7 (EN). (When transfer is completed, EN = 0). 7 EN 0 DMA channel enable bit. The MCU sets this bit to start the DMA transfer. When transfer completes, or when terminated due to error, this bit is cleared. The 1-to-0 transition of this bit generates an interrupt (if the interrupt is enabled). EN = 0 DMA is halted. The DMA is halted when transaction time-out occurs, or under a UART receiver-error condition. When halted, the DMA updates the byte count and sets NAK = 0 in the input endpoint byte count register. If the termination is due to transaction time-out, then the DMA generates an interrupt. However, if the termination is due to a UART error condition, then the DMA does not generate an interrupt. (The UART generates the interrupt.) EN = 1 Setting this bit starts the DMA transfer. DMA Controller 36 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 6.1.4 DMACSR3: DMA Control And Status Register (UART Receive Channel) (Addr:FFE5h) This register defines the transaction time-out value. In addition, it contains a completion code that reports any errors or a time-out condition. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TEN C4 C3 C2 C1 C0 TXFT OVRUN R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/C R/C BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 OVRUN 0 Overrun condition bit. This bit is set by DMA and cleared by the MCU (see Table 6−2) OVRUN = 0 No overrun condition OVRUN = 1 Overrun condition detected. When IEN = 0, this bit does not clear bit 7 (EN) in the DMACDR register; therefore, the DMAC stays enabled, ready for the next transaction. Clears when the MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 1 TXFT 0 Transfer time-out condition bit (see Table 6−2) TXFT = 0 DMA stopped transfer without time-out TXFT =1 DMA stopped due to transaction time-out. When IEN = 0, this bit does not clear bit 7 (EN) in the DMACDR3 register (see Section 6.1.3); therefore, the DMAC stays enabled, ready for the next transaction. Clears when the MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 6−2 C[4:0] 00000b This field defines the transaction time-out value in 1-ms increments. This value is loaded to a down counter every time a byte transfer occurs. The down counter is decremented every SOF pulse (1 ms). If the counter decrements to zero, then it sets bit 1 (TXFT) = 1 and halts the DMA transfer. The counter starts counting only when bit 7 (TEN) = 1 and bit 7 (EN) = 1 in the DMACDR3 register and the first byte has been received. 00000 = 0-ms time-out : : 11111 = 31-ms time-out 7 TEN 0 Transaction time-out counter enable/disable bit TEN = 0 TEN = 1 Counter is disabled (does not time-out) Counter is enabled Table 6−2. DMA IN-Termination Condition IN TERMINATION TXFT OVRUN COMMENTS UART error 0 0 UART error condition detected UART partial packet 1 0 This condition occurs when UART receiver has no more data for the host (data starvation). UART overrun 1 1 This condition occurs when X- and Y-input buffers are full and the UART FIFO is full (host is busy). 6.2 Bulk Data I/O Using the EDB The UBM (USB buffer manager) and the DMAC (DMA controller) access the EDB to fetch buffer parameters for IN and OUT transactions (IN and OUT are with respect to host). In this discussion, it is assumed that: • The MCU initialized the EDBs • DMA-continuous mode is being used • Double buffering is being used • The X/Y toggle is controlled by the UBM DMA Controller SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 37 6.2.1 IN Transaction (TUSB3410 to Host) 1. The MCU initializes the IEDB (64-byte packet, and double buffering is used) and the following DMA registers: • DMACSR3: Defines the transaction time-out value. • DMACDR3: Defines the IEDB being used and the DMA mode of operation (continuous mode). Once this register is set with EN = 1, the transfer starts. 2. The DMA transfers data from the UART to the X buffer. When a block of 64 bytes is transferred, the DMA updates the byte count and sets NAK to 0 in the input endpoint byte count register (indicating to the UBM that the X buffer is ready to be transferred to host). The UBM starts X-buffer transfer to host using the byte-count value in the input endpoint byte count register and toggles the X/Y bit. The DMA continues transferring data from a device to Y-buffer. At the end of the block transfer, the DMA updates the byte count and sets NAK to 0 in the input endpoint byte count register (indicating to the UBM that the Y-buffer is ready to be transferred to host). The DMA continues the transfer from the device to host, alternating between X-and Y-buffers without MCU intervention. 3. Transfer termination: As mentioned, the DMA/UBM continues the data transfer, alternating between the X- and Y-buffers. Termination of the transfer can happen under the following conditions: • Stop Transfer: The host notifies the MCU (via control-end-point) to stop the transfer. Under this condition, the MCU sets bit 7 (EN) to 0 in the DMACDR register. • Partial Packet: The device receiver has no data to be transferred to host. Under this condition, the byte-count value is less than 64 when the transaction timer time-out occurs. When the DMA detects this condition, it sets bit 1 (TXFT) to 1 and bit 0 (OVRUN) to 0 in the DMACSR3 register, updates the byte count and NAK bit in the the input endpoint byte count register, and interrupts the MCU. The UBM transfers the partial packet to host. • Buffer Overrun: The host is busy, X- and Y-buffers are full (X-NAK = 0 and Y-NAK = 0), and the DMA cannot write to these buffers. The transaction time-out stops the DMA transfer, the DMA sets bit 1 (TXFT) to 1 and bit 0 (OVRUN) to 1 in the DMACSR3 register, and interrupts the MCU. • UART Error Condition: When receiving from a UART, a receiver-error condition stops the DMA and sets bit 1 (TXFT) to 1 and bit 0 (OVRUN) to 0 in the DMACSR3 register, but the EN bit remains set at 1. Therefore, the DMA does not interrupt the MCU. However, the UART generates a status interrupt, notifying the MCU that an error condition has occurred. DMA Controller 38 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 6.2.2 OUT Transaction (Host to TUSB3410) 1. The MCU initializes the OEDB (64-byte packet, and double buffering is used) and the following DMA registers: • DMACSR1: Provides an indication of a partial packet. • DMACDR1: Defines the output endpoint being used, and the DMA mode of operation (continuous mode). Once the EN bit is set to 1 in this register, the transfer starts. 2. The UBM transfers data from host to X-buffer. When a block of 64 bytes is transferred, the UBM updates the byte count and sets NAK to 1 in the output endpoint byte count register (indicating to DMA that the X-buffer is ready to be transferred to the UART). The DMA starts X-buffer transfer using the byte-count value in the output endpoint byte count register. The UBM continues transferring data from host to Y-buffer. At the end of the block transfer, the UBM updates the byte count and sets NAK to 1 in the output endpoint byte count register (indicating to DMA that the Y-buffer is ready to be transferred to device). The DMA continues the transfer from the X-/Y-buffers to the device, alternating between X- and Y-buffers without MCU intervention. 3. Transfer termination: The DMA/UBM continues the data transfer alternating between X- and Y-buffers. The termination of the transfer can happen under the following conditions: • Stop Transfer: The host notifies the MCU (via control-end point) to stop the transfer. Under this condition, the MCU sets EN to 0 in the DMACDR1 register. • Partial-Packet: UBM receives a partial packet from host. Under this condition, the byte-count value is less than 64. When the DMA detects this condition, it transfers the partial packet to the device, sets PPKT to 1, updates NAK to 0 in the output endpoint byte count register, and interrupts the MCU. UART SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 39 7 UART 7.1 UART Registers Table 7−1 summarizes the UART registers. These registers are used for data I/O, control, and status information. UART setup is done by the MCU. Data transfer is typically performed by the DMAC. However, the MCU can perform data transfer without a DMA; this is useful when debugging the firmware. Table 7−1. UART Registers Summary REGISTER ADDRESS REGISTER NAME ACCESS FUNCTION COMMENTS FFA0h RDR R/O UART receiver data register Can be accessed by MCU or DMA FFA1h TDR W/O UART transmitter data register Can be accessed by MCU or DMA FFA2h LCR R/W UART line control register FFA3h FCRL R/W UART flow control register FFA4h MCR R/W UART modem control register FFA5h LSR R/O UART line status register Can generate an interrupt FFA6h MSR R/O UART modem status register Can generate an interrupt FFA7h DLL R/W UART divisor register (low byte) FFA8h DLH R/W UART divisor register (high byte) FFA9h XON R/W UART Xon register FFAAh XOFF R/W UART Xoff register FFABh MASK R/W UART interrupt mask register Can control three interrupt sources 7.1.1 RDR: Receiver Data Register (Addr:FFA0h) The receiver data register consists of a 32-byte FIFO. Data received via the SIN terminal is converted from serial-to-parallel format and stored in this FIFO. Data transfer from this register to the RAM buffer is the responsibility of the DMA controller. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] 0 Receiver byte 7.1.2 TDR: Transmitter Data Register (Addr:FFA1h) The transmitter data register is double buffered. Data written to this register is loaded into the shift register, and shifted out on SOUT. Data transfer from the RAM buffer to this register is the responsibility of the DMA controller. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] 0 Transmit byte UART 40 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 7.1.3 LCR: Line Control Register (Addr:FFA2h) This register controls the data communication format. The word length, number of stop bits, and parity type are selected by writing the appropriate bits to the LCR. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FEN BRK FPTY EPRTY PRTY STP WL1 WL0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 1:0 WL[1:0] 0 Specifies the word length for transmit and receive 00b = 5 bits 01b = 6 bits 10b = 7 bits 11b = 8 bits 2 STP 0 Specifies the number of stop bits for transmit and receive STP = 0 STP = 1 STP = 1 1 stop bit (word length = 5, 6, 7, 8) 1.5 stop bits (word length = 5) 2 stop bits (word length = 6, 7, 8) 3 PRTY 0 Specifies whether parity is used PRTY = 0 PRTY = 1 No parity Parity is generated 4 EPRTY 0 Specifies whether even or odd parity is generated EPRTY = 0 EPRTY = 1 Odd parity is generated (if bit 3 (PRTY) = 1) Even parity is generated (if PRTY = 1) 5 FPTY 0 Selects the forced parity bit FPTY = 0 FPTY = 1 Parity is not forced Parity bit is forced. If bit 4 (EPRTY) = 0, the parity bit is forced to 1 6 BRK 0 This bit is the break-control bit BRK = 0 BRK = 1 Normal operation Forces SOUT into break condition (logic 0) 7 FEN 0 FIFO enable. This bit disables/enables the FIFO. To reset the FIFO, the MCU clears and then sets this bit. FEN = 0 FEN = 1 The FIFO is cleared and disabled. When disabled, the selected receiver flow control is activated. The FIFO is enabled and it can receive data. UART SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 41 7.1.4 FCRL: UART Flow Control Register (Addr:FFA3h) This register provides the flow-control modes of operation (see Table 7−3 for more details). 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 485E DTR RTS RXOF DSR CTS TXOA TXOF R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 TXOF 0 This bit controls the transmitter Xon/Xoff flow control. TXOF = 0 TXOF = 1 Disable transmitter Xon/Xoff flow control Enable transmitter Xon/Xoff flow control 1 TXOA 0 This bit controls the transmitter Xon-on-any/Xoff flow control TXOA = 0 TXOA = 1 Disable the transmitter Xon-on-any/Xoff flow control Enable the transmitter Xon-on-any/Xoff flow control 2 CTS 0 Transmitter CTS flow-control enable bit CTS = 0 CTS = 1 Disables transmitter CTS flow control CTS flow control is enabled, that is, when CTS input terminal is high, transmission is halted; when the CTS terminal is low, transmission resumes. When loopback mode is enabled, this bit must be set if flow control is also required. 3 DSR 0 Transmitter DSR flow-control enable bit DSR = 0 DSR = 1 Disables transmitter DSR flow control DSR flow control is enabled, that is, when DSR input terminal is high, transmission is halted; when the DSR terminal is low, transmission resumes. When loopback mode is enabled, this bit must be set if flow control is also required. 4 RXOF 0 This bit controls the receiver Xon/Xoff flow control. RXOF = 0 RXOF = 1 Receiver does not attempt to match Xon/Xoff characters Receiver searches for Xon/Xoff characters 5 RTS 0 Receiver RTS flow control enable bit RTS = 0 RTS = 1 Disables receiver RTS flow control Receiver RTS flow control is enabled. RTS output terminal goes high when the receiver FIFO HALT trigger level is reached; it goes low, when the receiver FIFO RESUME receiving trigger level is reached. 6 DTR 0 Receiver DTR flow-control enable bit DTR = 0 DTR = 1 Disables receiver DTR flow control Receiver DTR flow control is enabled. DTR output terminal goes high when the receiver FIFO HALT trigger level is reached; it goes low, when the receiver FIFO RESUME receiving trigger level is reached. 7 485E 0 RS-485 enable bit. This bit configures the UART to control external RS-485 transceivers. When configured in half-duplex mode (485E = 1), RTS or DTR can be used to enable the RS-485 driver or receiver. See Figure 3−3. 485E = 0 485E = 1 UART is in normal operation mode (full duplex) The UART is in half duplex RS-485 mode. In this mode, RTS and DTR are active with opposite polarity (when RTS = 0, DTR = 1). When the DMA is ready to transmit, it drives RTS = 1 (and DTR = 0) 2-bit times before the transmission starts. When the DMA terminates the transmission, it drives RTS = 0 (and DTR = 1) after the transmission stops. When 485E is set to 1, bit 4 (DTR) and bit 5 (RTS) in the MCR register (see Section 7.1.6) have no effect. Also, see bit 1 (RCVE) in the MCR register. UART 42 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 7.1.5 Transmitter Flow Control On reset (power up, USB, or soft reset) the transmitter defaults to the Xon state and the flow control is set to mode-0 (flow control is disabled). Table 7−2. Transmitter Flow-Control Modes BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 BIT 0 DSR CTS TXOA TXOF All flow control is disabled 0 0 0 0 Xon/Xoff flow control is enabled 0 0 0 1 Xon on any/ Xoff flow control 0 0 1 0 Not permissible (see Note 9) X X 1 1 CTS flow control 0 1 0 0 Combination flow control (see Note 10) 0 1 0 1 Combination flow control 0 1 1 0 DSR flow control 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 Combination flow control 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 NOTES: 9. This is a nonpermissible combination. If used, TXOA and TXOF are cleared. 10. Combination example: Transmitter stops when either CTS or Xoff is detected. Transmitter resumes when both CTS is negated and Xon is detected. Table 7−3. Receiver Flow-Control Possibilities MODE BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 DTR RTS RXOF 0 All flow control is disabled 0 0 0 1 Xon/Xoff flow control is enabled 0 0 1 2 RTS flow control 0 1 0 3 Combination flow control (see Note 11) 0 1 1 4 DTR flow control 1 0 0 5 Combination flow control 1 0 1 6 Combination flow control (see Note 12) 1 1 0 7 Combination flow control 1 1 1 NOTES: 11. Combination example: Both RTS is asserted and Xoff transmitted when the FIFO is full. Both RTS is deasserted and Xon is transmitted when the FIFO is empty. 12. Combination example: Both DTR and RTS are asserted when the FIFO is full. Both DTR and RTS are deasserted when the FIFO is empty. UART SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 43 7.1.6 MCR: Modem-Control Register (Addr:FFA4h) This register provides control for modem interface I/O and definition of the flow control mode. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LCD LRI RTS DTR RSV LOOP RCVE URST R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 URST 0 UART soft reset. This bit can be used by the MCU to reset the UART. URST = 0 Normal operation. Writing a 0 by MCU has no effect. URST = 1 When the MCU writes a 1 to this bit, a UART reset is generated (ORed with hard reset). When the UART exits the reset state, URST is cleared. The MCU can monitor this bit to determine if the UART completed the reset cycle. 1 RCVE 0 Receiver enable bit. This bit is valid only when bit 7 (485E) in the FCRL register (see Section 7.1.4) is 1 (RS-485 mode). When 485E = 0, this bit has no effect on the receiver. RCVE = 0 When 485E = 1, the UART receiver is disabled when RTS = 1, i.e., when data is being transmitted, the UART receiver is disabled. RCVE = 1 When 485E = 1, the UART receiver is enabled regardless of the RTS state, i.e., UART receiver is enabled all the time. This mode can detect collisions on the RS-485 bus when received data does not match transmitted data. 2 LOOP 0 This bit controls the normal-/loop-back mode of operation (see Figure 7−1). LOOP = 0 Normal operation LOOP = 1 Enable loop-back mode of operation. In this mode the following occur:  SOUT is set high  SIN is disconnected from the receiver input.  The transmitter serial output is looped back into the receiver serial input.  The four modem-control inputs: CTS, DSR, DCD, and RI/CP are disconnected.  DTR, RTS, LRI and LCD are internally connected to the four modem-control inputs, and read in the MSR register (see Section 7.1.8) as described below. Note: the FCRL register (see Section 7.1.4) must be configured to enable bits 2 (CTS) and 3 (DSR) to maintain proper operation with flow control and loop back.  DTR is reflected in MSR register bit 4 (LCTS)  RTS is reflected in MSR register bit 5 (LDSR)  LRI is reflected in MSR register bit 6 (LRI)  LCD is reflected in MSR register bit 7 (LCD) 3 RSV 0 Reserved 4 DTR 0 This bit controls the state of the DTR output terminal (see Figure 7−1). This bit has no effect when auto-flow control is used or when bit 7 (485E) = 1 (in the FCRL register, see Section 7.1.4). DTR = 0 Forces the DTR output terminal to inactive (high) DTR = 1 Forces the DTR output terminal to active (low) 5 RTS 0 This bit controls the state of the RTS output terminal (see Figure 7−1). This bit has no effect when auto-flow control is used or when bit 7 (485E) = 1 (in the FCRL register, see Section 7.1.4). RTS = 0 Forces the RTS output terminal to inactive (high) RTS = 1 Forces the RTS output terminal to active (low) 6 LRI 0 This bit is used for loop-back mode only. When in loop-back mode, this bit is reflected in bit 6 (LRI) in the MSR register, see Section 7.1.8 (see Figure 7−1). LRI = 0 Clears the MSR register bit 6 to 0 LRI = 1 Sets the MSR register bit 6 to 1 7 LCD 0 This bit is used for loop-back mode only. When in loop-back mode, this bit is reflected in bit 7 (LCD) in the MSR register, see Section 7.1.8 (see Figure 7−1). LCD = 0 Clears the MSR register bit 7 to 0 LCD = 1 Sets the MSR register bit 7 to 1 UART 44 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 7.1.7 LSR: Line-Status Register (Addr:FFA5h) This register provides the status of the data transfer. DMA transfer is halted when any of bit 0 (OVR), bit 1 (PTE), bit 2 (FRE), or bit 3 (BRK) is 1. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSV TEMT TxE RxF BRK FRE PTE OVR R/O R/O R/O R/O R/C R/C R/C R/C BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 OVR 0 This bit indicates the overrun condition of the receiver. If set, it halts the DMA transfer and generates a status interrupt (if enabled). OVR = 0 OVR = 1 No overrun error Overrun error has occurred. Clears when the MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 1 PTE 0 This bit indicates the parity condition of the received byte. If set, it halts the DMA transfer and generates a status interrupt (if enabled). PTE = 0 PTE = 1 No parity error in data received Parity error in data received. Clears when the MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 2 FRE 0 This bit indicates the framing condition of the received byte. If set, it halts the DMA transfer and generates a status interrupt (if enabled). FRE = 0 FRE = 1 No framing error in data received Framing error in data received. Clears when MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 3 BRK 0 This bit indicates the break condition of the received byte. If set, it halts the DMA transfer and generates a status interrupt (if enabled). BRK = 0 BRK = 1 No break condition A break condition in data received was detected. Clears when the MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 4 RxF 0 This bit indicates the condition of the receiver data register. Typically, the MCU does not monitor this bit since data transfer is done by the DMA controller. RxF = 0 RxF = 1 No data in the RDR RDR contains data. Generates Rx interrupt (if enabled). 5 TxE 1 This bit indicates the condition of the transmitter data register. Typically, the MCU does not monitor this bit since data transfer is done by the DMA controller. TxE = 0 TxE = 1 TDR is not empty TDR is empty. Generates Tx interrupt (if enabled). 6 TEMT 1 This bit indicates the condition of both transmitter data register and shift register is empty. TEMT = 0 TEMT = 1 Either TDR or TSR is not empty Both TDR and TSR are empty 7 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 UART SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 45 CTS Modem Status Register Modem Control Register Bit 4 LCTS Bit 5 LDSR Bit 6 LRI Bit 7 LCD Bit 5 RTS Bit 4 DTR Bit 6 LRI Bit 7 LCD Bit 2 LOOP DSR RI/CP DCD RTS DTR FCRL Register Setting FCRL Register Setting Device Terminals Figure 7−1. MSR and MCR Registers in Loop-Back Mode UART 46 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 7.1.8 MSR: Modem-Status Register (Addr:FFA6h) This register provides information about the current state of the control lines from the modem. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 LCD LRI LDSR LCTS ΔCD TRI ΔDSR ΔCTS R/O R/O R/O R/O R/C R/C R/C R/C BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 ΔCTS 0 This bit indicates that the CTS input has changed state. Cleared when the MCU writes a 1 to this bit. Writing a 0 has no effect. 1 ΔDSR 0 This bit indicates that the DSR input has changed state. Cleared when the MCU writes a 1 to this bit. Writing a 0 has no effect. ΔDSR = 0 ΔDSR = 1 Indicates no change in the DSR input Indicates that the DSR input has changed state since the last time it was read. Clears when the MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 2 TRI 0 Trailing edge of the ring indicator. This bit indicates that the RI/CP input has changed from low to high. This bit is cleared when the MCU writes a 1 to this bit. Writing a 0 has no effect. TRI = 0 TRI = 1 Indicates no applicable transition on the RI/CP input Indicates that an applicable transition has occurred on the RI/CP input. 3 ΔCD 0 This bit indicates that the CD input has changed state. Cleared when the MCU writes a 1 to this bit. Writing a 0 has no effect. ΔCD = 0 ΔCD = 1 Indicates no change in the CD input Indicates that the CD input has changed state since the last time it was read. 4 LCTS 0 During loopback, this bit reflects the status of bit 4 (DTR) in the MCR register, see Section 7.1.6 (see Figure 7−1) LCTS = 0 LCTS = 1 CTS input is high CTS input is low 5 LDSR 0 During loop back, this bit reflects the status of bit 5 (RTS) in the MCR register, see Section 7.1.6 (see Figure 7−1) LDSR = 0 LDSR= 1 DSR input is high DSR input is low 6 LRI 0 During loop back, this bit reflects the status of bit 6 (LRI) in the MCR register, see Section 7.1.6 (see Figure 7−1) LRI = 0 LRI = 1 RI/CP input is high RI/CP input is low 7 LCD 0 During loopback, this bit reflects the status of bit 7 (LCD) in the MCR register, see Section 7.1.6 (see Figure 7−1) LCD = 0 LCD = 0 CD input is high CD input is low 7.1.9 DLL: Divisor Register Low Byte (Addr:FFA7h) This register contains the low byte of the baud-rate divisor. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] 08h Low-byte value of the 16-bit divisor for generation of the baud clock in the baud-rate generator. UART SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 47 7.1.10 DLH: Divisor Register High Byte (Addr:FFA8h) This register contains the high byte of the baud-rate divisor. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[15:8] 00h High-byte value of the 16-bit divisor for generation of the baud clock in the baud-rate generator. 7.1.11 Baud-Rate Calculation The following formulas calculate the baud-rate clock and the divisors. The baud-rate clock is derived from the 96-MHz master clock (dividing by 6.5). The table below presents the divisors used to achieve the desired baud rates, together with the associate rounding errors. Baud CLK  96 MHz 6.5  14.76923077 MHz Divisor  14.76923077106 Desired Baud Rate 16 Table 7−4. DLL/DLH Values and Resulted Baud Rates DESIRED BAUD DLL/DLH VALUE ACTUAL BAUD ERROR % RATE DECIMAL HEXADECIMAL RATE 1 200 769 0301 1 200.36 0.03 2 400 385 0181 2 397.60 0.01 4 800 192 00C0 4 807.69 0.16 7 200 128 0080 7 211.54 0.16 9 600 96 0060 9 615.38 0.16 14 400 64 0040 14 423.08 0.16 19 200 48 0030 19 230.77 0.16 38 400 24 0018 38 461.54 0.16 57 600 16 0010 57 692.31 0.16 115 200 8 0008 115 384.62 0.16 230 400 4 0004 230 769.23 0.16 460 800 2 0002 461 538.46 0.16 921 600 1 0001 923 076.92 0.16 NOTE: The TUSB3410 does support baud rates lower than 1200 bps, which are not listed due to less interest. 7.1.12 XON: Xon Register (Addr:FFA9h) This register contains a value that is compared to the received data stream. Detection of a match interrupts the MCU (only if the interrupt enable bit is set). This value is also used for Xon transmission. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] 0000 Xon value to be compared to the incoming data stream UART 48 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 7.1.13 XOFF: Xoff Register (Addr:FFAAh) This register contains a value that is compared to the received data stream. Detection of a match halts the DMA transfer, and interrupts the MCU (only if the interrupt enable bit is set). This value is also used for Xoff transmission. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] 0000 Xoff value to be compared to the incoming data stream 7.1.14 MASK: UART Interrupt-Mask Register (Addr:FFABh) This register controls the UARTs interrupt sources. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSV RSV RSV RSV RSV TRI SIE MIE R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 MIE 0 This bit controls the UART-modem interrupt. MIE = 0 MIE = 1 Modem interrupt is disabled Modem interrupt is enabled 1 SIE 0 This bit controls the UART-status interrupt. SIE = 0 SIE = 1 Status interrupt is disabled Status interrupt is enabled 2 TRI 0 This bit controls the UART-TxE/RxF interrupts TRI = 0 TRI = 1 TxE/RxF interrupts are disabled TxE/RxF interrupts are enabled 7−3 RSV 0 Reserved = 0 7.2 UART Data Transfer Figure 7−2 illustrates the data transfer between the UART and the host using the DMA controller and the USB buffer manager (UBM). A buffer of 512 bytes is reserved for buffering the UART channel (transmit and receive buffers). The UART channel has 64 bytes of double-buffer space (X- and Y-buffer). When the DMA writes to the X-buffer, the UBM reads from the Y-buffer. Similarly, when the DMA reads from the X-buffer, the UBM writes to the Y-buffer. The DMA channel is configured to operate in the continuous mode (by setting bit 5 (CNT) in the DMACDR registers = 1). Once the MCU enables the DMA, data transfer toggles between the UMB and the DMA without MCU intervention. See Section 6.2.1, IN Transaction (TUSB3410 to Host), for DMA transfer-termination condition. 7.2.1 Receiver Data Flow The UART receiver has a 32-byte FIFO. The receiver FIFO has two trigger levels. One is the high-level mark (HALT), which is set to 12 bytes, and the other is the low-level mark (RESUME), which is set to 4 bytes. When the HALT mark is reached, either the RTS terminal goes high or Xoff is transmitted (depending on the auto setting). When the FIFO reaches the RESUME mark, then either the RTS terminal goes low or Xon is transmitted. UART SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 49 64-Byte Y-Buffer 64-Byte X-Buffer DMA DMACDR3 USB Buffer Manager X/Y 4 8 Receiver Halt on Error or Time-Out RDR: 32-Byte FIFO RTS/DTR = 1 or Xoff Transmitted RTS/DTR = 0 or Xon Transmitted Xoff/Xon CTS/DTR = 1/0 64-Byte Y-Buffer 64-Byte X-Buffer DMA DMACDR1 SIN SOUT TDR Pause/Run Host Figure 7−2. Receiver/Transmitter Data Flow 7.2.2 Hardware Flow Control Figure 7−3 illustrates the connection necessary to achieve hardware flow control. The CTS and RTS signals are provided for this purpose. Auto CTS and auto RTS (and Xon/Xoff) can be enabled/disabled independently by programming the UART flow control register (FCRL). TUSB3410 SIN RTS SOUT CTS External Device SOUT CTS SIN RTS Figure 7−3. Auto Flow Control Interconnect 7.2.3 Auto RTS (Receiver Control) In this mode, the RTS output terminal signals the receiver-FIFO status to an external device. The RTS output signal is controlled by the high- and low-level marks of the FIFO. When the high-level mark is reached, RTS goes high, signaling to an external sending device to halt its transfer. Conversely, when the low-level mark is reached, RTS goes low, signaling to an external sending device to resume its transfer. Data transfer from the FIFO to the X-/Y-buffer is performed by the DMA controller. See Section 6.2.1, IN Transaction (TUSB3410 to Host), for DMA transfer-termination condition. 7.2.4 Auto CTS (Transmitter Control) In this mode, the CTS input terminal controls the transfer from internal buffer (X or Y) to the TDR. When the DMA controller transfers data from the Y-buffer to the TDR and the CTS input terminal goes high, the DMA controller is suspended until CTS goes low. Meanwhile, the UBM is transferring data from the host to the X-buffer. When CTS goes low, the DMA resumes the transfer. Data transfer continues alternating between the X- and Y-buffers, without MCU intervention. See Section 6.2.2, OUT Transaction (Host to TUSB3410), for DMA transfer-termination condition. UART 50 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 7.2.5 Xon/Xoff Receiver Flow Control To enable Xon/Xoff flow control, certain bits within the modem control register must be set as follows: MCR bit 5 = 1 and MCR bits 6 and 7 = 00. In this mode, the Xon/Xoff bytes are transmitted to an external sending device to control the device’s transmission. When the high-level mark (of the FIFO) is reached, the Xoff byte is transmitted, signaling to an external sending device to halt its transfer. Conversely, when the low-level mark is reached, the Xon byte is transmitted, signaling to an external sending device to resume its transfer. The data transfer from the FIFO to X-/Y-buffer is performed by the DMA controller. 7.2.6 Xon/Xoff Transmit Flow Control To enable Xon/Xoff flow control, certain bits within the modem control register must be set as follows: MCR bit 5 = 1 and MCR bits 6 and 7 = 00. In this mode, the incoming data are compared to the XON and XOFF registers. If a match to XOFF is detected, the DMA is paused. If a match to XON is detected, the DMA resumes. Meanwhile, the UBM is transferring data from the host to the X-buffer. The MCU does not switch the buffers unless the Y-buffer is empty and the X-buffer is full. When Xon is detected, the DMA resumes the transfer. Expanded GPIO Port SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 51 8 Expanded GPIO Port 8.1 Input/Output and Control Registers The TUSB3410 has four general-purpose I/O terminals (P3.0, P3.1, P3.3, and P3.4) that are controlled by firmware running on the MCU. Each terminal can be controlled individually and each is implemented with a 12-mA push/pull CMOS output with 3-state control plus input. The MCU treats the outputs as open drain types in that the output can be driven low continuously, but a high output is driven for two clock cycles and then the output is high impedance. An input terminal can be read using the MOV instruction. For example, MOV C,P3.3 reads the input on P3.3. As a precaution, be certain the associated output is high impedance before reading the input. An output can be set high (and then high impedance) using the SETB instruction. For example, SETB P3.1 sets P3.1 high. An output can be set low using the CLR instruction, as in CLR P3.4, which sets P3.4 low (driven continuously until changed). Each GPIO terminal has an associated internal pullup resistor. It is strongly recommended that the pullup resistor remain connected to the terminal to prevent oscillations in the input buffer. The only exception is if an external source always drives the input. 8.1.1 PUR_3: GPIO Pullup Register For Port 3 (Addr:FF9Eh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RSV RSV RSV Pin4 Pin3 RSV Pin1 Pin0 R/O R/O R/O R/W R/W R/O R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 1 3 4 Pin0 Pin1 Pin3 Pin4 0 The MCU may write to this register. If the MCU sets any of these bits to 1, then the pullup resistor is disconnected from the associated terminal. If the MCU clears any of these bits to 0, then the pullup resistor is connected from the terminal. The pullup resistor is connected to the VCC power supply. 2, 5, 6, 7 RSV 0 Reserved Expanded GPIO Port 52 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Interrupts SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 53 9 Interrupts 9.1 8052 Interrupt and Status Registers All 8052 standard, five interrupt sources are preserved. SIE is the standard interrupt-enable register that controls the five interrupt sources. This is also known as IE0 located at S:A8h in the special function register area. All the additional interrupt sources are ORed together to generate EX0. Table 9−1. 8052 Interrupt Location Map INTERRUPT SOURCE DESCRIPTION START ADDRESS COMMENTS ES UART interrupt 0023h ET1 Timer-1 interrupt 001Bh EX1 External interrupt-1 0013h ET0 Timer-0 interrupt 000Bh EX0 External interrupt-0 0003h Used for all internal peripherals Reset 0000h 9.1.1 8052 Standard Interrupt Enable (SIE) Register 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EA RSV RSV ES ET1 EX1 ET0 EX0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 EX0 0 Enable or disable external interrupt-0 EX0 = 0 EX0 = 1 External interrupt-0 is disabled External interrupt-0 is enabled 1 ET0 0 Enable or disable timer-0 interrupt ET0 = 0 ET0 = 1 Timer-0 interrupt is disabled Timer-0 interrupt is enabled 2 EX1 0 Enable or disable external interrupt-1 EX1 = 0 EX1 = 1 External interrupt-1 is disabled External interrupt-1 is enabled 3 ET1 0 Enable or disable timer-1 interrupt ET1 = 0 EX1 = 1 Timer-1 interrupt is disabled Timer-1 interrupt is enabled 4 ES 0 Enable or disable serial port interrupts ES = 0 ES = 1 Serial-port interrupt is disabled Serial-port interrupt is enabled 5, 6 RSV 0 Reserved 7 EA 0 Enable or disable all interrupts (global disable) EA = 0 EA = 1 Disable all interrupts Each interrupt source is individually controlled 9.1.2 Additional Interrupt Sources All nonstandard 8052 interrupts (DMA, I2C, etc.) are ORed to generate an internal INT0. Furthermore, the INT0 must be programmed as an active low-level interrupt (not edge-triggered). After reset, if INT0 is not changed, then it is an edge-triggered interrupt. A vector interrupt register is provided to identify all interrupt sources (see Section 9.1.3, VECINT: Vector Interrupt Register). Up to 64 interrupt vectors are provided. It is the responsibility of the MCU to read the vector and dispatch to the proper interrupt routine. Interrupts 54 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 9.1.3 VECINT: Vector Interrupt Register (Addr:FF92h) This register contains a vector value, which identifies the internal interrupt source that is trapped to location 0003h. Writing (any value) to this register removes the vector and updates the next vector value (if another interrupt is pending). Note: the vector value is offset; therefore, its value is in increments of two (bit 0 is set to 0). When no interrupt is pending, the vector is set to 00h (see Table 9−2). As shown, the interrupt vector is divided to two fields: I[2:0] and G[3:0]. The I field defines the interrupt source within a group (on a first-come-first-served basis). In the G field, which defines the group number, group G0 is the lowest and G15 is the highest priority. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 G3 G2 G1 G0 I2 I1 I0 0 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 3−1 I[2:0] 0H This field defines the interrupt source in a given group. See Table 9−2. Bit 0 = 0 always; therefore, vector values are offset by two. 7−4 G[3:0] 0H This field defines the interrupt group. I[2:0] and G[3:0] combine to produce the actual interrupt vector. Table 9−2. Vector Interrupt Values G[3:0] (Hex) I[2:0] (Hex) VECTOR (Hex) INTERRUPT SOURCE 0 0 00 No interrupt 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 2 3 4−7 10 12 14 16 18−1E Not used Output endpoint-1 Output endpoint-2 Output endpoint-3 Reserved 2 2 2 2 2 0 1 2 3 4−7 20 22 24 26 28−2E Reserved Input endpoint-1 Input endpoint-2 Input endpoint-3 Reserved 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 30 32 34 36 38 3A 3C 3E STPOW packet received SETUP packet received Reserved Reserved RESR interrupt SUSR interrupt RSTR interrupt Wakeup 4 4 4 4 4 0 1 2 3 4−7 40 42 44 46 48 → 4E I2C TXE interrupt I2C RXF interrupt Input endpoint-0 Output endpoint-0 Reserved 5 5 5 0 1 2−7 50 52 54 → 5E UART status interrupt UART modem interrupt Reserved 6 6 6 0 1 2−7 60 62 64 → 6E UART RXF interrupt UART TXE interrupt Reserved 7 0−7 70 → 7E Reserved 8 8 8 0 2 3−7 80 84 86−8E DMA1 interrupt DMA3 interrupt Reserved 9−15 X 90 → FE Not used Interrupts SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 55 9.1.4 Logical Interrupt Connection Diagram (Internal/External) Figure 9−1 shows the logical connection of the interrupt sources and its relationship to INT0. The priority encoder generates an 8-bit vector, corresponding to 64 interrupt sources (not all are used). The interrupt priorities are hardwired. Vector 0x88 is the highest and 0x12 is the lowest. Priority Encoder Interrupts IEO (INT0) IEO Vector Figure 9−1. Internal Vector Interrupt Interrupts 56 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 I2C Port SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 57 10 I2C Port 10.1 I2C Registers 10.1.1 I2CSTA: I2C Status and Control Register (Addr:FFF0h) This register controls the stop condition for read and write operations. In addition, it provides transmitter and receiver handshake signals with their respective interrupt enable bits. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RXF RIE ERR 1/4 TXE TIE SRD SWR R/O R/W R/C R/W R/O R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 SWR 0 Stop write condition. This bit determines if the I2C controller generates a stop condition when data from the I2CDAO register is transmitted to an external device. SWR = 0 Stop condition is not generated when data from the I2CDAO register is shifted out to an external device. SWR = 1 Stop condition is generated when data from the I2CDAO register is shifted out to an external device. 1 SRD 0 Stop read condition. This bit determines if the I2C controller generates a stop condition when data is received and loaded into the I2CDAI register. SRD = 0 Stop condition is not generated when data from the SDA line is shifted into the I2CDAI register. SRD = 1 Stop condition is generated when data from the SDA line are shifted into the I2CDAI register. 2 TIE 0 I2C transmitter empty interrupt enable TIE = 0 TIE = 1 Interrupt disable Interrupt enable 3 TXE 1 I2C transmitter empty. This bit indicates that data can be written to the transmitter. It can be used for polling or it can generate an interrupt. TXE = 0 Transmitter is full. This bit is cleared when the MCU writes a byte to the I2CDAO register. TXE = 1 Transmitter is empty. The I2C controller sets this bit when the contents of the I2CDAO register are copied to the SDA shift register. 4 1/4 0 Bus speed selection (see Note 13) 1/4 = 0 1/4 = 1 100-kHz bus speed 400-kHz bus speed 5 ERR 0 Bus error condition. This bit is set by the hardware when the device does not respond. It is cleared by the MCU. ERR = 0 No bus error ERR = 1 Bus error condition has been detected. Clears when the MCU writes a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 6 RIE 0 I2C receiver ready interrupt enable RIE = 0 RIE = 1 Interrupt disable Interrupt enable 7 RXF 0 I2C receiver full. This bit indicates that the receiver contains new data. It can be used for polling or it can generate an interrupt. RXF = 0 Receiver is empty. This bit is cleared when the MCU reads the I2CDAI register. RXF = 1 Receiver contains new data. This bit is set by the I2C controller when the received serial data has been loaded into the I2CDAI register. NOTE 13: The bootcode automatically sets the I2C bus speed to 400 kHz. Only 400-kHz I2C EEPROMs can be used. I2C Port 58 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 10.1.2 I2CADR: I2C Address Register (Addr:FFF3h) This register holds the device address and the read/write command bit. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 0 R/W 0 Read/write command bit R/W = 0 R/W = 1 Write operation Read operation 7−1 A[6:0] 0h Seven address bits for device addressing 10.1.3 I2CDAI: I2C Data-Input Register (Addr:FFF2h) This register holds the received data from an external device. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O R/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] 0 8-bit input data from an I2C device 10.1.4 I2CDAO: I2C Data-Output Register (Addr:FFF1h) This register holds the data to be transmitted to an external device. Writing to this register starts the transfer on the SDA line. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O W/O BIT NAME RESET FUNCTION 7−0 D[7:0] 0 8-bit output data to an I2C device 10.2 Random-Read Operation A random read requires a dummy byte-write sequence to load in the data word address. Once the device-address word and the data-word address are clocked out and acknowledged by the device, the MCU starts a current-address sequence. The following describes the sequence of events to accomplish this transaction. Device Address + EPROM [High Byte] • The MCU clears bit 1 (SRD) within the I2CSTA register. This forces the I2C controller not to generate a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAI register are received. • The MCU clears bit 0 (SWR) within the I2CSTA register. This forces the I2C controller not to generate a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted. • The MCU writes the device address (bit 0 (R/W) = 0) to the I2CADR register (write operation) • The MCU writes the high byte of the EEPROM address into the I2CDAO register (this starts the transfer on the SDA line). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is automatically cleared (indicates busy) by writing data to the I2CDAO register. • The contents of the I2CADR register are transmitted to EEPROM (preceded by start condition on SDA). I2C Port SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 59 • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to EEPROM (EPROM address). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register has been transmitted. • A stop condition is not generated. EPROM [Low Byte] • The MCU writes the low byte of the EEPROM address into the I2CDAO register. • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is automatically cleared (indicates busy) by writing to the I2CDAO register. • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to the device (EEPROM address). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register has been transmitted. • This completes the dummy write operation. At this point, the EEPROM address is set and the MCU can do either a single- or a sequential-read operation. 10.3 Current-Address Read Operation Once the EEPROM address is set, the MCU can read a single byte by executing the following steps: • The MCU sets bit 1 (SRD) in the I2CSTA register to 1. This forces the I2C controller to generate a stop condition after the I2CDAI-register contents are received. • The MCU writes the device address (bit 0 (R/W) = 1) to the I2CADR register (read operation). • The MCU writes a dummy byte to the I2CDAO register (this starts the transfer on SDA line). • Bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (RX is empty). • The contents of the I2CADR register are transmitted to the device (preceded by start condition on SDA). • The data from EEPROM are latched into the I2CDAI register (stop condition is transmitted). • Bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the data are available. • The MCU reads the I2CDAI register. This clears bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register. 10.4 Sequential-Read Operation Once the EEPROM address is set, the MCU can execute a sequential read operation by executing the following (this example illustrates a 32-byte sequential read): Device Address • The MCU clears bit 1 (SRD) in the I2CSTA register. This forces the I2C controller to not generate a stop condition after the I2CDAI register contents are received. • The MCU writes the device address (bit 0 (R/W) = 1) to the I2CADR register (read operation). • The MCU writes a dummy byte to the I2CDAO register (this starts the transfer on the SDA line). • Bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (RX is empty). • The contents of the I2CADR register are transmitted to the device (preceded by start condition on SDA). I2C Port 60 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 N-Byte Read (31 Bytes) • The data from the device is latched into the I2CDAI register (stop condition is not transmitted). • Bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that data is available. • The MCU reads the I2CDAI register. This clears bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register. • This operation repeats 31 times. Last-Byte Read (Byte 32) • MCU sets bit 1 (SRD) in the I2STA register to 1. This forces the I2C controller to generate a stop condition after the I2CDAI register contents are received. • The data from the device is latched into the I2CDAI register (stop condition is transmitted). • Bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that data is available. • The MCU reads the I2CDAI register. This clears bit 7 (RXF) in the I2CSTA register. 10.5 Byte-Write Operation The byte-write operation involves three phases: device address + EPROM [high byte] phase, EPROM [low byte] phase, and EPROM [DATA] phase. The following describes the sequence of events to accomplish the byte-write transaction. Device Address + EPROM [High Byte] • The MCU sets clears the SWR bit in the I2CSTA register. This forces the I2C controller to not generate a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted. • The MCU writes the device address (bit 0 (R/W) = 0) to the I2CADR register (write operation). • The MCU writes the high byte of the EEPROM address into the I2CDAO register (this starts the transfer on the SDA line). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (indicates busy). • The contents of the I2CADR register are transmitted to the device (preceded by start condition on SDA). • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to the device (EEPROM high address). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register contents have been transmitted. EPROM [Low Byte] • The MCU writes the low byte of the EEPROM address into the I2CDAO register. • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (indicating busy). • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to the device (EEPROM address). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register contents have been transmitted. EPROM [DATA] • The MCU sets bit 0 (SWR) in the I2CSTA register. This forces the I2C controller to generate a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted. • The data to be written to the EPROM is written by the MCU into the I2CDAO register. • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (indicates busy). • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to the device (EEPROM data). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register contents have been transmitted. • The I2C controller generates a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted. I2C Port SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 61 10.6 Page-Write Operation The page-write operation is initiated in the same way as byte write, with the exception that a stop condition is not generated after the first EPROM [DATA] is transmitted. The following describes the sequence of writing 32 bytes in page mode. Device Address + EPROM [High Byte] • The MCU clears bit 0 (SWR) in the I2CSTA register. This forces the I2C controller to not generate a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted. • The MCU writes the device address (bit 0 (R/W) = 0) to the I2CADR register (write operation). • The MCU writes the high byte of the EEPROM address into the I2CDAO register • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (indicating busy). • The contents of the I2CADR register are transmitted to the device (preceded by start condition on SDA). • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to the device (EEPROM address). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register contents have been transmitted. EPROM [Low Byte] • The MCU writes the low byte of the EEPROM address into the I2CDAO register. • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (indicates busy). • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to the device (EEPROM address). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register contents have been transmitted. EPROM [DATA]—31 Bytes • The data to be written to the EEPROM are written by the MCU into the I2CDAO register. • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (indicates busy). • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to the device (EEPROM data). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register contents have been transmitted. • This operation repeats 31 times. EPROM [DATA]—Last Byte • The MCU sets bit 0 (SWR) in the I2CSTA register. This forces the I2C controller to generate a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted. • The MCU writes the last date byte to be written to the EEPROM, into the I2CDAO register. • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is cleared (indicates busy). • The contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted to EEPROM (EEPROM data). • Bit 3 (TXE) in the I2CSTA register is set and interrupts the MCU, indicating that the I2CDAO register contents have been transmitted. • The I2C controller generates a stop condition after the contents of the I2CDAO register are transmitted. I2C Port 62 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 63 11 TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 11.1 Introduction TUSB3410 bootcode is a program embedded in the 10k-byte boot ROM within the TUSB3410. This program is designed to load application firmware from either an external I2C memory device or USB host bootloader device driver. After the TUSB3410 finishes downloading, the bootcode releases its control to the application firmware. This section describes how the bootcode initializes the TUSB3410 device in detail. In addition, the default USB descriptor, I2C device header format, USB host driver firmware downloading format, and supported built-in USB vendor specific requests are listed for reference. Users should carefully follow the appropriate format to interface with the bootcode. Unsupported formats may cause unexpected results. The bootcode source code is also provided for programming reference. 11.2 Bootcode Programming Flow After power-on reset, the bootcode initializes the I2C and USB registers along with internal variables. The bootcode then checks to see if an I2C device is present and contains a valid signature. If an I2C device is present and contains a valid signature, the bootcode continues searching for descriptor blocks and then processes them if the checksum is correct. If application firmware was found, then the bootcode downloads it and releases the control to the application firmware. Otherwise, the bootcode connects to the USB and waits for host driver to download application firmware. Once firmware downloading is complete, the bootcode releases the control to the firmware. The following is the bootcode step-by-step operation. • Check if bootcode is in the application mode. This is the mode that is entered after application code is downloaded via either an I2C device or the USB. If the bootcode is in the application mode, then the bootcode releases the control to the application firmware. Otherwise, the bootcode continues. • Initialize all the default settings. − Call CopyDefaultSettings() routine. Set I2C to 400-kHz speed. − Call UsbDataInitialization() routine. Set bFUNADR = 0 Disconnect from USB (bUSBCTL = 0x00) Bootcode handles USB reset Copy predefined device, configuration, and string descriptors to RAM Disable all endpoints and enable USB interrupts (SETUP, RSTR, SUSR, and RESR) • Search for product signature − Check if valid signature is in I2C. If not, skip the I2C process. Read 2 bytes from address 0x0000 with type III and device address 0. Stop searching if valid signature is found. Read 2 bytes from address 0x0000 with type II and device address 4. Stop searching if valid signature is found. • If a valid I2C signature is found, then load the customized device, configuration and string descriptors from I2C EEPROM. − Process each descriptor block from I2C until end of header is found If the descriptor block contains device, configuration, or string descriptors, then the bootcode overwrites the default descriptors. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 64 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 If the descriptor block contains binary firmware, then the bootcode sets the header pointer to the beginning of the binary firmware in the I2C EEPROM. If the descriptor block is end of header, then the bootcode stops searching. • Enable global and USB interrupts and set the connection bit to 1. − Enable global interrupts by setting bit 7 (EA) within the SIE register (see Section 9.1.1) to 1. − Enable all internal peripheral interrupts by setting the EX0 bit within the SIE register to 1. − Connect to the USB by setting bit 7 (CONT) within the USBCNTL register (see Section 5.4) to 1. • Wait for any interrupt events until Get DEVICE DESCIPTOR setup packet arrives. − Suspend interrupt The idle bit in the MCU PCON register is set and suspend mode is entered. USB reset wakes up the microcontroller. − Resume interrupt Bootcode wakes up and waits for new USB requests. − Reset interrupt Call UsbReset() routine. − Setup interrupt Bootcode processes the request. − USB reboot request Disconnect from the USB by clearing bit 7 (CONT) in the USBCTL register and restart at address 0x0000. • Download firmware from I2C EEPROM − Disable global interrupts by clearing bit 7 (EA) within the SIE register − Load firmware to XDATA space if available. • Download firmware from the USB. − If no firmware is found in an I2C EEPROM, the USB host downloads firmware via output endpoint 1. − In the first data packet to output endpoint 1, the USB host driver adds 3 bytes before the application firmware in binary format. These three bytes are the LSB and MSB indicating the firmware size and followed by the arithmetic checksum of the binary firmware. • Release control to the application firmware. − Update the USB configuration and interface number. − Release control to application firmware. • Application firmware − Either disconnect from the USB or continue responding to USB requests. 11.3 Default Bootcode Settings The bootcode has its own predefined device, configuration, and string descriptors. These default descriptors should be used in evaluation only. They must not be used in the end-user product. 11.3.1 Device Descriptor The device descriptor provides the USB version that the device supports, device class, protocol, vendor and product identifications, strings, and number of possible configurations. The operation system (Windows, MAC, or Linux) reads this descriptor to decide which device driver should be used to communicate with this device. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 65 The bootcode uses 0x0451 (Texas Instruments) as the vendor ID and 0x3410 (TUSB3410) as the product ID. It also supports three different strings and one configuration. Table 11−1 lists the device descriptor. Table 11−1. Device Descriptor OFFSET (decimal) FIELD SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0 bLength 1 0x12 Size of this descriptor in bytes 1 bDescriptorType 1 1 Device descriptor type 2 bcdUSB 2 0x0110 USB spec 1.1 4 bDeviceClass 1 0xFF Device class is vendor−specific 5 bDeviceSubClass 1 0 We have no subclasses. 6 bDeviceProtocol 1 0 We use no protocols. 7 bMaxPacketSize0 1 8 Max. packet size for endpoint zero 8 idVendor 2 0x0451 USB−assigned vendor ID = TI 10 idProduct 2 0x3410 TI part number = TUSB3410 12 bcdDevice 2 0x100 Device release number = 1.0 14 iManufacturer 1 1 Index of string descriptor describing manufacturer 15 iProducct 1 2 Index of string descriptor describing product 16 iSerialNumber 1 3 Index of string descriptor describing device’s serial number 17 bNumConfigurations 1 1 Number of possible configurations: 11.3.2 Configuration Descriptor The configuration descriptor provides the number of interfaces supported by this configuration, power configuration, and current consumption. The bootcode declares only one interface running in bus-powered mode. It consumes up to 100 mA at boot time. Table 11−2 lists the configuration descriptor. Table 11−2. Configuration Descriptor OFFSET (decimal) FIELD SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0 bLength 1 9 Size of this descriptor in bytes. 1 bDescriptor Type 1 2 Configuration descriptor type 2 wTotalLength 2 25 = 9 + 9 + 7 Total length of data returned for this configuration. Includes the combined length of all descriptors (configuration, interface, endpoint, and class- or vendor-specific) returned for this configuration. 4 bNumInterfaces 1 1 Number of interfaces supported by this configuration 5 bConfigurationValue 1 1 Value to use as an argument to the SetConfiguration() request to select this configuration. 6 iConfiguration 1 0 Index of string descriptor describing this configuration. 7 bmAttributes 1 0x80 Configuration characteristics D7: Reserved (set to one) D6: Self-powered D5: Remote wakeup is supported D4−0: Reserved (reset to zero) 8 bMaxPower 1 0x32 This device consumes 100 mA. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 66 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 11.3.3 Interface Descriptor The interface descriptor provides the number of endpoints supported by this interface as well as interface class, subclass, and protocol. The bootcode supports only one endpoint and use its own class. Table 11−3 lists the interface descriptor. Table 11−3. Interface Descriptor OFFSET (decimal) FIELD SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0 bLength 1 9 Size of this descriptor in bytes 1 bDescriptorType 1 4 Interface descriptor type 2 bInterfaceNumber 1 0 Number of interface. Zero-based value identifying the index in the array of concurrent interfaces supported by this configuration. 3 bAlternateSetting 1 0 Value used to select alternate setting for the interface identified in the prior field 4 bNumEndpoints 1 1 Number of endpoints used by this interface (excluding endpoint zero). If this value is zero, this interface only uses the default control pipe. 5 bInterfaceClass 1 0xFF The interface class is vendor specific. 6 bInterfaceSubClass 1 0 7 bInterfaceProtocol 1 0 8 iInterface 1 0 Index of string descriptor describing this interface 11.3.4 Endpoint Descriptor The endpoint descriptor provides the type and size of communication pipe supported by this endpoint. The bootcode supports only one output endpoint with the size of 64 bytes in addition to control endpoint 0 (required by all USB devices). Table 11−4 lists the endpoint descriptor. Table 11−4. Output Endpoint1 Descriptor OFFSET (decimal) FIELD SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0 bLength 1 7 Size of this descriptor in bytes 1 bDescriptorType 1 5 Endpoint descriptor type 2 bEndpointAddress 1 0x01 Bit 3…0: The endpoint number Bit 7: Direction 0 = OUT endpoint 1 = IN endpoint 3 bmAttributes 1 2 Bit 1…0: Transfer type 10 = Bulk 11 = Interrupt 4 wMaxPacketSize 2 64 Maximum packet size this endpoint is capable of sending or receiving when this configuration is selected. 6 bInterval 1 0 Interval for polling endpoint for data transfers. Expressed in milliseconds. 11.3.5 String Descriptor The string descriptor contains data in the unicode format. It is used to show the manufacturers name, product model, and serial number in human readable format. The bootcode supports three strings. The first string is the manufacturers name. The second string is the product name. The third string is the serial number. Table 11−5 lists the string descriptor. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 67 Table 11−5. String Descriptor OFFSET (decimal) FIELD SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0 bLength 1 4 Size of string 0 descriptor in bytes 1 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 String descriptor type 2 wLANGID[0] 2 0x0409 English 4 bLength 1 36 (decimal) Size of string 1 descriptor in bytes 5 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 String descriptor type 6 bString 2 ‘T’,0x00 Unicode, T is the first byte 8 2 ‘e’,0x00 Texas Instruments 10 2 ‘x’,0x00 12 2 ‘a’,0x00 14 2 ‘s’,0x00 16 2 ‘ ’,0x00 18 2 ‘I’,0x00 20 2 ‘n’,0x00 22 2 ‘s’,0x00 24 2 ‘t’,0x00 26 2 ‘r’,0x00 28 2 ‘u’,0x00 30 2 ‘m’,0x00 32 2 ‘e’,0x00 34 2 ‘n’,0x00 36 2 ‘t’,0x00 38 2 ‘s’,0x00 40 bLength 1 42 (decimal) Size of string 2 descriptor in bytes 41 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 STRING descriptor type 42 bString 2 ‘T’,0x00 UNICODE, T is first byte 44 2 ‘U’,0x00 TUSB3410 boot device 46 2 ‘S’,0x00 48 2 ‘B’,0x00 50 2 ‘3’,0x00 52 2 ‘4’,0x00 54 2 ‘1’,0x00 56 2 ‘0’,0x00 58 2 ‘ ‘,0x00 60 2 ‘B‘,0x00 62 2 ‘o’,0x00 64 2 ‘o’,0x00 66 2 ‘t’,0x00 TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 68 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Table 11−5. String Descriptor (Continued) OFFSET FIELD SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 68 2 ‘ ’,0x00 70 2 ‘D’,0x00 72 2 ‘e‘,0x00 74 2 ‘v’,0x00 76 2 ‘I,0x00 78 2 ‘c’,0x00 80 2 ‘e’,0x00 82 bLength 1 34 (decimal) Size of string 3 descriptor in bytes 84 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 STRING descriptor type 86 bString 2 r0,0x00 UNICODE 88 2 r1,0x00 R0 to rF are BCD of SERNUM0 to 90 2 r2,0x00 SERNUM7 registers. 16 digit hex 92 2 r3,0x00 16 digit hex numbers are created from 94 2 r4,0x00 SERNUM0 to SERNUM7 registers 96 2 r5,0x00 98 2 r6,0x00 100 2 r7,0x00 102 2 r8,0x00 104 2 r9,0x00 106 2 rA,0x00 108 2 rB,0x00 110 2 rC,0x00 112 2 rD,0x00 114 2 rE,0x00 116 2 rF,0x00 11.4 External I2C Device Header Format A valid header should contain a product signature and one or more descriptor blocks. The descriptor block contains the descriptor prefix and content. In the descriptor prefix, the data type, size, and checksum are specified to describe the content. The descriptor content contains the necessary information for the bootcode to process. The header processing routine always counts from the first descriptor block until the desired block number is reached. The header reads in the descriptor prefix with a size of 4 bytes. This prefix contains the type of block, size, and checksum. For example, if the bootcode would like to find the position of the third descriptor block, then it reads in the first descriptor prefix, calculates the position on the second descriptor prefix based on the size specified in the prefix. bootcode, then repeats the same calculation to find out the position of the third descriptor block. 11.4.1 Product Signature The product signature must be stored at the first 2 bytes within the I2C storage device. These 2 bytes must match the product number. The order of these 2 bytes must be the LSB first followed by the MSB. For example, the TUSB3410 is 0x3410. Therefore, the first byte must be 0x10 and the second byte must be 0x34. The TUSB3410 bootcode searches the first 2 bytes of the I2C device. If the first 2 bytes are not 0x10 and 0x34, then the bootcode skips the header processing. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 69 11.4.2 Descriptor Block Each descriptor block contains a prefix and content. The size of the prefix is always 4 bytes. It contains the data type, size, and checksum for data integrity. The descriptor content contains the corresponding information specified in the prefix. It could be as small as 1 byte or as large as 65535 bytes. The next descriptor immediately follows the previous descriptor. If there are no more descriptors, then an extra byte with a value of zero should be added to indicate the end of header. 11.4.2.1 Descriptor Prefix The first byte of the descriptor prefix is the data type. This tells the bootcode how to process the data in the descriptor content. The second and third bytes are the size of descriptor content. The second byte is the low byte of the size and the third byte is the high byte. The last byte is the 8-bit arithmetic checksum of descriptor content. 11.4.2.2 Descriptor Content Information stored in the descriptor content can be the USB information, firmware, or other type of data. The size of the content should be from 1 byte to 65535 bytes. 11.5 Checksum in Descriptor Block Each descriptor prefix contains one checksum of the descriptor content. If the checksum is wrong, the bootcode simply ignores the descriptor block. 11.6 Header Examples The header can be specified in different ways. The following descriptors show examples of the header format and the supported descriptor block. 11.6.1 TUSB3410 Bootcode Supported Descriptor Block The TUSB3410 bootcode supports the following descriptor blocks. • USB Device Descriptor • USB Configuration Descriptor • USB String Descriptor • Binary Firmware1 • Autoexec Binary Firmware2 11.6.2 USB Descriptor Header Table 11−6 contains the USB device, configuration, and string descriptors for the bootcode. The last byte is zero to indicate the end of header. 1 Binary firmware is loaded when the bootcode receives the first get device descriptor request from host. Downloading the firmware should either continue that request in the data stage or disconnect from the USB and then reconnect to the USB as a new device. 2 The bootcode loads this autoexec binary firmware before it connects to the USB. The firmware should connect to the USB once it is loaded. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 70 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Table 11−6. USB Descriptors Header OFFSET TYPE SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0 Signature0 1 0x10 FUNCTION_PID_L 1 Signature1 1 0x34 FUNCTION_PID_H 2 Data Type 1 0x03 USB device descriptor 3 Data Size (low byte) 1 0x12 The device descriptor is 18 (decimal) bytes. 4 Data Size (high byte) 1 0x00 5 Check Sum 1 0xCC Checksum of data below 6 bLength 1 0x12 Size of device descriptor in bytes 7 bDescriptorType 1 0x01 Device descriptor type 8 bcdUSB 2 0x0110 USB spec 1.1 10 bDeviceClass 1 0xFF Device class is vendor-specific 11 bDeviceSubClass 1 0x00 We have no subclasses. 12 bDeviceProtocol 1 0x00 We use no protocols 13 bMaxPacketSize0 1 0x08 Maximum packet size for endpoint zero 14 idVendor 2 0x0451 USB−assigned vendor ID = TI 16 idProduct 2 0x3410 TI part number = TUSB3410 18 bcdDevice 2 0x0100 Device release number = 1.0 20 iManufacturer 1 0x01 Index of string descriptor describing manufacturer 21 iProducct 1 0x02 Index of string descriptor describing product 22 iSerialNumber 1 0x03 Index of string descriptor describing device’s serial number 23 bNumConfigurations 1 0x01 Number of possible configurations: 24 Data Type 1 0x04 USB configuration descriptor 25 Data Size (low byte) 1 0x19 25 bytes 26 Data Size (high byte) 1 0x00 27 Check Sum 1 0xC6 Checksum of data below 28 bLength 1 0x09 Size of this descriptor in bytes 29 bDescriptorType 1 0x02 CONFIGURATION descriptor type 30 wTotalLength 2 25(0x19) = 9 + 9 + 7 Total length of data returned for this configuration. Includes the combined length of all descriptors (configuration, interface, endpoint, and class- or vendor-specific) returned for this configuration. 32 bNumInterfaces 1 0x01 Number of interfaces supported by this configuration 33 bConfigurationValue 1 0x01 Value to use as an argument to the SetConfiguration() request to select this configuration 34 iConfiguration 1 0x00 Index of string descriptor describing this configuration. 35 bmAttributes 1 0xE0 Configuration characteristics D7: Reserved (set to one) D6: Self-powered D5: Remote wakeup is supported D4−0: Reserved (reset to zero) 36 bMaxPower 1 0x64 This device consumes 100 mA. 37 bLength 1 0x09 Size of this descriptor in bytes 38 bDescriptorType 1 0x04 INTERFACE descriptor type 39 bInterfaceNumber 1 0x00 Number of interface. Zero-based value identifying the index in the array of concurrent interfaces supported by this configuration. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 71 Table 11−6. USB Descriptors Header (Continued) OFFSET TYPE SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 40 bAlternateSetting 1 0x00 Value used to select alternate setting for the interface identified in the prior field 41 bNumEndpoints 1 0x01 Number of endpoints used by this interface (excluding endpoint zero). If this value is zero, this interface only uses the default control pipe. 42 bInterfaceClass 1 0xFF The interface class is vendor specific. 43 bInterfaceSubClass 1 0x00 44 bInterfaceProtocol 1 0x00 45 iInterface 1 0x00 Index of string descriptor describing this interface 46 bLength 1 0x07 Size of this descriptor in bytes 47 bDescriptorType 1 0x05 ENDPOINT descriptor type 48 bEndpointAddress 1 0x01 Bit 3…0: The endpoint number Bit 7: Direction 0 = OUT endpoint 1 = IN endpoint 49 bmAttributes 1 0x02 Bit 1…0: Transfer Type 10 = Bulk 11 = Interrupt 50 wMaxPacketSize 2 0x0040 Maximum packet size this endpoint is capable of sending or receiving when this configuration is selected. 52 bInterval 1 0x00 Interval for polling endpoint for data transfers. Expressed in milliseconds. 53 Data Type 1 0x05 USB String descriptor 54 Data Size (low byte) 1 0x1A 26(0x1A) = 4 + 6 + 6 + 10 55 Data Size (high byte) 1 0x00 56 Check Sum 1 0x50 Checksum of data below 57 bLength 1 0x04 Size of string 0 descriptor in bytes 58 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 STRING descriptor type 59 wLANGID[0] 2 0x0409 English 61 bLength 1 0x06 Size of string 1 descriptor in bytes 62 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 STRING descriptor type 63 bString 2 ‘T’,0x00 UNICODE, ‘T’ is the first byte. 65 2 ‘I’,0x00 TI = 0x54, 0x49 67 bLength 1 0x06 Size of string 2 descriptor in bytes 68 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 STRING descriptor type 69 bString 2 ‘u’,0x00 UNICODE, ‘u’ is the first byte. 71 2 ‘C’,0x00 ‘uC’ = 0x75, 0x43 73 bLength 1 0x0A Size of string 3 descriptor in bytes 74 bDescriptorType 1 0x03 STRING descriptor type 75 bString 2 ‘3’,0x00 UNICODE, ‘T’ is the first byte. 77 2 ‘4’,0x00 ‘3410’ = 0x33, 0x34, 0x31, 0x30 79 2 ‘1’,0x00 81 2 ‘0’,0x00 83 Data Type 1 0x00 End of header 11.6.3 Autoexec Binary Firmware If the application requires firmware loaded prior to establishing a USB connection, then the following header can be used. The bootcode loads the firmware and releases control to the firmware directly without connecting to the USB. However, per the USB specification requirement, any USB device should connect to the bus and respond to the host within the first 100 ms. Therefore, if downloading time is more than 100 ms, the USB and header speed descriptor blocks should be added before the autoexec binary firmware. Table 11−7 shows an example of autoexec binary firmware header. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 72 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Table 11−7. Autoexec Binary Firmware OFFSET TYPE SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0x0000 Signature0 1 0x10 FUNCTION_PID_L 0x0001 Signature1 1 0x34 FUNCTION_PID_H 0x0002 Data Type 1 0x07 Autoexec binary firmware 0x0003 Data Size (low byte) 1 0x67 0x4567 bytes of application code 0x0004 Data Size (high byte) 1 0x45 0x0005 Check Sum 1 0xNN Checksum of the following firmware 0x0006 Program 0x4567 Binary application code 0x456d Data Type 1 0x00 End of header 11.7 USB Host Driver Downloading Header Format If firmware downloading from the USB host driver is desired, then the USB host driver must follow the format in Table 11−8. The Texas Instruments bootloader driver generates the proper format. Therefore, users only need to provide the binary image of the application firmware for the Bootloader. If the checksum is wrong, then the bootcode disconnects from the USB and waits before it reconnects to the USB. Table 11−8. Host Driver Downloading Format OFFSET TYPE SIZE VALUE DESCRIPTION 0x0000 Firmware size (low byte) 1 0xXX Application firmware size 0x0001 Firmware size (low byte) 1 0xYY 0x0002 Checksum 1 0xZZ Checksum of binary application code 0x0003 Program 0xYYXX Binary application code 11.8 Built-In Vendor Specific USB Requests The bootcode supports several vendor specific USB requests. These requests are primarily for internal testing only. These functions should not be used in normal operation. 11.8.1 Reboot The reboot command forces the bootcode to execute. bmRequestType USB_REQ_TYPE_DEVICE | USB_REQ_TYPE_VENDOR | USB_REQ_TYPE_OUT 01000000b bRequest BTC_REBOOT 0x85 wValue None 0x0000 wIndex None 0x0000 wLength None 0x0000 Data None 11.8.2 Force Execute Firmware The force execute firmware command requests the bootcode to execute the downloaded firmware unconditionally. bmRequestType USB_REQ_TYPE_DEVICE | USB_REQ_TYPE_VENDOR | USB_REQ_TYPE_OUT 01000000b bRequest BTC_FORCE_EXECUTE_FIRMWARE 0x8F wValue None 0x0000 wIndex None 0x0000 wLength None 0x0000 Data None TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 73 11.8.3 External Memory Read The bootcode returns the content of the specified address. bmRequestType USB_REQ_TYPE_DEVICE | USB_REQ_TYPE_VENDOR | USB_REQ_TYPE_IN 11000000b bRequest BTC_EXETERNAL_MEMORY_READ 0x90 wValue None 0x0000 wIndex Data address 0xNNNN (From 0x0000 to 0xFFFF) wLength 1 byte 0x0001 Data Byte in the specified address 0xNN 11.8.4 External Memory Write The external memory write command tells the bootcode to write data to the specified address. bmRequestType USB_REQ_TYPE_DEVICE | USB_REQ_TYPE_VENDOR | USB_REQ_TYPE_OUT 01000000b bRequest BTC_EXETERNAL_MEMORY_WRITE 0x91 wValue HI: 0x00 LO: Data 0x00NN wIndex Data address 0xNNNN (From 0x0000 to 0xFFFF) wLength None 0x0000 Data None 11.8.5 I2C Memory Read The bootcode returns the content of the specified address in I2C EEPROM. In the wValue field, the I2C device number is from 0x00 to 0x07 in the high byte. The memory type is from 0x01 to 0x03 for CAT I to CAT III devices. If bit 7 of bValueL is set, then the bus speed is 400 kHz. This request is also used to set the device number and speed before the I2C write request. bmRequestType USB_REQ_TYPE_DEVICE | USB_REQ_TYPE_VENDOR | USB_REQ_TYPE_IN 11000000b bRequest BTC_I2C_MEMORY_READ 0x92 wValue HI: I2C device number LO: Memory type bit[1:0] Speed bit[7] 0xXXYY wIndex Data address 0xNNNN (From 0x0000 to 0xFFFF) wLength 1 byte 0x0001 Data Byte in the specified address 0xNN 11.8.6 I2C Memory Write The I2C memory write command tells the bootcode to write data to the specified address. bmRequestType USB_REQ_TYPE_DEVICE | USB_REQ_TYPE_VENDOR | USB_REQ_TYPE_OUT 01000000b bRequest BTC_I2C_MEMORY_WRITE 0x93 wValue HI: should be zero LO: Data 0x00NN wIndex Data address 0xNNNN (From 0x0000 to 0xFFFF) wLength None 0x0000 Data None TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 74 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 11.8.7 Internal ROM Memory Read The bootcode returns the byte of the specified address within the boot ROM. That is, the binary code of the bootcode. bmRequestType USB_REQ_TYPE_DEVICE | USB_REQ_TYPE_VENDOR | USB_REQ_TYPE_OUT 01000000b bRequest BTC_INTERNAL_ROM_MEMORY_READ 0x94 wValue None 0x0000 wIndex Data address 0xNNNN (From 0x0000 to 0xFFFF) wLength 1 byte 0x0001 Data Byte in the specified address 0xNN 11.9 Bootcode Programming Consideration 11.9.1 USB Requests For each USB request, the bootcode follows the steps below to ensure proper operation of the hardware. 1. Determine the direction of the request by checking the MSB of the bmRequestType field and set the DIR bit within the USBCTL register accordingly. 2. Decode the command 3. If another setup is pending, then return. Otherwise, serve the request. 4. Check again, if another setup is pending then go to step 2. 5. Clear the interrupt source and then the VECINT register. 6. Exit the interrupt routine. 11.9.1.1 USB Request Transfers The USB request consist of three types of transfers. They are control-read-with-data-stage, control-writewithout- data-stage, and control-write-with-data-stage transfer. In each transfer, arrows indicate interrupts generated after receiving the setup packet, in or out token. Figure 11−1 and Figure 11−2 show the USB data flow and how the hardware and firmware respond to the USB requests. Table 11−9 and Table 11−10 lists the bootcode reposes to the standard USB requests. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 75 Setup (0) IN(1) IN(0) IN(0/1) OUT(1) INT INT INT INT More Packets Setup Stage Data Stage StatusStage 1.Hardware generates interrupt to MCU. 2.Hardware sets NAK on both the IN and the OUT endpoints. 3.Set DIR bit in USBCTL to indicate the data direction. 4.Decode the setup packet. 5.If another setup packet arrives, abandon this one. 6.Execute appropriate routine per a) Clear NAK bit in OUT endpoint. b) Copy data to IN endpoint buffer and set byte count. 1.Hardware generates interrupt to MCU. 2.Copy data to IN buffer. 3.Clear the NAK bit. 4.If all data has been sent, stall input endpoint. 1.Hardware does NOT generate interrupt to MCU. Table 11-9. Figure 11−1. Control Read Transfer Table 11−9. Bootcode Response to Control Read Transfer CONTROL READ ACTION IN BOOTCODE Get status of device Return power and remote wakeup settings Get status of interface Return 2 bytes of zeros Get status of endpoint Return endpoint status Get descriptor of device Return device descriptor Get descriptor of configuration Return configuration descriptor Get descriptor of string Return string descriptor Get descriptor of interface Stall Get descriptor of endpoint Stall Get configuration Return bConfiguredNumber value Get interface Return bInterfaceNumber value TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 76 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Setup (0) IN(1) INT Setup Stage Status Stage 1.Hardware generates interrupt to MCU. 2.Hardware sets NAK on both the IN and the OUT endpoints. 3.Set DIR bit in USBCTL to indicate the data direction. 4.Decode the setup packet. 5.If another setup packet arrives, abandon this one. 6.Execute appropriate routine per 1.Hardware does NOT generates interrupt to MCU. Table 11−10. Figure 11−2. Control Write Transfer Without Data Stage Table 11−10. Bootcode Response to Control Write Without Data Stage CONTROL WRITE WITHOUT DATA STAGE ACTION IN BOOTCODE Clear feature of device Stall Clear feature of interface Stall Clear feature of endpoint Clear endpoint stall Set feature of device Stall Set feature of interface Stall Set feature of endpoint Stall endpoint Set address Set device address Set descriptor Stall Set configuration Set bConfiguredNumber Set interface SetbInterfaceNumber Sync. frame Stall 11.9.1.2 Interrupt Handling Routine The higher-vector number has a higher priority than the lower-vector number. Table 11−11 lists all the interrupts and source of interrupts. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 77 Table 11−11. Vector Interrupt Values and Sources G[3:0] (Hex) I[2:0] (Hex) VECTOR (Hex) INTERRUPT SOURCE INTERRUPT SOURCE SHOULD BE CLEARED 0 0 00 No Interrupt No Source 1 1 12 Output−endpoint−1 VECINT register 1 2 14 Output−endpoint−2 VECINT register 1 3 16 Output−endpoint−3 VECINT register 1 4−7 18→1E Reserved 2 1 22 Input−endpoint−1 VECINT register 2 2 24 Input−endpoint−2 VECINT register 2 3 26 Input−endpoint−3 VECINT register 2 4−7 28→2E Reserved 3 0 30 STPOW packet received USBSTA/ VECINT registers 3 1 32 SETUP packet received USBSTA/ VECINT registers 3 2 34 Reserved 3 3 36 Reserved 3 4 38 RESR interrupt USBSTA/ VECINT registers 3 5 3A SUSR interrupt USBSTA/ VECINT registers 3 6 3C RSTR interrupt USBSTA/ VECINT registers 3 7 3E Wakeup interrupt USBSTA/ VECINT registers 4 0 40 I2C TXE interrupt VECINT register 4 1 42 I2C TXE interrupt VECINT register 4 2 44 Input−endpoint−0 VECINT register 4 3 46 Output−endpoint−0 VECINT register 4 4−7 48→4E Reserved 5 0 50 UART1 status interrupt LSR/VECNT register 5 1 52 UART1 modern interrupt LSR/VECINT register 5 2−7 54→5E Reserved 6 0 60 UART1 RXF interrupt LSR/VECNT register 6 1 62 UART1 TXE interrupt LSR/VECINT register 6 2−7 64→6E Reserved 7 0−7 70→7E Reserved 8 0 80 DMA1 interrupt DMACSR/VECINT register 8 1 82 Reserved 8 2 84 DMA3 interrupt DMACSR/VECINT register 8 3−7 86→7E Reserved 9−15 0−7 90→FE Reserved 11.9.2 Hardware Reset Introduced by the Firmware This feature can be used during a firmware upgrade. Once the upgrade is complete, the application firmware disconnects from the USB for at least 200 ms to ensure the operating system has unloaded the device driver. The firmware then enables the watchdog timer (enabled by default after power-on reset) and enters an endless loop without resetting the watchdog timer. Once the watchdog timer times out, it resets the TUSB3410 similar to a power on reset. The bootcode takes control and executes the power-on boot sequence. TUSB3410 Bootcode Flow 78 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 11.10 File Listings The TUSB3410 Bootcode Source Listing (SLLC139.zip) is available under the TUSB3410 product page on the TI website. Look under the Related Software link. The files listed below are included in the zip file. • Types.h • USB.h • TUSB3410.h • Bootcode.h • Watchdog.h • Bootcode.c • Bootlsr.c • BootUSB.c • Header.h • Header.c • I2c.h • I2c.c Electrical Specifications SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 79 12 Electrical Specifications 12.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings† Supply voltage, VCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . −0.5 V to 3.6 V Input voltage, VI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . −0.5 V to VCC + 0.5 V Output voltage, VO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . −0.5 V to VCC + 0.5 V Input clamp current, IIK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20 mA Output clamp current, IOK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20 mA † Stresses beyond those listed under “absolute maximum ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under “recommended operating conditions” is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. 12.2 Commercial Operating Condition (3.3 V) PARAMETER MIN TYP MAX UNIT VCC Supply voltage 3 3.3 3.6 V VI Input voltage 0 VCC V V High level input voltage TTL 2 VCC VIH High-V CMOS 0.7 × VCC VCC V Low level input voltage TTL 0 0.8 VIL Low-V CMOS 0 0.2 × VCC T Operating temperature Commercial range 0 70 °C TA Industrial range −40 85 °C 12.3 Electrical Characteristics TA = 25°C, VCC = 3.3 V ±5%, VSS = 0 V PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT V High level output voltage TTL I 4 mA VCC – 0.5 VOH High-V CMOS IOH = −VCC – 0.5 V Low level output voltage TTL I 4 mA 0.5 VOL Low-V CMOS IOL = 0.5 V Positive threshold voltage TTL V V 1.8 VIT+ V CMOS VI = VIH 0.7 × VCC V Negative threshold voltage TTL V V 0.8 1.8 VIT− V CMOS VI = VIH 0.2 × VCC V Hysteresis (V V ) TTL V V 0.3 0.7 Vhys VIT+ − VIT−) V CMOS VI = VIH 0.17 × VCC 0.3 × VCC I High level input current TTL V V ±20 IIH High-A CMOS VI = VIH ±1 μA I Low level input current TTL V V ±20 IIL Low-A CMOS VI = VIL ±1 μA IOZ Output leakage current (Hi-Z) VI = VCC or VSS ±20 μA IOL Output low drive current 0.1 mA IOH Output high drive current 0.1 mA I Supply current (operating) Serial data at 921.6 k 15 mA ICC Supply current (suspended) 200 μA Electrical Specifications 80 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 Electrical Characteristics (continued) TA = 25°C, VCC = 3.3 V ±5%, VSS = 0 V PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT Clock duty cycle‡ 50% Jitter specification‡ ±100 ppm CI Input capacitance 18 pF CO Output capacitance 10 pF ‡ Applies to all clock outputs Application Notes SLLS519H—January 2010 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I 81 13 Application Notes 13.1 Crystal Selection The TUSB3410 requires a 12-MHz clock source to work properly. This clock source can be a crystal placed across the X1 and X2 terminals. A parallel resonant crystal is recommended. Most parallel resonant crystals are specified at a frequency with a load capacitance of 18 pF. This load can be realized by placing 33-pF capacitors from each end of the crystal to ground. Together with the input capacitance of the TUSB3410 and stray board capacitance, this provides close to two 36-pF capacitors in series to emulate the 18-pF load requirement. Note, that when using a crystal, it takes about 2 ms after power up for a stable clock to be produced. When using a clock oscillator, the signal applied to the X1/CLKI terminal must not exceed 1.8 V. In this configuration, the X2 terminal is unconnected. TUSB3410 X1/CLKI 33 pF 12 MHz X2 33 pF Figure 13−1. Crystal Selection 13.2 External Circuit Required for Reliable Bus Powered Suspend Operation TI has found a potential problem with the action of the SUSPEND output terminal immediately after power on. In some cases the SUSPEND terminal can power up asserted high. When used in a bus powered application this can cause a problem because the VREGEN input is usually connected to the SUSPEND output. This in turn causes the internal 1.8-V voltage regulator to shut down, which means an external crystal may not have time to begin oscillating, thus the device will not initialize itself correctly. TI has determined that using components R2 and D1 (rated to 25 mA) in the circuit shown below can be used as a workaround. Note that R1 and C1 are required components for proper reset operation, unless the reset signal is provided by another means. Note that use of an external oscillator (1.8-V output) versus a crystal would avoid this situation. Self-powered applications would probably not see this problem because the VREGEN input would likely be tied low, enabling the internal 1.8-V regulator at all times. TUSB3410 SUSPEND D1 VREGEN RESET R2 32 kΩ C1 1 μF 3.3 V R1 15 kΩ Figure 13−2. External Circuit Application Notes 82 TUSB3410, TUSB3410I SLLS519H—January 2010 13.3 Wakeup Timing (WAKEUP or RI/CP Transitions) The TUSB3410 can be brought out of the suspended state, or woken up, by a command from the host. The TUSB3410 also supports remote wakeup and can be awakened by either of two input signals. A low pulse on the WAKEUP terminal or a low-to-high transition on the RI/CP terminal wakes the device up. Note that for reliable operation, either condition must persist for approximately 3 ms minimum. This allows time for the crystal to power up since in the suspend mode the crystal interface is powered down. The state of the WAKEUP or RI/CP terminal is then sampled by the clock to verify there was a valid wakeup event. 13.4 Reset Timing There are three requirements for the reset signal timing. First, the minimum reset pulse duration is 100 μs. At power up, this time is measured from the time the power ramps up to 90% of the nominal VCC until the reset signal exceeds 1.2 V. The second requirement is that the clock must be valid during the last 60 μs of the reset window. The third requirement is that, according to the USB specification, the device must be ready to respond to the host within 100 ms. This means that within the 100-ms window, the device must come out of reset, load any pertinent data from the I2C EEPROM device, and transfer execution to the application firmware if any is present. Because the latter two events can require significant time, the amount of which can change from system to system, TI recommends having the device come out of reset within 30 ms, leaving 70 ms for the other events to complete. This means the reset signal must rise to 1.8 V within 30 ms. These requirements are depicted in Figure 13−3. Notice that when using a 12-MHz crystal, the clock signal may take several milliseconds to ramp up and become valid after power up. Therefore, the reset window may need to be elongated up to 10 ms or more to ensure that there is a 60-μs overlap with a valid clock. CLK RESET t VCC 90% 3.3 V 1.2 V 0 V >60 μs 100 μs < RESET TIME 1.8 V RESET TIME < 30 ms Figure 13−3. Reset Timing PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 6-Feb-2014 Addendum-Page 1 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples TUSB3410IRHB ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 73 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR -40 to 85 3410I TUSB3410IRHBG4 ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 73 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR -40 to 85 3410I TUSB3410IRHBR ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 3000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR -40 to 85 3410I TUSB3410IRHBRG4 ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 3000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR -40 to 85 3410I TUSB3410IRHBT ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR -40 to 85 3410I TUSB3410IVF ACTIVE LQFP VF 32 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 TUSB3410I TUSB3410IVFG4 ACTIVE LQFP VF 32 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 TUSB3410I TUSB3410RHB ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 73 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR 0 to 70 3410 TUSB3410RHBG4 ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 73 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR 0 to 70 3410 TUSB3410RHBR ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 3000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR 0 to 70 3410 TUSB3410RHBRG4 ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 3000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR 0 to 70 3410 TUSB3410RHBT ACTIVE VQFN RHB 32 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-2-260C-1 YEAR 0 to 70 3410 TUSB3410VF ACTIVE LQFP VF 32 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR 0 to 70 TUSB3410 TUSB3410VFG4 ACTIVE LQFP VF 32 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR 0 to 70 TUSB3410 (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 6-Feb-2014 Addendum-Page 2 (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. OTHER QUALIFIED VERSIONS OF TUSB3410 : • Automotive: TUSB3410-Q1 NOTE: Qualified Version Definitions: • Automotive - Q100 devices qualified for high-reliability automotive applications targeting zero defects TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Reel Diameter (mm) Reel Width W1 (mm) A0 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W (mm) Pin1 Quadrant TUSB3410IRHBR VQFN RHB 32 3000 330.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q2 TUSB3410IRHBT VQFN RHB 32 250 180.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q2 TUSB3410RHBR VQFN RHB 32 3000 330.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q2 TUSB3410RHBT VQFN RHB 32 250 180.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q2 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 27-Jul-2013 Pack Materials-Page 1 *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) TUSB3410IRHBR VQFN RHB 32 3000 338.1 338.1 20.6 TUSB3410IRHBT VQFN RHB 32 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 TUSB3410RHBR VQFN RHB 32 3000 338.1 338.1 20.6 TUSB3410RHBT VQFN RHB 32 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 27-Jul-2013 Pack Materials-Page 2 MECHANICAL DATA MTQF002B – JANUARY 1995 – REVISED MAY 2000 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 1 VF (S-PQFP-G32) PLASTIC QUAD FLATPACK 4040172/D 04/00 Gage Plane Seating Plane 1,60 MAX 1,45 1,35 8,80 9,20 SQ 0,05 MIN 0,45 0,75 0,25 0,13 NOM 5,60 TYP 1 32 7,20 6,80 24 25 SQ 8 9 17 16 0,25 0,45 0,10 0°–7° 0,80 0,20 M NOTES: A. All linear dimensions are in millimeters. B. This drawing is subject to change without notice. IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated DB OR PW PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 EN C1+ V+ C1− C2+ C2− V− RIN FORCEOFF VCC GND DOUT FORCEON DIN INVALID ROUT MAX3221 www.ti.com SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 MAX3221 3-V to 5.5-V Multichannel RS-232 Line Driver/Receiver With ±15-kV ESD Protection Check for Samples: MAX3221 1FEATURES DESCRIPTION • RS-232 Bus-Pin ESD Protection Exceeds The MAX3221 device consists of one line driver, one ±15 kV Using Human-Body Model (HBM) line receiver, and a dual charge-pump circuit with ±15-kV ESD protection pin to pin (serial-port • Meets or Exceeds the Requirements of connection pins, including GND). The device meets TIA/EIA-232-F and ITU V.28 Standards the requirements of TIA/EIA-232-F and provides the • Operates With 3-V to 5.5-V VCC Supply electrical interface between an asynchronous • Operates Up To 250 kbit/s communication controller and the serial-port connector. The charge pump and four small external • One Driver and One Receiver capacitors allow operation from a single 3-V to 5.5-V • Low Standby Current: 1 μA Typical supply. These devices operate at data signaling rates • External Capacitors: 4 × 0.1 μF up to 250 kbit/s and a maximum of 30-V/μs driver output slew rate. • Accepts 5-V Logic Input With 3.3-V Supply • Alternative High-Speed Pin-Compatible Flexible control options for power management are Device (1 Mbit/s) available when the serial port is inactive. The auto- powerdown feature functions when FORCEON is low – SNx5C3221 and FORCEOFF is high. During this mode of • Auto-Powerdown Feature Automatically operation, if the device does not sense a valid RS- Disables Drivers for Power Savings 232 signal on the receiver input, the driver output is disabled. If FORCEOFF is set low and EN is high, APPLICATIONS both the driver and receiver are shut off, and the supply current is reduced to 1 μA. Disconnecting the • Battery-Powered, Hand-Held, and Portable serial port or turning off the peripheral drivers causes Equipment the auto-powerdown condition to occur. Auto• PDAs and Palmtop PCs powerdown can be disabled when FORCEON and • Notebooks, Subnotebooks, and Laptops FORCEOFF are high. With auto-powerdown enabled, the device is activated automatically when a valid • Digital Cameras signal is applied to the receiver input. The INVALID • Mobile Phones and Wireless Devices output notifies the user if an RS-232 signal is present at the receiver input. INVALID is high (valid data) if the receiver input voltage is greater than 2.7 V or less than −2.7 V, or has been between −0.3 V and 0.3 V for less than 30 μs. INVALID is low (invalid data) if the receiver input voltage is between −0.3 V and 0.3 V for more than 30 μs. Refer to Figure 5 for receiver input levels. 1 Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet. PRODUCTION DATA information is current as of publication date. Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Products conform to specifications per the terms of the Texas Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not necessarily include testing of all parameters. DIN DOUT Auto-powerdown INVALID RIN FORCEOFF FORCEON ROUT EN 11 16 9 13 10 8 1 12 MAX3221 SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 www.ti.com This integrated circuit can be damaged by ESD. Texas Instruments recommends that all integrated circuits be handled with appropriate precautions. Failure to observe proper handling and installation procedures can cause damage. ESD damage can range from subtle performance degradation to complete device failure. Precision integrated circuits may be more susceptible to damage because very small parametric changes could cause the device not to meet its published specifications. Function Tables xxx Each Driver(1) INPUTS DIN FORCEON FORCEOFF VALID RIN RS-232 OUPUT DOUT DRIVER STATUS LEVEL X X L X Z Powered off L H H X H Normal operation H H H X L with auto-powerdown disabled L L H Yes H Normal operation H L H Yes L with auto-powerdown enabled L L H No Z Powered off by autoH L H No Z powerdown feature (1) H = high level, L = low level, X = irrelevant, Z = high impedance Each Receiver(1) INPUTS OUTPUT ROUT RIN EN VALID RIN RS-232 LEVEL L L X H H L X L X H X Z Open L No H (1) H = high level, L = low level, X = irrelevant, Z = high impedance (off), Open = disconnected input or connected driver off Logic Diagram (Positive Logic) 2 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links :MAX3221 MAX3221 www.ti.com SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 Absolute Maximum Ratings over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted)(1) MIN MAX UNIT VCC Supply voltage range(2) –0.3 6 V V+ Positive output supply voltage range(2) –0.3 7 V V– Negative output supply voltage range(2) 0.3 –7 V V+ – V– Supply voltage difference(2) 13 V Driver (FORCEOFF, FORCEON, EN) –0.3 6 VI Input voltage range V Receiver –25 25 Driver –13.2 13.2 VO Output voltage range V Receiver (INVALID) –0.3 VCC + 0.3 DB package 82 θJA Package thermal impedance(3) (4) °C/W PW package 108 TJ Operating virtual junction temperature 150 °C Tstg Storage temperature range –65 150 °C (1) Stresses beyond those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under Recommended Operating Conditions is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. (2) All voltages are with respect to network GND. (3) Maximum power dissipation is a function of TJ(max), θJA, and TA. The maximum allowable power dissipation at any allowable ambient temperature is PD = (TJ(max) – TA)/θJA. Operating at the absolute maximum TJ of 150°C can affect reliability. (4) The package thermal impedance is calculated in accordance with JESD 51-7. Recommended Operating Conditions (see Figure 6)(1) MIN NOM MAX UNIT VCC = 3.3 V 3 3.3 3.6 Supply voltage V VCC = 5 V 4.5 5 5.5 DIN, FORCEOFF, VCC = 3.3 V 2 VIH Driver high-level input voltage FORCEON, EN V VCC = 5 V 2.4 V DIN, FORCEOFF, IL Driver low-level input voltage FORCEON, EN 0.8 V Driver input voltage DIN, FORCEOFF, 0 5.5 VI FORCEON, EN V Receiver input voltage –25 25 MAX3221C 0 70 TA Operating free-air temperature °C MAX3221I –40 85 (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 V. Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 3 Product Folder Links :MAX3221 MAX3221 SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 www.ti.com Electrical Characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1) (see Figure 6) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP(2) MAX UNIT I FORCEOFF, FORCEON, I Input leakage current EN ±0.01 ±1 μA Auto-powerdown No load, FORCEOFF and 0.3 1 mA disabled FORCEON at VCC I Powered off No load, FORCEOFF at GND 1 10 CC Supply current No load, VCC = 3.3 V to 5 V No load, FORCEOFF at VCC, μA Auto-powerdown enabled FORCEON at GND, 1 10 All RIN are open or grounded (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 V. (2) All typical values are at VCC = 3.3 V or VCC = 5 V, and TA = 25°C. Driver Section Electrical Characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1) (see Figure 6) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP(2) MAX UNIT VOH High-level output voltage DOUT at RL = 3 kΩ to GND, DIN = GND 5 5.4 V VOL Low-level output voltage DOUT at RL = 3 kΩ to GND, DIN = VCC –5 –5.4 V IIH High-level input current VI = VCC ±0.01 ±1 μA IIL Low-level input current VI at GND ±0.01 ±1 μA VCC = 3.6 V VO = 0 V ±35 ±60 IOS Short-circuit output current(3) mA VCC = 5.5 V VO = 0 V ±35 ±60 rO Output resistance VCC, V+, and V– = 0 V VO = ±2 V 300 10M Ω VO = ±12 V, ±25 VCC = 3 V to 3.6 V Ioff Output leakage current FORCEOFF = GND μA VO = ±12 V, ±25 VCC = 4.5 V to 5.5V (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 (2) All typical values are at VCC = 3.3 V or VCC = 5 V, and TA = 25°C. (3) Short-circuit durations should be controlled to prevent exceeding the device absolute power dissipation ratings, and not more than one output should be shorted at a time. Switching Characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1) (see Figure 6) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP(2) MAX UNIT Maximum data rate CL = 1000 pF, RL = 3 kΩ, 150 250 kbit/s See Figure 1 t CL = 150 to 2500 pF, RL = 3 kΩ to 7 kΩ, sk(p) Pulse skew(3) See Figure 2 100 ns Slew rate, transition region VCC = 3.3 V, CL = 150 to 1000 pF 6 30 SR(tr) (see Figure 1) R V/μs L = 3 kΩ to 7 kΩ CL = 150 to 2500 pF 4 30 (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 V. (2) All typical values are at VCC = 3.3 V or VCC = 5 V, and TA = 25°C. (3) Pulse skew is defined as |tPLH − tPHL| of each channel of the same device. ESD Protection TERMINAL TEST CONDITIONS TYP UNIT NAME NO DOUT 13 HBM ±15 kV 4 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links :MAX3221 MAX3221 www.ti.com SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 Receiver Section Electrical Characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1) (see Figure 6) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP(2) MAX UNIT VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –1 mA VCC – 0.6 VCC – 0.1 V VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 1.6 mA 0.4 V VCC = 3.3 V 1.5 2.4 VIT+ Positive-going input threshold voltage V VCC = 5 V 1.8 2.4 VCC = 3.3 V 0.6 1.1 VIT– Negative-going input threshold voltage V VCC = 5 V 0.8 1.4 Vhys Input hysteresis (VIT+ – VIT–) 0.5 V Ioff Output leakage current FORCEOFF = 0 V ±0.05 ±10 μA ri Input resistance VI = ±3 V to ±25 V 3 5 7 kΩ (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 V. (2) All typical values are at VCC = 3.3 V or VCC = 5 V, and TA = 25°C. Switching Characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1) (see Figure 3) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP(2) MAX UNIT t CL = 150 pF, PLH Propagation delay time, low- to high-level output See Figure 3 150 ns t CL = 150 pF, PHL Propagation delay time, high- to low-level output See Figure 3 150 ns t CL = 150 pF, RL = 3kΩ, en Output enable time See Figure 4 200 ns t CL = 150 pF, RL = 3kΩ, dis Output disable time See Figure 4 200 ns tsk(p) Pulse skew(3) See Figure 3 50 ns (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 V. (2) All typical values are at VCC = 3.3 V or VCC = 5 V, and TA = 25°C. (3) Pulse skew is defined as |tPLH − tPHL| of each channel of the same device. ESD Protection TERMINAL TEST CONDITIONS TYP UNIT NAME NO RIN 13 HBM ±15 kV Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 5 Product Folder Links :MAX3221 MAX3221 SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 www.ti.com Auto-Powerdown Section Electrical Characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1) (see Figure 5) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN MAX UNIT V Receiver input threshold for INVALID high-level FORCEON = GND, T+(valid) output voltage FORCEOFF = V 2.7 V CC V Receiver input threshold for INVALID high-level FORCEON = GND, T–(valid) output voltage FORCEOFF = V –2.7 V CC V Receiver input threshold for INVALID low-level FORCEON = GND, T(invalid) output voltage FORCEOFF = V –0.3 0.3 V CC IOH = –1 mA, VOH INVALID high-level output voltage FORCEON = GND, VCC – 0.6 V FORCEOFF = VCC IOH = –1 mA, VOL INVALID low-level output voltage FORCEON = GND, 0.4 V FORCEOFF = VCC (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 V. Switching Characteristics over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1) (see Figure 5) PARAMETER MIN TYP(2) MAX UNIT tvalid Propagation delay time, low- to high-level output 1 μs tinvalid Propagation delay time, high- to low-level output 30 μs ten Supply enable time 100 μs (1) Test conditions are C1−C4 = 0.1 μF at VCC = 3.3 V ± 0.3 V; C1 = 0.047 μF, C2−C4 = 0.33 μF at VCC = 5 V ± 0.5 V. (2) All typical values are at VCC = 3.3 V or VCC = 5 V, and TA = 25°C. 6 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links :MAX3221 TEST CIRCUIT VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS 50 ! −3 V 3 V Output Input VOL VOH Generator tPHL (see Note B) tPLH Output CL (see Note A) 3 V or 0 V FORCEON 3 V FORCEOFF 1.5 V 1.5 V 50% 50% 50 ! TEST CIRCUIT VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS 0 V 3 V Output Input VOL VOH tPLH Generator (see Note B) RL 3 V FORCEOFF RS-232 Output CL tPHL (see Note A) 50% 50% 1.5 V 1.5 V 50 ! TEST CIRCUIT VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS −3 V −3 V 3 V 3 V 0 V 3 V Output Input VOL VOH tTLH Generator (see Note B) RL 3 V FORCEOFF RS-232 Output C tTHL L (see Note A) SR(tr) = 6 V tTHL or tTLH MAX3221 www.ti.com SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 Parameter Measurement Information A. CL includes probe and jig capacitance. B. The pulse generator has the following characteristics: PRR = 250 kbit/s, ZO = 50 Ω, 50% duty cycle, tr ≤ 10 ns, tf ≤ 10 ns. Figure 1. Driver Slew Rate A. CL includes probe and jig capacitance. B. The pulse generator has the following characteristics: PRR = 250 kbit/s, ZO = 50 Ω, 50% duty cycle, tr ≤ 10 ns, tf ≤ 10 ns. Figure 2. Driver Pulse Skew A. CL includes probe and jig capacitance. B. The pulse generator has the following characteristics: ZO = 50 Ω, 50% duty cycle, tr ≤ 10 ns, tf ≤ 10 ns. Figure 3. Receiver Propagation Delay Times Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 7 Product Folder Links :MAX3221 TEST CIRCUIT VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS 50 ! Generator (see Note B) 3 V or 0 V Output VOL VOH tPZH (S1 at GND) 3 V 0 V 0.3 V Output Input 0.3 V 3 V or 0 V FORCEON EN 1.5 V 1.5 V 50% tPHZ (S1 at GND) tPLZ (S1 at VCC) 50% tPZL (S1 at VCC) RL S1 VCC GND CL (see Note A) Output MAX3221 SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 www.ti.com Parameter Measurement Information (continued) A. CL includes probe and jig capacitance. B. The pulse generator has the following characteristics: ZO = 50 Ω, 50% duty cycle, tr ≤ 10 ns, tf ≤ 10 ns. C. tPLZ and tPHZ are the same as tdis. D. tPZL and tPZH are the same as ten. Figure 4. Receiver Enable and Disable Times 8 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links :MAX3221 TEST CIRCUIT 50 ! Generator (see Note B) FORCEOFF ROUT FORCEON Autopowerdown INVALID DIN DOUT CL = 30 pF (see Note A) 2.7 V −2.7 V 0.3 V −0.3 V 0 V Valid RS-232 Level, INVALID High Indeterminate Indeterminate If Signal Remains Within This Region For More Than 30 μs, INVALID Is Low† Valid RS-232 Level, INVALID High † Auto-powerdown disables drivers and reduces supply current to 1 μA. VOLTAGE WAVEFORMS 3 V 2.7 V −2.7 V INVALID Output Receiver Input tvalid 0 V 0 V −3 V VCC 0 V !V+ 0 V !V− V+ VCC ten V− 50% VCC 50% VCC 2.7 V −2.7 V 0.3 V 0.3 V tinvalid Supply Voltages MAX3221 www.ti.com SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 Parameter Measurement Information (continued) Figure 5. INVALID Propagation Delay Times and Driver Enabling Time Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 9 Product Folder Links :MAX3221 CBYPASS = 0.1 μF Autopowerdown VCC C1 C2, C3, and C4 3.3 V ± 0.3 V 5 V ± 0.5 V 3 V to 5.5 V 0.1 μF 0.047 μF 0.1 μF 0.1 μF 0.33 μF 0.47 μF VCC vs CAPACITOR VALUES FORCEOFF + − + − + − + − + − 1 8 2 3 5 6 7 4 16 13 12 11 10 9 15 14 VCC GND C1+ V+ C2+ C1− C2− V− DOUT FORCEON DIN INVALID ROUT EN RIN C1 C2 C4 5 k! C3† † C3 can be connected to VCC or GND. NOTES: A. Resistor values shown are nominal. B. Nonpolarized ceramic capacitors are acceptable. If polarized tantalum or electrolytic capacitors are used, they should be connected as shown. MAX3221 SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 www.ti.com APPLICATION INFORMATION Figure 6. Typical Operating Circuit and Capacitor Values 10 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Links :MAX3221 MAX3221 www.ti.com SLLS348N –JUNE 1999–REVISED JANUARY 2014 REVISION HISTORY Changes from Revision M (March 2004) to Revision N Page • Updated document to new TI data sheet format - no specification changes. ...................................................................... 1 • Deleted Ordering Information table. ...................................................................................................................................... 1 • Added ESD warning. ............................................................................................................................................................ 2 Copyright © 1999–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 11 Product Folder Links :MAX3221 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 10-Jun-2014 Addendum-Page 1 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples MAX3221CDB ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 80 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CDBE4 ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 80 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CDBG4 ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 80 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CDBR ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CDBRG4 ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CPW ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CPWE4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CPWG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CPWR ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CPWRE4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221CPWRG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 MA3221C MAX3221IDB ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 80 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IDBE4 ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 80 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IDBG4 ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 80 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IDBR ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IDBRE4 ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IDBRG4 ACTIVE SSOP DB 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 10-Jun-2014 Addendum-Page 2 Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples MAX3221IPW ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IPWG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IPWR ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU | CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I MAX3221IPWRG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 16 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 MB3221I (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 10-Jun-2014 Addendum-Page 3 continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. OTHER QUALIFIED VERSIONS OF MAX3221 : • Enhanced Product: MAX3221-EP NOTE: Qualified Version Definitions: • Enhanced Product - Supports Defense, Aerospace and Medical Applications TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Reel Diameter (mm) Reel Width W1 (mm) A0 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W (mm) Pin1 Quadrant MAX3221CDBR SSOP DB 16 2000 330.0 16.4 8.2 6.6 2.5 12.0 16.0 Q1 MAX3221CPWR TSSOP PW 16 2000 330.0 12.4 6.9 5.6 1.6 8.0 12.0 Q1 MAX3221IDBR SSOP DB 16 2000 330.0 16.4 8.2 6.6 2.5 12.0 16.0 Q1 MAX3221IPWR TSSOP PW 16 2000 330.0 12.4 6.9 5.6 1.6 8.0 12.0 Q1 MAX3221IPWR TSSOP PW 16 2000 330.0 12.4 6.9 5.6 1.6 8.0 12.0 Q1 MAX3221IPWRG4 TSSOP PW 16 2000 330.0 12.4 6.9 5.6 1.6 8.0 12.0 Q1 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 29-Apr-2014 Pack Materials-Page 1 *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) MAX3221CDBR SSOP DB 16 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 MAX3221CPWR TSSOP PW 16 2000 367.0 367.0 35.0 MAX3221IDBR SSOP DB 16 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 MAX3221IPWR TSSOP PW 16 2000 364.0 364.0 27.0 MAX3221IPWR TSSOP PW 16 2000 367.0 367.0 35.0 MAX3221IPWRG4 TSSOP PW 16 2000 367.0 367.0 35.0 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 29-Apr-2014 Pack Materials-Page 2 MECHANICAL DATA MSSO002E – JANUARY 1995 – REVISED DECEMBER 2001 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 DB (R-PDSO-G**) PLASTIC SMALL-OUTLINE 4040065 /E 12/01 28 PINS SHOWN Gage Plane 8,20 7,40 0,55 0,95 0,25 38 12,90 12,30 28 10,50 24 8,50 Seating Plane 7,90 9,90 30 10,50 9,90 0,38 5,60 5,00 15 0,22 14 A 28 1 16 20 6,50 6,50 14 0,05 MIN 5,90 5,90 DIM A MAX A MIN PINS ** 2,00 MAX 6,90 7,50 0,65 0,15 M 0°–8° 0,10 0,09 0,25 NOTES: A. All linear dimensions are in millimeters. B. This drawing is subject to change without notice. C. Body dimensions do not include mold flash or protrusion not to exceed 0,15. D. Falls within JEDEC MO-150 IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Poly Phase Multifunction Energy Metering IC with Per Phase Information Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other rights of third parties that may result from its use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A. Tel: 781.329.4700 www.analog.com Fax: 781.461.3113 ©2004–2011 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. FEATURES Highly accurate; supports IEC 60687, IEC 61036, IEC 61268, IEC 62053-21, IEC 62053-22, and IEC 62053-23 Compatible with 3-phase/3-wire, 3-phase/4-wire, and other 3-phase services Less than 0.1% active energy error over a dynamic range of 1000 to 1 at 25°C Supplies active/reactive/apparent energy, voltage rms, current rms, and sampled waveform data Two pulse outputs, one for active power and the other selectable between reactive and apparent power with programmable frequency Digital power, phase, and rms offset calibration On-chip, user-programmable thresholds for line voltage SAG and overvoltage detections An on-chip, digital integrator enables direct interface-to-current sensors with di/dt output A PGA in the current channel allows direct interface to current transformers An SPI®-compatible serial interface with IRQ Proprietary ADCs and DSP provide high accuracy over large variations in environmental conditions and time Reference 2.4 V (drift 30 ppm/°C typical) with external overdrive capability Single 5 V supply, low power (70 mW typical) GENERAL DESCRIPTION The ADE7758 is a high accuracy, 3-phase electrical energy measurement IC with a serial interface and two pulse outputs. The ADE7758 incorporates second-order Σ-Δ ADCs, a digital integrator, reference circuitry, a temperature sensor, and all the signal processing required to perform active, reactive, and apparent energy measurement and rms calculations. The ADE7758 is suitable to measure active, reactive, and apparent energy in various 3-phase configurations, such as WYE or DELTA services, with both three and four wires. The ADE7758 provides system calibration features for each phase, that is, rms offset correction, phase calibration, and power calibration. The APCF logic output gives active power information, and the VARCF logic output provides instantaneous reactive or apparent power information. FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM PHASE BANDPHASE CDATA4AVDDPOWERSUPPLYMONITOR12REFIN/OUT11AGNDADC–+9ICP10ICNPGA1ADC–+14VCP13VNPGA2ACTIVE/REACTIVE/APPARENT ENERGIESAND VOLTAGE/CURRENT RMS CALCULATIONFOR PHASE C(SEE PHASE A FOR DETAILED SIGNALPATH)ADC–+7IBP8IBNPGA1ADC–+15VBPPGA2ACTIVE/REACTIVE/APPARENT ENERGIESAND VOLTAGE/CURRENT RMS CALCULATIONFOR PHASE B(SEE PHASE A FOR DETAILED SIGNALPATH)ADC–+5IAP6IANPGA1ADC–+16VAPPGA2AVRMSGAIN[11:0]AVAG[11:0]|X|APHCAL[6:0]ΦHPFINTEGRATORdtAVAROS[11:0]AVARG[11:0]LPF290° PHASESHIFTING FILTERπ2AWATTOS[11:0]AWG[11:0]LPF222DIN24DOUT23SCLK21CS18IRQADE7758 REGISTERSANDSERIAL INTERFACEWDIV[7:0]%VARDIV[7:0]%VADIV[7:0]%AIRMSOS[11:0]X2LPF2.4VREF4kΩDFC÷APCFNUM[11:0]APCFDEN[11:0]ACTIVE POWER1APCF3DVDD2DGND19CLKIN20CLKOUTDFCVARCFNUM[11:0]VARCFDEN[11:0]REACTIVE ORAPPARENT POWER17VARCFADE7758AVRMSOS[11:0]04443-001÷ Figure 1. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 2 of 72 TABLE OF CONTENTS Features..............................................................................................1 General Description.........................................................................1 Functional Block Diagram..............................................................1 General Description.........................................................................4 Specifications.....................................................................................5 Timing Characteristics................................................................6 Timing Diagrams..............................................................................7 Absolute Maximum Ratings............................................................8 ESD Caution..................................................................................8 Pin Configuration and Function Descriptions.............................9 Terminology....................................................................................11 Typical Performance Characteristics...........................................12 Test Circuits.....................................................................................17 Theory of Operation......................................................................18 Antialiasing Filter.......................................................................18 Analog Inputs..............................................................................18 Current Channel ADC...............................................................19 di/dt Current Sensor and Digital Integrator...............................20 Peak Current Detection.............................................................21 Overcurrent Detection Interrupt.............................................21 Voltage Channel ADC...............................................................22 Zero-Crossing Detection...........................................................23 Phase Compensation..................................................................23 Period Measurement..................................................................25 Line Voltage SAG Detection.....................................................25 SAG Level Set..............................................................................26 Peak Voltage Detection..............................................................26 Phase Sequence Detection.........................................................26 Power-Supply Monitor...............................................................27 Reference Circuit........................................................................27 Temperature Measurement.......................................................27 Root Mean Square Measurement.............................................28 Active Power Calculation..........................................................30 Reactive Power Calculation......................................................35 Apparent Power Calculation.....................................................39 Energy Registers Scaling...........................................................41 Waveform Sampling Mode.......................................................41 Calibration...................................................................................42 Checksum Register.....................................................................55 Interrupts.....................................................................................55 Using the Interrupts with an MCU..........................................56 Interrupt Timing........................................................................56 Serial Interface............................................................................56 Serial Write Operation...............................................................57 Serial Read Operation................................................................59 Accessing the On-Chip Registers.............................................59 Registers...........................................................................................60 Communications Register.........................................................60 Operational Mode Register (0x13)..........................................64 Measurement Mode Register (0x14).......................................64 Waveform Mode Register (0x15).............................................65 Computational Mode Register (0x16).....................................66 Line Cycle Accumulation Mode Register (0x17)...................67 Interrupt Mask Register (0x18)................................................68 Interrupt Status Register (0x19)/Reset Interrupt Status Register (0x1A)...........................................................................69 Outline Dimensions.......................................................................70 Ordering Guide..........................................................................70 Revision History 10/11—Rev. D to Rev. E Changes to Figure 1..........................................................................1 Changes to Figure 41......................................................................19 Changes to Figure 60......................................................................27 Added Figure 61; Renumbered Sequentially..............................27 Changes to Phase Sequence Detection Section..........................27 Changes to Power-Supply Monitor Section................................27 Changes to Figure 62......................................................................28 Changes to Figure 67......................................................................32 Changes to Figure 68......................................................................32 Changes to Equation 25.................................................................34 Changes to Figure 69......................................................................34 Changes to Table 17.......................................................................62 Change to Table 18.........................................................................64 Changes to Table 24.......................................................................69 Changes to Ordering Guide..........................................................70 10/08—Rev. C to Rev. D Changes to Figure 1...........................................................................1 Changes to Phase Sequence Detection Section and Figure 60.27 Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 3 of 72 Changes to Current RMS Calculation Section............................28 Changes to Voltage Channel RMS Calculation Section and Figure 63...........................................................................................29 Changes to Table 17........................................................................60 Changes to Ordering Guide...........................................................70 7/06—Rev. B to Rev. C Updated Format..................................................................Universal Changes to Figure 1...........................................................................1 Changes to Table 2............................................................................6 Changes to Table 4............................................................................9 Changes to Figure 34 and Figure 35.............................................17 Changes to Current Waveform Gain Registers Section and Current Channel Sampling Section..............................................19 Changes to Voltage Channel Sampling Section..........................22 Changes to Zero-Crossing Timeout Section...............................23 Changes to Figure 60......................................................................27 Changes to Current RMS Calculation Section............................28 Changes to Current RMS Offset Compensation Section and Voltage Channel RMS Calculation Section.................................29 Added Table 7 and Table 9; Renumbered Sequentially..............29 Changes to Figure 65......................................................................30 Changes to Active Power Offset Calibration Section.................31 Changes to Reactive Power Frequency Output Section.............38 Changes to Apparent Power Frequency Output Section and Waveform Sampling Mode Section..............................................41 Changes to Gain Calibration Using Line Accumulation Section....................................................................49 Changes to Example: Power Offset Calibration Using Line Accumulation Section....................................................................53 Changes to Calibration of IRMS and VRMS Offset Section.....54 Changes to Table 18........................................................................64 Changes to Table 20........................................................................65 11/05—Rev. A to Rev. B Changes to Table 1............................................................................5 Changes to Figure 23 Caption.......................................................14 Changes to Current Waveform Gain Registers Section.............19 Changes to di/dt Current Sensor and Digital Integrator Section............................................................................20 Changes to Phase Compensation Section....................................23 Changes to Figure 57......................................................................25 Changes to Figure 60......................................................................27 Changes to Temperature Measurement Section and Root Mean Square Measurement Section............................28 Inserted Table 6................................................................................28 Changes to Current RMS Offset Compensation Section..........29 Inserted Table 7................................................................................29 Added Equation 17.........................................................................31 Changes to Energy Accumulation Mode Section.......................33 Changes to the Reactive Power Calculation Section..................35 Added Equation 32...........................................................................36 Changes to Energy Accumulation Mode Section.......................38 Changes to the Reactive Power Frequency Output Section......38 Changes to the Apparent Energy Calculation Section...............40 Changes to the Calibration Section..............................................42 Changes to Figure 76 through Figure 84...............................43–54 Changes to Table 15........................................................................59 Changes to Table 16........................................................................63 Changes to Ordering Guide...........................................................69 9/04—Rev. 0 to Rev. A Changed Hexadecimal Notation......................................Universal Changes to Features List...................................................................1 Changes to Specifications Table......................................................5 Change to Figure 25........................................................................16 Additions to the Analog Inputs Section.......................................19 Added Figures 36 and 37; Renumbered Subsequent Figures....19 Changes to Period Measurement Section....................................26 Change to Peak Voltage Detection Section.................................26 Added Figure 60..............................................................................27 Change to the Current RMS Offset Compensation Section.....29 Edits to Active Power Frequency Output Section......................33 Added Figure 68; Renumbered Subsequent Figures..................33 Changes to Reactive Power Frequency Output Section.............37 Added Figure 73; Renumbered Subsequent Figures..................38 Change to Gain Calibration Using Pulse Output Example.......44 Changes to Equation 37.................................................................45 Changes to Example—Phase Calibration of Phase A Using Pulse Output.........................................................................45 Changes to Equations 56 and 57...................................................53 Addition to the ADE7758 Interrupts Section.............................54 Changes to Example-Calibration of RMS Offsets......................54 Addition to Table 20.......................................................................66 1/04—Revision 0: Initial Version ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 4 of 72 GENERAL DESCRIPTION The ADE7758 has a waveform sample register that allows access to the ADC outputs. The part also incorporates a detection circuit for short duration low or high voltage variations. The voltage threshold levels and the duration (number of half-line cycles) of the variation are user programmable. A zero-crossing detection is synchronized with the zero-crossing point of the line voltage of any of the three phases. This information can be used to measure the period of any one of the three voltage inputs. The zero-crossing detection is used inside the chip for the line cycle energy accumulation mode. This mode permits faster and more accurate calibration by synchronizing the energy accumulation with an integer number of line cycles. Data is read from the ADE7758 via the SPI serial interface. The interrupt request output (IRQ) is an open-drain, active low logic output. The IRQ output goes active low when one or more interrupt events have occurred in the . A status register indicates the nature of the interrupt. The is available in a 24-lead SOIC package. ADE7758ADE7758 Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 5 of 72 SPECIFICATIONS AVDD = DVDD = 5 V ± 5%, AGND = DGND = 0 V, on-chip reference, CLKIN = 10 MHz XTAL, TMIN to TMAX = −40°C to +85°C. Table 1. Parameter1, 2 Specification Unit Test Conditions/Comments ACCURACY Active Energy Measurement Error (per Phase) 0.1 % typ Over a dynamic range of 1000 to 1 Phase Error Between Channels Line frequency = 45 Hz to 65 Hz, HPF on PF = 0.8 Capacitive ±0.05 °max Phase lead 37° PF = 0.5 Inductive ±0.05 °max Phase lag 60° AC Power Supply Rejection AVDD = DVDD = 5 V + 175 mV rms/120 Hz Output Frequency Variation 0.01 % typ V1P = V2P = V3P = 100 mV rms DC Power Supply Rejection AVDD = DVDD = 5 V ± 250 mV dc Output Frequency Variation 0.01 % typ V1P = V2P = V3P = 100 mV rms Active Energy Measurement Bandwidth 14 kHz IRMS Measurement Error 0.5 % typ Over a dynamic range of 500:1 IRMS Measurement Bandwidth 14 kHz VRMS Measurement Error 0.5 % typ Over a dynamic range of 20:1 VRMS Measurement Bandwidth 260 Hz ANALOG INPUTS See the Analog Inputs section Maximum Signal Levels ±500 mV max Differential input Input Impedance (DC) 380 kΩ min ADC Offset Error3 ±30 mV max Uncalibrated error, see the Terminology section Gain Error3 ±6 % typ External 2.5 V reference WAVEFORM SAMPLING Sampling CLKIN/128, 10 MHz/128 = 78.1 kSPS Current Channels See the Current Channel ADC section Signal-to-Noise Plus Distortion 62 dB typ Bandwidth (−3 dB) 14 kHz Voltage Channels See the Voltage Channel ADC section Signal-to-Noise Plus Distortion 62 dB typ Bandwidth (−3 dB) 260 Hz REFERENCE INPUT REFIN/OUT Input Voltage Range 2.6 V max 2.4 V + 8% 2.2 V min 2.4 V − 8% Input Capacitance 10 pF max ON-CHIP REFERENCE Nominal 2.4 V at REFIN/OUT pin Reference Error ±200 mV max Current Source 6 μA max Output Impedance 4 kΩ min Temperature Coefficient 30 ppm/°C typ CLKIN All specifications CLKIN of 10 MHz Input Clock Frequency 15 MHz max 5 MHz min LOGIC INPUTS DIN, SCLK, CLKIN, and CS Input High Voltage, VINH 2.4 V min DVDD = 5 V ± 5% Input Low Voltage, VINL 0.8 V max DVDD = 5 V ± 5% Input Current, IIN ±3 μA max Typical 10 nA, VIN = 0 V to DVDD Input Capacitance, CIN 10 pF max ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 6 of 72 Parameter1, 2 Specification Unit Test Conditions/Comments LOGIC OUTPUTS DVDD = 5 V ± 5% IRQ, DOUT, and CLKOUT IRQ is open-drain, 10 kΩ pull-up resistor Output High Voltage, VOH 4 V min ISOURCE = 5 mA Output Low Voltage, VOL 0.4 V max ISINK = 1 mA APCF and VARCF Output High Voltage, VOH 4 V min ISOURCE = 8 mA Output Low Voltage, VOL 1 V max ISINK = 5 mA POWER SUPPLY For specified performance AVDD 4.75 V min 5 V − 5% 5.25 V max 5 V + 5% DVDD 4.75 V min 5 V − 5% 5.25 V max 5 V + 5% AIDD 8 mA max Typically 5 mA DIDD 13 mA max Typically 9 mA 1 See the Typical Performance Characteristics. 2 See the Terminology section for a definition of the parameters. 3 See the Analog Inputs section. TIMING CHARACTERISTICS AVDD = DVDD = 5 V ± 5%, AGND = DGND = 0 V, on-chip reference, CLKIN = 10 MHz XTAL, TMIN to TMAX = −40°C to +85°C. Table 2. Parameter1, 2 Specification Unit Test Conditions/Comments WRITE TIMING t1 50 ns (min) CS falling edge to first SCLK falling edge t2 50 ns (min) SCLK logic high pulse width t3 50 ns (min) SCLK logic low pulse width t4 10 ns (min) Valid data setup time before falling edge of SCLK t5 5 ns (min) Data hold time after SCLK falling edge t6 1200 ns (min) Minimum time between the end of data byte transfers t7 400 ns (min) Minimum time between byte transfers during a serial write t8 100 ns (min) CS hold time after SCLK falling edge READ TIMING t93 4 μs (min) Minimum time between read command (that is, a write to communication register) and data read t10 50 ns (min) Minimum time between data byte transfers during a multibyte read t114 30 ns (min) Data access time after SCLK rising edge following a write to the communications register t125 100 ns (max) Bus relinquish time after falling edge of SCLK 10 ns (min) t135 100 ns (max) Bus relinquish time after rising edge of CS 10 ns (min) 1 Sample tested during initial release and after any redesign or process change that may affect this parameter. All input signals are specified with tr = tf = 5 ns (10% to 90%) and timed from a voltage level of 1.6 V. 2 See the timing diagrams in Figure 3 and Figure 4 and the Serial Interface section. 3 Minimum time between read command and data read for all registers except waveform register, which is t9 = 500 ns min. 4 Measured with the load circuit in Figure 2 and defined as the time required for the output to cross 0.8 V or 2.4 V. 5 Derived from the measured time taken by the data outputs to change 0.5 V when loaded with the circuit in Figure 2. The measured number is then extrapolated back to remove the effects of charging or discharging the 50 pF capacitor. This means that the time quoted here is the true bus relinquish time of the part and is independent of the bus loading. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 7 of 72 TIMING DIAGRAMS 200μAIOL1.6mAIOH2.1VTO OUTPUTPINCL50pF04443-002 Figure 2. Load Circuit for Timing Specifications DINSCLKCSt2t3t1t4t5t7t6t8COMMAND BYTEMOST SIGNIFICANT BYTELEAST SIGNIFICANT BYTE1A6A4A5A3A2A1A0DB7DB0DB7DB0t704443-003 Figure 3. Serial Write Timing SCLKCSt1t10t130A6A4A5A3A2A1A0DB0DB7DB0DB7DINDOUTt11t12COMMAND BYTEMOST SIGNIFICANT BYTELEAST SIGNIFICANT BYTEt904443-004 Figure 4. Serial Read Timing ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 8 of 72 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS TA = 25°C, unless otherwise noted. Table 3. Parameter Rating AVDD to AGND –0.3 V to +7 V DVDD to DGND –0.3 V to +7 V DVDD to AVDD –0.3 V to +0.3 V Analog Input Voltage to AGND, IAP, IAN, IBP, IBN, ICP, ICN, VAP, VBP, VCP, VN –6 V to +6 V Reference Input Voltage to AGND –0.3 V to AVDD + 0.3 V Digital Input Voltage to DGND –0.3 V to DVDD + 0.3 V Digital Output Voltage to DGND –0.3 V to DVDD + 0.3 V Operating Temperature Industrial Range –40°C to +85°C Storage Temperature Range –65°C to +150°C Junction Temperature 150°C 24-Lead SOIC, Power Dissipation 88 mW θJA Thermal Impedance 53°C/W Lead Temperature, Soldering Vapor Phase (60 sec) 215°C Infrared (15 sec) 220°C Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only; functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those listed in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. ESD CAUTION Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 9 of 72 PIN CONFIGURATION AND FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS APCF1DGND2DVDD3AVDD4DOUT24SCLK23DIN22CS21IAP5CLKOUT20IAN6CLKIN19IBP7IRQ18IBN8VARCF17ICP9VAP16ICN10VBP15AGND11VCP14REFIN/OUT12VN13ADE7758TOP VIEW(Not to Scale)04443-005 Figure 5. Pin Configuration Table 4. Pin Function Descriptions Pin No. Mnemonic Description 1 APCF Active Power Calibration Frequency (APCF) Logic Output. It provides active power information. This output is used for operational and calibration purposes. The full-scale output frequency can be scaled by writing to the APCFNUM and APCFDEN registers (see the Active Power Frequency Output section). 2 DGND This provides the ground reference for the digital circuitry in the ADE7758, that is, the multiplier, filters, and digital-to-frequency converter. Because the digital return currents in the ADE7758 are small, it is acceptable to connect this pin to the analog ground plane of the whole system. However, high bus capacitance on the DOUT pin can result in noisy digital current that could affect performance. 3 DVDD Digital Power Supply. This pin provides the supply voltage for the digital circuitry in the ADE7758. The supply voltage should be maintained at 5 V ± 5% for specified operation. This pin should be decoupled to DGND with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor. 4 AVDD Analog Power Supply. This pin provides the supply voltage for the analog circuitry in the ADE7758. The supply should be maintained at 5 V ± 5% for specified operation. Every effort should be made to minimize power supply ripple and noise at this pin by the use of proper decoupling. The Typical Performance Characteristics show the power supply rejection performance. This pin should be decoupled to AGND with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor. 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 IAP, IAN, IBP, IBN, ICP, ICN Analog Inputs for Current Channel. This channel is used with the current transducer and is referenced in this document as the current channel. These inputs are fully differential voltage inputs with maximum differential input signal levels of ±0.5 V, ±0.25 V, and ±0.125 V, depending on the gain selections of the internal PGA (see the Analog Inputs section). All inputs have internal ESD protection circuitry. In addition, an overvoltage of ±6 V can be sustained on these inputs without risk of permanent damage. 11 AGND This pin provides the ground reference for the analog circuitry in the ADE7758, that is, ADCs, temperature sensor, and reference. This pin should be tied to the analog ground plane or the quietest ground reference in the system. This quiet ground reference should be used for all analog circuitry, for example, antialiasing filters, current, and voltage transducers. To keep ground noise around the ADE7758 to a minimum, the quiet ground plane should be connected to the digital ground plane at only one point. It is acceptable to place the entire device on the analog ground plane. 12 REFIN/OUT This pin provides access to the on-chip voltage reference. The on-chip reference has a nominal value of 2.4 V ± 8% and a typical temperature coefficient of 30 ppm/°C. An external reference source can also be connected at this pin. In either case, this pin should be decoupled to AGND with a 1 μF ceramic capacitor. 13, 14, 15, 16 VN, VCP, VBP, VAP Analog Inputs for the Voltage Channel. This channel is used with the voltage transducer and is referenced as the voltage channels in this document. These inputs are single-ended voltage inputs with the maximum signal level of ±0.5 V with respect to VN for specified operation. These inputs are voltage inputs with maximum input signal levels of ±0.5 V, ±0.25 V, and ±0.125 V, depending on the gain selections of the internal PGA (see the Analog Inputs section). All inputs have internal ESD protection circuitry, and in addition, an overvoltage of ±6 V can be sustained on these inputs without risk of permanent damage. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 10 of 72 Pin No. Mnemonic Description 17 VARCF Reactive Power Calibration Frequency Logic Output. It gives reactive power or apparent power information depending on the setting of the VACF bit of the WAVMODE register. This output is used for operational and calibration purposes. The full-scale output frequency can be scaled by writing to the VARCFNUM and VARCFDEN registers (see the Reactive Power Frequency Output section). 18 IRQ Interrupt Request Output. This is an active low open-drain logic output. Maskable interrupts include: an active energy register at half level, an apparent energy register at half level, and waveform sampling up to 26 kSPS (see the Interrupts section). 19 CLKIN Master Clock for ADCs and Digital Signal Processing. An external clock can be provided at this logic input. Alternatively, a parallel resonant AT crystal can be connected across CLKIN and CLKOUT to provide a clock source for the ADE7758. The clock frequency for specified operation is 10 MHz. Ceramic load capacitors of a few tens of picofarad should be used with the gate oscillator circuit. Refer to the crystal manufacturer’s data sheet for the load capacitance requirements 20 CLKOUT A crystal can be connected across this pin and CLKIN as previously described to provide a clock source for the ADE7758. The CLKOUT pin can drive one CMOS load when either an external clock is supplied at CLKIN or a crystal is being used. 21 CS Chip Select. Part of the 4-wire serial interface. This active low logic input allows the ADE7758 to share the serial bus with several other devices (see the Serial Interface section). 22 DIN Data Input for the Serial Interface. Data is shifted in at this pin on the falling edge of SCLK (see the Serial Interface section). 23 SCLK Serial Clock Input for the Synchronous Serial Interface. All serial data transfers are synchronized to this clock (see the Serial Interface section). The SCLK has a Schmidt-trigger input for use with a clock source that has a slow edge transition time, for example, opto-isolator outputs. 24 DOUT Data Output for the Serial Interface. Data is shifted out at this pin on the rising edge of SCLK. This logic output is normally in a high impedance state, unless it is driving data onto the serial data bus (see the Serial Interface section). Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 11 of 72 TERMINOLOGY Measurement Error The error associated with the energy measurement made by the ADE7758 is defined by %100–×=EnergyTrueEnergyTrueADE7758byRegisteredEnergyErrortMeasuremen (1) Phase Error Between Channels The high-pass filter (HPF) and digital integrator introduce a slight phase mismatch between the current and the voltage channel. The all-digital design ensures that the phase matching between the current channels and voltage channels in all three phases is within ±0.1° over a range of 45 Hz to 65 Hz and ±0.2° over a range of 40 Hz to 1 kHz. This internal phase mismatch can be combined with the external phase error (from current sensor or component tolerance) and calibrated with the phase calibration registers. Power Supply Rejection (PSR) This quantifies the ADE7758 measurement error as a percentage of reading when the power supplies are varied. For the ac PSR measurement, a reading at nominal supplies (5 V) is taken. A second reading is obtained with the same input signal levels when an ac signal (175 mV rms/100 Hz) is introduced onto the supplies. Any error introduced by this ac signal is expressed as a percentage of reading—see the Measurement Error definition. For the dc PSR measurement, a reading at nominal supplies (5 V) is taken. A second reading is obtained with the same input signal levels when the power supplies are varied ±5%. Any error introduced is again expressed as a percentage of the reading. ADC Offset Error This refers to the dc offset associated with the analog inputs to the ADCs. It means that with the analog inputs connected to AGND that the ADCs still see a dc analog input signal. The magnitude of the offset depends on the gain and input range selection (see the Typical Performance Characteristics section). However, when HPFs are switched on, the offset is removed from the current channels and the power calculation is not affected by this offset. Gain Error The gain error in the ADCs of the ADE7758 is defined as the difference between the measured ADC output code (minus the offset) and the ideal output code (see the Current Channel ADC section and the Voltage Channel ADC section). The difference is expressed as a percentage of the ideal code. Gain Error Match The gain error match is defined as the gain error (minus the offset) obtained when switching between a gain of 1, 2, or 4. It is expressed as a percentage of the output ADC code obtained under a gain of 1. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 12 of 72 TYPICAL PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS 0.5–0.5–0.4–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.30.40.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)+25°CPF = 1+85°C–40°C04443-006 Figure 6. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Temperature with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.3–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = +1, +25°CPF = +0.5, +25°CPF =–0.5, +25°CPF = +0.5, +85°CPF = +0.5,–40°C04443-007 Figure 7. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Power Factor with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.3–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)GAIN = +2GAIN = +4PF = 1GAIN = +104443-008 Figure 8. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading over Gain with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.20–0.20–0.15–0.10–0.0500.050.100.150.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF =–0.5, +25°CPF = +0.5, +25°CPF = +0.5,–40°CPF = +0.5, +85°C04443-009 Figure 9. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Temperature with External Reference and Integrator Off 0.50.6–0.2–0.3–0.4–0.100.10.20.30.44547495153555759616365LINE FREQUENCY (Hz)PERCENT ERROR (%)WITH RESPECT TO 55HzPF = 1PF = 0.504443-010 Figure 10. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Frequency with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.080.10–0.06–0.08–0.10–0.04–0.0200.020.040.060.010.1110100PERCENTFULL-SCALECURRENT(%)PERCENT ERROR (%)WITH RESPECTTO 5V; 3AVDD=5VVDD=5.25VVDD=4.75VPF=104443-011 Figure 11. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Power Supply with Internal Reference and Integrator Off Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 13 of 72 0.200.25–0.15–0.20–0.25–0.10–0.0500.050.100.150.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PHASE APHASE BPHASE CALL PHASESPF = 104443-012 Figure 12. APCF Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.4–0.4–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.30.010.1110100PF = 0, +25°CPF = 0, +85°CPF = 0,–40°CPERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)04443-013 Figure 13. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Temperature with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.8–0.8–0.6–0.4–0.200.20.40.60.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = 0, +25°CPF =–0.866, +25°CPF = +0.866, +25°CPF = +0.866, +85°CPF = +0.866,–40°C04443-014 Figure 14. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Power Factor with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.3–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = 0, +25°CPF = 0, +85°CPF = 0,–40°C04443-015 Figure 15. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Temperature with External Reference and Integrator Off 0.3–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = 0, +25°CPF =–0.866, +25°CPF = +0.866, +25°CPF = +0.866, +85°CPF = +0.866,–40°C04443-016 Figure 16. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Power Factor with External Reference and Integrator Off 0.8–0.8–0.6–0.4–0.200.20.40.64547495153555759616365LINE FREQUENCY (Hz)PERCENT ERROR (%)WITH RESPECT TO 55HzPF = 0PF = 0.86604443-017 Figure 17. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Frequency with Internal Reference and Integrator Off ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 14 of 72 0.10–0.10–0.08–0.06–0.04–0.0200.020.040.060.080.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)WITH RESPECT TO 5V; 3A5V5.25V4.75V04443-018 Figure 18. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Supply with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.3–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)GAIN = +1GAIN = +2GAIN = +4PF = 004443-019 Figure 19. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading over Gain with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.4–0.4–0.2–0.3–0.100.10.20.30.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PHASE AALL PHASESPHASE CPHASE BPF = 104443-020 Figure 20. VARCF Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.3–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)+25°C+85°C–40°C04443-021 Figure 21. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +4) over Temperature with Internal Reference and Integrator On 0.50.4–0.5–0.4–0.2–0.3–0.100.10.20.30.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = +1, +25°CPF =–0.5, +25°CPF = +0.5, +25°CPF = +0.5, +85°CPF = +0.5,–40°C04443-022 Figure 22. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +4) over Power Factor with Internal Reference and Integrator On 0.8–0.8–0.4–0.6–0.200.20.40.60.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = 0, +25°CPF = +0.866, +25°CPF =–0.866, +25°CPF =–0.866, +85°CPF =–0.866,–40°C04443-023 Figure 23. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +4) over Power Factor with Internal Reference and Integrator On Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 15 of 72 0.4–0.5–0.4–0.2–0.3–0.100.10.20.30.010.1110100PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)+25°C+85°C–40°CPF = 004443-024 Figure 24. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +4) over Temperature with Internal Reference and Integrator On 0.50.4–0.5–0.4–0.2–0.3–0.100.10.20.34547495153555759616365LINE FREQUENCY (Hz)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = 1PF = 0.504443-025 Figure 25. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +4) over Frequency with Internal Reference and Integrator On 1.21.0–0.8–0.6–0.2–0.400.20.40.60.84547495153555759616365LINE FREQUENCY (Hz)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = 0.866PF = 004443-026 Figure 26. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +4) over Frequency with Internal Reference and Integrator On 0.80.6–1.2–1.0–0.6–0.8–0.4–0.200.20.40.010.1110100PF = 0.5PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)PF = 104443-027 Figure 27. IRMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) with Internal Reference and Integrator Off 0.80.6–1.0–0.6–0.8–0.4–0.200.20.40.1110100PF = +1PF =–0.5PERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)04443-028 Figure 28. IRMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +4) with Internal Reference and Integrator On 0.4–0.4–0.3–0.2–0.100.10.20.3110100VOLTAGE (V)PERCENT ERROR (%)04443-029 Figure 29. VRMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) with Internal Reference ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 16 of 72 1.5–1.5–1.0–0.500.51.00.011100.1100+25°C+85°C–40°CPERCENT FULL-SCALE CURRENT (%)PERCENT ERROR (%)04443-030 –2024681012182115129630CH 1 PhB OFFSET (mV)HITSMEAN: 6.5149SD: 2.81604443-032 Figure 30. Apparent Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = +1) over Temperature with Internal Reference and Integrator Off Figure 32. Phase B Channel 1 Offset Distribution 2468101412121086420CH 1 PhC OFFSET (mV)HITSMEAN: 6.69333SD: 2.7044304443-033 –4–20246810121815129630CH 1 PhA OFFSET (mV)HITSMEAN: 5.55393SD: 3.298504443-031 Figure 33. Phase C Channel 1 Offset Distribution Figure 31. Phase A Channel 1 Offset Distribution Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 17 of 72 TEST CIRCUITS REFIN/OUT33nF1kΩ100nF33nF1kΩ10μFVDDVNIANIBPIBNICPICNVAPAVDDDVDDVBPVCPAGNDDGNDDOUTSCLKAPCFCLKOUTCLKINCSDINIRQ10MHz22pF22pFPS2501-1131121TO FREQ.COUNTER142320IAPRBSAMEASIAP, IAN98710161514100nF10μF33nF1kΩ1MΩ220V33nF1kΩ825ΩITO SPI BUS341956242321221812SAMEASIAP, IANSAMEAS VAPSAMEAS VAPADE7758CURRENTTRANSFORMER17VARCFCT TURN RATIO 1800:1CHANNEL 2 GAIN = +1CHANNEL 1 GAINRB110Ω25Ω42.5Ω81.25Ω04443-034 Figure 34. Test Circuit for Integrator Off REFIN/OUT33nF1kΩ33nF1kΩ33nF1kΩ33nF1kΩ100nF10μFVDDVNIANIBPIBNICPICNVAPAVDDDVDDVBPVCPAGNDDGNDDOUTSCLKAPCFCLKOUTCLKINCSDINIRQ10MHz22pF22pFPS2501-1131121TO FREQ.COUNTER142320IAPSAMEASIAP, IAN98710161514100nF10μF33nF1kΩ1MΩ220V33nF1kΩ825ΩTO SPI BUS341956242321221812SAMEASIAP, IANSAMEAS VAPSAMEAS VAPADE7758Idi/dt SENSOR17VARCFCHANNEL 1 GAIN = +8CHANNEL 2 GAIN = +104443-035 Figure 35. Test Circuit for Integrator On ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 18 of 72 THEORY OF OPERATION ANTIALIASING FILTER This filter prevents aliasing, which is an artifact of all sampled systems. Input signals with frequency components higher than half the ADC sampling rate distort the sampled signal at a fre-quency below half the sampling rate. This happens with all ADCs, regardless of the architecture. The combination of the high sampling rate Σ-Δ ADC used in the ADE7758 with the relatively low bandwidth of the energy meter allows a very simple low-pass filter (LPF) to be used as an antialiasing filter. A simple RC filter (single pole) with a corner frequency of 10 kHz produces an attenuation of approximately 40 dB at 833 kHz. This is usually sufficient to eliminate the effects of aliasing. ANALOG INPUTS The ADE7758 has six analog inputs divided into two channels: current and voltage. The current channel consists of three pairs of fully differential voltage inputs: IAP and IAN, IBP and IBN, and ICP and ICN. These fully differential voltage input pairs have a maximum differential signal of ±0.5 V. The current channel has a programmable gain amplifier (PGA) with possible gain selection of 1, 2, or 4. In addition to the PGA, the current channels also have a full-scale input range selection for the ADC. The ADC analog input range selection is also made using the gain register (see Figure 38). As mentioned previously, the maximum differential input voltage is ±0.5 V. However, by using Bit 3 and Bit 4 in the gain register, the maximum ADC input voltage can be set to ±0.5 V, ±0.25 V, or ±0.125 V on the current channels. This is achieved by adjusting the ADC reference (see the Reference Circuit section). Figure 36 shows the maximum signal levels on the current channel inputs. The maximum common-mode signal is ±25 mV, as shown in Figure 37. DIFFERENTIAL INPUTV1 + V2 = 500mV MAX PEAK+500mVVCMV1IAP, IBP,OR ICPVCM–500mVCOMMON-MODE±25mV MAXV1 + V2V2IAN, IBN,OR ICN04443-036 Figure 36. Maximum Signal Levels, Current Channels, Gain = 1 The voltage channel has three single-ended voltage inputs: VAP, VBP, and VCP. These single-ended voltage inputs have a maximum input voltage of ±0.5 V with respect to VN. Both the current and voltage channel have a PGA with possible gain selections of 1, 2, or 4. The same gain is applied to all the inputs of each channel. Figure 37 shows the maximum signal levels on the voltage channel inputs. The maximum common-mode signal is ±25 mV, as shown in Figure 36. SINGLE-ENDED INPUT±500mV MAX PEAK+500mVAGNDVCMV2VAP, VBP,OR VCPVCM–500mVCOMMON-MODE±25mV MAXVNV204443-037 Figure 37. Maximum Signal Levels, Voltage Channels, Gain = 1 The gain selections are made by writing to the gain register. Bit 0 to Bit 1 select the gain for the PGA in the fully differential current channel. The gain selection for the PGA in the single-ended voltage channel is made via Bit 5 to Bit 6. Figure 38 shows how a gain selection for the current channel is made using the gain register. IAP, IBP, ICPIAN, IBN, ICNVINK ×VINGAIN[7:0]GAIN (K)SELECTION04443-038 Figure 38. PGA in Current Channel Figure 39 shows how the gain settings in PGA 1 (current channel) and PGA 2 (voltage channel) are selected by various bits in the gain register. GAIN REGISTER1CURRENT AND VOLTAGE CHANNEL PGA CONTROL7 6 5 4 3 2 1 00 0 0 0 0 0 0 0ADDRESS: 0x23RESERVED1REGISTER CONTENTS SHOW POWER-ON DEFAULTSPGA 2 GAIN SELECT00 = ×101 = ×210 = ×4INTEGRATOR ENABLE0 = DISABLE1 = ENABLEPGA 1 GAIN SELECT00 = ×101 = ×210 = ×4CURRENT INPUT FULL-SCALE SELECT00 = 0.5V01 = 0.25V10 = 0.125V04443-039 Figure 39. Analog Gain Register Bit 7 of the gain register is used to enable the digital integrator in the current signal path. Setting this bit activates the digital integrator (see the DI/DT Current Sensor and Digital Integrator section). Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 19 of 72 CURRENT CHANNEL ADC Figure 41 shows the ADC and signal processing path for the input IA of the current channels (same for IB and IC). In waveform sampling mode, the ADC outputs are signed twos complement 24-bit data-words at a maximum of 26.0 kSPS (thousand samples per second). With the specified full-scale analog input signal of ±0.5 V, the ADC produces its maximum output code value (see Figure 41). This diagram shows a full-scale voltage signal being applied to the differential inputs IAP and IAN. The ADC output swings between 0xD7AE14 (−2,642,412) and 0x2851EC (+2,642,412). Current Channel Sampling The waveform samples of the current channel can be routed to the WFORM register at fixed sampling rates by setting the WAVSEL[2:0] bit in the WAVMODE register to 000 (binary) (see Table 20). The phase in which the samples are routed is set by setting the PHSEL[1:0] bits in the WAVMODE register. Energy calculation remains uninterrupted during waveform sampling. When in waveform sample mode, one of four output sample rates can be chosen by using Bit 5 and Bit 6 of the WAVMODE register (DTRT[1:0]). The output sample rate can be 26.04 kSPS, 13.02 kSPS, 6.51 kSPS, or 3.25 kSPS. By setting the WFSM bit in the interrupt mask register to Logic 1, the interrupt request output IRQ goes active low when a sample is available. The timing is shown in . The 24-bit waveform samples are transferred from the one byte (8-bits) at a time, with the most significant byte shifted out first. Figure 40ADE7758READ FROMWAVEFORM0SGNCURRENT CHANNEL DATA–24 BITS0x12SCLKDINDOUTIRQ04443-040 Figure 40. Current Channel Waveform Sampling The interrupt request output IRQ stays low until the interrupt routine reads the reset status register (see the section). InterruptsDIGITALINTEGRATOR1GAIN[7]ADCREFERENCEACTIVEAND REACTIVEPOWER CALCULATIONWAVEFORM SAMPLEREGISTERCURRENT RMS (IRMS)CALCULATIONIAPIANPGA1VINGAIN[4:3]2.42V, 1.21V, 0.6VGAIN[1:0]×1, ×2, ×4ANALOGINPUTRANGEVIN0V0.5V/GAIN0.25V/GAIN0.125V/GAINADC OUTPUTWORD RANGECHANNEL 1(CURRENTWAVEFORM)DATA RANGE0xD7AE140x0000000x2851EC50HzCHANNEL 1 (CURRENTWAVEFORM)DATA RANGEAFTER INTEGRATOR(50HzANDAIGAIN[11:0] = 0x000)0xCB2E480x0000000x34D1B860HzCHANNEL 1 (CURRENTWAVEFORM)DATA RANGEAFTER INTEGRATOR(60HzANDAIGAIN[11:0] = 0x000)0xD4176D0x0000000x2BE893HPF04443-0411WHEN DIGITAL INTEGRATOR IS ENABLED, FULL-SCALE OUTPUT DATA ISATTENUATED DEPENDING ON THE SIGNAL FREQUENCY BECAUSE THE INTEGRATOR HAS A –20dB/DECADE FREQUENCY RESPONSE. WHEN DISABLED, THE OUTPUT WILL NOT BE FURTHERATTENUATED. Figure 41. Current Channel Signal Path ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 20 of 72 DI/DT CURRENT SENSOR AND DIGITAL INTEGRATOR The di/dt sensor detects changes in the magnetic field caused by the ac current. Figure 42 shows the principle of a di/dt current sensor. MAGNETIC FIELD CREATED BY CURRENT (DIRECTLY PROPORTIONAL TO CURRENT) + EMF (ELECTROMOTIVE FORCE) – INDUCED BY CHANGES IN MAGNETIC FLUX DENSITY (di/dt) 04443-042 Figure 42. Principle of a di/dt Current Sensor The flux density of a magnetic field induced by a current is directly proportional to the magnitude of the current. The changes in the magnetic flux density passing through a conductor loop generate an electromotive force (EMF) between the two ends of the loop. The EMF is a voltage signal that is propor- tional to the di/dt of the current. The voltage output from the di/dt current sensor is determined by the mutual inductance between the current carrying conductor and the di/dt sensor. The current signal needs to be recovered from the di/dt signal before it can be used. An integrator is therefore necessary to restore the signal to its original form. The ADE7758 has a built- in digital integrator to recover the current signal from the di/dt sensor. The digital integrator on Channel 1 is disabled by default when the ADE7758 is powered up. Setting the MSB of the GAIN[7:0] register turns on the integrator. Figure 43 to Figure 46 show the magnitude and phase response of the digital integrator. 10 100 1k 10k 20 –50 –40 –30 –20 –10 0 10 FREQUENCY (Hz) GAIN (dB) 04443-043 Figure 43. Combined Gain Response of the Digital Integrator and Phase Compensator 10 100 1k 10k 80 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 FREQUENCY (Hz) PHASE (Degrees) 04443-044 Figure 44. Combined Phase Response of the Digital Integrator and Phase Compensator 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 5 –1 0 1 2 3 4 FREQUENCY (Hz) MAGNITUDE (dB) 04443-045 Figure 45. Combined Gain Response of the Digital Integrator and Phase Compensator (40 Hz to 70 Hz) 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 89.80 90.10 90.05 90.00 89.95 89.90 89.85 FREQUENCY (Hz) PHASE (Degrees) 04443-046 Figure 46. Combined Phase Response of the Digital Integrator and Phase Compensator (40 Hz to 70 Hz) Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 21 of 72 Note that the integrator has a −20 dB/dec attenuation and approximately −90° phase shift. When combined with a di/dt sensor, the resulting magnitude and phase response should be a flat gain over the frequency band of interest. However, the di/dt sensor has a 20 dB/dec gain associated with it and generates significant high frequency noise. A more effective antialiasing filter is needed to avoid noise due to aliasing (see the Theory of Operation section). When the digital integrator is switched off, the ADE7758 can be used directly with a conventional current sensor, such as a current transformer (CT) or a low resistance current shunt. PEAK CURRENT DETECTION The ADE7758 can be programmed to record the peak of the current waveform and produce an interrupt if the current exceeds a preset limit. Peak Current Detection Using the PEAK Register The peak absolute value of the current waveform within a fixed number of half-line cycles is stored in the IPEAK register. Figure 47 illustrates the timing behavior of the peak current detection. L2 L1 CONTENT OF IPEAK[7:0] 00 L1L2L1 NO. OF HALF LINE CYCLES SPECIFIED BY LINECYC[15:0] REGISTER CURRENT WAVEFORM (PHASE SELECTED BY PEAKSEL[2:0] IN MMODE REGISTER) 04443-047 Figure 47. Peak Current Detection Using the IPEAK Register Note that the content of the IPEAK register is equivalent to Bit 14 to Bit 21 of the current waveform sample. At full-scale analog input, the current waveform sample is 0x2851EC. The IPEAK at full-scale input is therefore expected to be 0xA1. In addition, multiple phases can be activated for the peak detection simultaneously by setting more than one of the PEAKSEL[2:4] bits in the MMODE register to logic high. These bits select the phase for both voltage and current peak measurements. Note that if more than one bit is set, the VPEAK and IPEAK registers can hold values from two different phases, that is, the voltage and current peak are independently processed (see the Peak Current Detection section). Note that the number of half-line cycles is based on counting the zero crossing of the voltage channel. The ZXSEL[2:0] bits in the LCYCMODE register determine which voltage channels are used for the zero-crossing detection. The same signal is also used for line cycle energy accumulation mode if activated (see the Line Cycle Accumulation Mode Register (0X17) section). OVERCURRENT DETECTION INTERRUPT Figure 48 illustrates the behavior of the overcurrent detection. IPINTLVL[7:0] READ RSTATUS REGISTER PKI INTERRUPT FLAG (BIT 15 OF STATUS REGISTER) PKI RESET LOW WHEN RSTATUS REGISTER IS READ CURRENT PEAK WAVEFORM BEING MONITORED (SELECTED BY PKIRQSEL[2:0] IN MMODE REGISTER) 04443-048 Figure 48. ADE7758 Overcurrent Detection Note that the content of the IPINTLVL[7:0] register is equivalent to Bit 14 to Bit 21 of the current waveform sample. Therefore, setting this register to 0xA1 represents putting peak detection at full-scale analog input. Figure 48 shows a current exceeding a threshold. The overcurrent event is recorded by setting the PKI flag (Bit 15) in the interrupt status register. If the PKI enable bit is set to Logic 1 in the interrupt mask register, the IRQ logic output goes active low (see the Interrupts section). Similar to peak level detection, multiple phases can be activated for peak detection. If any of the active phases produce waveform samples above the threshold, the PKI flag in the interrupt status register is set. The phase of which overcurrent is monitored is set by the PKIRQSEL[2:0] bits in the MMODE register (see Table 19). ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 22 of 72 ADCTO VOLTAGE RMSCALCULATION ANDWAVEFORM SAMPLINGTO ACTIVE ANDREACTIVE ENERGYCALCULATIONVAP+–VNPGAVAGAIN[6:5]×1, ×2, ×4LPF OUTPUTWORD RANGE0xD8690x00x279750HzLPF OUTPUTWORD RANGE0xD8B80x00x274860Hz0xD7AE0x00x2852PHASECALIBRATIONPHCAL[6:0]ΦANALOG INPUTRANGEVA0V0.5VGAINLPF1f3dB = 260Hz04443-049 Figure 49. ADC and Signal Processing in Voltage Channel VOLTAGE CHANNEL ADC Figure 49 shows the ADC and signal processing chain for the input VA in the voltage channel. The VB and VC channels have similar processing chains. For active and reactive energy measurements, the output of the ADC passes to the multipliers directly and is not filtered. This solution avoids the much larger multibit multiplier and does not affect the accuracy of the measurement. An HPF is not implemented on the voltage channel to remove the dc offset because the HPF on the current channel alone should be sufficient to eliminate error due to ADC offsets in the power calculation. However, ADC offset in the voltage channels produces large errors in the voltage rms calculation and affects the accuracy of the apparent energy calculation. Voltage Channel Sampling The waveform samples on the voltage channels can also be routed to the WFORM register. However, before passing to the WFORM register, the ADC outputs pass through a single-pole, low-pass filter (LPF1) with a cutoff frequency at 260 Hz. Figure 50 shows the magnitude and phase response of LPF1. This filter attenuates the signal slightly. For example, if the line frequency is 60 Hz, the signal at the output of LPF1 is attenuated by 3.575%. The waveform samples are 16-bit, twos complement data ranging between 0x2748 (+10,056d) and 0xD8B8 (−10,056d). The data is sign extended to 24-bit in the WFORM register. ()dB225.0974.0Hz260Hz60112−==⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛+=fH (3) 0–20–40–60–800–10–20–30–40101001kFREQUENCY (Hz)PHASE (Degrees)GAIN (dB)(60Hz;–0.2dB)(60Hz;–13°)04443-050 Figure 50. Magnitude and Phase Response of LPF1 Note that LPF1 does not affect the active and reactive energy calculation because it is only used in the waveform sampling signal path. However, waveform samples are used for the voltage rms calculation and the subsequent apparent energy accumulation. The WAVSEL[2:0] bits in the WAVMODE register should be set to 001 (binary) to start the voltage waveform sampling. The PHSEL[1:0] bits control the phase from which the samples are routed. In waveform sampling mode, one of four output sample rates can be chosen by changing Bit 5 and Bit 6 of the WAVMODE register (see Table 20). The available output sample rates are 26.0 kSPS, 13.5 kSPS, 6.5 kSPS, or 3.3 kSPS. By setting the WFSM bit in the interrupt mask register to Logic 1, the interrupt request output IRQ goes active low when a sample is available. The 24-bit waveform samples are transferred from the one byte (8 bits) at a time, with the most significant byte shifted out first. ADE7758 The sign of the register is extended in the upper 8 bits. The timing is the same as for the current channels, as seen in Figure 40. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 23 of 72 ZERO-CROSSING DETECTION The ADE7758 has zero-crossing detection circuits for each of the voltage channels (VAN, VBN, and VCN). Figure 51 shows how the zero-cross signal is generated from the output of the ADC of the voltage channel. REFERENCEADCZERO-CROSSINGDETECTORPGAVAN,VBN,VCNGAIN[6:5]×1,×2,×4LPF1f–3dB=260Hz24.8°@60HzANALOGVOLTAGEWAVEFORM(VAN,VBN, ORVCN)LPF1OUTPUTREADRSTATUSIRQ1.00.90804443-051 Figure 51. Zero-Crossing Detection on Voltage Channels The zero-crossing interrupt is generated from the output of LPF1. LPF1 has a single pole at 260 Hz (CLKIN = 10 MHz). As a result, there is a phase lag between the analog input signal of the voltage channel and the output of LPF1. The phase response of this filter is shown in the Voltage Channel Sampling section. The phase lag response of LPF1 results in a time delay of approximately 1.1 ms (at 60 Hz) between the zero crossing on the voltage inputs and the resulting zero-crossing signal. Note that the zero-crossing signal is used for the line cycle accumulation mode, zero-crossing interrupt, and line period/frequency measurement. When one phase crosses from negative to positive, the corresponding flag in the interrupt status register (Bit 9 to Bit 11) is set to Logic 1. An active low in the IRQ output also appears if the corresponding ZX bit in the interrupt mask register is set to Logic 1. Note that only zero crossing from negative to positive generates an interrupt. The flag in the interrupt status register is reset to 0 when the interrupt status register with reset (RSTATUS) is read. Each phase has its own interrupt flag and mask bit in the interrupt register. Zero-Crossing Timeout Each zero-crossing detection has an associated internal timeout register (not accessible to the user). This unsigned, 16-bit register is decreased by 1 every 384/CLKIN seconds. The registers are reset to a common user-programmed value, that is, the zero-crossing timeout register (ZXTOUT[15:0], Address 0x1B), every time a zero crossing is detected on its associated input. The default value of ZXTOUT is 0xFFFF. If the internal register decrements to 0 before a zero crossing at the corresponding input is detected, it indicates an absence of a zero crossing in the time determined by the ZXTOUT[15:0]. The ZXTOx detection bit of the corresponding phase in the interrupt status register is then switched on (Bit 6 to Bit 8). An active low on the IRQ output also appears if the ZXTOx mask bit for the corresponding phase in the interrupt mask register is set to Logic 1. shows the mechanism of the zero-crossing timeout detection when the Line Voltage A stays at a fixed dc level for more than 384/CLKIN × ZXTOUT[15:0] seconds. Figure 52ZXTOADETECTION BITREADRSTATUSVOLTAGECHANNEL AZXTOUT[15:0]16-BIT INTERNALREGISTER VALUE04443-052 Figure 52. Zero-Crossing Timeout Detection PHASE COMPENSATION When the HPF in the current channel is disabled, the phase error between the current channel (IA, IB, or IC) and the corresponding voltage channel (VA, VB, or VC) is negligible. When the HPF is enabled, the current channels have phase response (see Figure 53 through Figure 55). The phase response is almost 0 from 45 Hz to 1 kHz. The frequency band is sufficient for the requirements of typical energy measurement applications. However, despite being internally phase compensated, the ADE7758 must work with transducers that may have inherent phase errors. For example, a current transformer (CT) with a phase error of 0.1° to 0.3° is not uncommon. These phase errors can vary from part to part, and they must be corrected to perform accurate power calculations. The errors associated with phase mismatch are particularly noticeable at low power factors. The ADE7758 provides a means of digitally calibrating these small phase errors. The ADE7758 allows a small time delay or time advance to be introduced into the signal processing chain to compensate for the small phase errors. The phase calibration registers (APHCAL, BPHCAL, and CPHCAL) are twos complement, 7-bit sign-extended registers that can vary the time advance in the voltage channel signal path from +153.6 μs to −75.6 μs (CLKIN = 10 MHz), ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 24 of 72 407065605550450.200.150.100.050–0.05–0.10FREQUENCY (Hz)PHASE (Degrees)04443-054 respectively. Negative values written to the PHCAL registers represent a time advance, and positive values represent a time delay. One LSB is equivalent to 1.2 μs of time delay or 2.4 μs of time advance with a CLKIN of 10 MHz. With a line frequency of 60 Hz, this gives a phase resolution of 0.026° (360° × 1.2 μs × 60 Hz) at the fundamental in the positive direction (delay) and 0.052° in the negative direction (advance). This corresponds to a total correction range of −3.32° to +1.63° at 60 Hz. Figure 56 illustrates how the phase compensation is used to remove a 0.1° phase lead in IA of the current channel from the external current transducer. To cancel the lead (0.1°) in the current channel of Phase A, a phase lead must be introduced into the corresponding voltage channel. The resolution of the phase adjustment allows the introduction of a phase lead of 0.104°. The phase lead is achieved by introducing a time advance into VA. A time advance of 4.8 μs is made by writing −2 (0x7E) to the time delay block (APHCAL[6:0]), thus reducing the amount of time delay by 4.8 μs or equivalently, 360° × 4.8 μs × 60 Hz = 0.104° at 60 Hz. Figure 54. Phase Response of the HPF and Phase Compensation (40 Hz to 70 Hz) 445654525048460.100.080.060.040.020–0.02FREQUENCY (Hz)PHASE (Degrees)04443-055 01002003004005006007008001k9009001020304050607080FREQUENCY (Hz)PHASE (Degrees)04443-053 Figure 55. Phase Response of HPF and Phase Compensation (44 Hz to 56 Hz) Figure 53. Phase Response of the HPF and Phase Compensation (10 Hz to 1 kHz) Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 25 of 72 PGA1IAPIANIAADCHPFPGA2VAPVNVAADC60Hz0.1°IAVARANGE OF PHASECALIBRATION111110060APHCAL[6:0]–153.6μsTO +75.6μsVAVAADVANCED BY 4.8μs(+0.104° @ 60Hz)0x7EIA60HzDIGITALINTEGRATORACTIVE ANDREACTIVEENERGYCALCULATION+1.36°, –2.76° @ 50Hz; 0.022°, 0.043°+1.63°, –3.31° @ 60Hz; 0.026°, 0.052°04443-056 Figure 56. Phase Calibration on Voltage Channels PERIOD MEASUREMENT The ADE7758 provides the period or frequency measurement of the line voltage. The period is measured on the phase specified by Bit 0 to Bit 1 of the MMODE register. The period register is an unsigned 12-bit FREQ register and is updated every four periods of the selected phase. Bit 7 of the LCYCMODE selects whether the period register displays the frequency or the period. Setting this bit causes the register to display the period. The default setting is logic low, which causes the register to display the frequency. When set to measure the period, the resolution of this register is 96/CLKIN per LSB (9.6 μs/LSB when CLKIN is 10 MHz), which represents 0.06% when the line frequency is 60 Hz. At 60 Hz, the value of the period register is 1737d. At 50 Hz, the value of the period register is 2084d. When set to measure frequency, the value of the period register is approximately 960d at 60 Hz and 800d at 50 Hz. This is equivalent to 0.0625 Hz/LSB. LINE VOLTAGE SAG DETECTION The ADE7758 can be programmed to detect when the absolute value of the line voltage of any phase drops below a certain peak value for a number of half cycles. Each phase of the voltage channel is controlled simultaneously. This condition is illustrated in Figure 57. Figure 57 shows a line voltage fall below a threshold, which is set in the SAG level register (SAGLVL[7:0]), for nine half cycles. Because the SAG cycle register indicates a six half-cycle threshold (SAGCYC[7:0] = 0x06), the SAG event is recorded at the end of the sixth half cycle by setting the SAG flag of the corresponding phase in the interrupt status register (Bit 1 to Bit 3 in the interrupt status register). If the SAG enable bit is set to Logic 1 for this phase (Bit 1 to Bit 3 in the interrupt mask register), the IRQ logic output goes active low (see the section). The phases are compared to the same parameters defined in the SAGLVL and SAGCYC registers. InterruptsSAGLVL[7:0]FULL-SCALEREAD RSTATUSREGISTERSAGCYC[7:0]=0x066HALFCYCLESSAG INTERRUPT FLAG(BIT 3 TO BIT 5 OFSTATUS REGISTER)VAP, VBP, OR VCPSAG EVENT RESET LOWWHEN VOLTAGE CHANNELEXCEEDS SAGLVL[7:0]04443-057 Figure 57. ADE7758 SAG Detection Figure 57 shows a line voltage fall below a threshold, which is set in the SAG level register (SAGLVL[7:0]), for nine half cycles. Because the SAG cycle register indicates a six half-cycle threshold (SAGCYC[7:0] = 0x06), the SAG event is recorded at the end of the sixth half cycle by setting the SAG flag of the corresponding phase in the interrupt status register (Bit 1 to Bit 3 in the interrupt status register). If the SAG enable bit is set to Logic 1 for this phase (Bit 1 to Bit 3 in the interrupt mask register), the IRQ logic output goes active low (see the section). The phases are compared to the same parameters defined in the SAGLVL and SAGCYC registers. Interrupts ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 26 of 72 SAG LEVEL SET The contents of the single-byte SAG level register, SAGLVL[0:7], are compared to the absolute value of Bit 6 to Bit 13 from the voltage waveform samples. For example, the nominal maximum code of the voltage channel waveform samples with a full-scale signal input at 60 Hz is 0x2748 (see the Voltage Channel Sampling section). Bit 13 to Bit 6 are 0x9D. Therefore, writing 0x9D to the SAG level register puts the SAG detection level at full scale and sets the SAG detection to its most sensitive value. The detection is made when the content of the SAGLVL[7:0] register is greater than the incoming sample. Writing 0x00 puts the SAG detection level at 0. The detection of a decrease of an input voltage is disabled in this case. PEAK VOLTAGE DETECTION The ADE7758 can record the peak of the voltage waveform and produce an interrupt if the current exceeds a preset limit. Peak Voltage Detection Using the VPEAK Register The peak absolute value of the voltage waveform within a fixed number of half-line cycles is stored in the VPEAK register. Figure 58 illustrates the timing behavior of the peak voltage detection. L2L1CONTENT OFVPEAK[7:0]00L1L2L1NO. OF HALFLINE CYCLESSPECIFIED BYLINECYC[15:0]REGISTERVOLTAGE WAVEFORM(PHASE SELECTED BYPEAKSEL[2:4]IN MMODE REGISTER)04443-058 Figure 58. Peak Voltage Detection Using the VPEAK Register Note that the content of the VPEAK register is equivalent to Bit 6 to Bit 13 of the 16-bit voltage waveform sample. At full-scale analog input, the voltage waveform sample at 60 Hz is 0x2748. The VPEAK at full-scale input is, therefore, expected to be 0x9D. In addition, multiple phases can be activated for the peak detection simultaneously by setting multiple bits among the PEAKSEL[2:4] bits in the MMODE register. These bits select the phase for both voltage and current peak measurements. Note that if more than one bit is set, the VPEAK and IPEAK registers can hold values from two different phases, that is, the voltage and current peak are independently processed (see the Peak Current Detection section). Note that the number of half-line cycles is based on counting the zero crossing of the voltage channel. The ZXSEL[2:0] bits in the LCYCMODE register determine which voltage channels are used for the zero-crossing detection (see Table 22). The same signal is also used for line cycle energy accumulation mode if activated. Overvoltage Detection Interrupt Figure 59 illustrates the behavior of the overvoltage detection. VPINTLVL[7:0]READ RSTATUSREGISTERPKV INTERRUPT FLAG(BIT 14 OF STATUSREGISTER)PKV RESET LOWWHEN RSTATUSREGISTER IS READVOLTAGE PEAK WAVEFORM BEING MONITORED(SELECTED BY PKIRQSEL[5:7] IN MMODE REGISTER)04443-059 Figure 59. ADE7758 Overvoltage Detection Note that the content of the VPINTLVL[7:0] register is equivalent to Bit 6 to Bit 13 of the 16-bit voltage waveform samples; therefore, setting this register to 0x9D represents putting the peak detection at full-scale analog input. Figure 59 shows a voltage exceeding a threshold. By setting the PKV flag (Bit 14) in the interrupt status register, the overvoltage event is recorded. If the PKV enable bit is set to Logic 1 in the interrupt mask register, the IRQ logic output goes active low (see the section). Interrupts Multiple phases can be activated for peak detection. If any of the active phases produce waveform samples above the threshold, the PKV flag in the interrupt status register is set. The phase in which overvoltage is monitored is set by the PKIRQSEL[5:7] bits in the MMODE register (see Table 19). PHASE SEQUENCE DETECTION The ADE7758 has an on-chip phase sequence error detection interrupt. This detection works on phase voltages and considers all associated zero crossings. The regular succession of these zero crossings events is a negative to positive transition on Phase A, followed by a positive to negative transition on Phase C, followed by a negative to positive transition on Phase B, and so on. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 27 of 72 On the ADE7758, if the regular succession of the zero crossings presented above happens, the SEQERR bit (Bit 19) in the STATUS register is set (Figure 60). If SEQERR is set in the mask register, the IRQ logic output goes active low (see the section). Interrupts If the regular zero crossing succession does not occur, that is when a negative to positive transition on Phase A followed by a positive to negative transition on Phase B, followed by a negative to positive transition on Phase C, and so on, the SEQERR bit (Bit 19) in the STATUS register is cleared to 0. To have the ADE7758 trigger SEQERR status bit when the zero crossing regular succession does not occur, the analog inputs for Phase C and Phase B should be swapped. In this case, the Phase B voltage input should be wired to the VCP pin, and the Phase C voltage input should be wired to the VBP pin. 04443-060ABSEQERR BIT OF STATUS REGISTER IS SETA = 0°B = –120°C = +120°CVOLTAGEWAVEFORMSZEROCROSSINGSCABCACAB Figure 60. Regular Phase Sequence Sets SEQERR Bit to 1 04443-160ACSEQERR BIT OF STATUS REGISTER IS NOT SETA = 0°C = –120°B = +120°BZEROCROSSINGSVOLTAGEWAVEFORMSBACBABAC Figure 61. Erroneous Phase Sequence Clears SEQERR Bit to 0 POWER-SUPPLY MONITOR The ADE7758 also contains an on-chip power-supply monitor. The analog supply (AVDD) is monitored continuously by the ADE7758. If the supply is less than 4 V ± 5%, the ADE7758 goes into an inactive state, that is, no energy is accumulated when the supply voltage is below 4 V. This is useful to ensure correct device operation at power-up and during power-down. The power-supply monitor has built-in hysteresis and filtering. This gives a high degree of immunity to false triggering due to noisy supplies. When AVDD returns above 4 V ± 5%, the ADE7758 waits 18 μs for the voltage to achieve the recommended voltage range, 5 V ± 5% and then becomes ready to function. Figure 62 shows the behavior of the ADE7758 when the voltage of AVDD falls below the power-supply monitor threshold. The power supply and decoupling for the part should be designed such that the ripple at AVDD does not exceed 5 V ± 5% as specified for normal operation. AVDD5V4V0VADE7758INTERNALCALCULATIONSACTIVEINACTIVEINACTIVETIME04443-061 Figure 62. On-Chip, Power-Supply Monitoring REFERENCE CIRCUIT The nominal reference voltage at the REFIN/OUT pin is 2.42 V. This is the reference voltage used for the ADCs in the ADE7758. However, the current channels have three input range selections (full scale is selectable among 0.5 V, 0.25 V, and 0.125 V). This is achieved by dividing the reference internally by 1, ½, and ¼. The reference value is used for the ADC in the current channels. Note that the full-scale selection is only available for the current inputs. The REFIN/OUT pin can be overdriven by an external source, for example, an external 2.5 V reference. Note that the nominal reference value supplied to the ADC is now 2.5 V and not 2.42 V. This has the effect of increasing the nominal analog input signal range by 2.5/2.42 × 100% = 3% or from 0.5 V to 0.5165 V. The voltage of the ADE7758 reference drifts slightly with temperature; see the Specifications section for the temperature coefficient specification (in ppm/°C). The value of the temperature drift varies from part to part. Because the reference is used for all ADCs, any ×% drift in the reference results in a 2×% deviation of the meter accuracy. The reference drift resulting from temperature changes is usually very small and typically much smaller than the drift of other components on a meter. Alternatively, the meter can be calibrated at multiple temperatures. TEMPERATURE MEASUREMENT The ADE7758 also includes an on-chip temperature sensor. A temperature measurement is made every 4/CLKIN seconds. The output from the temperature sensing circuit is connected to an ADC for digitizing. The resultant code is processed and placed in the temperature register (TEMP[7:0]). This register can be read by the user and has an address of 0x11 (see the Serial Interface section). The contents of the temperature register are signed (twos complement) with a resolution of 3°C/LSB. The offset of this register may vary significantly from part to part. To calibrate this register, the nominal value should be measured, and the equation should be adjusted accordingly. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 28 of 72 Temp (°C) = [(TEMP[7:0] − Offset) × 3°C/LSB] + Ambient(°C) (4) For example, if the temperature register produces a code of 0x46 at ambient temperature (25°C), and the temperature register currently reads 0x50, then the temperature is 55°C : Temp (°C) = [(0x50 – 0x46) × 3°C/LSB] + 25°C = 55°C Depending on the nominal value of the register, some finite temperature can cause the register to roll over. This should be compensated for in the system master (MCU). The ADE7758 temperature register varies with power supply. It is recommended to use the temperature register only in applications with a fixed, stable power supply. Typical error with respect to power supply variation is show in Table 5. Table 5. Temperature Register Error with Power Supply Variation 4.5 V 4.75 V 5 V 5.25 V 5.5 V Register Value 219 216 214 211 208 % Error +2.34 +0.93 0 −1.40 −2.80 ROOT MEAN SQUARE MEASUREMENT Root mean square (rms) is a fundamental measurement of the magnitude of an ac signal. Its definition can be both practical and mathematical. Defined practically, the rms value assigned to an ac signal is the amount of dc required to produce an equivalent amount of power in the load. Mathematically, the rms value of a continuous signal f(t) is defined as ()dtT120TtfFRMS∫= (5) For time sampling signals, rms calculation involves squaring the signal, taking the average, and obtaining the square root. ][112nfNFRMSNnΣ== (6) The method used to calculate the rms value in the ADE7758 is to low-pass filter the square of the input signal (LPF3) and take the square root of the result (see Figure 63). i(t) = √2 × IRMS × sin(ωt) (7) then i2(t) = IRMS2 − IRMS2 × cos(ωt) (8) The rms calculation is simultaneously processed on the six analog input channels. Each result is available in separate registers. While the ADE7758 measures nonsinusoidal signals, it should be noted that the voltage rms measurement, and therefore the apparent energy, are bandlimited to 260 Hz. The current rms as well as the active power have a bandwidth of 14 kHz. Current RMS Calculation Figure 63 shows the detail of the signal processing chain for the rms calculation on one of the phases of the current channel. The current channel rms value is processed from the samples used in the current channel waveform sampling mode. The current rms values are stored in 24-bit registers (AIRMS, BIRMS, and CIRMS). One LSB of the current rms register is equivalent to one LSB of the current waveform sample. The update rate of the current rms measurement is CLKIN/12. SGN224223222216215214CURRENT SIGNALFROM HPF ORINTEGRATOR(IF ENABLED)0x1D37810x00++0x2851EC0x00xD7AE14X2LPF3AIRMS[23:0]AIRMSOS[11:0]04443-062 Figure 63. Current RMS Signal Processing With the specified full-scale analog input signal of 0.5 V, the ADC produces an output code that is approximately ±2,642,412d (see the Current Channel ADC section). The equivalent rms value of a full-scale sinusoidal signal at 60 Hz is 1,914,753 (0x1D3781). The accuracy of the current rms is typically 0.5% error from the full-scale input down to 1/500 of the full-scale input. Additionally, this measurement has a bandwidth of 14 kHz. It is recommended to read the rms registers synchronous to the voltage zero crossings to ensure stability. The IRQ can be used to indicate when a zero crossing has occurred (see the Interrupts section). Table 6 shows the settling time for the IRMS measurement, which is the time it takes for the rms register to reflect the value at the input to the current channel. Table 6. Settling Time for IRMS Measurement 63% 100% Integrator Off 80 ms 960 ms Integrator On 40 ms 1.68 sec Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 29 of 72 Current RMS Offset Compensation The ADE7758 incorporates a current rms offset compensation register for each phase (AIRMSOS, BIRMSOS, and CIRMSOS). These are 12-bit signed registers that can be used to remove offsets in the current rms calculations. An offset can exist in the rms calculation due to input noises that are integrated in the dc component of I2(t). Assuming that the maximum value from the current rms calculation is 1,914,753d with full-scale ac inputs (60 Hz), one LSB of the current rms offset represents 0.94% of the measurement error at 60 dB down from full scale. The IRMS measurement is undefined at zero input. Calibration of the offset should be done at low current and values at zero input should be ignored. For details on how to calibrate the current rms measurement, see the Calibration section. IRMS IRMS 2 IRMSOS 0    16384 (9) where IRMS0 is the rms measurement without offset correction. Table 7. Approximate IRMS Register Values Frequency (Hz) Integrator Off (d) Integrator On (d) 50 1,921,472 2,489,581 60 1,914,752 2,067,210 Voltage Channel RMS Calculation Figure 64 shows the details of the signal path for the rms estimation on Phase A of the voltage channel. This voltage rms estimation is done in the ADE7758 using the mean absolute value calculation, as shown in Figure 64.The voltage channel rms value is processed from the waveform samples after the low-pass filter LPF1. The output of the voltage channel ADC can be scaled by ±50% by changing VRMSGAIN[11:0] registers to perform an overall rms voltage calibration. The VRMSGAIN registers scale the rms calculations as well as the apparent energy calculation because apparent power is the product of the voltage and current rms values. The voltage rms values are stored in 24-bit registers (AVRMS, BVRMS, and CVRMS). One LSB of a voltage waveform sample is approximately equivalent to 256 LSBs of the voltage rms register. The update rate of the voltage rms measurement is CLKIN/12. With the specified full-scale ac analog input signal of 0.5 V, the LPF1 produces an output code that is approximately 63% of its full-scale value, that is, ±9,372d, at 60 Hz (see the Voltage Channel ADC section). The equivalent rms value of a full-scale ac signal is approximately 1,639,101 (0x1902BD) in the VRMS register. The accuracy of the VRMS measurement is typically 0.5% error from the full-scale input down to 1/20 of the full-scale input. Additionally, this measurement has a bandwidth of 260 Hz. It is recommended to read the rms registers synchronous to the voltage zero crossings to ensure stability. The IRQ can be used to indicate when a zero crossing has occurred (see the Interrupts section). VAN AVRMSGAIN[11:0] 0x2748 LPF OUTPUT WORD RANGE 0x0 60Hz 0xD8B8 0x2797 LPF OUTPUT WORD RANGE 0x0 50Hz 0xD869 LPF1 VOLTAGE SIGNAL–V(t) 0.5 GAIN 0x193504 50Hz 0x0 0x1902BD 60Hz 0x0 |X| AVRMS[23:0] LPF3 SGN216 215 214 28 27 26 VRMSOS[11:0] + + 04443-063 Figure 64. Voltage RMS Signal Processing Table 8 shows the settling time for the VRMS measurement, which is the time it takes for the rms register to reflect the value at the input to the voltage channel. Table 8. Settling Time for VRMS Measurement 63% 100% 100 ms 960 ms Voltage RMS Offset Compensation The ADE7758 incorporates a voltage rms offset compensation for each phase (AVRMSOS, BVRMSOS, and CVRMSOS). These are 12-bit signed registers that can be used to remove offsets in the voltage rms calculations. An offset can exist in the rms calculation due to input noises and offsets in the input samples. It should be noted that the offset calibration does not allow the contents of the VRMS registers to be maintained at 0 when no voltage is applied. This is caused by noise in the voltage rms calculation, which limits the usable range between full scale and 1/50th of full scale. One LSB of the voltage rms offset is equivalent to 64 LSBs of the voltage rms register. Assuming that the maximum value from the voltage rms calculation is 1,639,101d with full-scale ac inputs, then 1 LSB of the voltage rms offset represents 0.042% of the measurement error at 1/10 of full scale. VRMS = VRMS0 + VRMSOS × 64 (10) where VRMS0 is the rms measurement without the offset correction. Table 9. Approximate VRMS Register Values Frequency (Hz) Value (d) 50 1,678,210 60 1,665,118 ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 30 of 72 Voltage RMS Gain Adjust The ADC gain in each phase of the voltage channel can be adjusted for the rms calculation by using the voltage rms gain registers (AVRMSGAIN, BVRMSGAIN, and CVRMSGAIN). The gain of the voltage waveforms before LPF1 is adjusted by writing twos complement, 12-bit words to the voltage rms gain registers. Equation 11 shows how the gain adjustment is related to the contents of the voltage gain register.        212 ValuesWithout Gain 1 VRMSGAIN RMS Nominal VRMSRegister ofContent (11) For example, when 0x7FF is written to the voltage gain register, the RMS value is scaled up by 50%. 0x7FF = 2047d 2047/212 = 0.5 Similarly, when 0x800, which equals –2047d (signed twos complement), is written the ADC output is scaled by –50%. ACTIVE POWER CALCULATION Electrical power is defined as the rate of energy flow from source to load. It is given by the product of the voltage and current waveforms. The resulting waveform is called the instantaneous power signal and it is equal to the rate of energy flow at every instant of time. The unit of power is the watt or joules/sec. Equation 14 gives an expression for the instantaneous power signal in an ac system. v(t) = √2 × VRMS × sin(ωt) (12) i(t) = √2 × IRMS × sin(ωt) (13) where VRMS = rms voltage and IRMS = rms current. p(t) = v(t) × i(t) p(t) = IRMS × VRMS − IRMS × VRMS × cos(2ωt) (14) The average power over an integral number of line cycles (n) is given by the expression in Equation 15.   VRMS IRMS dttp nT p nT     0 1 (15) where: t is the line cycle period. P is referred to as the active or real power. Note that the active power is equal to the dc component of the instantaneous power signal p(t) in Equation 14, that is, VRMS × IRMS. This is the relationship used to calculate the active power in the ADE7758 for each phase. The instantaneous power signal p(t) is generated by multiplying the current and voltage signals in each phase. The dc component of the instantaneous power signal in each phase (A, B, and C) is then extracted by LPF2 (the low-pass filter) to obtain the average active power information on each phase. Figure 65 shows this process. The active power of each phase accumulates in the corresponding 16-bit watt-hour register (AWATTHR, BWATTHR, or CWATTHR). The input to each active energy register can be changed depending on the accumulation mode setting (see Table 22). INSTANTANEOUS POWER SIGNAL p(t) = VRMS×IRMS – VRMS×IRMS×cos(2ωt) ACTIVE REAL POWER SIGNAL = VRMS × IRMS 0x19999A VRMS ×IRMS 0xCCCCD 0x00000 CURRENT i(t) = 2 ×IRMS ×sin(ωt) VOLTAGE v(t) = 2 ×VRMS ×sin(ωt) 04443-064 Figure 65. Active Power Calculation Because LPF2 does not have an ideal brick wall frequency response (see Figure 66), the active power signal has some ripple due to the instantaneous power signal. This ripple is sinusoidal and has a frequency equal to twice the line frequency. Because the ripple is sinusoidal in nature, it is removed when the active power signal is integrated over time to calculate the energy. 0 –4 –8 –12 GAIN (dB) –16 –20 –24 1 3 18 0 FREQUENCY(Hz) 30 100 04443-065 Figure 66. Frequency Response of the LPF Used to Filter Instantaneous Power in Each Phase Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 31 of 72 Active Power Gain Calibration Note that the average active power result from the LPF output in each phase can be scaled by ±50% by writing to the phase’s watt gain register (AWG, BWG, or CWG). The watt gain registers are twos complement, signed registers and have a resolution of 0.024%/LSB. Equation 16 describes mathematically the function of the watt gain registers. ⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛+×=12212gisterReGainWattOutputLPFDataPowerAverage (16) The REVPAP bit (Bit 17) in the interrupt status register is set if the average power from any one of the phases changes sign. The phases monitored are selected by TERMSEL bits in the COMPMODE register (see Table 21). The TERMSEL bits are also used to select which phases are included in the APCF and VARCF pulse outputs. If the REVPAP bit is set in the mask register, the IRQ logic output goes active low (see the section). Note that this bit is set whenever there are sign changes, that is, the REVPAP bit is set for both a positive-to-negative change and a negative-to-positive change of the sign bit. The response time of this bit is approximately 176 ms for a full-scale signal, which has an average value of 0xCCCCD at the low pass filter output. For smaller inputs, the time is longer. Interrupts The output is scaled by −50% by writing 0x800 to the watt gain registers and increased by +50% by writing 0x7FF to them. These registers can be used to calibrate the active power (or energy) calculation in the ADE7758 for each phase. CLKINValueAveragemsTimesponseRe4252601×⎥⎥⎦⎤⎢⎢⎣⎡+≅(17) Active Power Offset Calibration The APCFNUM [15:13] indicate reverse power on each of the individual phases. Bit 15 is set if the sign of the power on Phase A is negative, Bit 14 for Phase B, and Bit 13 for Phase C. The ADE7758 also incorporates a watt offset register on each phase (AWATTOS, BWATTOS, and CWATTOS). These are signed twos complement, 12-bit registers that are used to remove offsets in the active power calculations. An offset can exist in the power calculation due to crosstalk between channels on the PCB or in the chip itself. The offset calibration allows the contents of the active power register to be maintained at 0 when no power is being consumed. One LSB in the active power offset register is equivalent to 1/16 LSB in the active power multiplier output. At full-scale input, if the output from the multiplier is 0xCCCCD (838,861d), then 1 LSB in the LPF2 output is equivalent to 0.0075% of measurement error at 60 dB down from full scale on the current channel. At −60 dB down on full scale (the input signal level is 1/1000 of full-scale signal inputs), the average word value from LPF2 is 838.861 (838,861/1000). One LSB is equivalent to 1/838.861/16 × 100% = 0.0075% of the measured value. The active power offset register has a correction resolution equal to 0.0075% at −60 dB. No-Load Threshold The ADE7758 has an internal no-load threshold on each phase. The no-load threshold can be activated by setting the NOLOAD bit (Bit 7) of the COMPMODE register. If the active power falls below 0.005% of full-scale input, the energy is not accumulated in that phase. As stated, the average multiplier output with full-scale input is 0xCCCCD. Therefore, if the average multiplier output falls below 0x2A, the power is not accumulated to avoid creep in the meter. The no-load threshold is implemented only on the active energy accumulation. The reactive and apparent energies do not have the no-load threshold option. Active Energy Calculation As previously stated, power is defined as the rate of energy flow. This relationship can be expressed mathematically as dtdEnergyPower= (18) Sign of Active Power Calculation Note that the average active power is a signed calculation. If the phase difference between the current and voltage waveform is more than 90°, the average power becomes negative. Negative power indicates that energy is being placed back on the grid. The ADE7758 has a sign detection circuitry for active power calculation. Conversely, Energy is given as the integral of power. ()dtp∫=tEnergy (19) ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 32 of 72 AWG[11:0]WDIV[7:0]DIGITALINTEGRATORMULTIPLIERIVHPFCURRENT SIGNAL–i(t)0x2851EC0x000xD7AE14VOLTAGE SIGNAL–v(t)0x2852000x0xD7AE++++LPF2%SIGN26202–12–22–32–4AWATTOS[11:0]AWATTHR[15:0]150400TOTAL ACTIVE POWER ISACCUMULATED (INTEGRATED) INTHE ACTIVE ENERGY REGISTERTIME (nT)TAVERAGE POWERSIGNAL–P0xCCCCD0x00000PHCAL[6:0]Φ04443-066 Figure 67. ADE7758 Active Energy Accumulation The ADE7758 achieves the integration of the active power signal by continuously accumulating the active power signal in the internal 41-bit energy registers. The watt-hr registers (AWATTHR, BWATTHR, and CWATTHR) represent the upper 16 bits of these internal registers. This discrete time accumulation or summation is equivalent to integration in continuous time. Equation 20 expresses the relationship. ()()⎭⎬⎫⎩⎨⎧×==Σ∫∞=→00TLimnTnTpdttpEnergy (20) where: n is the discrete time sample number. T is the sample period. Figure 67 shows a signal path of this energy accumulation. The average active power signal is continuously added to the internal active energy register. This addition is a signed operation. Negative energy is subtracted from the active energy register. Note the values shown in Figure 67 are the nominal full-scale values, that is, the voltage and current inputs at the corresponding phase are at their full-scale input level. The average active power is divided by the content of the watt divider register before it is added to the corresponding watt-hr accumulation registers. When the value in the WDIV[7:0] register is 0 or 1, active power is accumulated without division. WDIV is an 8-bit unsigned register that is useful to lengthen the time it takes before the watt-hr accumulation registers overflow. Figure 68 shows the energy accumulation for full-scale signals (sinusoidal) on the analog inputs. The three displayed curves show the minimum time it takes for the watt-hr accumulation register to overflow when the watt gain register of the corre-sponding phase equals to 0x7FF, 0x000, and 0x800. The watt gain registers are used to carry out a power calibration in the ADE7758. As shown, the fastest integration time occurs when the watt gain registers are set to maximum full scale, that is, 0x7FF. This is the time it takes before overflow can be scaled by writing to the WDIV register and therefore can be increased by a maximum factor of 255. Note that the active energy register content can roll over to full-scale negative (0x8000) and continue increasing in value when the active power is positive (see Figure 67). Conversely, if the active power is negative, the energy register would under flow to full-scale positive (0x7FFF) and continue decreasing in value. By setting the AEHF bit (Bit 0) of the interrupt mask register, the ADE7758 can be configured to issue an interrupt (IRQ) when Bit 14 of any one of the three watt-hr accumulation registers has changed, indicating that the accumulation register is half full (positive or negative). Setting the RSTREAD bit (Bit 6) of the LCYMODE register enables a read-with-reset for the watt-hr accumulation registers, that is, the registers are reset to 0 after a read operation. CONTENTS OFWATT-HRACCUMULATION REGISTER0x7FFF0x3FFF0x00000xC0000x8000TIME (Sec)0.340.681.021.361.702.04WATT GAIN = 0x7FFWATT GAIN = 0x000WATT GAIN = 0x80004443-067 Figure 68. Energy Register Roll-Over Time for Full-Scale Power (Minimum and Maximum Power Gain) Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 33 of 72 Integration Time Under Steady Load The discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation register is 0.4 μs (4/CLKIN). With full-scale sinusoidal signals on the analog inputs and the watt gain registers set to 0x000, the average word value from each LPF2 is 0xCCCCD (see Figure 65 and Figure 67). The maximum value that can be stored in the watt-hr accumulation register before it overflows is 215 − 1 or 0x7FFF. Because the average word value is added to the internal register, which can store 240 − 1 or 0xFF, FFFF, FFFF before it overflows, the integration time under these conditions with WDIV = 0 is calculated as sec0.524μs0.40xCCCCDFFFFFFFF,0xFF,=×=Time (21) When WDIV is set to a value different from 0, the time before overflow is scaled accordingly as shown in Equation 22. Time = Time (WDIV = 0) × WDIV[7:0] (22) Energy Accumulation Mode The active power accumulated in each watt-hr accumulation register (AWATTHR, BWATTHR, or CWATTHR) depends on the configuration of the CONSEL bits in the COMPMODE register (Bit 0 and Bit 1). The different configurations are described in Table 10. Table 10. Inputs to Watt-Hr Accumulation Registers CONSEL[1, 0] AWATTHR BWATTHR CWATTHR 00 VA × IA VB × IB VC × IC 01 VA × (IA – IB) 0 VC × (IC – IB) 10 VA × (IA – IB) 0 VC × IC 11 Reserved Reserved Reserved Depending on the poly phase meter service, the appropriate formula should be chosen to calculate the active energy. The American ANSI C12.10 Standard defines the different configurations of the meter. Table 11 describes which mode should be chosen in these different configurations. Table 11. Meter Form Configuration ANSI Meter Form CONSEL (d) TERMSEL (d) 5S/13S 3-Wire Delta 0 3, 5, or 6 6S/14S 4-Wire Wye 1 7 8S/15S 4-Wire Delta 2 7 9S/16S 4-Wire Wye 0 7 Active Power Frequency Output Pin 1 (APCF) of the ADE7758 provides frequency output for the total active power. After initial calibration during manufac-turing, the manufacturer or end customer often verifies the energy meter calibration. One convenient way to verify the meter calibration is for the manufacturer to provide an output frequency that is proportional to the energy or active power under steady load conditions. This output frequency can provide a simple, single-wire, optically isolated interface to external calibration equipment. Figure 69 illustrates the energy-to-frequency conversion in the ADE7758. INPUTTOBWATTHRREGISTERINPUTTOAWATTHRREGISTERINPUTTOCWATTHRREGISTERDFCAPCFAPCFNUM[11:0]APCFDEN[11:0]÷+++÷404443-068 Figure 69. Active Power Frequency Output A digital-to-frequency converter (DFC) is used to generate the APCF pulse output from the total active power. The TERMSEL bits (Bit 2 to Bit 4) of the COMPMODE register can be used to select which phases to include in the total power calculation. Setting Bit 2, Bit 3, and Bit 4 includes the input to the AWATTHR, BWATTHR, and CWATTHR registers in the total active power calculation. The total active power is signed addition. However, setting the ABS bit (Bit 5) in the COMPMODE register enables the absolute-only mode; that is, only the absolute value of the active power is considered. The output from the DFC is divided down by a pair of frequency division registers before being sent to the APCF pulse output. Namely, APCFDEN/APCFNUM pulses are needed at the DFC output before the APCF pin outputs a pulse. Under steady load conditions, the output frequency is directly proportional to the total active power. The pulse width of APCF is 64/CLKIN if APCFNUM and APCFDEN are both equal. If APCFDEN is greater than APCFNUM, the pulse width depends on APCFDEN. The pulse width in this case is T × (APCFDEN/2), where T is the period of the APCF pulse and APCFDEN/2 is rounded to the nearest whole number. An exception to this is when the period is greater than 180 ms. In this case, the pulse width is fixed at 90 ms. The maximum output frequency (APCFNUM = 0x00 and APCFDEN = 0x00) with full-scale ac signals on one phase is approximately 16 kHz. The ADE7758 incorporates two registers to set the frequency of APCF (APCFNUM[11:0] and APCFDEN[11:0]). These are unsigned 12-bit registers that can be used to adjust the frequency of APCF by 1/212 to 1 with a step of 1/212. For example, if the output frequency is 1.562 kHz while the contents of APCFDEN are 0 (0x000), then the output frequency can be set to 6.103 Hz by writing 0xFF to the APCFDEN register. If 0 were written to any of the frequency division registers, the divider would use 1 in the frequency division. In addition, the ratio APCFNUM/APCFDEN should be set not greater than 1 to ensure proper operation. In other words, the APCF output frequency cannot be higher than the frequency on the DFC output. The output frequency has a slight ripple at a frequency equal to 2× the line frequency. This is due to imperfect filtering of the instantaneous power signal to generate the active power signal ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 34 of 72 (see the Active Power Calculation section). Equation 14 gives an expression for the instantaneous power signal. This is filtered by LPF2, which has a magnitude response given by Equation 23. ()22811Hff+= (23) –E(t)tVltVI×cos(4π×f1 ×t)4π×f11 +22f1804443-069 The active power signal (output of the LPF2) can be rewritten as ()()(tffIRMSVRMSIRMSVRMStp12214cos821π×⎥⎥⎥⎥⎦⎤⎢⎢⎢⎢⎣⎡+×−×= (24) Figure 70. Output Frequency Ripple where f1 is the line frequency, for example, 60 Hz. Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation Mode From Equation 24, E(t) equals The ADE7758 is designed with a special energy accumulation mode that simplifies the calibration process. By using the on-chip, zero-crossing detection, the ADE7758 updates the watt-hr accumulation registers after an integer number of zero crossings (see Figure 71). The line-active energy accumulation mode for watt-hr accumulation is activated by setting the LWATT bit (Bit 0) of the LCYCMODE register. The total energy accumu-lated over an integer number of half-line cycles is written to the watt-hr accumulation registers after the LINECYC number of zero crossings is detected. When using the line cycle accumulation mode, the RSTREAD bit (Bit 6) of the LCYCMODE register should be set to Logic 0. ())4cos(8214–12211tfffIRMSVRMStIRMSVRMSππ×⎥⎥⎥⎥⎥⎦⎤⎢⎢⎢⎢⎢⎣⎡+××× (25) From Equation 25, it can be seen that there is a small ripple in the energy calculation due to the sin(2ωt) component (see Figure 70). The ripple gets larger with larger loads. Choosing a lower output frequency for APCF during calibration by using a large APCFDEN value and keeping APCFNUM relatively small can significantly reduce the ripple. Averaging the output frequency over a longer period achieves the same results. ZXSEL01ZERO-CROSSINGDETECTION(PHASEA)ZXSEL11ZERO-CROSSINGDETECTION(PHASEB)ZXSEL21ZERO-CROSSINGDETECTION(PHASEC)1ZXSEL[0:2]AREBITS3TO5 INTHELCYCMODEREGISTERCALIBRATIONCONTROLLINECYC[15:0]WATTOS[11:0]WG[11:0]WDIV[7:0]++%++WATTHR[15:0]ACCUMULATEACTIVEPOWERFORLINECYCNUMBER OFZERO-CROSSINGS;WATT-HRACCUMULATIONREGISTERSAREUPDATED ONCEEVERYLINECYCNUMBER OFZERO-CROSSINGSACTIVEPOWER15040004443-070 Figure 71. ADE7758 Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation Mode Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 35 of 72 Phase A, Phase B, and Phase C zero crossings are, respectively, included when counting the number of half-line cycles by setting ZXSEL[0:2] bits (Bit 3 to Bit 5) in the LCYCMODE register. Any combination of the zero crossings from all three phases can be used for counting the zero crossing. Only one phase should be selected at a time for inclusion in the zero crossings count during calibration (see the Calibration section). The number of zero crossings is specified by the LINECYC register. LINECYC is an unsigned 16-bit register. The ADE7758 can accumulate active power for up to 65535 combined zero crossings. Note that the internal zero-crossing counter is always active. By setting the LWATT bit, the first energy accumulation result is, therefore, incorrect. Writing to the LINECYC register when the LWATT bit is set resets the zero-crossing counter, thus ensuring that the first energy accumulation result is accurate. At the end of an energy calibration cycle, the LENERGY bit (Bit 12) in the STATUS register is set. If the corresponding mask bit in the interrupt mask register is enabled, the IRQ output also goes active low; thus, the IRQ can also be used to signal the end of a calibration. Because active power is integrated on an integer number of half-line cycles in this mode, the sinusoidal component is reduced to 0, eliminating any ripple in the energy calculation. Therefore, total energy accumulated using the line-cycle accumulation mode is E(t) = VRMS × IRMS × t (26) where t is the accumulation time. Note that line cycle active energy accumulation uses the same signal path as the active energy accumulation. The LSB size of these two methods is equivalent. Using the line cycle accumula-tion to calculate the kWh/LSB constant results in a value that can be applied to the WATTHR registers when the line accumulation mode is not selected (see the Calibration section). REACTIVE POWER CALCULATION A load that contains a reactive element (inductor or capacitor) produces a phase difference between the applied ac voltage and the resulting current. The power associated with reactive elements is called reactive power, and its unit is VAR. Reactive power is defined as the product of the voltage and current waveforms when one of these signals is phase shifted by 90°. Equation 30 gives an expression for the instantaneous reactive power signal in an ac system when the phase of the current channel is shifted by +90°. ()(θ=–sin2ωtVtv (27) ()()()⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛π+=′=2sin2isin2ωtItωtIti (28) where: v = rms voltage. i = rms current. θ = total phase shift caused by the reactive elements in the load. Then the instantaneous reactive power q(t) can be expressed as ()()()()⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛πθ⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛πθ=′×=2––2cos–2––cosωtVIVItqtitvtq (29) where ()ti′ is the current waveform phase shifted by 90°. Note that q(t) can be rewritten as ()()(θ +θ=–2sinsinωtVIVItq (30) The average reactive power over an integral number of line cycles (n) is given by the expression in Equation 31. ()()∫××==nT0θsindtnT1IVtqQ (31) where: T is the period of the line cycle. Q is referred to as the average reactive power. The instantaneous reactive power signal q(t) is generated by multiplying the voltage signals and the 90° phase-shifted current in each phase. The dc component of the instantaneous reactive power signal in each phase (A, B, and C) is then extracted by a low-pass filter to obtain the average reactive power information on each phase. This process is illustrated in Figure 72. The reactive power of each phase is accumulated in the corresponding 16-bit VAR-hour register (AVARHR, BVARHR, or CVARHR). The input to each reactive energy register can be changed depending on the accumulation mode setting (see Table 21). The frequency response of the LPF in the reactive power signal path is identical to that of the LPF2 used in the average active power calculation (see Figure 66). VRMS × IRMS × sin(φ)θ0x00000CURRENTi(t) = 2×IRMS×sin(ωt)VOLTAGEv(t) = 2×VRMS×sin(ωt –θ)INSTANTANEOUSREACTIVE POWER SIGNALq(t) = VRMS × IRMS × sin(φ) + VRMS × IRMS × sin(2ωt + θ)AVERAGE REACTIVE POWER SIGNAL =VRMS × IRMS × sin(θ)04443-071 Figure 72. Reactive Power Calculation The low-pass filter is nonideal, so the reactive power signal has some ripple. This ripple is sinusoidal and has a frequency equal to 2× the line frequency. Because the ripple is sinusoidal in nature, it is removed when the reactive power signal is integrated over time to calculate the reactive energy. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 36 of 72 The phase-shift filter has –90° phase shift when the integrator is enabled and +90° phase shift when the integrator is disabled. In addition, the filter has a nonunity magnitude response. Because the phase-shift filter has a large attenuation at high frequency, the reactive power is primarily for the calculation at line frequency. The effect of harmonics is largely ignored in the reactive power calculation. Note that because of the magnitude characteristic of the phase shifting filter, the LSB weight of the reactive power calculation is slightly different from that of the active power calculation (see the Energy Registers Scaling section). The ADE7758 uses the line frequency of the phase selected in the FREQSEL[1:0] bits of the MMODE[1:0] to compensate for attenuation of the reactive energy phase shift filter over frequency (see the Period Measurement section). Reactive Power Gain Calibration The average reactive power from the LPF output in each phase can be scaled by ±50% by writing to the phase’s VAR gain register (AVARG, BVARG, or CVARG). The VAR gain registers are twos complement, signed registers and have a resolution of 0.024%/LSB. The function of the VAR gain registers is expressed by ⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛+×=12212gisterReGainVAROutputLPFPowerReactiveAverage (32) The output is scaled by –50% by writing 0x800 to the VAR gain registers and increased by +50% by writing 0x7FF to them. These registers can be used to calibrate the reactive power (or energy) calculation in the ADE7758 for each phase. Reactive Power Offset Calibration The ADE7758 incorporates a VAR offset register on each phase (AVAROS, BVAROS, and CVAROS). These are signed twos complement, 12-bit registers that are used to remove offsets in the reactive power calculations. An offset can exist in the power calculation due to crosstalk between channels on the PCB or in the chip itself. The offset calibration allows the contents of the reactive power register to be maintained at 0 when no reactive power is being consumed. The offset registers’ resolution is the same as the active power offset registers (see the Apparent Power Offset Calibration section). Sign of Reactive Power Calculation Note that the average reactive power is a signed calculation. As stated previously, the phase shift filter has –90° phase shift when the integrator is enabled and +90° phase shift when the integrator is disabled. Table 12 summarizes the relationship between the phase difference between the voltage and the current and the sign of the resulting VAR calculation. The ADE7758 has a sign detection circuit for the reactive power calculation. The REVPRP bit (Bit 18) in the interrupt status register is set if the average reactive power from any one of the phases changes. The phases monitored are selected by TERMSEL bits in the COMPMODE register (see Table 21). If the REVPRP bit is set in the mask register, the IRQ logic output goes active low (see the section). Note that this bit is set whenever there is a sign change; that is, the bit is set for either a positive-to-negative change or a negative-to-positive change of the sign bit. The response time of this bit is approximately 176 ms for a full-scale signal, which has an average value of 0xCCCCD at the low-pass filter output. For smaller inputs, the time is longer. InterruptsCLKINueAverageValmssponseTimeRe4260125×⎥⎦⎤⎢⎣⎡+≅ (33) Table 12. Sign of Reactive Power Calculation Φ1 Integrator Sign of Reactive Power Between 0 to +90 Off Positive Between −90 to 0 Off Negative Between 0 to +90 On Positive Between −90 to 0 On Negative 1 Φ is defined as the phase angle of the voltage signal minus the current signal; that is, Φ is positive if the load is inductive and negative if the load is capacitive. Reactive Energy Calculation Reactive energy is defined as the integral of reactive power. ()dttqEnergyReactive∫= (34) Similar to active power, the ADE7758 achieves the integration of the reactive power signal by continuously accumulating the reactive power signal in the internal 41-bit accumulation registers. The VAR-hr registers (AVARHR, BVARHR, and CVARHR) represent the upper 16 bits of these internal registers. This discrete time accumulation or summation is equivalent to integration in continuous time. Equation 35 expresses the relationship ()()⎭⎬⎫⎩⎨⎧×==Σ∫∞=→0n0LimdtTnTqtqEnergyReactiveT (35) where: n is the discrete time sample number. T is the sample period. Figure 73 shows the signal path of the reactive energy accumula-tion. The average reactive power signal is continuously added to the internal reactive energy register. This addition is a signed operation. Negative energy is subtracted from the reactive energy register. The average reactive power is divided by the content of the VAR divider register before it is added to the corresponding VAR-hr accumulation registers. When the value in the VARDIV[7:0] register is 0 or 1, the reactive power is accumulated without any division. VARDIV is an 8-bit unsigned register that is useful to lengthen the time it takes before the VAR-hr accumulation registers overflow. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 37 of 72 Similar to reactive power, the fastest integration time occurs when the VAR gain registers are set to maximum full scale, that is, 0x7FF. The time it takes before overflow can be scaled by writing to the VARDIV register; and, therefore, it can be increased by a maximum factor of 255. By setting the REHF bit (Bit 1) of the interrupt mask register, the ADE7758 can be configured to issue an interrupt (IRQ) when Bit 14 of any one of the three VAR-hr accumulation registers has changed, indicating that the accumulation register is half full (positive or negative). When overflow occurs, the VAR-hr accumulation registers content can rollover to full-scale negative (0x8000) and continue increasing in value when the reactive power is positive. Con-versely, if the reactive power is negative, the VAR-hr accumulation registers content can roll over to full-scale positive (0x7FFF) and continue decreasing in value. Setting the RSTREAD bit (Bit 6) of the LCYMODE register enables a read-with-reset for the VAR-hr accumulation registers; that is, the registers are reset to 0 after a read operation. VARG[11:0]VARDIV[7:0]90°PHASESHIFTINGFILTERMULTIPLIERIVHPFCURRENTSIGNAL–i(t)0x2851EC0x000xD7AE14VOLTAGESIGNAL–v(t)0x28520x000xD7AE++++LPF2%SIGN26202–12–22–32–4VAROS[11:0]VARHR[15:0]150400TOTALREACTIVEPOWER ISACCUMULATED(INTEGRATED) INTHEVAR-HRACCUMULATIONREGISTERSπ2PHCAL[6:0]Φ04443-072 Figure 73. ADE7758 Reactive Energy Accumulation ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 38 of 72 Integration Time Under Steady Load The discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation register is 0.4 μs (4/CLKIN). With full-scale sinusoidal signals on the analog inputs, a 90° phase difference between the voltage and the current signal (the largest possible reactive power), and the VAR gain registers set to 0x000, the average word value from each LPF2 is 0xCCCCD. The maximum value that can be stored in the reactive energy register before it overflows is 215 − 1 or 0x7FFF. Because the average word value is added to the internal register, which can store 240 − 1 or 0xFF, FFFF, FFFF before it overflows, the integration time under these conditions with VARDIV = 0 is calculated as sec0.5243μs0.40xCCCCDFFFFFFFF,0xFF,=×=Time (36) When VARDIV is set to a value different from 0, the time before overflow are scaled accordingly as shown in Equation 37. Time = Time(VARDIV = 0) × VARDIV (37) Energy Accumulation Mode The reactive power accumulated in each VAR-hr accumulation register (AVARHR, BVARHR, or CVARHR) depends on the configuration of the CONSEL bits in the COMPMODE register (Bit 0 and Bit 1). The different configurations are described in Table 13. Note that IA’/IB’/IC’ are the current phase-shifted current waveform. Table 13. Inputs to VAR-Hr Accumulation Registers CONSEL[1, 0] AVARHR BVARHR CVARHR 00 VA × IA’ VB × IB VC × IC’ 01 VA (IA’ – IB’) 0 VC (IC’ – IB’) 10 VA (IA’ – IB’) 0 VC × IC’ 11 Reserved Reserved Reserved Reactive Power Frequency Output Pin 17 (VARCF) of the ADE7758 provides frequency output for the total reactive power. Similar to APCF, this pin provides an output frequency that is directly proportional to the total reactive power. The pulse width of VARPCF is 64/CLKIN if VARCFNUM and VARCFDEN are both equal. If VARCFDEN is greater than VARCFNUM, the pulse width depends on VARCFDEN. The pulse width in this case is T × (VARCFDEN/2), where T is the period of the VARCF pulse and VARCFDEN/2 is rounded to the nearest whole number. An exception to this is when the period is greater than 180 ms. In this case, the pulse width is fixed at 90 ms. A digital-to-frequency converter (DFC) is used to generate the VARCF pulse output from the total reactive power. The TERMSEL bits (Bit 2 to Bit 4) of the COMPMODE register can be used to select which phases to include in the total reactive power calcu-lation. Setting Bit 2, Bit 3, and Bit 4 includes the input to the AVARHR, BVARHR, and CVARHR registers in the total reactive power calculation. The total reactive power is signed addition. However, setting the SAVAR bit (Bit 6) in the COMPMODE register enables absolute value calculation. If the active power of that phase is positive, no change is made to the sign of the reactive power. However, if the sign of the active power is negative in that phase, the sign of its reactive power is inverted before summing and creating VARCF pulses. This mode should be used in conjunction with the absolute value mode for active power (Bit 5 in the COMPMODE register) for APCF pulses. The effects of setting the ABS and SAVAR bits of the COMPMODE register are as follows when ABS = 1 and SAVAR = 1: If watt > 0, APCF = Watts, VARCF = +VAR. If watt < 0, APCF = |Watts|, VARCF = −VAR. INPUTTO BVARHRREGISTERINPUTTOAVARHRREGISTERINPUTTO CVARHRREGISTER+++INPUTTO BVAHRREGISTERINPUTTOAVAHRREGISTERINPUTTO CVAHRREGISTER+++01VARCFVARCFNUM[11:0]VARCFDEN[11:0]÷DFCVACF BIT (BIT 7) OFWAVMODE REGISTER÷404443-073 Figure 74. Reactive Power Frequency Output The output from the DFC is divided down by a pair of frequency division registers before sending to the VARCF pulse output. Namely, VARCFDEN/VARCFNUM pulses are needed at the DFC output before the VARCF pin outputs a pulse. Under steady load conditions, the output frequency is directly proportional to the total reactive power. Figure 74 illustrates the energy-to-frequency conversion in the ADE7758. Note that the input to the DFC can be selected between the total reactive power and total apparent power. Therefore, the VARCF pin can output frequency that is proportional to the total reactive power or total apparent power. The selection is made by setting the VACF bit (Bit 7) in the WAVMODE register. Setting this bit switches the input to the total apparent power. The default value of this bit is logic low. Therefore, the default output from the VARCF pin is the total reactive power. All other operations of this frequency output are similar to that of the active power frequency output (see the Active Power Frequency Output section). Line Cycle Reactive Energy Accumulation Mode The line cycle reactive energy accumulation mode is activated by setting the LVAR bit (Bit 1) in the LCYCMODE register. The total reactive energy accumulated over an integer number of zero crossings is written to the VAR-hr accumulation registers after the LINECYC number of zero crossings is detected. The operation of this mode is similar to watt-hr accumulation (see the Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation Mode section). Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 39 of 72 When using the line cycle accumulation mode, the RSTREAD bit (Bit 6) of the LCYCMODE register should be set to Logic 0. APPARENT POWER CALCULATION Apparent power is defined as the amplitude of the vector sum of the active and reactive powers. Figure 75 shows what is typically referred to as the power triangle. REACTIVE POWERACTIVE POWERAPPARENTPOWERθ04443-074 Figure 75. Power Triangle There are two ways to calculate apparent power: the arithmetical approach or the vectorial method. The arithmetical approach uses the product of the voltage rms value and current rms value to calculate apparent power. Equation 38 describes the arithmetical approach mathematically. S = VRMS × IRMS (38) where S is the apparent power, and VRMS and IRMS are the rms voltage and current, respectively. The vectorial method uses the square root of the sum of the active and reactive power, after the two are individually squared. Equation 39 shows the calculation used in the vectorial approach. 22QPS+= (39) where: S is the apparent power. P is the active power. Q is the reactive power. For a pure sinusoidal system, the two approaches should yield the same result. The apparent energy calculation in the ADE7758 uses the arithmetical approach. However, the line cycle energy accumulation mode in the ADE7758 enables energy accumula-tion between active and reactive energies over a synchronous period, thus the vectorial method can be easily implemented in the external MCU (see the Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation Mode section). Note that apparent power is always positive regardless of the direction of the active or reactive energy flows. The rms value of the current and voltage in each phase is multiplied to produce the apparent power of the corresponding phase. The output from the multiplier is then low-pass filtered to obtain the average apparent power. The frequency response of the LPF in the apparent power signal path is identical to that of the LPF2 used in the average active power calculation (see Figure 66). Apparent Power Gain Calibration Note that the average active power result from the LPF output in each phase can be scaled by ±50% by writing to the phase’s VAGAIN register (AVAG, BVAG, or CVAG). The VAGAIN registers are twos complement, signed registers and have a resolution of 0.024%/LSB. The function of the VAGAIN registers is expressed mathematically as ⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛+×=12212RegisterVAGAINOutputLPFPowerApparentAverage (40) The output is scaled by –50% by writing 0x800 to the VAR gain registers and increased by +50% by writing 0x7FF to them. These registers can be used to calibrate the apparent power (or energy) calculation in the ADE7758 for each phase. Apparent Power Offset Calibration Each rms measurement includes an offset compensation register to calibrate and eliminate the dc component in the rms value (see the Current RMS Calculation section and the Voltage Channel RMS Calculation section). The voltage and current rms values are then multiplied together in the apparent power signal processing. As no additional offsets are created in the multiplication of the rms values, there is no specific offset compensation in the apparent power signal processing. The offset compensation of the apparent power measurement in each phase should be done by calibrating each individual rms measurement (see the Calibration section). ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 40 of 72 Apparent Energy Calculation Apparent energy is defined as the integral of apparent power. Apparent Energy = ∫ S(t)dt (41) Similar to active or reactive power accumulation, the fastest integration time occurs when the VAGAIN registers are set to maximum full scale, that is, 0x7FF. When overflow occurs, the content of the VA-hr accumulation registers can roll over to 0 and continue increasing in value. Similar to active and reactive energy, the ADE7758 achieves the integration of the apparent power signal by continuously accumulating the apparent power signal in the internal 41-bit, unsigned accumulation registers. The VA-hr registers (AVAHR, BVAHR, and CVAHR) represent the upper 16 bits of these internal registers. This discrete time accumulation or summation is equivalent to integration in continuous time. Equation 42 expresses the relationship By setting the VAEHF bit (Bit 2) of the mask register, the ADE7758 can be configured to issue an interrupt (IRQ) when the MSB of any one of the three VA-hr accumulation registers has changed, indicating that the accumulation register is half full. Setting the RSTREAD bit (Bit 6) of the LCYMODE register enables a read-with-reset for the VA-hr accumulation registers; that is, the registers are reset to 0 after a read operation. ()()⎭⎬⎫⎩⎨⎧×==Σ∫∞=→0n0TLimdtTnTStSEnergyApparent (42) Integration Time Under Steady Load The discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation register is 0.4 μs (4/CLKIN). With full-scale, 60 Hz sinusoidal signals on the analog inputs and the VAGAIN registers set to 0x000, the average word value from each LPF2 is 0xB9954. The maximum value that can be stored in the apparent energy register before it overflows is 216 − 1 or 0xFFFF. As the average word value is first added to the internal register, which can store 241 − 1 or 0x1FF, FFFF, FFFF before it overflows, the integration time under these conditions with VADIV = 0 is calculated as where: n is the discrete time sample number. T is the sample period. Figure 76 shows the signal path of the apparent energy accumu-lation. The apparent power signal is continuously added to the internal apparent energy register. The average apparent power is divided by the content of the VA divider register before it is added to the corresponding VA-hr accumulation register. When the value in the VADIV[7:0] register is 0 or 1, apparent power is accumulated without any division. VADIV is an 8-bit unsigned register that is useful to lengthen the time it takes before the VA-hr accumulation registers overflow. sec1.157μs0.40xB9954FFFFFFFF,0x1FF,=×=Time (43) When VADIV is set to a value different from 0, the time before overflow is scaled accordingly, as shown in Equation 44. Time = Time(VADIV = 0) × VADIV (44) VOLTAGE RMS SIGNAL0x174BAC60Hz0x00x17F26350Hz0x0CURRENT RMS SIGNAL0x1C82B0x00MULTIPLIERIRMSVRMSVAG[11:0]VADIV[7:0]++LPF2%VARHR[15:0]150400APPARENT POWER ISACCUMULATED (INTEGRATED) INTHE VA-HR ACCUMULATION REGISTERS04443-075 Figure 76. ADE7758 Apparent Energy Accumulation Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 41 of 72 Table 14. Inputs to VA-Hr Accumulation Registers CONSEL[1, 0] AVAHR1 BVAHR CVAHR 00 AVRMS × AIRMS BVRMS × BIRMS CVRMS × CIRMS 01 AVRMS × AIRMS AVRMS + CVRMS/2 × BIRMS CVRMS × CIRMS 10 AVRMS × AIRMS BVRMS × BIRMS CVRMS × CIRMS 11 Reserved Reserved Reserved 1 AVRMS/BVRMS/CVRMS are the rms voltage waveform, and AIRMS/BIRMS/CIRMS are the rms values of the current waveform. Energy Accumulation Mode The apparent power accumulated in each VA-hr accumulation register (AVAHR, BVAHR, or CVAHR) depends on the con- figuration of the CONSEL bits in the COMPMODE register (Bit 0 and Bit 1). The different configurations are described in Table 14. The contents of the VA-hr accumulation registers are affected by both the registers for rms voltage gain (VRMSGAIN), as well as the VAGAIN register of the corresponding phase. Apparent Power Frequency Output Pin 17 (VARCF) of the ADE7758 provides frequency output for the total apparent power. By setting the VACF bit (Bit 7) of the WAVMODE register, this pin provides an output frequency that is directly proportional to the total apparent power. A digital-to-frequency converter (DFC) is used to generate the pulse output from the total apparent power. The TERMSEL bits (Bit 2 to Bit 4) of the COMPMODE register can be used to select which phases to include in the total power calculation. Setting Bit 2, Bit 3, and Bit 4 includes the input to the AVAHR, BVAHR, and CVAHR registers in the total apparent power calculation. A pair of frequency divider registers, namely VARCFDEN and VARCFNUM, can be used to scale the output frequency of this pin. Note that either VAR or apparent power can be selected at one time for this frequency output (see the Reactive Power Frequency Output section). Line Cycle Apparent Energy Accumulation Mode The line cycle apparent energy accumulation mode is activated by setting the LVA bit (Bit 2) in the LCYCMODE register. The total apparent energy accumulated over an integer number of zero crossings is written to the VA-hr accumulation registers after the LINECYC number of zero crossings is detected. The operation of this mode is similar to watt-hr accumulation (see the Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation Mode section). When using the line cycle accumulation mode, the RSTREAD bit (Bit 6) of the LCYCMODE register should be set to Logic 0. Note that this mode is especially useful when the user chooses to perform the apparent energy calculation using the vectorial method. By setting LWATT and LVAR bits (Bit 0 and Bit 1) of the LCYCMODE register, the active and reactive energies are accumulated over the same period. Therefore, the MCU can perform the squaring of the two terms and then take the square root of their sum to determine the apparent energy over the same period. ENERGY REGISTERS SCALING The ADE7758 provides measurements of active, reactive, and apparent energies that use separate signal paths and filtering for calculation. The differences in the datapaths can result in small differences in LSB weight between the active, reactive, and apparent energy registers. These measurements are internally compensated so that the scaling is nearly one to one. The relationship between the registers is shown in Table 15. Table 15. Energy Registers Scaling Frequency 60 Hz 50 Hz Integrator Off VAR 1.004 × WATT 1.0054 × WATT VA 1.00058 × WATT 1.0085 × WATT Integrator On VAR 1.0059 × WATT 1.0064 × WATT VA 1.00058 × WATT 1.00845 × WATT WAVEFORM SAMPLING MODE The waveform samples of the current and voltage waveform, as well as the active, reactive, and apparent power multiplier out- puts, can all be routed to the WAVEFORM register by setting the WAVSEL[2:0] bits (Bit 2 to Bit 4) in the WAVMODE register. The phase in which the samples are routed is set by setting the PHSEL[1:0] bits (Bit 0 and Bit 1) in the WAVMODE register. All energy calculation remains uninterrupted during waveform sampling. Four output sample rates can be chosen by using Bit 5 and Bit 6 of the WAVMODE register (DTRT[1:0]). The output sample rate can be 26.04 kSPS, 13.02 kSPS, 6.51 kSPS, or 3.25 kSPS (see Table 20). By setting the WFSM bit in the interrupt mask register to Logic 1, the interrupt request output IRQ goes active low when a sample is available. The 24-bit waveform samples are transferred from the ADE7758 one byte (8 bits) at a time, with the most significant byte shifted out first. The interrupt request output IRQ stays low until the interrupt routine reads the reset status register (see the Interrupts section). ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 42 of 72 CALIBRATION A reference meter or an accurate source is required to calibrate the ADE7758 energy meter. When using a reference meter, the ADE7758 calibration output frequencies APCF and VARCF are adjusted to match the frequency output of the reference meter under the same load conditions. Each phase must be calibrated separately in this case. When using an accurate source for calibration, one can take advantage of the line cycle accumulation mode and calibrate the three phases simultaneously. There are two objectives in calibrating the meter: to establish the correct impulses/kW-hr constant on the pulse output and to obtain a constant that relates the LSBs in the energy and rms registers to Watt/VA/VAR hours, amps, or volts. Additionally, calibration compensates for part-to-part variation in the meter design as well as phase shifts and offsets due to the current sensor and/or input networks. Calibration Using Pulse Output The ADE7758 provides a pulsed output proportional to the active power accumulated by all three phases, called APCF. Additionally, the VARCF output is proportional to either the reactive energy or apparent energy accumulated by all three phases. The following section describes how to calibrate the gain, offset, and phase angle using the pulsed output information. The equations are based on the pulse output from the ADE7758 (APCF or VARCF) and the pulse output of the reference meter or CFEXPECTED. Figure 77 shows a flowchart of how to calibrate the ADE7758 using the pulse output. Because the pulse outputs are proportional to the total energy in all three phases, each phase must be calibrated individually. Writing to the registers is fast to reconfigure the part for calibrating a different phase; therefore, Figure 77 shows a method that calibrates all phases at a given test condition before changing the test condition. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 43 of 72 STARTCALIBRATE IRMSOFFSETCALIBRATE VRMSOFFSETMUST BE DONEBEFORE VA GAINCALIBRATIONWATT AND VACAN BE CALIBRATEDSIMULTANEOUSLY @PF = 1 BECAUSE THEYHAVE SEPARATE PULSE OUTPUTSALLPHASESVA AND WATTGAIN CAL?YESNOSET UP PULSEOUTPUT FORA, B, OR CCALIBRATEWATT AND VAGAIN @ ITEST,PF = 1ALLPHASESGAIN CALVAR?YESNOSET UP FORPHASEA, B, OR CCALIBRATEVAR GAIN@ ITEST, PF = 0,INDUCTIVEALLPHASESPHASE ERROR CAL?YESNOSET UP PULSEOUTPUT FORA, B, OR CCALIBRATEPHASE @ ITEST,PF = 0.5,INDUCTIVEALL PHASESVAR OFFSETCAL?YESNOSET UP PULSEOUTPUT FORA, B, OR CCALIBRATEVAR OFFSET@ IMIN, PF = 0,INDUCTIVEALL PHASESWATT OFFSETCAL?YESNOSET UP PULSEOUTPUT FORA, B, OR CCALIBRATEWATT OFFSET@ IMIN, PF = 1END04443-076 Figure 77. Calibration Using Pulse Output Gain Calibration Using Pulse Output Gain calibration is used for meter-to-meter gain adjustment, APCF or VARCF output rate calibration, and determining the Wh/LSB, VARh/LSB, and VAh/LSB constant. The registers used for watt gain calibration are APCFNUM (0x45), APCFDEN (0x46), and xWG (0x2A to 0x2C). Equation 50 through Equation 52 show how these registers affect the Wh/LSB constant and the APCF pulses. For calibrating VAR gain, the registers in Equation 50 through Equation 52 should be replaced by VARCFNUM (0x47), VARCFDEN (0x48), and xVARG (0x2D to 0x2F). For VAGAIN, they should be replaced by VARCFNUM (0x47), VARCFDEN (0x48), and xVAG (0x30 to 0x32). Figure 78 shows the steps for gain calibration of watts, VA, or VAR using the pulse outputs. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 44 of 72 STARTSTEP1STEP1AENABLEAPCFANDVARCFPULSEOUTPUTSSTEP2CLEAR GAINREGISTERS:xWG,xVAG,xVARGSELECTVAFORVARCF OUTPUTCFNUM/VARCFNUMSETTOCALCULATEVALUES?NOYESALLPHASESVAANDWATTGAINCAL?YESNOSTEP3SETUPPULSEOUTPUTFORPHASEA,B, ORCSTEP5SETUPSYSTEMFORITEST,VNOMPF=1STEP6MEASURE%ERRORFORAPCFANDVARCFSTEP7CALCULATEANDWRITETOxWG,xVAGCALCULATEWh/LSBANDVAh/LSBCONSTANTSSETCFNUM/VARCFNUMANDCFDEN/VARCFDENTOCALCULATEDVALUESSTEP4ENDALLPHASESVAR GAINCALIBRATED?YESNOSELECTVARFORVARCFOUTPUTSTEP3SETUPPULSEOUTPUTFORPHASEA,B, ORCVARCFNUM/VARCFDENSETTOCALCULATEDVALUES?NOYESSTEP5SETUPSYSTEMFORITEST,VNOMPF=0, INDUCTIVESTEP6MEASURE%ERRORFORVARCFSTEP7CALCULATEANDWRITETOxVARGCALCULATEVARh/LSBCONSTANTSETVARCFNUM/VARCFDENTOCALCULATEDVALUESSTEP404443-077SELECTPHASEA,B, ORCFORLINEPERIODMEASUREMENT Figure 78. Gain Calibration Using Pulse Output Step 1: Enable the pulse output by setting Bit 2 of the OPMODE register (0x13) to Logic 0. This bit enables both the APCF and VARCF pulses. Step 1a: VAR and VA share the VARCF pulse output. WAVMODE[7], Address (0x15), should be set to choose between VAR or VA pulses on the output. Setting the bit to Logic 1 selects VA. The default is Logic 0 or VARCF pulse output. Step 2: Ensure the xWG/xVARG/xVAG are zero. Step 3: Disable the Phase B and Phase C contribution to the APCF and VARCF pulses. This is done by the TERMSEL[2:4] bits of the COMPMODE register (0x16). Setting Bit 2 to Logic 1 and Bit 3 and Bit 4 to Logic 0 allows only Phase A to be included in the pulse outputs. Select Phase A, Phase B, or Phase C for a line period measurement with the FREQSEL[1:0] bits in the MMODE register (0x14). For example, clearing Bit 1 and Bit 0 selects Phase A for line period measurement. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 45 of 72 Step 4: Set APCFNUM (0x45) and APCFDEN (0x46) to the calculated value to perform a coarse adjustment on the imp/kWh ratio. For VAR/VA calibration, set VARCFNUM (0x47) and VARCFDEN (0x48) to the calculated value. The pulse output frequency with one phase at full-scale inputs is approximately 16 kHz. A sample set of meters could be tested to find a more exact value of the pulse output at full scale in the user application. To calculate the values for APCFNUM/APCFDEN and VARCFNUM/VARCFDEN, use the following formulas: FULLSCALETESTFULLSCALENOMNOMINALIIVVAPCF××=kHz16 (45) ()θ××××=cos36001000NOMTESTEXPECTEDVIMCAPCF (46) ⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛=EXPECTEDNOMINALAPCFAPCFINTAPCFDEN (47) where: MC is the meter constant. ITEST is the test current. VNOM is the nominal voltage at which the meter is tested. VFULLSCALE and IFULLSCALE are the values of current and voltage, which correspond to the full-scale ADC inputs of the ADE7758. θ is the angle between the current and the voltage channel. APCFEXPECTED is equivalent to the reference meter output under the test conditions. APCFNUM is written to 0 or 1. The equations for calculating the VARCFNUM and VARCFDEN during VAR calibration are similar: ()θ××××=sin36001000NOMTESTEXPECTEDVIMCVARCF (48) Because the APCFDEN and VARCFDEN values can be calculated from the meter design, these values can be written to the part automatically during production calibration. Step 5: Set the test system for ITEST, VNOM, and the unity power factor. For VAR calibration, the power factor should be set to 0 inductive in this step. For watt and VA, the unity power factor should be used. VAGAIN can be calibrated at the same time as WGAIN because VAGAIN can be calibrated at the unity power factor, and both pulse outputs can be measured simultaneously. However, when calibrating VAGAIN at the same time as WGAIN, the rms offsets should be calibrated first (see the Calibration of IRMS and VRMS Offset section). Step 6: Measure the percent error in the pulse output, APCF and/or VARCF, from the reference meter: %100–%×=REFREFCFCFAPCFError (49) where CFREF = APCFEXPECTED = the pulse output of the reference meter. Step 7: Calculate xWG adjustment. One LSB change in xWG (12 bits) changes the WATTHR register by 0.0244% and therefore APCF by 0.0244%. The same relationship holds true for VARCF. [][][]⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛+××=1220:1110:110:11xWGAPCFDENAPCFNUMAPCFAPCFNOMINALEXPECTED (50) %0244.0%–ErrorxWG= (51) When APCF is calibrated, the xWATTHR registers have the same Wh/LSB from meter to meter if the meter constant and the APCFNUM/APCFDEN ratio remain the same. The Wh/LSB constant is WDIVAPCFNUMAPCFDENMCLSBWh1100041×××= (52) Return to Step 2 to calibrate Phase B and Phase C gain. Example: Watt Gain Calibration of Phase A Using Pulse Output For this example, ITEST = 10 A, VNOM = 220 V, VFULLSCALE = 500 V, IFULLSCALE = 130 A, MC = 3200 impulses/kWh, Power Factor = 1, and Frequency = 50 Hz. Clear APCFNUM (0x45) and write the calculated value to APCFDEN (0x46) to perform a coarse adjustment on the imp/kWh ratio, using Equation 45 through Equation 47. kHz542.013010500220kHz16=××=NOMINALAPCF ()Hz9556.10cos36001000220103200=××××=EXPECTEDAPCF 277Hz9556.1Hz542=⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛=INTAPCFDEN With Phase A contributing to CF, at ITEST, VNOM, and the unity power factor, the example ADE7758 meter shows 2.058 Hz on the pulse output. This is equivalent to a 5.26% error from the reference meter value using Equation 49. %26.5%100Hz9556.1Hz9556.1–Hz058.2=×=%Error The AWG value is calculated to be −216 d using Equation 51, which means the value 0xF28 should be written to AWG. 2802165.215%0244.0%26.5–xFAWG=−=−== ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 46 of 72 PHASE CALIBRATION USING PULSE OUTPUT The ADE7758 includes a phase calibration register on each phase to compensate for small phase errors. Large phase errors should be compensated by adjusting the antialiasing filters. The ADE7758 phase calibration is a time delay with different weights in the positive and negative direction (see the Phase Compensation section). Because a current transformer is a source of phase error, a fixed nominal value can be decided on to load into the xPHCAL registers at power-up. During calibration, this value can be adjusted for CT-to-CT error. Figure 79 shows the steps involved in calibrating the phase using the pulse output. START ALL PHASES PHASEERROR CALIBRATED? END YES NO STEP1 SET UPPULSE OUTPUTFOR PHASEA,B, ORC ANDENABLECF OUTPUTS STEP2 SET UPSYSTEM FOR ITEST, VNOM, PF=0.5, INDUCTIVE STEP3 MEASURE% ERROR INAPCF STEP4 CALCULATEPHASE ERROR(DEGREES) STEP5 PERIOD OF SYSTEM KNOWN? MEASURE PERIODUSING FREQ[11:0] REGISTER NO YES CALCULATEAND WRITETO xPHCAL 04443-078 SELECTPHASE FORLINEPERIOD MEASUREMENT CONFIGURE FREQ[11:0]FORA LINEPERIOD MEASUREMENT Figure 79. Phase Calibration Using Pulse Output Step 1: Step 1 and Step 3 from the gain calibration should be repeated to configure the ADE7758 pulse output. Ensure the xPHCAL registers are zero. Step 2: Set the test system for ITEST, VNOM, and 0.5 power factor inductive. Step 3: Measure the percent error in the pulse output, APCF, from the reference meter using Equation 49. Step 4: Calculate the Phase Error in degrees by           100%3 – %Error Error Arcsin Phase (53) Step 5: Calculate xPHCAL.      360 1 ) ( 1 _ _ 1 s PeriodLine PHCAL LSB Weight Error Phase xPHCAL (54) where PHCAL_LSB_Weight is 1.2 μs if the %Error is negative or 2.4 μs if the %Error is positive (see the Phase Compensation section). If it is not known, the line period is available in the ADE7758 frequency register, FREQ (0x10). To configure line period measurement, select the phase for period measurement in the MMODE[1:0] and set LCYCMODE[7]. Equation 55 shows how to determine the value that needs to be written to xPHCAL using the period register measurement.      360 ] 0:11[ _ _ 6 .9 FREQ PHCAL LSB Weight s Error Phase xPHCAL (55) Example: Phase Calibration of Phase A Using Pulse Output For this example, ITEST = 10 A, VNOM = 220 V, VFULLSCALE = 500 V, IFULLSCALE = 130 A, MC = 3200 impulses/kWh, power factor = 0.5 inductive, and frequency = 50 Hz. With Phase A contributing to CF, at ITEST, VNOM, and 0.5 inductive power factor, the example ADE7758 meter shows 0.9668 Hz on the pulse output. This is equivalent to −1.122% error from the reference meter value using Equation 49. The Phase Error in degrees using Equation 53 is 0.3713°.             3713 .0 3 %100 1.122% – Error – Arcsin Phase If at 50 Hz the FREQ register = 2083d, the value that should be written to APHCAL is 17d, or 0x11 using Equation 55. Note that a PHCAL_LSB_Weight of 1.2 μs is used because the %Error is negative. 11 01719.17 360 2083 μs 2.1 μs 6.9 3713 .0 APHCAL  x     Power Offset Calibration Using Pulse Output Power offset calibration should be used for outstanding performance over a wide dynamic range (1000:1). Calibration of the power offset is done at or close to the minimum current where the desired accuracy is required. The ADE7758 has power offset registers for watts and VAR (xWATTOS and xVAROS). Offsets in the VA measurement are compensated by adjusting the rms offset registers (see the Calibration of IRMS and VRMS Offset section). Figure 80 shows the steps to calibrate the power offsets using the pulse outputs. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 47 of 72 STARTSTEP1ENABLECFOUTPUTSSTEP2CLEAR OFFSETREGISTERSxWATTOS,xVAROSALLPHASESWATT OFFSETCALIBRATED?YESNOALLPHASESVAR OFFSETCALIBRATED?YESNOSETUPAPCFPULSE OUTPUTFORPHASEA,B,ORCSTEP4STEP3SETUPSYSTEMFORIMIN,VNOM,PF=1STEP5MEASURE%ERRORFORAPCFSTEP6CALCULATEANDWRITETOxWATTOSENDSETUPVARCFPULSE OUTPUTFORPHASEA,B,ORCSTEP4STEP3SETUPSYSTEMFORIMIN,VNOM,PF=0, INDUCTIVESTEP5MEASURE%ERRORFORVARCFMEASUREPERIODUSINGFREQ[11:0]REGISTERSTEP6CALCULATEANDWRITETOxVAROSSTEP7.REPEATSTEP3TOSTEP6FORxVAROSSELECTPHASEFORLINEPERIODMEASUREMENTCONFIGUREFREQ[11:0]FORALINEPERIODMEASUREMENT04443-079 Figure 80. Offset Calibration Using Pulse Output Step 1: Repeat Step 1 and Step 3 from the gain calibration to configure the ADE7758 pulse output. Step 2: Clear the xWATTOS and xVAROS registers. Step3: Disable the Phase B and Phase C contribution to the APCF and VARCF pulses. This is done by the TERMSEL[2:4] bits of the COMPMODE register (0x16). Setting Bit 2 to Logic 1 and Bit 3 and Bit 4 to Logic 0 allows only Phase A to be included in the pulse outputs. Select Phase A, Phase B, or Phase C for a line period measurement with the FREQSEL[1:0] bits in the MMODE register (0x14). For example, clearing Bit 1 and Bit 0 selects Phase A for line period measurement. Step 4: Set the test system for IMIN, VNOM, and unity power factor. For Step 6, set the test system for IMIN, VNOM, and zero-power factor inductive. Step 5: Measure the percent error in the pulse output, APCF or VARCF, from the reference meter using Equation 49. Step 6: Calculate xWATTOS using Equation 56 (for xVAROS use Equation 57). APCFNUMAPCFDENQAPCF%APCFxWATTOSEXPECTEDERROR××⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛×=42%100– (56) ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 48 of 72 VARCFNUMVARCFDENQVARCF%VARCFxVAROSEXPECTEDERROR××⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛×=42%100– (57) where Q is defined in Equation 58 and Equation 59. For xWATTOS, 4121425××=CLKINQ (58) For xVAROS, 4140]:[1120221424×⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛××=FREQCLKINQ (59) where the FREQ (0x10) register is configured for line period measurements. Step 7: Repeat Step 3 to Step 6 for xVAROS calibration. Example: Offset Calibration of Phase A Using Pulse Output For this example, IMIN = 50 mA, VNOM = 220 V, VFULLSCALE = 500 V, IFULLSCALE = 130 A, MC = 3200 impulses/kWh, Power Factor = 1, Frequency = 50 Hz, and CLKIN = 10 MHz. With IMIN, VNOM, and unity power factor, the example ADE7758 meter shows 0.009789 Hz on the APCF pulse output. When the power factor is changed to 0.5 inductive, the VARCF output is 0.009769 Hz. This is equivalent to 0.1198% for the watt measurement and −0.0860% for the VAR measurement. Using Equation 56 through Equation 59, the values 0xFFD and 0x3 should be written to AWATTOS (0x39) and AVAROS (0x3C), respectively. 0xFFD3– –2.812770.0186320.009778%1000.1198%–4===××⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛×=AWATTOS 32.612770.0144420.009778%1000.0860%––4==××⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛×=AVAROS For AWATTOS, 01863.04121461025=××=EQ For AVAROS, 0.01444414208320221461024=×××=EQ Calibration Using Line Accumulation Line cycle accumulation mode configures the nine energy registers such that the amount of energy accumulated over an integer number of half line cycles appears in the registers after the LENERGY interrupt. The benefit of using this mode is that the sinusoidal component of the active energy is eliminated. Figure 81 shows a flowchart of how to calibrate the ADE7758 using the line accumulation mode. Calibration of all phases and energies can be done simultaneously using this mode to save time during calibration. STARTCAL IRMS OFFSETCAL VRMS OFFSETCAL WATT AND VAGAIN ALL PHASES@ PF = 1CAL VAR GAIN ALLPHASES @ PF = 0,INDUCTIVECALIBRATE PHASEALL PHASES@ PF = 0.5,INDUCTIVECALIBRATE ALLPHASES WATTOFFSET @ IMIN ANDPF = 1CALIBRATE ALLPHASES VAROFFSETS @ IMINAND PF = 0,INDUCTIVEEND04443-080 Figure 81. Calibration Using Line Accumulation Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 49 of 72 Gain Calibration Using Line Accumulation Step 2: Select Phase A, Phase B, or Phase C for a line period measurement with the FREQSEL[1:0] bits in the MMODE register (0x14). For example, clearing Bit 1 and Bit 0 selects Phase A for line period measurement. Gain calibration is used for meter-to-meter gain adjustment, APCF or VARCF output rate calibration, and determining the Wh/LSB, VARh/LSB, and VAh/LSB constant. Step 3: Set up ADE7758 for line accumulation by writing 0xBF to LCYCMODE. This enables the line accumulation mode on the xWATTHR, xVARHR, and xVAHR (0x01 to 0x09) registers by setting the LWATT, LVAR, and LVA bits, LCYCMODE[0:2] (0x17), to Logic 1. It also sets the ZXSEL bits, LCYCMODE[3:5], to Logic 1 to enable the zero-crossing detection on all phases for line accumulation. Additionally, the FREQSEL bit, LCYCMODE[7], is set so that FREQ (0x10) stores the line period. When using the line accumulation mode, the RSTREAD bit of LCYCMODE should be set to 0 to disable the read with reset mode. Select the phase for line period measurement in MMODE[1:0]. Step 0: Before performing the gain calibration, the APCFNUM/ APCFDEN (0x45/0x46) and VARCFNUM/ VARCFDEN (0x47/0x48) values can be set to achieve the correct impulses/kWh, impulses/kVAh, or impulses/kVARh using the same method outlined in Step 4 in the Gain Calibration Using Pulse Output section. The calibration of xWG/xVARG/xVAG (0x2A through 0x32) is done with the line accumulation mode. Figure 82 shows the steps involved in calibrating the gain registers using the line accumulation mode. Step 1: Clear xWG, xVARG, and xVAG. Step 4: Set the number of half-line cycles for line accumulation by writing to LINECYC (0x1C). FREQUENCYKNOWN?NOYESSTEP0SETAPCFNUM/APCFDENANDVARCFNUM/VARCFDENSTEP1STEP2CLEARxWG/xVAR/xVAGSTEP3SETLYCMODEREGISTERSTEP4SETACCUMULATIONTIME(LINECYC)STEP5SETMASKFORLENERGY INTERRUPTSTEP6SETUPSYSTEMFORITEST,VNOM,PF=1STEP7READFREQ[11:0]REGISTERSTEP8RESETSTATUSREGISTERSTEP9READALLxWATTHRANDxVAHRAFTERLENERGYINTERRUPTSTEP9ACALCULATExWGSTEP9BCALCULATExVAGSTEP10WRITETOxWGANDxVAGCALIBRATEWATTANDVA@PF=1STEP11SETUPTESTSYSTEMFORITEST,VNOM,PF=0, INDUCTIVESTEP12RESETSTATUSREGISTERSTEP13READALLxVARHRAFTERLENERGYINTERRUPTSTEP14CALCULATExVARGSTEP15WRITETOxVARGSTEP16CALCULATEWh/LSB,VAh/LSB,VARh/LSBEND04443-081SELECTPHASEFORLINEPERIODMEASUREMENTCONFIGUREFREQ[11:0]FORALINEPERIODMEASUREMENT Figure 82. Gain Calibration Using Line Accumulation ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 50 of 72 Step 5: Set the LENERGY bit, MASK[12] (0x18), to Logic 1 to enable the interrupt signaling the end of the line cycle accumulation. Step 6: Set the test system for ITEST, VNOM, and unity power factor (calibrate watt and VA simultaneously and first). Step 7: Read the FREQ (0x10) register if the line frequency is unknown. Step 8: Reset the interrupt status register by reading RSTATUS (0x1A). Step 9: Read all six xWATTHR (0x01 to 0x03) and xVAHR (0x07 to 0x09) energy registers after the LENERGY interrupt and store the values. Step 9a: Calculate the values to be written to xWG registers according to the following equations: ()WDIVAPCFNUMAPCFDENAccumTimeθcosVIMCWATTHRNOMTESTEXPECTED1360010004××××××××= (60) where AccumTime is []SelectedPhasesofNo.FrequencyLine :LINECYC××2015 (61) where: MC is the meter constant. θ is the angle between the current and voltage. Line Frequency is known or calculated from the FREQ[11:0] register. With the FREQ[11:0] register configured for line period measurements, the line frequency is calculated with Equation 62. 6-109.60]:[111××=FREQFrequencyLine (62) No. of Phases Selected is the number of ZXSEL bits set to Logic 1 in LCYCMODE (0x17). Then, xWG is calculated as 1221×⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛−=MEASUREDEXPECTEDWATTHRWATTHRxWG (63) Step 9b: Calculate the values to be written to the xVAG registers according to the following equation: VADIVVARCFNUMVARCFDENAccumTimeVIMCVAHRNOMTESTEXPECTED1360010004×××××××= (64) 1221×⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛−=MEASUREDEXPECTEDVAHRVAHRxVAG Step 10: Write to xWG and xVAG. Step 11: Set the test system for ITEST, VNOM, and zero power factor inductive to calibrate VAR gain. Step 12: Repeat Step 7. Step 13: Read the xVARHR (0x04 to 0x06) after the LENERGY interrupt and store the values. Step 14: Calculate the values to be written to the xVARG registers (to adjust VARCF to the expected value). ()VARDIVVARCFNUMVARCFDENAccumTimeθsinVIMCVARHRNOMTESTEXPECTED1360010004××××××××= (65) 1221×⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛−=MEASUREDEXPECTEDVARHRVARHRxVARG Step 15: Write to xVARG. Step 16: Calculate the Wh/LSB, VARh/LSB, and VAh/LSB constants. ()xWATTHRAccumTimeθcosVILSBWhNOMTEST××××=3600 (66) xVAHRAccumTimeVILSBVAhNOMTEST×××=3600 (67) ()xVARHRAccumTimeθsinVILSBVARhNOMTEST××××=3600 (68) Example: Watt Gain Calibration Using Line Accumulation This example shows only Phase A watt calibration. The steps outlined in the Gain Calibration Using Line Accumulation section show how to calibrate watt, VA, and VAR. All three phases can be calibrated simultaneously because there are nine energy registers. For this example, ITEST = 10 A, VNOM = 220 V, Power Factor = 1, Frequency = 50 Hz, LINECYC (0x1C) is set to 0x800, and MC = 3200 imp/kWhr. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 51 of 72 To set APCFNUM (0x45) and APCFDEN (0x46) to the calculated value to perform a coarse adjustment on the imp/kW-hr ratio, use Equation 45 to Equation 47. kHz5415.013010500220kH16=××=zAPCFNOMINAL ()Hz1.956cos36001000220103200=θ××××=EXPECTEDAPCF 277Hz956.1Hz5.541INT=⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛=APCFDEN Under the test conditions above, the AWATTHR register value is 15559d after the LENERGY interrupt. Using Equation 60 and Equation 61, the value to be written to AWG is −199d, 0xF39. []SelectedPhasesofNo.FREQ:LINECYCAccumTime××××=−6106.9]0:11[12015 6.832128s3106.920851280006=××××=−xAccumTime 148041127736001000832.612201032004=××××××××=EXPECTEDWATTHR 0xF39–199–198.8764021155591480412===×⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛−=xWG Using Equation 66, the Wh/LSB constant is 00.000282148043600832.622010=×××=LSBWh Phase Calibration Using Line Accumulation The ADE7758 includes a phase calibration register on each phase to compensate for small phase errors. Large phase errors should be compensated by adjusting the antialiasing filters. The ADE7758 phase calibration is a time delay with different weights in the positive and negative direction (see the Phase Compensation section). Because a current transformer is a source of phase error, a fixed nominal value can be decided on to load into the xPHCAL (0x3F to 0x41) registers at power-up. During calibration, this value can be adjusted for CT-to-CT error. Figure 83 shows the steps involved in calibrating the phase using the line accumulation mode. STEP1SETLCYCMODE,LINECYCANDMASKREGISTERSSTEP2SETUPSYSTEMFORITEST,VNOM,PF=0.5,INDUCTIVESTEP3RESETSTATUSREGISTERSTEP4READALLxWATTHRREGISTERSAFTERLENERGYINTERRUPTSTEP5CALCULATEPHASEERROR INDEGREESFORALLPHASESSTEP6CALCULATEANDWRITETOALLxPHCALREGISTERS04443-082 Figure 83. Phase Calibration Using Line Accumulation Step 1: If the values were changed after gain calibration, Step 1, Step 3, and Step 4 from the gain calibration should be repeated to configure the LCYCMODE and LINECYC registers. Step 2: Set the test system for ITEST, VNOM, and 0.5 power factor inductive. Step 3: Reset the interrupt status register by reading RSTATUS (0x1A). Step 4: The xWATTHR registers should be read after the LENERGY interrupt. Measure the percent error in the energy register readings (AWATTHR, BWATTHR, and CWATTHR) compared to the energy register readings at unity power factor (after gain calibration) using Equation 69. The readings at unity power factor should have been repeated after the gain calibration and stored for use in the phase calibration routine. 22–1PF1PF5PF====xWATTHRxWATTHRxWATTHRError (69) Step 5: Calculate the Phase Error in degrees using the equation ()⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛=°3–ErrorArcsinErrorPhase (70) Step 6: Calculate xPHCAL and write to the xPHCAL registers (0x3F to 0x41). °×××=3601)(1__1sPeriodLineWeightLSBPHCALErrorPhasexPHCAL(71) where PHCAL_LSB_Weight is 1.2 μs if the %Error is negative or 2.4 μs if the %Error is positive (see the Phase Compensation section). ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 52 of 72 If it is not known, the line period is available in the ADE7758 frequency register, FREQ (0x10). To configure line period measurement, select the phase for period measurement in the MMODE[1:0] and set LCYCMODE[7]. Equation 72 shows how to determine the value that needs to be written to xPHCAL using the period register measurement. °××=360]0:11[__μs6.9FREQWeightLSBPHCALErrorPhasexPHCAL (72) Example: Phase Calibration Using Line Accumulation This example shows only Phase A phase calibration. All three PHCAL registers can be calibrated simultaneously using the same method. For this example, ITEST = 10 A, VNOM = 220 V, power factor = 0.5 inductive, and frequency = 50 Hz. Also, LINECYC = 0x800. With ITEST, VNOM, and 0.5 inductive power factor, the example ADE7758 meter shows 7318d in the AWATTHR (0x01) register. 14804d in the AWATTHR register. This is equivalent to −1.132% error. %132.101132.0214804214804–7318−=−==Error ()°=⎟⎠ ⎞⎛−01132.0 50 Hz, the FREQ (0x10) register = 2085d, is 17d. Note that a PHCAL_LSB_Weight of 1.2 μs is used because the %Error is negative. 11x01736020852.16.9374.0==××°=APHCAL F STEP1SETMMODE,LCYCMODE,LINECYCANDMASKREGISTERSSTEP2SETUPSYSTEMFORIMIN,VNOM@PF=1STEP3RESETSTATUSREGISTERSTEP4READALLxWATTHRREGISTERSAFTERLENERGYINTERRUPTENDFORSTEP8READALLxVARHRAFTERLENERGYINTERRUPTFORSTEP8,CALCULATExVAROSFORALLPHASESSTEP5CALCULATExWATTOSFORALLPHASESFORSTEP8,WRITETOALLxVAROSREGISTERSSTEP6WRITETOALLxWATTOSREGISTERSSTEP7SETUPSYSTEMFORITEST,VNOM@PF=0, INDUCTIVESTEP8REPEATSTEP3TOSTEP8FORxVARHR,xVAROS CALIBRATION Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 53 of 72 Power Offset Calibration Using Line Accumulation Power offset calibration should be used for outstanding performance over a wide dynamic range (1000:1). Calibration of the power offset is done at or close to the minimum current. The ADE7758 has power offset registers for watts and VAR, xWATTOS (0x39 to 0x3B) and xVAROS (0x3C to 0x3E). Offsets in the VA measurement are compensated by adjusting the rms offset registers (see the Calibration of IRMS and VRMS Offset section). More line cycles could be required at the minimum current to minimize the effect of quantization error on the offset calibration. For example, if a current of 40 mA results in an active energy accumulation of 113 after 2000 half line cycles, one LSB variation in this reading represents an 0.8% error. This measurement does not provide enough resolution to calibrate out a <1% offset error. However, if the active energy is accumulated over 37,500 half line cycles, one LSB variation results in 0.05% error, reducing the quantization error. Figure 84 shows the steps to calibrate the power offsets using the line accumulation mode. Step 1: If the values change after gain calibration, Step 1, Step 3, and Step 4 from the gain calibration should be repeated to configure the LCYCMODE, LINECYC, and MASK registers. Select Phase A, Phase B, or Phase C for a line period measure-ment with the FREQSEL[1:0] bits in the MMODE register (0x14). For example, clearing Bit 1 and Bit 0 selects Phase A for line period measurement. Step 2: Set the test system for IMIN, VNOM, and unity power factor. Step 3: Reset the interrupt status register by reading RSTATUS (0x1A). Step 4: Read all xWATTHR energy registers (0x01 to 0x03) after the LENERGY interrupt and store the values. Step 4a: If it is not known, the line period is available in the ADE7758 frequency register, FREQ (0x10). To configure line period measurement, select the phase for period measurement in the MMODE[1:0] and set LCYCMODE[7]. Step 5: Calculate the value to be written to the xWATTOS registers according to the following equations: TESTMINMINITESTIMINITESTIIIILINECYCLINECYCxWATTHRIxWATTHROffsetTESTMIN––×⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛××= (73) []29240:11×××=CLKINAccumTimeOffsetxWATTOS (74) where: AccumTime is defined in Equation 61. is the value in the energy register at ITEST. is the value in the energy register at IMIN. LINECYCIMIN is the number of line cycles accumulated at IMIN. LINECYCIMAX is the number of line cycles accumulated at IMAX. TESTIxWATTHRMINIxWATTHR Step 6: Write to all xWATTOS registers (0x39 to 0x3B). Step 7: Set the test system for IMIN, VNOM, and zero power factor inductive to calibrate VAR gain. Step 8: Repeat Steps 3, 4, and 5. Step 9: Calculate the value written to the xVAROS registers according to the following equations: TESTMINMINITESTIMINITESTIIIILINECYCLINECYCxVARHRIxVARHROffsetTESTMIN––×⎟⎟⎠⎞⎜⎜⎝⎛××= (75) 262202]0:11[40]:[11××××=FREQCLKINAccumTimeOffsetxVAROS(76) where the FREQ[11:0] register is configured for line period readings. Example: Power Offset Calibration Using Line Accumulation This example only shows Phase A of the phase active power offset calibration. Both active and reactive power offset for all phases can be calibrated simultaneously using the method explained in the Power Offset Calibration Using Line Accumulation section. For this example, IMIN = 50 mA, ITEST = 10 A, VNOM = 220 V, VFULLSCALE = 500 V, IFULLSCALE = 130 A, MC = 3200 impulses/kWh, Power Factor = 1, Frequency = 50 Hz, and CLKIN = 10 MHz. Also, LINECYCITEST = 0x800 and LINECYCIMIN = 0x4000. After accumulating over 0x800 line cycles for gain calibration at ITEST, the example ADE7758 meter shows 14804d in the AWATTHR (0x01) register. At IMIN, the meter shows 592d in the AWATTHR register. By using Equation 73, this is equivalent to 0.161 LSBs of offset; therefore, using Equation 61 and Equation 74, the value written to AWATTOS is 0d. 0.1610–0.050.050x8000x400014804–10592=×⎟⎠⎞⎜⎝⎛××=Offset s64.453106.9208512400006=×××××=−AccumTime ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 54 of 72 00.0882MHz1054.6440.16129=−=×××=AWATTOS The low-pass filter used to obtain the rms measurements is not ideal; therefore, it is recommended to synchronize the readings with the zero crossings of the voltage waveform and to average a few measurements when reading the rms registers. Calibration of IRMS and VRMS Offset IRMSOS and VRMSOS are used to cancel noise and offset contributions from the inputs. The calibration method is the same whether calibrating using the pulse outputs or line accumulation. Reading the registers is required for this calibration because there is no rms pulse output. The rms offset calibration should be performed before VAGAIN calibration. The rms offset calibration also removes offset from the VA calculation. For this reason, no VA offset register exists in the ADE7758. The ADE7758 IRMS measurement is linear over a 500:1 range, and the VRMS measurement is linear over a 20:1 range. To measure the voltage VRMS offset (xVRMSOS), measure rms values at two different nonzero current levels, for example, VNOM and VFULLSCALE/20. To measure the current rms offset (IRMSOS), measure rms values at two different nonzero current levels, for example, ITEST and IFULLSCALE/500. This translates to two test conditions: ITEST and VNOM, and IFULLSCALE/500 and VFULLSCALE/20. Figure 85 shows a flowchart for calibrating the rms measurements. STEP1SETCONFIGURATIONREGISTERSFORZEROCROSSINGONALLPHASESSTEP2SET INTERRUPTMASKFORZEROCROSSINGONALLPHASESSTEP3STEP4READRMSREGISTERSSTEP5WRITETOxVRMSOSxIRMSOSSETUPSYSTEMFORITEST,VNOMSETUPSYSTEMFORIFULLSCALE/500,VFULLSCALE/20STARTTESTEDALLPHASES?YESNOTESTEDALLCONDITIONS?12STEP4ACHOOSENn=0STEP4DREADxIRMSxVRMSSTEP4ECALCULATETHEAVERAGE OFNSAMPLESSTEP4BRESET INTERRUPTSTATUSREGISTERENDn=n+1n=N?NOYESYESNOSTEP4CINTERRUPT?04443-084 Figure 85. RMS Calibration Routine Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 55 of 72 Step 1: Set configuration registers for zero crossings on all phases by writing the value 0x38 to the LCYCMODE register (0x17). This sets all of the ZXSEL bits to Logic 1. Step 2: Set the interrupt mask register for zero-crossing detection on all phases by writing 0xE00 to the MASK[0:24] register (0x18). This sets all of the ZX bits to Logic 1. Step 3: Set up the calibration system for one of the two test conditions: ITEST and VNOM, and IFULLSCALE/500 and VFULLSCALE/20. Step 4: Read the rms registers after the zero-crossing interrupt and take an average of N samples. This is recommended to get the most stable rms readings. This procedure is detailed in Figure 85: Steps 4a through 4e. Step 4a. Choose the number of samples, N, to be averaged. Step 4b. Reset the interrupt status register by reading RSTATUS (0x1A). Step 4c. Wait for the zero-crossing interrupt. When the zero-crossing interrupt occurs, move to Step 4d. Step 4d. Read the xIRMS and xVRMS registers. These values will be averaged in Step 4e. Step 4e: Average the N samples of xIRMS and xVRMS. The averaged values will be used in Step 5. Step 5: Write to the xVRMSOS (0x33 to 0x35) and xIRMSOS (0x36 to 0x38) registers according to the following equations: ()( 222222163841TESTMINITESTMINIMINTESTI–IIRMSI–IRMSIxIRMSOS×××= (77) where: IMIN is the full scale current/500. ITEST is the test current. IRMSIMIN and IRMSITEST are the current rms register values without offset correction for the inputs IMIN and ITEST, respectively. NOMMINVNOMMINVMINNOMV–VVRMSV–VRMSVxVRMSOS×××=641 (78) where: VMIN is the full scale voltage/20 VNOM is the nominal line voltage. VRMSVMIN and VRMSVNOM are the voltage rms register values without offset correction for the input VMIN and VNOM, respectively. Example: Calibration of RMS Offsets For this example, ITEST = 10 A, IMAX = 100 A, VNOM = 220 V, VFULLSCALE = 500 V, Power Factor = 1, and Frequency = 50 Hz. Twenty readings are taken synchronous to the zero crossings of all three phases at each current and voltage to determine the average xIRMS and xVRMS readings. At ITEST and VNOM, the example ADE7758 meter gets an average AIRMS (0x0A) reading of 148242.2 and 744570.8 in the AVRMS (0x0D) register. Then the current is set to IMIN = IFULLSCALE/500 or 260 mA. At IMIN, the average AIRMS reading is 3885.68. At VMIN = VFULLSCALE/20 or 25 V, the example meter gets an average AVRMS of 86362.36. Using this data, −15d is written to AIRMSOS (0x36) and −31d is written to AVRMSOS (0x33) registers according to the Equation 77 and Equation 78. ()(() 0xFF2158.1410–260.0148242.2260.0–3885.681016384122222=−=−=×××=AIRMSOS ()()()0xFE1319.30220–25744570.825–86362.36220641=−=−=×××=AVRMSOS This example shows the calculations and measurements for Phase A only. However, all three xIRMS and xVRMS registers can be read simultaneously to compute the values for each xIRMSOS and xVRMSOS register. CHECKSUM REGISTER The ADE7758 has a checksum register CHKSUM[7:0] (0x7E) to ensure the data bits received in the last serial read operation are not corrupted. The 8-bit checksum register is reset before the first bit (MSB of the register to be read) is put on the DOUT pin. During a serial read operation, when each data bit becomes available on the rising edge of SCLK, the bit is added to the checksum register. In the end of the serial read operation, the contents of the checksum register are equal to the sum of all the 1s in the register previously read. Using the checksum register, the user can determine if an error has occurred during the last read operation. Note that a read to the checksum register also generates a checksum of the checksum register itself. DOUTADDR: 0x7ECHECKSUMREGISTERCONTENT OF REGISTERS(N-BYTES)04443-085 Figure 86. Checksum Register for Serial Interface Read INTERRUPTS The ADE7758 interrupts are managed through the interrupt status register (STATUS[23:0], Address 0x19) and the interrupt mask register (MASK[23:0], Address 0x18). When an interrupt event occurs in the ADE7758, the corresponding flag in the interrupt status register is set to a Logic 1 (see Table 24). If the mask bit for this interrupt in the interrupt mask register is Logic 1, then the IRQ logic output goes active low. The flag bits ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 56 of 72 in the interrupt status register are set irrespective of the state of the mask bits. To determine the source of the interrupt, the MCU should perform a read from the reset interrupt status register with reset. This is achieved by carrying out a read from RSTATUS, Address 0x1A. The IRQ output goes logic high on completion of the interrupt status register read command (see the section). When carrying out a read with reset, the is designed to ensure that no interrupt events are missed. If an interrupt event occurs just as the interrupt status register is being read, the event is not lost, and the Interrupt TimingADE7758IRQ logic output is guaranteed to go logic high for the duration of the interrupt status register data transfer before going logic low again to indicate the pending interrupt. Note that the reset interrupt bit in the status register is high for only one clock cycle, and it then goes back to 0. USING THE INTERRUPTS WITH AN MCU Figure 87 shows a timing diagram that illustrates a suggested implementation of ADE7758 interrupt management using an MCU. At time t1, the IRQ line goes active low indicating that one or more interrupt events have occurred in the . The ADE7758IRQ logic output should be tied to a negative-edge-triggered external interrupt on the MCU. On detection of the negative edge, the MCU should be configured to start executing its interrupt service routine (ISR). On entering the ISR, all interrupts should be disabled using the global interrupt mask bit. At this point, the MCU external interrupt flag can be cleared to capture interrupt events that occur during the current ISR. When the MCU interrupt flag is cleared, a read from the reset interrupt status register with reset is carried out. (This causes the IRQ line to be reset logic high (t2); see the section.) The reset interrupt status register contents are used to determine the source of the interrupt(s) and hence the appropriate action to be taken. If a subsequent interrupt event occurs during the ISR (t3) that event is recorded by the MCU external interrupt flag being set again. Interrupt Timing On returning from the ISR, the global interrupt mask bit is cleared (same instruction cycle) and the external interrupt flag uses the MCU to jump to its ISR once again. This ensures that the MCU does not miss any external interrupts. The reset bit in the status register is an exception to this and is only high for one clock cycle after a reset event. INTERRUPT TIMING The Serial Interface section should be reviewed before reviewing this section. As previously described, when the IRQ output goes low, the MCU ISR must read the interrupt status register to determine the source of the interrupt. When reading the interrupt status register contents, the IRQ output is set high on the last falling edge of SCLK of the first byte transfer (read interrupt status register command). The IRQ output is held high until the last bit of the next 8-bit transfer is shifted out (interrupt status register contents), as shown in . If an interrupt is pending at this time, the Figure 88IRQ output goes low again. If no interrupt is pending, the IRQ output remains high. SERIAL INTERFACE The ADE7758 has a built-in SPI interface. The serial interface of the ADE7758 is made of four signals: SCLK, DIN, DOUT, and CS. The serial clock for a data transfer is applied at the SCLK logic input. This logic input has a Schmitt trigger input structure that allows slow rising (and falling) clock edges to be used. All data transfer operations are synchronized to the serial clock. Data is shifted into the at the DIN logic input on the falling edge of SCLK. Data is shifted out of the at the DOUT logic output on a rising edge of SCLK. ADE7758ADE7758 The CS logic input is the chip select input. This input is used when multiple devices share the serial bus. A falling edge on CS also resets the serial interface and places the in communications mode. ADE7758 The CS input should be driven low for the entire data transfer operation. Bringing CS high during a data transfer operation aborts the transfer and places the serial bus in a high impedance state. The CS logic input can be tied low if the is the only device on the serial bus. ADE7758 However, with CS tied low, all initiated data transfer operations must be fully completed. The LSB of each register must be transferred because there is no other way of bringing the back into communications mode without resetting the entire device, that is, performing a software reset using Bit 6 of the OPMODE[7:0] register, Address 0x13. ADE7758 The functionality of the ADE7758 is accessible via several on-chip registers (see Figure 89). The contents of these registers can be updated or read using the on-chip serial interface. After a falling edge on CS, the is placed in communications mode. In communications mode, the expects the first communication to be a write to the internal communications register. The data written to the communications register contains the address and specifies the next data transfer to be a read or a write command. Therefore, all data transfer operations with the , whether a read or a write, must begin with a write to the communications register. ADE7758ADE7758ADE7758 Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 57 of 72 GLOBALINTERRUPTMASKISR RETURNGLOBAL INTERRUPTMASK RESETCLEAR MCUINTERRUPTFLAGREADSTATUS WITHRESET (0x1A)ISR ACTION(BASED ON STATUS CONTENTS)MCUINTERRUPTFLAG SETPROGRAMSEQUENCEt1t2t3JUMPTOISRJUMPTOISRIRQ04443-086 Figure 87. ADE7758 Interrupt Management STATUS REGISTER CONTENTSSCLKDINDOUTREAD STATUS REGISTER COMMANDt1CS0001000DB15DB8DB7DB01t9t11t12IRQ04443-087 Figure 88. ADE7758 Interrupt Timing COMMUNICATIONSREGISTERINOUTINOUTINOUTINOUTINOUTREGISTER NO. 1REGISTER NO. 2REGISTER NO. 3REGISTER NO. n–1REGISTER NO. nREGISTERADDRESSDECODEDINDOUT04443-088 Figure 89. Addressing ADE7758 Registers via the Communications Register The communications register is an 8-bit, write-only register. The MSB determines whether the next data transfer operation is a read or a write. The seven LSBs contain the address of the register to be accessed (see Table 16). Figure 90 and Figure 91 show the data transfer sequences for a read and write operation, respectively. MULTIBYTECOMMUNICATIONS REGISTER WRITEDINSCLKDOUTREAD DATAADDRESS0CS04443-089 Figure 90. Reading Data from the ADE7758 via the Serial Interface COMMUNICATIONS REGISTER WRITEDINSCLKADDRESS1CSMULTIBYTEREAD DATA04443-090 Figure 91. Writing Data to the ADE7758 via the Serial Interface On completion of a data transfer (read or write), the ADE7758 once again enters into communications mode, that is, the next instruction followed must be a write to the communications register. A data transfer is completed when the LSB of the ADE7758 register being addressed (for a write or a read) is transferred to or from the ADE7758. SERIAL WRITE OPERATION The serial write sequence takes place as follows. With the ADE7758 in communications mode and the CS input logic low, a write to the communications register takes place first. The MSB of this byte transfer must be set to 1, indicating that the next data transfer operation is a write to the register. The seven LSBs of this byte contain the address of the register to be written to. The starts shifting in the register data on the next falling edge of SCLK. All remaining bits of register data are shifted in on the falling edge of the subsequent SCLK pulses (see ). ADE7758Figure 92 ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 58 of 72 As explained earlier, the data write is initiated by a write to the communications register followed by the data. During a data write operation to the ADE7758, data is transferred to all on-chip registers one byte at a time. After a byte is transferred into the serial port, there is a finite time duration before the content in the serial port buffer is transferred to one of the ADE7758 on-chip registers. Although another byte transfer to the serial port can start while the previous byte is being transferred to the destination register, this second-byte transfer should not finish until at least 900 ns after the end of the previous byte transfer. This functionality is expressed in the timing specification t6 (see Figure 92). If a write operation is aborted during a byte transfer (CS brought high), then that byte is not written to the destination register. Destination registers can be up to 3 bytes wide (see the Accessing the On-Chip Registers section). Therefore, the first byte shifted into the serial port at DIN is transferred to the most significant byte (MSB) of the destination register. If the destination register is 12 bits wide, for example, a two-byte data transfer must take place. The data is always assumed to be right justified; therefore, in this case, the four MSBs of the first byte would be ignored, and the four LSBs of the first byte written to the ADE7758 would be the four MSBs of the 12-bit word. Figure 93 illustrates this example. DINSCLKCSt2t3t1t4t5t7t6t8COMMAND BYTEMOST SIGNIFICANT BYTELEAST SIGNIFICANT BYTE1A6A4A5A3A2A1A0DB7DB0DB7DB0t704443-091 Figure 92. Serial Interface Write Timing Diagram SCLKDINXXXXDB11DB10DB9DB8DB7DB6DB5DB4DB3DB2DB1DB0MOST SIGNIFICANT BYTELEAST SIGNIFICANT BYTE04443-092 Figure 93. 12-Bit Serial Write Operation SCLKCSt1t10t130A6A4A5A3A2A1A0DB0DB7DB0DB7DINDOUTt11t12COMMAND BYTEMOST SIGNIFICANT BYTELEAST SIGNIFICANT BYTEt904443-093 Figure 94. Serial Interface Read Timing Diagram Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 59 of 72 SERIAL READ OPERATION During a data read operation from the ADE7758, data is shifted out at the DOUT logic output on the rising edge of SCLK. As was the case with the data write operation, a data read must be preceded with a write to the communications register. With the ADE7758 in communications mode and CS logic low, an 8-bit write to the communications register takes place first. The MSB of this byte transfer must be a 0, indicating that the next data transfer operation is a read. The seven LSBs of this byte contain the address of the register that is to be read. The starts shifting out of the register data on the next rising edge of SCLK (see ). At this point, the DOUT logic output switches from a high impedance state and starts driving the data bus. All remaining bits of register data are shifted out on subsequent SCLK rising edges. The serial interface enters communications mode again as soon as the read is completed. The DOUT logic output enters a high impedance state on the falling edge of the last SCLK pulse. ADE7758Figure 94 The read operation can be aborted by bringing the CS logic input high before the data transfer is completed. The DOUT output enters a high impedance state on the rising edge of CS. When an ADE7758 register is addressed for a read operation, the entire contents of that register are transferred to the serial port. This allows the ADE7758 to modify its on-chip registers without the risk of corrupting data during a multibyte transfer. Note that when a read operation follows a write operation, the read command (that is, write to communications register) should not happen for at least 1.1 μs after the end of the write operation. If the read command is sent within 1.1 μs of the write operation, the last byte of the write operation can be lost. ACCESSING THE ON-CHIP REGISTERS All ADE7758 functionality is accessed via the on-chip registers. Each register is accessed by first writing to the communications register and then transferring the register data. For a full description of the serial interface protocol, see the Serial Interface section. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 60 of 72 REGISTERS COMMUNICATIONS REGISTER The communications register is an 8-bit, write-only register that controls the serial data transfer between the ADE7758 and the host processor. All data transfer operations must begin with a write to the communications register. The data written to the communications register determines whether the next operation is a read or a write and which register is being accessed. Table 16 outlines the bit designations for the communications register. Table 16. Communications Register Bit Location Bit Mnemonic Description 0 to 6 A0 to A6 The seven LSBs of the communications register specify the register for the data transfer operation. Table 17 lists the address of each ADE7758 on-chip register. 7 W/R When this bit is a Logic 1, the data transfer operation immediately following the write to the communications register is interpreted as a write to the ADE7758. When this bit is a Logic 0, the data transfer operation immediately following the write to the communications register is interpreted as a read operation. DB7 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 W/R A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 Table 17. ADE7758 Register List Address [A6:A0] Name R/W1 Length Type2 Default Value Description 0x00 Reserved – Reserved. 0x01 AWATTHR R 16 S 0 Watt-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase A. Active power is accumulated over time in this read-only register. The AWATTHR register can hold a maximum of 0.52 seconds of active energy information with full-scale analog inputs before it overflows (see the Active Energy Calculation section). Bit 0 and Bit 1 of the COMPMODE register determine how the active energy is processed from the six analog inputs. 0x02 BWATTHR R 16 S 0 Watt-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase B. 0x03 CWATTHR R 16 S 0 Watt-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase C. 0x04 AVARHR R 16 S 0 VAR-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase A. Reactive power is accumulated over time in this read-only register. The AVARHR register can hold a maximum of 0.52 seconds of reactive energy information with full-scale analog inputs before it overflows (see the Reactive Energy Calculation section). Bit 0 and Bit 1 of the COMPMODE register determine how the reactive energy is processed from the six analog inputs. 0x05 BVARHR R 16 S 0 VAR-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase B. 0x06 CVARHR R 16 S 0 VAR-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase C. 0x07 AVAHR R 16 S 0 VA-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase A. Apparent power is accumulated over time in this read-only register. The AVAHR register can hold a maximum of 1.15 seconds of apparent energy information with full-scale analog inputs before it overflows (see the Apparent Energy Calculation section). Bit 0 and Bit 1 of the COMPMODE register determine how the apparent energy is processed from the six analog inputs. 0x08 BVAHR R 16 S 0 VA-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase B. 0x09 CVAHR R 16 S 0 VA-Hour Accumulation Register for Phase C. 0x0A AIRMS R 24 S 0 Phase A Current Channel RMS Register. The register contains the rms component of the Phase A input of the current channel. The source is selected by data bits in the mode register. 0x0B BIRMS R 24 S 0 Phase B Current Channel RMS Register. 0x0C CIRMS R 24 S 0 Phase C Current Channel RMS Register. 0x0D AVRMS R 24 S 0 Phase A Voltage Channel RMS Register. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 61 of 72 Address [A6:A0] Name R/W1 Length Type2 Default Value Description 0x0E BVRMS R 24 S 0 Phase B Voltage Channel RMS Register. 0x0F CVRMS R 24 S 0 Phase C Voltage Channel RMS Register. 0x10 FREQ R 12 U 0 Frequency of the Line Input Estimated by the Zero-Crossing Processing. It can also display the period of the line input. Bit 7 of the LCYCMODE register determines if the reading is frequency or period. Default is frequency. Data Bit 0 and Bit 1 of the MMODE register determine the voltage channel used for the frequency or period calculation. 0x11 TEMP R 8 S 0 Temperature Register. This register contains the result of the latest temperature conversion. Refer to the Temperature Measurement section for details on how to interpret the content of this register. 0x12 WFORM R 24 S 0 Waveform Register. This register contains the digitized waveform of one of the six analog inputs or the digitized power waveform. The source is selected by Data Bit 0 to Bit 4 in the WAVMODE register. 0x13 OPMODE R/W 8 U 4 Operational Mode Register. This register defines the general configuration of the ADE7758 (see Table 18). 0x14 MMODE R/W 8 U 0xFC Measurement Mode Register. This register defines the channel used for period and peak detection measurements (see Table 19). 0x15 WAVMODE R/W 8 U 0 Waveform Mode Register. This register defines the channel and sampling frequency used in the waveform sampling mode (see Table 20). 0x16 COMPMODE R/W 8 U 0x1C Computation Mode Register. This register configures the formula applied for the energy and line active energy measurements (see Table 22). 0x17 LCYCMODE R/W 8 U 0x78 Line Cycle Mode Register. This register configures the line cycle accumulation mode for WATT-HR, VAR-HR, and VA-Hr (see Table 23). 0x18 Mask R/W 24 U 0 IRQ Mask Register. It determines if an interrupt event generates an active-low output at the IRQ pin (see the section). Interrupts 0x19 Status R 24 U 0 IRQ Status Register. This register contains information regarding the source of the interrupts (see the section). ADE7758Interrupts 0x1A RSTATUS R 24 U 0 IRQ Reset Status Register. Same as the STATUS register, except that its contents are reset to 0 (all flags cleared) after a read operation. 0x1B ZXTOUT R/W 16 U 0xFFFF Zero-Cross Timeout Register. If no zero crossing is detected within the time period specified by this register, the interrupt request line (IRQ) goes active low for the corresponding line voltage. The maximum timeout period is 2.3 seconds (see the section). Zero-Crossing Detection 0x1C LINECYC R/W 16 U 0xFFFF Line Cycle Register. The content of this register sets the number of half-line cycles that the active, reactive, and apparent energies are accumulated for in the line accumulation mode. 0x1D SAGCYC R/W 8 U 0xFF SAG Line Cycle Register. This register specifies the number of consecutive half-line cycles where voltage channel input may fall below a threshold level. This register is common to the three line voltage SAG detection. The detection threshold is specified by the SAGLVL register (see the Line Voltage SAG Detection section). 0x1E SAGLVL R/W 8 U 0 SAG Voltage Level. This register specifies the detection threshold for the SAG event. This register is common to all three phases’ line voltage SAG detections. See the description of the SAGCYC register for details. 0x1F VPINTLVL R/W 8 U 0xFF Voltage Peak Level Interrupt Threshold Register. This register sets the level of the voltage peak detection. Bit 5 to Bit 7 of the MMODE register determine which phases are to be monitored. If the selected voltage phase exceeds this level, the PKV flag in the IRQ status register is set. 0x20 IPINTLVL R/W 8 U 0xFF Current Peak Level Interrupt Threshold Register. This register sets the level of the current peak detection. Bit 5 to Bit 7 of the MMODE register determine which phases are to be monitored. If the selected current phase exceeds this level, the PKI flag in the IRQ status register is set. 0x21 VPEAK R 8 U 0 Voltage Peak Register. This register contains the value of the peak voltage waveform that has occurred within a fixed number of half-line cycles. The number of half-line cycles is set by the LINECYC register. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 62 of 72 Address [A6:A0] Name R/W1 Length Type2 Default Value Description 0x22 IPEAK R 8 U 0 Current Peak Register. This register holds the value of the peak current waveform that has occurred within a fixed number of half-line cycles. The number of half-line cycles is set by the LINECYC register. 0x23 Gain R/W 8 U 0 PGA Gain Register. This register is used to adjust the gain selection for the PGA in the current and voltage channels (see the Analog Inputs section). 0x24 AVRMSGAIN R/W 12 S 0 Phase A VRMS Gain Register. The range of the voltage rms calculation can be adjusted by writing to this register. It has an adjustment range of ±50% with a resolution of 0.0244%/LSB. 0x25 BVRMSGAIN R/W 12 S 0 Phase B VRMS Gain Register. 0x26 CVRMSGAIN R/W 12 S 0 Phase C VRMS Gain Register. 0x27 AIGAIN R/W 12 S 0 Phase A Current Gain Register. This register is not recommended to be used and it should be kept at 0, its default value. 0x28 BIGAIN R/W 12 S 0 Phase B Current Gain Register. This register is not recommended to be used and it should be kept at 0, its default value. 0x29 CIGAIN R/W 12 S 0 Phase C Current Gain Register. This register is not recommended to be used and it should be kept at 0, its default value. 0x2A AWG R/W 12 S 0 Phase A Watt Gain Register. The range of the watt calculation can be adjusted by writing to this register. It has an adjustment range of ±50% with a resolution of 0.0244%/LSB. 0x2B BWG R/W 12 S 0 Phase B Watt Gain Register. 0x2C CWG R/W 12 S 0 Phase C Watt Gain Register. 0x2D AVARG R/W 12 S 0 Phase A VAR Gain Register. The range of the VAR calculation can be adjusted by writing to this register. It has an adjustment range of ±50% with a resolution of 0.0244%/LSB. 0x2E BVARG R/W 12 S 0 Phase B VAR Gain Register. 0x2F CVARG R/W 12 S 0 Phase C VAR Gain Register. 0x30 AVAG R/W 12 S 0 Phase A VA Gain Register. The range of the VA calculation can be adjusted by writing to this register. It has an adjustment range of ±50% with a resolution of 0.0244%/LSB. 0x31 BVAG R/W 12 S 0 Phase B VA Gain Register. 0x32 CVAG R/W 12 S 0 Phase C VA Gain Register. 0x33 AVRMSOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase A Voltage RMS Offset Correction Register. 0x34 BVRMSOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase B Voltage RMS Offset Correction Register. 0x35 CVRMSOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase C Voltage RMS Offset Correction Register. 0x36 AIRMSOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase A Current RMS Offset Correction Register. 0x37 BIRMSOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase B Current RMS Offset Correction Register. 0x38 CIRMSOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase C Current RMS Offset Correction Register. 0x39 AWATTOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase A Watt Offset Calibration Register. 0x3A BWATTOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase B Watt Offset Calibration Register. 0x3B CWATTOS R/W 12 S 0 Phase C Watt Offset Calibration Register. 0x3C AVAROS R/W 12 S 0 Phase A VAR Offset Calibration Register. 0x3D BVAROS R/W 12 S 0 Phase B VAR Offset Calibration Register. 0x3E CVAROS R/W 12 S 0 Phase C VAR Offset Calibration Register. 0x3F APHCAL R/W 7 S 0 Phase A Phase Calibration Register. The phase relationship between the current and voltage channel can be adjusted by writing to this signed 7-bit register (see the Phase Compensation section). 0x40 BPHCAL R/W 7 S 0 Phase B Phase Calibration Register. 0x41 CPHCAL R/W 7 S 0 Phase C Phase Calibration Register. 0x42 WDIV R/W 8 U 0 Active Energy Register Divider. 0x43 VARDIV R/W 8 U 0 Reactive Energy Register Divider. 0x44 VADIV R/W 8 U 0 Apparent Energy Register Divider. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 63 of 72 Address [A6:A0] Name R/W1 Length Type2 Default Value Description 0x45 APCFNUM R/W 16 U 0 Active Power CF Scaling Numerator Register. The content of thisregister is used in the numerator of the APCF output scaling calculation. Bits [15:13] indicate reverse polarity active power measurement for Phase A, Phase B, and Phase C in order; that is, Bit 15 is Phase A, Bit 14 is Phase B, and so on. 0x46 APCFDEN R/W 12 U 0x3F Active Power CF Scaling Denominator Register. The content of this register is used in the denominator of the APCF output scaling. 0x47 VARCFNUM R/W 16 U 0 Reactive Power CF Scaling Numerator Register. The content of this register is used in the numerator of the VARCF output scaling. Bits [15:13] indicate reverse polarity reactive power measurement for Phase A, Phase B, and Phase C in order; that is, Bit 15 is Phase A, Bit 14 is Phase B, and so on. 0x48 VARCFDEN R/W 12 U 0x3F Reactive Power CF Scaling Denominator Register. The content of this register is used in the denominator of the VARCF output scaling. 0x49 to 0x7D Reserved − − – − Reserved. 0x7E CHKSUM R 8 U − Checksum Register. The content of this register represents the sum of all the ones in the last register read from the SPI port. 0x7F Version R 8 U − Version of the Die. 1 This column specifies the read/write capability of the register. R = Read only register. R/W = Register that can be both read and written. 2 Type decoder: U = unsigned; S = signed. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 64 of 72 OPERATIONAL MODE REGISTER (0x13) The general configuration of the ADE7758 is defined by writing to the OPMODE register. Table 18 summarizes the functionality of each bit in the OPMODE register. Table 18. OPMODE Register Bit Location Bit Mnemonic Default Value Description 0 DISHPF 0 The HPFs in all current channel inputs are disabled when this bit is set. 1 DISLPF 0 The LPFs after the watt and VAR multipliers are disabled when this bit is set. 2 DISCF 1 The frequency outputs APCF and VARCF are disabled when this bit is set. 3 to 5 DISMOD 0 By setting these bits, the ADE7758 ADCs can be turned off. In normal operation, these bits should be left at Logic 0. DISMOD[2:0] Description 0 0 0 Normal operation. 1 0 0 Redirect the voltage inputs to the signal paths for the current channels and the current inputs to the signal paths for the voltage channels. 0 0 1 Switch off only the current channel ADCs. 1 0 1 Switch off current channel ADCs and redirect the current input signals to the voltage channel signal paths. 0 1 0 Switch off only the voltage channel ADCs. 1 1 0 Switch off voltage channel ADCs and redirect the voltage input signals to the current channel signal paths. 0 1 1 Put the ADE7758 in sleep mode. 1 1 1 Put the ADE7758 in power-down mode (reduces AIDD to 1 mA typ). 6 SWRST 0 Software Chip Reset. A data transfer to the ADE7758 should not take place for at least 166 μs after a software reset. 7 Reserved 0 This should be left at 0. MEASUREMENT MODE REGISTER (0x14) The configuration of the PERIOD and peak measurements made by the ADE7758 is defined by writing to the MMODE register. Table 19 summarizes the functionality of each bit in the MMODE register. Table 19. MMODE Register Bit Location Bit Mnemonic Default Value Description 0 to 1 FREQSEL 0 These bits are used to select the source of the measurement of the voltage line frequency. FREQSEL1 FREQSEL0 Source 0 0 Phase A 0 1 Phase B 1 0 Phase C 1 1 Reserved 2 to 4 PEAKSEL 7 These bits select the phases used for the voltage and current peak registers. Setting Bit 2 switches the IPEAK and VPEAK registers to hold the absolute values of the largest current and voltage waveform (over a fixed number of half-line cycles) from Phase A. The number of half-line cycles is determined by the content of the LINECYC register. At the end of the LINECYC number of half-line cycles, the content of the registers is replaced with the new peak values. Similarly, setting Bit 3 turns on the peak detection for Phase B, and Bit 4 for Phase C. Note that if more than one bit is set, the VPEAK and IPEAK registers can hold values from two different phases, that is, the voltage and current peak are independently processed (see the Peak Current Detection section). 5 to 7 PKIRQSEL 7 These bits select the phases used for the peak interrupt detection. Setting Bit 5 switches on the monitoring of the absolute current and voltage waveform to Phase A. Similarly, setting Bit 6 turns on the waveform detection for Phase B, and Bit 7 for Phase C. Note that more than one bit can be set for detection on multiple phases. If the absolute values of the voltage or current waveform samples in the selected phases exceeds the preset level specified in the VPINTLVL or IPINTLVL registers the corresponding bit(s) in the STATUS registers are set (see the Peak Current Detection section). Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 65 of 72 WAVEFORM MODE REGISTER (0x15) The waveform sampling mode of the ADE7758 is defined by writing to the WAVMODE register. Table 20 summarizes the functionality of each bit in the WAVMODE register. Table 20. WAVMODE Register Bit Location Bit Mnemonic Default Value Description 0 to 1 PHSEL 0 These bits are used to select the phase of the waveform sample. PHSEL[1:0] Source 0 0 Phase A 0 1 Phase B 1 0 Phase C 1 1 Reserved 2 to 4 WAVSEL 0 These bits are used to select the type of waveform. WAVSEL[2:0] Source 0 0 0 Current 0 0 1 Voltage 0 1 0 Active Power Multiplier Output 0 1 1 Reactive Power Multiplier Output 1 0 0 VA Multiplier Output Others- Reserved 5 to 6 DTRT 0 These bits are used to select the data rate. DTRT[1:0] Update Rate 0 0 26.04 kSPS (CLKIN/3/128) 0 1 13.02 kSPS (CLKIN/3/256) 1 0 6.51 kSPS (CLKIN/3/512) 1 1 3.25 kSPS (CLKIN/3/1024) 7 VACF 0 Setting this bit to Logic 1 switches the VARCF output pin to an output frequency that is proportional to the total apparent power (VA). In the default state, Logic 0, the VARCF pin outputs a frequency proportional to the total reactive power (VAR). ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 66 of 72 COMPUTATIONAL MODE REGISTER (0x16) The computational method of the ADE7758 is defined by writing to the COMPMODE register. Table 21 summarizes the functionality of each bit in the COMPMODE register. Table 21. COMPMODE Register Bit Location Bit Mnemonic Default Value Description 0 to 1 CONSEL 0 These bits are used to select the input to the energy accumulation registers. CONSEL[1:0] = 11 is reserved. IA, IB, and IC are IA, IB, and IC phase shifted by –90°, respectively. Registers CONSEL[1, 0] = 00 CONSEL[1, 0] = 01 CONSEL[1, 0] = 10 AWATTHR VA × IA VA × (IA – IB) VA × (IA–IB) BWATTHR VB × IB 0 0 CWATTHR VC × IC VC × (IC – IB) VC × IC AVARHR VA × IA VA × (IA – IB) VA × (IA–IB) BVARHR VB × IB 0 0 CVARHR VC × IC VC × (IC – IB) VC × IC AVAHR VARMS × IARMS VARMS × IARMS VARMS × ARMS BVAHR VBRMS × IBRMS (VARMS + VCRMS)/2 × IBRMS VARMS × IBRMS CVAHR VCRMS × ICRMS VCRMS × ICRMS VCRMS × ICRMS 2 to 4 TERMSEL 7 These bits are used to select the phases to be included in the APCF and VARCF pulse outputs. Setting Bit 2 selects Phase A (the inputs to AWATTHR and AVARHR registers) to be included. Bit 3 and Bit 4 are for Phase B and Phase C, respectively. Setting all three bits enables the sum of all three phases to be included in the frequency outputs (see the Active Power Frequency Output and the Reactive Power Frequency Output sections). 5 ABS 0 Setting this bit places the APCF output pin in absolute only mode. Namely, the APCF output frequency is proportional to the sum of the absolute values of the watt-hour accumulation registers (AWATTHR, BWATTHR, and CWATTHR). Note that this bit only affects the APCF pin and has no effect on the content of the corresponding registers. 6 SAVAR 0 Setting this bit places the VARCF output pin in the signed adjusted mode. Namely, the VARCF output frequency is proportional to the sign-adjusted sum of the VAR-hour accumulation registers (AVARHR, BVARHR, and CVARHR). The sign of the VAR is determined from the sign of the watt calculation from the corresponding phase, that is, the sign of the VAR is flipped if the sign of the watt is negative, and if the watt is positive, there is no change to the sign of the VAR. Note that this bit only affects the VARCF pin and has no effect on the content of the corresponding registers. 7 NOLOAD 0 Setting this bit activates the no-load threshold in the ADE7758. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 67 of 72 LINE CYCLE ACCUMULATION MODE REGISTER (0x17) The functionalities involved the line-cycle accumulation mode in the ADE7758 are defined by writing to the LCYCMODE register. Table 22 summarizes the functionality of each bit in the LCYCMODE register. Table 22. LCYCMODE Register Bit Location Bit Mnemonic Default Value Description 0 LWATT 0 Setting this bit places the watt-hour accumulation registers (AWATTHR, BWATTHR, and CWATTHR registers) into line-cycle accumulation mode. 1 LVAR 0 Setting this bit places the VAR-hour accumulation registers (AVARHR, BVARHR, and CVARHR registers) into line-cycle accumulation mode. 2 LVA 0 Setting this bit places the VA-hour accumulation registers (AVAHR, BVAHR, and CVAHR registers) into line-cycle accumulation mode. 3 to 5 ZXSEL 7 These bits select the phases used for counting the number of zero crossings in the line-cycle accumulation mode. Bit 3, Bit 4, and Bit 5 select Phase A, Phase B, and Phase C, respectively. More than one phase can be selected for the zero-crossing detection, and the accumulation time is shortened accordingly. 6 RSTREAD 1 Setting this bit enables the read-with-reset for all the WATTHR, VARHR, and VAHR registers for all three phases, that is, a read to those registers resets the registers to 0 after the content of the registers have been read. This bit should be set to Logic 0 when the LWATT, LVAR, or LVA bits are set to Logic 1. 7 FREQSEL 0 Setting this bit causes the FREQ (0x10) register to display the period, instead of the frequency of the line input. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 68 of 72 INTERRUPT MASK REGISTER (0x18) When an interrupt event occurs in the ADE7758, the IRQ logic output goes active low if the mask bit for this event is Logic 1 in the MASK register. The IRQ logic output is reset to its default collector open state when the RSTATUS register is read. describes the function of each bit in the interrupt mask register. Table 23 Table 23. Function of Each Bit in the Interrupt Mask Register Bit Location Interrupt Flag Default Value Description 0 AEHF 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a change in Bit 14 of any one of the three WATTHR registers, that is, the WATTHR register is half full. 1 REHF 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a change in Bit 14 of any one of the three VARHR registers, that is, the VARHR register is half full. 2 VAEHF 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a 0 to 1 transition in the MSB of any one of the three VAHR registers, that is, the VAHR register is half full. 3 SAGA 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a SAG on the line voltage of the Phase A. 4 SAGB 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a SAG on the line voltage of the Phase B. 5 SAGC 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a SAG on the line voltage of the Phase C. 6 ZXTOA 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a zero-crossing timeout detection on Phase A. 7 ZXTOB 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a zero-crossing timeout detection on Phase B. 8 ZXTOC 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a zero-crossing timeout detection on Phase C. 9 ZXA 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a zero crossing in the voltage channel of Phase A (see the Zero-Crossing Detection section). 10 ZXB 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a zero crossing in the voltage channel of Phase B (see the Zero-Crossing Detection section). 11 ZXC 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a zero crossing in the voltage channel of Phase C (see the Zero-Crossing Detection section). 12 LENERGY 0 Enables an interrupt when the energy accumulations over LINECYC are finished. 13 Reserved 0 Reserved. 14 PKV 0 Enables an interrupt when the voltage input selected in the MMODE register is above the value in the VPINTLVL register. 15 PKI 0 Enables an interrupt when the current input selected in the MMODE register is above the value in the IPINTLVL register. 16 WFSM 0 Enables an interrupt when data is present in the WAVEMODE register. 17 REVPAP 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a sign change in the watt calculation among any one of the phases specified by the TERMSEL bits in the COMPMODE register. 18 REVPRP 0 Enables an interrupt when there is a sign change in the VAR calculation among any one of the phases specified by the TERMSEL bits in the COMPMODE register. 19 SEQERR 0 Enables an interrupt when the zero crossing from Phase A is followed not by the zero crossing of Phase C but with that of Phase B. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 69 of 72 INTERRUPT STATUS REGISTER (0x19)/RESET INTERRUPT STATUS REGISTER (0x1A) The interrupt status register is used to determine the source of an interrupt event. When an interrupt event occurs in the ADE7758, the corresponding flag in the interrupt status register is set. The IRQ pin goes active low if the corresponding bit in the interrupt mask register is set. When the MCU services the interrupt, it must first carry out a read from the interrupt status register to determine the source of the interrupt. All the interrupts in the interrupt status register stay at their logic high state after an event occurs. The state of the interrupt bit in the interrupt status register is reset to its default value once the reset interrupt status register is read. Table 24. Interrupt Status Register Bit Location Interrupt Flag Default Value Event Description 0 AEHF 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a change in Bit 14 among any one of the three WATTHR registers, that is, the WATTHR register is half full. 1 REHF 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a change in Bit 14 among any one of the three VARHR registers, that is, the VARHR register is half full. 2 VAEHF 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a 0 to 1 transition in Bit 15 among any one of the three VAHR registers, that is, the VAHR register is half full. 3 SAGA 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a SAG on the line voltage of the Phase A. 4 SAGB 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a SAG on the line voltage of the Phase B. 5 SAGC 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a SAG on the line voltage of the Phase C. 6 ZXTOA 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a missing zero crossing on the line voltage of the Phase A. 7 ZXTOB 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a missing zero crossing on the line voltage of the Phase B. 8 ZXTOC 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a missing zero crossing on the line voltage of the Phase C. 9 ZXA 0 Indicates a detection of a rising edge zero crossing in the voltage channel of Phase A. 10 ZXB 0 Indicates a detection of a rising edge zero crossing in the voltage channel of Phase B. 11 ZXC 0 Indicates a detection of a rising edge zero crossing in the voltage channel of Phase C. 12 LENERGY 0 In line energy accumulation, indicates the end of an integration over an integer number of half-line cycles (LINECYC). See the Calibration section. 13 Reset 1 After Bit 6 (SWRST) in OPMODE register is set to 1, the ADE7758 enters software reset. This bit becomes 1 after 166 μsec, indicating the reset process has ended and the registers are set to their default values. It stays 1 until the reset interrupt status register is read and then becomes 0. 14 PKV 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused when the selected voltage input is above the value in the VPINTLVL register. 15 PKI 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused when the selected current input is above the value in the IPINTLVL register. 16 WFSM 0 Indicates that new data is present in the waveform register. 17 REVPAP 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a sign change in the watt calculation among any one of the phases specified by the TERMSEL bits in the COMPMODE register. 18 REVPRP 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a sign change in the VAR calculation among any one of the phases specified by the TERMSEL bits in the COMPMODE register. 19 SEQERR 0 Indicates that an interrupt was caused by a zero crossing from Phase A followed not by the zero crossing of Phase C but by that of Phase B. ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 70 of 72 OUTLINE DIMENSIONS COMPLIANTTOJEDECSTANDARDSMS-013-ADCONTROLLINGDIMENSIONSAREINMILLIMETERS;INCHDIMENSIONS(INPARENTHESES)AREROUNDED-OFFMILLIMETEREQUIVALENTSFORREFERENCEONLYANDARENOTAPPROPRIATEFORUSEINDESIGN.15.60(0.6142)15.20(0.5984)0.30(0.0118)0.10(0.0039)2.65(0.1043)2.35(0.0925)10.65(0.4193)10.00(0.3937)7.60(0.2992)7.40(0.2913)0.75(0.0295)0.25(0.0098)45°1.27(0.0500)0.40(0.0157)COPLANARITY0.100.33(0.0130)0.20(0.0079)0.51(0.0201)0.31(0.0122)SEATINGPLANE8°0°24131211.27(0.0500)BSC12-09-2010-A Figure 95. 24-Lead Standard Small Outline Package [SOIC_W] Wide Body (RW-24) Dimensions shown in millimeters and (inches) ORDERING GUIDE Model1 Temperature Range Package Description Package Option ADE7758ARWZ −40°C to + 85°C 24-Lead Wide Body SOIC_W RW-24 ADE7758ARWZRL −40°C to + 85°C 24-Lead Wide Body SOIC_W RW-24 EVAL-ADE7758ZEB Evaluation Board 1 Z = RoHS Compliant Part. Data Sheet ADE7758 Rev. E | Page 71 of 72 NOTES ADE7758 Data Sheet Rev. E | Page 72 of 72 NOTES ©2004–2011 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. D04443-0-10/11(E) 1 2 3 4 8 7 6 5 GND TRIG OUT RESET VCC DISCH THRES CONT 3 2 1 20 19 9 10 11 12 13 4 5 6 7 8 18 17 16 15 14 NC DISCH NC THRES NC NC TRIG NC OUT NC NC GND NC CONT NC VCC NC NC RESET NC NC – No internal connection NA555...D OR P PACKAGE NE555...D, P, PS, OR PW PACKAGE SA555...D OR P PACKAGE SE555...D, JG, OR P PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) SE555...FK PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 PRECISION TIMERS Check for Samples: NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 1FEATURES • Timing From Microseconds to Hours • Adjustable Duty Cycle • Astable or Monostable Operation • TTL-Compatible Output Can Sink or Source up to 200 mA DESCRIPTION/ORDERING INFORMATION These devices are precision timing circuits capable of producing accurate time delays or oscillation. In the time-delay or monostable mode of operation, the timed interval is controlled by a single external resistor and capacitor network. In the astable mode of operation, the frequency and duty cycle can be controlled independently with two external resistors and a single external capacitor. The threshold and trigger levels normally are two-thirds and one-third, respectively, of VCC. These levels can be altered by use of the control-voltage terminal. When the trigger input falls below the trigger level, the flip-flop is set, and the output goes high. If the trigger input is above the trigger level and the threshold input is above the threshold level, the flip-flop is reset and the output is low. The reset (RESET) input can override all other inputs and can be used to initiate a new timing cycle. When RESET goes low, the flip-flop is reset, and the output goes low. When the output is low, a low-impedance path is provided between discharge (DISCH) and ground. The output circuit is capable of sinking or sourcing current up to 200 mA. Operation is specified for supplies of 5 V to 15 V. With a 5-V supply, output levels are compatible with TTL inputs. 1 Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet. PRODUCTION DATA information is current as of publication date. Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Products conform to specifications per the terms of the Texas Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not On products compliant to MIL-PRF-38535, all parameters are necessarily include testing of all parameters. tested unless otherwise noted. On all other products, production processing does not necessarily include testing of all parameters. NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 www.ti.com ORDERING INFORMATION(1) T VTHRES MAX A V PACKAGE(2) ORDERABLE PART NUMBER TOP-SIDE MARKING CC = 15 V PDIP – P Tube of 50 NE555P NE555P Tube of 75 NE555D SOIC – D NE555 Reel of 2500 NE555DR 0°C to 70°C 11.2 V SOP – PS Reel of 2000 NE555PSR N555 Tube of 150 NE555PW TSSOP – PW N555 Reel of 2000 NE555PWR PDIP – P Tube of 50 SA555P SA555P –40°C to 85°C 11.2 V Tube of 75 SA555D SOIC – D SA555 Reel of 2000 SA555DR PDIP – P Tube of 50 NA555P NA555P –40°C to 105°C 11.2 V Tube of 75 NA555D SOIC – D NA555 Reel of 2000 NA555DR PDIP – P Tube of 50 SE555P SE555P Tube of 75 SE555D SOIC – D SE555D –55°C to 125°C 10.6 Reel of 2500 SE555DR CDIP – JG Tube of 50 SE555JG SE555JG LCCC – FK Tube of 55 SE555FK SE555FK (1) For the most current package and ordering information, see the Package Option Addendum at the end of this document, or see the TI web site at www.ti.com. (2) Package drawings, thermal data, and symbolization are available at www.ti.com/packaging. Table 1. FUNCTION TABLE RESET TRIGGER THRESHOLD OUTPUT DISCHARGE VOLTAGE(1) VOLTAGE(1) SWITCH Low Irrelevant Irrelevant Low On High <1/3 VCC Irrelevant High Off High >1/3 VCC >2/3 VCC Low On High >1/3 VCC <2/3 VCC As previously established (1) Voltage levels shown are nominal. 2 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 1 S R R1 TRIG THRES VCC CONT RESET OUT DISCH GND ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ Î ÎÎÎ 8 4 5 6 2 1 7 3 NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM A. Pin numbers shown are for the D, JG, P, PS, and PW packages. B. RESET can override TRIG, which can override THRES. Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 3 Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 www.ti.com Absolute Maximum Ratings(1) over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) MIN MAX UNIT VCC Supply voltage(2) 18 V VI Input voltage CONT, RESET, THRES, TRIG VCC V IO Output current ±225 mA D package 97 P package 85 qJA Package thermal impedance(3) (4) °C/W PS package 95 PW package 149 FK package 5.61 qJC Package thermal impedance(5) (6) °C/W JG package 14.5 TJ Operating virtual junction temperature 150 °C Case temperature for 60 s FK package 260 °C Lead temperature 1, 6 mm (1/16 in) from case for 60 s JG package 300 °C Tstg Storage temperature range –65 150 °C (1) Stresses beyond those listed under "absolute maximum ratings" may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under "recommended operating conditions" is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. (2) All voltage values are with respect to GND. (3) Maximum power dissipation is a function of TJ(max), qJA, and TA. The maximum allowable power dissipation at any allowable ambient temperature is PD = (TJ(max) - TA)/qJA. Operating at the absolute maximum TJ of 150°C can affect reliability. (4) The package thermal impedance is calculated in accordance with JESD 51-7. (5) Maximum power dissipation is a function of TJ(max), qJC, and TC. The maximum allowable power dissipation at any allowable case temperature is PD = (TJ(max) - TC)/qJC. Operating at the absolute maximum TJ of 150°C can affect reliability. (6) The package thermal impedance is calculated in accordance with MIL-STD-883. Recommended Operating Conditions over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) MIN MAX UNIT NA555, NE555, SA555 4.5 16 VCC Supply voltage V SE555 4.5 18 VI Input voltage CONT, RESET, THRES, and TRIG VCC V IO Output current ±200 mA NA555 –40 105 NE555 0 70 TA Operating free-air temperature °C SA555 –40 85 SE555 –55 125 4 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 Electrical Characteristics VCC = 5 V to 15 V, TA = 25°C (unless otherwise noted) NA555 SE555 NE555 PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS SA555 UNIT MIN TYP MAX MIN TYP MAX VCC = 15 V 9.4 10 10.6 8.8 10 11.2 THRES voltage level V VCC = 5 V 2.7 3.3 4 2.4 3.3 4.2 THRES current(1) 30 250 30 250 nA 4.8 5 5.2 4.5 5 5.6 VCC = 15 V TA = –55°C to 125°C 3 6 TRIG voltage level V 1.45 1.67 1.9 1.1 1.67 2.2 VCC = 5 V TA = –55°C to 125°C 1.9 TRIG current TRIG at 0 V 0.5 0.9 0.5 2 mA 0.3 0.7 1 0.3 0.7 1 RESET voltage level V TA = –55°C to 125°C 1.1 RESET at VCC 0.1 0.4 0.1 0.4 RESET current mA RESET at 0 V –0.4 –1 –0.4 –1.5 DISCH switch off-state 20 100 20 100 nA current 9.6 10 10.4 9 10 11 VCC = 15 V CONT voltage TA = –55°C to 125°C 9.6 10.4 (open circuit) V 2.9 3.3 3.8 2.6 3.3 4 VCC = 5 V TA = –55°C to 125°C 2.9 3.8 0.1 0.15 0.1 0.25 VCC = 15 V, IOL = 10 mA TA = –55°C to 125°C 0.2 0.4 0.5 0.4 0.75 VCC = 15 V, IOL = 50 mA TA = –55°C to 125°C 1 2 2.2 2 2.5 VCC = 15 V, IOL = 100 mA Low-level output voltage TA = –55°C to 125°C 2.7 V VCC = 15 V, IOL = 200 mA 2.5 2.5 VCC = 5 V, IOL = 3.5 mA TA = –55°C to 125°C 0.35 0.1 0.2 0.1 0.35 VCC = 5 V, IOL = 5 mA TA = –55°C to 125°C 0.8 VCC = 5 V, IOL = 8 mA 0.15 0.25 0.15 0.4 13 13.3 12.75 13.3 VCC = 15 V, IOL = –100 mA TA = –55°C to 125°C 12 High-level output voltage VCC = 15 V, IOH = –200 mA 12.5 12.5 V 3 3.3 2.75 3.3 VCC = 5 V, IOL = –100 mA TA = –55°C to 125°C 2 VCC = 15 V 10 12 10 15 Output low, No load VCC = 5 V 3 5 3 6 Supply current mA VCC = 15 V 9 10 9 13 Output high, No load VCC = 5 V 2 4 2 5 (1) This parameter influences the maximum value of the timing resistors RA and RB in the circuit of Figure 12. For example, when VCC = 5 V, the maximum value is R = RA + RB ≉ 3.4 MΩ, and for VCC = 15 V, the maximum value is 10 MΩ. Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 5 Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 www.ti.com Operating Characteristics VCC = 5 V to 15 V, TA = 25°C (unless otherwise noted) NA555 TEST SE555 NE555 PARAMETER CONDITIONS(1) SA555 UNIT MIN TYP MAX MIN TYP MAX Initial error of timing Each timer, monostable(3) TA = 25°C 0.5 1.5(4) 1 3 interval(2) % Each timer, astable(5) 1.5 2.25 Temperature coefficient of Each timer, monostable(3) TA = MIN to MAX 30 100(4) 50 ppm/ timing interval Each timer, astable(5) 90 150 °C Supply-voltage sensitivity of Each timer, monostable(3) TA = 25°C 0.05 0.2(4) 0.1 0.5 timing interval %/V Each timer, astable(5) 0.15 0.3 Output-pulse rise time CL = 15 pF, 100 200(4) 100 300 ns TA = 25°C Output-pulse fall time CL = 15 pF, 100 200(4) 100 300 ns TA = 25°C (1) For conditions shown as MIN or MAX, use the appropriate value specified under recommended operating conditions. (2) Timing interval error is defined as the difference between the measured value and the average value of a random sample from each process run. (3) Values specified are for a device in a monostable circuit similar to Figure 9, with the following component values: RA = 2 kΩ to 100 kΩ, C = 0.1 mF. (4) On products compliant to MIL-PRF-38535, this parameter is not production tested. (5) Values specified are for a device in an astable circuit similar to Figure 12, with the following component values: RA = 1 kΩ to 100 kΩ, C = 0.1 mF. 6 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = 125°C ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = 25°C IOL − Low-Level Output Current − mA ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ VCC = 5 V LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = −55°C 0.1 0.04 0.01 1 2 4 7 10 20 40 70 100 0.07 1 0.4 0.7 10 4 7 0.02 0.2 2 VOL − Low-Level Output Voltage − V ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ VCC = 10 V LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT VOL − Low-Level Output Voltage − V IOL − Low-Level Output Current − mA 0.1 0.04 0.01 1 2 4 7 10 20 40 70 100 0.07 1 0.4 0.7 10 4 7 0.02 0.2 2 ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = 125°C ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = 25°C TA= −55°C TA = 125°C TA = 25°C TA = −55°C ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ VCC = 15 V LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT VOL − Low-Level Output Voltage − V IOL − Low-Level Output Current − mA 0.1 0.04 0.01 1 2 4 7 10 20 40 70 100 0.07 1 0.4 0.7 10 4 7 0.02 0.2 2 1 0.6 0.2 0 1.4 1.8 2.0 0.4 1.6 0.8 1.2 − IOH − High-Level Output Current − mA ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = 125°C ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = 25°C 1 2 4 7 10 20 40 70 100 ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ VCC = 5 V to 15 V ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ TA = −55°C (VCC VOH) − Voltage Drop − V DROP BETWEEN SUPPLY VOLTAGE AND OUTPUT vs HIGH-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 TYPICAL CHARACTERISTICS Data for temperatures below 0°C and above 70°C are applicable for SE555 circuits only. Figure 1. Figure 2. Figure 3. Figure 4. Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 7 Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 5 4 2 1 0 9 3 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 − Supply Current − mA 7 6 8 SUPPLY CURRENT vs SUPPLY VOLTAGE 10 12 13 14 15 TA = 25°C TA = 125°C TA = −55°C Output Low, No Load ICC VCC − Supply Voltage − V 1 0.995 0.990 0.985 0 5 10 1.005 1.010 NORMALIZED OUTPUT PULSE DURATION (MONOSTABLE OPERATION) vs SUPPLY VOLTAGE 1.015 15 20 Pulse Duration Relative to Value at V C C = 10 V VCC − Supply Voltage − V 1 0.995 0.990 0.985 −75 −25 25 1.005 1.010 NORMALIZED OUTPUT PULSE DURATION (MONOSTABLE OPERATION) vs FREE-AIR TEMPERATURE 1.015 75 125 TA − Free-Air Temperature − °C −50 0 50 100 VCC = 10 V Pulse Duration Relative to Value at TA = 25C 0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900 1000 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35 0.4 Lowest Level of Trigger Pulse – ×VCC tPD – Propagation Delay Time – ns TA = 125°C TA = 70°C TA = 25°C TA = 0°C TA = –55°C PROPAGATION DELAY TIME vs LOWEST VOLTAGE LEVEL OF TRIGGER PULSE NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 www.ti.com TYPICAL CHARACTERISTICS (continued) Data for temperatures below 0°C and above 70°C are applicable for SE555 circuits only. Figure 5. Figure 6. Figure 7. Figure 8. 8 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 VCC (5 V to 15 V) RA RL Output GND OUT CONT VCC RESET DISCH THRES Input TRIG ÎÎÎ 5 8 4 7 6 2 3 1 Pin numbers shown are for the D, JG, P, PS, and PW packages. NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 APPLICATION INFORMATION Monostable Operation For monostable operation, any of these timers can be connected as shown in Figure 9. If the output is low, application of a negative-going pulse to the trigger (TRIG) sets the flip-flop (Q goes low), drives the output high, and turns off Q1. Capacitor C then is charged through RA until the voltage across the capacitor reaches the threshold voltage of the threshold (THRES) input. If TRIG has returned to a high level, the output of the threshold comparator resets the flip-flop (Q goes high), drives the output low, and discharges C through Q1. Figure 9. Circuit for Monostable Operation Monostable operation is initiated when TRIG voltage falls below the trigger threshold. Once initiated, the sequence ends only if TRIG is high for at least 10 μs before the end of the timing interval. When the trigger is grounded, the comparator storage time can be as long as 10 μs, which limits the minimum monostable pulse width to 10 μs. Because of the threshold level and saturation voltage of Q1, the output pulse duration is approximately tw = 1.1RAC. Figure 11 is a plot of the time constant for various values of RA and C. The threshold levels and charge rates both are directly proportional to the supply voltage, VCC. The timing interval is, therefore, independent of the supply voltage, so long as the supply voltage is constant during the time interval. Applying a negative-going trigger pulse simultaneously to RESET and TRIG during the timing interval discharges C and reinitiates the cycle, commencing on the positive edge of the reset pulse. The output is held low as long as the reset pulse is low. To prevent false triggering, when RESET is not used, it should be connected to VCC. Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 9 Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 − Output Pulse Duration − s C − Capacitance − mF 10 1 10−1 10−2 10−3 10−4 0.01 0.1 1 10 100 10−5 0.001 tw RA = 10 MW RA = 10 kW RA = 1 kW RA = 100 kW RA = 1 MW Voltage − 2 V/div Time − 0.1 ms/div ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Capacitor Voltage Output Voltage Input Voltage ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ RA = 9.1 kW CL = 0.01 mF RL = 1 kW See Figure 9 Voltage − 1 V/div Time − 0.5 ms/div tH Capacitor Voltage tL Output Voltage ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ RA = 5 k RL = 1 k RB = 3 k See Figure 12 C = 0.15 mF GND OUT CONT VCC RESET DISCH THRES TRIG C RB RA Output RL 0.01 mF VCC (5 V to 15 V) (see Note A) ÎÎÎ NOTE A: Decoupling CONT voltage to ground with a capacitor can improve operation. This should be evaluated for individual applications. Open 5 8 4 7 6 2 3 1 Pin numbers shown are for the D, JG, P, PS, and PW packages. NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 www.ti.com Figure 10. Typical Monostable Waveforms Figure 11. Output Pulse Duration vs Capacitance Astable Operation As shown in Figure 12, adding a second resistor, RB, to the circuit of Figure 9 and connecting the trigger input to the threshold input causes the timer to self-trigger and run as a multivibrator. The capacitor C charges through RA and RB and then discharges through RB only. Therefore, the duty cycle is controlled by the values of RA and RB. This astable connection results in capacitor C charging and discharging between the threshold-voltage level (≉0.67 × VCC) and the trigger-voltage level (≉0.33 × VCC). As in the monostable circuit, charge and discharge times (and, therefore, the frequency and duty cycle) are independent of the supply voltage. Figure 12. Circuit for Astable Operation Figure 13. Typical Astable Waveforms 10 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 tH  0.693 (RARB) C tL  0.693 (RB) C Other useful relationships are shown below. period  tHtL  0.693 (RA2RB) C frequency  1.44 (RA2RB) C Output driver duty cycle  tL tHtL  RB RA2RB Output waveform duty cycle  tL tH  RB RARB Low-to-high ratio  tH tHtL  1– RB RA2RB f − Free-Running Frequency − Hz C − Capacitance − mF 100 k 10 k 1 k 100 10 1 0.01 0.1 1 10 100 0.1 0.001 RA + 2 RB = 10 MW RA + 2 RB = 1 MW RA + 2 RB = 100 kW RA + 2 RB = 10 kW RA + 2 RB = 1 kW Time − 0.1 ms/div Voltage − 2 V/div ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ VCC = 5 V RA = 1 kW C = 0.1 mF See Figure 15 Capacitor Voltage ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ Output Voltage Input Voltage VCC (5 V to 15 V) DISCH OUT RESET VCC RL RA A5T3644 C THRES GND CONT TRIG Input 0.01 mF ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ Output 4 8 3 7 6 2 5 1 Pin numbers shown are shown for the D, JG, P, PS, and PW packages. NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 Figure 12 shows typical waveforms generated during astable operation. The output high-level duration tH and low-level duration tL can be calculated as follows: Figure . Figure 14. Free-Running Frequency Missing-Pulse Detector The circuit shown in Figure 15 can be used to detect a missing pulse or abnormally long spacing between consecutive pulses in a train of pulses. The timing interval of the monostable circuit is retriggered continuously by the input pulse train as long as the pulse spacing is less than the timing interval. A longer pulse spacing, missing pulse, or terminated pulse train permits the timing interval to be completed, thereby generating an output pulse as shown in Figure 16. Figure 15. Circuit for Missing-Pulse Detector Figure 16. Completed Timing Waveforms for Missing-Pulse Detector Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 11 Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 Voltage − 2 V/div Time − 0.1 ms/div Capacitor Voltage Output Voltage ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏInput Voltage VCC = 5 V RA = 1250 W C = 0.02 mF See Figure 9 NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 www.ti.com Frequency Divider By adjusting the length of the timing cycle, the basic circuit of Figure 9 can be made to operate as a frequency divider. Figure 17 shows a divide-by-three circuit that makes use of the fact that retriggering cannot occur during the timing cycle. Figure 17. Divide-by-Three Circuit Waveforms 12 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 THRES GND C RL RA VCC (5 V to 15 V) Output DISCH OUT RESET VCC TRIG CONT Modulation Input (see Note A) Clock Input NOTE A: The modulating signal can be direct or capacitively coupled to CONT. For direct coupling, the effects of modulation source voltage and impedance on the bias of the timer should be considered. 4 8 3 7 6 2 5 Pin numbers shown are for the D, JG, P, PS, and PW packages. 1 Voltage − 2 V/div Time − 0.5 ms/div ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Capacitor VoltageÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Output Voltage ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Clock Input Voltage ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ RA = 3 kW C = 0.02 mF RL = 1 kW See Figure 18 ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Modulation Input Voltage NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 Pulse-Width Modulation The operation of the timer can be modified by modulating the internal threshold and trigger voltages, which is accomplished by applying an external voltage (or current) to CONT. Figure 18 shows a circuit for pulse-width modulation. A continuous input pulse train triggers the monostable circuit, and a control signal modulates the threshold voltage. Figure 19 shows the resulting output pulse-width modulation. While a sine-wave modulation signal is shown, any wave shape could be used. Figure 18. Circuit for Pulse-Width Modulation Figure 19. Pulse-Width-Modulation Waveforms Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 13 Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 Voltage − 2 V/div ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ RA = 3 kW RB = 500 W RL = 1 kW See Figure 20 ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ Capacitor Voltage ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ Output Voltage ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ Modulation Input Voltage Time − 0.1 ms/div RB Modulation Input (see Note A) CONT TRIG RESET VCC OUT DISCH VCC (5 V to 15 V) RL RA C GND THRES NOTE A: The modulating signal can be direct or capacitively coupled to CONT. For direct coupling, the effects of modulation source voltage and impedance on the bias of the timer should be considered. Pin numbers shown are for the D, JG, P, PS, and PW packages. 4 8 3 7 6 2 5 Output NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 www.ti.com Pulse-Position Modulation As shown in Figure 20, any of these timers can be used as a pulse-position modulator. This application modulates the threshold voltage and, thereby, the time delay, of a free-running oscillator. Figure 21 shows a triangular-wave modulation signal for such a circuit; however, any wave shape could be used. Figure 20. Circuit for Pulse-Position Modulation Figure 21. Pulse-Position-Modulation Waveforms 14 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 S VCC RESET VCC OUT DISCH GND CONT TRIG 4 8 3 7 6 1 5 2 THRES RC CC 0.01 CC = 14.7 mF RC = 100 kW Output C RESET VCC OUT DISCH GND CONT TRIG 4 8 3 7 6 1 5 2 THRES RB 33 kW 0.001 0.01 mF CB = 4.7 mF RB = 100 kW RA = 100 kW Output A Output B CA = 10 mF mF 0.01 mF 0.001 RA 33 kW THRES 2 5 1 6 7 3 4 8 TRIG CONT GND DISCH OUT RESET VCC mF mF CA CB Pin numbers shown are for the D, JG, P, PS, and PW packages. NOTE A: S closes momentarily at t = 0. Voltage − 5 V/div t − Time − 1 s/div ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ See Figure 22 ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Output A ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Output B ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ Output C ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ t = 0 ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ twC = 1.1 RCCC ÏÏÏÏÏÏ twC ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ twB = 1.1 RBCB ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ twA = 1.1 RACA ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ twA ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ twB NA555, NE555, SA555, SE555 www.ti.com SLFS022H –SEPTEMBER 1973–REVISED JUNE 2010 Sequential Timer Many applications, such as computers, require signals for initializing conditions during start-up. Other applications, such as test equipment, require activation of test signals in sequence. These timing circuits can be connected to provide such sequential control. The timers can be used in various combinations of astable or monostable circuit connections, with or without modulation, for extremely flexible waveform control. Figure 22 shows a sequencer circuit with possible applications in many systems, and Figure 23 shows the output waveforms. Figure 22. Sequential Timer Circuit Figure 23. Sequential Timer Waveforms Copyright © 1973–2010, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 15 Product Folder Link(s): NA555 NE555 SA555 SE555 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 24-May-2014 Addendum-Page 1 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples JM38510/10901BPA ACTIVE CDIP JG 8 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 JM38510 /10901BPA M38510/10901BPA ACTIVE CDIP JG 8 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 JM38510 /10901BPA NA555D ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 105 NA555 NA555DG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 105 NA555 NA555DR ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 105 NA555 NA555DRG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 105 NA555 NA555P ACTIVE PDIP P 8 50 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU N / A for Pkg Type -40 to 105 NA555P NA555PE4 ACTIVE PDIP P 8 50 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU N / A for Pkg Type -40 to 105 NA555P NE555D ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555 NE555DE4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555 NE555DG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555 NE555DR ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU | CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555 NE555DRE4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555 NE555DRG3 PREVIEW SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555 NE555DRG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555 NE555P ACTIVE PDIP P 8 50 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU | CU SN N / A for Pkg Type 0 to 70 NE555P NE555PE3 PREVIEW PDIP P 8 50 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 NE555P PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 24-May-2014 Addendum-Page 2 Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples NE555PE4 ACTIVE PDIP P 8 50 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU N / A for Pkg Type 0 to 70 NE555P NE555PSLE OBSOLETE SO PS 8 TBD Call TI Call TI 0 to 70 NE555PSR ACTIVE SO PS 8 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PSRE4 ACTIVE SO PS 8 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PSRG4 ACTIVE SO PS 8 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PW ACTIVE TSSOP PW 8 150 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PWE4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 8 150 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PWG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 8 150 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PWR ACTIVE TSSOP PW 8 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PWRE4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 8 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555PWRG4 ACTIVE TSSOP PW 8 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM 0 to 70 N555 NE555Y OBSOLETE 0 TBD Call TI Call TI 0 to 70 SA555D ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 SA555 SA555DE4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 SA555 SA555DG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 SA555 SA555DR ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU | CU SN Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 SA555 SA555DRE4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 SA555 SA555DRG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 SA555 SA555P ACTIVE PDIP P 8 50 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU N / A for Pkg Type -40 to 85 SA555P PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 24-May-2014 Addendum-Page 3 Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples SA555PE4 ACTIVE PDIP P 8 50 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU N / A for Pkg Type -40 to 85 SA555P SE555D ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -55 to 125 SE555 SE555DG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 75 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -55 to 125 SE555 SE555DR ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -55 to 125 SE555 SE555DRG4 ACTIVE SOIC D 8 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -55 to 125 SE555 SE555FKB ACTIVE LCCC FK 20 1 TBD POST-PLATE N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 SE555FKB SE555JG ACTIVE CDIP JG 8 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 SE555JG SE555JGB ACTIVE CDIP JG 8 1 TBD A42 N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 SE555JGB SE555N OBSOLETE PDIP N 8 TBD Call TI Call TI -55 to 125 SE555P ACTIVE PDIP P 8 50 Pb-Free (RoHS) CU NIPDAU N / A for Pkg Type -55 to 125 SE555P (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 24-May-2014 Addendum-Page 4 (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. OTHER QUALIFIED VERSIONS OF SE555, SE555M : • Catalog: SE555 • Military: SE555M • Space: SE555-SP, SE555-SP NOTE: Qualified Version Definitions: • Catalog - TI's standard catalog product • Military - QML certified for Military and Defense Applications • Space - Radiation tolerant, ceramic packaging and qualified for use in Space-based application TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Reel Diameter (mm) Reel Width W1 (mm) A0 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W (mm) Pin1 Quadrant NA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 NA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 NE555DR SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.8 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 NE555DR SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 NE555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 NE555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 NE555PSR SO PS 8 2000 330.0 16.4 8.2 6.6 2.5 12.0 16.0 Q1 NE555PWR TSSOP PW 8 2000 330.0 12.4 7.0 3.6 1.6 8.0 12.0 Q1 SA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 SA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.8 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 SA555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 SE555DR SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 SE555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 330.0 12.4 6.4 5.2 2.1 8.0 12.0 Q1 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 15-Oct-2013 Pack Materials-Page 1 *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) NA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 340.5 338.1 20.6 NA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 NE555DR SOIC D 8 2500 364.0 364.0 27.0 NE555DR SOIC D 8 2500 340.5 338.1 20.6 NE555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 340.5 338.1 20.6 NE555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 NE555PSR SO PS 8 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 NE555PWR TSSOP PW 8 2000 367.0 367.0 35.0 SA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 340.5 338.1 20.6 SA555DR SOIC D 8 2500 364.0 364.0 27.0 SA555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 340.5 338.1 20.6 SE555DR SOIC D 8 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 SE555DRG4 SOIC D 8 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 15-Oct-2013 Pack Materials-Page 2 MECHANICAL DATA MCER001A – JANUARY 1995 – REVISED JANUARY 1997 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 JG (R-GDIP-T8) CERAMIC DUAL-IN-LINE 0.310 (7,87) 0.290 (7,37) 0.014 (0,36) 0.008 (0,20) Seating Plane 4040107/C 08/96 5 4 0.065 (1,65) 0.045 (1,14) 8 1 0.020 (0,51) MIN 0.400 (10,16) 0.355 (9,00) 0.015 (0,38) 0.023 (0,58) 0.063 (1,60) 0.015 (0,38) 0.200 (5,08) MAX 0.130 (3,30) MIN 0.245 (6,22) 0.280 (7,11) 0.100 (2,54) 0°–15° NOTES: A. All linear dimensions are in inches (millimeters). B. This drawing is subject to change without notice. C. This package can be hermetically sealed with a ceramic lid using glass frit. D. Index point is provided on cap for terminal identification. E. Falls within MIL STD 1835 GDIP1-T8 IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated CC1100 SWRS038D Page 1 of 92 CC1100 Low-Power Sub- 1 GHz RF Transceiver Applications • Ultra low-power wireless applications operating in the 315/433/868/915 MHz ISM/SRD bands • Wireless alarm and security systems • Industrial monitoring and control • Wireless sensor networks • AMR – Automatic Meter Reading • Home and building automation Product Description The CC1100 is a low-cost sub- 1 GHz transceiver designed for very low-power wireless applications. The circuit is mainly intended for the ISM (Industrial, Scientific and Medical) and SRD (Short Range Device) frequency bands at 315, 433, 868, and 915 MHz, but can easily be programmed for operation at other frequencies in the 300-348 MHz, 400-464 MHz and 800-928 MHz bands. The RF transceiver is integrated with a highly configurable baseband modem. The modem supports various modulation formats and has a configurable data up to 500 kBaud. CC1100 provides extensive hardware support for packet handling, data buffering, burst transmissions, clear channel assessment, link quality indication, and wake-on-radio. The main operating parameters and the 64- byte transmit/receive FIFOs of CC1100 can be controlled via an SPI interface. In a typical system, the CC1100 will be used together with a microcontroller and a few additional passive components. 6 7 8 9 10 20 19 18 17 16 1 2 3 4 5 15 14 13 12 11 CC1100 This product shall not be used in any of the following products or systems without prior express written permission from Texas Instruments: (i) implantable cardiac rhythm management systems, including without limitation pacemakers, defibrillators and cardiac resynchronization devices, (ii) external cardiac rhythm management systems that communicate directly with one or more implantable medical devices; or (iii) other devices used to monitor or treat cardiac function, including without limitation pressure sensors, biochemical sensors and neurostimulators. Please contact lpw-medical-approval@list.ti.com if your application might fall within the category described above. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 2 of 92 Key Features RF Performance • High sensitivity (–111 dBm at 1.2 kBaud, 868 MHz, 1% packet error rate) • Low current consumption (14.4 mA in RX, 1.2 kBaud, 868 MHz) • Programmable output power up to +10 dBm for all supported frequencies • Excellent receiver selectivity and blocking performance • Programmable data rate from 1.2 to 500 kBaud • Frequency bands: 300-348 MHz, 400-464 MHz and 800-928 MHz Analog Features • 2-FSK, GFSK, and MSK supported as well as OOK and flexible ASK shaping • Suitable for frequency hopping systems due to a fast settling frequency synthesizer: 90us settling time • Automatic Frequency Compensation (AFC) can be used to align the frequency synthesizer to the received centre frequency • Integrated analog temperature sensor Digital Features • Flexible support for packet oriented systems: On-chip support for sync word detection, address check, flexible packet length, and automatic CRC handling • Efficient SPI interface: All registers can be programmed with one “burst” transfer • Digital RSSI output • Programmable channel filter bandwidth • Programmable Carrier Sense (CS) indicator • Programmable Preamble Quality Indicator (PQI) for improved protection against false sync word detection in random noise • Support for automatic Clear Channel Assessment (CCA) before transmitting (for listen-before-talk systems) • Support for per-package Link Quality Indication (LQI) • Optional automatic whitening and dewhitening of data Low-Power Features • 400nA SLEEP mode current consumption • Fast startup time: 240us from sleep to RX or TX mode (measured on EM reference design [5] and [6]) • Wake-on-radio functionality for automatic low-power RX polling • Separate 64-byte RX and TX data FIFOs (enables burst mode data transmission) General • Few external components: Completely onchip frequency synthesizer, no external filters or RF switch needed • Green package: RoHS compliant and no antimony or bromine • Small size (QLP 4x4 mm package, 20 pins) • Suited for systems targeting compliance with EN 300 220 (Europe) and FCC CFR Part 15 (US). • Support for asynchronous and synchronous serial receive/transmit mode for backwards compatibility with existing radio communication protocols CC1100 SWRS038D Page 3 of 92 Abbreviations Abbreviations used in this data sheet are described below. ACP Adjacent Channel Power MSK Minimum Shift Keying ADC Analog to Digital Converter N/A Not Applicable AFC Automatic Frequency Compensation NRZ Non Return to Zero (Coding) AGC Automatic Gain Control OOK On-Off Keying AMR Automatic Meter Reading PA Power Amplifier ASK Amplitude Shift Keying PCB Printed Circuit Board BER Bit Error Rate PD Power Down BT Bandwidth-Time product PER Packet Error Rate CCA Clear Channel Assessment PLL Phase Locked Loop CFR Code of Federal Regulations POR Power-On Reset CRC Cyclic Redundancy Check PQI Preamble Quality Indicator CS Carrier Sense PQT Preamble Quality Threshold CW Continuous Wave (Unmodulated Carrier) PTAT Proportional To Absolute Temperature DC Direct Current QLP Quad Leadless Package DVGA Digital Variable Gain Amplifier QPSK Quadrature Phase Shift Keying ESR Equivalent Series Resistance RC Resistor-Capacitor FCC Federal Communications Commission RF Radio Frequency FEC Forward Error Correction RSSI Received Signal Strength Indicator FIFO First-In-First-Out RX Receive, Receive Mode FHSS Frequency Hopping Spread Spectrum SAW Surface Aqustic Wave 2-FSK Binary Frequency Shift Keying SMD Surface Mount Device GFSK Gaussian shaped Frequency Shift Keying SNR Signal to Noise Ratio IF Intermediate Frequency SPI Serial Peripheral Interface I/Q In-Phase/Quadrature SRD Short Range Devices ISM Industrial, Scientific, Medical TBD To Be Defined LC Inductor-Capacitor T/R Transmit/Receive LNA Low Noise Amplifier TX Transmit, Transmit Mode LO Local Oscillator UHF Ultra High frequency LSB Least Significant Bit VCO Voltage Controlled Oscillator LQI Link Quality Indicator WOR Wake on Radio, Low power polling MCU Microcontroller Unit XOSC Crystal Oscillator MSB Most Significant Bit XTAL Crystal CC1100 SWRS038D Page 4 of 92 Table Of Contents APPLICATIONS..................................................................................................................................................1 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION................................................................................................................................1 KEY FEATURES .................................................................................................................................................2 RF PERFORMANCE ..........................................................................................................................................2 ANALOG FEATURES ........................................................................................................................................2 DIGITAL FEATURES.........................................................................................................................................2 LOW-POWER FEATURES................................................................................................................................2 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................................................2 ABBREVIATIONS...............................................................................................................................................3 TABLE OF CONTENTS.....................................................................................................................................4 1 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS.....................................................................................................7 2 OPERATING CONDITIONS .................................................................................................................7 3 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS.........................................................................................................7 4 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS.......................................................................................................8 4.1 CURRENT CONSUMPTION ............................................................................................................................8 4.2 RF RECEIVE SECTION..................................................................................................................................9 4.3 RF TRANSMIT SECTION .............................................................................................................................13 4.4 CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR..............................................................................................................................14 4.5 LOW POWER RC OSCILLATOR...................................................................................................................15 4.6 FREQUENCY SYNTHESIZER CHARACTERISTICS..........................................................................................15 4.7 ANALOG TEMPERATURE SENSOR ..............................................................................................................16 4.8 DC CHARACTERISTICS ..............................................................................................................................16 4.9 POWER-ON RESET .....................................................................................................................................16 5 PIN CONFIGURATION........................................................................................................................17 6 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................18 7 APPLICATION CIRCUIT....................................................................................................................19 8 CONFIGURATION OVERVIEW........................................................................................................22 9 CONFIGURATION SOFTWARE........................................................................................................24 10 4-WIRE SERIAL CONFIGURATION AND DATA INTERFACE..................................................24 10.1 CHIP STATUS BYTE ...................................................................................................................................26 10.2 REGISTER ACCESS.....................................................................................................................................26 10.3 SPI READ ..................................................................................................................................................27 10.4 COMMAND STROBES .................................................................................................................................27 10.5 FIFO ACCESS ............................................................................................................................................27 10.6 PATABLE ACCESS...................................................................................................................................28 11 MICROCONTROLLER INTERFACE AND PIN CONFIGURATION ..........................................28 11.1 CONFIGURATION INTERFACE.....................................................................................................................28 11.2 GENERAL CONTROL AND STATUS PINS .....................................................................................................28 11.3 OPTIONAL RADIO CONTROL FEATURE ......................................................................................................29 12 DATA RATE PROGRAMMING..........................................................................................................29 13 RECEIVER CHANNEL FILTER BANDWIDTH..............................................................................30 14 DEMODULATOR, SYMBOL SYNCHRONIZER, AND DATA DECISION..................................30 14.1 FREQUENCY OFFSET COMPENSATION........................................................................................................30 14.2 BIT SYNCHRONIZATION.............................................................................................................................30 14.3 BYTE SYNCHRONIZATION..........................................................................................................................31 15 PACKET HANDLING HARDWARE SUPPORT..............................................................................31 15.1 DATA WHITENING.....................................................................................................................................31 15.2 PACKET FORMAT.......................................................................................................................................32 15.3 PACKET FILTERING IN RECEIVE MODE......................................................................................................34 15.4 PACKET HANDLING IN TRANSMIT MODE...................................................................................................34 15.5 PACKET HANDLING IN RECEIVE MODE .....................................................................................................35 CC1100 SWRS038D Page 5 of 92 15.6 PACKET HANDLING IN FIRMWARE.............................................................................................................35 16 MODULATION FORMATS.................................................................................................................36 16.1 FREQUENCY SHIFT KEYING.......................................................................................................................36 16.2 MINIMUM SHIFT KEYING...........................................................................................................................36 16.3 AMPLITUDE MODULATION ........................................................................................................................36 17 RECEIVED SIGNAL QUALIFIERS AND LINK QUALITY INFORMATION ............................37 17.1 SYNC WORD QUALIFIER............................................................................................................................37 17.2 PREAMBLE QUALITY THRESHOLD (PQT) ..................................................................................................37 17.3 RSSI..........................................................................................................................................................37 17.4 CARRIER SENSE (CS).................................................................................................................................39 17.5 CLEAR CHANNEL ASSESSMENT (CCA) .....................................................................................................40 17.6 LINK QUALITY INDICATOR (LQI)..............................................................................................................40 18 FORWARD ERROR CORRECTION WITH INTERLEAVING.....................................................40 18.1 FORWARD ERROR CORRECTION (FEC)......................................................................................................40 18.2 INTERLEAVING ..........................................................................................................................................41 19 RADIO CONTROL................................................................................................................................42 19.1 POWER-ON START-UP SEQUENCE.............................................................................................................42 19.2 CRYSTAL CONTROL...................................................................................................................................43 19.3 VOLTAGE REGULATOR CONTROL..............................................................................................................43 19.4 ACTIVE MODES .........................................................................................................................................44 19.5 WAKE ON RADIO (WOR)..........................................................................................................................44 19.6 TIMING ......................................................................................................................................................45 19.7 RX TERMINATION TIMER ..........................................................................................................................46 20 DATA FIFO ............................................................................................................................................46 21 FREQUENCY PROGRAMMING........................................................................................................48 22 VCO.........................................................................................................................................................48 22.1 VCO AND PLL SELF-CALIBRATION ..........................................................................................................48 23 VOLTAGE REGULATORS .................................................................................................................49 24 OUTPUT POWER PROGRAMMING ................................................................................................49 25 SHAPING AND PA RAMPING............................................................................................................50 26 SELECTIVITY.......................................................................................................................................52 27 CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR....................................................................................................................53 27.1 REFERENCE SIGNAL ..................................................................................................................................54 28 EXTERNAL RF MATCH .....................................................................................................................54 29 PCB LAYOUT RECOMMENDATIONS.............................................................................................54 30 GENERAL PURPOSE / TEST OUTPUT CONTROL PINS.............................................................55 31 ASYNCHRONOUS AND SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL OPERATION..............................................57 31.1 ASYNCHRONOUS OPERATION....................................................................................................................57 31.2 SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL OPERATION ..........................................................................................................57 32 SYSTEM CONSIDERATIONS AND GUIDELINES.........................................................................57 32.1 SRD REGULATIONS...................................................................................................................................57 32.2 FREQUENCY HOPPING AND MULTI-CHANNEL SYSTEMS............................................................................58 32.3 WIDEBAND MODULATION NOT USING SPREAD SPECTRUM .......................................................................58 32.4 DATA BURST TRANSMISSIONS...................................................................................................................58 32.5 CONTINUOUS TRANSMISSIONS ..................................................................................................................59 32.6 CRYSTAL DRIFT COMPENSATION ..............................................................................................................59 32.7 SPECTRUM EFFICIENT MODULATION.........................................................................................................59 32.8 LOW COST SYSTEMS .................................................................................................................................59 32.9 BATTERY OPERATED SYSTEMS .................................................................................................................59 32.10 INCREASING OUTPUT POWER ................................................................................................................59 33 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS........................................................................................................60 33.1 CONFIGURATION REGISTER DETAILS – REGISTERS WITH PRESERVED VALUES IN SLEEP STATE...............64 33.2 CONFIGURATION REGISTER DETAILS – REGISTERS THAT LOSE PROGRAMMING IN SLEEP STATE............84 33.3 STATUS REGISTER DETAILS.......................................................................................................................85 CC1100 SWRS038D Page 6 of 92 34 PACKAGE DESCRIPTION (QLP 20).................................................................................................88 34.1 RECOMMENDED PCB LAYOUT FOR PACKAGE (QLP 20) ...........................................................................88 34.2 SOLDERING INFORMATION ........................................................................................................................88 35 ORDERING INFORMATION..............................................................................................................89 36 REFERENCES .......................................................................................................................................90 37 GENERAL INFORMATION................................................................................................................91 37.1 DOCUMENT HISTORY ................................................................................................................................91 CC1100 SWRS038D Page 7 of 92 1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Under no circumstances must the absolute maximum ratings given in Table 1 be violated. Stress exceeding one or more of the limiting values may cause permanent damage to the device. Caution! ESD sensitive device. Precaution should be used when handling the device in order to prevent permanent damage. Parameter Min Max Units Condition Supply voltage –0.3 3.9 V All supply pins must have the same voltage Voltage on any digital pin –0.3 VDD+0.3 max 3.9 V Voltage on the pins RF_P, RF_N, and DCOUPL –0.3 2.0 V Voltage ramp-up rate 120 kV/μs Input RF level +10 dBm Storage temperature range –50 150 °C Solder reflow temperature 260 °C According to IPC/JEDEC J-STD-020C ESD <500 V According to JEDEC STD 22, method A114, Human Body Model Table 1: Absolute Maximum Ratings 2 Operating Conditions The operating conditions for CC1100 are listed Table 2 in below. Parameter Min Max Unit Condition Operating temperature -40 85 °C Operating supply voltage 1.8 3.6 V All supply pins must have the same voltage Table 2: Operating Conditions 3 General Characteristics Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Frequency range 300 348 MHz 400 464 MHz 800 928 MHz Data rate 1.2 1.2 26 500 250 500 kBaud kBaud kBaud 2-FSK GFSK, OOK, and ASK (Shaped) MSK (also known as differential offset QPSK) Optional Manchester encoding (the data rate in kbps will be half the baud rate) Table 3: General Characteristics CC1100 SWRS038D Page 8 of 92 4 Electrical Specifications 4.1 Current Consumption Tc = 25°C, VDD = 3.0V if nothing else stated. All measurement results are obtained using the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]). Reduced current settings (MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1) gives a slightly lower current consumption at the cost of a reduction in sensitivity. See Table 5 for additional details on current consumption and sensitivity. Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition 400 nA Voltage regulator to digital part off, register values retained (SLEEP state). All GDO pins programmed to 0x2F (HW to 0) 900 nA Voltage regulator to digital part off, register values retained, lowpower RC oscillator running (SLEEP state with WOR enabled 95 μA Voltage regulator to digital part off, register values retained, XOSC running (SLEEP state with MCSM0.OSC_FORCE_ON set) Current consumption in power down modes 160 μA Voltage regulator to digital part on, all other modules in power down (XOFF state) 9.8 μA Automatic RX polling once each second, using low-power RC oscillator, with 460 kHz filter bandwidth and 250 kBaud data rate, PLL calibration every 4th wakeup. Average current with signal in channel below carrier sense level (MCSM2.RX_TIME_RSSI=1). 34.2 μA Same as above, but with signal in channel above carrier sense level, 1.95 ms RX timeout, and no preamble/sync word found. 1.5 μA Automatic RX polling every 15th second, using low-power RC oscillator, with 460kHz filter bandwidth and 250 kBaud data rate, PLL calibration every 4th wakeup. Average current with signal in channel below carrier sense level (MCSM2.RX_TIME_RSSI=1). 39.3 μA Same as above, but with signal in channel above carrier sense level, 29.3 ms RX timeout, and no preamble/sync word found. 1.6 mA Only voltage regulator to digital part and crystal oscillator running (IDLE state) Current consumption 8.2 mA Only the frequency synthesizer is running (FSTXON state). This currents consumption is also representative for the other intermediate states when going from IDLE to RX or TX, including the calibration state. 15.1 mA Receive mode, 1.2 kBaud, reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 13.9 mA Receive mode, 1.2 kBaud, reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 14.9 mA Receive mode, 38.4 kBaud, reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 14.1 mA Receive mode,38.4 kBaud, reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 15.9 mA Receive mode, 250 kBaud, reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 14.5 mA Receive mode, 250 kBaud, reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 27.0 mA Transmit mode, +10 dBm output power 14.8 mA Transmit mode, 0 dBm output power Current consumption, 315MHz 12.3 mA Transmit mode, –6 dBm output power CC1100 SWRS038D Page 9 of 92 Table 4: Electrical Specifications 4.2 RF Receive Section Tc = 25°C, VDD = 3.0V if nothing else stated. All measurement results are obtained using the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]). Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Digital channel filter bandwidth 58 812 kHz User programmable. The bandwidth limits are proportional to crystal frequency (given values assume a 26.0 MHz crystal). 315 MHz, 1.2 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (2-FSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 5.2 kHz deviation, 58 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity -111 dBm Sensitivity can be traded for current consumption by setting MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1. The typical current consumption is then reduced from 17.1 mA to 15.1 mA at sensitivity limit. The sensitivity is typically reduced to -109 dBm 315 MHz, 500 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1 cannot be used for data rates > 250 kBaud) (MSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 812 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) -88 dBm Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition 15.5 mA Receive mode, 1.2 kBaud , reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 14.5 mA Receive mode, 1.2 kBaud , reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 15.4 mA Receive mode, 38.4 kBaud , reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 14.4 mA Receive mode, 38.4 kBaud , reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 16.5 mA Receive mode, 250 kBaud , reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 15.2 mA Receive mode, 250 kBaud , reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 28.9 mA Transmit mode, +10 dBm output power 15.5 mA Transmit mode, 0 dBm output power Current consumption, 433MHz 13.1 mA Transmit mode, –6 dBm output power 15.4 mA Receive mode, 1.2 kBaud , reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 14.4 mA Receive mode, 1.2 kBaud , reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 15.2 mA Receive mode, 38.4 kBaud , reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 14.4 mA Receive mode,38.4 kBaud , reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 16.4 mA Receive mode, 250 kBaud , reduced current, input at sensitivity limit 15.1 mA Receive mode, 250 kBaud , reduced current, input well above sensitivity limit 31.1 mA Transmit mode, +10 dBm output power 16.9 mA Transmit mode, 0 dBm output power Current consumption, 868/915MHz 13.5 mA Transmit mode, –6 dBm output power CC1100 SWRS038D Page 10 of 92 Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note 433 MHz, 1.2 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (2-FSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 5.2 kHz deviation, 58 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth Receiver sensitivity –110 dBm Sensitivity can be traded for current consumption by setting MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1. The typical current consumption is then reduced from 17.4 mA to 15.5 mA at sensitivity limit. The sensitivity is typically reduced to -108 dBm 433 MHz, 38.4 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (2-FSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 20 kHz deviation, 100 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –103 dBm 433 MHz, 250 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (MSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 540 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –94 dBm 433 MHz, 500 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1 cannot be used for data rates > 250 kBaud) (MSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 812 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –88 dBm 868 MHz, 1.2 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (2-FSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 5.2 kHz deviation, 58 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –111 dBm Sensitivity can be traded for current consumption by setting MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1. The typical current consumption is then reduced from 17.7 mA to 15.4 mA at sensitivity limit. The sensitivity is typically reduced to -109 dBm Saturation –15 dBm Adjacent channel rejection 33 dB Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 100 kHz channel spacing Alternate channel rejection 33 dB Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 100 kHz channel spacing See Figure 25 for plot of selectivity versus frequency offset Image channel rejection, 868MHz 30 dB IF frequency 152 kHz Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 868 MHz, 38.4 kBaud data rate (2-FSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 20 kHz deviation, 100 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –103 dBm Saturation –16 dBm Adjacent channel rejection 20 dB Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 200 kHz channel spacing Alternate channel rejection 28 dB Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 200 kHz channel spacing See Figure 26 for plot of selectivity versus frequency offset Image channel rejection, 868MHz 23 dB IF frequency 152 kHz Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 11 of 92 Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note 868 MHz, 250 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (MSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 540 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –93 dBm Sensitivity can be traded for current consumption by setting MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1. The typical current consumption is then reduced from 18.8 mA to 16.4 mA at sensitivity limit. The sensitivity is typically reduced to -91 dBm Saturation –16 dBm Adjacent channel rejection 24 dB Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 750 kHz channel spacing Alternate channel rejection 37 dB Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 750 kHz channel spacing See Figure 27 for plot of selectivity versus frequency offset Image channel rejection, 868MHz 14 dB IF frequency 254 kHz Desired channel 3 dB above the sensitivity limit. 868 MHz, 500 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1 cannot be used for data rates > 250 kBaud ) (MSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 812 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –88 dBm 868 MHz, 250 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (OOK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 540 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity -86 dBm 915 MHz, 1.2 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (2-FSK, 5.2kHz deviation, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 58 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –111 dBm Sensitivity can be traded for current consumption by setting MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1. The typical current consumption is then reduced from 17.7 mA to 15.4 mA at sensitivity limit. The sensitivity is typically reduced to -109 dBm 915 MHz, 38.4 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (2-FSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 20 kHz deviation, 100 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –104 dBm 915 MHz, 250 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (MSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 540 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –93 dBm Sensitivity can be traded for current consumption by setting MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1. The typical current consumption is then reduced from 18.8 mA to 16.4 mA at sensitivity limit. The sensitivity is typically reduced to -92 dBm 915 MHz, 500 kBaud data rate, sensitivity optimized, MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=0 (MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1 cannot be used for data rates > 250 kBaud ) (MSK, 1% packet error rate, 20 bytes packet length, 812 kHz digital channel filter bandwidth) Receiver sensitivity –87 dBm CC1100 SWRS038D Page 12 of 92 Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Blocking Blocking at ±2 MHz offset, 1.2 kBaud, 868 MHz -53 dBm Desired channel 3dB above the sensitivity limit. Compliant with ETSI EN 300 220 class 2 receiver requirement. Blocking at ±2 MHz offset, 500 kBaud, 868 MHz -51 dBm Desired channel 3dB above the sensitivity limit. Compliant with ETSI EN 300 220 class 2 receiver requirement. Blocking at ±10 MHz offset, 1.2 kBaud, 868 MHz -43 dBm Desired channel 3dB above the sensitivity limit. Compliant with ETSI EN 300 220 class 2 receiver requirement. Blocking at ±10 MHz offset, 500 kBaud, 868 MHz -43 dBm Desired channel 3dB above the sensitivity limit. Compliant with ETSI EN 300 220 class 2 receiver requirement. General Spurious emissions -68 -66 –57 –47 dBm dBm 25 MHz – 1 GHz (Maximum figure is the ETSI EN 300 220 limit) Above 1 GHz (Maximum figure is the ETSI EN 300 220 limit) RX latency 9 bit Serial operation. Time from start of reception until data is available on the receiver data output pin is equal to 9 bit. Table 5: RF Receive Section CC1100 SWRS038D Page 13 of 92 4.3 RF Transmit Section Tc = 25°C, VDD = 3.0V, +10dBm if nothing else stated. All measurement results are obtained using the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]). Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Differential load impedance 315 MHz 433 MHz 868/915 MHz 122 + j31 116 + j41 86.5 + j43 Ω Differential impedance as seen from the RF-port (RF_P and RF_N) towards the antenna. Follow the CC1100EM reference design ([5] and [6]) available from theTI website. Output power, highest setting +10 dBm Output power is programmable, and full range is available in all frequency bands (Output power may be restricted by regulatory limits. See also Application Note AN039 [3]. Delivered to a 50Ω single-ended load via CC1100EM reference design ([5] and [6]) RF matching network. Output power, lowest setting -30 dBm Output power is programmable, and full range is available in all frequency bands. Delivered to a 50Ω single-ended load via CC1100EM reference design([5] and [6]) RF matching network. Harmonics, radiated 2nd Harm, 433 MHz 3rd Harm, 433 MHz 2nd Harm, 868 MHz 3rd Harm, 868 MHz -50 -40 -34 -45 dBm Measured on CC1100EM reference designs([5] and [6]) with CW, 10 dBm output power The antennas used during the radiated measurements (SMAFF- 433 from R.W.Badland and Nearson S331 868/915) plays a part in attenuating the harmonics Harmonics, conducted 315 MHz 433 MHz 868 MHz 915 MHz < -33 < -38 < -51 < -34 < -32 < -30 dBm Measured with 10 dBm CW, TX frequency at 315.00 MHz, 433.00 MHz, 868.00 MHz, or 915.00 MHz Frequencies below 960 MHz Frequencies above 960 MHz Frequencies below 1 GHz Frequencies above 1 GHz CC1100 SWRS038D Page 14 of 92 Spurious emissions, conducted Harmonics not included 315 MHz 433 MHz 868 MHz 915 MHz < -58 < -53 < -50 < -54 < -56 < -50 < -51 < -53 < -51 < -51 dBm Measured with 10 dBm CW, TX frequency at 315.00 MHz, 433.00 MHz, 868.00 MHz or 915.00 MHz Frequencies below 960 MHz Frequencies above 960 MHz Frequencies below 1 GHz Frequencies above 1 GHz Frequencies within 47-74, 87.5-118, 174-230, 470-862 MHz Frequencies below 1 GHz Frequencies above 1 GHz Frequencies within 47-74, 87.5-118, 174-230, 470-862 MHz. The peak conducted spurious emission is -53dBm @ 699 MHz, which is in an EN300220 restricted band limited to -54dBm. All radiated spurious emissions are within the limits of ETSI. Frequencies below 960 MHz Frequencies above 960 MHz General TX latency 8 bit Serial operation. Time from sampling the data on the transmitter data input DIO pin until it is observed on the RF output ports. Table 6: RF Transmit Section 4.4 Crystal Oscillator Tc = 25°C @ VDD = 3.0 V if nothing else is stated. Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Crystal frequency 26 26 27 MHz Tolerance ±40 ppm This is the total tolerance including a) initial tolerance, b) crystal loading, c) aging, and d) temperature dependence. The acceptable crystal tolerance depends on RF frequency and channel spacing / bandwidth. ESR 100 Ω Start-up time 150 μs Measured on the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]) using crystal AT-41CD2 from NDK. This parameter is to a large degree crystal dependent. Table 7: Crystal Oscillator Parameters CC1100 SWRS038D Page 15 of 92 4.5 Low Power RC Oscillator Tc = 25°C, VDD = 3.0 V if nothing else is stated. All measurement results obtained using the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]). Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Calibrated frequency 34.7 34.7 36 kHz Calibrated RC Oscillator frequency is XTAL frequency divided by 750 Frequency accuracy after calibration ±1 % Temperature coefficient +0.5 % / °C Frequency drift when temperature changes after calibration Supply voltage coefficient +3 % / V Frequency drift when supply voltage changes after calibration Initial calibration time 2 ms When the RC Oscillator is enabled, calibration is continuously done in the background as long as the crystal oscillator is running. Table 8: RC Oscillator Parameters 4.6 Frequency Synthesizer Characteristics Tc = 25°C @ VDD = 3.0 V if nothing else is stated. All measurement results are obtained using the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]). Min figures are given using a 27 MHz crystal. Typ and max are given using a 26 MHz crystal. Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Programmed frequency resolution 397 FXOSC/ 216 412 Hz 26-27 MHz crystal. The resolution (in Hz) is equal for all frequency bands. Synthesizer frequency tolerance ±40 ppm Given by crystal used. Required accuracy (including temperature and aging) depends on frequency band and channel bandwidth / spacing. RF carrier phase noise –89 dBc/Hz @ 50 kHz offset from carrier RF carrier phase noise –89 dBc/Hz @ 100 kHz offset from carrier RF carrier phase noise –90 dBc/Hz @ 200 kHz offset from carrier RF carrier phase noise –98 dBc/Hz @ 500 kHz offset from carrier RF carrier phase noise –107 dBc/Hz @ 1 MHz offset from carrier RF carrier phase noise –113 dBc/Hz @ 2 MHz offset from carrier RF carrier phase noise –119 dBc/Hz @ 5 MHz offset from carrier RF carrier phase noise –129 dBc/Hz @ 10 MHz offset from carrier PLL turn-on / hop time 85.1 88.4 88.4 μs Time from leaving the IDLE state until arriving in the RX, FSTXON or TX state, when not performing calibration. Crystal oscillator running. PLL RX/TX settling time 9.3 9.6 9.6 μs Settling time for the 1·IF frequency step from RX to TX PLL TX/RX settling time 20.7 21.5 21.5 μs Settling time for the 1·IF frequency step from TX to RX PLL calibration time 694 721 721 μs Calibration can be initiated manually or automatically before entering or after leaving RX/TX. Table 9: Frequency Synthesizer Parameters CC1100 SWRS038D Page 16 of 92 4.7 Analog Temperature Sensor The characteristics of the analog temperature sensor at 3.0 V supply voltage are listed in Table 10 below. Note that it is necessary to write 0xBF to the PTEST register to use the analog temperature sensor in the IDLE state. Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Output voltage at –40°C 0.651 V Output voltage at 0°C 0.747 V Output voltage at +40°C 0.847 V Output voltage at +80°C 0.945 V Temperature coefficient 2.45 mV/°C Fitted from –20 °C to +80 °C Error in calculated temperature, calibrated -2 * 0 2 * °C From –20 °C to +80 °C when using 2.45 mV / °C, after 1-point calibration at room temperature * The indicated minimum and maximum error with 1- point calibration is based on simulated values for typical process parameters Current consumption increase when enabled 0.3 mA Table 10: Analog Temperature Sensor Parameters 4.8 DC Characteristics Tc = 25°C if nothing else stated. Digital Inputs/Outputs Min Max Unit Condition Logic "0" input voltage 0 0.7 V Logic "1" input voltage VDD-0.7 VDD V Logic "0" output voltage 0 0.5 V For up to 4 mA output current Logic "1" output voltage VDD-0.3 VDD V For up to 4 mA output current Logic "0" input current N/A –50 nA Input equals 0V Logic "1" input current N/A 50 nA Input equals VDD Table 11: DC Characteristics 4.9 Power-On Reset When the power supply complies with the requirements in Table 12 below, proper Power-On-Reset functionality is guaranteed. Otherwise, the chip should be assumed to have unknown state until transmitting an SRES strobe over the SPI interface. See Section 19.1 on page 42 for further details. Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Condition/Note Power-up ramp-up time. 5 ms From 0V until reaching 1.8V Power off time 1 ms Minimum time between power-on and power-off Table 12: Power-On Reset Requirements CC1100 SWRS038D Page 17 of 92 5 Pin Configuration 1 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 6 7 8 9 10 5 4 3 2 GND Exposed die attach pad SCLK SO (GDO1) GDO2 DVDD DCOUPL GDO0 (ATEST) XOSC_Q1 AVDD XOSC_Q2 AVDD RF_P RF_N GND AVDD RBIAS DGUARD GND SI CSn AVDD Figure 1: Pinout Top View Note: The exposed die attach pad must be connected to a solid ground plane as this is the main ground connection for the chip. Pin # Pin Name Pin type Description 1 SCLK Digital Input Serial configuration interface, clock input 2 SO (GDO1) Digital Output Serial configuration interface, data output. Optional general output pin when CSn is high 3 GDO2 Digital Output Digital output pin for general use: • Test signals • FIFO status signals • Clear Channel Indicator • Clock output, down-divided from XOSC • Serial output RX data 4 DVDD Power (Digital) 1.8 - 3.6 V digital power supply for digital I/O’s and for the digital core voltage regulator 5 DCOUPL Power (Digital) 1.6 - 2.0 V digital power supply output for decoupling. NOTE: This pin is intended for use with the CC1100 only. It can not be used to provide supply voltage to other devices. 6 GDO0 (ATEST) Digital I/O Digital output pin for general use: • Test signals • FIFO status signals • Clear Channel Indicator • Clock output, down-divided from XOSC • Serial output RX data • Serial input TX data Also used as analog test I/O for prototype/production testing 7 CSn Digital Input Serial configuration interface, chip select 8 XOSC_Q1 Analog I/O Crystal oscillator pin 1, or external clock input 9 AVDD Power (Analog) 1.8 - 3.6 V analog power supply connection 10 XOSC_Q2 Analog I/O Crystal oscillator pin 2 CC1100 SWRS038D Page 18 of 92 Pin # Pin Name Pin type Description 11 AVDD Power (Analog) 1.8 -3.6 V analog power supply connection 12 RF_P RF I/O Positive RF input signal to LNA in receive mode Positive RF output signal from PA in transmit mode 13 RF_N RF I/O Negative RF input signal to LNA in receive mode Negative RF output signal from PA in transmit mode 14 AVDD Power (Analog) 1.8 - 3.6 V analog power supply connection 15 AVDD Power (Analog) 1.8 - 3.6 V analog power supply connection 16 GND Ground (Analog) Analog ground connection 17 RBIAS Analog I/O External bias resistor for reference current 18 DGUARD Power (Digital) Power supply connection for digital noise isolation 19 GND Ground (Digital) Ground connection for digital noise isolation 20 SI Digital Input Serial configuration interface, data input Table 13: Pinout Overview 6 Circuit Description BIAS PA RBIAS XOSC_Q1 XOSC_Q2 CSn SI SO (GDO1) XOSC SCLK LNA 0 90 FREQ SYNTH ADC ADC DEMODULATOR FEC / INTERLEAVER PACKET HANDLER RXFIFO MODULATOR TXFIFO DIGITAL INTERFACE TO MCU RADIO CONTROL RF_P RF_N GDO2 GDO0 (ATEST) RC OSC Figure 2: CC1100 Simplified Block Diagram A simplified block diagram of CC1100 is shown in Figure 2. CC1100 features a low-IF receiver. The received RF signal is amplified by the lownoise amplifier (LNA) and down-converted in quadrature (I and Q) to the intermediate frequency (IF). At IF, the I/Q signals are digitised by the ADCs. Automatic gain control (AGC), fine channel filtering and demodulation bit/packet synchronization are performed digitally. The transmitter part of CC1100 is based on direct synthesis of the RF frequency. The frequency synthesizer includes a completely on-chip LC VCO and a 90 degree phase shifter for generating the I and Q LO signals to the down-conversion mixers in receive mode. A crystal is to be connected to XOSC_Q1 and XOSC_Q2. The crystal oscillator generates the reference frequency for the synthesizer, as well as clocks for the ADC and the digital part. A 4-wire SPI serial interface is used for configuration and data buffer access. The digital baseband includes support for channel configuration, packet handling, and data buffering. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 19 of 92 7 Application Circuit Only a few external components are required for using the CC1100. The recommended application circuits are shown in Figure 3 and Figure 4. The external components are described in Table 14, and typical values are given in Table 15. Bias Resistor The bias resistor R171 is used to set an accurate bias current. Balun and RF Matching The components between the RF_N/RF_P pins and the point where the two signals are joined together (C131, C121, L121 and L131 for the 315/433 MHz reference design [5]. L121, L131, C121, L122, C131, C122 and L132 for the 868/915 MHz reference design [6]) form a balun that converts the differential RF signal on CC1100 to a single-ended RF signal. C124 is needed for DC blocking. Together with an appropriate LC network, the balun components also transform the impedance to match a 50 Ω antenna (or cable). Suggested values for 315 MHz, 433 MHz, and 868/915 MHz are listed in Table 15. The balun and LC filter component values and their placement are important to keep the performance optimized. It is highly recommended to follow the CC1100EM reference design [5] and [6]. Crystal The crystal oscillator uses an external crystal with two loading capacitors (C81 and C101). See Section 27 on page 53 for details. Additional Filtering Additional external components (e.g. an RF SAW filter) may be used in order to improve the performance in specific applications. Power Supply Decoupling The power supply must be properly decoupled close to the supply pins. Note that decoupling capacitors are not shown in the application circuit. The placement and the size of the decoupling capacitors are very important to achieve the optimum performance. The CC1100EM reference design ([5] and [6]) should be followed closely. Component Description C51 Decoupling capacitor for on-chip voltage regulator to digital part C81/C101 Crystal loading capacitors, see Section 27 on page 53 for details C121/C131 RF balun/matching capacitors C122 RF LC filter/matching filter capacitor (315 and 433 MHz). RF balun/matching capacitor (868/915 MHz). C123 RF LC filter/matching capacitor C124 RF balun DC blocking capacitor C125 RF LC filter DC blocking capacitor (only needed if there is a DC path in the antenna) L121/L131 RF balun/matching inductors (inexpensive multi-layer type) L122 RF LC filter/matching filter inductor (315 and 433 MHz). RF balun/matching inductor (868/915 MHz). (inexpensive multi-layer type) L123 RF LC filter/matching filter inductor (inexpensive multi-layer type) L124 RF LC filter/matching filter inductor (inexpensive multi-layer type) L132 RF balun/matching inductor. (inexpensive multi-layer type) R171 Resistor for internal bias current reference. XTAL 26MHz - 27MHz crystal, see Section 27 on page 53 for details. Table 14: Overview of External Components (excluding supply decoupling capacitors) CC1100 SWRS038D Page 20 of 92 Antenna (50 Ohm) Digital Inteface 1.8V-3.6V power supply 6 GDO0 7 CSn 8 XOSC_Q1 9 AVDD 10 XOSC_Q2 SI 20 GND 19 DGUARD 18 RBIAS 17 GND 16 1 SCLK 2 SO (GDO1) 3 GDO2 4 DVDD 5 DCOUPL AVDD 15 AVDD 14 RF_N 13 RF_P 12 AVDD 11 XTAL L122 L123 C122 C123 C125 R171 C81 C101 C51 CSn GDO0 (optional) GDO2 (optional) SO (GDO1) SCLK SI CC1100 DIE ATTACH PAD: C131 C121 L121 L131 C124 Figure 3: Typical Application and Evaluation Circuit 315/433 MHz (excluding supply decoupling capacitors) Antenna (50 Ohm) Digital Inteface 1.8V-3.6V power supply 6 GDO0 7 CSn 8 XOSC_Q1 9 AVDD 10 XOSC_Q2 SI 20 GND 19 DGUARD 18 RBIAS 17 GND 16 1 SCLK 2 SO (GDO1) 3 GDO2 4 DVDD 5 DCOUPL AVDD 15 AVDD 14 RF_N 13 RF_P 12 AVDD 11 XTAL C121 C122 L122 L132 C131 L121 L123 C125 R171 C81 C101 C51 CSn GDO0 (optional) GDO2 (optional) SO (GDO1) SCLK SI DIE ATTACH PAD: L131 C124 C123 L124 Figure 4: Typical Application and Evaluation Circuit 868/915 MHz (excluding supply decoupling capacitors) CC1100 SWRS038D Page 21 of 92 Component Value at 315MHz Value at 433MHz Value at 868/915MHz Manufacturer C51 100 nF ± 10%, 0402 X5R Murata GRM1555C series C81 27 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series C101 27 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series C121 6.8 pF ± 0.5 pF, 0402 NP0 3.9 pF ± 0.25 pF, 0402 NP0 1.0 pF ± 0.25 pF, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series C122 12 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 8.2 pF ± 0.5 pF, 0402 NP0 1.5 pF ± 0.25 pF, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series C123 6.8 pF ± 0.5 pF, 0402 NP0 5.6 pF ± 0.5 pF, 0402 NP0 3.3 pF ± 0.25 pF, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series C124 220 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 220 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 100 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series C125 220 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 220 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 100 pF ± 5%, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series C131 6.8 pF ± 0.5 pF, 0402 NP0 3.9 pF ± 0.25 pF, 0402 NP0 1.5 pF ± 0.25 pF, 0402 NP0 Murata GRM1555C series L121 33 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 27 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 12 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic Murata LQG15HS series L122 18 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 22 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 18 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic Murata LQG15HS series L123 33 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 27 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 12 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic Murata LQG15HS series L124 12 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic Murata LQG15HS series L131 33 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 27 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic 12 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic Murata LQG15HS series L132 18 nH ± 5%, 0402 monolithic Murata LQG15HS series R171 56 kΩ ± 1%, 0402 Koa RK73 series XTAL 26.0 MHz surface mount crystal NDK, AT-41CD2 Table 15: Bill Of Materials for the Application Circuit The Gerber files for the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]) are available from the TI website. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 22 of 92 8 Configuration Overview CC1100 can be configured to achieve optimum performance for many different applications. Configuration is done using the SPI interface. The following key parameters can be programmed: • Power-down / power up mode • Crystal oscillator power-up / power-down • Receive / transmit mode • RF channel selection • Data rate • Modulation format • RX channel filter bandwidth • RF output power • Data buffering with separate 64-byte receive and transmit FIFOs • Packet radio hardware support • Forward Error Correction (FEC) with interleaving • Data Whitening • Wake-On-Radio (WOR) Details of each configuration register can be found in Section 33, starting on page 60. Figure 5 shows a simplified state diagram that explains the main CC1100 states, together with typical usage and current consumption. For detailed information on controlling the CC1100 state machine, and a complete state diagram, see Section 19, starting on page 42. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 23 of 92 Transmit mode Receive mode IDLE Manual freq. synth. calibration RX FIFO overflow TX FIFO underflow Frequency synthesizer on SFSTXON SRX or wake-on-radio (WOR) STX STX STX or RXOFF_MODE=10 RXOFF_MODE = 00 SFTX SRX or TXOFF_MODE = 11 SIDLE SCAL SFRX IDLE TXOFF_MODE = 00 SFSTXON or RXOFF_MODE = 01 SRX or STX or SFSTXON or wake-on-radio (WOR) Sleep SPWD or wake-on-radio (WOR) Crystal oscillator off SXOFF CSn = 0 CSn = 0 TXOFF_MODE = 01 Frequency synthesizer startup, optional calibration, settling Optional freq. synth. calibration Default state when the radio is not receiving or transmitting. Typ. current consumption: 1.6 mA. Lowest power mode. Most register values are retained. Current consumption typ 400 nA, or typ 900 nA when wake-on-radio (WOR) is enabled. All register values are retained. Typ. current consumption; 0.16 mA. Used for calibrating frequency synthesizer upfront (entering receive or transmit mode can then be done quicker). Transitional state. Typ. current consumption: 8.2 mA. Frequency synthesizer is turned on, can optionally be calibrated, and then settles to the correct frequency. Transitional s Frequency synthesizer is on, tate. Typ. current consumption: 8.2 mA. ready to start transmitting. Transmission starts very quickly after receiving the STX command strobe.Typ. current consumption: 8.2 mA. Typ. current consumption: 13.5 mA at -6 dBm output, 16.9 mA at 0 dBm output, 30.7 mA at +10 dBm output. Typ. current consumption: from 14.4 mA (strong input signal) to 15.4mA (weak input signal). Optional transitional state. Typ. In FIFO-based modes, current consumption: 8.2mA. transmission is turned off and this state entered if the TX FIFO becomes empty in the middle of a packet. Typ. current consumption: 1.6 mA. In FIFO-based modes, reception is turned off and this state entered if the RX FIFO overflows. Typ. current consumption: 1.6 mA. Figure 5: Simplified State Diagram, with Typical Current Consumption at 1.2 kBaud Data Rate and MDMCFG2.DEM_DCFILT_OFF=1 (current optimized). Freq. Band = 868 MHz CC1100 SWRS038D Page 24 of 92 9 Configuration Software CC1100 can be configured using the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. The SmartRF® Studio software is highly recommended for obtaining optimum register settings, and for evaluating performance and functionality. A screenshot of the SmartRF® Studio user interface for CC1100 is shown in Figure 6. After chip reset, all the registers have default values as shown in the tables in Section 33. The optimum register setting might differ from the default value. After a reset all registers that shall be different from the default value therefore needs to be programmed through the SPI interface. Figure 6: SmartRF® Studio [7] User Interface 10 4-wire Serial Configuration and Data Interface CC1100 is configured via a simple 4-wire SPIcompatible interface (SI, SO, SCLK and CSn) where CC1100 is the slave. This interface is also used to read and write buffered data. All transfers on the SPI interface are done most significant bit first. All transactions on the SPI interface start with a header byte containing a R/W;¯ bit, a burst access bit (B), and a 6-bit address (A5 – A0). The CSn pin must be kept low during transfers on the SPI bus. If CSn goes high during the transfer of a header byte or during read/write from/to a register, the transfer will be cancelled. The timing for the address and data transfer on the SPI interface is shown in Figure 7 with reference to Table 16. When CSn is pulled low, the MCU must wait until CC1100 SO pin goes low before starting to transfer the header byte. This indicates that the crystal is running. Unless the chip was in CC1100 SWRS038D Page 25 of 92 the SLEEP or XOFF states, the SO pin will always go low immediately after taking CSn low. Figure 7: Configuration Registers Write and Read Operations Parameter Description Min Max Units SCLK frequency 100 ns delay inserted between address byte and data byte (single access), or between address and data, and between each data byte (burst access). - 10 SCLK frequency, single access No delay between address and data byte - 9 fSCLK SCLK frequency, burst access No delay between address and data byte, or between data bytes - 6.5 MHz tsp,pd CSn low to positive edge on SCLK, in power-down mode 150 - μs tsp CSn low to positive edge on SCLK, in active mode 20 - ns tch Clock high 50 - ns tcl Clock low 50 - ns trise Clock rise time - 5 ns tfall Clock fall time - 5 ns tsd Setup data (negative SCLK edge) to positive edge on SCLK (tsd applies between address and data bytes, and between data bytes) Single access Burst access 55 76 - - ns thd Hold data after positive edge on SCLK 20 - ns tns Negative edge on SCLK to CSn high. 20 - ns Table 16: SPI Interface Timing Requirements Note: The minimum tsp,pd figure in Table 16 can be used in cases where the user does not read the CHIP_RDYn signal. CSn low to positive edge on SCLK when the chip is woken from power-down depends on the start-up time of the crystal being used. The 150 us in Table 16 is the crystal oscillator start-up time measured on CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]) using crystal AT-41CD2 from NDK. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 26 of 92 10.1 Chip Status Byte When the header byte, data byte, or command strobe is sent on the SPI interface, the chip status byte is sent by the CC1100 on the SO pin. The status byte contains key status signals, useful for the MCU. The first bit, s7, is the CHIP_RDYn signal; this signal must go low before the first positive edge of SCLK. The CHIP_RDYn signal indicates that the crystal is running. Bits 6, 5, and 4 comprise the STATE value. This value reflects the state of the chip. The XOSC and power to the digital core is on in the IDLE state, but all other modules are in power down. The frequency and channel configuration should only be updated when the chip is in this state. The RX state will be active when the chip is in receive mode. Likewise, TX is active when the chip is transmitting. The last four bits (3:0) in the status byte contains FIFO_BYTES_AVAILABLE. For read operations (the R/W;¯ bit in the header byte is set to 1), the FIFO_BYTES_AVAILABLE field contains the number of bytes available for reading from the RX FIFO. For write operations (the R/W;¯ bit in the header byte is set to 0), the FIFO_BYTES_AVAILABLE field contains the number of bytes that can be written to the TX FIFO. When FIFO_BYTES_AVAILABLE=15, 15 or more bytes are available/free. Table 17 gives a status byte summary. Bits Name Description 7 CHIP_RDYn Stays high until power and crystal have stabilized. Should always be low when using the SPI interface. 6:4 STATE[2:0] Indicates the current main state machine mode Value State Description 000 IDLE IDLE state (Also reported for some transitional states instead of SETTLING or CALIBRATE) 001 RX Receive mode 010 TX Transmit mode 011 FSTXON Fast TX ready 100 CALIBRATE Frequency synthesizer calibration is running 101 SETTLING PLL is settling 110 RXFIFO_OVERFLOW RX FIFO has overflowed. Read out any useful data, then flush the FIFO with SFRX 111 TXFIFO_UNDERFLOW TX FIFO has underflowed. Acknowledge with SFTX 3:0 FIFO_BYTES_AVAILABLE[3:0] The number of bytes available in the RX FIFO or free bytes in the TX FIFO Table 17: Status Byte Summary 10.2 Register Access The configuration registers on the CC1100 are located on SPI addresses from 0x00 to 0x2E. Table 36 on page 61 lists all configuration registers. It is highly recommended to use SmartRF® Studio [7] to generate optimum register settings. The detailed description of each register is found in Section 33.1 and 33.2, starting on page 64. All configuration registers can be both written to and read. The R/W;¯ bit controls if the register should be written to or read. When writing to registers, the status byte is sent on the SO pin each time a header byte or data byte is transmitted on the SI pin. When reading from registers, the status byte is sent on the SO pin each time a header byte is transmitted on the SI pin. Registers with consecutive addresses can be accessed in an efficient way by setting the burst bit (B) in the header byte. The address bits (A5 – A0) set the start address in an internal address counter. This counter is incremented by one each new byte (every 8 clock pulses). The burst access is either a CC1100 SWRS038D Page 27 of 92 read or a write access and must be terminated by setting CSn high. For register addresses in the range 0x30- 0x3D, the burst bit is used to select between status registers, burst bit is one, and command strobes, burst bit is zero (see 10.4 below). Because of this, burst access is not available for status registers and they must be accesses one at a time. The status registers can only be read. 10.3 SPI Read When reading register fields over the SPI interface while the register fields are updated by the radio hardware (e.g. MARCSTATE or TXBYTES), there is a small, but finite, probability that a single read from the register is being corrupt. As an example, the probability of any single read from TXBYTES being corrupt, assuming the maximum data rate is used, is approximately 80 ppm. Refer to the CC1100 Errata Notes [1] for more details. 10.4 Command Strobes Command Strobes may be viewed as single byte instructions to CC1100. By addressing a command strobe register, internal sequences will be started. These commands are used to disable the crystal oscillator, enable receive mode, enable wake-on-radio etc. The 13 command strobes are listed in Table 35 on page 60. The command strobe registers are accessed by transferring a single header byte (no data is being transferred). That is, only the R/W;¯ bit, the burst access bit (set to 0), and the six address bits (in the range 0x30 through 0x3D) are written. The R/W;¯ bit can be either one or zero and will determine how the FIFO_BYTES_AVAILABLE field in the status byte should be interpreted. When writing command strobes, the status byte is sent on the SO pin. A command strobe may be followed by any other SPI access without pulling CSn high. However, if an SRES strobe is being issued, one will have to waith for SO to go low again before the next header byte can be issued as shown in Figure 8. The command strobes are executed immediately, with the exception of the SPWD and the SXOFF strobes that are executed when CSn goes high. Figure 8: SRES Command Strobe 10.5 FIFO Access The 64-byte TX FIFO and the 64-byte RX FIFO are accessed through the 0x3F address. When the R/W;¯ bit is zero, the TX FIFO is accessed, and the RX FIFO is accessed when the R/W;¯ bit is one. The TX FIFO is write-only, while the RX FIFO is read-only. The burst bit is used to determine if the FIFO access is a single byte access or a burst access. The single byte access method expects a header byte with the burst bit set to zero and one data byte. After the data byte a new header byte is expected; hence, CSn can remain low. The burst access method expects one header byte and then consecutive data bytes until terminating the access by setting CSn high. The following header bytes access the FIFOs: • 0x3F: Single byte access to TX FIFO • 0x7F: Burst access to TX FIFO • 0xBF: Single byte access to RX FIFO • 0xFF: Burst access to RX FIFO When writing to the TX FIFO, the status byte (see Section 10.1) is output for each new data byte on SO, as shown in Figure 7. This status byte can be used to detect TX FIFO underflow while writing data to the TX FIFO. Note that the status byte contains the number of bytes free before writing the byte in progress to the TX FIFO. When the last byte that fits in the TX FIFO is transmitted on SI, the status byte received concurrently on SO will indicate that one byte is free in the TX FIFO. The TX FIFO may be flushed by issuing a SFTX command strobe. Similarly, a SFRX command strobe will flush the RX FIFO. A SFTX or SFRX command strobe can only be issued in the IDLE, TXFIFO_UNDERLOW, or RXFIFO_OVERFLOW states. Both FIFOs are flushed when going to the SLEEP state. Figure 9 gives a brief overview of different register access types possible. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 28 of 92 10.6 PATABLE Access The 0x3E address is used to access the PATABLE, which is used for selecting PA power control settings. The SPI expects up to eight data bytes after receiving the address. By programming the PATABLE, controlled PA power ramp-up and ramp-down can be achieved, as well as ASK modulation shaping for reduced bandwidth. Note that both the ASK modulation shaping and the PA ramping is limited to output powers up to -1 dBm, and the PATABLE settings allowed are 0x00 and 0x30 to 0x3F. See SmartRF® Studio [7] for recommended shaping / PA ramping sequences. See Section 24 on page 49 for details on output power programming. The PATABLE is an 8-byte table that defines the PA control settings to use for each of the eight PA power values (selected by the 3-bit value FREND0.PA_POWER). The table is written and read from the lowest setting (0) to the highest (7), one byte at a time. An index counter is used to control the access to the table. This counter is incremented each time a byte is read or written to the table, and set to the lowest index when CSn is high. When the highest value is reached the counter restarts at zero. The access to the PATABLE is either single byte or burst access depending on the burst bit. When using burst access the index counter will count up; when reaching 7 the counter will restart at 0. The R/W;¯ bit controls whether the access is a read or a write access. If one byte is written to the PATABLE and this value is to be read out then CSn must be set high before the read access in order to set the index counter back to zero. Note that the content of the PATABLE is lost when entering the SLEEP state, except for the first byte (index 0). Figure 9: Register Access Types 11 Microcontroller Interface and Pin Configuration In a typical system, CC1100 will interface to a microcontroller. This microcontroller must be able to: • Program CC1100 into different modes • Read and write buffered data • Read back status information via the 4-wire SPI-bus configuration interface (SI, SO, SCLK and CSn). 11.1 Configuration Interface The microcontroller uses four I/O pins for the SPI configuration interface (SI, SO, SCLK and CSn). The SPI is described in Section 10 on page 24. 11.2 General Control and Status Pins The CC1100 has two dedicated configurable pins (GDO0 and GDO2) and one shared pin (GDO1) that can output internal status information useful for control software. These pins can be used to generate interrupts on the MCU. See Section 30 page 55 for more details on the signals that can be programmed. GDO1 is shared with the SO pin in the SPI interface. The default setting for GDO1/SO is 3-state output. By selecting any other of the programming options, the GDO1/SO pin will become a generic pin. When CSn is low, the pin will always function as a normal SO pin. In the synchronous and asynchronous serial modes, the GDO0 pin is used as a serial TX data input pin while in transmit mode. The GDO0 pin can also be used for an on-chip analog temperature sensor. By measuring the voltage on the GDO0 pin with an external ADC, the temperature can be calculated. Specifications for the temperature sensor are found in Section 4.7 on page 16. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 29 of 92 With default PTEST register setting (0x7F) the temperature sensor output is only available when the frequency synthesizer is enabled (e.g. the MANCAL, FSTXON, RX, and TX states). It is necessary to write 0xBF to the PTEST register to use the analog temperature sensor in the IDLE state. Before leaving the IDLE state, the PTEST register should be restored to its default value (0x7F). 11.3 Optional Radio Control Feature The CC1100 has an optional way of controlling the radio, by reusing SI, SCLK, and CSn from the SPI interface. This feature allows for a simple three-pin control of the major states of the radio: SLEEP, IDLE, RX, and TX. This optional functionality is enabled with the MCSM0.PIN_CTRL_EN configuration bit. State changes are commanded as follows: When CSn is high the SI and SCLK is set to the desired state according to Table 18. When CSn goes low the state of SI and SCLK is latched and a command strobe is generated internally according to the pin configuration. It is only possible to change state with this functionality. That means that for instance RX will not be restarted if SI and SCLK are set to RX and CSn toggles. When CSn is low the SI and SCLK has normal SPI functionality. All pin control command strobes are executed immediately, except the SPWD strobe, which is delayed until CSn goes high. CSn SCLK SI Function 1 X X Chip unaffected by SCLK/SI ↓ 0 0 Generates SPWD strobe ↓ 0 1 Generates STX strobe ↓ 1 0 Generates SIDLE strobe ↓ 1 1 Generates SRX strobe 0 SPI mode SPI mode SPI mode (wakes up into IDLE if in SLEEP/XOFF) Table 18: Optional Pin Control Coding 12 Data Rate Programming The data rate used when transmitting, or the data rate expected in receive is programmed by the MDMCFG3.DRATE_M and the MDMCFG4.DRATE_E configuration registers. The data rate is given by the formula below. As the formula shows, the programmed data rate depends on the crystal frequency. ( ) XOSC DRATE E DATA R = + DRATE M ⋅ ⋅ f 28 _ 2 256 _ 2 The following approach can be used to find suitable values for a given data rate: 256 2 2 _ 2 _ log _ 28 20 2 − ⋅ ⋅ = ⎥ ⎥⎦ ⎥ ⎢ ⎢⎣ ⎢ ⎟ ⎟⎠ ⎞ ⎜ ⎜⎝ ⎛ ⋅ = DRATE E XOSC DATA XOSC DATA f DRATE M R f DRATE E R If DRATE_M is rounded to the nearest integer and becomes 256, increment DRATE_E and use DRATE_M = 0. The data rate can be set from 1.2 kBaud to 500 kBaud with the minimum step size of: Min Data Rate [kBaud] Typical Data Rate [kBaud] Max Data Rate [kBaud] Data rate Step Size [kBaud] 0.8 1.2 / 2.4 3.17 0.0062 3.17 4.8 6.35 0.0124 6.35 9.6 12.7 0.0248 12.7 19.6 25.4 0.0496 25.4 38.4 50.8 0.0992 50.8 76.8 101.6 0.1984 101.6 153.6 203.1 0.3967 203.1 250 406.3 0.7935 406.3 500 500 1.5869 Table 19: Data Rate Step Size CC1100 SWRS038D Page 30 of 92 13 Receiver Channel Filter Bandwidth In order to meet different channel width requirements, the receiver channel filter is programmable. The MDMCFG4.CHANBW_E and MDMCFG4.CHANBW_M configuration registers control the receiver channel filter bandwidth, which scales with the crystal oscillator frequency. The following formula gives the relation between the register settings and the channel filter bandwidth: CHANBW E XOSC channel CHANBW M BW f 8⋅ (4 + _ )·2 _ = The CC1100 supports the following channel filter bandwidths: MDMCFG4. MDMCFG4.CHANBW_E CHANBW_M 00 01 10 11 00 812 406 203 102 01 650 325 162 81 10 541 270 135 68 11 464 232 116 58 Table 20: Channel Filter Bandwidths [kHz] (Assuming a 26MHz crystal) For best performance, the channel filter bandwidth should be selected so that the signal bandwidth occupies at most 80% of the channel filter bandwidth. The channel centre tolerance due to crystal accuracy should also be subtracted from the signal bandwidth. The following example illustrates this: With the channel filter bandwidth set to 500 kHz, the signal should stay within 80% of 500 kHz, which is 400 kHz. Assuming 915 MHz frequency and ±20 ppm frequency uncertainty for both the transmitting device and the receiving device, the total frequency uncertainty is ±40 ppm of 915MHz, which is ±37 kHz. If the whole transmitted signal bandwidth is to be received within 400kHz, the transmitted signal bandwidth should be maximum 400kHz – 2·37 kHz, which is 326 kHz. 14 Demodulator, Symbol Synchronizer, and Data Decision CC1100 contains an advanced and highly configurable demodulator. Channel filtering and frequency offset compensation is performed digitally. To generate the RSSI level (see Section 17.3 for more information) the signal level in the channel is estimated. Data filtering is also included for enhanced performance. 14.1 Frequency Offset Compensation When using 2-FSK, GFSK, or MSK modulation, the demodulator will compensate for the offset between the transmitter and receiver frequency, within certain limits, by estimating the centre of the received data. This value is available in the FREQEST status register. Writing the value from FREQEST into FSCTRL0.FREQOFF the frequency synthesizer is automatically adjusted according to the estimated frequency offset. The tracking range of the algorithm is selectable as fractions of the channel bandwidth with the FOCCFG.FOC_LIMIT configuration register. If the FOCCFG.FOC_BS_CS_GATE bit is set, the offset compensator will freeze until carrier sense asserts. This may be useful when the radio is in RX for long periods with no traffic, since the algorithm may drift to the boundaries when trying to track noise. The tracking loop has two gain factors, which affects the settling time and noise sensitivity of the algorithm. FOCCFG.FOC_PRE_K sets the gain before the sync word is detected, and FOCCFG.FOC_POST_K selects the gain after the sync word has been found. Note that frequency offset compensation is not supported for ASK or OOK modulation. 14.2 Bit Synchronization The bit synchronization algorithm extracts the clock from the incoming symbols. The algorithm requires that the expected data rate is programmed as described in Section 12 on page 29. Re-synchronization is performed continuously to adjust for error in the incoming symbol rate. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 31 of 92 14.3 Byte Synchronization Byte synchronization is achieved by a continuous sync word search. The sync word is a 16 bit configurable field (can be repeated to get a 32 bit) that is automatically inserted at the start of the packet by the modulator in transmit mode. The demodulator uses this field to find the byte boundaries in the stream of bits. The sync word will also function as a system identifier, since only packets with the correct predefined sync word will be received if the sync word detection in RX is enabled in register MDMCFG2 (see Section 17.1). The sync word detector correlates against the user-configured 16 or 32 bit sync word. The correlation threshold can be set to 15/16, 16/16, or 30/32 bits match. The sync word can be further qualified using the preamble quality indicator mechanism described below and/or a carrier sense condition. The sync word is configured through the SYNC1 and SYNC0 registers. In order to make false detections of sync words less likely, a mechanism called preamble quality indication (PQI) can be used to qualify the sync word. A threshold value for the preamble quality must be exceeded in order for a detected sync word to be accepted. See Section 17.2 on page 37 for more details. 15 Packet Handling Hardware Support The CC1100 has built-in hardware support for packet oriented radio protocols. In transmit mode, the packet handler can be configured to add the following elements to the packet stored in the TX FIFO: • A programmable number of preamble bytes • A two byte synchronization (sync) word. Can be duplicated to give a 4-byte sync word (recommended). It is not possible to only insert preamble or only insert a sync word. • A CRC checksum computed over the data field. • • The recommended setting is 4-byte preamble and 4-byte sync word, except for 500 kBaud data rate where the recommended preamble length is 8 bytes. • • In addition, the following can be implemented on the data field and the optional 2-byte CRC checksum: • • Whitening of the data with a PN9 sequence. • Forward error correction by the use of interleaving and coding of the data (convolutional coding). • In receive mode, the packet handling support will de-construct the data packet by implementing the following (if enabled): • Preamble detection. • Sync word detection. • CRC computation and CRC check. • One byte address check. • Packet length check (length byte checked against a programmable maximum length). • De-whitening • De-interleaving and decoding • Optionally, two status bytes (see Table 21 and Table 22) with RSSI value, Link Quality Indication, and CRC status can be appended in the RX FIFO. • Bit Field Name Description 7:0 RSSI RSSI value Table 21: Received Packet Status Byte 1 (first byte appended after the data) Bit Field Name Description 7 CRC_OK 1: CRC for received data OK (or CRC disabled) 0: CRC error in received data 6:0 LQI Indicating the link quality Table 22: Received Packet Status Byte 2 (second byte appended after the data) • • Note that register fields that control the packet handling features should only be altered when CC1100 is in the IDLE state. 15.1 Data Whitening From a radio perspective, the ideal over the air data are random and DC free. This results in the smoothest power distribution over the occupied bandwidth. This also gives the regulation loops in the receiver uniform operation conditions (no data dependencies). CC1100 SWRS038D Page 32 of 92 Real world data often contain long sequences of zeros and ones. Performance can then be improved by whitening the data before transmitting, and de-whitening the data in the receiver. With CC1100, this can be done automatically by setting PKTCTRL0.WHITE_DATA=1. All data, except the preamble and the sync word, are then XOR-ed with a 9-bit pseudo-random (PN9) sequence before being transmitted, as shown in Figure 10. At the receiver end, the data are XOR-ed with the same pseudo-random sequence. This way, the whitening is reversed, and the original data appear in the receiver. The PN9 sequence is initialized to all 1’s. Figure 10: Data Whitening in TX Mode 15.2 Packet Format The format of the data packet can be configured and consists of the following items (see Figure 11): • Preamble • Synchronization word • Optional length byte • Optional address byte • Payload • Optional 2 byte CRC • Preamble bits (1010...1010) Sync word Length field Address field Data field CRC-16 Optional CRC-16 calculation Optionally FEC encoded/decoded 8 x n bits 16/32 bits 8 bits 8 bits 8 x n bits 16 bits Optional data whitening Legend: Inserted automatically in TX, processed and removed in RX. Optional user-provided fields processed in TX, processed but not removed in RX. Unprocessed user data (apart from FEC and/or whitening) Figure 11: Packet Format The preamble pattern is an alternating sequence of ones and zeros (10101010…). The minimum length of the preamble is programmable. When enabling TX, the modulator will start transmitting the preamble. When the programmed number of preamble bytes has been transmitted, the modulator will send the sync word and then data from the TX FIFO if data is available. If the TX FIFO is empty, the modulator will continue to send CC1100 SWRS038D Page 33 of 92 preamble bytes until the first byte is written to the TX FIFO. The modulator will then send the sync word and then the data bytes. The number of preamble bytes is programmed with the MDMCFG1.NUM_PREAMBLE value. The synchronization word is a two-byte value set in the SYNC1 and SYNC0 registers. The sync word provides byte synchronization of the incoming packet. A one-byte synch word can be emulated by setting the SYNC1 value to the preamble pattern. It is also possible to emulate a 32 bit sync word by using MDMCFG2.SYNC_MODE set to 3 or 7. The sync word will then be repeated twice. CC1100 supports both constant packet length protocols and variable length protocols. Variable or fixed packet length mode can be used for packets up to 255 bytes. For longer packets, infinite packet length mode must be used. Fixed packet length mode is selected by setting PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=0. The desired packet length is set by the PKTLEN register. In variable packet length mode, PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=1, the packet length is configured by the first byte after the sync word. The packet length is defined as the payload data, excluding the length byte and the optional CRC. The PKTLEN register is used to set the maximum packet length allowed in RX. Any packet received with a length byte with a value greater than PKTLEN will be discarded. With PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=2, the packet length is set to infinite and transmission and reception will continue until turned off manually. As described in the next section, this can be used to support packet formats with different length configuration than natively supported by CC1100. One should make sure that TX mode is not turned off during the transmission of the first half of any byte. Refer to the CC1100 Errata Notes [1] for more details. Note that the minimum packet length supported (excluding the optional length byte and CRC) is one byte of payload data. 15.2.1 Arbitrary Length Field Configuration The packet length register, PKTLEN, can be reprogrammed during receive and transmit. In combination with fixed packet length mode (PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=0) this opens the possibility to have a different length field configuration than supported for variable length packets (in variable packet length mode the length byte is the first byte after the sync word). At the start of reception, the packet length is set to a large value. The MCU reads out enough bytes to interpret the length field in the packet. Then the PKTLEN value is set according to this value. The end of packet will occur when the byte counter in the packet handler is equal to the PKTLEN register. Thus, the MCU must be able to program the correct length, before the internal counter reaches the packet length. 15.2.2 Packet Length > 255 Also the packet automation control register, PKTCTRL0, can be reprogrammed during TX and RX. This opens the possibility to transmit and receive packets that are longer than 256 bytes and still be able to use the packet handling hardware support. At the start of the packet, the infinite packet length mode (PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=2) must be active. On the TX side, the PKTLEN register is set to mod(length, 256). On the RX side the MCU reads out enough bytes to interpret the length field in the packet and sets the PKTLEN register to mod(length, 256). When less than 256 bytes remains of the packet the MCU disables infinite packet length mode and activates fixed packet length mode. When the internal byte counter reaches the PKTLEN value, the transmission or reception ends (the radio enters the state determined by TXOFF_MODE or RXOFF_MODE). Automatic CRC appending/checking can also be used (by setting PKTCTRL0.CRC_EN=1). When for example a 600-byte packet is to be transmitted, the MCU should do the following (see also Figure 12) • Set PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=2. • Pre-program the PKTLEN register to mod(600, 256) = 88. • Transmit at least 345 bytes (600 - 255), for example by filling the 64-byte TX FIFO six times (384 bytes transmitted). • Set PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=0. • The transmission ends when the packet counter reaches 88. A total of 600 bytes are transmitted. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 34 of 92 0,1,..........,88,....................255,0,........,88,..................,255,0,........,88,..................,255,0,....................... Internal byte counter in packet handler counts from 0 to 255 and then starts at 0 again Length field transmitted and received. Rx and Tx PKTLEN value set to mod(600,256) = 88 Infinite packet length enabled Fixed packet length enabled when less than 256 bytes remains of packet 600 bytes transmitted and received Figure 12: Packet Length > 255 15.3 Packet Filtering in Receive Mode CC1100 supports three different types of packet-filtering; address filtering, maximum length filtering, and CRC filtering. 15.3.1 Address Filtering Setting PKTCTRL1.ADR_CHK to any other value than zero enables the packet address filter. The packet handler engine will compare the destination address byte in the packet with the programmed node address in the ADDR register and the 0x00 broadcast address when PKTCTRL1.ADR_CHK=10 or both 0x00 and 0xFF broadcast addresses when PKTCTRL1.ADR_CHK=11. If the received address matches a valid address, the packet is received and written into the RX FIFO. If the address match fails, the packet is discarded and receive mode restarted (regardless of the MCSM1.RXOFF_MODE setting). If the received address matches a valid address when using infinite packet length mode and address filtering is enabled, 0xFF will be written into the RX FIFO followed by the address byte and then the payload data. 15.3.2 Maximum Length Filtering In variable packet length mode, PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=1, the PKTLEN.PACKET_LENGTH register value is used to set the maximum allowed packet length. If the received length byte has a larger value than this, the packet is discarded and receive mode restarted (regardless of the MCSM1.RXOFF_MODE setting). 15.3.3 CRC Filtering The filtering of a packet when CRC check fails is enabled by setting PKTCTRL1.CRC_AUTOFLUSH=1. The CRC auto flush function will flush the entire RX FIFO if the CRC check fails. After auto flushing the RX FIFO, the next state depends on the MCSM1.RXOFF_MODE setting. When using the auto flush function, the maximum packet length is 63 bytes in variable packet length mode and 64 bytes in fixed packet length mode. Note that the maximum allowed packet length is reduced by two bytes when PKTCTRL1.APPEND_STATUS is enabled, to make room in the RX FIFO for the two status bytes appended at the end of the packet. Since the entire RX FIFO is flushed when the CRC check fails, the previously received packet must be read out of the FIFO before receiving the current packet. The MCU must not read from the current packet until the CRC has been checked as OK. 15.4 Packet Handling in Transmit Mode The payload that is to be transmitted must be written into the TX FIFO. The first byte written must be the length byte when variable packet length is enabled. The length byte has a value equal to the payload of the packet (including the optional address byte). If address recognition is enabled on the receiver, the second byte written to the TX FIFO must be the address byte. If fixed packet length is enabled, then the first byte written to the TX FIFO should be the address (if the receiver uses address recognition). The modulator will first send the programmed number of preamble bytes. If data is available in the TX FIFO, the modulator will send the two-byte (optionally 4-byte) sync word and then the payload in the TX FIFO. If CRC is enabled, the checksum is calculated over all the data pulled from the TX FIFO and the result is sent as two extra bytes following the payload data. If the TX FIFO runs empty before the complete packet has been CC1100 SWRS038D Page 35 of 92 transmitted, the radio will enter TXFIFO_UNDERFLOW state. The only way to exit this state is by issuing an SFTX strobe. Writing to the TX FIFO after it has underflowed will not restart TX mode. If whitening is enabled, everything following the sync words will be whitened. This is done before the optional FEC/Interleaver stage. Whitening is enabled by setting PKTCTRL0.WHITE_DATA=1. If FEC/Interleaving is enabled, everything following the sync words will be scrambled by the interleaver and FEC encoded before being modulated. FEC is enabled by setting MDMCFG1.FEC_EN=1. 15.5 Packet Handling in Receive Mode In receive mode, the demodulator and packet handler will search for a valid preamble and the sync word. When found, the demodulator has obtained both bit and byte synchronism and will receive the first payload byte. If FEC/Interleaving is enabled, the FEC decoder will start to decode the first payload byte. The interleaver will de-scramble the bits before any other processing is done to the data. If whitening is enabled, the data will be dewhitened at this stage. When variable packet length mode is enabled, the first byte is the length byte. The packet handler stores this value as the packet length and receives the number of bytes indicated by the length byte. If fixed packet length mode is used, the packet handler will accept the programmed number of bytes. Next, the packet handler optionally checks the address and only continues the reception if the address matches. If automatic CRC check is enabled, the packet handler computes CRC and matches it with the appended CRC checksum. At the end of the payload, the packet handler will optionally write two extra packet status bytes (see Table 21 and Table 22) that contain CRC status, link quality indication, and RSSI value. 15.6 Packet Handling in Firmware When implementing a packet oriented radio protocol in firmware, the MCU needs to know when a packet has been received/transmitted. Additionally, for packets longer than 64 bytes the RX FIFO needs to be read while in RX and the TX FIFO needs to be refilled while in TX. This means that the MCU needs to know the number of bytes that can be read from or written to the RX FIFO and TX FIFO respectively. There are two possible solutions to get the necessary status information: a) Interrupt Driven Solution In both RX and TX one can use one of the GDO pins to give an interrupt when a sync word has been received/transmitted and/or when a complete packet has been received/transmitted (IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG=0x06). In addition, there are 2 configurations for the IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG register that are associated with the RX FIFO (IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG=0x00 and IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG=0x01) and two that are associated with the TX FIFO (IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG=0x02 and IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG=0x03) that can be used as interrupt sources to provide information on how many bytes are in the RX FIFO and TX FIFO respectively. See Table 34. b) SPI Polling The PKTSTATUS register can be polled at a given rate to get information about the current GDO2 and GDO0 values respectively. The RXBYTES and TXBYTES registers can be polled at a given rate to get information about the number of bytes in the RX FIFO and TX FIFO respectively. Alternatively, the number of bytes in the RX FIFO and TX FIFO can be read from the chip status byte returned on the MISO line each time a header byte, data byte, or command strobe is sent on the SPI bus. It is recommended to employ an interrupt driven solution as high rate SPI polling will reduce the RX sensitivity. Furthermore, as explained in Section 10.3 and the CC1100 Errata Notes [1], when using SPI polling there is a small, but finite, probability that a single read from registers PKTSTATUS , RXBYTES and TXBYTES is being corrupt. The same is the case when reading the chip status byte. Refer to the TI website for SW examples ([8] and [9]). CC1100 SWRS038D Page 36 of 92 16 Modulation Formats CC1100 supports amplitude, frequency, and phase shift modulation formats. The desired modulation format is set in the MDMCFG2.MOD_FORMAT register. Optionally, the data stream can be Manchester coded by the modulator and decoded by the demodulator. This option is enabled by setting MDMCFG2.MANCHESTER_EN=1. Manchester encoding is not supported at the same time as using the FEC/Interleaver option. 16.1 Frequency Shift Keying 2-FSK can optionally be shaped by a Gaussian filter with BT = 1, producing a GFSK modulated signal. The frequency deviation is programmed with the DEVIATION_M and DEVIATION_E values in the DEVIATN register. The value has an exponent/mantissa form, and the resultant deviation is given by: xosc DEVIATION E dev f f DEVIATION M _ 17 (8 _ ) 2 2 = ⋅ + ⋅ The symbol encoding is shown in Table 23. Format Symbol Coding 2-FSK/GFSK ‘0’ – Deviation ‘1’ + Deviation Table 23: Symbol Encoding for 2-FSK/GFSK Modulation 16.2 Minimum Shift Keying When using MSK1, the complete transmission (preamble, sync word, and payload) will be MSK modulated. Phase shifts are performed with a constant transition time. The fraction of a symbol period used to change the phase can be modified with the DEVIATN.DEVIATION_M setting. This is equivalent to changing the shaping of the symbol. The MSK modulation format implemented in CC1100 inverts the sync word and data compared to e.g. signal generators. 16.3 Amplitude Modulation CC1100 supports two different forms of amplitude modulation: On-Off Keying (OOK) and Amplitude Shift Keying (ASK). OOK modulation simply turns on or off the PA to modulate 1 and 0 respectively. The ASK variant supported by the CC1100 allows programming of the modulation depth (the difference between 1 and 0), and shaping of the pulse amplitude. Pulse shaping will produce a more bandwidth constrained output spectrum. Note that the pulse shaping feature on the CC1100 does only support output power up to about -1dBm. The PATABLE settings that can be used for pulse shaping are 0x00 and 0x30 to 0x3F. 1 Identical to offset QPSK with half-sine shaping (data coding may differ) CC1100 SWRS038D Page 37 of 92 17 Received Signal Qualifiers and Link Quality Information CC1100 has several qualifiers that can be used to increase the likelihood that a valid sync word is detected. 17.1 Sync Word Qualifier If sync word detection in RX is enabled in register MDMCFG2 the CC1100 will not start filling the RX FIFO and perform the packet filtering described in Section 15.3 before a valid sync word has been detected. The sync word qualifier mode is set by MDMCFG2.SYNC_MODE and is summarized in Table 24. Carrier sense is described in Section 17.4. MDMCFG2. SYNC_MODE Sync Word Qualifier Mode 000 No preamble/sync 001 15/16 sync word bits detected 010 16/16 sync word bits detected 011 30/32 sync word bits detected 100 No preamble/sync, carrier sense above threshold 101 15/16 + carrier sense above threshold 110 16/16 + carrier sense above threshold 111 30/32 + carrier sense above threshold Table 24: Sync Word Qualifier Mode 17.2 Preamble Quality Threshold (PQT) The Preamble Quality Threshold (PQT) syncword qualifier adds the requirement that the received sync word must be preceded with a preamble with a quality above the programmed threshold. Another use of the preamble quality threshold is as a qualifier for the optional RX termination timer. See Section 19.7 on page 46 for details. The preamble quality estimator increases an internal counter by one each time a bit is received that is different from the previous bit, and decreases the counter by 8 each time a bit is received that is the same as the last bit. The threshold is configured with the register field PKTCTRL1.PQT. A threshold of 4·PQT for this counter is used to gate sync word detection. By setting the value to zero, the preamble quality qualifier of the synch word is disabled. A “Preamble Quality Reached” signal can be observed on one of the GDO pins by setting IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG=8. It is also possible to determine if preamble quality is reached by checking the PQT_REACHED bit in the PKTSTATUS register. This signal / bit asserts when the received signal exceeds the PQT. 17.3 RSSI The RSSI value is an estimate of the signal power level in the chosen channel. This value is based on the current gain setting in the RX chain and the measured signal level in the channel. In RX mode, the RSSI value can be read continuously from the RSSI status register until the demodulator detects a sync word (when sync word detection is enabled). At that point the RSSI readout value is frozen until the next time the chip enters the RX state. The RSSI value is in dBm with ½dB resolution. The RSSI update rate, fRSSI, depends on the receiver filter bandwidth (BWchannel defined in Section 13) and AGCCTRL0.FILTER_LENGTH. FILTER LENGTH channel RSSI f BW8 2 _ 2 ⋅ = ⋅ If PKTCTRL1.APPEND_STATUS is enabled the last RSSI value of the packet is automatically added to the first byte appended after the payload. The RSSI value read from the RSSI status register is a 2’s complement number. The following procedure can be used to convert the RSSI reading to an absolute power level (RSSI_dBm). 1) Read the RSSI status register 2) Convert the reading from a hexadecimal number to a decimal number (RSSI_dec) 3) If RSSI_dec ≥ 128 then RSSI_dBm = (RSSI_dec - 256)/2 – RSSI_offset 4) Else if RSSI_dec < 128 then RSSI_dBm = (RSSI_dec)/2 – RSSI_offset Table 25 gives typical values for the RSSI_offset. Figure 13 and Figure 14 shows typical plots of RSSI reading as a function of input power level for different data rates. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 38 of 92 Data rate [kBaud] RSSI_offset [dB], 433 MHz RSSI_offset [dB], 868 MHz 1.2 75 74 38.4 75 74 250 79 78 500 79 77 Table 25: Typical RSSI_offset Values Figure 13: Typical RSSI Value vs. Input Power Level for Different Data Rates at 433 MHz Figure 14: Typical RSSI Value vs. Input Power Level for Different Data Rates at 868 MHz -120 -110 -100 -90 -80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 -120 -110 -100 -90 -80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 Input Power [dBm] 1.2 kBuad 38.4 kBaud 250 kBaud 500 kBaud RSSI Readout [dBm] -120 -110 -100 -90 -80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 -120 -110 -100 -90 -80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 Input Power [dBm] RSSI Readout [ dBm] 1.2 kBaud 38.4 kBuad 250 kBaud 500 kBaud CC1100 SWRS038D Page 39 of 92 17.4 Carrier Sense (CS) Carrier Sense (CS) is used as a sync word qualifier and for CCA and can be asserted based on two conditions, which can be individually adjusted: • CS is asserted when the RSSI is above a programmable absolute threshold, and deasserted when RSSI is below the same threshold (with hysteresis). • CS is asserted when the RSSI has increased with a programmable number of dB from one RSSI sample to the next, and de-asserted when RSSI has decreased with the same number of dB. This setting is not dependent on the absolute signal level and is thus useful to detect signals in environments with time varying noise floor. Carrier Sense can be used as a sync word qualifier that requires the signal level to be higher than the threshold for a sync word search to be performed. The signal can also be observed on one of the GDO pins by setting IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG=14 and in the status register bit PKTSTATUS.CS. Other uses of Carrier Sense include the TX-if- CCA function (see Section 17.5 on page 40) and the optional fast RX termination (see Section 19.7 on page 46). CS can be used to avoid interference from other RF sources in the ISM bands. 17.4.1 CS Absolute Threshold The absolute threshold related to the RSSI value depends on the following register fields: • AGCCTRL2.MAX_LNA_GAIN • AGCCTRL2.MAX_DVGA_GAIN • AGCCTRL1.CARRIER_SENSE_ABS_THR • AGCCTRL2.MAGN_TARGET • For a given AGCCTRL2.MAX_LNA_GAIN and AGCCTRL2.MAX_DVGA_GAIN setting the absolute threshold can be adjusted ±7 dB in steps of 1 dB using CARRIER_SENSE_ABS_THR. The MAGN_TARGET setting is a compromise between blocker tolerance/selectivity and sensitivity. The value sets the desired signal level in the channel into the demodulator. Increasing this value reduces the headroom for blockers, and therefore close-in selectivity. It is strongly recommended to use SmartRF® Studio to generate the correct MAGN_TARGET setting. Table 26 and Table 27 show the typical RSSI readout values at the CS threshold at 2.4 kBaud and 250 kBaud data rate respectively. The default CARRIER_SENSE_ABS_THR=0 (0 dB) and MAGN_TARGET=3 (33 dB) have been used. For other data rates the user must generate similar tables to find the CS absolute threshold. MAX_DVGA_GAIN[1:0] 00 01 10 11 000 -97.5 -91.5 -85.5 -79.5 001 -94 -88 -82.5 -76 010 -90.5 -84.5 -78.5 -72.5 011 -88 -82.5 -76.5 -70.5 100 -85.5 -80 -73.5 -68 101 -84 -78 -72 -66 110 -82 -76 -70 -64 MAX_LNA_GAIN[2:0] 111 -79 -73.5 -67 -61 Table 26: Typical RSSI Value in dBm at CS Threshold with Default MAGN_TARGET at 2.4 kBaud, 868 MHz MAX_DVGA_GAIN[1:0] 00 01 10 11 000 -90.5 -84.5 -78.5 -72.5 001 -88 -82 -76 -70 010 -84.5 -78.5 -72 -66 011 -82.5 -76.5 -70 -64 100 -80.5 -74.5 -68 -62 101 -78 -72 -66 -60 110 -76.5 -70 -64 -58 MAX_LNA_GAIN[2:0] 111 -74.5 -68 -62 -56 Table 27: Typical RSSI Value in dBm at CS Threshold with Default MAGN_TARGET at 250 kBaud, 868 MHz If the threshold is set high, i.e. only strong signals are wanted, the threshold should be adjusted upwards by first reducing the MAX_LNA_GAIN value and then the MAX_DVGA_GAIN value. This will reduce power consumption in the receiver front end, since the highest gain settings are avoided. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 40 of 92 17.4.2 CS Relative Threshold The relative threshold detects sudden changes in the measured signal level. This setting is not dependent on the absolute signal level and is thus useful to detect signals in environments with a time varying noise floor. The register field AGCCTRL1.CARRIER_SENSE_REL_THR is used to enable/disable relative CS, and to select threshold of 6 dB, 10 dB, or 14 dB RSSI change. 17.5 Clear Channel Assessment (CCA) The Clear Channel Assessment (CCA) is used to indicate if the current channel is free or busy. The current CCA state is viewable on any of the GDO pins by setting IOCFGx.GDOx_ CFG=0x09. MCSM1.CCA_MODE selects the mode to use when determining CCA. When the STX or SFSTXON command strobe is given while CC1100 is in the RX state, the TX or FSTXON state is only entered if the clear channel requirements are fulfilled. The chip will otherwise remain in RX (if the channel becomes available, the radio will not enter TX or FSTXON state before a new strobe command is sent on the SPI interface). This feature is called TX-if-CCA. Four CCA requirements can be programmed: • Always (CCA disabled, always goes to TX) • If RSSI is below threshold • Unless currently receiving a packet • Both the above (RSSI below threshold and not currently receiving a packet) 17.6 Link Quality Indicator (LQI) The Link Quality Indicator is a metric of the current quality of the received signal. If PKTCTRL1.APPEND_STATUS is enabled, the value is automatically added to the last byte appended after the payload. The value can also be read from the LQI status register. The LQI gives an estimate of how easily a received signal can be demodulated by accumulating the magnitude of the error between ideal constellations and the received signal over the 64 symbols immediately following the sync word. LQI is best used as a relative measurement of the link quality (a high value indicates a better link than what a low value does), since the value is dependent on the modulation format. 18 Forward Error Correction with Interleaving 18.1 Forward Error Correction (FEC) CC1100 has built in support for Forward Error Correction (FEC). To enable this option, set MDMCFG1.FEC_EN to 1. FEC is only supported in fixed packet length mode (PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=0). FEC is employed on the data field and CRC word in order to reduce the gross bit error rate when operating near the sensitivity limit. Redundancy is added to the transmitted data in such a way that the receiver can restore the original data in the presence of some bit errors. The use of FEC allows correct reception at a lower SNR, thus extending communication range if the receiver bandwidth remains constant. Alternatively, for a given SNR, using FEC decreases the bit error rate (BER). As the packet error rate (PER) is related to BER by: PER = 1− (1− BER) packet _ length a lower BER can be used to allow longer packets, or a higher percentage of packets of a given length, to be transmitted successfully. Finally, in realistic ISM radio environments, transient and time-varying phenomena will produce occasional errors even in otherwise good reception conditions. FEC will mask such errors and, combined with interleaving of the coded data, even correct relatively long periods of faulty reception (burst errors). The FEC scheme adopted for CC1100 is convolutional coding, in which n bits are generated based on k input bits and the m most recent input bits, forming a code stream able to withstand a certain number of bit errors between each coding state (the m-bit window). The convolutional coder is a rate 1/2 code with a constraint length of m = 4. The coder codes one input bit and produces two output bits; hence, the effective data rate is halved. I.e. to transmit at the same effective datarate when using FEC, it is necessary to use twice as high over-the-air datarate. This will require a higher receiver bandwidth, and thus reduce sensitivity. In other words the improved CC1100 SWRS038D Page 41 of 92 reception by using FEC and the degraded sensitivity from a higher receiver bandwidth will be counteracting factors. 18.2 Interleaving Data received through radio channels will often experience burst errors due to interference and time-varying signal strengths. In order to increase the robustness to errors spanning multiple bits, interleaving is used when FEC is enabled. After de-interleaving, a continuous span of errors in the received stream will become single errors spread apart. CC1100 employs matrix interleaving, which is illustrated in Figure 15. The on-chip interleaving and de-interleaving buffers are 4 x 4 matrices. In the transmitter, the data bits from the rate ½ convolutional coder are written into the rows of the matrix, whereas the bit sequence to be transmitted is read from the columns of the matrix. Conversely, in the receiver, the received symbols are written into the columns of the matrix, whereas the data passed onto the convolutional decoder is read from the rows of the matrix. When FEC and interleaving is used at least one extra byte is required for trellis termination. In addition, the amount of data transmitted over the air must be a multiple of the size of the interleaver buffer (two bytes). The packet control hardware therefore automatically inserts one or two extra bytes at the end of the packet, so that the total length of the data to be interleaved is an even number. Note that these extra bytes are invisible to the user, as they are removed before the received packet enters the RX FIFO. When FEC and interleaving is used the minimum data payload is 2 bytes. Packet Engine FEC Encoder Modulator Interleaver Write buffer Interleaver Read buffer Demodulator FEC Decoder Packet Engine Interleaver Write buffer Interleaver Read buffer Figure 15: General Principle of Matrix Interleaving CC1100 SWRS038D Page 42 of 92 19 Radio Control TX 19,20 RX 13,14,15 IDLE 1 CALIBRATE 8 MANCAL 3,4,5 SETTLING 9,10,11 RX_OVERFLOW 17 TX_UNDERFLOW 22 RXTX_SETTLING 21 FSTXON 18 SFSTXON FS_AUTOCAL = 00 | 10 | 11 & SRX | STX | SFSTXON | WOR STX SRX | WOR STX TXFIFO_UNDERFLOW STX | RXOFF_MODE = 10 RXOFF_MODE = 00 & FS_AUTOCAL = 10 | 11 SFTX SRX | TXOFF_MODE = 11 SIDLE SCAL CAL_COMPLETE FS_AUTOCAL = 01 & SRX | STX | SFSTXON | WOR RXFIFO_OVERFLOW CAL_COMPLETE SFRX CALIBRATE 12 IDLE 1 TXOFF_MODE = 00 & FS_AUTOCAL = 10 | 11 RXOFF_MODE = 00 & FS_AUTOCAL = 00 | 01 TXOFF_MODE = 00 & FS_AUTOCAL = 00 | 01 TXOFF_MODE = 10 RXOFF_MODE = 11 SFSTXON | RXOFF_MODE = 01 TXRX_SETTLING 16 SRX | STX | SFSTXON | WOR SLEEP 0 SPWD | SWOR XOFF 2 SXOFF CSn = 0 CSn = 0 | WOR ( STX | SFSTXON ) & CCA | RXOFF_MODE = 01 | 10 TXOFF_MODE=01 FS_WAKEUP 6,7 SRX Figure 16: Complete Radio Control State Diagram CC1100 has a built-in state machine that is used to switch between different operational states (modes). The change of state is done either by using command strobes or by internal events such as TX FIFO underflow. A simplified state diagram, together with typical usage and current consumption, is shown in Figure 5 on page 23. The complete radio control state diagram is shown in Figure 16. The numbers refer to the state number readable in the MARCSTATE status register. This register is primarily for test purposes. 19.1 Power-On Start-Up Sequence When the power supply is turned on, the system must be reset. This is achieved by one of the two sequences described below, i.e. automatic power-on reset (POR) or manual reset. After the automatic power-on reset or manual reset it is also recommended to change the signal that is output on the GDO0 pin. The default setting is to output a clock signal with a frequency of CLK_XOSC/192, but to optimize CC1100 SWRS038D Page 43 of 92 performance in TX and RX an alternative GDO setting should be selected from the settings found in Table 34 on page 56. 19.1.1 Automatic POR A power-on reset circuit is included in the CC1100. The minimum requirements stated in Table 12 must be followed for the power-on reset to function properly. The internal powerup sequence is completed when CHIP_RDYn goes low. CHIP_RDYn is observed on the SO pin after CSn is pulled low. See Section 10.1 for more details on CHIP_RDYn. When the CC1100 reset is completed the chip will be in the IDLE state and the crystal oscillator will be running. If the chip has had sufficient time for the crystal oscillator to stabilize after the power-on-reset the SO pin will go low immediately after taking CSn low. If CSn is taken low before reset is completed the SO pin will first go high, indicating that the crystal oscillator is not stabilized, before going low as shown in Figure 17. Figure 17: Power-On Reset 19.1.2 Manual Reset The other global reset possibility on CC1100 uses the SRES command strobe. By issuing this strobe, all internal registers and states are set to the default, IDLE state. The manual power-up sequence is as follows (see Figure 18): • Set SCLK = 1 and SI = 0, to avoid potential problems with pin control mode (see Section 11.3 on page 29). • Strobe CSn low / high. • Hold CSn high for at least 40μs relative to pulling CSn low • Pull CSn low and wait for SO to go low (CHIP_RDYn). • Issue the SRES strobe on the SI line. • When SO goes low again, reset is complete and the chip is in the IDLE state. CSn SO XOSC Stable XOSC and voltage regulator switched on SI SRES 40 us Figure 18: Power-On Reset with SRES Note that the above reset procedure is only required just after the power supply is first turned on. If the user wants to reset the CC1100 after this, it is only necessary to issue an SRES command strobe. 19.2 Crystal Control The crystal oscillator (XOSC) is either automatically controlled or always on, if MCSM0.XOSC_FORCE_ON is set. In the automatic mode, the XOSC will be turned off if the SXOFF or SPWD command strobes are issued; the state machine then goes to XOFF or SLEEP respectively. This can only be done from the IDLE state. The XOSC will be turned off when CSn is released (goes high). The XOSC will be automatically turned on again when CSn goes low. The state machine will then go to the IDLE state. The SO pin on the SPI interface must be pulled low before the SPI interface is ready to be used; as described in Section 10.1 on page 26. If the XOSC is forced on, the crystal will always stay on even in the SLEEP state. Crystal oscillator start-up time depends on crystal ESR and load capacitances. The electrical specification for the crystal oscillator can be found in Section 4.4 on page 14. 19.3 Voltage Regulator Control The voltage regulator to the digital core is controlled by the radio controller. When the chip enters the SLEEP state, which is the state with the lowest current consumption, the voltage regulator is disabled. This occurs after CSn is released when a SPWD command strobe has been sent on the SPI interface. The chip is now in the SLEEP state. Setting CSn CC1100 SWRS038D Page 44 of 92 low again will turn on the regulator and crystal oscillator and make the chip enter the IDLE state. When wake on radio is enabled, the WOR module will control the voltage regulator as described in Section 19.5. 19.4 Active Modes CC1100 has two active modes: receive and transmit. These modes are activated directly by the MCU by using the SRX and STX command strobes, or automatically by Wake on Radio. The frequency synthesizer must be calibrated regularly. CC1100 has one manual calibration option (using the SCAL strobe), and three automatic calibration options, controlled by the MCSM0.FS_AUTOCAL setting: • Calibrate when going from IDLE to either RX or TX (or FSTXON) • Calibrate when going from either RX or TX to IDLE automatically • Calibrate every fourth time when going from either RX or TX to IDLE automatically If the radio goes from TX or RX to IDLE by issuing an SIDLE strobe, calibration will not be performed. The calibration takes a constant number of XOSC cycles (see Table 28 for timing details). When RX is activated, the chip will remain in receive mode until a packet is successfully received or the RX termination timer expires (see Section 19.7). Note: the probability that a false sync word is detected can be reduced by using PQT, CS, maximum sync word length, and sync word qualifier mode as described in Section 17. After a packet is successfully received the radio controller will then go to the state indicated by the MCSM1.RXOFF_MODE setting. The possible destinations are: • IDLE • FSTXON: Frequency synthesizer on and ready at the TX frequency. Activate TX with STX . • TX: Start sending preamble • RX: Start search for a new packet Similarly, when TX is active the chip will remain in the TX state until the current packet has been successfully transmitted. Then the state will change as indicated by the MCSM1.TXOFF_MODE setting. The possible destinations are the same as for RX. The MCU can manually change the state from RX to TX and vice versa by using the command strobes. If the radio controller is currently in transmit and the SRX strobe is used, the current transmission will be ended and the transition to RX will be done. If the radio controller is in RX when the STX or SFSTXON command strobes are used, the TXif- CCA function will be used. If the channel is not clear, the chip will remain in RX. The MCSM1.CCA_MODE setting controls the conditions for clear channel assessment. See Section 17.5 on page 40 for details. The SIDLE command strobe can always be used to force the radio controller to go to the IDLE state. 19.5 Wake On Radio (WOR) The optional Wake on Radio (WOR) functionality enables CC1100 to periodically wake up from SLEEP and listen for incoming packets without MCU interaction. When the WOR strobe command is sent on the SPI interface, the CC1100 will go to the SLEEP state when CSn is released. The RC oscillator must be enabled before the WOR strobe can be used, as it is the clock source for the WOR timer. The on-chip timer will set CC1100 into IDLE state and then RX state. After a programmable time in RX, the chip will go back to the SLEEP state, unless a packet is received. See Figure 19 and Section 19.7 for details on how the timeout works. Set the CC1100 into the IDLE state to exit WOR mode. CC1100 can be set up to signal the MCU that a packet has been received by using the GDO pins. If a packet is received, the MCSM1.RXOFF_MODE will determine the behaviour at the end of the received packet. When the MCU has read the packet, it can put the chip back into SLEEP with the SWOR strobe from the IDLE state. The FIFO will loose its contents in the SLEEP state. The WOR timer has two events, Event 0 and Event 1. In the SLEEP state with WOR activated, reaching Event 0 will turn on the digital regulator and start the crystal oscillator. Event 1 follows Event 0 after a programmed timeout. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 45 of 92 The time between two consecutive Event 0 is programmed with a mantissa value given by WOREVT1.EVENT0 and WOREVT0.EVENT0, and an exponent value set by WORCTRL.WOR_RES. The equation is: WOR RES XOSC Event EVENT f t 5 _ 0 = 750 ⋅ 0 ⋅ 2 ⋅ The Event 1 timeout is programmed with WORCTRL.EVENT1. Figure 19 shows the timing relationship between Event 0 timeout and Event 1 timeout. Figure 19: Event 0 and Event 1 Relationship The time from the CC1100 enters SLEEP state until the next Event0 is programmed to appear (tSLEEP in Figure 19) should be larger than 11.08 ms when using a 26 MHz crystal and 10.67 ms when a 27 MHz crystal is used. If tSLEEP is less than 11.08 (10.67) ms there is a chance that the consecutive Event 0 will occur 750 ⋅128 XOSC f seconds too early. Application Note AN047 [4] explains in detail the theory of operation and the different registers involved when using WOR, as well as highlighting important aspects when using WOR mode. 19.5.1 RC Oscillator and Timing The frequency of the low-power RC oscillator used for the WOR functionality varies with temperature and supply voltage. In order to keep the frequency as accurate as possible, the RC oscillator will be calibrated whenever possible, which is when the XOSC is running and the chip is not in the SLEEP state. When the power and XOSC is enabled, the clock used by the WOR timer is a divided XOSC clock. When the chip goes to the sleep state, the RC oscillator will use the last valid calibration result. The frequency of the RC oscillator is locked to the main crystal frequency divided by 750. In applications where the radio wakes up very often, typically several times every second, it is possible to do the RC oscillator calibration once and then turn off calibration (WORCTRL.RC_CAL=0) to reduce the current consumption. This requires that RC oscillator calibration values are read from registers RCCTRL0_STATUS and RCCTRL1_STATUS and written back to RCCTRL0 and RCCTRL1 respectively. If the RC oscillator calibration is turned off it will have to be manually turned on again if temperature and supply voltage changes. Refer to Application Note AN047 [4] for further details. 19.6 Timing The radio controller controls most of the timing in CC1100, such as synthesizer calibration, PLL lock time, and RX/TX turnaround times. Timing from IDLE to RX and IDLE to TX is constant, dependent on the auto calibration setting. RX/TX and TX/RX turnaround times are constant. The calibration time is constant 18739 clock periods. Table 28 shows timing in crystal clock cycles for key state transitions. Power on time and XOSC start-up times are variable, but within the limits stated in Table 7. Note that in a frequency hopping spread spectrum or a multi-channel protocol the calibration time can be reduced from 721 μs to approximately 150 μs. This is explained in Section 32.2. Description XOSC Periods 26 MHz Crystal IDLE to RX, no calibration 2298 88.4μs IDLE to RX, with calibration ~21037 809μs IDLE to TX/FSTXON, no calibration 2298 88.4μs IDLE to TX/FSTXON, with calibration ~21037 809μs TX to RX switch 560 21.5μs RX to TX switch 250 9.6μs RX or TX to IDLE, no calibration 2 0.1μs RX or TX to IDLE, with calibration ~18739 721μs Manual calibration ~18739 721μs Table 28: State Transition Timing CC1100 SWRS038D Page 46 of 92 19.7 RX Termination Timer CC1100 has optional functions for automatic termination of RX after a programmable time. The main use for this functionality is wake-onradio (WOR), but it may be useful for other applications. The termination timer starts when in RX state. The timeout is programmable with the MCSM2.RX_TIME setting. When the timer expires, the radio controller will check the condition for staying in RX; if the condition is not met, RX will terminate. The programmable conditions are: • MCSM2.RX_TIME_QUAL=0: Continue receive if sync word has been found • MCSM2.RX_TIME_QUAL=1: Continue receive if sync word has been found or preamble quality is above threshold (PQT) If the system can expect the transmission to have started when enabling the receiver, the MCSM2.RX_TIME_RSSI function can be used. The radio controller will then terminate RX if the first valid carrier sense sample indicates no carrier (RSSI below threshold). See Section 17.4 on page 39 for details on Carrier Sense. For ASK/OOK modulation, lack of carrier sense is only considered valid after eight symbol periods. Thus, the MCSM2.RX_TIME_RSSI function can be used in ASK/OOK mode when the distance between “1” symbols is 8 or less. If RX terminates due to no carrier sense when the MCSM2.RX_TIME_RSSI function is used, or if no sync word was found when using the MCSM2.RX_TIME timeout function, the chip will always go back to IDLE if WOR is disabled and back to SLEEP if WOR is enabled. Otherwise, the MCSM1.RXOFF_MODE setting determines the state to go to when RX ends. This means that the chip will not automatically go back to SLEEP once a sync word has been received. It is therefore recommended to always wake up the microcontroller on sync word detection when using WOR mode. This can be done by selecting output signal 6 (see Table 34 on page 56) on one of the programmable GDO output pins, and programming the microcontroller to wake up on an edge-triggered interrupt from this GDO pin. 20 Data FIFO The CC1100 contains two 64 byte FIFOs, one for received data and one for data to be transmitted. The SPI interface is used to read from the RX FIFO and write to the TX FIFO. Section 10.5 contains details on the SPI FIFO access. The FIFO controller will detect overflow in the RX FIFO and underflow in the TX FIFO. When writing to the TX FIFO it is the responsibility of the MCU to avoid TX FIFO overflow. A TX FIFO overflow will result in an error in the TX FIFO content. Likewise, when reading the RX FIFO the MCU must avoid reading the RX FIFO past its empty value, since an RX FIFO underflow will result in an error in the data read out of the RX FIFO. The chip status byte that is available on the SO pin while transferring the SPI header contains the fill grade of the RX FIFO if the access is a read operation and the fill grade of the TX FIFO if the access is a write operation. Section 10.1 on page 26 contains more details on this. The number of bytes in the RX FIFO and TX FIFO can be read from the status registers RXBYTES.NUM_RXBYTES and TXBYTES.NUM_TXBYTES respectively. If a received data byte is written to the RX FIFO at the exact same time as the last byte in the RX FIFO is read over the SPI interface, the RX FIFO pointer is not properly updated and the last read byte is duplicated. To avoid this problem one should never empty the RX FIFO before the last byte of the packet is received. For packet lengths less than 64 bytes it is recommended to wait until the complete packet has been received before reading it out of the RX FIFO. If the packet length is larger than 64 bytes the MCU must determine how many bytes can be read from the RX FIFO (RXBYTES.NUM_RXBYTES-1) and the following software routine can be used: 1. Read RXBYTES.NUM_RXBYTES repeatedly at a rate guaranteed to be at least twice that of which RF bytes are received until the same value is returned twice; store value in n. 2. If n < # of bytes remaining in packet, read n-1 bytes from the RX FIFO. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 47 of 92 3. Repeat steps 1 and 2 until n = # of bytes remaining in packet. 4. Read the remaining bytes from the RX FIFO. The 4-bit FIFOTHR.FIFO_THR setting is used to program threshold points in the FIFOs. Table 29 lists the 16 FIFO_THR settings and the corresponding thresholds for the RX and TX FIFOs. The threshold value is coded in opposite directions for the RX FIFO and TX FIFO. This gives equal margin to the overflow and underflow conditions when the threshold is reached. A signal will assert when the number of bytes in the FIFO is equal to or higher than the programmed threshold. This signal can be viewed on the GDO pins (see Table 34 on page 56). Figure 21 shows the number of bytes in both the RX FIFO and TX FIFO when the threshold signal toggles, in the case of FIFO_THR=13. Figure 20 shows the signal as the respective FIFO is filled above the threshold, and then drained below. 53 54 55 56 57 56 55 54 53 6 7 8 9 10 9 8 7 6 NUM_RXBYTES GDO NUM_TXBYTES GDO Figure 20: FIFO_THR=13 vs. Number of Bytes in FIFO (GDOx_CFG=0x00 in RX and GDOx_CFG=0x02 in TX) FIFO_THR Bytes in TX FIFO Bytes in RX FIFO 0 (0000) 61 4 1 (0001) 57 8 2 (0010) 53 12 3 (0011) 49 16 4 (0100) 45 20 5 (0101) 41 24 6 (0110) 37 28 7 (0111) 33 32 8 (1000) 29 36 9 (1001) 25 40 10 (1010) 21 44 11 (1011) 17 48 12 (1100) 13 52 13 (1101) 9 56 14 (1110) 5 60 15 (1111) 1 64 Table 29: FIFO_THR Settings and the Corresponding FIFO Thresholds 56 bytes 8 bytes Overflow margin Underflow margin FIFO_TH R=13 FIFO_THR=13 RXFIFO TXFIFO Figure 21: Example of FIFOs at Threshold CC1100 SWRS038D Page 48 of 92 21 Frequency Programming The frequency programming in CC1100 is designed to minimize the programming needed in a channel-oriented system. To set up a system with channel numbers, the desired channel spacing is programmed with the MDMCFG0.CHANSPC_M and MDMCFG1.CHANSPC_E registers. The channel spacing registers are mantissa and exponent respectively. The base or start frequency is set by the 24 bit frequency word located in the FREQ2, FREQ1, and FREQ0 registers. This word will typically be set to the centre of the lowest channel frequency that is to be used. The desired channel number is programmed with the 8-bit channel number register, CHANNR.CHAN, which is multiplied by the channel offset. The resultant carrier frequency is given by: ( (( ) _ 2 )) 16 256 _ 2 2 = XOSC ⋅ + ⋅ + ⋅ CHANSPC E− carrier f f FREQ CHAN CHANSPC M With a 26 MHz crystal the maximum channel spacing is 405 kHz. To get e.g. 1 MHz channel spacing one solution is to use 333 kHz channel spacing and select each third channel in CHANNR.CHAN. The preferred IF frequency is programmed with the FSCTRL1.FREQ_IF register. The IF frequency is given by: f fXOSC FREQ IF IF _ 210 = ⋅ Note that the SmartRF® Studio software [7] automatically calculates the optimum FSCTRL1.FREQ_IF register setting based on channel spacing and channel filter bandwidth. If any frequency programming register is altered when the frequency synthesizer is running, the synthesizer may give an undesired response. Hence, the frequency programming should only be updated when the radio is in the IDLE state. 22 VCO The VCO is completely integrated on-chip. 22.1 VCO and PLL Self-Calibration The VCO characteristics will vary with temperature and supply voltage changes, as well as the desired operating frequency. In order to ensure reliable operation, CC1100 includes frequency synthesizer self-calibration circuitry. This calibration should be done regularly, and must be performed after turning on power and before using a new frequency (or channel). The number of XOSC cycles for completing the PLL calibration is given in Table 28 on page 45. The calibration can be initiated automatically or manually. The synthesizer can be automatically calibrated each time the synthesizer is turned on, or each time the synthesizer is turned off automatically. This is configured with the MCSM0.FS_AUTOCAL register setting. In manual mode, the calibration is initiated when the SCAL command strobe is activated in the IDLE mode. Note that the calibration values are maintained in SLEEP mode, so the calibration is still valid after waking up from SLEEP mode (unless supply voltage or temperature has changed significantly). To check that the PLL is in lock the user can program register IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG to 0x0A and use the lock detector output available on the GDOx pin as an interrupt for the MCU (x = 0,1, or 2). A positive transition on the GDOx pin means that the PLL is in lock. As an alternative the user can read register FSCAL1. The PLL is in lock if the register content is different from 0x3F. Refer also to the CC1100 Errata Notes [1]. For more robust operation the source code could include a check so that the PLL is re-calibrated until PLL lock is achieved if the PLL does not lock the first time. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 49 of 92 23 Voltage Regulators CC1100 contains several on-chip linear voltage regulators, which generate the supply voltage needed by low-voltage modules. These voltage regulators are invisible to the user, and can be viewed as integral parts of the various modules. The user must however make sure that the absolute maximum ratings and required pin voltages in Table 1 and Table 13 are not exceeded. The voltage regulator for the digital core requires one external decoupling capacitor. Setting the CSn pin low turns on the voltage regulator to the digital core and starts the crystal oscillator. The SO pin on the SPI interface must go low before the first positive edge of SCLK. (setup time is given in Table 16). If the chip is programmed to enter power-down mode, (SPWD strobe issued), the power will be turned off after CSn goes high. The power and crystal oscillator will be turned on again when CSn goes low. The voltage regulator output should only be used for driving the CC1100. 24 Output Power Programming The RF output power level from the device has two levels of programmability, as illustrated in Figure 22. Firstly, the special PATABLE register can hold up to eight user selected output power settings. Secondly, the 3-bit FREND0.PA_POWER value selects the PATABLE entry to use. This two-level functionality provides flexible PA power ramp up and ramp down at the start and end of transmission, as well as ASK modulation shaping. All the PA power settings in the PATABLE from index 0 up to the FREND0.PA_POWER value are used. The power ramping at the start and at the end of a packet can be turned off by setting FREND0.PA_POWER to zero and then program the desired output power to index 0 in the PATABLE. If OOK modulation is used, the logic 0 and logic 1 power levels shall be programmed to index 0 and 1 respectively. Table 30 contains recommended PATABLE settings for various output levels and frequency bands. Using PA settings from 0x61 to 0x6F is not recommended. See Section 10.6 on page 28 for PATABLE programming details. Table 31 contains output power and current consumption for default PATABLE setting (0xC6). PATABLE must be programmed in burst mode if you want to write to other entries than PATABLE[0]. Note that all content of the PATABLE, except for the first byte (index 0) is lost when entering the SLEEP state. 315 MHz 433 MHz 868 MHz 915 MHz Output Power [dBm] Setting Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] Setting Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] Setting Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] Setting Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] -30 0x04 10.6 0x04 11.5 0x03 11.9 0x11 11.8 -20 0x17 11.1 0x17 12.1 0x0D 12.4 0x0D 12.3 -15 0x1D 11.8 0x1C 12.7 0x1C 13.0 0x1C 13.0 -10 0x26 13.0 0x26 14.0 0x34 14.5 0x26 14.3 -5 0x57 12.9 0x57 13.7 0x57 14.1 0x57 13.9 0 0x60 14.8 0x60 15.6 0x8E 16.9 0x8E 16.7 5 0x85 18.1 0x85 19.1 0x85 20.0 0x83 19.9 7 0xCB 22.1 0xC8 24.2 0xCC 25.8 0xC9 25.8 10 0xC2 27.1 0xC0 29.2 0xC3 31.1 0xC0 32.3 Table 30: Optimum PATABLE Settings for Various Output Power Levels and Frequency Bands CC1100 SWRS038D Page 50 of 92 315 MHz 433 MHz 868 MHz 915 MHz Default Power Setting Output Power [dBm] Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] Output Power [dBm] Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] Output Power [dBm] Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] Output Power [dBm] Current Consumption, Typ. [mA] 0xC6 8.7 24.5 7.9 25.2 8.9 28.3 7.9 26.8 Table 31: Output Power and Current Consumption for Default PATABLE Setting 25 Shaping and PA Ramping With ASK modulation, up to eight power settings are used for shaping. The modulator contains a counter that counts up when transmitting a one and down when transmitting a zero. The counter counts at a rate equal to 8 times the symbol rate. The counter saturates at FREND0.PA_POWER and 0 respectively. This counter value is used as an index for a lookup in the power table. Thus, in order to utilize the whole table, FREND0.PA_POWER should be 7 when ASK is active. The shaping of the ASK signal is dependent on the configuration of the PATABLE. Note that the ASK shaping feature is only supported for output power levels up to -1 dBm and only values in the range 0x30–0x3F, together with 0x00 can be used. The same is the case when implementing PA ramping for other modulations formats. Figure 23 shows some examples of ASK shaping. e.g 6 PA_POWER[2:0] in FREND0 register PATABLE(0)[7:0] PATABLE(1)[7:0] PATABLE(2)[7:0] PATABLE(3)[7:0] PATABLE(4)[7:0] PATABLE(5)[7:0] PATABLE(6)[7:0] PATABLE(7)[7:0] Index into PATABLE(7:0) The PA uses this setting. Settings 0 to PA_POWER are used during ramp-up at start of transmission and ramp-down at end of transmission, and for ASK/OOK modulation. The SmartRF® Studio software should be used to obtain optimum PATABLE settings for various output powers. Figure 22: PA_POWER and PATABLE 1 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 Bit Sequence FREND0.PA_POWER = 3 FREND0.PA_POWER = 7 Time PATABLE[0] PATABLE[1] PATABLE[2] PATABLE[3] PATABLE[4] PATABLE[5] PATABLE[6] PATABLE[7] Output Power Figure 23: Shaping of ASK Signal CC1100 SWRS038D Page 51 of 92 Output Power [dBm] PATABLE Setting 315 MHz 433 MHz 868 MHz 915 MHz 0x00 -62.0 -62.0 -57.1 -56.0 0x30 -41.7 -39.0 -33.6 -33.1 0x31 -21.8 -21.7 -21.2 -21.0 0x32 -16.2 -16.1 -16.0 -15.8 0x33 -12.8 -12.7 -12.7 -12.5 0x34 -10.5 -10.4 -10.5 -10.3 0x35 -8.6 -8.5 -8.7 -8.5 0x36 -7.2 -7.1 -7.4 -7.2 0x37 -5.9 -5.8 -6.2 -6.0 0x38 -4.8 -4.9 -5.3 -5.1 0x39 -3.9 -4.0 -4.5 -4.3 0x3A -3.2 -3.3 -3.8 -3.7 0x3B -2.5 -2.7 -3.3 -3.1 0x3C -2.1 -2.3 -2.8 -2.7 0x3D -1.7 -1.9 -2.5 -2.3 0x3E -1.3 -1.6 -2.1 -2.0 0x3F -1.1 -1.3 -1.9 -1.7 Table 32: PATABLE Settings used together with ASK Shaping and PA Ramping Assume working in the 433 MHz and using FSK. The desired output power is -10 dBm. Figure 24 shows how the PATABLE should look like in the two cases where no ramping is used (A) and when PA ramping is being implemented (B). In case A, the PATABLE value is taken from Table 30, while in case B, the values are taken from Table 32. PATABLE[7] = 0x00 PATABLE[6] = 0x00 PATABLE[5] = 0x00 PATABLE[4] = 0x00 PATABLE[3] = 0x00 PATABLE[2] = 0x00 PATABLE[1] = 0x00 PATABLE[0] = 0x26 FREND0.PA_POWER = 0 PATABLE[7] = 0x00 PATABLE[6] = 0x00 PATABLE[5] = 0x34 PATABLE[4] = 0x33 PATABLE[3] = 0x32 PATABLE[2] = 0x31 PATABLE[1] = 0x30 PATABLE[0] = 0x00 FREND0.PA_POWER = 5 A: Output Power = -10 dBm, No PA Ramping B: Output Power = -10 dBm, PA Ramping Figure 24: PA Ramping CC1100 SWRS038D Page 52 of 92 26 Selectivity Figure 25 to Figure 27 show the typical selectivity performance (adjacent and alternate rejection). -10.0 0.0 10.0 20.0 30.0 40.0 50.0 -0.5 -0.4 -0.3 -0.2 -0.1 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.4 0.5 Frequency offset [MHz] Selectivity [dB] Figure 25: Typical Selectivity at 1.2 kBaud Data Rate, 868 MHz, 2-FSK, 5.2 kHz Deviation. IF Frequency is 152.3 kHz and the Digital Channel Filter Bandwidth is 58 kHz -20.0 -10.0 0.0 10.0 20.0 30.0 40.0 -0.5 -0.4 -0.3 -0.2 -0.1 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.4 0.5 Frequency offset [MHz] Selectivity [dB] Figure 26: Typical Selectivity at 38.4 kBaud Data Rate, 868 MHz, 2-FSK, 20 kHz Deviation. IF Frequency is 152.3 kHz and the Digital Channel Filter Bandwidth is 100 kHz CC1100 SWRS038D Page 53 of 92 -20.0 -10.0 0.0 10.0 20.0 30.0 40.0 50.0 -2.3 1.5 -1.0 -0.8 0.0 0.8 1.0 1.5 2.3 Frequency offset [MHz] Selectivity [dB] Figure 27: Typical Selectivity at 250 kBaud Data Rate, 868 MHz, MSK, IF Frequency is 254 kHz and the Digital Channel Filter Bandwidth is 540 kHz 27 Crystal Oscillator A crystal in the frequency range 26-27 MHz must be connected between the XOSC_Q1 and XOSC_Q2 pins. The oscillator is designed for parallel mode operation of the crystal. In addition, loading capacitors (C81 and C101) for the crystal are required. The loading capacitor values depend on the total load capacitance, CL, specified for the crystal. The total load capacitance seen between the crystal terminals should equal CL for the crystal to oscillate at the specified frequency. L parasitic C C C C + + = 81 101 1 1 1 The parasitic capacitance is constituted by pin input capacitance and PCB stray capacitance. Total parasitic capacitance is typically 2.5 pF. The crystal oscillator circuit is shown in Figure 28. Typical component values for different values of CL are given in Table 33. The crystal oscillator is amplitude regulated. This means that a high current is used to start up the oscillations. When the amplitude builds up, the current is reduced to what is necessary to maintain approximately 0.4 Vpp signal swing. This ensures a fast start-up, and keeps the drive level to a minimum. The ESR of the crystal should be within the specification in order to ensure a reliable start-up (see Section 4.4 on page 14). The initial tolerance, temperature drift, aging and load pulling should be carefully specified in order to meet the required frequency accuracy in a certain application. XOSC_Q1 XOSC_Q2 XTAL C81 C101 Figure 28: Crystal Oscillator Circuit Component CL = 10 pF CL = 13 pF CL = 16 pF C81 15 pF 22 pF 27 pF C101 15 pF 22 pF 27 pF Table 33: Crystal Oscillator Component Values CC1100 SWRS038D Page 54 of 92 27.1 Reference Signal The chip can alternatively be operated with a reference signal from 26 to 27 MHz instead of a crystal. This input clock can either be a fullswing digital signal (0 V to VDD) or a sine wave of maximum 1 V peak-peak amplitude. The reference signal must be connected to the XOSC_Q1 input. The sine wave must be connected to XOSC_Q1 using a serial capacitor. When using a full-swing digital signal this capacitor can be omitted. The XOSC_Q2 line must be left un-connected. C81 and C101 can be omitted when using a reference signal. 28 External RF Match The balanced RF input and output of CC1100 share two common pins and are designed for a simple, low-cost matching and balun network on the printed circuit board. The receive- and transmit switching at the CC1100 front-end is controlled by a dedicated on-chip function, eliminating the need for an external RX/TXswitch. A few passive external components combined with the internal RX/TX switch/termination circuitry ensures match in both RX and TX mode. Although CC1100 has a balanced RF input/output, the chip can be connected to a single-ended antenna with few external low cost capacitors and inductors. The passive matching/filtering network connected to CC1100 should have the following differential impedance as seen from the RFport (RF_P and RF_N) towards the antenna: Zout 315 MHz = 122 + j31 Ω Zout 433 MHz = 116 + j41 Ω Zout 868/915 MHz = 86.5 + j43 Ω To ensure optimal matching of the CC1100 differential output it is recommended to follow the CC1100EM reference design ([5] or [6]) as closely as possible. Gerber files for the reference designs are available for download from the TI website. 29 PCB Layout Recommendations The top layer should be used for signal routing, and the open areas should be filled with metallization connected to ground using several vias. The area under the chip is used for grounding and shall be connected to the bottom ground plane with several vias. In the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]) we have placed 5 vias inside the exposed die attached pad. These vias should be “tented” (covered with solder mask) on the component side of the PCB to avoid migration of solder through the vias during the solder reflow process. The solder paste coverage should not be 100%. If it is, out gassing may occur during the reflow process, which may cause defects (splattering, solder balling). Using “tented” vias reduces the solder paste coverage below 100%. See Figure 29 for top solder resist and top paste masks. Each decoupling capacitor should be placed as close as possible to the supply pin it is supposed to decouple. Each decoupling capacitor should be connected to the power line (or power plane) by separate vias. The best routing is from the power line (or power plane) to the decoupling capacitor and then to the CC1100 supply pin. Supply power filtering is very important. Each decoupling capacitor ground pad should be connected to the ground plane using a separate via. Direct connections between neighboring power pins will increase noise coupling and should be avoided unless absolutely necessary. The external components should ideally be as small as possible (0402 is recommended) and surface mount devices are highly recommended. Please note that components smaller than those specified may have differing characteristics. Precaution should be used when placing the microcontroller in order to avoid noise interfering with the RF circuitry. A CC1100/1150DK Development Kit with a fully assembled CC1100EM Evaluation Module is available. It is strongly advised that this reference layout is followed very closely in order to get the best performance. The schematic, BOM and layout Gerber files are all available from the TI website ([5] and [6]). CC1100 SWRS038D Page 55 of 92 Figure 29: Left: Top Solder Resist Mask (Negative). Right: Top Paste Mask. Circles are Vias 30 General Purpose / Test Output Control Pins The three digital output pins GDO0, GDO1, and GDO2 are general control pins configured with IOCFG0.GDO0_CFG, IOCFG1.GDO1_CFG, and IOCFG2.GDO3_CFG respectively. Table 34 shows the different signals that can be monitored on the GDO pins. These signals can be used as inputs to the MCU. GDO1 is the same pin as the SO pin on the SPI interface, thus the output programmed on this pin will only be valid when CSn is high. The default value for GDO1 is 3- stated, which is useful when the SPI interface is shared with other devices. The default value for GDO0 is a 135-141 kHz clock output (XOSC frequency divided by 192). Since the XOSC is turned on at poweron- reset, this can be used to clock the MCU in systems with only one crystal. When the MCU is up and running, it can change the clock frequency by writing to IOCFG0.GDO0_CFG. An on-chip analog temperature sensor is enabled by writing the value 128 (0x80) to the IOCFG0 register. The voltage on the GDO0 pin is then proportional to temperature. See Section 4.7 on page 16 for temperature sensor specifications. If the IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG setting is less than 0x20 and IOCFGx_GDOx_INV is 0 (1), the GDO0 and GDO2 pins will be hardwired to 0 (1) and the GDO1 pin will be hardwired to 1 (0) in the SLEEP state. These signals will be hardwired until the CHIP_RDYn signal goes low. If the IOCFGx.GDOx_CFG setting is 0x20 or higher the GDO pins will work as programmed also in SLEEP state. As an example, GDO1 is high impedance in all states if IOCFG1.GDO1_CFG=0x2E. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 56 of 92 GDOx_CFG[5:0] Description 0 (0x00) Associated to the RX FIFO: Asserts when RX FIFO is filled at or above the RX FIFO threshold. De-asserts when RX FIFO is drained below the same threshold. 1 (0x01) Associated to the RX FIFO: Asserts when RX FIFO is filled at or above the RX FIFO threshold or the end of packet is reached. De-asserts when the RX FIFO is empty. 2 (0x02) Associated to the TX FIFO: Asserts when the TX FIFO is filled at or above the TX FIFO threshold. De-asserts when the TX FIFO is below the same threshold. 3 (0x03) Associated to the TX FIFO: Asserts when TX FIFO is full. De-asserts when the TX FIFO is drained below theTX FIFO threshold. 4 (0x04) Asserts when the RX FIFO has overflowed. De-asserts when the FIFO has been flushed. 5 (0x05) Asserts when the TX FIFO has underflowed. De-asserts when the FIFO is flushed. 6 (0x06) Asserts when sync word has been sent / received, and de-asserts at the end of the packet. In RX, the pin will de-assert when the optional address check fails or the RX FIFO overflows. In TX the pin will de-assert if the TX FIFO underflows. 7 (0x07) Asserts when a packet has been received with CRC OK. De-asserts when the first byte is read from the RX FIFO. 8 (0x08) Preamble Quality Reached. Asserts when the PQI is above the programmed PQT value. 9 (0x09) Clear channel assessment. High when RSSI level is below threshold (dependent on the current CCA_MODE setting) 10 (0x0A) Lock detector output. The PLL is in lock if the lock detector output has a positive transition or is constantly logic high. To check for PLL lock the lock detector output should be used as an interrupt for the MCU. 11 (0x0B) Serial Clock. Synchronous to the data in synchronous serial mode. In RX mode, data is set up on the falling edge by CC1100 when GDOx_INV=0. In TX mode, data is sampled by CC1100 on the rising edge of the serial clock when GDOx_INV=0. 12 (0x0C) Serial Synchronous Data Output. Used for synchronous serial mode. 13 (0x0D) Serial Data Output. Used for asynchronous serial mode. 14 (0x0E) Carrier sense. High if RSSI level is above threshold. 15 (0x0F) CRC_OK. The last CRC comparison matched. Cleared when entering/restarting RX mode. 16 (0x10) Reserved – used for test. 17 (0x11) Reserved – used for test. 18 (0x12) Reserved – used for test. 19 (0x13) Reserved – used for test. 20 (0x14) Reserved – used for test. 21 (0x15) Reserved – used for test. 22 (0x16) RX_HARD_DATA[1]. Can be used together with RX_SYMBOL_TICK for alternative serial RX output. 23 (0x17) RX_HARD_DATA[0]. Can be used together with RX_SYMBOL_TICK for alternative serial RX output. 24 (0x18) Reserved – used for test. 25 (0x19) Reserved – used for test. 26 (0x1A) Reserved – used for test. 27 (0x1B) PA_PD. Note: PA_PD will have the same signal level in SLEEP and TX states. To control an external PA or RX/TX switch in applications where the SLEEP state is used it is recommended to use GDOx_CFGx=0x2F instead. 28 (0x1C) LNA_PD. Note: LNA_PD will have the same signal level in SLEEP and RX states. To control an external LNA or RX/TX switch in applications where the SLEEP state is used it is recommended to use GDOx_CFGx=0x2F instead. 29 (0x1D) RX_SYMBOL_TICK. Can be used together with RX_HARD_DATA for alternative serial RX output. 30 (0x1E) Reserved – used for test. 31 (0x1F) Reserved – used for test. 32 (0x20) Reserved – used for test. 33 (0x21) Reserved – used for test. 34 (0x22) Reserved – used for test. 35 (0x23) Reserved – used for test. 36 (0x24) WOR_EVNT0 37 (0x25) WOR_EVNT1 38 (0x26) Reserved – used for test. 39 (0x27) CLK_32k 40 (0x28) Reserved – used for test. 41 (0x29) CHIP_RDYn 42 (0x2A) Reserved – used for test. 43 (0x2B) XOSC_STABLE 44 (0x2C) Reserved – used for test. 45 (0x2D) GDO0_Z_EN_N. When this output is 0, GDO0 is configured as input (for serial TX data). 46 (0x2E) High impedance (3-state) 47 (0x2F) HW to 0 (HW1 achieved by setting GDOx_INV=1). Can be used to control an external LNA/PA or RX/TX switch. 48 (0x30) CLK_XOSC/1 49 (0x31) CLK_XOSC/1.5 50 (0x32) CLK_XOSC/2 51 (0x33) CLK_XOSC/3 52 (0x34) CLK_XOSC/4 53 (0x35) CLK_XOSC/6 54 (0x36) CLK_XOSC/8 55 (0x37) CLK_XOSC/12 56 (0x38) CLK_XOSC/16 57 (0x39) CLK_XOSC/24 58 (0x3A) CLK_XOSC/32 59 (0x3B) CLK_XOSC/48 60 (0x3C) CLK_XOSC/64 61 (0x3D) CLK_XOSC/96 62 (0x3E) CLK_XOSC/128 63 (0x3F) CLK_XOSC/192 Note: There are 3 GDO pins, but only one CLK_XOSC/n can be selected as an output at any time. If CLK_XOSC/n is to be monitored on one of the GDO pins, the other two GDO pins must be configured to values less than 0x30. The GDO0 default value is CLK_XOSC/192. To optimize rf performance, these signal should not be used while the radio is in RX or TX mode. Table 34: GDOx Signal Selection (x = 0, 1, or 2) CC1100 SWRS038D Page 57 of 92 31 Asynchronous and Synchronous Serial Operation Several features and modes of operation have been included in the CC1100 to provide backward compatibility with previous Chipcon products and other existing RF communication systems. For new systems, it is recommended to use the built-in packet handling features, as they can give more robust communication, significantly offload the microcontroller, and simplify software development. 31.1 Asynchronous Operation For backward compatibility with systems already using the asynchronous data transfer from other Chipcon products, asynchronous transfer is also included in CC1100. When asynchronous transfer is enabled, several of the support mechanisms for the MCU that are included in CC1100 will be disabled, such as packet handling hardware, buffering in the FIFO, and so on. The asynchronous transfer mode does not allow the use of the data whitener, interleaver, and FEC, and it is not possible to use Manchester encoding. Note that MSK is not supported for asynchronous transfer. Setting PKTCTRL0.PKT_FORMAT to 3 enables asynchronous serial mode. In TX, the GDO0 pin is used for data input (TX data). Data output can be on GDO0, GDO1, or GDO2. This is set by the IOCFG0.GDO0_CFG, IOCFG1.GDO1_CFG and IOCFG2.GDO2_CFG fields. The CC1100 modulator samples the level of the asynchronous input 8 times faster than the programmed data rate. The timing requirement for the asynchronous stream is that the error in the bit period must be less than one eighth of the programmed data rate. 31.2 Synchronous Serial Operation Setting PKTCTRL0.PKT_FORMAT to 1 enables synchronous serial mode. In the synchronous serial mode, data is transferred on a two wire serial interface. The CC1100 provides a clock that is used to set up new data on the data input line or sample data on the data output line. Data input (TX data) is the GDO0 pin. This pin will automatically be configured as an input when TX is active. The data output pin can be any of the GDO pins; this is set by the IOCFG0.GDO0_CFG, IOCFG1.GDO1_CFG, and IOCFG2.GDO2_CFG fields. Preamble and sync word insertion/detection may or may not be active, dependent on the sync mode set by the MDMCFG2.SYNC_MODE. If preamble and sync word is disabled, all other packet handler features and FEC should also be disabled. The MCU must then handle preamble and sync word insertion and detection in software. If preamble and sync word insertion/detection is left on, all packet handling features and FEC can be used. One exception is that the address filtering feature is unavailable in synchronous serial mode. When using the packet handling features in synchronous serial mode, the CC1100 will insert and detect the preamble and sync word and the MCU will only provide/get the data payload. This is equivalent to the recommended FIFO operation mode. 32 System Considerations and Guidelines 32.1 SRD Regulations International regulations and national laws regulate the use of radio receivers and transmitters. Short Range Devices (SRDs) for license free operation below 1 GHz are usually operated in the 433 MHz, 868 MHz or 915 MHz frequency bands. The CC1100 is specifically designed for such use with its 300 - 348 MHz, 400 - 464 MHz, and 800 - 928 MHz operating ranges. The most important regulations when using the CC1100 in the 433 MHz, 868 MHz, or 915 MHz frequency bands are EN 300 220 (Europe) and FCC CFR47 part 15 (USA). A summary of the most important aspects of these regulations can be found in Application Note AN001 [2]. Please note that compliance with regulations is dependent on complete system performance. It is the customer’s responsibility to ensure that the system complies with regulations. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 58 of 92 32.2 Frequency Hopping and Multi- Channel Systems The 433 MHz, 868 MHz, or 915 MHz bands are shared by many systems both in industrial, office, and home environments. It is therefore recommended to use frequency hopping spread spectrum (FHSS) or a multi-channel protocol because the frequency diversity makes the system more robust with respect to interference from other systems operating in the same frequency band. FHSS also combats multipath fading. CC1100 is highly suited for FHSS or multichannel systems due to its agile frequency synthesizer and effective communication interface. Using the packet handling support and data buffering is also beneficial in such systems as these features will significantly offload the host controller. Charge pump current, VCO current, and VCO capacitance array calibration data is required for each frequency when implementing frequency hopping for CC1100. There are 3 ways of obtaining the calibration data from the chip: 1) Frequency hopping with calibration for each hop. The PLL calibration time is approximately 720 μs. The blanking interval between each frequency hop is then approximately 810 us. 2) Fast frequency hopping without calibration for each hop can be done by calibrating each frequency at startup and saving the resulting FSCAL3, FSCAL2, and FSCAL1 register values in MCU memory. Between each frequency hop, the calibration process can then be replaced by writing the FSCAL3, FSCAL2and FSCAL1 register values corresponding to the next RF frequency. The PLL turn on time is approximately 90 μs. The blanking interval between each frequency hop is then approximately 90 us. The VCO current calibration result available in FSCAL2 is not dependent on the RF frequency. Neither is the charge pump current calibration result available in FSCAL3. The same value can therefore be used for all frequencies. 3) Run calibration on a single frequency at startup. Next write 0 to FSCAL3[5:4] to disable the charge pump calibration. After writing to FSCAL3[5:4] strobe SRX (or STX) with MCSM0.FS_AUTOCAL=1 for each new frequency hop. That is, VCO current and VCO capacitance calibration is done but not charge pump current calibration. When charge pump current calibration is disabled the calibration time is reduced from approximately 720 μs to approximately 150 μs. The blanking interval between each frequency hop is then approximately 240 us. There is a trade off between blanking time and memory space needed for storing calibration data in non-volatile memory. Solution 2) above gives the shortest blanking interval, but requires more memory space to store calibration values. Solution 3) gives approximately 570 μs smaller blanking interval than solution 1). Note that the recommended settings for TEST0.VCO_SEL_CAL_EN will change with frequency. This means that one should always use SmartRF® Studio [7] to get the correct settings for a specific frequency before doing a calibration, regardless of which calibration method is being used. It must be noted that the TESTn registers (n = 0, 1, or 2) content is not retained in SLEEP state, and thus it is necessary to re-write these registers when returning from the SLEEP state. 32.3 Wideband Modulation not Using Spread Spectrum Digital modulation systems under FFC part 15.247 includes 2-FSK and GFSK modulation. A maximum peak output power of 1W (+30 dBm) is allowed if the 6 dB bandwidth of the modulated signal exceeds 500 kHz. In addition, the peak power spectral density conducted to the antenna shall not be greater than +8 dBm in any 3 kHz band. Operating at high data rates and frequency separation, the CC1100 is suited for systems targeting compliance with digital modulation system as defined by FFC part 15.247. An external power amplifier is needed to increase the output above +10 dBm. 32.4 Data Burst Transmissions The high maximum data rate of CC1100 opens up for burst transmissions. A low average data rate link (e.g. 10 kBaud), can be realized using a higher over-the-air data rate. Buffering the data and transmitting in bursts at high data rate (e.g. 500 kBaud) will reduce the time in active mode, and hence also reduce the average current consumption significantly. Reducing the time in active mode will reduce the likelihood of collisions with other systems in the same frequency range. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 59 of 92 32.5 Continuous Transmissions In data streaming applications the CC1100 opens up for continuous transmissions at 500 kBaud effective data rate. As the modulation is done with a closed loop PLL, there is no limitation in the length of a transmission (open loop modulation used in some transceivers often prevents this kind of continuous data streaming and reduces the effective data rate). 32.6 Crystal Drift Compensation The CC1100 has a very fine frequency resolution (see Table 9). This feature can be used to compensate for frequency offset and drift. The frequency offset between an ‘external’ transmitter and the receiver is measured in the CC1100 and can be read back from the FREQEST status register as described in Section 14.1. The measured frequency offset can be used to calibrate the frequency using the ‘external’ transmitter as the reference. That is, the received signal of the device will match the receiver’s channel filter better. In the same way the centre frequency of the transmitted signal will match the ‘external’ transmitter’s signal. 32.7 Spectrum Efficient Modulation CC1100 also has the possibility to use Gaussian shaped 2-FSK (GFSK). This spectrum-shaping feature improves adjacent channel power (ACP) and occupied bandwidth. In ‘true’ 2-FSK systems with abrupt frequency shifting, the spectrum is inherently broad. By making the frequency shift ‘softer’, the spectrum can be made significantly narrower. Thus, higher data rates can be transmitted in the same bandwidth using GFSK. 32.8 Low Cost Systems As the CC1100 provides 500 kBaud multichannel performance without any external filters, a very low cost system can be made. A differential antenna will eliminate the need for a balun, and the DC biasing can be achieved in the antenna topology, see Figure 3 and Figure 4. A HC-49 type SMD crystal is used in the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]). Note that the crystal package strongly influences the price. In a size constrained PCB design a smaller, but more expensive, crystal may be used. 32.9 Battery Operated Systems In low power applications, the SLEEP state with the crystal oscillator core switched off should be used when the CC1100 is not active. It is possible to leave the crystal oscillator core running in the SLEEP state if start-up time is critical. The WOR functionality should be used in low power applications. 32.10 Increasing Output Power In some applications it may be necessary to extend the link range. Adding an external power amplifier is the most effective way of doing this. The power amplifier should be inserted between the antenna and the balun, and two T/R switches are needed to disconnect the PA in RX mode. See Figure 30. Figure 30: Block Diagram of CC1100 Usage with External Power Amplifier Balun CC1100 Filter Antenna T/R switch T/R switch PA CC1100 SWRS038D Page 60 of 92 33 Configuration Registers The configuration of CC1100 is done by programming 8-bit registers. The optimum configuration data based on selected system parameters are most easily found by using the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. Complete descriptions of the registers are given in the following tables. After chip reset, all the registers have default values as shown in the tables. The optimum register setting might differ from the default value. After a reset all registers that shall be different from the default value therefore needs to be programmed through the SPI interface. There are 13 command strobe registers, listed in Table 35. Accessing these registers will initiate the change of an internal state or mode. There are 47 normal 8-bit configuration registers, listed in Table 36. Many of these registers are for test purposes only, and need not be written for normal operation of CC1100. There are also 12 Status registers, which are listed in Table 37. These registers, which are read-only, contain information about the status of CC1100. The two FIFOs are accessed through one 8-bit register. Write operations write to the TX FIFO, while read operations read from the RX FIFO. During the header byte transfer and while writing data to a register or the TX FIFO, a status byte is returned on the SO line. This status byte is described in Table 17 on page 26. Table 38 summarizes the SPI address space. The address to use is given by adding the base address to the left and the burst and read/write bits on the top. Note that the burst bit has different meaning for base addresses above and below 0x2F. Address Strobe Name Description 0x30 SRES Reset chip. 0x31 SFSTXON Enable and calibrate frequency synthesizer (if MCSM0.FS_AUTOCAL=1). If in RX (with CCA): Go to a wait state where only the synthesizer is running (for quick RX / TX turnaround). 0x32 SXOFF Turn off crystal oscillator. 0x33 SCAL Calibrate frequency synthesizer and turn it off. SCAL can be strobed from IDLE mode without setting manual calibration mode (MCSM0.FS_AUTOCAL=0) 0x34 SRX Enable RX. Perform calibration first if coming from IDLE and MCSM0.FS_AUTOCAL=1. 0x35 STX In IDLE state: Enable TX. Perform calibration first if MCSM0.FS_AUTOCAL=1. If in RX state and CCA is enabled: Only go to TX if channel is clear. 0x36 SIDLE Exit RX / TX, turn off frequency synthesizer and exit Wake-On-Radio mode if applicable. 0x38 SWOR Start automatic RX polling sequence (Wake-on-Radio) as described in Section 19.5 if WORCTRL.RC_PD=0. 0x39 SPWD Enter power down mode when CSn goes high. 0x3A SFRX Flush the RX FIFO buffer. Only issue SFRX in IDLE or, RXFIFO_OVERFLOW states. 0x3B SFTX Flush the TX FIFO buffer. Only issue SFTX in IDLE or TXFIFO_UNDERFLOW states. 0x3C SWORRST Reset real time clock to Event1 value. 0x3D SNOP No operation. May be used to get access to the chip status byte. Table 35: Command Strobes CC1100 SWRS038D Page 61 of 92 Address Register Description Preserved in SLEEP State Details on Page Number 0x00 IOCFG2 GDO2 output pin configuration Yes 64 0x01 IOCFG1 GDO1 output pin configuration Yes 64 0x02 IOCFG0 GDO0 output pin configuration Yes 64 0x03 FIFOTHR RX FIFO and TX FIFO thresholds Yes 65 0x04 SYNC1 Sync word, high byte Yes 65 0x05 SYNC0 Sync word, low byte Yes 65 0x06 PKTLEN Packet length Yes 65 0x07 PKTCTRL1 Packet automation control Yes 66 0x08 PKTCTRL0 Packet automation control Yes 67 0x09 ADDR Device address Yes 67 0x0A CHANNR Channel number Yes 67 0x0B FSCTRL1 Frequency synthesizer control Yes 68 0x0C FSCTRL0 Frequency synthesizer control Yes 68 0x0D FREQ2 Frequency control word, high byte Yes 68 0x0E FREQ1 Frequency control word, middle byte Yes 68 0x0F FREQ0 Frequency control word, low byte Yes 68 0x10 MDMCFG4 Modem configuration Yes 69 0x11 MDMCFG3 Modem configuration Yes 69 0x12 MDMCFG2 Modem configuration Yes 70 0x13 MDMCFG1 Modem configuration Yes 71 0x14 MDMCFG0 Modem configuration Yes 71 0x15 DEVIATN Modem deviation setting Yes 72 0x16 MCSM2 Main Radio Control State Machine configuration Yes 73 0x17 MCSM1 Main Radio Control State Machine configuration Yes 74 0x18 MCSM0 Main Radio Control State Machine configuration Yes 75 0x19 FOCCFG Frequency Offset Compensation configuration Yes 76 0x1A BSCFG Bit Synchronization configuration Yes 77 0x1B AGCTRL2 AGC control Yes 78 0x1C AGCTRL1 AGC control Yes 79 0x1D AGCTRL0 AGC control Yes 80 0x1E WOREVT1 High byte Event 0 timeout Yes 80 0x1F WOREVT0 Low byte Event 0 timeout Yes 81 0x20 WORCTRL Wake On Radio control Yes 81 0x21 FREND1 Front end RX configuration Yes 82 0x22 FREND0 Front end TX configuration Yes 82 0x23 FSCAL3 Frequency synthesizer calibration Yes 82 0x24 FSCAL2 Frequency synthesizer calibration Yes 83 0x25 FSCAL1 Frequency synthesizer calibration Yes 83 0x26 FSCAL0 Frequency synthesizer calibration Yes 83 0x27 RCCTRL1 RC oscillator configuration Yes 83 0x28 RCCTRL0 RC oscillator configuration Yes 83 0x29 FSTEST Frequency synthesizer calibration control No 84 0x2A PTEST Production test No 84 0x2B AGCTEST AGC test No 84 0x2C TEST2 Various test settings No 84 0x2D TEST1 Various test settings No 84 0x2E TEST0 Various test settings No 84 Table 36: Configuration Registers Overview CC1100 SWRS038D Page 62 of 92 Address Register Description Details on page number 0x30 (0xF0) PARTNUM Part number for CC1100 85 0x31 (0xF1) VERSION Current version number 85 0x32 (0xF2) FREQEST Frequency Offset Estimate 85 0x33 (0xF3) LQI Demodulator estimate for Link Quality 85 0x34 (0xF4) RSSI Received signal strength indication 85 0x35 (0xF5) MARCSTATE Control state machine state 86 0x36 (0xF6) WORTIME1 High byte of WOR timer 86 0x37 (0xF7) WORTIME0 Low byte of WOR timer 86 0x38 (0xF8) PKTSTATUS Current GDOx status and packet status 87 0x39 (0xF9) VCO_VC_DAC Current setting from PLL calibration module 87 0x3A (0xFA) TXBYTES Underflow and number of bytes in the TX FIFO 87 0x3B (0xFB) RXBYTES Overflow and number of bytes in the RX FIFO 87 0x3C (0xFC) RCCTRL1_STATUS Last RC oscillator calibration result 87 0x3D (0xFD) RCCTRL0_STATUS Last RC oscillator calibration result 88 Table 37: Status Registers Overview CC1100 SWRS038D Page 63 of 92 Write Read Single Byte Burst Single Byte Burst +0x00 +0x40 +0x80 +0xC0 0x00 IOCFG2 0x01 IOCFG1 0x02 IOCFG0 0x03 FIFOTHR 0x04 SYNC1 0x05 SYNC0 0x06 PKTLEN 0x07 PKTCTRL1 0x08 PKTCTRL0 0x09 ADDR 0x0A CHANNR 0x0B FSCTRL1 0x0C FSCTRL0 0x0D FREQ2 0x0E FREQ1 0x0F FREQ0 0x10 MDMCFG4 0x11 MDMCFG3 0x12 MDMCFG2 0x13 MDMCFG1 0x14 MDMCFG0 0x15 DEVIATN 0x16 MCSM2 0x17 MCSM1 0x18 MCSM0 0x19 FOCCFG 0x1A BSCFG 0x1B AGCCTRL2 0x1C AGCCTRL1 0x1D AGCCTRL0 0x1E WOREVT1 0x1F WOREVT0 0x20 WORCTRL 0x21 FREND1 0x22 FREND0 0x23 FSCAL3 0x24 FSCAL2 0x25 FSCAL1 0x26 FSCAL0 0x27 RCCTRL1 0x28 RCCTRL0 0x29 FSTEST 0x2A PTEST 0x2B AGCTEST 0x2C TEST2 0x2D TEST1 0x2E TEST0 0x2F R/W configuration registers, burst access possible 0x30 SRES SRES PARTNUM 0x31 SFSTXON SFSTXON VERSION 0x32 SXOFF SXOFF FREQEST 0x33 SCAL SCAL LQI 0x34 SRX SRX RSSI 0x35 STX STX MARCSTATE 0x36 SIDLE SIDLE WORTIME1 0x37 WORTIME0 0x38 SWOR SWOR PKTSTATUS 0x39 SPWD SPWD VCO_VC_DAC 0x3A SFRX SFRX TXBYTES 0x3B SFTX SFTX RXBYTES 0x3C SWORRST SWORRST RCCTRL1_STATUS 0x3D SNOP SNOP RCCTRL0_STATUS 0x3E PATABLE PATABLE PATABLE PATABLE 0x3F TX FIFO TX FIFO RX FIFO RX FIFO Command Strobes, Status registers (read only) and multi byte registers Table 38: SPI Address Space CC1100 SWRS038D Page 64 of 92 33.1 Configuration Register Details – Registers with preserved values in SLEEP state 0x00: IOCFG2 – GDO2 Output Pin Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved R0 6 GDO2_INV 0 R/W Invert output, i.e. select active low (1) / high (0) 5:0 GDO2_CFG[5:0] 41 (0x29) R/W Default is CHP_RDYn (See Table 34 on page 56). 0x01: IOCFG1 – GDO1 Output Pin Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 GDO_DS 0 R/W Set high (1) or low (0) output drive strength on the GDO pins. 6 GDO1_INV 0 R/W Invert output, i.e. select active low (1) / high (0) 5:0 GDO1_CFG[5:0] 46 (0x2E) R/W Default is 3-state (See Table 34 on page 56). 0x02: IOCFG0 – GDO0 Output Pin Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 TEMP_SENSOR_ENABLE 0 R/W Enable analog temperature sensor. Write 0 in all other register bits when using temperature sensor. 6 GDO0_INV 0 R/W Invert output, i.e. select active low (1) / high (0) 5:0 GDO0_CFG[5:0] 63 (0x3F) R/W Default is CLK_XOSC/192 (See Table 34 on page 56). It is recommended to disable the clock output in initialization, in order to optimize RF performance. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 65 of 92 0x03: FIFOTHR – RX FIFO and TX FIFO Thresholds Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:4 Reserved 0 R/W Write 0 for compatibility with possible future extensions 3:0 FIFO_THR[3:0] 7 (0111) R/W Set the threshold for the TX FIFO and RX FIFO. The threshold is exceeded when the number of bytes in the FIFO is equal to or higher than the threshold value. Setting Bytes in TX FIFO Bytes in RX FIFO 0 (0000) 61 4 1 (0001) 57 8 2 (0010) 53 12 3 (0011) 49 16 4 (0100) 45 20 5 (0101) 41 24 6 (0110) 37 28 7 (0111) 33 32 8 (1000) 29 36 9 (1001) 25 40 10 (1010) 21 44 11 (1011) 17 48 12 (1100) 13 52 13 (1101) 9 56 14 (1110) 5 60 15 (1111) 1 64 0x04: SYNC1 – Sync Word, High Byte Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 SYNC[15:8] 211 (0xD3) R/W 8 MSB of 16-bit sync word 0x05: SYNC0 – Sync Word, Low Byte Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 SYNC[7:0] 145 (0x91) R/W 8 LSB of 16-bit sync word 0x06: PKTLEN – Packet Length Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 PACKET_LENGTH 255 (0xFF) R/W Indicates the packet length when fixed packet length mode is enabled. If variable packet length mode is used, this value indicates the maximum packet length allowed. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 66 of 92 0x07: PKTCTRL1 – Packet Automation Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:5 PQT[2:0] 0 (0x00) R/W Preamble quality estimator threshold. The preamble quality estimator increases an internal counter by one each time a bit is received that is different from the previous bit, and decreases the counter by 8 each time a bit is received that is the same as the last bit. A threshold of 4·PQT for this counter is used to gate sync word detection. When PQT=0 a sync word is always accepted. 4 Reserved 0 R0 3 CRC_AUTOFLUSH 0 R/W Enable automatic flush of RX FIFO when CRC in not OK. This requires that only one packet is in the RXIFIFO and that packet length is limited to the RX FIFO size. 2 APPEND_STATUS 1 R/W When enabled, two status bytes will be appended to the payload of the packet. The status bytes contain RSSI and LQI values, as well as CRC OK. 1:0 ADR_CHK[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Controls address check configuration of received packages. Setting Address check configuration 0 (00) No address check 1 (01) Address check, no broadcast 2 (10) Address check and 0 (0x00) broadcast 3 (11) Address check and 0 (0x00) and 255 (0xFF) broadcast CC1100 SWRS038D Page 67 of 92 0x08: PKTCTRL0 – Packet Automation Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved R0 6 WHITE_DATA 1 R/W Turn data whitening on / off 0: Whitening off 1: Whitening on 5:4 PKT_FORMAT[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Format of RX and TX data Setting Packet format 0 (00) Normal mode, use FIFOs for RX and TX 1 (01) Synchronous serial mode, used for backwards compatibility. Data in on GDO0 2 (10) Random TX mode; sends random data using PN9 generator. Used for test. Works as normal mode, setting 0 (00), in RX. 3 (11) Asynchronous serial mode. Data in on GDO0 and Data out on either of the GDO0 pins 3 Reserved 0 R0 2 CRC_EN 1 R/W 1: CRC calculation in TX and CRC check in RX enabled 0: CRC disabled for TX and RX 1:0 LENGTH_CONFIG[1:0] 1 (01) R/W Configure the packet length Setting Packet length configuration 0 (00) Fixed packet length mode. Length configured in PKTLEN register 1 (01) Variable packet length mode. Packet length configured by the first byte after sync word 2 (10) Infinite packet length mode 3 (11) Reserved 0x09: ADDR – Device Address Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 DEVICE_ADDR[7:0] 0 (0x00) R/W Address used for packet filtration. Optional broadcast addresses are 0 (0x00) and 255 (0xFF). 0x0A: CHANNR – Channel Number Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 CHAN[7:0] 0 (0x00) R/W The 8-bit unsigned channel number, which is multiplied by the channel spacing setting and added to the base frequency. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 68 of 92 0x0B: FSCTRL1 – Frequency Synthesizer Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:5 Reserved R0 4:0 FREQ_IF[4:0] 15 (0x0F) R/W The desired IF frequency to employ in RX. Subtracted from FS base frequency in RX and controls the digital complex mixer in the demodulator. f f XOSC FREQ IF IF _ 210 = ⋅ The default value gives an IF frequency of 381kHz, assuming a 26.0 MHz crystal. 0x0C: FSCTRL0 – Frequency Synthesizer Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 FREQOFF[7:0] 0 (0x00) R/W Frequency offset added to the base frequency before being used by the frequency synthesizer. (2s-complement). Resolution is FXTAL/214 (1.59kHz-1.65kHz); range is ±202 kHz to ±210 kHz, dependent of XTAL frequency. 0x0D: FREQ2 – Frequency Control Word, High Byte Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 FREQ[23:22] 0 (00) R FREQ[23:22] is always 0 (the FREQ2 register is less than 36 with 26-27 MHz crystal) 5:0 FREQ[21:16] 30 (0x1E) R/W FREQ[23:22] is the base frequency for the frequency synthesiser in increments of FXOSC/216. [23 : 0] 216 f f XOSC FREQ carrier = ⋅ 0x0E: FREQ1 – Frequency Control Word, Middle Byte Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 FREQ[15:8] 196 (0xC4) R/W Ref. FREQ2 register 0x0F: FREQ0 – Frequency Control Word, Low Byte Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 FREQ[7:0] 236 (0xEC) R/W Ref. FREQ2 register CC1100 SWRS038D Page 69 of 92 0x10: MDMCFG4 – Modem Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 CHANBW_E[1:0] 2 (0x02) R/W 5:4 CHANBW_M[1:0] 0 (0x00) R/W Sets the decimation ratio for the delta-sigma ADC input stream and thus the channel bandwidth. CHANBW E XOSC channel CHANBW M BW f 8 ⋅ (4 + _ )·2 _ = The default values give 203 kHz channel filter bandwidth, assuming a 26.0 MHz crystal. 3:0 DRATE_E[3:0] 12 (0x0C) R/W The exponent of the user specified symbol rate 0x11: MDMCFG3 – Modem Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 DRATE_M[7:0] 34 (0x22) R/W The mantissa of the user specified symbol rate. The symbol rate is configured using an unsigned, floating-point number with 9-bit mantissa and 4-bit exponent. The 9th bit is a hidden ‘1’. The resulting data rate is: ( ) XOSC DRATE E DATA R = + DRATE M ⋅ ⋅ f 28 _ 2 256 _ 2 The default values give a data rate of 115.051 kBaud (closest setting to 115.2 kBaud), assuming a 26.0 MHz crystal. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 70 of 92 0x12: MDMCFG2 – Modem Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 DEM_DCFILT_OFF 0 R/W Disable digital DC blocking filter before demodulator. 0 = Enable (better sensitivity) 1 = Disable (current optimized). Only for data rates ≤ 250 kBaud The recommended IF frequency changes when the DC blocking is disabled. Please use SmartRF® Studio [7] to calculate correct register setting. 6:4 MOD_FORMAT[2:0] 0 (000) R/W The modulation format of the radio signal Setting Modulation format 0 (000) 2-FSK 1 (001) GFSK 2 (010) - 3 (011) ASK/OOK 4 (100) - 5 (101) - 6 (110) - 7 (111) MSK ASK is only supported for output powers up to -1 dBm MSK is only supported for datarates above 26 kBaud 3 MANCHESTER_EN 0 R/W Enables Manchester encoding/decoding. 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 2:0 SYNC_MODE[2:0] 2 (010) R/W Combined sync-word qualifier mode. The values 0 (000) and 4 (100) disables preamble and sync word transmission in TX and preamble and sync word detection in RX. The values 1 (001), 2 (010), 5 (101) and 6 (110) enables 16-bit sync word transmission in TX and 16-bits sync word detection in RX. Only 15 of 16 bits need to match in RX when using setting 1 (001) or 5 (101). The values 3 (011) and 7 (111) enables repeated sync word transmission in TX and 32-bits sync word detection in RX (only 30 of 32 bits need to match). Setting Sync-word qualifier mode 0 (000) No preamble/sync 1 (001) 15/16 sync word bits detected 2 (010) 16/16 sync word bits detected 3 (011) 30/32 sync word bits detected 4 (100) No preamble/sync, carrier-sense above threshold 5 (101) 15/16 + carrier-sense above threshold 6 (110) 16/16 + carrier-sense above threshold 7 (111) 30/32 + carrier-sense above threshold CC1100 SWRS038D Page 71 of 92 0x13: MDMCFG1– Modem Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 FEC_EN 0 R/W Enable Forward Error Correction (FEC) with interleaving for packet payload 0 = Disable 1 = Enable (Only supported for fixed packet length mode, i.e. PKTCTRL0.LENGTH_CONFIG=0) 6:4 NUM_PREAMBLE[2:0] 2 (010) R/W Sets the minimum number of preamble bytes to be transmitted Setting Number of preamble bytes 0 (000) 2 1 (001) 3 2 (010) 4 3 (011) 6 4 (100) 8 5 (101) 12 6 (110) 16 7 (111) 24 3:2 Reserved R0 1:0 CHANSPC_E[1:0] 2 (10) R/W 2 bit exponent of channel spacing 0x14: MDMCFG0– Modem Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 CHANSPC_M[7:0] 248 (0xF8) R/W 8-bit mantissa of channel spacing. The channel spacing is multiplied by the channel number CHAN and added to the base frequency. It is unsigned and has the format: XOSC ( ) CHANSPC E CHANNEL f f CHANSPC M _ 18 256 _ 2 2 Δ = ⋅ + ⋅ The default values give 199.951 kHz channel spacing (the closest setting to 200 kHz), assuming 26.0 MHz crystal frequency. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 72 of 92 0x15: DEVIATN – Modem Deviation Setting Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved R0 6:4 DEVIATION_E[2:0] 4 (0x04) R/W Deviation exponent 3 Reserved R0 2:0 DEVIATION_M[2:0] 7 (111) R/W When MSK modulation is enabled: Sets fraction of symbol period used for phase change. Refer to the SmartRF® Studio software [7] for correct deviation setting when using MSK. When 2-FSK/GFSK modulation is enabled: Deviation mantissa, interpreted as a 4-bit value with MSB implicit 1. The resulting frequency deviation is given by: xosc DEVIATION E dev f f DEVIATION M _ 17 (8 _ ) 2 2 = ⋅ + ⋅ The default values give ±47.607 kHz deviation, assuming 26.0 MHz crystal frequency. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 73 of 92 0x16: MCSM2 – Main Radio Control State Machine Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:5 Reserved R0 Reserved 4 RX_TIME_RSSI 0 R/W Direct RX termination based on RSSI measurement (carrier sense). For ASK/OOK modulation, RX times out if there is no carrier sense in the first 8 symbol periods. 3 RX_TIME_QUAL 0 R/W When the RX_TIME timer expires, the chip checks if sync word is found when RX_TIME_QUAL=0, or either sync word is found or PQI is set when RX_TIME_QUAL=1. RX_TIME[2:0] 7 (111) R/W Timeout for sync word search in RX for both WOR mode and normal RX operation. The timeout is relative to the programmed EVENT0 timeout. 2:0 The RX timeout in μs is given by EVENT0·C(RX_TIME, WOR_RES) ·26/X, where C is given by the table below and X is the crystal oscillator frequency in MHz: Setting WOR_RES = 0 WOR_RES = 1 WOR_RES = 2 WOR_RES = 3 0 (000) 3.6058 18.0288 32.4519 46.8750 1 (001) 1.8029 9.0144 16.2260 23.4375 2 (010) 0.9014 4.5072 8.1130 11.7188 3 (011) 0.4507 2.2536 4.0565 5.8594 4 (100) 0.2254 1.1268 2.0282 2.9297 5 (101) 0.1127 0.5634 1.0141 1.4648 6 (110) 0.0563 0.2817 0.5071 0.7324 7 (111) Until end of packet As an example, EVENT0=34666, WOR_RES=0 and RX_TIME=6 corresponds to 1.96 ms RX timeout, 1 s polling interval and 0.195% duty cycle. Note that WOR_RES should be 0 or 1 when using WOR because using WOR_RES > 1 will give a very low duty cycle. In applications where WOR is not used all settings of WOR_RES can be used. The duty cycle using WOR is approximated by: Setting WOR_RES=0 WOR_RES=1 0 (000) 12.50% 1.95% 1 (001) 6.250% 9765ppm 2 (010) 3.125% 4883ppm 3 (011) 1.563% 2441ppm 4 (100) 0.781% NA 5 (101) 0.391% NA 6 (110) 0.195% NA 7 (111) NA Note that the RC oscillator must be enabled in order to use setting 0-6, because the timeout counts RC oscillator periods. WOR mode does not need to be enabled. The timeout counter resolution is limited: With RX_TIME=0, the timeout count is given by the 13 MSBs of EVENT0, decreasing to the 7MSBs of EVENT0 with RX_TIME=6. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 74 of 92 0x17: MCSM1– Main Radio Control State Machine Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 Reserved R0 5:4 CCA_MODE[1:0] 3 (11) R/W Selects CCA_MODE; Reflected in CCA signal Setting Clear channel indication 0 (00) Always 1 (01) If RSSI below threshold 2 (10) Unless currently receiving a packet 3 (11) If RSSI below threshold unless currently receiving a packet 3:2 RXOFF_MODE[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Select what should happen when a packet has been received Setting Next state after finishing packet reception 0 (00) IDLE 1 (01) FSTXON 2 (10) TX 3 (11) Stay in RX It is not possible to set RXOFF_MODE to be TX or FSTXON and at the same time use CCA. 1:0 TXOFF_MODE[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Select what should happen when a packet has been sent (TX) Setting Next state after finishing packet transmission 0 (00) IDLE 1 (01) FSTXON 2 (10) Stay in TX (start sending preamble) 3 (11) RX CC1100 SWRS038D Page 75 of 92 0x18: MCSM0– Main Radio Control State Machine Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 Reserved R0 5:4 FS_AUTOCAL[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Automatically calibrate when going to RX or TX, or back to IDLE Setting When to perform automatic calibration 0 (00) Never (manually calibrate using SCAL strobe) 1 (01) When going from IDLE to RX or TX (or FSTXON) 2 (10) When going from RX or TX back to IDLE automatically 3 (11) Every 4th time when going from RX or TX to IDLE automatically In some automatic wake-on-radio (WOR) applications, using setting 3 (11) can significantly reduce current consumption. 3:2 PO_TIMEOUT 1 (01) R/W Programs the number of times the six-bit ripple counter must expire after XOSC has stabilized before CHP_RDYn goes low. If XOSC is on (stable) during power-down, PO_TIMEOUT should be set so that the regulated digital supply voltage has time to stabilize before CHP_RDYn goes low (PO_TIMEOUT=2 recommended). Typical start-up time for the voltage regulator is 50 us. If XOSC is off during power-down and the regulated digital supply voltage has sufficient time to stabilize while waiting for the crystal to be stable, PO_TIMEOUT can be set to 0. For robust operation it is recommended to use PO_TIMEOUT=2. Setting Expire count Timeout after XOSC start 0 (00) 1 Approx. 2.3 – 2.4 μs 1 (01) 16 Approx. 37 – 39 μs 2 (10) 64 Approx. 149 – 155 μs 3 (11) 256 Approx. 597 – 620 μs Exact timeout depends on crystal frequency. 1 PIN_CTRL_EN 0 R/W Enables the pin radio control option 0 XOSC_FORCE_ON 0 R/W Force the XOSC to stay on in the SLEEP state. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 76 of 92 0x19: FOCCFG – Frequency Offset Compensation Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 Reserved R0 5 FOC_BS_CS_GATE 1 R/W If set, the demodulator freezes the frequency offset compensation and clock recovery feedback loops until the CS signal goes high. 4:3 FOC_PRE_K[1:0] 2 (10) R/W The frequency compensation loop gain to be used before a sync word is detected. Setting Freq. compensation loop gain before sync word 0 (00) K 1 (01) 2K 2 (10) 3K 3 (11) 4K 2 FOC_POST_K 1 R/W The frequency compensation loop gain to be used after a sync word is detected. Setting Freq. compensation loop gain after sync word 0 Same as FOC_PRE_K 1 K/2 1:0 FOC_LIMIT[1:0] 2 (10) R/W The saturation point for the frequency offset compensation algorithm: Setting Saturation point (max compensated offset) 0 (00) ±0 (no frequency offset compensation) 1 (01) ±BWCHAN/8 2 (10) ±BWCHAN/4 3 (11) ±BWCHAN/2 Frequency offset compensation is not supported for ASK/OOK; Always use FOC_LIMIT=0 with these modulation formats. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 77 of 92 0x1A: BSCFG – Bit Synchronization Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 BS_PRE_KI[1:0] 1 (01) R/W The clock recovery feedback loop integral gain to be used before a sync word is detected (used to correct offsets in data rate): Setting Clock recovery loop integral gain before sync word 0 (00) KI 1 (01) 2KI 2 (10) 3KI 3 (11) 4 KI 5:4 BS_PRE_KP[1:0] 2 (10) R/W The clock recovery feedback loop proportional gain to be used before a sync word is detected. Setting Clock recovery loop proportional gain before sync word 0 (00) KP 1 (01) 2KP 2 (10) 3KP 3 (11) 4KP 3 BS_POST_KI 1 R/W The clock recovery feedback loop integral gain to be used after a sync word is detected. Setting Clock recovery loop integral gain after sync word 0 Same as BS_PRE_KI 1 KI /2 2 BS_POST_KP 1 R/W The clock recovery feedback loop proportional gain to be used after a sync word is detected. Setting Clock recovery loop proportional gain after sync word 0 Same as BS_PRE_KP 1 KP 1:0 BS_LIMIT[1:0] 0 (00) R/W The saturation point for the data rate offset compensation algorithm: Setting Data rate offset saturation (max data rate difference) 0 (00) ±0 (No data rate offset compensation performed) 1 (01) ±3.125% data rate offset 2 (10) ±6.25% data rate offset 3 (11) ±12.5% data rate offset CC1100 SWRS038D Page 78 of 92 0x1B: AGCCTRL2 – AGC Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 MAX_DVGA_GAIN[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Reduces the maximum allowable DVGA gain. Setting Allowable DVGA settings 0 (00) All gain settings can be used 1 (01) The highest gain setting can not be used 2 (10) The 2 highest gain settings can not be used 3 (11) The 3 highest gain settings can not be used 5:3 MAX_LNA_GAIN[2:0] 0 (000) R/W Sets the maximum allowable LNA + LNA 2 gain relative to the maximum possible gain. Setting Maximum allowable LNA + LNA 2 gain 0 (000) Maximum possible LNA + LNA 2 gain 1 (001) Approx. 2.6 dB below maximum possible gain 2 (010) Approx. 6.1 dB below maximum possible gain 3 (011) Approx. 7.4 dB below maximum possible gain 4 (100) Approx. 9.2 dB below maximum possible gain 5 (101) Approx. 11.5 dB below maximum possible gain 6 (110) Approx. 14.6 dB below maximum possible gain 7 (111) Approx. 17.1 dB below maximum possible gain 2:0 MAGN_TARGET[2:0] 3 (011) R/W These bits set the target value for the averaged amplitude from the digital channel filter (1 LSB = 0 dB). Setting Target amplitude from channel filter 0 (000) 24 dB 1 (001) 27 dB 2 (010) 30 dB 3 (011) 33 dB 4 (100) 36 dB 5 (101) 38 dB 6 (110) 40 dB 7 (111) 42 dB CC1100 SWRS038D Page 79 of 92 0x1C: AGCCTRL1 – AGC Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved R0 6 AGC_LNA_PRIORITY 1 R/W Selects between two different strategies for LNA and LNA 2 gain adjustment. When 1, the LNA gain is decreased first. When 0, the LNA 2 gain is decreased to minimum before decreasing LNA gain. 5:4 CARRIER_SENSE_REL_THR[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Sets the relative change threshold for asserting carrier sense Setting Carrier sense relative threshold 0 (00) Relative carrier sense threshold disabled 1 (01) 6 dB increase in RSSI value 2 (10) 10 dB increase in RSSI value 3 (11) 14 dB increase in RSSI value 3:0 CARRIER_SENSE_ABS_THR[3:0] 0 (0000) R/W Sets the absolute RSSI threshold for asserting carrier sense. The 2-complement signed threshold is programmed in steps of 1 dB and is relative to the MAGN_TARGET setting. Setting Carrier sense absolute threshold (Equal to channel filter amplitude when AGC has not decreased gain) -8 (1000) Absolute carrier sense threshold disabled -7 (1001) 7 dB below MAGN_TARGET setting … … -1 (1111) 1 dB below MAGN_TARGET setting 0 (0000) At MAGN_TARGET setting 1 (0001) 1 dB above MAGN_TARGET setting … … 7 (0111) 7 dB above MAGN_TARGET setting CC1100 SWRS038D Page 80 of 92 0x1D: AGCCTRL0 – AGC Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 HYST_LEVEL[1:0] 2 (10) R/W Sets the level of hysteresis on the magnitude deviation (internal AGC signal that determine gain changes). Setting Description 0 (00) No hysteresis, small symmetric dead zone, high gain 1 (01) Low hysteresis, small asymmetric dead zone, medium gain 2 (10) Medium hysteresis, medium asymmetric dead zone, medium gain 3 (11) Large hysteresis, large asymmetric dead zone, low gain 5:4 WAIT_TIME[1:0] 1 (01) R/W Sets the number of channel filter samples from a gain adjustment has been made until the AGC algorithm starts accumulating new samples. Setting Channel filter samples 0 (00) 8 1 (01) 16 2 (10) 24 3 (11) 32 3:2 AGC_FREEZE[1:0] 0 (00) R/W Control when the AGC gain should be frozen. Setting Function 0 (00) Normal operation. Always adjust gain when required. 1 (01) The gain setting is frozen when a sync word has been found. 2 (10) Manually freeze the analogue gain setting and continue to adjust the digital gain. 3 (11) Manually freezes both the analogue and the digital gain setting. Used for manually overriding the gain. 1:0 FILTER_LENGTH[1:0] 1 (01) R/W Sets the averaging length for the amplitude from the channel filter. Sets the OOK/ASK decision boundary for OOK/ASK reception. Setting Channel filter samples OOK decision 0 (00) 8 4 dB 1 (01) 16 8 dB 2 (10) 32 12 dB 3 (11) 64 16 dB 0x1E: WOREVT1 – High Byte Event0 Timeout Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 EVENT0[15:8] 135 (0x87) R/W High byte of EVENT0 timeout register WOR RES XOSC Event EVENT f t 5 _ 0 = 750 ⋅ 0⋅ 2 ⋅ CC1100 SWRS038D Page 81 of 92 0x1F: WOREVT0 –Low Byte Event0 Timeout Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 EVENT0[7:0] 107 (0x6B) R/W Low byte of EVENT0 timeout register. The default EVENT0 value gives 1.0s timeout, assuming a 26.0 MHz crystal. 0x20: WORCTRL – Wake On Radio Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 RC_PD 1 R/W Power down signal to RC oscillator. When written to 0, automatic initial calibration will be performed 6:4 EVENT1[2:0] 7 (111) R/W Timeout setting from register block. Decoded to Event 1 timeout. RC oscillator clock frequency equals FXOSC/750, which is 34.7 – 36 kHz, depending on crystal frequency. The table below lists the number of clock periods after Event 0 before Event 1 times out. Setting tEvent1 0 (000) 4 (0.111 – 0.115 ms) 1 (001) 6 (0.167 – 0.173 ms) 2 (010) 8 (0.222 – 0.230 ms) 3 (011) 12 (0.333 – 0.346 ms) 4 (100) 16 (0.444 – 0.462 ms) 5 (101) 24 (0.667 – 0.692 ms) 6 (110) 32 (0.889 – 0.923 ms) 7 (111) 48 (1.333 – 1.385 ms) 3 RC_CAL 1 R/W Enables (1) or disables (0) the RC oscillator calibration. 2 Reserved R0 1:0 WOR_RES 0 (00) R/W Controls the Event 0 resolution as well as maximum timeout of the WOR module and maximum timeout under normal RX operation:: Setting Resolution (1 LSB) Max timeout 0 (00) 1 period (28μs – 29μs) 1.8 – 1.9 seconds 1 (01) 25 periods (0.89ms –0.92 ms) 58 – 61 seconds 2 (10) 210 periods (28 – 30 ms) 31 – 32 minutes 3 (11) 215 periods (0.91 – 0.94 s) 16.5 – 17.2 hours Note that WOR_RES should be 0 or 1 when using WOR because WOR_RES > 1 will give a very low duty cycle. In normal RX operation all settings of WOR_RES can be used. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 82 of 92 0x21: FREND1 – Front End RX Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 LNA_CURRENT[1:0] 1 (01) R/W Adjusts front-end LNA PTAT current output 5:4 LNA2MIX_CURRENT[1:0] 1 (01) R/W Adjusts front-end PTAT outputs 3:2 LODIV_BUF_CURRENT_RX[1:0] 1 (01) R/W Adjusts current in RX LO buffer (LO input to mixer) 1:0 MIX_CURRENT[1:0] 2 (10) R/W Adjusts current in mixer 0x22: FREND0 – Front End TX Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 Reserved R0 5:4 LODIV_BUF_CURRENT_TX[1:0] 1 (0x01) R/W Adjusts current TX LO buffer (input to PA). The value to use in this field is given by the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. 3 Reserved R0 2:0 PA_POWER[2:0] 0 (0x00) R/W Selects PA power setting. This value is an index to the PATABLE, which can be programmed with up to 8 different PA settings. In OOK/ASK mode, this selects the PATABLE index to use when transmitting a ‘1’. PATABLE index zero is used in OOK/ASK when transmitting a ‘0’. The PATABLE settings from index ‘0’ to the PA_POWER value are used for ASK TX shaping, and for power ramp-up/ramp-down at the start/end of transmission in all TX modulation formats. 0x23: FSCAL3 – Frequency Synthesizer Calibration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 FSCAL3[7:6] 2 (0x02) R/W Frequency synthesizer calibration configuration. The value to write in this field before calibration is given by the SmartRF® Studio software. 5:4 CHP_CURR_CAL_EN[1:0] 2 (0x02) R/W Enable charge pump calibration stage when 1 3:0 FSCAL3[3:0] 9 (1001) R/W Frequency synthesizer calibration result register. Digital bit vector defining the charge pump output current, on an exponential scale: IOUT = I0·2FSCAL3[3:0]/4 Fast frequency hopping without calibration for each hop can be done by calibrating upfront for each frequency and saving the resulting FSCAL3, FSCAL2 and FSCAL1 register values. Between each frequency hop, calibration can be replaced by writing the FSCAL3, FSCAL2 and FSCAL1 register values corresponding to the next RF frequency. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 83 of 92 0x24: FSCAL2 – Frequency Synthesizer Calibration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 Reserved R0 5 VCO_CORE_H_EN 0 R/W Choose high (1) / low (0) VCO 4:0 FSCAL2[4:0] 10 (0x0A) R/W Frequency synthesizer calibration result register. VCO current calibration result and override value Fast frequency hopping without calibration for each hop can be done by calibrating upfront for each frequency and saving the resulting FSCAL3, FSCAL2 and FSCAL1 register values. Between each frequency hop, calibration can be replaced by writing the FSCAL3, FSCAL2 and FSCAL1 register values corresponding to the next RF frequency. 0x25: FSCAL1 – Frequency Synthesizer Calibration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:6 Reserved R0 5:0 FSCAL1[5:0] 32 (0x20) R/W Frequency synthesizer calibration result register. Capacitor array setting for VCO coarse tuning. Fast frequency hopping without calibration for each hop can be done by calibrating upfront for each frequency and saving the resulting FSCAL3, FSCAL2 and FSCAL1 register values. Between each frequency hop, calibration can be replaced by writing the FSCAL3, FSCAL2 and FSCAL1 register values corresponding to the next RF frequency. 0x26: FSCAL0 – Frequency Synthesizer Calibration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved R0 6:0 FSCAL0[6:0] 13 (0x0D) R/W Frequency synthesizer calibration control. The value to use in this register is given by the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. 0x27: RCCTRL1 – RC Oscillator Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved 0 R0 6:0 RCCTRL1[6:0] 65 (0x41) R/W RC oscillator configuration. 0x28: RCCTRL0 – RC Oscillator Configuration Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved 0 R0 6:0 RCCTRL0[6:0] 0 (0x00) R/W RC oscillator configuration. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 84 of 92 33.2 Configuration Register Details – Registers that Lose Programming in SLEEP State 0x29: FSTEST – Frequency Synthesizer Calibration Control Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 FSTEST[7:0] 89 (0x59) R/W For test only. Do not write to this register. 0x2A: PTEST – Production Test Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 PTEST[7:0] 127 (0x7F) R/W Writing 0xBF to this register makes the on-chip temperature sensor available in the IDLE state. The default 0x7F value should then be written back before leaving the IDLE state. Other use of this register is for test only. 0x2B: AGCTEST – AGC Test Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 AGCTEST[7:0] 63 (0x3F) R/W For test only. Do not write to this register. 0x2C: TEST2 – Various Test Settings Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 TEST2[7:0] 136 (0x88) R/W The value to use in this register is given by the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. 0x2D: TEST1 – Various Test Settings Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 TEST1[7:0] 49 (0x31) R/W The value to use in this register is given by the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. 0x2E: TEST0 – Various Test Settings Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:2 TEST0[7:2] 2 (0x02) R/W The value to use in this register is given by the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. 1 VCO_SEL_CAL_EN 1 R/W Enable VCO selection calibration stage when 1 0 TEST0[0] 1 R/W The value to use in this register is given by the SmartRF® Studio software [7]. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 85 of 92 33.3 Status Register Details 0x30 (0xF0): PARTNUM – Chip ID Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 PARTNUM[7:0] 0 (0x00) R Chip part number 0x31 (0xF1): VERSION – Chip ID Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 VERSION[7:0] 3 (0x03) R Chip version number. 0x32 (0xF2): FREQEST – Frequency Offset Estimate from Demodulator Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 FREQOFF_EST R The estimated frequency offset (2’s complement) of the carrier. Resolution is FXTAL/214 (1.59 - 1.65 kHz); range is ±202 kHz to ±210 kHz, dependent of XTAL frequency. Frequency offset compensation is only supported for 2-FSK, GFSK, and MSK modulation. This register will read 0 when using ASK or OOK modulation. 0x33 (0xF3): LQI – Demodulator Estimate for Link Quality Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 CRC OK R The last CRC comparison matched. Cleared when entering/restarting RX mode. 6:0 LQI_EST[6:0] R The Link Quality Indicator estimates how easily a received signal can be demodulated. Calculated over the 64 symbols following the sync word 0x34 (0xF4): RSSI – Received Signal Strength Indication Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 RSSI R Received signal strength indicator CC1100 SWRS038D Page 86 of 92 0x35 (0xF5): MARCSTATE – Main Radio Control State Machine State Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:5 Reserved R0 4:0 MARC_STATE[4:0] R Main Radio Control FSM State Value State name State (Figure 16, page 42) 0 (0x00) SLEEP SLEEP 1 (0x01) IDLE IDLE 2 (0x02) XOFF XOFF 3 (0x03) VCOON_MC MANCAL 4 (0x04) REGON_MC MANCAL 5 (0x05) MANCAL MANCAL 6 (0x06) VCOON FS_WAKEUP 7 (0x07) REGON FS_WAKEUP 8 (0x08) STARTCAL CALIBRATE 9 (0x09) BWBOOST SETTLING 10 (0x0A) FS_LOCK SETTLING 11 (0x0B) IFADCON SETTLING 12 (0x0C) ENDCAL CALIBRATE 13 (0x0D) RX RX 14 (0x0E) RX_END RX 15 (0x0F) RX_RST RX 16 (0x10) TXRX_SWITCH TXRX_SETTLING 17 (0x11) RXFIFO_OVERFLOW RXFIFO_OVERFLOW 18 (0x12) FSTXON FSTXON 19 (0x13) TX TX 20 (0x14) TX_END TX 21 (0x15) RXTX_SWITCH RXTX_SETTLING 22 (0x16) TXFIFO_UNDERFLOW TXFIFO_UNDERFLOW Note: it is not possible to read back the SLEEP or XOFF state numbers because setting CSn low will make the chip enter the IDLE mode from the SLEEP or XOFF states. 0x36 (0xF6): WORTIME1 – High Byte of WOR Time Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 TIME[15:8] R High byte of timer value in WOR module 0x37 (0xF7): WORTIME0 – Low Byte of WOR Time Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 TIME[7:0] R Low byte of timer value in WOR module CC1100 SWRS038D Page 87 of 92 0x38 (0xF8): PKTSTATUS – Current GDOx Status and Packet Status Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 CRC_OK R The last CRC comparison matched. Cleared when entering/restarting RX mode. 6 CS R Carrier sense 5 PQT_REACHED R Preamble Quality reached 4 CCA R Channel is clear 3 SFD R Sync word found 2 GDO2 R Current GDO2 value. Note: the reading gives the non-inverted value irrespective of what IOCFG2.GDO2_INV is programmed to. It is not recommended to check for PLL lock by reading PKTSTATUS[2] with GDO2_CFG=0x0A. 1 Reserved R0 0 GDO0 R Current GDO0 value. Note: the reading gives the non-inverted value irrespective of what IOCFG0.GDO0_INV is programmed to. It is not recommended to check for PLL lock by reading PKTSTATUS[0] with GDO0_CFG=0x0A. 0x39 (0xF9): VCO_VC_DAC – Current Setting from PLL Calibration Module Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7:0 VCO_VC_DAC[7:0] R Status register for test only. 0x3A (0xFA): TXBYTES – Underflow and Number of Bytes Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 TXFIFO_UNDERFLOW R 6:0 NUM_TXBYTES R Number of bytes in TX FIFO 0x3B (0xFB): RXBYTES – Overflow and Number of Bytes Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 RXFIFO_OVERFLOW R 6:0 NUM_RXBYTES R Number of bytes in RX FIFO 0x3C (0xFC): RCCTRL1_STATUS – Last RC Oscillator Calibration Result Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved R0 6:0 RCCTRL1_STATUS[6:0] R Contains the value from the last run of the RC oscillator calibration routine. For usage description refer to AN047 [4] CC1100 SWRS038D Page 88 of 92 0x3D (0xFC): RCCTRL0_STATUS – Last RC Oscillator Calibration Result Bit Field Name Reset R/W Description 7 Reserved R0 6:0 RCCTRL0_STATUS[6:0] R Contains the value from the last run of the RC oscillator calibration routine. For usage description refer to Aplication Note AN047 [4]. 34 Package Description (QLP 20) 34.1 Recommended PCB Layout for Package (QLP 20) Figure 31: Recommended PCB Layout for QLP 20 Package Note: Figure 31 is an illustration only and not to scale. There are five 10 mil via holes distributed symmetrically in the ground pad under the package. See also the CC1100EM reference designs ([5] and [6]). 34.2 Soldering Information The recommendations for lead-free reflow in IPC/JEDEC J-STD-020 should be followed. CC1100 SWRS038D Page 89 of 92 35 Ordering Information Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead Finish MSL Peak Temp (3) CC1100RTKR NRND QLP RTK 20 3000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Cu NiPdAu LEVEL3-260C 1 YEAR CC1100RTK NRND QLP RTK 20 92 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Cu NiPdAu LEVEL3-260C 1 YEAR Table 39: Ordering Information CC1100 SWRS038D Page 90 of 92 36 References [1] CC1100 Errata Notes (swrz012.pdf) [2] AN001 SRD Regulations for Licence Free Transceiver Operation (swra090.pdf) [3] AN039 Using the CC1100 in the European 433 and 868 MHz ISM Bands (swra054.pdf) [4] AN047 CC1100/CC2500 – Wake-On-Radio (swra126.pdf) [5] CC1100EM 315 - 433 MHz Reference Design 1.0 (swrr037.zip) [6] CC1100EM 868 – 915 MHz Reference Design 2.0 (swrr038.zip) [7] SmartRF® Studio (swrc046.zip) [8] CC1100 CC2500 Examples Libraries (swrc021.zip) [9] CC1100/CC1150DK, CC1101DK, and CC2500/CC2550DK Examples and Libraries User Manual (swru109.pdf) CC1100 SWRS038D Page 91 of 92 37 General Information 37.1 Document History Revision Date Description/Changes SWRS038D 2009-05-26 Updated packet and ordering information. Removed Product Status Definition, Address Information and TI World Wide Support section. Removed Low-Cost from datasheet title. SWRS038C 2008-05-22 Added product information on front page SWRS038B 2007-07-09 Added info to ordering information Changes in the General Principle of Matrix Interleaving figure. Changes in Table: Bill Of Materials for the Application Circuit Changes in Figure: Typical Application and Evaluation Circuit 868/915 MHz Changed the equation for channel spacing in the MDMCFG0 register. kbps replaced by kBaud throughout the document. Some of the sections have been re-written to be easier to read without having any new info added. Absolute maximum supply voltage rating increased from 3.6 V to 3.9 V. Changed the frequency accuracy after calibration for the low power RC oscillator from ±0.3 to ±1 %. Updates to sensitivity and current consumption numbers listed under Key Features. FSK changed to 2-FSK throughout the document. Updates to the Abbreviation table. Updates to the Electrical Specifications section. Added info about RX and TX latency. Added info in the Pinout Overview table regarding GDO0 and GDO2. Changed current consumption in RX and TX in the simplified state diagram. Added info about default values after reset vs. optimum register settings in the Configuration Software section Changes to the SPI Interface Timing Requirements. Info added about tsp,pd The following figures have been changed: Configuration Registers Write and Read Operations, SRES Command Strobe, and Register Access Types. In the Register Access section, the address range is changed. In the PATABLE Access section, info is added regarding limitations on output power programming when using PA ramping. In the Packet Format section, preamble pattern is changed to 10101010 and info about bug related to turning off the transmitter in infinite packet length mode is added. Added info to the Frequency Offset Compensation section. Added info about the initial value of the PN9 sequence in the Data Whitening section. In the Packet Handling in Transmit Mode section, info about TX FIFO underflow state is added. Added section Packet Handling in Firmware. 0x00 is added as a valid PATABLE setting in addition to 0x30-0x3F when using ASK. In the PQT section a change is made as to how much the counter decreases. The RSSI value is in dBm and not dB. The whole CS Absolute Threshold section has been re-written and the equation calculating the threshold has been removed. Added info in the CCA section on what happens if the channel is not clear. Added info to the LQI section for better understanding. Removed all references to the voltage regulator in relation with the CHP_RDYn signal, as this signal is only related to the crystal. Removed references to the voltage regulator in the figures: Power-On Reset and Power-On Reset with SRES. Changes to the SI line in the Power-On Reset with SRES figure Added info on the three automatic calibration options. Removed the autosync feature from the WOR section and added info on how to exit WOR mode. Also added info about minimum sleep time and references to App. Note 047 together with info about calibration of the RC oscillator. The figure: Event 0 and Event 1 Relationship is changed for better readability. Info added to the Timing section related to reduced calibration time. The Output Power Programming section is divided into 2 new sections; Output Power Programming and Shaping and PA Ramping. Added info on programming of PATABLE when using OOK, and about PATABLE when entering SLEEP mode. 2 new figures added to the Shaping and PA Ramping section: Shaping of ASK Signal and PA Ramping, together with one new table: PATABLE Settings Used Together with ASK Shaping and PA Ramping. Changed made to current consumption in the Optimum PATABLE Settings for Various Output Power Levels and Frequency Bands table. Added section Layout Recommendations. In section General Purpose / Test Output Control Pins: Added info on GDO pins in SLEEP CC1100 SWRS038D Page 92 of 92 Revision Date Description/Changes state. Better explanation of some of the signals in the GDOx Signal Selection table. Also added some more signals. Asynchronous transparent mode is called asynchronous serial mode throughout the document. Removed comments about having to use NRZ coding in synchronous serial mode. Added info that Manschester encoding cannot be used in this mode. Added a third calibration method plus additional info about the 3 methods in the Frequency Hopping and Multi-Channel Systems section. Added info about differential antenna in the Low Cost Systems section. Changes number of commands strobes from 14 to 13. Changed description of SFRX, SFTX, SWORRST, and SNOP in the Command Strobes table. Added two new registers; RCCTRL1_STATUS and RCCTRL0_STATUS Changed field name and/or description of the following registers: PKTCTRL1, MCSM2, MCSM0, WORCTRL, FSCAL3, FSCAL2, FSCAL1, and TEST0. Changed tray width in the Tray Specification table. Added references. SWRS038A 2006-06-20 Updates to Electrical Specifications due to increased amount of measurement data. Updated application circuit for 868 MHz. Updated balun component values. Updated current consumption figures in state diagrams. Added figures to table on SPI interface timing requirements. Added information about SPI read. Added table for channel filter bandwidths. Added figure showing data whitening. Updates to text and included new figure in section on arbitrary length configuration. References to SAFC strobe removed. Added additional information about support of ASK modulation. Added information about CRC filtering. Added information about sync word qualifier. Added information on RSSI offset, RSSI update rate, RSSI calculation and typical RSSI curves. Added information on CS and tables with register settings versus CS threshold. Updates to text and included new figures in section on power-on start-up sequence. Changes to wake-on-radio current consumption figures under electrical specifications. Updates to text in section on data FIFO. Corrected formula for calculation of output frequency in Frequency Programming section. Added information about how to check for PLL lock in section on VCO. Corrected table with PATABLE setting versus output power. Added typical selectivity curves for selected datarates. Added information on how to interface external clock signal. Added optimal match impedances in RF match section. Better explanation of some of the signals in table of GDO signal selection. Also added some more signals. Added information on system considerations. Added CRC_AUTOFLUSH option in PCTRL1 register. Added information on timeout for sync word search in RX in register MCSM2. Changes to wake-on-radio control register WORCTRL. WOR_RES[1:0] settings 10 b and 11b changed to NA. Added more detailed information on PO_TIMEOUT in register MCSM0. Added description of programming bits in registers FOCCFG, BSCFG, AGCCTRL2, AGCCTRL1, AGCCTRL0, FREND1, FSCAL3. 1.0 2005-04-25 First preliminary Data Sheet release Table 40: Document History PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 24-Apr-2014 Addendum-Page 1 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish (6) MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) Samples CC1100-RTR1 NRND VQFN RTK 20 3000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 CC1100 CC1100-RTY1 NRND VQFN RTK 20 92 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 CC1100 CC1100RTK NRND VQFN RTK 20 92 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 CC1100 CC1100RTKG3 NRND VQFN RTK 20 92 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 CC1100 CC1100RTKR NRND VQFN RTK 20 3000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 CC1100 (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 24-Apr-2014 Addendum-Page 2 (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Reel Diameter (mm) Reel Width W1 (mm) A0 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W (mm) Pin1 Quadrant CC1100RTKR VQFN RTK 20 3000 330.0 12.4 4.3 4.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q2 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 15-Jan-2014 Pack Materials-Page 1 *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) CC1100RTKR VQFN RTK 20 3000 338.1 338.1 20.6 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 15-Jan-2014 Pack Materials-Page 2 IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Low Cost, Low Power, True RMS-to-DC Converter Data Sheet AD736 Rev. I Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other rights of third parties that may result from its use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A. Tel: 781.329.4700 www.analog.com Fax: 781.461.3113 ©1988–2012 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. FEATURES Converts an ac voltage waveform to a dc voltage and then converts to the true rms, average rectified, or absolute value 200 mV rms full-scale input range (larger inputs with input attenuator) High input impedance: 1012 Ω Low input bias current: 25 pA maximum High accuracy: ±0.3 mV ± 0.3% of reading RMS conversion with signal crest factors up to 5 Wide power supply range: +2.8 V, −3.2 V to ±16.5 V Low power: 200 μA maximum supply current Buffered voltage output No external trims needed for specified accuracy Related device: the AD737—features a power-down control with standby current of only 25 μA; the dc output voltage is negative and the output impedance is 8 kΩ GENERAL DESCRIPTION The AD736 is a low power, precision, monolithic true rms-to-dc converter. It is laser trimmed to provide a maximum error of ±0.3 mV ± 0.3% of reading with sine wave inputs. Furthermore, it maintains high accuracy while measuring a wide range of input waveforms, including variable duty-cycle pulses and triac (phase)-controlled sine waves. The low cost and small size of this converter make it suitable for upgrading the performance of non-rms precision rectifiers in many applications. Compared to these circuits, the AD736 offers higher accuracy at an equal or lower cost. The AD736 can compute the rms value of both ac and dc input voltages. It can also be operated as an ac-coupled device by adding one external capacitor. In this mode, the AD736 can resolve input signal levels of 100 μV rms or less, despite variations in temperature or supply voltage. High accuracy is also maintained for input waveforms with crest factors of 1 to 3. In addition, crest factors as high as 5 can be measured (introducing only 2.5% additional error) at the 200 mV full-scale input level. The AD736 has its own output buffer amplifier, thereby pro-viding a great deal of design flexibility. Requiring only 200 μA of power supply current, the AD736 is optimized for use in portable multimeters and other battery-powered applications. FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM CC8kΩ–VSCAVCOMVINCAVOUTFULL WAVERECTIFIERRMSCORE8kΩCF(OPT)CFBIASSECTION+VS00834-001 Figure 1. The AD736 allows the choice of two signal input terminals: a high impedance FET input (1012 Ω) that directly interfaces with High-Z input attenuators and a low impedance input (8 kΩ) that allows the measurement of 300 mV input levels while operating from the minimum power supply voltage of +2.8 V, −3.2 V. The two inputs can be used either single ended or differentially. The AD736 has a 1% reading error bandwidth that exceeds 10 kHz for the input amplitudes from 20 mV rms to 200 mV rms while consuming only 1 mW. The AD736 is available in four performance grades. The AD736J and AD736K grades are rated over the 0°C to +70°C and −20°C to +85°C commercial temperature ranges. The AD736A and AD736B grades are rated over the −40°C to +85°C industrial temperature range. The AD736 is available in three low cost, 8-lead packages: PDIP, SOIC, and CERDIP. PRODUCT HIGHLIGHTS 1. The AD736 is capable of computing the average rectified value, absolute value, or true rms value of various input signals. 2. Only one external component, an averaging capacitor, is required for the AD736 to perform true rms measurement. 3. The low power consumption of 1 mW makes the AD736 suitable for many battery-powered applications. 4. A high input impedance of 1012 Ω eliminates the need for an external buffer when interfacing with input attenuators. 5. A low impedance input is available for those applications that require an input signal up to 300 mV rms operating from low power supply voltages. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 1  Low Supply-Voltage Range: 1.8 V to 3.6 V  Ultralow Power Consumption − Active Mode: 330 μA at 1 MHz, 2.2 V − Standby Mode: 1.1 μA − Off Mode (RAM Retention): 0.2 μA  Five Power-Saving Modes  Wake-Up From Standby Mode in Less Than 6 μs  16-Bit RISC Architecture, 125-ns Instruction Cycle Time  Three-Channel Internal DMA  12-Bit Analog-to-Digital (A/D) Converter With Internal Reference, Sample-and-Hold, and Autoscan Feature  Dual 12-Bit Digital-to-Analog (D/A) Converters With Synchronization  16-Bit Timer_A With Three Capture/Compare Registers  16-Bit Timer_B With Three or Seven Capture/Compare-With-Shadow Registers  On-Chip Comparator  Serial Communication Interface (USART0), Functions as Asynchronous UART or Synchronous SPI or I2CTM Interface  Serial Communication Interface (USART1), Functions as Asynchronous UART or Synchronous SPI Interface  Supply Voltage Supervisor/Monitor With Programmable Level Detection  Brownout Detector  Bootstrap Loader I2C is a registered trademark of Philips Incorporated.  Serial Onboard Programming, No External Programming Voltage Needed, Programmable Code Protection by Security Fuse  Family Members Include − MSP430F155 16KB+256B Flash Memory 512B RAM − MSP430F156 24KB+256B Flash Memory 1KB RAM − MSP430F157 32KB+256B Flash Memory, 1KB RAM − MSP430F167 32KB+256B Flash Memory, 1KB RAM − MSP430F168 48KB+256B Flash Memory, 2KB RAM − MSP430F169 60KB+256B Flash Memory, 2KB RAM − MSP430F1610 32KB+256B Flash Memory 5KB RAM − MSP430F1611 48KB+256B Flash Memory 10KB RAM − MSP430F1612 55KB+256B Flash Memory 5KB RAM  Available in 64-Pin QFP Package (PM) and 64-Pin QFN Package (RTD)  For Complete Module Descriptions, See the MSP430x1xx Family User’s Guide, Literature Number SLAU049 description The Texas Instruments MSP430 family of ultralow power microcontrollers consist of several devices featuring different sets of peripherals targeted for various applications. The architecture, combined with five low power modes is optimized to achieve extended battery life in portable measurement applications. The device features a powerful 16-bit RISC CPU, 16-bit registers, and constant generators that contribute to maximum code efficiency. The digitally controlled oscillator (DCO) allows wake-up from low-power modes to active mode in less than 6 μs. This integrated circuit can be damaged by ESD. Texas Instruments recommends that all integrated circuits be handled with appropriate precautions. Failure to observe proper handling and installation procedures can cause damage. ESD damage can range from subtle performance degradation to complete device failure. Precision integrated circuits may be more susceptible to damage because very small parametric changes could cause the device not to meet its published specifications. These devices have limited built-in ESD protection. PRODUCTION DATA information is current as of publication date. Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Products conform to specifications per the terms of Texas Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not necessarily include testing of all parameters. Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 2 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 description (continued) The MSP430F15x/16x/161x series are microcontroller configurations with two built-in 16-bit timers, a fast 12-bit A/D converter, dual 12-bit D/A converter, one or two universal serial synchronous/asynchronous communication interfaces (USART), I2C, DMA, and 48 I/O pins. In addition, the MSP430F161x series offers extended RAM addressing for memory-intensive applications and large C-stack requirements. Typical applications include sensor systems, industrial control applications, hand-held meters, etc. AVAILABLE OPTIONS T PACKAGED DEVICES TA PLASTIC 64-PIN QFP (PM) PLASTIC 64-PIN QFN (RTD) −40°C to 85°C MSP430F155IPM MSP430F156IPM MSP430F157IPM MSP430F167IPM MSP430F168IPM MSP430F169IPM MSP430F1610IPM MSP430F1611IPM MSP430F1612IPM MSP430F155IRTD MSP430F156IRTD MSP430F157IRTD MSP430F167IRTD MSP430F168IRTD MSP430F169IRTD MSP430F1610IRTD MSP430F1611IRTD MSP430F1612IRTD † For the most current package and ordering information, see the Package Option Addendum at the end of this document, or see the TI web site at www.ti.com. ‡ Package drawings, thermal data, and symbolization are available at www.ti.com/packaging. DEVELOPMENT TOOL SUPPORT All MSP430 microcontrollers include an Embedded Emulation Module (EEM) allowing advanced debugging and programming through easy to use development tools. Recommended hardware options include the following:  Debugging and Programming Interface − MSP-FET430UIF (USB) − MSP-FET430PIF (Parallel Port)  Debugging and Programming Interface with Target Board − MSP-FET430U64 (PM package)  Standalone Target Board − MSP-TS430PM64 (PM package)  Production Programmer − MSP-GANG430 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 3 pin designation, MSP430F155, MSP430F156, and MSP430F157 17 18 19 P5.4/MCLK P5.3 P5.2 P5.1 P5.0 P4.7/TBCLK P4.6 P4.5 P4.4 P4.3 P4.2/TB2 P4.1/TB1 P4.0/TB0 P3.7 P3.6 P3.5/URXD0 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 20 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 DVCC P6.3/A3 P6.4/A4 P6.5/A5 P6.6/A6/DAC0 P6.7/A7/DAC1/SVSIN VREF+ XIN XOUT VeREF+ VREF−/VeREF− P1.0/TACLK P1.1/TA0 P1.2/TA1 P1.3/TA2 P1.4/SMCLK 21 22 23 24 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 25 26 27 28 29 53 52 51 50 49 30 31 32 PM, RTD PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) AVCC DVSS AVSS P6.2/A2 P6.1/A1 P6.0/A0 RST/NMI TCK TMS TDI/TCLK TDO/TDI XT2IN XT2OUT P5.7/TBOUTH/SVSOUT P5.6/ACLK P5.5/SMCLK P1.5/TA0 P1.6/TA1 P1.7/TA2 P2.0/ACLK P2.1/TAINCLK P2.2/CAOUT/TA0 P2.3/CA0/TA1 P2.4/CA1/TA2 P2.5/ROSC P2.6/ADC12CLK/DMAE0 P2.7/TA0 P3.0/STE0 P3.1/SIMO0/SDA P3.2/SOMI0 P3.3/UCLK0/SCL P3.4/UTXD0 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 4 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 pin designation, MSP430F167, MSP430F168, MSP430F169 17 18 19 P5.4/MCLK P5.3/UCLK1 P5.2/SOMI1 P5.1/SIMO1 P5.0/STE1 P4.7/TBCLK P4.6/TB6 P4.5/TB5 P4.4/TB4 P4.3/TB3 P4.2/TB2 P4.1/TB1 P4.0/TB0 P3.7/URXD1 P3.6/UTXD1 P3.5/URXD0 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 20 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 DVCC P6.3/A3 P6.4/A4 P6.5/A5 P6.6/A6/DAC0 P6.7/A7/DAC1/SVSIN VREF+ XIN XOUT VeREF+ VREF−/VeREF− P1.0/TACLK P1.1/TA0 P1.2/TA1 P1.3/TA2 P1.4/SMCLK 21 22 23 24 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 25 26 27 28 29 53 52 51 50 49 30 31 32 PM, RTD PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) AVCC DVSS AVSS P6.2/A2 P6.1/A1 P6.0/A0 RST/NMI TCK TMS TDI/TCLK TDO/TDI XT2IN XT2OUT P5.7/TBOUTH/SVSOUT P5.6/ACLK P5.5/SMCLK P1.5/TA0 P1.6/TA1 P1.7/TA2 P2.0/ACLK P2.1/TAINCLK P2.2/CAOUT/TA0 P2.3/CA0/TA1 P2.4/CA1/TA2 P2.5/ROSC P2.6/ADC12CLK/DMAE0 P2.7/TA0 P3.0/STE0 P3.1/SIMO0/SDA P3.2/SOMI0 P3.3/UCLK0/SCL P3.4/UTXD0 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 5 pin designation, MSP430F1610, MSP430F1611, MSP430F1612 17 18 19 P5.4/MCLK P5.3/UCLK1 P5.2/SOMI1 P5.1/SIMO1 P5.0/STE1 P4.7/TBCLK P4.6/TB6 P4.5/TB5 P4.4/TB4 P4.3/TB3 P4.2/TB2 P4.1/TB1 P4.0/TB0 P3.7/URXD1 P3.6/UTXD1 P3.5/URXD0 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 20 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 DVCC P6.3/A3 P6.4/A4 P6.5/A5 P6.6/A6/DAC0 P6.7/A7/DAC1/SVSIN VREF+ XIN XOUT VeREF+ VREF−/VeREF− P1.0/TACLK P1.1/TA0 P1.2/TA1 P1.3/TA2 P1.4/SMCLK 21 22 23 24 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 25 26 27 28 29 53 52 51 50 49 30 31 32 PM, RTD PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) AVCC DVSS AVSS P6.2/A2 P6.1/A1 P6.0/A0 RST/NMI TCK TMS TDI/TCLK TDO/TDI XT2IN XT2OUT P5.7/TBOUTH/SVSOUT P5.6/ACLK P5.5/SMCLK P1.5/TA0 P1.6/TA1 P1.7/TA2 P2.0/ACLK P2.1/TAINCLK P2.2/CAOUT/TA0 P2.3/CA0/TA1 P2.4/CA1/TA2 P2.5/ROSC P2.6/ADC12CLK/DMAE0 P2.7/TA0 P3.0/STE0 P3.1/SIMO0/SDA P3.2/SOMI0 P3.3/UCLK0/SCL P3.4/UTXD0 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 6 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 functional block diagram, MSP430F15x Oscillator ACLK SMCLK CPU Incl. 16 Reg. Bus Conv MCB XIN XOUT P2 P3 P4 XT2IN XT2OUT TMS TCK MDB, 16 Bit MAB, 16 Bit MCLK 4 TDI/TCLK TDO/TDI P5 P6 MAB, 4 Bit DVCC DVSS AVCC AVSS RST/NMI System Clock ROSC P1 32KB Flash 24KB Flash 16KB Flash 1KB RAM 1KB RAM 512B RAM ADC12 12-Bit 8 Channels <10μs Conv. DAC12 12-Bit 2 Channels Voltage out DMA Controller 3 Channels Watchdog Timer 15/16-Bit Timer_B3 3 CC Reg Shadow Reg Timer_A3 3 CC Reg Test JTAG Emulation Module I/O Port 1/2 16 I/Os, with Interrupt Capability I/O Port 3/4 16 I/Os POR SVS Brownout Comparator A USART0 UART Mode SPI Mode I2C Mode I/O Port 5/6 16 I/Os MDB, 16-Bit MDB, 8 Bit MAB, 16-Bit 8 8 8 8 8 8 functional block diagram, MSP430F16x Oscillator ACLK SMCLK CPU Incl. 16 Reg. Bus Conv MCB XIN XOUT P2 P3 P4 XT2IN XT2OUT TMS TCK MDB, 16 Bit MAB, 16 Bit MCLK 4 TDI/TCLK TDO/TDI P5 P6 MAB, 4 Bit DVCC DVSS AVCC AVSS RST/NMI System Clock ROSC P1 Hardware Multiplier MPY, MPYS MAC,MACS 60KB Flash 48KB Flash 32KB Flash 2KB RAM 2KB RAM 1KB RAM ADC12 12-Bit 8 Channels <10μs Conv. DAC12 12-Bit 2 Channels Voltage out DMA Controller 3 Channels Watchdog Timer 15/16-Bit Timer_B7 7 CC Reg Shadow Reg Timer_A3 3 CC Reg Test JTAG Emulation Module I/O Port 1/2 16 I/Os, with Interrupt Capability I/O Port 3/4 16 I/Os POR SVS Brownout Comparator A USART0 UART Mode SPI Mode I2C Mode USART1 UART Mode SPI Mode I/O Port 5/6 16 I/Os MDB, 16-Bit MDB, 8 Bit MAB, 16-Bit 8 8 8 8 8 8 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 7 functional block diagram, MSP430F161x Oscillator ACLK SMCLK CPU Incl. 16 Reg. Bus Conv MCB XIN XOUT P2 P3 P4 XT2IN XT2OUT TMS TCK MDB, 16 Bit MAB, 16 Bit MCLK 4 TDI/TCLK TDO/TDI P5 P6 MAB, 4 Bit DVCC DVSS AVCC AVSS RST/NMI System Clock ROSC P1 Hardware Multiplier MPY, MPYS MAC,MACS 55KB Flash 48KB Flash 32KB Flash 5KB RAM 10KB RAM 5KB RAM ADC12 12-Bit 8 Channels <10μs Conv. DAC12 12-Bit 2 Channels Voltage out DMA Controller 3 Channels Watchdog Timer 15/16-Bit Timer_B7 7 CC Reg Shadow Reg Timer_A3 3 CC Reg Test JTAG Emulation Module I/O Port 1/2 16 I/Os, with Interrupt Capability I/O Port 3/4 16 I/Os POR SVS Brownout Comparator A USART0 UART Mode SPI Mode I2C Mode USART1 UART Mode SPI Mode I/O Port 5/6 16 I/Os MDB, 16-Bit MDB, 8 Bit MAB, 16-Bit 8 8 8 8 8 8 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 8 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 Terminal Functions TERMINAL DESCRIPTION NAME NO. I/O AVCC 64 Analog supply voltage, positive terminal. Supplies only the analog portion of ADC12 and DAC12. AVSS 62 Analog supply voltage, negative terminal. Supplies only the analog portion of ADC12 and DAC12. DVCC 1 Digital supply voltage, positive terminal. Supplies all digital parts. DVSS 63 Digital supply voltage, negative terminal. Supplies all digital parts. P1.0/TACLK 12 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, clock signal TACLK input P1.1/TA0 13 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, capture: CCI0A input, compare: Out0 output/BSL transmit P1.2/TA1 14 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, capture: CCI1A input, compare: Out1 output P1.3/TA2 15 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, capture: CCI2A input, compare: Out2 output P1.4/SMCLK 16 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/SMCLK signal output P1.5/TA0 17 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, compare: Out0 output P1.6/TA1 18 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, compare: Out1 output P1.7/TA2 19 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, compare: Out2 output P2.0/ACLK 20 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/ACLK output P2.1/TAINCLK 21 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, clock signal at INCLK P2.2/CAOUT/TA0 22 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, capture: CCI0B input/Comparator_A output/BSL receive P2.3/CA0/TA1 23 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, compare: Out1 output/Comparator_A input P2.4/CA1/TA2 24 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, compare: Out2 output/Comparator_A input P2.5/Rosc 25 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/input for external resistor defining the DCO nominal frequency P2.6/ADC12CLK/ DMAE0 26 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/conversion clock – 12-bit ADC/DMA channel 0 external trigger P2.7/TA0 27 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_A, compare: Out0 output P3.0/STE0 28 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/slave transmit enable – USART0/SPI mode P3.1/SIMO0/SDA 29 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/slave in/master out of USART0/SPI mode, I2C data − USART0/I2C mode P3.2/SOMI0 30 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/slave out/master in of USART0/SPI mode P3.3/UCLK0/SCL 31 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/external clock input − USART0/UART or SPI mode, clock output – USART0/SPI mode, I2C clock − USART0/I2C mode P3.4/UTXD0 32 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/transmit data out – USART0/UART mode P3.5/URXD0 33 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/receive data in – USART0/UART mode P3.6/UTXD1† 34 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/transmit data out – USART1/UART mode P3.7/URXD1† 35 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/receive data in – USART1/UART mode P4.0/TB0 36 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, capture: CCI0A/B input, compare: Out0 output P4.1/TB1 37 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, capture: CCI1A/B input, compare: Out1 output P4.2/TB2 38 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, capture: CCI2A/B input, compare: Out2 output P4.3/TB3† 39 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, capture: CCI3A/B input, compare: Out3 output P4.4/TB4† 40 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, capture: CCI4A/B input, compare: Out4 output P4.5/TB5† 41 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, capture: CCI5A/B input, compare: Out5 output P4.6/TB6† 42 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, capture: CCI6A input, compare: Out6 output P4.7/TBCLK 43 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/Timer_B, clock signal TBCLK input P5.0/STE1† 44 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/slave transmit enable – USART1/SPI mode P5.1/SIMO1† 45 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/slave in/master out of USART1/SPI mode P5.2/SOMI1† 46 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/slave out/master in of USART1/SPI mode P5.3/UCLK1† 47 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/external clock input – USART1/UART or SPI mode, clock output – USART1/SPI mode † 16x, 161x devices only MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 9 Terminal Functions (Continued) TERMINAL DESCRIPTION NAME NO. I/O P5.4/MCLK 48 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/main system clock MCLK output P5.5/SMCLK 49 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/submain system clock SMCLK output P5.6/ACLK 50 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/auxiliary clock ACLK output P5.7/TBOUTH/ SVSOUT 51 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/switch all PWM digital output ports to high impedance − Timer_B TB0 to TB6/SVS comparator output P6.0/A0 59 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a0 – 12-bit ADC P6.1/A1 60 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a1 – 12-bit ADC P6.2/A2 61 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a2 – 12-bit ADC P6.3/A3 2 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a3 – 12-bit ADC P6.4/A4 3 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a4 – 12-bit ADC P6.5/A5 4 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a5 – 12-bit ADC P6.6/A6/DAC0 5 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a6 – 12-bit ADC/DAC12.0 output P6.7/A7/DAC1/ SVSIN 6 I/O General-purpose digital I/O pin/analog input a7 – 12-bit ADC/DAC12.1 output/SVS input RST/NMI 58 I Reset input, nonmaskable interrupt input port, or bootstrap loader start (in Flash devices). TCK 57 I Test clock. TCK is the clock input port for device programming test and bootstrap loader start TDI/TCLK 55 I Test data input or test clock input. The device protection fuse is connected to TDI/TCLK. TDO/TDI 54 I/O Test data output port. TDO/TDI data output or programming data input terminal TMS 56 I Test mode select. TMS is used as an input port for device programming and test. VeREF+ 10 I Input for an external reference voltage VREF+ 7 O Output of positive terminal of the reference voltage in the ADC12 VREF−/VeREF− 11 I Negative terminal for the reference voltage for both sources, the internal reference voltage, or an external applied reference voltage XIN 8 I Input port for crystal oscillator XT1. Standard or watch crystals can be connected. XOUT 9 O Output terminal of crystal oscillator XT1 XT2IN 53 I Input port for crystal oscillator XT2. Only standard crystals can be connected. XT2OUT 52 O Output terminal of crystal oscillator XT2 QFN Pad NA NA QFN package pad connection to DVSS recommended (RTD package only) General-Purpose Register Program Counter Stack Pointer Status Register Constant Generator General-Purpose Register General-Purpose Register General-Purpose Register PC/R0 SP/R1 SR/CG1/R2 CG2/R3 R4 R5 R12 R13 General-Purpose Register General-Purpose Register R6 R7 General-Purpose Register General-Purpose Register R8 R9 General-Purpose Register General-Purpose Register R10 R11 General-Purpose Register General-Purpose Register R14 R15 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 10 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 short-form description CPU The MSP430 CPU has a 16-bit RISC architecture that is highly transparent to the application. All operations, other than program-flow instructions, are performed as register operations in conjunction with seven addressing modes for source operand and four addressing modes for destination operand. The CPU is integrated with 16 registers that provide reduced instruction execution time. The register-to-register operation execution time is one cycle of the CPU clock. Four of the registers, R0 to R3, are dedicated as program counter, stack pointer, status register, and constant generator, respectively. The remaining registers are general-purpose registers. Peripherals are connected to the CPU using data, address, and control buses, and can be handled with all instructions. instruction set The instruction set consists of 51 instructions with three formats and seven address modes. Each instruction can operate on word and byte data. Table 1 shows examples of the three types of instruction formats; Table 2 shows the address modes. Table 1. Instruction Word Formats Dual operands, source-destination e.g., ADD R4,R5 R4 + R5 −−−> R5 Single operands, destination only e.g., CALL R8 PC −−>(TOS), R8−−> PC Relative jump, un/conditional e.g., JNE Jump-on-equal bit = 0 Table 2. Address Mode Descriptions ADDRESS MODE S D SYNTAX EXAMPLE OPERATION Register   MOV Rs,Rd MOV R10,R11 R10 −−> R11 Indexed   MOV X(Rn),Y(Rm) MOV 2(R5),6(R6) M(2+R5)−−> M(6+R6) Symbolic (PC relative)   MOV EDE,TONI M(EDE) −−> M(TONI) Absolute   MOV &MEM,&TCDAT M(MEM) −−> M(TCDAT) Indirect  MOV @Rn,Y(Rm) MOV @R10,Tab(R6) M(R10) −−> M(Tab+R6) Indirect autoincrement  MOV @Rn+,Rm MOV @R10+,R11 M(R10) −−> R11 R10 + 2−−> R10 Immediate  MOV #X,TONI MOV #45,TONI #45 −−> M(TONI) NOTE: S = source D = destination MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 11 operating modes The MSP430 has one active mode and five software selectable low-power modes of operation. An interrupt event can wake up the device from any of the five low-power modes, service the request, and restore back to the low-power mode on return from the interrupt program. The following six operating modes can be configured by software:  Active mode AM − All clocks are active  Low-power mode 0 (LPM0) − CPU is disabled − ACLK and SMCLK remain active. MCLK is disabled  Low-power mode 1 (LPM1) − CPU is disabled − ACLK and SMCLK remain active. MCLK is disabled − DCO’s dc generator is disabled if DCO not used in active mode  Low-power mode 2 (LPM2) − CPU is disabled − MCLK and SMCLK are disabled − DCO’s dc generator remains enabled − ACLK remains active  Low-power mode 3 (LPM3) − CPU is disabled − MCLK and SMCLK are disabled − DCO’s dc generator is disabled − ACLK remains active  Low-power mode 4 (LPM4) − CPU is disabled − ACLK is disabled − MCLK and SMCLK are disabled − DCO’s dc generator is disabled − Crystal oscillator is stopped MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 12 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 interrupt vector addresses The interrupt vectors and the power-up starting address are located in the address range 0FFFFh to 0FFE0h. The vector contains the 16-bit address of the appropriate interrupt-handler instruction sequence. INTERRUPT SOURCE INTERRUPT FLAG SYSTEM INTERRUPT WORD ADDRESS PRIORITY Power-up External Reset Watchdog Flash memory WDTIFG KEYV (see Note 1) Reset 0FFFEh 15, highest NMI Oscillator Fault Flash memory access violation NMIIFG (see Notes 1 and 3) OFIFG (see Notes 1 and 3) ACCVIFG (see Notes 1 and 3) (Non)maskable (Non)maskable (Non)maskable 0FFFCh 14 Timer_B7 (see Note 5) TBCCR0 CCIFG (see Note 2) Maskable 0FFFAh 13 Timer_B7 (see Note 5) TBCCR1 to TBCCR6 CCIFGs, TBIFG (see Notes 1 and 2) Maskable 0FFF8h 12 Comparator_A CAIFG Maskable 0FFF6h 11 Watchdog timer WDTIFG Maskable 0FFF4h 10 USART0 receive URXIFG0 Maskable 0FFF2h 9 USART0 transmit I2C transmit/receive/others UTXIFG0 I2CIFG (see Note 4) Maskable 0FFF0h 8 ADC12 ADC12IFG (see Notes 1 and 2) Maskable 0FFEEh 7 Timer_A3 TACCR0 CCIFG (see Note 2) Maskable 0FFECh 6 Timer_A3 TACCR1 and TACCR2 CCIFGs, TAIFG (see Notes 1 and 2) Maskable 0FFEAh 5 I/O port P1 (eight flags) P1IFG.0 to P1IFG.7 (see Notes 1 and 2) Maskable 0FFE8h 4 USART1 receive URXIFG1 Maskable 0FFE6h 3 USART1 transmit UTXIFG1 Maskable 0FFE4h 2 I/O port P2 (eight flags) P2IFG.0 to P2IFG.7 (see Notes 1 and 2) Maskable 0FFE2h 1 DAC12 DMA DAC12_0IFG, DAC12_1IFG DMA0IFG, DMA1IFG, DMA2IFG (see Notes 1 and 2) Maskable 0FFE0h 0, lowest NOTES: 1. Multiple source flags 2. Interrupt flags are located in the module. 3. (Non)maskable: the individual interrupt-enable bit can disable an interrupt event, but the general-interrupt enable cannot disable it. 4. I2C interrupt flags located in the module 5. Timer_B7 in MSP430F16x/161x family has 7 CCRs; Timer_B3 in MSP430F15x family has 3 CCRs; in Timer_B3 there are only interrupt flags TBCCR0, 1 and 2 CCIFGs and the interrupt-enable bits TBCCR0, 1 and 2 CCIEs. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 13 special function registers Most interrupt and module-enable bits are collected in the lowest address space. Special-function register bits not allocated to a functional purpose are not physically present in the device. This arrangement provides simple software access. interrupt enable 1 and 2 7 6 5 4 0 UTXIE0 OFIE WDTIE 3 2 1 rw-0 rw-0 rw-0 Address 0h URXIE0 ACCVIE NMIIE rw-0 rw-0 rw-0 WDTIE: Watchdog timer interrupt enable. Inactive if watchdog mode is selected. Active if watchdog timer is configured as general-purpose timer. OFIE: Oscillator fault interrupt enable NMIIE: Nonmaskable interrupt enable ACCVIE: Flash memory access violation interrupt enable URXIE0: USART0: UART and SPI receive-interrupt enable UTXIE0: USART0: UART and SPI transmit-interrupt enable 7 6 5 4 0 UTXIE1 3 2 1 rw-0 rw-0 Address 01h URXIE1 URXIE1†: USART1: UART and SPI receive interrupt enable UTXIE1†: USART1: UART and SPI transmit interrupt enable † URXIE1 and UTXIE1 are not present in MSP430F15x devices. interrupt flag register 1 and 2 7 6 5 4 0 UTXIFG0 OFIFG WDTIFG 3 2 1 rw-0 rw-1 rw-(0) Address 02h URXIFG0 NMIIFG rw-1 rw-0 WDTIFG: Set on watchdog-timer overflow (in watchdog mode) or security key violation Reset on VCC power-on, or a reset condition at the RST/NMI pin in reset mode OFIFG: Flag set on oscillator fault NMIIFG: Set via RST/NMI pin URXIFG0: USART0: UART and SPI receive flag UTXIFG0: USART0: UART and SPI transmit flag 7 6 5 4 0 UTXIFG1 3 2 1 rw-1 rw-0 Address 03h URXIFG1 URXIFG1‡: USART1: UART and SPI receive flag UTXIFG1‡: USART1: UART and SPI transmit flag ‡ URXIFG1 and UTXIFG1 are not present in MSP430F15x devices. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 14 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 module enable registers 1 and 2 7 6 5 4 0 UTXE0 3 2 1 rw-0 rw-0 Address 04h URXE0 USPIE0 URXE0: USART0: UART mode receive enable UTXE0: USART0: UART mode transmit enable USPIE0: USART0: SPI mode transmit and receive enable 7 6 5 4 0 UTXE1 3 2 1 rw-0 rw-0 Address 05h URXE1 USPIE1 URXE1†: USART1: UART mode receive enable UTXE1†: USART1: UART mode transmit enable USPIE1†: USART1: SPI mode transmit and receive enable † URXE1, UTXE1, and USPIE1 are not present in MSP430F15x devices. rw-0: Legend: rw: Bit Can Be Read and Written Bit Can Be Read and Written. It Is Reset by PUC. SFR Bit Not Present in Device MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 15 memory organization, MSP430F15x MSP430F155 MSP430F156 MSP430F157 Memory Main: interrupt vector Main: code memory Size Flash Flash 16KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 0C000h 24KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 0A000h 32KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 08000h Information memory Size Flash 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h Boot memory Size ROM 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h RAM Size 512B 03FFh − 0200h 1KB 05FFh − 0200h 1KB 05FFh − 0200h Peripherals 16-bit 8-bit 8-bit SFR 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h memory organization, MSP430F16x MSP430F167 MSP430F168 MSP430F169 Memory Main: interrupt vector Main: code memory Size Flash Flash 32KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 08000h 48KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 04000h 60KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 01100h Information memory Size Flash 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h Boot memory Size ROM 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h RAM Size 1KB 05FFh − 0200h 2KB 09FFh − 0200h 2KB 09FFh − 0200h Peripherals 16-bit 8-bit 8-bit SFR 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h memory organization, MSP430F161x MSP430F1610 MSP430F1611 MSP430F1612 Memory Main: interrupt vector Main: code memory Size Flash Flash 32KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 08000h 48KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 04000h 55KB 0FFFFh − 0FFE0h 0FFFFh − 02500h RAM (Total) Size 5KB 024FFh − 01100h 10KB 038FFh − 01100h 5KB 024FFh − 01100h Extended Size 3KB 024FFh − 01900h 8KB 038FFh − 01900h 3KB 024FFh − 01900h Mirrored Size 2KB 018FFh − 01100h 2KB 018FFh − 01100h 2KB 018FFh − 01100h Information memory Size Flash 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h 256 Byte 010FFh − 01000h Boot memory Size ROM 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h 1KB 0FFFh − 0C00h RAM (mirrored at 018FFh - 01100h) Size 2KB 09FFh − 0200h 2KB 09FFh − 0200h 2KB 09FFh − 0200h Peripherals 16-bit 8-bit 8-bit SFR 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h 01FFh − 0100h 0FFh − 010h 0Fh − 00h MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 16 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 bootstrap loader (BSL) The MSP430 bootstrap loader (BSL) enables users to program the flash memory or RAM using a UART serial interface. Access to the MSP430 memory via the BSL is protected by user-defined password. For complete description of the features of the BSL and its implementation, see the Application report Features of the MSP430 Bootstrap Loader, Literature Number SLAA089. BSL FUNCTION PM, RTD PACKAGE PINS Data Transmit 13 - P1.1 Data Receive 22 - P2.2 flash memory The flash memory can be programmed via the JTAG port, the bootstrap loader, or in-system by the CPU. The CPU can perform single-byte and single-word writes to the flash memory. Features of the flash memory include:  Flash memory has n segments of main memory and two segments of information memory (A and B) of 128 bytes each. Each segment in main memory is 512 bytes in size.  Segments 0 to n may be erased in one step, or each segment may be individually erased.  Segments A and B can be erased individually, or as a group with segments 0 to n. Segments A and B are also called information memory.  New devices may have some bytes programmed in the information memory (needed for test during manufacturing). The user should perform an erase of the information memory prior to the first use. Segment 0 w/ Interrupt Vectors Segment 1 Segment 2 Segment n-1 Segment n† Segment A Segment B Main Memory Info Memory 32KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 48KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 08400h 083FFh 08200h 081FFh 08000h 024FFh 01100h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h 04400h 043FFh 04200h 041FFh 04000h 038FFh 01100h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h RAM (’F161x only) 48KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 60KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 04400h 043FFh 04200h 041FFh 04000h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h 01400h 013FFh 01200h 011FFh 01100h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h 24KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 32KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 0A400h 0A3FFh 0A200h 0A1FFh 0A000h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h 08400h 083FFh 08200h 081FFh 08000h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h 16KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 0C400h 0C3FFh 0C200h 0C1FFh 0C000h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h MSP430F15x and MSP430F16x MSP430F161x 55KB 0FFFFh 0FE00h 0FDFFh 0FC00h 0FBFFh 0FA00h 0F9FFh 02800h 027FFh 02600h 025FFh 02500h 024FFh 01100h 010FFh 01080h 0107Fh 01000h † MSP430F169 and MSP430F1612 flash segment n = 256 bytes. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 17 peripherals Peripherals are connected to the CPU through data, address, and control busses and can be handled using all instructions. For complete module descriptions, see the MSP430x1xx Family User’s Guide, literature number SLAU049. DMA controller The DMA controller allows movement of data from one memory address to another without CPU intervention. For example, the DMA controller can be used to move data from the ADC12 conversion memory to RAM. Using the DMA controller can increase the throughput of peripheral modules. The DMA controller reduces system power consumption by allowing the CPU to remain in sleep mode without having to awaken to move data to or from a peripheral. oscillator and system clock The clock system in the MSP430F15x and MSP430F16x(x) family of devices is supported by the basic clock module that includes support for a 32768-Hz watch crystal oscillator, an internal digitally-controlled oscillator (DCO) and a high frequency crystal oscillator. The basic clock module is designed to meet the requirements of both low system cost and low-power consumption. The internal DCO provides a fast turn-on clock source and stabilizes in less than 6 μs. The basic clock module provides the following clock signals:  Auxiliary clock (ACLK), sourced from a 32768-Hz watch crystal or a high frequency crystal.  Main clock (MCLK), the system clock used by the CPU.  Sub-Main clock (SMCLK), the sub-system clock used by the peripheral modules. brownout, supply voltage supervisor (SVS) The brownout circuit is implemented to provide the proper internal reset signal to the device during power on and power off. The supply voltage supervisor (SVS) circuitry detects if the supply voltage drops below a user selectable level and supports both supply voltage supervision (the device is automatically reset) and supply voltage monitoring (SVM, the device is not automatically reset). The CPU begins code execution after the brownout circuit releases the device reset. However, VCC may not have ramped to VCC(min) at that time. The user must insure the default DCO settings are not changed until VCC reaches VCC(min). If desired, the SVS circuit can be used to determine when VCC reaches VCC(min). digital I/O There are six 8-bit I/O ports implemented—ports P1 through P6:  All individual I/O bits are independently programmable.  Any combination of input, output, and interrupt conditions is possible.  Edge-selectable interrupt input capability for all the eight bits of ports P1 and P2.  Read/write access to port-control registers is supported by all instructions. watchdog timer The primary function of the watchdog timer (WDT) module is to perform a controlled system restart after a software problem occurs. If the selected time interval expires, a system reset is generated. If the watchdog function is not needed in an application, the module can be configured as an interval timer and can generate interrupts at selected time intervals. hardware multiplier (MSP430F16x/161x only) The multiplication operation is supported by a dedicated peripheral module. The module performs 1616, 168, 816, and 88 bit operations. The module is capable of supporting signed and unsigned multiplication as well as signed and unsigned multiply and accumulate operations. The result of an operation can be accessed immediately after the operands have been loaded into the peripheral registers. No additional clock cycles are required. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 18 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 USART0 The MSP430F15x and the MSP430F16x(x) have one hardware universal synchronous/asynchronous receive transmit (USART0) peripheral module that is used for serial data communication. The USART supports synchronous SPI (3 or 4 pin), asynchronous UART and I2C communication protocols using double-buffered transmit and receive channels. The I2C support is compliant with the Philips I2C specification version 2.1 and supports standard mode (up to 100 kbps) and fast mode (up to 400 kbps). In addition, 7-bit and 10-bit device addressing modes are supported, as well as master and slave modes. The USART0 also supports 16-bit-wide I2C data transfers and has two dedicated DMA channels to maximize bus throughput. Extensive interrupt capability is also given in the I2C mode. USART1 (MSP430F16x/161x only) The MSP430F16x(x) devices have a second hardware universal synchronous/asynchronous receive transmit (USART1) peripheral module that is used for serial data communication. The USART supports synchronous SPI (3 or 4 pin) and asynchronous UART communication protocols, using double-buffered transmit and receive channels. With the exception of I2C support, operation of USART1 is identical to USART0. Timer_A3 Timer_A3 is a 16-bit timer/counter with three capture/compare registers. Timer_A3 can support multiple capture/compares, PWM outputs, and interval timing. Timer_A3 also has extensive interrupt capabilities. Interrupts may be generated from the counter on overflow conditions and from each of the capture/compare registers. TIMER_A3 SIGNAL CONNECTIONS INPUT PIN NUMBER DEVICE INPUT SIGNAL MODULE INPUT NAME MODULE BLOCK MODULE OUTPUT SIGNAL OUTPUT PIN NUMBER 12 - P1.0 TACLK TACLK ACLK ACLK Timer NA SMCLK SMCLK 21 - P2.1 TAINCLK INCLK 13 - P1.1 TA0 CCI0A 13 - P1.1 22 - P2.2 TA0 CCI0B CCR0 TA0 17 - P1.5 DVSS GND 27 - P2.7 DVCC VCC 14 - P1.2 TA1 CCI1A 14 - P1.2 CAOUT (internal) CCI1B CCR1 TA1 18 - P1.6 DVSS GND 23 - P2.3 DVCC VCC ADC12 (internal) 15 - P1.3 TA2 CCI2A 15 - P1.3 ACLK (internal) CCI2B CCR2 TA2 19 - P1.7 DVSS GND 24 - P2.4 DVCC VCC Timer_B3 (MSP430F15x only) Timer_B3 is a 16-bit timer/counter with three capture/compare registers. Timer_B3 can support multiple capture/compares, PWM outputs, and interval timing. Timer_B3 also has extensive interrupt capabilities. Interrupts may be generated from the counter on overflow conditions and from each of the capture/compare registers. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 19 Timer_B7 (MSP430F16x/161x only) Timer_B7 is a 16-bit timer/counter with seven capture/compare registers. Timer_B7 can support multiple capture/compares, PWM outputs, and interval timing. Timer_B7 also has extensive interrupt capabilities. Interrupts may be generated from the counter on overflow conditions and from each of the capture/compare registers. TIMER_B3/B7 SIGNAL CONNECTIONS† INPUT PIN NUMBER DEVICE INPUT SIGNAL MODULE INPUT NAME MODULE BLOCK MODULE OUTPUT SIGNAL OUTPUT PIN NUMBER 43 - P4.7 TBCLK TBCLK ACLK ACLK Timer NA SMCLK SMCLK 43 - P4.7 TBCLK INCLK 36 - P4.0 TB0 CCI0A 36 - P4.0 36 - P4.0 TB0 CCI0B CCR0 TB0 ADC12 (internal) DVSS GND DVCC VCC 37 - P4.1 TB1 CCI1A 37 - P4.1 37 - P4.1 TB1 CCI1B CCR1 TB1 ADC12 (internal) DVSS GND DVCC VCC 38 - P4.2 TB2 CCI2A 38 - P4.2 38 - P4.2 TB2 CCI2B CCR2 TB2 DVSS GND DVCC VCC 39 - P4.3 TB3 CCI3A 39 - P4.3 39 - P4.3 TB3 CCI3B CCR3 TB3 DVSS GND DVCC VCC 40 - P4.4 TB4 CCI4A 40 - P4.4 40 - P4.4 TB4 CCI4B CCR4 TB4 DVSS GND DVCC VCC 41 - P4.5 TB5 CCI5A 41 - P4.5 41 - P4.5 TB5 CCI5B CCR5 TB5 DVSS GND DVCC VCC 42 - P4.6 TB6 CCI6A 42 - P4.6 ACLK (internal) CCI6B CCR6 TB6 DVSS GND DVCC VCC † Timer_B3 implements three capture/compare blocks (CCR0, CCR1 and CCR2 only). MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 20 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 Comparator_A The primary function of the comparator_A module is to support precision slope analog−to−digital conversions, battery−voltage supervision, and monitoring of external analog signals. ADC12 The ADC12 module supports fast, 12-bit analog-to-digital conversions. The module implements a 12-bit SAR core, sample select control, reference generator and a 16 word conversion-and-control buffer. The conversion-and-control buffer allows up to 16 independent ADC samples to be converted and stored without any CPU intervention. DAC12 The DAC12 module is a 12-bit, R-ladder, voltage output DAC. The DAC12 may be used in 8- or 12-bit mode, and may be used in conjunction with the DMA controller. When multiple DAC12 modules are present, they may be grouped together for synchronous operation. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 21 peripheral file map PERIPHERAL FILE MAP DMA DMA channel 2 transfer size DMA2SZ 01F6h DMA channel 2 destination address DMA2DA 01F4h DMA channel 2 source address DMA2SA 01F2h DMA channel 2 control DMA2CTL 01F0h DMA channel 1 transfer size DMA1SZ 01EEh DMA channel 1 destination address DMA1DA 01ECh DMA channel 1 source address DMA1SA 01EAh DMA channel 1 control DMA1CTL 01E8h DMA channel 0 transfer size DMA0SZ 01E6h DMA channel 0 destination address DMA0DA 01E4h DMA channel 0 source address DMA0SA 01E2h DMA channel 0 control DMA0CTL 01E0h DMA module control 1 DMACTL1 0124h DMA module control 0 DMACTL0 0122h DAC12 DAC12_1 data DAC12_1DAT 01CAh DAC12_1 control DAC12_1CTL 01C2h DAC12_0 data DAC12_0DAT 01C8h DAC12_0 control DAC12_0CTL 01C0h ADC12 Interrupt-vector-word register ADC12IV 01A8h Inerrupt-enable register ADC12IE 01A6h Inerrupt-flag register ADC12IFG 01A4h Control register 1 ADC12CTL1 01A2h Control register 0 ADC12CTL0 01A0h Conversion memory 15 ADC12MEM15 015Eh Conversion memory 14 ADC12MEM14 015Ch Conversion memory 13 ADC12MEM13 015Ah Conversion memory 12 ADC12MEM12 0158h Conversion memory 11 ADC12MEM11 0156h Conversion memory 10 ADC12MEM10 0154h Conversion memory 9 ADC12MEM9 0152h Conversion memory 8 ADC12MEM8 0150h Conversion memory 7 ADC12MEM7 014Eh Conversion memory 6 ADC12MEM6 014Ch Conversion memory 5 ADC12MEM5 014Ah Conversion memory 4 ADC12MEM4 0148h Conversion memory 3 ADC12MEM3 0146h Conversion memory 2 ADC12MEM2 0144h Conversion memory 1 ADC12MEM1 0142h Conversion memory 0 ADC12MEM0 0140h MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 22 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 peripheral file map (continued) PERIPHERAL FILE MAP (CONTINUED) ADC12 ADC memory-control register15 ADC12MCTL15 08Fh (continued) ADC memory-control register14 ADC12MCTL14 08Eh ADC memory-control register13 ADC12MCTL13 08Dh ADC memory-control register12 ADC12MCTL12 08Ch ADC memory-control register11 ADC12MCTL11 08Bh ADC memory-control register10 ADC12MCTL10 08Ah ADC memory-control register9 ADC12MCTL9 089h ADC memory-control register8 ADC12MCTL8 088h ADC memory-control register7 ADC12MCTL7 087h ADC memory-control register6 ADC12MCTL6 086h ADC memory-control register5 ADC12MCTL5 085h ADC memory-control register4 ADC12MCTL4 084h ADC memory-control register3 ADC12MCTL3 083h ADC memory-control register2 ADC12MCTL2 082h ADC memory-control register1 ADC12MCTL1 081h ADC memory-control register0 ADC12MCTL0 080h Timer_B7/ Capture/compare register 6 TBCCR6 019Eh Timer_B3 (see Note 1) Capture/compare register 5 TBCCR5 019Ch Capture/compare register 4 TBCCR4 019Ah Capture/compare register 3 TBCCR3 0198h Capture/compare register 2 TBCCR2 0196h Capture/compare register 1 TBCCR1 0194h Capture/compare register 0 TBCCR0 0192h Timer_B register TBR 0190h Capture/compare control 6 TBCCTL6 018Eh Capture/compare control 5 TBCCTL5 018Ch Capture/compare control 4 TBCCTL4 018Ah Capture/compare control 3 TBCCTL3 0188h Capture/compare control 2 TBCCTL2 0186h Capture/compare control 1 TBCCTL1 0184h Capture/compare control 0 TBCCTL0 0182h Timer_B control TBCTL 0180h Timer_B interrupt vector TBIV 011Eh Timer_A3 Reserved 017Eh Reserved 017Ch Reserved 017Ah Reserved 0178h Capture/compare register 2 TACCR2 0176h Capture/compare register 1 TACCR1 0174h Capture/compare register 0 TACCR0 0172h Timer_A register TAR 0170h Reserved 016Eh Reserved 016Ch Reserved 016Ah Reserved 0168h NOTE 1: Timer_B7 in MSP430F16x/161x family has seven CCRs, Timer_B3 in MSP430F15x family has three CCRs. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 23 peripheral file map (continued) PERIPHERAL FILE MAP (CONTINUED) Timer_A3 Capture/compare control 2 TACCTL2 0166h (continued) Capture/compare control 1 TACCTL1 0164h Capture/compare control 0 TACCTL0 0162h Timer_A control TACTL 0160h Timer_A interrupt vector TAIV 012Eh Hardware Sum extend SUMEXT 013Eh Multiplier (MSP430F16x and Result high word RESHI 013Ch MSP430F161x Result low word RESLO 013Ah only) Second operand OP2 0138h Multiply signed +accumulate/operand1 MACS 0136h Multiply+accumulate/operand1 MAC 0134h Multiply signed/operand1 MPYS 0132h Multiply unsigned/operand1 MPY 0130h Flash Flash control 3 FCTL3 012Ch Flash control 2 FCTL2 012Ah Flash control 1 FCTL1 0128h Watchdog Watchdog Timer control WDTCTL 0120h USART1 Transmit buffer U1TXBUF 07Fh (MSP430F16x and MSP430F161x Receive buffer U1RXBUF 07Eh only) Baud rate U1BR1 07Dh Baud rate U1BR0 07Ch Modulation control U1MCTL 07Bh Receive control U1RCTL 07Ah Transmit control U1TCTL 079h USART control U1CTL 078h USART0 Transmit buffer U0TXBUF 077h (UART or SPI mode) Receive buffer U0RXBUF 076h Baud rate U0BR1 075h Baud rate U0BR0 074h Modulation control U0MCTL 073h Receive control U0RCTL 072h Transmit control U0TCTL 071h USART control U0CTL 070h USART0 2 I2C interrupt vector I2CIV 011Ch (I2C mode) I2C slave address I2CSA 011Ah I2C own address I2COA 0118h I2C data I2CDR 076h I2C SCLL I2CSCLL 075h I2C SCLH I2CSCLH 074h I2C PSC I2CPSC 073h I2C data control I2CDCTL 072h I2C transfer control I2CTCTL 071h USART control U0CTL 070h I2C data count I2CNDAT 052h I2C interrupt flag I2CIFG 051h I2C interrupt enable I2CIE 050h MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 24 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 peripheral file map (continued) PERIPHERAL FILE MAP (CONTINUED) Comparator_A Comparator_A port disable CAPD 05Bh Comparator_A control2 CACTL2 05Ah Comparator_A control1 CACTL1 059h Basic Clock Basic clock system control2 BCSCTL2 058h Basic clock system control1 BCSCTL1 057h DCO clock frequency control DCOCTL 056h BrownOUT, SVS SVS control register (reset by brownout signal) SVSCTL 055h Port P6 Port P6 selection P6SEL 037h Port P6 direction P6DIR 036h Port P6 output P6OUT 035h Port P6 input P6IN 034h Port P5 Port P5 selection P5SEL 033h Port P5 direction P5DIR 032h Port P5 output P5OUT 031h Port P5 input P5IN 030h Port P4 Port P4 selection P4SEL 01Fh Port P4 direction P4DIR 01Eh Port P4 output P4OUT 01Dh Port P4 input P4IN 01Ch Port P3 Port P3 selection P3SEL 01Bh Port P3 direction P3DIR 01Ah Port P3 output P3OUT 019h Port P3 input P3IN 018h Port P2 Port P2 selection P2SEL 02Eh Port P2 interrupt enable P2IE 02Dh Port P2 interrupt-edge select P2IES 02Ch Port P2 interrupt flag P2IFG 02Bh Port P2 direction P2DIR 02Ah Port P2 output P2OUT 029h Port P2 input P2IN 028h Port P1 Port P1 selection P1SEL 026h Port P1 interrupt enable P1IE 025h Port P1 interrupt-edge select P1IES 024h Port P1 interrupt flag P1IFG 023h Port P1 direction P1DIR 022h Port P1 output P1OUT 021h Port P1 input P1IN 020h Special Functions SFR module enable 2 ME2 005h SFR module enable 1 ME1 004h SFR interrupt flag2 IFG2 003h SFR interrupt flag1 IFG1 002h SFR interrupt enable2 IE2 001h SFR interrupt enable1 IE1 000h MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 25 absolute maximum ratings over operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)† Voltage applied at VCC to VSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . −0.3 V to 4.1 V Voltage applied to any pin (see Note) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . −0.3 V to VCC + 0.3 V Diode current at any device terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2 mA Storage temperature, Tstg: Unprogrammed device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . −55°C to 150°C Programmed device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . −55°C to 85°C † Stresses beyond those listed under “absolute maximum ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under “recommended operating conditions” is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. NOTE: All voltages referenced to VSS. The JTAG fuse-blow voltage, VFB, is allowed to exceed the absolute maximum rating. The voltage is applied to the TDI/TCLK pin when blowing the JTAG fuse. recommended operating conditions MIN NOM MAX UNIT Supply voltage during program execution, VCC (AVCC = DVCC = VCC) MSP430F15x/16x/161x 1.8 3.6 V Supply voltage during flash memory programming, VCC (AVCC = DVCC = VCC) MSP430F15x/16x/161x 2.7 3.6 V Supply voltage during program execution, SVS enabled (see Note 1), VCC (AVCC = DVCC = VCC) MSP430F15x/16x/161x 2 3.6 V Supply voltage, VSS (AVSS = DVSS = VSS) 0 0 V Operating free-air temperature range, TA MSP430F15x/16x/161x −40 85 °C LFXT1 t l f f LF selected, XTS=0 Watch crystal 32.768 kHz crystal frequency, f(LFXT1) XT1 selected, XTS=1 Ceramic resonator 450 8000 kHz (see Notes 2 and 3) XT1 selected, XTS=1 Crystal 1000 8000 kHz XT2 crystal frequency f Ceramic resonator 450 8000 frequency, f(XT2) kHz Crystal 1000 8000 Processor frequency (signal MCLK) f VCC = 1.8 V DC 4.15 MCLK), f(System) MHz VCC = 3.6 V DC 8 NOTES: 1. The minimum operating supply voltage is defined according to the trip point where POR is going active by decreasing the supply voltage. POR is going inactive when the VCC is raised above the minimum supply voltage plus the hysteresis of the SVS circuitry. 2. In LF mode, the LFXT1 oscillator requires a watch crystal. A 5.1-MΩ resistor from XOUT to VSS is recommended when VCC < 2.5 V. In XT1 mode, the LFXT1 and XT2 oscillators accept a ceramic resonator or crystal up to 4.15 MHz at VCC ≥ 2.2 V. In XT1 mode, the LFXT1 and XT2 oscillators accept a ceramic resonator or crystal up to 8 MHz at VCC ≥ 2.8 V. 3. In LF mode, the LFXT1 oscillator requires a watch crystal. In XT1 mode, LFXT1 accepts a ceramic resonator or a crystal. f (MHz) 1.8 V 2.7 V 3 V 3.6 V ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ 4.15 MHz 8.0 MHz Supply Voltage − V Supply voltage range, ’F15x/16x/161x, during flash memory programming Supply voltage range, ’F15x/16x/161x, during program execution Figure 1. Frequency vs Supply Voltage, MSP430F15x/16x/161x MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 26 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) MSP430F15x/16x supply current into AVCC + DVCC excluding external current (AVCC = DVCC = VCC) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT Active mode, (see Note 1) f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = 1 MHz, T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 330 400 A I f(ACLK) = 32,768 Hz XTS=0, SELM=(0,1) TA = −3 V 500 600 μA I(AM) Active mode, (see Note 1) f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = 4,096 Hz, T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 2.5 7 A f(ACLK) = 4,096 Hz XTS=0, SELM=3 TA = −3 V 9 20 μA I Low-power mode, (LPM0) f(MCLK) = 0 MHz, f(SMCLK) = 1 MHz, f 32 768 Hz T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 50 60 I(LPM0) A ( ) ( ) f(ACLK) = 32,768 XTS=0, SELM=(0,1) (see Note 1) TA = −3 V 75 90 μA I Low-power mode, (LPM2), f f 0 MHz T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 11 14 I(LPM2) f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = MHz, A f(ACLK) = 32.768 Hz, SCG0 = 0 TA = −3 V 17 22 μA TA = −40°C 1.1 1.6 Low-power mode (LPM3) TA = 25°C 2.2 V 1.1 1.6 I mode, f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = 0 MHz, TA = 85°C 2.2 3.0 I(LPM3) A f(ACLK) = 32,768 Hz, SCG0 = 1 ( Nt 2) TA = −40°C 2.2 2.8 μA (see Note TA = 25°C 3 V 2.0 2.6 TA = 85°C 3.0 4.3 Low-power mode, (LPM4) TA = −40°C 0.1 0.5 I(LPM4) f(MCLK) = 0 MHz, f(SMCLK) = 0 MHz, TA = 25°C 2.2V / 3 V 0.2 0.5 μA f(ACLK) = 0 Hz, SCG0 = 1 TA = 85°C 1.3 2.5 NOTES: 1. Timer_B is clocked by f(DCOCLK) = 1 MHz. All inputs are tied to 0 V or to VCC. Outputs do not source or sink any current. 2. WDT is clocked by f(ACLK) = 32,768 Hz. All inputs are tied to 0 V or to VCC. Outputs do not source or sink any current. The current consumption in LPM2 and LPM3 are measured with ACLK selected. Current consumption of active mode versus system frequency I(AM) = I(AM) [1 MHz] × f(System) [MHz] Current consumption of active mode versus supply voltage I(AM) = I(AM) [3 V] + 210 μA/V × (VCC – 3 V) MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 27 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) MSP430F161x supply current into AVCC + DVCC excluding external current (AVCC = DVCC = VCC) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT Active mode, (see Note 1) f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = 1 MHz, T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 330 400 A I f(ACLK) = 32,768 Hz XTS=0, SELM=(0,1) TA = −3 V 500 600 μA I(AM) Active mode, (see Note 1) f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = 4,096 Hz, T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 2.5 7 A f(ACLK) = 4,096 Hz XTS=0, SELM=3 TA = −3 V 9 20 μA I Low-power mode, (LPM0) f(MCLK) = 0 MHz, f(SMCLK) = 1 MHz, f 32 768 Hz T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 50 60 I(LPM0) A ( ) ( ) f(ACLK) = 32,768 XTS=0, SELM=(0,1) (see Note 1) TA = −3 V 75 95 μA I Low-power mode, (LPM2), f f 0 MHz T 40°C to 85°C 2.2 V 11 14 I(LPM2) f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = MHz, A f(ACLK) = 32.768 Hz, SCG0 = 0 TA = −3 V 17 22 μA TA = −40°C 1.3 1.6 Low-power mode (LPM3) TA = 25°C 2.2 V 1.3 1.6 I mode, f(MCLK) = f(SMCLK) = 0 MHz, TA = 85°C 3.0 6.0 I(LPM3) A f(ACLK) = 32,768 Hz, SCG0 = 1 ( Nt 2) TA = −40°C 2.6 3.0 μA (see Note TA = 25°C 3 V 2.6 3.0 TA = 85°C 4.4 8.0 Low-power mode, (LPM4) TA = −40°C 0.2 0.5 I(LPM4) f(MCLK) = 0 MHz, f(SMCLK) = 0 MHz, TA = 25°C 2.2V / 3 V 0.2 0.5 μA f(ACLK) = 0 Hz, SCG0 = 1 TA = 85°C 2.0 5.0 NOTES: 1. Timer_B is clocked by f(DCOCLK) = 1 MHz. All inputs are tied to 0 V or to VCC. Outputs do not source or sink any current. 2. WDT is clocked by f(ACLK) = 32,768 Hz. All inputs are tied to 0 V or to VCC. Outputs do not source or sink any current. The current consumption in LPM2 and LPM3 are measured with ACLK selected. Current consumption of active mode versus system frequency I(AM) = I(AM) [1 MHz] × f(System) [MHz] Current consumption of active mode versus supply voltage I(AM) = I(AM) [3 V] + 210 μA/V × (VCC – 3 V) MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 28 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) Schmitt-trigger inputs − ports P1, P2, P3, P4, P5, P6, RST/NMI, JTAG (TCK, TMS, TDI/TCLK, TDO/TDI) PARAMETER VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT V Positive going input threshold voltage 2.2 V 1.1 1.5 VIT+ Positive-V 3 V 1.5 1.98 V Negative going input threshold voltage 2.2 V 0.4 0.9 VIT− Negative-V 3 V 0.9 1.3 V Input voltage hysteresis (V V ) 2.2 V 0.3 1.1 Vhys VIT+ − VIT−) V 3 V 0.5 1 inputs Px.x, TAx, TBx PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT t External interrupt timing Port P1, P2: P1.x to P2.x, external trigger 2.2 V 62 t(int) ns signal for the interrupt flag (see Note 1) 3 V 50 TA0, TA1, TA2 2.2 V 62 t(cap) Timer_A, Timer_B capture timing TB0, TB1, TB2, TB3, TB4, TB5, TB6 (see Note 2) 3 V 50 ns f(TAext) Timer_A, Timer_B clock frequency TACLK TBCLK INCLK: t = t 2.2 V 8 MHz f(TBext) externally applied to pin TACLK, TBCLK, t(H) t(L) 3 V 10 f(TAint) Timer A Timer B clock frequency SMCLK or ACLK signal selected 2.2 V 8 MHz f(TBint) Timer_A, Timer_3 V 10 NOTES: 1. The external signal sets the interrupt flag every time the minimum t(int) parameters are met. It may be set even with trigger signals shorter than t(int). 2. Seven capture/compare registers in ’F16x/161x and three capture/compare registers in ’F15x. leakage current − ports P1, P2, P3, P4, P5, P6 (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT Ilkg(Px.y) Leakage current Port Px V(Px.y) (see Note 2) 2.2 V/3 V ±50 nA NOTES: 1. The leakage current is measured with VSS or VCC applied to the corresponding pin(s), unless otherwise noted. 2. The port pin must be selected as input. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 29 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) outputs − ports P1, P2, P3, P4, P5, P6 PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT IOH(max) = −1.5 mA, VCC = 2.2 V, See Note 1 VCC−0.25 VCC V High level output voltage IOH(max) = −6 mA, VCC = 2.2 V, See Note 2 VCC−0.6 VCC VOH High-V IOH(max) = −1.5 mA, VCC = 3 V, See Note 1 VCC−0.25 VCC IOH(max) = −6 mA, VCC = 3 V, See Note 2 VCC−0.6 VCC IOL(max) = 1.5 mA, VCC = 2.2 V, See Note 1 VSS VSS+0.25 V Low level output voltage IOL(max) = 6 mA, VCC = 2.2 V, See Note 2 VSS VSS+0.6 VOL Low-V IOL(max) = 1.5 mA, VCC = 3 V, See Note 1 VSS VSS+0.25 IOL(max) = 6 mA, VCC = 3 V, See Note 2 VSS VSS+0.6 NOTES: 1. The maximum total current, IOH(max) and IOL(max), for all outputs combined, should not exceed ±12 mA to satisfy the maximum specified voltage drop. 2. The maximum total current, IOH(max) and IOL(max), for all outputs combined, should not exceed ±48 mA to satisfy the maximum specified voltage drop. output frequency PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT f (1 ≤ x ≤ 6 0≤ y ≤ 7) CL = 20 pF, f(Px.y) 6, 0 ≤ V 2 2 V / 3 V DC f MHz IL = ±1.5 mA VCC = 2.2 fSystem f(ACLK) f P2.0/ACLK, P5.6/ACLK P5 4/MCLK C 20 pF V 2 2 V / 3 V fSystem MHz f(MCLK) f(SMCLK) P5.4/MCLK, P1.4/SMCLK, P5.5/SMCLK CL = VCC = 2.2 P1.0/TACLK f(ACLK) = f(LFXT1) = f(XT1) 40% 60% CL = 20 pF f(ACLK) = f(LFXT1) = f(LF) 30% 70% VCC = 2.2 V / 3 V f(ACLK) = f(LFXT1) 50% P1.1/TA0/MCLK, f(MCLK) = f(XT1) 40% 60% t(Xdc) Duty cycle of output frequency CL = 20 pF, VCC = 2.2 V / 3 V f(MCLK) = f(DCOCLK) 50%− 15 ns 50% 50%+ 15 ns P1.4/TBCLK/SMCLK, f(SMCLK) = f(XT2) 40% 60% CL = 20 pF, VCC = 2.2 V / 3 V f(SMCLK) = f(DCOCLK) 50%− 15 ns 50% 50%+ 15 ns MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 30 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) outputs − ports P1, P2, P3, P4, P5, P6 (continued) Figure 2 VOL − Low-Level Output Voltage − V 0 5 10 15 20 25 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 VCC = 2.2 V P3.5 TYPICAL LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT vs LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT VOLTAGE TA = 25°C TA = 85°C IOL − Low-Level Output Current − mA Figure 3 VOL − Low-Level Output Voltage − V 0 10 20 30 40 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 VCC = 3 V P3.5 TYPICAL LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT vs LOW-LEVEL OUTPUT VOLTAGE TA = 25°C TA = 85°C IOL − Low-Level Output Current − mA Figure 4 VOH − High-Level Output Voltage − V −25 −20 −15 −10 −5 0 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 VCC = 2.2 V P3.5 TYPICAL HIGH-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT vs HIGH-LEVEL OUTPUT VOLTAGE TA = 25°C TA = 85°C IOH− High-Level Output Current − mA Figure 5 VOH − High-Level Output Voltage − V −45 −35 −25 −15 −5 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 VCC = 3 V P3.5 TYPICAL HIGH-LEVEL OUTPUT CURRENT vs HIGH-LEVEL OUTPUT VOLTAGE TA = 25°C TA = 85°C IOH− High-Level Output Current − mA MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 31 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) wake-up LPM3 PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT t(LPM3) Delay time VCC = 2.2 V/3 V, fDCO ≥ fDCO43 6 μs RAM PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT VRAMh See Note 1 CPU HALTED 1.6 V NOTE 1: This parameter defines the minimum supply voltage when the data in program memory RAM remain unchanged. No program execution should take place during this supply voltage condition. Comparator_A (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT I CAON=1 CARSEL=0 CAREF=0 2.2 V 25 40 I(DD) 1, 0, μA 3 V 45 60 I CAON=1, CARSEL=0, CAREF 1/2/3 no load at 2.2 V 30 50 I(Refladder/Refdiode) CAREF=3, μA P2.3/CA0/TA1 and P2.4/CA1/TA2 3 V 45 71 V(IC) Common-mode input voltage CAON =1 2.2 V/3 V 0 VCC−1 V V(Ref025) Voltage @ 0.25 VCC node VCC PCA0=1, CARSEL=1, CAREF=1, no load at P2.3/CA0/TA1 and P2.4/CA1/TA2 2.2 V/3 V 0.23 0.24 0.25 V(Ref050) Voltage @ 0.5VCC node VCC PCA0=1, CARSEL=1, CAREF=2, no load at P2.3/CA0/TA1 and P2.4/CA1/TA2 2.2 V/3 V 0.47 0.48 0.5 V (see Figure 6 and Figure 7) PCA0=1, CARSEL=1, CAREF=3, no load at P2 3/CA0/TA1 and 2.2 V 390 480 540 V(RefVT) P2.3/mV P2.4/CA1/TA2 TA = 85°C 3 V 400 490 550 V(offset) Offset voltage See Note 2 2.2 V/3 V −30 30 mV Vhys Input hysteresis CAON=1 2.2 V/3 V 0 0.7 1.4 mV TA = 25°C, Overdrive 10 mV, 2.2 V 130 210 300 ns t 25 Without filter: CAF=0 3 V 80 150 240 t(response LH) TA = 25°C, Overdrive 10 mV, 2.2 V 1.4 1.9 3.4 μs 25 With filter: CAF=1 3 V 0.9 1.5 2.6 TA = 25°C, Overdrive 10 mV, 2.2 V 130 210 300 ns t 25 Without filter: CAF=0 3 V 80 150 240 t(response HL) TA = 25°C, Overdrive 10 mV, 2.2 V 1.4 1.9 3.4 μs 25 With filter: CAF=1 3 V 0.9 1.5 2.6 NOTES: 1. The leakage current for the Comparator_A terminals is identical to Ilkg(Px.x) specification. 2. The input offset voltage can be cancelled by using the CAEX bit to invert the Comparator_A inputs on successive measurements. The two successive measurements are then summed together. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 32 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) TA − Free-Air Temperature − °C 400 450 500 550 600 650 −45 −25 −5 15 35 55 75 95 VCC = 3 V Figure 6. V(RefVT) vs Temperature, VCC = 3 V V(REFVT) − Reference Volts −mV Typical Figure 7. V(RefVT) vs Temperature, VCC = 2.2 V TA − Free-Air Temperature − °C 400 450 500 550 600 650 −45 −25 −5 15 35 55 75 95 VCC = 2.2 V V(REFVT) − Reference Volts −mV Typical _ + CAON 0 1 V+ 0 1 CAF Low Pass Filter τ ≈ 2.0 μs To Internal Modules Set CAIFG Flag CAOUT V− VCC 1 0 V 0 Figure 8. Block Diagram of Comparator_A Module Overdrive VCAOUT V+ t(response) V− 400 mV Figure 9. Overdrive Definition MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 33 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) POR/brownout reset (BOR) (see Notes 1 and 2) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT td(BOR) 2000 μs VCC(Start) dVCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 10) 0.7 × V(B_IT−) V V(B_IT−) Brownout dVCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 10 through Figure 12) 1.71 V Vhys(B_IT−) dVCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 10) 70 130 180 mV t(reset) Pulse length needed at RST/NMI pin to accepted reset internally, VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 2 μs NOTES: 1. The current consumption of the brownout module is already included in the ICC current consumption data. The voltage level V(B_IT−) + Vhys(B_IT−) is ≤ 1.8 V. 2. During power up, the CPU begins code execution following a period of tBOR(delay) after VCC = V(B_IT−) + Vhys(B_IT−). The default DCO settings must not be changed until VCC ≥ VCC(min), where VCC(min) is the minimum supply voltage for the desired operating frequency. See the MSP430x1xx Family User’s Guide (SLAU049) for more information on the brownout/SVS circuit. typical characteristics 0 1 t d(BOR) VCC V(B_IT−) Vhys(B_IT−) VCC(Start) BOR Figure 10. POR/Brownout Reset (BOR) vs Supply Voltage MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 34 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 typical characteristics (continued) VCC(min) VCC 3 V tpw 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 0.001 1 1000 Vcc = 3 V typical conditions 1 ns 1 ns tpw − Pulse Width − μs VCC(min)− V tpw − Pulse Width − μs Figure 11. VCC(min) Level With a Square Voltage Drop to Generate a POR/Brownout Signal VCC 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 Vcc = 3 V typical conditions VCC(min) tpw tpw − Pulse Width − μs VCC(min)− V 3 V 0.001 1 1000 tf tr tpw − Pulse Width − μs tf = tr Figure 12. VCC(min) Level With a Triangle Voltage Drop to Generate a POR/Brownout Signal MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 35 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) SVS (supply voltage supervisor/monitor) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN NOM MAX UNIT t dVCC/dt > 30 V/ms (see Figure 13) 5 150 t(SVSR) μs dVCC/dt ≤ 30 V/ms 2000 td(SVSon) SVSON, switch from VLD = 0 to VLD ≠ 0, VCC = 3 V 150 300 μs tsettle VLD ≠ 0‡ 12 μs V(SVSstart) VLD ≠ 0, VCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 13) 1.55 1.7 V VLD = 1 70 120 155 mV Vhys(SVS_IT−) VCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 13) VLD = 2 to 14 V(SVS_IT−) x 0.004 V(SVS_IT−) x 0.008 VCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 13), External voltage applied on A7 VLD = 15 4.4 10.4 mV VLD = 1 1.8 1.9 2.05 VLD = 2 1.94 2.1 2.25 VLD = 3 2.05 2.2 2.37 VLD = 4 2.14 2.3 2.48 VLD = 5 2.24 2.4 2.6 VLD = 6 2.33 2.5 2.71 VCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 13 and Figure 14) VLD = 7 2.46 2.65 2.86 V(SVS IT ) VLD = 8 2.58 2.8 3 SVS_IT−) V VLD = 9 2.69 2.9 3.13 VLD = 10 2.83 3.05 3.29 VLD = 11 2.94 3.2 3.42 VLD = 12 3.11 3.35 3.61† VLD = 13 3.24 3.5 3.76† VLD = 14 3.43 3.7† 3.99† VCC/dt ≤ 3 V/s (see Figure 13 and Figure 14), External voltage applied on A7 VLD = 15 1.1 1.2 1.3 ICC(SVS) (see Note 1) VLD ≠ 0, VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 10 15 μA † The recommended operating voltage range is limited to 3.6 V. ‡ tsettle is the settling time that the comparator o/p needs to have a stable level after VLD is switched VLD ≠ 0 to a different VLD value somewhere between 2 and 15. The overdrive is assumed to be > 50 mV. NOTE 1: The current consumption of the SVS module is not included in the ICC current consumption data. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 36 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 typical characteristics VCC(start) AVCC V(B_IT−) Brownout Region V(SVSstart) V(SVS_IT−) Software sets VLD >0: SVS is active td(SVSR) undefined Vhys(SVS_IT−) 0 1 td(BOR) Brownout 0 1 td(SVSon) td(BOR) 0 1 Set POR Brownout Region SVS Circuit is Active From VLD > to VCC < V(B_IT−) SVS out Vhys(B_IT−) Figure 13. SVS Reset (SVSR) vs Supply Voltage 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 VCC VCC 1 ns 1 ns VCC(min) tpw tpw − Pulse Width − μs VCC(min)− V 3 V 1 10 1000 tf tr t − Pulse Width − μs 100 tpw 3 V tf = tr Rectangular Drop Triangular Drop VCC(min) Figure 14. VCC(min): Square Voltage Drop and Triangle Voltage Drop to Generate an SVS Signal (VLD = 1) MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 37 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) DCO (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT f R 0 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 0.08 0.12 0.15 f(DCO03) Rsel = 0, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 0.08 0.13 0.16 f R 1 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 0.14 0.19 0.23 f(DCO13) Rsel = 1, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 0.14 0.18 0.22 f R 2 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 0.22 0.30 0.36 f(DCO23) Rsel = 2, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 0.22 0.28 0.34 f R 3 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 0.37 0.49 0.59 f(DCO33) Rsel = 3, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 0.37 0.47 0.56 f R 4 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 0.61 0.77 0.93 f(DCO43) Rsel = 4, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 0.61 0.75 0.90 f R 5 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 1 1.2 1.5 f(DCO53) Rsel = 5, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 1 1.3 1.5 f R 6 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 1.6 1.9 2.2 f(DCO63) Rsel = 6, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 1.69 2.0 2.29 f R 7 DCO 3 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 2.4 2.9 3.4 f(DCO73) Rsel = 7, = 3, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 2.7 3.2 3.65 f(DCO47) Rsel = 4, DCO = 7, MOD = 0, DCOR = 0, TA = 25°C 2.2 V/3 V fDCO40 × 1.7 fDCO40 × 2.1 fDCO40 × 2.5 MHz f R 7 DCO 7 MOD 0 DCOR 0 T 25°C 2.2 V 4 4.5 4.9 f(DCO77) Rsel = 7, = 7, = 0, = 0, TA = MHz 3 V 4.4 4.9 5.4 SRsel SR = fRsel+1 / fRsel 2.2 V/3 V 1.35 1.65 2 SDCO SDCO = f(DCO+1) / f(DCO) 2.2 V/3 V 1.07 1.12 1.16 D Temperature drift R 4 DCO 3 MOD 0 (see Note 2) 2.2 V −0.31 −0.36 −0.40 Dt drift, Rsel = 4, = 3, = %/°C 3 V −0.33 −0.38 −0.43 DV Drift with VCC variation, Rsel = 4, DCO = 3, MOD = 0 (see Note 2) 2.2 V/3 V 0 5 10 %/V NOTES: 1. The DCO frequency may not exceed the maximum system frequency defined by parameter processor frequency, f(System). 2. This parameter is not production tested. 2.2 3 fDCO_0 Max Min ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ Max Min fDCO_7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 DCO f DCOCLK 1 ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ VCC − V Frequency Variance Figure 15. DCO Characteristics MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 38 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) main DCO characteristics  Individual devices have a minimum and maximum operation frequency. The specified parameters for f(DCOx0) to f(DCOx7) are valid for all devices.  All ranges selected by Rsel(n) overlap with Rsel(n+1): Rsel0 overlaps Rsel1, ... Rsel6 overlaps Rsel7.  DCO control bits DCO0, DCO1, and DCO2 have a step size as defined by parameter SDCO.  Modulation control bits MOD0 to MOD4 select how often f(DCO+1) is used within the period of 32 DCOCLK cycles. The frequency f(DCO) is used for the remaining cycles. The frequency is an average equal to: faverage  32f(DCO) f(DCO1) MODf(DCO) (32MOD)f(DCO1) DCO when using ROSC (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT f DCO output frequency Rsel = 4, DCO = 3, MOD = 0, DCOR = 1, 2.2 V 1.8±15% MHz fDCO, TA = 25°C 3 V 1.95±15% MHz Dt, Temperature drift Rsel = 4, DCO = 3, MOD = 0, DCOR = 1 2.2 V/3 V ±0.1 %/°C Dv, Drift with VCC variation Rsel = 4, DCO = 3, MOD = 0, DCOR = 1 2.2 V/3 V 10 %/V NOTES: 1. ROSC = 100kΩ. Metal film resistor, type 0257. 0.6 watt with 1% tolerance and TK = ±50ppm/°C. crystal oscillator, LFXT1 oscillator (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT C Integrated input capacitance XTS=0; LF oscillator selected, VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 12 CXIN pF XTS=1; XT1 oscillator selected, VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 2 C Integrated output capacitance XTS=0; LF oscillator selected, VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 12 CXOUT pF XTS=1; XT1 oscillator selected, VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 2 VIL I t l l t XIN VCC = 2.2 V/3 V ( N 2) XTS = 0 or 1 XT1 or LF modes VSS 0.2 × VCC V V Input levels at CC see Note XTS = 0, LF mode 0.9 × VCC VCC VIH XTS = 1, XT1 mode 0.8 × VCC VCC NOTES: 1. The oscillator needs capacitors at both terminals, with values specified by the crystal manufacturer. 2. Applies only when using an external logic-level clock source. Not applicable when using a crystal or resonator. crystal oscillator, XT2 oscillator (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT CXIN Integrated input capacitance VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 2 pF CXOUT Integrated output capacitance VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 2 pF VIL Input levels at XIN V = 2 2 V/3 V (see Note 2) VSS 0.2 × VCC V VIH VCC 2.2 0.8 × VCC VCC V NOTES: 1. The oscillator needs capacitors at both terminals, with values specified by the crystal manufacturer. 2. Applies only when using an external logic-level clock source. Not applicable when using a crystal or resonator. USART0, USART1 (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT t( ) USART0/USART1: deglitch time VCC = 2.2 V 200 430 800 τ) ns VCC = 3 V 150 280 500 NOTE 1: The signal applied to the USART0/USART1 receive signal/terminal (URXD0/1) should meet the timing requirements of t(τ) to ensure that the URXS flip-flop is set. The URXS flip-flop is set with negative pulses meeting the minimum-timing condition of t(τ). The operating conditions to set the flag must be met independently from this timing constraint. The deglitch circuitry is active only on negative transitions on the URXD0/1 line. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 39 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) 12-bit ADC, power supply and input range conditions (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT AVCC Analog supply voltage AVCC and DVCC are connected together AVSS and DVSS are connected together V(AVSS) = V(DVSS) = 0 V 2.2 3.6 V V(P6.x/Ax) Analog input voltage range (see Note 2) All P6.0/A0 to P6.7/A7 terminals. Analog inputs selected in ADC12MCTLx register and P6Sel.x=1 0 ≤ x ≤ 7; V(AVSS) ≤ VP6.x/Ax ≤ V(AVCC) 0 VAVCC V I Operating supply current into AV terminal fADC12CLK = 5.0 MHz ADC12ON 1 REFON 0 2.2 V 0.65 1.3 IADC12 AVCC mA (see Note 3) = 1, = SHT0=0, SHT1=0, ADC12DIV=0 3 V 0.8 1.6 I Operating supply current i t AV t i l fADC12CLK = 5.0 MHz ADC12ON = 0, REFON = 1, REF2_5V = 1 3 V 0.5 0.8 mA IREF+ into AVCC terminal (see Note 4) fADC12CLK = 5.0 MHz ADC12ON 0 2.2 V 0.5 0.8 mA = 0, REFON = 1, REF2_5V = 0 3 V 0.5 0.8 CI † Input capacitance Only one terminal can be selected at one time, P6.x/Ax 2.2 V 40 pF RI † Input MUX ON resistance 0V ≤ VAx ≤ VAVCC 3 V 2000 Ω † Not production tested, limits verified by design NOTES: 1. The leakage current is defined in the leakage current table with P6.x/Ax parameter. 2. The analog input voltage range must be within the selected reference voltage range VR+ to VR− for valid conversion results. 3. The internal reference supply current is not included in current consumption parameter IADC12. 4. The internal reference current is supplied via terminal AVCC. Consumption is independent of the ADC12ON control bit, unless a conversion is active. The REFON bit enables to settle the built-in reference before starting an A/D conversion. 12-bit ADC, external reference (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT VeREF+ Positive external reference voltage input VeREF+ > VREF−/VeREF− (see Note 2) 1.4 VAVCC V VREF− /VeREF− Negative external reference voltage input VeREF+ > VREF−/VeREF− (see Note 3) 0 1.2 V (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−) Differential external reference voltage input VeREF+ > VREF−/VeREF− (see Note 4) 1.4 VAVCC V IVeREF+ Static input current 0V ≤VeREF+ ≤ VAVCC 2.2 V/3 V ±1 μA IVREF−/VeREF− Static input current 0V ≤ VeREF− ≤ VAVCC 2.2 V/3 V ±1 μA NOTES: 1. The external reference is used during conversion to charge and discharge the capacitance array. The input capacitance, Ci, is also the dynamic load for an external reference during conversion. The dynamic impedance of the reference supply should follow the recommendations on analog-source impedance to allow the charge to settle for 12-bit accuracy. 2. The accuracy limits the minimum positive external reference voltage. Lower reference voltage levels may be applied with reduced accuracy requirements. 3. The accuracy limits the maximum negative external reference voltage. Higher reference voltage levels may be applied with reduced accuracy requirements. 4. The accuracy limits minimum external differential reference voltage. Lower differential reference voltage levels may be applied with reduced accuracy requirements. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 40 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) 12-bit ADC, built-in reference PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT V built-REF2_5V = 1 for 2.5 V IVREF+max ≤ IVREF+≤ IVREF+min VCC = 3 V 2.4 2.5 2.6 VREF+ V Positive built in reference voltage output REF2_5V = 0 for 1.5 V IVREF+max ≤ IVREF+≤ IVREF+min VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 1.44 1.5 1.56 AVCC minimum voltage, REF2_5V = 0, IVREF+max ≤ IVREF+≤ IVREF+min 2.2 AVCC(min) Positive built-in reference REF2_5V = 1, −0.5mA ≤ IVREF+≤ IVREF+min 2.8 V active REF2_5V = 1, −1mA ≤ IVREF+≤ IVREF+min 2.9 I Load current out of VREF+ VCC = 2.2 V 0.01 −0.5 IVREF+ mA terminal VCC = 3 V 0.01 −1 IVREF+ = 500 μA +/− 100 μA Analog input voltage 0 75 V VCC = 2.2 V ±2 LSB I Load-current regulation ~0.75 V, REF2_5V = 0 VCC = 3 V ±2 IL(VREF)+ † Load VREF+ terminal IVREF+ = 500 μA ± 100 μA Analog input voltage ~1.25 V, REF2_5V = 1 VCC = 3 V ±2 LSB I Load current regulation IVREF+ =100 μA → 900 μA, IDL(VREF) + C 5 μF ax 0 5 x V V 3 V 20 ns ‡ VREF+ terminal CVREF+=μF, ~0.5 VREF+ , Error of conversion result ≤ 1 LSB VCC = CVREF+ Capacitance at pin VREF+ (see Note 1) REFON =1, 0 mA ≤ IVREF+ ≤ IVREF+max VCC = 2.2 V/3 V 5 10 μF TREF+ † Temperature coefficient of built-in reference IVREF+ is a constant in the range of 0 mA ≤ IVREF+ ≤ 1 mA VCC = 2.2 V/3 V ±100 ppm/°C tREFON † Settle time of internal reference voltage (see Figure 16 and Note 2) IVREF+ = 0.5 mA, CVREF+ = 10 μF, VREF+ = 1.5 V, VAVCC = 2.2 V 17 ms † Not production tested, limits characterized ‡ Not production tested, limits verified by design NOTES: 1. The internal buffer operational amplifier and the accuracy specifications require an external capacitor. All INL and DNL tests uses two capacitors between pins VREF+ and AVSS and VREF−/VeREF− and AVSS: 10 μF tantalum and 100 nF ceramic. 2. The condition is that the error in a conversion started after tREFON is less than ±0.5 LSB. The settling time depends on the external capacitive load. CVREF+ 1 μF 0 1 ms 10 ms 100 ms tREFON tREFON ≈ .66 x CVREF+ [ms] with CVREF+ in μF 100 μF 10 μF Figure 16. Typical Settling Time of Internal Reference tREFON vs External Capacitor on VREF+ MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 41 + − 10 μF 100 nF AVSS MSP430F15x MSP430F16x + − + − 10 μF 100 nF 10 μF 100 nF AVCC 10 μF 100 nF DVSS From DVCC Power Supply Apply External Reference + − Apply External Reference [VeREF+] or Use Internal Reference [VREF+] VREF+ or VeREF+ VREF−/VeREF− MSP430F161x Figure 17. Supply Voltage and Reference Voltage Design VREF−/VeREF− External Supply + − 10 μF 100 nF AVSS MSP430F15x MSP430F16x + − 10 μF 100 nF AVCC 10 μF 100 nF DVSS From DVCC Power Supply + − Apply External Reference [VeREF+] or Use Internal Reference [VREF+] VREF+ or VeREF+ Reference Is Internally VREF−/VeREF− Switched to AVSS MSP430F161x Figure 18. Supply Voltage and Reference Voltage Design VREF−/VeREF− = AVSS, Internally Connected MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 42 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) 12-bit ADC, timing parameters PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT fADC12CLK For specified performance of ADC12 linearity parameters 2.2V/3 V 0.45 5 6.3 MHz fADC12OSC Internal ADC12 oscillator ADC12DIV=0, fADC12CLK=fADC12OSC 2.2 V/ 3 V 3.7 5 6.3 MHz t Conversion time CVREF+ ≥ 5 μF, Internal oscillator, fADC12OSC = 3.7 MHz to 6.3 MHz 2.2 V/ 3 V 2.06 3.51 μs tCONVERT External fADC12CLK from ACLK, MCLK or SMCLK: ADC12SSEL ≠ 0 13×ADC12DIV× 1/fADC12CLK μs tADC12ON ‡ Turn on settling time of the ADC (see Note 1) 100 ns t ‡ Sampling time RS = 400 Ω, RI = 1000 Ω, C 30 pF 3 V 1220 tSample ns CI = τ = [RS + RI] x CI;(see Note 2) 2.2 V 1400 † Not production tested, limits characterized ‡ Not production tested, limits verified by design NOTES: 1. The condition is that the error in a conversion started after tADC12ON is less than ±0.5 LSB. The reference and input signal are already settled. 2. Approximately ten Tau (τ) are needed to get an error of less than ±0.5 LSB: tSample = ln(2n+1) x (RS + RI) x CI+ 800 ns where n = ADC resolution = 12, RS = external source resistance. 12-bit ADC, linearity parameters PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT E Integral linearity error 1.4 V ≤ (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−) min ≤ 1.6 V 2 2 V/3 V ±2 EI LSB 1.6 V < (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−) min ≤ [VAVCC] 2.2 ±1.7 ED Differential linearity error (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−)min ≤ (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−), CVREF+ = 10 μF (tantalum) and 100 nF (ceramic) 2.2 V/3 V ±1 LSB EO Offset error (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−)min ≤ (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−), Internal impedance of source RS < 100 Ω, CVREF+ = 10 μF (tantalum) and 100 nF (ceramic) 2.2 V/3 V ±2 ±4 LSB EG Gain error (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−)min ≤ (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−), CVREF+ = 10 μF (tantalum) and 100 nF (ceramic) 2.2 V/3 V ±1.1 ±2 LSB ET Total unadjusted error (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−)min ≤ (VeREF+ − VREF−/VeREF−), CVREF+ = 10 μF (tantalum) and 100 nF (ceramic) 2.2 V/3 V ±2 ±5 LSB MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 43 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) 12-bit ADC, temperature sensor and built-in VMID PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT I Operating supply current into REFON = 0, INCH = 0Ah, 2.2 V 40 120 ISENSOR A AVCC terminal (see Note 1) ADC12ON=NA, TA = 25C 3 V 60 160 μA V (see Note 2) ADC12ON = 1, INCH = 0Ah, 2.2 V 986 VSENSOR mV † TA = 0°C 3 V 986 TC † ADC12ON 1 INCH 0Ah 2.2 V 3.55 3.55±3% TCSENSOR mV/°C = 1, = 3 V 3.55 3.55±3% t Sample time required if channel ADC12ON = 1, INCH = 0Ah, Error of conversion result ≤ 1 2.2 V 30 tSENSOR(sample) s † 10 is selected (see Note 3) LSB 3 V 30 μs I Current into divider at channel 11 ADC12ON 1 INCH 0Bh 2.2 V NA IVMID A (see Note 4) = 1, = 0Bh, 3 V NA μA V AV divider at channel 11 ADC12ON = 1, INCH = 0Bh, 2.2 V 1.1 1.1±0.04 VMID AVCC V VMID is ~0.5 x VAVCC 3 V 1.5 1.50±0.04 t Sample time required if channel ADC12ON = 1, INCH = 0Bh, Error of conversion result ≤ 1 2.2 V 1400 tVMID(sample) ns 11 is selected (see Note 5) LSB 3 V 1220 † Not production tested, limits characterized NOTES: 1. The sensor current ISENSOR is consumed if (ADC12ON = 1 and REFON=1), or (ADC12ON=1 AND INCH=0Ah and sample signal is high). When REFON = 1, ISENSOR is already included in IREF+. 2. The temperature sensor offset can be as much as ±20C. A single-point calibration is recommended in order to minimize the offset error of the built-in temperature sensor. 3. The typical equivalent impedance of the sensor is 51 kΩ. The sample time required includes the sensor-on time tSENSOR(on) 4. No additional current is needed. The VMID is used during sampling. 5. The on-time tVMID(on) is included in the sampling time tVMID(sample); no additional on time is needed. 12-bit DAC, supply specifications PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT AVCC Analog supply voltage AVCC = DVCC, AVSS = DVSS =0 V 2.20 3.60 V DAC12AMPx=2, DAC12IR=0, DAC12_xDAT=0800h 2.2V/3V 50 110 I Supply Current: DAC12AMPx=2, DAC12IR=1, DAC12_xDAT=0800h , VeREF+=VREF+= AVCC 2.2V/3V 50 110 IDD Single DAC Channel A (see Notes 1 and 2) DAC12AMPx=5, DAC12IR=1, DAC12_xDAT=0800h, VeREF+=VREF+= AVCC 2.2V/3V 200 440 μA DAC12AMPx=7, DAC12IR=1, DAC12_xDAT=0800h, VeREF+=VREF+= AVCC 2.2V/3V 700 1500 PSRR Power supply DAC12_xDAT = 800h, VREF = 1.5 V ΔAVCC = 100mV 2.2V rejection ratio 70 dB (see Notes 3 and 4) DAC12_xDAT = 800h, VREF = 1.5 V or 2.5 V ΔAVCC = 100mV 3V NOTES: 1. No load at the output pin, DAC12_0 or DAC12_1, assuming that the control bits for the shared pins are set properly. 2. Current into reference terminals not included. If DAC12IR = 1 current flows through the input divider; see Reference Input specifications. 3. PSRR = 20*log{ΔAVCC/ΔVDAC12_xOUT}. 4. VREF is applied externally. The internal reference is not used. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 44 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) 12-bit DAC, linearity specifications (see Figure 19) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT Resolution (12-bit Monotonic) 12 bits INL Vref = 1.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 2.2V ±2 0 ±8 0 LSB Integral nonlinearity (see Note 1) Vref = 2.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 3V 2.0 8.0 DNL Vref = 1.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 2.2V ±0 4 ±1 0 LSB Differential nonlinearity (see Note 1) Vref = 2.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 3V 0.4 1.0 Offset voltage w/o Vref = 1.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 2.2V ±21 EO calibration (see Notes 1, 2) Vref = 2.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 3V mV Offset voltage with Vref = 1.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 2.2V ±2 5 calibration (see Notes 1, 2) Vref = 2.5 V DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12IR = 1 3V 2.5 dE(O)/dT Offset error temperature coefficient (see Note 1) 2.2V/3V 30 uV/C E Gain error (see Note 1) VREF = 1.5 V 2.2V EG ±3 50 % FSR VREF = 2.5 V 3V 3.50 dE(G)/dT Gain temperature coefficient (see Note 1) 2.2V/3V 10 ppm of FSR/°C Time for offset calibration DAC12AMPx=2 2.2V/3V 100 tOffset_Cal DAC12AMPx=3,5 2.2V/3V 32 ms (see Note 3) DAC12AMPx=4,6,7 2.2V/3V 6 NOTES: 1. Parameters calculated from the best-fit curve from 0x0A to 0xFFF. The best-fit curve method is used to deliver coefficients “a” and “b” of the first order equation: y = a + b*x. VDAC12_xOUT = EO + (1 + EG) * (VeREF+/4095) * DAC12_xDAT, DAC12IR = 1. 2. The offset calibration works on the output operational amplifier. Offset Calibration is triggered setting bit DAC12CALON 3. The offset calibration can be done if DAC12AMPx = {2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7}. The output operational amplifier is switched off with DAC12AMPx ={0, 1}. It is recommended that the DAC12 module be configured prior to initiating calibration. Port activity during calibration may effect accuracy and is not recommended. Positive Negative VR+ Offset Error Gain Error DAC Code DAC VOUT Ideal transfer function RLoad = AVCC CLoad = 100pF 2 DAC Output Figure 19. Linearity Test Load Conditions and Gain/Offset Definition MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 45 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) 12-bit DAC, linearity specifications (continued) DAC12_xDAT − Digital Code −4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3 4 0 512 1024 1536 2048 2560 3072 3584 VCC = 2.2 V, VREF = 1.5V DAC12AMPx = 7 DAC12IR = 1 TYPICAL INL ERROR vs DIGITAL INPUT DATA 4095 INL − Integral Nonlinearity Error − LSB DAC12_xDAT − Digital Code −2.0 −1.5 −1.0 −0.5 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 0 512 1024 1536 2048 2560 3072 3584 VCC = 2.2 V, VREF = 1.5V DAC12AMPx = 7 DAC12IR = 1 TYPICAL DNL ERROR vs DIGITAL INPUT DATA 4095 DNL − Differential Nonlinearity Error − LSB MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 46 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (continued) 12-bit DAC, output specifications PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT No Load, VeREF+ = AVCC, DAC12_xDAT = 0h, DAC12IR = 1, DAC12AMPx = 7 2.2V/3V 0 0.005 V V Output voltage range No Load, VeREF+ = AVCC, DAC12_xDAT = 0FFFh, DAC12IR = 1, DAC12AMPx = 7 2.2V/3V AVCC−0.05 AVCC VO (see Note 1, Figure 22) RLoad= 3 kΩ, VeREF+ = AVCC, DAC12_xDAT = 0h, DAC12IR = 1, DAC12AMPx = 7 2.2V/3V 0 0.1 V RLoad= 3 kΩ, VeREF+ = AVCC, DAC12_xDAT = 0FFFh, DAC12IR = 1, DAC12AMPx = 7 2.2V/3V AVCC−0.13 AVCC V CL(DAC12) Max DAC12 load capacitance 2.2V/3V 100 pF I Max DAC12 2.2V −0.5 +0.5 mA IL(DAC12) load current 3V −1.0 +1.0 mA RLoad= 3 kΩ VO/P(DAC12) = 0 V DAC12AMPx = 7 DAC12_xDAT = 0h 2.2V/3V 150 250 RO/P(DAC12) Output resistance (see Figure 22) RLoad= 3 kΩ VO/P(DAC12) = AVCC DAC12AMPx = 7 DAC12_xDAT = 0FFFh 2.2V/3V 150 250 Ω RLoad= 3 kΩ 0.3 V < VO/P(DAC12) < AVCC − 0.3 V DAC12AMPx = 7 2.2V/3V 1 4 NOTES: 1. Data is valid after the offset calibration of the output amplifier. RO/P(DAC12_x) Max 0.3 AVCC AVCC −0.3V VOUT Min RLoad AVCC CLoad = 100pF 2 ILoad DAC12 O/P(DAC12_x) Figure 22. DAC12_x Output Resistance Tests MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 47 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) 12-bit DAC, reference input specifications PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT Ve Reference input DAC12IR=0 (see Notes 1 and 2) 2.2V/3V AVCC/3 AVCC+0.2 VeREF+ V voltage range DAC12IR=1 (see Notes 3 and 4) 2.2V/3V AVcc AVcc+0.2 DAC12_0 IR = DAC12_1 IR = 0 2.2V/3V 20 MΩ DAC12_0 IR = 1, DAC12_1 IR = 0 2.2V/3V 40 48 56 kΩ Ri(VREF+), Ri Reference input i t DAC12_0 IR = 0, DAC12_1 IR = 1 2.2V/3V (VREF+) Ri(VeREF+) p resistance DAC12_0 IR = DAC12_1 IR =1, DAC12_0 SREFx = DAC12_1 SREFx (see Note 5) 2.2V/3V 20 24 28 kΩ NOTES: 1. For a full-scale output, the reference input voltage can be as high as 1/3 of the maximum output voltage swing (AVCC). 2. The maximum voltage applied at reference input voltage terminal VeREF+ = [AVCC − VE(O)] / [3*(1 + EG)]. 3. For a full-scale output, the reference input voltage can be as high as the maximum output voltage swing (AVCC). 4. The maximum voltage applied at reference input voltage terminal VeREF+ = [AVCC − VE(O)] / (1 + EG). 5. When DAC12IR = 1 and DAC12SREFx = 0 or 1 for both channels, the reference input resistive dividers for each DAC are in parallel reducing the reference input resistance. 12-bit DAC, dynamic specifications; Vref = VCC, DAC12IR = 1 (see Figure 23 and Figure 24) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT DAC12_xDAT = 800h, DAC12AMPx = 0 → {2, 3, 4} 2.2V/3V 60 120 tON DAC12 _ , ErrorV(O) < ±0.5 LSB (see Note ON DAC12AMPx = 0 → {5, 6} 2.2V/3V 15 30 μs on-time 1,Figure 23) DAC12AMPx = 0 → 7 2.2V/3V 6 12 μ S ttli ti DAC12 DAT DAC12AMPx = 2 2.2V/3V 100 200 tS(FS) Settling time, DAC12_xDAT = DAC12AMPx = 3,5 2.2V/3V 40 80 μs full-scale 80h→ F7Fh→ 80h DAC12AMPx = 4,6,7 2.2V/3V 15 30 S ttli ti DAC12 xDAT = DAC12AMPx = 2 2.2V/3V 5 tS(C-C) Settling time, code to code DAC12_3F8h→ 408h→ 3F8h DAC12AMPx = 3,5 2.2V/3V 2 μs BF8h→ C08h→ BF8h DAC12AMPx = 4,6,7 2.2V/3V 1 DAC12 DAT DAC12AMPx = 2 2.2V/3V 0.05 0.12 SR Slew rate DAC12_xDAT = DAC12AMPx = 3,5 2.2V/3V 0.35 0.7 V/μs 80h→ F7Fh→ 80h DAC12AMPx = 4,6,7 2.2V/3V 1.5 2.7 DAC12 DAT DAC12AMPx = 2 2.2V/3V 10 Glitch energy: full-scale DAC12_xDAT = full DAC12AMPx = 3,5 2.2V/3V 10 nV-s 80h→ F7Fh→ 80h DAC12AMPx = 4,6,7 2.2V/3V 10 nV NOTES: 1. RLoad and CLoad connected to AVSS (not AVCC/2) in Figure 23. 2. Slew rate applies to output voltage steps ≥ 200mV. RLoad AVCC CLoad = 100pF 2 DAC Output RO/P(DAC12.x) ILoad Conversion 1 Conversion 2 VOUT Conversion 3 Glitch Energy +/− 1/2 LSB +/− 1/2 LSB tsettleLH tsettleHL = 3 kΩ Figure 23. Settling Time and Glitch Energy Testing MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 48 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) Conversion 1 Conversion 2 VOUT Conversion 3 10% tSRLH tSRHL 90% 10% 90% Figure 24. Slew Rate Testing 12-bit DAC, dynamic specifications continued (TA = 25°C unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT DAC12AMPx = {2, 3, 4}, DAC12SREFx = 2, DAC12IR = 1, DAC12_xDAT = 800h 2.2V/3V 40 BW−3dB 3-dB bandwidth, VDC=1.5V, VAC=0.1VPP DAC12AMPx = {5, 6}, DAC12SREFx = 2, DAC12IR = 1, DAC12_xDAT = 800h 2.2V/3V 180 kHz (see Figure 25) DAC12AMPx = 7, DAC12SREFx = 2, DAC12IR = 1, DAC12_xDAT = 800h 2.2V/3V 550 Channel to channel crosstalk DAC12_0DAT = 800h, No Load, DAC12_1DAT = 80h<−>F7Fh, RLoad = 3kΩ fDAC12_1OUT = 10kHz @ 50/50 duty cycle 2.2V/3V −80 dB (see Note 1 and Figure 26) DAC12_0DAT = 80h<−>F7Fh, RLoad = 3kΩ, DAC12_1DAT = 800h, No Load fDAC12_0OUT = 10kHz @ 50/50 duty cycle 2.2V/3V −80 NOTES: 1. RLOAD = 3 kΩ, CLOAD = 100 pF VeREF+ AC DC RLoad AVCC CLoad = 100pF 2 ILoad DAC12_x DACx = 3 kΩ Figure 25. Test Conditions for 3-dB Bandwidth Specification DAC12_xDAT 080h VOUT fToggle 7F7h VDAC12_yOUT 080h 7F7h 080h VDAC12_xOUT e REF+ RLoad AVCC CLoad = 100pF 2 ILoad DAC12_1 RLoad AVCC CLoad = 100pF 2 ILoad DAC12_0 DAC0 DAC1 V Figure 26. Crosstalk Test Conditions MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 49 electrical characteristics over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) flash memory PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT VCC(PGM/ ERASE) Program and erase supply voltage 2.7 3.6 V fFTG Flash timing generator frequency 257 476 kHz IPGM Supply current from DVCC during program 2.7 V/ 3.6 V 3 5 mA IERASE Supply current from DVCC during erase 2.7 V/ 3.6 V 3 7 mA tCPT Cumulative program time see Note 1 2.7 V/ 3.6 V 4 ms tCMErase Cumulative mass erase time see Note 2 2.7 V/ 3.6 V 200 ms Program/Erase endurance 104 105 cycles tRetention Data retention duration TJ = 25°C 100 years tWord Word or byte program time 35 tBlock, 0 Block program time for 1st byte or word 30 tBlock, 1-63 Block program time for each additional byte or word see Note 3 21 t tBlock, End Block program end-sequence wait time 6 tFTG tMass Erase Mass erase time 5297 tSeg Erase Segment erase time 4819 NOTES: 1. The cumulative program time must not be exceeded when writing to a 64-byte flash block. This parameter applies to all programming methods: individual word/byte write and block write modes. 2. The mass erase duration generated by the flash timing generator is at least 11.1ms ( = 5297x1/fFTG,max = 5297x1/476kHz). To achieve the required cumulative mass erase time the Flash Controller’s mass erase operation can be repeated until this time is met. (A worst case minimum of 19 cycles are required). 3. These values are hardwired into the Flash Controller’s state machine (tFTG = 1/fFTG). JTAG interface PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN NOM MAX UNIT f TCK input frequency see Note 1 2.2 V 0 5 MHz fTCK 3 V 0 10 MHz RInternal Internal pull-up resistance on TMS, TCK, TDI/TCLK see Note 2 2.2 V/ 3 V 25 60 90 kΩ NOTES: 1. fTCK may be restricted to meet the timing requirements of the module selected. 2. TMS, TDI/TCLK, and TCK pull-up resistors are implemented in all versions. JTAG fuse (see Note 1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN NOM MAX UNIT VCC(FB) Supply voltage during fuse-blow condition TA = 25°C 2.5 V VFB Voltage level on TDI/TCLK for fuse-blow: F versions 6 7 V IFB Supply current into TDI/TCLK during fuse blow 100 mA tFB Time to blow fuse 1 ms NOTES: 1. Once the fuse is blown, no further access to the MSP430 JTAG/Test and emulation features is possible. The JTAG block is switched to bypass mode. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 50 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics port P1, P1.0 to P1.7, input/output with Schmitt trigger P1.0/TACLK ... P1IN.x Module X IN Pad Logic Interrupt Flag Edge Select Interrupt P1SEL.x P1IES.x P1IFG.x P1IRQ.x P1IE.x EN D Set EN Q P1OUT.x P1DIR.x P1SEL.x Module X OUT Direction Control From Module 0 1 0 1 P1.7/TA2 PnSel.x PnDIR.x Dir. CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN PnIE.x PnIFG.x PnIES.x P1Sel.0 P1DIR.0 P1DIR.0 P1OUT.0 DVSS P1IN.0 TACLK† P1IE.0 P1IFG.0 P1IES.0 P1Sel.1 P1DIR.1 P1DIR.1 P1OUT.1 Out0 signal† P1IN.1 CCI0A† P1IE.1 P1IFG.1 P1IES.1 P1Sel.2 P1DIR.2 P1DIR.2 P1OUT.2 Out1 signal† P1IN.2 CCI1A† P1IE.2 P1IFG.2 P1IES.2 P1Sel.3 P1DIR.3 P1DIR.3 P1OUT.3 Out2 signal† P1IN.3 CCI2A† P1IE.3 P1IFG.3 P1IES.3 P1Sel.4 P1DIR.4 P1DIR.4 P1OUT.4 SMCLK P1IN.4 unused P1IE.4 P1IFG.4 P1IES.4 P1Sel.5 P1DIR.5 P1DIR.5 P1OUT.5 Out0 signal† P1IN.5 unused P1IE.5 P1IFG.5 P1IES.5 P1Sel.6 P1DIR.6 P1DIR.6 P1OUT.6 Out1 signal† P1IN.6 unused P1IE.6 P1IFG.6 P1IES.6 P1Sel.7 P1DIR.7 P1DIR.7 P1OUT.7 Out2 signal† P1IN.7 unused P1IE.7 P1IFG.7 P1IES.7 † Signal from or to Timer_A MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 51 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P2, P2.0 to P2.2, P2.6, and P2.7 input/output with Schmitt trigger P2IN.x P2OUT.x Pad Logic P2DIR.x P2SEL.x Module X OUT Edge Select Interrupt P2SEL.x P2IES.x P2IFG.x P2IRQ.x P2IE.x Direction Control P2.0/ACLK 0 1 0 1 Interrupt Flag Set EN Q Module X IN EN D Bus Keeper CAPD.X P2.1/TAINCLK P2.2/CAOUT/TA0 P2.6/ADC12CLK/DMAE0 P2.7/TA0 0: Input 1: Output x: Bit Identifier 0 to 2, 6, and 7 for Port P2 From Module PnSel.x PnDIR.x Dir. CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN PnIE.x PnIFG.x PnIES.x P2Sel.0 P2DIR.0 P2DIR.0 P2OUT.0 ACLK P2IN.0 unused P2IE.0 P2IFG.0 P2IES.0 P2Sel.1 P2DIR.1 P2DIR.1 P2OUT.1 DVSS P2IN.1 INCLK‡ P2IE.1 P2IFG.1 P2IES.1 P2Sel.2 P2DIR.2 P2DIR.2 P2OUT.2 CAOUT† P2IN.2 CCI0B‡ P2IE.2 P2IFG.2 P2IES.2 P2Sel.6 P2DIR.6 P2DIR.6 P2OUT.6 ADC12CLK¶ P2IN.6 DMAE0# P2IE.6 P2IFG.6 P2IES.6 P2Sel.7 P2DIR.7 P2DIR.7 P2OUT.7 Out0 signal§ P2IN.7 unused P2IE.7 P2IFG.7 P2IES.7 † Signal from Comparator_A ‡ Signal to Timer_A § Signal from Timer_A ¶ ADC12CLK signal is output of the 12-bit ADC module # Signal to DMA, channel 0, 1 and 2 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 52 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P2, P2.3 to P2.4, input/output with Schmitt trigger Bus Keeper P2IN.3 P2OUT.3 Pad Logic P2DIR.3 P2SEL.3 Module X OUT Edge Select Interrupt P2SEL.3 P2IES.3 P2IFG.3 P2IRQ.3 P2IE.3 Direction Control From Module P2.3/CA0/TA1 0 1 0 1 Interrupt Flag Set EN Q Module X IN EN D P2IN.4 P2OUT.4 Pad Logic P2DIR.4 P2SEL.4 Module X OUT Edge Select Interrupt P2SEL.4 P2IES.4 P2IFG.4 P2IRQ.4 P2IE.4 Direction Control From Module P2.4/CA1/TA2 0 1 0 1 Interrupt Flag Set EN Q Module X IN EN D Comparator_A − + Reference Block CCI1B CAF CAREF P2CA CAEX CAREF Bus Keeper CAPD.3 CAPD.4 To Timer_A3 0: Input 1: Output 0: Input 1: Output PnSel.x PnDIR.x DIRECTION CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN PnIE.x PnIFG.x PnIES.x P2Sel.3 P2DIR.3 P2DIR.3 P2OUT.3 Out1 signal† P2IN.3 unused P2IE.3 P2IFG.3 P2IES.3 P2Sel.4 P2DIR.4 P2DIR.4 P2OUT.4 Out2 signal† P2IN.4 unused P2IE.4 P2IFG.4 P2IES.4 † Signal from Timer_A MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 53 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P2, P2.5, input/output with Schmitt trigger and Rosc function for the basic clock module P2IN.5 P2OUT.5 Pad Logic P2DIR.5 P2SEL.5 Module X OUT Edge Select Interrupt P2SEL.5 P2IES.5 P2IFG.5 P2IRQ.5 P2IE.5 Direction Control P2.5/Rosc 0 1 0 1 Interrupt Flag Set EN Q DCOR Module X IN EN D to 0 1 DC Generator Bus Keeper CAPD.5 DCOR: Control Bit From Basic Clock Module If it Is Set, P2.5 Is Disconnected From P2.5 Pad Internal to Basic Clock Module VCC 0: Input 1: Output From Module PnSel.x PnDIR.x DIRECTION CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN PnIE.x PnIFG.x PnIES.x P2Sel.5 P2DIR.5 P2DIR.5 P2OUT.5 DVSS P2IN.5 unused P2IE.5 P2IFG.5 P2IES.5 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 54 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P3, P3.0 and P3.4 to P3.7, input/output with Schmitt trigger P3.0/STE0 P3IN.x Module X IN Pad Logic EN D P3OUT.x P3DIR.x P3SEL.x Module X OUT Direction Control From Module 0 1 0 1 P3.4/UTXD0 P3.5/URXD0 0: Input 1: Output x: Bit Identifier, 0 and 4 to 7 for Port P3 P3.6/UTXD1‡ P3.7/URXD1¶ PnSel.x PnDIR.x DIRECTION CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN P3Sel.0 P3DIR.0 DVSS P3OUT.0 DVSS P3IN.0 STE0 P3Sel.4 P3DIR.4 DVCC P3OUT.4 UTXD0† P3IN.4 Unused P3Sel.5 P3DIR.5 DVSS P3OUT.5 DVSS P3IN.5 URXD0§ P3Sel.6 P3DIR.6 DVCC P3OUT.6 UTXD1‡ P3IN.6 Unused P3Sel.7 P3DIR.7 DVSS P3OUT.7 DVSS P3IN.7 URXD1¶ † Output from USART0 module ‡ Output from USART1 module ‡ Input to USART0 module ¶ Input to USART1 module MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 55 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P3, P3.1, input/output with Schmitt trigger P3.1/SIMO0/SDA P3IN.1 Pad Logic EN D P3OUT1 P3DIR.1 P3SEL.1 (SI)MO0 or SDAo/p 0 1 0 1 DCM_SIMO SYNC MM STE STC From USART0 SI(MO)0 or SDAi/p To USAET0 0: Input 1: Output MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 56 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P3, P3.2, input/output with Schmitt trigger P3.2/SOMI0 P3IN.2 Pad Logic EN D P3OUT.2 P3DIR.2 P3SEL.2 0 1 0 1 DCM_SOMI SYNC MM STE STC SO(MI)0 From USART0 (SO)MI0 To USART0 0: Input 1: Output port P3, P3.3, input/output with Schmitt-trigger P3.3/UCLK0/SCL P3IN.3 Pad Logic EN D P3OUT.3 P3DIR.3 P3SEL.3 UCLK.0 0 1 0 1 DCM_UCLK SYNC MM STE STC From USART0 UCLK0 To USART0 0: Input 1: Output NOTE: UART mode: The UART clock can only be an input. If UART mode and UART function are selected, the P3.3/UCLK0 is always an input. SPI, slave mode: The clock applied to UCLK0 is used to shift data in and out. SPI, master mode: The clock to shift data in and out is supplied to connected devices on pin P3.3/UCLK0 (in slave mode). I2C, slave mode: The clock applied to SCL is used to shift data in and out. The frequency of the clock source of the module must be  10 times the frequency of the SCL clock. I2C, master mode: To shift data in and out, the clock is supplied via the SCL terminal to all I2C slaves. The frequency of the clock source of the module must be  10 times the frequency of the SCL clock. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 57 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P4, P4.0 to P4.6, input/output with Schmitt trigger P4OUT.x Module X OUT P4DIR.x Direction Control From Module P4SEL.x D EN 0 1 1 0 Module X IN P4IN.x 0: Input 1: Output Bus Keeper Module IN of pin P5.7/TBOUTH/SVSOUT x: Bit Identifier, 0 to 6 for Port P4 P4.0/TB0 ... P4.6/TB6 P4SEL.7 P4DIR.7 PnSel.x PnDIR.x DIRECTION CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN P4Sel.0 P4DIR.0 P4DIR.0 P4OUT.0 Out0 signal† P4IN.0 CCI0A / CCI0B‡ P4Sel.1 P4DIR.1 P4DIR.1 P4OUT.1 Out1 signal† P4IN.1 CCI1A / CCI1B‡ P4Sel.2 P4DIR.2 P4DIR.2 P4OUT.2 Out2 signal† P4IN.2 CCI2A / CCI2B‡ P4Sel.3 P4DIR.3 P4DIR.3 P4OUT.3 Out3 signal† P4IN.3 CCI3A / CCI3B‡ P4Sel.4 P4DIR.4 P4DIR.4 P4OUT.4 Out4 signal† P4IN.4 CCI4A / CCI4B‡ P4Sel.5 P4DIR.5 P4DIR.5 P4OUT.5 Out5 signal† P4IN.5 CCI5A / CCI5B‡ P4Sel.6 P4DIR.6 P4DIR.6 P4OUT.6 Out6 signal† P4IN.6 CCI6A † Signal from Timer_B ‡ Signal to Timer_B MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 58 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P4, P4.7, input/output with Schmitt trigger P4.7/TBCLK P4IN.7 Timer_B, Pad Logic EN D P4OUT.7 P4DIR.7 P4SEL.7 0 1 0 1 TBCLK 0: Input 1: Output DVSS port P5, P5.0 and P5.4 to P5.7, input/output with Schmitt trigger P5.0/STE1 P5IN.x Module X IN Pad Logic EN D P5OUT.x P5DIR.x P5SEL.x Module X OUT Direction Control From Module 0 1 0 1 P5.4/MCLK P5.5/SMCLK P5.6/ACLK P5.7/TBOUTH/SVSOUT x: Bit Identifier, 0 and 4 to 7 for Port P5 0: Input 1: Output PnSel.x PnDIR.x Dir. CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN P5Sel.0 P5DIR.0 DVSS P5OUT.0 DVSS P5IN.0 STE.1 P5Sel.4 P5DIR.4 DVCC P5OUT.4 MCLK P5IN.4 unused P5Sel.5 P5DIR.5 DVCC P5OUT.5 SMCLK P5IN.5 unused P5Sel.6 P5DIR.6 DVCC P5OUT.6 ACLK P5IN.6 unused P5Sel.7 P5DIR.7 DVSS P5OUT.7 SVSOUT P5IN.7 TBOUTHiZ NOTE: TBOUTHiZ signal is used by port module P4, pins P4.0 to P4.6. The function of TBOUTHiZ is mainly useful when used with Timer_B7. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 59 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P5, P5.1, input/output with Schmitt trigger P5.1/SIMO1 P5IN.1 Pad Logic EN D P5OUT.1 P5DIR.1 P5SEL.1 0 1 0 1 DCM_SIMO SYNC MM STE STC (SI)MO1 From USART1 SI(MO)1 To USART1 0: Input 1: Output port P5, P5.2, input/output with Schmitt trigger P5.2/SOMI1 P5IN.2 Pad Logic EN D P5OUT.2 P5DIR.2 P5SEL.2 0 1 0 1 DCM_SOMI SYNC MM STE STC SO(MI)1 From USART1 (SO)MI1 To USART1 0: Input 1: Output MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 60 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P5, P5.3, input/output with Schmitt trigger P5.3/UCLK1 P5IN.3 Pad Logic EN D P5OUT.3 P5DIR.3 P5SEL.3 0 1 0 1 DCM_SIMO SYNC MM STE STC UCLK1 From USART1 UCLK1 To USART1 0: Input 1: Output NOTE: UART mode: The UART clock can only be an input. If UART mode and UART function are selected, the P5.3/UCLK1 direction is always input. SPI, slave mode: The clock applied to UCLK1 is used to shift data in and out. SPI, master mode: The clock to shift data in and out is supplied to connected devices on pin P5.3/UCLK1 (in slave mode). MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 61 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P6, P6.0 to P6.5, input/output with Schmitt trigger P6IN.x Module X IN Pad Logic EN D P6OUT.x P6DIR.x P6SEL.x Module X OUT Direction Control From Module 0 1 0 1 Bus Keeper To ADC From ADC 0: Input 1: Output x: Bit Identifier, 0 to 5 for Port P6 P6.0/A0 P6.1/A1 P6.2/A2 P6.3/A3 P6.4/A4 P6.5/A5 NOTE: Analog signals applied to digital gates can cause current flow from the positive to the negative terminal. The throughput current flows if the analog signal is in the range of transitions 0→1 or 1←0. The value of the throughput current depends on the driving capability of the gate. For MSP430, it is approximately 100 μA. Use P6SEL.x=1 to prevent throughput current. P6SEL.x should be set, even if the signal at the pin is not being used by the ADC12. PnSel.x PnDIR.x DIR. CONTROL FROM MODULE PnOUT.x MODULE X OUT PnIN.x MODULE X IN P6Sel.0 P6DIR.0 P6DIR.0 P6OUT.0 DVSS P6IN.0 unused P6Sel.1 P6DIR.1 P6DIR.1 P6OUT.1 DVSS P6IN.1 unused P6Sel.2 P6DIR.2 P6DIR.2 P6OUT.2 DVSS P6IN.2 unused P6Sel.3 P6DIR.3 P6DIR.3 P6OUT.3 DVSS P6IN.3 unused P6Sel.4 P6DIR.4 P6DIR.4 P6OUT.4 DVSS P6IN.4 unused P6Sel.5 P6DIR.5 P6DIR.5 P6OUT.5 DVSS P6IN.5 unused NOTE: The signal at pins P6.x/Ax is used by the 12-bit ADC module. MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 62 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P6, P6.6, input/output with Schmitt trigger 0, if DAC12.0CALON = 0 and DAC12.0AMP > 1 P6OUT.6 DVSS P6DIR.6 P6DIR.6 P6SEL.6 D EN 0 1 1 0 0: Port Active, T-Switch Off 1: T-Switch On, Port Disabled P6.6/A6/DAC0 P6IN.6 Pad Logic 0: Input 1: Output Bus Keeper 1 0 1, if DAC12.0AMP = 1 ’1’, if DAC12.0AMP > 0 1, if DAC12.0AMP >1 + − INCH = 6† a6† †Signal from or to ADC12 MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 63 APPLICATION INFORMATION input/output schematics (continued) port P6, P6.7, input/output with Schmitt trigger 0, if DAC12.0CALON = 0 and DAC12.0AMP > 1 P6OUT.7 DVSS P6DIR.7 P6DIR.7 P6SEL.6 D EN 0 1 1 0 0: Port Active, T-Switch Off 1: T-Switch On, Port Disabled P6.7/A7/ P6IN.7 Pad Logic 0: Input 1: Output Bus Keeper 1 0 1, if DAC12.0AMP = 1 ’1’, if DAC12.0AMP > 0 1, if DAC12.0AMP > 1 + − INCH = 7‡ a7‡ †Signal to SVS Block, Selected if VLD = 15 ‡Signal From or To ADC12 §VLD Control Bits are Located in SVS DAC1/SVSIN To SVS Mux (15)† ’1’, if VLD = 15§ MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 64 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 APPLICATION INFORMATION JTAG pins TMS, TCK, TDI/TCLK, TDO/TDI, input/output with Schmitt trigger TDI TDO TMS TCK Test JTAG and Emulation Module Burn & Test Fuse Controlled by JTAG Controlled by JTAG Controlled by JTAG DVCC DVCC DVCC During Programming Activity and During Blowing of the Fuse, Pin TDO/TDI Is Used to Apply the Test Input Data for JTAG Circuitry TDO/TDI TDI/TCLK TMS TCK Fuse DVCC MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 65 APPLICATION INFORMATION JTAG fuse check mode MSP430 devices that have the fuse on the TDI/TCLK terminal have a fuse check mode that tests the continuity of the fuse the first time the JTAG port is accessed after a power-on reset (POR). When activated, a fuse check current, ITF, of 1 mA at 3 V, 2.5 mA at 5 V can flow from the TDI/TCLK pin to ground if the fuse is not burned. Care must be taken to avoid accidentally activating the fuse check mode and increasing overall system power consumption. Activation of the fuse check mode occurs with the first negative edge on the TMS pin after power up or if the TMS is being held low during power up. The second positive edge on the TMS pin deactivates the fuse check mode. After deactivation, the fuse check mode remains inactive until another POR occurs. After each POR the fuse check mode has the potential to be activated. The fuse check current will only flow when the fuse check mode is active and the TMS pin is in a low state (see Figure 27). Therefore, the additional current flow can be prevented by holding the TMS pin high (default condition). Time TMS Goes Low After POR TMS ITF ITDI/TCLK Figure 27. Fuse Check Mode Current, MSP430F15x/16x/161x MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F161x MIXED SIGNAL MICROCONTROLLER SLAS368G − OCTOBER 2002 − REVISED MARCH 2011 66 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 Data Sheet Revision History LITERATURE NUMBER SUMMARY SLAS368F In absolute maximum ratings table, changed Tstg min from −40°C to −55°C (page 25) Added Development Tools Support section (page 2) SLAS368G Changed limits on td(SVSon) parameter (page 35) PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 11-Apr-2013 Addendum-Page 1 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Top-Side Markings (4) Samples MSP430F155IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F155 MSP430F155IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F155 MSP430F155IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F155 MSP430F155IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F155 MSP430F156IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F156 MSP430F156IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F156 MSP430F156IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F156 MSP430F156IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F156 MSP430F157IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F157 MSP430F157IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F157 MSP430F157IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F157 MSP430F157IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F157 MSP430F1610IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1610 MSP430F1610IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1610 MSP430F1610IRTD ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 TBD Call TI Call TI MSP430F1610IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1610 MSP430F1610IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1610 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 11-Apr-2013 Addendum-Page 2 Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Top-Side Markings (4) Samples MSP430F1611IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F1611 MSP430F1611IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F1611 MSP430F1611IRTD ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 TBD Call TI Call TI MSP430F1611IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1611 MSP430F1611IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1611 MSP430F1612IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1612 MSP430F1612IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1612 MSP430F1612IRTD ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 TBD Call TI Call TI MSP430F1612IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1612 MSP430F1612IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F1612 MSP430F167IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F167 MSP430F167IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F167 MSP430F167IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F167 MSP430F167IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F167 MSP430F168IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F168 MSP430F168IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F168 MSP430F168IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F168 MSP430F168IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F168 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 11-Apr-2013 Addendum-Page 3 Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Drawing Pins Package Qty Eco Plan (2) Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (3) Op Temp (°C) Top-Side Markings (4) Samples MSP430F169IPM ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 160 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F169 MSP430F169IPMR ACTIVE LQFP PM 64 1000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 M430F169 MSP430F169IRTDR ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F169 MSP430F169IRTDT ACTIVE VQFN RTD 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU SN Level-3-260C-168 HR M430F169 (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. -- The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) Multiple Top-Side Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Top-Side Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Top-Side Marking for that device. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Reel Diameter (mm) Reel Width W1 (mm) A0 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W (mm) Pin1 Quadrant MSP430F155IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F156IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F157IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F1610IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F1611IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F1612IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F167IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F168IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 MSP430F169IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 330.0 24.4 13.0 13.0 2.1 16.0 24.0 Q2 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 13-Sep-2013 Pack Materials-Page 1 *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) MSP430F155IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F156IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F157IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F1610IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F1611IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F1612IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F167IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F168IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 MSP430F169IPMR LQFP PM 64 1000 367.0 367.0 45.0 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 13-Sep-2013 Pack Materials-Page 2 MECHANICAL DATA MTQF008A – JANUARY 1995 – REVISED DECEMBER 1996 POST OFFICE BOX 655303 • DALLAS, TEXAS 75265 1 PM (S-PQFP-G64) PLASTIC QUAD FLATPACK 4040152/C 11/96 32 17 0,13 NOM 0,25 0,45 0,75 Seating Plane 0,05 MIN Gage Plane 0,27 33 16 48 1 0,17 49 64 SQ SQ 10,20 11,80 12,20 9,80 7,50 TYP 1,60 MAX 1,45 1,35 0,08 0,50 0,08 M 0°–7° NOTES: A. All linear dimensions are in millimeters. B. This drawing is subject to change without notice. C. Falls within JEDEC MS-026 D. May also be thermally enhanced plastic with leads connected to the die pads. IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated 20 mW Power, 2.3 V to 5.5 V, 75 MHz Complete DDS Data Sheet AD9834 FEATURES Narrow-band SFDR >72 dB 2.3 V to 5.5 V power supply Output frequency up to 37.5 MHz Sine output/triangular output On-board comparator 3-wire SPI® interface Extended temperature range: −40°C to +105°C Power-down option 20 mW power consumption at 3 V 20-lead TSSOP APPLICATIONS Frequency stimulus/waveform generation Frequency phase tuning and modulation Low power RF/communications systems Liquid and gas flow measurement Sensory applications: proximity, motion, and defect detection Test and medical equipment GENERAL DESCRIPTION The AD9834 is a 75 MHz low power DDS device capable of producing high performance sine and triangular outputs. It also has an on-board comparator that allows a square wave to be produced for clock generation. Consuming only 20 mW of power at 3 V makes the AD9834 an ideal candidate for power-sensitive applications.Capability for phase modulation and frequency modulation is provided. The frequency registers are 28 bits; with a 75 MHz clock rate, resolution of 0.28 Hz can be achieved. Similarly, with a 1 MHz clock rate, the AD9834 can be tuned to 0.004 Hz resolution. Frequency and phase modulation are affected by loading registers through the serial interface and toggling the registers using software or the FSELECT pin and PSELECT pin, respectively. The AD9834 is written to using a 3-wire serial interface. This serial interface operates at clock rates up to 40 MHz and is compatible with DSP and microcontroller standards. The device operates with a power supply from 2.3 V to 5.5 V. The analog and digital sections are independent and can be run from different power supplies, for example, AVDD can equal 5 V with DVDD equal to 3 V. The AD9834 has a power-down pin (SLEEP) that allows external control of the power-down mode. Sections of the device that are not being used can be powered down to minimize the current consumption. For example, the DAC can be powered down when a clock output is being generated. The part is available in a 20-lead TSSOP. FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM 12ΣMUXMUXCOMPARATORMSBCAP/2.5VDVDDAGNDAVDDMCLKAD9834FSYNCSCLKSDATACOMPIOUTIOUTBDGNDREGULATORREFOUTFS ADJUSTVINFSELECT12-BIT PHASE0 REG12-BIT PHASE1 REGSLEEPRESETPSELECTMUXMUXMUXSIGN BIT OUTVCC2.5VON-BOARDREFERENCE16-BIT CONTROLREGISTERFULL-SCALECONTROL10-BITDACDIVIDEDBY 2SINROMPHASEACCUMULATOR(28-BIT)28-BIT FREQ0REG28-BIT FREQ1REGSERIAL INTERFACEANDCONTROL LOGIC02705-001 Figure 1. Rev. D Document Feedback Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other rights of third parties that may result from its use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A. Tel: 781.329.4700 ©2003–2014 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Technical Support www.analog.com AD9834 Data Sheet TABLE OF CONTENTS Features .............................................................................................. 1 Applications ....................................................................................... 1 General Description ......................................................................... 1 Functional Block Diagram .............................................................. 1 Revision History ............................................................................... 3 Specifications ..................................................................................... 4 Timing Characteristics ................................................................ 6 Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................ 7 ESD Caution .................................................................................. 7 Pin Configuration and Function Descriptions ............................. 8 Typical Performance Characteristics ........................................... 10 Terminology .................................................................................... 14 Theory of Operation ...................................................................... 15 Circuit Description ......................................................................... 16 Numerically Controlled Oscillator Plus Phase Modulator ... 16 SIN ROM ..................................................................................... 16 Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) ....................................... 16 Comparator ................................................................................. 16 Regulator ...................................................................................... 17 Output Voltage Compliance ...................................................... 17 Functional Description .................................................................. 18 Serial Interface ............................................................................ 18 Powering Up the AD9834 ......................................................... 18 Latency ......................................................................................... 18 Control Register ......................................................................... 18 Frequency and Phase Registers ................................................ 20 Writing to a Frequency Register ............................................... 21 Writing to a Phase Register ....................................................... 21 RESET Function ......................................................................... 21 SLEEP Function .......................................................................... 21 SIGN BIT OUT Pin .................................................................... 22 The IOUT and IOUTB Pins ...................................................... 22 Applications Information .............................................................. 23 Grounding and Layout .................................................................. 26 Interfacing to Microprocessors ..................................................... 27 AD9834 to ADSP-21xx Interface ............................................. 27 AD9834 to 68HC11/68L11 Interface ....................................... 27 AD9834 to 80C51/80L51 Interface .......................................... 28 AD9834 to DSP56002 Interface ............................................... 28 Outline Dimensions ....................................................................... 29 Ordering Guide .......................................................................... 29 Rev. D | Page 2 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 REVISION HISTORY 3/14—Rev. C to Rev. D Changes to Table 3 ............................................................................ 7 Deleted Evaluation Board Section ................................................ 29 Changes to Ordering Guide ........................................................... 35 2/11—Rev. B to Rev. C Changes to IDD Parameter, Table 1 .................................................. 5 Changes to FS ADJUST Description, Table 4 ................................ 8 Added Output Voltage Compliance Section................................ 17 Changes to Figure 31 ...................................................................... 23 Changes to Figure 32 ...................................................................... 24 Deleted Using the AD9834 Evaluation Board Section and the Prototyping Area Section ............................................................... 28 Added System Development Platform Section, AD9834 to SPORT Interface Section, Figure 39, and Figure 40; Renumbered Sequentially .............................................................. 29 Changes to XO vs. External Clock Section and Power Supply Section .............................................................................................. 29 Deleted Bill of Materials, Table 19; Renumbered Sequentially .............................................................. 30 Added Evaluation Board Schematics Section and Figure 41 .... 30 Added Figure 42 .............................................................................. 31 Added Evaluation Board Layout Section and Figure 43 ............ 32 Added Figure 44 .............................................................................. 33 Added Figure 45 .............................................................................. 34 Changes to Ordering Guide ........................................................... 35 4/10—Rev. A to Rev. B Changes to Comparator Section ................................................... 15 Added Figure 28 .............................................................................. 16 Changes to Serial Interface Section .............................................. 17 8/06—Rev. 0 to Rev. A Updated Format ................................................................. Universal Changed to 75 MHz Complete DDS ............................... Universal Changes to Features Section ............................................................ 1 Changes to Table 1 ............................................................................ 4 Changes to Table 2 ............................................................................ 6 Changes to Table 3 ............................................................................ 8 Added Figure 10, Figures Renumbered Sequentially ................... 9 Added Figure 16 and Figure 17, Figures Renumbered Sequentially ...................................................................................... 10 Changes to Table 6 .......................................................................... 19 Changes to Writing a Frequency Register Section ..................... 20 Changes to Figure 29 ...................................................................... 21 Changes to Table 19 ........................................................................ 30 Changes to Figure 38 ...................................................................... 28 2/03—Revision 0: Initial Version Rev. D | Page 3 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet SPECIFICATIONS VDD = 2.3 V to 5.5 V, AGND = DGND = 0 V, TA = TMIN to TMAX, RSET = 6.8 kΩ, RLOAD = 200 Ω for IOUT and IOUTB, unless otherwise noted. Table 1. Grade B, Grade C1 Parameter2 Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions/Comments SIGNAL DAC SPECIFICATIONS Resolution 10 Bits Update Rate 75 MSPS IOUT Full Scale3 3.0 mA VOUT Max 0.6 V VOUT Min 30 mV Output Compliance4 0.8 V DC Accuracy Integral Nonlinearity ±1 LSB Differential Nonlinearity ±0.5 LSB DDS SPECIFICATIONS Dynamic Specifications Signal-to-Noise Ratio 55 60 dB fMCLK = 75 MHz, fOUT = fMCLK/4096 Total Harmonic Distortion −66 −56 dBc fMCLK = 75 MHz, fOUT = fMCLK/4096 Spurious-Free Dynamic Range (SFDR) Wideband (0 to Nyquist) −60 −56 dBc fMCLK = 75 MHz, fOUT = fMCLK/75 Narrow Band (±200 kHz) B Grade −78 −67 dBc fMCLK = 50 MHz, fOUT = fMCLK/50 C Grade −74 −65 dBc fMCLK = 75 MHz, fOUT = fMCLK/75 Clock Feedthrough −50 dBc Wake-Up Time 1 ms COMPARATOR Input Voltage Range 1 V p-p AC-coupled internally Input Capacitance 10 pF Input High-Pass Cutoff Frequency 4 MHz Input DC Resistance 5 MΩ Input Leakage Current 10 μA OUTPUT BUFFER Output Rise/Fall Time 12 ns Using a 15 pF load Output Jitter 120 ps rms 3 MHz sine wave, 0.6 V p-p VOLTAGE REFERENCE Internal Reference 1.12 1.18 1.24 V REFOUT Output Impedance5 1 kΩ Reference Temperature Coefficient 100 ppm/°C LOGIC INPUTS Input High Voltage, VINH 1.7 V 2.3 V to 2.7 V power supply 2.0 V 2.7 V to 3.6 V power supply 2.8 V 4.5 V to 5.5 V power supply Input Low Voltage, VINL 0.6 V 2.3 V to 2.7 V power supply 0.7 V 2.7 V to 3.6 V power supply 0.8 V 4.5 V to 5.5 V power supply Input Current, IINH/IINL 10 μA Input Capacitance, CIN 3 pF Rev. D | Page 4 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 Grade B, Grade C1 Parameter2 Min Typ Max Unit Test Conditions/Comments POWER SUPPLIES AVDD 2.3 5.5 V fMCLK = 75 MHz, fOUT = fMCLK/4096 DVDD 2.3 5.5 V IAA6 3.8 5 mA IDD6 B Grade 2.0 3 mA IDD code dependent (see Figure 8) C Grade 2.7 3.7 mA IDD code dependent (see Figure 8) IAA + IDD6 B Grade 5.8 8 mA C Grade 6.5 8.7 mA Low Power Sleep Mode B Grade 0.5 mA DAC powered down, MCLK running C Grade 0.6 mA DAC powered down, MCLK running 1 B grade: MCLK = 50 MHz; C grade: MCLK = 75 MHz. For specifications that do not specify a grade, the value applies to both grades. 2 Operating temperature range is as follows: B, C versions: −40°C to +105°C, typical specifications are at 25°C. 3 For compliance, with specified load of 200 Ω, IOUT full scale should not exceed 4 mA. 4 Guaranteed by design. 5 Applies when REFOUT is sourcing current. The impedance is higher when REFOUT is sinking current. 6 Measured with the digital inputs static and equal to 0 V or DVDD. RSET6.8kΩIOUT1210-BIT DAC20pFFS ADJUSTAD9834REGULATOR100nFCAP/2.5V10nFREFOUTCOMP10nFAVDDSINROMRLOAD200ΩON-BOARDREFERENCEFULL-SCALECONTROL02705-002 Figure 2. Test Circuit Used to Test the Specifications Rev. D | Page 5 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet TIMING CHARACTERISTICS DVDD = 2.3 V to 5.5 V, AGND = DGND = 0 V, unless otherwise noted. Table 2. Parameter1 Limit at TMIN to TMAX Unit Test Conditions/Comments t1 20/13.33 ns min MCLK period: 50 MHz/75 MHz t2 8/6 ns min MCLK high duration: 50 MHz/75 MHz t3 8/6 ns min MCLK low duration: 50 MHz/75 MHz t4 25 ns min SCLK period t5 10 ns min SCLK high duration t6 10 ns min SCLK low duration t7 5 ns min FSYNC-to-SCLK falling edge setup time t8 MIN 10 ns min FSYNC-to-SCLK hold time t8 MAX t4 − 5 ns max t9 5 ns min Data setup time t10 3 ns min Data hold time t11 8 ns min FSELECT, PSELECT setup time before MCLK rising edge t11A 8 ns min FSELECT, PSELECT setup time after MCLK rising edge t12 5 ns min SCLK high to FSYNC falling edge setup time 1 Guaranteed by design, not production tested. Timing Diagrams MCLKt1t3t202705-003 Figure 3. Master Clock FSELECT,PSELECTVALID DATAVALID DATAVALID DATAMCLKt11At1102705-004 Figure 4. Control Timing D0SCLKFSYNCSDATAD15D14D2D1D15D14t12t7t6t8t5t4t9t1002705-005 Figure 5. Serial Timing Rev. D | Page 6 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS TA = 25°C, unless otherwise noted. Table 3. Parameter Ratings AVDD to AGND −0.3 V to +6 V DVDD to DGND −0.3 V to +6 V AGND to DGND −0.3 V to +0.3 V CAP/2.5V 2.75 V Digital I/O Voltage to DGND −0.3 V to DVDD + 0.3 V Analog I/O Voltage to AGND −0.3 V to AVDD + 0.3 V Operating Temperature Range Industrial (B Version) −40°C to +105°C Storage Temperature Range −65°C to +150°C Maximum Junction Temperature 150°C TSSOP Package θJA Thermal Impedance 143°C/W θJC Thermal Impedance 45°C/W Lead Temperature, Soldering (10 sec) 300°C IR Reflow, Peak Temperature 220°C Reflow Soldering (Pb-Free) Peak Temperature 260°C (+0/–5) Time at Peak Temperature 10 sec to 40 sec Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only; functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operational section of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. ESD CAUTION Rev. D | Page 7 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 8 of 32 PIN CONFIGURATION AND FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 REFOUT COMP AVDD DGND CAP/2.5V DVDD FS ADJUST IOUT AGND VIN SCLK FSYNC SIGN BIT OUT PSELECT FSELECT MCLK RESET SLEEP SDATA IOUTB AD9834 TOP VIEW (Not to Scale) 02705-006 Figure 6. Pin Configuration Table 4. Pin Function Descriptions Pin No. Mnemonic Description ANALOG SIGNAL AND REFERENCE 1 FS ADJUST Full-Scale Adjust Control. A resistor (RSET) is connected between this pin and AGND. This determines the magnitude of the full-scale DAC current. The relationship between RSET and the full-scale current is as follows: IOUT FULL SCALE = 18 × FSADJUST/RSET FSADJUST = 1.15 V nominal, RSET = 6.8 kΩ typical. 2 REFOUT Voltage Reference Output. The AD9834 has an internal 1.20 V reference that is made available at this pin. 3 COMP DAC Bias Pin. This pin is used for decoupling the DAC bias voltage. 17 VIN Input to Comparator. The comparator can be used to generate a square wave from the sinusoidal DAC output. The DAC output should be filtered appropriately before being applied to the comparator to improve jitter. When Bit OPBITEN and Bit SIGN/PIB in the control register are set to 1, the comparator input is connected to VIN. 19, 20 IOUT, IOUTB Current Output. This is a high impedance current source. A load resistor of nominally 200 Ω should be connected between IOUT and AGND. IOUTB should preferably be tied through an external load resistor of 200 Ω to AGND, but it can be tied directly to AGND. A 20 pF capacitor to AGND is also recommended to prevent clock feedthrough. POWER SUPPLY 4 AVDD Positive Power Supply for the Analog Section. AVDD can have a value from 2.3 V to 5.5 V. A 0.1 μF decoupling capacitor should be connected between AVDD and AGND. 5 DVDD Positive Power Supply for the Digital Section. DVDD can have a value from 2.3 V to 5.5 V. A 0.1 μF decoupling capacitor should be connected between DVDD and DGND. 6 CAP/2.5V The digital circuitry operates from a 2.5 V power supply. This 2.5 V is generated from DVDD using an on-board regulator (when DVDD exceeds 2.7 V). The regulator requires a decoupling capacitor of typically 100 nF that is connected from CAP/2.5 V to DGND. If DVDD is equal to or less than 2.7 V, CAP/2.5 V should be shorted to DVDD. 7 DGND Digital Ground. 18 AGND Analog Ground. DIGITAL INTERFACE AND CONTROL 8 MCLK Digital Clock Input. DDS output frequencies are expressed as a binary fraction of the frequency of MCLK. The output frequency accuracy and phase noise are determined by this clock. 9 FSELECT Frequency Select Input. FSELECT controls which frequency register, FREQ0 or FREQ1, is used in the phase accumulator. The frequency register to be used can be selected using Pin FSELECT or Bit FSEL. When Bit FSEL is used to select the frequency register, the FSELECT pin should be tied to CMOS high or low. 10 PSELECT Phase Select Input. PSELECT controls which phase register, PHASE0 or PHASE1, is added to the phase accumulator output. The phase register to be used can be selected using Pin PSELECT or Bit PSEL. When the phase registers are being controlled by Bit PSEL, the PSELECT pin should be tied to CMOS high or low. 11 RESET Active High Digital Input. RESET resets appropriate internal registers to zero; this corresponds to an analog output of midscale. RESET does not affect any of the addressable registers. 12 SLEEP Active High Digital Input. When this pin is high, the DAC is powered down. This pin has the same function as Control Bit SLEEP12. Data Sheet AD9834 Pin No. Mnemonic Description 13 SDATA Serial Data Input. The 16-bit serial data-word is applied to this input. 14 SCLK Serial Clock Input. Data is clocked into the AD9834 on each falling SCLK edge. 15 FSYNC Active Low Control Input. This is the frame synchronization signal for the input data. When FSYNC is taken low, the internal logic is informed that a new word is being loaded into the device. 16 SIGN BIT OUT Logic Output. The comparator output is available on this pin or, alternatively, the MSB from the NCO can be output on this pin. Setting Bit OPBITEN in the control register to 1 enables this output pin. Bit SIGN/PIB determines whether the comparator output or the MSB from the NCO is output on the pin. Rev. D | Page 9 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet TYPICAL PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS MCLK FREQUENCY (MHz)4.000755V3VTA = 25°CIDD ( mA)3.53.02.52.01.51.00.51530456002705-007 Figure 7. Typical Current Consumption (IDD) vs. MCLK Frequency 4.000.51.01.52.02.53.03.5fOUT (Hz)IDD (mA)TA = 25°C5V3V1001k10k100k1M10M100M02705-008 Figure 8. Typical IDD vs. fOUT for fMCLK = 50 MHz MCLK FREQUENCY (MHz)SFDR (dBc)–65–60–90–70–75–80–85AVDD = DVDD = 3VTA = 25°CSFDR dB MCLK/50SFDR dB MCLK/70153045607502705-009 Figure 9. Narrow-Band SFDR vs. MCLK Frequency 0–10–20–30–40–50–60–70–80MCLK FREQUENCY (MHz)SFDR (dBc)010203040506070fOUT = 1MHzSFDR dB MCLK/7AVDD = DVDD = 3VTA = 25°C02705-010 Figure 10. Wideband SFDR vs. MCLK Frequency SFDR (dBc)0–40–80–50–60–70–10–20–3050MHz CLOCK30MHz CLOCKAVDD = DVDD = 3VTA = 25°CfOUT/fMCLK0.0010.010.11.01010002705-011 Figure 11. Wideband SFDR vs. fOUT/fMCLK for Various MCLK Frequencies MCLK FREQUENCY (MHz)SNR (dB)–60–65–70–50–55–40–451.05.010.012.525.050.0TA = 25°CAVDD = DVDD = 3VfOUT = MCLK/409602705-012 Figure 12. SNR vs. MCLK Frequency Rev. D | Page 10 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 50010007006506005508507508009009505.5V2.3VTEMPERATURE (°C)–4025105WAKE-UP TIME ( μs)02705-013 Figure 13. Wake-Up Time vs. Temperature 1.1501.1251.1001.1751.2001.2501.225TEMPERATURE (°C)V(REFOUT) (V)LOWER RANGEUPPER RANGE–402510502705-014 Figure 14. VREFOUT vs. Temperature FREQUENCY (Hz)(dBc/Hz)–150–110–100–120–130–140–160AVDD = DVDD = 5VTA = 25°C1001k10k100k200k02705-015 Figure 15. Output Phase Noise, fOUT = 2 MHz, MCLK = 50 MHz 0.200–40–2002040608010002705-037TEMPERATURE(°C)DVDD (V)0.180.160.140.120.100.080.060.040.02DVDD=3.3VDVDD=5.5VDVDD=2.3V Figure 16. SIGN BIT OUT Low Level, ISINK = 1 mA 5.51.5–40–2002040608010002705-038TEMPERATURE(°C)DVDD ( V)5.04.54.03.53.02.52.0DVDD=2.3VDVDD=2.7VDVDD=3.3VDVDD=4.5VDVDD=5.5V Figure 17. SIGN BIT OUT High Level, ISINK = 1 mA FREQUENCY (Hz)(dB)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–10RWB 100ST 100 SECVWB 300100k02705-016 Figure 18. fMCLK = 10 MHz; fOUT = 2.4 kHz, Frequency Word = 000FBA9 Rev. D | Page 11 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet FREQUENCY (Hz)(dB)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–1005MRWB 1kST 50 SECVWB 30002705-017 Figure 19. fMCLK = 10 MHz; fOUT = 1.43 MHz = fMCLK/7, Frequency Word = 2492492 FREQUENCY (Hz)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–1005MRWB 1kST 50 SECVWB 300(dB)02705-018 Figure 20. fMCLK = 10 MHz; fOUT = 3.33 MHz = fMCLK/3, Frequency Word = 5555555 FREQUENCY (Hz)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–100160kRWB 100ST 200 SECVWB 30(dB)02705-019 Figure 21. fMCLK = 50 MHz; fOUT = 12 kHz, Frequency Word = 000FBA9 FREQUENCY (Hz)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–1001.6MRWB 100ST 200 SECVWB 300(dB)02705-020 Figure 22. fMCLK = 50 MHz; fOUT = 120 kHz, Frequency Word = 009D496 FREQUENCY (Hz)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–10025MRWB 1kST 200 SECVWB 300(dB)02705-021 Figure 23. fMCLK = 50 MHz; fOUT = 1.2 MHz, Frequency Word = 0624DD3 FREQUENCY (Hz)(dB)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–10025MRWB 1kST 200 SECVWB 30002705-022 Figure 24. fMCLK = 50 MHz; fOUT = 4.8 MHz, Frequency Word = 189374C Rev. D | Page 12 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 FREQUENCY (Hz)(dB)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–10025MRWB 1kST 200 SECVWB 30002705-023 Figure 25. fMCLK = 50 MHz; fOUT = 7.143 MHz = fMCLK/7, Frequency Word = 2492492 FREQUENCY (Hz)(dB)0–20–50–90–100–80–70–60–40–30–10025MRWB 1kST 200 SECVWB 30002705-024 Figure 26. fMCLK = 50 MHz; fOUT = 16.667 MHz = fMCLK/3, Frequency Word = 5555555 Rev. D | Page 13 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet Rev. D | Page 14 of 32 TERMINOLOGY Integral Nonlinearity (INL) INL is the maximum deviation of any code from a straight line passing through the endpoints of the transfer function. The endpoints of the transfer function are zero scale, a point 0.5 LSB below the first code transition (000 . . . 00 to 000 . . . 01), and full scale, a point 0.5 LSB above the last code transition (111 . . . 10 to 111 . . . 11). The error is expressed in LSBs. Differential Nonlinearity (DNL) DNL is the difference between the measured and ideal 1 LSB change between two adjacent codes in the DAC. A specified DNL of ±1 LSB maximum ensures monotonicity. Output Compliance The output compliance refers to the maximum voltage that can be generated at the output of the DAC to meet the specifications. When voltages greater than that specified for the output com- pliance are generated, the AD9834 may not meet the specifications listed in the data sheet. Spurious-Free Dynamic Range (SFDR) Along with the frequency of interest, harmonics of the fundamental frequency and images of these frequencies are present at the output of a DDS device. The SFDR refers to the largest spur or harmonic present in the band of interest. The wideband SFDR gives the magnitude of the largest harmonic or spur relative to the magnitude of the fundamental frequency in the 0 to Nyquist bandwidth. The narrow-band SFDR gives the attenuation of the largest spur or harmonic in a bandwidth of ±200 kHz about the fundamental frequency. Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) THD is the ratio of the rms sum of harmonics to the rms value of the fundamental. For the AD9834, THD is defined as 1 2 3456 V V VVVV THD 2 2222 log 20    where V1 is the rms amplitude of the fundamental and V2, V3, V4, V5, and V6 are the rms amplitudes of the second harmonic through the sixth harmonic. Signal-to-Noise Ratio (SNR) SNR is the ratio of the rms value of the measured output signal to the rms sum of all other spectral components below the Nyquist frequency. The value for SNR is expressed in decibels. Clock Feedthrough There is feedthrough from the MCLK input to the analog output. Clock feedthrough refers to the magnitude of the MCLK signal relative to the fundamental frequency in the output spectrum of the AD9834. Data Sheet AD9834 THEORY OF OPERATION Sine waves are typically thought of in terms of their magnitude form a(t) = sin (ωt). However, these are nonlinear and not easy to generate except through piecewise construction. On the other hand, the angular information is linear in nature, that is, the phase angle rotates through a fixed angle for each unit of time. The angular rate depends on the frequency of the signal by the traditional rate of ω = 2πf. MAGNITUDEPHASE+10–12p02π4π6π2π4π6π02705-025 Figure 27. Sine Wave Knowing that the phase of a sine wave is linear and given a reference interval (clock period), the phase rotation for that period can be determined. ΔPhase = ωΔt Solving for ω, ω = ΔPhase/Δt = 2πf Solving for f and substituting the reference clock frequency for the reference period (1/fMCLK = Δt), f = ΔPhase × fMCLK/2π The AD9834 builds the output based on this simple equation. A simple DDS chip can implement this equation with three major subcircuits: numerically controlled oscillator + phase modulator, SIN ROM, and digital-to-analog converter (DAC). Each of these subcircuits is discussed in the Circuit Description section. Rev. D | Page 15 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION The AD9834 is a fully integrated direct digital synthesis (DDS) chip. The chip requires one reference clock, one low precision resistor, and eight decoupling capacitors to provide digitally created sine waves up to 37.5 MHz. In addition to the generation of this RF signal, the chip is fully capable of a broad range of simple and complex modulation schemes. These modulation schemes are fully implemented in the digital domain, allowing accurate and simple realization of complex modulation algorithms using DSP techniques. The internal circuitry of the AD9834 consists of the following main sections: a numerically controlled oscillator (NCO), frequency and phase modulators, SIN ROM, a DAC, a comparator, and a regulator. NUMERICALLY CONTROLLED OSCILLATOR PLUS PHASE MODULATOR This consists of two frequency select registers, a phase accumulator, two phase offset registers, and a phase offset adder. The main component of the NCO is a 28-bit phase accumulator. Continuous time signals have a phase range of 0 π to 2π. Outside this range of numbers, the sinusoid functions repeat themselves in a periodic manner. The digital implementation is no different. The accumulator simply scales the range of phase numbers into a multibit digital word. The phase accumulator in the AD9834 is implemented with 28 bits. Therefore, in the AD9834, 2π = 228. Likewise, the ΔPhase term is scaled into this range of numbers: 0 < ΔPhase < 228 − 1. Making these substitutions into the previous equation f = ΔPhase × fMCLK/228 where 0 < ΔPhase < 228 − 1. The input to the phase accumulator can be selected either from the FREQ0 register or FREQ1 register and is controlled by the FSELECT pin or the FSEL bit. NCOs inherently generate con-tinuous phase signals, thus avoiding any output discontinuity when switching between frequencies. Following the NCO, a phase offset can be added to perform phase modulation using the 12-bit phase registers. The contents of one of these phase registers is added to the MSBs of the NCO. The AD9834 has two phase registers, the resolution of these registers being 2π/4096. SIN ROM To make the output from the NCO useful, it must be converted from phase information into a sinusoidal value. Phase informa-tion maps directly into amplitude; therefore, the SIN ROM uses the digital phase information as an address to a look-up table and converts the phase information into amplitude. Although the NCO contains a 28-bit phase accumulator, the output of the NCO is truncated to 12 bits. Using the full resolu-tion of the phase accumulator is impractical and unnecessary because it requires a look-up table of 228 entries. It is necessary only to have sufficient phase resolution such that the errors due to truncation are smaller than the resolution of the 10-bit DAC. This requires the SIN ROM to have two bits of phase resolution more than the 10-bit DAC. The SIN ROM is enabled using the OPBITEN and MODE bits in the control register. This is explained further in Table 18. DIGITAL-TO-ANALOG CONVERTER (DAC) The AD9834 includes a high impedance current source 10-bit DAC capable of driving a wide range of loads. The full-scale output current can be adjusted for optimum power and external load requirements using a single external resistor (RSET). The DAC can be configured for either single-ended or differential operation. IOUT and IOUTB can be connected through equal external resistors to AGND to develop complementary output voltages. The load resistors can be any value required, as long as the full-scale voltage developed across it does not exceed the voltage compliance range. Because full-scale current is controlled by RSET, adjustments to RSET can balance changes made to the load resistors. COMPARATOR The AD9834 can be used to generate synthesized digital clock signals. This is accomplished by using the on-board self-biasing comparator that converts the sinusoidal signal of the DAC to a square wave. The output from the DAC can be filtered externally before being applied to the comparator input. The comparator reference voltage is the time average of the signal applied to VIN. The comparator can accept signals in the range of approximately 100 mV p-p to 1 V p-p. As the comparator input is ac-coupled, to operate correctly as a zero crossing detector, it requires a minimum input frequency of typically 3 MHz. The comparator output is a square wave with an amplitude from 0 V to DVDD. Rev. D | Page 16 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 The AD9834 is a sampled signal with its output following Nyquist sampling theorem. Specifically, its output spectrum contains the fundamental plus aliased signals (images) that occur at multiples of the reference clock frequency and the selected output frequency. A graphical representation of the sampled spectrum, with aliased images, is shown in Figure 28. The prominence of the aliased images is dependent on the ratio of fOUT to MCLK. If ratio is small, the aliased images are very prominent and of a relatively high energy level as determined by the sin(x)/x roll-off of the quantized DAC output. In fact, depending on the fOUT/reference clock relationship, the first aliased image can be on the order of −3 dB below the fundamental. A low-pass filter is generally placed between the output of the DAC and the input of the comparator to further suppress the effects of aliased images. Obviously, consideration must be given to the relationship of the selected output frequency and the reference clock frequency to avoid unwanted (and unexpected) output anomalies. To apply the AD9834 as a clock generator, limit the selected output frequency to <33% of reference clock frequency, and thereby avoid generating aliased signals that fall within, or close to, the output band of interest (generally dc-selected output frequency). This practice eases the complexity (and cost) of the external filter requirement for the clock generator application. Refer to the AN-837 Application Note for more information. To enable the comparator, Bit SIGN/PIB and Bit OPBITEN in the control resister are set to 1. This is explained further in Table 17. REGULATOR The AD9834 has separate power supplies for the analog and digital sections. AVDD provides the power supply required for the analog section, and DVDD provides the power supply for the digital section. Both of these supplies can have a value of 2.3 V to 5.5 V and are independent of each other. For example, the analog section can be operated at 5 V, and the digital section can be operated at 3 V, or vice versa. The internal digital section of the AD9834 is operated at 2.5 V. An on-board regulator steps down the voltage applied at DVDD to 2.5 V. The digital interface (serial port) of the AD9834 also operates from DVDD. These digital signals are level shifted within the AD9834 to make them 2.5 V compatible. When the applied voltage at the DVDD pin of the AD9834 is equal to or less than 2.7 V, Pin CAP/2.5V and Pin DVDD should be tied together, thus bypassing the on-board regulator. OUTPUT VOLTAGE COMPLIANCE The AD9834 has a maximum current density, set by the RSET, of 4 mA. The maximum output voltage from the AD9834 is VDD − 1.5 V. This is to ensure that the output impedance of the internal switch does not change, affecting the spectral performance of the part. For a minimum supply of 2.3 V, the maximum output voltage is 0.8 V. Specifications in Table 1 are guaranteed with an RSET of 6.8 kΩ and an RLOAD of 200 Ω. 02705-040SYSTEM CLOCKfOUTfC–fOUTfC+fOUT2fC–fOUT2fC+fOUT3fC–fOUT3fC+fOUTfC0HzFIRSTIMAGESECONDIMAGETHIRDIMAGEFOURTHIMAGEFIFTHIMAGESIXTHIMAGE2fC3fCFREQUENCY ( Hz)SIGNAL AMPLITUDEsin x/x ENVELOPEx = π ( f/fC) Figure 28. The DAC Output Spectrum Rev. D | Page 17 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION SERIAL INTERFACE The AD9834 has a standard 3-wire serial interface that is com-patible with SPI, QSPI™, MICROWIRE™, and DSP interface standards. Data is loaded into the device as a 16-bit word under the control of a serial clock input (SCLK). The timing diagram for this operation is given in Figure 5. For a detailed example of programming the AD9833 and AD9834 devices, refer to the AN-1070 Application Note. The FSYNC input is a level triggered input that acts as a frame synchronization and chip enable. Data can only be transferred into the device when FSYNC is low. To start the serial data transfer, FSYNC should be taken low, observing the minimum FSYNC-to-SCLK falling edge setup time (t7). After FSYNC goes low, serial data is shifted into the input shift register of the device on the falling edges of SCLK for 16 clock pulses. FSYNC can be taken high after the 16th falling edge of SCLK, observing the minimum SCLK falling edge to FSYNC rising edge time (t8). Alternatively, FSYNC can be kept low for a multiple of 16 SCLK pulses and then brought high at the end of the data transfer. In this way, a continuous stream of 16-bit words can be loaded while FSYNC is held low, with FSYNC only going high after the 16th SCLK falling edge of the last word is loaded. The SCLK can be continuous, or alternatively, the SCLK can idle high or low between write operations but must be high when FSYNC goes low (t12). POWERING UP THE AD9834 The flow chart in Figure 31 shows the operating routine for the AD9834. When the AD9834 is powered up, the part should be reset. This resets appropriate internal registers to 0 to provide an analog output of midscale. To avoid spurious DAC outputs during AD9834 initialization, the RESET bit/pin should be set to 1 until the part is ready to begin generating an output. RESET does not reset the phase, frequency, or control registers. These registers contain invalid data, and, therefore, should be set to a known value by the user. The RESET bit/pin should then be set to 0 to begin generating an output. The data appears on the DAC output eight MCLK cycles after RESET is set to 0. LATENCY Latency is associated with each operation. When Pin FSELECT and Pin PSELECT change value, there is a pipeline delay before control is transferred to the selected register. When the t11 and t11A timing specifications are met (see Figure 4), FSELECT and PSELECT have latencies of eight MCLK cycles. When the t11 and t11A timing specifications are not met, the latency is increased by one MCLK cycle. Similarly, there is a latency associated with each asynchronous write operation. If a selected frequency/phase register is loaded with a new word, there is a delay of eight to nine MCLK cycles before the analog output changes. There is an uncertainty of one MCLK cycle because it depends on the position of the MCLK rising edge when the data is loaded into the destination register. The negative transition of the RESET and SLEEP functions are sampled on the internal falling edge of MCLK. Therefore, they also have a latency associated with them. CONTROL REGISTER The AD9834 contains a 16-bit control register that sets up the AD9834 as the user wants to operate it. All control bits, except MODE, are sampled on the internal negative edge of MCLK. Table 6 describes the individual bits of the control register. The different functions and the various output options from the AD9834 are described in more detail in the Frequency and Phase Registers section. To inform the AD9834 that the contents of the control register are to be altered, DB15 and DB14 must be set to 0 as shown in Table 5. Table 5. Control Register DB15 DB14 DB13 . . . DB0 0 0 CONTROL bits Rev. D | Page 18 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 MUXSLEEP12SLEEP1OPBITENIOUTBIOUTCOMPARATORVINSIGN/PIBMUXMSBSIGNBIT OUT01MUX1001DIGITALOUTPUT(ENABLE)(LOWPOWER)10-BITDACDIVIDEBY2SINROMMODE+ OPBITENPHASEACCUMULATOR(28-BIT)02705-026 Figure 29. Function of Control Bits DB15 DB14 DB13 DB12 DB11 DB10 DB9 DB8 DB7 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 0 0 B28 HLB FSEL PSEL PIN/SW RESET SLEEP1 SLEEP12 OPBITEN SIGN/PIB DIV2 0 MODE 0 Table 6. Description of Bits in the Control Register Bit Name Description DB13 B28 Two write operations are required to load a complete word into either of the frequency registers. B28 = 1 allows a complete word to be loaded into a frequency register in two consecutive writes. The first write contains the 14 LSBs of the frequency word and the next write contains the 14 MSBs. The first two bits of each 16-bit word define the frequency register the word is loaded to and should, therefore, be the same for both of the consecutive writes. Refer to Table 10 for the appropriate addresses. The write to the frequency register occurs after both words have been loaded. An example of a complete 28-bit write is shown in Table 11. Note however, that consecutive 28-bit writes to the same frequency register are not allowed, switch between frequency registers to do this type of function. B28 = 0, the 28-bit frequency register operates as two 14-bit registers, one containing the 14 MSBs and the other containing the 14 LSBs. This means that the 14 MSBs of the frequency word can be altered independent of the 14 LSBs, and vice versa. To alter the 14 MSBs or the 14 LSBs, a single write is made to the appropriate frequency address. The Control Bit DB12 (HLB) informs the AD9834 whether the bits to be altered are the 14 MSBs or 14 LSBs. DB12 HLB This control bit allows the user to continuously load the MSBs or LSBs of a frequency register ignoring the remaining 14 bits. This is useful if the complete 28-bit resolution is not required. HLB is used in conjunction with DB13 (B28). This control bit indicates whether the 14 bits being loaded are being transferred to the 14 MSBs or 14 LSBs of the addressed frequency register. DB13 (B28) must be set to 0 to be able to change the MSBs and LSBs of a frequency word separately. When DB13 (B28) = 1, this control bit is ignored. HLB = 1 allows a write to the 14 MSBs of the addressed frequency register. HLB = 0 allows a write to the 14 LSBs of the addressed frequency register. DB11 FSEL The FSEL bit defines whether the FREQ0 register or the FREQ1 register is used in the phase accumulator. See Table 8 to select a frequency register. DB10 PSEL The PSEL bit defines whether the PHASE0 register data or the PHASE1 register data is added to the output of the phase accumulator. See Table 9 to select a phase register. DB9 PIN/SW Functions that select frequency and phase registers, reset internal registers, and power down the DAC can be implemented using either software or hardware. PIN/SW selects the source of control for these functions. PIN/SW = 1 implies that the functions are being controlled using the appropriate control pins. PIN/SW = 0 implies that the functions are being controlled using the appropriate control bits. DB8 RESET RESET = 1 resets internal registers to 0, this corresponds to an analog output of midscale. RESET = 0 disables RESET. This function is explained in the RESET Function section. DB7 SLEEP1 SLEEP1 = 1, the internal MCLK is disabled. The DAC output remains at its present value as the NCO is no longer accumulating. SLEEP1 = 0, MCLK is enabled. This function is explained in the SLEEP Function section. DB6 SLEEP12 SLEEP12 = 1 powers down the on-chip DAC. This is useful when the AD9834 is used to output the MSB of the DAC data. SLEEP12 = 0 implies that the DAC is active. This function is explained in the SLEEP Function section. Rev. D | Page 19 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet Bit Name Description DB5 OPBITEN The function of this bit is to control whether there is an output at the SIGN BIT OUT pin. This bit should remain at 0 if the user is not using the SIGN BIT OUT pin. OPBITEN = 1 enables the SIGN BIT OUT pin. OPBITEN = 0, the SIGN BIT OUT output buffer is put into a high impedance state, therefore no output is available at the SIGN BIT OUT pin. DB4 SIGN/PIB The function of this bit is to control what is output at the SIGN BIT OUT pin. SIGN/PIB = 1, the on-board comparator is connected to SIGN BIT OUT. After filtering the sinusoidal output from the DAC, the waveform can be applied to the comparator to generate a square waveform. Refer to Table 17. SIGN/PIB = 0, the MSB (or MSB/2) of the DAC data is connected to the SIGN BIT OUT pin. Bit DIV2 controls whether it is the MSB or MSB/2 that is output. DB3 DIV2 DIV2 is used in association with SIGN/PIB and OPBITEN. Refer to Table 17. DIV2 = 1, the digital output is passed directly to the SIGN BIT OUT pin. DIV2 = 0, the digital output/2 is passed directly to the SIGN BIT OUT pin. DB2 Reserved This bit must always be set to 0. DB1 MODE The function of this bit is to control what is output at the IOUT pin/IOUTB pin. This bit should be set to 0 if the Control Bit OPBITEN = 1. MODE = 1, the SIN ROM is bypassed, resulting in a triangle output from the DAC. MODE = 0, the SIN ROM is used to convert the phase information into amplitude information, resulting in a sinusoidal signal at the output. See Table 18. DB0 Reserved This bit must always be set to 0. FREQUENCY AND PHASE REGISTERS The AD9834 contains two frequency registers and two phase registers. These are described in Table 7. Table 7. Frequency/Phase Registers Register Size Description FREQ0 28 bits Frequency Register 0. When either the FSEL bit or FSELECT pin = 0, this register defines the output frequency as a fraction of the MCLK frequency. FREQ1 28 bits Frequency Register 1. When either the FSEL bit or FSELECT pin = 1, this register defines the output frequency as a fraction of the MCLK frequency. PHASE0 12 bits Phase Offset Register 0. When either the PSEL bit or PSELECT pin = 0, the contents of this register are added to the output of the phase accumulator. PHASE1 12 bits Phase Offset Register 1. When either the PSEL bit or PSELECT pin = 1, the contents of this register are added to the output of the phase accumulator. The analog output from the AD9834 is fMCLK/228 × FREQREG where FREQREG is the value loaded into the selected frequency register. This signal is phase shifted by 2π/4096 × PHASEREG where PHASEREG is the value contained in the selected phase register. Consideration must be given to the relationship of the selected output frequency and the reference clock frequency to avoid unwanted output anomalies. Access to the frequency and phase registers is controlled by both the FSELECT and PSELECT pins, and the FSEL and PSEL control bits. If the Control Bit PIN/SW = 1, the pins control the function; whereas, if PIN/SW = 0, the bits control the function. This is outlined in Table 8 and Table 9. If the FSEL and PSEL bits are used, the pins should be held at CMOS logic high or low. Control of the frequency/phase registers is interchangeable from the pins to the bits. Table 8. Selecting a Frequency Register FSELECT FSEL PIN/SW Selected Register 0 X 1 FREQ0 REG 1 X 1 FREQ1 REG X 0 0 FREQ0 REG X 1 0 FREQ1 REG Table 9. Selecting a Phase Register PSELECT PSEL PIN/SW Selected Register 0 X 1 PHASE0 REG 1 X 1 PHASE1 REG X 0 0 PHASE0 REG X 1 0 PHASE1 REG The FSELECT pin and PSELECT pin are sampled on the internal falling edge of MCLK. It is recommended that the data on these pins does not change within a time window of the falling edge of MCLK (see Figure 4 for timing). If FSELECT or PSELECT changes value when a falling edge occurs, there is an uncertainty of one MCLK cycle because it pertains to when control is transferred to the other frequency/phase register. The flow charts in Figure 32 and Figure 33 show the routine for selecting and writing to the frequency and phase registers of the AD9834. Rev. D | Page 20 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 WRITING TO A FREQUENCY REGISTER When writing to a frequency register, Bit DB15 and Bit DB14 give the address of the frequency register. Table 10. Frequency Register Bits DB15 DB14 DB13 . . . DB0 0 1 14 FREQ0 REG BITS 1 0 14 FREQ1 REG BITS If the user wants to alter the entire contents of a frequency register, two consecutive writes to the same address must be performed because the frequency registers are 28 bits wide. The first write contains the 14 LSBs, and the second write contains the 14 MSBs. For this mode of operation, Control Bit B28 (DB13) should be set to 1. An example of a 28-bit write is shown in Table 11. Note however that continuous writes to the same frequency register are not recommended. This results in intermediate updates during the writes. If a frequency sweep, or something similar, is required, it is recommended that users alternate between the two frequency registers. Table 11. Writing FFFC000 to FREQ0 REG SDATA Input Result of Input Word 0010 0000 0000 0000 Control word write (DB15, DB14 = 00), B28 (DB13) = 1, HLB (DB12) = X 0100 0000 0000 0000 FREQ0 REG write (DB15, DB14 = 01), 14 LSBs = 0000 0111 1111 1111 1111 FREQ0 REG write (DB15, DB14 = 01), 14 MSBs = 3FFF In some applications, the user does not need to alter all 28 bits of the frequency register. With coarse tuning, only the 14 MSBs are altered; though with fine tuning only the 14 LSBs are altered. By setting Control Bit B28 (DB13) to 0, the 28-bit frequency register operates as two 14-bit registers, one containing the 14 MSBs and the other containing the 14 LSBs. This means that the 14 MSBs of the frequency word can be altered independent of the 14 LSBs, and vice versa. Bit HLB (DB12) in the control register identifies the 14 bits that are being altered. Examples of this are shown in Table 12 and Table 13. Table 12. Writing 3FFF to the 14 LSBs of FREQ1 REG SDATA Input Result of Input Word 0000 0000 0000 0000 Control word write (DB15, DB14 = 00), B28 (DB13) = 0, HLB (DB12) = 0, that is, LSBs 1011 1111 1111 1111 FREQ1 REG write (DB15, DB14 = 10), 14 LSBs = 3FFF Table 13. Writing 00FF to the 14 MSBs of FREQ0 REG SDATA Input Result of Input Word 0001 0000 0000 0000 Control word write (DB15, DB14 = 00), B28 (DB13) = 0, HLB (DB12) = 1, that is, MSBs 0100 0000 1111 1111 FREQ0 REG write (DB15, DB14 = 01), 14 MSBs = 00FF WRITING TO A PHASE REGISTER When writing to a phase register, Bit DB15 and Bit DB14 are set to 11. Bit DB13 identifies which phase register is being loaded. Table 14. Phase Register Bits DB15 DB14 DB13 DB12 DB11 DB0 1 1 0 X MSB 12 PHASE0 bits LSB 1 1 1 X MSB 12 PHASE1 bits LSB RESET FUNCTION The RESET function resets appropriate internal registers to 0 to provide an analog output of midscale. RESET does not reset the phase, frequency, or control registers. When the AD9834 is powered up, the part should be reset. To reset the AD9834, set the RESET pin/bit to 1. To take the part out of reset, set the pin/bit to 0. A signal appears at the DAC output seven MCLK cycles after RESET is set to 0. The RESET function is controlled by both the RESET pin and the RESET control bit. If the Control Bit PIN/SW = 0, the RESET bit controls the function, whereas if PIN/SW = 1, the RESET pin controls the function. Table 15. Applying RESET RESET Pin RESET Bit PIN/SW Bit Result 0 X 1 No reset applied 1 X 1 Internal registers reset X 0 0 No reset applied X 1 0 Internal registers reset The effect of asserting the RESET pin is evident immediately at the output, that is, the zero-to-one transition of this pin is not sampled. However, the negative transition of RESET is sampled on the internal falling edge of MCLK. SLEEP FUNCTION Sections of the AD9834 that are not in use can be powered down to minimize power consumption by using the SLEEP function. The parts of the chip that can be powered down are the internal clock and the DAC. The DAC can be powered down through hardware or software. The pin/bits required for the SLEEP function are outlined in Table 16. Rev. D | Page 21 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet Table 16. Applying the SLEEP Function SLEEP Pin SLEEP1 Bit SLEEP12 Bit PIN/SW Bit Result 0 X X 1 No power-down 1 X X 1 DAC powered down X 0 0 0 No power-down X 0 1 0 DAC powered down X 1 0 0 Internal clock disabled X 1 1 0 Both the DAC powered down and the internal clock disabled DAC Powered Down This is useful when the AD9834 is used to output the MSB of the DAC data only. In this case, the DAC is not required and can be powered down to reduce power consumption. Internal Clock Disabled When the internal clock of the AD9834 is disabled, the DAC output remains at its present value because the NCO is no longer accumulating. New frequency, phase, and control words can be written to the part when the SLEEP1 control bit is active. The synchronizing clock remains active, meaning that the selected frequency and phase registers can also be changed either at the pins or by using the control bits. Setting the SLEEP1 bit to 0 enables the MCLK. Any changes made to the registers when SLEEP1 is active are observed at the output after a certain latency. The effect of asserting the SLEEP pin is evident immediately at the output, that is, the zero-to-one transition of this pin is not sampled. However, the negative transition of SLEEP is sampled on the internal falling edge of MCLK. SIGN BIT OUT PIN The AD9834 offers a variety of outputs from the chip. The digital outputs are available from the SIGN BIT OUT pin. The available outputs are the comparator output or the MSB of the DAC data. The bits controlling the SIGN BIT OUT pin are outlined in Table 17. This pin must be enabled before use. The enabling/disabling of this pin is controlled by the Bit OPBITEN (DB5) in the control register. When OPBITEN = 1, this pin is enabled. Note that the MODE bit (DB1) in the control register should be set to 0 if OPBITEN = 1. Comparator Output The AD9834 has an on-board comparator. To connect this comparator to the SIGN BIT OUT pin, the SIGN/PIB (DB4) control bit must be set to 1. After filtering the sinusoidal output from the DAC, the waveform can be applied to the comparator to generate a square waveform. MSB from the NCO The MSB from the NCO can be output from the AD9834. By setting the SIGN/PIB (DB4) control bit to 0, the MSB of the DAC data is available at the SIGN BIT OUT pin. This is useful as a coarse clock source. This square wave can also be divided by two before being output. Bit DIV2 (DB3) in the control register controls the frequency of this output from the SIGN BIT OUT pin. Table 17. Various Outputs from SIGN BIT OUT OPBITEN Bit MODE Bit SIGN/PIB Bit DIV2 Bit SIGN BIT OUT Pin 0 X X X High impedance 1 0 0 0 DAC data MSB/2 1 0 0 1 DAC data MSB 1 0 1 0 Reserved 1 0 1 1 Comparator output 1 1 X X Reserved THE IOUT AND IOUTB PINS The analog outputs from the AD9834 are available from the IOUT and IOUTB pins. The available outputs are a sinusoidal output or a triangle output. Sinusoidal Output The SIN ROM converts the phase information from the frequency and phase registers into amplitude information, resulting in a sinusoidal signal at the output. To have a sinusoidal output from the IOUT and IOUTB pins, set Bit MODE (DB1) to 0. Triangle Output The SIN ROM can be bypassed so that the truncated digital output from the NCO is sent to the DAC. In this case, the output is no longer sinusoidal. The DAC produces 10-bit linear triangular function. To have a triangle output from the IOUT and IOUTB pins, set Bit MODE (DB1) to 1. Note that the SLEEP pin and SLEEP12 bit must be 0 (that is, the DAC is enabled) when using the IOUT and IOUTB pins. Table 18. Various Outputs from IOUT and IOUTB OPBITEN Bit MODE Bit IOUT and IOUTB Pins 0 0 Sinusoid 0 1 Triangle 1 0 Sinusoid 1 1 Reserved 3π/27π/211π/2VOUT MAXVOUT MIN02705-027 Figure 30. Triangle Output Rev. D | Page 22 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 Rev. D | Page 23 of 32 APPLICATIONS INFORMATION Because of the various output options available from the part, the AD9834 can be configured to suit a wide variety of applications. One of the areas where the AD9834 is suitable is in modulation applications. The part can be used to perform simple modulation such as FSK. More complex modulation schemes such as GMSK and QPSK can also be implemented using the AD9834. In an FSK application, the two frequency registers of the AD9834 are loaded with different values. One frequency represents the space frequency, and the other represents the mark frequency. The digital data stream is fed to the FSELECT pin, causing the AD9834 to modulate the carrier frequency between the two values. The AD9834 has two phase registers, enabling the part to perform PSK. With phase shift keying, the carrier frequency is phase shifted, the phase being altered by an amount that is related to the bit stream that is input to the modulator. The AD9834 is also suitable for signal generator applications. With the on-board comparator, the device can be used to generate a square wave. With its low current consumption, the part is suitable for applications where it is used as a local oscillator. CHANGE PHASE? CHANGE FREQUENCY? NO NO NO NO YES NO YES NO YES YES YES YES YES YES DAC OUTPUT VOUT = VREFOUT × 18 × RLOAD/RSET × (1 + (SIN(2π(FREQREG × fMCLK × t/228 + PHASEREG/212)))) INITIALIZATION SEE FIGURE 32 SELECT DATA SOURCES SEE FIGURE 34 WAIT 8/9 MCLK CYCLES SEE TIMING DIAGRAM FIGURE 3 CHANGE PSEL/ PSELECT? CHANGE PHASE REGISTER? CHANGE DAC OUTPUT FROM SIN TO RAMP? CHANGE OUTPUT AT SIGN BIT OUT PIN? CHANGE FSEL/ FSELECT? CHANGE FREQUENCY REGISTER? CONTROL REGISTER WRITE DATA WRITE SEE FIGURE 33 02705-028 Figure 31. Flow Chart for Initialization and Operation AD9834 Data Sheet INITIALIZATIONAPPLY RESETUSING PINSET RESET PIN = 1USING PINUSING CONTROLBIT(CONTROL REGISTER WRITE)RESET = 1PIN/SW = 0(CONTROL REGISTER WRITE)PIN/SW = 1USING CONTROLBITSET RESET = 0SELECT FREQUENCY REGISTERSSELECT PHASE REGISTERS(CONTROL REGISTER WRITE)RESET BIT = 0FSEL = SELECTED FREQUENCY REGISTERPSEL = SELECTED PHASE REGISTERPIN/SW = 0(APPLY SIGNALS AT PINS)RESET PIN = 0FSELECT = SELECTED FREQUENCY REGISTERPSELECT = SELECTED PHASE REGISTERWRITE TO FREQUENCY AND PHASE REGISTERSFREQ0 REG = fOUT0/fMCLK × 228FREQ1 REG = fOUT1/fMCLK × 228PHASE0 AND PHASE1 REG = (PHASESHIFT × 212)/2π(SEE FIGURE 33)02705-029 Figure 32. Initialization NOYESDATA WRITENOYESYESNOYESNONOYESYESWRITE A FULL 28-BIT WORDTO A FREQUENCY REGISTER?(CONTROL REGISTER WRITE)B28 (D13) = 1WRITE TWO CONSECUTIVE16-BIT WORDS(SEE TABLE 11 FOR EXAMPLE)WRITE ANOTHER FULL28-BIT TO AFREQUENCY REGISTER?WRITE 14 MSBs OR LSBsTO A FREQUENCY REGISTER?(CONTROL REGISTER WRITE)B28 (D13) = 0HLB (D12) = 0/1WRITE A 16-BIT WORD(SEE TABLES 12 AND 13FOR EXAMPLES)WRITE 14 MSBs OR LSBsTO AFREQUENCY REGISTER?WRITE TO PHASEREGISTER?D15, D14 = 11D13 = 0/1 (CHOOSE THEPHASE REGISTER)D12 = XD11 ... D0 = PHASE DATA(16-BIT WRITE)WRITE TO ANOTHERPHASE REGISTER?02705-030 Figure 33. Data Write Rev. D | Page 24 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 SELECT DATA SOURCESYESNOFSELECT AND PSELECTPINS BEING USED?(CONTROL REGISTER WRITE)PIN/SW = 0SET FSEL BITSET PSEL BITSET FSELECTAND PSELECT(CONTROL REGISTER WRITE)PIN/SW = 102705-031 Figure 34. Selecting Data Sources Rev. D | Page 25 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet GROUNDING AND LAYOUT The printed circuit board (PCB) that houses the AD9834 should be designed so that the analog and digital sections are separated and confined to certain areas of the board. This facilitates the use of ground planes that can easily be separated. A minimum etch technique is generally best for ground planes because it gives the best shielding. Digital and analog ground planes should only be joined in one place. If the AD9834 is the only device requiring an AGND-to-DGND connection, the ground planes should be connected at the AGND and DGND pins of the AD9834. If the AD9834 is in a system where multiple devices require AGND-to-DGND connections, the connection should be made at one point only, establishing a star ground point as close as possible to the AD9834. Avoid running digital lines under the device because these couple noise onto the die. The analog ground plane should be allowed to run under the AD9834 to avoid noise coupling. The power supply lines to the AD9834 should use as large a track as possible to provide low impedance paths and reduce the effects of glitches on the power supply line. Fast switching signals, such as clocks, should be shielded with digital ground to avoid radiating noise to other sections of the board. Avoid crossover of digital and analog signals. Traces on opposite sides of the board should run at right angles to each other to reduce the effects of feed-through through the board. A microstrip technique is by far the best, but it is not always possible with a double-sided board. In this technique, the component side of the board is dedicated to ground planes and signals are placed on the other side. Good decoupling is important. The analog and digital supplies to the AD9834 are independent and separately pinned out to minimize coupling between analog and digital sections of the device. All analog and digital supplies should be decoupled to AGND and DGND, respectively, with 0.1 μF ceramic capacitors in parallel with 10 μF tantalum capacitors. To achieve the best performance from the decoupling capacitors, they should be placed as close as possible to the device, ideally right up against the device. In systems where a common supply is used to drive both the AVDD and DVDD of the AD9834, it is recommended that the system’s AVDD supply be used. This supply should have the recommended analog supply decoupling between the AVDD pins of the AD9834 and AGND, and the recommended digital supply decoupling capacitors between the DVDD pins and DGND. Proper operation of the comparator requires good layout strategy. The strategy must minimize the parasitic capacitance between VIN and the SIGN BIT OUT pin by adding isolation using a ground plane. For example, in a multilayered board, the VIN signal could be connected to the top layer, and the SIGN BIT OUT could be connected to the bottom layer so that isolation is provided by the power and ground planes between them. Rev. D | Page 26 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 Rev. D | Page 27 of 32 INTERFACING TO MICROPROCESSORS The AD9834 has a standard serial interface that allows the part to interface directly with several microprocessors. The device uses an external serial clock to write the data/control information into the device. The serial clock can have a frequency of 40 MHz maximum. The serial clock can be continuous, or it can idle high or low between write operations. When data/control information is being written to the AD9834, FSYNC is taken low and is held low until the 16 bits of data are written into the AD9834. The FSYNC signal frames the 16 bits of information being loaded into the AD9834. AD9834 TO ADSP-21xx INTERFACE Figure 35 shows the serial interface between the AD9834 and the ADSP-21xx. The ADSP-21xx should be set up to operate in the SPORT transmit alternate framing mode (TFSW = 1). The ADSP-21xx is programmed through the SPORT control register and should be configured as follows:  Internal clock operation (ISCLK = 1)  Active low framing (INVTFS = 1)  16-bit word length (SLEN = 15)  Internal frame sync signal (ITFS = 1)  Generate a frame sync for each write (TFSR = 1) Transmission is initiated by writing a word to the Tx register after the SPORT has been enabled. The data is clocked out on each rising edge of the serial clock and clocked into the AD9834 on the SCLK falling edge. 1ADDITIONALPINS OMITTEDFORCLARITY. AD98341 FSYNC SDATA SCLK TFS DT SCLK ADSP-21xx1 02705-032 Figure 35. ADSP-21xx to AD9834 Interface AD9834 TO 68HC11/68L11 INTERFACE Figure 36 shows the serial interface between the AD9834 and the 68HC11/68L11 microcontroller. The microcontroller is configured as the master by setting Bit MSTR in the SPCR to 1, providing a serial clock on SCK while the MOSI output drives the serial data line SDATA. Because the microcontroller does not have a dedicated frame sync pin, the FSYNC signal is derived from a port line (PC7). The setup conditions for correct operation of the interface are as follows:  SCK idles high between write operations (CPOL = 0)  Data is valid on the SCK falling edge (CPHA = 1) When data is being transmitted to the AD9834, the FSYNC line is taken low (PC7). Serial data from the 68HC11/68L11 is transmitted in 8-bit bytes with only eight falling clock edges occurring in the transmit cycle. Data is transmitted MSB first. To load data into the AD9834, PC7 is held low after the first eight bits are transferred and a second serial write operation is performed to the AD9834. Only after the second eight bits have been transferred should FSYNC be taken high again. 1ADDITIONAL PINS OMITTED FOR CLARITY. AD98341 FSYNC SDATA SCLK 68HC11/68L111 PC7 MOSI SCK 02705-033 Figure 36. 68HC11/68L11 to AD9834 Interface AD9834 Data Sheet AD9834 TO 80C51/80L51 INTERFACE Figure 37 shows the serial interface between the AD9834 and the 80C51/80L51 microcontroller. The microcontroller is operated in Mode 0 so that TXD of the 80C51/80L51 drives SCLK of the AD9834, and RXD drives the serial data line (SDATA). The FSYNC signal is derived from a bit programmable pin on the port (P3.3 is shown in the diagram). When data is to be transmitted to the AD9834, P3.3 is taken low. The 80C51/80L51 transmits data in 8-bit bytes, thus only eight falling SCLK edges occur in each cycle. To load the remaining eight bits to the AD9834, P3.3 is held low after the first eight bits have been transmitted, and a second write operation is initiated to transmit the second byte of data. P3.3 is taken high following the completion of the second write operation. SCLK should idle high between the two write operations. The 80C51/80L51 outputs the serial data in an LSB-first format. The AD9834 accepts the MSB first (the four MSBs being the control information, the next four bits being the address, and the eight LSBs containing the data when writing to a destination register). Therefore, the transmit routine of the 80C51/80L51 must take this into account and rearrange the bits so that the MSB is output first. 1ADDITIONAL PINS OMITTED FOR CLARITY.AD98341FSYNCSDATASCLK80C51/80L511P3.3RXDTXD02705-034 Figure 37. 80C51/80L51 to AD9834 Interface AD9834 TO DSP56002 INTERFACE Figure 38 shows the interface between the AD9834 and the DSP56002. The DSP56002 is configured for normal mode asynchronous operation with a gated internal clock (SYN = 0, GCK = 1, SCKD = 1). The frame sync pin is generated internally (SC2 = 1), the transfers are 16 bits wide (WL1 = 1, WL0 = 0), and the frame sync signal frames the 16 bits (FSL = 0). The frame sync signal is available on Pin SC2, but needs to be inverted before being applied to the AD9834. The interface to the DSP56000/ DSP56001 is similar to that of the DSP56002. 1ADDITIONAL PINS OMITTED FOR CLARITY.AD98341FSYNCSDATASCLKDSP560021SC2STDSCK02705-035 Figure 38. DSP56002 to AD9834 Interface Rev. D | Page 28 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 OUTLINE DIMENSIONS COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MO-153-AC20111106.40 BSC4.504.404.30PIN 16.606.506.40SEATINGPLANE0.150.050.300.190.65BSC1.20 MAX0.200.090.750.600.458°0°COPLANARITY0.10 Figure 39. 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] (RU-20) Dimensions shown in millimeters ORDERING GUIDE Model1 Maximum MCLK (MHz) Temperature Range Package Description Package Option AD9834BRU 50 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 AD9834BRU-REEL 50 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 AD9834BRU-REEL7 50 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 AD9834BRUZ 50 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 AD9834BRUZ-REEL 50 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 AD9834BRUZ-REEL7 50 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 AD9834CRUZ 75 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 AD9834CRUZ-REEL7 75 −40°C to +105°C 20-Lead Thin Shrink Small Outline Package [TSSOP] RU-20 1 Z = RoHS Compliant Part. Rev. D | Page 29 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet NOTES Rev. D | Page 30 of 32 Data Sheet AD9834 NOTES Rev. D | Page 31 of 32 AD9834 Data Sheet NOTES ©2003–2014 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. D02705-0-3/14(A) Rev. D | Page 32 of 32 STM32F405xx STM32F407xx ARM Cortex-M4 32b MCU+FPU, 210DMIPS, up to 1MB Flash/192+4KB RAM, USB OTG HS/FS, Ethernet, 17 TIMs, 3 ADCs, 15 comm. interfaces & camera Datasheet - production data Features • Core: ARM 32-bit Cortex™-M4 CPU with FPU, Adaptive real-time accelerator (ART Accelerator™) allowing 0-wait state execution from Flash memory, frequency up to 168 MHz, memory protection unit, 210 DMIPS/ 1.25 DMIPS/MHz (Dhrystone 2.1), and DSP instructions • Memories – Up to 1 Mbyte of Flash memory – Up to 192+4 Kbytes of SRAM including 64- Kbyte of CCM (core coupled memory) data RAM – Flexible static memory controller supporting Compact Flash, SRAM, PSRAM, NOR and NAND memories • LCD parallel interface, 8080/6800 modes • Clock, reset and supply management – 1.8 V to 3.6 V application supply and I/Os – POR, PDR, PVD and BOR – 4-to-26 MHz crystal oscillator – Internal 16 MHz factory-trimmed RC (1% accuracy) – 32 kHz oscillator for RTC with calibration – Internal 32 kHz RC with calibration • Low power – Sleep, Stop and Standby modes – VBAT supply for RTC, 20×32 bit backup registers + optional 4 KB backup SRAM • 3×12-bit, 2.4 MSPS A/D converters: up to 24 channels and 7.2 MSPS in triple interleaved mode • 2×12-bit D/A converters • General-purpose DMA: 16-stream DMA controller with FIFOs and burst support • Up to 17 timers: up to twelve 16-bit and two 32- bit timers up to 168 MHz, each with up to 4 IC/OC/PWM or pulse counter and quadrature (incremental) encoder input • Debug mode – Serial wire debug (SWD) & JTAG interfaces – Cortex-M4 Embedded Trace Macrocell™ • Up to 140 I/O ports with interrupt capability – Up to 136 fast I/Os up to 84 MHz – Up to 138 5 V-tolerant I/Os • Up to 15 communication interfaces – Up to 3 × I2C interfaces (SMBus/PMBus) – Up to 4 USARTs/2 UARTs (10.5 Mbit/s, ISO 7816 interface, LIN, IrDA, modem control) – Up to 3 SPIs (42 Mbits/s), 2 with muxed full-duplex I2S to achieve audio class accuracy via internal audio PLL or external clock – 2 × CAN interfaces (2.0B Active) – SDIO interface • Advanced connectivity – USB 2.0 full-speed device/host/OTG controller with on-chip PHY – USB 2.0 high-speed/full-speed device/host/OTG controller with dedicated DMA, on-chip full-speed PHY and ULPI – 10/100 Ethernet MAC with dedicated DMA: supports IEEE 1588v2 hardware, MII/RMII • 8- to 14-bit parallel camera interface up to 54 Mbytes/s • True random number generator • CRC calculation unit • 96-bit unique ID • RTC: subsecond accuracy, hardware calendar LQFP64 (10 × 10 mm) LQFP100 (14 × 14 mm) LQFP144 (20 × 20 mm) FBGA UFBGA176 (10 × 10 mm) LQFP176 (24 × 24 mm) WLCSP90 Table 1. Device summary Reference Part number STM32F405xx STM32F405RG, STM32F405VG, STM32F405ZG, STM32F405OG, STM32F405OE STM32F407xx STM32F407VG, STM32F407IG, STM32F407ZG, STM32F407VE, STM32F407ZE, STM32F407IE www.st.com Contents STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 2/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 2 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 2.1 Full compatibility throughout the family . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 2.2 Device overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 2.2.1 ARM® Cortex™-M4F core with embedded Flash and SRAM . . . . . . . . 19 2.2.2 Adaptive real-time memory accelerator (ART Accelerator™) . . . . . . . . 19 2.2.3 Memory protection unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 2.2.4 Embedded Flash memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 2.2.5 CRC (cyclic redundancy check) calculation unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 2.2.6 Embedded SRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 2.2.7 Multi-AHB bus matrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 2.2.8 DMA controller (DMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 2.2.9 Flexible static memory controller (FSMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 2.2.10 Nested vectored interrupt controller (NVIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 2.2.11 External interrupt/event controller (EXTI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 2.2.12 Clocks and startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 2.2.13 Boot modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 2.2.14 Power supply schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 2.2.15 Power supply supervisor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 2.2.16 Voltage regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 2.2.17 Regulator ON/OFF and internal reset ON/OFF availability . . . . . . . . . . 28 2.2.18 Real-time clock (RTC), backup SRAM and backup registers . . . . . . . . 28 2.2.19 Low-power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 2.2.20 VBAT operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 2.2.21 Timers and watchdogs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 2.2.22 Inter-integrated circuit interface (I²C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 2.2.23 Universal synchronous/asynchronous receiver transmitters (USART) . 33 2.2.24 Serial peripheral interface (SPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 2.2.25 Inter-integrated sound (I2S) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 2.2.26 Audio PLL (PLLI2S) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 2.2.27 Secure digital input/output interface (SDIO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 2.2.28 Ethernet MAC interface with dedicated DMA and IEEE 1588 support . 35 2.2.29 Controller area network (bxCAN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 DocID022152 Rev 4 3/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Contents 2.2.30 Universal serial bus on-the-go full-speed (OTG_FS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 2.2.31 Universal serial bus on-the-go high-speed (OTG_HS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 2.2.32 Digital camera interface (DCMI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 2.2.33 Random number generator (RNG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 2.2.34 General-purpose input/outputs (GPIOs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 2.2.35 Analog-to-digital converters (ADCs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 2.2.36 Temperature sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 2.2.37 Digital-to-analog converter (DAC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 2.2.38 Serial wire JTAG debug port (SWJ-DP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 2.2.39 Embedded Trace Macrocell™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 3 Pinouts and pin description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 4 Memory mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 5 Electrical characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 5.1 Parameter conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 5.1.1 Minimum and maximum values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 5.1.2 Typical values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 5.1.3 Typical curves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 5.1.4 Loading capacitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 5.1.5 Pin input voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 5.1.6 Power supply scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 5.1.7 Current consumption measurement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 5.2 Absolute maximum ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 5.3 Operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 5.3.1 General operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 5.3.2 VCAP_1/VCAP_2 external capacitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 5.3.3 Operating conditions at power-up / power-down (regulator ON) . . . . . . 80 5.3.4 Operating conditions at power-up / power-down (regulator OFF) . . . . . 80 5.3.5 Embedded reset and power control block characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . 80 5.3.6 Supply current characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 5.3.7 Wakeup time from low-power mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 5.3.8 External clock source characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 5.3.9 Internal clock source characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 5.3.10 PLL characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 5.3.11 PLL spread spectrum clock generation (SSCG) characteristics . . . . . 102 Contents STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 4/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.12 Memory characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 5.3.13 EMC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 5.3.14 Absolute maximum ratings (electrical sensitivity) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 5.3.15 I/O current injection characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 5.3.16 I/O port characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 5.3.17 NRST pin characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 5.3.18 TIM timer characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 5.3.19 Communications interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 5.3.20 12-bit ADC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 5.3.21 Temperature sensor characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 5.3.22 VBAT monitoring characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 5.3.23 Embedded reference voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 5.3.24 DAC electrical characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 5.3.25 FSMC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 5.3.26 Camera interface (DCMI) timing specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 5.3.27 SD/SDIO MMC card host interface (SDIO) characteristics . . . . . . . . . 156 5.3.28 RTC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 6 Package characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 6.1 Package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 6.2 Thermal characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 7 Part numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Appendix A Application block diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 A.1 USB OTG full speed (FS) interface solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 A.2 USB OTG high speed (HS) interface solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 A.3 Ethernet interface solutions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 8 Revision history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 DocID022152 Rev 4 5/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx List of tables List of tables Table 1. Device summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Table 2. STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Table 3. Regulator ON/OFF and internal reset ON/OFF availability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Table 4. Timer feature comparison. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Table 5. USART feature comparison . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Table 6. Legend/abbreviations used in the pinout table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Table 8. FSMC pin definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Table 9. Alternate function mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Table 10. STM32F40x register boundary addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Table 11. Voltage characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Table 12. Current characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Table 13. Thermal characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Table 14. General operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Table 15. Limitations depending on the operating power supply range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Table 16. VCAP_1/VCAP_2 operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Table 17. Operating conditions at power-up / power-down (regulator ON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Table 18. Operating conditions at power-up / power-down (regulator OFF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Table 19. Embedded reset and power control block characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Table 20. Typical and maximum current consumption in Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash memory (ART accelerator enabled) or RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Table 21. Typical and maximum current consumption in Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash memory (ART accelerator disabled) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Table 22. Typical and maximum current consumption in Sleep mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Table 23. Typical and maximum current consumptions in Stop mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Table 24. Typical and maximum current consumptions in Standby mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Table 25. Typical and maximum current consumptions in VBAT mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Table 26. Switching output I/O current consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Table 27. Peripheral current consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Table 28. Low-power mode wakeup timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Table 29. High-speed external user clock characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Table 30. Low-speed external user clock characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Table 31. HSE 4-26 MHz oscillator characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Table 32. LSE oscillator characteristics (fLSE = 32.768 kHz) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Table 33. HSI oscillator characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Table 34. LSI oscillator characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Table 35. Main PLL characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Table 36. PLLI2S (audio PLL) characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Table 37. SSCG parameters constraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Table 38. Flash memory characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Table 39. Flash memory programming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Table 40. Flash memory programming with VPP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Table 41. Flash memory endurance and data retention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Table 42. EMS characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Table 43. EMI characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Table 44. ESD absolute maximum ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Table 45. Electrical sensitivities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Table 46. I/O current injection susceptibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 List of tables STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 6/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Table 47. I/O static characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Table 48. Output voltage characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Table 49. I/O AC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Table 50. NRST pin characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Table 51. Characteristics of TIMx connected to the APB1 domain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Table 52. Characteristics of TIMx connected to the APB2 domain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Table 53. I2C characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Table 54. SCL frequency (fPCLK1= 42 MHz.,VDD = 3.3 V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Table 55. SPI dynamic characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Table 56. I2S dynamic characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Table 57. USB OTG FS startup time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Table 58. USB OTG FS DC electrical characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Table 59. USB OTG FS electrical characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Table 60. USB HS DC electrical characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Table 61. USB HS clock timing parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Table 62. ULPI timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Table 63. Ethernet DC electrical characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Table 64. Dynamic characteristics: Ehternet MAC signals for SMI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Table 65. Dynamic characteristics: Ethernet MAC signals for RMII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Table 66. Dynamic characteristics: Ethernet MAC signals for MII . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Table 67. ADC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Table 68. ADC accuracy at fADC = 30 MHz . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Table 69. Temperature sensor characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Table 70. Temperature sensor calibration values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Table 71. VBAT monitoring characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Table 72. Embedded internal reference voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Table 73. Internal reference voltage calibration values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Table 74. DAC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Table 75. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR read timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Table 76. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR write timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Table 77. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR read timings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Table 78. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR write timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Table 79. Synchronous multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Table 80. Synchronous multiplexed PSRAM write timings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Table 81. Synchronous non-multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Table 82. Synchronous non-multiplexed PSRAM write timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Table 83. Switching characteristics for PC Card/CF read and write cycles in attribute/common space. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Table 84. Switching characteristics for PC Card/CF read and write cycles in I/O space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Table 85. Switching characteristics for NAND Flash read cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Table 86. Switching characteristics for NAND Flash write cycles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Table 87. DCMI characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Table 88. Dynamic characteristics: SD / MMC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Table 89. RTC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Table 90. WLCSP90 - 0.400 mm pitch wafer level chip size package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . 159 Table 91. LQFP64 – 10 x 10 mm 64 pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . 160 Table 92. LQPF100 – 14 x 14 mm 100-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data. . . . . . . 162 Table 93. LQFP144, 20 x 20 mm, 144-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data . . . . . . . 164 Table 94. UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Table 95. LQFP176, 24 x 24 mm, 176-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data . . . . . . . 167 DocID022152 Rev 4 7/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx List of tables Table 96. Package thermal characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 Table 97. Ordering information scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Table 98. Document revision history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 List of figures STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 8/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 List of figures Figure 1. Compatible board design between STM32F10xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP64. . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Figure 2. Compatible board design STM32F10xx/STM32F2xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP100 package. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Figure 3. Compatible board design between STM32F10xx/STM32F2xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP144 package. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Figure 4. Compatible board design between STM32F2xx and STM32F4xx for LQFP176 and BGA176 packages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Figure 5. STM32F40x block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Figure 6. Multi-AHB matrix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Figure 7. Power supply supervisor interconnection with internal reset OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Figure 8. PDR_ON and NRST control with internal reset OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Figure 9. Regulator OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Figure 10. Startup in regulator OFF mode: slow VDD slope - power-down reset risen after VCAP_1/VCAP_2 stabilization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Figure 11. Startup in regulator OFF mode: fast VDD slope - power-down reset risen before VCAP_1/VCAP_2 stabilization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Figure 12. STM32F40x LQFP64 pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Figure 13. STM32F40x LQFP100 pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Figure 14. STM32F40x LQFP144 pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Figure 15. STM32F40x LQFP176 pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Figure 16. STM32F40x UFBGA176 ballout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Figure 17. STM32F40x WLCSP90 ballout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Figure 18. STM32F40x memory map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Figure 19. Pin loading conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Figure 20. Pin input voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Figure 21. Power supply scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Figure 22. Current consumption measurement scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Figure 23. External capacitor CEXT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Figure 24. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator ON) or RAM, and peripherals OFF . . . . 85 Figure 25. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator ON) or RAM, and peripherals ON . . . . . 85 Figure 26. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator OFF) or RAM, and peripherals OFF . . . 86 Figure 27. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator OFF) or RAM, and peripherals ON . . . . 86 Figure 28. Typical VBAT current consumption (LSE and RTC ON/backup RAM OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Figure 29. Typical VBAT current consumption (LSE and RTC ON/backup RAM ON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Figure 30. High-speed external clock source AC timing diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Figure 31. Low-speed external clock source AC timing diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Figure 32. Typical application with an 8 MHz crystal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Figure 33. Typical application with a 32.768 kHz crystal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Figure 34. ACCLSI versus temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Figure 35. PLL output clock waveforms in center spread mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Figure 36. PLL output clock waveforms in down spread mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Figure 37. I/O AC characteristics definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Figure 38. Recommended NRST pin protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Figure 39. I2C bus AC waveforms and measurement circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 DocID022152 Rev 4 9/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx List of figures Figure 40. SPI timing diagram - slave mode and CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Figure 41. SPI timing diagram - slave mode and CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Figure 42. SPI timing diagram - master mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Figure 43. I2S slave timing diagram (Philips protocol) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Figure 44. I2S master timing diagram (Philips protocol)(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Figure 45. USB OTG FS timings: definition of data signal rise and fall time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Figure 46. ULPI timing diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Figure 47. Ethernet SMI timing diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Figure 48. Ethernet RMII timing diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Figure 49. Ethernet MII timing diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Figure 50. ADC accuracy characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Figure 51. Typical connection diagram using the ADC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Figure 52. Power supply and reference decoupling (VREF+ not connected to VDDA). . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Figure 53. Power supply and reference decoupling (VREF+ connected to VDDA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Figure 54. 12-bit buffered /non-buffered DAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Figure 55. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR read waveforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Figure 56. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR write waveforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Figure 57. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR read waveforms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Figure 58. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR write waveforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Figure 59. Synchronous multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Figure 60. Synchronous multiplexed PSRAM write timings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Figure 61. Synchronous non-multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Figure 62. Synchronous non-multiplexed PSRAM write timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Figure 63. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for common memory read access . . . . . . 148 Figure 64. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for common memory write access . . . . . . 148 Figure 65. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for attribute memory read access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Figure 66. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for attribute memory write access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Figure 67. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for I/O space read access . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Figure 68. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for I/O space write access . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Figure 69. NAND controller waveforms for read access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Figure 70. NAND controller waveforms for write access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Figure 71. NAND controller waveforms for common memory read access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Figure 72. NAND controller waveforms for common memory write access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Figure 73. DCMI timing diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Figure 74. SDIO high-speed mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Figure 75. SD default mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Figure 76. WLCSP90 - 0.400 mm pitch wafer level chip size package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Figure 77. LQFP64 – 10 x 10 mm 64 pin low-profile quad flat package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Figure 78. LQFP64 recommended footprint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Figure 79. LQFP100, 14 x 14 mm 100-pin low-profile quad flat package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Figure 80. LQFP100 recommended footprint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Figure 81. LQFP144, 20 x 20 mm, 144-pin low-profile quad flat package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Figure 82. LQFP144 recommended footprint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Figure 83. UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm, package outline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Figure 84. LQFP176 24 x 24 mm, 176-pin low-profile quad flat package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Figure 85. LQFP176 recommended footprint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 Figure 86. USB controller configured as peripheral-only and used in Full speed mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Figure 87. USB controller configured as host-only and used in full speed mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 List of figures STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 10/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 88. USB controller configured in dual mode and used in full speed mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Figure 89. USB controller configured as peripheral, host, or dual-mode and used in high speed mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Figure 90. MII mode using a 25 MHz crystal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Figure 91. RMII with a 50 MHz oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Figure 92. RMII with a 25 MHz crystal and PHY with PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 DocID022152 Rev 4 11/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Introduction 1 Introduction This datasheet provides the description of the STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx lines of microcontrollers. For more details on the whole STMicroelectronics STM32™ family, please refer to Section 2.1: Full compatibility throughout the family. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx datasheet should be read in conjunction with the STM32F4xx reference manual. The reference and Flash programming manuals are both available from the STMicroelectronics website www.st.com. For information on the Cortex™-M4 core, please refer to the Cortex™-M4 programming manual (PM0214) available from www.st.com. Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 12/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 2 Description The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx family is based on the high-performance ARM® Cortex™-M4 32-bit RISC core operating at a frequency of up to 168 MHz. The Cortex-M4 core features a Floating point unit (FPU) single precision which supports all ARM singleprecision data-processing instructions and data types. It also implements a full set of DSP instructions and a memory protection unit (MPU) which enhances application security. The Cortex-M4 core with FPU will be referred to as Cortex-M4F throughout this document. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx family incorporates high-speed embedded memories (Flash memory up to 1 Mbyte, up to 192 Kbytes of SRAM), up to 4 Kbytes of backup SRAM, and an extensive range of enhanced I/Os and peripherals connected to two APB buses, three AHB buses and a 32-bit multi-AHB bus matrix. All devices offer three 12-bit ADCs, two DACs, a low-power RTC, twelve general-purpose 16-bit timers including two PWM timers for motor control, two general-purpose 32-bit timers. a true random number generator (RNG). They also feature standard and advanced communication interfaces. • Up to three I2Cs • Three SPIs, two I2Ss full duplex. To achieve audio class accuracy, the I2S peripherals can be clocked via a dedicated internal audio PLL or via an external clock to allow synchronization. • Four USARTs plus two UARTs • An USB OTG full-speed and a USB OTG high-speed with full-speed capability (with the ULPI), • Two CANs • An SDIO/MMC interface • Ethernet and the camera interface available on STM32F407xx devices only. New advanced peripherals include an SDIO, an enhanced flexible static memory control (FSMC) interface (for devices offered in packages of 100 pins and more), a camera interface for CMOS sensors. Refer to Table 2: STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts for the list of peripherals available on each part number. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx family operates in the –40 to +105 °C temperature range from a 1.8 to 3.6 V power supply. The supply voltage can drop to 1.7 V when the device operates in the 0 to 70 °C temperature range using an external power supply supervisor: refer to Section : Internal reset OFF. A comprehensive set of power-saving mode allows the design of low-power applications. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx family offers devices in various packages ranging from 64 pins to 176 pins. The set of included peripherals changes with the device chosen. These features make the STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx microcontroller family suitable for a wide range of applications: • Motor drive and application control • Medical equipment • Industrial applications: PLC, inverters, circuit breakers • Printers, and scanners • Alarm systems, video intercom, and HVAC • Home audio appliances STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description DocID022152 Rev 4 13/185 Figure 5 shows the general block diagram of the device family. Table 2. STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts Peripherals STM32F405RG STM32F405OG STM32F405VG STM32F405ZG STM32F405OE STM32F407Vx STM32F407Zx STM32F407Ix Flash memory in Kbytes 1024 512 512 1024 512 1024 512 1024 SRAM in Kbytes System 192(112+16+64) Backup 4 FSMC memory controller No Yes(1) Ethernet No Yes Timers Generalpurpose 10 Advanced -control 2 Basic 2 IWDG Yes WWDG Yes RTC Yes Random number generator Yes Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 14/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Communi cation interfaces SPI / I2S 3/2 (full duplex)(2) I2C 3 USART/ UART 4/2 USB OTG FS Yes USB OTG HS Yes CAN 2 SDIO Yes Camera interface No Yes GPIOs 51 72 82 114 72 82 114 140 12-bit ADC Number of channels 3 16 13 16 24 13 16 24 24 12-bit DAC Number of channels Yes 2 Maximum CPU frequency 168 MHz Operating voltage 1.8 to 3.6 V(3) Operating temperatures Ambient temperatures: –40 to +85 °C /–40 to +105 °C Junction temperature: –40 to + 125 °C Package LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 1. For the LQFP100 and WLCSP90 packages, only FSMC Bank1 or Bank2 are available. Bank1 can only support a multiplexed NOR/PSRAM memory using the NE1 Chip Select. Bank2 can only support a 16- or 8-bit NAND Flash memory using the NCE2 Chip Select. The interrupt line cannot be used since Port G is not available in this package. 2. The SPI2 and SPI3 interfaces give the flexibility to work in an exclusive way in either the SPI mode or the I2S audio mode. 3. VDD/VDDA minimum value of 1.7 V is obtained when the device operates in reduced temperature range, and with the use of an external power supply supervisor (refer to Section : Internal reset OFF). Table 2. STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts Peripherals STM32F405RG STM32F405OG STM32F405VG STM32F405ZG STM32F405OE STM32F407Vx STM32F407Zx STM32F407Ix DocID022152 Rev 4 15/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description 2.1 Full compatibility throughout the family The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx are part of the STM32F4 family. They are fully pinto- pin, software and feature compatible with the STM32F2xx devices, allowing the user to try different memory densities, peripherals, and performances (FPU, higher frequency) for a greater degree of freedom during the development cycle. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx devices maintain a close compatibility with the whole STM32F10xxx family. All functional pins are pin-to-pin compatible. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx, however, are not drop-in replacements for the STM32F10xxx devices: the two families do not have the same power scheme, and so their power pins are different. Nonetheless, transition from the STM32F10xxx to the STM32F40x family remains simple as only a few pins are impacted. Figure 4, Figure 3, Figure 2, and Figure 1 give compatible board designs between the STM32F40x, STM32F2xxx, and STM32F10xxx families. Figure 1. Compatible board design between STM32F10xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP64 31 1 16 17 32 48 33 64 49 47 VSS VSS VSS VSS 0 Ω resistor or soldering bridge present for the STM32F10xx configuration, not present in the STM32F4xx configuration ai18489 Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 16/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 2. Compatible board design STM32F10xx/STM32F2xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP100 package Figure 3. Compatible board design between STM32F10xx/STM32F2xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP144 package 20 49 1 25 26 50 75 51 100 76 73 19 VSS VSS VDD VSS VSS VSS 0 ΩΩ resistor or soldering bridge present for the STM32F10xxx configuration, not present in the STM32F4xx configuration ai18488c 99 (VSS) VDD VSS Two 0 Ω resistors connected to: - VSS for the STM32F10xx - VSS for the STM32F4xx VSS for STM32F10xx VDD for STM32F4xx - VSS, VDD or NC for the STM32F2xx ai18487d 31 71 1 36 37 72 108 73 144 109 VSS 0 Ω resistor or soldering bridge present for the STM32F10xx configuration, not present in the STM32F4xx configuration 106 VSS 30 Two 0 Ω resistors connected to: - VSS for the STM32F10xx - VDD or signal from external power supply supervisor for the STM32F4xx VDD VSS VSS VSS 143 (PDR_ON) VDD VSS VSS for STM32F10xx VDD for STM32F4xx - VSS, VDD or NC for the STM32F2xx Signal from external power supply supervisor DocID022152 Rev 4 17/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description Figure 4. Compatible board design between STM32F2xx and STM32F4xx for LQFP176 and BGA176 packages MS19919V3 1 44 45 88 132 89 176 133 Two 0 Ω resistors connected to: - VSS, VDD or NC for the STM32F2xx - VDD or signal from external power supply supervisor for the STM32F4xx 171 (PDR_ON) VDDVSS Signal from external power supply supervisor Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 18/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 2.2 Device overview Figure 5. STM32F40x block diagram 1. The timers connected to APB2 are clocked from TIMxCLK up to 168 MHz, while the timers connected to APB1 are clocked from TIMxCLK either up to 84 MHz or 168 MHz, depending on TIMPRE bit configuration in the RCC_DCKCFGR register. 2. The camera interface and ethernet are available only on STM32F407xx devices. MS19920V3 GPIO PORT A AHB/APB2 140 AF PA[15:0] TIM1 / PWM 4 compl. channels (TIM1_CH1[1:4]N, 4 channels (TIM1_CH1[1:4]ETR, BKIN as AF RX, TX, CK, CTS, RTS as AF MOSI, MISO, SCK, NSS as AF APB 1 30M Hz 8 analog inputs common to the 3 ADCs VDDREF_ADC MOSI/SD, MISO/SD_ext, SCK/CK NSS/WS, MCK as AF TX, RX DAC1_OUT as AF ITF WWDG 4 KB BKPSRAM RTC_AF1 OSC32_IN OSC32_OUT VDDA, VSSA NRST 16b SDIO / MMC D[7:0] CMD, CK as AF VBAT = 1.65 to 3.6 V DMA2 SCL, SDA, SMBA as AF JTAG & SW ARM Cortex-M4 168 MHz ETM NVIC MPU TRACECLK TRACED[3:0] Ethernet MAC 10/100 DMA/ FIFO MII or RMII as AF MDIO as AF USB OTG HS DP, DM ULPI:CK, D[7:0], DIR, STP, NXT ID, VBUS, SOF DMA2 8 Streams FIFO ART ACCEL/ CACHE SRAM 112 KB CLK, NE [3:0], A[23:0], D[31:0], OEN, WEN, NBL[3:0], NL, NREG, NWAIT/IORDY, CD INTN, NIIS16 as AF RNG Camera interface HSYNC, VSYNC PUIXCLK, D[13:0] PHY USB OTG FS DP DM ID, VBUS, SOF FIFO AHB1 168 MHz PHY FIFO @VDDA @VDDA POR/PDR BOR Supply supervision @VDDA PVD Int POR reset XTAL 32 kHz MAN AGT RTC RC HS FCLK RC LS PWR interface IWDG @VBAT AWU Reset & clock control P L L1&2 PCLKx VDD = 1.8 to 3.6 V VSS VCAP1, VCPA2 Voltage regulator 3.3 to 1.2 V VDD Power managmt Backup register RTC_AF1 AHB bus-matrix 8S7M LS 2 channels as AF DAC1 DAC2 Flash up to 1 MB SRAM, PSRAM, NOR Flash, PC Card (ATA), NAND Flash External memory controller (FSMC) TIM6 TIM7 TIM2 TIM3 TIM4 TIM5 TIM12 TIM13 TIM14 USART2 USART3 UART4 UART5 SP3/I2S3 I2C1/SMBUS I2C2/SMBUS I2C3/SMBUS bxCAN1 bxCAN2 SPI1 EXT IT. WKUP D-BUS FIFO FPU APB142 MHz (max) SRAM 16 KB CCM data RAM 64 KB AHB3 AHB2 168 MHz NJTRST, JTDI, JTCK/SWCLK JTDO/SWD, JTDO I-BUS S-BUS DMA/ FIFO DMA1 8 Streams FIFO PB[15:0] PC[15:0] PD[15:0] PE[15:0] PF[15:0] PG[15:0] PH[15:0] PI[11:0] GPIO PORT B GPIO PORT C GPIO PORT D GPIO PORT E GPIO PORT F GPIO PORT G GPIO PORT H GPIO PORT I TIM8 / PWM 16b 4 compl. channels (TIM1_CH1[1:4]N, 4 channels (TIM1_CH1[1:4]ETR, BKIN as AF 1 channel as AF 1 channel as AF RX, TX, CK, CTS, RTS as AF 8 analog inputs common to the ADC1 & 2 8 analog inputs for ADC3 DAC2_OUT as AF 16b 16b SCL, SDA, SMBA as AF SCL, SDA, SMBA as AF MOSI/SD, MISO/SD_ext, SCK/CK NSS/WS, MCK as AF TX, RX RX, TX as AF RX, TX as AF RX, TX as AF CTS, RTS as AF RX, TX as AF CTS, RTS as AF 1 channel as AF smcard irDA smcard irDA 16b 16b 16b 1 channel as AF 2 channels as AF 32b 16b 16b 32b 4 channels 4 channels, ETR as AF 4 channels, ETR as AF 4 channels, ETR as AF DMA1 AHB/APB1 LS OSC_IN OSC_OUT HCLKx XTAL OSC 4- 16MHz FIFO SP2/I2S2 NIORD, IOWR, INT[2:3] ADC3 ADC2 ADC1 Temperature sensor IF TIM9 16b TIM10 16b TIM11 16b smcard irDA USART1 irDA smcard USART6 APB2 84 MHz @VDD @VDD @VDDA DocID022152 Rev 4 19/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description 2.2.1 ARM® Cortex™-M4F core with embedded Flash and SRAM The ARM Cortex-M4F processor is the latest generation of ARM processors for embedded systems. It was developed to provide a low-cost platform that meets the needs of MCU implementation, with a reduced pin count and low-power consumption, while delivering outstanding computational performance and an advanced response to interrupts. The ARM Cortex-M4F 32-bit RISC processor features exceptional code-efficiency, delivering the high-performance expected from an ARM core in the memory size usually associated with 8- and 16-bit devices. The processor supports a set of DSP instructions which allow efficient signal processing and complex algorithm execution. Its single precision FPU (floating point unit) speeds up software development by using metalanguage development tools, while avoiding saturation. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx family is compatible with all ARM tools and software. Figure 5 shows the general block diagram of the STM32F40x family. Note: Cortex-M4F is binary compatible with Cortex-M3. 2.2.2 Adaptive real-time memory accelerator (ART Accelerator™) The ART Accelerator™ is a memory accelerator which is optimized for STM32 industrystandard ARM® Cortex™-M4F processors. It balances the inherent performance advantage of the ARM Cortex-M4F over Flash memory technologies, which normally requires the processor to wait for the Flash memory at higher frequencies. To release the processor full 210 DMIPS performance at this frequency, the accelerator implements an instruction prefetch queue and branch cache, which increases program execution speed from the 128-bit Flash memory. Based on CoreMark benchmark, the performance achieved thanks to the ART accelerator is equivalent to 0 wait state program execution from Flash memory at a CPU frequency up to 168 MHz. 2.2.3 Memory protection unit The memory protection unit (MPU) is used to manage the CPU accesses to memory to prevent one task to accidentally corrupt the memory or resources used by any other active task. This memory area is organized into up to 8 protected areas that can in turn be divided up into 8 subareas. The protection area sizes are between 32 bytes and the whole 4 gigabytes of addressable memory. The MPU is especially helpful for applications where some critical or certified code has to be protected against the misbehavior of other tasks. It is usually managed by an RTOS (realtime operating system). If a program accesses a memory location that is prohibited by the MPU, the RTOS can detect it and take action. In an RTOS environment, the kernel can dynamically update the MPU area setting, based on the process to be executed. The MPU is optional and can be bypassed for applications that do not need it. 2.2.4 Embedded Flash memory The STM32F40x devices embed a Flash memory of 512 Kbytes or 1 Mbytes available for storing programs and data. Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 20/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 2.2.5 CRC (cyclic redundancy check) calculation unit The CRC (cyclic redundancy check) calculation unit is used to get a CRC code from a 32-bit data word and a fixed generator polynomial. Among other applications, CRC-based techniques are used to verify data transmission or storage integrity. In the scope of the EN/IEC 60335-1 standard, they offer a means of verifying the Flash memory integrity. The CRC calculation unit helps compute a software signature during runtime, to be compared with a reference signature generated at link-time and stored at a given memory location. 2.2.6 Embedded SRAM All STM32F40x products embed: • Up to 192 Kbytes of system SRAM including 64 Kbytes of CCM (core coupled memory) data RAM RAM memory is accessed (read/write) at CPU clock speed with 0 wait states. • 4 Kbytes of backup SRAM This area is accessible only from the CPU. Its content is protected against possible unwanted write accesses, and is retained in Standby or VBAT mode. 2.2.7 Multi-AHB bus matrix The 32-bit multi-AHB bus matrix interconnects all the masters (CPU, DMAs, Ethernet, USB HS) and the slaves (Flash memory, RAM, FSMC, AHB and APB peripherals) and ensures a seamless and efficient operation even when several high-speed peripherals work simultaneously. DocID022152 Rev 4 21/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description Figure 6. Multi-AHB matrix 2.2.8 DMA controller (DMA) The devices feature two general-purpose dual-port DMAs (DMA1 and DMA2) with 8 streams each. They are able to manage memory-to-memory, peripheral-to-memory and memory-to-peripheral transfers. They feature dedicated FIFOs for APB/AHB peripherals, support burst transfer and are designed to provide the maximum peripheral bandwidth (AHB/APB). The two DMA controllers support circular buffer management, so that no specific code is needed when the controller reaches the end of the buffer. The two DMA controllers also have a double buffering feature, which automates the use and switching of two memory buffers without requiring any special code. Each stream is connected to dedicated hardware DMA requests, with support for software trigger on each stream. Configuration is made by software and transfer sizes between source and destination are independent. The DMA can be used with the main peripherals: • SPI and I2S • I2C • USART • General-purpose, basic and advanced-control timers TIMx • DAC • SDIO • Camera interface (DCMI) • ADC. ARM Cortex-M4 GP DMA1 GP DMA2 MAC Ethernet USB OTG HS Bus matrix-S S0 S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 ICODE DCODE ACCEL Flash memory SRAM1 112 Kbyte SRAM2 16 Kbyte AHB1 peripherals AHB2 FSMC Static MemCtl M0 M1 M2 M3 M4 M5 M6 I-bus D-bus S-bus DMA_PI DMA_MEM1 DMA_MEM2 DMA_P2 ETHERNET_M USB_HS_M ai18490c CCM data RAM 64-Kbyte APB1 APB2 peripherals Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 22/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 2.2.9 Flexible static memory controller (FSMC) The FSMC is embedded in the STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx family. It has four Chip Select outputs supporting the following modes: PCCard/Compact Flash, SRAM, PSRAM, NOR Flash and NAND Flash. Functionality overview: • Write FIFO • Maximum FSMC_CLK frequency for synchronous accesses is 60 MHz. LCD parallel interface The FSMC can be configured to interface seamlessly with most graphic LCD controllers. It supports the Intel 8080 and Motorola 6800 modes, and is flexible enough to adapt to specific LCD interfaces. This LCD parallel interface capability makes it easy to build costeffective graphic applications using LCD modules with embedded controllers or high performance solutions using external controllers with dedicated acceleration. 2.2.10 Nested vectored interrupt controller (NVIC) The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx embed a nested vectored interrupt controller able to manage 16 priority levels, and handle up to 82 maskable interrupt channels plus the 16 interrupt lines of the Cortex™-M4F. • Closely coupled NVIC gives low-latency interrupt processing • Interrupt entry vector table address passed directly to the core • Allows early processing of interrupts • Processing of late arriving, higher-priority interrupts • Support tail chaining • Processor state automatically saved • Interrupt entry restored on interrupt exit with no instruction overhead This hardware block provides flexible interrupt management features with minimum interrupt latency. 2.2.11 External interrupt/event controller (EXTI) The external interrupt/event controller consists of 23 edge-detector lines used to generate interrupt/event requests. Each line can be independently configured to select the trigger event (rising edge, falling edge, both) and can be masked independently. A pending register maintains the status of the interrupt requests. The EXTI can detect an external line with a pulse width shorter than the Internal APB2 clock period. Up to 140 GPIOs can be connected to the 16 external interrupt lines. 2.2.12 Clocks and startup On reset the 16 MHz internal RC oscillator is selected as the default CPU clock. The 16 MHz internal RC oscillator is factory-trimmed to offer 1% accuracy over the full temperature range. The application can then select as system clock either the RC oscillator or an external 4-26 MHz clock source. This clock can be monitored for failure. If a failure is detected, the system automatically switches back to the internal RC oscillator and a software interrupt is generated (if enabled). This clock source is input to a PLL thus allowing to increase the frequency up to 168 MHz. Similarly, full interrupt management of the PLL DocID022152 Rev 4 23/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description clock entry is available when necessary (for example if an indirectly used external oscillator fails). Several prescalers allow the configuration of the three AHB buses, the high-speed APB (APB2) and the low-speed APB (APB1) domains. The maximum frequency of the three AHB buses is 168 MHz while the maximum frequency of the high-speed APB domains is 84 MHz. The maximum allowed frequency of the low-speed APB domain is 42 MHz. The devices embed a dedicated PLL (PLLI2S) which allows to achieve audio class performance. In this case, the I2S master clock can generate all standard sampling frequencies from 8 kHz to 192 kHz. 2.2.13 Boot modes At startup, boot pins are used to select one out of three boot options: • Boot from user Flash • Boot from system memory • Boot from embedded SRAM The boot loader is located in system memory. It is used to reprogram the Flash memory by using USART1 (PA9/PA10), USART3 (PC10/PC11 or PB10/PB11), CAN2 (PB5/PB13), USB OTG FS in Device mode (PA11/PA12) through DFU (device firmware upgrade). 2.2.14 Power supply schemes • VDD = 1.8 to 3.6 V: external power supply for I/Os and the internal regulator (when enabled), provided externally through VDD pins. • VSSA, VDDA = 1.8 to 3.6 V: external analog power supplies for ADC, DAC, Reset blocks, RCs and PLL. VDDA and VSSA must be connected to VDD and VSS, respectively. • VBAT = 1.65 to 3.6 V: power supply for RTC, external clock 32 kHz oscillator and backup registers (through power switch) when VDD is not present. Refer to Figure 21: Power supply scheme for more details. Note: VDD/VDDA minimum value of 1.7 V is obtained when the device operates in reduced temperature range, and with the use of an external power supply supervisor (refer to Section : Internal reset OFF). Refer to Table 2 in order to identify the packages supporting this option. 2.2.15 Power supply supervisor Internal reset ON On packages embedding the PDR_ON pin, the power supply supervisor is enabled by holding PDR_ON high. On all other packages, the power supply supervisor is always enabled. The device has an integrated power-on reset (POR) / power-down reset (PDR) circuitry coupled with a Brownout reset (BOR) circuitry. At power-on, POR/PDR is always active and ensures proper operation starting from 1.8 V. After the 1.8 V POR threshold level is reached, the option byte loading process starts, either to confirm or modify default BOR threshold levels, or to disable BOR permanently. Three BOR thresholds are available through option bytes. The device remains in reset mode when VDD is below a specified threshold, VPOR/PDR or VBOR, without the need for an external reset circuit. Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 24/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 The device also features an embedded programmable voltage detector (PVD) that monitors the VDD/VDDA power supply and compares it to the VPVD threshold. An interrupt can be generated when VDD/VDDA drops below the VPVD threshold and/or when VDD/VDDA is higher than the VPVD threshold. The interrupt service routine can then generate a warning message and/or put the MCU into a safe state. The PVD is enabled by software. Internal reset OFF This feature is available only on packages featuring the PDR_ON pin. The internal power-on reset (POR) / power-down reset (PDR) circuitry is disabled with the PDR_ON pin. An external power supply supervisor should monitor VDD and should maintain the device in reset mode as long as VDD is below a specified threshold. PDR_ON should be connected to this external power supply supervisor. Refer to Figure 7: Power supply supervisor interconnection with internal reset OFF. Figure 7. Power supply supervisor interconnection with internal reset OFF 1. PDR = 1.7 V for reduce temperature range; PDR = 1.8 V for all temperature range. The VDD specified threshold, below which the device must be maintained under reset, is 1.8 V (see Figure 7). This supply voltage can drop to 1.7 V when the device operates in the 0 to 70 °C temperature range. A comprehensive set of power-saving mode allows to design low-power applications. When the internal reset is OFF, the following integrated features are no more supported: • The integrated power-on reset (POR) / power-down reset (PDR) circuitry is disabled • The brownout reset (BOR) circuitry is disabled • The embedded programmable voltage detector (PVD) is disabled • VBAT functionality is no more available and VBAT pin should be connected to VDD All packages, except for the LQFP64 and LQFP100, allow to disable the internal reset through the PDR_ON signal. MS31383V3 NRST VDD PDR_ON External VDD power supply supervisor Ext. reset controller active when VDD < 1.7 V or 1.8 V (1) VDD Application reset signal (optional) DocID022152 Rev 4 25/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description Figure 8. PDR_ON and NRST control with internal reset OFF 1. PDR = 1.7 V for reduce temperature range; PDR = 1.8 V for all temperature range. 2.2.16 Voltage regulator The regulator has four operating modes: • Regulator ON – Main regulator mode (MR) – Low power regulator (LPR) – Power-down • Regulator OFF Regulator ON On packages embedding the BYPASS_REG pin, the regulator is enabled by holding BYPASS_REG low. On all other packages, the regulator is always enabled. There are three power modes configured by software when regulator is ON: • MR is used in the nominal regulation mode (With different voltage scaling in Run) In Main regulator mode (MR mode), different voltage scaling are provided to reach the best compromise between maximum frequency and dynamic power consumption. Refer to Table 14: General operating conditions. • LPR is used in the Stop modes The LP regulator mode is configured by software when entering Stop mode. • Power-down is used in Standby mode. The Power-down mode is activated only when entering in Standby mode. The regulator output is in high impedance and the kernel circuitry is powered down, inducing zero consumption. The contents of the registers and SRAM are lost) MS19009V6 VDD time PDR = 1.7 V or 1.8 V (1) time NRST PDR_ON PDR_ON Reset by other source than power supply supervisor Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 26/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Two external ceramic capacitors should be connected on VCAP_1 & VCAP_2 pin. Refer to Figure 21: Power supply scheme and Figure 16: VCAP_1/VCAP_2 operating conditions. All packages have regulator ON feature. Regulator OFF This feature is available only on packages featuring the BYPASS_REG pin. The regulator is disabled by holding BYPASS_REG high. The regulator OFF mode allows to supply externally a V12 voltage source through VCAP_1 and VCAP_2 pins. Since the internal voltage scaling is not manage internally, the external voltage value must be aligned with the targetted maximum frequency. Refer to Table 14: General operating conditions. The two 2.2 μF ceramic capacitors should be replaced by two 100 nF decoupling capacitors. Refer to Figure 21: Power supply scheme When the regulator is OFF, there is no more internal monitoring on V12. An external power supply supervisor should be used to monitor the V12 of the logic power domain. PA0 pin should be used for this purpose, and act as power-on reset on V12 power domain. In regulator OFF mode the following features are no more supported: • PA0 cannot be used as a GPIO pin since it allows to reset a part of the V12 logic power domain which is not reset by the NRST pin. • As long as PA0 is kept low, the debug mode cannot be used under power-on reset. As a consequence, PA0 and NRST pins must be managed separately if the debug connection under reset or pre-reset is required. Figure 9. Regulator OFF ai18498V4 External VCAP_1/2 power supply supervisor Ext. reset controller active when VCAP_1/2 < Min V12 V12 VCAP_1 VCAP_2 BYPASS_REG VDD PA0 NRST Application reset signal (optional) VDD V12 DocID022152 Rev 4 27/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description The following conditions must be respected: • VDD should always be higher than VCAP_1 and VCAP_2 to avoid current injection between power domains. • If the time for VCAP_1 and VCAP_2 to reach V12 minimum value is faster than the time for VDD to reach 1.8 V, then PA0 should be kept low to cover both conditions: until VCAP_1 and VCAP_2 reach V12 minimum value and until VDD reaches 1.8 V (see Figure 10). • Otherwise, if the time for VCAP_1 and VCAP_2 to reach V12 minimum value is slower than the time for VDD to reach 1.8 V, then PA0 could be asserted low externally (see Figure 11). • If VCAP_1 and VCAP_2 go below V12 minimum value and VDD is higher than 1.8 V, then a reset must be asserted on PA0 pin. Note: The minimum value of V12 depends on the maximum frequency targeted in the application (see Table 14: General operating conditions). Figure 10. Startup in regulator OFF mode: slow VDD slope - power-down reset risen after VCAP_1/VCAP_2 stabilization 1. This figure is valid both whatever the internal reset mode (onON or OFFoff). 2. PDR = 1.7 V for reduced temperature range; PDR = 1.8 V for all temperature ranges. ai18491e VDD time Min V12 PDR = 1.7 V or 1.8 V (2) VCAP_1/VCAP_2 V12 NRST time Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 28/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 11. Startup in regulator OFF mode: fast VDD slope - power-down reset risen before VCAP_1/VCAP_2 stabilization 1. This figure is valid both whatever the internal reset mode (onON or offOFF). 2. PDR = 1.7 V for a reduced temperature range; PDR = 1.8 V for all temperature ranges. 2.2.17 Regulator ON/OFF and internal reset ON/OFF availability 2.2.18 Real-time clock (RTC), backup SRAM and backup registers The backup domain of the STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx includes: • The real-time clock (RTC) • 4 Kbytes of backup SRAM • 20 backup registers The real-time clock (RTC) is an independent BCD timer/counter. Dedicated registers contain the second, minute, hour (in 12/24 hour), week day, date, month, year, in BCD (binarycoded decimal) format. Correction for 28, 29 (leap year), 30, and 31 day of the month are performed automatically. The RTC provides a programmable alarm and programmable periodic interrupts with wakeup from Stop and Standby modes. The sub-seconds value is also available in binary format. It is clocked by a 32.768 kHz external crystal, resonator or oscillator, the internal low-power RC oscillator or the high-speed external clock divided by 128. The internal low-speed RC VDD time Min V12 VCAP_1/VCAP_2 V12 PA0 asserted externally NRST time ai18492d PDR = 1.7 V or 1.8 V (2) Table 3. Regulator ON/OFF and internal reset ON/OFF availability Regulator ON Regulator OFF Internal reset ON Internal reset OFF LQFP64 LQFP100 Yes No Yes No LQFP144 LQFP176 Yes PDR_ON set to VDD Yes PDR_ON connected to an external power supply supervisor WLCSP90 UFBGA176 Yes BYPASS_REG set to VSS Yes BYPASS_REG set to VDD DocID022152 Rev 4 29/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description has a typical frequency of 32 kHz. The RTC can be calibrated using an external 512 Hz output to compensate for any natural quartz deviation. Two alarm registers are used to generate an alarm at a specific time and calendar fields can be independently masked for alarm comparison. To generate a periodic interrupt, a 16-bit programmable binary auto-reload downcounter with programmable resolution is available and allows automatic wakeup and periodic alarms from every 120 μs to every 36 hours. A 20-bit prescaler is used for the time base clock. It is by default configured to generate a time base of 1 second from a clock at 32.768 kHz. The 4-Kbyte backup SRAM is an EEPROM-like memory area. It can be used to store data which need to be retained in VBAT and standby mode. This memory area is disabled by default to minimize power consumption (see Section 2.2.19: Low-power modes). It can be enabled by software. The backup registers are 32-bit registers used to store 80 bytes of user application data when VDD power is not present. Backup registers are not reset by a system, a power reset, or when the device wakes up from the Standby mode (see Section 2.2.19: Low-power modes). Additional 32-bit registers contain the programmable alarm subseconds, seconds, minutes, hours, day, and date. Like backup SRAM, the RTC and backup registers are supplied through a switch that is powered either from the VDD supply when present or from the VBAT pin. 2.2.19 Low-power modes The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx support three low-power modes to achieve the best compromise between low power consumption, short startup time and available wakeup sources: • Sleep mode In Sleep mode, only the CPU is stopped. All peripherals continue to operate and can wake up the CPU when an interrupt/event occurs. • Stop mode The Stop mode achieves the lowest power consumption while retaining the contents of SRAM and registers. All clocks in the V12 domain are stopped, the PLL, the HSI RC and the HSE crystal oscillators are disabled. The voltage regulator can also be put either in normal or in low-power mode. The device can be woken up from the Stop mode by any of the EXTI line (the EXTI line source can be one of the 16 external lines, the PVD output, the RTC alarm / wakeup / tamper / time stamp events, the USB OTG FS/HS wakeup or the Ethernet wakeup). • Standby mode The Standby mode is used to achieve the lowest power consumption. The internal voltage regulator is switched off so that the entire V12 domain is powered off. The PLL, the HSI RC and the HSE crystal oscillators are also switched off. After entering Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 30/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Standby mode, the SRAM and register contents are lost except for registers in the backup domain and the backup SRAM when selected. The device exits the Standby mode when an external reset (NRST pin), an IWDG reset, a rising edge on the WKUP pin, or an RTC alarm / wakeup / tamper /time stamp event occurs. The standby mode is not supported when the embedded voltage regulator is bypassed and the V12 domain is controlled by an external power. 2.2.20 VBAT operation The VBAT pin allows to power the device VBAT domain from an external battery, an external supercapacitor, or from VDD when no external battery and an external supercapacitor are present. VBAT operation is activated when VDD is not present. The VBAT pin supplies the RTC, the backup registers and the backup SRAM. Note: When the microcontroller is supplied from VBAT, external interrupts and RTC alarm/events do not exit it from VBAT operation. When PDR_ON pin is not connected to VDD (internal reset OFF), the VBAT functionality is no more available and VBAT pin should be connected to VDD. 2.2.21 Timers and watchdogs The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx devices include two advanced-control timers, eight general-purpose timers, two basic timers and two watchdog timers. All timer counters can be frozen in debug mode. Table 4 compares the features of the advanced-control, general-purpose and basic timers. Table 4. Timer feature comparison Timer type Timer Counter resolutio n Counter type Prescaler factor DMA request generatio n Capture/ compare channels Complementar y output Max interface clock (MHz) Max timer clock (MHz) Advanced -control TIM1, TIM8 16-bit Up, Down, Up/dow n Any integer between 1 and 65536 Yes 4 Yes 84 168 DocID022152 Rev 4 31/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description Advanced-control timers (TIM1, TIM8) The advanced-control timers (TIM1, TIM8) can be seen as three-phase PWM generators multiplexed on 6 channels. They have complementary PWM outputs with programmable inserted dead times. They can also be considered as complete general-purpose timers. Their 4 independent channels can be used for: • Input capture • Output compare • PWM generation (edge- or center-aligned modes) • One-pulse mode output If configured as standard 16-bit timers, they have the same features as the general-purpose TIMx timers. If configured as 16-bit PWM generators, they have full modulation capability (0- 100%). The advanced-control timer can work together with the TIMx timers via the Timer Link feature for synchronization or event chaining. TIM1 and TIM8 support independent DMA request generation. General purpose TIM2, TIM5 32-bit Up, Down, Up/dow n Any integer between 1 and 65536 Yes 4 No 42 84 TIM3, TIM4 16-bit Up, Down, Up/dow n Any integer between 1 and 65536 Yes 4 No 42 84 TIM9 16-bit Up Any integer between 1 and 65536 No 2 No 84 168 TIM10 , TIM11 16-bit Up Any integer between 1 and 65536 No 1 No 84 168 TIM12 16-bit Up Any integer between 1 and 65536 No 2 No 42 84 TIM13 , TIM14 16-bit Up Any integer between 1 and 65536 No 1 No 42 84 Basic TIM6, TIM7 16-bit Up Any integer between 1 and 65536 Yes 0 No 42 84 Table 4. Timer feature comparison (continued) Timer type Timer Counter resolutio n Counter type Prescaler factor DMA request generatio n Capture/ compare channels Complementar y output Max interface clock (MHz) Max timer clock (MHz) Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 32/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 General-purpose timers (TIMx) There are ten synchronizable general-purpose timers embedded in the STM32F40x devices (see Table 4 for differences). • TIM2, TIM3, TIM4, TIM5 The STM32F40x include 4 full-featured general-purpose timers: TIM2, TIM5, TIM3, and TIM4.The TIM2 and TIM5 timers are based on a 32-bit auto-reload up/downcounter and a 16-bit prescaler. The TIM3 and TIM4 timers are based on a 16- bit auto-reload up/downcounter and a 16-bit prescaler. They all feature 4 independent channels for input capture/output compare, PWM or one-pulse mode output. This gives up to 16 input capture/output compare/PWMs on the largest packages. The TIM2, TIM3, TIM4, TIM5 general-purpose timers can work together, or with the other general-purpose timers and the advanced-control timers TIM1 and TIM8 via the Timer Link feature for synchronization or event chaining. Any of these general-purpose timers can be used to generate PWM outputs. TIM2, TIM3, TIM4, TIM5 all have independent DMA request generation. They are capable of handling quadrature (incremental) encoder signals and the digital outputs from 1 to 4 hall-effect sensors. • TIM9, TIM10, TIM11, TIM12, TIM13, and TIM14 These timers are based on a 16-bit auto-reload upcounter and a 16-bit prescaler. TIM10, TIM11, TIM13, and TIM14 feature one independent channel, whereas TIM9 and TIM12 have two independent channels for input capture/output compare, PWM or one-pulse mode output. They can be synchronized with the TIM2, TIM3, TIM4, TIM5 full-featured general-purpose timers. They can also be used as simple time bases. Basic timers TIM6 and TIM7 These timers are mainly used for DAC trigger and waveform generation. They can also be used as a generic 16-bit time base. TIM6 and TIM7 support independent DMA request generation. Independent watchdog The independent watchdog is based on a 12-bit downcounter and 8-bit prescaler. It is clocked from an independent 32 kHz internal RC and as it operates independently from the main clock, it can operate in Stop and Standby modes. It can be used either as a watchdog to reset the device when a problem occurs, or as a free-running timer for application timeout management. It is hardware- or software-configurable through the option bytes. Window watchdog The window watchdog is based on a 7-bit downcounter that can be set as free-running. It can be used as a watchdog to reset the device when a problem occurs. It is clocked from the main clock. It has an early warning interrupt capability and the counter can be frozen in debug mode. DocID022152 Rev 4 33/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description SysTick timer This timer is dedicated to real-time operating systems, but could also be used as a standard downcounter. It features: • A 24-bit downcounter • Autoreload capability • Maskable system interrupt generation when the counter reaches 0 • Programmable clock source. 2.2.22 Inter-integrated circuit interface (I²C) Up to three I²C bus interfaces can operate in multimaster and slave modes. They can support the Standard-mode (up to 100 kHz) and Fast-mode (up to 400 kHz) . They support the 7/10-bit addressing mode and the 7-bit dual addressing mode (as slave). A hardware CRC generation/verification is embedded. They can be served by DMA and they support SMBus 2.0/PMBus. 2.2.23 Universal synchronous/asynchronous receiver transmitters (USART) The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx embed four universal synchronous/asynchronous receiver transmitters (USART1, USART2, USART3 and USART6) and two universal asynchronous receiver transmitters (UART4 and UART5). These six interfaces provide asynchronous communication, IrDA SIR ENDEC support, multiprocessor communication mode, single-wire half-duplex communication mode and have LIN Master/Slave capability. The USART1 and USART6 interfaces are able to communicate at speeds of up to 10.5 Mbit/s. The other available interfaces communicate at up to 5.25 Mbit/s. USART1, USART2, USART3 and USART6 also provide hardware management of the CTS and RTS signals, Smart Card mode (ISO 7816 compliant) and SPI-like communication capability. All interfaces can be served by the DMA controller. Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 34/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 2.2.24 Serial peripheral interface (SPI) The STM32F40x feature up to three SPIs in slave and master modes in full-duplex and simplex communication modes. SPI1 can communicate at up to 42 Mbits/s, SPI2 and SPI3 can communicate at up to 21 Mbit/s. The 3-bit prescaler gives 8 master mode frequencies and the frame is configurable to 8 bits or 16 bits. The hardware CRC generation/verification supports basic SD Card/MMC modes. All SPIs can be served by the DMA controller. The SPI interface can be configured to operate in TI mode for communications in master mode and slave mode. 2.2.25 Inter-integrated sound (I2S) Two standard I2S interfaces (multiplexed with SPI2 and SPI3) are available. They can be operated in master or slave mode, in full duplex and half-duplex communication modes, and can be configured to operate with a 16-/32-bit resolution as an input or output channel. Audio sampling frequencies from 8 kHz up to 192 kHz are supported. When either or both of the I2S interfaces is/are configured in master mode, the master clock can be output to the external DAC/CODEC at 256 times the sampling frequency. All I2Sx can be served by the DMA controller. 2.2.26 Audio PLL (PLLI2S) The devices feature an additional dedicated PLL for audio I2S application. It allows to achieve error-free I2S sampling clock accuracy without compromising on the CPU performance, while using USB peripherals. Table 5. USART feature comparison USART name Standard features Modem (RTS/ CTS) LIN SPI master irDA Smartcard (ISO 7816) Max. baud rate in Mbit/s (oversampling by 16) Max. baud rate in Mbit/s (oversampling by 8) APB mapping USART1 X X X X X X 5.25 10.5 APB2 (max. 84 MHz) USART2 X X X X X X 2.62 5.25 APB1 (max. 42 MHz) USART3 X X X X X X 2.62 5.25 APB1 (max. 42 MHz) UART4 X - X - X - 2.62 5.25 APB1 (max. 42 MHz) UART5 X - X - X - 2.62 5.25 APB1 (max. 42 MHz) USART6 X X X X X X 5.25 10.5 APB2 (max. 84 MHz) DocID022152 Rev 4 35/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description The PLLI2S configuration can be modified to manage an I2S sample rate change without disabling the main PLL (PLL) used for CPU, USB and Ethernet interfaces. The audio PLL can be programmed with very low error to obtain sampling rates ranging from 8 KHz to 192 KHz. In addition to the audio PLL, a master clock input pin can be used to synchronize the I2S flow with an external PLL (or Codec output). 2.2.27 Secure digital input/output interface (SDIO) An SD/SDIO/MMC host interface is available, that supports MultiMediaCard System Specification Version 4.2 in three different databus modes: 1-bit (default), 4-bit and 8-bit. The interface allows data transfer at up to 48 MHz, and is compliant with the SD Memory Card Specification Version 2.0. The SDIO Card Specification Version 2.0 is also supported with two different databus modes: 1-bit (default) and 4-bit. The current version supports only one SD/SDIO/MMC4.2 card at any one time and a stack of MMC4.1 or previous. In addition to SD/SDIO/MMC, this interface is fully compliant with the CE-ATA digital protocol Rev1.1. 2.2.28 Ethernet MAC interface with dedicated DMA and IEEE 1588 support Peripheral available only on the STM32F407xx devices. The STM32F407xx devices provide an IEEE-802.3-2002-compliant media access controller (MAC) for ethernet LAN communications through an industry-standard mediumindependent interface (MII) or a reduced medium-independent interface (RMII). The STM32F407xx requires an external physical interface device (PHY) to connect to the physical LAN bus (twisted-pair, fiber, etc.). the PHY is connected to the STM32F407xx MII port using 17 signals for MII or 9 signals for RMII, and can be clocked using the 25 MHz (MII) from the STM32F407xx. The STM32F407xx includes the following features: • Supports 10 and 100 Mbit/s rates • Dedicated DMA controller allowing high-speed transfers between the dedicated SRAM and the descriptors (see the STM32F40x reference manual for details) • Tagged MAC frame support (VLAN support) • Half-duplex (CSMA/CD) and full-duplex operation • MAC control sublayer (control frames) support • 32-bit CRC generation and removal • Several address filtering modes for physical and multicast address (multicast and group addresses) • 32-bit status code for each transmitted or received frame • Internal FIFOs to buffer transmit and receive frames. The transmit FIFO and the receive FIFO are both 2 Kbytes. • Supports hardware PTP (precision time protocol) in accordance with IEEE 1588 2008 (PTP V2) with the time stamp comparator connected to the TIM2 input • Triggers interrupt when system time becomes greater than target time Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 36/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 2.2.29 Controller area network (bxCAN) The two CANs are compliant with the 2.0A and B (active) specifications with a bitrate up to 1 Mbit/s. They can receive and transmit standard frames with 11-bit identifiers as well as extended frames with 29-bit identifiers. Each CAN has three transmit mailboxes, two receive FIFOS with 3 stages and 28 shared scalable filter banks (all of them can be used even if one CAN is used). 256 bytes of SRAM are allocated for each CAN. 2.2.30 Universal serial bus on-the-go full-speed (OTG_FS) The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx embed an USB OTG full-speed device/host/OTG peripheral with integrated transceivers. The USB OTG FS peripheral is compliant with the USB 2.0 specification and with the OTG 1.0 specification. It has software-configurable endpoint setting and supports suspend/resume. The USB OTG full-speed controller requires a dedicated 48 MHz clock that is generated by a PLL connected to the HSE oscillator. The major features are: • Combined Rx and Tx FIFO size of 320 × 35 bits with dynamic FIFO sizing • Supports the session request protocol (SRP) and host negotiation protocol (HNP) • 4 bidirectional endpoints • 8 host channels with periodic OUT support • HNP/SNP/IP inside (no need for any external resistor) • For OTG/Host modes, a power switch is needed in case bus-powered devices are connected 2.2.31 Universal serial bus on-the-go high-speed (OTG_HS) The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx devices embed a USB OTG high-speed (up to 480 Mb/s) device/host/OTG peripheral. The USB OTG HS supports both full-speed and high-speed operations. It integrates the transceivers for full-speed operation (12 MB/s) and features a UTMI low-pin interface (ULPI) for high-speed operation (480 MB/s). When using the USB OTG HS in HS mode, an external PHY device connected to the ULPI is required. The USB OTG HS peripheral is compliant with the USB 2.0 specification and with the OTG 1.0 specification. It has software-configurable endpoint setting and supports suspend/resume. The USB OTG full-speed controller requires a dedicated 48 MHz clock that is generated by a PLL connected to the HSE oscillator. The major features are: • Combined Rx and Tx FIFO size of 1 Kbit × 35 with dynamic FIFO sizing • Supports the session request protocol (SRP) and host negotiation protocol (HNP) • 6 bidirectional endpoints • 12 host channels with periodic OUT support • Internal FS OTG PHY support • External HS or HS OTG operation supporting ULPI in SDR mode. The OTG PHY is connected to the microcontroller ULPI port through 12 signals. It can be clocked using the 60 MHz output. • Internal USB DMA • HNP/SNP/IP inside (no need for any external resistor) • for OTG/Host modes, a power switch is needed in case bus-powered devices are connected DocID022152 Rev 4 37/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Description 2.2.32 Digital camera interface (DCMI) The camera interface is not available in STM32F405xx devices. STM32F407xx products embed a camera interface that can connect with camera modules and CMOS sensors through an 8-bit to 14-bit parallel interface, to receive video data. The camera interface can sustain a data transfer rate up to 54 Mbyte/s at 54 MHz. It features: • Programmable polarity for the input pixel clock and synchronization signals • Parallel data communication can be 8-, 10-, 12- or 14-bit • Supports 8-bit progressive video monochrome or raw bayer format, YCbCr 4:2:2 progressive video, RGB 565 progressive video or compressed data (like JPEG) • Supports continuous mode or snapshot (a single frame) mode • Capability to automatically crop the image 2.2.33 Random number generator (RNG) All STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx products embed an RNG that delivers 32-bit random numbers generated by an integrated analog circuit. 2.2.34 General-purpose input/outputs (GPIOs) Each of the GPIO pins can be configured by software as output (push-pull or open-drain, with or without pull-up or pull-down), as input (floating, with or without pull-up or pull-down) or as peripheral alternate function. Most of the GPIO pins are shared with digital or analog alternate functions. All GPIOs are high-current-capable and have speed selection to better manage internal noise, power consumption and electromagnetic emission. The I/O configuration can be locked if needed by following a specific sequence in order to avoid spurious writing to the I/Os registers. Fast I/O handling allowing maximum I/O toggling up to 84 MHz. 2.2.35 Analog-to-digital converters (ADCs) Three 12-bit analog-to-digital converters are embedded and each ADC shares up to 16 external channels, performing conversions in the single-shot or scan mode. In scan mode, automatic conversion is performed on a selected group of analog inputs. Additional logic functions embedded in the ADC interface allow: • Simultaneous sample and hold • Interleaved sample and hold The ADC can be served by the DMA controller. An analog watchdog feature allows very precise monitoring of the converted voltage of one, some or all selected channels. An interrupt is generated when the converted voltage is outside the programmed thresholds. To synchronize A/D conversion and timers, the ADCs could be triggered by any of TIM1, TIM2, TIM3, TIM4, TIM5, or TIM8 timer. 2.2.36 Temperature sensor The temperature sensor has to generate a voltage that varies linearly with temperature. The conversion range is between 1.8 V and 3.6 V. The temperature sensor is internally Description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 38/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 connected to the ADC1_IN16 input channel which is used to convert the sensor output voltage into a digital value. As the offset of the temperature sensor varies from chip to chip due to process variation, the internal temperature sensor is mainly suitable for applications that detect temperature changes instead of absolute temperatures. If an accurate temperature reading is needed, then an external temperature sensor part should be used. 2.2.37 Digital-to-analog converter (DAC) The two 12-bit buffered DAC channels can be used to convert two digital signals into two analog voltage signal outputs. This dual digital Interface supports the following features: • two DAC converters: one for each output channel • 8-bit or 12-bit monotonic output • left or right data alignment in 12-bit mode • synchronized update capability • noise-wave generation • triangular-wave generation • dual DAC channel independent or simultaneous conversions • DMA capability for each channel • external triggers for conversion • input voltage reference VREF+ Eight DAC trigger inputs are used in the device. The DAC channels are triggered through the timer update outputs that are also connected to different DMA streams. 2.2.38 Serial wire JTAG debug port (SWJ-DP) The ARM SWJ-DP interface is embedded, and is a combined JTAG and serial wire debug port that enables either a serial wire debug or a JTAG probe to be connected to the target. Debug is performed using 2 pins only instead of 5 required by the JTAG (JTAG pins could be re-use as GPIO with alternate function): the JTAG TMS and TCK pins are shared with SWDIO and SWCLK, respectively, and a specific sequence on the TMS pin is used to switch between JTAG-DP and SW-DP. 2.2.39 Embedded Trace Macrocell™ The ARM Embedded Trace Macrocell provides a greater visibility of the instruction and data flow inside the CPU core by streaming compressed data at a very high rate from the STM32F40x through a small number of ETM pins to an external hardware trace port analyser (TPA) device. The TPA is connected to a host computer using USB, Ethernet, or any other high-speed channel. Real-time instruction and data flow activity can be recorded and then formatted for display on the host computer that runs the debugger software. TPA hardware is commercially available from common development tool vendors. The Embedded Trace Macrocell operates with third party debugger software tools. DocID022152 Rev 4 39/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description 3 Pinouts and pin description Figure 12. STM32F40x LQFP64 pinout 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 VBAT PC14 PC15 NRST PC0 PC1 PC2 PC3 VSSA VDDA PA0_WKUP PA1 PA2 VDD PB9 PB8 BOOT0 PB7 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PD2 PC12 PC11 PC10 PA15 PA14 VDD VCAP_2 PA13 PA12 PA11 PA10 PA9 PA8 PC9 PC8 PC7 PC6 PB15 PB14 PB13 PB12 PA3 VSS VDD PA4 PA5 PA6 PA7 PC4 PC5 PB0 PB1 PB2 PB10 PB11 VCAP_1 VDD LQFP64 ai18493b PC13 PH0 PH1 VSS Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 40/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 13. STM32F40x LQFP100 pinout 100 99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 123456789 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 PE2 PE3 PE4 PE5 PE6 VBAT PC14 PC15 VSS VDD PH0 NRST PC0 PC1 PC2 PC3 VDD VSSA VREF+ VDDA PA0 PA1 PA2 VDD VSS VCAP_2 PA13 PA12 PA 11 PA10 PA9 PA8 PC9 PC8 PC7 PC6 PD15 PD14 PD13 PD12 PD11 PD10 PD9 PD8 PB15 PB14 PB13 PB12 PA3 VSS VDD PA4 PA5 PA6 PA7 PC4 PC5 PB0 PB1 PB2 PE7 PE8 PE9 PE10 PE11 PE12 PE13 PE14 PE15 PB10 PB11 VCAP_1 VDD VDD VSS PE1 PE0 PB9 PB8 BOOT0 PB7 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PD7 PD6 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 PC12 PC11 PC10 PA15 PA14 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 ai18495c LQFP100 PC13 PH1 DocID022152 Rev 4 41/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description Figure 14. STM32F40x LQFP144 pinout VDD PDR_ON PE1 PE0 PB9 PB8 BOOT0 PB7 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PG15 VDD VSS PG14 PG13 PG12 PG11 PG10 PG9 PD7 PD6 VDD VSS PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 PC12 PC11 PC10 PA15 PA14 PE2 VDD PE3 VSS PE4 PE5 PA13 PE6 PA12 VBAT PA11 PC13 PA10 PC14 PA9 PC15 PA8 PF0 PC9 PF1 PC8 PF2 PC7 PF3 PC6 PF4 VDD PF5 VSS VSS PG8 VDD PG7 PF6 PG6 PF7 PG5 PF8 PG4 PF9 PG3 PF10 PG2 PH0 PD15 PH1 PD14 NRST VDD PC0 VSS PC1 PD13 PC2 PD12 PC3 PD11 VSSA VDD PD10 PD9 VREF+ PD8 VDDA PB15 PA0 PB14 PA1 PB13 PA2 PB12 PA3 VSS VDD PA4 PA5 PA6 PA7 PC4 PC5 PB0 PB1 PB2 PF11 PF12 VDD PF13 PF14 PF15 PG0 PG1 PE7 PE8 PE9 VSS VDD PE10 PE11 PE12 PE13 PE14 PE15 PB10 PB11 VCAP_1 VDD 144 143 142 141 140 139 138 137 136 135 134 133 132 131 130 129 128 127 126 125 124 123 122 121 109 123456789 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 72 LQFP144 120 119 118 117 116 115 114 113 112 111 110 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 ai18496b VCAP_2 VSS Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 42/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 15. STM32F40x LQFP176 pinout MS19916V3 PDR_ON PE1 PE0 PB9 PB8 BOOT0 PB7 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PG15 PG14 PG13 PG12 PG11 PG10 PG9 PD7 PD6 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 PC12 PC11 PC10 PI7 PI6 PE2 PE3 PE4 PE5 PA13 PE6 PA12 VBAT PA11 PI8 PA10 PC14 PA9 PC15 PA8 PF0 PC9 PF1 PC8 PF2 PC7 PF3 PC6 PF4 PF5 PG8 PG7 PF6 PG6 PF7 PG5 PF8 PG4 PF9 PG3 PF10 PG2 PH0 PD15 PH1 PD14 NRST V PC0 V PC1 PD13 PC2 PD12 PC3 PD11 PD10 PD9 VREF+ PD8 PB15 PA0 PB14 PA1 PB13 PA2 PB12 PA3 PA4 PA5 PA6 PA7 PC4 PC5 PB0 PB1 PB2 PF11 PF12 VSS PF13 PF14 PF15 PG0 PG1 PE7 PE8 PE9 PE10 PE11 PE12 PE13 PE14 PE15 PB10 PB11 176 175 174 173 172 171 170 169 168 167 166 165 164 163 162 161 160 159 158 157 156 155 154 153 141 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 132 131 130 129 128 127 126 125 124 123 122 121 120 119 118 117 116 115 114 113 112 111 110 109 108 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 80 LQFP176 152 151 150 149 148 147 146 145 144 143 142 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 89 PI4 PA15 PA14 PI3 PI2 PI5 140 139 138 137 136 135 134 133 PH4 PH5 PH6 PH7 PH8 PH9 PH10 PH11 88 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 PI1 PI0 PH15 PH14 PH13 PH12 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 97 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 PC13 PI9 PI10 PI11 VSS PH2 PH3 VDD VSS VDD VDDA VSSA VDDA BYPASS_REG VDD VDD VSS VDD VCAP_1 VDD VSS VDD VCAP_2 VSS VDD VSS VDD VSS VDD VSS VDD VDD VSS VDD VSS VDD DocID022152 Rev 4 43/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description Figure 16. STM32F40x UFBGA176 ballout 1. This figure shows the package top view. ai18497b 1 2 3 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 A PE3 PE2 PE1 PE0 PB8 PB5 PG14 PG13 PB4 PB3 PD7 PC12 PA15 PA14 PA13 B PE4 PE5 PE6 PB9 PB7 PB6 PG15 PG12 PG11 PG10 PD6 PD0 PC11 PC10 PA12 C VBAT PI7 PI6 PI5 VDD PDR_ON VDD VDD VDD PG9 PD5 PD1 PI3 PI2 PA11 D PC13 PI8 PI9 PI4 BOOT0 VSS VSS VSS PD4 PD3 PD2 PH15 PI1 PA10 E PC14 PF0 PI10 PI11 PH13 PH14 PI0 PA9 F PC15 VSS VDD PH2 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VCAP_2 PC9 PA8 G PH0 VSS VDD PH3 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VDD PC8 PC7 H PH1 PF2 PF1 PH4 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VDD PG8 PC6 J NRST PF3 PF4 PH5 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VDD VDD PG7 PG6 K PF7 PF6 PF5 VDD VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS PH12 PG5 PG4 PG3 L PF10 PF9 PF8 BYPASS_ REG PH11 PH10 PD15 PG2 M VSSA PC0 PC1 PC2 PC3 PB2 PG1 VSS VSS VCAP_1 PH6 PH8 PH9 PD14 PD13 N VREF- PA1 PA0 PA4 PC4 PF13 PG0 VDD VDD VDD PE13 PH7 PD12 PD11 PD10 P VREF+ PA2 PA6 PA5 PC5 PF12 PF15 PE8 PE9 PE11 PE14 PB12 PB13 PD9 PD8 R VDDA PA3 PA7 PB1 PB0 PF11 PF14 PE7 PE10 PE12 PE15 PB10 PB11 PB14 PB15 VSS 4 5 6 7 8 Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 44/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 17. STM32F40x WLCSP90 ballout 1. This figure shows the package bump view. A VBAT PC13 PDR_ON PB4 PD7 PD4 PC12 B PC15 VDD PB7 PB3 PD6 PD2 PA15 C PA0 VSS PB6 PD5 PD1 PC11 PI0 D PC2 PB8 PA13 E PC3 VSS F PH1 PA1 G NRST H VSSA J PA2 PA 4 PA7 PB2 PE11 PB11 PB12 MS30402V1 1 PA14 PI1 PA12 PA10 PA9 PC0 PC9 PC8 PH0 PB13 PC6 PD14 PD12 PE8 PE12 BYPASS_ REG PD9 PD8 PE9 PB14 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 VDD PC14 VCAP_2 PA11 PB5 PD0 PC10 PA8 VSS VDD VSS VDD PC7 VDD PE10 PE14 VCAP_1 PD15 PE13 PE15 PD10 PD11 PA3 PA6 PB1 PB10 PB15 PB9 BOOT0 VDDA PA5 PB0 PE7 Table 6. Legend/abbreviations used in the pinout table Name Abbreviation Definition Pin name Unless otherwise specified in brackets below the pin name, the pin function during and after reset is the same as the actual pin name Pin type S Supply pin I Input only pin I/O Input / output pin I/O structure FT 5 V tolerant I/O TTa 3.3 V tolerant I/O directly connected to ADC B Dedicated BOOT0 pin RST Bidirectional reset pin with embedded weak pull-up resistor Notes Unless otherwise specified by a note, all I/Os are set as floating inputs during and after reset Alternate functions Functions selected through GPIOx_AFR registers Additional functions Functions directly selected/enabled through peripheral registers DocID022152 Rev 4 45/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 - - 1 1 A2 1 PE2 I/O FT TRACECLK/ FSMC_A23 / ETH_MII_TXD3 / EVENTOUT - - 2 2 A1 2 PE3 I/O FT TRACED0/FSMC_A19 / EVENTOUT - - 3 3 B1 3 PE4 I/O FT TRACED1/FSMC_A20 / DCMI_D4/ EVENTOUT - - 4 4 B2 4 PE5 I/O FT TRACED2 / FSMC_A21 / TIM9_CH1 / DCMI_D6 / EVENTOUT - - 5 5 B3 5 PE6 I/O FT TRACED3 / FSMC_A22 / TIM9_CH2 / DCMI_D7 / EVENTOUT 1 A10 6 6 C1 6 VBAT S - - - - D2 7 PI8 I/O FT (2)( 3) EVENTOUT RTC_TAMP1, RTC_TAMP2, RTC_TS 2 A9 7 7 D1 8 PC13 I/O FT (2) (3) EVENTOUT RTC_OUT, RTC_TAMP1, RTC_TS 3 B10 8 8 E1 9 PC14/OSC32_IN (PC14) I/O FT (2)( 3) EVENTOUT OSC32_IN(4) 4 B9 9 9 F1 10 PC15/ OSC32_OUT (PC15) I/O FT (2)( 3) EVENTOUT OSC32_OUT(4) - - - - D3 11 PI9 I/O FT CAN1_RX / EVENTOUT - - - - E3 12 PI10 I/O FT ETH_MII_RX_ER / EVENTOUT - - - - E4 13 PI11 I/O FT OTG_HS_ULPI_DIR / EVENTOUT - - - - F2 14 VSS S - - - - F3 15 VDD S - - - 10 E2 16 PF0 I/O FT FSMC_A0 / I2C2_SDA / EVENTOUT Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 46/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 - - - 11 H3 17 PF1 I/O FT FSMC_A1 / I2C2_SCL / EVENTOUT - - - 12 H2 18 PF2 I/O FT FSMC_A2 / I2C2_SMBA / EVENTOUT - - - 13 J2 19 PF3 I/O FT (4) FSMC_A3/EVENTOUT ADC3_IN9 - - - 14 J3 20 PF4 I/O FT (4) FSMC_A4/EVENTOUT ADC3_IN14 - - - 15 K3 21 PF5 I/O FT (4) FSMC_A5/EVENTOUT ADC3_IN15 - C9 10 16 G2 22 VSS S - B8 11 17 G3 23 VDD S - - - 18 K2 24 PF6 I/O FT (4) TIM10_CH1 / FSMC_NIORD/ EVENTOUT ADC3_IN4 - - - 19 K1 25 PF7 I/O FT (4) TIM11_CH1/FSMC_NREG / EVENTOUT ADC3_IN5 - - - 20 L3 26 PF8 I/O FT (4) TIM13_CH1 / FSMC_NIOWR/ EVENTOUT ADC3_IN6 - - - 21 L2 27 PF9 I/O FT (4) TIM14_CH1 / FSMC_CD/ EVENTOUT ADC3_IN7 - - - 22 L1 28 PF10 I/O FT (4) FSMC_INTR/ EVENTOUT ADC3_IN8 5 F10 12 23 G1 29 PH0/OSC_IN (PH0) I/O FT EVENTOUT OSC_IN(4) 6 F9 13 24 H1 30 PH1/OSC_OUT (PH1) I/O FT EVENTOUT OSC_OUT(4) 7 G10 14 25 J1 31 NRST I/O RS T 8 E10 15 26 M2 32 PC0 I/O FT (4) OTG_HS_ULPI_STP/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN10 9 - 16 27 M3 33 PC1 I/O FT (4) ETH_MDC/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN11 10 D10 17 28 M4 34 PC2 I/O FT (4) SPI2_MISO / OTG_HS_ULPI_DIR / ETH_MII_TXD2 /I2S2ext_SD/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN12 Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 DocID022152 Rev 4 47/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description 11 E9 18 29 M5 35 PC3 I/O FT (4) SPI2_MOSI / I2S2_SD / OTG_HS_ULPI_NXT / ETH_MII_TX_CLK/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN13 - - 19 30 G3 36 VDD S 12 H10 20 31 M1 37 VSSA S - - - - N1 - VREF– S - - 21 32 P1 38 VREF+ S 13 G9 22 33 R1 39 VDDA S 14 C10 23 34 N3 40 PA0/WKUP (PA0) I/O FT (5) USART2_CTS/ UART4_TX/ ETH_MII_CRS / TIM2_CH1_ETR/ TIM5_CH1 / TIM8_ETR/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN0/WKUP(4 ) 15 F8 24 35 N2 41 PA1 I/O FT (4) USART2_RTS / UART4_RX/ ETH_RMII_REF_CLK / ETH_MII_RX_CLK / TIM5_CH2 / TIM2_CH2/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN1 16 J10 25 36 P2 42 PA2 I/O FT (4) USART2_TX/TIM5_CH3 / TIM9_CH1 / TIM2_CH3 / ETH_MDIO/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN2 - - - - F4 43 PH2 I/O FT ETH_MII_CRS/EVENTOU T - - - - G4 44 PH3 I/O FT ETH_MII_COL/EVENTOU T - - - - H4 45 PH4 I/O FT I2C2_SCL / OTG_HS_ULPI_NXT/ EVENTOUT - - - - J4 46 PH5 I/O FT I2C2_SDA/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 48/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 17 H9 26 37 R2 47 PA3 I/O FT (4) USART2_RX/TIM5_CH4 / TIM9_CH2 / TIM2_CH4 / OTG_HS_ULPI_D0 / ETH_MII_COL/ EVENTOUT ADC123_IN3 18 E5 27 38 - - VSS S D9 L4 48 BYPASS_REG I FT 19 E4 28 39 K4 49 VDD S 20 J9 29 40 N4 50 PA4 I/O TTa (4) SPI1_NSS / SPI3_NSS / USART2_CK / DCMI_HSYNC / OTG_HS_SOF/ I2S3_WS/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN4 /DAC_OUT1 21 G8 30 41 P4 51 PA5 I/O TTa (4) SPI1_SCK/ OTG_HS_ULPI_CK / TIM2_CH1_ETR/ TIM8_CH1N/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN5/DAC_OU T2 22 H8 31 42 P3 52 PA6 I/O FT (4) SPI1_MISO / TIM8_BKIN/TIM13_CH1 / DCMI_PIXCLK / TIM3_CH1 / TIM1_BKIN/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN6 23 J8 32 43 R3 53 PA7 I/O FT (4) SPI1_MOSI/ TIM8_CH1N / TIM14_CH1/TIM3_CH2/ ETH_MII_RX_DV / TIM1_CH1N / ETH_RMII_CRS_DV/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN7 24 - 33 44 N5 54 PC4 I/O FT (4) ETH_RMII_RX_D0 / ETH_MII_RX_D0/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN14 25 - 34 45 P5 55 PC5 I/O FT (4) ETH_RMII_RX_D1 / ETH_MII_RX_D1/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN15 26 G7 35 46 R5 56 PB0 I/O FT (4) TIM3_CH3 / TIM8_CH2N/ OTG_HS_ULPI_D1/ ETH_MII_RXD2 / TIM1_CH2N/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN8 Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 DocID022152 Rev 4 49/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description 27 H7 36 47 R4 57 PB1 I/O FT (4) TIM3_CH4 / TIM8_CH3N/ OTG_HS_ULPI_D2/ ETH_MII_RXD3 / TIM1_CH3N/ EVENTOUT ADC12_IN9 28 J7 37 48 M6 58 PB2/BOOT1 (PB2) I/O FT EVENTOUT - - - 49 R6 59 PF11 I/O FT DCMI_D12/ EVENTOUT - - - 50 P6 60 PF12 I/O FT FSMC_A6/ EVENTOUT - - - 51 M8 61 VSS S - - - 52 N8 62 VDD S - - - 53 N6 63 PF13 I/O FT FSMC_A7/ EVENTOUT - - - 54 R7 64 PF14 I/O FT FSMC_A8/ EVENTOUT - - - 55 P7 65 PF15 I/O FT FSMC_A9/ EVENTOUT - - - 56 N7 66 PG0 I/O FT FSMC_A10/ EVENTOUT - - - 57 M7 67 PG1 I/O FT FSMC_A11/ EVENTOUT - G6 38 58 R8 68 PE7 I/O FT FSMC_D4/TIM1_ETR/ EVENTOUT - H6 39 59 P8 69 PE8 I/O FT FSMC_D5/ TIM1_CH1N/ EVENTOUT - J6 40 60 P9 70 PE9 I/O FT FSMC_D6/TIM1_CH1/ EVENTOUT - - - 61 M9 71 VSS S - - - 62 N9 72 VDD S - F6 41 63 R9 73 PE10 I/O FT FSMC_D7/TIM1_CH2N/ EVENTOUT - J5 42 64 P10 74 PE11 I/O FT FSMC_D8/TIM1_CH2/ EVENTOUT - H5 43 65 R10 75 PE12 I/O FT FSMC_D9/TIM1_CH3N/ EVENTOUT - G5 44 66 N11 76 PE13 I/O FT FSMC_D10/TIM1_CH3/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 50/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 - F5 45 67 P11 77 PE14 I/O FT FSMC_D11/TIM1_CH4/ EVENTOUT - G4 46 68 R11 78 PE15 I/O FT FSMC_D12/TIM1_BKIN/ EVENTOUT 29 H4 47 69 R12 79 PB10 I/O FT SPI2_SCK / I2S2_CK / I2C2_SCL/ USART3_TX / OTG_HS_ULPI_D3 / ETH_MII_RX_ER / TIM2_CH3/ EVENTOUT 30 J4 48 70 R13 80 PB11 I/O FT I2C2_SDA/USART3_RX/ OTG_HS_ULPI_D4 / ETH_RMII_TX_EN/ ETH_MII_TX_EN / TIM2_CH4/ EVENTOUT 31 F4 49 71 M10 81 VCAP_1 S 32 - 50 72 N10 82 VDD S - - - - M11 83 PH6 I/O FT I2C2_SMBA / TIM12_CH1 / ETH_MII_RXD2/ EVENTOUT - - - - N12 84 PH7 I/O FT I2C3_SCL / ETH_MII_RXD3/ EVENTOUT - - - - M12 85 PH8 I/O FT I2C3_SDA / DCMI_HSYNC/ EVENTOUT - - - - M13 86 PH9 I/O FT I2C3_SMBA / TIM12_CH2/ DCMI_D0/ EVENTOUT - - - - L13 87 PH10 I/O FT TIM5_CH1 / DCMI_D1/ EVENTOUT - - - - L12 88 PH11 I/O FT TIM5_CH2 / DCMI_D2/ EVENTOUT - - - - K12 89 PH12 I/O FT TIM5_CH3 / DCMI_D3/ EVENTOUT - - - - H12 90 VSS S - - - - J12 91 VDD S Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 DocID022152 Rev 4 51/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description 33 J3 51 73 P12 92 PB12 I/O FT SPI2_NSS / I2S2_WS / I2C2_SMBA/ USART3_CK/ TIM1_BKIN / CAN2_RX / OTG_HS_ULPI_D5/ ETH_RMII_TXD0 / ETH_MII_TXD0/ OTG_HS_ID/ EVENTOUT 34 J1 52 74 P13 93 PB13 I/O FT SPI2_SCK / I2S2_CK / USART3_CTS/ TIM1_CH1N /CAN2_TX / OTG_HS_ULPI_D6 / ETH_RMII_TXD1 / ETH_MII_TXD1/ EVENTOUT OTG_HS_VBUS 35 J2 53 75 R14 94 PB14 I/O FT SPI2_MISO/ TIM1_CH2N / TIM12_CH1 / OTG_HS_DM/ USART3_RTS / TIM8_CH2N/I2S2ext_SD/ EVENTOUT 36 H1 54 76 R15 95 PB15 I/O FT SPI2_MOSI / I2S2_SD/ TIM1_CH3N / TIM8_CH3N / TIM12_CH2 / OTG_HS_DP/ EVENTOUT RTC_REFIN - H2 55 77 P15 96 PD8 I/O FT FSMC_D13 / USART3_TX/ EVENTOUT - H3 56 78 P14 97 PD9 I/O FT FSMC_D14 / USART3_RX/ EVENTOUT - G3 57 79 N15 98 PD10 I/O FT FSMC_D15 / USART3_CK/ EVENTOUT - G1 58 80 N14 99 PD11 I/O FT FSMC_CLE / FSMC_A16/USART3_CT S/ EVENTOUT - G2 59 81 N13 100 PD12 I/O FT FSMC_ALE/ FSMC_A17/TIM4_CH1 / USART3_RTS/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 52/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 - - 60 82 M15 101 PD13 I/O FT FSMC_A18/TIM4_CH2/ EVENTOUT - - - 83 - 102 VSS S - - - 84 J13 103 VDD S - F2 61 85 M14 104 PD14 I/O FT FSMC_D0/TIM4_CH3/ EVENTOUT/ EVENTOUT - F1 62 86 L14 105 PD15 I/O FT FSMC_D1/TIM4_CH4/ EVENTOUT - - - 87 L15 106 PG2 I/O FT FSMC_A12/ EVENTOUT - - - 88 K15 107 PG3 I/O FT FSMC_A13/ EVENTOUT - - - 89 K14 108 PG4 I/O FT FSMC_A14/ EVENTOUT - - - 90 K13 109 PG5 I/O FT FSMC_A15/ EVENTOUT - - - 91 J15 110 PG6 I/O FT FSMC_INT2/ EVENTOUT - - - 92 J14 111 PG7 I/O FT FSMC_INT3 /USART6_CK/ EVENTOUT - - - 93 H14 112 PG8 I/O FT USART6_RTS / ETH_PPS_OUT/ EVENTOUT - - - 94 G12 113 VSS S - - - 95 H13 114 VDD S 37 F3 63 96 H15 115 PC6 I/O FT I2S2_MCK / TIM8_CH1/SDIO_D6 / USART6_TX / DCMI_D0/TIM3_CH1/ EVENTOUT 38 E1 64 97 G15 116 PC7 I/O FT I2S3_MCK / TIM8_CH2/SDIO_D7 / USART6_RX / DCMI_D1/TIM3_CH2/ EVENTOUT 39 E2 65 98 G14 117 PC8 I/O FT TIM8_CH3/SDIO_D0 /TIM3_CH3/ USART6_CK / DCMI_D2/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 DocID022152 Rev 4 53/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description 40 E3 66 99 F14 118 PC9 I/O FT I2S_CKIN/ MCO2 / TIM8_CH4/SDIO_D1 / /I2C3_SDA / DCMI_D3 / TIM3_CH4/ EVENTOUT 41 D1 67 100 F15 119 PA8 I/O FT MCO1 / USART1_CK/ TIM1_CH1/ I2C3_SCL/ OTG_FS_SOF/ EVENTOUT 42 D2 68 101 E15 120 PA9 I/O FT USART1_TX/ TIM1_CH2 / I2C3_SMBA / DCMI_D0/ EVENTOUT OTG_FS_VBUS 43 D3 69 102 D15 121 PA10 I/O FT USART1_RX/ TIM1_CH3/ OTG_FS_ID/DCMI_D1/ EVENTOUT 44 C1 70 103 C15 122 PA11 I/O FT USART1_CTS / CAN1_RX / TIM1_CH4 / OTG_FS_DM/ EVENTOUT 45 C2 71 104 B15 123 PA12 I/O FT USART1_RTS / CAN1_TX/ TIM1_ETR/ OTG_FS_DP/ EVENTOUT 46 D4 72 105 A15 124 PA13 (JTMS-SWDIO) I/O FT JTMS-SWDIO/ EVENTOUT 47 B1 73 106 F13 125 VCAP_2 S - E7 74 107 F12 126 VSS S 48 E6 75 108 G13 127 VDD S - - - - E12 128 PH13 I/O FT TIM8_CH1N / CAN1_TX/ EVENTOUT - - - - E13 129 PH14 I/O FT TIM8_CH2N / DCMI_D4/ EVENTOUT - - - - D13 130 PH15 I/O FT TIM8_CH3N / DCMI_D11/ EVENTOUT - C3 - - E14 131 PI0 I/O FT TIM5_CH4 / SPI2_NSS / I2S2_WS / DCMI_D13/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 54/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 - B2 - - D14 132 PI1 I/O FT SPI2_SCK / I2S2_CK / DCMI_D8/ EVENTOUT - - - - C14 133 PI2 I/O FT TIM8_CH4 /SPI2_MISO / DCMI_D9 / I2S2ext_SD/ EVENTOUT - - - - C13 134 PI3 I/O FT TIM8_ETR / SPI2_MOSI / I2S2_SD / DCMI_D10/ EVENTOUT - - - - D9 135 VSS S - - - - C9 136 VDD S 49 A2 76 109 A14 137 PA14 (JTCK/SWCLK) I/O FT JTCK-SWCLK/ EVENTOUT 50 B3 77 110 A13 138 PA15 (JTDI) I/O FT JTDI/ SPI3_NSS/ I2S3_WS/TIM2_CH1_ET R / SPI1_NSS / EVENTOUT 51 D5 78 111 B14 139 PC10 I/O FT SPI3_SCK / I2S3_CK/ UART4_TX/SDIO_D2 / DCMI_D8 / USART3_TX/ EVENTOUT 52 C4 79 112 B13 140 PC11 I/O FT UART4_RX/ SPI3_MISO / SDIO_D3 / DCMI_D4/USART3_RX / I2S3ext_SD/ EVENTOUT 53 A3 80 113 A12 141 PC12 I/O FT UART5_TX/SDIO_CK / DCMI_D9 / SPI3_MOSI /I2S3_SD / USART3_CK/ EVENTOUT - D6 81 114 B12 142 PD0 I/O FT FSMC_D2/CAN1_RX/ EVENTOUT - C5 82 115 C12 143 PD1 I/O FT FSMC_D3 / CAN1_TX/ EVENTOUT 54 B4 83 116 D12 144 PD2 I/O FT TIM3_ETR/UART5_RX/ SDIO_CMD / DCMI_D11/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 DocID022152 Rev 4 55/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description - - 84 117 D11 145 PD3 I/O FT FSMC_CLK/ USART2_CTS/ EVENTOUT - A4 85 118 D10 146 PD4 I/O FT FSMC_NOE/ USART2_RTS/ EVENTOUT - C6 86 119 C11 147 PD5 I/O FT FSMC_NWE/USART2_TX / EVENTOUT - - - 120 D8 148 VSS S - - - 121 C8 149 VDD S - B5 87 122 B11 150 PD6 I/O FT FSMC_NWAIT/ USART2_RX/ EVENTOUT - A5 88 123 A11 151 PD7 I/O FT USART2_CK/FSMC_NE1/ FSMC_NCE2/ EVENTOUT - - - 124 C10 152 PG9 I/O FT USART6_RX / FSMC_NE2/FSMC_NCE3 / EVENTOUT - - - 125 B10 153 PG10 I/O FT FSMC_NCE4_1/ FSMC_NE3/ EVENTOUT - - - 126 B9 154 PG11 I/O FT FSMC_NCE4_2 / ETH_MII_TX_EN/ ETH _RMII_TX_EN/ EVENTOUT - - - 127 B8 155 PG12 I/O FT FSMC_NE4 / USART6_RTS/ EVENTOUT - - - 128 A8 156 PG13 I/O FT FSMC_A24 / USART6_CTS /ETH_MII_TXD0/ ETH_RMII_TXD0/ EVENTOUT - - - 129 A7 157 PG14 I/O FT FSMC_A25 / USART6_TX /ETH_MII_TXD1/ ETH_RMII_TXD1/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 56/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 - E8 - 130 D7 158 VSS S - F7 - 131 C7 159 VDD S - - - 132 B7 160 PG15 I/O FT USART6_CTS / DCMI_D13/ EVENTOUT 55 B6 89 133 A10 161 PB3 (JTDO/ TRACESWO) I/O FT JTDO/ TRACESWO/ SPI3_SCK / I2S3_CK / TIM2_CH2 / SPI1_SCK/ EVENTOUT 56 A6 90 134 A9 162 PB4 (NJTRST) I/O FT NJTRST/ SPI3_MISO / TIM3_CH1 / SPI1_MISO / I2S3ext_SD/ EVENTOUT 57 D7 91 135 A6 163 PB5 I/O FT I2C1_SMBA/ CAN2_RX / OTG_HS_ULPI_D7 / ETH_PPS_OUT/TIM3_CH 2 / SPI1_MOSI/ SPI3_MOSI / DCMI_D10 / I2S3_SD/ EVENTOUT 58 C7 92 136 B6 164 PB6 I/O FT I2C1_SCL/ TIM4_CH1 / CAN2_TX / DCMI_D5/USART1_TX/ EVENTOUT 59 B7 93 137 B5 165 PB7 I/O FT I2C1_SDA / FSMC_NL / DCMI_VSYNC / USART1_RX/ TIM4_CH2/ EVENTOUT 60 A7 94 138 D6 166 BOOT0 I B VPP 61 D8 95 139 A5 167 PB8 I/O FT TIM4_CH3/SDIO_D4/ TIM10_CH1 / DCMI_D6 / ETH_MII_TXD3 / I2C1_SCL/ CAN1_RX/ EVENTOUT 62 C8 96 140 B4 168 PB9 I/O FT SPI2_NSS/ I2S2_WS / TIM4_CH4/ TIM11_CH1/ SDIO_D5 / DCMI_D7 / I2C1_SDA / CAN1_TX/ EVENTOUT Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 DocID022152 Rev 4 57/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description - - 97 141 A4 169 PE0 I/O FT TIM4_ETR / FSMC_NBL0 / DCMI_D2/ EVENTOUT - - 98 142 A3 170 PE1 I/O FT FSMC_NBL1 / DCMI_D3/ EVENTOUT 63 - 99 - D5 - VSS S - A8 - 143 C6 171 PDR_ON I FT 64 A1 10 0 144 C5 172 VDD S - - - - D4 173 PI4 I/O FT TIM8_BKIN / DCMI_D5/ EVENTOUT - - - - C4 174 PI5 I/O FT TIM8_CH1 / DCMI_VSYNC/ EVENTOUT - - - - C3 175 PI6 I/O FT TIM8_CH2 / DCMI_D6/ EVENTOUT - - - - C2 176 PI7 I/O FT TIM8_CH3 / DCMI_D7/ EVENTOUT 1. Function availability depends on the chosen device. 2. PC13, PC14, PC15 and PI8 are supplied through the power switch. Since the switch only sinks a limited amount of current (3 mA), the use of GPIOs PC13 to PC15 and PI8 in output mode is limited: - The speed should not exceed 2 MHz with a maximum load of 30 pF. - These I/Os must not be used as a current source (e.g. to drive an LED). 3. Main function after the first backup domain power-up. Later on, it depends on the contents of the RTC registers even after reset (because these registers are not reset by the main reset). For details on how to manage these I/Os, refer to the RTC register description sections in the STM32F4xx reference manual, available from the STMicroelectronics website: www.st.com. 4. FT = 5 V tolerant except when in analog mode or oscillator mode (for PC14, PC15, PH0 and PH1). 5. If the device is delivered in an UFBGA176 or WLCSP90 and the BYPASS_REG pin is set to VDD (Regulator off/internal reset ON mode), then PA0 is used as an internal Reset (active low). Table 7. STM32F40x pin and ball definitions (continued) Pin number Pin name (function after reset)(1) Pin type I / O structure Notes Alternate functions Additional functions LQFP64 WLCSP90 LQFP100 LQFP144 UFBGA176 LQFP176 Table 8. FSMC pin definition Pins(1) FSMC LQFP100(2) WLCSP90 (2) CF NOR/PSRAM/ SRAM NOR/PSRAM Mux NAND 16 bit PE2 A23 A23 Yes PE3 A19 A19 Yes Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 58/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 PE4 A20 A20 Yes PE5 A21 A21 Yes PE6 A22 A22 Yes PF0 A0 A0 - - PF1 A1 A1 - - PF2 A2 A2 - - PF3 A3 A3 - - PF4 A4 A4 - - PF5 A5 A5 - - PF6 NIORD - - PF7 NREG - - PF8 NIOWR - - PF9 CD - - PF10 INTR - - PF12 A6 A6 - - PF13 A7 A7 - - PF14 A8 A8 - - PF15 A9 A9 - - PG0 A10 A10 - - PG1 A11 - - PE7 D4 D4 DA4 D4 Yes Yes PE8 D5 D5 DA5 D5 Yes Yes PE9 D6 D6 DA6 D6 Yes Yes PE10 D7 D7 DA7 D7 Yes Yes PE11 D8 D8 DA8 D8 Yes Yes PE12 D9 D9 DA9 D9 Yes Yes PE13 D10 D10 DA10 D10 Yes Yes PE14 D11 D11 DA11 D11 Yes Yes PE15 D12 D12 DA12 D12 Yes Yes PD8 D13 D13 DA13 D13 Yes Yes PD9 D14 D14 DA14 D14 Yes Yes PD10 D15 D15 DA15 D15 Yes Yes PD11 A16 A16 CLE Yes Yes Table 8. FSMC pin definition (continued) Pins(1) FSMC LQFP100(2) WLCSP90 (2) CF NOR/PSRAM/ SRAM NOR/PSRAM Mux NAND 16 bit DocID022152 Rev 4 59/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description PD12 A17 A17 ALE Yes Yes PD13 A18 A18 Yes PD14 D0 D0 DA0 D0 Yes Yes PD15 D1 D1 DA1 D1 Yes Yes PG2 A12 - - PG3 A13 - - PG4 A14 - - PG5 A15 - - PG6 INT2 - - PG7 INT3 - - PD0 D2 D2 DA2 D2 Yes Yes PD1 D3 D3 DA3 D3 Yes Yes PD3 CLK CLK Yes PD4 NOE NOE NOE NOE Yes Yes PD5 NWE NWE NWE NWE Yes Yes PD6 NWAIT NWAIT NWAIT NWAIT Yes Yes PD7 NE1 NE1 NCE2 Yes Yes PG9 NE2 NE2 NCE3 - - PG10 NCE4_1 NE3 NE3 - - PG11 NCE4_2 - - PG12 NE4 NE4 - - PG13 A24 A24 - - PG14 A25 A25 - - PB7 NADV NADV Yes Yes PE0 NBL0 NBL0 Yes PE1 NBL1 NBL1 Yes 1. Full FSMC features are available on LQFP144, LQFP176, and UFBGA176. The features available on smaller packages are given in the dedicated package column. 2. Ports F and G are not available in devices delivered in 100-pin packages. Table 8. FSMC pin definition (continued) Pins(1) FSMC LQFP100(2) WLCSP90 (2) CF NOR/PSRAM/ SRAM NOR/PSRAM Mux NAND 16 bit Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 60/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Table 9. Alternate function mapping Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI Port A PA0 TIM2_CH1_E TR TIM 5_CH1 TIM8_ETR USART2_CTS UART4_TX ETH_MII_CRS EVENTOUT PA1 TIM2_CH2 TIM5_CH2 USART2_RTS UART4_RX ETH_MII _RX_CLK ETH_RMII__REF _CLK EVENTOUT PA2 TIM2_CH3 TIM5_CH3 TIM9_CH1 USART2_TX ETH_MDIO EVENTOUT PA3 TIM2_CH4 TIM5_CH4 TIM9_CH2 USART2_RX OTG_HS_ULPI_ D0 ETH _MII_COL EVENTOUT PA4 SPI1_NSS SPI3_NSS I2S3_WS USART2_CK OTG_HS_SO F DCMI_HSYN C EVENTOUT PA5 TIM2_CH1_E TR TIM8_CH1N SPI1_SCK OTG_HS_ULPI_ CK EVENTOUT PA6 TIM1_BKIN TIM3_CH1 TIM8_BKIN SPI1_MISO TIM13_CH1 DCMI_PIXCK EVENTOUT PA7 TIM1_CH1N TIM3_CH2 TIM8_CH1N SPI1_MOSI TIM14_CH1 ETH_MII _RX_DV ETH_RMII _CRS_DV EVENTOUT PA8 MCO1 TIM1_CH1 I2C3_SCL USART1_CK OTG_FS_SOF EVENTOUT PA9 TIM1_CH2 I2C3_SMB A USART1_TX DCMI_D0 EVENTOUT PA10 TIM1_CH3 USART1_RX OTG_FS_ID DCMI_D1 EVENTOUT PA11 TIM1_CH4 USART1_CTS CAN1_RX OTG_FS_DM EVENTOUT PA12 TIM1_ETR USART1_RTS CAN1_TX OTG_FS_DP EVENTOUT PA13 JTMSSWDIO EVENTOUT PA14 JTCKSWCLK EVENTOUT PA15 JTDI TIM 2_CH1 TIM 2_ETR SPI1_NSS SPI3_NSS/ I2S3_WS EVENTOUT STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description DocID022152 Rev 4 61/185 Port B PB0 TIM1_CH2N TIM3_CH3 TIM8_CH2N OTG_HS_ULPI_ D1 ETH _MII_RXD2 EVENTOUT PB1 TIM1_CH3N TIM3_CH4 TIM8_CH3N OTG_HS_ULPI_ D2 ETH _MII_RXD3 EVENTOUT PB2 EVENTOUT PB3 JTDO/ TRACES WO TIM2_CH2 SPI1_SCK SPI3_SCK I2S3_CK EVENTOUT PB4 NJTRST TIM3_CH1 SPI1_MISO SPI3_MISO I2S3ext_SD EVENTOUT PB5 TIM3_CH2 I2C1_SMB A SPI1_MOSI SPI3_MOSI I2S3_SD CAN2_RX OTG_HS_ULPI_ D7 ETH _PPS_OUT DCMI_D10 EVENTOUT PB6 TIM4_CH1 I2C1_SCL USART1_TX CAN2_TX DCMI_D5 EVENTOUT PB7 TIM4_CH2 I2C1_SDA USART1_RX FSMC_NL DCMI_VSYN C EVENTOUT PB8 TIM4_CH3 TIM10_CH1 I2C1_SCL CAN1_RX ETH _MII_TXD3 SDIO_D4 DCMI_D6 EVENTOUT PB9 TIM4_CH4 TIM11_CH1 I2C1_SDA SPI2_NSS I2S2_WS CAN1_TX SDIO_D5 DCMI_D7 EVENTOUT PB10 TIM2_CH3 I2C2_SCL SPI2_SCK I2S2_CK USART3_TX OTG_HS_ULPI_ D3 ETH_ MII_RX_ER EVENTOUT PB11 TIM2_CH4 I2C2_SDA USART3_RX OTG_HS_ULPI_ D4 ETH _MII_TX_EN ETH _RMII_TX_EN EVENTOUT PB12 TIM1_BKIN I2C2_SMB A SPI2_NSS I2S2_WS USART3_CK CAN2_RX OTG_HS_ULPI_ D5 ETH _MII_TXD0 ETH _RMII_TXD0 OTG_HS_ID EVENTOUT PB13 TIM1_CH1N SPI2_SCK I2S2_CK USART3_CTS CAN2_TX OTG_HS_ULPI_ D6 ETH _MII_TXD1 ETH _RMII_TXD1 EVENTOUT PB14 TIM1_CH2N TIM8_CH2N SPI2_MISO I2S2ext_SD USART3_RTS TIM12_CH1 OTG_HS_DM EVENTOUT PB15 RTC_ REFIN TIM1_CH3N TIM8_CH3N SPI2_MOSI I2S2_SD TIM12_CH2 OTG_HS_DP EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 62/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Port C PC0 OTG_HS_ULPI_ STP EVENTOUT PC1 ETH_MDC EVENTOUT PC2 SPI2_MISO I2S2ext_SD OTG_HS_ULPI_ DIR ETH _MII_TXD2 EVENTOUT PC3 SPI2_MOSI I2S2_SD OTG_HS_ULPI_ NXT ETH _MII_TX_CLK EVENTOUT PC4 ETH_MII_RXD0 ETH_RMII_RXD0 EVENTOUT PC5 ETH _MII_RXD1 ETH _RMII_RXD1 EVENTOUT PC6 TIM3_CH1 TIM8_CH1 I2S2_MCK USART6_TX SDIO_D6 DCMI_D0 EVENTOUT PC7 TIM3_CH2 TIM8_CH2 I2S3_MCK USART6_RX SDIO_D7 DCMI_D1 EVENTOUT PC8 TIM3_CH3 TIM8_CH3 USART6_CK SDIO_D0 DCMI_D2 EVENTOUT PC9 MCO2 TIM3_CH4 TIM8_CH4 I2C3_SDA I2S_CKIN SDIO_D1 DCMI_D3 EVENTOUT PC10 SPI3_SCK/ I2S3_CK USART3_TX/ UART4_TX SDIO_D2 DCMI_D8 EVENTOUT PC11 I2S3ext_SD SPI3_MISO/ USART3_RX UART4_RX SDIO_D3 DCMI_D4 EVENTOUT PC12 SPI3_MOSI I2S3_SD USART3_CK UART5_TX SDIO_CK DCMI_D9 EVENTOUT PC13 EVENTOUT PC14 EVENTOUT PC15 EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description DocID022152 Rev 4 63/185 Port D PD0 CAN1_RX FSMC_D2 EVENTOUT PD1 CAN1_TX FSMC_D3 EVENTOUT PD2 TIM3_ETR UART5_RX SDIO_CMD DCMI_D11 EVENTOUT PD3 USART2_CTS FSMC_CLK EVENTOUT PD4 USART2_RTS FSMC_NOE EVENTOUT PD5 USART2_TX FSMC_NWE EVENTOUT PD6 USART2_RX FSMC_NWAIT EVENTOUT PD7 USART2_CK FSMC_NE1/ FSMC_NCE2 EVENTOUT PD8 USART3_TX FSMC_D13 EVENTOUT PD9 USART3_RX FSMC_D14 EVENTOUT PD10 USART3_CK FSMC_D15 EVENTOUT PD11 USART3_CTS FSMC_A16 EVENTOUT PD12 TIM4_CH1 USART3_RTS FSMC_A17 EVENTOUT PD13 TIM4_CH2 FSMC_A18 EVENTOUT PD14 TIM4_CH3 FSMC_D0 EVENTOUT PD15 TIM4_CH4 FSMC_D1 EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 64/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Port E PE0 TIM4_ETR FSMC_NBL0 DCMI_D2 EVENTOUT PE1 FSMC_NBL1 DCMI_D3 EVENTOUT PE2 TRACECL K ETH _MII_TXD3 FSMC_A23 EVENTOUT PE3 TRACED0 FSMC_A19 EVENTOUT PE4 TRACED1 FSMC_A20 DCMI_D4 EVENTOUT PE5 TRACED2 TIM9_CH1 FSMC_A21 DCMI_D6 EVENTOUT PE6 TRACED3 TIM9_CH2 FSMC_A22 DCMI_D7 EVENTOUT PE7 TIM1_ETR FSMC_D4 EVENTOUT PE8 TIM1_CH1N FSMC_D5 EVENTOUT PE9 TIM1_CH1 FSMC_D6 EVENTOUT PE10 TIM1_CH2N FSMC_D7 EVENTOUT PE11 TIM1_CH2 FSMC_D8 EVENTOUT PE12 TIM1_CH3N FSMC_D9 EVENTOUT PE13 TIM1_CH3 FSMC_D10 EVENTOUT PE14 TIM1_CH4 FSMC_D11 EVENTOUT PE15 TIM1_BKIN FSMC_D12 EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description DocID022152 Rev 4 65/185 Port F PF0 I2C2_SDA FSMC_A0 EVENTOUT PF1 I2C2_SCL FSMC_A1 EVENTOUT PF2 I2C2_ SMBA FSMC_A2 EVENTOUT PF3 FSMC_A3 EVENTOUT PF4 FSMC_A4 EVENTOUT PF5 FSMC_A5 EVENTOUT PF6 TIM10_CH1 FSMC_NIORD EVENTOUT PF7 TIM11_CH1 FSMC_NREG EVENTOUT PF8 TIM13_CH1 FSMC_ NIOWR EVENTOUT PF9 TIM14_CH1 FSMC_CD EVENTOUT PF10 FSMC_INTR EVENTOUT PF11 DCMI_D12 EVENTOUT PF12 FSMC_A6 EVENTOUT PF13 FSMC_A7 EVENTOUT PF14 FSMC_A8 EVENTOUT PF15 FSMC_A9 EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 66/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Port G PG0 FSMC_A10 EVENTOUT PG1 FSMC_A11 EVENTOUT PG2 FSMC_A12 EVENTOUT PG3 FSMC_A13 EVENTOUT PG4 FSMC_A14 EVENTOUT PG5 FSMC_A15 EVENTOUT PG6 FSMC_INT2 EVENTOUT PG7 USART6_CK FSMC_INT3 EVENTOUT PG8 USART6_ RTS ETH _PPS_OUT EVENTOUT PG9 USART6_RX FSMC_NE2/ FSMC_NCE3 EVENTOUT PG10 FSMC_ NCE4_1/ FSMC_NE3 EVENTOUT PG11 ETH _MII_TX_EN ETH _RMII_ TX_EN FSMC_NCE4_ 2 EVENTOUT PG12 USART6_ RTS FSMC_NE4 EVENTOUT PG13 UART6_CTS ETH _MII_TXD0 ETH _RMII_TXD0 FSMC_A24 EVENTOUT PG14 USART6_TX ETH _MII_TXD1 ETH _RMII_TXD1 FSMC_A25 EVENTOUT PG15 USART6_ CTS DCMI_D13 EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Pinouts and pin description DocID022152 Rev 4 67/185 Port H PH0 EVENTOUT PH1 EVENTOUT PH2 ETH _MII_CRS EVENTOUT PH3 ETH _MII_COL EVENTOUT PH4 I2C2_SCL OTG_HS_ULPI_ NXT EVENTOUT PH5 I2C2_SDA EVENTOUT PH6 I2C2_SMB A TIM12_CH1 ETH _MII_RXD2 EVENTOUT PH7 I2C3_SCL ETH _MII_RXD3 EVENTOUT PH8 I2C3_SDA DCMI_HSYN C EVENTOUT PH9 I2C3_SMB A TIM12_CH2 DCMI_D0 EVENTOUT PH10 TIM5_CH1 DCMI_D1 EVENTOUT PH11 TIM5_CH2 DCMI_D2 EVENTOUT PH12 TIM5_CH3 DCMI_D3 EVENTOUT PH13 TIM8_CH1N CAN1_TX EVENTOUT PH14 TIM8_CH2N DCMI_D4 EVENTOUT PH15 TIM8_CH3N DCMI_D11 EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI Pinouts and pin description STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 68/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Port I PI0 TIM5_CH4 SPI2_NSS I2S2_WS DCMI_D13 EVENTOUT PI1 SPI2_SCK I2S2_CK DCMI_D8 EVENTOUT PI2 TIM8_CH4 SPI2_MISO I2S2ext_SD DCMI_D9 EVENTOUT PI3 TIM8_ETR SPI2_MOSI I2S2_SD DCMI_D10 EVENTOUT PI4 TIM8_BKIN DCMI_D5 EVENTOUT PI5 TIM8_CH1 DCMI_ VSYNC EVENTOUT PI6 TIM8_CH2 DCMI_D6 EVENTOUT PI7 TIM8_CH3 DCMI_D7 EVENTOUT PI8 EVENTOUT PI9 CAN1_RX EVENTOUT PI10 ETH _MII_RX_ER EVENTOUT PI11 OTG_HS_ULPI_ DIR EVENTOUT Table 9. Alternate function mapping (continued) Port AF0 AF1 AF2 AF3 AF4 AF5 AF6 AF7 AF8 AF9 AF10 AF11 AF12 AF13 AF14 AF15 SYS TIM1/2 TIM3/4/5 TIM8/9/10/1 1 I2C1/2/3 SPI1/SPI2/ I2S2/I2S2ext SPI3/I2Sext/ I2S3 USART1/2/3/ I2S3ext UART4/5/ USART6 CAN1/ CAN2/ TIM12/13/14 OTG_FS/ OTG_HS ETH FSMC/SDIO/ OTG_FS DCMI DocID022152 Rev 4 69/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Memory mapping 4 Memory mapping The memory map is shown in Figure 18. Figure 18. STM32F40x memory map 512-Mbyte block 7 Cortex-M4's internal peripherals 512-Mbyte block 6 Not used 512-Mbyte block 5 FSMC registers 512-Mbyte block 4 FSMC bank 3 & bank4 512-Mbyte block 3 FSMC bank1 & bank2 512-Mbyte block 2 Peripherals 512-Mbyte block 1 SRAM 0x0000 0000 0x1FFF FFFF 0x2000 0000 0x3FFF FFFF 0x4000 0000 0x5FFF FFFF 0x6000 0000 0x7FFF FFFF 0x8000 0000 0x9FFF FFFF 0xA000 0000 0xBFFF FFFF 0xC000 0000 0xDFFF FFFF 0xE000 0000 0xFFFF FFFF 512-Mbyte block 0 Code Flash 0x0810 0000 - 0x0FFF FFFF 0x1FFF 0000 - 0x1FFF 7A0F 0x1FFF C000 - 0x1FFF C007 0x0800 0000 - 0x080F FFFF 0x0010 0000 - 0x07FF FFFF 0x0000 0000 - 0x000F FFFF System memory + OTP Reserved Reserved Aliased to Flash, system memory or SRAM depending on the BOOT pins SRAM (16 KB aliased by bit-banding) Reserved 0x2000 0000 - 0x2001 BFFF 0x2001 C000 - 0x2001 FFFF 0x2002 0000 - 0x3FFF FFFF 0x4000 0000 Reserved 0x4000 7FFF 0x4000 7800 - 0x4000 FFFF 0x4001 0000 0x4001 57FF 0x4002 000 Reserved 0x5006 0C00 - 0x5FFF FFFF 0x6000 0000 AHB3 0xA000 0FFF 0xA000 1000 - 0xDFFF FFFF ai18513f Option Bytes Reserved 0x4001 5800 - 0x4001 FFFF 0x5006 0BFF AHB2 0x5000 0000 Reserved 0x4008 0000 - 0x4FFF FFFF AHB1 SRAM (112 KB aliased by bit-banding) Reserved 0x1FFF C008 - 0x1FFF FFFF Reserved 0x1FFF 7A10 - 0x1FFF 7FFF CCM data RAM (64 KB data SRAM) 0x1000 0000 - 0x1000 FFFF Reserved 0x1001 0000 - 0x1FFE FFFF Reserved APB2 0x4007 FFFF APB1 CORTEX-M4 internal peripherals 0xE000 0000 - 0xE00F FFFF Reserved 0xE010 0000 - 0xFFFF FFFF Memory mapping STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 70/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Table 10. STM32F40x register boundary addresses Bus Boundary address Peripheral 0xE00F FFFF - 0xFFFF FFFF Reserved Cortex-M4 0xE000 0000 - 0xE00F FFFF Cortex-M4 internal peripherals 0xA000 1000 - 0xDFFF FFFF Reserved AHB3 0xA000 0000 - 0xA000 0FFF FSMC control register 0x9000 0000 - 0x9FFF FFFF FSMC bank 4 0x8000 0000 - 0x8FFF FFFF FSMC bank 3 0x7000 0000 - 0x7FFF FFFF FSMC bank 2 0x6000 0000 - 0x6FFF FFFF FSMC bank 1 0x5006 0C00- 0x5FFF FFFF Reserved AHB2 0x5006 0800 - 0x5006 0BFF RNG 0x5005 0400 - 0x5006 07FF Reserved 0x5005 0000 - 0x5005 03FF DCMI 0x5004 0000- 0x5004 FFFF Reserved 0x5000 0000 - 0x5003 FFFF USB OTG FS 0x4008 0000- 0x4FFF FFFF Reserved DocID022152 Rev 4 71/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Memory mapping AHB1 0x4004 0000 - 0x4007 FFFF USB OTG HS 0x4002 9400 - 0x4003 FFFF Reserved 0x4002 9000 - 0x4002 93FF ETHERNET MAC 0x4002 8C00 - 0x4002 8FFF 0x4002 8800 - 0x4002 8BFF 0x4002 8400 - 0x4002 87FF 0x4002 8000 - 0x4002 83FF 0x4002 6800 - 0x4002 7FFF Reserved 0x4002 6400 - 0x4002 67FF DMA2 0x4002 6000 - 0x4002 63FF DMA1 0x4002 5000 - 0x4002 5FFF Reserved 0x4002 4000 - 0x4002 4FFF BKPSRAM 0x4002 3C00 - 0x4002 3FFF Flash interface register 0x4002 3800 - 0x4002 3BFF RCC 0x4002 3400 - 0x4002 37FF Reserved 0x4002 3000 - 0x4002 33FF CRC 0x4002 2400 - 0x4002 2FFF Reserved 0x4002 2000 - 0x4002 23FF GPIOI 0x4002 1C00 - 0x4002 1FFF GPIOH 0x4002 1800 - 0x4002 1BFF GPIOG 0x4002 1400 - 0x4002 17FF GPIOF 0x4002 1000 - 0x4002 13FF GPIOE 0x4002 0C00 - 0x4002 0FFF GPIOD 0x4002 0800 - 0x4002 0BFF GPIOC 0x4002 0400 - 0x4002 07FF GPIOB 0x4002 0000 - 0x4002 03FF GPIOA 0x4001 5800- 0x4001 FFFF Reserved Table 10. STM32F40x register boundary addresses (continued) Bus Boundary address Peripheral Memory mapping STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 72/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 APB2 0x4001 4C00 - 0x4001 57FF Reserved 0x4001 4800 - 0x4001 4BFF TIM11 0x4001 4400 - 0x4001 47FF TIM10 0x4001 4000 - 0x4001 43FF TIM9 0x4001 3C00 - 0x4001 3FFF EXTI 0x4001 3800 - 0x4001 3BFF SYSCFG 0x4001 3400 - 0x4001 37FF Reserved 0x4001 3000 - 0x4001 33FF SPI1 0x4001 2C00 - 0x4001 2FFF SDIO 0x4001 2400 - 0x4001 2BFF Reserved 0x4001 2000 - 0x4001 23FF ADC1 - ADC2 - ADC3 0x4001 1800 - 0x4001 1FFF Reserved 0x4001 1400 - 0x4001 17FF USART6 0x4001 1000 - 0x4001 13FF USART1 0x4001 0800 - 0x4001 0FFF Reserved 0x4001 0400 - 0x4001 07FF TIM8 0x4001 0000 - 0x4001 03FF TIM1 0x4000 7800- 0x4000 FFFF Reserved Table 10. STM32F40x register boundary addresses (continued) Bus Boundary address Peripheral DocID022152 Rev 4 73/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Memory mapping APB1 0x4000 7800 - 0x4000 7FFF Reserved 0x4000 7400 - 0x4000 77FF DAC 0x4000 7000 - 0x4000 73FF PWR 0x4000 6C00 - 0x4000 6FFF Reserved 0x4000 6800 - 0x4000 6BFF CAN2 0x4000 6400 - 0x4000 67FF CAN1 0x4000 6000 - 0x4000 63FF Reserved 0x4000 5C00 - 0x4000 5FFF I2C3 0x4000 5800 - 0x4000 5BFF I2C2 0x4000 5400 - 0x4000 57FF I2C1 0x4000 5000 - 0x4000 53FF UART5 0x4000 4C00 - 0x4000 4FFF UART4 0x4000 4800 - 0x4000 4BFF USART3 0x4000 4400 - 0x4000 47FF USART2 0x4000 4000 - 0x4000 43FF I2S3ext 0x4000 3C00 - 0x4000 3FFF SPI3 / I2S3 0x4000 3800 - 0x4000 3BFF SPI2 / I2S2 0x4000 3400 - 0x4000 37FF I2S2ext 0x4000 3000 - 0x4000 33FF IWDG 0x4000 2C00 - 0x4000 2FFF WWDG 0x4000 2800 - 0x4000 2BFF RTC & BKP Registers 0x4000 2400 - 0x4000 27FF Reserved 0x4000 2000 - 0x4000 23FF TIM14 0x4000 1C00 - 0x4000 1FFF TIM13 0x4000 1800 - 0x4000 1BFF TIM12 0x4000 1400 - 0x4000 17FF TIM7 0x4000 1000 - 0x4000 13FF TIM6 0x4000 0C00 - 0x4000 0FFF TIM5 0x4000 0800 - 0x4000 0BFF TIM4 0x4000 0400 - 0x4000 07FF TIM3 0x4000 0000 - 0x4000 03FF TIM2 Table 10. STM32F40x register boundary addresses (continued) Bus Boundary address Peripheral Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 74/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5 Electrical characteristics 5.1 Parameter conditions Unless otherwise specified, all voltages are referenced to VSS. 5.1.1 Minimum and maximum values Unless otherwise specified the minimum and maximum values are guaranteed in the worst conditions of ambient temperature, supply voltage and frequencies by tests in production on 100% of the devices with an ambient temperature at TA = 25 °C and TA = TAmax (given by the selected temperature range). Data based on characterization results, design simulation and/or technology characteristics are indicated in the table footnotes and are not tested in production. Based on characterization, the minimum and maximum values refer to sample tests and represent the mean value plus or minus three times the standard deviation (mean±3Σ). 5.1.2 Typical values Unless otherwise specified, typical data are based on TA = 25 °C, VDD = 3.3 V (for the 1.8 V ≤ VDD ≤ 3.6 V voltage range). They are given only as design guidelines and are not tested. Typical ADC accuracy values are determined by characterization of a batch of samples from a standard diffusion lot over the full temperature range, where 95% of the devices have an error less than or equal to the value indicated (mean±2Σ). 5.1.3 Typical curves Unless otherwise specified, all typical curves are given only as design guidelines and are not tested. 5.1.4 Loading capacitor The loading conditions used for pin parameter measurement are shown in Figure 19. 5.1.5 Pin input voltage The input voltage measurement on a pin of the device is described in Figure 20. Figure 19. Pin loading conditions Figure 20. Pin input voltage MS19011V1 C = 50 pF STM32F pin OSC_OUT (Hi-Z when using HSE or LSE) MS19010V1 STM32F pin VIN OSC_OUT (Hi-Z when using HSE or LSE) DocID022152 Rev 4 75/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics 5.1.6 Power supply scheme Figure 21. Power supply scheme 1. Each power supply pair must be decoupled with filtering ceramic capacitors as shown above. These capacitors must be placed as close as possible to, or below, the appropriate pins on the underside of the PCB to ensure the good functionality of the device. 2. To connect BYPASS_REG and PDR_ON pins, refer to Section 2.2.16: Voltage regulator and Table 2.2.15: Power supply supervisor. 3. The two 2.2 μF ceramic capacitors should be replaced by two 100 nF decoupling capacitors when the voltage regulator is OFF. 4. The 4.7 μF ceramic capacitor must be connected to one of the VDD pin. 5. VDDA=VDD and VSSA=VSS. MS19911V2 Backup circuitry (OSC32K,RTC, Wakeup logic Backup registers, backup RAM) Kernel logic (CPU, digital & RAM) Analog: RCs, PLL,.. Power switch VBAT GPIOs OUT IN 15 × 100 nF + 1 × 4.7 μF VBAT = 1.65 to 3.6V Voltage regulator VDDA ADC Level shifter IO Logic VDD 100 nF + 1 μF Flash memory VCAP_1 2 × 2.2 μF VCAP_2 BYPASS_REG PDR_ON Reset controller VDD 1/2/...14/15 VSS 1/2/...14/15 VDD VREF+ VREFVSSA VREF 100 nF + 1 μF Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 76/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.1.7 Current consumption measurement Figure 22. Current consumption measurement scheme 5.2 Absolute maximum ratings Stresses above the absolute maximum ratings listed in Table 11: Voltage characteristics, Table 12: Current characteristics, and Table 13: Thermal characteristics may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only and functional operation of the device at these conditions is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. ai14126 VBAT VDD VDDA IDD_VBAT IDD Table 11. Voltage characteristics Symbol Ratings Min Max Unit VDD–VSS External main supply voltage (including VDDA, VDD)(1) 1. All main power (VDD, VDDA) and ground (VSS, VSSA) pins must always be connected to the external power supply, in the permitted range. –0.3 4.0 V VIN Input voltage on five-volt tolerant pin(2) 2. VIN maximum value must always be respected. Refer to Table 12 for the values of the maximum allowed injected current. VSS–0.3 VDD+4 Input voltage on any other pin VSS–0.3 4.0 |ΔVDDx| Variations between different VDD power pins - 50 mV |VSSX − VSS| Variations between all the different ground pins - 50 VESD(HBM) Electrostatic discharge voltage (human body model) see Section 5.3.14: Absolute maximum ratings (electrical sensitivity) DocID022152 Rev 4 77/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics 5.3 Operating conditions 5.3.1 General operating conditions Table 12. Current characteristics Symbol Ratings Max. Unit IVDD Total current into VDD power lines (source)(1) 1. All main power (VDD, VDDA) and ground (VSS, VSSA) pins must always be connected to the external power supply, in the permitted range. 150 mA IVSS Total current out of VSS ground lines (sink)(1) 150 IIO Output current sunk by any I/O and control pin 25 Output current source by any I/Os and control pin 25 IINJ(PIN) (2) 2. Negative injection disturbs the analog performance of the device. See note in Section 5.3.20: 12-bit ADC characteristics. Injected current on five-volt tolerant I/O(3) 3. Positive injection is not possible on these I/Os. A negative injection is induced by VINVDD while a negative injection is induced by VIN 25 MHz. 4. When the ADC is ON (ADON bit set in the ADC_CR2 register), add an additional power consumption of 1.6 mA per ADC for the analog part. 5. When analog peripheral blocks such as ADCs, DACs, HSE, LSE, HSI, or LSI are ON, an additional power consumption should be considered. 6. In this case HCLK = system clock/2. Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 84/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Table 21. Typical and maximum current consumption in Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash memory (ART accelerator disabled) Symbol Parameter Conditions fHCLK Typ Max(1) Unit TA = 25 °C TA = 85 °C TA = 105 °C IDD Supply current in Run mode External clock(2), all peripherals enabled(3)(4) 168 MHz 93 109 117 mA 144 MHz 76 89 96 120 MHz 67 79 86 90 MHz 53 65 73 60 MHz 37 49 56 30 MHz 20 32 39 25 MHz 16 27 35 16 MHz 11 23 30 8 MHz 6 18 25 4 MHz 4 16 23 2 MHz 3 15 22 External clock(2), all peripherals disabled(3)(4) 168 MHz 46 61 69 144 MHz 40 52 60 120 MHz 37 48 56 90 MHz 30 42 50 60 MHz 22 33 41 30 MHz 12 24 31 25 MHz 10 21 29 16 MHz 7 19 26 8 MHz 4 16 23 4 MHz 3 15 22 2 MHz 2 14 21 1. Based on characterization, tested in production at VDD max and fHCLK max with peripherals enabled. 2. External clock is 4 MHz and PLL is on when fHCLK > 25 MHz. 3. When analog peripheral blocks such as (ADCs, DACs, HSE, LSE, HSI,LSI) are on, an additional power consumption should be considered. 4. When the ADC is ON (ADON bit set in the ADC_CR2 register), add an additional power consumption of 1.6 mA per ADC for the analog part. DocID022152 Rev 4 85/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 24. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator ON) or RAM, and peripherals OFF Figure 25. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator ON) or RAM, and peripherals ON MS19974V1 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180 IDD RUN( mA) CPU Frequency (MHz -45 °C 0 °C 25 °C 55 °C 85 °C 105 °C MS19975V1 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180 IDD RUN( mA) CPU Frequency (MHz -45°C 0°C 25°C 55°C 85°C 105°C Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 86/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 26. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator OFF) or RAM, and peripherals OFF Figure 27. Typical current consumption versus temperature, Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash (ART accelerator OFF) or RAM, and peripherals ON MS19976V1 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180 IDD RUN( mA) CPU Frequency (MHz -45°C 0°C 25°C 55°C 85°C 105°C MS19977V1 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180 IDD RUN( mA) CPU Frequency (MHz -45°C 0°C 25°C 55°C 85°C 105°C DocID022152 Rev 4 87/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Table 22. Typical and maximum current consumption in Sleep mode Symbol Parameter Conditions fHCLK Typ Max(1) T Unit A = 25 °C TA = 85 °C TA = 105 °C IDD Supply current in Sleep mode External clock(2), all peripherals enabled(3) 168 MHz 59 77 84 mA 144 MHz 46 61 67 120 MHz 38 53 60 90 MHz 30 44 51 60 MHz 20 34 41 30 MHz 11 24 31 25 MHz 8 21 28 16 MHz 6 18 25 8 MHz 3 16 23 4 MHz 2 15 22 2 MHz 2 14 21 External clock(2), all peripherals disabled 168 MHz 12 27 35 144 MHz 9 22 29 120 MHz 8 20 28 90 MHz 7 19 26 60 MHz 5 17 24 30 MHz 3 16 23 25 MHz 2 15 22 16 MHz 2 14 21 8 MHz 1 14 21 4 MHz 1 13 21 2 MHz 1 13 21 1. Based on characterization, tested in production at VDD max and fHCLK max with peripherals enabled. 2. External clock is 4 MHz and PLL is on when fHCLK > 25 MHz. 3. Add an additional power consumption of 1.6 mA per ADC for the analog part. In applications, this consumption occurs only while the ADC is ON (ADON bit is set in the ADC_CR2 register). Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 88/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Table 23. Typical and maximum current consumptions in Stop mode Symbol Parameter Conditions Typ Max T Unit A = 25 °C TA = 25 °C TA = 85 °C TA = 105 °C IDD_STOP Supply current in Stop mode with main regulator in Run mode Flash in Stop mode, low-speed and highspeed internal RC oscillators and high-speed oscillator OFF (no independent watchdog) 0.45 1.5 11.00 20.00 mA Flash in Deep power down mode, low-speed and high-speed internal RC oscillators and high-speed oscillator OFF (no independent watchdog) 0.40 1.5 11.00 20.00 Supply current in Stop mode with main regulator in Low Power mode Flash in Stop mode, low-speed and highspeed internal RC oscillators and high-speed oscillator OFF (no independent watchdog) 0.31 1.1 8.00 15.00 Flash in Deep power down mode, low-speed and high-speed internal RC oscillators and high-speed oscillator OFF (no independent watchdog) 0.28 1.1 8.00 15.00 Table 24. Typical and maximum current consumptions in Standby mode Symbol Parameter Conditions Typ Max(1) TA = 25 °C Unit TA = 85 °C TA = 105 °C VDD = 1.8 V VDD= 2.4 V VDD = 3.3 V VDD = 3.6 V IDD_STBY Supply current in Standby mode Backup SRAM ON, lowspeed oscillator and RTC ON 3.0 3.4 4.0 20 36 μA Backup SRAM OFF, lowspeed oscillator and RTC ON 2.4 2.7 3.3 16 32 Backup SRAM ON, RTC OFF 2.4 2.6 3.0 12.5 24.8 Backup SRAM OFF, RTC OFF 1.7 1.9 2.2 9.8 19.2 1. Based on characterization, not tested in production. DocID022152 Rev 4 89/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 28. Typical VBAT current consumption (LSE and RTC ON/backup RAM OFF) Table 25. Typical and maximum current consumptions in VBAT mode Symbol Parameter Conditions Typ Max(1) Unit TA = 25 °C TA = 85 °C TA = 105 °C VBAT = 1.8 V VBAT= 2.4 V VBAT = 3.3 V VBAT = 3.6 V IDD_VBA T Backup domain supply current Backup SRAM ON, low-speed oscillator and RTC ON 1.29 1.42 1.68 6 11 μA Backup SRAM OFF, low-speed oscillator and RTC ON 0.62 0.73 0.96 3 5 Backup SRAM ON, RTC OFF 0.79 0.81 0.86 5 10 Backup SRAM OFF, RTC OFF 0.10 0.10 0.10 2 4 1. Based on characterization, not tested in production. MS19990V1 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 IVBAT in (μA) Temperature in (°C) 1.65V 1.8V 2V 2.4V 2.7V 3V 3.3V 3.6V Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 90/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 29. Typical VBAT current consumption (LSE and RTC ON/backup RAM ON) I/O system current consumption The current consumption of the I/O system has two components: static and dynamic. I/O static current consumption All the I/Os used as inputs with pull-up generate current consumption when the pin is externally held low. The value of this current consumption can be simply computed by using the pull-up/pull-down resistors values given in Table 47: I/O static characteristics. For the output pins, any external pull-down or external load must also be considered to estimate the current consumption. Additional I/O current consumption is due to I/Os configured as inputs if an intermediate voltage level is externally applied. This current consumption is caused by the input Schmitt trigger circuits used to discriminate the input value. Unless this specific configuration is required by the application, this supply current consumption can be avoided by configuring these I/Os in analog mode. This is notably the case of ADC input pins which should be configured as analog inputs. Caution: Any floating input pin can also settle to an intermediate voltage level or switch inadvertently, as a result of external electromagnetic noise. To avoid current consumption related to floating pins, they must either be configured in analog mode, or forced internally to a definite digital value. This can be done either by using pull-up/down resistors or by configuring the pins in output mode. I/O dynamic current consumption In addition to the internal peripheral current consumption measured previously (see Table 27: Peripheral current consumption), the I/Os used by an application also contribute to the current consumption. When an I/O pin switches, it uses the current from the MCU MS19991V1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 IVBAT in (μA) Temperature in (°C) 1.65V 1.8V 2V 2.4V 2.7V 3V 3.3V 3.6V DocID022152 Rev 4 91/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics supply voltage to supply the I/O pin circuitry and to charge/discharge the capacitive load (internal or external) connected to the pin: where ISW is the current sunk by a switching I/O to charge/discharge the capacitive load VDD is the MCU supply voltage fSW is the I/O switching frequency C is the total capacitance seen by the I/O pin: C = CINT+ CEXT The test pin is configured in push-pull output mode and is toggled by software at a fixed frequency. ISW = VDD × fSW × C Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 92/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Table 26. Switching output I/O current consumption Symbol Parameter Conditions(1) I/O toggling frequency (fSW) Typ Unit IDDIO I/O switching current VDD = 3.3 V(2) C = CINT 2 MHz 0.02 mA 8 MHz 0.14 25 MHz 0.51 50 MHz 0.86 60 MHz 1.30 VDD = 3.3 V CEXT = 0 pF C = CINT + CEXT+ CS 2 MHz 0.10 8 MHz 0.38 25 MHz 1.18 50 MHz 2.47 60 MHz 2.86 VDD = 3.3 V CEXT = 10 pF C = CINT + CEXT+ CS 2 MHz 0.17 8 MHz 0.66 25 MHz 1.70 50 MHz 2.65 60 MHz 3.48 VDD = 3.3 V CEXT = 22 pF C = CINT + CEXT+ CS 2 MHz 0.23 8 MHz 0.95 25 MHz 3.20 50 MHz 4.69 60 MHz 8.06 VDD = 3.3 V CEXT = 33 pF C = CINT + CEXT+ CS 2 MHz 0.30 8 MHz 1.22 25 MHz 3.90 50 MHz 8.82 60 MHz -(3) 1. CS is the PCB board capacitance including the pad pin. CS = 7 pF (estimated value). 2. This test is performed by cutting the LQFP package pin (pad removal). 3. At 60 MHz, C maximum load is specified 30 pF. DocID022152 Rev 4 93/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics On-chip peripheral current consumption The current consumption of the on-chip peripherals is given in Table 27. The MCU is placed under the following conditions: • At startup, all I/O pins are configured as analog pins by firmware. • All peripherals are disabled unless otherwise mentioned • The code is running from Flash memory and the Flash memory access time is equal to 5 wait states at 168 MHz. • The code is running from Flash memory and the Flash memory access time is equal to 4 wait states at 144 MHz, and the power scale mode is set to 2. • ART accelerator and Cache off. • The given value is calculated by measuring the difference of current consumption – with all peripherals clocked off – with one peripheral clocked on (with only the clock applied) • When the peripherals are enabled: HCLK is the system clock, fPCLK1 = fHCLK/4, and fPCLK2 = fHCLK/2. • The typical values are obtained for VDD = 3.3 V and TA= 25 °C, unless otherwise specified. Table 27. Peripheral current consumption Peripheral(1) 168 MHz 144 MHz Unit AHB1 GPIO A 0.49 0.36 mA GPIO B 0.45 0.33 GPIO C 0.45 0.34 GPIO D 0.45 0.34 GPIO E 0.47 0.35 GPIO F 0.45 0.33 GPIO G 0.44 0.33 GPIO H 0.45 0.34 GPIO I 0.44 0.33 OTG_HS + ULPI 4.57 3.55 CRC 0.07 0.06 BKPSRAM 0.11 0.08 DMA1 6.15 4.75 DMA2 6.24 4.8 ETH_MAC + ETH_MAC_TX ETH_MAC_RX ETH_MAC_PTP 3.28 2.54 AHB2 OTG_FS 4.59 3.69 mA DCMI 1.04 0.80 Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 94/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 AHB3 FSMC 2.18 1.67 mA APB1 TIM2 0.80 0.61 TIM3 0.58 0.44 TIM4 0.62 0.48 TIM5 0.79 0.61 TIM6 0.15 0.11 TIM7 0.16 0.12 TIM12 0.33 0.26 TIM13 0.27 0.21 TIM14 0.27 0.21 PWR 0.04 0.03 USART2 0.17 0.13 USART3 0.17 0.13 UART4 0.17 0.13 UART5 0.17 0.13 I2C1 0.17 0.13 I2C2 0.18 0.13 I2C3 0.18 0.13 SPI2/I2S2(2) 0.17/0.16 0.13/0.12 SPI3/I2S3(2) 0.16/0.14 0.12/0.12 CAN1 0.27 0.21 CAN2 0.26 0.20 DAC 0.14 0.10 DAC channel 1(3) 0.91 0.89 DAC channel 2(4) 0.91 0.89 DAC channel 1 and 2(3)(4) 1.69 1.68 WWDG 0.04 0.04 Table 27. Peripheral current consumption (continued) Peripheral(1) 168 MHz 144 MHz Unit DocID022152 Rev 4 95/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics 5.3.7 Wakeup time from low-power mode The wakeup times given in Table 28 is measured on a wakeup phase with a 16 MHz HSI RC oscillator. The clock source used to wake up the device depends from the current operating mode: • Stop or Standby mode: the clock source is the RC oscillator • Sleep mode: the clock source is the clock that was set before entering Sleep mode. All timings are derived from tests performed under ambient temperature and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. APB2 SDIO 0.64 0.54 mA TIM1 1.47 1.14 TIM8 1.58 1.22 TIM9 0.68 0.54 TIM10 0.45 0.36 TIM11 0.47 0.38 ADC1(5) 2.20 2.10 ADC2(5) 2.04 1.93 ADC3(5) 2.10 2.00 SPI1 0.14 0.12 USART1 0.34 0.27 USART6 0.34 0.28 1. HSE oscillator with 4 MHz crystal and PLL are ON. 2. I2SMOD bit set in SPI_I2SCFGR register, and then the I2SE bit set to enable I2S peripheral. 3. EN1 bit is set in DAC_CR register. 4. EN2 bit is set in DAC_CR register. 5. ADON bit set in ADC_CR2 register. Table 27. Peripheral current consumption (continued) Peripheral(1) 168 MHz 144 MHz Unit Table 28. Low-power mode wakeup timings Symbol Parameter Min(1) Typ(1) Max(1) Unit tWUSLEEP (2) Wakeup from Sleep mode - 1 - μs tWUSTOP (2) Wakeup from Stop mode (regulator in Run mode) - 13 - Wakeup from Stop mode (regulator in low power mode) - 17 40 μs Wakeup from Stop mode (regulator in low power mode and Flash memory in Deep power down mode) - 110 - tWUSTDBY (2)(3) Wakeup from Standby mode 260 375 480 μs 1. Based on characterization, not tested in production. 2. The wakeup times are measured from the wakeup event to the point in which the application code reads the first instruction. 3. tWUSTDBY minimum and maximum values are given at 105 °C and –45 °C, respectively. Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 96/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.8 External clock source characteristics High-speed external user clock generated from an external source The characteristics given in Table 29 result from tests performed using an high-speed external clock source, and under ambient temperature and supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. Low-speed external user clock generated from an external source The characteristics given in Table 30 result from tests performed using an low-speed external clock source, and under ambient temperature and supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. Table 29. High-speed external user clock characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fHSE_ext External user clock source frequency(1) 1 - 50 MHz VHSEH OSC_IN input pin high level voltage 0.7VDD - VDD V VHSEL OSC_IN input pin low level voltage VSS - 0.3VDD tw(HSE) tw(HSE) OSC_IN high or low time(1) 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 5 - - ns tr(HSE) tf(HSE) OSC_IN rise or fall time(1) - - 10 Cin(HSE) OSC_IN input capacitance(1) - 5 - pF DuCy(HSE) Duty cycle 45 - 55 % IL OSC_IN Input leakage current VSS ≤ VIN ≤ VDD - - ±1 μA Table 30. Low-speed external user clock characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fLSE_ext User External clock source frequency(1) - 32.768 1000 kHz VLSEH OSC32_IN input pin high level voltage 0.7VDD - VDD V VLSEL OSC32_IN input pin low level voltage VSS - 0.3VDD tw(LSE) tf(LSE) OSC32_IN high or low time(1) 450 - - ns tr(LSE) tf(LSE) OSC32_IN rise or fall time(1) - - 50 Cin(LSE) OSC32_IN input capacitance(1) - 5 - pF DuCy(LSE) Duty cycle 30 - 70 % IL OSC32_IN Input leakage current VSS ≤ VIN ≤ VDD - - ±1 μA 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. DocID022152 Rev 4 97/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 30. High-speed external clock source AC timing diagram Figure 31. Low-speed external clock source AC timing diagram High-speed external clock generated from a crystal/ceramic resonator The high-speed external (HSE) clock can be supplied with a 4 to 26 MHz crystal/ceramic resonator oscillator. All the information given in this paragraph are based on characterization results obtained with typical external components specified in Table 31. In the application, the resonator and the load capacitors have to be placed as close as possible to the oscillator pins in order to minimize output distortion and startup stabilization time. Refer to the crystal resonator manufacturer for more details on the resonator characteristics (frequency, package, accuracy). ai17528 OSC_IN External STM32F clock source VHSEH tf(HSE) tW(HSE) IL 90% 10% THSE tr(HSE) tW(HSE) t fHSE_ext VHSEL ai17529 External OSC32_IN STM32F clock source VLSEH tf(LSE) tW(LSE) IL 90% 10% TLSE tr(LSE) tW(LSE) t fLSE_ext VLSEL Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 98/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 For CL1 and CL2, it is recommended to use high-quality external ceramic capacitors in the 5 pF to 25 pF range (typ.), designed for high-frequency applications, and selected to match the requirements of the crystal or resonator (see Figure 32). CL1 and CL2 are usually the same size. The crystal manufacturer typically specifies a load capacitance which is the series combination of CL1 and CL2. PCB and MCU pin capacitance must be included (10 pF can be used as a rough estimate of the combined pin and board capacitance) when sizing CL1 and CL2. Note: For information on electing the crystal, refer to the application note AN2867 “Oscillator design guide for ST microcontrollers” available from the ST website www.st.com. Figure 32. Typical application with an 8 MHz crystal 1. REXT value depends on the crystal characteristics. Low-speed external clock generated from a crystal/ceramic resonator The low-speed external (LSE) clock can be supplied with a 32.768 kHz crystal/ceramic resonator oscillator. All the information given in this paragraph are based on characterization results obtained with typical external components specified in Table 32. In the application, the resonator and the load capacitors have to be placed as close as possible to the oscillator pins in order to minimize output distortion and startup stabilization time. Refer to the crystal resonator manufacturer for more details on the resonator characteristics (frequency, package, accuracy). Table 31. HSE 4-26 MHz oscillator characteristics(1) (2) 1. Resonator characteristics given by the crystal/ceramic resonator manufacturer. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fOSC_IN Oscillator frequency 4 - 26 MHz RF Feedback resistor - 200 - kΩ IDD HSE current consumption VDD=3.3 V, ESR= 30 Ω, CL=5 pF@25 MHz - 449 - μA VDD=3.3 V, ESR= 30 Ω, CL=10 pF@25 MHz - 532 - gm Oscillator transconductance Startup 5 - - mA/V tSU(HSE (3) 3. tSU(HSE) is the startup time measured from the moment it is enabled (by software) to a stabilized 8 MHz oscillation is reached. This value is measured for a standard crystal resonator and it can vary significantly with the crystal manufacturer Startup time VDD is stabilized - 2 - ms ai17530 OSC_OUT OSC_IN fHSE CL1 RF STM32F 8 MHz resonator Resonator with integrated capacitors Bias controlled gain CL2 REXT(1) DocID022152 Rev 4 99/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Note: For information on electing the crystal, refer to the application note AN2867 “Oscillator design guide for ST microcontrollers” available from the ST website www.st.com. Figure 33. Typical application with a 32.768 kHz crystal 5.3.9 Internal clock source characteristics The parameters given in Table 33 and Table 34 are derived from tests performed under ambient temperature and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. High-speed internal (HSI) RC oscillator Table 32. LSE oscillator characteristics (fLSE = 32.768 kHz) (1) 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit RF Feedback resistor - 18.4 - MΩ IDD LSE current consumption - - 1 μA gm Oscillator Transconductance 2.8 - - μA/V tSU(LSE) (2) 2. tSU(LSE) is the startup time measured from the moment it is enabled (by software) to a stabilized 32.768 kHz oscillation is reached. This value is measured for a standard crystal resonator and it can vary significantly with the crystal manufacturer startup time VDD is stabilized - 2 - s ai17531 OSC32_OUT OSC32_IN fLSE CL1 RF STM32F 32.768 kHz resonator Resonator with integrated capacitors Bias controlled gain CL2 Table 33. HSI oscillator characteristics (1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fHSI Frequency - 16 - MHz ACCHSI Accuracy of the HSI oscillator User-trimmed with the RCC_CR register - - 1 % Factorycalibrated TA = –40 to 105 °C(2) –8 - 4.5 % TA = –10 to 85 °C(2) –4 - 4 % TA = 25 °C –1 - 1 % tsu(HSI) (3) HSI oscillator startup time - 2.2 4 μs IDD(HSI) HSI oscillator power consumption - 60 80 μA Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 100/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Low-speed internal (LSI) RC oscillator Figure 34. ACCLSI versus temperature 5.3.10 PLL characteristics The parameters given in Table 35 and Table 36 are derived from tests performed under temperature and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. 1. VDD = 3.3 V, TA = –40 to 105 °C unless otherwise specified. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. 3. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. Table 34. LSI oscillator characteristics (1) 1. VDD = 3 V, TA = –40 to 105 °C unless otherwise specified. Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit fLSI (2) 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Frequency 17 32 47 kHz tsu(LSI) (3) 3. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. LSI oscillator startup time - 15 40 μs IDD(LSI) (3) LSI oscillator power consumption - 0.4 0.6 μA MS19013V1 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 -45 -35 -25 -15 -5 5 15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 105 Normalized deviati on (%) Temperature (°C) max avg min DocID022152 Rev 4 101/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Table 35. Main PLL characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fPLL_IN PLL input clock(1) 0.95(2) 1 2.10 MHz fPLL_OUT PLL multiplier output clock 24 - 168 MHz fPLL48_OUT 48 MHz PLL multiplier output clock - 48 75 MHz fVCO_OUT PLL VCO output 192 - 432 MHz tLOCK PLL lock time VCO freq = 192 MHz 75 - 200 μs VCO freq = 432 MHz 100 - 300 Jitter(3) Cycle-to-cycle jitter System clock 120 MHz RMS - 25 - ps peak to peak - ±150 - Period Jitter RMS - 15 - peak to peak - ±200 - Main clock output (MCO) for RMII Ethernet Cycle to cycle at 50 MHz on 1000 samples - 32 - Main clock output (MCO) for MII Ethernet Cycle to cycle at 25 MHz on 1000 samples - 40 - Bit Time CAN jitter Cycle to cycle at 1 MHz on 1000 samples - 330 - IDD(PLL) (4) PLL power consumption on VDD VCO freq = 192 MHz VCO freq = 432 MHz 0.15 0.45 - 0.40 0.75 mA IDDA(PLL) (4) PLL power consumption on VDDA VCO freq = 192 MHz VCO freq = 432 MHz 0.30 0.55 - 0.40 0.85 mA 1. Take care of using the appropriate division factor M to obtain the specified PLL input clock values. The M factor is shared between PLL and PLLI2S. 2. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 3. The use of 2 PLLs in parallel could degraded the Jitter up to +30%. 4. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 36. PLLI2S (audio PLL) characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fPLLI2S_IN PLLI2S input clock(1) 0.95(2) 1 2.10 MHz fPLLI2S_OUT PLLI2S multiplier output clock - - 216 MHz fVCO_OUT PLLI2S VCO output 192 - 432 MHz tLOCK PLLI2S lock time VCO freq = 192 MHz 75 - 200 μs VCO freq = 432 MHz 100 - 300 Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 102/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.11 PLL spread spectrum clock generation (SSCG) characteristics The spread spectrum clock generation (SSCG) feature allows to reduce electromagnetic interferences (see Table 43: EMI characteristics). It is available only on the main PLL. Equation 1 The frequency modulation period (MODEPER) is given by the equation below: fPLL_IN and fMod must be expressed in Hz. As an example: If fPLL_IN = 1 MHz, and fMOD = 1 kHz, the modulation depth (MODEPER) is given by equation 1: Jitter(3) Master I2S clock jitter Cycle to cycle at 12.288 MHz on 48KHz period, N=432, R=5 RMS - 90 - peak to peak - ±280 - ps Average frequency of 12.288 MHz N = 432, R = 5 on 1000 samples - 90 - ps WS I2S clock jitter Cycle to cycle at 48 KHz on 1000 samples - 400 - ps IDD(PLLI2S) (4) PLLI2S power consumption on VDD VCO freq = 192 MHz VCO freq = 432 MHz 0.15 0.45 - 0.40 0.75 mA IDDA(PLLI2S) (4) PLLI2S power consumption on VDDA VCO freq = 192 MHz VCO freq = 432 MHz 0.30 0.55 - 0.40 0.85 mA 1. Take care of using the appropriate division factor M to have the specified PLL input clock values. 2. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 3. Value given with main PLL running. 4. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 36. PLLI2S (audio PLL) characteristics (continued) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit Table 37. SSCG parameters constraint Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max(1) Unit fMod Modulation frequency - - 10 KHz md Peak modulation depth 0.25 - 2 % MODEPER * INCSTEP - - 215−1 - 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. MODEPER = round[fPLL_IN ⁄ (4 × fMod)] MODEPER round 106 4 10 3 = [ ⁄ ( × )] = 250 DocID022152 Rev 4 103/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Equation 2 Equation 2 allows to calculate the increment step (INCSTEP): fVCO_OUT must be expressed in MHz. With a modulation depth (md) = ±2 % (4 % peak to peak), and PLLN = 240 (in MHz): An amplitude quantization error may be generated because the linear modulation profile is obtained by taking the quantized values (rounded to the nearest integer) of MODPER and INCSTEP. As a result, the achieved modulation depth is quantized. The percentage quantized modulation depth is given by the following formula: As a result: Figure 35 and Figure 36 show the main PLL output clock waveforms in center spread and down spread modes, where: F0 is fPLL_OUT nominal. Tmode is the modulation period. md is the modulation depth. Figure 35. PLL output clock waveforms in center spread mode INCSTEP = round[((215 – 1) × md × PLLN) ⁄ (100 × 5 × MODEPER)] INCSTEP = round[((215 – 1) × 2 × 240) ⁄ (100 × 5 × 250)] = 126md(quantitazed)% mdquantized% = (MODEPER × INCSTEP × 100 × 5) ⁄ ((215 – 1) × PLLN) mdquantized% = (250 × 126 × 100 × 5) ⁄ ((215 – 1) × 240) = 2.002%(peak) Frequency (PLL_OUT) Time F0 tmode md ai17291 md 2 x tmode Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 104/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 36. PLL output clock waveforms in down spread mode 5.3.12 Memory characteristics Flash memory The characteristics are given at TA = –40 to 105 °C unless otherwise specified. The devices are shipped to customers with the Flash memory erased. Time ai17292 Frequency (PLL_OUT) F0 2 x md tmode 2 x tmode Table 38. Flash memory characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit IDD Supply current Write / Erase 8-bit mode, VDD = 1.8 V - 5 - Write / Erase 16-bit mode, VDD = 2.1 V - 8 - mA Write / Erase 32-bit mode, VDD = 3.3 V - 12 - Table 39. Flash memory programming Symbol Parameter Conditions Min(1) Typ Max(1) Unit tprog Word programming time Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 8/16/32 - 16 100(2) μs tERASE16KB Sector (16 KB) erase time Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 8 - 400 800 Program/erase parallelism ms (PSIZE) = x 16 - 300 600 Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 32 - 250 500 DocID022152 Rev 4 105/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics tERASE64KB Sector (64 KB) erase time Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 8 - 1200 2400 Program/erase parallelism ms (PSIZE) = x 16 - 700 1400 Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 32 - 550 1100 tERASE128KB Sector (128 KB) erase time Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 8 - 2 4 Program/erase parallelism s (PSIZE) = x 16 - 1.3 2.6 Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 32 - 1 2 tME Mass erase time Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 8 - 16 32 Program/erase parallelism s (PSIZE) = x 16 - 11 22 Program/erase parallelism (PSIZE) = x 32 - 8 16 Vprog Programming voltage 32-bit program operation 2.7 - 3.6 V 16-bit program operation 2.1 - 3.6 V 8-bit program operation 1.8 - 3.6 V 1. Based on characterization, not tested in production. 2. The maximum programming time is measured after 100K erase operations. Table 39. Flash memory programming (continued) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min(1) Typ Max(1) Unit Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 106/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.13 EMC characteristics Susceptibility tests are performed on a sample basis during device characterization. Functional EMS (electromagnetic susceptibility) While a simple application is executed on the device (toggling 2 LEDs through I/O ports). the device is stressed by two electromagnetic events until a failure occurs. The failure is indicated by the LEDs: • Electrostatic discharge (ESD) (positive and negative) is applied to all device pins until a functional disturbance occurs. This test is compliant with the IEC 61000-4-2 standard. • FTB: A burst of fast transient voltage (positive and negative) is applied to VDD and VSS through a 100 pF capacitor, until a functional disturbance occurs. This test is compliant with the IEC 61000-4-4 standard. Table 40. Flash memory programming with VPP Symbol Parameter Conditions Min(1) Typ Max(1) 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. Unit tprog Double word programming TA = 0 to +40 °C VDD = 3.3 V VPP = 8.5 V - 16 100(2) 2. The maximum programming time is measured after 100K erase operations. μs tERASE16KB Sector (16 KB) erase time - 230 - tERASE64KB Sector (64 KB) erase time - 490 - ms tERASE128KB Sector (128 KB) erase time - 875 - tME Mass erase time - 6.9 - s Vprog Programming voltage 2.7 - 3.6 V VPP VPP voltage range 7 - 9 V IPP Minimum current sunk on the VPP pin 10 - - mA tVPP (3) 3. VPP should only be connected during programming/erasing. Cumulative time during which VPP is applied - - 1 hour Table 41. Flash memory endurance and data retention Symbol Parameter Conditions Value Unit Min(1) 1. Based on characterization, not tested in production. NEND Endurance TA = –40 to +85 °C (6 suffix versions) TA = –40 to +105 °C (7 suffix versions) 10 kcycles tRET Data retention 1 kcycle(2) at TA = 85 °C 2. Cycling performed over the whole temperature range. 30 1 kcycle(2) at TA = 105 °C 10 Years 10 kcycles(2) at TA = 55 °C 20 DocID022152 Rev 4 107/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics A device reset allows normal operations to be resumed. The test results are given in Table 42. They are based on the EMS levels and classes defined in application note AN1709. Designing hardened software to avoid noise problems EMC characterization and optimization are performed at component level with a typical application environment and simplified MCU software. It should be noted that good EMC performance is highly dependent on the user application and the software in particular. Therefore it is recommended that the user applies EMC software optimization and prequalification tests in relation with the EMC level requested for his application. Software recommendations The software flowchart must include the management of runaway conditions such as: • Corrupted program counter • Unexpected reset • Critical Data corruption (control registers...) Prequalification trials Most of the common failures (unexpected reset and program counter corruption) can be reproduced by manually forcing a low state on the NRST pin or the Oscillator pins for 1 second. To complete these trials, ESD stress can be applied directly on the device, over the range of specification values. When unexpected behavior is detected, the software can be hardened to prevent unrecoverable errors occurring (see application note AN1015). Electromagnetic Interference (EMI) The electromagnetic field emitted by the device are monitored while a simple application, executing EEMBC? code, is running. This emission test is compliant with SAE IEC61967-2 standard which specifies the test board and the pin loading. Table 42. EMS characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Level/ Class VFESD Voltage limits to be applied on any I/O pin to induce a functional disturbance VDD = 3.3 V, LQFP176, TA = +25 °C, fHCLK = 168 MHz, conforms to IEC 61000-4-2 2B VEFTB Fast transient voltage burst limits to be applied through 100 pF on VDD and VSS pins to induce a functional disturbance VDD = 3.3 V, LQFP176, TA = +25 °C, fHCLK = 168 MHz, conforms to IEC 61000-4-2 4A Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 108/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.14 Absolute maximum ratings (electrical sensitivity) Based on three different tests (ESD, LU) using specific measurement methods, the device is stressed in order to determine its performance in terms of electrical sensitivity. Electrostatic discharge (ESD) Electrostatic discharges (a positive then a negative pulse separated by 1 second) are applied to the pins of each sample according to each pin combination. The sample size depends on the number of supply pins in the device (3 parts × (n+1) supply pins). This test conforms to the JESD22-A114/C101 standard. Static latchup Two complementary static tests are required on six parts to assess the latchup performance: • A supply overvoltage is applied to each power supply pin • A current injection is applied to each input, output and configurable I/O pin These tests are compliant with EIA/JESD 78A IC latchup standard. Table 43. EMI characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Monitored frequency band Max vs. [fHSE/fCPU] Unit 25/168 MHz SEMI Peak level VDD = 3.3 V, TA = 25 °C, LQFP176 package, conforming to SAE J1752/3 EEMBC, code running from Flash with ART accelerator enabled 0.1 to 30 MHz 32 30 to 130 MHz 25 dBμV 130 MHz to 1GHz 29 SAE EMI Level 4 - VDD = 3.3 V, TA = 25 °C, LQFP176 package, conforming to SAE J1752/3 EEMBC, code running from Flash with ART accelerator and PLL spread spectrum enabled 0.1 to 30 MHz 19 30 to 130 MHz 16 dBμV 130 MHz to 1GHz 18 SAE EMI level 3.5 - Table 44. ESD absolute maximum ratings Symbol Ratings Conditions Class Maximum value(1) Unit VESD(HBM) Electrostatic discharge voltage (human body model) TA = +25 °C conforming to JESD22-A114 2 2000(2) V VESD(CDM) Electrostatic discharge voltage (charge device model) TA = +25 °C conforming to JESD22-C101 II 500 1. Based on characterization results, not tested in production. 2. On VBAT pin, VESD(HBM) is limited to 1000 V. DocID022152 Rev 4 109/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics 5.3.15 I/O current injection characteristics As a general rule, current injection to the I/O pins, due to external voltage below VSS or above VDD (for standard, 3 V-capable I/O pins) should be avoided during normal product operation. However, in order to give an indication of the robustness of the microcontroller in cases when abnormal injection accidentally happens, susceptibility tests are performed on a sample basis during device characterization. Functional susceptibilty to I/O current injection While a simple application is executed on the device, the device is stressed by injecting current into the I/O pins programmed in floating input mode. While current is injected into the I/O pin, one at a time, the device is checked for functional failures. The failure is indicated by an out of range parameter: ADC error above a certain limit (>5 LSB TUE), out of conventional limits of induced leakage current on adjacent pins (out of 5 uA/+0 uA range), or other functional failure (for example reset, oscillator frequency deviation). Negative induced leakage current is caused by negative injection and positive induced leakage current by positive injection. The test results are given in Table 46. 5.3.16 I/O port characteristics General input/output characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 47 are derived from tests performed under the conditions summarized in Table 14. All I/Os are CMOS and TTL compliant. Table 45. Electrical sensitivities Symbol Parameter Conditions Class LU Static latch-up class TA = +105 °C conforming to JESD78A II level A Table 46. I/O current injection susceptibility Symbol Description Functional susceptibility Negative Unit injection Positive injection IINJ (1) 1. It is recommended to add a Schottky diode (pin to ground) to analog pins which may potentially inject negative currents. Injected current on all FT pins –5 +0 mA Injected current on any other pin –5 +5 Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 110/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 All I/Os are CMOS and TTL compliant (no software configuration required). Their characteristics cover more than the strict CMOS-technology or TTL parameters. Output driving current The GPIOs (general purpose input/outputs) can sink or source up to ±8 mA, and sink or source up to ±20 mA (with a relaxed VOL/VOH) except PC13, PC14 and PC15 which can sink or source up to ±3mA. When using the PC13 to PC15 GPIOs in output mode, the speed should not exceed 2 MHz with a maximum load of 30 pF. Table 47. I/O static characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit VIL Input low level voltage TTL ports 2.7 V ≤ VDD ≤ 3.6 V - - 0.8 V VIH (1) Input high level voltage 2.0 - - VIL Input low level voltage CMOS ports 1.8 V ≤ VDD ≤ 3.6 V - - 0.3VDD VIH (1) Input high level voltage 0.7VDD - - - - Vhys I/O Schmitt trigger voltage hysteresis(2) - 200 - IO FT Schmitt trigger voltage mV hysteresis(2) 5% VDD (3) - - Ilkg I/O input leakage current (4) VSS ≤ VIN ≤ VDD - - ±1 μA I/O FT input leakage current (4) VIN = 5 V - - 3 RPU Weak pull-up equivalent resistor(5) All pins except for PA10 and PB12 VIN = VSS 30 40 50 kΩ PA10 and PB12 8 11 15 RPD Weak pull-down equivalent resistor All pins except for PA10 and PB12 VIN = VDD 30 40 50 PA10 and PB12 8 11 15 CIO (6) I/O pin capacitance 5 pF 1. Tested in production. 2. Hysteresis voltage between Schmitt trigger switching levels. Based on characterization, not tested in production. 3. With a minimum of 100 mV. 4. Leakage could be higher than the maximum value, if negative current is injected on adjacent pins. 5. Pull-up and pull-down resistors are designed with a true resistance in series with a switchable PMOS/NMOS. This MOS/NMOS contribution to the series resistance is minimum (~10% order). 6. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. DocID022152 Rev 4 111/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics In the user application, the number of I/O pins which can drive current must be limited to respect the absolute maximum rating specified in Section 5.2. In particular: • The sum of the currents sourced by all the I/Os on VDD, plus the maximum Run consumption of the MCU sourced on VDD, cannot exceed the absolute maximum rating IVDD (see Table 12). • The sum of the currents sunk by all the I/Os on VSS plus the maximum Run consumption of the MCU sunk on VSS cannot exceed the absolute maximum rating IVSS (see Table 12). Output voltage levels Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 48 are derived from tests performed under ambient temperature and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. All I/Os are CMOS and TTL compliant. Input/output AC characteristics The definition and values of input/output AC characteristics are given in Figure 37 and Table 49, respectively. Table 48. Output voltage characteristics(1) 1. PC13, PC14, PC15 and PI8 are supplied through the power switch. Since the switch only sinks a limited amount of current (3 mA), the use of GPIOs PC13 to PC15 and PI8 in output mode is limited: the speed should not exceed 2 MHz with a maximum load of 30 pF and these I/Os must not be used as a current source (e.g. to drive an LED). Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit VOL (2) 2. The IIO current sunk by the device must always respect the absolute maximum rating specified in Table 12 and the sum of IIO (I/O ports and control pins) must not exceed IVSS. Output low level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sunk at same time CMOS port IIO = +8 mA 2.7 V < VDD < 3.6 V - 0.4 V VOH (3) 3. The IIO current sourced by the device must always respect the absolute maximum rating specified in Table 12 and the sum of IIO (I/O ports and control pins) must not exceed IVDD. Output high level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sourced at same time VDD–0.4 - VOL (2) Output low level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sunk at same time TTL port IIO =+ 8mA 2.7 V < VDD < 3.6 V - 0.4 V VOH (3) Output high level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sourced at same time 2.4 - VOL (2)(4) 4. Based on characterization data, not tested in production. Output low level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sunk at same time IIO = +20 mA 2.7 V < VDD < 3.6 V - 1.3 V VOH (3)(4) Output high level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sourced at same time VDD–1.3 - VOL (2)(4) Output low level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sunk at same time IIO = +6 mA 2 V < VDD < 2.7 V - 0.4 V VOH (3)(4) Output high level voltage for an I/O pin when 8 pins are sourced at same time VDD–0.4 - Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 112/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 49 are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. Table 49. I/O AC characteristics(1)(2)(3) OSPEEDRy [1:0] bit value(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit 00 fmax(IO)out Maximum frequency(4) CL = 50 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - 2 MHz CL = 50 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - 2 CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - TBD CL = 10 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - TBD tf(IO)out Output high to low level fall time CL = 50 pF, VDD = 1.8 V to 3.6 V - - TBD ns tr(IO)out Output low to high level rise time - - TBD 01 fmax(IO)out Maximum frequency(4) CL = 50 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - 25 MHz CL = 50 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - 12.5(5) CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - 50(5) CL = 10 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - TBD tf(IO)out Output high to low level fall time CL = 50 pF, VDD < 2.7 V - - TBD ns CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.7 V - - TBD tr(IO)out Output low to high level rise time CL = 50 pF, VDD < 2.7 V - - TBD CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.7 V - - TBD 10 fmax(IO)out Maximum frequency(4) CL = 40 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - 50(5) MHz CL = 40 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - 25 CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - 100(5) CL = 10 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - TBD tf(IO)out Output high to low level fall time CL = 50 pF, 2.4 < VDD < 2.7 V - - TBD CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.7 V - - TBD ns tr(IO)out Output low to high level rise time CL = 50 pF, 2.4 < VDD < 2.7 V - - TBD CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.7 V - - TBD DocID022152 Rev 4 113/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 37. I/O AC characteristics definition 5.3.17 NRST pin characteristics The NRST pin input driver uses CMOS technology. It is connected to a permanent pull-up resistor, RPU (see Table 47). Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 50 are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. 11 Fmax(IO)ou t Maximum frequency(4) CL = 30 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - 100(5) MHz CL = 30 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - 50(5) CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.70 V - - 200(5) CL = 10 pF, VDD > 1.8 V - - TBD tf(IO)out Output high to low level fall time CL = 20 pF, 2.4 < VDD < 2.7 V - - TBD ns CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.7 V - - TBD tr(IO)out Output low to high level rise time CL = 20 pF, 2.4 < VDD < 2.7 V - - TBD CL = 10 pF, VDD > 2.7 V - - TBD - tEXTIpw Pulse width of external signals detected by the EXTI controller 10 - - ns 1. Based on characterization data, not tested in production. 2. The I/O speed is configured using the OSPEEDRy[1:0] bits. Refer to the STM32F20/21xxx reference manual for a description of the GPIOx_SPEEDR GPIO port output speed register. 3. TBD stands for “to be defined”. 4. The maximum frequency is defined in Figure 37. 5. For maximum frequencies above 50 MHz, the compensation cell should be used. Table 49. I/O AC characteristics(1)(2)(3) (continued) OSPEEDRy [1:0] bit value(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit ai14131 10% 90% 50% tr(IO)out OUTPUT EXTERNAL ON 50pF Maximum frequency is achieved if (tr + tf) ≤ 2/3)T and if the duty cycle is (45-55%) 10% 50% 90% when loaded by 50pF T tr(IO)out Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 114/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 38. Recommended NRST pin protection 1. The reset network protects the device against parasitic resets. 2. The user must ensure that the level on the NRST pin can go below the VIL(NRST) max level specified in Table 50. Otherwise the reset is not taken into account by the device. 5.3.18 TIM timer characteristics The parameters given in Table 51 and Table 52 are guaranteed by design. Refer to Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for details on the input/output alternate function characteristics (output compare, input capture, external clock, PWM output). Table 50. NRST pin characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit VIL(NRST) (1) 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. NRST Input low level voltage TTL ports 2.7 V ≤ VDD ≤ 3.6 V - - 0.8 V VIH(NRST) (1) NRST Input high level voltage 2 - - VIL(NRST) (1) NRST Input low level voltage CMOS ports 1.8 V ≤ VDD ≤ 3.6 V - 0.3VDD VIH(NRST) (1) NRST Input high level voltage 0.7VDD - Vhys(NRST) NRST Schmitt trigger voltage hysteresis - 200 - mV RPU Weak pull-up equivalent resistor(2) 2. The pull-up is designed with a true resistance in series with a switchable PMOS. This PMOS contribution to the series resistance must be minimum (~10% order). VIN = VSS 30 40 50 kΩ VF(NRST) (1) NRST Input filtered pulse - - 100 ns VNF(NRST) (1) NRST Input not filtered pulse VDD > 2.7 V 300 - - ns TNRST_OUT Generated reset pulse duration Internal Reset source 20 - - μs ai14132c STM32Fxxx NRST(2) RPU VDD Filter Internal Reset 0.1 μF External reset circuit(1) DocID022152 Rev 4 115/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Table 51. Characteristics of TIMx connected to the APB1 domain(1) 1. TIMx is used as a general term to refer to the TIM2, TIM3, TIM4, TIM5, TIM6, TIM7, and TIM12 timers. Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit tres(TIM) Timer resolution time AHB/APB1 prescaler distinct from 1, fTIMxCLK = 84 MHz 1 - tTIMxCLK 11.9 - ns AHB/APB1 prescaler = 1, fTIMxCLK = 42 MHz 1 - tTIMxCLK 23.8 - ns fEXT Timer external clock frequency on CH1 to CH4 fTIMxCLK = 84 MHz APB1= 42 MHz 0 fTIMxCLK/2 MHz 0 42 MHz ResTIM Timer resolution - 16/32 bit tCOUNTER 16-bit counter clock period when internal clock is selected 1 65536 tTIMxCLK 0.0119 780 μs 32-bit counter clock period when internal clock is selected 1 - tTIMxCLK 0.0119 51130563 μs tMAX_COUNT Maximum possible count - 65536 × 65536 tTIMxCLK - 51.1 s Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 116/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.19 Communications interfaces I2C interface characteristics The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx I2C interface meets the requirements of the standard I2C communication protocol with the following restrictions: the I/O pins SDA and SCL are mapped to are not “true” open-drain. When configured as open-drain, the PMOS connected between the I/O pin and VDD is disabled, but is still present. The I2C characteristics are described in Table 53. Refer also to Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output alternate function characteristics (SDA and SCL). Table 52. Characteristics of TIMx connected to the APB2 domain(1) 1. TIMx is used as a general term to refer to the TIM1, TIM8, TIM9, TIM10, and TIM11 timers. Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit tres(TIM) Timer resolution time AHB/APB2 prescaler distinct from 1, fTIMxCLK = 168 MHz 1 - tTIMxCLK 5.95 - ns AHB/APB2 prescaler = 1, fTIMxCLK = 84 MHz 1 - tTIMxCLK 11.9 - ns fEXT Timer external clock frequency on CH1 to CH4 fTIMxCLK = 168 MHz APB2 = 84 MHz 0 fTIMxCLK/2 MHz 0 84 MHz ResTIM Timer resolution - 16 bit tCOUNTER 16-bit counter clock period when internal clock is selected 1 65536 tTIMxCLK tMAX_COUNT Maximum possible count - 32768 tTIMxCLK Table 53. I2C characteristics Symbol Parameter Standard mode I2C(1) Fast mode I2C(1)(2) Unit Min Max Min Max tw(SCLL) SCL clock low time 4.7 - 1.3 - μs tw(SCLH) SCL clock high time 4.0 - 0.6 - tsu(SDA) SDA setup time 250 - 100 - ns th(SDA) SDA data hold time 0(3) - 0 900(4) tr(SDA) tr(SCL) SDA and SCL rise time - 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300 tf(SDA) tf(SCL) SDA and SCL fall time - 300 - 300 DocID022152 Rev 4 117/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 39. I2C bus AC waveforms and measurement circuit 1. Rs= series protection resistor. 2. Rp = external pull-up resistor. 3. VDD_I2C is the I2C bus power supply. th(STA) Start condition hold time 4.0 - 0.6 - μs tsu(STA) Repeated Start condition setup time 4.7 - 0.6 - tsu(STO) Stop condition setup time 4.0 - 0.6 - μs tw(STO:STA) Stop to Start condition time (bus free) 4.7 - 1.3 - μs Cb Capacitive load for each bus line - 400 - 400 pF 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 2. fPCLK1 must be at least 2 MHz to achieve standard mode I2C frequencies. It must be at least 4 MHz to achieve fast mode I2C frequencies, and a multiple of 10 MHz to reach the 400 kHz maximum I2C fast mode clock. 3. The device must internally provide a hold time of at least 300 ns for the SDA signal in order to bridge the undefined region of the falling edge of SCL. 4. The maximum data hold time has only to be met if the interface does not stretch the low period of SCL signal. Table 53. I2C characteristics (continued) Symbol Parameter Standard mode I2C(1) Fast mode I2C(1)(2) Unit Min Max Min Max ai14979c S TAR T SD A RP I²C bus VDD_I2C STM32Fxx SDA SCL tf(SDA) tr(SDA) SCL th(STA) tw(SCLH) tw(SCLL) tsu(SDA) tr(SCL) tf(SCL) th(SDA) S TAR T REPEATED t S TAR T su(STA) tsu(STO) S TOP tw(STO:STA) VDD_I2C RP RS RS Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 118/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 SPI interface characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 55 for SPI are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fPCLKx frequency and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14 with the following configuration: • Output speed is set to OSPEEDRy[1:0] = 10 • Capacitive load C = 30 pF • Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.5 VDD Refer to Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output alternate function characteristics (NSS, SCK, MOSI, MISO). Table 54. SCL frequency (fPCLK1= 42 MHz.,VDD = 3.3 V)(1)(2) 1. RP = External pull-up resistance, fSCL = I2C speed, 2. For speeds around 200 kHz, the tolerance on the achieved speed is of ±5%. For other speed ranges, the tolerance on the achieved speed ±2%. These variations depend on the accuracy of the external components used to design the application. fSCL (kHz) I2C_CCR value RP = 4.7 kΩ 400 0x8019 300 0x8021 200 0x8032 100 0x0096 50 0x012C 20 0x02EE Table 55. SPI dynamic characteristics(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fSCK SPI clock frequency Master mode, SPI1, 2.7V < VDD < 3.6V - - 42 MHz Slave mode, SPI1, 2.7V < VDD < 3.6V 42 1/tc(SCK) Master mode, SPI1/2/3, 1.7V < VDD < 3.6V - - 21 Slave mode, SPI1/2/3, 1.7V < VDD < 3.6V 21 Duty(SCK) Duty cycle of SPI clock frequency Slave mode 30 50 70 % DocID022152 Rev 4 119/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics tw(SCKH) SCK high and low time Master mode, SPI presc = 2, 2.7V < VDD < 3.6V TPCLK-0.5 TPCLK TPCLK+0.5 ns tw(SCKL) Master mode, SPI presc = 2, 1.7V < VDD < 3.6V TPCLK-2 TPCLK TPCLK+2 tsu(NSS) NSS setup time Slave mode, SPI presc = 2 4 x TPCLK - - th(NSS) NSS hold time Slave mode, SPI presc = 2 2 x TPCLK tsu(MI) Data input setup time Master mode 6.5 - - tsu(SI) Slave mode 2.5 - - th(MI) Data input hold time Master mode 2.5 - - th(SI) Slave mode 4 - - ta(SO) (2) Data output access time Slave mode, SPI presc = 2 0 - 4 x TPCLK tdis(SO) (3) Data output disable time Slave mode, SPI1, 2.7V < VDD < 3.6V 0 - 7.5 Slave mode, SPI1/2/3 1.7V < VDD < 3.6V 0 - 16.5 tv(SO) th(SO) Data output valid/hold time Slave mode (after enable edge), SPI1, 2.7V < VDD < 3.6V - 11 13 Slave mode (after enable edge), SPI2/3, 2.7V < VDD < 3.6V - 12 16.5 Slave mode (after enable edge), SPI1, 1.7V < VDD < 3.6V - 15.5 19 Slave mode (after enable edge), SPI2/3, 1.7V < VDD < 3.6V - 18 20.5 tv(MO) Data output valid time Master mode (after enable edge), SPI1 , 2.7V < VDD < 3.6V - - 2.5 Master mode (after enable edge), SPI1/2/3 , 1.7V < VDD < 3.6V - - 4.5 th(MO) Data output hold time Master mode (after enable edge) 0 - - 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. 2. Min time is for the minimum time to drive the output and the max time is for the maximum time to validate the data. 3. Min time is for the minimum time to invalidate the output and the max time is for the maximum time to put the data in Hi-Z. Table 55. SPI dynamic characteristics(1) (continued) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 120/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 40. SPI timing diagram - slave mode and CPHA = 0 Figure 41. SPI timing diagram - slave mode and CPHA = 1 ai14134c SCK Input CPHA=0 MOSI INPUT MISO OUT PUT CPHA=0 MSB O UT MSB IN BIT6 OUT LSB IN LSB OUT CPOL=0 CPOL=1 BIT1 IN NSS input tSU(NSS) tc(SCK) th(NSS) ta(SO) tw(SCKH) tw(SCKL) tv(SO) th(SO) tr(SCK) tf(SCK) tdis(SO) tsu(SI) th(SI) ai14135 SCK Input CPHA=1 MOSI INPUT MISO OUT PUT CPHA=1 MSB O UT MSB IN BIT6 OUT LSB IN LSB OUT CPOL=0 CPOL=1 BIT1 IN tSU(NSS) tc(SCK) th(NSS) ta(SO) tw(SCKH) tw(SCKL) tv(SO) th(SO) tr(SCK) tf(SCK) tdis(SO) tsu(SI) th(SI) NSS input DocID022152 Rev 4 121/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 42. SPI timing diagram - master mode ai14136 SCK Input CPHA=0 MOSI OUTUT MISO INPUT CPHA=0 MSBIN MSB OUT BIT6 IN LSB OUT LSB IN CPOL=0 CPOL=1 BIT1 OUT NSS input tc(SCK) tw(SCKH) tw(SCKL) tr(SCK) tf(SCK) th(MI) High SCK Input CPHA=1 CPHA=1 CPOL=0 CPOL=1 tsu(MI) tv(MO) th(MO) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 122/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 I2S interface characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 56 for the i2S interface are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fPCLKx frequency and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14, with the following configuration: • Output speed is set to OSPEEDRy[1:0] = 10 • Capacitive load C = 30 pF • Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.5 VDD Refer to Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output alternate function characteristics (CK, SD, WS). Note: Refer to the I2S section of RM0090 reference manual for more details on the sampling frequency (FS). fMCK, fCK, and DCK values reflect only the digital peripheral behavior. The value of these parameters might be slightly impacted by the source clock accuracy. DCK depends mainly on the value of ODD bit. The digital contribution leads to a minimum value of I2SDIV / (2 x I2SDIV + ODD) and a maximum value of (I2SDIV + ODD) / (2 x I2SDIV + ODD). FS maximum value is supported for each mode/condition. Table 56. I2S dynamic characteristics(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit fMCK I2S main clock output - 256 x 8K 256 x FS (2) MHz fCK I2S clock frequency Master data: 32 bits - 64 x FS MHz Slave data: 32 bits - 64 x FS DCK I2S clock frequency duty cycle Slave receiver 30 70 % tv(WS) WS valid time Master mode 0 6 ns th(WS) WS hold time Master mode 0 - tsu(WS) WS setup time Slave mode 1 - th(WS) WS hold time Slave mode 0 - tsu(SD_MR) Data input setup time Master receiver 7.5 - tsu(SD_SR) Slave receiver 2 - th(SD_MR) Data input hold time Master receiver 0 - th(SD_SR) Slave receiver 0 - tv(SD_ST) th(SD_ST) Data output valid time Slave transmitter (after enable edge) - 27 tv(SD_MT) Master transmitter (after enable edge) - 20 th(SD_MT) Data output hold time Master transmitter (after enable edge) 2.5 - 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. 2. The maximum value of 256 x FS is 42 MHz (APB1 maximum frequency). DocID022152 Rev 4 123/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 43. I2S slave timing diagram (Philips protocol) 1. LSB transmit/receive of the previously transmitted byte. No LSB transmit/receive is sent before the first byte. Figure 44. I2S master timing diagram (Philips protocol)(1) 1. Based on characterization, not tested in production. 2. LSB transmit/receive of the previously transmitted byte. No LSB transmit/receive is sent before the first byte. USB OTG FS characteristics This interface is present in both the USB OTG HS and USB OTG FS controllers. CK Input CPOL = 0 CPOL = 1 tc(CK) WS input SDtransmit SDreceive tw(CKH) tw(CKL) tsu(WS) tv(SD_ST) th(SD_ST) th(WS) tsu(SD_SR) th(SD_SR) MSB receive Bitn receive LSB receive MSB transmit Bitn transmit LSB transmit ai14881b LSB receive(2) LSB transmit(2) CK output CPOL = 0 CPOL = 1 tc(CK) WS output SDreceive SDtransmit tw(CKH) tw(CKL) tsu(SD_MR) tv(SD_MT) th(SD_MT) th(WS) th(SD_MR) MSB receive Bitn receive LSB receive MSB transmit Bitn transmit LSB transmit ai14884b tf(CK) tr(CK) tv(WS) LSB receive(2) LSB transmit(2) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 124/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 45. USB OTG FS timings: definition of data signal rise and fall time Table 57. USB OTG FS startup time Symbol Parameter Max Unit tSTARTUP (1) 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. USB OTG FS transceiver startup time 1 μs Table 58. USB OTG FS DC electrical characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min.(1) 1. All the voltages are measured from the local ground potential. Typ. Max.(1) Unit Input levels VDD USB OTG FS operating voltage 3.0(2) 2. The STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx USB OTG FS functionality is ensured down to 2.7 V but not the full USB OTG FS electrical characteristics which are degraded in the 2.7-to-3.0 V VDD voltage range. - 3.6 V VDI (3) 3. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. Differential input sensitivity I(USB_FS_DP/DM, USB_HS_DP/DM) 0.2 - - VCM V (3) Differential common mode range Includes VDI range 0.8 - 2.5 VSE (3) Single ended receiver threshold 1.3 - 2.0 Output levels VOL Static output level low RL of 1.5 kΩ to 3.6 V(4) 4. RL is the load connected on the USB OTG FS drivers - - 0.3 V VOH Static output level high RL of 15 kΩ to VSS (4) 2.8 - 3.6 RPD PA11, PA12, PB14, PB15 (USB_FS_DP/DM, USB_HS_DP/DM) VIN = VDD 17 21 24 kΩ PA9, PB13 (OTG_FS_VBUS, OTG_HS_VBUS) 0.65 1.1 2.0 RPU PA12, PB15 (USB_FS_DP, USB_HS_DP) VIN = VSS 1.5 1.8 2.1 PA9, PB13 (OTG_FS_VBUS, OTG_HS_VBUS) VIN = VSS 0.25 0.37 0.55 ai14137 tf Differen tial Data L ines VSS VCRS tr Crossover points DocID022152 Rev 4 125/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics USB HS characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 62 for ULPI are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fHCLK frequency summarized in Table 61 and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 60, with the following configuration: • Output speed is set to OSPEEDRy[1:0] = 10 • Capacitive load C = 30 pF • Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.5VDD. Refer to Section Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/outputcharacteristics. Table 59. USB OTG FS electrical characteristics(1) 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. Driver characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit tr Rise time(2) 2. Measured from 10% to 90% of the data signal. For more detailed informations, please refer to USB Specification - Chapter 7 (version 2.0). CL = 50 pF 4 20 ns tf Fall time(2) CL = 50 pF 4 20 ns trfm Rise/ fall time matching tr/tf 90 110 % VCRS Output signal crossover voltage 1.3 2.0 V Table 60. USB HS DC electrical characteristics Symbol Parameter Min.(1) 1. All the voltages are measured from the local ground potential. Max.(1) Unit Input level VDD USB OTG HS operating voltage 2.7 3.6 V Table 61. USB HS clock timing parameters(1) Parameter Symbol Min Nominal Max Unit fHCLK value to guarantee proper operation of USB HS interface 30 MHz Frequency (first transition) 8-bit ±10% FSTART_8BIT 54 60 66 MHz Frequency (steady state) ±500 ppm FSTEADY 59.97 60 60.03 MHz Duty cycle (first transition) 8-bit ±10% DSTART_8BIT 40 50 60 % Duty cycle (steady state) ±500 ppm DSTEADY 49.975 50 50.025 % Time to reach the steady state frequency and duty cycle after the first transition TSTEADY - - 1.4 ms Clock startup time after the de-assertion of SuspendM Peripheral TSTART_DEV - - 5.6 ms Host TSTART_HOST - - - PHY preparation time after the first transition of the input clock TPREP - - - μs Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 126/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 46. ULPI timing diagram Ethernet characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 64, Table 65 and Table 66 for SMI, RMII and MII are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fHCLK frequency summarized in Table 14 and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 63, with the following configuration: • Output speed is set to OSPEEDRy[1:0] = 10 • Capacitive load C = 30 pF • Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.5VDD. Refer to Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output characteristics. 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. Table 62. ULPI timing Parameter Symbol Value(1) 1. VDD = 2.7 V to 3.6 V and TA = –40 to 85 °C. Unit Min. Max. Control in (ULPI_DIR) setup time tSC - 2.0 ns Control in (ULPI_NXT) setup time - 1.5 Control in (ULPI_DIR, ULPI_NXT) hold time tHC 0 - Data in setup time tSD - 2.0 Data in hold time tHD 0 - Control out (ULPI_STP) setup time and hold time tDC - 9.2 Data out available from clock rising edge tDD - 10.7 Clock Control In (ULPI_DIR, ULPI_NXT) data In (8-bit) Control out (ULPI_STP) data out (8-bit) tDD tDC tSD tHD tSC tHC ai17361c tDC DocID022152 Rev 4 127/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Table 64 gives the list of Ethernet MAC signals for the SMI (station management interface) and Figure 47 shows the corresponding timing diagram. Figure 47. Ethernet SMI timing diagram Table 65 gives the list of Ethernet MAC signals for the RMII and Figure 48 shows the corresponding timing diagram. Figure 48. Ethernet RMII timing diagram Table 63. Ethernet DC electrical characteristics Symbol Parameter Min.(1) 1. All the voltages are measured from the local ground potential. Max.(1) Unit Input level VDD Ethernet operating voltage 2.7 3.6 V Table 64. Dynamic characteristics: Ehternet MAC signals for SMI(1) 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit tMDC MDC cycle time( 2.38 MHz) 411 420 425 ns Td(MDIO) Write data valid time 6 10 13 tsu(MDIO) Read data setup time 12 - - th(MDIO) Read data hold time 0 - - MS31384V1 ETH_MDC ETH_MDIO(O) ETH_MDIO(I) tMDC td(MDIO) tsu(MDIO) th(MDIO) RMII_REF_CLK RMII_TX_EN RMII_TXD[1:0] RMII_RXD[1:0] RMII_CRS_DV td(TXEN) td(TXD) tsu(RXD) tsu(CRS) tih(RXD) tih(CRS) ai15667 Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 128/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Table 66 gives the list of Ethernet MAC signals for MII and Figure 48 shows the corresponding timing diagram. Figure 49. Ethernet MII timing diagram Table 65. Dynamic characteristics: Ethernet MAC signals for RMII Symbol Rating Min Typ Max Unit tsu(RXD) Receive data setup time 2 - - ns tih(RXD) Receive data hold time 1 - - ns tsu(CRS) Carrier sense set-up time 0.5 - - ns tih(CRS) Carrier sense hold time 2 - - ns td(TXEN) Transmit enable valid delay time 8 9.5 11 ns td(TXD) Transmit data valid delay time 8.5 10 11.5 ns Table 66. Dynamic characteristics: Ethernet MAC signals for MII(1) 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit tsu(RXD) Receive data setup time 9 - ns tih(RXD) Receive data hold time 10 - tsu(DV) Data valid setup time 9 - tih(DV) Data valid hold time 8 - tsu(ER) Error setup time 6 - tih(ER) Error hold time 8 - td(TXEN) Transmit enable valid delay time 0 10 14 td(TXD) Transmit data valid delay time 0 10 15 MII_RX_CLK MII_RXD[3:0] MII_RX_DV MII_RX_ER td(TXEN) td(TXD) tsu(RXD) tsu(ER) tsu(DV) tih(RXD) tih(ER) tih(DV) ai15668 MII_TX_CLK MII_TX_EN MII_TXD[3:0] DocID022152 Rev 4 129/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics CAN (controller area network) interface Refer to Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output alternate function characteristics (CANTX and CANRX). 5.3.20 12-bit ADC characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 67 are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fPCLK2 frequency and VDDA supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. Table 67. ADC characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit VDDA Power supply 1.8(1) - 3.6 V VREF+ Positive reference voltage 1.8(1)(2)(3) - VDDA V fADC ADC clock frequency VDDA = 1.8(1)(3) to 2.4 V 0.6 15 18 MHz VDDA = 2.4 to 3.6 V(3) 0.6 30 36 MHz fTRIG (4) External trigger frequency fADC = 30 MHz, 12-bit resolution - - 1764 kHz - - 17 1/fADC VAIN Conversion voltage range(5) 0 (VSSA or VREFtied to ground) - VREF+ V RAIN (4) External input impedance See Equation 1 for details - - 50 κΩ RADC (4)(6) Sampling switch resistance - - 6 κΩ CADC (4) Internal sample and hold capacitor - 4 - pF tlat (4) Injection trigger conversion latency fADC = 30 MHz - - 0.100 μs - - 3(7) 1/fADC tlatr (4) Regular trigger conversion latency fADC = 30 MHz - - 0.067 μs - - 2(7) 1/fADC tS (4) Sampling time fADC = 30 MHz 0.100 - 16 μs 3 - 480 1/fADC tSTAB (4) Power-up time - 2 3 μs Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 130/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Equation 1: RAIN max formula The formula above (Equation 1) is used to determine the maximum external impedance allowed for an error below 1/4 of LSB. N = 12 (from 12-bit resolution) and k is the number of sampling periods defined in the ADC_SMPR1 register. tCONV (4) Total conversion time (including sampling time) fADC = 30 MHz 12-bit resolution 0.50 - 16.40 μs fADC = 30 MHz 10-bit resolution 0.43 - 16.34 μs fADC = 30 MHz 8-bit resolution 0.37 - 16.27 μs fADC = 30 MHz 6-bit resolution 0.30 - 16.20 μs 9 to 492 (tS for sampling +n-bit resolution for successive approximation) 1/fADC fS (4) Sampling rate (fADC = 30 MHz, and tS = 3 ADC cycles) 12-bit resolution Single ADC - - 2 Msps 12-bit resolution Interleave Dual ADC mode - - 3.75 Msps 12-bit resolution Interleave Triple ADC mode - - 6 Msps IVREF+ (4) ADC VREF DC current consumption in conversion mode - 300 500 μA IVDDA (4) ADC VDDA DC current consumption in conversion mode - 1.6 1.8 mA 1. VDD/VDDA minimum value of 1.7 V is obtained when the device operates in reduced temperature range, and with the use of an external power supply supervisor (refer to Section : Internal reset OFF). 2. It is recommended to maintain the voltage difference between VREF+ and VDDA below 1.8 V. 3. VDDA -VREF+ < 1.2 V. 4. Based on characterization, not tested in production. 5. VREF+ is internally connected to VDDA and VREF- is internally connected to VSSA. 6. RADC maximum value is given for VDD=1.8 V, and minimum value for VDD=3.3 V. 7. For external triggers, a delay of 1/fPCLK2 must be added to the latency specified in Table 67. Table 67. ADC characteristics (continued) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit RAIN (k – 0.5) fADC CADC 2N + 2 × × ln( ) = -------------------------------------------------------------- – RADC DocID022152 Rev 4 131/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics a Note: ADC accuracy vs. negative injection current: injecting a negative current on any analog input pins should be avoided as this significantly reduces the accuracy of the conversion being performed on another analog input. It is recommended to add a Schottky diode (pin to ground) to analog pins which may potentially inject negative currents. Any positive injection current within the limits specified for IINJ(PIN) and ΣIINJ(PIN) in Section 5.3.16 does not affect the ADC accuracy. Figure 50. ADC accuracy characteristics 1. See also Table 68. 2. Example of an actual transfer curve. 3. Ideal transfer curve. 4. End point correlation line. 5. ET = Total Unadjusted Error: maximum deviation between the actual and the ideal transfer curves. EO = Offset Error: deviation between the first actual transition and the first ideal one. Table 68. ADC accuracy at fADC = 30 MHz(1) 1. Better performance could be achieved in restricted VDD, frequency and temperature ranges. Symbol Parameter Test conditions Typ Max(2) 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Unit ET Total unadjusted error fPCLK2 = 60 MHz, fADC = 30 MHz, RAIN < 10 kΩ, VDDA = 1.8(3) to 3.6 V 3. VDD/VDDA minimum value of 1.7 V is obtained when the device operates in reduced temperature range, and with the use of an external power supply supervisor (refer to Section : Internal reset OFF). ±2 ±5 LSB EO Offset error ±1.5 ±2.5 EG Gain error ±1.5 ±3 ED Differential linearity error ±1 ±2 EL Integral linearity error ±1.5 ±3 ai14395c EO EG 1L SBIDEAL 4095 4094 4093 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 1 2 3 456 7 4093 4094 4095 4096 (1) (2) ET ED EL (3) VSSA VDDA VREF+ 4096 (or depending on package)] VDDA 4096 [1LSB IDEAL = Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 132/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 EG = Gain Error: deviation between the last ideal transition and the last actual one. ED = Differential Linearity Error: maximum deviation between actual steps and the ideal one. EL = Integral Linearity Error: maximum deviation between any actual transition and the end point correlation line. Figure 51. Typical connection diagram using the ADC 1. Refer to Table 67 for the values of RAIN, RADC and CADC. 2. Cparasitic represents the capacitance of the PCB (dependent on soldering and PCB layout quality) plus the pad capacitance (roughly 5 pF). A high Cparasitic value downgrades conversion accuracy. To remedy this, fADC should be reduced. ai17534 VDD STM32F AINx IL±1 μA 0.6 V VT RAIN (1) Cparasitic VAIN 0.6 V VT RADC (1) CADC(1) 12-bit converter Sample and hold ADC converter DocID022152 Rev 4 133/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics General PCB design guidelines Power supply decoupling should be performed as shown in Figure 52 or Figure 53, depending on whether VREF+ is connected to VDDA or not. The 10 nF capacitors should be ceramic (good quality). They should be placed them as close as possible to the chip. Figure 52. Power supply and reference decoupling (VREF+ not connected to VDDA) 1. VREF+ and VREF– inputs are both available on UFBGA176. VREF+ is also available on LQFP100, LQFP144, and LQFP176. When VREF+ and VREF– are not available, they are internally connected to VDDA and VSSA. Figure 53. Power supply and reference decoupling (VREF+ connected to VDDA) 1. VREF+ and VREF– inputs are both available on UFBGA176. VREF+ is also available on LQFP100, LQFP144, and LQFP176. When VREF+ and VREF– are not available, they are internally connected to VDDA and VSSA. VREF+ STM32F VDDA VSSA/V REF- 1 μF // 10 nF 1 μF // 10 nF ai17535 (See note 1) (See note 1) VREF+/VDDA STM32F 1 μF // 10 nF VREF–/VSSA ai17536 (See note 1) (See note 1) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 134/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.21 Temperature sensor characteristics 5.3.22 VBAT monitoring characteristics Table 69. Temperature sensor characteristics Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit TL (1) VSENSE linearity with temperature - ±1 ±2 °C Avg_Slope(1) Average slope - 2.5 mV/°C V25 (1) Voltage at 25 °C - 0.76 V tSTART (2) Startup time - 6 10 μs TS_temp (3)(2) ADC sampling time when reading the temperature (1 °C accuracy) 10 - - μs 1. Based on characterization, not tested in production. 2. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 3. Shortest sampling time can be determined in the application by multiple iterations. Table 70. Temperature sensor calibration values Symbol Parameter Memory address TS_CAL1 TS ADC raw data acquired at temperature of 30 °C, VDDA=3.3 V 0x1FFF 7A2C - 0x1FFF 7A2D TS_CAL2 TS ADC raw data acquired at temperature of 110 °C, VDDA=3.3 V 0x1FFF 7A2E - 0x1FFF 7A2F Table 71. VBAT monitoring characteristics Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit R Resistor bridge for VBAT - 50 - KΩ Q Ratio on VBAT measurement - 2 - Er(1) Error on Q –1 - +1 % TS_vbat (2)(2) ADC sampling time when reading the VBAT 1 mV accuracy 5 - - μs 1. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 2. Shortest sampling time can be determined in the application by multiple iterations. DocID022152 Rev 4 135/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics 5.3.23 Embedded reference voltage The parameters given in Table 72 are derived from tests performed under ambient temperature and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14. 5.3.24 DAC electrical characteristics Table 72. Embedded internal reference voltage Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit VREFINT Internal reference voltage –40 °C < TA < +105 °C 1.18 1.21 1.24 V TS_vrefint (1) ADC sampling time when reading the internal reference voltage 10 - - μs VRERINT_s (2) Internal reference voltage spread over the temperature range VDD = 3 V - 3 5 mV TCoeff (2) Temperature coefficient - 30 50 ppm/°C tSTART (2) Startup time - 6 10 μs 1. Shortest sampling time can be determined in the application by multiple iterations. 2. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. Table 73. Internal reference voltage calibration values Symbol Parameter Memory address VREFIN_CAL Raw data acquired at temperature of 30 °C, VDDA=3.3 V 0x1FFF 7A2A - 0x1FFF 7A2B Table 74. DAC characteristics Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Comments VDDA Analog supply voltage 1.8(1) - 3.6 V VREF+ Reference supply voltage 1.8(1) - 3.6 V VREF+ ≤ VDDA VSSA Ground 0 - 0 V RLOAD (2) Resistive load with buffer ON 5 - - kΩ RO (2) Impedance output with buffer OFF - - 15 kΩ When the buffer is OFF, the Minimum resistive load between DAC_OUT and VSS to have a 1% accuracy is 1.5 MΩ CLOAD (2) Capacitive load - - 50 pF Maximum capacitive load at DAC_OUT pin (when the buffer is ON). DAC_OUT min(2) Lower DAC_OUT voltage with buffer ON 0.2 - - V It gives the maximum output excursion of the DAC. It corresponds to 12-bit input code (0x0E0) to (0xF1C) at VREF+ = 3.6 V and (0x1C7) to (0xE38) at VREF+ = 1.8 V DAC_OUT max(2) Higher DAC_OUT voltage with buffer ON - - VDDA – 0.2 V Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 136/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 DAC_OUT min(2) Lower DAC_OUT voltage with buffer OFF - 0.5 - mV It gives the maximum output DAC_OUT excursion of the DAC. max(2) Higher DAC_OUT voltage with buffer OFF - - VREF+ – 1LSB V IVREF+ (4) DAC DC VREF current consumption in quiescent mode (Standby mode) - 170 240 μA With no load, worst code (0x800) at VREF+ = 3.6 V in terms of DC consumption on the inputs - 50 75 With no load, worst code (0xF1C) at VREF+ = 3.6 V in terms of DC consumption on the inputs IDDA (4) DAC DC VDDA current consumption in quiescent mode(3) - 280 380 μA With no load, middle code (0x800) on the inputs - 475 625 μA With no load, worst code (0xF1C) at VREF+ = 3.6 V in terms of DC consumption on the inputs DNL(4) Differential non linearity Difference between two consecutive code-1LSB) - - ±0.5 LSB Given for the DAC in 10-bit configuration. - - ±2 LSB Given for the DAC in 12-bit configuration. INL(4) Integral non linearity (difference between measured value at Code i and the value at Code i on a line drawn between Code 0 and last Code 1023) - - ±1 LSB Given for the DAC in 10-bit configuration. - - ±4 LSB Given for the DAC in 12-bit configuration. Offset(4) Offset error (difference between measured value at Code (0x800) and the ideal value = VREF+/2) - - ±10 mV Given for the DAC in 12-bit configuration - - ±3 LSB Given for the DAC in 10-bit at VREF+ = 3.6 V - - ±12 LSB Given for the DAC in 12-bit at VREF+ = 3.6 V Gain error(4) Gain error - - ±0.5 % Given for the DAC in 12-bit configuration tSETTLING (4) Settling time (full scale: for a 10-bit input code transition between the lowest and the highest input codes when DAC_OUT reaches final value ±4LSB - 3 6 μs CLOAD ≤ 50 pF, RLOAD ≥ 5 kΩ THD(4) Total Harmonic Distortion Buffer ON - - - dB CLOAD ≤ 50 pF, RLOAD ≥ 5 kΩ Table 74. DAC characteristics (continued) Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Comments DocID022152 Rev 4 137/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 54. 12-bit buffered /non-buffered DAC 1. The DAC integrates an output buffer that can be used to reduce the output impedance and to drive external loads directly without the use of an external operational amplifier. The buffer can be bypassed by configuring the BOFFx bit in the DAC_CR register. 5.3.25 FSMC characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 75 to Table 86 for the FSMC interface are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fHCLK frequency and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14, with the following configuration: • Output speed is set to OSPEEDRy[1:0] = 10 • Capacitive load C = 30 pF • Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.5VDD Refer to Section Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output characteristics. Update rate(2) Max frequency for a correct DAC_OUT change when small variation in the input code (from code i to i+1LSB) - - 1 MS/s CLOAD ≤ 50 pF, RLOAD ≥ 5 kΩ tWAKEUP (4) Wakeup time from off state (Setting the ENx bit in the DAC Control register) - 6.5 10 μs CLOAD ≤ 50 pF, RLOAD ≥ 5 kΩ input code between lowest and highest possible ones. PSRR+ (2) Power supply rejection ratio (to VDDA) (static DC measurement) - –67 –40 dB No RLOAD, CLOAD = 50 pF 1. VDD/VDDA minimum value of 1.7 V is obtained when the device operates in reduced temperature range, and with the use of an external power supply supervisor (refer to Section : Internal reset OFF). 2. Guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 3. The quiescent mode corresponds to a state where the DAC maintains a stable output level to ensure that no dynamic consumption occurs. 4. Guaranteed by characterization, not tested in production. Table 74. DAC characteristics (continued) Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit Comments RLOAD CLOAD Buffered/Non-buffered DAC DACx_OUT Buffer(1) 12-bit digital to analog converter ai17157 Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 138/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Asynchronous waveforms and timings Figure 55 through Figure 58 represent asynchronous waveforms and Table 75 through Table 78 provide the corresponding timings. The results shown in these tables are obtained with the following FSMC configuration: • AddressSetupTime = 1 • AddressHoldTime = 0x1 • DataSetupTime = 0x1 • BusTurnAroundDuration = 0x0 In all timing tables, the THCLK is the HCLK clock period. Figure 55. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR read waveforms 1. Mode 2/B, C and D only. In Mode 1, FSMC_NADV is not used. Table 75. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR read timings(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(NE) FSMC_NE low time 2THCLK–0.5 2 THCLK+1 ns tv(NOE_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NOE low 0.5 3 ns tw(NOE) FSMC_NOE low time 2THCLK–2 2THCLK+ 2 ns th(NE_NOE) FSMC_NOE high to FSMC_NE high hold time 0 - ns tv(A_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_A valid - 4.5 ns th(A_NOE) Address hold time after FSMC_NOE high 4 - ns Data FSMC_NE FSMC_NBL[1:0] FSMC_D[15:0] tv(BL_NE) t h(Data_NE) FSMC_NOE FSMC_A[25:0] Address tv(A_NE) FSMC_NWE tsu(Data_NE) tw(NE) ai14991c tv(NOE_NE) t w(NOE) t h(NE_NOE) th(Data_NOE) t h(A_NOE) t h(BL_NOE) tsu(Data_NOE) FSMC_NADV(1) t v(NADV_NE) tw(NADV) DocID022152 Rev 4 139/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 56. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR write waveforms 1. Mode 2/B, C and D only. In Mode 1, FSMC_NADV is not used. tv(BL_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_BL valid - 1.5 ns th(BL_NOE) FSMC_BL hold time after FSMC_NOE high 0 - ns tsu(Data_NE) Data to FSMC_NEx high setup time THCLK+4 - ns tsu(Data_NOE) Data to FSMC_NOEx high setup time THCLK+4 - ns th(Data_NOE) Data hold time after FSMC_NOE high 0 - ns th(Data_NE) Data hold time after FSMC_NEx high 0 - ns tv(NADV_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NADV low - 2 ns tw(NADV) FSMC_NADV low time - THCLK ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 76. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR write timings(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(NE) FSMC_NE low time 3THCLK 3THCLK+ 4 ns tv(NWE_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NWE low THCLK–0.5 THCLK+0.5 ns tw(NWE) FSMC_NWE low time THCLK–1 THCLK+2 ns th(NE_NWE) FSMC_NWE high to FSMC_NE high hold time THCLK–1 - ns tv(A_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_A valid - 0 ns Table 75. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR read timings(1)(2) NBL Data FSMC_NEx FSMC_NBL[1:0] FSMC_D[15:0] tv(BL_NE) th(Data_NWE) FSMC_NOE FSMC_A[25:0] Address tv(A_NE) tw(NWE) FSMC_NWE tv(NWE_NE) t h(NE_NWE) th(A_NWE) th(BL_NWE) tv(Data_NE) tw(NE) ai14990 FSMC_NADV(1) t v(NADV_NE) tw(NADV) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 140/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 57. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR read waveforms th(A_NWE) Address hold time after FSMC_NWE high THCLK– 2 - ns tv(BL_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_BL valid - 1.5 ns th(BL_NWE) FSMC_BL hold time after FSMC_NWE high THCLK– 1 - ns tv(Data_NE) Data to FSMC_NEx low to Data valid - THCLK+3 ns th(Data_NWE) Data hold time after FSMC_NWE high THCLK–1 - ns tv(NADV_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NADV low - 2 ns tw(NADV) FSMC_NADV low time - THCLK+0.5 ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 77. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR read timings(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(NE) FSMC_NE low time 3THCLK–1 3THCLK+1 ns tv(NOE_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NOE low 2THCLK–0.5 2THCLK+0.5 ns tw(NOE) FSMC_NOE low time THCLK–1 THCLK+1 ns th(NE_NOE) FSMC_NOE high to FSMC_NE high hold time 0 - ns tv(A_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_A valid - 3 ns Table 76. Asynchronous non-multiplexed SRAM/PSRAM/NOR write timings(1)(2) NBL Data FSMC_NBL[1:0] FSMC_AD[15:0] tv(BL_NE) th(Data_NE) FSMC_A[25:16] Address tv(A_NE) FSMC_NWE t v(A_NE) ai14892b Address FSMC_NADV t v(NADV_NE) tw(NADV) tsu(Data_NE) th(AD_NADV) FSMC_NE FSMC_NOE tw(NE) t w(NOE) tv(NOE_NE) t h(NE_NOE) th(A_NOE) th(BL_NOE) tsu(Data_NOE) th(Data_NOE) DocID022152 Rev 4 141/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 58. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR write waveforms tv(NADV_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NADV low 1 2 ns tw(NADV) FSMC_NADV low time THCLK– 2 THCLK+1 ns th(AD_NADV) FSMC_AD(adress) valid hold time after FSMC_NADV high) THCLK - ns th(A_NOE) Address hold time after FSMC_NOE high THCLK–1 - ns th(BL_NOE) FSMC_BL time after FSMC_NOE high 0 - ns tv(BL_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_BL valid - 2 ns tsu(Data_NE) Data to FSMC_NEx high setup time THCLK+4 - ns tsu(Data_NOE) Data to FSMC_NOE high setup time THCLK+4 - ns th(Data_NE) Data hold time after FSMC_NEx high 0 - ns th(Data_NOE) Data hold time after FSMC_NOE high 0 - ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 78. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR write timings(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(NE) FSMC_NE low time 4THCLK–0.5 4THCLK+3 ns tv(NWE_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NWE low THCLK–0.5 THCLK -0.5 ns tw(NWE) FSMC_NWE low tim e 2THCLK–0.5 2THCLK+3 ns Table 77. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR read timings(1)(2) (continued) NBL Data FSMC_NEx FSMC_NBL[1:0] FSMC_AD[15:0] tv(BL_NE) th(Data_NWE) FSMC_NOE FSMC_A[25:16] Address tv(A_NE) tw(NWE) FSMC_NWE tv(NWE_NE) t h(NE_NWE) th(A_NWE) th(BL_NWE) t v(A_NE) tw(NE) ai14891B Address FSMC_NADV t v(NADV_NE) tw(NADV) t v(Data_NADV) th(AD_NADV) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 142/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Synchronous waveforms and timings Figure 59 through Figure 62 represent synchronous waveforms and Table 80 through Table 82 provide the corresponding timings. The results shown in these tables are obtained with the following FSMC configuration: • BurstAccessMode = FSMC_BurstAccessMode_Enable; • MemoryType = FSMC_MemoryType_CRAM; • WriteBurst = FSMC_WriteBurst_Enable; • CLKDivision = 1; (0 is not supported, see the STM32F40xxx/41xxx reference manual) • DataLatency = 1 for NOR Flash; DataLatency = 0 for PSRAM In all timing tables, the THCLK is the HCLK clock period (with maximum FSMC_CLK = 60 MHz). th(NE_NWE) FSMC_NWE high to FSMC_NE high hold time THCLK - ns tv(A_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_A valid - 0 ns tv(NADV_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_NADV low 1 2 ns tw(NADV) FSMC_NADV low time THCLK– 2 THCLK+ 1 ns th(AD_NADV) FSMC_AD(address) valid hold time after FSMC_NADV high) THCLK–2 - ns th(A_NWE) Address hold time after FSMC_NWE high THCLK - ns th(BL_NWE) FSMC_BL hold time after FSMC_NWE high THCLK–2 - ns tv(BL_NE) FSMC_NEx low to FSMC_BL valid - 1.5 ns tv(Data_NADV) FSMC_NADV high to Data valid - THCLK–0.5 ns th(Data_NWE) Data hold time after FSMC_NWE high THCLK - ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 78. Asynchronous multiplexed PSRAM/NOR write timings(1)(2) DocID022152 Rev 4 143/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 59. Synchronous multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings Table 79. Synchronous multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(CLK) FSMC_CLK period 2THCLK - ns td(CLKL-NExL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx low (x=0..2) - 0 ns td(CLKL-NExH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx high (x= 0…2) 2 - ns td(CLKL-NADVL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV low - 2 ns td(CLKL-NADVH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV high 2 - ns td(CLKL-AV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax valid (x=16…25) - 0 ns td(CLKL-AIV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax invalid (x=16…25) 0 - ns td(CLKL-NOEL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NOE low - 0 ns td(CLKL-NOEH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NOE high 2 - ns td(CLKL-ADV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_AD[15:0] valid - 4.5 ns td(CLKL-ADIV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_AD[15:0] invalid 0 - ns tsu(ADV-CLKH) FSMC_A/D[15:0] valid data before FSMC_CLK high 6 - ns FSMC_CLK FSMC_NEx FSMC_NADV FSMC_A[25:16] FSMC_NOE FSMC_AD[15:0] AD[15:0] D1 D2 FSMC_NWAIT (WAITCFG = 1b, WAITPOL + 0b) FSMC_NWAIT (WAITCFG = 0b, WAITPOL + 0b) tw(CLK) tw(CLK) Data latency = 0 BUSTURN = 0 td(CLKL-NExL) td(CLKL-NExH) td(CLKL-NADVL) td(CLKL-AV) td(CLKL-NADVH) td(CLKL-AIV) td(CLKL-NOEL) td(CLKL-NOEH) td(CLKL-ADV) td(CLKL-ADIV) tsu(ADV-CLKH) th(CLKH-ADV) tsu(ADV-CLKH) th(CLKH-ADV) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) th(CLKH-NWAITV) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) th(CLKH-NWAITV) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) th(CLKH-NWAITV) ai14893g Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 144/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 60. Synchronous multiplexed PSRAM write timings th(CLKH-ADV) FSMC_A/D[15:0] valid data after FSMC_CLK high 0 - ns tsu(NWAIT-CLKH) FSMC_NWAIT valid before FSMC_CLK high 4 - ns th(CLKH-NWAIT) FSMC_NWAIT valid after FSMC_CLK high 0 - ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 80. Synchronous multiplexed PSRAM write timings(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(CLK) FSMC_CLK period 2THCLK - ns td(CLKL-NExL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx low (x=0..2) - 1 ns td(CLKL-NExH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx high (x= 0…2) 1 - ns td(CLKL-NADVL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV low - 0 ns td(CLKL-NADVH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV high 0 - ns td(CLKL-AV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax valid (x=16…25) - 0 ns Table 79. Synchronous multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings(1)(2) (continued) FSMC_CLK FSMC_NEx FSMC_NADV FSMC_A[25:16] FSMC_NWE FSMC_AD[15:0] AD[15:0] D1 D2 FSMC_NWAIT (WAITCFG = 0b, WAITPOL + 0b) tw(CLK) tw(CLK) Data latency = 0 BUSTURN = 0 td(CLKL-NExL) td(CLKL-NExH) td(CLKL-NADVL) td(CLKL-AV) td(CLKL-NADVH) td(CLKL-AIV) td(CLKL-NWEL) td(CLKL-NWEH) td(CLKL-NBLH) td(CLKL-ADV) td(CLKL-ADIV) td(CLKL-Data) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) th(CLKH-NWAITV) ai14992g td(CLKL-Data) FSMC_NBL DocID022152 Rev 4 145/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 61. Synchronous non-multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings td(CLKL-AIV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax invalid (x=16…25) 8 - ns td(CLKL-NWEL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NWE low - 0.5 ns td(CLKL-NWEH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NWE high 0 - ns td(CLKL-ADIV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_AD[15:0] invalid 0 - ns td(CLKL-DATA) FSMC_A/D[15:0] valid data after FSMC_CLK low - 3 ns td(CLKL-NBLH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NBL high 0 - ns tsu(NWAIT-CLKH) FSMC_NWAIT valid before FSMC_CLK high 4 - ns th(CLKH-NWAIT) FSMC_NWAIT valid after FSMC_CLK high 0 - ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 81. Synchronous non-multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(CLK) FSMC_CLK period 2THCLK –0.5 - ns td(CLKL-NExL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx low (x=0..2) - 0.5 ns Table 80. Synchronous multiplexed PSRAM write timings(1)(2) FSMC_CLK FSMC_NEx FSMC_A[25:0] FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0] D1 D2 FSMC_NWAIT (WAITCFG = 1b, WAITPOL + 0b) FSMC_NWAIT (WAITCFG = 0b, WAITPOL + 0b) tw(CLK) tw(CLK) Data latency = 0 BUSTURN = 0 td(CLKL-NExL) td(CLKL-NExH) td(CLKL-AV) td(CLKL-AIV) td(CLKL-NOEL) td(CLKL-NOEH) tsu(DV-CLKH) th(CLKH-DV) tsu(DV-CLKH) th(CLKH-DV) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) th(CLKH-NWAITV) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) t h(CLKH-NWAITV) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) th(CLKH-NWAITV) ai14894f FSMC_NADV td(CLKL-NADVL) td(CLKL-NADVH) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 146/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 62. Synchronous non-multiplexed PSRAM write timings td(CLKL-NExH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx high (x= 0…2) 0 - ns td(CLKL-NADVL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV low - 2 ns td(CLKL-NADVH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV high 3 - ns td(CLKL-AV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax valid (x=16…25) - 0 ns td(CLKL-AIV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax invalid (x=16…25) 2 - ns td(CLKL-NOEL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NOE low - 0.5 ns td(CLKL-NOEH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NOE high 1.5 - ns tsu(DV-CLKH) FSMC_D[15:0] valid data before FSMC_CLK high 6 - ns th(CLKH-DV) FSMC_D[15:0] valid data after FSMC_CLK high 3 - ns tsu(NWAIT-CLKH) FSMC_NWAIT valid before FSMC_CLK high 4 - ns th(CLKH-NWAIT) FSMC_NWAIT valid after FSMC_CLK high 0 - ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Table 81. Synchronous non-multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings(1)(2) (continued) FSMC_CLK FSMC_NEx FSMC_A[25:0] FSMC_NWE FSMC_D[15:0] D1 D2 FSMC_NWAIT (WAITCFG = 0b, WAITPOL + 0b) tw(CLK) tw(CLK) Data latency = 0 BUSTURN = 0 td(CLKL-NExL) td(CLKL-NExH) td(CLKL-AV) td(CLKL-AIV) td(CLKL-NWEL) td(CLKL-NWEH) td(CLKL-Data) tsu(NWAITV-CLKH) th(CLKH-NWAITV) ai14993g FSMC_NADV td(CLKL-NADVL) td(CLKL-NADVH) td(CLKL-Data) FSMC_NBL td(CLKL-NBLH) DocID022152 Rev 4 147/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms and timings Figure 63 through Figure 68 represent synchronous waveforms, and Table 83 and Table 84 provide the corresponding timings. The results shown in this table are obtained with the following FSMC configuration: • COM.FSMC_SetupTime = 0x04; • COM.FSMC_WaitSetupTime = 0x07; • COM.FSMC_HoldSetupTime = 0x04; • COM.FSMC_HiZSetupTime = 0x00; • ATT.FSMC_SetupTime = 0x04; • ATT.FSMC_WaitSetupTime = 0x07; • ATT.FSMC_HoldSetupTime = 0x04; • ATT.FSMC_HiZSetupTime = 0x00; • IO.FSMC_SetupTime = 0x04; • IO.FSMC_WaitSetupTime = 0x07; • IO.FSMC_HoldSetupTime = 0x04; • IO.FSMC_HiZSetupTime = 0x00; • TCLRSetupTime = 0; • TARSetupTime = 0. In all timing tables, the THCLK is the HCLK clock period. Table 82. Synchronous non-multiplexed PSRAM write timings(1)(2) 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(CLK) FSMC_CLK period 2THCLK - ns td(CLKL-NExL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx low (x=0..2) - 1 ns td(CLKL-NExH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NEx high (x= 0…2) 1 - ns td(CLKL-NADVL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV low - 7 ns td(CLKL-NADVH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NADV high 6 - ns td(CLKL-AV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax valid (x=16…25) - 0 ns td(CLKL-AIV) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_Ax invalid (x=16…25) 6 - ns td(CLKL-NWEL) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NWE low - 1 ns td(CLKL-NWEH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NWE high 2 - ns td(CLKL-Data) FSMC_D[15:0] valid data after FSMC_CLK low - 3 ns td(CLKL-NBLH) FSMC_CLK low to FSMC_NBL high 3 - ns tsu(NWAIT-CLKH) FSMC_NWAIT valid before FSMC_CLK high 4 - ns th(CLKH-NWAIT) FSMC_NWAIT valid after FSMC_CLK high 0 - ns Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 148/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 63. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for common memory read access 1. FSMC_NCE4_2 remains high (inactive during 8-bit access. Figure 64. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for common memory write access FSMC_NWE tw(NOE) FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0] FSMC_A[10:0] FSMC_NCE4_2(1) FSMC_NCE4_1 FSMC_NREG FSMC_NIOWR FSMC_NIORD td(NCE4_1-NOE) tsu(D-NOE) th(NOE-D) tv(NCEx-A) td(NREG-NCEx) td(NIORD-NCEx) th(NCEx-AI) th(NCEx-NREG) th(NCEx-NIORD) th(NCEx-NIOWR) ai14895b td(NCE4_1-NWE) tw(NWE) th(NWE-D) tv(NCE4_1-A) td(NREG-NCE4_1) td(NIORD-NCE4_1) th(NCE4_1-AI) MEMxHIZ =1 tv(NWE-D) th(NCE4_1-NREG) th(NCE4_1-NIORD) th(NCE4_1-NIOWR) ai14896b FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0] FSMC_A[10:0] FSMC_NCE4_1 FSMC_NREG FSMC_NIOWR FSMC_NIORD td(NWE-NCE4_1) td(D-NWE) FSMC_NCE4_2 High DocID022152 Rev 4 149/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 65. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for attribute memory read access 1. Only data bits 0...7 are read (bits 8...15 are disregarded). td(NCE4_1-NOE) tw(NOE) tsu(D-NOE) th(NOE-D) tv(NCE4_1-A) th(NCE4_1-AI) td(NREG-NCE4_1) th(NCE4_1-NREG) ai14897b FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0](1) FSMC_A[10:0] FSMC_NCE4_2 FSMC_NCE4_1 FSMC_NREG FSMC_NIOWR FSMC_NIORD td(NOE-NCE4_1) High Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 150/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 66. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for attribute memory write access 1. Only data bits 0...7 are driven (bits 8...15 remains Hi-Z). Figure 67. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for I/O space read access tw(NWE) tv(NCE4_1-A) td(NREG-NCE4_1) th(NCE4_1-AI) th(NCE4_1-NREG) tv(NWE-D) ai14898b FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[7:0](1) FSMC_A[10:0] FSMC_NCE4_2 FSMC_NCE4_1 FSMC_NREG FSMC_NIOWR FSMC_NIORD td(NWE-NCE4_1) High td(NCE4_1-NWE) td(NIORD-NCE4_1) tw(NIORD) tsu(D-NIORD) td(NIORD-D) tv(NCEx-A) th(NCE4_1-AI) ai14899B FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0] FSMC_A[10:0] FSMC_NCE4_2 FSMC_NCE4_1 FSMC_NREG FSMC_NIOWR FSMC_NIORD DocID022152 Rev 4 151/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 68. PC Card/CompactFlash controller waveforms for I/O space write access td(NCE4_1-NIOWR) tw(NIOWR) tv(NCEx-A) th(NCE4_1-AI) th(NIOWR-D) ATTxHIZ =1 tv(NIOWR-D) ai14900c FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0] FSMC_A[10:0] FSMC_NCE4_2 FSMC_NCE4_1 FSMC_NREG FSMC_NIOWR FSMC_NIORD Table 83. Switching characteristics for PC Card/CF read and write cycles in attribute/common space(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tv(NCEx-A) FSMC_Ncex low to FSMC_Ay valid - 0 ns th(NCEx_AI) FSMC_NCEx high to FSMC_Ax invalid 4 - ns td(NREG-NCEx) FSMC_NCEx low to FSMC_NREG valid - 3.5 ns th(NCEx-NREG) FSMC_NCEx high to FSMC_NREG invalid THCLK+4 - ns td(NCEx-NWE) FSMC_NCEx low to FSMC_NWE low - 5THCLK+0.5 ns td(NCEx-NOE) FSMC_NCEx low to FSMC_NOE low - 5THCLK +0.5 ns tw(NOE) FSMC_NOE low width 8THCLK–1 8THCLK+1 ns td(NOE_NCEx) FSMC_NOE high to FSMC_NCEx high 5THCLK+2.5 - ns tsu (D-NOE) FSMC_D[15:0] valid data before FSMC_NOE high 4.5 - ns th(N0E-D) FSMC_N0E high to FSMC_D[15:0] invalid 3 - ns tw(NWE) FSMC_NWE low width 8THCLK–0.5 8THCLK+ 3 ns td(NWE_NCEx) FSMC_NWE high to FSMC_NCEx high 5THCLK–1 - ns td(NCEx-NWE) FSMC_NCEx low to FSMC_NWE low - 5THCLK+ 1 ns tv(NWE-D) FSMC_NWE low to FSMC_D[15:0] valid - 0 ns th (NWE-D) FSMC_NWE high to FSMC_D[15:0] invalid 8THCLK –1 - ns td (D-NWE) FSMC_D[15:0] valid before FSMC_NWE high 13THCLK –1 - ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 152/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 NAND controller waveforms and timings Figure 69 through Figure 72 represent synchronous waveforms, and Table 85 and Table 86 provide the corresponding timings. The results shown in this table are obtained with the following FSMC configuration: • COM.FSMC_SetupTime = 0x01; • COM.FSMC_WaitSetupTime = 0x03; • COM.FSMC_HoldSetupTime = 0x02; • COM.FSMC_HiZSetupTime = 0x01; • ATT.FSMC_SetupTime = 0x01; • ATT.FSMC_WaitSetupTime = 0x03; • ATT.FSMC_HoldSetupTime = 0x02; • ATT.FSMC_HiZSetupTime = 0x01; • Bank = FSMC_Bank_NAND; • MemoryDataWidth = FSMC_MemoryDataWidth_16b; • ECC = FSMC_ECC_Enable; • ECCPageSize = FSMC_ECCPageSize_512Bytes; • TCLRSetupTime = 0; • TARSetupTime = 0. In all timing tables, the THCLK is the HCLK clock period. Table 84. Switching characteristics for PC Card/CF read and write cycles in I/O space(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(NIOWR) FSMC_NIOWR low width 8THCLK –1 - ns tv(NIOWR-D) FSMC_NIOWR low to FSMC_D[15:0] valid - 5THCLK– 1 ns th(NIOWR-D) FSMC_NIOWR high to FSMC_D[15:0] invalid 8THCLK– 2 - ns td(NCE4_1-NIOWR) FSMC_NCE4_1 low to FSMC_NIOWR valid - 5THCLK+ 2.5 ns th(NCEx-NIOWR) FSMC_NCEx high to FSMC_NIOWR invalid 5THCLK–1.5 - ns td(NIORD-NCEx) FSMC_NCEx low to FSMC_NIORD valid - 5THCLK+ 2 ns th(NCEx-NIORD) FSMC_NCEx high to FSMC_NIORD) valid 5THCLK– 1.5 - ns tw(NIORD) FSMC_NIORD low width 8THCLK–0.5 - ns tsu(D-NIORD) FSMC_D[15:0] valid before FSMC_NIORD high 9 - ns td(NIORD-D) FSMC_D[15:0] valid after FSMC_NIORD high 0 - ns 1. CL = 30 pF. 2. Based on characterization, not tested in production. DocID022152 Rev 4 153/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 69. NAND controller waveforms for read access Figure 70. NAND controller waveforms for write access FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE (NRE) FSMC_D[15:0] tsu(D-NOE) th(NOE-D) ai14901c ALE (FSMC_A17) CLE (FSMC_A16) FSMC_NCEx td(ALE-NOE) th(NOE-ALE) tv(NWE-D) th(NWE-D) ai14902c FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE (NRE) FSMC_D[15:0] ALE (FSMC_A17) CLE (FSMC_A16) FSMC_NCEx td(ALE-NWE) th(NWE-ALE) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 154/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 71. NAND controller waveforms for common memory read access Figure 72. NAND controller waveforms for common memory write access Table 85. Switching characteristics for NAND Flash read cycles(1) 1. CL = 30 pF. Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(N0E) FSMC_NOE low width 4THCLK– 0.5 4THCLK+ 3 ns tsu(D-NOE) FSMC_D[15-0] valid data before FSMC_NOE high 10 - ns th(NOE-D) FSMC_D[15-0] valid data after FSMC_NOE high 0 - ns td(ALE-NOE) FSMC_ALE valid before FSMC_NOE low - 3THCLK ns th(NOE-ALE) FSMC_NWE high to FSMC_ALE invalid 3THCLK– 2 - ns FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0] tw(NOE) tsu(D-NOE) th(NOE-D) ai14912c ALE (FSMC_A17) CLE (FSMC_A16) FSMC_NCEx td(ALE-NOE) th(NOE-ALE) tw(NWE) tv(NWE-D) th(NWE-D) ai14913c FSMC_NWE FSMC_NOE FSMC_D[15:0] td(D-NWE) ALE (FSMC_A17) CLE (FSMC_A16) FSMC_NCEx td(ALE-NOE) th(NOE-ALE) DocID022152 Rev 4 155/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics 5.3.26 Camera interface (DCMI) timing specifications Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 87 for DCMI are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fHCLK frequency and VDD supply voltage summarized in Table 13, with the following configuration: • PCK polarity: falling • VSYNC and HSYNC polarity: high • Data format: 14 bits Figure 73. DCMI timing diagram Table 86. Switching characteristics for NAND Flash write cycles(1) 1. CL = 30 pF. Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tw(NWE) FSMC_NWE low width 4THCLK–1 4THCLK+ 3 ns tv(NWE-D) FSMC_NWE low to FSMC_D[15-0] valid - 0 ns th(NWE-D) FSMC_NWE high to FSMC_D[15-0] invalid 3THCLK –2 - ns td(D-NWE) FSMC_D[15-0] valid before FSMC_NWE high 5THCLK–3 - ns td(ALE-NWE) FSMC_ALE valid before FSMC_NWE low - 3THCLK ns th(NWE-ALE) FSMC_NWE high to FSMC_ALE invalid 3THCLK–2 - ns Table 87. DCMI characteristics(1) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit Frequency ratio DCMI_PIXCLK/fHCLK - 0.4 DCMI_PIXCLK Pixel clock input - 54 MHz Dpixel Pixel clock input duty cycle 30 70 % MS32414V1 Pixel clock tsu(VSYNC) tsu(HSYNC) HSYNC VSYNC DATA[0:13] 1/DCMI_PIXCLK th(HSYNC) th(HSYNC) tsu(DATA) th(DATA) Electrical characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 156/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 5.3.27 SD/SDIO MMC card host interface (SDIO) characteristics Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 88 are derived from tests performed under ambient temperature, fPCLKx frequency and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14 with the following configuration: • Output speed is set to OSPEEDRy[1:0] = 10 • Capacitive load C = 30 pF • Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.5VDD Refer to Section 5.3.16: I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output characteristics. Figure 74. SDIO high-speed mode tsu(DATA) Data input setup time 2.5 - ns th(DATA) Data hold time 1 - tsu(HSYNC), tsu(VSYNC) HSYNC/VSYNC input setup time 2 - th(HSYNC), th(VSYNC) HSYNC/VSYNC input hold time 0.5 - 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. Table 87. DCMI characteristics(1) (continued) Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit tW(CKH) CK D, CMD (output) D, CMD (input) tC tW(CKL) tOV tOH tISU tIH tf tr ai14887 DocID022152 Rev 4 157/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Electrical characteristics Figure 75. SD default mode 5.3.28 RTC characteristics CK D, CMD (output) tOVD tOHD ai14888 Table 88. Dynamic characteristics: SD / MMC characteristics(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit fPP Clock frequency in data transfer mode 0 48 MHz SDIO_CK/fPCLK2 frequency ratio - - 8/3 - tW(CKL) Clock low time fpp = 48 MHz 8.5 9 - ns tW(CKH) Clock high time fpp = 48 MHz 8.3 10 - CMD, D inputs (referenced to CK) in MMC and SD HS mode tISU Input setup time HS fpp = 48 MHz 3 - - ns tIH Input hold time HS fpp = 48 MHz 0 - - CMD, D outputs (referenced to CK) in MMC and SD HS mode tOV Output valid time HS fpp = 48 MHz - 4.5 6 ns tOH Output hold time HS fpp = 48 MHz 1 - - CMD, D inputs (referenced to CK) in SD default mode tISUD Input setup time SD fpp = 24 MHz 1.5 - - ns tIHD Input hold time SD fpp = 24 MHz 0.5 - - CMD, D outputs (referenced to CK) in SD default mode tOVD Output valid default time SD fpp = 24 MHz - 4.5 7 ns tOHD Output hold default time SD fpp = 24 MHz 0.5 - - 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. Table 89. RTC characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max - fPCLK1/RTCCLK frequency ratio Any read/write operation from/to an RTC register 4 - Package characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 158/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 6 Package characteristics 6.1 Package mechanical data In order to meet environmental requirements, ST offers these devices in different grades of ECOPACK® packages, depending on their level of environmental compliance. ECOPACK® specifications, grade definitions and product status are available at: www.st.com. ECOPACK® is an ST trademark. DocID022152 Rev 4 159/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Package characteristics Figure 76. WLCSP90 - 0.400 mm pitch wafer level chip size package outline Bump side Side view Detail A Wafer back side A1 ball location A1 Detail A rotated by 90 °C eee D A0JW_ME Seating plane A2 A b E e e1 e G F e2 Table 90. WLCSP90 - 0.400 mm pitch wafer level chip size package mechanical data Symbol millimeters inches(1) Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 0.520 0.570 0.620 0.0205 0.0224 0.0244 A1 0.165 0.190 0.215 0.0065 0.0075 0.0085 A2 0.350 0.380 0.410 0.0138 0.015 0.0161 b 0.240 0.270 0.300 0.0094 0.0106 0.0118 D 4.178 4.218 4.258 0.1645 0.1661 0.1676 E 3.964 3.969 4.004 0.1561 0.1563 0.1576 e 0.400 0.0157 e1 3.600 0.1417 e2 3.200 0.126 F 0.312 0.0123 G 0.385 0.0152 eee 0.050 0.0020 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. Package characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 160/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 77. LQFP64 – 10 x 10 mm 64 pin low-profile quad flat package outline 1. Drawing is not to scale. ai14398b A A2 A1 c L1 L E E1 D D1 e b Table 91. LQFP64 – 10 x 10 mm 64 pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data Symbol millimeters inches(1) Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 1.600 0.0630 A1 0.050 0.150 0.0020 0.0059 A2 1.350 1.400 1.450 0.0531 0.0551 0.0571 b 0.170 0.220 0.270 0.0067 0.0087 0.0106 c 0.090 0.200 0.0035 0.0079 D 12.000 0.4724 D1 10.000 0.3937 E 12.000 0.4724 E1 10.000 0.3937 e 0.500 0.0197 θ 0° 3.5° 7° 0° 3.5° 7° L 0.450 0.600 0.750 0.0177 0.0236 0.0295 L1 1.000 0.0394 N Number of pins 64 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. DocID022152 Rev 4 161/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Package characteristics Figure 78. LQFP64 recommended footprint 1. Drawing is not to scale. 2. Dimensions are in millimeters. 48 49 32 64 17 1 16 1.2 0.3 33 10.3 12.7 10.3 0.5 7.8 12.7 ai14909 Package characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 162/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 79. LQFP100, 14 x 14 mm 100-pin low-profile quad flat package outline 1. Drawing is not to scale. IDENTIFICATION e PIN 1 GAUGE PLANE 0.25 mm SEATING PLANE D D1 D3 E3 E1 E K ccc C C 1 25 100 26 76 75 51 50 1L_ME_V4 A2 A A1 L1 L c b A1 Table 92. LQPF100 – 14 x 14 mm 100-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data(1) Symbol millimeters inches Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 1.600 0.0630 A1 0.050 0.150 0.0020 0.0059 A2 1.350 1.400 1.450 0.0531 0.0551 0.0571 b 0.170 0.220 0.270 0.0067 0.0087 0.0106 c 0.090 0.200 0.0035 0.0079 D 15.800 16.000 16.200 0.6220 0.6299 0.6378 D1 13.800 14.000 14.200 0.5433 0.5512 0.5591 D3 12.000 0.4724 E 15.80v 16.000 16.200 0.6220 0.6299 0.6378 E1 13.800 14.000 14.200 0.5433 0.5512 0.5591 E3 12.000 0.4724 e 0.500 0.0197 L 0.450 0.600 0.750 0.0177 0.0236 0.0295 L1 1.000 0.0394 k 0° 3.5° 7° 0° 3.5° 7° ccc 0.080 0.0031 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. DocID022152 Rev 4 163/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Package characteristics Figure 80. LQFP100 recommended footprint 1. Drawing is not to scale. 2. Dimensions are in millimeters. 75 51 76 50 0.5 0.3 16.7 14.3 100 26 12.3 25 1.2 16.7 1 ai14906 Package characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 164/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 81. LQFP144, 20 x 20 mm, 144-pin low-profile quad flat package outline 1. Drawing is not to scale. D1 D3 D E3 E1 E e Pin 1 identification 73 72 37 36 109 144 108 1 A A2A1 b c A1 L L1 k Seating plane C ccc C 0.25 mm gage plane ME_1A Table 93. LQFP144, 20 x 20 mm, 144-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data Symbol millimeters inches(1) Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 1.600 0.0630 A1 0.050 0.150 0.0020 0.0059 A2 1.350 1.400 1.450 0.0531 0.0551 0.0571 b 0.170 0.220 0.270 0.0067 0.0087 0.0106 c 0.090 0.200 0.0035 0.0079 D 21.800 22.000 22.200 0.8583 0.8661 0.874 D1 19.800 20.000 20.200 0.7795 0.7874 0.7953 D3 17.500 0.689 E 21.800 22.000 22.200 0.8583 0.8661 0.8740 E1 19.800 20.000 20.200 0.7795 0.7874 0.7953 E3 17.500 0.6890 e 0.500 0.0197 L 0.450 0.600 0.750 0.0177 0.0236 0.0295 L1 1.000 0.0394 DocID022152 Rev 4 165/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Package characteristics Figure 82. LQFP144 recommended footprint 1. Drawing is not to scale. 2. Dimensions are in millimeters. k 0° 3.5° 7° 0° 3.5° 7° ccc 0.080 0.0031 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. Table 93. LQFP144, 20 x 20 mm, 144-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data Symbol millimeters inches(1) Min Typ Max Min Typ Max ai14905c 0.5 0.35 19.9 17.85 22.6 1.35 22.6 19.9 1 36 37 72 108 73 109 144 Package characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 166/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 83. UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm, package outline 1. Drawing is not to scale. Table 94. UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm mechanical data Symbol millimeters inches(1) 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 0.460 0.530 0.600 0.0181 0.0209 0.0236 A1 0.050 0.080 0.110 0.002 0.0031 0.0043 A2 0.400 0.450 0.500 0.0157 0.0177 0.0197 b 0.230 0.280 0.330 0.0091 0.0110 0.0130 D 9.900 10.000 10.100 0.3898 0.3937 0.3976 E 9.900 10.000 10.100 0.3898 0.3937 0.3976 e 0.650 0.0256 F 0.425 0.450 0.475 0.0167 0.0177 0.0187 ddd 0.080 0.0031 eee 0.150 0.0059 fff 0.080 0.0031 A0E7_ME_V4 Seating plane A2 ddd C A1 A e F F e R A 15 1 BOTTOM VIEW E D TOP VIEW Øb (176 + 25 balls) B A Ø eee M B Ø fff M C C A C A1 ball identifier A1 ball index area DocID022152 Rev 4 167/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Package characteristics Figure 84. LQFP176 24 x 24 mm, 176-pin low-profile quad flat package outline 1. Drawing is not to scale. ccc C C Seating plane A A2 A1 c 0.25 mm gauge plane HD D A1 L L1 k 89 88 E HE 45 44 e 1 176 Pin 1 identification b 133 132 1T_ME ZD ZE Table 95. LQFP176, 24 x 24 mm, 176-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data Symbol millimeters inches(1) Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 1.600 0.0630 A1 0.050 0.150 0.0020 A2 1.350 1.450 0.0531 0.0060 b 0.170 0.270 0.0067 0.0106 C 0.090 0.200 0.0035 0.0079 D 23.900 24.100 0.9409 0.9488 E 23.900 24.100 0.9409 0.9488 e 0.500 0.0197 HD 25.900 26.100 1.0200 1.0276 HE 25.900 26.100 1.0200 1.0276 L 0.450 0.750 0.0177 0.0295 L1 1.000 0.0394 ZD 1.250 0.0492 ZE 1.250 0.0492 Package characteristics STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 168/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 85. LQFP176 recommended footprint 1. Dimensions are expressed in millimeters. ccc 0.080 0.0031 k 0 ° 7 ° 0 ° 7 ° 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. Table 95. LQFP176, 24 x 24 mm, 176-pin low-profile quad flat package mechanical data Symbol millimeters inches(1) Min Typ Max Min Typ Max 1T_FP_V1 133 132 1.2 0.3 0.5 89 88 1.2 44 45 21.8 26.7 1 176 26.7 21.8 DocID022152 Rev 4 169/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Package characteristics 6.2 Thermal characteristics The maximum chip-junction temperature, TJ max, in degrees Celsius, may be calculated using the following equation: TJ max = TA max + (PD max x ΘJA) Where: • TA max is the maximum ambient temperature in °C, • ΘJA is the package junction-to-ambient thermal resistance, in °C/W, • PD max is the sum of PINT max and PI/O max (PD max = PINT max + PI/Omax), • PINT max is the product of IDD and VDD, expressed in Watts. This is the maximum chip internal power. PI/O max represents the maximum power dissipation on output pins where: PI/O max = Σ (VOL × IOL) + Σ((VDD – VOH) × IOH), taking into account the actual VOL / IOL and VOH / IOH of the I/Os at low and high level in the application. Reference document JESD51-2 Integrated Circuits Thermal Test Method Environment Conditions - Natural Convection (Still Air). Available from www.jedec.org. Table 96. Package thermal characteristics Symbol Parameter Value Unit ΘJA Thermal resistance junction-ambient LQFP64 - 10 × 10 mm / 0.5 mm pitch 46 °C/W Thermal resistance junction-ambient LQFP100 - 14 × 14 mm / 0.5 mm pitch 43 Thermal resistance junction-ambient LQFP144 - 20 × 20 mm / 0.5 mm pitch 40 Thermal resistance junction-ambient LQFP176 - 24 × 24 mm / 0.5 mm pitch 38 Thermal resistance junction-ambient UFBGA176 - 10× 10 mm / 0.65 mm pitch 39 Thermal resistance junction-ambient WLCSP90 - 0.400 mm pitch 38.1 Part numbering STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 170/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 7 Part numbering For a list of available options (speed, package, etc.) or for further information on any aspect of this device, please contact your nearest ST sales office. Table 97. Ordering information scheme Example: STM32 F 405 R E T 6 xxx Device family STM32 = ARM-based 32-bit microcontroller Product type F = general-purpose Device subfamily 405 = STM32F40x, connectivity 407= STM32F40x, connectivity, camera interface, Ethernet Pin count R = 64 pins O = 90 pins V = 100 pins Z = 144 pins I = 176 pins Flash memory size E = 512 Kbytes of Flash memory G = 1024 Kbytes of Flash memory Package T = LQFP H = UFBGA Y = WLCSP Temperature range 6 = Industrial temperature range, –40 to 85 °C. 7 = Industrial temperature range, –40 to 105 °C. Options xxx = programmed parts TR = tape and reel DocID022152 Rev 4 171/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Application block diagrams Appendix A Application block diagrams A.1 USB OTG full speed (FS) interface solutions Figure 86. USB controller configured as peripheral-only and used in Full speed mode 1. External voltage regulator only needed when building a VBUS powered device. 2. The same application can be developed using the OTG HS in FS mode to achieve enhanced performance thanks to the large Rx/Tx FIFO and to a dedicated DMA controller. Figure 87. USB controller configured as host-only and used in full speed mode 1. The current limiter is required only if the application has to support a VBUS powered device. A basic power switch can be used if 5 V are available on the application board. 2. The same application can be developed using the OTG HS in FS mode to achieve enhanced performance thanks to the large Rx/Tx FIFO and to a dedicated DMA controller. STM32F4xx 5V to VDD Volatge regulator (1) VDD VBUS DP VSS PA12/PB15 PA11//PB14 USB Std-B connector DM OSC_IN OSC_OUT MS19000V5 STM32F4xx VDD VBUS DP VSS USB Std-A connector DM GPIO+IRQ GPIO EN Overcurrent 5 V Pwr OSC_IN OSC_OUT MS19001V4 Current limiter power switch(1) PA12/PB15 PA11//PB14 Application block diagrams STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 172/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 Figure 88. USB controller configured in dual mode and used in full speed mode 1. External voltage regulator only needed when building a VBUS powered device. 2. The current limiter is required only if the application has to support a VBUS powered device. A basic power switch can be used if 5 V are available on the application board. 3. The ID pin is required in dual role only. 4. The same application can be developed using the OTG HS in FS mode to achieve enhanced performance thanks to the large Rx/Tx FIFO and to a dedicated DMA controller. STM32F4xx VDD VBUS DP VSS PA9/PB13 PA12/PB15 PA11/PB14 USB micro-AB connector DM GPIO+IRQ GPIO EN Overcurrent 5 V Pwr 5 V to VDD voltage regulator (1) VDD ID(3) PA10/PB12 OSC_IN OSC_OUT MS19002V3 Current limiter power switch(2) DocID022152 Rev 4 173/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Application block diagrams A.2 USB OTG high speed (HS) interface solutions Figure 89. USB controller configured as peripheral, host, or dual-mode and used in high speed mode 1. It is possible to use MCO1 or MCO2 to save a crystal. It is however not mandatory to clock the STM32F40x with a 24 or 26 MHz crystal when using USB HS. The above figure only shows an example of a possible connection. 2. The ID pin is required in dual role only. DP STM32F4xx DM VBUS VSS DM DP ID(2) USB USB HS OTG Ctrl FS PHY ULPI High speed OTG PHY ULPI_CLK ULPI_D[7:0] ULPI_DIR ULPI_STP ULPI_NXT not connected connector MCO1 or MCO2 24 or 26 MHz XT(1) PLL XT1 XI MS19005V2 Application block diagrams STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 174/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 A.3 Ethernet interface solutions Figure 90. MII mode using a 25 MHz crystal 1. fHCLK must be greater than 25 MHz. 2. Pulse per second when using IEEE1588 PTP optional signal. Figure 91. RMII with a 50 MHz oscillator 1. fHCLK must be greater than 25 MHz. MCU Ethernet MAC 10/100 Ethernet PHY 10/100 PLL HCLK XT1 PHY_CLK 25 MHz MII_RX_CLK MII_RXD[3:0] MII_RX_DV MII_RX_ER MII_TX_CLK MII_TX_EN MII_TXD[3:0] MII_CRS MII_COL MDIO MDC HCLK(1) PPS_OUT(2) XTAL 25 MHz STM32 OSC TIM2 Timestamp comparator Timer input trigger IEEE1588 PTP MII = 15 pins MII + MDC = 17 pins MS19968V1 MCO1/MCO2 MCU Ethernet MAC 10/100 Ethernet PHY 10/100 PLL HCLK PHY_CLK 50 MHz XT1 RMII_RXD[1:0] RMII_CRX_DV RMII_REF_CLK RMII_TX_EN RMII_TXD[1:0] MDIO MDC HCLK(1) STM32 OSC 50 MHz TIM2 Timestamp comparator Timer input trigger IEEE1588 PTP RMII = 7 pins RMII + MDC = 9 pins MS19969V1 /2 or /20 2.5 or 25 MHz synchronous 50 MHz 50 MHz DocID022152 Rev 4 175/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Application block diagrams Figure 92. RMII with a 25 MHz crystal and PHY with PLL 1. fHCLK must be greater than 25 MHz. 2. The 25 MHz (PHY_CLK) must be derived directly from the HSE oscillator, before the PLL block. MCU Ethernet MAC 10/100 Ethernet PHY 10/100 PLL HCLK PHY_CLK 25 MHz XT1 RMII_RXD[1:0] RMII_CRX_DV RMII_REF_CLK RMII_TX_EN RMII_TXD[1:0] MDIO MDC HCLK(1) STM32F TIM2 Timestamp comparator Timer input trigger IEEE1588 PTP RMII = 7 pins RMII + MDC = 9 pins MS19970V1 /2 or /20 2.5 or 25 MHz synchronous 50 MHz XTAL 25 MHz OSC PLL REF_CLK MCO1/MCO2 Revision history STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 176/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 8 Revision history Table 98. Document revision history Date Revision Changes 15-Sep-2011 1 Initial release. 24-Jan-2012 2 Added WLCSP90 package on cover page. Renamed USART4 and USART5 into UART4 and UART5, respectively. Updated number of USB OTG HS and FS in Table 2: STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts. Updated Figure 3: Compatible board design between STM32F10xx/STM32F2xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP144 package and Figure 4: Compatible board design between STM32F2xx and STM32F4xx for LQFP176 and BGA176 packages, and removed note 1 and 2. Updated Section 2.2.9: Flexible static memory controller (FSMC). Modified I/Os used to reprogram the Flash memory for CAN2 and USB OTG FS in Section 2.2.13: Boot modes. Updated note in Section 2.2.14: Power supply schemes. PDR_ON no more available on LQFP100 package. Updated Section 2.2.16: Voltage regulator. Updated condition to obtain a minimum supply voltage of 1.7 V in the whole document. Renamed USART4/5 to UART4/5 and added LIN and IrDA feature for UART4 and UART5 in Table 5: USART feature comparison. Removed support of I2C for OTG PHY in Section 2.2.30: Universal serial bus on-the-go full-speed (OTG_FS). Added Table 6: Legend/abbreviations used in the pinout table. Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions: replaced VSS_3, VSS_4, and VSS_8 by VSS; reformatted Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions to better highlight I/O structure, and alternate functions versus additional functions; signal corresponding to LQFP100 pin 99 changed from PDR_ON to VSS; EVENTOUT added in the list of alternate functions for all I/Os; ADC3_IN8 added as alternate function for PF10; FSMC_CLE and FSMC_ALE added as alternate functions for PD11 and PD12, respectively; PH10 alternate function TIM15_CH1_ETR renamed TIM5_CH1; updated PA4 and PA5 I/O structure to TTa. Removed OTG_HS_SCL, OTG_HS_SDA, OTG_FS_INTN in Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions and Table 9: Alternate function mapping. Changed TCM data RAM to CCM data RAM in Figure 18: STM32F40x memory map. Added IVDD and IVSS maximum values in Table 12: Current characteristics. Added Note 1 related to fHCLK, updated Note 2 in Table 14: General operating conditions, and added maximum power dissipation values. Updated Table 15: Limitations depending on the operating power supply range. DocID022152 Rev 4 177/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Revision history 24-Jan-2012 2 (continued) Added V12 in Table 19: Embedded reset and power control block characteristics. Updated Table 21: Typical and maximum current consumption in Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash memory (ART accelerator disabled) and Table 20: Typical and maximum current consumption in Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash memory (ART accelerator enabled) or RAM. Added Figure , Figure 25, Figure 26, and Figure 27. Updated Table 22: Typical and maximum current consumption in Sleep mode and removed Note 1. Updated Table 23: Typical and maximum current consumptions in Stop mode and Table 24: Typical and maximum current consumptions in Standby mode, Table 25: Typical and maximum current consumptions in VBAT mode, and Table 26: Switching output I/O current consumption. Section : On-chip peripheral current consumption: modified conditions, and updated Table 27: Peripheral current consumption and Note 2. Changed fHSE_ext to 50 MHz and tr(HSE)/tf(HSE) maximum value in Table 29: High-speed external user clock characteristics. Added Cin(LSE) in Table 30: Low-speed external user clock characteristics. Updated maximum PLL input clock frequency, removed related note, and deleted jitter for MCO for RMII Ethernet typical value in Table 35: Main PLL characteristics. Updated maximum PLLI2S input clock frequency and removed related note in Table 36: PLLI2S (audio PLL) characteristics. Updated Section : Flash memory to specify that the devices are shipped to customers with the Flash memory erased. Updated Table 38: Flash memory characteristics, and added tME in Table 39: Flash memory programming. Updated Table 42: EMS characteristics, and Table 43: EMI characteristics. Updated Table 56: I2S dynamic characteristics Updated Figure 46: ULPI timing diagram and Table 62: ULPI timing. Added tCOUNTER and tMAX_COUNT in Table 51: Characteristics of TIMx connected to the APB1 domain and Table 52: Characteristics of TIMx connected to the APB2 domain. Updated Table 65: Dynamic characteristics: Ethernet MAC signals for RMII. Removed USB-IF certification in Section : USB OTG FS characteristics. Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes Revision history STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 178/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 24-Jan-2012 2 (continued) Updated Table 61: USB HS clock timing parameters Updated Table 67: ADC characteristics. Updated Table 68: ADC accuracy at fADC = 30 MHz. Updated Note 1 in Table 74: DAC characteristics. Section 5.3.25: FSMC characteristics: updated Table 75 toTable 86, changed CL value to 30 pF, and modified FSMC configuration for asynchronous timings and waveforms. Updated Figure 60: Synchronous multiplexed PSRAM write timings. Updated Table 96: Package thermal characteristics. Appendix A.1: USB OTG full speed (FS) interface solutions: modified Figure 86: USB controller configured as peripheral-only and used in Full speed mode added Note 2, updated Figure 87: USB controller configured as host-only and used in full speed mode and added Note 2, changed Figure 88: USB controller configured in dual mode and used in full speed mode and added Note 3. Appendix A.2: USB OTG high speed (HS) interface solutions: removed figures USB OTG HS device-only connection in FS mode and USB OTG HS host-only connection in FS mode, and updated Figure 89: USB controller configured as peripheral, host, or dual-mode and used in high speed mode and added Note 2. Added Appendix A.3: Ethernet interface solutions. Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes DocID022152 Rev 4 179/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Revision history 31-May-2012 3 Updated Figure 5: STM32F40x block diagram and Figure 7: Power supply supervisor interconnection with internal reset OFF Added SDIO, added notes related to FSMC and SPI/I2S in Table 2: STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts. Starting from Silicon revision Z, USB OTG full-speed interface is now available for all STM32F405xx devices. Added full information on WLCSP90 package together with corresponding part numbers. Changed number of AHB buses to 3. Modified available Flash memory sizes in Section 2.2.4: Embedded Flash memory. Modified number of maskable interrupt channels in Section 2.2.10: Nested vectored interrupt controller (NVIC). Updated case of Regulator ON/internal reset ON, Regulator ON/internal reset OFF, and Regulator OFF/internal reset ON in Section 2.2.16: Voltage regulator. Updated standby mode description in Section 2.2.19: Low-power modes. Added Note 1 below Figure 16: STM32F40x UFBGA176 ballout. Added Note 1 below Figure 17: STM32F40x WLCSP90 ballout. Updated Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions. Added Table 8: FSMC pin definition. Removed OTG_HS_INTN alternate function in Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions and Table 9: Alternate function mapping. Removed I2S2_WS on PB6/AF5 in Table 9: Alternate function mapping. Replaced JTRST by NJTRST, removed ETH_RMII _TX_CLK, and modified I2S3ext_SD on PC11 in Table 9: Alternate function mapping. Added Table 10: STM32F40x register boundary addresses. Updated Figure 18: STM32F40x memory map. Updated VDDA and VREF+ decoupling capacitor in Figure 21: Power supply scheme. Added power dissipation maximum value for WLCSP90 in Table 14: General operating conditions. Updated VPOR/PDR in Table 19: Embedded reset and power control block characteristics. Updated notes in Table 21: Typical and maximum current consumption in Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash memory (ART accelerator disabled), Table 20: Typical and maximum current consumption in Run mode, code with data processing running from Flash memory (ART accelerator enabled) or RAM, and Table 22: Typical and maximum current consumption in Sleep mode. Updated maximum current consumption at TA = 25 °n Table 23: Typical and maximum current consumptions in Stop mode. Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes Revision history STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 180/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 31-May-2012 3 (continued) Removed fHSE_ext typical value in Table 29: High-speed external user clock characteristics. Updated Table 31: HSE 4-26 MHz oscillator characteristics and Table 32: LSE oscillator characteristics (fLSE = 32.768 kHz). Added fPLL48_OUT maximum value in Table 35: Main PLL characteristics. Modified equation 1 and 2 in Section 5.3.11: PLL spread spectrum clock generation (SSCG) characteristics. Updated Table 38: Flash memory characteristics, Table 39: Flash memory programming, and Table 40: Flash memory programming with VPP. Updated Section : Output driving current. Table 53: I2C characteristics: Note 4 updated and applied to th(SDA) in Fast mode, and removed note 4 related to th(SDA) minimum value. Updated Table 67: ADC characteristics. Updated note concerning ADC accuracy vs. negative injection current below Table 68: ADC accuracy at fADC = 30 MHz. Added WLCSP90 thermal resistance in Table 96: Package thermal characteristics. Updated Table 90: WLCSP90 - 0.400 mm pitch wafer level chip size package mechanical data. Updated Figure 83: UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm, package outline and Table 94: UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm mechanical data. Added Figure 85: LQFP176 recommended footprint. Removed 256 and 768 Kbyte Flash memory density from Table 97: Ordering information scheme. Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes DocID022152 Rev 4 181/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Revision history 04-Jun-2013 4 Modified Note 1 below Table 2: STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts. Updated Figure 4 title. Updated Note 3 below Figure 21: Power supply scheme. Changed simplex mode into half-duplex mode in Section 2.2.25: Interintegrated sound (I2S). Replaced DAC1_OUT and DAC2_OUT by DAC_OUT1 and DAC_OUT2, respectively. Updated pin 36 signal in Figure 15: STM32F40x LQFP176 pinout. Changed pin number from F8 to D4 for PA13 pin in Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions. Replaced TIM2_CH1/TIM2_ETR by TIM2_CH1_ETR for PA0 and PA5 pins in Table 9: Alternate function mapping. Changed system memory into System memory + OTP in Figure 18: STM32F40x memory map. Added Note 1 below Table 16: VCAP_1/VCAP_2 operating conditions. Updated IDDA description in Table 74: DAC characteristics. Removed PA9/PB13 connection to VBUS in Figure 86: USB controller configured as peripheral-only and used in Full speed mode and Figure 87: USB controller configured as host-only and used in full speed mode. Updated SPI throughput on front page and Section 2.2.24: Serial peripheral interface (SPI) Updated operating voltages in Table 2: STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts Updated note in Section 2.2.14: Power supply schemes Updated Section 2.2.15: Power supply supervisor Updated “Regulator ON” paragraph in Section 2.2.16: Voltage regulator Removed note in Section 2.2.19: Low-power modes Corrected wrong reference manual in Section 2.2.28: Ethernet MAC interface with dedicated DMA and IEEE 1588 support Updated Table 15: Limitations depending on the operating power supply range Updated Table 24: Typical and maximum current consumptions in Standby mode Updated Table 25: Typical and maximum current consumptions in VBAT mode Updated Table 36: PLLI2S (audio PLL) characteristics Updated Table 43: EMI characteristics Updated Table 48: Output voltage characteristics Updated Table 50: NRST pin characteristics Updated Table 55: SPI dynamic characteristics Updated Table 56: I2S dynamic characteristics Deleted Table 59 Updated Table 62: ULPI timing Updated Figure 47: Ethernet SMI timing diagram Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes Revision history STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 182/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 04-Jun-2013 4 (continued) Updated Figure 83: UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm, package outline Updated Table 94: UFBGA176+25 - ultra thin fine pitch ball grid array 10 × 10 × 0.6 mm mechanical data Updated Figure 5: STM32F40x block diagram Updated Section 2: Description Updated footnote (3) in Table 2: STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts Updated Figure 3: Compatible board design between STM32F10xx/STM32F2xx/STM32F4xx for LQFP144 package Updated Figure 4: Compatible board design between STM32F2xx and STM32F4xx for LQFP176 and BGA176 packages Updated Section 2.2.14: Power supply schemes Updated Section 2.2.15: Power supply supervisor Updated Section 2.2.16: Voltage regulator, including figures. Updated Table 14: General operating conditions, including footnote (2). Updated Table 15: Limitations depending on the operating power supply range, including footnote (3). Updated footnote (1) in Table 67: ADC characteristics. Updated footnote (3) in Table 68: ADC accuracy at fADC = 30 MHz. Updated footnote (1) in Table 74: DAC characteristics. Updated Figure 9: Regulator OFF. Updated Figure 7: Power supply supervisor interconnection with internal reset OFF. Added Section 2.2.17: Regulator ON/OFF and internal reset ON/OFF availability. Updated footnote (2) of Figure 21: Power supply scheme. Replaced respectively “I2S3S_WS" by "I2S3_WS”, “I2S3S_CK” by “I2S3_CK” and “FSMC_BLN1” by “FSMC_NBL1” in Table 9: Alternate function mapping. Added “EVENTOUT” as alternate function “AF15” for pin PC13, PC14, PC15, PH0, PH1, PI8 in Table 9: Alternate function mapping Replaced “DCMI_12” by “DCMI_D12” in Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions. Removed the following sentence from Section : I2C interface characteristics: ”Unless otherwise specified, the parameters given in Table 53 are derived from tests performed under the ambient temperature, fPCLK1 frequency and VDD supply voltage conditions summarized in Table 14.”. In Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions on page 45: – For pin PC13, replaced “RTC_AF1” by “RTC_OUT, RTC_TAMP1, RTC_TS” – for pin PI8, replaced “RTC_AF2” by “RTC_TAMP1, RTC_TAMP2, RTC_TS”. – for pin PB15, added RTC_REFIN in Alternate functions column. In Table 9: Alternate function mapping on page 60, for port PB15, replaced “RTC_50Hz” by “RTC_REFIN”. Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes DocID022152 Rev 4 183/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Revision history 04-Jun-2013 4 (continued) Updated Figure 6: Multi-AHB matrix. Updated Figure 7: Power supply supervisor interconnection with internal reset OFF Changed 1.2 V to V12 in Section : Regulator OFF Updated LQFP176 pin 48. Updated Section 1: Introduction. Updated Section 2: Description. Updated operating voltage in Table 2: STM32F405xx and STM32F407xx: features and peripheral counts. Updated Note 1. Updated Section 2.2.15: Power supply supervisor. Updated Section 2.2.16: Voltage regulator. Updated Figure 9: Regulator OFF. Updated Table 3: Regulator ON/OFF and internal reset ON/OFF availability. Updated Section 2.2.19: Low-power modes. Updated Section 2.2.20: VBAT operation. Updated Section 2.2.22: Inter-integrated circuit interface (I²C) . Updated pin 48 in Figure 15: STM32F40x LQFP176 pinout. Updated Table 6: Legend/abbreviations used in the pinout table. Updated Table 7: STM32F40x pin and ball definitions. Updated Table 14: General operating conditions. Updated Table 15: Limitations depending on the operating power supply range. Updated Section 5.3.7: Wakeup time from low-power mode. Updated Table 33: HSI oscillator characteristics. Updated Section 5.3.15: I/O current injection characteristics. Updated Table 47: I/O static characteristics. Updated Table 50: NRST pin characteristics. Updated Table 53: I2C characteristics. Updated Figure 39: I2C bus AC waveforms and measurement circuit. Updated Section 5.3.19: Communications interfaces. Updated Table 67: ADC characteristics. Added Table 70: Temperature sensor calibration values. Added Table 73: Internal reference voltage calibration values. Updated Section 5.3.25: FSMC characteristics. Updated Section 5.3.27: SD/SDIO MMC card host interface (SDIO) characteristics. Updated Table 23: Typical and maximum current consumptions in Stop mode. Updated Section : SPI interface characteristics included Table 55. Updated Section : I2S interface characteristics included Table 56. Updated Table 64: Dynamic characteristics: Ehternet MAC signals for SMI. Updated Table 66: Dynamic characteristics: Ethernet MAC signals for MII. Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes Revision history STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx 184/185 DocID022152 Rev 4 04-Jun-2013 4 (continued) Updated Table 64: Dynamic characteristics: Ehternet MAC signals for SMI. Updated Table 66: Dynamic characteristics: Ethernet MAC signals for MII. Updated Table 79: Synchronous multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings. Updated Table 80: Synchronous multiplexed PSRAM write timings. Updated Table 81: Synchronous non-multiplexed NOR/PSRAM read timings. Updated Table 82: Synchronous non-multiplexed PSRAM write timings. Updated Section 5.3.26: Camera interface (DCMI) timing specifications including Table 87: DCMI characteristics and addition of Figure 73: DCMI timing diagram. Updated Section 5.3.27: SD/SDIO MMC card host interface (SDIO) characteristics including Table 88. Updated Chapter Figure 9. Table 98. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes DocID022152 Rev 4 185/185 STM32F405xx, STM32F407xx Please Read Carefully: Information in this document is provided solely in connection with ST products. STMicroelectronics NV and its subsidiaries (“ST”) reserve the right to make changes, corrections, modifications or improvements, to this document, and the products and services described herein at any time, without notice. All ST products are sold pursuant to ST’s terms and conditions of sale. Purchasers are solely responsible for the choice, selection and use of the ST products and services described herein, and ST assumes no liability whatsoever relating to the choice, selection or use of the ST products and services described herein. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any intellectual property rights is granted under this document. If any part of this document refers to any third party products or services it shall not be deemed a license grant by ST for the use of such third party products or services, or any intellectual property contained therein or considered as a warranty covering the use in any manner whatsoever of such third party products or services or any intellectual property contained therein. UNLESS OTHERWISE SET FORTH IN ST’S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE ST DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY WITH RESPECT TO THE USE AND/OR SALE OF ST PRODUCTS INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE (AND THEIR EQUIVALENTS UNDER THE LAWS OF ANY JURISDICTION), OR INFRINGEMENT OF ANY PATENT, COPYRIGHT OR OTHER INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHT. ST PRODUCTS ARE NOT AUTHORIZED FOR USE IN WEAPONS. NOR ARE ST PRODUCTS DESIGNED OR AUTHORIZED FOR USE IN: (A) SAFETY CRITICAL APPLICATIONS SUCH AS LIFE SUPPORTING, ACTIVE IMPLANTED DEVICES OR SYSTEMS WITH PRODUCT FUNCTIONAL SAFETY REQUIREMENTS; (B) AERONAUTIC APPLICATIONS; (C) AUTOMOTIVE APPLICATIONS OR ENVIRONMENTS, AND/OR (D) AEROSPACE APPLICATIONS OR ENVIRONMENTS. WHERE ST PRODUCTS ARE NOT DESIGNED FOR SUCH USE, THE PURCHASER SHALL USE PRODUCTS AT PURCHASER’S SOLE RISK, EVEN IF ST HAS BEEN INFORMED IN WRITING OF SUCH USAGE, UNLESS A PRODUCT IS EXPRESSLY DESIGNATED BY ST AS BEING INTENDED FOR “AUTOMOTIVE, AUTOMOTIVE SAFETY OR MEDICAL” INDUSTRY DOMAINS ACCORDING TO ST PRODUCT DESIGN SPECIFICATIONS. PRODUCTS FORMALLY ESCC, QML OR JAN QUALIFIED ARE DEEMED SUITABLE FOR USE IN AEROSPACE BY THE CORRESPONDING GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY. Resale of ST products with provisions different from the statements and/or technical features set forth in this document shall immediately void any warranty granted by ST for the ST product or service described herein and shall not create or extend in any manner whatsoever, any liability of ST. ST and the ST logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of ST in various countries. Information in this document supersedes and replaces all information previously supplied. The ST logo is a registered trademark of STMicroelectronics. All other names are the property of their respective owners. © 2013 STMicroelectronics - All rights reserved STMicroelectronics group of companies Australia - Belgium - Brazil - Canada - China - Czech Republic - Finland - France - Germany - Hong Kong - India - Israel - Italy - Japan - Malaysia - Malta - Morocco - Philippines - Singapore - Spain - Sweden - Switzerland SIXTY User Guide LU Sixty.book Page 1 Mardi, 26. octobre 2010 2:22 14 1Couv.fm Page 1 Dimanche, 16. mai 2010 3:20 15 3 Dear customer, You have just acquired a new generation Sagemcom telephone and thank you for placing your confidence in us. This device has been manufactured with the utmost care. If you should have difficulties in operating it, we recommend that you consult this user manual. You can also find information on the following site: http://www.sagemcom.com/sixty To operate the device safely and easily, please read carefully the paragraph “Recommendations and safety instructions”, page 6. The CE label confirms that the product complies with the 1999/5/EC regulations of the European Union Parliament regarding wireless systems and telecommunications. The declaration of compliance may be looked up on the www.sagemcom.com website, or can be obtained from the following address : Sagemcom Broadband SAS 250, route de l'Empereur - 92848 Rueil-Malmaison Cedex - France Copyright © Sagemcom Broadband SAS All rights reserved Sagemcom is a registered trademark LU Sixty.book Page 3 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 4 Contents Recommendations and safety instructions .....................6 Unpacking .......................................................................8 Phone description ...........................................................8 Your base................................................................... 8 Your handset.............................................................. 9 Control panel............................................................ 10 Phone installation ............................................ 12 Connecting the base .....................................................12 Setting up the handset ..................................................12 Charging batteries .........................................................12 Settings required before use .........................................13 Navigating in the menu .................................................13 Menu structure ......................................................... 14 Browsing through the menus ................................... 14 Phone use......................................................... 15 Handset location ...........................................................15 Telephoning ..................................................................15 Receiving a call ........................................................ 15 Making a call ............................................................ 16 Ending a call............................................................. 16 During a call ............................................................. 16 Call key function....................................................... 17 Secret mode............................................................. 17 Hands-free/speakerphone mode.............................. 17 Calling the last number dialled ................................. 18 Call time display ....................................................... 18 Phonebook ....................................................... 18 Creating an entry ...........................................................18 Editing an entry .............................................................19 Associating a ring tone with a phonebook entry ............19 Other number ................................................................19 Deleting an entry ...........................................................19 Calling using the phonebook .........................................20 Searching for a contact .................................................20 Call log.............................................................. 20 Viewing the received and dialled call log ...................... 20 The events log .............................................................. 21 Viewing the events log............................................. 21 Activating/deactivating the new event information screen............................ 21 Clearing notifications ............................................... 21 Information .................................................................... 21 Accessories...................................................... 22 Alarm clock ................................................................... 22 Activating / deactivating the alarm clock.................. 22 Changing the alarm clock ring tone ......................... 22 Modifying the alarm clock time ................................ 22 Timer ............................................................................ 22 Activate the timer..................................................... 22 Changing the programmed time of the timer ........... 23 Displaying or hiding the programmed time of the timer............................................................... 23 Changing the timer ring tone ................................... 23 Ring tones ........................................................ 23 Changing the ring tones ............................................... 23 Activating or deactivating the beeps ............................. 23 Activating/deactivating the silent mode ........................ 24 Settings............................................................. 24 Modifying the date and time ......................................... 24 Adjusting the contrast ................................................... 24 Modifying the language ................................................ 24 the voice box number (according to operator) .............. 25 Defining forbidden prefixes - Call barring ..................... 25 Demo ............................................................................ 26 Advanced settings ........................................................ 26 Base settings ........................................................... 26 Line settings ............................................................ 27 Modifying the base code.......................................... 29 LU Sixty.book Page 4 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 5 Answering machine......................................... 29 Enabling / disabling the answering machine .................29 Modifying the OGM .......................................................30 Recording a personal outgoing message ................ 30 Deleting your personal OGM ................................... 30 Listen to a personal message .................................. 30 Playing messages .........................................................30 Remote access to answering machine .........................31 Deleting all the old messages .......................................31 TAM settings .................................................... 32 Activating and deactivating call screening ....................32 Modifying the remote access code ...............................32 Number of rings ............................................................32 Replacing the batteries................................... 33 Pairing GAP-compatible DECT handsets on the SIXTY base ........................................... 33 Appendix .......................................................... 34 Care and Maintenance ..................................................34 Problems .......................................................................34 Technical characteristics................................ 35 Initial condition .............................................................35 Environment..................................................... 36 Packaging .....................................................................36 Batteries and rechargeable batteries ............................36 The product ...................................................................36 Guarantee......................................................... 37 Terms and Conditions for United Kingdom & Ireland only ................................................................37 Terms and Conditions for other countries .....................39 LU SixtyTDM.fm Page 5 Jeudi, 20. mai 2010 9:03 09 6 RECOMMENDATIONS AND SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS Do not install your DECT telephone in a damp environment, such as a bathroom, washroom, kitchen etc, and not within 1.50 metres of a source of water or outside. This device is designed for use in temperatures of between 5 °C and 45 °C. Do not attempt to remove screws or open the appliance. It does not contain any user-replaceable parts. Only use the power unit supplied and connect it to the electricity mains in accordance with the installation instructions in this user manual and the details on the sticker regarding voltage, electrical current and frequency. As a precaution if there is a risk of danger, the power plug can be pulled out to disconnect the 230 volt power supply. Therefore the sockets should be near the device and easily accessible. This device is designed to be used for connecting to the public telephone network. If problems should arise, contact your nearest specialist dealer. Only use the telephone cable supplied. For safety reasons, never put the handset in the base station without the battery inserted or without the lid on the battery compartment as this could cause an electric shock. To avoid damaging your handset/base, only use certified rechargeable batteries NiMH 1.2 V 450 mAh, never use non rechargeable batteries. Insert the batteries in the handset/base battery compartment respecting polarity. The used battery must be disposed of in line with the recycling regulations in this user manual. Your DECT telephone has a range of approx. 50 metres indoors and up to 300 metres outdoors. The range can be affected by the proximity of metal objects, such as a television and electrical devices. Zones without reception may appear owing to elements in the building. This can cause brief interruptions in the conversation, caused by faulty transmission. LU Sixty.book Page 6 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 7 Certain medical equipment and highly-sensitive machines or security systems may be affected by the transmission power of the telephone. In these cases we recommend adhering to the safety information. In regions greatly affected by electrical storms we recommend that you protect your telephone circuit with a special fixture for excess voltage. Your SIXTY has anti-skid pads that should leave no traces on your furniture and ensure stability. However, given the the wide variety of finishes used by furniture manufacturers, traces may appear on surfaces in contact with the parts of your SIXTY. Sagemcom Broadband SAS decline all responsibility in any such cases of damage. LU Sixty.book Page 7 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 8 UNPACKING Place the box in front of you, open it and make sure it contains the following items: • one base SIXTY, one handset, one telephone line cord, one equipped power adapter and this user guide. PHONE DESCRIPTION Your base The SIXTY is the contemporary interpretation by SAGEMCOM of the S63, which accompanied the development of telephone communications in many countries in the 60s and 70s. It nevertheless has the latest technology, such as browser touch buttons, Hifi ringtones, dialling light and sound effects. * Keyway: indicates the position of the handset earpiece ** Press and hold the key : - If the answering machine is turned off: access to voice messaging service. - If the answering machine is turned on: access to your messages on the answering machine. Base button/Paging - Short press: find handsets (Paging) - Press and hold : handset registration Keyway * Loudspeaker/ Pick up Indicator light Access to voice messaging service/ Access to your messages on the answering machine ** LU Sixty.book Page 8 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 9 Your handset SIXTY's particularity is that it has a wireless handset. The single button on the handset allows the user to hang up or answer an incoming call. It should be noted that the handset is provided with a buzzer that sounds on receiving an incoming call with the handset not on its base. The handset batteries are charged when the handset is placed on its base. When off the base, the handset's battery power provides 120 hours of standby time and 10 hours of talk time. Indicator light operation: • Fast flashing: handset registration or paging. • Slow flashing: handset on line or new events. Make sure that when the handset is on the charger, the icon is animated. Hang up/ Pick up Battery compartment Battery cover Handset charging contacts Speaker Microphone + - LU Sixty.book Page 9 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 10 Control panel Your SIXTY has a touch keys for access to configuration and settings functions. The screen tells you about the state (date and time, unread message, etc..). Using the touch buttons The screen includes six touch keys around its periphery. Simply touch the tactile area for the function to be taken into account: Key Function(s) Key Function(s) Scroll up /Go to the menu list. Browse down / Go to the menu list. Context key 1: Access a menu / Validate the selection. Context key 2: Delete an entry / Return to the previous menu. Asterisk key. # key. LU Sixty.book Page 10 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 11 Display screen During use or on standby, the screen of your SIXTY tells you about the state of your telephone by showing icons, and in particular: * The low emission icon (ECO mode): Your telephone is provided with an automatic power management system. As soon as the handset is near its base, the power required is reduced to the minimum. Radio transmissions are also cut off when the handset is placed on the base, and the low emission icon is then displayed. If a second handset is paired with the base, the "low emission" icon is no longer displayed. Battery indicator Microphone off Current call Speakerphone on Recording answering machine on Alarm on New voice message Low emission icon* LU Sixty.book Page 11 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 12 PHONE INSTALLATION CONNECTING THE BASE Never force the plugs: they are in different shapes to avoid connection mistakes. 1. On the underside of the base, click the phone jack into its socket and connect the other end of the cord to the telephone wall outlet. 2. Connect the end of the power supply cord on the underside of the base and connect the power adapter to the mains socket. The phone display is turned on. SETTING UP THE HANDSET The batteries are already inserted in the handset. To put the handset into use, simply remove the tab by pulling on it firmly in the direction of the arrow. The handset emits a double beep to indicate that it has started and then a second beep to indicate that the handset is synchronized with the base. From then on, your handset becomes operative and you can use it to make calls. You can now use your telephone to make and receive calls. CHARGING BATTERIES Place the handset on its base and fully charge the batteries. An audio signal is emitted and a light flashes when the handset is placed correctly on the base. The battery charge icon is animated to indicate that the battery is being charged and stops to indicate that the batteries are fully charged. Before making any connections, please refer to the safety instructions presented at the beginning of this user guide. Power socket Telephone socket On leaving the factory, the handset is already registered in the base. If your handset is not recognized by the base, then launch a manual registration (See paragraph "Set the base to registration mode", page 26. LU Sixty.book Page 12 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 13 SETTINGS REQUIRED BEFORE USE Setting the date and time accurately will enable you to Follow your calls and messages chronologically. According to where your base is situated in the room, You may have to adjust the contrast. To set the date and time, refer to paragraph "Modifying the date and time ", page 24. To set the contrast or the brightness of the screen, refer to paragraph "Adjusting the contrast ", page 24. NAVIGATING IN THE MENU With your SIXTY you can create your own telephone directory, display the list of calls etc. To do this, use the touch keys. With the touch keys 􀀘 and 􀀙 you can choose a menu, a sub-menu or a precise setting. The key allows you to enter the sub-menus of the chosen function and select the setting to modify. With the key you can return to the previous function or cancel the current choice. The keys and are used when you use the answerphone. See the menu structure to familiarise yourself with what your phone can do. The handset batteries charging time is 10 hours. During charging, the batteries may heat up. This is quite normal and perfectly safe. Handset charging contacts Base charging contacts LU Sixty.book Page 13 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 14 Menu structure To access one of your phone's menus, use key 􀀘 or 􀀙. Browsing through the menus Use the browsing keys 􀀘 or 􀀙 to select the desired menu. Press Valid. To confirm your selection. Select the desired function by pressing the browsing keys 􀀘 or 􀀙 and then press the Valid. key. - To return to the previous menu, press Return. - To save the settings, press Valid.. Example: To access the menu SETTINGS /DATE/TIME: 1. Use 􀀘 or 􀀙 to access the menu list. 2. Select SETTINGS using 􀀘 or 􀀙. Press Valid.. 3. Select DATE/TIME using 􀀘 or 􀀙. Press Valid. You are now under the DATE/TIME menu.P Menu PHONEBOOK ACCESSORIES CALLS CALL INCOMING CALLS OUTGOING CALLS EVENTS ALARM TIMER EXTERNAL CALL SILENT MODE RING TONE SETTINGS Option VIEW RING TONE DELETE ADD NUMBER NEW ENTRY BEEPS DATE/TIME CONTRAST DEMO ANS.MACH MESSAGES ON/ OFF OUTGOING MESS. SETTINGS LANGUAGE Edit RESTRICTION ADVANCED SET. VOICE BOX No DATE/TIME LU Sixty.book Page 14 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 15 PHONE USE HANDSET LOCATION Lost your handset? Press the button on the back of the base, behind the keypad. The handset will then ring. TELEPHONING Receiving a call • When a call is received, the phone rings. • The caller's phone number is displayed on the screen if you have subscribed to the "Caller ID" service. The caller's name may also be displayed if it is included in your phone book. Accepting a call in handset mode • Pick up the phone handset. You do not need to press the handset's button. • Make sure to identify the handset direction by the dot which identifies the earpiece end. The call time counter is displayed on the screen. • To end the call, hang up the handset or press the handset button. • A visual and audible signal confirms that the handset is hung up correctly. • If the handset is not on the base, you have to press the handset button to take the call. Accepting a call in speakerphone mode • Press to speak in speakerphone mode (without holding the handset). The symbol and the call time counter are displayed on the screen. • To end the call, press again. Toggle between handset mode and speakerphone mode • If you are in handset mode, press and hold the key and then hang up the handset to toggle to speakerphone mode. Press the key again to end the call. • If you are in speakerphone mode: - If the handset is hung up on the base, lift the phone handset to toggle to handset mode. - If the handset is not hung up on the base, press the dial tone button to toggle to handset mode. • To end the call, hang up the handset on the base or press . Use the 􀀘 and 􀀙 keys to vary the earphone volume or speakerphone volume. The handset earphone volume or speakerphone volume can vary from 1 to 5. LU Sixty.book Page 15 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 16 Making a call The call can be made in two ways: Making a call in handset mode • Pick up the handset. • The icon is displayed on the screen. Dial your number on the keypad. The call time counter is displayed on the screen. Making a call in speakerphone mode • Press to obtain a dial tone prompt on the screen. Dial your number on the keypad. The and icons are displayed on the screen. The call time counter is displayed on the screen. Ending a call When you have finished your call, press or hang up the handset on the base. During a call Receiving a second call • During the call, a beep is transmitted to your telephone by your service provider to let you know that you have a second call waiting. • Press ACCEPT to take this new call. • Your other caller is then put on hold and you can talk with your second caller. Making a second call • During a call, you can put your contact on hold and call a second one by pressing -R- and dial the number using the keypad. • The second call is then launched, with the first call still on hold. To alternate from one call to the other • To toggle from one call to the other, press Menu then SWITCH. • The call in progress is put on hold, and you can then take the second call. To end one of the calls and continue the other one • To toggle from one call and take the other, press Menu and then HANGING UP. • The call in progress is definitely terminated, and you can then take the second call. You can also dial a number in pre-dialling mode, whether in handset or speakerphone mode: dial the number on the keypad and then lift the handset or press . If necessary, you can correct the number entered by pressing BACK. The caller on hold hears a beep emitted by the network. LU Sixty.book Page 16 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 17 To set up a 3 way-call (the two parties and yourself) • During a call, press Menu and then 3-PARTY CONF. • You can then talk to both parties simultaneously, and "3-PARTY CONF" is displayed on the screen. • To end the 3 way-call, Hang up the handset. Call key function This key is a shortcut to your phone's call log. • From the idle screen, press the key : - INCOMING CALLS, - OUTGOING CALLS, - EVENTS. • Press keys 􀀘 or 􀀙 to select the calls list. • Press Valid. and then select the number using keys 􀀘 or 􀀙. Secret mode During a call, you can switch to mute mode and your phone's microphone will be muted. The person you are on line with can no longer hear you. To activate secret mode : • During a call, press Menu/ SECRET and then Activ.. • The "SECRET MODE" message will appear on the screen. To deactivate secret mode : • Press Exit, "SECRET MODE" disappears from the screen. Your correspondent will be able to hear you again. Hands-free/speakerphone mode If you want to phone in speakerphone mode, do not lift the handset, but press the base key; the icon is displayed on your phone's screen. The caller can then be heard through the loudspeaker and you speak into the base microphone. To end the call, press the key again . If you want to toggle to speakerphone mode during a call in handset mode, press the key; the icon is displayed on your phone's screen. The caller can then be heard through the base loudspeaker and the handset earphone and you speak into the handset microphone. In this mode the base microphone is inactive. You can return to speakerphone mode by holding down the key and then replacing the handset. To end the call, replace the handset or press the key . When you call hand-free/speakerphone mode, you can increase or decrease the audio volume from 1 to 5, using 􀀘 or 􀀙. LU Sixty.book Page 17 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 18 Calling the last number dialled Your SIXTY stores the last 20 dialled numbers: • Go to CALLS / OUTGOING CALLS. • Select the number you want to call. • Go to Option / CALL. The number is automatically dialed in speakerphone mode. Call time display Once connected, the call time is displayed on the screen (minutes and seconds). PHONEBOOK You can save up to 150 entries in your phone book, with each sheet able to contain a 24-digit number and a name up to 12 letters long. CREATING AN ENTRY To enter a text, repeatedly press the required key to display the desired letter. • Go to PHONEBOOK / New. • Enter the name of your contact using the alphanumeric keys. • Press Valid.. • Enter the contact`s telephone number using the alphanumeric keys. • PressValid.. • Select an icon for this number to specify the type of number. • Press Valid.. The name and number are then stored in your phone book. LU Sixty.book Page 18 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 19 EDITING AN ENTRY • Go to the menu PHONEBOOK. • Press keys 􀀘 or 􀀙 to select the contact you want to change. • Select Option / Edit. • Press Valid.. • You enter the name input screen. To correct the name, press Return to delete characters. Enter your changes on the keypad. After making the changes, press Valid.. • You enter the number input screen. To correct the number, press Return to delete the numbers. Enter your changes on the keypad. After making the changes, press Valid.. • Select an icon for this number. • Press Valid.. ASSOCIATING A RING TONE WITH A PHONEBOOK ENTRY You can associate a unique ring tone to each entry and thus create your own call groups As you need the active number presentation service on your handset, contact your operator to find out about the conditions for obtaining the service. • Go to the menu PHONEBOOK. • Select the entry with which you want to associate a ring tone. • Go to Option / RING TONE. • Select the ring tone of your choice. • Press Valid.. OTHER NUMBER This function allows you to assign new numbers to the same name. • Go to the menu PHONEBOOK. • Select the entry you want to assign another number to. • Go to Option / ADD NUMBER. • Enter the phone number on the alphanumeric keys. • PressValid.. • Select an icon according to the type of number entered. Press Valid.. DELETING AN ENTRY • Go to the menu PHONEBOOK. • Press keys 􀀘 or 􀀙 to select the contact you want to delete. • Select Option / DELETE. • Press Valid.. • A confirmation screen asks you if you wish to delete the entry. - To delete the entry, press Yes, the contact is deleted from your phone book. - If you do not wish to delete the entry, press No. LU Sixty.book Page 19 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 20 CALLING USING THE PHONEBOOK • Go to the menu PHONEBOOK. • From the list of names, select the contact you want to call using keys 􀀘 or 􀀙. • Go to Option/CALL. The number is automatically dialled in speakerphone mode. SEARCHING FOR A CONTACT • Access your phonebook list, press successively on the keypad key which corresponds to the first letter of the name you are searching for so as to make it appear at the top of the screen. • Once the first letter of the name is displayed, wait a moment. • The phonebook selects the first name in the list that starts with the selected letter. CALL LOG Caller identification is a service that requires prior registration with your operator. VIEWING THE RECEIVED AND DIALLED CALL LOG • Go to the menu CALLS / INCOMING CALLS or OUTGOING CALLS. • Select the event to be viewed. • Press Valid.. • The screen presents the following information. (depending on the operator and the subscription): - the full name of your contact and the telephone number, - the number of consecutive calls, - time (for calls during the day) or the date (for previous calls) of the call. The calls are organised in chronological order, from the most recent call to the oldest call. To see the previous calls, use the keys 􀀘 or 􀀙. To check your call log directly, press the Log key from the idle screen. LU Sixty.book Page 20 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 21 By pressing Option, a list of various executable actions appears: - CALL : To call the number. - VIEW : To view the selected call again. - STORE NUMBER : To store the name and number in the phonebook. - DELETE : To delete the call currently viewed. - DELETE ALL : To delete all calls. To return to the call viewing screen, press Return. THE EVENTS LOG Viewing the events log If one or more new events occurred during your absence, the information screen "NEW EVENTS !" appears and the light starts flashing. • If you do not wish to view the event log at this time, press Return. • To view the event log, press Valid.. • Choose the event using 􀀘 or 􀀙. • Press Valid.. Activating/deactivating the new event information screen The new event information screen can be inhibited. The events which have occurred can then be viewed in the menu CALLS / EVENTS / VIEW. The default setting is active. • Go to the menu CALLS / EVENTS. • Select ACTIVATE or DEACTIVATE to enable or disable the displaying of the new events screen. • Press Valid.. Clearing notifications The notifications received are saved in the event log and can be deleted once they have been viewed. • Go to the menu CALLS / EVENTS. • Select DELETE NOTIF. and press Valid. to remove the notifications received on your base. INFORMATION During an incoming call, following messages can be displayed: PRIVATE: Your contact does not want their number to be displayed. UNAVAILABLE: If there is a problem on the phone network. The light only stops flashing when all the events have been viewed. LU Sixty.book Page 21 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 22 ACCESSORIES ALARM CLOCK This function enable you to use your SIXTY as an alarm clock. When the alarm is triggered the selected ring tone sounds for 60 seconds through the handset speaker and an alert screen is displayed. Activating / deactivating the alarm clock • Go to ACCESSORIES / ALARM. • An information screen shows the alarm clock status. • Use􀀘 or 􀀙 to select ACTIVATE or DEACTIVATE. • Press Valid.. The alarm settings information screen appears showing the new status. Changing the alarm clock ring tone • Go to ACCESSORIES / ALARM. • Use􀀘 or 􀀙 to select RING TONE in the list, press Valid.. • Select the ring tone of your choice, press Volume. • Select the desired ring tone using 􀀘 or 􀀙 to increase or decrease the volume, press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. Modifying the alarm clock time • Go to ACCESSORIES / ALARM. • Use􀀘 or 􀀙 to select SET TIME. • Enter the time at which you would like the alarm clock to sound. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. TIMER With this menu you can use your telephone as a timer. Once the specified time has elapsed, the base rings for 60 seconds and the alarm screen is activated. Turn off the alarm by pressing Stop, the base stops ringing. Activate the timer • Go to ACCESSORIES / TIMER. • Press Start. If a timer duration is already specified, the timer is directly activated. If not please follow instructions in the next paragraph. The timer function must be inactive so that it can be set. LU Sixty.book Page 22 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 23 Changing the programmed time of the timer • Go to ACCESSORIES / TIMER. • Press Valid.. • Select SET DURATION in the list. Press Valid.. • Enter the desired time. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. Displaying or hiding the programmed time of the timer • Go to ACCESSORIES / TIMER. • Select VIEW in the list. Press Valid.. • If you want to show the timer, press Yes, else press No. • Press Return. Changing the timer ring tone • Go to ACCESSORIES / TIMER. • Select RING TONE in the list of options, press Valid.. • The list of ring tones appears, the handset plays the ring tone. • Select the ring tone. Press Volume. • Press 􀀘 or 􀀙 to increase or decrease the volume. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. RING TONES CHANGING THE RING TONES This menu enables you to associate a unique ring tone to incoming calls. • Go to RING TONE / EXTERNAL CALL. • Press Valid.. • Select the ring tone of your choice. • then press Volume. Adjust the ringer volume using 􀀘 or 􀀙. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. ACTIVATING OR DEACTIVATING THE BEEPS • Go to RING TONE / BEEPS. • Press Valid.. • To change the beep status, press Edit. The status is changed on the screen. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. LU Sixty.book Page 23 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 24 ACTIVATING/DEACTIVATING THE SILENT MODE When in silent mode, the telephone ringer and keypad beeps are inhibited. • Go to RING TONE / SILENT MODE. • SILENCE MODE? is displayed on the screen. • Press Yes to activate the silent mode. SETTINGS MODIFYING THE DATE AND TIME • Go to SETTINGS / DATE/TIME. • Enter the date in DD/MM/YY format. • Press Valid.. • Enter the time in HH/ MM format. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. ADJUSTING THE CONTRAST • Go to SETTINGS / CONTRAST. • A list with five levels of contrast is displayed. • Select the level you want using the keys 􀀘 or 􀀙. The contrast is directly visible on the screen. • when you have obtained a satisfactory level. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. MODIFYING THE LANGUAGE • Go to SETTINGS / LANGUAGE. • An information screen presents the current language used. - To keep the setting, press Valid.. - To change the setting, press 􀀘 or 􀀙. • Select the language. When you activate the silent mode, your handset is muted for all timer and alarm type functions. LU Sixty.book Page 24 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 25 • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. THE VOICE BOX NUMBER (ACCORDING TO OPERATOR) This function allows you to receive calls in your absence on your operator's voice messaging service. To indicate that a new message has been received the reception indicator on the the top of the '1' key is lit in red and the new event message is displayed on the screen. To change the voice box number, proceed as follows: • Go to SETTINGS / VOICE BOX No. • The programmed number is displayed on the screen. - The number is correct, press Valid.. - To modify the number, press Edit. DEFINING FORBIDDEN PREFIXES - CALL BARRING You can prohibit the use of certain prefixes on your telephone. When a prefix is forbidden, it becomes impossible to call numbers that begin by this prefix. • Go to SETTINGS/ RESTRICTION. • Press Edit, • Select PREFIX using 􀀘 or 􀀙, press Valid.. • Enter the base code (by default 0000), press Valid.. • Select a location (dashes), press Valid.. • Enter the prefix using the keypad (for example : 06, 08, etc..). • Press Valid.. • OK is displayed on the screen. • Select ACTIVATE using 􀀘 or 􀀙. • Enter the base code (by default 0000), press Valid.. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. The answering machine message language depends on the phone language. To check your voice messaging service, hold down key . LU Sixty.book Page 25 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 26 DEMO This menu allows you to see an animation for each of your phone's key and ring tones. • Go to SETTINGS / DEMO. • Press Valid.. • Display of "DEMO Chenillard" with the animation of each key. • Press the key during this animation, "DEMO MELODY" is displayed, and the melody for external calls is initiated. • Press Exit to stop the demonstration. ADVANCED SETTINGS Base settings Set the base to registration mode Using this function you can add GAP compatible hnadsets to your base. The handset that you want to pair with your base must itself be in pair mode. Consult the user booklet of your handset to find out what to do. • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / SET BASE / REGISTR. MODE. • Press Valid.. • REGISTR. MODE? is displayed on the screen, press Yes. • Indicator on the the top of the '1' key starts to flash rapidly. Your base will remain in registration mode for about 1 minute. Resetting the base When you reset your base, all the base parameters are reset to their initial values (factory settings). • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / SET BASE / RESET BASE. • Press Valid.. • REINIT. BASE? is displayed on the screen. • Press Yes. • Enter the base code. • Press Valid.. The "RE-INIT. IN PROCESS" and the OK messages are displayed successively. Your base is now reset. You can save up to 5 GAP-compatible handsets on your SIXTY base. You can also set the base to pairing mode by holding down your base's key. LU Sixty.book Page 26 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 27 De-registering a handset • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / SET BASE / DELETE HANDSET. • Press Valid.. • Select the handset you wish to unregister using 􀀘 or 􀀙. • Press Valid.. • A screen prompts you to confirm the unregistration. Press Yes to unregister the handset. The handset is no more registered to the base. Line settings Modifying the network type Your telephone can be installed on a public or private network (when using a PABX). This function enables you to configure your telephone according to the type of network. • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / SET LINE / NETWORK TYPE. • Press Valid.. • A screen presents the current status. - To keep the status, press Valid.. - To change the status, press Edit. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. Modifying the dialling mode The type of dialling generally used is voice frequency. It is possible that the exchange to which you are connected uses pulse dialling. • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / SET LINE / DIAL. • Press Valid.. • A screen displays the current status. - To keep the status, press Valid.. - To modify the status, press Edit. The status is modified on the screen. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. Before changing the settings of the telephone line, contact your operator to obtain the parameters for your line. The default dialling mode is tone. LU Sixty.book Page 27 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 28 Modifying the flash duration If you connect your telephone to a private automatic branch exchange or use it in a foreign country, you may need to modify the flash duration in order to use your telephone correctly with regard to the following functionalities: outgoing 2nd call, incoming 2nd call, 3 way calling. Contact your service provider to obtain the correct flash duration and then modify it by doing the following. • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / SET LINE / FLASHING. • Press Valid.. • An information screen presents the current flash duration. - To keep the duration, press Valid.. - To modify the duration, press Edit. • Select the new duration. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. Setting a PABX prefix If a private automatic branch exchange is used, you can programme the external call prefix. With this function you can set the: - PABX prefix number, - dialled number length at which point the PABX prefix will be automatically inserted (this length is called “digit before prefix”), - prefix status (on or off). • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / SET LINE / PABX PREFIX. • Press Valid.. • Press to modify this setting. • Select the desired option: - ACTIVATE / DEACTIVATE : to select a status. - PREFIX : to enter the number giving you access to the outside line. - EDIT LENGTH : to specify the «digits before prefix». • To modify the prefix, select PREFIX press Valid.. • Enter the prefix using the keypad, press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • To modify the digits before prefix, select EDIT LENGTH, press Valid.. • Enter the digits before prefix using the keypad. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. • Now you can activate the automatic PABX prefix functionality, select ACTIVATE and press Valid.. LU Sixty.book Page 28 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 29 Modifying the base code This code securises and limits the use of your telephone. • Go to SETTINGS / ADVANCED SET. / CHANGE CODE. • Press Valid.. • Enter the old base code using the keypad (default is 0000). • Press Valid.. • Enter the new base code using the keypad. • Press Valid.. • Confirm by entering the new base code again. • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. ANSWERING MACHINE Your phone's answering machine provides the following features: • Active answering machine mode with pre-recorded messages, • Call filtering, • Remote querying. ENABLING / DISABLING THE ANSWERING MACHINE • Go to ANS. MACH / ON/OFF. • Press Valid.. • A screen displays the current status of the answering machine (On or Off). - To keep the displayed status, press Valid.. - To change the status, press 􀀘 or 􀀙: To activate the answering machine, select ACTIVATE. To turn off the answering machine, select OFF. Press Valid.. • OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. If you have not recorded a personal message, the answering machine will automatically use one of the pre-recorded messages in the selected language. LU Sixty.book Page 29 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 30 MODIFYING THE OGM Recording a personal outgoing message • Go to ANS. MACH / OUTGOING MESS. / CHANGE. • Press Valid.. • RECORD OGM is displayed on the screen. • Press Begin to start recording your OGM. Start talking in the base microphone. • To stop recording press End. Your outgoing message is automatically played back. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu or make a new recording. Deleting your personal OGM • Go to ANS. MACH / OUTGOING MESS. / DELETE. • Press Valid.. • DELETE ANOUNCE? is displayed on the screen, press Yes to confirm the deletion of your personal outgoing message. • OGM DELETED is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. Listen to a personal message • Go to ANS. MACH / OUTGOING MESS. / PLAY. • Press Valid.. • PLAY OGM is displayed on the screen and the OGM is played back. At the end of the playback you will return to the menu RECORD OGM. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. PLAYING MESSAGES If you have new messages (unread), these messages are read first. Afterwards, the messages that have already been taken are played back in chronological order (from the oldest messages to the most recent messages). • Go to ANS. MACH / MESSAGES / PLAY. • Press Valid.. • The messages are played through the loudspeaker. In order to modify an OGM, you must first turn on the answering machine. If you delete your personal outgoing message, the answering machine will automatically use the anonymous message. If you have not recorded a personal message, you will hear the anonymous, pre-recorded message. LU Sixty.book Page 30 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 31 • Depending on your service provider and your subscription, the name and number of your contact will be displayed on the screen (except for a confidential call). • During playback, you can use the touch-sensitive keys to perform the following actions: - * : go back to the beginning of the message. - * x 2: return to the previous message. - # : go to the next message. - Pause/PLAY (context key 1): pause/resume playback. - DELETE (context key 2): delete the message being played. - : exit playback of messages. REMOTE ACCESS TO ANSWERING MACHINE Your answering machine can be queried remotely. This feature allows you to read your messages and query your answering from any phone when you are not at home. To remotely access your answering machine: • Dial your telephone number. • Wait for the answering machine to come on. • When your outgoing message is played, press «#». • Enter your remote access code. • A beep will indicate access to the answer machine, Any unread messages will be automatically played back. • At the end of playback, a new beep will sound to let you know that the answer machine is ready. • You can carry out the following operations : - 0 : delete the message being played. - 1 : go back to the beginning of the message. - 1 (x2): previous message. - 2 : pause / play. - 3 : next message. - 5 : messages read. - 9 : enable/disable the answering machine. DELETING ALL THE OLD MESSAGES • Go to ANS. MACH / MESSAGES / DELETE OLD. • Press Valid.. • To confirm the deletion of all the old messages, press Yes. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. The remote access code is 0000 by default. However, it can only be used once it is customised, refer to paragraph "Modifying the remote access code ", page 32. To delete old messages one by one, refer to the previous paragraph and delete unwanted messages during playback. LU Sixty.book Page 31 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 32 TAM SETTINGS This menu allows you to change the advanced settings of your answering machine. You can access the answering machine SETTINGS menu from the ANS. MACH menu. ACTIVATING AND DEACTIVATING CALL SCREENING The filtering function, when activated, allows you to listen to the message left by the caller as it is being recorded. You can unhook to answer at any time. • Go to ANS. MACH/SETTINGS/CALL SCREENING. • Press Valid.. • A screen indicating the function status appears. - To keep the current status, press Valid.. - To change the status, press 􀀘 or 􀀙. • Press Valid.. MODIFYING THE REMOTE ACCESS CODE The remote access code enables you to listen to the messages left on your answering machine via another telephone. • Go to ANS. MACH / SETTINGS / REMOTE CODE. • Press Valid.. • CODE BASE is displayed, enter your Base code (default setting is 0000). • Press Valid.. • CODE DISTANCE is displayed, enter the new remote access code (4 digits mandatory). • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. NUMBER OF RINGS This parameter determines the number of times your phone rings before your answering machine is started. The number of rings is between 3 and 7. • Go to ANS. MACH / SETTINGS / NO OF RINGS. • Press Valid.. • The programmed number of rings is displayed on the screen. Press keys 􀀘 or 􀀙 to change this number (from 3 to 7). • Press Valid.. OK is displayed on the screen. • Press Return to go back to the previous menu. LU Sixty.book Page 32 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 33 REPLACING THE BATTERIES Your batteries' autonomy is no more satisfactory ? Please contact your retailer, he will propose to you new equivalent batteries. • Remove the battery compartment hatch. • Remove the old batteries, insert the new batteries one by one in compliance with the polarity of the batteries, as indicated in paragraph “Your handset”, page 9 • Refit the battery compartment hatch. • Leave your handset on its base in order to fully charge the batteries. PAIRING GAP-COMPATIBLE DECT HANDSETS ON THE SIXTY BASE Additional GAP-compatible DECT handsets can be registered on the SIXTY base. To register an additional handset on the SIXTY base: • Set your base to pairing mode by holding down the key. The light indicator on the top of the '1' key starts flashing. The base remains in pairing mode for one minute. • Set the additional handset to registration mode. (Refer to the your handset's user manual). Up to five GAP-compatible DECT handsets can be registered on the SIXTY base. LU Sixty.book Page 33 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 34 APPENDIX CARE AND MAINTENANCE Turn off your phone. Use a soft damp cloth to wipe it. Do not use a dry cloth, strong liquid detergents, thinners, alcohol or any other type of solvent to clean your phone. These products may damage your phone. PROBLEMS Refer to the table presented below in case of an operational malfunction: Problems Possible causes Remedies You are having trouble reading or cannot read the display when not in standby mode. Contrast too low. Increase the contrast level (refer to paragraph "Adjusting the contrast ", page 24). No display on the base screen. Power connection unplugged. Check the power connection to the phone. No tone. The phone jack is not connected or is incorrectly connected. Check the phone cable connection (refer to paragraph "Connecting the base ", page 12). Make sure you have a dialling tone. The speaker volume is too low. Increase the speaker volume (refer to paragraph "Receiving a call ", page 15). The phone does not ring when a call is received. The mute mode is turned on. Turn off the mute mode (refer to paragraph "Activating/ deactivating the silent mode ", page 24). Your party cannot hear you. You have turned on the mute mode (microphone off). Turn off the mute mode (microphone off) in MENU then MUTE. Make sure that the "MUTE MODE" message is not displayed. You obtain a "busy" dial tone for each dialled number. Incorrect flashing time. Set the flashing time (refer to paragraph "Modifying the flash duration ", page 28). Contact your operator to get it to provide you with the right time. LU Sixty.book Page 34 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 35 TECHNICAL CHARACTERISTICS INITIAL CONDITION Standard Radio frequency band Number of channels Duplex mode Spacing between channels Bit rate Modulation Vocoding Transmitting power ::::::::: DECT, GAP 1.88-1.90 GHz 120 TDMA 1.728MHz 1152 kbit/s GFSK ADPCM 250 mW Charging time Range up to Batteries Handset operating time Max answering machine capacity Ambient temperature Dimensions Weight including batteries :::::::: Handset Batteries: 10 hours 300 m outside and up to, up to 50 m inside buildings Type Ni-MH, AAA, 2 x 1.2 V 450 mAh talk time up to 10 hours standby time up to 120 hours 20 minutes +5°C to +45°C Base(WxHxL) 220 x 63 x 39 mm Handset(WxHxL) 176 x 130 x 89 mm Base 172g Handset 43 g Accessories Advanced Settings Alarm clock off Network type Public Timer off Dial mode Tone Ring Tone Flashing 100 ms Ringer Traditional PABX prefix Off Keyboard beeps On Answering Machine Silent mode Off Status On Settings Call screening Off Date/Time 01/01/10 // 00:00 Remote access code 0000 Contrast Level 2 Number of rings 7 Language English Restriction off Base code 0000 LU Sixty.book Page 35 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 36 ENVIRONMENT Environmental protection and sustainable development is an important priority for SAGEMCOM. SAGEMCOM has a policy of using environmentally- friendly systems and makes environmental protection an essential part of the life-cycle of its products – from the manufacturing, to the installation, operation and disposal. PACKAGING The logo (green point) on the packaging means that a fee is paid to an authorised national organisation to improve packaging recycling and the recycling infrastructure. Follow the local sorting regulations for this type of waste product in order to improve recycling. BATTERIES AND RECHARGEABLE BATTERIES If your product contains batteries or rechargeable batteries, these must be disposed of at designated collecting centers. THE PRODUCT The crossed out dustbin displayed on the product signifies that it belongs to the electrical and electronic equipment group. The European regulations request you to carry out your own selective recycling collection at: • the sales outlet when you buy a similar new device. • the collection points available in your area (recycling centres, sorting points, etc). This means you participate in the recycling and valorisation of used electric and electronic goods which would otherwise have a negative impact on the environment and health. Annexe.fm Page 36 Jeudi, 20. mai 2010 9:03 09 37 GUARANTEE TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR UNITED KINGDOM & IRELAND ONLY In order to apply the guarantee, you should contact the SAGEMCOM Helpdesk or the retailer where you purchased the equipment. Proof of purchase will be required in either case. Please make sure that you use your equipment only for the purpose for which it was designed and under normal usage conditions. SAGEMCOM do not accept any liability for the equipment if used outside the frame of its original designed purpose or any consequence that may arise from this usage. Should any malfunction arise, the SAGEMCOM Helpdesk or your retailer will advise you how to proceed. A) General Guarantee conditions SAGEMCOM undertakes to remedy by repair or exchange at its own convenience, free of charge for labour and replacement parts, any defects in the equipment during the guarantee period of 12 (twelve) months or 3 (three) months for accessories, from the date of original invoice of the Equipment, where those defects are a result of faulty workmanship. Unless the customer has concluded with SAGEMCOM a maintenance contract in respect of the equipment which specifically provides for repairs to be carried out at the customer`s premises, the repairs will not be carried out on the equipment at the customer premises. The customer must however return the defective equipment at his/her own expense, to the address supplied by the SAGEMCOM Helpdesk or by the retailer. In the case that a product needs to be sent in for a repair, it must always be accompanied by a proof of purchase (which is not altered, written on or in any way made illegible) showing that the product is still under guarantee. In the case that no proof of purchase is enclosed, the SAGEMCOM repair centre will use the production date as its reference for establishing the guarantee status of the product. Apart from all legal obligatory rules, SAGEMCOM, do not give any Guarantee, either implicit or explicit which is not set force in the present section, and can not be held responsible for any direct or indirect, material or immaterial damage, either in or out of the frame of the present guarantee. If any provision of this guarantee shall be held to be in whole or in part invalid or illegal due to an obligatory rule applicable to consumers pursuant to their national legislation, such invalidity or illegality shall not impair or affect the remaining provisions or parts of this guarantee. This guarantee does not affect the Customer statutory rights. LU Sixty.book Page 37 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 38 B) Exclusions From Guarantee SAGEMCOM shall have no liability under the guarantee in respect of: • Damage, defects, breakdown or malfunction due to one or more of the following: - Failure to properly follow the installation process and instructions for use - An external cause to the equipment (including but not limited to: lightening, fire, shock, vandalism, inappropriate conditions of electrical network or water damage of any nature) - Modifications made without the written approval of SAGEMCOM - Unsuitable operating conditions, particularly of temperature and humidity - Repair or maintenance of the equipment by persons not authorised by SAGEMCOM • Wear and tear from normal daily use of the equipment and its accessories • Damage due to insufficient or bad packaging of equipment when returned to SAGEMCOM • Usage of new versions of software without the previous approval of SAGEMCOM • Work on any equipment or software modified or added without the prior written consent of SAGEMCOM • Malfunctions not resulting from the Equipment or from software installed in user workstations for the purpose of use of the equipment. Communication problems related to an unsuitable environment including: - Problems related to access and/or connection to the Internet such as interruptions by access networks or malfunction of the line used by the subscriber or his correspondent - Transmission faults (for example poor geographical coverage by radio and TV transmitters, interference or poor line quality) - Local network faults (wiring, servers, workstations) or the failure of the transmission network (such as but not limited to interferences, fault or poor quality of the network) - Modification of the parameters of the cellular or broadcast network carried out after the sale of the Product • Normal servicing (as defined in the user guide supplied with the equipment) as well as malfunctioning due to servicing not being carried out. Servicing costs are in any event always borne by the customer. • Malfunctions resulting from the usage of products, consumables or accessories not compatible with the equipment. C) Out of Guarantee Repairs In the cases set forth in B) as well as after expiry of the guarantee period, the customer must ask the Authorised SAGEMCOM Repair Centre for a cost estimation prior to work being carried out. In such cases, the repair and delivery costs will be invoiced to the customer. The foregoing shall apply unless otherwise agreed in writing with the customer and only for the United Kingdom and Ireland. LU Sixty.book Page 38 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 39 TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR OTHER COUNTRIES If, despite our best efforts, your product presents any defects, you should refer to your retailer and present the proof of purchase that they gave you on the day of purchase. Should any malfunctioning arise, the retailer will advise you what to do. For the warranty to apply, you should ensure that the product was used in accordance with the instructions for use and the purpose for use, and that you have at your disposal the sales invoice or receipt stating the date of purchase, the name of the retailer, the reference and the serial number of the product. No coverage shall be given under this warranty if the following conditions are applicable: • The required documents have been modified or altered in order to take advantage of the warranty. • The manufacturing numbers, product brands or labels have been altered or made illegible. • Interventions on the product have been made by an unauthorized person. • The product has been subjected to abnormal or improper use. • The product has been damaged by external factors such as lightning, over-voltage, moisture, accidental damage, improper care as well as all Acts of God. This present warranty does not affect the consumer rights that you may have under the laws in effect in your country. Important: Should you return the product to the after-sales department, please ensure that you return as well all the elements and accessories originally supplied with the product. LU Sixty.book Page 39 Mercredi, 19. mai 2010 12:30 12 SIXTY by Sagemcom Broadband SAS 250, route de l'Empereur - 92848 Rueil-Malmaison - France Tél. +33(0)1 57 61 10 00 - Fax : +33(0)1 57 61 10 01 www.sagemcom.com All rights reserved. Sagemcom Broadband SAS reserves the right to change the technical characteristics of its products and services or to stop marketing them at any time. The information and specifications included are subject to change without prior notice. Sagemcom Broadband SAS tries to ensure that all information in this document is correct, but does not accept liability for error or omission. Non contractual document. All trademarks are registered by their respective owners. Simplified joint stock company - Capital 35 703 000 € - 518 250 360 RCS Nanterre Thermomètre infrarouge 572-2 L'outil qu'il vous faut pour les environnements les plus chauds 2 Fluke Corporation Thermomètre infrarouge 572-2 Caractéristiques techniques du thermomètre infrarouge 572-2 Mesures infrarouges Gamme de température infrarouge -30 °C à 900 °C Précision IR (Géométrie d'étalonnage à une température ambiante de 23 °C ± 2 °C) ≥0 °C ± 1 °C ou ± 1 % du relevé, selon la valeur la plus élevée ≥-10 °C à <0 °C ± 2 °C <-10 °C ± 3 °C Répétabilité IR ± 0,5 % de la mesure ou ± 0,5 °C, selon la valeur la plus élevée Résolution d'affichage 0,1 °C / 0,1 °F Distance : Mesure 60:1 (calculée à 90 % de l'énergie) Dimensions minimales du point 19 mm Système de visée laser Décalage du laser double, puissance de sortie <1 mW Réponse spectrale 8 μm à 14 μm Temps de réponse (95 %) <500 ms Emissivité Réglable numériquement de 0,10 à 1,00 par pas de 0,01 ou à partir du tableau intégré des matériaux courants Options de mesure Alarmes Basse et/ou Haute Sonores ou visuelles en couleur Min/Max/Moy/Dif Oui Commutable entre degrés Celsius et Fahrenheit Oui Rétro-éclairage Deux niveaux, normal et ultra-lumineux pour les environnements sombres Entrée sonde Thermocouple de type K Affichage simultanée de la température IR et de la sonde sur le thermocouple de type-K Verrouillage du déclenchement Oui Stockage de données 99 points Ecran Matriciel de 98 x 96 pixels avec menus de fonctions Communication USB 2.0 Caractéristiques techniques du thermocouple de type K Gamme de températures en entrée du thermocouple de type K -270 °C à 1 372 °C Précision d'entrée du thermocouple de type-K (avec température ambiante de 23 °C ± 2 °C) <-40 °C ± (1 °C + 0,2 °/1 °C) ≥-40 °C ± 1 % ou 1 °C, selon le plus élevé des deux Résolution du thermocouple de type K 0,1 °C Répétabilité de thermocouple type K ± 0,5 % de la mesure ou ± 0,5 °C, selon la valeur la plus élevée Gamme de mesure (sonde à perles du thermocouple de type K) -40 °C à 260 °C Précision ± 1,1 °C de 0 °C à 260 °C. Typiquement à moins de 1,1 °C de -40 °C à 0 °C Longueur du câble Câble de thermocouple de type K de 1 m avec connecteur de thermocouple miniature standard et terminaison par perle Caractéristiques générales Température de fonctionnement 0 °C à 50 °C Température de stockage -20 °C à 60 °C Humidité relative 10 % à 90 % HR sans condensation jusqu'à 30 °C Altitude de fonctionnement 2 000 mètres au-dessus du niveau moyen de la mer Poids 0,322 kg Puissance 2 piles AA Autonomie 8 heures avec laser et rétro-éclairage allumés ; 100 heures avec laser et rétro-éclairage éteints, rapport cyclique de 100 % (thermomètre actif en continu) Sécurité et conformité IEC 60825-1 Laser FDA Classe II EMC 61326-1 Conformité CE CMC 沪制01120009 3 Fluke Corporation Thermomètre infrarouge 572-2 Pour commander Thermomètre infrarouge 572-2 Comprend Thermomètre infrarouge avec fonctions de thermomètre de contact, sonde à perle pour thermocouple de type K, cordon d’interface USB 2.0, logiciel de documentation FlukeView® Forms, mallette de transport rigide, manuel d'introduction (papier) et manuel de l'utilisateur (CD). Sondes de température recommandées Sonde Utilisation 80PK-1 Cette sonde à perle polyvalente permet de mesurer rapidement et avec précision les températures de surface et les températures de l'air dans les gaines et les bouches d'aération. 80PK-8 Les sondes de température à collier de serrage (2) sont essentielles pour le suivi des différentiels de température en constante évolution sur les boucles de tuyauterie et les tubulures d'eau chaude, et excellentes pour obtenir des températures de réfrigération rapides et précises. 80PK-9 La sonde de perforation d'isolant dispose d'un embout pointu pour perforer l'isolation des tuyaux, et d'un embout à bout plat pour obtenir des mesures de contact thermique en surface, des températures dans les gaines et les bouches d'aération. 80PK-11 La sonde pour thermocouple à gaine souple permet de fixer facilement un thermocouple au tuyau pour une utilisation en mains libres. 80PK-25 La sonde perforante est l’option la plus polyvalente. Excellente pour vérifier la température de l'air des conduits, la température de surface sous les moquettes/rembourrages, des liquides, des puits de thermomètre, des températures d'évacuation et pour pénétrer l'isolation des tuyaux. 80PK-26 La sonde conique est une excellente sonde polyvalente de mesure de surface et de gaz, disposant d'une bonne longueur et d'un revêtement d'embout à faible masse pour une réaction accélérée aux températures de l'air et des surfaces. Fluke Deutschland GmbH Parc des Nations - Allee du Ponant Bat T3 95956 ROISSY CDG CEDEX Téléphone: (01) 48 17 37 37 Télécopie: (01) 48 17 37 30 E-mail: info@fr.fluke.nl Web: www.fluke.fr N.V. Fluke Belgium S.A. Langveld Park – Unit 5 P. Basteleusstraat 2-4-6 1600 St. Pieters-Leeuw Tel: 02/40 22 100 Fax: 02/40 22 101 E-mail: info@fluke.be Web: www.fluke.be Fluke (Switzerland) GmbH Industrial Division Hardstrasse 20 CH-8303 Bassersdorf Tel: 044 580 75 00 Fax: 044 580 75 01 E-mail: info@ch.fluke.nl Web: www.fluke.ch ©2013 Fluke Corporation. Tous droits réservés. Informations modifiables sans préavis. 6/2013 Pub_ID: 12090-fre La modiflcation de ce document est interdite sans l’autorisation écrite de Fluke Corporation. User’s Guide October 2012 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide October 2012 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide CONTENTS 1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................... 1 2 SETUP .................................................................................................................. 2 3 OPERATION ......................................................................................................... 5 4 INSTALLING THE SENSOR AFE SOFTWARE ................................................... 10 5 BOARD LAYOUT ................................................................................................ 11 6 SCHEMATIC ....................................................................................................... 12 7 BOM .................................................................................................................... 13 LIST OF FIGURES 1 Connection Diagram ............................................................................................... 2 2 Jumper Setting (Default) for voltage reading ........................................................... 3 3 LMP91051EVM to SPIO-4 Board Connection ......................................................... 4 4 Sensor AFE Items of Interest .................................................................................. 5 5 Recommended LMP91051 Configuration for a voltage Reading ............................. 7 6 Sensor Database Window ..................................................................................... 8 7 Reults of DC Reading ............................................................................................. 9 8 LMP91051EVM’s J3 for SPI Signals ..................................................................... 10 9 LMP91051EVM Layout ......................................................................................... 11 8 LMP91051EVM Schematic ................................................................................... 12 LIST OF TABLES 1 Jumpers for Voltage Measurement ......................................................................... 3 2 LMP91051EVM Bill of Materials............................................................................ 13 1. Introduction The LMP91051 Design Kit (consisting of the LMP91051 Evaluation Module, the SPIO-4 Digital Controller Board, the Sensor AFE software, and this user’s guide) is designed to ease evaluation and design-in of Texas Instrument’s LMP91051 Configurable AFE for Nondispersive Infrared (NDIR). Data capturing and evaluations are simplified by connecting the SPIO-4 Digital Controller Board (SPIO-4 board) to a PC via USB and running the Sensor AFE software. The data capture board will generate the SPI signals to communicate to and capture data from the LMP91051. The user will also have the option to evaluate the LMP91051 without using the SPIO-4 board or the Sensor AFE software. The on board data converter will digitize the LMP91051’s analog output, and the software will display these results in time domain and histogram. The software also allows customers to write to and read from registers, to configure the device’s gain, output offset, and common mode voltage, and most importantly, to configure and learn about the LMP91051. 2 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide snou034 This document describes the connection between the boards and PC, and provides a quick start for voltage measurements. This document also describes how to evaluate the LMP91051 with and without the SPIO-4 board and provides the schematic, board layout, and BOM. 2. Setup This section describes the jumpers and connectors on the EVM as well and how to properly connect, set up and use the LMP91051EVM. 2.1. Connection Diagram Figure 1 shows the connection between the LMP91051 Evaluation Module (LMP91051EVM), SPIO-4 board, and a personal computer with the Sensor AFE software. LMP91051 can be powered using external power supplies or from the SPIO-4 board. Figure 1: Connection Diagram 2.2. Jumper Connections 1. The jumpers for this example application can be seen in Figure 2 and Table 1. 2. The SPIO-4 board is properly setup out of the box (no assembly required). 3. The schematic for the LMP91051EVM can be seen in Figure 10. 3 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide October 2012 Figure 2: Jumper Setting (Default) for voltage reading Table 1: Jumpers for Voltage Measurement Jumpers Pin Purpose JP1: VDD_DUT P1-P2 Connect LMP91051 VDD to +3.3V from SPIO4 JP2: VREF_ADC P1-P2 Connect ADC VREF to 4.1V from U5 (LM4140) JP3: VA_ADC P1-P2 Connect ADC VA to +5V from SPIO4 JP4: OUT_DUT to ADC P1-P2 Connect LMP91051 OUT to ADC input RC filter JP5: VDD to VIO Open Connect LMP91051 VDD to VIO JP6: VIO P2-P3 Connect LMP91051 VIO to +3.3V from SPIO4 J1: IN1 to CMOUT Open Connect LMP91051 IN1 to CMOUT. Note: Board is provided with this jumper open. Use provided jumper to short IN to CMOUT for easy evaluation. J2: IN2 to CMOUT Open Connect LMP91051 IN2 to CMOUT. Note: Board is provided with this jumper open. Use provided jumper to short IN to CMOUT for easy evaluation. 4 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide snou034 2.3. Installing/Opening the Software Follow Section 4 to install and open the Sensor AFE software. 2.4. Connecting and Powering the Boards These Steps have to be done in this order. 1. Connect the LMP91051EVM’s J3 to SPIO-4 Board’s J6. See Figure 3. . Figure 3: LMP91051EVM to SPIO-4 Board Connection 2. Connect SPIO-4 board to a PC via USB. 3. Use a multimeter to measure LMP91051EVM’s +5V test point; it should be approximately 5V. If it is not, check your power supplies and jumpers. Measure test point VREF_ADC; it should be approximately 4.1V. If it’s not, check your jumpers and U5. J3 5 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide October 2012 3. Operation 3.1. Sensor AFE Software Overview Once connection between the boards and PC is established, you can use the software to communicate to and capture data from the LMP91051. Drag cursor over window icons to get an icon description. Some items of interest are shown in Figure 4. Figure 4: Sensor AFE Items of Interest . 1. Menu Bar Icons (from left to right) a. Save Configuration to File: Saves the current configuration settings (register settings) to an .xml file. b. Load Configuration File: Loads the selected configuration settings (register settings) .xml file. c. Register Map: Opens Register Map window. An alternative to the Virtual Device, for writing and reading the device registers. See datasheet for details on device Register Map. d. Save All Registers to File: Saves register contents to a .cvs file. e. Read All Register from Board: After configuring the register map, use this button to read all registers. Functional only in SDIO Mode (see Item 3). f. Write All Registers To Board: After configuring the register map use this button to write all registers. Registers will not be updated until this step is done. g. Zoom In/Out Diagram Image: Zoom in and out of the virtual device image. h. Show Tutorial: Takes you to the interactive Software Overview videos. 1 2 3 4 5 6 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide snou034 i. Documentation: Accesses the LMP91051 Datasheet, SPIO4 User’s Guide, or Evaluation Board User’s Guide. 2. Device Selection and User Inputs a. LMP91050/1 : Toggle between LMP91050 and LMP91051 device. b. fc: Center frequency of external bandpass filter. c. bandwidth: Pass band bandwidth of external bandpass filter. d. R1_EXT, R2_EXT, C1_EXT, C2_EXT: External bandpass filter component values calculated based on user input for center frequency (fc) and pass band (bandwidth) described above. e. Supply: LMP91051 supply voltage (VDD). f. IC Temp: LMP91051 operating temperature g. Offset Adjust Voltage: The tool will calculate the DAC code (decimal) required to achieve this output offset adjust voltage. User must then Write to the register to update the value in the NDAC register. h. ADC Vref: ADC reference voltage. User should input value measured at VREF_ADC test point. Value used to calculate displayed Output Voltage. i. Vout Dark: This value corresponds to the user measured value at the LMP91051 output (OUT) when input is shorted (IN = CMOUT). Tool will use this value to estimate LMP91051 input voltage (IN - CMOUT) on subsequent measurements. 3. Change Mode: Change between device Read Mode OFF (default) and ON. See datasheet for details on SPI Read Mode. 4. Eval Board Setting: Document to show user how to configure jumpers and connect thermopile based on sensor selected. 5. Virtual Device: Drag cursor across color coded blocks and click to configure each block. To update registers “Write All Registers” when done. 3.2. Configuring the LMP91051 Using the Sensor AFE Software Follow the step-by-step instructions under the “HelpBar” mini-tab (left hand side of the GUI) to configure the LMP91051 for this example. These step-by-step instructions are discussed in details below, and the recommended configuration should look similar to Figure 5. 7 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide October 2012 Figure 5: Recommended LMP91051 Configuration for a voltage Reading 1. Step 1: Select a Sensor – Sensor Database window opens. See Figure 6. Step 1: Click sensor type (Thermopile) and the sensors will show in the bottom table. Step 2: Click sensor and then click “Select” button on the left to use this sensor. 8 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide snou034 Figure 6: Sensor Database Window 2. Step 2: Input Mux – click on the mux block to set “1: IN1” (default). 3. Step 3: PGA1 Enable – click on the “PGA1” block to set “1: PGA1 ON” . Remember after configuring the register map to use the Write All Registers button to update the registers. 4. Step 4: PGA2 Enable – click on the “PGA2” block to set “1: PGA2 ON” . Note: By default PGA1 and PGA2 are OFF on power up. However the software was designed to automatically power ON PGA1 and PGA2 for ease of use. 5. Step 5: External Filter – click on the switch block to choose “0: PGA1 to PGA2 direct” (default). 6. Step 6: Common Mode – click on the “CM GEN” block to set “0: 1.15V” (default). 7. Step 7: GAIN 2 – click on the “PGA2” block to set “00: 4” (default). 8. Step 8: GAIN 1 – click on the “PGA1” block to set “0: 250” (default). 9. Step 8: DAC (Output Offset) – click on the “DAC” block to set “128” (default) for 0 mV offset. Alternatively, user can also use the Offset Adjust Voltage user input field to input 0 mV. 10. Step 10: Performance - click on the “Performance” mini-tab. This tab displays the Estimated Device Performance based on device configuration and user input device Supply and IC Temp .This tab also displays the Measured System Performance if you’ve connected a board and ran the LMP91051. Step 1 Step 2 9 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide October 2012 3.3. Capturing Data 1. Click on the “Measurement” tab. 2. Under the “Output Format” field, select Display as “Output Voltage (V)” 3. Under the “Stop Condition” field, select Run as “1” Seconds. Alternatively, select “Run Continuously” radio button to run continuously up to 1 hour. 4. Click on the “Run” button to view the output voltage results. A reading should be plotted as seen in Figure . Output voltage will vary depending on input voltage across input (IN1/IN2) and CMOUT. If J1/J2 are shorted, IN1/IN2 = CMOUT, output voltage should be about 1V. Note: Board is provided with jumper J1/J2 open. Use provided jumper to short IN1/IN2 to CMOUT for easy evaluation. Figure 7: Results of DC Reading 3.4. Powering the LMP91051EVM There are two ways in which VDD can be sourced: external supply or SPIO-4 power. If using an external power supply to source VDD, do the following: 1. Connect an external power supply to banana jacks VDD-EXT and GND. 2. Jumper pins 2 and 3 of JP1 to connect the external power to VDD_DUT. If using the SPIO-4 power to source VDD, then do the following: 1. Jumper pins 1 and 2 of JP1 to connect +3.3V SPIO-4 power to VDD_DUT. The schematic for the LMP91051EVM can be seen in Figure 10. 10 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide snou034 3.5. Evaluating the LMP91051 without the SPIO-4 Board The SPIO-4 digital controller board is used to generate the SPI signals to communicate to the LMP91051. Without the SPIO-4 board, the Sensor AFE software for the LMP91051 cannot be used to capture and analyze data from the LMP91051EVM. If the SPIO-4 board is not available but LMP91051 evaluation is desirable, then connect your own SPI signals to J1 of the LMP91051EVM as seen below. Reference the LMP91051 datasheet for appropriate SPI timing diagrams. Source LMP91051 VDD with an external power supply per previous section. Figure 8: LMP91051EVM’s J3 for SPI Signals Refer to the LMP91051 datasheet for more information on the LMP91051’s SPI protocol. 4. Installing the Sensor AFE Software Each Sensor AFE product will have its own software. To access the Sensor AFE software for LMP91051, follow the steps below. 1. Getting the Zip Files a. You can find the latest downloadable Sensor AFE software at ti.com/sensorafe b. Download the zip file onto your local hard drive. Unzip this folder. 2. Installing the Driver - skip this step if you don’t have the LMP91051EVM and SPIO4 digital controller board. a. See the provided Installation Guide For SensorAFE Drivers.pdf. 11 LMP91051EVM User’s Guide October 2012 3. Installing the Software a. See the provided Installation Guide for LMP91050 SensorAFE Software.pdf i. Note: If you run the software without the boards, you’ll get an error message. Ignore that error message and click “Ok” to continue. 5. Board Layout Figure 9: LMP91051EVM Layout 6. Schematic Figure 10: LMP91051EVM Schematic 7. BOM LMP91051EVM Bill of Materials Item Designator Description Manufacturer PartNumber Quantity 1 +3P3V, +5V, A0_DUT, A1_DUT, CMOUT_DUT, CSB_ADC, CSB_DUT, DOUT_ADC, IN1_DUT, IN2_DUT, MISO, MOSI, MOSI_EN, OUT_DUT, REF_ADC, SCLK_ADC, SCLK_DUT, SDIO_DUT, TEMP, VA_ADC, VDD_DUT, VDD_EXT, VIO, VIO_ADC, VIO_EXT, VREF_ADC Test Point, TH, Compact, Red Keystone Electronics 5005 26 2 AA1 Printed Circuit Board TBD by TI 551xxxxxx-001 REV A 1 3 BNC1, BNC2, OUT DNS Amphenol Connex 112404 3 4 C1 CAP, CERM, 10uF, 6.3V, +/- 20%, X5R, 1206 TDK C3216X5R0J106M 1 5 C2 CAP CER 4700PF 250V X7R 10% 0805 TDK C2012X7R2E472K 1 6 C3, C9, C10, C12, C17, C22 CAP, TANT, 10uF, 10V, +/- 20%, 3.4 ohm, 3216-18 SMD Vishay-Sprague 293D106X0010A2TE3 6 7 C4, C7, C13, C15, C18, C19, C23 CAP, CERM, 0.1uF, 16V, +/- 5%, X7R, 0603 AVX 0603YC104JAT2A 7 8 C5, C6, C21 CAP, CERM, 10nF, 50V, +/-5%, C0G/NP0, 0805 MuRata GRM2195C1H103JA01D 3 9 C8, C14 CAP, CERM, 0.1uF, 25V, +/- 10%, X7R, 0805 AVX 08053C104KAT2A 2 10 C11 CAP, CERM, 0.1uF, 100V, +/- 5%, X7R, 1206 AVX 12061C104JAT2A 1 11 C16, C20 CAP, CERM, 1uF, 10V, +/-10%, X7R, 0805 AVX 0805ZC105KAT2A 2 12 FID1, FID2, FID3 Fiducial mark. There is nothing to buy or mount. N/A N/A 3 13 GND1, GND2, GND3, GND4, GND5, GND6, GND7, GND8, GND9, GND10, GND11 Test Point, TH, Compact, Black Keystone Electronics 5006 11 14 H1, H2, H3, H4 Bump Hemisphere B&F Fastener Supply NY PMS 440 0025 PH 4 15 J1, J2, JP3, JP4, JP5 Header, TH, 100mil, 2x1, Gold plated, 230 mil above insulator Samtec Inc. TSW-102-07-G-S 5 16 J3 SPIO-GPSI16 Header, 16-Pin, Dual row, Right Angle Sullins Connector Solutions PBC36DGAN 1 17 JP1, JP2, JP6 Header, TH, 100mil, 1x3, Gold plated, 230 mil above insulator Samtec Inc. TSW-103-07-G-S 3 18 L1, L2 Ferrite, Chip, 200mA, .080 ohm, SMD Wurth Elektronik eiSos BLM21BD272SN1L 2 19 R1, R2 RES, 160k ohm, 5%, 0.125W, 0805 Vishay-Dale CRCW0805160KJNEA 2 20 R3 DNS Vishay-Dale DNS 1 21 R4 RES, 100k ohm, 5%, 0.125W, 0805 Vishay-Dale CRCW0805100KJNEA 1 22 R5, R10 RES, 0 ohm, 5%, 0.125W, 0805 Vishay-Dale CRCW08050000Z0EA 2 23 R6 RES, 100k ohm, 1%, 0.125W, 0805 Vishay-Dale CRCW0805100KFKEA 1 24 R7 RES, 1.00k ohm, 1%, 0.125W, 0805 Vishay-Dale CRCW08051K00FKEA 1 25 R8 RES, 27.4 ohm, 1%, 0.1W, 0603 Vishay-Dale CRCW060327R4FKEA 1 26 R9 RES, 51.1 ohm, 1%, 0.1W, 0603 Vishay-Dale CRCW060351R1FKEA 1 27 R11, R12, R13, R14 DNS Vishay-Dale CRCW06031R00JNEA 4 28 U1 LMP91051 Texas Instruments LMP91051 1 29 U2 16-Bit, 50 to 250 kSPS, Differential Input, MicroPower ADC, 10-pin Mini SOIC, Pb- Free Texas Instruments ADC141S628QIMMX/NOP B 1 30 U3 Non-Inverting 3-State Buffer Texas Instruments SN74AHC1G125DCKR 1 31 U4 DNS Heimann HMS J21 1 32 U5 Precision Micropower Low Dropout Voltage Reference, 8- pin Narrow SOIC Texas Instruments LM4140ACM-4.1 1 33 U6 2K 5.0V I2C Serial EEPROM On Semiconductor CAT24C02WI-GT3 1 34 Y1 Osc 4.000Mhz 5.0V Full Size ECS Inc ECS-100AX-100 1 35 Y1A Oscllator Socket Aires Electronics A462-ND 1 EVALUATION BOARD/KIT/MODULE (EVM) ADDITIONAL TERMS Texas Instruments (TI) provides the enclosed Evaluation Board/Kit/Module (EVM) under the following conditions: The user assumes all responsibility and liability for proper and safe handling of the goods. Further, the user indemnifies TI from all claims arising from the handling or use of the goods. Should this evaluation board/kit not meet the specifications indicated in the User’s Guide, the board/kit may be returned within 30 days from the date of delivery for a full refund. THE FOREGOING LIMITED WARRANTY IS THE EXCLUSIVE WARRANTY MADE BY SELLER TO BUYER AND IS IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED, IMPLIED, OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT OF THE INDEMNITY SET FORTH ABOVE, NEITHER PARTY SHALL BE LIABLE TO THE OTHER FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES. Please read the User's Guide and, specifically, the Warnings and Restrictions notice in the User's Guide prior to handling the product. This notice contains important safety information about temperatures and voltages. For additional information on TI's environmental and/or safety programs, please visit www.ti.com/esh or contact TI. No license is granted under any patent right or other intellectual property right of TI covering or relating to any machine, process, or combination in which such TI products or services might be or are used. TI currently deals with a variety of customers for products, and therefore our arrangement with the user is not exclusive. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance, customer product design, software performance, or infringement of patents or services described herein. REGULATORY COMPLIANCE INFORMATION As noted in the EVM User’s Guide and/or EVM itself, this EVM and/or accompanying hardware may or may not be subject to the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Industry Canada (IC) rules. For EVMs not subject to the above rules, this evaluation board/kit/module is intended for use for ENGINEERING DEVELOPMENT, DEMONSTRATION OR EVALUATION PURPOSES ONLY and is not considered by TI to be a finished end product fit for general consumer use. It generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and has not been tested for compliance with the limits of computing devices pursuant to part 15 of FCC or ICES-003 rules, which are designed to provide reasonable protection against radio frequency interference. Operation of the equipment may cause interference with radio communications, in which case the user at his own expense will be required to take whatever measures may be required to correct this interference. General Statement for EVMs including a radio User Power/Frequency Use Obligations: This radio is intended for development/professional use only in legally allocated frequency and power limits. Any use of radio frequencies and/or power availability of this EVM and its development application(s) must comply with local laws governing radio spectrum allocation and power limits for this evaluation module. It is the user’s sole responsibility to only operate this radio in legally acceptable frequency space and within legally mandated power limitations. Any exceptions to this are strictly prohibited and unauthorized by Texas Instruments unless user has obtained appropriate experimental/development licenses from local regulatory authorities, which is responsibility of user including its acceptable authorization. For EVMs annotated as FCC – FEDERAL COMMUNICATIONS COMMISSION Part 15 Compliant Caution This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. FCC Interference Statement for Class A EVM devices This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense. FCC Interference Statement for Class B EVM devices This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. For EVMs annotated as IC – INDUSTRY CANADA Compliant This Class A or B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. Concerning EVMs including radio transmitters This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Concerning EVMs including detachable antennas Under Industry Canada regulations, this radio transmitter may only operate using an antenna of a type and maximum (or lesser) gain approved for the transmitter by Industry Canada. To reduce potential radio interference to other users, the antenna type and its gain should be so chosen that the equivalent isotropically radiated power (e.i.r.p.) is not more than that necessary for successful communication. This radio transmitter has been approved by Industry Canada to operate with the antenna types listed in the user guide with the maximum permissible gain and required antenna impedance for each antenna type indicated. Antenna types not included in this list, having a gain greater than the maximum gain indicated for that type, are strictly prohibited for use with this device. Cet appareil numérique de la classe A ou B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada. Les changements ou les modifications pas expressément approuvés par la partie responsable de la conformité ont pu vider l’autorité de l'utilisateur pour actionner l'équipement. Concernant les EVMs avec appareils radio Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR d'Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de licence. L'exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes : (1) l'appareil ne doit pas produire de brouillage, et (2) l'utilisateur de l'appareil doit accepter tout brouillage radioélectrique subi, même si le brouillage est susceptible d'en compromettre le fonctionnement. Concernant les EVMs avec antennes détachables Conformément à la réglementation d'Industrie Canada, le présent émetteur radio peut fonctionner avec une antenne d'un type et d'un gain maximal (ou inférieur) approuvé pour l'émetteur par Industrie Canada. Dans le but de réduire les risques de brouillage radioélectrique à l'intention des autres utilisateurs, il faut choisir le type d'antenne et son gain de sorte que la puissance isotrope rayonnée équivalente (p.i.r.e.) ne dépasse pas l'intensité nécessaire à l'établissement d'une communication satisfaisante. Le présent émetteur radio a été approuvé par Industrie Canada pour fonctionner avec les types d'antenne énumérés dans le manuel d’usage et ayant un gain admissible maximal et l'impédance requise pour chaque type d'antenne. Les types d'antenne non inclus dans cette liste, ou dont le gain est supérieur au gain maximal indiqué, sont strictement interdits pour l'exploitation de l'émetteur. SPACER SPACER SPACER 【Important Notice for Users of this Product in Japan】 This development kit is NOT certified as Confirming to Technical Regulations of Radio Law of Japan If you use this product in Japan, you are required by Radio Law of Japan to follow the instructions below with respect to this product: 1. Use this product in a shielded room or any other test facility as defined in the notification #173 issued by Ministry of Internal Affairs and Communications on March 28, 2006, based on Sub-section 1.1 of Article 6 of the Ministry’s Rule for Enforcement of Radio Law of Japan, 2. Use this product only after you obtained the license of Test Radio Station as provided in Radio Law of Japan with respect to this product, or 3. Use of this product only after you obtained the Technical Regulations Conformity Certification as provided in Radio Law of Japan with respect to this product. Also, please do not transfer this product, unless you give the same notice above to the transferee. Please note that if you could not follow the instructions above, you will be subject to penalties of Radio Law of Japan. Texas Instruments Japan Limited (address) 24-1, Nishi-Shinjuku 6 chome, Shinjuku-ku, Tokyo, Japan http://www.tij.co.jp 【ご使用にあたっての注】 本開発キットは技術基準適合証明を受けておりません。 本製品のご使用に際しては、電波法遵守のため、以下のいずれかの措置を取っていただく必要がありますのでご注 意ください。 1. 電波法施行規則第6条第1項第1号に基づく平成18年3月28日総務省告示第173号で定められた電波暗室等の 試験設備でご使用いただく。 2. 実験局の免許を取得後ご使用いただく。 3. 技術基準適合証明を取得後ご使用いただく。 なお、本製品は、上記の「ご使用にあたっての注意」を譲渡先、移転先に通知しない限り、譲渡、移転できないも のとします。 上記を遵守頂けない場合は、電波法の罰則が適用される可能性があることをご留意ください。 日本テキサス・インスツルメンツ株式会社 東京都新宿区西新宿6丁目24番1号 西新宿三井ビル http://www.tij.co.jp SPACER SPACER EVALUATION BOARD/KIT/MODULE (EVM) WARNINGS, RESTRICTIONS AND DISCLAIMERS For Feasibility Evaluation Only, in Laboratory/Development Environments. Unless otherwise indicated, this EVM is not a finished electrical equipment and not intended for consumer use. It is intended solely for use for preliminary feasibility evaluation in laboratory/development environments by technically qualified electronics experts who are familiar with the dangers and application risks associated with handling electrical mechanical components, systems and subsystems. It should not be used as all or part of a finished end product. Your Sole Responsibility and Risk. You acknowledge, represent and agree that: 1. You have unique knowledge concerning Federal, State and local regulatory requirements (including but not limited to Food and Drug Administration regulations, if applicable) which relate to your products and which relate to your use (and/or that of your employees, affiliates, contractors or designees) of the EVM for evaluation, testing and other purposes. 2. You have full and exclusive responsibility to assure the safety and compliance of your products with all such laws and other applicable regulatory requirements, and also to assure the safety of any activities to be conducted by you and/or your employees, affiliates, contractors or designees, using the EVM. Further, you are responsible to assure that any interfaces (electronic and/or mechanical) between the EVM and any human body are designed with suitable isolation and means to safely limit accessible leakage currents to minimize the risk of electrical shock hazard. 3. You will employ reasonable safeguards to ensure that your use of the EVM will not result in any property damage, injury or death, even if the EVM should fail to perform as described or expected. 4. You will take care of proper disposal and recycling of the EVM’s electronic components and packing materials. Certain Instructions. It is important to operate this EVM within TI’s recommended specifications and environmental considerations per the user guidelines. Exceeding the specified EVM ratings (including but not limited to input and output voltage, current, power, and environmental ranges) may cause property damage, personal injury or death. If there are questions concerning these ratings please contact a TI field representative prior to connecting interface electronics including input power and intended loads. Any loads applied outside of the specified output range may result in unintended and/or inaccurate operation and/or possible permanent damage to the EVM and/or interface electronics. Please consult the EVM User's Guide prior to connecting any load to the EVM output. If there is uncertainty as to the load specification, please contact a TI field representative. During normal operation, some circuit components may have case temperatures greater than 60°C as long as the input and output are maintained at a normal ambient operating temperature. These components include but are not limited to linear regulators, switching transistors, pass transistors, and current sense resistors which can be identified using the EVM schematic located in the EVM User's Guide. When placing measurement probes near these devices during normal operation, please be aware that these devices may be very warm to the touch. As with all electronic evaluation tools, only qualified personnel knowledgeable in electronic measurement and diagnostics normally found in development environments should use these EVMs. Agreement to Defend, Indemnify and Hold Harmless. You agree to defend, indemnify and hold TI, its licensors and their representatives harmless from and against any and all claims, damages, losses, expenses, costs and liabilities (collectively, "Claims") arising out of or in connection with any use of the EVM that is not in accordance with the terms of the agreement. This obligation shall apply whether Claims arise under law of tort or contract or any other legal theory, and even if the EVM fails to perform as described or expected. Safety-Critical or Life-Critical Applications. If you intend to evaluate the components for possible use in safety critical applications (such as life support) where a failure of the TI product would reasonably be expected to cause severe personal injury or death, such as devices which are classified as FDA Class III or similar classification, then you must specifically notify TI of such intent and enter into a separate Assurance and Indemnity Agreement. Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components which meet ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. Components which have not been so designated are neither designed nor intended for automotive use; and TI will not be responsible for any failure of such components to meet such requirements. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2012, Texas Instruments Incorporated Copyright 2012 by Fen Logic Ltd. All rights reserved. FEN LOGIC LTD. Gertboard User Manual Gert van Loo and Myra VanInwegen Revision 1.0 The Gertboard is an add-on GPIO expansion board for the Raspberry Pi computer. It comes with a large variety of components, including buttons, LEDs, A/D and D/A converters, a motor controller, and an Atmel AVR microcontroller. There is a suite of test/example programs for the Gertboard, written in C, which is freely available at www.element14.com/raspberrypi This manual explains both how to set up the Gertboard for various control experiments and also explains at a high level how the test code works. 3 Contents Gertboard Overview ................................................................................................................................ 4 Labels on the circuit board .................................................................................................................. 5 Location of the building blocks on the Gertboard .............................................................................. 7 Jumpers and straps .............................................................................................................................. 8 GPIO pins ........................................................................................................................................... 8 Schematics .......................................................................................................................................... 9 Test programs overview ...................................................................................................................... 9 Macros........................................................................................................................................... 10 Buffered I/O, LEDs, and pushbuttons ................................................................................................... 11 Push buttons ...................................................................................................................................... 12 Locating the relevant sections of the Gertboard ............................................................................... 12 Testing the pushbuttons .................................................................................................................... 14 Testing the LEDs .............................................................................................................................. 16 Testing I/O ........................................................................................................................................ 18 Open Collector Driver ........................................................................................................................... 19 Testing the open collector drivers ..................................................................................................... 20 Motor Controller ................................................................................................................................... 22 Testing the motor controller .............................................................................................................. 23 Digital to Analogue and Analogue to Digital Converters ..................................................................... 25 Digital to analogue converter ............................................................................................................ 25 Analogue to Digital converter ........................................................................................................... 26 Testing the D/A and A/D .................................................................................................................. 26 ATmega device ..................................................................................................................................... 29 Programming the ATmega ................................................................................................................ 30 Arduino pins on the Gertboard ...................................................................................................... 30 A few sketches to get you going ................................................................................................... 31 Minicom ........................................................................................................................................ 36 Combined Tests .................................................................................................................................... 38 A/D and motor controller .................................................................................................................. 38 Decoder ............................................................................................................................................. 39 For More Information ........................................................................................................................... 40 Appendix A: Schematics ....................................................................................................................... 40 4 Gertboard Overview Raspi open collector (6x) Micro controller strapping area Motor controller D A A D SPI PWM I/O UART I/O 12x 3x SPI/dbg out in 1k 1k ULN2803a ATmega 74xx244 L6203 MCP3002 MCP4802 Fig. 1: The principle, high level diagram of the Gertboard. In this view it is possible to see how flexible Gertboard is, by being able to connect various parts of the board together. Above is a principle diagram1 of the Gertboard. Each circle in the diagram represents a header pin. These headers give you access to a wide range of control combinations. As you begin experimenting with the board, you will probably use the strapping area to connect various components on the Gertboard to the Raspberry Pi. This flexibility even allows you, for example, to connect the motor controller input pins to the Atmel ATmega device (an AVR microcontroller). The ATmega device has a separate 6-pin header, which allows it to be programmed by the Raspberry Pi using the (Serial Peripheral Interface) SPI bus. The major building blocks are: • 12x buffered I/O • 3x push buttons • 6x open collector drivers (50V, 0.5A) • 48V, 4A motor controller • 28-pin dual in line ATmega microcontroller • 2-channel 8/10/12 bit Digital to Analogue converter • 2-channel 10 bit Analogue to Digital converter Each of these building blocks has a section below. 1 A ‘principle diagram’ is a coarse overview of the most important parts of the system. It is not correct in all details. For that you must look at the board schematics. 5 Labels on the circuit board Fig. 2: A photograph of the unpopulated Gertboard viewed from above, showing the silver coloured holes and pads that eventually will be home to the components, as well as the legends printed in white epoxy ink, and green solder resist coating. Fig. 3: This image is a diagrammatic representation of the same photograph shown in Fig. 2 above. It was generated from the same files that were used to create the physical printed circuit board. The blue elements in the diagram correspond to the white text and lines on the photo and the red elements correspond to the silver pads and holes on the photo. 6 From now onwards in this guide, because it is much clearer to see, the diagram shown in Fig. x will be used in preference to show you how to wire up the Gertboard, and to run the test and example programs. It is useful to be able to look at the bare board in order to see the labels (the white text in the photo and the blue text in the diagram) on the board without the components getting in the way. These labels provide essential information that is required in order to use Gertboard to its full potential. Almost all of the components have labels, and more importantly, the pins in the headers have labels. It isn’t necessary to be too concerned about the majority of the components; such as resistors and capacitors (labelled with Cn and Rn, where n is some number). These are fairly simple devices that don’t have a ‘right way round’ when they are assembled to the board. Diodes on the other hand, do need assembling the right way round (covered later) - all the diodes are labelled Dn; of these, the ones that you will be interested in are D1 through D12, the light emitting diodes (LEDs; they are located near the top of the board on the left). Pushbutton switches are labelled S1, S2, and S3 (they are located just beneath the LEDs). Fig. 4: Two examples of ICs – an 8-pin and a 20-pin dual-inline (DIL) package. In this package style, pin 1 is always identified as the first pin anticlockwise from the package notch marking. Integrated circuits, or ICs, are marked Un, so for example the I/O buffer chips are U3, U4, and U5 (these are near the middle of the board), while the Atmel microcontroller is U8 (this is below and to the left of U3 to U5). For the ICs, it is very important to know which is pin 1. If the IC is orientated so that the end with the semi-circle notch is to the left, then pin 1 is the leftmost pin in the bottom row. On the Gertboard, the location of pin 1 is always marked with a square pad. Pin numbers increase in an anti-clockwise direction from there, as shown in the diagram. Knowing this means that the schematics in Appendix A can always be related to the pinning on the ICs on the Gertboard. Headers (the rows of pins sticking up from the board) will be a frequently used component on the Gertboard. They are labelled Jn, so for example the header to the ribbon cable from the Raspberry Pi is attached, is J1. Pin 1 on the headers is again marked with a square pad. Power pins are marked with their voltage; for example there are a few positions marked 3V3. This is a commonly used notation in electronics, and in this case it means 3.3 volts. A 5V power supply comes onto the board via the GPIO connector, but the standard Gertboard assembly instructions do not require that a header is installed to access this. If 5V is really required, and spare header pins are available, a header can be soldered in location J24 in the lower right-hand corner of the board, and then a 5V supply can be picked up from the lower pin (next to the text ‘5V’). Ground is marked with GND or a ⊥ symbol. 1 2 3 4 8 7 6 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 20 19 18 9 10 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 7 Location of the building blocks on the Gertboard Fig. 5: Photograph of an assembled Gertboard, with key functional blocks identified by coloured boundary marking. This image serves as a good reference point for a board that has been successfully assembled from bare board and components. Please note that the appearance of some components can vary. This annotated photo of a populated Gertboard shows where the building blocks (the major capabilities of the board) are located. Some of the building blocks have two areas marked. For example, the turquoise lines showing the Atmel ATmega chip not only surround the chip itself (on the lower left) but also surround two header pins near the bottom of the board, in the middle. These pins are connected to the Atmel chip and provide an easy way to interface the GPIO signals from the Raspberry Pi (which are in the black box) with the Atmel chip. The supply voltage (the voltage that acts as high or logical 1 on the board) is 3.3V. This is generated from the 5V power pin in the J1 header (the one where the ribbon cable to the Raspberry Pi is attached) by the components in the lower right corner of the board. The open collector and motor controllers can handle higher voltages and have points to attach external power supplies. 8 Jumpers and straps Fig. 6: Image showing straps on the left hand side, and jumpers on the right. Straps connect two parts of Gertboard together, whilst jumpers conveniently connect two adjacent pins on the same header, together. The Gertboard Kit contains materials to produce single straps, although the double strap also shown can also be useful. To work properly, and get the maximum flexibility from the Gertboard a number of straps and jumpers are essential. On the left of the photo are straps: they consist of wires that connect the small metal connector and plastic housing, that slip over the header pins. They are meant for connecting header pins that are further apart. It is sometimes useful to have straps that connect two or three adjacent pins to the same number of adjacent pins elsewhere on the board. This is useful for example when you want to use several LEDs. On the right of the above photo are jumpers: they are used to connect two header pins that are right next to each other. There is one jumper that should be in place at all times on the board: the one connecting pins 1 and 2 in header J7. This is the jumper that connects power from the power input pins to the rest of the board. It is near the lower right corner of the board and is the jumper connecting the two pins below the text 3V3 in the photo below. Fig. 7: Image showing header J7 with translucent jumper in place. J7 is located just above J8 (J7 legend is obscured in this image) GPIO pins The header J2, to the right of the text ‘Raspberry Pi’ on the board, provides access to all the I/O pins on the GPIO header. There are 26 pins in J1 (the GPIO header which is connected to the Raspberry Pi through the ribbon cable) but only 17 pins in J2: 3 of the pins in J1 are power and ground, and 6 are DNC (do not connect). The labels on these pins, GP0, GP1, GP4, GP7, etc, may initially seem a little arbitrary, as there are some obvious gaps, and the numbers do not correspond with the pin numbers on the GPIO header J1. These labels are important however: they correspond with the signal names used 9 by the BCM2835, the processor on the Raspberry Pi. Signal GPIOn on the BCM2835 datasheet corresponds to the pin labelled GPn on header J2 (so for example, GPIO17 on the data sheet can be found at the pin labelled GP17 on the board). The numbers in the labels allow us to specify which pins are required in the control programs to be run later. Some of the GPIO pins have an alternate function that are made use of in some of the test programs. These are shown in the table below. The rest are only used as general purpose input/output in the code. On page 27 there is a description of how to gain access to the alternate functions of GPIO pins. GPIO0 SDA0 (alt 0) I2C bus GPIO1 SLC0 (alt 0) GPIO7 SPI_CE1_N (alt 0) SPI bus GPIO8 SPI_CE0_N (alt 0) GPIO9 SPI_MISO (alt 0) GPIO10 SPI_MOSI (alt 0) GPIO11 SPI_SCLK (alt 0) GPIO14 TXD0 (alt 0) UART GPIO15 RXD0 (alt 0) GPIO18 PWM0 (alt 5) pulse width modulation Table 1: Table showing the GPIO pins on the Gertboard, and what their alternative function is. We mention the I2C bus use of GPIO0 and 1 above not because the I2C bus is used in the test programs, but because each of them has a 1800 pull-up resistor on the Raspberry Pi, and this prevents them from being used with the pushbuttons (see page 134). Schematics Whilst there are some circuit diagrams, or schematics, in the main body of the manual for some of the building blocks of the board, they are simplifications of the actual circuits on the board. To truly understand the board and the connections you need to make on it, you need to be a little familiar with the schematics. Thus we have attached the full schematics at the end of this manual as Appendix A. These pages are in landscape format. The page numbers A-1, A-2, etc, are in the lower left corner of the pages (if you hold them so that the writing is the right way up). Test programs overview When you download the Gertboard test/example code (available at www.element14.com/raspberrypi), you will have a file with a name something like gertboard_sw_10_07_12.tar.gz. This is a compressed (hence the .gz suffix, which means it was compressed using the gzip algorithm) archive (hence the .tar), where an archive is a collection of different files, all stored in a single file. To retrieve the original software, put the file where you want your Gertboard software to end up on your Raspberry Pi computer, then uncompress it by typing the following in one of the terminal windows on your Pi (substituting the name of the actual file you have downloaded for the file name we are using in this example): gunzip gertboard_sw_10_07_12.tar.gz 10 Typing a directory command, ls, should then show the newly uncompressed archive file gertboard_sw_10_07_12.tar . So now, to extract the files from the archive, type tar –xvf gertboard_sw_10_07_12.tar A new directory, gertboard_sw, will be created. In it is a set of C files and a makefile. C files are software files, but they need to be compiled to run on the processor on your system. In the case of Raspberry Pi, this is an ARM11. To compile all the code to run on Raspberry Pi, first change directory to gertboard_sw by typing: cd gertboard_sw And then in that directory, type: make all Each building block has at least one test program that goes with it. Currently the test programs are written in C; but they’ll be translated into Python in the near future. Each test program is compiled from two or more C files. The file gb_common.c (which has an associated header file gb_common.h) contains code used by all of the building blocks on the board. Each test has a C file that contains code specific to that test (thus you will find main here). Some of the tests use a special interface (for example the SPI bus), and these tests have an additional C file that provides code specific to that interface (these files are gb_spi.c for the SPI bus and gb_pwm for the pulse width modulator). In each of the sections about the individual building blocks, the code specific to the tests for that block is explained. Since all of the tests share the code in gb_common.c, an overview of that code will be given here. In order to use the Gertboard via the GPIO, the test code first needs to call setup_io. This function allocates various arrays and then calls mmap to associate the arrays with the devices that it wants to control, such as the GPIO, SPI bus, PWM (pulse width modulator) etc. The result of this is that it writes to these arrays control the devices or sends data to them, and reads from these arrays get status bits or data from the devices. At the end of a test program, restore_io should be called, which undoes the memory map and frees the allocated memory. Macros In gb_common.h, gb_spi.h, and gb_pwm.h there are a number of macros that give a more intuitive name to various parts of the arrays that have been mapped. These macros are used to do everything from setting whether a GPIO is used as input or output to controlling the clock speed of the pulse width modulator. In the chart below is a summary of the purpose of the more commonly used macros and give the page number on which its use is explained in more detail. The T column below gives the ‘type’ of the macro. This shows how the macro is used. ‘E’ means that the command is executed, as in: INP_GPIO(17); ‘W’ means that that the command is written to (assigned), as in: GPIO_PULL = 2; 11 ‘R’ means that that the command is read from, as in: data = GPIO_IN0; Macro name T Explanation Page no. INP_GPIO(n) E activates GPIO pin number n (for input) 11 OUT_GPIO(n) E used after above, sets pin n for output 11 SET_GPIO_ALT(n, a) E used after INP_GPIO, select alternate function for pin 24 GPIO_PULL W set pull code 16 GPIO_PULLCCLK0 W select which pins pull code is applied to 16 GPIO_IN0 R get input values 16 GPIO_SET0 W select which pins are set high 17 GPIO_CLR0 W select which pins are set low 17 Table 2: Commonly used macros, their purpose, type and location within this manual. The macro INP_GPIO(n) must be called for a pin number n to allow this pin to be used. By default its mode is set up as an input. If it is required that the pin is used for an output, OUT_GPIO(n)must be called after INP_GPIO(n). Buffered I/O, LEDs, and pushbuttons There are 12 pins which can be used as input or output ports. Each can be set to behave either as an input or an output, using a jumper. Note that the terms ‘input’ and ‘output’ here are always with respect to the Raspberry Pi: in input mode, the pin inputs data to the Pi; in output mode it acts as output from the Pi. It is important to keep this in mind as the Gertboard is set up: an output from the Gertboard is an input to the Raspberry Pi, and so the ‘input’ jumper must be installed to implement this. I/O 1k 1k-10k input 74xx244 output Raspi Fig. 8: The circuit diagram for I/O ports 4-12 The triangles symbols in the diagram above represent buffers. In order to make the port function as an input to the Raspberry Pi you install the ‘input’ jumper: then the data flows from the ‘I/O’ point to the ‘Raspi’ point. To make the port function as an output, the ‘output’ jumper must be installed: then the data flows from the ‘Raspi’ point to the ‘I/O’ point. If both jumpers are installed, it won’t harm the board, but the port won’t do anything sensible. 12 In both the input and output mode the LED will indicate what the logic level is on the ‘I/O’ pin. The LED will be on when the level is high and it will be off when the level is low. There is a third option for using this port: if neither the input nor output jumper is placed the I/O pin can be used as a simple ‘logic’ detector. The I/O pin can be connected to some other logic point (i.e. one that is either at 0V or 3.3V) and use the LED to check if the connect point is seen as high or low. Depending on the type of 74xx244 buffer chosen, the LED could behave randomly if the port is not driven properly. In that case it may easily switch state, switching on or off with the smallest of electronic changes, for example, when the board is simply touched. There is a series resistor between the input buffer and the GPIO port. This is to protect the BCM2835 (the processor on the Raspberry Pi) in case the user programs the GPIO as output and also leaves the ‘input’ jumper in place. The BCM2835 input is a high impedance input and thus even a 10K series resistor will not produce a noticeable change in behaviour when it is used as input. Push buttons The Gertboard has three push buttons; these are connected to ports 1, 2, and 3. Thus the first three I/O ports look like this: I/O 1k 1k-10k input 74xx244 output Raspi 1k Fig. 9: Circuit diagram showing one of the three push buttons I/Os. There is a circuit like this for ports 1 to 3. In order to use a push button, the ‘input’ jumper must not be installed, even if the intention is to use this as an input to the Raspberry Pi. If it is installed, the output of the lower buffer prevents the pushbutton from working properly. To make clear what state each button is in, the output jumper can be installed, and then the LED will now show the button state (LED on means button up, LED off means button down). To use the push buttons, a pull-up must be set on the Raspberry Pi GPIO pins used (described below, page 16) so that they are read as high (logical 1) when the buttons are not pressed. Locating the relevant sections of the Gertboard In the building blocks location diagram on page 7, the components implementing the buffered I/O are outlined in red. The ICs containing the buffers are U3, U4, and U5 near the centre of the board. The LEDs (the round translucent red plastic devices) are labelled D1 to D12; D1 is driven by port 1, D2 by port 2, etc. The pushbutton switches (the silver rectangular devices with circular depressions in the middle) are labelled S1 to S3; S1 is connected to port 1 and so on. The long thin yellow components with multiple pins, are resistor arrays. 13 The pins corresponding to ‘Raspi’ in the circuit diagrams above are B1 to B12 on the J3 header above the words ‘Raspberry Pi’ on the board (B1 to B3 correspond to the ‘Raspi’ points on the second circuit diagram with the pushbutton, and B4 to B12 correspond to the ‘Raspi’ points on the first circuit diagram). They are called ‘Raspi’ because these are the ones that should be connected to the pins in header J2, which are directly connected to the pins in J1, and which are then finally connected via the ribbon cable to the Raspberry Pi. The pins corresponding to the ‘I/O’ point on the right of the circuit diagrams above are BUF1 to BUF12 in the (unlabeled) single row header at the top of the Gertboard. On the Gertboard schematic, I/O buffers are on page A-2. The buffer chips U3, U4, and U5 are clearly labelled. It should be apparent that ports 1 to 4 are handled by chip U3, ports 5 to 8 by chip U4, and ports 9 to 12 by chip U5. The ‘Raspi’ points in the circuit diagrams above are shown as the signals BUF_1 to BUF_12 on the left side of the page, and the ‘I/O’ points are BUF1 to BUF12 to the right of the buffer chips. The input jumper locations are the blue rectangles labelled P1, P3, P5, P7, etc to the left of the buffer chips, and the output jumper locations are the blue rectangles labelled P2, P4, P6, P8, etc, to the right of the buffer chips. The pushbutton switches S1, S2, and S3 are shown separately, on the right side of the page near the bottom. The buffered I/O ports can be used with (almost) any of the GPIO pins; they just have to be connected up using the straps. So for example, if you want to use port 1 with GPIO17 a strap is placed between the B1 pin in J3 and the GP17 pin in J2. Beware that the push buttons cannot be used with GPIO0 or GPIO1 (GP0 and GP1 in header J2 on the board) as those two pins have a 1800 pull-up resistor on the Raspberry Pi. When the button is pressed the voltage on the input will be 3.3 × 1000Ω 1000Ω + 1800Ω = 1.2 This is not an I/O voltage which can be reliably seen as low. The output and input jumper locations are above and below the U3, U4, and U5 buffer chips. The ‘input’ jumpers need to be placed on the headers below the chips (shown on the board with the ‘in’ text; they are separated from the chip they go with by a yellow resistor array), and the ‘output’ jumpers need to be placed on the headers above the chips (with the ‘out’ text). If viewed closely (it is clearer on the bare board), it is possible to see that each row of 8 header pins above and below the buffer chips is divided up into 4 pairs of pins. The pairs on U3 are labelled B1 to B4, the ones on U4 are B5 to B8, and the ones on U5 are B9 to B12. The B1 pins are for port 1, B2 for port 2, etc. To use port n as an input (but not when using the pushbutton, if n is 1, 2, or 3), a jumper is installed over the pair of pins in Bn in the row marked ‘in’ (below the appropriate buffer chip). To use port n as an output, a jumper is installed over the pair of pins in Bn in the row marked ‘out’ (above the appropriate buffer chip). 14 Fig. 10: Example of port configuration where ports 1 to 3 are set to be outputs and ports 10 and 11 are set to be inputs. As a concrete example, in the picture above, ports 1, 2, and 3 are configured for output (because of the jumpers across B1, B2, and B3 on the ‘out’ side of chip U3). Ports 10 and 11 are configured for input (because of the jumpers across B10 and B11 on the ‘in’ side of U5). In the test programs, the required connections are printed out before starting the tests. The input and output jumpers are referred to in the following way: U3-out-B1 means that there is a jumper across the B1 pins on the ‘out’ side of the U3 buffer chip. So the 5 jumpers in the picture above would be referred to as U3-out-B1, U3-out-B2, U3-out-B3, U5-in-B10, and U5-in-B11. Testing the pushbuttons The test program for the pushbutton switches is called buttons. To run this test, the Gertboard must be set up as in the image below. There are straps connecting pins B1, B2, and B3 in header J3 to pins GP25, GP24, and GP23 in header J2 (respectively). Thus GPIO25 will read the leftmost pushbutton, GPIO24 will read the middle one, and GPIO23 will read the rightmost pushbutton. The jumpers on the ‘out’ area of U3 (U3-out-B1, U3-out-B2, U3-out-B3) are optional: if they are installed, the leftmost 3 LEDs will light up to indicate the state of the switches. 15 Fig. 11: Whilst the image above is clear, it isn’t very good at showing exactly how the straps are connected, and between which pins on the board. Fig. 12: This type of diagram is much more effective at showing how straps connect pins together on the board, so from now onwards, we will use these type of diagrams to show wiring arrangements. 16 In the diagram, black circles show which pins are being connected, and black lines between two pins indicate that jumpers (if they are adjacent) or straps (if they are further apart) are used to connect them. The code specific to the buttons test is buttons.c. In the main routine, the connections required for this test are firstly printed to the terminal (a text description of the wiring diagram above). When the user verifies that the connections are correct, setup_io is called (described on page 10) to get everything ready. setup_gpio is then called, which gets GPIO pins 1 to 3 ready to be used as pushbutton inputs. It does this by first using the macro INP_GPIO(n) (where n is the GPIO pin number) to select these 3 pins for input. Then pins are required to be pulled high: the buttons work by dropping the voltage down to 0V when the button is pressed, so it needs to be high when the button is not pressed. This is done by setting GPIO_PULL to 2, the code for pull-up. Should it ever be required, the code for pull-down is 1. The code for no pull is 0; this will allows this pin to be used for output after it has been used as a pushbutton input. To apply this code to the desired pins, set GPIO_PULLCCLK0 = 0X03800000. This hexadecimal number has bits 23, 24, and 25 set to 1 and all the rest set to 0. This means that the pull code is applied to GPIO pins 23, 24, and 25. A short_wait allows time for this to take effect, and then GPIO_PULL and GPIO_PULLCLK0 are set back to 0. Back in the main routine, a loop is entered in which the button states are read (using macro GPIO_IN0), grabbing bits 23, 24, and 25 using a shift and mask logical operations, and, if the button state is different from before, it is printed out in binary: up (high) is printed as ‘1’ and down (low) is printed as ‘0’. This loop executes until a sufficient number of button state changes have occurred. After the loop, unpull_pins is called, which undoes the pull-up on the pins, then call restore_io in gb_common.c to clean up. Testing the LEDs The test program for the LEDs is called leds. To set up the Gertboard to run this test, see the wiring diagram below. Every I/O port is connected up as an output, so all the ‘out’ jumpers (those above the buffer chips) are installed. Straps are used to connect the following (where all the ‘GP’ pins are in header J2 and all the ‘B’ pins are in header J3): GP25 to B1, GP24 to B2, GP23 to B3, GP22 to B4, GP21 to B5, GP18 to B6, GP17 to B7, GP11 to B8, GP10 to B9, GP9 to B10, GP8 to B11, and GP7 to B12. In other words, the leftmost 12 ‘GP’ pins are connected to the ‘B’ pins, except that GP14 and GP15 are missed out: they are already set to UART mode by Linux, so it’s best if they are not touched. If there aren’t enough jumpers or straps to wire these connections all up at once, don’t worry. Just wire up as many as possible, and run the test. Once it’s finished the straps/jumpers can be moved and the test can be run again. Nothing bad will happen if a pin is written to that has nothing connected to it. 17 Fig. 13: The wiring diagram necessary to run the Gertboard LED test program, leds The test code in leds.c first calls setup_io to get everything ready. Then setup_gpio is called, which prepares 12 GPIO pins to be used as outputs (as all 12 I/O ports will require controlling). All of the GPIO signals except GPIO 0, 1, 4, 14, and 15 are used. To set them up for output, first call INP_GPIO(n) (where n is the GPIO pin number) for each of the 12 pins to activate them. This also sets them up for input, so then call OUT_GPIO(n) afterwards for each of the 12 pins to put them in output mode. LEDs are switched on using the macro GPIO_SET0: the value assigned to GPIO_SET0 will set GPIO pin n to high if bit n is set in that value. When a GPIO pin is set high, the I/O port connected to that pin goes high, and the LED for that port turns on. Thus, the line of code “GPIO_SET0 = 0x180;” will set GPIO pins 7 and 8 high (since bits 7 and 8 are set in the hexadecimal number 0x180). Given the wiring setup above, ports 11 and 12 will go high (because these are the ports connected to GP7 and GP8), and thus the rightmost two LEDs will turn on. To turn LEDs off, use macro GPIO_CLR0. This works in a similar way to GPIO_SET0, but here the bits that are high in the value assigned to GPIO_CLR0 specify which GPIO ports will be set low (and hence which ports will be set low, and which LEDs will turn off). So for example, given the wiring above, the command “GPIO_CLR0 = 0x100;” will set GPIO8 pin low, and thus turn off the LED for port 11, which is the port connected to GP8. (In leds.c the LEDs are always all turned off together, but they don’t have to be used this way.) The test program flashes the LEDs in three patterns. The patterns are specified by a collection of global arrays given values using an initializer. The number in each of the arrays says which LEDs will 18 be turned on at that point in the pattern – so, pattern value is submitted sequentially to produce the changing pattern, switching all the LEDs off between successive pattern values. Each pattern is run through twice. The first pattern lights the LEDs one at a time in sequence, left to right. The second pattern does the same but when it reaches the rightmost LED, it then reverses direction and lights them in sequence right to left. The third pattern starts at the left end and at each step switches on one more LED until they are all lit up, then starting at the left it switches them off one by one until they are all off. Finally, the test program switches off all the LEDs and then finally calls restore_io to clean up all the LEDs to a predictable final state. Testing I/O Our two examples so far have only used the ports to access the pushbuttons and LEDs. The next example, called butled (for BUTton LED) will show one of the ports serving just as an input port. The idea is that one port (along with its button) is used to generate a signal, and software then sends that signal to another port which it is used as just an input. We read both ports in and print them on the screen. Fig. 14: The wiring diagram for test program butled which detects a button press, and then display that button state on the screen. This is to test all the I/O on the Gertboard. The wiring for this test is shown above. Pin GPIO23 controls I/O port 3, and GPIO22 controls I/O port 6, so GP23 in header J2 is connected to pin B3 in header J3, and GP22 is connected to B6. Now, for the interesting part. The pushbutton on port 3 is going to be used here, but the LED for port 3 should not be used, so therefore the output jumper for port 3 is not installed (which would be placed at U3-out-B3). 19 Looking at the schematic on page A-2, it is clear that the output buffer for port 3 goes to pin 14 of buffer chip U3. This is connected to the U3-out-B3 header pin just above pin 14 on the chip (it is pin 1 of U3-out-B3; this is clear from the schematic and from the fact that this pin has a square pad on the bare circuit board), so that pin is connected to the BUF6 pin at the top of the board. This allows the switch to generate a signal which is then sent to port 6. A jumper is installed across U4-in-B6 to allow that signal to be input from the board. The value of the switch from port 3 is also read in, and these two should be the same (most of the time). In butled.c we use INP_GPIO to set GPIO22 and GPIO23 to input and GPIO_PULL and GPIO_PULLCLK0 to set the pull-up on GPIO23. This is described in more detail on page 16, in the buttons test. Then the GPIO values are repeatedly read in, and the binary values of GPIO22 and GPIO23 are printed out, if they have changed since the last cycle. So if ‘01’ is displayed on the monitor, it can be deduced that GPIO23 is low and GPIO22 is high. (Note that the LED for port 6, labelled D6, should be off when switch 3 is pressed and on when switch 3 is up.) Now, if the values for GPIO22 and GPIO23 are always the same, ‘00’ and ‘11’ will only ever be printed out. But if the test is started with button 3 up (so ‘11’ is displayed), and then the button is pushed down, occasionally ‘01’ might be seen, followed very quickly by ‘00’. The reason for this differs between the Python and C implementations. In the C version, both values are read at the same time, and the signal from the push button (which is connected to GPIO23) takes a small amount of time to propagate through the buffers to get to GPIO22. It may even be possible to get one reading in after GPIO23 has changed, but insufficient time has passed for GPIO22 to change state and follow it! In the Python code, the read of GPIO22 occurs before the read of GPIO23 (the button). Thus if the button is pressed or released between these two reads, the new value will be read in for the button (GPIO23), but the new value of the other input (GPIO22) won’t change until the next time through the while loop. Open Collector Driver The Gertboard uses six ports of a ULN2803a to provide open collector drivers. These are used to turn off and on devices, especially those that need a different voltage or higher current than that available on the Gertboard and are powered by an external power supply. The ULN2803a can withstand up to 50V and drive 500mA on each of its ports. Each driver has an integrated protection diode (the uppermost diode in the circuit diagram below). Raspi OUT common Fig. 15: Circuit diagram of each open collector driver. 20 The ‘common’ pin is, as the name states, common for all open collector drivers. It is not connected to any other point on the Gertboard. As with all devices the control for the open collector drivers (the ‘Raspi’ point) can also be connected to the ATmega controller to, for example, drive relays or motors. The open collector drivers are in the schematics on page A-3. On the Gertboard building block diagram on page 7, the area containing the components for the open collector drivers are outlined in yellow. The pins corresponding to ‘Raspi’ in the diagram above are RLY1 to RLY6 pins in the J4 header; the pins corresponding to ‘common’ are the ones marked RPWR in the headers on the right edge of the board; and the pins corresponding to ‘OUT’ are the RLY1 to RLY6 pins in the headers J12 to J17. How these are then used is demonstrated by the test wiring and code examples. Testing the open collector drivers The program ocol (for open collector) allows the functional testing of the open collector drivers. A simple mechanism was required to switch the driver on and off, so we created a little circuit (see diagram below) consisting of two large LEDs and a resistor in series. Once connected, the forward voltage across each of these LEDs is a little above 3V, so we used a 9V battery as a power supply, and calculated a series resistance of around about 90 to set a suitable current flow through the LEDs. Since this small test circuit will not be used again, it can simply be hand soldered together off-board. Remember that LEDs are diodes, and have to be connected the right way round. The small ‘flat’ in the LED moulding denotes the ‘cathode’ or negative pin. If you think of the LED symbol in the circuit diagram below as an arrow, it is pointing in the direction of the current flow, from + to -, or from anode to cathode. To turn the circuit off and on using the open collector driver (say you want to use driver 1), first check that it works with the power supply described above. Then, leave the positive side of your circuit attached to the positive terminal of the power supply, but in addition connect it to one of the RPWR pins in the headers on the right edge of the board (they are all connected together). Disconnect the ground side of the circuit from the power supply and connect it instead to RLY1 in header J12 on the right of the board. Attach the ground terminal of the power supply to any GND or ⊥ pin on the board. Now, we need a signal to control the driver. For the ocol test we are using GPIO4 to control the open collector (you could of course use any logic signal), so connect GP4 in header J2 to RLY1 in J4. (To test a different driver, say n, with the ocol test, connect the ground side of the circuit up to RLYn in the headers on the right of the board and connect GP4 in header J2 to RLYn in J4.) Now, when RLY1 in J4 is set low, the circuit doesn’t receive any power and thus is off. When RLY1 in J4 goes high, the open collector driver uses transistors to connect the ‘ground’ side of the circuit to the ground on the board, and since this is connected to the ground terminal on the power supply, the power supply ends up powering the circuit: it is just turned off and on by the open collector driver. 21 Fig.16: Wiring diagram showing how to connect Gertboard to test the open collector drivers. It also shows the small test power supply made up of two LEDs in series, a 90  resistor and a 9V battery. You may wonder why you need to connect the positive terminal of the power supply to the open collector driver (via the RPWR pin). The reason for this is that if the circuit happens to contain an component that has electrical inductance, for example a motor or a relay, when the power is turned off this inductance causes the voltage on RLYn pin to quickly rise to a higher voltage than the positive terminal of the power supply, dropping quickly afterwards. The chip itself has an internal diode connecting the RLYn pin to the RPWR. This allows current to flow to the top (positive side) of your circuit, allowing the energy to dissipate, and preventing damage. The ocol test is very simple. First, it prints out the connections required on the board (and with your external circuit and power supply), and then it calls setup_io to get the GPIO interface ready to use and setup_gpio to set pin GPIO4 to be used as an output (using the commands INP_GPIO(4); OUT_GPIO(4); as described on page 11). Then in it uses GPIO_SET0 and GPIO_CLR0 (described on page 17) to set GPIO4 high then low 10 times. Note: the test asks which driver should be tested, but it only uses this information to print out the connections that need to be made. Otherwise it ignores your response. 22 Motor Controller The Gertboard has a position for a L6203 (Miniwatt package) motor controller. The motor controller is for brushed DC motors. The controller has two input pins, A and B (labelled MOTA and MOTB on the board). The pins can be driven high or low, and the motor responds according to the table below. The speed of the motor can be controlled by applying a pulse-width-modulated (PWM) signal to either the A or B pin. A B Motor action 0 0 no movement 0 1 rotate one way 1 0 rotate opposite way from above 1 1 no movement Table 3: Truth table showing the behaviour of the motor controller under different logic combinations. The motor controller IC has internal temperature protection. Current protection is provided by a fuse on the Gertboard. The motor controller is in the schematics on page A-4. On the Gertboard building block diagram on page 7, the area containing the components for the motor controller are outlined in purple. The motor controller and screw terminals are near the top of the board, and there are two pins for the control signals in a small header just above GP4 and GP1 in header J2. The MOTA and MOTB pins just above header J2 are the inputs to the motor controller – these are digital signals (low and high). The screw terminals at the top of the board labelled MOTA and MOTB are the outputs of the motor controller: they actually provide the power to the motor. The motor will probably need more power (a higher voltage or current) than that provided by the Gertboard. The screw terminals at the top labelled MOT+ and ⊥ allow the connection of an external power supply to provide this: the motor controller directs this power to the MOTA and MOTB screw terminals, modulating it according to the MOTA and MOTB inputs near J2. If you just want to turn the motor off and on, in either direction, this is achieved by simply choosing two of the GPIO pins and installing straps between them to the MOTA and MOTB motor controller inputs. Then, to control the motor, the pins are set high or low per the table 3 above. To control the speed of the motor however, pulse width modulation (PWM) is required. This is a device that outputs a square wave that flips back and forth from on to off very rapidly, as in the diagram below: Fig. 17: An example of a PWM output. In this example the output is neither on nor off all the time. In fact, here it is on for 50% of the time, and is therefore said to have a duty cycle of 50%. 0 1 23 With a PWM, you can control the amount of time the output is high vs. when it is low. This is called the duty cycle and is expressed as a percentage. The diagram above shows a 50% duty cycle; the one below is 25%. Fig. 18: In this PWM example, the duty cycle is 25%. There is a PWM in the BCM2835 (the Raspberry Pi processor), and it’s output can be accessed via GPIO18 (it is alternate function 5). If this is connected to one of the motor controller inputs (MOTA has been used in our motor test), and set the other motor controller input (MOTB in our test) to a steady high or low, the speed and direction of the motor can be controlled. Fig. 19: The motor direction is set by MOTB. Whilst MOTA has a duty cycle of 25%, the motor only receives power when MOTA and MOTB are different, thus it receives power for 75% of the time. For example, in the diagram above we are alternating between A low/B high and A high/B high (the second and fourth lines of the table above). When A is low, the motor will receive power making it turn one way; when A is high it will not receive power. The end result for the 25% duty cycle shown here is that the motor will turn one way at roughly ¾ speed. Fig. 20: In this example, the truth table predicts that the motor will run in the opposite direction at around 25% speed. If on the other hand you set MOTB low, as in the diagram above, then when A is high the motor will receive power making it turn in the other direction, and when A is low the motor will not receive power. The result for the 25% duty cycle is that it will turn in the other direction at about ¼ speed. Testing the motor controller The PWM is controlled by a memory map, like the GPIO and SPI bus. This memory map is part of the setup_io function in gb_common.c, so that is whether the PWM is used or not. Further setup code is found in, gb_pwm.c, with an associated header file gb_pwm.h. The function setup_pwm in gb_pwm.c sets the speed of the PWM clock, and sets the maximum value of the PWM to 1024: this is the value at which the duty cycle of the PWM will be 100%. It also makes sure that the PWM is off. The two routines set_pwm0 and force_pwm0 set the value that controls the duty cycle for the PWM. set_pwm0 sets the value (first checking that it is between 0 and 1024), but as there are only certain points in the PWM cycle where a new value is picked up, if a second value is written again quickly the first will have no effect. The force_pwm0 routine takes two arguments, a new value and a new mode. It disables the PWM, then sets the value, then re-enables it with the given mode setting, 0 1 0 1 0 1 MOTA MOTB 0 1 0 1 MOTA MOTB 24 with delays in strategic places to allow the new values to be picked up. The pwm_off routine simply disables the PWM. The test program for the motor controller is called motor. To set up Gertboard for this, connect GP17 in J2 to the MOTB pin (the MOTB pin in the 2-pin header above GP1 and GP4, not the one at the top of the board), and GP18 to MOTA in that little header. The motor leads need to be connected to the MOTA and MOTB screw terminals at the top of the board, and the power supply for the motor needs to be connected to the MOT+ and ⊥ screw terminals. This is shown below. Fig. 20: The wiring diagram for the test program motor. The code for the motor program is in motor.c. In the main routine, first the connections that must be made on the board to run this program are printed out, then call setup_io to get the GPIO interface ready for use. setup_gpio is then called to set GPIO18 up for use as the PWM output and GPIO17 up for normal output. For the latter, both INP_GPIO and OUT_GPIO are used, see page 11 for more info. To set up GPIO18, first use INP_GPIO(18) to activate the pin. One of the alternate functions for GPIO18 is to act as the output for the PWM; this is alternative 5. Thus use the macro SET_GPIO_ALT(18, 5) to select this alternate use of the pin. (See table Table 6-31 from the BCM2835 datasheet, or the online version at http://elinux.org/RPi_BCM2835_GPIOs, for more details about alternative functions for the GPIO pins. A summary of the alternate function of GPIO pins used on the Gertboard, see the table on page 9.) 25 We set the output of GPIO17 low (to make sure that the motor doesn’t turn) and then initialize the PWM by calling setup_pwm. We enable the PWM by setting the mode to PWM0_ENABLE using force_pwm0. Since GPIO17 (motor controller B input) is set low, when the duty cycle on the PWM (motor controller A input) is high enough, the motor will turn the ‘opposite way’ as described in the motor table on page 22. A loop now starts where the PWM is started, first with a very low duty cycle (because the value passed to set_pwm0 is low), then gradually increasing this to the maximum (which is set to 0x400 – 1024 – in setup_pwm). Then the value sent to the PWM is decreased to slow the motor down. Then GPIO17 is set high, so that the motor will get power on the low phase of the PWM signal. The PWM is re-enabled with the mode PWM0_ENABLE|PWM0_REVPOLAR. The reverse polarization flag flips the PWM signal, so that a low value sent to the PWM results in a signal that is high most of the time (rather than low most of the time). That way the same code can be used to slowly ramp up the speed of the motor (but in the ‘one way’ direction as in the table on page 22), then slow it down again. Finally the PWM is switched off, and the GPIO interface is closed down. Digital to Analogue and Analogue to Digital Converters In the Gertboard building blocks diagram on page 7, the components implementing the converters are outlined in orange. Both the analogue converter (D/A) and analogue to digital converter (A/D) are 8- pin chips from Microchip. The D/A is U6 (above) and the A/D is U10 (below). Each supports 2 channels. Both use the SPI bus to communicate with the Raspberry Pi. The SPI pins on the two chips are connected to the pins labelled SCLK, MOSI, MISO, CSnA, and CSnB in the header just above J2 on the board (thus in the building blocks diagram, these pins are also outlined in orange). SCLK is the clock, MOSI is the output from the RPi, and MISO is the input to the RPi. CSnA is the chip select for the A/D, and CSnB is the chip select signal for the D/A (the ‘n’ in the signal name means that the signal is ‘negative’, thus the chip is only selected when the pin is low). Both A/D and D/A chips have a 10K pull-up resistor on their chip-select pins, so the devices will not be accessed if the chips select pins are not connected. The SPI pins are conveniently located just above GP7 to GP11 in header J2, because one of the alternate functions of these pins is to drive the SPI signals. For example, the “ALT0” (alternative 0) function of GPIO9 is SPI0_MISO, which is why the pin labelled MISO is just about the pin labelled GP9. Thus to use the A/D and D/A, simply put jumpers connecting pins GP7 to GP11 to the SPI pins directly about them (although technically you only need CSnA for the A/D and CSnB for the D/A). In the schematics, the D/A and A/D converts are on page A-6. Digital to analogue converter The Gertboard uses a MCP48xx digital to analogue converter (D/A) from Microchip. The device comes in three different types: 8, 10 or 12 bits. It is likely that MCP4802, the 8 bit version, will be used, but if higher resolutions are needed, it can be replaced with the MCP4812 (10 bits) or MCP4822 (12 bits). These chips are all pin-compatible and are written to in the same way. In particular, the routine that writes to the D/A assumes that writes are in 12 bits, so it is important that the value is selected appropriately (details are below in the “Testing the D/A and A/D” section). The maximum output voltage of the D/A – the output voltage when you send an input of all 1s – is 2.04V. 26 The analogue outputs of the two channels go to pins labelled DA0 (for channel 0) and DA1 (for channel 1) in the J29 header. Just next to these pins are ground pins (GND) to provide a reference. Analogue to Digital converter The Gertboard uses a MCP3002 10-bit analogue to digital converter from Microchip. It supports 2 channels with a sampling rate of ~72k samples per second (sps). The maximum value (1023) is returned when the input voltage is 3.3V. The analogue inputs for these two channels are AD0 (for channel 0) and AD1 (for channel 1) in the J28 header. Just next to these pins are ground pins (GND) to provide a reference. Testing the D/A and A/D Since the D/A and A/D converters both use the SPI bus, the common SPI bus code has been placed into a separate file, gb_spi.c. There is also an associated header file, gb_spi.h, which contains many macros and constants needed for interacting with the SPI bus, as well as the declarations for the functions in gb_spi.c. These functions are setup_spi, read_adc, and write_dac. setup_spi sets the clock speed for the bus and clears status bits. read_adc takes an argument specifying the channel (should be 0 or 1) and returns an integer with the value read from the A/D converter. The value returned will be between 0 and 1023 (i.e. only the least significant 10 bits are set), with 0 returned when the input pin for that channel is 0V and 1023 returned for 3.3V. The write_dac routine takes two arguments, a channel number (0 or 1) and a value to write. The value written requires some explanation. The MCP48xx family of digital to analogue converters all accept a 12 bit value. The MCP4822 uses all the bits; the MCP4812 ignores the last two; and the MCP4802 (which is probably the one you are using) ignores the last four. Since you could use any of those chips on the Gertboard, write_dac is written in so that it will work with all three, so it simply sends to the D/A the value it was given. If Gertboard is fitted with the MCP4802, it can only handle values between 0 and 255, but these must be in bits 4 through 11 (assuming the least significant bit is bit 0) of the bit string it is sent. Thus if the desired number to be sent to the D/A is between 0 and 255, it must be multiplied by 16 (which effectively shifts the information 4 bits to the left) before sending this value to write_dac. The value on the output pin, Vout, is given by the following formula (assuming the 8-bit MCP4802):  =  256 × 2.048 To test the D/A, a multimeter is required. The test program for this is dtoa. To set up Gertboard for this test, jumpers are placed on the pins GP11, GP10, GP9, and GP7 connecting them to the SPI bus pins above them. Attach the multimeter as follows: the black lead needs to be connected to ground. You can use any of the pins marked with ⊥ or GND for this. The red lead needs to be connected to DA0 (to test the D/A channel 0 which is shown below) or DA1 (for channel 1). Switch the multimeter on, and set it to measure voltages from 0 to around 5V. 27 Fig. 21: The wiring diagram required to measure the output from the D to A converter fitted to the Gertboard whilst running the test program dtoa. The dtoa program first asks which channel to use and prints out the connections needed to make on Gertboard to run the program. Then it calls setup_io to get the GPIO ready to use, then calls setup_gpio to choose which pins to use and how to use them. In setup_gpio, as usual INP_GPIO(n) (where n is the pin number) is used to activate the pins. This also sets them up to be used as inputs. They should however, be used as an SPI bus, which is one of the alternative functions for these pins (it is alternate 0). Thus we use SET_GPIO_ALT(n, a) (where n is the pin number and a is the alternate number, in this case 0) to select this alternate use of the pins. Then the program sends different values to the D/A and asks for real verification, using the multimeter, that the D/A converter is generating the correct output voltage. The test program for the A/D is called atod. To run this test a voltage source on the analogue input is required. This is most easily provided by a potentiometer (a variable resistor). The two ends of the potentiometer are connected, one side to high (3.3V, which you can access from any pin labelled 3V3) and the other to low (GND or ⊥), and the middle (wiper) part to AD0 (for channel 0 as shown below) or AD1 (for channel 1). To use the SPI bus jumpers should be installed on the pins GP11, GP10, GP9, and GP8 connecting them to the SPI bus pins above them. 28 Fig. 22: Wiring diagram showing how the Gertboard is connected to verify that the A/D converter is working properly, using the test program atod. The atod program first asks which channel should be used and prints out the connections required on Gertboard to run the program. Then it calls setup_io to get the GPIO ready, then calls setup_gpio to choose which pins will be used, and how they will be used. The setup_gpio used in atod works the same way as the one in dtoa (except for activating GPIO8 instead of GPIO7). Then atod repeatedly reads the 10 bit value from the A/D converter and prints out the value on the terminal, both as an absolute number and as a bar graph (the value read is divided by 16, and the quotient is represented as a string of ‘#’ characters). One thing to be aware of is that even if the potentiometer is not moved, exactly the same result may not appear on successive reads. With 10 bits of accuracy, it is very sensitive, and even the smallest changes, such as house current running in nearby wires, can affect the value read. Even without a multimeter or a potentiometer, it is still possible to test the A/D and D/A by sending the output of the D/A to the input of the A/D. The test that does this is called dad, for digitalanalogue- digital. To set the Gertboard up for this test, hook up all the SPI bus pins (connecting GP11 though GP7 with jumpers to the pins above them) and put a jumper between pins DA1 and AD0, as in the diagram below. 29 Fig. 23: The wiring diagram for an alternative method of testing the A/D and D/A converters together, without the aid of a multimeter and potentiometer. The dad test sends 17 different digital values to the D/A (0 to 255 in even jumps, then back down to 0). The resulting values are then read in from the A/D. Both the original digital values sent and the values read back are printed out, as is a bar graph representing the value read back (divided by 16 as in atod). The bar graph printed out should be a triangle shape: the lines will start out very short, then get longer and longer as larger digital values are read back, then will get shorter again. ATmega device The Gertboard can hold an Atmel AVR microcontroller, a 28-pin ATmega device, at location U8 on the lower left of the board. This can be any of the following: ATmega48A/PA, 88A/PA, 168A/PA or 328/P in a 28-pin DIP package. The device has a 12MHz ceramic resonator attached to pins 9 and 10. All input/output pins are brought out to header J25 on the left edge of the board. There is a separate 6- pin header (J23 on the left side of the board) that can be used to program the device. The PD0/PD1 pins (ATmega UART TX and RX) are brought out to pins placed adjacent to the Raspberry Pi UART pins so you only need to place two jumpers to connect the two devices. Note that the ATmega device on the Gertboard operates at 3.3Volts. That is in contrast to the ‘Arduino’ system which runs at 5V. It is also the reason why the device does not have a 16MHz clock. In fact at 3V3 the maximum operating frequency according to the specification is just under 12MHz. Warning: many of the Arduino example sketches (programs) mention +5V as part of the circuit. Because we are running at 3.3V, you must use 3.3V instead of 5V wherever the latter is mentioned. If you use 5V you risk damaging the chip. The ATmega device is in the schematics on page A-6. 30 Programming the ATmega Programming the ATmega microcontroller is straightforward once you have all the infrastructure set up, but it requires a fair bit of software to be installed on your Raspberry Pi. We are immensely grateful to Gordon Henderson, of Drogon Systems, for working out what needed to be done and providing the customized software. Using his system, you can use the Arduino IDE (Integrated Development Environment) on the Raspberry Pi to develop and upload code for the ATmega chip on the Gertboard. The Atmel chips most commonly used on the Gertboard are the ATmega168 and ATmega328, so Gordon assumes you have one of these. To use Gordon’s system, first you need to install the Arduino IDE. Then you download a custom version of avrdude, which allows you to program the AVR microcontroller using the SPI bus. (GPIO pins GPIO7 through GPIO11 can be used as a SPI bus.) Then you have to edit various configuration files to fully integrate the Gertboard into the Arduino IDE. Finally, you have to program the ‘fuses’ on the ATmega chip. Happily, Gordon has written some scripts to do all this for you. Full instructions, scripts, and the modified avrdude are available at: https://projects.drogon.net/raspberry-pi/gertboard/ We assume now that you have downloaded and successfully installed and configured the Arduino IDE, as described above, and we proceed from there. To get going with the ATmega chip, start up the Arduino IDE. This should be easy: if the installation of the Arduino package was successful, you will have a new item “Arduino IDE” in your start menu, under “Electronics”. The exact version of the IDE you get with depends on the operating system you are using. The version number is given in the title bar. The Debian squeeze package is version 0018, while the wheezy package is 1.0.1. First you will need to configure the IDE to work with the Gertboard. Go to the Tools > Board menu and choose the Gertboard option with the chip you are using (ATmega168 or ATmega328). For IDE version 1.0.1, you will also have go to the Tools > Programmer menu and choose “Raspberry Pi GPIO”. Arduino pins on the Gertboard All the input and output pins of the ATmega chip are brought out to header J25 on the left edge of the board. They are labelled PCn, PDn, and PBn, where n is a number. These labels correspond to the pinout diagrams of the ATmega168/328 chips. However, in the Arduino world, the pins of the chips are not referred to directly. Instead there is an abstract notion of digital and analogue pin numbers, which is independent of the physical devices. This allows code written for one Arduino board to be easily used with another Arduino board, which may have a chip with a different pinout. Thus, in order to use your Gertboard with the Arduino IDE, you need to know how the Arduino pin number relates to the labels on your Gertboard. The table below shows this correspondence (“GB” means Gertboard). 31 Arduino Pin GB pin Arduino Pin GB pin Arduino Pin GB pin digital 0 PD0 digital 7 PD7 analogue 0, A0 PC0 digital 1 PD1 digital 8 PB0 analogue 1, A1 PC1 digital 2 PD2 digital 9 PB1 analogue 2, A2 PC2 digital 3 PD3 digital 10 PB2 analogue 3, A3 PC3 digital 4 PD4 digital 11 PB3 analogue 4, A4 PC4 digital 5 PD5 digital 12 PB4 analogue 5, A5 PC5 digital 6 PD6 digital 13 PB5 Table 4: The relationship between pins on Arduino and pins on the Gertboard. In both versions of the Arduino IDE, digital pins are referred to in the code with just a number. For example digitalWrite(13, HIGH); will set pin 13 (PB5 on the Gertboard) to logical 1. (In the Arduino world, LOW refers to logical 0, and HIGH refers to logical 1.) The analogue pins are handled slightly differently. In version 0018, analogue pins are referred to simply by number, so whether 0 refers to PD0 (a digital pin) or PC0 (an analogue pin) depends on the context. The command value = digitalRead(0); will cause a read from digital 0 (PD0), and value will be assigned LOW or HIGH, while the command value = analogRead(0); will cause a read from analogue 0 (PC0), and value will be assigned a number between 0 and 1023, as the A/D converters in the ATmega chip return 10 bit values. In version 1.0.1, however, although numbers 0 through 5 still work to specify analogue pins, they are referred to in the examples as A0 to A5, and this seems to be the preferred style now. So to read from analogue pin 0 you would use the command value = analogRead(A0); A few sketches to get you going A good first sketch to try is Blink, which makes an LED turn on and off. With version 0018 of the IDE it’s in the File > Examples > Digital menu; in 1.0.1 it’s in the File > Examples > Basics menu. When you select this, a new window pops up with the Blink code. There are only two functions in the code, setup and loop. These are required for all Arduino programs: setup is executed once at the very beginning, and loop is called repeatedly, as long as the chip has power. Note that you do not need to provide any code to call these functions. 32 The modified avrdude that you downloaded uses the SPI bus to upload the code to the ATmega chip, so you need to connect the GPIO pins used for the SPI bus to the 6-pin header J23, as in the diagram below. Here you are simply connecting the SPI pins in the GPIO to the corresponding SPI pins in the header. The arrangement of the pins in J23 is shown in the schematics, on page A-6. Fig. 23: The wiring diagram for downloading sketches to the ATmega microprocessor. To upload your sketch to the chip in Arduino IDE version 0018, either choose File > Upload to I/O Board option, or click the icon with the right-pointing arrow and the array of dots. With version 1.0.1 choose File > Upload Using Programmer. It will take a bit of time to compile and upload, and then your sketch is running. But nothing is happening! On most Arduino boards, pin 13 (the digital pin used by this sketch) has an LED attached to it, but not the Gertboard. You have to wire up the LED yourself. Looking at the table above, we see that digital pin 13 is labelled PB5 on the Gertboard, so you need to connect PB5 to one of the I/O ports. Looking back to the port diagram on page Error! Bookmark not defined., we need to connect it to the point labelled ‘I/O’ on that diagram. Recall that the pins corresponding to these points are BUF1 to BUF12 in the (unlabeled) single row header at the top of the Gertboard. So if you connect PB5 to BUF1, as below, the first LED will start to blink. 33 Fig. 24: Wiring diagram for the sketch Blink. Note that in this diagram we have not shown the connections to the SPI pins. Once you have uploaded the code, you no longer need them and can remove the straps. On the other hand, if you want you can leave them in place, and this is a good idea if you are planning on uploading some other sketches later. Let’s look at another fairly simple sketch called Button, located under File > Examples > Digital menu in both 0018 and 1.0.1. The comments at the beginning of the sketch read The circuit: * LED attached from pin 13 to ground * pushbutton attached to pin 2 from +5V * 10K resistor attached to pin 2 from ground Assuming that you have Blink working, your LED is already wired up, but what about the button? As mentioned above, since the ATmega chip on the Gertboard runs at 3.3V, we must replace the 5V with 3.3V. So they suggest using a circuit like the one below, where the value read at pin 2 is logical 0 if the button is not pressed (due to the 10K pull-down resistor) and logical 1 if the button is pressed. Fig. 25: Suggested switch circuit for use with Button sketch. However, the buttons on the Gertboard are used like this: 34 Fig. 26: Circuit actually in use on the Gertboard, showing an additional 1k resistor to protect the input to BCM2835. The 1K resistor between the pushbutton and the ‘Raspi’ point is to protect the BCM2835 (the processor on the Raspberry Pi) if you accidentally set the GPIO pin connected to ‘Raspi’ to output instead of input. The circuit to the right of the ‘Raspi’ point happens on the Raspberry Pi: to use the push button we set a pull-up (shown as a resistor in the circuit above) on the pin so that the value read is logical 1 when the button is not pressed (see page 16). The Gertboard buttons are connected directly to ground so they cannot be made to read logic 1 when pressed. If you are want to use a Gertboard button with an Arduino sketch that assumes that the button reads 1 when pressed, the best approach is to modify the sketch, if needed, so that it will invert the value it reads from the button. For the pull-up, we can take advantage of the pull-ups in the ATmega chip. To do this, find the lines below in the sketch // initialize the pushbutton pin as an input: pinMode(buttonPin, INPUT); and insert the following two lines after them: // set pullup on pushbutton pin digitalWrite(buttonPin, HIGH); To invert the value read from the button, find the line below: buttonSate = digitalRead(buttonPin); and insert a ! (the negation operator in C) as follows: buttonSate = !digitalRead(buttonPin); Now upload this modified sketch, as described for Blink. We still need to attach Arduino digial pin 2 (PD2 on the Gertboard, as you can see from the table) to a button, say button 3.The ‘Raspi’ pin in the circuit diagram above, which is where we want to read the value, is in the J3 header. 35 Fig. 27: Wiring diagram showing the additional strap necessary for button operation for the sketch Button. When you have done this, the first LED will be on when the third button is pressed, and off when the third button is up. Now let’s try using an analogue pin. Find the AnalogInput sketch under File > Examples > Analog (in both versions 0018 and 1.0.1). This reads in a value from analogue input 0 (which has already been converted by the internal A/D to a value between 0 and 1023), then uses that number as a delay between turning an LED on and off. Thus, the lower the voltage on the analogue pin, the faster the LED flashes. To run this example, you’ll need a potentiometer. The one used to test the A/D will work fine here. The comments for AnalogInput say to connect the potentiometer so that the wiper is on analogue pin 0 (PC0 on the Gertboard) and the outer pins are connected to +5V and ground. As above, you must use 3.3V instead of 5V as we’re running the chip at 3.3V here. The diagram below shows how to connect up the Gertboard to make this sketch work after it is uploaded. 36 Fig. 28: Wiring diagram for the AnalogInput sketch. Minicom Some of the Arduino sketches involve reading or writing data via the serial port, or UART. An example is AnalogInSerial under File > Examples > Analog for version 0018. In version 1.0.1, this same example has been renamed AnalogReadSerial and is under File > Examples > Basics. This sketch sets the baud rate to 9600, then repeatedly reads in a value from analogue pin 0 and prints this value to the serial port (also called UART). The value read in is between 0 and 1023; 0 means that the input pin is at 0V and 1023 means that it is at the supply voltage (3.3V for the Gertboard). To set up your Gertboard for this sketch, you need the potentiometer attached to analogue input 0 as described above. In addition you need to connect the ATmega chip’s UART pins to the Raspberry Pi. Digital pin 0 (PD0 on the Gertboard) is RX (receive), and digital pin 1 (PD1 on the Gertboard) is TX (transmit). These signals are also brought out to the pins labelled MCTX and MCRX just above the GP15 and GP14 pins in header J2 on the Gertboard. Thus you can use two jumpers to attach the ATmega’s TX to GP15 and RX to GP14, as shown below. 37 Fig. 29: Wiring diagram for the sketch AnalogInSerial/AnalogReadSerial. GPIO14 and GPIO15 are the pins that the Raspberry Pi uses for the UART serial port. If you refer back to the table of alternate functions on page 9, you will see that GPIO14 is listed as TX and GPIO15 as RX. This is not a mistake! This swapping is necessary: the data that is transmitted by the ATmega is received by the Raspberry Pi, and vice versa. Now, how to we get the Raspberry Pi to read and show us the data that the ATmega is sending out on the serial port? There is a button labelled Serial Monitor on the toolbar of the Arduino IDE, but it doesn’t work on the Raspberry Pi. It assumes that you are talking to an Arduino board over USB, not talking to a Gertboard over GPIO. The easiest way to retrieve this data is to use the minicom program. You can install this easily by typing into a terminal this command: sudo apt-get install minicom You can use menus to configure minicom (by typing minicom –s). Alternatively, included with the Gertboard software is a file minirc.ama0 with the settings you need to read from the GPIO UART pins at 9600 baud. Copy this file (which was provided by Gordon Henderson) to /etc/minicom/ (you’ll probably need to sudo this) and invoke minicom by typing sudo minicom ama0 Now if you upload the sketch to the ATmega chip, you should see the value from the potentiometer displayed in your minicom monitor. These examples have only just scratched the surface of the wonderful world of Arduino. Check out http://arduino.cc/en/Tutorial/HomePage for much, much more. 38 Combined Tests This section shows some examples of using more than one building block at a time. A/D and motor controller In the potmot (for potentiometer-motor) test we use a potentiometer (“pot”) connected to the analogue to digital converter (A/D) to get an input value, and this value is used to control the speed and direction of the motor. It is set up so that at one extreme, the motor is going at top speed, and as you move the wiper towards the middle it slows, at the middle the motor stops, and as you continue to move the wiper along, the motor speeds up again but in the other direction. The main routine for this is in potmot.c. Functions from gb_spi.c and gb_pwm.c are used to control the SPI bus (for reading the A/D) and the pulse width modulator (for controlling the speed of the motor). To wire up the Gertboard for this example, you combine the wiring for the A/D and motor tests. Jumpers connect GP8 to GP11 to the pins directly above them to allow us to control the SPI bus using GPIO8 to GPIO11. You must attach your potentiometer to the AD0 input. GPIO17 controls the motor B input and GPIO18 controls the motor A input using the pulse width modulator (PWM). Thus GP17 must be connected via a strap to MOTB, and GP18 must be connected to MOTA. The motor and its power source must be connected to the screw terminals in J19 at the top of the board. See the wiring diagram below. Fig. 30: Wiring diagram for the combined potmot test. + - your power source goes here M 1 2 3 39 In the main routine for potmot, first we print to the terminal the connections that need to be made on the Gertboard to run this example, then we call setup_io to set up the GPIO ready for use. Then we call setup_gpio to set the GPIO pins the way we want them. In this, we set up GPIO8 to GPIO11 to use the SPI bus using INP_GPIO and SET_GPIO_ALT as described in the section on A/D and D/A converters (page 27). GPIO17 is set up as an output (using INP_GPIO and OUT_GPIO), and GPIO18 is set up as a PWM using as INP_GPIO and SET_GPIO_ALT as described in the section on the motor controller (page 24). Back in main, we call setup_spi and setup_pwm to get the SPI bus and PWM ready for use and get the motor ready to go. Then we repeatedly read the A/D and set the direction and speed of the motor depending on the value we read. Lower A/D values (up to 511 – recall that the A/D chip used returns a 10 bit value so the maximum will be 1023) result in the motor B input being set high, and thus the motor goes in the “rotate one way” as in the motor controller table on page 22. Confusingly, this motor direction is called “backwards” in the comments of the program! Higher A/D values (512 to 1023) result in the motor B input being set low, and the motor goes in the “rotate opposite way” direction. This is called “forwards” in the comments of the program. Simple arithmetic is used to translate A/D values near 511 to slow motor speeds and A/D values near the endpoints of the range (0 and 1023) to fast motor speeds by varying the value sent to the PWM. Decoder The decoder implemented by the decoder program takes the three pushbuttons as input and turns on one of 8 LEDs to indicate the number with the binary encoding given by the state of the buttons. Switch S1 gives the most significant bit of the number, S2 the middle bit, and S3 the least significant bit. For output, the LED D5 represents the number 0, D6 represents 1, and so on, so D12 represents 7. Recall that the pushbuttons are high (1) when up and low (0) when pushed, so LED D12 is lit up when no buttons are pressed (giving binary 111 or 7), D6 is lit up when S1 and S2 are pressed (giving binary 001), etc. There is quite a bit of wiring for this one, as we are using all but one of the I/O ports.GPIO25 to GPIO23 are reading the pushbuttons, so you need to connect GP25 to B1, GP24 to B2, and GP23 to B3. The 8 lowest-numbered GPIO pins are used with I/O ports 5 to 12, so you need to connect GP11 to B5, GP10 to B6, GP9 to B7, GP8 to B8, GP7 to B9, GP4 to B10, GP1to B11, and GP0 to B12. In addition, since we are using I/O ports 5 to 12 for output, you need to install all the out jumpers for buffer chips U4 and U5 (recall that the out jumpers are those above the chips). 40 Fig. 31: Wiring diagram for the decoder test. In the main routine for decoder, as always we start out by printing out to the terminal the connections that need to be made on the Gertboard. Then we call setup_io to set up the GPIO ready for use. Then we call setup_gpio to set GPIO25 to 23 for use with the pushbuttons (by selecting them for input and enabling a pull-up, as described on page 16) and to set GPIO11 to GP7, GPIO4, GPIO1, and GPIO0 up as outputs (as described on page 11). Then we enter a loop where we read the state of the pushbuttons and light up the LED corresponding to this number (after turning off the LED previously set). We turn the LEDs on and off using GPIO_SET0 and GPIO_CLR0 as described on page 17. For More Information For further information, the datasheet for the processor can be found here: http://www.raspberrypi.org/wp-content/uploads/2012/02/BCM2835-ARM-Peripherals.pdf Appendix A: Schematics We have included the schematics for the Gertboard in the pages that follow. They are numbered A-1, A-2, etc. The page number is located in the lower left hand of each page. 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 D D C C B B A A in gnd out Front 1 2 3 TO220 Not used. Do not install! Do not use LDxxx series. They have a different pin-out! GPIO9 GPIO22 GPIO21 GPIO1 GPIO11 GPIO17 GPIO4 GPIO10 GPIO14 GPIO15 GPIO18 GPIO23 GPIO24 GPIO25 GPIO8 GPIO7 GPIO0 GPIO0 GPIO1 GPIO4 GPIO7 GPIO8 GPIO9 GPIO10 GPIO11 GPIO14 GPIO15 GPIO17 GPIO18 GPIO21 GPIO22 GPIO23 GPIO24 GPIO25 3V3_RASP 5V_RASP 3V3_RASP 3V3 5V_RASP 3V3 3V3 MOTOR_A MOTOR_B BUF_1 BUF_2 BUF_4 BUF_3 BUF_6 BUF_7 BUF_8 BUF_5 RELAY_1 RELAY_2 RELAY_3 RELAY_4 BUF_9 BUF_12 BUF_10 BUF_11 RELAY_5 RELAY_6 SCLK MOSI MISO CSnA CSnB MC_TX MC_RX Title Size Document Number Rev Date: Sheet of - 3 Gertboard A4 1 6 R1 10K-0805 J4 CON6 1 2 3 4 5 6 J2 CON17 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 D20 ~1.5A MH1 HOLE_M3 J5 CON2 1 2 C6 100nF-0805 MH2 HOLE_M3 C3 100nF-0805 R2 10K-0805 U2 REG78xx In 1 Gnd 2 Out 3 J64 CON2 1 2 J11 HEADER 5 1 2 3 4 5 J3 CON12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 U1 REG3v3 In 1 Gnd 2 Out 3 C2 100nF-0805 + C5 10uF-1206 J7 CON3 1 2 3 MH4 HOLE_M3 J9 CON3 1 2 3 J1 CON26A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 + C1 10uF-1206 + C4 100uF-CX02-C MH3 HOLE_M3 C7 100nF-0805 J8 CON3 1 2 3 J24 CON2 1 2 A-1 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 D D C C B B A A BUF1 BUF2 BUF6 BUF5 BUF10 BUF9 BUF3 BUF4 BUF8 BUF11 BUF12 BUF2 BUF12 BUF1 BUF6 BUF5 BUF11 BUF7 BUF4 BUF9 BUF3 BUF8 BUF10 BUF7 3V3 3V3 3V3 3V3 BUF_1 BUF_3 BUF_4 BUF_8 BUF_5 BUF_6 BUF_7 BUF_12 BUF_9 BUF_10 BUF_11 BUF_2 BUF_3 BUF_2 BUF_1 Title Size Document Number Rev Date: Sheet of - 3 Gertboard A4 2 6 P4 CON2 1 2 P11 CON2 1 2 U4 74xx244 20 1 19 2 4 6 8 18 14 16 12 9 7 5 3 10 11 13 15 17 RN7B 1k 4 3 P23 CON2 1 2 RN5B 1k-10k 4 3 P1 CON2 1 2 D10 LED P12 CON2 1 2 P3 CON2 1 2 D12 LED D6 LED D8 LED S3 Switch 1 2 3 4 S1 Switch 1 2 3 4 P8 CON2 1 2 RN2 1K_RESN4X1 1 2 3 4 5 D1 LED RN4C 1k-10k 6 5 P13 CON2 1 2 D9 LED RN7A 1k 2 1 C9 100n-0805 RN5A 1k-10k 2 1 D5 LED P17 CON2 1 2 P18 CON2 1 2 P15 CON2 1 2 P6 CON2 1 2 P14 CON2 1 2 P24 CON2 1 2 RN5C 1k-10k 6 5 S2 Switch 1 2 3 4 D11 LED RN7D 1k 8 7 D7 LED P2 CON2 1 2 P5 CON2 1 2 RN3 1K_RESN4x1 1 2 3 4 5 RN6D 1k-10k 8 7 RN6B 1k-10k 4 3 P20 CON2 1 2 C10 100n-0805 P9 CON2 1 2 P19 CON2 1 2 RN4A 1k-10k 2 1 D3 LED RN4D 1k-10k 8 7 J10 CON24 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 P10 24 CON2 1 2 RN6A 1k-10k 2 1 U3 74xx244 20 1 19 2 4 6 8 18 14 16 12 9 7 5 3 10 11 13 15 17 D4 LED RN1 1K_RESN4X1 1 2 3 4 5 C8 100n-0805 RN5D 1k-10k 8 7 RN4B 1k-10k 4 3 P7 CON2 1 2 RN6C 1k-10k 6 5 U5 74xx244 20 1 19 2 4 6 8 18 14 16 12 9 7 5 3 10 11 13 15 17 D2 LED P21 CON2 1 2 P22 CON2 1 2 P16 CON2 1 2 RN7C 1k 6 5 A-2 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 D D C C B B A A RELAY_PWR RELAY_6 RELAY_4 RELAY_2 RELAY_1 RELAY_5 RELAY_3 Title Size Document Number Rev Date: Sheet of - 3 Gertboard A4 3 6 J16 CON2 1 2 J13 CON2 1 2 8x U12 ULN2803A I1 1 I2 2 I3 3 I4 4 I5 5 I6 6 I7 7 I8 8 GND 9 Q1 18 Q2 17 Q3 16 Q4 15 Q5 14 Q6 13 Q7 12 Q8 11 COM 10 J12 CON2 1 2 J15 CON2 1 2 J17 CON2 1 2 J14 CON2 1 2 J6 CON2 1 2 A-3 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 D D C C B B A A motor power nets named to make high current MB MP MPC MA MGND 3V3 MOTOR_A MOTOR_B Title Size Document Number Rev Date: Sheet of - 3 Gertboard A4 4 6 C13 22n-0805 J20 CON2 1 2 F1 4A C11 100n-0805 R23 0.1-2512 C12 22n-0805 J19 CON4 1 2 3 4 U7 L6203-MW VREF 9 ENB 11 IN1 5 IN2 7 BOOT1 4 BOOT2 8 OUT1 3 OUT2 1 VSS 2 GND 6 Sense 10 A-4 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 D D C C B B A A Patch area 3V3 3V3 3V3 of - 3 Gertboard A4 5 6 Title Size Document Number Rev Date: Sheet J37 CON2-DNF 1 2 J68 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J42 CON2-DNF 1 2 J51 CON2-DNF 1 2 J70 CON2-DNF 1 2 J30 CON2-DNF 1 2 J36 CON2-DNF 1 2 J48 CON2-DNF 1 2 J50 CON2-DNF 1 2 J35 CON2-DNF 1 2 J55 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J43 CON2-DNF 1 2 J32 CON2-DNF 1 2 J60 CON2-DNF 1 2 J62 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J53 CON2-DNF 1 2 J69 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J40 CON2-DNF 1 2 J56 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J57 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J38 CON2-DNF 1 2 J54 CON2-DNF 1 2 J26 CON2-DNF 1 2 J34 CON2-DNF 1 2 J47 CON2-DNF 1 2 J66 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J67 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J45 CON2-DNF 1 2 J41 CON2-DNF 1 2 J59 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J39 CON2-DNF 1 2 J44 CON2-DNF 1 2 J49 CON2-DNF 1 2 J63 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J52 CON2-DNF 1 2 J33 CON2-DNF 1 2 J46 CON2-DNF 1 2 J58 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J27 CON2-DNF 1 2 J65 CON3-DNF 1 2 3 J31 CON2-DNF 1 2 J61 CON2-DNF 1 2 A-5 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 D D C C B B A A AD0 XTAL_IN DA0 DA1 AD1 XTAL_IN PD0 PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PC4 PC5 PB1 PB0 PC0 PC1 PC2 RC3 PD6 PD5 PD7 PC6/DBG/RESETn PC1 PC4 PC5 PC0 PC2 RC3 PD0 PD5 PD3 PD6 PD2 PD7 PD4 PD1 PB1 PB0 PC6/DBG/RESETn PD0 PD1 MC_SCK MC_MISO MC_MOSI MC_MOSI PB2 PB2 MC_MOSI MC_MISO MC_SCK MC_SCK MC_MISO 3V3 3V3 3V3 3V3 MISO MOSI MOSI SCLK SCLK MC_RX MC_TX CSnA CSnB Title Size Document Number Rev Date: Sheet of - 3 Gertboard A4 6 6 R4 0_0805 U8 ATmega328P PC6/Reset_n 1 PD0/RXD 2 PD1/TXD 3 PD2/INT0 4 PD4/XCK/T0 6 VCC 7 PB6/XTAL1 9 GND 8 PB7/XTAL2 10 PD5/OC0B/T1 11 PD6/OC0A/AIN0 12 PD7/AIN1 13 PB0/CLK0/ICP1 14 GND 22 AVCC 20 AREF 21 OC1A/PB1 SS_n/OC1B/PB2 15 MOSI/OC2A/PB3 16 MISO/OC2A/PB4 17 SCK/PB5 18 19 ADC0/PC0 ADC1/PC1 23 ADC2/PC2 24 ADC3/PC3 25 ADC4/SDA/PC4 26 ADC5/SCL/PC5 27 28 PD3/INT1/OC2B 5 J25 CONN PCB 20x2 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 22 26 28 30 32 34 36 38 40 39 37 35 33 31 29 27 25 23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9 7 5 3 1 D19 1N4001 J29 CON4A 1 3 2 4 U10 MCP4802 VDD 1 CSn 2 SCK 3 SDI 4 LDACn 5 VOUTB 6 VOUTA 8 VSS 7 J71 HEADER 1 1 J28 CON4A 1 3 2 4 C15 100nF-0805 U6 MCP3002 VDD 8 VSS 4 CH0 2 CH1 3 CSn/SHDN 1 CLK 7 DOUT 6 DIN 5 R24 0_0805 C17 100nF-0805 X1 Cer resonator 1 2 3 C19 100nF-0805 C20 100nF-0805 R34 10K-0805 J23 HEADER 3X2 2 4 6 1 3 5 C16 xxF-1206 A-6 User's Guide SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial This user's guide describes the characteristics, operation, and use of the TMP006EVM evaluation board. It discusses how to set up and configure the software and hardware, and reviews various aspects of the program operation. Throughout this document, the terms evaluation board, evaluation module, and EVM are synonymous with the TMP006EVM. This document also includes an electrical schematic, printed circuit board (PCB) layout drawings, and a parts list for the EVM. Contents 1 Overview ..................................................................................................................... 2 2 TMP006EVM Hardware Setup ............................................................................................ 3 3 TMP006EVM Hardware Overview ........................................................................................ 7 4 TMP006EVM Software Overview ......................................................................................... 8 5 TMP006EVM Software Use .............................................................................................. 11 List of Figures 1 Hardware Included with TMP006EVM Kit ............................................................................... 2 2 TMP006EVM Hardware Setup ............................................................................................ 3 3 TMP006EVM Board Block Diagram ...................................................................................... 4 4 TMP006 Test Board Schematic........................................................................................... 5 5 Typical Hardware Connection ............................................................................................. 7 6 Typical PC Behavior After Connecting TMP006EVM .................................................................. 8 7 TMP006EVM Software Installation Files................................................................................. 8 8 TMP006EVM Software Installation Launch.............................................................................. 9 9 TMP006EVM GUI Software Installation Prompts....................................................................... 9 10 TMP006EVM GUI Software Default Configuration.................................................................... 10 11 Hardware Error Message................................................................................................. 11 12 Read All Registers to Update Temperature............................................................................ 12 13 Make Changes to TMP006 Registers .................................................................................. 13 14 Write Changes to TMP006 Registers................................................................................... 14 15 TMP006EVM GUI Software Registers Tab ............................................................................ 15 16 Read Registers Continuously to Update Graphs...................................................................... 16 17 Enable Transient Correction Algorithm ................................................................................. 17 18 Start Data Logging ........................................................................................................ 18 19 Example .CSV Output File (Formatted and Displayed in Microsoft Excel®) ....................................... 19 List of Tables 1 TMP006EVM Kit Contents................................................................................................. 2 2 TMP006 Test Board Parts List ........................................................................................... 6 3 Signal Definitions for H1 (10-Pin Female Socket) on TMP006EVM Board ......................................... 6 4 Signal Definition for H2 (10-Pin FFC Connector) on TMP006EVM Board .......................................... 7 Excel, Microsoft, Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. SPI is a trademark of Motorola Inc. I2C is a trademark of NXP Semiconductors. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 1 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Overview www.ti.com 1 Overview The TMP006 is an infrared thermopile sensor with digital output integrated circuit. This device measures the temperature of an object without making contact, making it ideal for many types of applications. The TMP006EVM is a platform for evaluating the performance of the TMP006 under various conditions. The TMP006EVM consists of two PCBs. One board, the SM-USB-DIG, communicates with the user’s computer, provides power, and sends and receives appropriate digital signals to communicate with the TMP006. The second PCB, the TMP006_Test_Board, contains the TMP006 as well as support and configuration circuitry. This document gives a general overview of the TMP006EVM, and provides a general description of the features and functions to be considered while using this evaluation module. 1.1 TMP006EVM Kit Contents Table 1 summarizes the contents of the TMP006EVM kit. Figure 1 shows all of the included hardware. Contact the Texas Instruments Product Information Center nearest you if any component is missing. It is highly recommended that you also check the TMP006 product folder on the TI web site at www.ti.com to verify that you have the latest versions of the related software. Table 1. TMP006EVM Kit Contents Item Quantity TMP006_Test_Board 1 SM-USB-DIG Board 1 USB Cable 1 CR-ROM with TMP006EVM GUI Software (not shown) 1 Figure 1. Hardware Included with TMP006EVM Kit 2 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Hardware Setup 1.2 Related Documentation from Texas Instruments The following documents provide information regarding Texas Instruments' integrated circuits used in the assembly of the TMP006EVM. This user's guide is available from the TI web site under literature number SBOU109A. Any letter appended to the literature number corresponds to the document revision that is current at the time of the writing of this document. Newer revisions may be available from the TI web site, or call the Texas Instruments' Literature Response Center at (800) 477-8924 or the Product Information Center at (972) 644-5580. When ordering, identify the document by both title and literature number. Related Documentation Document Literature Number TMP006 Product Data Sheet SBOS518 SM-USB-DIG_Platform User Guide SBOU0958 TMP006 Layout and Assembly SBOU108 Guidelines 2 TMP006EVM Hardware Setup Figure 2 shows the system setup for the TMP006EVM. The PC runs graphical user interface (GUI) software that communicates with the SM-USB-DIG over a USB connection. The SM-USB-DIG translates the USB commands from the PC into power, I2C™, SPI™, and general-purpose input/output (GPIO) commands for the TMP006_Test_Board. The TMP006EVM does not require any additional components to operate. Figure 2. TMP006EVM Hardware Setup SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 3 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006 V Supply (Switched +3.3-V Power) DUT I C Interface 2 Serial Interface (SPI) 10-Pin Female SM-USB-DIG Connector DRDY LED Circuitry 10-Pin FFC Cable Connector TMP006EVM Hardware Setup www.ti.com 2.1 Theory of Operation for the TMP006 Test Board A block diagram of the TMP006 test board hardware setup is shown in Figure 3. The TMP006 Test Board contains connections for the power, I2C, SPI, and GPIO signals from the SM-USB-DIG. It also has a connector that allows other boards to be connected to the TMP006 Test Board to assist with calibrating the TMP006. Figure 3. TMP006EVM Board Block Diagram 4 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Hardware Setup Figure 4 shows the complete schematic of the TMP006 Test Board. The ferrite bead and input capacitor, FB1 and C1 respectively, filter the power coming into the TMP006 test board from the SM-USB-DIG. The I2C pull-up resistors, R3 and R4, and the DRDY pull-up, R5, are required for the open-drain outputs to operate correctly. The Q1 and R6 components drive the LED (D1) so current is not provided from the TMP006 that would cause the device to self-heat. Power, I2C, and SPI signals are provided to the calibration header, H2, for use with the TMP006 calibration tools. Figure 4. TMP006 Test Board Schematic SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 5 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006EVM Hardware Setup www.ti.com 2.2 Bill of Materials for the TMP006 Test Board Table 2 lists the bill of materials for the TMP006EVM board. Table 2. TMP006 Test Board Parts List Qty RefDes Value Description Part Number MFR 1 C1 1μF Capacitor, Ceramic 1.0μF 16V X7R 10% 0603 C1608X7R1C105K TDK 1 C2 0.01μF Capacitor, Ceramic 10000pF 25V X7R 10% 0402 C1005X7R1E103K TDK 1 D1 LED Alingap Grn Wht Diff 0603SMD SML-LX0603SUGW- Lumex TR 1 FB1 Ferrite Bead 300Ω .2A 0402 74279272 Wurth 1 H1 Connector, Socket 50-Pl .050 R/A Sngl 851-43-050-20- Mill-Max 001000 1 H2 Connector, FPC/FFC 10-Pos .5mm Horz SMD FH12-10S-0.5SH(55) Hirose 1 Q1 MOSFET P-CH 50V 130mA SC70-3 BSS84W-7-F Diodes Inc 2 R1, R2 0Ω Resistor, 0.0Ω 1/16W 0402 SMD MCR01MZPJ000 Rohm 3 R3, R4, R5 47k Resistor, 47.0kΩ 1/16W 1% 0402 SMD MCR01MZPF4702 Rohm 1 R6 160Ω Resistor, 160Ω 1/16W 1% 0402 SMD MCR01MZPF1600 Rohm 1 U1 Infrared Sensor with Digital Interface TMP006 Texas Instruments 2.3 Signal Definition of H1 (10-Pin Female Socket) Table 3 identifies the signals connected to the H1 connector on the TMP006 Test Board. This summary also identifies the signals that are used with the TMP006EVM along with the respective signal names. Table 3. Signal Definitions for H1 (10-Pin Female Socket) on TMP006EVM Board Used on the TMP006 Test Board Pin No. Signal TMP006EVM? Signal 1 I2C_SCL Yes SCL 2 CTRL/MEAS4 Yes DRDY 3 I2C_SDA1 Yes SDA 4 CTRL/MEAS5 No — 5 SPI_DOUT1 Yes SDO 6 VDUT Yes VCC 7 SPI_CLK Yes SCLK 8 GND Yes GND 9 SPI_CS1 Yes CS 10 SPI_DIN1 Yes SDI 6 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Hardware Overview 2.4 Signal Definition of H2 (10-Pin FFC Connector) Table 4 shows the signals connected to the H2 connector on the TMP006 Test Board. Table 4. Signal Definition for H2 (10-Pin FFC Connector) on TMP006EVM Board Pin No. Signal 1 SCL 2 VCC 3 SDA 4 VCC 5 SDO 6 GND 7 SCLK 8 GND 9 CS 10 SDI 3 TMP006EVM Hardware Overview If not already assembled, the basic hardware setup for the TMP006EVM involves connecting the TMP006 Test Board to the SM-USB-DIG and then connecting the USB cable. This section presents the details of this procedure. 3.1 Electrostatic Discharge Warning CAUTION Many of the components on the TMP006EVM are susceptible to damage by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Customers are advised to observe proper ESD handling precautions when unpacking and handling the EVM, including the use of a grounded wrist strap at an approved ESD workstation. 3.2 Typical TMP006EVM Hardware Setup Connect the right-angle female socket (H1) on the TMP006 Test Board to the right-angle male header (H2) on the SM-USB-DIG. Take special care to ensure that the two 10-pin sockets directly align with each other. Plug the female USB-A cable to the SM-USB-DIG and then plug the male USB-A cable into the computer. Always connect the two boards together before connecting the USB cable to avoid any issues if the connectors are misaligned. Figure 5. Typical Hardware Connection SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 7 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006EVM Software Overview www.ti.com Figure 6 shows the typical behavior when the SM-USB-DIG is plugged into the USB port of a PC for the first time. Typically, the computer will respond with a Found New Hardware, USB Device pop-up dialog. The pop-up window then typically changes to Found New Hardware, USB Human Interface Device. This pop-up indicates that the device is ready to be used. The SM-USB-DIG uses the human interface device drivers that are part of the Microsoft® Windows® operating system. Figure 6. Typical PC Behavior After Connecting TMP006EVM In some cases, the Windows Add Hardware wizard appears. If this installation prompt occurs, allow the Device Manager to install the human interface drivers by clicking Yes at each request to install the drivers. 4 TMP006EVM Software Overview This section describes the installation and use of the TMP006EVM software. 4.1 Hardware Requirements The TMP006EVM software has been tested on the Microsoft Windows XP operating system (OS) with United States and European regional settings. The software should function correctly on other Windows-based OSs. 4.2 GUI Software Installation The TMP006EVM software is included on the CD that is shipped with the EVM kit. It is also available through the TMP006EVM product folder on the TI web site. To install the software to a computer, insert the disc into an available CD-ROM drive. Navigate to the drive contents and open the TMP006EVM software folder. Locate and launch the TMP006EVM installation file, setup.exe, as shown in Figure 7. It is in the Installer directory. Figure 7. TMP006EVM Software Installation Files 8 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Software Overview The TMP006EVM software installer file then begins the installation process as shown in Figure 8. Figure 8. TMP006EVM Software Installation Launch Follow the prompts as shown in Figure 9 to install the TMP006EVM GUI software. Figure 9. TMP006EVM GUI Software Installation Prompts The TMP006EVM GUI software is now installed. SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 9 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006EVM Software Overview www.ti.com 4.3 Launching the TMP006EVM GUI Software With the TMP006EVM properly connected (see Figure 5), launch the EVM GUI software from the Start menu. It is located in a folder titled, TMP006EVM GUI Installer. The software should launch with a screen similar to that shown in Figure 10. Figure 10. TMP006EVM GUI Software Default Configuration 10 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Software Use If the message shown in Figure 11 appears when the TMP006EVM GUI software is launched, disconnect all components of the TMP006EVM kit, and repeat the hardware assembly instructions in Section 3.2. Figure 11. Hardware Error Message 5 TMP006EVM Software Use This section discusses how to use the TMP006EVM software. The TMP006EVM GUI software has a primary window that is used to configure and read from the TMP006, along with two other windows that are used to access different features of the TMP006. Basic GUI functionality and a description of the tabs are also presented in this section. SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 11 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006EVM Software Use www.ti.com 5.1 Reading from the TMP006 On the primary GUI window (see Figure 10), press the Read All Reg button to read the TMP006 registers and begin collecting temperature measurement data. Figure 12 illustrates this action. Raw temperature and configuration register values can be found in the Registers tab (refer to Section 5.3). Figure 12. Read All Registers to Update Temperature 12 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Software Use 5.2 Writing to the TMP006 To modify the TMP006 configuration register, make any desired changes on the Block Diagram tab and then press the Write All Reg button, as shown in Figure 13. Figure 13. Make Changes to TMP006 Registers SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 13 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006EVM Software Use www.ti.com The Pending changes need to be written LED illuminates when there are changes that have not been written to the TMP006, as shown in Figure 14. Figure 14. Write Changes to TMP006 Registers 14 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Software Use 5.3 Registers Tab In this tab, you can select any row in the Register table by clicking on it with your mouse. When a row is selected, it becomes highlighted in blue in the table. The individual 16 bits in the selected register are displayed below the Register table. Note that each bit has descriptive text above the bit that identifies the function of the bit. You can edit the bit value using the up (↑) or down (↓) arrow to the left of the bit. Any changes on the bit are displayed in the table and in the block diagram. Additionally, any changes in the block diagram are reflected in the table. The Help w Reg button can be pressed to see detailed help about the register that is currently selected. This feature gives detailed information regarding the meaning of each bit. The Registers tab on the TMP006EVM GUI software is illustrated in Figure 15. Figure 15. TMP006EVM GUI Software Registers Tab SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 15 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006EVM Software Use www.ti.com 5.4 Graphing Tab The Graphing tab allows you to graph the temperature sensor results. To start the graphing process, you must press the Read Continuous button. After pressing this button, it turns green and the graph starts to update. Press the Read Continuous button again to turn off this function. Figure 16 shows this process. Figure 16. Read Registers Continuously to Update Graphs 16 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Software Use 5.5 Transient Correction Algorithm The accurate performance of the TMP006EVM is highly dependent on a stable local temperature. Degraded performance can be observed when local temperature transients are introduced into the system, because the infrared (IR) thermopile in the TMP006 is sensitive to conducted and radiated IR energy from below the sensor as well as radiated IR energy that comes from above the sensor. When the TMP006EVM experiences a local temperature transient event, the PCB temperature and the TMP006 die temperature drift apart from each other as a result of the thermal time constant of the TMP006 thermopile. This difference in temperatures causes a heat transfer between the IR sensor and the PCB to occur. Because of the small distance between the PCB and the bottom of the sensor, this heat energy is conducted (as opposed to radiated) through the thin layer of air between the IR sensor and the PCB below it. This conducted heat energy causes an offset in the IR sensor voltage reading, and ultimately leads to unwanted temperature calculation error. The additional error that results from local temperature transient events can be suppressed in the software by using a transient correction algorithm. This algorithm monitors the TMP006 die temperature over a four-second interval and uses the die temperature data to calculate a local temperature slope, as shown in Equation 1. TSLOPE = – (0.3 × TDIE1) – (0.1 × TDIE2) + (0.1 × TDIE3) + (0.3 × TDIE4) (1) The local temperature slope and the known thermal resistance and capacitance of the TMP006 thermopile are then applied to Equation 2 to correct the sensor voltage reading. VOBJ_CORRECTED = VOBJ + TSLOPE × 2.96 × 10–4 (2) The corrected sensor voltage value is then substituted for the raw sensor voltage, and the object temperature is calculated using the normal methods. To enable the transient correction algorithm, simply click the Transient Correction button in the TMP006EVM GUI as shown in Figure 17. When transient correction is first enabled, a delay of four conversions will be observed while the local temperature slope is being calculated. Figure 17. Enable Transient Correction Algorithm SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 17 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated TMP006EVM Software Use www.ti.com 5.6 Logging Data from the TMP006EVM The TMP006EVM software has the ability to save data collected by the TMP006 into a comma-separated value (.CSV) format file. To save data in this format, select Save Temperature Data from the USB Controls drop-down menu. Figure 18 shows the steps required to begin logging temperature data with the TMP006EVM. Figure 18. Start Data Logging 18 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com TMP006EVM Software Use Figure 19 displays an example of how the output file can appear after minimal formatting by the user. Figure 19. Example .CSV Output File (Formatted and Displayed in Microsoft Excel®) SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 TMP006EVM User Guide and Software Tutorial 19 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Revision History www.ti.com Revision History Changes from Original (May, 2011) to A Revision .......................................................................................................... Page • Updated document to reflect new software functionality ............................................................................ 1 • Revised Figure 2 for improved clarity .................................................................................................. 3 • Updated Figure 4 to reflect unpopulated connector H2 ............................................................................. 5 • Changed Figure 5 to reflect new SM-USB-DIG casing .............................................................................. 7 • Corrected typos and updated Figure 10 through Figure 16 to reflect new software functionality ............................. 8 • Added Transient Correction Algorithm section ...................................................................................... 17 • Updated Figure 18 to reflect new software functionality ........................................................................... 18 • Revised Figure 19 for improved clarity ............................................................................................... 19 NOTE: Page numbers for previous revisions may differ from page numbers in the current version. 20 Revision History SBOU109A–May 2011–Revised October 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Evaluation Board/Kit Important Notice Texas Instruments (TI) provides the enclosed product(s) under the following conditions: This evaluation board/kit is intended for use for ENGINEERING DEVELOPMENT, DEMONSTRATION, OR EVALUATION PURPOSES ONLY and is not considered by TI to be a finished end-product fit for general consumer use. Persons handling the product(s) must have electronics training and observe good engineering practice standards. As such, the goods being provided are not intended to be complete in terms of required design-, marketing-, and/or manufacturing-related protective considerations, including product safety and environmental measures typically found in end products that incorporate such semiconductor components or circuit boards. This evaluation board/kit does not fall within the scope of the European Union directives regarding electromagnetic compatibility, restricted substances (RoHS), recycling (WEEE), FCC, CE or UL, and therefore may not meet the technical requirements of these directives or other related directives. Should this evaluation board/kit not meet the specifications indicated in the User’s Guide, the board/kit may be returned within 30 days from the date of delivery for a full refund. THE FOREGOING WARRANTY IS THE EXCLUSIVE WARRANTY MADE BY SELLER TO BUYER AND IS IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED, IMPLIED, OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE. The user assumes all responsibility and liability for proper and safe handling of the goods. Further, the user indemnifies TI from all claims arising from the handling or use of the goods. Due to the open construction of the product, it is the user’s responsibility to take any and all appropriate precautions with regard to electrostatic discharge. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT OF THE INDEMNITY SET FORTH ABOVE, NEITHER PARTY SHALL BE LIABLE TO THE OTHER FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES. TI currently deals with a variety of customers for products, and therefore our arrangement with the user is not exclusive. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance, customer product design, software performance, or infringement of patents or services described herein. Please read the User’s Guide and, specifically, the Warnings and Restrictions notice in the User’s Guide prior to handling the product. This notice contains important safety information about temperatures and voltages. For additional information on TI’s environmental and/or safety programs, please contact the TI application engineer or visit www.ti.com/esh. No license is granted under any patent right or other intellectual property right of TI covering or relating to any machine, process, or combination in which such TI products or services might be or are used. FCC Warning This evaluation board/kit is intended for use for ENGINEERING DEVELOPMENT, DEMONSTRATION, OR EVALUATION PURPOSES ONLY and is not considered by TI to be a finished end-product fit for general consumer use. It generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and has not been tested for compliance with the limits of computing devices pursuant to part 15 of FCC rules, which are designed to provide reasonable protection against radio frequency interference. Operation of this equipment in other environments may cause interference with radio communications, in which case the user at his own expense will be required to take whatever measures may be required to correct this interference. EVM Warnings and Restrictions It is important to operate this EVM within the input voltage range of 2.7V (min) to 5.5V (max) and the output voltage range of 2.7V (min) to 5.5V (max). Exceeding the specified input range may cause unexpected operation and/or irreversible damage to the EVM. If there are questions concerning the input range, please contact a TI field representative prior to connecting the input power. Applying loads outside of the specified output range may result in unintended operation and/or possible permanent damage to the EVM. Please consult the EVM User's Guide prior to connecting any load to the EVM output. If there is uncertainty as to the load specification, please contact a TI field representative. During normal operation, some circuit components may have case temperatures greater than +25°C. The EVM is designed to operate properly with certain components above +25°C as long as the input and output ranges are maintained. These components include but are not limited to linear regulators, switching transistors, pass transistors, and current sense resistors. These types of devices can be identified using the EVM schematic located in the EVM User's Guide. When placing measurement probes near these devices during operation, please be aware that these devices may be very warm to the touch. Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, modifications, enhancements, improvements, and other changes to its products and services at any time and to discontinue any product or service without notice. Customers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All products are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its hardware products to the specifications applicable at the time of sale in accordance with TI’s standard warranty. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by government requirements, testing of all parameters of each product is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or customer product design. Customers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with customer products and applications, customers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any TI patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other TI intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI products or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license from TI to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. Reproduction of this information with alteration is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI products or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that product or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI product or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. TI products are not authorized for use in safety-critical applications (such as life support) where a failure of the TI product would reasonably be expected to cause severe personal injury or death, unless officers of the parties have executed an agreement specifically governing such use. Buyers represent that they have all necessary expertise in the safety and regulatory ramifications of their applications, and acknowledge and agree that they are solely responsible for all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning their products and any use of TI products in such safety-critical applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Further, Buyers must fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of TI products in such safety-critical applications. TI products are neither designed nor intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments unless the TI products are specifically designated by TI as military-grade or "enhanced plastic." Only products designated by TI as military-grade meet military specifications. Buyers acknowledge and agree that any such use of TI products which TI has not designated as military-grade is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that they are solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI products are neither designed nor intended for use in automotive applications or environments unless the specific TI products are designated by TI as compliant with ISO/TS 16949 requirements. Buyers acknowledge and agree that, if they use any non-designated products in automotive applications, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet such requirements. Following are URLs where you can obtain information on other Texas Instruments products and application solutions: Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DLP® Products www.dlp.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy DSP dsp.ti.com Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Medical www.ti.com/medical Interface interface.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Logic logic.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Power Mgmt power.ti.com Transportation and Automotive www.ti.com/automotive Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Mobile Processors www.ti.com/omap Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity TI E2E Community Home Page e2e.ti.com Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page ii © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. Information contained in this publication regarding device applications and the like is provided only for your convenience and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to ensure that your application meets with your specifications. MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION, QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip’s products as critical components in life support systems is not authorized except with express written approval by Microchip. No licenses are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip intellectual property rights. Trademarks The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, Accuron, dsPIC, KEELOQ, microID, MPLAB, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART, PRO MATE, PowerSmart, rfPIC, and SmartShunt are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. AmpLab, FilterLab, Migratable Memory, MXDEV, MXLAB, PICMASTER, SEEVAL, SmartSensor and The Embedded Control Solutions Company are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, dsPICDEM, dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, ECAN, ECONOMONITOR, FanSense, FlexROM, fuzzyLAB, In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, ICEPIC, Linear Active Thermistor, MPASM, MPLIB, MPLINK, MPSIM, PICkit, PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICLAB, PICtail, PowerCal, PowerInfo, PowerMate, PowerTool, rfLAB, rfPICDEM, Select Mode, Smart Serial, SmartTel, Total Endurance and WiperLock are trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their respective companies. © 2005, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the U.S.A., All Rights Reserved. Printed on recycled paper. Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices: • Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet. • Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the intended manner and under normal conditions. • There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property. • Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code. • Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.” Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act. Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2002 quality system certification for its worldwide headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and Tempe, Arizona and Mountain View, California in October 2003. The Company’s quality system processes and procedures are for its PICmicro® 8-bit MCUs, KEELOQ® code hopping devices, Serial EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and analog products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design and manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified. EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page iii Table of Contents Preface ........................................................................................................................... 1 Chapter 1. Introducing the Explorer 16 Development Board 1.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................... 7 1.2 Highlights ........................................................................................................ 7 1.3 What’s in the Kit ............................................................................................. 7 1.4 Explorer 16 Development Board Functionality and Features ......................... 8 1.5 Using the Explorer 16 Out of the Box ............................................................. 9 1.6 Explorer 16 Development Board Demonstration Programs ......................... 10 1.7 Reference Documents .................................................................................. 10 Chapter 2. Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial 2.1 Introduction ................................................................................................... 11 2.2 Highlights ...................................................................................................... 11 2.3 Tutorial Overview ......................................................................................... 11 2.4 Creating the Project ...................................................................................... 12 2.5 Building The Code ........................................................................................ 16 2.6 Programming the Device .............................................................................. 19 Chapter 3. Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs 3.1 Introduction ................................................................................................... 23 3.2 PIC24 Tutorial Program Operation ............................................................... 23 3.3 dsPIC33F Tutorial Program Operation ......................................................... 25 Chapter 4. Explorer 16 Development Hardware 4.1 Introduction .................................................................................................. 27 4.2 Hardware Features ....................................................................................... 27 Appendix A. Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics A.1 Introduction .................................................................................................. 33 A.2 Development Board Block Diagram ............................................................. 33 A.3 Development Board Schematics .................................................................. 34 Appendix B. Updating the USB Connectivity Firmware B.1 Introduction .................................................................................................. 43 B.2 Updating the PICkit 2 Microcontroller Programmer ..................................... 43 B.3 Other USB Firmware Updates ..................................................................... 44 Index ............................................................................................................................. 45 Worldwide Sales and Service .................................................................................... 46 Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page iv © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. NOTES: EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 1 Preface INTRODUCTION This chapter contains general information that will be useful to know before using the Explorer 16 Development Board. Items discussed in this chapter include: • Document Layout • Conventions Used in this Guide • Warranty Registration • Recommended Reading • The Microchip Web Site • Development Systems Customer Change Notification Service • Customer Support • Document Revision History DOCUMENT LAYOUT This document describes how to use the Explorer 16 Development Board as a development tool to emulate and debug firmware on a target board. The manual layout is as follows: • Chapter 1. “Introducing the Explorer 16 Development Board” provides a brief overview of the Explorer 16 Development Board, its features and its uses. • Chapter 2. “Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial” provides step-by-step instructions for using MBLAB® IDE to create a project and program the Explorer 16 board. • Chapter 3. “Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs” describes the demonstration program created in Chapter 2. “Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial”. • Chapter 4. “Explorer 16 Development Hardware” provides a more detailed description of the Explorer 16 board’s hardware features. • Appendix A. “Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics” provides a block diagram and detailed schematics of the Explorer 16 board. • Appendix B. “Updating the USB Connectivity Firmware” describes how to upgrade the Explorer 16 board’s USB connectivity subsystem. NOTICE TO CUSTOMERS All documentation becomes dated, and this manual is no exception. Microchip tools and documentation are constantly evolving to meet customer needs, so some actual dialogs and/or tool descriptions may differ from those in this document. Please refer to our web site (www.microchip.com) to obtain the latest documentation available. Documents are identified with a “DS” number. This number is located on the bottom of each page, in front of the page number. The numbering convention for the DS number is “DSXXXXXA”, where “XXXXX” is the document number and “A” is the revision level of the document. For the most up-to-date information on development tools, see the MPLAB® IDE on-line help. Select the Help menu, and then Topics to open a list of available on-line help files. Preface © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 2 CONVENTIONS USED IN THIS GUIDE This manual uses the following documentation conventions: WARRANTY REGISTRATION Please complete the enclosed Warranty Registration Card and mail it promptly. Sending in the Warranty Registration Card entitles users to receive new product updates. Interim software releases are available at the Microchip web site. DOCUMENTATION CONVENTIONS Description Represents Examples Arial font: Italic characters Referenced books MPLAB® IDE User’s Guide Emphasized text ...is the only compiler... Initial caps A window the Output window A dialog the Settings dialog A menu selection select Enable Programmer Quotes A field name in a window or dialog “Save project before build” Underlined, italic text with right angle bracket A menu path File>Save Bold characters A dialog button Click OK A tab Click the Power tab Text in angle brackets < > A key on the keyboard Press , Courier New font: Plain Courier New Sample source code #define START Filenames autoexec.bat File paths c:\mcc18\h Keywords _asm, _endasm, static Command-line options -Opa+, -Opa- Bit values 0, 1 Constants (in source code) 0xFF, ‘A’ Italic Courier New A variable argument file.o, where file can be any valid filename Square brackets [ ] Optional arguments mcc18 [options] file [options] Curly brackets and pipe character: { | } Choice of mutually exclusive arguments; an OR selection errorlevel {0|1} Ellipses... Replaces repeated text var_name [, var_name...] Represents code supplied by user void main (void) { ... } Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 3 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. RECOMMENDED READING This user’s guide describes how to use the Explorer 16 Development Board. Other useful documents are listed below. The following Microchip documents are available and recommended as supplemental reference resources. Readme for the Explorer 16 Development Board For the latest information on using the Explorer 16 Development Board, read the Readme for Explorer 16 Development Board.txt file (an ASCII text file) at the root level of the Explorer 16 CD-ROM. The Readme file contains update information and known issues that may not be included in this user’s guide. Readme Files For the latest information on using other tools, read the tool-specific Readme files in the Readmes subdirectory of the MPLAB IDE installation directory. The Readme files contain update information and known issues that may not be included in this user’s guide. PIC24FJ128GA010 PS Data Sheet (DS39756) and PIC24FJ128GA Family Data Sheet (DS39747) Consult this document for detailed information on the PIC24F general purpose, 16-bit devices. Reference information found in this data sheet includes: • Device memory map • Device pinout and packaging details • Device electrical specifications • List of peripherals included on the device Note that document, DS39756, is for use only with the initial prototype samples of the PIC24F family. These devices are all marked with a “PS” suffix at the end of the device number. For all other PIC24FJ128GA family devices, including those with an “ES” suffix, use DS39747. dsPIC33F Family Data Sheet (DS70165) Consult this document for detailed information on the dsPIC33F Digital Signal Controllers. Reference information found in this data sheet includes: • Device memory map • Device pinout and packaging details • Device electrical specifications • List of peripherals included on the device dsPIC30F Programmer’s Reference Manual (DS70030) This manual is a software developer’s reference for all of Microchip’s 16-bit digital signal controllers. It describes the instruction set in detail and also provides general information to assist in developing software for PIC24 MCUs, dsPIC30F and dsPIC33F DSCs. PIC24H Family Overview (DS70166) This document provides an overview of the functionality of the new PIC24H product family. It helps determine how the PIC24H high-performance, 16-bit microcontrollers fit a specific product application. Preface © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 4 MPLAB® C30 C Compiler User’s Guide (DS51284) This document details the use of Microchip’s MPLAB C30 C Compiler for dsPIC® devices to develop an application. MPLAB C30 is a GNU-based language tool, based on source code from the Free Software Foundation (FSF). For more information about the FSF, see www.fsf.org. Other GNU language tools available from Microchip are: • MPLAB ASM30 Assembler • MPLAB LINK30 Linker • MPLAB LIB30 Librarian/Archiver MPLAB® IDE Simulator, Editor User’s Guide (DS51025) Consult this document for more information pertaining to the installation and implementation of the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment (IDE) software. THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE Microchip provides online support via our web site at www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means to make files and information easily available to customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet browser, the web site contains the following information: • Product Support – Data sheets and errata, application notes and sample programs, design resources, user’s guides and hardware support documents, latest software releases and archived software • General Technical Support – Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs), technical support requests, online discussion groups, Microchip consultant program member listing • Business of Microchip – Product selector and ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases, listing of seminars and events, listings of Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory representatives Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 5 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DEVELOPMENT SYSTEMS CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION SERVICE Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers will receive e-mail notification whenever there are changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a specified product family or development tool of interest. To register, access the Microchip web site at www.microchip.com, click on Customer Change Notification and follow the registration instructions. The Development Systems product group categories are: • Compilers – The latest information on Microchip C compilers and other language tools. These include the MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C compilers; MPASM™ and MPLAB ASM30 assemblers; MPLINK™ and MPLAB LINK30 object linkers; and MPLIB™ and MPLAB LIB30 object librarians. • Emulators – The latest information on Microchip in-circuit emulators.This includes the MPLAB ICE 2000 and MPLAB ICE 4000. • In-Circuit Debuggers – The latest information on the Microchip in-circuit debugger, MPLAB ICD 2. • MPLAB® IDE – The latest information on Microchip MPLAB IDE, the Windows® Integrated Development Environment for development systems tools. This list is focused on the MPLAB IDE, MPLAB SIM simulator, MPLAB IDE Project Manager and general editing and debugging features. • Programmers – The latest information on Microchip programmers. These include the MPLAB PM3 and PRO MATE® II device programmers and the PICSTART® Plus and PICkit™ 1 development programmers. CUSTOMER SUPPORT Users of Microchip products can receive assistance through several channels: • Distributor or Representative • Local Sales Office • Field Application Engineer (FAE) • Technical Support • Development Systems Information Line Customers should contact their distributor, representative or field application engineer (FAE) for support. Local sales offices are also available to help customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is included in the back of this document. Technical support is available through the web site at: http://support.microchip.com DOCUMENT REVISION HISTORY Revision A (November 2005) This is the initial release of this Document. Preface © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 6 NOTES: EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 7 Chapter 1. Introducing the Explorer 16 Development Board 1.1 INTRODUCTION Thank you for purchasing Microchip Technology’s Explorer 16 Development Board Kit. The development board provides a low-cost, modular development system for Microchip’s new line of 16-bit microcontroller families, including the PIC24, PIC24H and the 16-bit digital signal controller family, dsPIC33F. As provided, the development board works as a demo board right from the box, and also has the ability to extend its functionality through modular expansion interfaces. The Explorer 16 board supports MPLAB ICD 2 for full emulation and debug capabilities, and also allows 3V controllers to interface with 5V peripheral devices. 1.2 HIGHLIGHTS This chapter covers the following topics: • What’s in the Kit • Explorer 16 Development Board Functionality and Features • Using the Explorer 16 Out of the Box • Explorer 16 Development Board Demonstration Programs • Reference Documents 1.3 WHAT’S IN THE KIT The Explorer 16 Development Board Kit contains the following: • The Explorer 16 Development Board. • A preprogrammed PIC24FJ128GA010 Processor Installation Module (PIM), already installed to the board • A preprogrammed dsPIC33FJ256GP710 PIM • An RS-232 cable • The Explorer 16 Development CD ROM, containing: - This User’s Guide - Data Sheets for the PIC24FJ128GA family and dsPIC33FJ256GP family - Schematics and PCB drawing files for the PIM modules - Example programs for use with the PIC24 and dsPIC33F devices - Files detailing general purpose expansion boards that can be used with the Explorer 16 board (provided in Gerber format) If you are missing any part of the kit, please contact your nearest Microchip sales office, listed on the last page of this manual, for further assistance. Note: The Explorer 16 Development Board has been designed to function primarily from a permanently mounted PIC24FJ128GA010 device at position U1. Initial units will be shipped with U1 unpopulated and a PIC24FJ PIM of equal functionality mounted on the U1A headers instead. When using the PIC24FJ PIM or any other PIM, it is critical to verify that switch S2 always remains in the “PIM” position. See Section 4.2.1 “Processor Support” for more information. Introducing the Explorer 16 Development Board © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 8 1.4 EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD FUNCTIONALITY AND FEATURES A layout of the Explorer 16 Development Board is shown in Figure 1-1. The board includes these key features, as indicated in the diagram: 1. 100-pin PIM riser, compatible with the PIM versions of all Microchip PIC24F/24H/dsPIC33F devices 2. Direct 9 VDC power input that provides +3.3V and +5V (regulated) to the entire board 3. Power indicator LED 4. RS-232 serial port and associated hardware 5. On-board analog thermal sensor 6. USB connectivity for communications and device programming/debugging 7. Standard 6-wire In-Circuit Debugger (ICD) connector for connections to an MPLAB ICD 2 programmer/debugger module 8. Hardware selection of PIM or soldered on-board microcontroller (in future versions) 9. 2-line by 16-character LCD 10. Provisioning on PCB for add on graphic LCD 11. Push button switches for device Reset and user-defined inputs 12. Potentiometer for analog input 13. Eight indicator LEDs 14. 74HCT4053 multiplexers for selectable crossover configuration on serial communication lines 15. Serial EEPROM 16. Independent crystals for precision microcontroller clocking (8 MHz) and RTCC operation (32.768 kHz) 17. Prototype area for developing custom applications 18. Socket and edge connector for PICtail™ Plus card compatibility 19. Six-pin interface for PICkit 2 Programmer 20. JTAG connector pad for optional boundary scan functionality For additional details on these features, refer to Chapter 4. “Explorer 16 Development Hardware”. 1.4.1 Sample Devices Included with the Development Kit Each Explorer 16 Development Board Kit contains two preprogrammed 16-bit devices: a PIC24FJ128GA010 and a dsPIC33FJ256GP710. These are provided as 100-pin PIMs on riser sockets, which can be quickly installed on pin header U1A and exchanged as needed. Note: As Microchip’s 16-bit portfolio develops, alternate devices may be included with the Explorer 16 Development Board Kit. It is anticipated that one device each of the PIC24 and dsPIC33F families will always be included. Also in the future, the included PIC24 device will be soldered onto the board and only the dsPIC33F device will be provided as a PIM. Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 9 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE 1-1: EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD LAYOUT 1.5 USING THE EXPLORER 16 OUT OF THE BOX Although intended as a development platform, the Explorer 16 board may also be used directly from the box as a demonstration board for PIC24 and dsPIC33F devices. The programs discussed in Chapter 3. “Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs” are preprogrammed into the sample device PIMs (i.e., PIC24ExplDemo.hex for the PIC24 device and dsPIC33ExplDemo.hex for the dsPIC33F device) and are ready for immediate use. To get started with the board: 1. For Explorer 16 boards without a permanently mounted PIC24FJ device: verify that the PIC24FJ128GA010 PIM is correctly installed onto the board. If you want to use the dsPIC® device PIM, carefully remove the PIC24 PIM and install the dsPIC33F PIM in its place. For all PIMs, be certain to align the PIM so the notched corner marking is oriented in the upper left corner. 2. For Explorer 16 boards without a permanently mounted PIC24FJ device: verify that switch S2 is set in the “PIM” position. For Explorer 16 boards with a permanently mounted PIC24FJ device: verify that switch S2 is set in the “PIC” position. 3. Verify that the jumper on JP2 is installed (to enable the LEDs). 4. Apply power to the board (9 VDC) at power input J2. For information on acceptable power sources, see Appendix A. “Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics”. Refer to Chapter 3. “Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs” for details on the demonstration code operation. 1 10 7 4 5 6 3 2 8 9 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 Introducing the Explorer 16 Development Board © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 10 FIGURE 1-2: EXPLORER 16 PIM MODULE, SHOWING NOTCHED CORNER MARKING 1.6 EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD DEMONSTRATION PROGRAMS The preprogrammed example code on the PIMs has been included on the Explorer 16 CD-ROM for future reference. All project files have been included, so that the code may be used directly to restore a PIM to its original state (i.e., if the sample device has been reprogrammed with another program), or so the user may use the tutorial code as a platform for further experimentation. In addition, the CD-ROM contains sample demonstration programs for both PIC24 and dsPIC33F family devices. Separate demo source code (as files in C) and compiled code files (in Hex) are provided for each family. These may be used with the included PIC24 and dsPIC33F PIMs by reprogramming the devices using MPLAB ICD 2. 1.7 REFERENCE DOCUMENTS In addition to the documents listed in the “Recommended Reading” section, these documents are also available from Microchip to support the use of the Explorer 16 Development Board: • PIC18F2455/2550/4455/4550 Data Sheet (DS39632) • TC1047/TC1047A Data Sheet (DS21498) • 25AA256/25LC256 Data Sheet (DS21822) • PICkit™ 2 Microcontroller Programmer User’s Guide (DS51553) • MPLAB® ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger Quick Start Guide (DS51268) • PRO MATE® II User’s Guide (DS30082) You can obtain these reference documents from your nearest Microchip sales office (listed in the back of this document) or by downloading them from the Microchip web site (www.microchip.com). PIC24FJ128GA010 EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 11 Chapter 2. Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial 2.1 INTRODUCTION This chapter is a self-paced tutorial to get you started using the Explorer 16 Development Board. 2.2 HIGHLIGHTS Items discussed in this chapter include: • Tutorial Overview • Creating the Project • Building the Code • Programming the Device 2.3 TUTORIAL OVERVIEW The tutorial in this chapter demonstrates the main features of the MPLAB IDE and MPLAB ICD 2 as they are used with the Explorer 16 Development Board. As presented, it is designed for use with the PIC24FJ128GA010 specifically. However, the same procedures and toolsuites can also be used with PIC24H or dsPIC33F devices. The PIC24 tutorial project demonstrated here, PIC24ExplDemo.mcp, is written in C for MPLAB C30. The program displays PIC24 features on the alphanumeric LCD, and also displays voltage, temperature and date/time as the various buttons are pressed. Described with the PIC24 project is the dsPIC device tutorial, Example1_RTC_LED_ADC.mcp. It is also written in C for MPLAB C30. The program displays voltage and current time, updating the display on command. Both programs are described in more detail in Chapter 3. “Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs”. For either project, the source file (PIC24ExplDemo.c or main_rtc.c for PIC24 or dsPIC33F, respectively) is used with a linker script file (p24fj128ga010.gld or p33fj256gp710ps.gld) and header file (p24fj128ga010.h or p33fj256gp710ps.h) to form a complete project. While these simple projects use a single source code file, more complex projects might use multiple assembler and compiler source files, as well as library files and precompiled object files. Upon completing this tutorial, you should be able to: • Create a project using the Project Wizard • Assemble and link the code and set the Configuration bits • Set up MPLAB IDE to use the MPLAB ICD 2 • Program the chip with the MPLAB ICD 2 There are three steps to this tutorial: 1. Creating a project in MPLAB IDE. 2. Assembling and linking the code. 3. Programming the chip with the MPLAB ICD 2. Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 12 2.4 CREATING THE PROJECT The first step is to create a project and a workspace in MPLAB IDE. Typically, there is one project in one workspace. A project contains the files needed to build an application (source code, linker script files, etc.) along with their associations to various build tools and build options. A workspace contains one or more projects and information on the selected device, debug tool and/or programmer, open windows and their location and other MPLAB IDE configuration settings. MPLAB IDE contains a Project Wizard to help create new projects. Before starting, create a folder named Tutorial for the project files for this tutorial (C:\Tutorial is assumed in the instructions that follow). From the Example Code\Tutorial Code directory on the Explorer 16 Development Kit Software CD-ROM, copy all of the source files into this folder. 2.4.1 Select a Device 1. Start MPLAB IDE. 2. Close any workspace that might be open (File > Close Workspace). 3. From the Project menu, select Project Wizard. 4. From the Welcome screen, click Next > to display the Project Wizard Step One dialog (Figure 2-1). FIGURE 2-1: SELECTING THE DEVICE 5. From the Device drop-down list, select “PIC24FJ128GA010” or “dsPIC33FJ256GP710PS”, depending on the PIM being used. Click Next >. The Project Wizard Step Two dialog will be displayed (see Figure 2-2). Note: These instructions presume the use of MPLAB IDE 7.22 or newer. Note: The screen shots in the following sections show the PIC24 tutorial. Except for displayed file names, the screens for the dsPIC33F tutorial will be identical. Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 13 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE 2-2: SELECTING THE TOOLSUITE 2.4.2 Select Language Toolsuite 1. From the Active Toolsuite drop-down list, select Microchip C30 Toolsuite. This toolsuite includes the assembler and linker that will be used. 2. In the Toolsuite Contents combo box, select MPLAB C30 Compiler (pic30-gcc.exe). 3. In the Location box, click Browse... and navigate to C:\Program Files\Microchip\MPLAB C30\bin\pic30-as.exe. 4. With MPLAB LINK 30 Object Linker (pic30-ld.exe) selected in Toolsuite Contents, click Browse... and navigate to C:\Program Files\Microchip\MPLAB C30\bin\pic30-Id.exe. 5. Click Next > to continue. The Project Wizard Step Three dialog displays (Figure 2-3). Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 14 FIGURE 2-3: NAMING YOUR PROJECT 2.4.3 Name Your Project 1. In the Project Name text box, type “MyProject”. 2. In the Project Directory box, click Browse... and navigate to C:\Tutorial to place your project in the Tutorial folder. 3. Click Next > to continue. The Project Wizard Step Four dialog displays (Figure 2-4). FIGURE 2-4: ADDING FILES TO THE PROJECT Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 15 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. 2.4.4 Add Files to Project 1. From the list of folders on the PC, locate the C:\Tutorial folder. 2. Select the source (.c) and header (.h) files. Click Add >> to include the file in the project. 3. Expand the C:\Program Files\Microchip\MPLAB 30\support\gld folder and select the p24fj128ga010.gld or p33fj256gp710ps.gld file, as appropriate. 4. Click Add >> to include this file in the project. There should now be two files in the project. 5. Click Next > to continue. 6. When the summary screen displays, click Finish. After the Project Wizard completes, the MPLAB Project window shows the source files in the Source Files folder and the appropriate linker script in the Linker Scripts folder (Figure 2-5). FIGURE 2-5: PROJECT WINDOW A project and workspace has now been created in MPLAB IDE. MyProject.mcw is the workspace file and MyProject.mcp is the project file. Double-click the PIC24ExplDemo.c file (for PIC24) or main_rtc.c file (for dsPIC33F) in the Project window to open the file. MPLAB IDE should now look similar to Figure 2-6. Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 16 FIGURE 2-6: MPLAB® IDE WORKSPACE 2.5 BUILDING THE CODE In this project, building the code consists of compiling the source files to create an object file, MyProject.o, then linking the object file to create the MyProject.hex and MyProject.cof output files. (For dsPIC33F projects, the files would be Example1_RTC_LED_ADC.o, Example1_RTC_LED_ADC.hex and Example1_RTC_LED_ADC.cof.)The Hex file contains the data necessary to program the device, and the .cof file contains additional information that lets you debug the code at the source code level. Before building, there are settings required to tell MPLAB IDE where to find the include files and to reserve space for the extra debug code when the MPLAB ICD 2 is used. For PIC24 projects, the following line in the system.h file is: #include “p24fj128ga010.h” For dsPIC33 projects, the line is: #include “p33fj256gp710ps.h” This line causes a standard include file to be used. Microchip provides these files with all the Special Function Register (SFR) labels already defined for convenience. To build the code, select Build Options > Project from the Project menu. The Build Options dialog displays (Figure 2-7). Project Window Output Window Source Window Code Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 17 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE 2-7: BUILD OPTIONS 2.5.1 Identify Assembler Include Path 1. Select the General tab. 2. Click Suite Default. This tells the environment where to find the library files. 3. Select the MPLAB LINK30 tab to view the linker settings (Figure 2-8). 4. Check Link for ICD2. 5. Click OK. The text box closes while the linker reserves space for the debug code used by the MPLAB ICD 2. 6. Click OK again to save these changes. The project is now ready to build. Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 18 FIGURE 2-8: MPLAB® LINK30 BUILD OPTIONS 2.5.2 Build the Project From the menu bar of the main MPLAB IDE window, select Project > Make. The Build Output window displays (Figure 2-9). Observe the progress of the build. When the “BUILD SUCCEEDED” message displays, you are ready to program the device. FIGURE 2-9: BUILD OUTPUT Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 19 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. 2.6 PROGRAMMING THE DEVICE The MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger is used to program and debug the microcontroller in-circuit on the Explorer 16 Development Board. 2.6.1 Set Up the Device Configuration The device configuration for the target microcontroller can be set by two methods: using configuration macros in the source code, or using the Configuration Bits window in MPLAB IDE. The PIC24 Explorer 16 tutorial code already includes configuration macros in the source code itself. It is only necessary to confirm that the following macros are in place near the top of the PIC24ExplDemo.c file: _CONFIG1(JTAGEN_OFF & GSS0_OFF & GWRP_OFF & BKBUG_OFF & COE_OFF & FWDTEN_OFF & FNOSC_PRI) _CONFIG2(FCKSM_CSDCMD & OSCIOFNC_ON & POSCMOD_HS) For the dsPIC33F tutorial code, confirm that the following macros are in place near the top of the main_rtc.c file: _FGS(CODE_WRITE_PROT_OFF); _FOSCSEL(FRC_PLL); _FOSC(CSW_FSCM_OFF & OSC2_IO & XT); _FWDT(WDT_OFF); If configuration macros are not used in the source code, it is also possible to set device configuration with the Configuration Bits window. For the PIC24 code, the process is as follows: 1. From the main window’s menu bar, select Configure > Configuration Bits to display the configuration settings (Figure 2-10). 2. Set the Configuration bits by clicking on a particular line item and selecting an option from the drop-down menu that appears. The Configuration bits should be set as shown in Figure 2-10. The settings that will most likely need to change are: a) Primary Oscillator Select: HS Oscillator Enabled b) Oscillator Select: Primary Oscillator (XT, HS, ES) c) Clock Switching and Monitor: SW Disabled, Mon Disabled d) Watchdog Timer Enable: Disable Note: Before proceeding, make sure that the USB driver for the MPLAB ICD 2 has been installed on the PC (see the MPLAB® ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger User’s Guide (DS51331) for more details regarding the installation of the MPLAB ICD 2). Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 20 FIGURE 2-10: CONFIGURATION SETTINGS (PIC24) 2.6.2 Connect and Enable MPLAB ICD 2 1. Connect the MPLAB ICD 2 module to the PC with the USB cable. 2. Connect the MPLAB ICD 2 to the Explorer 16 Development Board with the short RJ-11 cable. 3. Apply power to the Explorer 16 board. 4. From the Debugger menu, click Select Tool > MPLAB ICD 2 to set the MPLAB ICD 2 as the debug tool in MPLAB IDE. 5. From the Debugger menu, select Connect to connect the debugger to the device. MPLAB IDE should report that it found the PIC24FJ128GA010 device, as shown in Figure 2-11. FIGURE 2-11: ENABLING MPLAB® ICD 2 Note: Do not use the Configuration Bits window to set device configuration if configuration macros are already used in the source code. In cases where both methods are used, configuration macros may override settings from the Configuration Bits window. Refer to the MPLAB IDE Simulator, Editor User’s Guide (DS51025) for additional information. Note: MPLAB IDE may need to download new firmware if this is the first time the MPLAB ICD 2 is being used with a PIC24FJ device. Allow it to do so. If any errors are shown, double-click the error message to get more information. Status indicates device is found Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 21 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. 2.6.3 Program the Device 1. From the Debugger menu, select Program to program the part. The Output window (Figure 2-12) displays the program steps as they occur. 2. Observe the results of the programming. When “MPLAB ICD 2 Ready” displays, the device is programmed and ready to run. FIGURE 2-12: PROGRAMMING THE DEVICE Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 22 NOTES: EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 23 Chapter 3. Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs 3.1 INTRODUCTION This chapter provides a high-level overview of the PIC24 and dsPIC33F firmware programmed during the tutorial exercise in the previous chapter. 3.2 PIC24 TUTORIAL PROGRAM OPERATION The PIC24 tutorial program is made up of three components which are individually displayed on the LCD. The program is used to demonstrate the new Parallel Master Port (PMP) module which is used to drive the LCD, as well as the new Real-Time Clock/Calendar module (RTCC). The program flow is shown in Figure 3-1. 3.2.1 PIC24 Features Features mode displays a continuous description of the PIC24FJ128GA010 device feature set. To exit the display and continue to the next mode, press S4. 3.2.2 Voltmeter/Temperature Voltmeter/Temperature mode uses the code modules, vbanner.c and ADC.c, and the A/D module to measure analog signals from the board and convert them for display on the LCD. The voltage is taken from the potentiometer (R6) and displays a voltage between 0.00V and 3.29V on line 1 of the LCD. Temperature is from a TC1074A analog thermal sensor (U5). The temperature is displayed on line 2 of the LCD and automatically alternates between Celsius and Fahrenheit values. The voltage and temperature are updated continuously. This mode also lets users store the current temperature in the on-board serial EEPROM by pressing S5. Pressing S6 switches the display between current and stored temperature values. An ‘M’ on the right side of the LCD indicates that a stored temperature value is being displayed. To exit and continue to the next mode, press S4. 3.2.3 Clock/Calendar Clock/Calendar mode uses code in the modules, rtcc.c and tbanner.c. Once this mode is entered from the main menu, a Real-Time Clock will start counting from 10:00:00, and display the date and day for Oct. 10, 2005. The new RTCC module and a 32 kHz clock crystal are used to provide the Real-Time Clock with day/date calendar. In Clock/Calendar mode, the user-defined push buttons do the following: • S3 toggles the Clock Set mode, which allows the user to set the date and time. Setup mode starts with the tens digit of the hour in the time display. • S4 accepts the value of the current item and moves cursor to the next item. • S5 decrements the currently selected item. • S6 increments the currently selected item. Pressing S3 once superimposes a flashing cursor over the tens digit of the hour in the time display. Each press of S4 moves the cursor sequentially through the digits of the time display, then the month, day and year. Pressing S3 at any time in the process returns to the regular clock/calendar display. Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 24 Pressing S4 at this point exits Clock/Calendar mode and returns the device to the PIC24 Features mode. The data that is sent to the LCD is also sent to the RS-232 serial port using the UART. A terminal emulator, such as HyperTerminal (installed by default on most Microsoft® Windows systems), will be able to display the same information. To do this, set the terminal emulator for 19200 baud, 8-bit data, 1 Stop bit and no parity check. FIGURE 3-1: PIC24 TUTORIAL PROGRAM FLOWCHART “Explorer 16 Development Board” Power-up PIC24 Features Scrolling Banner Is S4 pressed? “Mon 10:00:00” “Oct 10, 2005” No Yes Is S4 pressed? Is S5 pressed? Toggle Displayed Temperature between Current and Stored Is S4 pressed? No Is S3 pressed? Clock Setup mode: S3 – Exit Setup mode S4 – Accept Selection, Adjust Next Value S5 – Decrement Selection S6 – Increment Selection Yes Yes No Yes No Yes No Display Voltage Display Display Display Store Temperature in EEROM Is S6 pressed? No Yes and Temperature Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 25 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. 3.3 dsPIC33F TUTORIAL PROGRAM OPERATION The dsPIC33F tutorial program is made up of five simple processes which continuously execute on the dsPIC33FJ256GP710 device: • Real-Time Clock (RTC) using Timer1 • A/D conversion of Potentiometer (R6) • A/D volts to Hex conversion • Hex to Decimal conversion (for LCD display) • LCD Update The time of day and A/D conversion values are continually updated and displayed on the LCD. The program demonstrates the basic code to initialize Timer1, enable the Timer1 oscillator for RTC operation, and initialize the A/D for single channel conversion of potentiometer, RP5. The LCD is driven via the port pins. The program flow is shown in Figure 3-2. In addition to the tutorial, the Explorer 16 CD also provides code examples to demonstrate higher level processing requirements, such as DMA, digital filters and Fast Fourier Transforms (FFT). See Code Example 2 on the CD for more information. 3.3.1 Voltmeter The simple tutorial program initializes the A/D module for 12-bit mode with auto-sampling and conversion of the potentiometer connected to pin AN5 and initializes the respective interrupt. The A/D module continually samples and converts the potentiometer signal (0 to 3.3 VDC) on analog channel, AN5. When a conversion is complete, an interrupt is generated and the result in the ADCBUF0 register is copied into a temporary variable, temp1. The adc_lcd_update flag is then asserted and the A/D Interrupt Flag, AD1IF (IFS0<13>), is cleared. The program exits the Interrupt Service Routine and re-enters the main program loop. The variable, adc_lcd_update, is evaluated in the main loop to determine if there is a new A/D conversion value which can be converted and displayed on the LCD. The primary code modules associated with the operation of the ADC module and display are: • init_ADC.c • isr_ADC.c • advolts.c • hexdec.c 3.3.2 Real-Time Clock The tutorial program also supports a Real-Time Clock demo. Timer1 is initialized with interrupts enabled and the external 32.768 kHz oscillator is enabled. Within the Timer1 Interrupt Service Routine (once every second), the variables, hours, minutes and seconds, are updated, the flag variable, rtc_lcd_update, is asserted and the Timer1 Interrupt Flag, T1IF (IFS0<3>), is cleared. The program exits the Interrupt Service Routine and re-enters the main program loop. The variable, rtc_lcd_update, is evaluated in the main loop to determine if there is a new time of day value which can be converted and displayed on the LCD. The primary code modules associated with the operation of the Timer1 module and display are: • init_timer1.c • isr_timer1.c • hexdec.c Explorer 16 Tutorial Programs © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 26 FIGURE 3-2: dsPIC33F TUTORIAL PROGRAM FLOWCHART “dsPIC33 Demo” “Press S3 to cont” Power-up Initialize Timer1 Is S3 pressed? Initialize A/D Converter to Decimal and Call Update_LCD No Update time? Update volts? Yes Yes No Yes No Convert Time of Day Display “Time 00:00:00” “R6 = 0.00 VDC” Display to Decimal and Call Update_LCD Convert A/D Result EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 27 Chapter 4. Explorer 16 Development Hardware 4.1 INTRODUCTION This chapter provides a more detailed description of the hardware features of the Explorer 16 Development Board. 4.2 HARDWARE FEATURES The key features of the Explorer 16 board are listed below. They are presented in the order given in Section 1.4 “Explorer 16 Development Board Functionality and Features”, Figure 1-1. 4.2.1 Processor Support The Explorer 16 board has been designed to accommodate both permanently mounted (i.e., soldered on) and detachable PIM processors. Slider switch, S2, allows the user to choose which processor to use. This makes it possible for the Explorer 16 board to support most 3V, 16-bit, pin compatible microcontrollers with appropriate PIMs. PIMs are visually indexed for proper installation. The PIM is always installed with the notched corner mark on the corner of the PIM board oriented to the upper left corner. Current revisions of the board do not have a permanently mounted microcontroller in U1. In order for the board to work, therefore, S2 must always be left in the “PIM” position. In future versions with a permanently mounted PIC24 device at U1, setting S2 in the “PIC” position will enable the on-board device and disable the PIM socket. 4.2.2 Power Supply There are two ways to supply power to the Explorer 16 board: • An unregulated DC supply of 9V to 15V (preferably 9V) supplied to J12. For default functionality, a power supply with a current capability of 250 mA is sufficient. Since the board can serve as a modular development platform that can connect to multiple expansion boards, voltage regulators (Q1 and Q2) with a maximum current capability of 800 mA are used. This may require a larger power supply of up to 1.6A. Because the regulators do not have heat sinks, long-term operation at such loads is not recommended. • An external, regulated DC power supply that provides both +5V and +3.3V can be connected to the terminals provided (at the bottom left side of the board, near S3). One green LED (D1) is provided to show when the Explorer 16 board is powered up. The power-on LED indicates the presence of +3.3V. Note: The Explorer 16 kit does not include a power supply. If an external supply is needed, use Microchip part number AC162039. Note: Do not attempt to power the Explorer 16 board using the MPLAB ICD 2 module. It is not designed to be a USB bus power source. Explorer 16 Development Hardware © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 28 4.2.3 RS-232 Serial Port An RS-232 level shifter (U3) has been provided with all necessary hardware to support RS-232 connection with hardware flow control through the DB9 connector. The port is configured as a DCE device, and can be connected to a PC using a straight-through cable. The PIC24/dsPIC33F RX and TX pins are tied to the RX and TX lines of U3. The PIC24/dsPIC33F RTS and CTS pins are tied to the RX2 (DIN2) and TX2 (DOUT2) lines of the MAX3232 for hardware flow control. 4.2.4 Temperature Sensor An analog output thermal sensor (Microchip TC1074A, U4) is connected to one of the controller’s A/D channels. 4.2.5 USB Connectivity The Explorer 16 board includes a PIC18LF4550 USB microcontroller, which provides both USB connectivity and support for protocol translation. The PIC18LF4550 is hard-wired to the PIC24/dsPIC33F devices to provide three types of connectivity: • SPI™ of PIC18LF4550 to SPI1 of PIC24/dsPIC33F • I/O pins of PIC18LF4550 to ICSP™ pins of PIC24/dsPIC33F • I/O pins of PIC18LF4550 to JTAG pins of PIC24/dsPIC33F The type of connectivity depends on the firmware installed on the PIC18LF4550. At the time of initial release, the PIC18LF4550 is loaded with USB bootloader firmware, which permits easy upgrades of connectivity firmware over the USB. Installing this firmware is described in Appendix B. “Updating the USB Connectivity Firmware”. PIC24 and dsPIC33F devices both have some 5V tolerant input pins. If a 5V tolerant input is connected to the PIC18LF4550, protection diodes on the PIC18LF4550 device’s port pins will limit inputs to VDD. For more information on which pins of the 16-bit devices are 5V tolerant, refer to the appropriate device data sheet. 4.2.6 ICD Connector An MPLAB ICD 2 module can be connected by way of the modular connector (JP1) for low-cost debugging. The ICD connector utilizes port pins, RB6 and RB7 of the microcontroller, for in-circuit debugging. Jumper J7 decides the terminus of the ICD 2 connector. If the jumper is set to the “PIC24” side, JP1 communicates directly with RB6/RB7 of the PIM or on-board device (determined by S2). If the jumper is set to the “F4450” side, JP1 communicates with the on-board PIC18LF4550 USB device. 4.2.7 LCD The Explorer 16 board includes an alphanumeric LCD display with two lines of 16 characters each. The display is driven with three control lines (RD4, RD5 and RD15) and eight data lines (RE7:RE0). On PIC24 devices, the LCD is driven by the PMP module, not the I/O port. The Explorer 16 board has multiple LCD footprints and support options, although only one footprint is ever populated at one time. The Lumex LCM-SO1062 (populated at LCD4) is a 5V LCD with TTL input, and is used in the initial version of the Explorer 16 board. The Tianma TM162JCAWG1 (populated at LCD1) is a 3V LCD; it is anticipated to be used in future versions of the board. An alternate configuration option allows the use of RD3:RD0 as four of the data lines, instead of RE7:RE4. To do this, the user must cut the trace jumpers at R60/62/64/66 and create solder bridges from the pads for R61/63/65/67 (see Figure 4-1). Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 29 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE 4-1: MODIFICATIONS TO R60-R67 FOR LCD CONFIGURATION (SCALE ENHANCED FOR VISIBILITY) 4.2.8 Graphic LCD The Explorer 16 also has a footprint and layout support for the Optrex 128 x 64 dot-matrix graphic LCD (part number F-51320GNB-LW-AB) and associated circuitry. This is the same display used in Microchip’s MPLAB PM3 programmer. 4.2.9 Switches Five push button switches provide the following functions: • S1: Active-low MCLR switch to hard reset the processor • S3: Active-low switch connected to RD6 (user-defined) • S4: Active-low switch connected to RD13 (user-defined) • S5: Active-low switch connected to RA7 (user-defined) • S6: Active-low switch connected to RD7 (user-defined) Switch S1 has a debounce capacitor, whereas S3 through S6 do not; this allows the user to investigate debounce techniques. When Idle, the switches are pulled high (+3.3V). When pressed, they are grounded. 4.2.10 Analog Input (Potentiometer) A 10 kΩ potentiometer is connected through a series resistor to AN5. It can be adjusted from VDD to GND to provide an analog input to one of the controller’s A/D channels. 4.2.11 LEDs Eight red LEDs (D2 through D9) are connected to PORTA of the PIM socket. The PORTA pins are set high to light the LEDs. These LEDs may be disabled by removing jumper JP2. 4.2.12 Oscillator Options The installed microcontroller has two separate oscillator circuits connected.The main oscillator uses an 8 MHz crystal (Y3) and functions as the controller’s primary oscillator. A second circuit, using a 32.768 kHz (watch type) crystal (Y2), functions as the Timer1 oscillator and serves as the source for the RTCC and secondary oscillator. The PIC18LF4550, at the heart of the USB subsystem, is independently clocked and has its own 20 MHz crystal (Y1). 4.2.13 Serial EEPROM A 25LC256 256K (32K x 8) serial EEPROM (U5) is included for nonvolatile firmware storage. It is also used to demonstrate SPI bus operation. R60 R61 R62 R63 R64 R65 R66 R67 Cut Traces Here Add Solder Bridges Here Explorer 16 Development Hardware © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 30 4.2.14 PICkit 2 Connector Connector J14 provides the footprint for a 6-pin PICkit 2 programmer interface. This will provide a third low-cost programming option, besides MPLAB ICD 2 and the JTAG interface, when PICkit 2 support for larger devices become available in the future. 4.2.15 JTAG Connector Connector J13 provides a standard JTAG interface, allowing users to connect to and program the controller via JTAG. 4.2.16 PICtail™ Plus Card Edge Modular Expansion Connectors The Explorer 16 board has been designed with the PICtail™ Plus modular expansion interface, allowing the board to provide basic generic functionality and still be easily extendable to new technologies as they become available. PICtail Plus is based on a 120-pin connection divided into three sections of 30 pins, 30 pins and 56 pins. The two 30-pin connections have parallel functionality; for example, pins 1, 3, 5 and 7 have SPI1 functionality on the top 30-pin segment, with similar SPI2 functionality on the corresponding pins in the middle 30-pin segment. Each 30-pin section provides connections to all of the serial communications peripherals, as well as many I/O ports, external interrupts and A/D channels. This provides enough signals to develop many different expansion interfaces, such as Ethernet, Zigbee™, IrDA® and so on. The 30-pin PICtail Plus expansion boards can be used in either the top or middle 30-pin sections. The Explorer 16 board provides footprints for two edge connectors for daughter cards, one populated (J5, Samtec # MEC1-160-02-S-D-A) and one unpopulated (J6). The board also has a matching male edge connection (J9), allowing it to be used as an expansion card itself. 4.2.16.1 CROSSOVER CONNECTIONS FOR SPI AND UART The PICtail Plus interface allows two Explorer 16 boards to be connected directly to each other without any external connector. This provides 1-to-1 connection between the microcontrollers on the two boards, an interface that works well for many types of peripherals (I2C, PMP, etc.). However, certain serial peripheral modules, such as SPIs and UARTs, require cross-wire connections; that is, the TX (or SDO) pin of one controller must be connected to the RX (or SDI) of the other and vice versa. The Explorer 16 board uses two 74HCT4053 analog multiplexers to simplify the connections between itself and any daughter boards. U6 and U7 provide active control of the cross-wire capability on SPI1 and UART1, with a hardware flow control signal provided by three I/O pins. The multiplexers are controlled by the state of pins RB12, RB13 and RB14. When a control pin is high (the default state), the corresponding SPI1 or UART1 pin pairs are connected to their default pins on the PICtail Plus interface. When a control pin is asserted low, the corresponding pin pair functions are swapped. Table 4-1 details the relationship between the control pins and SPI1/UART1 functions on the interface. Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 31 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. TABLE 4-1: LOCATION OF SPI1 AND UART1 PINS ON PICtail™ PLUS INTERFACE Control Pin State UART1 Control Pins SPI1 Control Pin RB14 Control Pin RB13 Control Pin RB12 U1RX U1TX U1CTS U1RTS SDI1 SDO1 1 2 4 19 20 5 7 0 4 2 20 19 7 5 Note: When connecting SPI and UART peripherals on two Explorer 16 boards, use crossover connection on only one of the boards. Explorer 16 Development Hardware © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 32 NOTES: EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 33 Appendix A. Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics A.1 INTRODUCTION This section provides detailed technical information on the Explorer 16 board. A.2 DEVELOPMENT BOARD BLOCK DIAGRAM FIGURE A-1: HIGH-LEVEL BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD PIC24FJ128GA010 dsPIC33FJ256GP710 16x2 LCD Display PIC18LF4550 SPI* ICSP* JTAG* ICD/ICSP JTAG RS-232 Transceiver SPI EEPROM +3.3V and +5V Supply 9-15 VDC Switches Temperature Sensor LEDs POT Modular Expansion Connector USB PICtail™ Plus PICtail™ Plus * Hardware support only; firmware support for SPI™, JTAG and ICSP™ via USB are not available at this time. Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 34 A.3 DEVELOPMENT BOARD SCHEMATICS FIGURE A-2: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 1 OF 8 (PIM SOCKET) VCAP/VDDCORE VDDCORE VSS VSS VDD 100-Pin PIM VSS VDD VSS VDD CVREF/AN10/RB10 AVDD AVSS VSS VDD VDD Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 35 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE A-3: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 2 OF 8 (BOARD MOUNTED PIC24FJ128GA010 MCU, WHEN INSTALLED) 10 μF .1 μF VCAP/VDDCORE VDD VSS PIC24FJ128GA010 VDD AVDD VDD VSS AVSS CVREF/AN10/RB10 VSS VDD VDD VSS VSS Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 36 FIGURE A-4: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 3 OF 8 (MPLAB® ICD 2, JTAG, PICkit™ 2 AND PICtail™ Plus CONNECTORS) MPLAB® ICD 2 Connector .1 μF PICkit™ 2 Programmer Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 37 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE A-5: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 4 OF 8 (PICtail™ PLUS EDGE AND SOCKET CONNECTORS) Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 38 FIGURE A-6: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 5 OF 8 (SWITCHES, MULTIPLEXERS AND POTENTIOMETER) VEE VCC .1 μF .1 μF VCC VEE .1 μF Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 39 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE A-7: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 6 OF 8 (EEPROM, TEMPERATURE SENSOR, LEDs, OSCILLATOR CIRCUITS AND POWER SUPPLY) .1 μF 25LC256 .1 μF TC1047A 22 pF 22 pF 32 kHz .1 μF 47 μF .1 μF 47 μF 47 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF VCC VSS VDD VOUT VSS 8 MHz 22 pF 22 pF Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 40 FIGURE A-8: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 7 OF 8 (USB AND UART SUBSYSTEMS) VUSB VSS VDD VDD VSS VSS VDD PIC18F4550_QFN44 VDD .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF .1 μF 22 pF 22 pF 20 MHz VBUS VCC Explorer 16 Development Board User’s Guide DS51589A-page 41 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE A-9: EXPLORER 16 BOARD SCHEMATIC, SHEET 8 OF 8 (LCDs AND OPTIONAL LCD CONNECTIONS) Alternative LCD Configurations: 4.7 μF 4.7 μF 4.7 μF 4.7 μF 1 μF 1 μF 1 μF 1 μF 1 μF .1 μF VEE VO VCC VEE VCC VEE VEE VSS VDD VO Explorer 16 Development Board Schematics © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 42 NOTES: EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 43 Appendix B. Updating the USB Connectivity Firmware B.1 INTRODUCTION The USB subsystem of the Explorer 16 Development Board is preprogrammed with USB bootloader firmware. This provides an easy method for upgrading the PIC18LF4550 firmware to support ICSP, JTAG and SPI connectivity to PIC24 and dsPIC33F devices. This chapter describes how to upgrade the PIC18LF4550 device’s firmware with the PICkit 2 software. The same process can be used to upgrade the PIC18LF4550 device’s firmware when updates and new firmware packages become available. B.2 UPDATING THE PICkit 2 MICROCONTROLLER PROGRAMMER Before beginning, it will be necessary to obtain and install the PICkit 2 programmer software. Complete instructions for installing and using the programmer software application is provided in the PICkit™ 2 Microcontroller Programmer User’s Guide (DS51553). The programmer and user’s guide, as well as the latest version of the PICkit 2 operating system firmware, are available from the Microchip corporate web site, www.microchip.com. To update the USB firmware: 1. If not done already, download the latest PICkit 2 operating system software from the Microchip web site. 2. On the Explorer 16 board, install a jumper between pins 9 and 10 of the JTAG connector (J13). 3. Press and release MCLR (S1). This places the USB subsystem in Bootloader mode and makes it ready to accept new code. 4. Connect the Explorer 16 board to the PC via a standard USB cable. 5. Launch the PICkit 2 programmer software. From the menu bar, select Tools > Download PICKit 2 Operating System (Figure B-1). FIGURE B-1: DOWNLOAD PICkit™ 2 OPERATING SYSTEM Updating the USB Connectivity Firmware © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 44 6. Browse to the directory where the latest operating system firmware was saved (Figure B-2). FIGURE B-2: SELECT PICkit™ 2 OPERATING SYSTEM 7. Select the PK2_Explorer16_*.hex file and click the Open button. The progress of the update is displayed in the status bar of the programming software. When the update completes successfully, the status bar displays “Operating System Verified”. The update is now complete. B.3 OTHER USB FIRMWARE UPDATES It is anticipated that various USB connectivity firmwares will be made available in the future. Users are encouraged to periodically check the Microchip web site (www.microchip.com) for new and revised code. EXPLORER 16 DEVELOPMENT BOARD USER’S GUIDE © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. DS51589A-page 45 Index B Build Options............................................................ 16 C Configuration Bits..................................................... 19 Crossover Connections (Serial Communications) ...................................8, 30 Customer Change Notification Service ...................... 5 Customer Support ...................................................... 5 D Documentation Conventions........................................................ 2 Layout ................................................................. 1 dsPIC33 Tutorial Program........................................ 25 dsPIC33F Tutorial Program Flowchart .......................................................... 26 E Explorer 16 Development Board Block Diagram .................................................. 33 Layout ................................................................. 9 Schematics ..................................................34–41 Explorer 16 Programming Tutorial ........................... 11 Building the Code ............................................. 16 Creating the Project .......................................... 12 Programming the Device .................................. 19 F Free Software Foundation ......................................... 4 G GNU Language Tools ................................................ 4 H Hardware Features Analog Potentiometer ....................................8, 29 ICD Connector ...............................................8, 28 JTAG Connector ............................................8, 30 LCD, Alphanumeric........................................8, 28 LCD, Graphic .................................................8, 29 LEDs ..............................................................8, 29 Multiplexers....................................................8, 30 Oscillator Options ..........................................8, 29 PICkit 2 Connector.........................................8, 30 PICtail Plus Card Edge Connectors...............8, 30 Power Indicator LED........................................... 8 Power Supply.................................................8, 27 Processor Support ........................................ 8, 27 Prototype Area .................................................... 8 RS-232 Serial Port ........................................ 8, 28 Serial EEPROM............................................ 8, 29 Switches........................................................ 8, 29 Temperature Sensor ..................................... 8, 28 USB Connectivity .......................................... 8, 28 I Internet Address......................................................... 4 L Language Toolsuite.................................................. 13 M Microchip Internet Web Site ....................................... 4 MPLAB ICD 2........................................................... 10 MPLAB IDE Simulator, Editor User’s Guide............... 4 P PIC24 Tutorial Program ........................................... 23 Flowchart .......................................................... 24 PICtail Plus Edge Connectors Use with Crossover Serial Connections........................................ 30 Project ...................................................................... 12 Project Wizard.......................................................... 12 R Reading, Recommended ........................................... 3 Readme...................................................................... 3 Reference Documents ............................................. 10 S Schematics......................................................... 34–41 U USB Connectivity ...................................................... 28 Updating the USB Connectivity Firmware............................................. 43 W Warranty Registration ................................................ 2 Workspace ............................................................... 12 WWW Address........................................................... 4 DS51589A-page 46 © 2005 Microchip Technology Inc. AMERICAS Corporate Office 2355 West Chandler Blvd. Chandler, AZ 85224-6199 Tel: 480-792-7200 Fax: 480-792-7277 Technical Support: http://support.microchip.com Web Address: www.microchip.com Atlanta Alpharetta, GA Tel: 770-640-0034 Fax: 770-640-0307 Boston Westborough, MA Tel: 774-760-0087 Fax: 774-760-0088 Chicago Itasca, IL Tel: 630-285-0071 Fax: 630-285-0075 Dallas Addison, TX Tel: 972-818-7423 Fax: 972-818-2924 Detroit Farmington Hills, MI Tel: 248-538-2250 Fax: 248-538-2260 Kokomo Kokomo, IN Tel: 765-864-8360 Fax: 765-864-8387 Los Angeles Mission Viejo, CA Tel: 949-462-9523 Fax: 949-462-9608 San Jose Mountain View, CA Tel: 650-215-1444 Fax: 650-961-0286 Toronto Mississauga, Ontario, Canada Tel: 905-673-0699 Fax: 905-673-6509 ASIA/PACIFIC Australia - Sydney Tel: 61-2-9868-6733 Fax: 61-2-9868-6755 China - Beijing Tel: 86-10-8528-2100 Fax: 86-10-8528-2104 China - Chengdu Tel: 86-28-8676-6200 Fax: 86-28-8676-6599 China - Fuzhou Tel: 86-591-8750-3506 Fax: 86-591-8750-3521 China - Hong Kong SAR Tel: 852-2401-1200 Fax: 852-2401-3431 China - Qingdao Tel: 86-532-8502-7355 Fax: 86-532-8502-7205 China - Shanghai Tel: 86-21-5407-5533 Fax: 86-21-5407-5066 China - Shenyang Tel: 86-24-2334-2829 Fax: 86-24-2334-2393 China - Shenzhen Tel: 86-755-8203-2660 Fax: 86-755-8203-1760 China - Shunde Tel: 86-757-2839-5507 Fax: 86-757-2839-5571 China - Wuhan Tel: 86-27-5980-5300 Fax: 86-27-5980-5118 China - Xian Tel: 86-29-8833-7250 Fax: 86-29-8833-7256 ASIA/PACIFIC India - Bangalore Tel: 91-80-2229-0061 Fax: 91-80-2229-0062 India - New Delhi Tel: 91-11-5160-8631 Fax: 91-11-5160-8632 India - Pune Tel: 91-20-2566-1512 Fax: 91-20-2566-1513 Japan - Yokohama Tel: 81-45-471- 6166 Fax: 81-45-471-6122 Korea - Gumi Tel: 82-54-473-4301 Fax: 82-54-473-4302 Korea - Seoul Tel: 82-2-554-7200 Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or 82-2-558-5934 Malaysia - Penang Tel: 60-4-646-8870 Fax: 60-4-646-5086 Philippines - Manila Tel: 63-2-634-9065 Fax: 63-2-634-9069 Singapore Tel: 65-6334-8870 Fax: 65-6334-8850 Taiwan - Hsin Chu Tel: 886-3-572-9526 Fax: 886-3-572-6459 Taiwan - Kaohsiung Tel: 886-7-536-4818 Fax: 886-7-536-4803 Taiwan - Taipei Tel: 886-2-2500-6610 Fax: 886-2-2508-0102 Thailand - Bangkok Tel: 66-2-694-1351 Fax: 66-2-694-1350 EUROPE Austria - Wels Tel: 43-7242-2244-399 Fax: 43-7242-2244-393 Denmark - Copenhagen Tel: 45-4450-2828 Fax: 45-4485-2829 France - Paris Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20 Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79 Germany - Munich Tel: 49-89-627-144-0 Fax: 49-89-627-144-44 Italy - Milan Tel: 39-0331-742611 Fax: 39-0331-466781 Netherlands - Drunen Tel: 31-416-690399 Fax: 31-416-690340 Spain - Madrid Tel: 34-91-708-08-90 Fax: 34-91-708-08-91 UK - Wokingham Tel: 44-118-921-5869 Fax: 44-118-921-5820 WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE 10/31/05 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board User's Guide Literature Number: SLAU330A May 2011–Revised June 2011 2 SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Contents Preface ....................................................................................................................................... 5 1 Getting Started ................................................................................................................... 7 1.1 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board Introduction ............................................................. 7 1.2 Kit Contents .............................................................................................................. 8 2 User Experience Software .................................................................................................... 9 2.1 Introduction ............................................................................................................... 9 2.2 Main Menu ............................................................................................................... 9 2.3 Clock ..................................................................................................................... 10 2.4 Games ................................................................................................................... 10 2.5 Power Tests ............................................................................................................ 10 2.6 Demo Apps ............................................................................................................. 11 2.7 SD Card Access ....................................................................................................... 12 2.8 Settings Menu .......................................................................................................... 12 3 Software Installation and Debugging ................................................................................... 13 3.1 Software ................................................................................................................. 13 3.2 Download the Required Software .................................................................................... 13 3.3 Working With the Example Software ................................................................................ 13 4 MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware .............................................................................................. 17 4.1 Hardware Overview .................................................................................................... 17 4.2 Jumper Settings and Power .......................................................................................... 18 4.3 eZ-FET Emulator ....................................................................................................... 21 4.4 MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware Components ...................................................................... 21 5 Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics .................................................... 24 5.1 Frequently Asked Questions ......................................................................................... 24 5.2 References .............................................................................................................. 24 5.3 Schematics and BOM ................................................................................................. 25 SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Table of Contents 3 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com List of Figures 1 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board ............................................................................... 7 2 User Experience Navigation ............................................................................................... 9 3 Selecting a CCS Workspace............................................................................................. 14 4 Opening Existing Project ................................................................................................. 14 5 Simple Hardware Overview .............................................................................................. 17 6 Hardware Block Details ................................................................................................... 18 7 Common Power Jumper Settings ....................................................................................... 18 8 Visual Power Schematic.................................................................................................. 20 9 MSP430 Current Measurement Connection ........................................................................... 21 10 Schematics (1 of 7)........................................................................................................ 25 11 Schematics (2 of 7)........................................................................................................ 26 12 Schematics (3 of 7)........................................................................................................ 27 13 Schematics (4 of 7)........................................................................................................ 28 14 Schematics (5 of 7)........................................................................................................ 29 15 Schematics (6 of 7)........................................................................................................ 30 16 Schematics (7 of 7)........................................................................................................ 31 List of Tables 1 MSP-EXP430F5529 Jumper Settings and Functionality ............................................................. 19 2 Push Buttons, Potentiometer, and LED Connections................................................................. 22 3 Pinning Mapping for Header J4.......................................................................................... 23 4 Pin Mapping for Header J5............................................................................................... 23 5 Pin Mapping for Header J12 ............................................................................................. 23 6 Bill of Materials............................................................................................................. 32 4 List of Figures SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Preface SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Read This First If You Need Assistance The primary sources of information for MSP430 devices are the data sheets and the family user's guides. The most up-to-date versions of these documents can be found at www.ti.com/msp430. Information specific to the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board can be found at www.ti.com/usbexp. Customer support for MSP430 devices and the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board is provided by the Texas Instruments Product Information Center (PIC), as well as on the TI E2E (Engineer-2-Engineer) Forum at the link below. Contact information for the PIC can be found on the TI web site at: support.ti.com. The MSP430 Specific E2E forum is located at: community.ti.com/forums/12.aspx. Related Documentation from Texas Instruments MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board User's Guide (SLAU330) MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board User Experience Software MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board Quick Start Guide (SLAU339) MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board PCB Design Files (SLAR055) MSP430F552x Code Examples (SLAC300) FCC Warning This equipment is intended for use in a laboratory test environment only. It generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and has not been tested for compliance with the limits of computing devices pursuant to subpart J of part 15 of FCC rules, which are designed to provide reasonable protection against radio frequency interference. Operation of this equipment in other environments may cause interference with radio communications, in which case the user, at his own expense, will be required to take whatever measures may be required to correct this interference. SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Preface 5 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated 6 Read This First SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated User's Guide SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 1 Getting Started 1.1 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board Introduction The MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board is a development platform based on the MSP430F5529 with integrated USB. The Experimenter Board showcases the abilities of the latest family of MSP430s and is perfect for learning and developing USB-based applications using the MSP430. The features include a 102x64 dot-matrix LCD, microSD memory card interface, 3-axis accelerometer, five capacitive-touch pads, RF EVM expansion headers, nine LEDs, an analog thumb-wheel, easy access to spare F5529 pins, integrated Spy-Bi-Wire flash emulation module, and standard full JTAG pin access. The kit is pre-programmed with an out-of-box demo to immediately demonstrate the capabilities of the MSP430 and Experimenter Board. This document details the hardware, its use, and the example software. Figure 1. MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board The MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board is available for purchase from the TI eStore: https://estore.ti.com/MSP-EXP430F5529-MSP430F5529-Experimenter-Board-P2413C43.aspx SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 7 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Getting Started www.ti.com 1.2 Kit Contents • MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board • Two mini-USB cables • Battery holder • 1GB microSD card • Quick start guide 8 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com User Experience Software 2 User Experience Software 2.1 Introduction The MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board arrives with a User Experience application installed to demonstrate a few of the capabilities of the MSP430F5529. Set the power switch to "LDO", and connect your PC to the "5529 USB" connection as shown in Figure 2. A splash screen displaying the TI logo should appear on the LCD. Wait approximately three seconds, or press either the S1 or S2 button, to display the Main Menu. Use the thumb wheel to navigate up and down the menu items on the LCD screen. Press the S1 pushbutton to enter a selection, or press the S2 pushbutton to cancel. Figure 2. User Experience Navigation 2.2 Main Menu The main menu displays a list of applications and settings that demonstrate key features of the MSP430F5529. Use the thumb wheel on the bottom right of the PCB to scroll up and down through the menu options. Use the push-buttons to enter and exit menu items. Press S1 to enter a menu item. Press S2 to return to a previous menu or to cancel an operation. Each application in the main menu is described in the following sections. SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 9 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated User Experience Software www.ti.com 2.3 Clock Select this option from the main menu to bring up the Clock sub-menu. Press S2 to return to the previous menu. NOTE: The User Experience software initializes the real-time clock to 04:30:00 - 01/01/2011 when powered is applied to the MSP430. Digital Clock: Displays an image of a digital watch with the current time and date. Analog Clock: Displays an image of an analog clock with the current time. Set Time: Allows the user to set the current time. Use the scroll wheel to change the value of the current selection. Press push-button S1 is used to advance to the next field. The clock changes take affect after the last field is updated. 2.4 Games Select this option from the main menu to bring up the Games sub-menu. Press S2 to return to the previous menu. Defender: The player controls a small spaceship. The object of the game is to fly through a tunnel without hitting the walls and to successfully navigate around mines scattered throughout the tunnel. Press S1 or S2 to begin the game. Use the wheel to move the ship up and down and press S1 or S2 to shoot a missile. As the game progresses, the tunnel gets narrower and the game speeds up. After the player's ship crashes, the score is displayed. Simon: A version of the famous memory game. The objective of the game is to match a randomly generated sequence of LEDs displayed on the touch pads. After the sequence is displayed, the user must touch the correct pads in the same sequence. The game begins with a single-symbol sequence and adds an additional symbol to the sequence after each successful response by the user. The game ends when the user incorrectly enters a sequence. The number of turns obtained in the sequence is then displayed. Tilt Puzzle: A version of the famous "8-puzzle" game. The game consists of a 3 by 3 grid with eight numbers and one empty space. The game utilizes the on-board accelerometer to shift numbers up-down and left-right. The objective of the game is to have the sum of the numbers in each row and column equal to twelve. Press S1 to begin a new game if the current game is unsolvable. The nature of the game is that there is a 50% probability the game is not solvable. 2.5 Power Tests Select this option from the main menu to bring up the Power Test sub-menu. Press S2 to return to the previous menu. The Power Test menu contains two demonstrations that allow the user to externally measure the current consumption of the MSP430 in both active mode and low-power mode. Current consumption can be measured using a multi-meter with current measuring capabilities (ammeter). Remove the jumper on "430 PWR" (JP6) and connect a multi-meter in series with the MSP430 VCC supply. This connection can be made using the two large vias near the "430 PWR" text on the PCB. See Section 4 for more details on this connection. Active Mode: Demo for measuring active mode current of the MSP430. Instructions are presented on screen. Press S1 to continue to the application. Press S2 to return to the Power Tests sub-menu. The Active Mode menu consists of two columns. The left column controls the core voltage (VCORE) of the MSP430F5529, and the right column controls MCLK. The right column displays only those MCLK frequencies that are valid for the current VCORE setting. The capacitive touch pads at the bottom of the board control which column is currently active. The wheel scrolls through the options in the active column. 10 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com User Experience Software Press S1 to enter Measurement Mode. While in measurement mode, measure the current by attaching a multi-meter across the 430 PWR holes and removing the 430 PWR jumper J6. Replace the 430 PWR jumper after making the measurement, then press S1 or S2 to return to the Active Mode menu. Press S2 to return to the Power Tests sub-menu Low Power Mode: Selecting Low Power Mode takes the user to an information screen with directions on how to navigate the Low Power Mode menu. Press S1 to continue on to the application. Press S2 to return to the Power Tests sub-menu. In the Low Power Mode menu, use the wheel to select a low-power mode option, then press S1 to enter low-power mode. While in low-power mode, measure the current by attaching a multi-meter across the 430 PWR holes and removing the 430 PWR jumper. Press S1 or S2 to return to the Low Power Mode menu. 2.6 Demo Apps Select this option from the main menu to bring up the Demo Apps sub-menu, which allows access to various demo applications. Many of them require a USB connection. Use the wheel to select one of the options and then press S1 to enter the application. Press S2 to return to the main menu. Terminal Echo uses the CDC stack to communicate with a hyperterminal on the PC. USB Mouse uses the HID stack to interface with the PC. Terminal Echo: Select Terminal Echo to display an informational screen and connects to the PC. Make sure to connect a USB cable from the USB port labeled "5529 USB" to the host PC. Open a hyperterminal window and connect to the MSP430. Text that is typed in the hyperterminal window is echoed back to the terminal and is displayed on the LCD screen of the Experimenter Board. Press S2 to exit and return Demo Apps sub-menu. USB Mouse: Select USB Mouse to display an informational screen and connects to the PC. Make sure to connect a USB cable from the USB port labeled "5529 USB" to the host PC. The MSP430 now acts as the mouse for the PC. Tilt the board to move the mouse around the screen, and press S1 to click. Press S2 to exit and return Demo Apps sub-menu. USB microSD: Select USB microSD to connect to the PC as a mass storage device. Make sure to connect a USB cable from the USB port labeled "5529 USB" to the host PC. The MSP430 shows as an external drive (or removable drive) for the PC. Press S2 to return to the Demo Apps sub-menu. Touch Graph: Select Touch Graph to display an instruction screen for a very short time and then launch the application. Touch the capacitor key pads with varying pressures to see the varying capacitance being displayed as bars with varying heights. Slide a finger over multiple capacitor key pads to observe the change in heights of bars with respect to the current position of the finger and also the effect of capacitance from neighboring pads. Press S2 to exit and return Demo Apps sub-menu. Touch Slide: Select Touch Slide to display an instruction screen for a very short time and then launch the application. Touch the capacitor key pads with varying pressures to see the varying capacitance being displayed as bars with varying heights. Slide a finger over multiple capacitor key pads to observe the change in heights of bars with respect to the current position of the finger and also the effect of capacitance from neighboring pads. Press S2 to exit and return Demo Apps sub-menu. Demo Cube: Select Demo Cube to launch the demo cube application. Read the instructions and press S1 to start the application. There are two modes. Use S1 to toggle between them. In the first mode, the cube randomly rotates by itself. In the second mode, the cube can be rotated by tilting the board. This mode uses the accelerometer. Press S2 to exit and return Demo Apps sub-menu. SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 11 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated User Experience Software www.ti.com 2.7 SD Card Access Select SD Card Access to access a microSD card placed in the SD card reader at the top of the board. If no SD card is present, a warning screen is displayed. When an SD card is present, the screen displays a list of the contents of the card. Directories are denoted by "". Use the wheel to scroll through the list and select files or directories to open by pressing S1. When a file is open, use the wheel to scroll further through the file. Press S2 to close the current file or directory. Press S2 while in the root directory to return to the main menu. 2.8 Settings Menu Select Settings to modify the display settings for the Experimenter Board. Use the wheel to select the setting to modify and press S1 to enter. Press S2 to return to the main menu. Contrast: Modify the contrast of the LCD by turning the wheel. When first entering the menu, the contrast remains unchanged for a few seconds to allow the user to read the instructions and then changes to the setting for the current position of the wheel. After the contrast is set at the desired level, press S2 to return to the Settings sub-menu. Backlight: Modify the brightness of the backlight by turning the wheel. There are 12 brightness settings, from having the backlight turned off up to full brightness. After the backlight is set at the desired level, press S2 to return to the Settings sub-menu. Calibrate Accel: Sets the "default" position for the accelerometer. An instruction screen is shown first. For best results, set the board on a flat surface. Press S1 to start calibrations. The accelerometer readings at that point in time are stored to flash and are subtracted from the subsequent accelerometer readings of other applications like USB Mouse and USB Tilt Puzzle. SW Version: Displays the current version of the firmware loaded on the Experimenter Board. LEDs & Logo: Lights all the LEDs on the board. There are one red, one yellow, one green, and five blue LEDs on the capacitive touch pads. This provides a method to determine whether or not all the LEDs are in working condition. The screen also displays the TI Bug and a USB Flash Drive logo on the screen. 12 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Software Installation and Debugging 3 Software Installation and Debugging 3.1 Software Texas Instruments' Code Composer Studio (CCS) is an MSP430 integrated development environment (IDE) designed specifically to develop applications and program MSP430 devices. CCS, CCS Core Edition, and IAR Embedded Workbench can all be used to evaluate the example software for the Experimenter Board. The compiler limitation of 8KB prevents IAR KickStart from being used for the evaluation of the example software. The example software, titled "User Experience," is available online as MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board User Experience Software. 3.2 Download the Required Software Different development software tools are available for the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board development board. IAR Embedded Workbench KickStart and Code Composer Studio (CCS) are both available in a free limited version. IAR Embedded Workbench KickStart allows 8KB of C-code compilation. CCS is limited to a code size of 16KB. The software is available at www.ti.com/msp430. The firmware is larger than IAR KickStart's 8KB limit, so a full license of IAR Workbench is required to compile the application using IAR. A 30-day evaluation version of IAR is also available from http://supp.iar.com/Download/SW/?item=EW430-EVAL. This document describes working with Code Composer Studio (CCS). There are many other compilers and integrated development environments (IDEs) for MSP430 that can be used with the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board, including Rowley Crossworks and MSPGCC. However, the example project has been created using Code Composer Studio (CCS) and IAR. For more information on the supported software and the latest code examples visit the online product folder (http://focus.ti.com/docs/toolsw/folders/print/msp-exp430f5529.html). 3.3 Working With the Example Software The MSP-EXP430F5529 example software is written in C and offers APIs to control the MSP430F5529 chip and external components on the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board. New application development can use this library for guidance. The example software can be downloaded from the MSP-EXP430F5529 tools page, MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board User Experience Software. The zip package includes the MSP-EXP430F5529 example software. The code is ready for compilation and execution. To modify, compile, and debug the example code the following steps should be followed: 1. If you have not already done so, download the sample code from the MSP-EXP430F5529 tools page. 2. Install 5529UE-x.xx-Setup.exe installation package to the PC. 3. Connect the MSP-FET430UIF programmer to the PC. If you have not already done so, install the drivers for the programmer. 4. Connect one end of the 14-pin cable to JTAG programmer and another end to the JTAG header on the board. 5. Open CCS and select a workspace directory (see Figure 3). SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 13 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Software Installation and Debugging www.ti.com Figure 3. Selecting a CCS Workspace • Select Project > Import Existing CCS/CCE Eclipse Project. • Browse to the extracted project directory. The project should now show up in the Projects list (see Figure 4). • Make sure the project is selected, and click Finish. Figure 4. Opening Existing Project The project is now open. To build, download, and debug the code on the device on the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board, select Target > Debug Active Project or click the green 'bug' button. 14 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Software Installation and Debugging You may be prompted to update the firmware on the MSP-FET430UIF programmer. Do not be concerned; click the button that says Update, and the program download should continue as expected. NOTE: To begin developing your own application, follow these steps: 1. Download and install a supported IDE: Code Composer Studio – Free 16KB IDE: www.ti.com/ccs IAR Embedded Workbench KickStart – Free 8KB IDE: www.ti.com/iar-kickstart 2. Connect the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board "eZ-FET" USB to the PC. 3. Download and debug your application. SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 15 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Software Installation and Debugging www.ti.com 3.3.1 Basic Code Structure CTS "Capacitive Touch Sensing" library with functions related to the capacitive touch pads. CCS CCS-specific project files CCS_Code_Size_Limited CCS-specific project files for 16kb code size limited version F5xx_F6xx_Core_Lib Core Libraries FatFs Stack for the FAT file system used by SD Card IAR IAR-specific project files MSP-EXP430F5529_HAL Provides an abstraction layer for events like button presses, etc. HAL_AppUart Functions for controlling application UART HAL_Board Experimenter Board port initialization and control HAL_Buttons Driver for the buttons on the Experimenter Board HAL_Cma3000 Functions required to use on-board accelerometer HAL_Dogs102x6 Driver for the DOGS 102x64 display HAL_Menu Used to create the menus for the example software and applications HAL_SDCard Driver for the SD Card module HAL_Wheel Driver for the scroll (thumb) wheel USB USB stack for the Experimenter Board UserExperienceDemo Files related to the example software provided with the board 5xx_ACTIVE_test Runs a RAM test Clock Displays analog and digital clocks. Also provides a function to set time and date. Demo_Cube Displays a auto/manual rotating cube (uses accelerometer) DemoApps Contains the demos for capacitive touch EchoUsb HyperTerminal application LPM Provides options for various low-power modes MassStorage Use microSD as external storage on computer menuGames Play LaunchPad Defender or Simon Puzzle Play Tilt-puzzle Mouse Use the Experimenter Board as a mouse PMM Active low-power modes. Choose VCORE and MCLK settings. PowerTest Test the current consumption of various low-power modes Random Random number generator SDCard Access microSD card contents on the Experimenter's Board Settings Options to set various parameters like contrast, brightness, etc. UserExperience.c Main MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board file MSP-EXP430F5529 User Experience Manifest.pdf readme.txt 16 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware 4 MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware 4.1 Hardware Overview Figure 5 and Figure 6 show the functional blocks and connections of the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board. The area of the PCB labeled as "eZ430-FET Emulator" and bordered by a thick broken line on the PCB silk screen is an integrated TI Flash Emulation Tool (FET) which is connected to the Experimenter Board by the jumpers on JP16. This module is similar to any eZ430 emulator, and provides real-time in-system Spy-Bi-Wire programming and debugging via a USB connection to a PC. Using the eZ430-FET Emulator module eliminates the need for using an external MSP430 Flash Emulation Tool (MSP-FET430UIF). However, full speed 4-wire JTAG communication is only possible with a MSP-FET430UIF connected to the "5529 JTAG" header. For additional details on the installation and usage of the Flash Emulation Tool, Spy-Bi-Wire and JTAG, see the MSP430 Hardware Tools User's Guide (SLAU278). Figure 5. Simple Hardware Overview SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 17 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware www.ti.com Figure 6. Hardware Block Details 4.2 Jumper Settings and Power Figure 7 shows the common jumper settings, depending on the power source for the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board. Figure 7. Common Power Jumper Settings 18 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware There are also other jumpers available for current measurement, disconnection of certain peripherals, and other advanced options (see Table 1). The black line on the board below the jumpers JP8 (LDO) and JP11 (JTAG) indicates the default jumper position. Table 1. MSP-EXP430F5529 Jumper Settings and Functionality Header Functionality When Jumper Present Functionality When Jumper Absent JP2 – POT Connects pin P8.0 to potentiometer Disconnects pin P8.0 to potentiometer JP3 – LED1 Connects pin P1.0 to LED1 Disconnects pin P1.0 to LED1 JP6 – 430 PWR Provides power to MSP430F5529. Also used to measure current MSP430F5529 is not powered. consumption of the MSP430F5529. NOTE: The two large vias near the "430 PWR" label on the PCB are connected to JP6 as well. These vias can be used to easily connect a test lead onto the PCB for current consumption measurement. JP7 – SYS PWR Provides power to the entire MSP-EXP430F5529 board. Also MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter used to measure current consumption of the entire board. Board system devices are not powered. JP8 – LDO Only applicable when powering via "5529 USB" connection. No connection to MSP430 VCC when powered via "5529 USB". ALT (Default): Connects the alternate LDO (TPS73533) to the MSP430 VCC. INT: Connects the internal 'F5529 LDO to the MSP430 VCC. JP11 – JTAG Only applicable when powering via JTAG connection. JTAG tool does NOT provide power to system. EXT (Default): JTAG tool does NOT provide power to system. INT: JTAG tool will provide power to system. JP14 – RF PWR Connects system VCC to the RF headers: J12, J13, and RF2. RF headers: J12, J13, and RF2 do not have power. JP15 – USB PWR Connects USB 5-V power to MSP430F5529 and Alternate LDO USB 5-V power not connected to (TPS73533). system. JP16 – eZ-FET DVCC: Connects MSP430 V No connection between CC to eZ-FET Connection MSP430F5529 and the eZ-FET. TXD / RXD: Connects UART between F5529 and eZ-FET. RST / TEST: Connects Spy-Bi-Wire JTAG between F5529 and eZ-FET. SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 19 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware www.ti.com Figure 8 shows a visual diagram of the power connections for the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board. Care should be observed when using multiple power sources such as USB and a battery at the same time. This could lead to the battery being charged if the power settings are not correct. Figure 8. Visual Power Schematic 20 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware Figure 9 shows a method of connecting a multi-meter to the MSP-EXP430F5529 to measure the current of the MSP430F5529. Figure 9. MSP430 Current Measurement Connection 4.3 eZ-FET Emulator The connection between the eZ-FET emulator and the MSP-EXP430F5529 can be opened by removing the jumpers on JP16. This is necessary only to ensure there is no interaction between the two sub-systems. The eZ-FET Emulator can program other eZ430 tools such as the eZ430-F2013 target board as well. A six-pin header on J17 would need be installed on the PCB for this feature. The USB interface on the eZ-FET emulator also allows for UART communication with a PC host, in addition to providing power to Experimenter Board when the power switch is set to 'eZ'. The USCI module in the MSP430F5529 supports the UART protocol that is used to communicate with the TI TUSB3410 device on the eZ-FET emulator for data transfer to the PC. 4.4 MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware Components 4.4.1 Dot-Matrix LCD The EA DOGS102W-6 is a dot-matrix LCD with a resolution of 102x64 pixels. The LCD has a built-in back-light driver that can be controlled by a PWM signal from the MSP430F5529, pin P7.6. The MSP430F5529 communicates with the EA DOGS102W-6 via an SPI-like communication protocol. To supplement the limited set of instructions and functionalities provided by the on-chip LCD driver, an LCD driver has been developed for the MSP430F5529 to support additional functionalities such as font set and graphical utilities. More information on the LCD can be obtained from the manufacturer's data sheet. SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 21 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware www.ti.com 4.4.2 Push Buttons, Potentiometer, and LEDs Table 2 describes the pin connections for the potentiometer, push-button switches, and the on-board LEDs. Table 2. Push Buttons, Potentiometer, and LED Connections Peripheral Pin Connection Potentiometer Wheel P8.0 Switch 1 (S1) P1.7 Switch 2 (S2) P2.2 RESET Switch (S3) RST / NMI LED1 P1.0 LED2 P8.1 LED3 P8.3 Capacitive Touch Pad 1 (Cross) P1.1 Capacitive Touch Pad 2 (Square) P1.2 Capacitive Touch Pad 3 (Octagon) P1.3 Capacitive Touch Pad 4 (Triangle) P1.4 Capacitive Touch Pad 5 (Circle) P1.5 4.4.3 Wireless Evaluation Module Interface Included in the communication peripherals are the headers that support the CC-EM boards from TI. The transceiver modules connect to the USCI of the MSP430F5529 configured in SPI mode using the UCB0 peripheral. Libraries that interface the MSP430 to these transceivers are available at www.ti.com/msp430 under the Code Examples tab. The RF PWR jumper must be populated to provide power to the EM daughterboard. The following radio daughter cards are compatible with the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board: • CC1100EMK/CC1101EMK – Sub-1-GHz radio • CC2500EMK – 2.4-GHz radio • CC2420EMK/CC2430EMK – 2.4-GHz 802.15.4 [SoC] radio • CC2520EMK/CC2530EMK – 2.4-GHz 802.15.4 [SoC] radio • CC2520 + CC2591 EM (if R4 and R8 0-Ω resistors are connected) NOTE: Future evaluation boards may also be compatible with the header connections. 4.4.4 eZ430-RF2500T Interface The eZ430-RF2500T module can be attached to the MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board in one of two ways – through an 18-pin connector (J12 – eZ RF) or a 6-pin connector (J13 – eZ RF Target). The pins on the eZ430-RF2500T headers are multiplexed with the pins on the CC-EM headers, which allows the EZ430-RF2500T module to behave identically to a CC-EM daughterboard. Power must be provided to the EZ430-RF2500T module by setting the jumper RF PWR (JP14). The eZ430-RF2500T connection should always be made with the antenna facing off of the board. For more information on the connections to the required eZ430-RF2500T, see the eZ430-RF2500 Development Tool User's Guide (SLAU227), available through www.ti.com/ez430. 22 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-EXP430F5529 Hardware 4.4.5 Three-Axis Accelerometer The MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board includes a VTI digital three-axis accelerometer (part number CMA3000-D01). The accelerometer supports SPI communication and outputs data for each X, Y and Z axis. The accelerometer is powered through pin P3.6. This interface, especially in conjunction with other on-board interfaces such as the LCD, enables several potential applications such as USB mouse movement emulation and tilt sensing. The example software used the accelerometer for the Tilt Puzzle, Demo Cube, and USB Mouse. For more information on the accelerometer chip, see the manufacturer's data sheet (http://www.vti.fi). 4.4.6 Pin Access Headers The MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Boards includes three headers (J4, J5, and J12) that can be used as additional connections to external hardware or for signal analysis during firmware development. All pins except the GND pin are internally selectable as either general purpose input/output pins or as described in the device datasheet. Table 3. Pinning Mapping for Header J4 Pin Description Port Pin Port Pin Pin Description Vcc VCC P6.6 CB6 / A6 UCA1RXD / UCA1SOMI P4.5 P8.1 GPIO – LED2 UCA1TXD / UCA1SIMO P4.4 P8.2 GPIO – LED3 GPIO P4.6 P8.0 GPIO – POT GPIO P4.7 P4.5 UCA1RXD / UCA1SOMI A9 / VREF- / VeREF- P5.1 P4.4 UCA1TXD / UCA1SIMO GND GND P6.7 CB7 / A7 Table 4. Pin Mapping for Header J5 Pin Description Port Pin Port Pin Pin Description VCC VCC P7.0 CB8 / A12 UCB1SOMI / UCB1SCL - SD P4.2 P7.1 CB9 / A13 UCB1SIMO / UCB1SDA - LCD/SD P4.1 P7.2 CB10 / A14 UCB1CLK / UCA1STE - LCD/SD P4.3 P7.3 CB11 / A15 UCB1STE / UCA1CLK - RF P4.0 P4.1 UCB1SIMO / UCB1SDA - LCD/SD TB0OUTH / SVMOUT - SD P3.7 P4.2 UCB1SOMI / UCB1SCL - SD GND GND P7.7 TB0CLK / MCLK Table 5. Pin Mapping for Header J12 Pin Description Port Pin Port Pin Pin Description (RF_STE) P2.6 P3.0 (RF_SIMO) (RF_SOMI) P3.1 P3.2 (RF_SPI_CLK) TA2.0 P2.3 P2.1 TA1.2 TB0.3 P7.5 GND GND GPIO P4.7 P2.4 TA2.1 (RXD) P4.5 P4.6 GPIO (TXD) P4.4 P4.0 UCx1xx (LED1) P1.0 P2.0 TA1.1 GND GND RF_PWR RF_PWR SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 23 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics www.ti.com 5 Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics 5.1 Frequently Asked Questions 1. Which devices can be programmed with the Experimenter Board? The MSP-EXP430F5529 board is designed specifically to demonstrate the MSP430F5529. 2. The MSP430F5529 is no longer accessible via JTAG. Is something wrong with the device? Verify that the jumpers are configured correctly. See Section 4 for jumper configuration. Verify that the target device is powered properly. If the target is powered locally, verify that the supplied VCC is sufficient to power the board. Check the device data sheet for the specification. 3. I did every step in the previous question but still could not use or communicate with the device. Improper programming of the device could lead to a JTAG total lockup condition. The cause of this problem might be an incorrect device selection when creating a new project in CCS (select MSP430F5529) or programming the device without a stable power source (low battery, switching the Power Selector while programming, or absence of the MSP430 power jumper JP6 during programming). To solve this, completely reset the device. First unplug all power sources and connections (JTAG and USB cables). Set the Power Selector Switch to FET mode. Use a jumper cable to briefly short one of the GND test points with the 430 PWR test point. The device should now be released from the lockup state. 4. Does the Experimenter board protect against blowing the JTAG fuse of the target device? No. Fuse blow capability is inherent to all flash-based MSP430 devices to protect user's intellectual property. Care must be taken to avoid the enabling of the fuse blow option during programming, because blowing the fuse would prevent further access to the MSP430 device via JTAG. 5. I am measuring system current in the range of 30 mA, is this normal? The LCD and the LCD backlight require a large amount of current (approximately 20 mA to 25 mA) to operate. This results in a total system current consumption in the range of 30 mA. If the LCD backlight is on, 30 mA is considered normal. To ensure the board is OK, disable the LCD and the LCD backlight and measure the current again. The entire board current consumption should not exceed 10 mA at this state. Note that the current consumption of the board could vary greatly depending on the optimization of the board configurations and the applications. The expected current consumption for the MSP430F5529 in standby mode (LPM3), for example, is ~2 μA. Operating at 1 MHz, the total current consumption should not exceed ~280 μA. 6. I have trouble reading the LCD clearly. Why is the LCD contrast setting so low? The LCD contrast is highly dependent on the voltage of the system. Changing power source from USB (3.3 V) to batteries (~3 V) could drastically reduce the contrast. Fortunately, the LCD driver supports adjustable contrast. The specific instruction can be found in the LCD user's guide. The MSP-EXP430F5529 software also provides the function to adjust the contrast using the wheel (see Section 2.8). 7. When I run the example code, nothing happens on the LCD. Verify that all jumpers are installed correctly and the 14-pin JTAG cable are properly connected. 5.2 References • MSP430x5xx/MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208) • Code Composer Studio (CCStudio) Integrated Development Environment (IDE) (http://focus.ti.com/docs/toolsw/folders/print/msp-ccstudio.html) • MSP430 Interface to CC1100/2500 Code Library (PDF: SLAA325) (Associated Files: SLAA325.ZIP) 24 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics 5.3 Schematics and BOM The following pages show the schematics and BOM. In addition, the original Eagle CAD schematics and Gerber files are available for download (SLAR055). Figure 10. Schematics (1 of 7) SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 25 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics www.ti.com Figure 11. Schematics (2 of 7) 26 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics Figure 12. Schematics (3 of 7) SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 27 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics www.ti.com Figure 13. Schematics (4 of 7) 28 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics Figure 14. Schematics (5 of 7) SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 29 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics www.ti.com Figure 15. Schematics (6 of 7) 30 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics Figure 16. Schematics (7 of 7) SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 31 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics www.ti.com Table 6. Bill of Materials Part Value Package Type Device C1 47pF 0805 C2 12pF 0805 C3 DNP 0603 C4 12pF 0805 C5 10μF 0805 C6 47pF 0805 C7 100nF 0805 C8 220n 0603 C9 220n 0603 C10 10uF/6,3V 1210 C11 100n 0603 C12 100n 0805 C13 100n 0805 C14 DNP 0603 C15 10uF/6,3V 1210 C16 100n 0805 C17 470n 0805 C18 10μF 0805 C19 100nF 0805 C20 .1u 0603 C21 .1u 0603 C22 1μF 0805 C23 1μF 0805 C24 1μF 0805 C25 1μF 0805 C26 1μF 0805 C27 1μF 0805 C28 4.7uF 0805 C29 10nF 0805 C30 1μF 0805 C31 .1u 0603 C32 4.7u 0805 C33 0.1u 0603 C34 4u7 0603 C35 10p 0603 C36 10p 0603 C37 10n 0402 C38 33p 0402 C39 33p 0402 C40 1u/6.3V 0603 C41 100n 0402 C42 1u/6.3V 0603 C43 100n 0402 C44 1u/6.3V 0603 C45 22p 0402 C46 22p 0402 C47 100n 0402 C48 100n 0402 C49 100n 0402 C50 10uF/6,3V 1210 CON1 8PIN_SM_MA_HEADER HEADER 2x4 MALE .1" SMD CON2 8PIN_SM_MA_HEADER HEADER 2x4 MALE .1" SMD 32 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics Table 6. Bill of Materials (continued) Part Value Package Type Device CON3 8PIN_SM_MA_HEADER HEADER 2x4 MALE .1" SMD D1 LLSD103A-7 Mini MELF D2 1N4148 Micro MELF SOD110-R J1 103308-2 14-Pin Male JTAG Connector JP2 POT_JMP HEADER 1x2 MALE .1" TH JP1E\SMALL_PIN JP3 LED_JMP HEADER 1x2 MALE .1" TH JP1E\SMALL_PIN J4 HEADER - F5529 PIN ACCESS HEADER 2x7 MALE .1" TH J5 HEADER - F5529 PIN ACCESS HEADER 2x7 MALE .1" TH JP6 430_PWR HEADER 1x2 MALE .1" TH JP1E JP7 SYS_PWR HEADER 1x2 MALE .1" TH JP1E JP8 LDO_PWR_SEL HEADER 1x3 MALE .1" TH PINHD-1X3/SMALL_PIN J9 22-03-5035 MOLEX 3-PIN MALE HEADER 22-03-5035 J10 HEADER - PWR HEADER 1x3 MALE .1" TH PINHD-1X3 JP11 JTAG_PWR_SEN HEADER 1x3 MALE .1" TH PINHD-1X3/SMALL_PIN J12 eZ-RF1 HEADER - RF2500 HEADER 2x9 MALE .1" TH J13 6-Pin Male eZ430 Connector 6-Pin Male eZ430 Connector SL127L6TH JP14 RF_PWR HEADER 1x2 MALE .1" TH JP1E JP15 USB_PWR HEADER 1x2 MALE .1" TH JP1E JP16 eZ430-FET_JMP HEADER 2x5 MALE .1" TH JP5Q J17 6-Pin Male eZ430 Connector 6-Pin Male eZ430 Connector SL127L6TH LED1 LEDCHIPLED_0603 0603 LEDCHIPLED_0603 LED2 LEDCHIPLED_0603 0603 LEDCHIPLED_0603 LED3 LEDCHIPLED_0603 0603 LEDCHIPLED_0603 LED4 OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED 0805 (Surface Mount Bottom) OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED LED5 OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED 0805 (Surface Mount Bottom) OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED LED6 OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED 0805 (Surface Mount Bottom) OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED LED7 OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED 0805 (Surface Mount Bottom) OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED LED8 OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED 0805 (Surface Mount Bottom) OSRAM TOPLED Santana Blue LED LED9 LEDCHIPLED_0603 0603 LED_0603D0603 PAD1 CAP_TOUCH_PAD CAP_TOUCH_PAD PROJECT7264_CC430_PAD PAD2 CAP_TOUCH_PAD CAP_TOUCH_PAD PROJECT7264_CC430_PAD PAD3 CAP_TOUCH_PAD CAP_TOUCH_PAD PROJECT7264_CC430_PAD PAD4 CAP_TOUCH_PAD CAP_TOUCH_PAD PROJECT7264_CC430_PAD PAD5 CAP_TOUCH_PAD CAP_TOUCH_PAD PROJECT7264_CC430_PAD POT1 EVL-HFKA05B54 POT EVL-HFKA05B54 Q1 MS3V-T1R 32.768kHz CL Clock Crystal 32kHz F20XX_PIR_DEMO_&_EVAL_CM200T Q2 SMD Oscillator 4MHz SMD Oscillator 4MHz QUARZ_HC49_4P-1 Q3 SMD Oscillator 12MHz SMD Oscillator 12MHz XTL_FT7AFT10A R1 47k 0603 R-US_R0603 R2 0R 0603 R-US_R0603 R3 470R 0603 R-US_R0603 R4 470R 0603 R-US_R0603 R5 470R 0603 R-US_R0603 R6 47k 0603 R-US_R0603 R7 680 0805 RES0805 R8 680 0805 RES0805 R9 680 0805 RES0805 R10 680 0805 RES0805 R11 680 0805 RES0805 R12 100K 0603 R-US_R0603 R13 100k 0603 R-US_R0603 SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 33 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics www.ti.com Table 6. Bill of Materials (continued) Part Value Package Type Device R14 100k 0603 R-US_R0603 R15 100K 0603 R-US_R0603 R16 100k 0603 R-US_R0603 R17 47k 0603 R-US_R0603 R18 47k 0603 R-US_R0603 R19 0 0603 R-US_R0603 R20 100k 0603 R-US_R0603 R21 36k 1% 0603 R-US_R0603 R22 27R 0603 R-US_R0603 R23 27R 0603 R-US_R0603 R24 1M 0603 R-US_R0603 R25 1k4 0603 R-US_R0603 R26 100R 0603 R-US_R0603 R27 33k 0603 R-US_R0603 R28 47k 0402 R_SMDR0402 R29 47k 0402 R_SMDR0402 R30 47k 0402 R_SMDR0402 R31 100R 0402 R_SMDR0402 R32 100R 0402 R_SMDR0402 R33 270 0402 R_SMDR0402 R34 DNP 0402 R_SMDR0402 R35 100R 0402 R_SMDR0402 R36 100R 0402 R_SMDR0402 R37 6k8 0402 R_SMDR0402 R38 3k3 0402 R_SMDR0402 R39 10k 0402 R_SMDR0402 R40 15k 0402 R_SMDR0402 R41 33k 0402 R_SMDR0402 R42 1k5 0402 R_SMDR0402 R43 33R 0402 R_SMDR0402 R44 DNP (47k) 0402 R_SMDR0402 R45 DNP (47k) 0402 R_SMDR0402 R46 33R 0402 R_SMDR0402 R47 100k/1% 0402 R_SMDR0402 R48 33k 0402 R_SMDR0402 R49 3k3 0402 R_SMDR0402 R50 100k/1% 0402 R_SMDR0402 R51 3k3 0402 R_SMDR0402 R52 100R 0402 R_SMDR0402 R53 1k5 0402 R_SMDR0402 R54 1k5 0402 R_SMDR0402 RF1 CCxxxx RF EVM HEADER CCXXXX_20PIN TFM-110-02-SM-D-A-K RF2 CCxxxx RF EVM HEADER CCXXXX_20PIN TFM-110-02-SM-D-A-K S1 USER1 PUSHBUTTON BUTTON EVQ-11L05R S2 USER2 PUSHBUTTON BUTTON EVQ-11L05R S3 F5529 RESET PUSHBUTTON BUTTON EVQ-11L05R S4 F5529 USB BSL PUSHBUTTON BUTTON EVQ-11L05R SW1 POWER SELECT SWITCH DP3T_SWITCH JS203011CQN TP1 F5529 VREF+ TEST POINT TEST_POINT - TP2 F5529 VCORE TEST POINT TEST_POINT - TP3 CC430 EM TEST POINT TEST_POINT - 34 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Frequently Asked Questions, References, and Schematics Table 6. Bill of Materials (continued) Part Value Package Type Device TP4 CC430 EM TEST POINT TEST_POINT - TP5 CC430 EM TEST POINT TEST_POINT - TP6 CC430 EM TEST POINT TEST_POINT - TP7 CC430 EM TEST POINT TEST_POINT - TP8 CC430 EM TEST POINT TEST_POINT - TP9 eZ430 F16x TEST POINT (EZ_VBUS) TEST_POINT - TP10 eZ430 F16x TEST POINT (RESET) TEST_POINT - TP11 eZ430 F16x TEST POINT (GND) TEST_POINT - TP12 eZ430 F16x TEST POINT (HTCK) TEST_POINT - TP13 eZ430 F16x TEST POINT (HTMS) TEST_POINT - TP14 eZ430 F16x TEST POINT (HTDI) TEST_POINT - TP15 eZ430 F16x TEST POINT (HTDO) TEST_POINT - U1 F5529 - MSP430F5529 80-LQFP MSP430F5529IPNR U2 3-AXIS SPI/I2C ACCELEROMETER SMD CMA3000 CMA3000-D01 U3 102x64 LCD DISPLAY EA DOGS102-6 EA DOGS102-6 U3 LED BACKLIGHT EA DOGS102-6 EA LED39x41-W U4 Alternate LDO - TPS73533 SC70-5 TPS73533DRBT U5 LED Backlight Current Source - TPS75105 SON-10 TPS75105DSKR U6 F5529 USB ESD Protection - TPD2E001 SOT-5 TPD2E001DRLR U7 eZ430 - MSP430F16x 64-LQFP MSP430F1612IPMR U8 eZ430 Level Translator - TXS0104E 14-TSSOP TXS0104EPWR U9 eZ430 LDO - TPS77301 8-MSOP TPS77301DGK U10 eZ430 - TUSB3410 32-LQFP TUSB3410VF U11 eZ430 USB ESD Protection - TPD2E001 SOT-5 TPD2E001DRLR U12 eZ430 EEPROM - CAT24C128YI 8-TSSOP CAT24C128YI USB1 F5529 USB Mini-USB Through Hole 54819-0519 USB2 eZ430 USB Mini-USB Through Hole 54819-0519 X1 microSD Card Holder microSD Card Holder 502702-0891 SLAU330A–May 2011–Revised June 2011 MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board 35 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, modifications, enhancements, improvements, and other changes to its products and services at any time and to discontinue any product or service without notice. Customers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All products are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its hardware products to the specifications applicable at the time of sale in accordance with TI’s standard warranty. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by government requirements, testing of all parameters of each product is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or customer product design. Customers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with customer products and applications, customers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any TI patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other TI intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI products or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license from TI to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. Reproduction of this information with alteration is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI products or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that product or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI product or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. TI products are not authorized for use in safety-critical applications (such as life support) where a failure of the TI product would reasonably be expected to cause severe personal injury or death, unless officers of the parties have executed an agreement specifically governing such use. Buyers represent that they have all necessary expertise in the safety and regulatory ramifications of their applications, and acknowledge and agree that they are solely responsible for all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning their products and any use of TI products in such safety-critical applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Further, Buyers must fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of TI products in such safety-critical applications. TI products are neither designed nor intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments unless the TI products are specifically designated by TI as military-grade or "enhanced plastic." Only products designated by TI as military-grade meet military specifications. Buyers acknowledge and agree that any such use of TI products which TI has not designated as military-grade is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that they are solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI products are neither designed nor intended for use in automotive applications or environments unless the specific TI products are designated by TI as compliant with ISO/TS 16949 requirements. Buyers acknowledge and agree that, if they use any non-designated products in automotive applications, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet such requirements. Following are URLs where you can obtain information on other Texas Instruments products and application solutions: Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DLP® Products www.dlp.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy DSP dsp.ti.com Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Medical www.ti.com/medical Interface interface.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Logic logic.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Power Mgmt power.ti.com Transportation and www.ti.com/automotive Automotive Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com Wireless www.ti.com/wireless-apps RF/IF and ZigBee® Solutions www.ti.com/lprf TI E2E Community Home Page e2e.ti.com Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2011, Texas Instruments Incorporated STK525 ............................................................................................. Hardware User Guide STK525 Hardware User Guide User Guide 1 7608A–AVR–04/06 Section 1 Introduction ........................................................................................... 1-3 1.1 Overview ...................................................................................................1-3 1.2 STK525 Starter Kit Features .....................................................................1-4 Section 2 Using the STK525................................................................................. 2-6 2.1 Overview ...................................................................................................2-6 2.2 Power Supply ............................................................................................2-7 2.3 RESET ....................................................................................................2-10 2.4 AT90USBxxx AVR Microcontroller..........................................................2-11 2.5 Serial Links .............................................................................................2-11 2.6 On-board Resources...............................................................................2-14 2.7 STK500 Resources .................................................................................2-19 2.8 In-System Programming .........................................................................2-20 2.10 Test Points ..............................................................................................2-23 2.11 Configuration Pads .................................................................................2-24 2.12 Solder Pads ............................................................................................2-25 Section 3 Troubleshooting Guide ....................................................................... 3-26 Section 4 Technical Specifications ..................................................................... 4-27 Section 5 Technical Support............................................................................... 5-28 Section 6 Complete Schematics......................................................................... 6-29 STK525 Hardware User Guide 1-3 7608A–AVR–04/06 Section 1 Introduction Congratulation for acquiring the AVR® STK525 Starter Kit. This kit is designed to give designers a quick start to develop code on the AT90USBxxx and for prototyping and testing of new designs. 1.1 Overview This document describes the STK525 dedicated to the AT90USBxxx AVR microcontroller. This board is designed to allow an easy evaluation of the product using demonstration software. To complement the evaluation and enable additional development capability, the STK525 can be plugged into the Atmel STK500 Starter Kit Board in order to use the AT90USBxxx with advanced features such as variable VCC, variable VRef, variable XTAL, etc. and supports all AVR development tools. To increase its demonstrative capabilities, this stand alone board has numerous onboard resources (USB, RS232, joystick, data-flash, microphone and temperature sensor). This user guide acts as a general getting started guide as well as a complete technical reference for advanced users. Introduction 1-4 STK525 Hardware User Guide 7608A–AVR–04/06 Figure 1-1 . STK525 Board 1.2 STK525 Starter Kit Features The STK525 provides the following features: 􀀀 AT90USBxxx TQFP device (2.7V 1.0 STK500 Expand connectors A4 Tuesday , January 17, 2006 2 4 STKNC Important: Def ault conf iguration: open reserv ed f or f uture mass storage extension 3.3V SP3 STK525 MEZZANINE FOR STK500 NRST STKNC VTG XTAL1 PA0 R8 2k PB7 PB3 PB5 PD5 PD7 PB1 PB6 PD1 PD3 PB2 PB4 PD6 PB0 PD2 PD4 C12 1nF PD0 1 2 AREF JP3 STK AREF VTG REF XT1 XT2 PE[2..0] VTG VTG PE[2..0] VTG PC[7..0] PC[7..0] PB[7..0] PD[7..0] PA[7..0] PA[7..0] PA5 PA7 PA6 PA1 PA3 PA4 1 2 JP1 STK X1 PA2 1 2 JP2 STK X2 PB[7..0] Complete Schematics STK525 Hardware User Guide 6-33 7608A–AVR–04/06 Figure 6-3 . Schematics, 3 of 5 Data Flash 3.3V LEDs 3.3V PF[7..0] DECOUPLING CAPACITOR CLOSE TO THE CONNECTOR R19 POT 100k Select 5 Lef t 7 Up 3 Right 6 Down 4 Com1 1 Com2 2 SW3 TPA511G PF[7..0] Temp Sensor PB[7..0] R18 NCP18WF104J03RB 5 9 4 8 3 7 2 6 1 10 11 P1 SUB-D9 FEMALE RS232 1234 J7 PF Spare (Not mounted) RS232 Interface JTAG Interface RS-CTS 3.3V Serial ISP Interface PE[7..0] CP1 VCC R16 100k STK525 MEZZANINE FOR STK500 3.3V VCC BUSY 1 RESET 2 WP 3 VCC 6 GND 7 CS 11 SCK 12 SI 13 SO 14 U2 AT45DB321C TSOP28 Microphone Preamplifier Interface PF0 VCC PB[7..0] CTS Title Size Document Number Rev Date: Sheet of 1.0 Interf aces A4 Tuesday , January 17, 2006 3 4 C20 100nF RTS CP2 R23 100k . 11 . 12 . 10 . 9 . 8 . 7 . 13 . 14 . 15 . 16 C1+ 1 V+ 2 C1- 3 C2+ 4 C2- 5 V- 6 TTL RS 232 GND VCC U3 MAX3232 RS232 BUFFER C17 100nF C16 100nF C18 100nF PF1 C19 100nF PD2 RxD DECOUPLING CAPACITOR CLOSE TO THE DEVICE RS-TxD RS-RxD PD[7..0] VCC PF0 1 TP4 Mic VCC DECOUPLING CAPACITOR CLOSE TO THE DEVICE C15 100nF PF1 SP4 PF2 SP5 VCC Caution DataFlash Fix 3V Power supply Only PF3 PB[7..0] C26 100nF RESET R11 100k CP3 DECOUPLING CAPACITOR CLOSE TO THE CONNECTOR PB5 PDO 1 VCC 2 SCK 3 PDI 4 RESET 5 GND 6 CON 2x3 J5 ISP CON TCK 1 GND 2 TDO 3 VCC 4 TMS 5 RESET 6 VCC 7 n.c. 8 TDI 9 GND 10 CON 2x5 J4 JTAG CON C21 100nF C23 100nF PD1 PF4 PF6 PF7 PF5 RESET PB1 R17 0 PB2 PB3 3.3V PB6 PD0 VCC PD3 TXD SP7 PB7 5 6 7 8 4 + - U4B LMV358 3 2 1 8 4 + - U4A LMV358 R27 0 R26 22k R25 10k R24 100k PB4 + C25 1uF R21 100k R28 100k C22 220pF + C24 4.7uF 3.3V R20 2.2k MIC1 MICROPHONE R22 100k DECOUPLING CAPACITOR CLOSE TO THE DEVICE PE4 PB1 R10 100k PF2 In-line Grouped LEDs RESET TOPLED LP M676 D2 LED 0 (green) TOPLED LP M676 D3 LED 1 (green) TOPLED LP M676 D4 LED 2 (green) TOPLED LP M676 D5 LED 3 (green) PB2 1k R12 1k R13 PE5 1k R14 1k R15 PD4 PB3 PD5 PD7 PD[7..0] PD6 SP8 RS-RTS Joystick Interface Complete Schematics 6-34 STK525 Hardware User Guide 7608A–AVR–04/06 Figure 6-4 . Schematics, 4 of 5 - C30 4.7uF VTG IN GND OUT U8 LM340 VBUS generator f or OTG/HOST mode 1F 1.0 POWER A4 Tuesday , January 17, 2006 4 4 5V C32 220nF 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 JP6 VCC Source VCC - C34 4.7uF 2 1 3 JP7 VBUS gen D6 LL4148 R32 10k R35 100k 1% 3 1 4 2 - + U7 DF005S 321 J6 CONNECTOR JACK PWR Ext Power Supply C33 100nF C29 33nF UVCON VBUS OUT 1 IN 2 GND 3 OUT 4 FAULT SHDN 8 7 CC 6 SET 5 U6 LP3982 Complete Schematics STK525 Hardware User Guide 6-35 7608A–AVR–04/06 Figure 6-5 . Assembly Drawing, 1 of 2 (component side) Figure 6-6 . Assembly Drawing, 2 of 2 (solder side) Complete Schematics 6-36 STK525 Hardware User Guide 7608A–AVR–04/06 Table 6-1 . Bill of material Item Q.ty Reference Part Tech. Characteristics Package 1 2 CR1,CR2 PGB0010603 ESD protection CASE 0805 2 19 C1,C2,C3,C4,C5,C6,C13,C14,C15,C16,C 17,C18,C19,C20,C21,C23,C26,C27,C33 100nF 50V-10% Ceramic CASE 0805 3 2 C7,C25 1uF 10Vmin ±10% EIA/IECQ 3216 4 3 C8,C9,C32 220nF 50V-10% Ceramic CASE 0805 5 2 C10,C11 15pF 50V-5% Ceramic CASE 0805 6 1 C12 1nF 50V-5% Ceramic CASE 0805 7 1 C22 220pF 50V-5% Ceramic CASE 0805 8 5 C24,C28,C30,C31,C34 4.7uF 10Vmin ±10% EIA/IECQ 3216 9 1 C29 33nF 50V-5% Ceramic CASE 0805 10 3 CP1, CP2, CP3 Configuration Pad 11 1 D1 BAT54/SOT Vf=0.3V SOT23 12 5 D2,D3,D4,D5,D8 TOPLED LP M676 Green I=10 mA_ PLCC-2 13 2 D6,D7 LL4148 i=200mA max LL-34 14 5 JP1,JP2,JP3,JP4,JP5 JUMPER 1x2 Need 1 shunt 0,1" pitch 15 1 J1 USB_MiniABF USB mini AB receptacle Surface mount 16 2 J2,J3 CON 2x20 17 1 J4 CON 2x5 18 1 J5 CON 2x3 19 1 J7 CON 2x2 Not Mounted 20 1 JP6 JUMPER 2x4 Need 1 shunt 0,1" pitch 21 1 J6 CONNECTOR JACK PWR Int.Diam=2.1mm PCB Embase 22 1 JP7 JUMPER 3x1 23 1 L1 BLM-21A102S FERRITE BEAD 1 KOhms at 100 MHz CASE 0805 24 1 MIC1 MICROPHONE Electret Cap Mic 25 1 M1 FDV304P/FAI MOSFET P SOT23 26 1 P1 SUB-D9 FEMALE 90° with harpoons 27 2 Q1,Q2 BC847B NPN IC peak=200mA SOT23 28 2 R1,R2 22 1/16W-5% SMD CASE 0602 29 2 R3,R5 47k 1/16W-5% SMD CASE 0603 30 5 R4,R6,R7,R17,R27 0 CASE 0603 31 1 R8 2k CASE 0604 32 4 R9,R25,R29,R32 10k 1/16W-5% SMD CASE 0603 Complete Schematics STK525 Hardware User Guide 6-37 7608A–AVR–04/06 6.0.1 Default Configuration - Summary Table 6-2 . Default Configuration summary 33 9 R10,R11,R16,R21,R22,R23,R24,R28,R33 100k 1/16W-5% SMD CASE 0603 34 5 R12,R13,R14,R15,R34 1k 1/16W-5% SMD CASE 0603 35 1 R18 NCP18WF104J03RB 100K - ß=4250 CASE 0603 36 1 R19 POT 100k PT10MH104ME 37 1 R19 Button Pot Button 38 1 R20 2.2k 1/16W-5% SMD CASE 0603 39 1 R26 22k 1/16W-5% SMD CASE 0603 40 1 R30, R35 100k 1% 1/16W-1% SMD CASE 0603 41 1 R31 120k 1% 1/16W-1% SMD CASE 0603 42 6 SP1,SP2,SP3,SP4,SP5,SP6 SolderPad (NA) (NA) 43 2 SW1,SW2 PUSH-BUTTON 6x3.5mm - 1.6N 44 1 SW3 TPA511G 4+1 ways joystick CMS 45 8 TP1,TP2,TP3,TP4,TP5,TP6, TP7, TP8 TEST POINT Diam.=1.32mm 46 1 U1 AT90USBxxx TQFP64 47 1 U1 Socket TQFP64 ZIF 48 1 U2 AT45DB321C TSOP28 49 1 U3 MAX3232ECAE+ SSOP16 50 1 U4 LMV358 SO8 51 1 U5 TPS2041A SOIC8 52 1 U6 LP3982 Low Drop Out Vin Max 6V, 300mA MSOP8 53 1 U7 DF005S Bridge rectifier See DS 54 1 U8 LM340 Reg 5V CMS SOT223 55 1 Y1 8MHz CRYSTAL H=4mm HC49/4H Item Q.ty Reference Part Tech. Characteristics Package Name Ref. Function State Jumpers STKX1 JP1 XTAL Configuration OFF STKX2 JP2 XTAL Configuration OFF Aref JP3 STK500 Analog Ref OFF VTG33 JP4 Short 3.3V to VTG (Mass storage extension board) OFF UCAP JP5 Short UCAP with Uvcc OFF Vcc Src JP6 Vcc Selection 3.4 shorted Vbus Gen JP7 VBUS generation selection (host mode) 2.3 shorted Solder PADS Complete Schematics 6-38 STK525 Hardware User Guide 7608A–AVR–04/06 SP1 Bypass L1 OPEN SP2 OPEN SP3 3.3V on Expand 0 NC pin OPEN SP4 CTS OPEN SP5 RTS OPEN SP6 Bypass limiter OPEN SP7 RS232 hardware control enable OPEN SP8 RS232 hardware control enable OPEN Configuration PADS CP1 Bypass CTN in on PF0 CLOSE CP2 Bypass Potentiometer ADC in on PF1 CLOSE CP3 Bypass Mic In on PF2 CLOSE Name Ref. Function State Printed on recycled paper. 7608A–AVR–04/06 /xM © Atmel Corporation 2006. All rights reserved. Atmel®, logo and combinations thereof, are registered trademarks, and Everywhere You Are® are the trademarks of Atmel Corporation or its subsidiaries. Other terms and product names may be trademarks of others. Disclaimer: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise,to anyintellectualproperty right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN ATMEL’S TERMS AND CONDI-TIONS OF SALE LOCATED ON ATMEL’S WEB SITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORYWARRANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULARPURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDEN-TAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUTOF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Atmel makes norepresentationsor warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specificationsand product descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein. Unless specifically provided otherwise, Atmel products are not suitable for, and shall not be used in, automotive applications. Atmel’s products are not intended, authorized, or warranted for useas components in applications intended to support or sustainlife. Atmel Corporation Atmel Operations 2325 Orchard Parkway San Jose, CA 95131, USA Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 Fax: 1(408) 487-2600 Regional Headquarters Europe Atmel Sarl Route des Arsenaux 41 Case Postale 80 CH-1705 Fribourg Switzerland Tel: (41) 26-426-5555 Fax: (41) 26-426-5500 Asia Room 1219 Chinachem Golden Plaza 77 Mody Road Tsimshatsui East Kowloon Hong Kong Tel: (852) 2721-9778 Fax: (852) 2722-1369 Japan 9F, Tonetsu Shinkawa Bldg. 1-24-8 Shinkawa Chuo-ku, Tokyo 104-0033 Japan Tel: (81) 3-3523-3551 Fax: (81) 3-3523-7581 Memory 2325 Orchard Parkway San Jose, CA 95131, USA Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 Fax: 1(408) 436-4314 Microcontrollers 2325 Orchard Parkway San Jose, CA 95131, USA Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 Fax: 1(408) 436-4314 La Chantrerie BP 70602 44306 Nantes Cedex 3, France Tel: (33) 2-40-18-18-18 Fax: (33) 2-40-18-19-60 ASIC/ASSP/Smart Cards Zone Industrielle 13106 Rousset Cedex, France Tel: (33) 4-42-53-60-00 Fax: (33) 4-42-53-60-01 1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd. Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA Tel: 1(719) 576-3300 Fax: 1(719) 540-1759 Scottish Enterprise Technology Park Maxwell Building East Kilbride G75 0QR, Scotland Tel: (44) 1355-803-000 Fax: (44) 1355-242-743 RF/Automotive Theresienstrasse 2 Postfach 3535 74025 Heilbronn, Germany Tel: (49) 71-31-67-0 Fax: (49) 71-31-67-2340 1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd. Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA Tel: 1(719) 576-3300 Fax: 1(719) 540-1759 Biometrics/Imaging/Hi-Rel MPU/ High Speed Converters/RF Datacom Avenue de Rochepleine BP 123 38521 Saint-Egreve Cedex, France Tel: (33) 4-76-58-30-00 Fax: (33) 4-76-58-34-80 Literature Requests www.atmel.com/literature MSP430 Hardware Tools User's Guide Literature Number: SLAU278R May 2009–Revised May 2014 Contents Preface ........................................................................................................................................ 8 1 Get Started Now!................................................................................................................ 11 1.1 Flash Emulation Tool (FET) Overview................................................................................... 12 1.2 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430PIF........................................................................................... 13 1.3 Kit Contents, eZ430-F2013 ............................................................................................... 13 1.4 Kit Contents, eZ430-T2012 ............................................................................................... 13 1.5 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500 ............................................................................................. 13 1.6 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500T............................................................................................ 13 1.7 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500-SEH....................................................................................... 13 1.8 Kit Contents, eZ430-Chronos-xxx........................................................................................ 14 1.9 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430UIF........................................................................................... 14 1.10 Kit Contents, MSP-FET.................................................................................................... 14 1.11 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430xx ............................................................................................ 14 1.12 Kit Contents, FET430F6137RF900 ...................................................................................... 15 1.13 Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx .............................................................................................. 15 1.14 Kit Contents, EM430Fx1x7RF900 ....................................................................................... 17 1.15 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430PIF ................................................................................ 17 1.16 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430UIF ................................................................................ 18 1.17 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET ......................................................................................... 18 1.18 Hardware Installation, eZ430-XXXX, MSP-EXP430G2, MSP-EXP430FR5739, MSP-EXP430F5529.......... 18 1.19 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430Uxx, MSP-TS430xxx, FET430F6137RF900, EM430Fx137RF900 ....... 19 1.20 Important MSP430 Documents on the Web ............................................................................ 20 2 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming ................................................................ 21 2.1 Signal Connections for In-System Programming and Debugging ................................................... 22 2.2 External Power ............................................................................................................. 26 2.3 Bootstrap Loader (BSL) ................................................................................................... 26 A Frequently Asked Questions and Known Issues .................................................................... 27 A.1 Hardware FAQs ............................................................................................................ 28 A.2 Known Issues ............................................................................................................... 30 B Hardware........................................................................................................................... 31 B.1 MSP-TS430D8.............................................................................................................. 33 B.2 MSP-TS430PW14.......................................................................................................... 36 B.3 MSP-TS430L092 ........................................................................................................... 39 B.4 MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable ........................................................................................... 42 B.5 MSP-TS430PW24.......................................................................................................... 45 B.6 MSP-TS430DW28.......................................................................................................... 48 B.7 MSP-TS430PW28.......................................................................................................... 51 B.8 MSP-TS430PW28A........................................................................................................ 54 B.9 MSP-TS430RHB32A....................................................................................................... 57 B.10 MSP-TS430DA38 .......................................................................................................... 60 B.11 MSP-TS430QFN23x0...................................................................................................... 63 B.12 MSP-TS430RSB40......................................................................................................... 66 B.13 MSP-TS430RHA40A....................................................................................................... 69 B.14 MSP-TS430DL48........................................................................................................... 72 2 Contents SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com B.15 MSP-TS430RGZ48B....................................................................................................... 75 B.16 MSP-TS430RGZ48C ...................................................................................................... 78 B.17 MSP-TS430PM64 .......................................................................................................... 81 B.18 MSP-TS430PM64A ........................................................................................................ 84 B.19 MSP-TS430RGC64B ...................................................................................................... 87 B.20 MSP-TS430RGC64C ...................................................................................................... 90 B.21 MSP-TS430RGC64USB................................................................................................... 94 B.22 MSP-TS430PN80 .......................................................................................................... 98 B.23 MSP-TS430PN80A ....................................................................................................... 101 B.24 MSP-TS430PN80USB ................................................................................................... 104 B.25 MSP-TS430PZ100........................................................................................................ 108 B.26 MSP-TS430PZ100A...................................................................................................... 111 B.27 MSP-TS430PZ100B...................................................................................................... 114 B.28 MSP-TS430PZ100C...................................................................................................... 117 B.29 MSP-TS430PZ100D...................................................................................................... 121 B.30 MSP-TS430PZ5x100..................................................................................................... 124 B.31 MSP-TS430PZ100USB .................................................................................................. 127 B.32 MSP-TS430PEU128...................................................................................................... 131 B.33 EM430F5137RF900 ...................................................................................................... 134 B.34 EM430F6137RF900 ...................................................................................................... 138 B.35 EM430F6147RF900 ...................................................................................................... 142 B.36 MSP-FET .................................................................................................................. 146 B.36.1 Features ......................................................................................................... 146 B.36.2 Release Notes .................................................................................................. 146 B.36.3 Schematics ...................................................................................................... 148 B.36.4 Layout............................................................................................................ 153 B.36.5 LED Signals ..................................................................................................... 153 B.36.6 JTAG Target Connector ....................................................................................... 154 B.36.7 Specifications ................................................................................................... 156 B.36.8 MSP-FET Revision History.................................................................................... 156 B.37 MSP-FET430PIF.......................................................................................................... 157 B.38 MSP-FET430UIF.......................................................................................................... 159 B.38.1 MSP-FET430UIF Revision History ........................................................................... 164 C Hardware Installation Guide ............................................................................................... 165 C.1 Hardware Installation ..................................................................................................... 166 Revision History ........................................................................................................................ 171 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Contents 3 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com List of Figures 2-1. Signal Connections for 4-Wire JTAG Communication................................................................. 23 2-2. Signal Connections for 2-Wire JTAG Communication (Spy-Bi-Wire) Used by MSP430F2xx, MSP430G2xx, and MSP430F4xx Devices.............................................................................. 24 2-3. Signal Connections for 2-Wire JTAG Communication (Spy-Bi-Wire) Used by MSP430F5xx and MSP430F6xx Devices ..................................................................................................... 25 B-1. MSP-TS430D8 Target Socket Module, Schematic .................................................................... 33 B-2. MSP-TS430D8 Target Socket Module, PCB ........................................................................... 34 B-3. MSP-TS430PW14 Target Socket Module, Schematic ................................................................ 36 B-4. MSP-TS430PW14 Target Socket Module, PCB ....................................................................... 37 B-5. MSP-TS430L092 Target Socket Module, Schematic.................................................................. 39 B-6. MSP-TS430L092 Target Socket Module, PCB......................................................................... 40 B-7. MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Target Socket Module, Schematic.................................................. 42 B-8. MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Target Socket Module, PCB......................................................... 43 B-9. MSP-TS430PW24 Target Socket Module, Schematic ................................................................ 45 B-10. MSP-TS430PW24 Target Socket Module, PCB ....................................................................... 46 B-11. MSP-TS430DW28 Target Socket Module, Schematic ................................................................ 48 B-12. MSP-TS430DW28 Target Socket Module, PCB ....................................................................... 49 B-13. MSP-TS430PW28 Target Socket Module, Schematic ................................................................ 51 B-14. MSP-TS430PW28 Target Socket Module, PCB ....................................................................... 52 B-15. MSP-TS430PW28A Target Socket Module, Schematic .............................................................. 54 B-16. MSP-TS430PW28A Target Socket Module, PCB (Red) .............................................................. 55 B-17. MSP-TS430RHB32A Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................. 57 B-18. MSP-TS430RHB32A Target Socket Module, PCB .................................................................... 58 B-19. MSP-TS430DA38 Target Socket Module, Schematic................................................................. 60 B-20. MSP-TS430DA38 Target Socket Module, PCB........................................................................ 61 B-21. MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................ 63 B-22. MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Target Socket Module, PCB ................................................................... 64 B-23. MSP-TS430RSB40 Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................... 66 B-24. MSP-TS430RSB40 Target Socket Module, PCB ...................................................................... 67 B-25. MSP-TS430RHA40A Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................. 69 B-26. MSP-TS430RHA40A Target Socket Module, PCB .................................................................... 70 B-27. MSP-TS430DL48 Target Socket Module, Schematic ................................................................. 72 B-28. MSP-TS430DL48 Target Socket Module, PCB ........................................................................ 73 B-29. MSP-TS430RGZ48B Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................. 75 B-30. MSP-TS430RGZ48B Target Socket Module, PCB .................................................................... 76 B-31. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................. 78 B-32. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Target Socket Module, PCB .................................................................... 79 B-33. MSP-TS430PM64 Target Socket Module, Schematic................................................................. 81 B-34. MSP-TS430PM64 Target Socket Module, PCB........................................................................ 82 B-35. MSP-TS430PM64A Target Socket Module, Schematic............................................................... 84 B-36. MSP-TS430PM64A Target Socket Module, PCB...................................................................... 85 B-37. MSP-TS430RGC64B Target Socket Module, Schematic............................................................. 87 B-38. MSP-TS430RGC64B Target Socket Module, PCB.................................................................... 88 B-39. MSP-TS430RGC64C Target Socket Module, Schematic............................................................. 91 B-40. MSP-TS430RGC64C Target Socket Module, PCB.................................................................... 92 B-41. MSP-TS430RGC64USB Target Socket Module, Schematic ......................................................... 94 B-42. MSP-TS430RGC64USB Target Socket Module, PCB ................................................................ 95 B-43. MSP-TS430PN80 Target Socket Module, Schematic................................................................. 98 4 List of Figures SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com B-44. MSP-TS430PN80 Target Socket Module, PCB........................................................................ 99 B-45. MSP-TS430PN80A Target Socket Module, Schematic.............................................................. 101 B-46. MSP-TS430PN80A Target Socket Module, PCB..................................................................... 102 B-47. MSP-TS430PN80USB Target Socket Module, Schematic.......................................................... 104 B-48. MSP-TS430PN80USB Target Socket Module, PCB................................................................. 105 B-49. MSP-TS430PZ100 Target Socket Module, Schematic .............................................................. 108 B-50. MSP-TS430PZ100 Target Socket Module, PCB ..................................................................... 109 B-51. MSP-TS430PZ100A Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................ 111 B-52. MSP-TS430PZ100A Target Socket Module, PCB ................................................................... 112 B-53. MSP-TS430PZ100B Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................ 114 B-54. MSP-TS430PZ100B Target Socket Module, PCB ................................................................... 115 B-55. MSP-TS430PZ100C Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................ 117 B-56. MSP-TS430PZ100C Target Socket Module, PCB ................................................................... 118 B-57. MSP-TS430PZ100D Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................ 121 B-58. MSP-TS430PZ100D Target Socket Module, PCB ................................................................... 122 B-59. MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Target Socket Module, Schematic ........................................................... 124 B-60. MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Target Socket Module, PCB .................................................................. 125 B-61. MSP-TS430PZ100USB Target Socket Module, Schematic......................................................... 127 B-62. MSP-TS430PZ100USB Target Socket Module, PCB................................................................ 128 B-63. MSP-TS430PEU128 Target Socket Module, Schematic ............................................................ 131 B-64. MSP-TS430PEU128 Target Socket Module, PCB ................................................................... 132 B-65. EM430F5137RF900 Target board, Schematic........................................................................ 134 B-66. EM430F5137RF900 Target board, PCB............................................................................... 135 B-67. EM430F6137RF900 Target board, Schematic........................................................................ 138 B-68. EM430F6137RF900 Target Board, PCB .............................................................................. 139 B-69. EM430F6147RF900 Target Board, Schematic ....................................................................... 142 B-70. EM430F6147RF900 Target Board, PCB .............................................................................. 143 B-71. MSP-FET Top View ...................................................................................................... 147 B-72. MSP-FET Bottom View .................................................................................................. 147 B-73. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (1 of 5)........................................................................ 148 B-74. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (2 of 5)........................................................................ 149 B-75. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (3 of 5)........................................................................ 150 B-76. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (4 of 5)........................................................................ 151 B-77. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (5 of 5)........................................................................ 152 B-78. MSP-FET USB Debugger, PCB (Top) ................................................................................. 153 B-79. MSP-FET USB Debugger, PCB (Bottom) ............................................................................. 153 B-80. JTAG Connector Pinout.................................................................................................. 154 B-81. Pin States After Power-Up............................................................................................... 155 B-82. MSP-FET430PIF FET Interface Module, Schematic................................................................. 157 B-83. MSP-FET430PIF FET Interface Module, PCB........................................................................ 158 B-84. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (1 of 4) ................................................................ 159 B-85. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (2 of 4) ................................................................ 160 B-86. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (3 of 4) ................................................................ 161 B-87. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (4 of 4) ................................................................ 162 B-88. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, PCB................................................................................. 163 C-1. Windows XP Hardware Wizard ......................................................................................... 166 C-2. Windows XP Driver Location Selection Folder........................................................................ 167 C-3. Device Manager Using USB Debug Interface using VID/PID 0x2047/0x0010 ................................... 168 C-4. Device Manager Using USB Debug Interface with VID/PID 0x0451/0xF430 ..................................... 169 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 List of Figures 5 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com C-5. Device Manager Using USB Debug Interface With VID/PID 0x0451/0xF432 .................................... 170 6 List of Figures SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com List of Tables 1-1. Flash Emulation Tool (FET) Features and Device Compatibility..................................................... 12 1-2. Individual Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx.................................................................................. 15 B-1. MSP-TS430D8 Bill of Materials .......................................................................................... 35 B-2. MSP-TS430PW14 Bill of Materials....................................................................................... 38 B-3. MSP-TS430L092 Bill of Materials ........................................................................................ 41 B-4. MSP-TS430L092 JP1 Settings ........................................................................................... 43 B-5. MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Bill of Materials ........................................................................ 44 B-6. MSP-TS430PW24 Bill of Materials....................................................................................... 47 B-7. MSP-TS430DW28 Bill of Materials ...................................................................................... 50 B-8. MSP-TS430PW28 Bill of Materials ...................................................................................... 53 B-9. MSP-TS430PW28A Bill of Materials..................................................................................... 56 B-10. MSP-TS430RHB32A Bill of Materials ................................................................................... 59 B-11. MSP-TS430DA38 Bill of Materials ....................................................................................... 62 B-12. MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Bill of Materials .................................................................................. 65 B-13. MSP-TS430RSB40 Bill of Materials ..................................................................................... 68 B-14. MSP-TS430RHA40A Bill of Materials ................................................................................... 71 B-15. MSP-TS430DL48 Bill of Materials ....................................................................................... 74 B-16. MSP-TS430RGZ48B Bill of Materials ................................................................................... 77 B-17. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Revision History .................................................................................. 79 B-18. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Bill of Materials ................................................................................... 80 B-19. MSP-TS430PM64 Bill of Materials....................................................................................... 83 B-20. MSP-TS430PM64A Bill of Materials ..................................................................................... 86 B-21. MSP-TS430RGC64B Bill of Materials ................................................................................... 89 B-22. MSP-TS430RGC64C Bill of Materials ................................................................................... 93 B-23. MSP-TS430RGC64USB Bill of Materials ............................................................................... 96 B-24. MSP-TS430PN80 Bill of Materials...................................................................................... 100 B-25. MSP-TS430PN80A Bill of Materials.................................................................................... 103 B-26. MSP-TS430PN80USB Bill of Materials ................................................................................ 106 B-27. MSP-TS430PZ100 Bill of Materials .................................................................................... 110 B-28. MSP-TS430PZ100A Bill of Materials................................................................................... 113 B-29. MSP-TS430PZ100B Bill of Materials................................................................................... 116 B-30. MSP-TS430PZ100C Bill of Materials .................................................................................. 119 B-31. MSP-TS430PZ100D Bill of Materials .................................................................................. 123 B-32. MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Bill of Materials.................................................................................. 126 B-33. MSP-TS430PZ100USB Bill of Materials ............................................................................... 129 B-34. MSP-TS430PEU128 Bill of Materials .................................................................................. 133 B-35. EM430F5137RF900 Bill of Materials................................................................................... 136 B-36. EM430F6137RF900 Bill of Materials................................................................................... 140 B-37. EM430F6147RF900 Bill of Materials................................................................................... 144 B-38. UART Backchannel Implementation ................................................................................... 146 B-39. MSP-FET LED Signals................................................................................................... 153 B-40. JTAG Connector Pin State by Operating Mode ...................................................................... 154 B-41. Specifications.............................................................................................................. 156 B-42. MSP-FET Revision History .............................................................................................. 156 C-1. USB VIDs and PIDs Used in MSP430 Tools.......................................................................... 166 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 List of Tables 7 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Preface SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Read This First About This Manual This manual describes the hardware of the Texas Instruments MSP-FET430 Flash Emulation Tool (FET). The FET is the program development tool for the MSP430™ ultra-low-power microcontroller. Both available interface types, the parallel port interface and the USB interface, are described. How to Use This Manual Read and follow the instructions in Chapter 1. This chapter lists the contents of the FET, provides instructions on installing the hardware and according software drivers. After you see how quick and easy it is to use the development tools, TI recommends that you read all of this manual. This manual describes the setup and operation of the FET but does not fully describe the MSP430™ microcontrollers or the development software systems. For details of these items, see the appropriate TI documents listed in Section 1.20. This manual applies to the following tools (and devices): • MSP-FET430PIF (debug interface with parallel port connection, for all MSP430 flash-based devices) • MSP-FET430UIF (debug interface with USB connection, for all MSP430 flash-based devices) • MSP-FET (successor to MSP-FET430UIF, debug interface with USB connection, for all MSP430 devices) • eZ430-F2013 (USB stick form factor interface with attached MSP430F2013 target, for all MSP430F20xx, MSP430G2x01, MSP430G2x11, MSP430G2x21, and MSP430G2x31 devices) • eZ430-T2012 (three MSP430F2012 based target boards) • eZ430-RF2500 (USB stick form factor interface with attached MSP430F2274 and CC2500 target, for all MSP430F20xx, MSP430F21x2, MSP430F22xx, MSP430G2x01, MSP430G2x11, MSP430G2x21, and MSP430G2x31 devices) • eZ430-RF2500T (one MSP430F2274 and CC2500 target board including battery pack) • eZ430-RF2500-SEH (USB stick form factor interface with attached MSP430F2274 and CC2500 target and solar energy harvesting module) • eZ430-Chronos-xxx (USB stick form factor interface with CC430F6137 based development system contained in a watch. Includes <1 GHz RF USB access point) Stand-alone target-socket modules (without debug interface) named as MSP-TS430TSxx. Tools named as MSP-FET430Uxx contain the USB debug interface (MSP-FET430UIF) and the respective target socket module MSP-TS430TSxx, where 'xx' is the same for both names. The following tools contain also the USB debug interface (MSP-FET430UIF): • FET430F5137RF900 (for CC430F513x devices in 48-pin RGZ packages) (green PCB) • FET430F6137RF900 (for CC430F612x and CC430F613x devices in 64-pin RGC packages) (green PCB) These tools contain the most up-to-date materials available at the time of packaging. For the latest materials (data sheets, user's guides, software, application information, and so on), visit the TI MSP430 web site at www.ti.com/msp430 or contact your local TI sales office. 8 Read This First SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Information About Cautions and Warnings Information About Cautions and Warnings This document may contain cautions and warnings. CAUTION This is an example of a caution statement. A caution statement describes a situation that could potentially damage your software or equipment. WARNING This is an example of a warning statement. A warning statement describes a situation that could potentially cause harm to you. The information in a caution or a warning is provided for your protection. Read each caution and warning carefully. Related Documentation From Texas Instruments MSP430 development tools documentation: Code Composer Studio for MSP430 User's Guide (literature number SLAU157) Code Composer Studio v5.x Core Edition (CCS Mediawiki) IAR Embedded Workbench for MSP430(tm) User's Guide (literature number SLAU138) IAR Embedded Workbench KickStart installer (literature number SLAC050) eZ430-F2013 Development Tool User's Guide (literature number SLAU176) eZ430-RF2480 Demonstration Kit User's Guide (literature number SWRU151) eZ430-RF2500 Development Tool User's Guide (literature number SLAU227) eZ430-RF2500-SEH Development Tool User's Guide (literature number SLAU273) eZ430-Chronos Development Tool User's Guide (literature number SLAU292) Spectrum Analyzer (MSP-SA430-SUB1GHZ) User's Guide (literature number SLAU371) MSP-EXP430F5529 Experimenter Board User's Guide (literature number SLAU330) MSP-EXP430F5438 Experimenter Board User's Guide (literature number SLAU263) MSP-EXP430G2 LaunchPad Experimenter Board User's Guide (literature number SLAU318) MSP Gang Programmer (MSP-GANG) User's Guide (literature number SLAU358) MSP430 Gang Programmer (MSP-GANG430) User's Guide (literature number SLAU101) MSP430 device user's guides: MSP430x1xx Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU049) MSP430x2xx Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU144) MSP430x3xx Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU012) MSP430x4xx Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU056) MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU208) CC430 Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU259) SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Read This First 9 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated If You Need Assistance www.ti.com MSP430FR57xx Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU272) MSP430FR58xx and MSP430FR59xx Family User's Guide (literature number SLAU367) If You Need Assistance Support for the MSP430 devices and the FET development tools is provided by the Texas Instruments Product Information Center (PIC). Contact information for the PIC can be found on the TI web site at www.ti.com/support. The Texas Instruments E2E Community support forums for the MSP430 provide open interaction with peer engineers, TI engineers, and other experts. Additional device-specific information can be found on the MSP430 web site. 10 Read This First SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Chapter 1 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Get Started Now! This chapter lists the contents of the FET and provides instruction on installing the hardware. Topic ........................................................................................................................... Page 1.1 Flash Emulation Tool (FET) Overview ................................................................... 12 1.2 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430PIF.............................................................................. 13 1.3 Kit Contents, eZ430-F2013................................................................................... 13 1.4 Kit Contents, eZ430-T2012................................................................................... 13 1.5 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500 ................................................................................ 13 1.6 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500T............................................................................... 13 1.7 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500-SEH ......................................................................... 13 1.8 Kit Contents, eZ430-Chronos-xxx......................................................................... 14 1.9 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430UIF.............................................................................. 14 1.10 Kit Contents, MSP-FET ....................................................................................... 14 1.11 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430xx .............................................................................. 14 1.12 Kit Contents, FET430F6137RF900 ........................................................................ 15 1.13 Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx ................................................................................. 15 1.14 Kit Contents, EM430Fx1x7RF900.......................................................................... 17 1.15 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430PIF ................................................................. 17 1.16 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430UIF ................................................................. 18 1.17 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET........................................................................... 18 1.18 Hardware Installation, eZ430-XXXX, MSP-EXP430G2, MSP-EXP430FR5739, MSPEXP430F5529..................................................................................................... 18 1.19 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430Uxx, MSP-TS430xxx, FET430F6137RF900, EM430Fx137RF900 ............................................................................................. 19 1.20 Important MSP430 Documents on the Web............................................................ 20 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Get Started Now! 11 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Flash Emulation Tool (FET) Overview www.ti.com 1.1 Flash Emulation Tool (FET) Overview TI offers several flash emulation tools according to different requirements. Table 1-1. Flash Emulation Tool (FET) Features and Device Compatibility(1) eZ430-F2013 eZ430-RF2500 eZ430-RF2480 eZ430-RF2560 MSP-WDSxx Metawatch eZ430-Chronos MSP-FET430PIF MSP-FET430UIF LaunchPad (MSP-EXP430G2) MSP-EXP430FR5739 MSP-EXP430F5529 Supports all programmable MSP430 and CC430 devices (F1xx, F2xx, F4xx, F5xx, F6xx, G2xx, L092, FR57xx, FR59xx, x x MSP430TCH5E) Supports only F20xx, G2x01, G2x11, x G2x21, G2x31 Supports MSP430F20xx, F21x2, F22xx, x G2x01, G2x11, G2x21, G2x31, G2x53 Supports MSP430F20xx, F21x2, F22xx, x x G2x01, G2x11, G2x21, G2x31 Supports F5438, F5438A x Supports BT5190, F5438A x x Supports only F552x x Supports FR57xx, F5638, F6638 x Supports only CC430F613x x Allows fuse blow x Adjustable target supply voltage x Fixed 2.8-V target supply voltage x Fixed 3.6-V target supply voltage x x x x x x x x x 4-wire JTAG x x 2-wire JTAG(2) x x x x x x x x x x Application UART x x x x x x x x Supported by CCS for Windows x x x x x x x x x x x Supported by CCS for Linux x Supported by IAR x x x x x x x x x x x (1) The MSP-FET430PIF is for legacy device support only. This emulation tool will not support any new devices released after 2011. (2) The 2-wire JTAG debug interface is also referred to as Spy-Bi-Wire (SBW) interface. 12 Get Started Now! SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Kit Contents, MSP-FET430PIF 1.2 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430PIF • One READ ME FIRST document • One MSP-FET430PIF interface module • One 25-conductor cable • One 14-conductor cable NOTE: This part is obsolete and is not recommended to use in new design. 1.3 Kit Contents, eZ430-F2013 • One QUICK START GUIDE document • One eZ430-F2013 development tool including one MSP430F2013 target board 1.4 Kit Contents, eZ430-T2012 • Three MSP430F2012-based target boards 1.5 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500 • One QUICK START GUIDE document • One eZ430-RF2500 CD-ROM • One eZ430-RF2500 development tool including one MSP430F2274 and CC2500 target board • One eZ430-RF2500T target board • One AAA battery pack with expansion board (batteries included) 1.6 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500T • One eZ430-RF2500T target board • One AAA battery pack with expansion board (batteries included) 1.7 Kit Contents, eZ430-RF2500-SEH • One MSP430 development tool CD containing documentation and development software • One eZ430-RF USB debugging interface • Two eZ430-RF2500T wireless target boards • One SEH-01 solar energy harvester board • One AAA battery pack with expansion board (batteries included) SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Get Started Now! 13 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Kit Contents, eZ430-Chronos-xxx www.ti.com 1.8 Kit Contents, eZ430-Chronos-xxx '433, '868, '915 • One QUICK START GUIDE document • One ez430-Chronos emulator • One screwdriver • Two spare screws eZ430-Chronos-433: – One 433-MHz eZ430-Chronos watch (battery included) – One 433-MHz eZ430-Chronos access point eZ430-Chronos-868: – One 868-MHz eZ430-Chronos watch (battery included) – One 868-MHz eZ430-Chronos access point eZ430-Chronos-915: – One 915-MHz eZ430-Chronos watch (battery included) – One 915-MHz eZ430-Chronos access point 1.9 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430UIF • One READ ME FIRST document • One MSP-FET430UIF interface module • One USB cable • One 14-conductor cable 1.10 Kit Contents, MSP-FET • One READ ME FIRST document • One MSP-FET interface module • One USB cable • One 14-conductor cable 1.11 Kit Contents, MSP-FET430xx • One READ ME FIRST document • One MSP-FET430UIF USB interface module. This is the unit that has a USB B-connector on one end of the case, and a 2×7-pin male connector on the other end of the case. • One USB cable • One 32.768-kHz crystal from Micro Crystal, if the board has an option to use the quartz. • A 2×7-pin male JTAG connector is also present on the PCB (see different setup for L092) • One 14-Pin JTAG conductor cable • One small box containing two MSP430 device samples (See table for Sample Type) • One target socket module. To determine the devices used for each board and a summary of the board, see Table 1-2. The name of MSP-TS430xx board can be derived from the name of the MSP-FET430xx kit; for example, the MSP-FET430U28A kit contains the MSP-TS430PW28A board. Refer to the device data sheets for device specifications. Device errata can be found in the respective device product folder on the web provided as a PDF document. Depending on the device, errata may also be found in the device bug database at www.ti.com/sc/cgi-bin/buglist.cgi. 14 Get Started Now! SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Kit Contents, FET430F6137RF900 1.12 Kit Contents, FET430F6137RF900 • One READ ME FIRST document • One legal notice • One MSP-FET430UIF interface module • Two EM430F6137RF900 target socket modules. This is the PCB on which is soldered a CC430F6137 device in a 64-pin RGC package. A 2×7-pin male connector is also present on the PCB. • Two CC430EM battery packs • Four AAA batteries • Two 868-MHz or 915-MHz antennas • Two 32.768-kHz crystals • 18 PCB 2x4-pin headers • One USB cable • One 14-pin JTAG conductor cable 1.13 Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx • One READ ME FIRST document • One 32.768-kHz crystal from Micro Crystal (except MSP-TS430PW24) • One target socket module • A 2×7-pin male JTAG connector is also present on the PCB (see different setup for L092) • MSP430 device samples (see Table 1-2 for sample type) Table 1-2. Individual Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx Part Number Socket Type Supported Devices Included Devices Headers and Comment MSP-TS430D8 8-pin D MSP430G2210, 1 x MSP430G2210ID and Two PCB 1×4-pin headers (two male and (green PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) MSP430G2230 1 x MSP430G2230ID two female) MSP430F20xx, MSP-TS430PW14 14-pin PW MSP430G2x01, Four PCB 1×7-pin headers (two male and (green PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) MSP430G2x11, 2 x MSP430F2013IPW two female) MSP430G2x21, MSP430G2x31 Four PCB 1×7-pin headers (two male and two female). A "Micro-MaTch" 10-pin MSP-TS430L092 14-pin PW female connector is also present on the (green PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) MSP-TS430L092 2 x MSP430L092IPW PCB which connects the kit with an 'Active Cable' PCB; this 'Active Cable' PCB is connected by 14-pin JTAG cable with the FET430UIF MSP-TS430PW24 24-pin PW MSP430AFE2xx 2 x MSP430AFE253IPW Four PCB 1×12-pin headers (two male (green PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) and two female) MSP430F11x1, MSP430F11x2, MSP-TS430DW28 28-pin DW MSP430F12x, Four PCB 1×12-pin headers (two male (green PCB) (SSOP ZIF) MSP430F12x2, 2 x MSP430F123IDW and two female) MSP430F21xx Supports devices in 20- and 28-pin DA packages MSP430F11x1, MSP-TS430PW28 28-pin PW MSP430F11x2, Four PCB 1×12-pin headers (two male (green PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) MSP430F12x, 2 x MSP430F2132IPW and two female) MSP430F12x2, MSP430F21xx MSP430F20xx, MSP-TS430PW28A 28-pin PW MSP430G2xxx in 14-, 20-, Four PCB 1×12-pin headers (two male (red PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) and 28-pin PW packages, 2 x MSP430G2452IPW20 and two female) MSP430TCH5E in PW package MSP-TS430RHB32A 32-pin RHB MSP430i204x 2 x MSP430i2041TRHB Eight PCB 1×8-pin headers (four male (red PCB) (QFN ZIF) and four female) MSP-TS430DA38 38-pin DA MSP430F22xx, 2 x MSP430F2274IDA Four PCB 1×19-pin headers (two male (green PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) MSP430G2x44, 2 x MSP430G2744IDA and two female) MSP430G2x55 2 x MSP430G2955IDA SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Get Started Now! 15 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx www.ti.com Table 1-2. Individual Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx (continued) Part Number Socket Type Supported Devices Included Devices Headers and Comment MSP-TS430QFN23x0 40-pin RHA MSP430F23x0 2 x MSP430F2370IRHA Eight PCB 1×10-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFN ZIF) and four female) MSP-TS430RSB40 40-pin RSB MSP430F51x1, 2 x MSP430F5172IRSB Eight PCB 1×10-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFN ZIF) MSP430F51x2 and four female) MSP-TS430RHA40A 40-pin RHA MSP430FR572x, 2 x MSP430FR5739IRHA Eight PCB 1×10-pin headers (four male (red PCB) (QFN ZIF) MSP430FR573x and four female) MSP-TS430DL48 48-pin DL MSP430F42x0 2 x MSP430F4270IDL Four PCB 2×12-pin headers (two male (green PCB) (TSSOP ZIF) and two female) MSP-TS430RGZ48B 48-pin RGZ MSP430F534x 2 x MSP430F5342IRGZ Eight PCB 1×12-pin headers (four male (blue PCB) (QFN ZIF) and four female) MSP-TS430RGZ48C 48-pin RGZ MSP430FR58xx and 2 x MSP430FR5969IRGZ Eight PCB 1×12-pin headers (four male (black PCB) (QFN ZIF) MSP430FR59xx and four female) MSP430F13x, MSP430F14x, MSP430F14x1, MSP430F15x, MSP430F16x, MSP430F16x1, MSP430F23x, TS Kit: MSP-TS430PM64 64-pin PM MSP430F24x, 2 x MSP430F2618IPM; Eight PCB 1×16-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430F24xx, FET Kit: and four female) MSP430F261x, 2 x MSP430F417IPM and MSP430F41x, 2 x MSP430F169IPM MSP430F42x, MSP430F42xA, MSP430FE42x, MSP430FE42xA, MSP430FE42x2, MSP430FW42x MSP-TS430PM64A 64-pin PM MSP430F41x2 2 x MSP430F4152IPM Eight PCB 1×16-pin headers (four male (red PCB) (QFP ZIF) and four female) MSP-TS430RGC64B 64-pin RGC MSP430F530x 2 x MSP430F5310IRGC Eight PCB 1×16-pin headers (four male (blue PCB) (QFN ZIF) and four female) MSP430F522x, MSP-TS430RGC64C 64-pin RGC MSP430F521x , Eight PCB 1×16-pin headers (four male (black PCB) (QFN ZIF) MSP430F523x, 2 x MSP430F5229IRGC and four female) MSP430F524x, MSP430F525x MSP-TS430RGC64USB 64-pin RGC MSP430F550x, 2 x MSP430F5510IRGC or Eight PCB 1×16-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFN ZIF) MSP430F551x, 2 x MSP430F5528IRGC and four female) MSP430F552x MSP430F241x, MSP430F261x, MSP-TS430PN80 80-pin PN MSP430F43x, Eight PCB 1×20-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430F43x1, 2 x MSP430FG439IPN and four female) MSP430FG43x, MSP430F47x, MSP430FG47x MSP-TS430PN80A 80-pin PN MSP430F532x 2 x MSP430F5329IPN Eight PCB 1×20-pin headers (four male (red PCB) (QFP ZIF) and four female) MSP-TS430PN80USB 80-pin PN MSP430F552x, 2 x MSP430F5529IPN Eight PCB 1×20-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430F551x and four female) MSP430F43x, MSP-TS430PZ100 100-pin PZ MSP430F43x1, Eight PCB 1×25-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430F44x, 2 x MSP430FG4619IPZ and four female) MSP430FG461x, MSP430F47xx MSP-TS430PZ100A 100-pin PZ MSP430F471xx 2 x MSP430F47197IPZ Eight PCB 1×25-pin headers (four male (red PCB) (QFP ZIF) and four female) MSP-TS430PZ100B 100-pin PZ MSP430F67xx 2 x MSP430F6733IPZ Eight PCB 1×25-pin headers (four male (blue PCB) (QFP ZIF) and four female) MSP430F645x, MSP-TS430PZ100C 100-pin PZ MSP430F643x, 2 x MSP430F6438IPZ Eight PCB 1×25-pin headers (four male (black PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430F535x, and four female) MSP430F533x MSP-TS430PZ100D 100-pin PZ MSP430FR698x(1), 2 x MSP430FR6989IPZ Eight PCB 1×25-pin headers (four male (white PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430FR688x(1) and four female) 16 Get Started Now! SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Kit Contents, EM430Fx1x7RF900 Table 1-2. Individual Kit Contents, MSP-TS430xx (continued) Part Number Socket Type Supported Devices Included Devices Headers and Comment MSP-TS430PZ5x100 100-pin PZ MSP430F543x, Eight PCB 1×25-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430BT5190, 2 x MSP430F5438IPZ and four female) MSP430SL5438A MSP-TS430PZ100USB 100-pin PZ MSP430F665x, Eight PCB 1×25-pin headers (four male (green PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430F663x, 2 x MSP430F6638IPZ and four female) MSP430F563x MSP430F677x, MSP430F676x, Four PCB 1x26-pin headers (two male MSP-TS430PEU128 128-pin PEU MSP430F674x, 2 x MSP430F67791IPEU and two female) and four PCB 1x38-pin (green PCB) (QFP ZIF) MSP430F677x1, headers (two male and two female) MSP430F676x1, MSP430F674x1 See the device data sheets for device specifications. Device errata can be found in the respective device product folder on the web provided as a PDF document. Depending on the device, errata may also be found in the device bug database at www.ti.com/sc/cgi-bin/buglist.cgi. 1.14 Kit Contents, EM430Fx1x7RF900 • One READ ME FIRST document • One legal notice • Two target socket module MSP-EM430F5137RF900: Two EM430F5137RF900 target socket modules. This is the PCB on which is soldered a CC430F5137 device in a 48-pin RGZ package. A 2×7-pin male connector is also present on the PCB MSP-EM430F6137RF900: Two EM430F6137RF900 target socket modules. This is the PCB on which is soldered a CC430F6137 device in a 64-pin RGC package. A 2×7-pin male connector is also present on the PCB MSP-EM430F6147RF900: Two EM430F6147RF900 target socket modules. This is the PCB on which is soldered a CC430F6147 device in a 64-pin RGC package. A 2×7-pin male connector is also present on the PCB • Two CC430EM battery packs • Four AAA batteries • Two 868- or 915-MHz antennas • Two 32.768-kHz crystals • 18 PCB 2×4-pin headers 1.15 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430PIF Follow these steps to install the hardware for the MSP-FET430PIF tools: 1. Use the 25-conductor cable to connect the FET interface module to the parallel port of the PC. The necessary driver for accessing the PC parallel port is installed automatically during CCS or IAR Embedded Workbench installation. Note that a restart is required after the CCS or IAR Embedded Workbench installation for the driver to become active. 2. Use the 14-conductor cable to connect the parallel-port debug interface module to a target board, such as an MSP-TS430xxx target socket module. Module schematics and PCBs are shown in Appendix B. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Get Started Now! 17 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430UIF www.ti.com 1.16 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430UIF Follow these steps to install the hardware for the MSP-FET430UIF tool: 1. Install the IDE (CCS or IAR) you plan to use before connecting USB-FET interface to PC. The IDE installation installs drivers automatically. 2. Use the USB cable to connect the USB-FET interface module to a USB port on the PC. The USB FET should be recognized, as the USB device driver is installed automatically. If the driver has not been installed yet, the install wizard starts. Follow the prompts and point the wizard to the driver files. The default location for CCS is c:\ti\ccsv5\ccs_base\emulation\drivers\msp430\USB_CDC or c:\ti\ccsv5\ccs_base\emulation\drivers\msp430\USB_FET_XP_XX, depending of firmware version of the tool. The default location for IAR Embedded Workbench is \Embedded Workbench x.x\430\drivers\TIUSBFET\eZ430-UART or \Embedded Workbench x.x\430\drivers\, depending of firmware version of the tool. The USB driver is installed automatically. Detailed driver installation instructions can be found in Appendix C. 3. After connecting to a PC, the USB FET performs a self-test during which the red LED may flash for approximately two seconds. If the self-test passes successfully, the green LED stays on. 4. Use the 14-conductor cable to connect the USB-FET interface module to a target board, such as an MSP-TS430xxx target socket module. 5. Ensure that the MSP430 device is securely seated in the socket, and that its pin 1 (indicated with a circular indentation on the top surface) aligns with the "1" mark on the PCB. 6. Compared to the parallel-port debug interface, the USB FET has additional features including JTAG security fuse blow and adjustable target VCC (1.8 V to 3.6 V). Supply the module with up to 60 mA. 1.17 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET Follow these steps to install the hardware for the MSP-FET tool: 1. Install the IDE (CCS or IAR) that you plan to use before connecting MSP-FET to PC. During IDE installation, USB drivers are installed automatically. Make sure to use the latest IDE version, otherwise the USB drivers might not be able to recognize the MSP-FET. 2. Connect the MSP-FET to a USB port on the PC with the provided USB cable. 3. The following procedure applies to operation under Windows: (a) After connecting to the PC, the MSP-FET should be recognized automatically, as the USB device driver has been already installed together with the IDE. (b) If the driver has not been installed yet, the Found New Hardware wizard starts. Follow the instructions and point the wizard to the driver files. (c) The default location for CCS is c:\ti\ccsv6\ccs_base\emulation\drivers\msp430\USB_CDC. (d) The default location for IAR Embedded Workbench is \Embedded Workbench x.x\430\drivers\. 4. After connecting to a PC, the MSP-FET performs a self-test. If the self-test passes successfully, the green LED stays on. For a complete list of LED signals, please refer to the MSP-FET chapter in this document. 5. Connect the MSP-FET to a target board, such as an MSP-TS430xxx target socket module, with the 14-conductor cable. 6. Make sure that the MSP430 device is securely seated in the socket and that its pin 1 (indicated with a circular indentation on the top surface) aligns with the "1" mark on the PCB. 1.18 Hardware Installation, eZ430-XXXX, MSP-EXP430G2, MSP-EXP430FR5739, MSPEXP430F5529 To install the eZ430-XXXX, MSP-EXP430G2, MSP-EXP430FR5739, MSP-EXP430F5529 tools, follow steps 1 and 2 of Section 1.16 18 Get Started Now! SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430Uxx, MSP-TS430xxx, FET430F6137RF900, EM430Fx137RF900 1.19 Hardware Installation, MSP-FET430Uxx, MSP-TS430xxx, FET430F6137RF900, EM430Fx137RF900 Follow these steps to install the hardware for the MSP-FET430Uxx and MSP-TS430xxx tools: 1. Follow steps 1 and 2 of Section 1.16 2. Connect the MSP-FET430PIF or MSP-FET430UIF debug interface to the appropriate port of the PC. Use the 14-conductor cable to connect the FET interface module to the supplied target socket module. 3. Ensure that the MSP430 device is securely seated in the socket and that its pin 1 (indicated with a circular indentation on the top surface) aligns with the "1" mark on the PCB. 4. Ensure that the two jumpers (LED and VCC) near the 2×7-pin male connector are in place. Illustrations of the target socket modules and their parts are found in Appendix B. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Get Started Now! 19 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Important MSP430 Documents on the Web www.ti.com 1.20 Important MSP430 Documents on the Web The primary sources of MSP430 information are the device-specific data sheet and user's guide. The MSP430 web site (www.ti.com/msp430) contains the most recent version of these documents. PDF documents describing the CCS tools (CCS IDE, the assembler, the C compiler, the linker, and the librarian) are in the msp430\documentation folder. A Code Composer Studio specific Wiki page (FAQ) is available, and the Texas Instruments E2E Community support forums for the MSP430 and Code Composer Studio v5 provide additional help besides the product help and Welcome page. PDF documents describing the IAR tools (Workbench C-SPY, the assembler, the C compiler, the linker, and the librarian) are in the common\doc and 430\doc folders. Supplements to the documents (that is, the latest information) are available in HTML format in the same directories. A IAR specific Wiki Page is also available. 20 Get Started Now! SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Chapter 2 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming This chapter presents signal requirements for in-circuit programming of the MSP430. Topic ........................................................................................................................... Page 2.1 Signal Connections for In-System Programming and Debugging............................. 22 2.2 External Power................................................................................................... 26 2.3 Bootstrap Loader (BSL) ...................................................................................... 26 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming 21 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Signal Connections for In-System Programming and Debugging www.ti.com 2.1 Signal Connections for In-System Programming and Debugging MSP-FET430PIF, MSP-FET430UIF, MSP-GANG, MSP-GANG430, MSP-PRGS430 With the proper connections, the debugger and an FET hardware JTAG interface (such as the MSPFET430PIF and MSP-FET430UIF) can be used to program and debug code on the target board. In addition, the connections also support the MSP-GANG430 or MSP-PRGS430 production programmers, thus providing an easy way to program prototype boards, if desired. Figure 2-1 shows the connections between the 14-pin FET interface module connector and the target device required to support in-system programming and debugging for 4-wire JTAG communication. Figure 2-2 shows the connections for 2-wire JTAG mode (Spy-Bi-Wire). The 4-wire JTAG mode is supported on most MSP430 devices, except devices with low pin counts (for example, MSP430G2230). The 2-wire JTAG mode is available on selected devices only. See the Code Composer Studio for MSP430 User's Guide (SLAU157) or IAR Embedded Workbench Version 3+ for MSP430 User's Guide (SLAU138) for information on which interface method can be used on which device. The connections for the FET interface module and the MSP-GANG, MSP-GANG430, or MSP-PRGS430 are identical. Both the FET interface module and MSP-GANG430 can supply VCC to the target board (through pin 2). In addition, the FET interface module, MSP-GANG, and MSP-GANG430 have a VCCsense feature that, if used, requires an alternate connection (pin 4 instead of pin 2). The VCC-sense feature senses the local VCC present on the target board (that is, a battery or other local power supply) and adjusts the output signals accordingly. If the target board is to be powered by a local VCC, then the connection to pin 4 on the JTAG should be made, and not the connection to pin 2. This uses the VCCsense feature and prevents any contention that might occur if the local on-board VCC were connected to the VCC supplied from the FET interface module, MSP-GANG or the MSP-GANG430. If the VCC-sense feature is not necessary (that is, if the target board is to be powered from the FET interface module, MSPGANG, or MSP-GANG430), the VCC connection is made to pin 2 on the JTAG header, and no connection is made to pin 4. Figure 2-1 and Figure 2-2 show a jumper block that supports both scenarios of supplying VCC to the target board. If this flexibility is not required, the desired VCC connections may be hard-wired to eliminate the jumper block. Pins 2 and 4 must not be connected at the same time. Note that in 4-wire JTAG communication mode (see Figure 2-1), the connection of the target RST signal to the JTAG connector is optional when using devices that support only 4-wire JTAG communication mode. However, when using devices that support 2-wire JTAG communication mode in 4-wire JTAG mode, the RST connection must be made. The MSP430 development tools and device programmers perform a target reset by issuing a JTAG command to gain control over the device. However, if this is unsuccessful, the RST signal of the JTAG connector may be used by the development tool or device programmer as an additional way to assert a device reset. 22 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 TDO/TDI TDI/VPP TMS TCK GND TEST/VPP JTAG VCC TOOL VCC TARGET J1 (see Note A) J2 (see Note A) VCC R1 47 k (see Note B) W C2 10 μF C3 0.1 μF VCC/AVCC/DVCC RST/NMI TDO/TDI TDI/VPP TMS TCK TEST/VPP (see Note C) V /AV /DV SS SS SS MSP430Fxxx C1 10 nF/2.2 nF (see Notes B and E) RST (see Note D) Important to connect www.ti.com Signal Connections for In-System Programming and Debugging A If a local target power supply is used, make connection J1. If power from the debug or programming adapter is used, make connection J2. B The configuration of R1 and C1 for the RST/NMI pin depends on the device family. See the respective MSP430 family user's guide for the recommended configuration. C The TEST pin is available only on MSP430 family members with multiplexed JTAG pins. See the device-specific data sheet to determine if this pin is available. D The connection to the JTAG connector RST pin is optional when using a device that supports only 4-wire JTAG communication mode, and it is not required for device programming or debugging. However, this connection is required when using a device that supports 2-wire JTAG communication mode in 4-wire JTAG mode. E When using a device that supports 2-wire JTAG communication in 4-wire JTAG mode, the upper limit for C1 should not exceed 2.2 nF. This applies to both TI FET interface modules (LPT and USB FET). Figure 2-1. Signal Connections for 4-Wire JTAG Communication SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming 23 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 TEST/SBWTCK MSP430Fxxx RST/NMI/SBWTDIO TDO/TDI TCK GND TEST/VPP JTAG VCC TOOL VCC TARGET 330! R2 J1 (see Note A) J2 (see Note A) Important to connect VCC/AVCC/DVCC V /AV /DV SS SS SS R1 47 k! See Note B C1 2.2 nF See Note B VCC C2 10 μF C3 0.1 μF Signal Connections for In-System Programming and Debugging www.ti.com A If a local target power supply is used, make connection J1. If power from the debug or programming adapter is used, make connection J2. B The device RST/NMI/SBWTDIO pin is used in 2-wire mode for bidirectional communication with the device during JTAG access, and any capacitance that is attached to this signal may affect the ability to establish a connection with the device. The upper limit for C1 is 2.2 nF when using current TI tools. C R2 protects the JTAG debug interface TCK signal from the JTAG security fuse blow voltage that is supplied by the TEST/VPP pin during the fuse blow process. If fuse blow functionality is not needed, R2 is not required (populate 0 Ω) and do not connect TEST/VPP to TEST/SBWTCK. Figure 2-2. Signal Connections for 2-Wire JTAG Communication (Spy-Bi-Wire) Used by MSP430F2xx, MSP430G2xx, and MSP430F4xx Devices 24 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 TEST/SBWTCK MSP430Fxxx RST/NMI/SBWTDIO TDO/TDI TCK GND JTAG R1 47 k! See Note B VCC TOOL VCC TARGET C1 2.2 nF See Note B J1 (see Note A) J2 (see Note A) Important to connect VCC/AVCC/DVCC V /AV /DV SS SS SS VCC C2 10 μF C3 0.1 μF www.ti.com Signal Connections for In-System Programming and Debugging A Make connection J1 if a local target power supply is used, or make connection J2 if the target is powered from the debug or programming adapter. B The device RST/NMI/SBWTDIO pin is used in 2-wire mode for bidirectional communication with the device during JTAG access, and any capacitance that is attached to this signal may affect the ability to establish a connection with the device. The upper limit for C1 is 2.2 nF when using current TI tools. Figure 2-3. Signal Connections for 2-Wire JTAG Communication (Spy-Bi-Wire) Used by MSP430F5xx and MSP430F6xx Devices SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming 25 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated External Power www.ti.com 2.2 External Power The MSP-FET430UIF can supply targets with up to 60 mA through pin 2 of the 14-pin connector. Note that the target should not consume more than 60 mA, even as a peak current, as it may violate the USB specification. For example, if the target board has a capacitor on VCC more than 10 μF, it may cause inrush current during capacitor charging that may exceed 60 mA. In this case, the current should be limited by the design of the target board, or an external power supply should be used. The VCC for the target can be selected between 1.8 V and 3.6 V in steps of 0.1 V. Alternatively, the target can be supplied externally. In this case, the external voltage should be connected to pin 4 of the 14-pin connector. The MSP-FET430UIF then adjusts the level of the JTAG signals to external VCC automatically. Only pin 2 (MSP-FET430UIF supplies target) or pin 4 (target is externally supplied) must be connected; not both at the same time. When a target socket module is powered from an external supply, the external supply powers the device on the target socket module and any user circuitry connected to the target socket module, and the FET interface module continues to be powered from the PC through the parallel port. If the externally supplied voltage differs from that of the FET interface module, the target socket module must be modified so that the externally supplied voltage is routed to the FET interface module (so that it may adjust its output voltage levels accordingly). See the target socket module schematics in Appendix B. The PC parallel port can source a limited amount of current. Because of the ultra-low-power requirement of the MSP430, a standalone FET does not exceed the available current. However, if additional circuitry is added to the tool, this current limit could be exceeded. In this case, external power can be supplied to the tool through connections provided on the target socket modules. See the schematics and pictorials of the target socket modules in Appendix B to locate the external power connectors. Note that the MSPFET430PIF is not recommended for new design. 2.3 Bootstrap Loader (BSL) The JTAG pins provide access to the memory of the MSP430 and CC430 devices. On some devices, these pins are shared with the device port pins, and this sharing of pins can complicate a design (or sharing may not be possible). As an alternative to using the JTAG pins, most MSP430Fxxx devices contain a program (a "bootstrap loader") that permits the flash memory to be erased and programmed using a reduced set of signals. The MSP430 Programming Via the Bootstrap Loader User's Guide (SLAU319) describes this interface. See the MSP430 web site for the application reports and a list of MSP430 BSL tool developers. TI suggests that MSP430Fxxx customers design their circuits with the BSL in mind (that is, TI suggests providing access to these signals by, for example, a header). See FAQ Hardware #10 for a second alternative to sharing the JTAG and port pins. 26 Design Considerations for In-Circuit Programming SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Appendix A SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Frequently Asked Questions and Known Issues This appendix presents solutions to frequently asked questions regarding the MSP-FET430 hardware. Topic ........................................................................................................................... Page A.1 Hardware FAQs.................................................................................................. 28 A.2 Known Issues .................................................................................................... 30 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Frequently Asked Questions and Known Issues 27 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Hardware FAQs www.ti.com A.1 Hardware FAQs 1. MSP430F22xx Target Socket Module (MSP-TS430DA38) – Important Information Due to the large capacitive coupling introduced by the device socket between the adjacent signals XIN/P2.6 (socket pin 6) and RST/SBWTDIO (socket pin 7), in-system debugging can disturb the LFXT1 low-frequency crystal oscillator operation (ACLK). This behavior applies only to the Spy-Bi-Wire (2-wire) JTAG configuration and only to the period while a debug session is active. Workarounds: • Use the 4-wire JTAG mode debug configuration instead of the Spy-Bi-Wire (2-wire) JTAG configuration. This can be achieved by placing jumpers JP4 through JP9 accordingly. • Use the debugger option "Run Free" that can be selected from the Advanced Run drop-down menu (at top of Debug View). This prevents the debugger from accessing the MSP430 device while the application is running. Note that, in this mode, a manual halt is required to see if a breakpoint was hit. See the IDE documentation for more information on this feature. • Use an external clock source to drive XIN directly. 2. With current interface hardware and software, there is a weakness when adapting target boards that are powered externally. This leads to an accidental fuse check in the MSP430 device. This is valid for PIF and UIF but is seen most often on the UIF. A solution is being developed. Workarounds: • Connect the RST/NMI pin to the JTAG header (pin 11). LPT and USB tools are able to pull the RST line, which also resets the device internal fuse logic. • Use the debugger option "Release JTAG On Go" that can be selected from the IDE drop-down menu. This prevents the debugger from accessing the MCU while the application is running. Note that in this mode, a manual halt is required to see if a breakpoint was hit. See the IDE documentation for more information on this feature. • Use an external clock source to drive XIN directly. 3. The 14-conductor cable that connects the FET interface module and the target socket module must not exceed 8 inches (20 centimeters) in length. 4. The signal assignment on the 14-conductor cable is identical for the parallel port interface and the USB FET. 5. To use the on-chip ADC voltage references, the capacitor must be installed on the target socket module. See the schematic of the target socket module to populate the capacitor according to the data sheet of the device. 6. To use the charge pump on the devices with LCD+ Module, the capacitor must be installed on the target socket module. See the schematic of the target socket module to populate the capacitor according to the data sheet of the device. 7. Crystals or resonators Q1 and Q2 (if applicable) are not provided on the target socket module. For MSP430 devices that contain user-selectable loading capacitors, see the device and crystal data sheets for the value of capacitance. 8. Crystals or resonators have no effect upon the operation of the tool and the CCS debugger or C-SPY (as any required clocking and timing is derived from the internal DCO and FLL). 9. On devices with multiplexed port or JTAG pins, to use these pin in their port capability: For CCS: "Run Free" (in Run pulldown menu at top of Debug View) must be selected. For C-SPY: "Release JTAG On Go" must be selected. 10. As an alternative to sharing the JTAG and port pins (on low pin count devices), consider using an MSP430 device that is a "superset" of the smaller device. A very powerful feature of the MSP430 is that the family members are code and architecturally compatible, so code developed on one device (for example, one without shared JTAG and port pins) ports effortlessly to another (assuming an equivalent set of peripherals). 28 Frequently Asked Questions and Known Issues SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Hardware FAQs 11. Information memory may not be blank (erased to 0xFF) when the device is delivered from TI. Customers should erase the information memory before its first use. Main memory of packaged devices is blank when the device is delivered from TI. 12. The device current is higher then expected. The device current measurement may not be accurate with the debugger connected to the device. For accurate measurement, disconnect the debugger. Additionally some unused pins of the device should be terminated. See the Connection of Unused Pins table in the device's family user's guide. 13. The following ZIF sockets are used in the FET tools and target socket modules: • 8-pin device (D package): Yamaichi IC369-0082 • 14-pin device (PW package): Enplas OTS-14-065-01 • 14-pin package for 'L092 (PW package): Yamaichi IC189-0142-146 • 24-pin package (PW package): Enplas OTS-24(28)-0.65-02 • 28-pin device (DW package): Wells-CTI 652 D028 • 28-pin device (PW package): Enplas OTS-28-0.65-01 • 38-pin device (DA package): Yamaichi IC189-0382-037 • 40-pin device (RHA package): Enplas QFN-40B-0.5-01 • 40-pin device (RSB package): Enplas QFN-40B-0.4 • 48-pin device (RGZ package): Yamaichi QFN11T048-008 A101121-001 • 48-pin device (DL package): Yamaichi IC51-0482-1163 • 64-pin device (PM package): Yamaichi IC51-0644-807 • 64-pin device (RGC package): Yamaichi QFN11T064-006 • 80-pin device (PN package): Yamaichi IC201-0804-014 • 100-pin device (PZ package): Yamaichi IC201-1004-008 • 128-pin device (PEU package): Yamaichi IC500-1284-009P Enplas: www.enplas.com Wells-CTI: www.wellscti.com Yamaichi: www.yamaichi.us SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Frequently Asked Questions and Known Issues 29 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Known Issues www.ti.com A.2 Known Issues MSP-FET430UIF Current detection algorithm of the UIF firmware Problem Description If high current is detected, the ICC monitor algorithm stays in a loop of frequently switching on and off the target power supply. This power switching puts some MSP430 devices such as the MSP430F5438 in a state that requires a power cycle to return the device to JTAG control. A side issue is that if the UIF firmware has entered this switch on and switch off loop, it is not possible to turn off the power supply to the target by calling MSP430_VCC(0). A power cycle is required to remove the device from this state. Solution IAR KickStart and Code Composer Essentials that have the MSP430.dll version 2.04.00.003 and higher do not show this problem. Update the software development tool to this version or higher to update the MSP-FET430UIF firmware. MSP-FET430PIF Some PCs do not supply 5 V through the parallel port Problem Description Device identification problems with modern PCs, because the parallel port often does not deliver 5 V as was common with earlier hardware. 1. When connected to a laptop, the test signal is clamped to 2.5 V. 2. When the external VCC becomes less than 3 V, up to 10 mA is flowing in the adapter through pin 4 (sense). Solution Measure the voltage level of the parallel port. If it is too low, provide external 5 V to the VCC pads of the interface. The jumper on a the target socket must be switched to external power. 30 Frequently Asked Questions and Known Issues SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Appendix B SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware This appendix contains information relating to the FET hardware, including schematics, PCB pictorials, and bills of materials (BOMs). All other tools, such as the eZ430 series, are described in separate productspecific user's guides. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 31 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Appendix B www.ti.com Topic ........................................................................................................................... Page B.1 MSP-TS430D8 .................................................................................................... 33 B.2 MSP-TS430PW14................................................................................................ 36 B.3 MSP-TS430L092 ................................................................................................. 39 B.4 MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable .............................................................................. 42 B.5 MSP-TS430PW24................................................................................................ 45 B.6 MSP-TS430DW28................................................................................................ 48 B.7 MSP-TS430PW28................................................................................................ 51 B.8 MSP-TS430PW28A.............................................................................................. 54 B.9 MSP-TS430RHB32A............................................................................................ 57 B.10 MSP-TS430DA38 ................................................................................................ 60 B.11 MSP-TS430QFN23x0........................................................................................... 63 B.12 MSP-TS430RSB40 .............................................................................................. 66 B.13 MSP-TS430RHA40A............................................................................................ 69 B.14 MSP-TS430DL48 ................................................................................................ 72 B.15 MSP-TS430RGZ48B ............................................................................................ 75 B.16 MSP-TS430RGZ48C ............................................................................................ 78 B.17 MSP-TS430PM64 ................................................................................................ 81 B.18 MSP-TS430PM64A.............................................................................................. 84 B.19 MSP-TS430RGC64B............................................................................................ 87 B.20 MSP-TS430RGC64C............................................................................................ 90 B.21 MSP-TS430RGC64USB ....................................................................................... 94 B.22 MSP-TS430PN80 ................................................................................................ 98 B.23 MSP-TS430PN80A ............................................................................................ 101 B.24 MSP-TS430PN80USB ........................................................................................ 104 B.25 MSP-TS430PZ100 ............................................................................................. 108 B.26 MSP-TS430PZ100A ........................................................................................... 111 B.27 MSP-TS430PZ100B ........................................................................................... 114 B.28 MSP-TS430PZ100C ........................................................................................... 117 B.29 MSP-TS430PZ100D ........................................................................................... 121 B.30 MSP-TS430PZ5x100 .......................................................................................... 124 B.31 MSP-TS430PZ100USB ....................................................................................... 127 B.32 MSP-TS430PEU128 ........................................................................................... 131 B.33 EM430F5137RF900 ........................................................................................... 134 B.34 EM430F6137RF900 ........................................................................................... 138 B.35 EM430F6147RF900 ........................................................................................... 142 B.36 MSP-FET ......................................................................................................... 146 B.37 MSP-FET430PIF................................................................................................ 157 B.38 MSP-FET430UIF ............................................................................................... 159 32 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated GND 100nF 330R 10uF/10V 47K 2.2nF GND 330R GND GND green FE4L FE4H GND Ext_PWR Socket: YAMAICHI Type: IC369-0082 Vcc ext int to measure supply current DNP 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 SBW C5 R3 C7 R5 C8 1 2 3 J3 1 2 J4 1 2 J6 1 2 3 J5 R2 D1 1 2 3 4 J1 5 6 7 8 J2 DVCC 1 DVSS 8 P1.2/TA1/A2 2 P1.5/TA0/A5/SCLK 3 P1.6/TA1/A6/SDO/SCL 4 TST/SBWTCK 7 RST/SBWTDIO 6 P1.7/A7/SDI/SDA 5 U1 MSP-TS430D8 GND VCC RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO SBWTCK VCC430 TST/SBWTCK TST/SBWTCK TST/SBWTCK P1.5 P1.6 P1.7 P1.2 Date: 28.07.201111:03:35 Sheet: /11 REV: TITLE: Document Number: MSP-TS430D8 + 1.0 MSP-TS430D8 Target Socket Board www.ti.com MSP-TS430D8 B.1 MSP-TS430D8 Figure B-1. MSP-TS430D8 Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 33 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper J4 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.2 Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device 14-pin connector for debugging in Spy-Bi-Wire mode only (4-Wire JTAG not available) Jumper J6 Open to measure current Jumper J5 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector J3 External power connector Jumper J5 to “ext” MSP-TS430D8 www.ti.com Figure B-2. MSP-TS430D8 Target Socket Module, PCB 34 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430D8 Table B-1. MSP-TS430D8 Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 J4, J6 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 2 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumper on pins 1-2 3 SBW 1 10-pin connector, male, TH HRP10H-ND 4 J3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 5 C8 1 2.2nF, CSMD0805 Buerklin 53 D 292 6 C7 1 10uF, 10V, 1210ELKO 478-3875-1-ND 7 R5 1 47K, 0805 541-47000ATR-ND 8 C5 1 100nF, CSMD0805 311-1245-2-ND 9 R2, R3 2 330R, 0805 541-330ATR-ND 10 J1, J2 2 4-pin header, TH SAM1029-04-ND DNP: headers enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 10,1 J1, J2 1 4-pin socket, TH SAM1029-04-ND DNP: receptacles enclosed with kit. 11 U1 1 SO8 Socket: Type IC369-0082 Manuf.: Yamaichi 12 D1 1 red, LED 0603 13 MSP430 2 MSP430G2210, MSP430G2230 DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI 14 PCB 1 50,0mmx44,5mm MSP-TS430D8 Rev. 1.0 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 35 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 12pF 12pF GND 100nF 330R 10uF/10V 47K 2.2nF GND 330R 100nF GND GND GND green Ext_PWR Socket: ENPLAS Type: OTS-14-065 Vcc ext int to measure supply current DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP JTAG -> SBW -> JTAG-Mode selection: 4-wire JTAG: Set jumpers J7 to J12 to position 2-3 2-wire "SpyBiWire": Set jumpers J7 to J12 to position 2-1 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG C2 C1 C5 R3 C7 R5 C8 1 2 3 J3 Q1 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 J2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 J1 1 2 J4 1 2 J6 J5 1 2 3 R2 C3 J7 1 2 3 J8 1 2 3 J9 1 2 3 J10 1 2 3 J11 1 2 3 J12 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 14 13 12 11 D1 P1.0 P1.3 P1.2 P1.1 XOUT XOUT GND XIN XIN VCC RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK VCC430 P1.4/TCK P1.4/TCK P1.5/TMS P1.5/TMS P1.6/TDI P1.6/TDI P1.7/TDO P1.7/TDO TDO/SBWTDIO RST/NMI TMS TDI Date: 7/16/2007 8:22:36 AM Sheet: 1/1 REV: TITLE: Document Number: MSP-TS430PW14 + 2.0 MSP-TS430PW14 Target Socket Board MSP-TS430PW14 www.ti.com B.2 MSP-TS430PW14 Figure B-3. MSP-TS430PW14 Target Socket Module, Schematic 36 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper J4 Open to disconnect LED Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper J6 Open to measure current Connector J3 External power connector D1 Jumper J5 to "ext" LED connected to P1.0 Jumpers J7 to J12 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode. Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode. Jumper J5 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool www.ti.com MSP-TS430PW14 Figure B-4. MSP-TS430PW14 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 37 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PW14 www.ti.com Table B-2. MSP-TS430PW14 Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C7 1 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size 511-1463-2-ND B 3 C3, C5 1 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND DNP: C3 4 C8 0 2.2nF, SMD0805 DNP 5 D1 1 green LED, SMD0603 475-1056-2-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of 6 J1, J2 0 7-pin header, TH solder SAM1029-07-ND : Header SAM1213-07-ND : Receptacle J3, J5, J7, Place jumpers on headers J5, J7, J8, 7 J8, J9, J10, 8 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND J9, J10, J11, J12; Pos 1-2 J11, J12 8 J4, J6 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 9 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: J5, J7-J12; Pos 1-2 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K 12 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = DNP: keep vias free of solder 12.5pF 13 R2, R3 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND 15 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 16 U1 1 Socket: OTS-14-0.65-01 Manuf.: Enplas 17 PCB 1 56 x 53 mm 2 layers Adhesive Approximately 6mm For example, 3M 18 plastic feet 4 width, 2mm height Bumpons Part No. SJ- Apply to corners at bottom side 5302 19 MSP430 2 MSP430F2013IPW DNP: enclosed with kit, supplied by TI 38 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430L092 B.3 MSP-TS430L092 Figure B-5. MSP-TS430L092 Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 39 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J3 External power connector Jumper JP3 Open to measure current Jumper JP1 Write enable for EPROM Orient pin 1 of MSP430 device MSP-TS430L092 www.ti.com Settings of the MSP-TS430L092 Target Socket Figure B-6 shows the PCB layout of the MSP-TS430L092 target socket. The following pinning is recommended: • JP1 is write enable for the EPROM. If this is not set, the EPROM can only be read. • JP2 and JP3 connect device supply with boost converter. They can be opened to measure device current consumption. For default operation, they should be closed. Figure B-6. MSP-TS430L092 Target Socket Module, PCB 40 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430L092 Table B-3. MSP-TS430L092 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 2 330nF, SMD0603 2 C5 1 100n, SMD0603 3 C6 1 10u, SMD0805 4 C10 1 100n, SMD0603 5 EEPROM1 1 M95512 SO08 (SO8) ST Micro M95160R Digikey: 497-8688-1-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 7 J1, J2 2 7-pin header, TH Keep vias free of solder. SAM1213-07-ND : Header SAM1035-07-ND : Receptacle 8 J3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 9 J4, J5 2 FE4L, FE4H 4 pol. Stiftreihe DNP; Keep vias free of solder. 11 J13 1 MICRO_STECKV_10 Reichelt: MicroMaTch- Connector: MM FL 10G 12 JP1, JP2,JP3 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 15 L1 1 33uH, SMD0806 LQH2MCN330K02L Farnell: 151-5557 16 LED1, LED4 2 LEDCHIPLED_0603 Farnell: 1686065 17 Q2 1 BC817-16LT1SMD BC817-16LT1SMD SOT23-BEC 18 R0, R6, R7 3 2K7, SMD0603 19 R1 1 1k, SMD0603 20 R2 1 47k, SMD0603 21 R4,R5, R8, 6 10k, SMD0603 R10, RC, RD 22 RA 1 3.9k, SMD0603 23 RB 1 6.8k, SMD0603 24 U1 1 14 Pin Socket - IC189-0142- Manuf. Yamaichi 146 22 MSP430 2 MSP430L092PWR DNP: Enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 41 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable www.ti.com B.4 MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Figure B-7. MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Target Socket Module, Schematic 42 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool JP2 JP1 www.ti.com MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Figure B-8 shows the PCB layout for the Active Cable. The following pinning is possible: • JP1 has two jumpers (Jumper 1 and Jumper 2) that can be set as shown in Table B-4. Table B-4. MSP-TS430L092 JP1 Settings Jumper 1 Jumper 2 Description Off Off The active cable has no power and does not function. Off On The active cable receives power from target socket. For this option, the target socket must have its own power supply. On Off The active cable receives power from the JTAG connector. The JTAG connector powers the active cable and the target socket. For On On this option, the target socket must not have its own power source, as this would cause a not defined state. • JP2 is for reset. For the standard MSP-TS430L092, this jumper must be set. It sets the reset pin to high and can also control it. Without this jumper on the MSP-TS430L092, reset is set to zero. Figure B-8. MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 43 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable www.ti.com Table B-5. MSP-TS430L092 Active Cable Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C3, C5, 4 100nF, SMD0603 C6 2 C2, C4 2 1uF, SMD0805 3 R1, R10 2 10K, SMD0603 4 R2 1 4K7, SMD0603 5 R5, R6, R7, 4 100, SMD0603 R9 6 R8 1 680k, SMD0603 7 R11, R15 2 1K, SMD0603 8 R12 0 SMD0603 DNP 9 R13 0 SMD0603 DNP 10 R14 1 0, SMD0603 11 IC1 1 SN74AUC1G04DBVR Manu: TI 12 IC2, IC3, IC4 3 SN74AUC2G125DCTR Manu: TI 13 J2 1 MICRO_STECKV_10 Reichelt: MicroMaTch- Connector: MM FL 10G 14 JP1 1 2x2 Header JP2Q Put jumper on Position 1 and 2. Do not mix direction. 15 JP2 1 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 16 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 17 Q1 1 BC817-25LT1SMD, SOT23- Digi-Key: BC817- BEC 25LT1GOSCT-ND 18 U1, U2 2 TLVH431IDBVR SOT23-5 Manu: TI 44 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PW24 B.5 MSP-TS430PW24 Figure B-9. MSP-TS430PW24 Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 45 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP3 Open to disconnect LED Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP1 to "ext" Jumpers JP4 to JP9 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool MSP-TS430PW24 www.ti.com Figure B-10. MSP-TS430PW24 Target Socket Module, PCB 46 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PW24 Table B-6. MSP-TS430PW24 Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C5 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 3 C3, C7 2 10uF, 10V, SMD0805 4 C4, C6, C8 3 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 5 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND SAM1029-07- DNP: Headers and receptacles 6 J1, J2 0 12-pin header, TH NDSAM1213-07-ND enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. (Header and Receptacle) J5, JP1, 7 JP4, JP5, 8 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on 1-2 of JP4-JP9 JP6, JP7, Place on 1-2 on JP1 JP8, JP9 8 JP2, JP3 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 9 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND see Pos 7 an 8 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH 11 Q1 0 Crystal DNP: keep vias free of solder 12 R1, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND 13 R5, R6, 2 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP R5, R6 R8, R9, 14 R4 1 47k Ohm, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 15 U1 1 Socket: OTS 24(28)- Manuf.: Enplas 065-02-00 16 PCB 1 68.5 x 61 mm 2 layers Adhesive Approximately 6mm for example, 3M 17 plastic feet 4 width, 2mm height Bumpons Part No. SJ- Apply to corners at bottom side 5302 18 MSP430 2 MSP430AFE2xx DNP: enclosed with kit, supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 47 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated ML14 LED3 12pF 12pF GND GND 100nF 560R ML10 JP1Q JP1Q 10uF/10V 50K 10nF 0R 0R 0R - - 0R - U1 SOCK28DW F123 FE14H FE14L 0R GND remove R8 and add R9 (0 Ohm) If external supply voltage: remove R11 and add R10 (0 Ohm) SMD-Footprint Socket: Yamaichi 2.0 MSP-TS430DW28 Target Socket DW28 Type: IC189-0282-042 If external supply voltage: R1, C1, C2 not assembled not assembled 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG D1 C2 C1 C5 R3 BOOTST 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 J5 J4 1 2 C7 R5 C8 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 TST 1 VCC 2 P2.5 3 VSS 4 XOUT 5 XIN 6 RST 7 P2.0 8 P2.1 9 P2.2 10 P2.3 19 P2.4 20 P1.0 21 P1.1 22 P1.2 23 P1.3 24 P1.4 25 P1.5 26 P1.6 27 P1.7 28 P3.0 11 P3.1 12 P3.2 13 P3.3 14 P3.4 15 P3.5 16 P3.6 17 P3.7 18 U2 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 J2 J1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 R2 1 2 3 J3 Q1 QUARZ3 P1.0 P1.0 P1.3 P1.3 P1.2 P1.2 P1.1 P1.1 RST/NMI RST/NMI RST/NMI RST/NMI RST/NMI TCK TCK TCK TMS TMS TMS TDI TDI TDI TDO TDO TDO XOUT XOUT VCC GND GND GND P2.3 P2.3 P2.4 P2.4 XIN XIN P2.5 P2.5 P2.2 P2.2 P2.1 P2.1 P2.0 P2.0 TST/VPP TST/VPP TST/VPP P3.0 P3.0 P3.1 P3.1 P3.2 P3.2 P3.3 P3.3 P3.7 P3.7 P3.6 P3.6 P3.5 P3.5 P3.4 P3.4 VCC430 Ext_PWR Date: 11/14/2006 1:26:04 PM Sheet: 1/1 REV: TITLE: Document Number: MSP-TS430DW28 + VCC430 MSP-TS430DW28 www.ti.com B.6 MSP-TS430DW28 Figure B-11. MSP-TS430DW28 Target Socket Module, Schematic 48 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper J4 Open to disconnect LED Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper J5 Open to measure current Connector J3 External power connector Remove R8 and jumper R9 D1 LED connected to P1.0 Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool www.ti.com MSP-TS430DW28 Figure B-12. MSP-TS430DW28 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 49 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430DW28 www.ti.com Table B-7. MSP-TS430DW28 Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2, Cover holes while soldering 2 C5 1 100nF, SMD0805 3 C7 1 10uF, 10V Tantal Elko B 4 C8 1 10nF SMD0805 5 D1 1 LED3 T1 3mm yellow RS: 228-4991 Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K 6 Q1 0 QUARZ, Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = DNP: Cover holes while soldering 12.5pF DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of 7 J1, J2 2 14-pin header, TH male solder. : Header : Receptacle DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of 7.1 2 14-pin header, TH solder. female : Header : Receptacle 8 J3 1 3-Pin Connector, male 9 J4, J5 2 2-Pin Connector, male With jumper 10 BOOTST 0 ML10, 10-Pin Conn., m RS: 482-115 DNP, Cover holes while soldering 11 JTAG 1 ML14, 14-Pin Conn., m RS: 482-121 R1, R2, 12 R6, R7, 4 0R, SMD0805 DNP: R1, R2, R9, R10 R8,R9, R10, R11 13 R3 1 560R, SMD0805 14 R5 1 47K, SMD0805 15 U1 1 SOP28DW socket Yamaichi: IC189-0282- 042 16 U2 0 TSSOP DNP 50 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 12pF 12pF GND GND 100nF 330R 10uF/10V - 0R GND GND green 2.2nF 47k GND 0R 0R 330R MSP430F12xx If external supply voltage: remove R11 and add R10 (0 Ohm) 3.1 MSP-TS430PW28: OTS-28-0.65-01 Socket: Enplas Vcc int ext Target Socket Board for MSP430's in PW28 package DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP JTAG -> SBW -> JTAG-Mode selection: 4-wire JTAG: Set jumpers JP4 to JP9 to position 2-3 2-wire "SpyBiWire": Set jumpers JP4 to JP9 to position 1-2 DNP 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG C2 C1 C4 R1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 BOOTST C3 R2 R3 1 2 3 J5 JP1 1 2 3 JP2 1 2 1 2 JP3 D1 C5 R4 JP4 1 2 3 JP5 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP8 1 2 3 JP9 1 2 3 R5 R6 1 2 Q1 R7 J1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 J2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 U1 TST 1 VCC 2 P2.5 3 VSS 4 XOUT 5 XIN 6 RST 7 P2.0 8 P2.1 9 P2.2 10 P2.3 19 P2.4 20 P1.0 21 P1.1 22 P1.2 23 P1.3 24 P1.4 25 P1.5 26 P1.6 27 P1.7 28 P3.0 11 P3.1 12 P3.2 13 P3.3 14 P3.4 15 P3.5 16 P3.6 17 P3.7 18 P1.0 P1.0 RST/NMI TMS TDI VCC GND GND VCC430 VCC430 P2.0 P1.1 P1.1 P3.3 P3.2 P3.1 P3.0 P2.2 P2.2 XIN/P2.6 XIN/P2.6 XOUT/P2.7 XOUT/P2.7 P2.1 RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO P3.4 P3.5 P3.6 P3.7 P2.3 P2.4 P1.2 P1.3 P1.4/TCK P1.4/TCK P1.5/TMS P1.5/TMS P1.6/TDI P1.6/TDI P1.7/TDO P1.7/TDO TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK P2.5 TCK/SBWTCK TDO/SBWTDIO XTLGND Ext_PWR + www.ti.com MSP-TS430PW28 B.7 MSP-TS430PW28 Figure B-13. MSP-TS430PW28 Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 51 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Jumper JP3 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P5.1 Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumper JP4 to JP9: Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP1 to “ext” MSP-TS430PW28 www.ti.com Figure B-14. MSP-TS430PW28 Target Socket Module, PCB 52 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PW28 Table B-8. MSP-TS430PW28 Bill of Materials(1) Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 , Cover holes while soldering 2 C3 1 10uF, 10V Tantal Elko B 3 C4 1 100nF, SMD0805 4 C5 0 2.2nF, SMD0805 DNP 5 D1 1 LED green SMD0603 Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Cover holes and 6 Q1 0 QUARZ, Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = neighboring holes while 12.5pF soldering DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with 7 J1, J2 2 14-pin header, TH male kit.Keep vias free of solder. : Header : Receptacle DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with 7.1 2 14-pin header, TH female kit.Keep vias free of solder. : Header : Receptacle 8 J5, IP1 1 3-Pin Connector , male JP1, JP4, 8a JP5, JP6, 7 3-Pin Connector , male Jumper on Pos 1-2 JP7, JP8, JP9 9 JP2, JP3 2 2-Pin Connector , male with Jumper 10 BOOTST 0 ML10, 10-Pin Conn. , m RS: 482-115 DNP: Cover holes while soldering 11 JTAG 1 ML14, 14-Pin Conn. , m RS: 482-121 12 R1, R7 2 330R, SMD0805 12 R2, R3, R5, 0 0R, SMD0805 DNP R6 14 R4 1 47K, SMD0805 15 U1 1 SOP28PW socket Enplas: OTS-28-0.65-01 (1) PCB 66 x 79 mm, two layers; Rubber stand off, four pieces SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 53 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated JTAG Mode selection: 4-wire JTAG: Set jumpers J4 to J9 to position 2-3 2-wire "SpyBiWire": Set jumpers J4 to J9 to position 2-1 MSP-TS430PW28A www.ti.com B.8 MSP-TS430PW28A Figure B-15. MSP-TS430PW28A Target Socket Module, Schematic 54 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper JP3 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP1 to "ext" Jumpers JP4 to JP9 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply www.ti.com MSP-TS430PW28A Figure B-16. MSP-TS430PW28A Target Socket Module, PCB (Red) SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 55 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PW28A www.ti.com Table B-9. MSP-TS430PW28A Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C5 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 3 C3 1 10uF, 10V, SMD0805 4 C4, C6, 2 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 5 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles 6 J1, J2 0 14-pin header, TH enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder: (Header and Receptacle) J5, JP1, 7 JP4, JP5, 8 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on 1-2 of JP4-JP9 JP6, JP7, Place on 1-2 on JP1 JP8, JP9 8 JP2, JP3 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 9 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND see Pos 7 an 8 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH 11 BOOTST 0 DNP Keep vias free of solder Micro Crystal MS3V 12 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = DNP: keep vias free of solder 12.5pF 13 R1, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND 14 R2, R3,R5, 0 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP R2, R3,R5, R6 R6, 15 R4 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 16 U1 1 Socket: OTS-28-0.65-01 Manuf.: Enplas 17 PCB 1 63.5 x 64.8 mm 2 layers Adhesive Approximately 6mm for example, 3M 18 plastic feet 4 width, 2mm height Bumpons Part No. SJ- Apply to corners at bottom side 5302 19 MSP430 2 MSP430G2553IPW28 DNP: enclosed with kit, supplied by TI 56 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP GND 0R 330R 2.2nF PWR3 GND GND 0R 47K 470nF 100nF 10uF 100nF GND GND 20k/0.1% 10k 10k 10k 10k GND AVSS AVSS 10k 10k 10k 10k GND SAM1029-08-ND1-8 SAM1029-08-ND9-16 MSP430I2040TRHBQFN11T032-003 SAM1029-08-ND17-2417-24 SAM1029-08-ND25-32 1.0 for MSP430i2040 MSP430: Target-Socket MSP-TS430RHB32A DNP <- SBW <- JTAG Vcc int ext Socket: Yamaichi QFN11T032-003 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG R1 R3 C8 J5 1 2 3 1 JP1 2 1 2 JP2 R4 1 2 3 JP4 1 2 3 JP9 1 2 3 JP8 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP5 R5 D1 C9 1 2 3 JP3 C14 C12 C13 R2 R6 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13 R14 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J1 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 J2 A0.0+ 1 A0.0- 2 A1.0+ 3 A1.0- 4 A2.0+ 5 A2.0- 6 A3.0+ 7 A3.0- 8 VREF 9 AVSS 10 ROSC 11 DVSS 12 VCC 13 VCORE 14 P2.3/VMONIN 28 P2.2/TA1.2 27 P2.1/TA1.1 26 P2.0/TA1.0/CLKIN 25 P1.7/UCB0SDA/UCB0SIMO/TA1CLK 24 P1.6/UCB0SCL/UCB0SOMI/TA0.2 23 P1.5/UCB0CLK/TA0.1 22 P1.4/UCB0STE/TA0.0 21 P1.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO/TA0CLK/TDO/TDI 20 P1.2/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI/ACLK/TDI/TCLK 19 P1.1/UCA0CLK/SMCLK/TMS 18 P1.0/UCA0STE/MCLK/TCK 17 TEST/SBWTCK 16 RST/NMI/SBWTDIO 15 U1 P2.4/TA1.0 29 P2.5/TA0.0 30 P2.6/TA0.1 31 P2.7/TA0.2 32 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 J3 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 J4 TMS TMS TDI TDI TDO TDO TDO VCC GND GND P1.4 P1.4 DVCC DVCC DVCC AVSS M M I I O O RST/NMI RST/NMI TCK TCK TCK C TEST/SBWTCK C TEST/SBWTCK VCORE A0.0+ A0.0- A1.0+ A1.0- VREF ROSC RST RST RST A2.0+ A2.0- A3.0+ A3.0- P1.5 P1.6 P1.7 P2.0 P2.1 P2.2 P2.3 P2.4 P2.5 P2.6 P2.7 www.ti.com MSP-TS430RHB32A B.9 MSP-TS430RHB32A Figure B-17. MSP-TS430RHB32A Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 57 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device D1 LED connected to P1.4 Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to “ext” Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Jumper JP4 to JP9 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 3-4 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED P1.4 14 1 2 GND GND VCC 1 2 3 3 2 1 8 5 1 16 9 17 20 24 25 30 32 Vcc ext int MSP-TS430RHB32A Rev.: 1.0 RoHS SBW JTAG 1 Curr. Meas. JTAG R1 R3 C8 J5 JP1 JP2 R4 JP4 JP9 JP8 JP7 JP6 JP5 R5 D1 C9 JP3 C14 C13 C12 R2 R6 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13 R14 J1 J2 U1 J3 J4 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 MSP-TS430RHB32A www.ti.com Figure B-18. MSP-TS430RHB32A Target Socket Module, PCB 58 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RHB32A Table B-10. MSP-TS430RHB32A Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 PCB 1 76.9 x 67.6 mm MSP-TS430RHB32A Rev. 2 layers, red solder mask 1 2 D1 1 green LED, DIODE0805 P516TR-ND 3 JP1, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 4 JP3, JP4, 7 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumpers on pins 1-2 JP5, JP6, (SBW) JP7, JP8, JP9 5 R1, R4 2 0R, 0805 541-0.0ATR-ND 6 C8 1 2.2nF, CSMD0805 490-1628-2-ND DNP 7 R6, R8, R9, 8 10k, 0805 311-10KARTR-ND DNP R10, R11, R12, R13, R14 8 C12 1 10uF, CSMD0805 445-1371-2-ND 9 R2 1 20k/0.1%, 0805 P20KDACT-ND 10 R5 1 47K, 0805 311-47KARTR-ND 11 C13, C14 2 100nF, CSMD0805 311-1245-2-ND 12 R3 1 330R, 0805 541-330ATR-ND 13 C9 1 470nF, CSMD0805 445-1357-2-ND 14 J1, J2, J3, 1 8-pin header, TH SAM1029-08-ND DNP: headers and J4 receptacles, enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 15 J1, J2, J3, 1 8-pin receptable, TH SAM1213-08-ND DNP: headers and J4 receptacles, enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 16 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 17 U1 1 Socket QFN11T032-003 Manuf.: Yamaichi 18 U1 1 MSP430i2041TRHB DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI 19 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 20 Rubber 4 Buerklin: 20H1724 apply to corners at bottom stand off side SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 59 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 12pF 12pF GND GND 100nF 560R 10uF/10V 47k 10nF - 0R GND MSP430F2274IDA GND 330R GND yellow If external supply voltage: remove R11 and add R10 (0 Ohm) IC189-0382-037 Socket: 4-wire JTAG: 2-wire "SpyBiWire": JTAG-Mode selection: Set jumpers JP4 to JP9 to position 2-3 Set jumpers JP4 to JP9 to position 2-1 JTAG -> SBW -> Yamaichi DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG C2 C1 C5 R3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 BOOTST C7 R5 C8 R10 R11 1 2 3 J3 Q1 TEST/SBWTCK 1 P3.5 26 P3.6 27 P1.4/TCK 35 RST/SBWDAT 7 DVCC 2 DVSS 4 P4.7 24 P3.7 28 AVSS 15 AVCC 16 P3.0 11 P3.1 12 P3.2 13 P3.3 14 P4.0 17 P4.1 18 P4.2 19 P3.4 25 P2.5 3 P2.4 30 P2.3 29 P2.2 10 P2.1 9 P2.0 8 P1.5/TMS 36 P1.6/TDI 37 P1.7/TDO 38 P2.7 5 P2.6 6 P4.6 23 P4.5 22 P4.4 21 P4.3 20 P1.0 31 P1.1 32 P1.2 33 P1.3 34 U1 JP1 1 2 3 JP2 1 2 1 2 JP3 1 2 3 JP4 JP5 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP8 1 2 3 R1 JP9 1 2 3 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1 J1 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 20 J2 D1 P1.0 P1.0 RST/NMI TMS TDI VCC GND GND GND VCC430 VCC430 VCC430 TCK/SBWTCK TDO/SBWTDIO TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK P2.5 P2.0 P2.1 P3.0 P3.1 P3.2 P3.3 P4.0 P4.1 P4.2 P1.7/TDO P1.7/TDO P1.6/TDI P1.6/TDI P1.5/TMS P1.5/TMS P1.4/TCK P1.4/TCK P1.3 P1.2 P1.1 P1.1 P2.4 P2.3 P3.7 P3.6 P3.5 P3.4 P4.7 P4.6 P4.5 P4.4 P4.3 P2.7/XOUT P2.7/XOUT P2.6/XIN P2.6/XIN RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO P2.2 P2.2 Ext_PWR Date: 6/18/2008 11:04:56 AM Sheet: 1/1 REV: TITLE: Document Number: MSP-TS430DA38 + 1.3 MSP-TS430DA38: Vcc int ext Target Socket Board for MSP430F2247IDA MSP-TS430DA38 www.ti.com B.10 MSP-TS430DA38 Figure B-19. MSP-TS430DA38 Target Socket Module, Schematic 60 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Orient pin 1 of MSP430 device D1 LED connected to P1.0 Connector J3 External power connector Jumper JP1 to "ext" Jumper JP3 Open to disconnect LED Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Jumpers JP4 to JP9 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool www.ti.com MSP-TS430DA38 Figure B-20. MSP-TS430DA38 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 61 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430DA38 www.ti.com Table B-11. MSP-TS430DA38 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C7 1 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 3 C5 1 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 4 C8 0 2.2nF, SMD0805 DNP 5 D1 1 green LED, SMD0603 475-1056-2-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with 6 J1, J2 0 19-pin header, TH kit.Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-19-ND : Header SAM1213-19-ND : Receptacle "J3, JP1, Place jumpers on headers 7 JP4, JP5, 8 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP1, JP4,JP5, JP6, JP7, JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9; Pos 1-2 JP8, JP9" 8 JP2, JP3 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 9 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: JP1 - JP9; Pos 1- 2 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 11 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Keep vias free of 12 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 13 R1, R3 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND 14 R10, R11 0 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP 15 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 16 U1 1 Socket: IC189-0382--037 Manuf.: Yamaichi 17 PCB 1 67 x 66 mm 2 layers 18 Adhesive 4 ~6mm width, 2mm height for example, 3M Bumpons Apply to corners at bottom Plastic feet Part No. SJ-5302 side 19 MSP430 2 MSP430F2274IDA DNP: enclosed with kit supplied by TI 62 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430QFN23x0 B.11 MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Figure B-21. MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 63 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated D1 LED connected to P1.0 Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP1 to "ext" Jumper JP3 Open to disconnect LED Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device MSP-TS430QFN23x0 www.ti.com Figure B-22. MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Target Socket Module, PCB 64 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Table B-12. MSP-TS430QFN23x0 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C3 1 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 3 C4 1 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 4 C5 1 10nF, SMD0805 478-1383-2-ND 5 D1 1 green LED, SMD0603 475-1056-2-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with 6 J1, J2, J3, 0 10-pin header, TH kit.Keep vias free of solder. J4 SAM1034-10-ND : Header SAM1212-10-ND : Receptacle 7 J5, JP1 2 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on header JP1; Pos 1-2. 8 JP2, JP3 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 3 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 11 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Keep vias free of 12 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 13 R1 1 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND 14 R2, R3 0 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP 15 R4 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 16 U1 1 Socket: QFN-40B-0.5-01 Manuf.: Enplas 17 PCB 1 79 x 66 mm 2 layers 18 Adhesive 4 ~6mm width, 2mm height for example, 3M Bumpons Apply to corners at bottom Plastic feet Part No. SJ-5302 side 19 MSP430 2 MSP430F2370IRHA DNP: enclosed with kit supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 65 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430RSB40 www.ti.com B.12 MSP-TS430RSB40 Figure B-23. MSP-TS430RSB40 Target Socket Module, Schematic 66 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper JP3 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumpers JP4 to JP9 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP1 to "ext" Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply www.ti.com MSP-TS430RSB40 Figure B-24. MSP-TS430RSB40 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 67 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430RSB40 www.ti.com Table B-13. MSP-TS430RSB40 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 2 C3, C7, C10, 3 10uF, 10V, SMD 0805 445-1371-1-ND DNP C12 C12 3 C4, C6, C8, 3 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND DNP C11 C11 4 C5 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 7 J1, J2, J3, J4 4 10-pin header, TH Keep vias free of solder. : Header : Receptacle DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 7.1 4 10-pin header, TH Keep vias free of solder. : Header : Receptacle JP1, JP4,JP5, Jumper: 1-2 on JP1, JP10; 2- 8 JP6, JP7, 9 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 3 on JP4-JP9 JP8, JP9, J5, JP10 9 JP2, JP3 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 11 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP. Keep vias free of solder 12 U1 1 QFN-40B-0.4_ Enplas ENPLAS_SOCKET Micro Crystal MS3V-T1R DNP: Q1. Keep vias free of 13 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3, 15 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND JP4, JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 16 R1,R7 2 330R SMD0805 R2, R3, R5, 17 R6, R8, R9, 3 0R SMD0805 DNP R2, R3, R5, R6 R10 18 R4 1 47k SMD0805 19 MSP430 2 MSP430F5132 DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI 20 Rubber stand 4 select appropriate; for apply to corners at bottom off example, Buerklin: 20H1724 side 68 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RHA40A B.13 MSP-TS430RHA40A Figure B-25. MSP-TS430RHA40A Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 69 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP1 to "ext" Jumpers JP4 to JP9 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP3 Open to disconnect LED Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool MSP-TS430RHA40A www.ti.com Figure B-26. MSP-TS430RHA40A Target Socket Module, PCB 70 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RHA40A Table B-14. MSP-TS430RHA40A Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 2 C5 0 2.2nF, SMD0805 DNP C12 3 C3, C7 2 10uF, 10V, SMD0805 5 DNP C11 4 C4, C6 2 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of 7 J1, J2, J3, 4 10-pin header, TH solder. J4 : Header : Receptacle DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of 7.1 4 10-pin header, TH solder. : Header : Receptacle J5, JP1, 8 JP4, JP5, 8 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on 1-2 of JP4-JP9; JP6, JP7, Place on 1-2 on JP1 JP8, JP9 9 JP2, JP3 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 10 9 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND see Pos 8 an 9 11 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH 12 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, DNP. Keep vias free of solder TH 13 U1 1 Socket: QFN-40B-0.5-01 Manuf.: Enplas Micro Crystal MS3V-T1R 14 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = DNP: Q1. Keep vias free of solder 12.5pF 15 R1,R7 2 330R SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R2, R3, 16 R5, R6, 2 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP:R2, R3, R5, R6 R8, R9, 17 R4 1 47k SMD0805 18 PCB 1 79 x 66 mm 2 layers Rubber select appropriate; for 19 stand off 4 example, Buerklin: apply to corners at bottom side 20H1724 20 MSP430 2 MSP430N5736IRHA DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 71 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated ML14 LED3 12pF 12pF GND GND 100nF 560R ML10 JP1Q JP1Q 10uF/10V 47K 10nF 0R 0R GND 0R 0R 10uF/10V GND IC51-1387.KS-15186 100nF 1.3 MSP-TS430DL48 Target Socket DL48 Q1, C1, C2 not assembled 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG D1 C2 C1 C5 R3 BOOTST 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 J5 J4 1 2 C7 R5 C8 R6 R7 1 2 3 J3 Q1 QUARZ3 J2 1 3 5 2 4 6 7 9 8 10 11 13 15 12 14 16 17 19 18 20 21 23 22 24 1 3 5 2 4 6 7 9 8 10 11 13 15 12 14 16 17 19 18 20 21 23 22 24 J1 R12 R4 JP1 1 2 3 1 2 3 JP2 C4 U1 TDO/TDI 1 TDI/TCLK 2 TMS 3 TCK 4 RST/NMI 5 DVCC 6 DVSS 7 XIN 8 XOUT 9 AVSS 10 AVCC 11 VREF+ 12 P6.0 13 P6.1 14 P6.2 15 P6.3 16 P6.4 17 P6.5 18 P6.6 19 P6.7 20 P2.5 39 P2.4 40 P2.3 41 P2.2 42 P2.1 43 P2.0 44 COM0 45 P5.2 46 P5.3 47 P5.4 48 LCDREF 29 LCDCAP 30 P5.1 31 P5.0 32 P5.5 33 P5.6 34 P5.7 35 S5 36 P2.7 37 P2.6 38 P1.7 21 P1.6 22 P1.5 23 P1.4 24 P1.0 28 P1.1 27 P1.2 26 P1.3 25 C3 P1.0 P1.0 RST/NMI RST/NMI RST/NMI TCK TCK TCK TMS TMS TDI TDI TDO TDO XOUT XOUT GND GND GND XIN XIN BSL_TX VCC BSL_RX Ext_PWR Date: 11/14/2006 1:24:44 PM Sheet: 1/1 REV: TITLE: Document Number: MSP-TS430DL48 + + Vcc ext int int ext Vcc MSP-TS430DL48 www.ti.com B.14 MSP-TS430DL48 Figure B-27. MSP-TS430DL48 Target Socket Module, Schematic 72 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper J4 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Orient pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper J5 Open to measure current Connector J3 External power connector Jumper JP2 to "ext" Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP2 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply www.ti.com MSP-TS430DL48 Figure B-28. MSP-TS430DL48 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 73 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430DL48 www.ti.com Table B-15. MSP-TS430DL48 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C4, C7 2 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 3 C3, C5 2 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 4 C8 1 10nF, SMD0805 478-1383-2-ND 5 D1 1 yellow LED, TH, 3mm, T1 511-1251-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with 6 J1, J2 0 24-pin header, TH kit.Keep vias free of solder. SAM1034-12-ND : Header SAM1212-12-ND : Receptacle 7 J3, JP1, JP2 2 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on header JP1; Pos 1-2. DNP: JP2 8 J4, J5 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 3 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: JP1, J4, J5 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 11 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Keep vias free of 12 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 13 R3 1 560 Ω, SMD0805 541-560ATR-ND 14 R4, R6, R7, 2 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R6, R7 R12 15 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 16 U1 1 Socket: IC51-1387 KS- Manuf.: Yamaichi 15186 17 PCB 1 58 x 66 mm 2 layers 18 Adhesive 4 ~6mm width, 2mm height for example, 3M Bumpons Apply to corners at bottom Plastic feet Part No. SJ-5302 side 19 MSP430 2 MSP430F4270IDL DNP: Enclosed with kit supplied by TI 74 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGZ48B B.15 MSP-TS430RGZ48B Figure B-29. MSP-TS430RGZ48B Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 75 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply MSP-TS430RGZ48B www.ti.com Figure B-30. MSP-TS430RGZ48B Target Socket Module, PCB 76 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGZ48B Table B-16. MSP-TS430RGZ48B Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C3, C4 0 47pF, SMD0805 DNP 3 C6, C7, 3 10uF, 6.3V, SMD0805 C12 4 C5, C11, 4 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C13, C14 5 C8 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 6 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 7 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND J1, J2, J3, SAM1029-12-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles 8 J4 0 12-pin header, TH (Header) SAM1213-12- enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of ND (Receptacle) solder: 9 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH JP3, JP5, place jumpers on pins 2-3 on JP5, 10 JP6, JP7, 7 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 place JP8, JP9, jumpers on pins 1-2 on JP3, JP10 11 JP1, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 12 9 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND See Pos. 10and Pos. 11 13 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH 14 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, "DNP Keep vias free of solder" TH Micro Crystal MS3V-T1R 15 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = DNP: Q1 Keep vias free of solder 12.5pF 16 Q2 0 Crystal Q2: 4MHz Buerklin: DNP: Q2 Keep vias free of solder 78D134 Insulating http://www.ettinger.de/Ar 17 disk to Q2 0 Insulating disk to Q2 t_Detail.cfm?ART_ART NUM=70.08.121 18 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, R6, 19 R8, 3 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R6, R8, R9, R10, R11,R12 R9,R10, R11, R12 20 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 21 U1 1 Socket: QFN11T048- Manuf.: Yamaichi 008_A101121_RGZ48 22 PCB 1 81 x 76 mm 2 layers Adhesive Approximately 6mm for example, 3M 23 plastic feet 4 width, 2mm height Bumpons Part No. SJ- Apply to corners at bottom side 5302 24 MSP430 2 MSP430F5342IRGZ DNP: enclosed with kit, supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 77 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated DNP DNP DNP GND GND 100nF 330R 0R - GND GND 47k 1.1nF GND 0R 0R 0R 1uF/10V QUARZ5 1uF/10V 100nF green DNP yellow (DNP) DNP red (DNP) 0R GND DNP DNP 0R 0R QUARZ5 EVQ11 0R DNP DNP If external supply voltage: remove R3 and add R2 (0 Ohm) 1.3 Ext_PWR MSP-TS430RGZ48C Vcc int ext Target Socket Board for MSP430FR58xx, FR59xx IRGZ DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP JTAG -> SBW -> JTAG-Mode selection: 4-wire JTAG: Set jumpers JP3 to JP8 to position 2-3 2-wire "SpyBiWire": Set jumpers JP3 to JP8 to position 1-2 connection by via DNP DNP 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG C2 C1 C4 R1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 BOOTST R3 R2 1 2 3 J2 J1 1 2 3 JP1 1 2 1 2 JP9 R4 C5 1 2 3 JP3 1 2 3 JP4 1 2 3 JP5 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP8 R5 R6 R7 C3 Q1 C7 C6 D1 R10 1 2 JP10 D2 R11 1 2 JP11 D3 R12 JP2 1 2 C8 C9 R9 R8 Q2 SV4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 SV1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 SV2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 SV3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 1_P1.0 2 2_P1.1 3 3_P1.2 4 4_P3.0 5 5_P3.1 6 6_P3.2 7 7_P3.3 8 8_P4.7 9 9_P1.3 10 10_P1.4 11 11_P1.5 12 12_PJ.0_TDO 13 13_PJ.1_TDI 14 14_PJ.2_TMS 15 15_PJ.3/TCK 16 16_P4.0 17 17_P4.1 18 18_P4.2 19 19_P4.3 20 20_P2.5 21 21_P2.6 22 22_TEST/SBWTCK 23 23_RST/SBWTDIO 24 24_P2.0 25_P2.1 25 26_P2.2 26 27_P3.4 27 28_P3.5 28 29_P3.6 29 30_P3.7 30 31_P1.6 31 32_P1.7 32 33_P4.4 33 34_P4.5 34 35_P4.6 35 36_DVSS 36 37_DVCC 37 38_P2.7 38 39_P2.3 39 40_P2.4 40 41_AVSS 41 42_HFXIN 42 43_HFXOUT 43 44_AVSS 44 45_LFXIN 45 46_LFXOUT 46 47_AVSS 47 48_AVCC 48 U1 SW1 R13 TP1TP2 SW2 R14 P1.0 P1.0 RST/NMI TMS TDI VCC GND P1.1 P1.1 RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO TCK/SBWTCK TDO/SBWTDIO PJ.0/TDO PJ.0/TDO PJ.2/TMS PJ.2/TMS PJ.3/TCK PJ.3/TCK PJ.1/TDI PJ.1/TDI P1.2 P1.2 P2.0 P2.0 P2.1 P2.1 P1.3 P1.3 P1.4 P1.5 AVCC AVCC AVSS AVSS AVSS AVSS LFXOUT LFXIN LFGND HFGND HFXOUT HFXIN P2.4 P2.3 P2.7 DVCC DVCC DVCC DVCC DVSS DVSS P4.6 P4.5 P4.4 P1.7 P1.6 P3.7 P3.6 P3.5 P3.4 P2.2 P2.6 P2.5 P4.3 P4.2 P4.1 P4.0 P4.7 P3.3 P3.2 P3.1 P3.0 TEST/SBWTCK1 TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK MSP-TS430RGZ48C www.ti.com B.16 MSP-TS430RGZ48C Figure B-31. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Target Socket Module, Schematic 78 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Connector J2 External power connector Jumper J1 to "ext" Jumpers JP3 to JP8 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Switch SW1 Device reset LEDs connected to P1.0, P1.1, P1.2 via JP9, JP10, JP11 (only D1 assembled) Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper J1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumper JP2 Analog/digital power Switch SW2 Connected to P1.3 HF ands LF oscillators with capacitors and resistors to connect pinheads www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGZ48C Figure B-32. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Target Socket Module, PCB Table B-17. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Revision History Revision Comments 1.2 Initial release LFOSC pins swapped at SV1 (9-10). 1.3 HFOSC pins swapped at SV1 (6-7). BOOTST pin 4 now directly connected to the device RST/SBWTDIO pin. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 79 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430RGZ48C www.ti.com Table B-18. MSP-TS430RGZ48C Bill of Materials Number Pos Ref Des Per Description Digi-Key Part Number Comment Board 1 SV1, SV2, SV3, 4 12-pin header, TH DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. SV4 Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-12-ND : Header : Receptacle 1.1 SV1, SV2, SV3, 4 12-pin receptable, TH DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. SV4 Keep vias free of solder. : Header SAM1213-12-ND : Receptacle 2 JP1, JP2, JP9 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 3 JP10, JP11 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND DNP 4 J1, JP3, JP4, JP5, 7 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumpers on pins 2-3 JP6, JP7, JP8 5 J2 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 6 JP1, JP2, JP9, J1, 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: JP1, JP2, JP9, J1, JP3, JP4, JP5, JP6, JP3, JP4, JP5, JP7, JP8 JP6, JP7, JP8 7 R2, R3, R5, R6, 9 DNP, 0805 DNP R8, R9, R10, R11, R14 8 R12, R13, R7 3 0R, 0805 541-000ATR-ND 9 C5 1 1.1nF, CSMD0805 490-1623-2-ND 10 C3, C7 2 1uF, 10V, CSMD0805 490-1702-2-ND 11 R4 1 47k, 0805 541-47000ATR-ND 12 C4, C6 2 100nF, CSMD0805 311-1245-2-ND 13 R1 1 330R, 0805 541-330ATR-ND 14 C1, C2, C8, C9 4 DNP, CSMD0805 DNP 15 SW1, SW2 2 EVQ-11L05R P8079STB-ND DNP 16 BOOTST 1 10-pin connector, male, TH HRP10H-ND DNP, keep vias free of solder 17 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 18 Q1 1 DNP: MS3V-TR1 (32768kHz, depends on application Micro Crystal, DNP, enclosed in kit, keep vias 20ppm, 12.5pF) free of solder 19 Q2 1 DNP, Christal depends on application DNP, keep vias free of solder 20 U1 1 Socket: QFN11T048-008 Manuf.: Yamaichi A101121-001 20.1 U1 1 MSP430FR5969IRGZ DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI. 21 D1 1 green LED, DIODE0805 P516TR-ND 22 D3 1 red (DNP), DIODE0805 DNP 23 D2 1 yellow (DNP), DIODE0805 DNP 24 TP1, TP2 2 Testpoint DNP, keep pads free of solder 25 Rubber stand off 4 Buerklin: 20H1724 apply to corners at bottom side 26 PCB 1 79.6 x 91.0 mm MSP-TS430RGZ48C 2 layers, black solder mask Rev. 1.2 80 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated ML14 LED3 0R 12pF 12pF 12pF 12pF GND GND 0R 100nF 560R ML10 JP1Q JP1Q 10uF/6,3V 10uF/10V 47K 10nF 0R 0R 0R - - 0R - 0R 0R FE16-1-1 FE16-1-2 FE16-1-3 FE16-1-4 PWR3 GNDGND - MSP64PM not assembled not assembled not assembled not assembled enhancement reserved for future JTAG 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 D1 R2 C2 C1 C3 C4 R1 C5 R3 BOOTST 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 J7 1 2 J6 1 2 C6 C7 R5 C8 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13 R14 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 J1 J2 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 J3 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 J4 J5 1 2 3 R4 Q1 LFXTCLK XTCLK U2 DVCC 2 3 4 5 6 7 XIN XOUT 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 TDO TDI TMS TCK RST 59 60 61 AVSS DVSS AVCC RST/NMI TCK TMS TDI TDO VCC Date: 3/14/2006 10:46:30 AM Sheet: 1/1 REV: TITLE: Document Number: MSP-TS430PM64 + + 1 MSP-TS430PM64 Target Socket PM64 Yamaichi IC51-0644-807 Socket: 1.2 for F14x and F41x Open J6 if LCD is connected If external supply voltage: remove R8 and add R9 (0 Ohm) If external supply voltage: remove R11 and add R10 (0 Ohm) For BSL usage add: R6 R7 R13 R14 MSP430F14x : 0 0 open open MSP430F41x : open open 0 0 www.ti.com MSP-TS430PM64 B.17 MSP-TS430PM64 NOTE: Connections between the JTAG header and pins XOUT and XIN are no longer required and should not be made. Figure B-33. MSP-TS430PM64 Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 81 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J5 External power connection Remove R8 and jumper R9 D1 LED connected to pin 12 Jumper J6 Open to disconnect LED Jumper J7 Open to measure current Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool MSP-TS430PM64 www.ti.com Figure B-34. MSP-TS430PM64 Target Socket Module, PCB 82 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PM64 Table B-19. MSP-TS430PM64 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 1.1 C3, C4 0 47pF, SMD0805 DNP: Only recommendation. Check your crystal spec. 2 C6, C7 1 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND DNP: C6 3 C5 1 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 4 C8 1 10nF, SMD0805 478-1383-2-ND 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with 7 J1, J2, J3, J4 0 16-pin header, TH kit.Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-16-ND : Header SAM1213-16-ND : Receptacle 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 9 J6, J7 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 11 2 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: J6, J7 12 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 13 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Q1: Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Keep vias free of 14 Q1, Q2 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 15 R3 1 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, R6, R7, R8, DNP: R4, R6, R7, R9, R10, 16 R9, R10, 3 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND R11, R12, R13, R14 R11, R12, R13, R14 17 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 18 U1 1 Socket: IC51-0644-807 Manuf.: Yamaichi 19 PCB 1 78 x 75 mm 2 layers 20 Rubber 4 select appropriate Apply to corners at bottom standoff side 21 MSP430 22 MSP430F2619IPM DNP: Enclosed with kit MSP430F417IPM supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 83 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 0R 12pF 12pF GND GND 0R 100nF 330R 10uF/6.3V 0R 0R 0R 0R PWR3 GND 47k 2.2nF 330R GND GND 100nF GND 0R 0R MSP-TS430PM64A Target Socket DNP Yamaichi IC51-0644-807 Socket: DNP 1.1 for F4152 Open JP1 if LCD is connected JTAG -> SBW -> DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP Vcc ext int TEST/SBWTCK RST/SBWTDIO P7.0/TDO P7.1/TDI P7.2/TMS P7.3/TCK ADD LCD-CAP! DNP DNP JTAG 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 R2 C2 C1 R1 C5 R3 BOOTST 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 C6 R10 R11 R13 R14 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 J1 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 J2 J3 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 J4 J5 1 2 3 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 11 12 13 14 15 10 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 1 2 Q1 R4 C3 1 2 3 JP4 JP5 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP8 1 2 3 R6 JP9 1 2 3 1 2 JP1 JP2 1 2 JP3 1 2 3 D1 C4 R5 R7 RST/NMI TMS TDI VCC GND XTLGND TCK/SBWTCK TDO/SBWTDIO VCC430 VCC430 VCC430 P5.1 P5.1 AVCC AVCC AVSS AVSS P1.0 P1.1 XIN XOUT A A A B B B C C D D E E F F Date: 3/29/2011 3:07:02 PM Sheet: 1/1 REV: TITLE: Document Number: MSP-TS430PM64A + TEST/SBWTCK RST/SBWTDIO If supplied locally: populate R10 (0R), remove R11 If supplied by interface: populate R11 (0R), remove R10 MSP-TS430PM64A www.ti.com B.18 MSP-TS430PM64A Figure B-35. MSP-TS430PM64A Target Socket Module, Schematic 84 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to measure current Jumper JP1 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P5.1 Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumpers JP4 to JP9 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Orient Pin 1 ofMSP430 device Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" www.ti.com MSP-TS430PM64A Figure B-36. MSP-TS430PM64A Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 85 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PM64A www.ti.com Table B-20. MSP-TS430PM64A Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2, 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C3 0 2.2nF, SMD0805 DNP 3 C6, 1 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 4 C4, C5 2 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 5 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 6 J1, J2, J3, J4 0 16-pin header, TH Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-16-ND : Header SAM1213-16-ND : Receptacle J5, JP3, JP4, 7 JP5, JP6, 8 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP7, JP8, JP9 8 JP1, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 2 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: J6, J7 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 11 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Keep vias free of 12 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 13 R3, R6 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R5, 14 R7, R9, R10, 2 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R5, R7, R9, R10, R11, R11, R13, R13, R14 R14 15 R4 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 16 U1 1 Socket: IC51-0644-807 Manuf.: Yamaichi 17 PCB 1 78 x 75 mm 4 layers 18 Rubber stand 4 select appropriate Apply to corners at bottom off side 19 MSP430 2 MSP430F4152IPM DNP: Enclosed with kit supplied by TI 86 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGC64B B.19 MSP-TS430RGC64B Figure B-37. MSP-TS430RGC64B Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 87 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED Connector J5 External power connector Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Jumper JP3 to "ext" Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode D1 LED connected to P1.0 If the system should be supplied via LDOI (J6), close JP4 and set JP3 to "ext" Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumper JP1 Open to measure current MSP-TS430RGC64B www.ti.com Figure B-38. MSP-TS430RGC64B Target Socket Module, PCB 88 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGC64B Table B-21. MSP-TS430RGC64B Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C3, C4 0 47pF, SMD0805 DNP 3 C6, C7, C10 3 10uF, 6.3V, SMD0805 C5, C11, 4 C13, C14, 5 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C15 5 C8 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 6 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 7 C16 1 4.7uF, SMD0805 8 C17 1 220nF, SMD0805 9 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND J1, J2, J3, SAM1029-16-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles 10 J4 0 16-pin header, TH (Header) SAM1213-16- enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of ND (Receptacle) solder: 11 J5 , J6 2 3-pin header, male, TH JP3, JP5, place jumpers on pins 2-3 on JP5, JP6, 12 JP6, JP7, 7 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 place jumpers on JP8, JP9, pins 1-2 on JP3, JP10 13 JP1, JP2, 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header JP4 14 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND See Pos. 12 and Pos. 13 15 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH 16 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, "DNP Keep vias free of solder" TH Micro Crystal MS3V-T1R 17 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = DNP: Q1 Keep vias free of solder 12.5pF 18 Q2 0 Crystal Q2: 4MHz Buerklin: DNP: Q2 Keep vias free of solder 78D134 Insulating http://www.ettinger.de/Art 19 disk to Q2 0 Insulating disk to Q2 _Detail.cfm?ART_ARTNU M=70.08.121 20 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 21 R6, R8, 3 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R6, R8, R9, R10, R11,R12 R9,R10, R11, R12 22 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 23 U1 1 Socket: QFN11T064-006- Manuf.: Yamaichi N-HSP 24 PCB 1 85 x 76 mm 2 layers Adhesive Approximately 6mm for example, 3M 25 plastic feet 4 width, 2mm height Bumpons Part No. SJ- Apply to corners at bottom side 5302 26 D3,D4 27 MSP430 2 MSP430F5310 RGC DNP: enclosed with kit, supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 89 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430RGC64C www.ti.com B.20 MSP-TS430RGC64C The MSP-TS430RGC64C target board has been designed with the option to operate with the target device DVIO input voltage supplied via header J6 (see Figure B-39). This development platform does not supply the 1.8-V DVIO rail on board and it MUST be provided by external power supply for proper device operation. For correct JTAG connection, programming, and debug operation, it is important to follow this procedure: 1. Make sure that the VCC and DVIO voltage supplies are OFF and that the power rails are fully discharged to 0 V. 2. Enable the 1.8-V external DVIO power supply. 3. Enable the 1.8-V to 3.6-V VCC power supply (alternatively, this supply can be provided from the MSPFET430UIF JTAG debugger interface). 4. Connect the MSP-FET430UIF JTAG connector to the target board. 5. Start the debug session using IAR or CCS IDE. For more information on debugging the MSP4and MSP430F525x, see the device-specific data sheets (MSP430F522x: SLAS718; MSP430F525x: SLAS903) and Designing with MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558). For debugging of devices (MSP430F524x and MSP430F523x) without use of the DVIO power domain, short JP4 with the jumper. 90 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 1.1 MSP-TS430RGC64C TI Friesing Tools MSP430 1 1 12/14/10 S.G. 1 2 3 4 5 6 A B C D A B C D Design: Appr.: Rev.: Comment: Drawing#: Revision: File: Page: Size: Title of Schematic of Mentor Pads Logic V9 Date: Name: 1 2 3 4 5 6 MSP-TS430RGC64C.sch <-- SBW <-- JTAG ext int VCC DVIO Power Circle BSL 1 P6.0/CB0/A0 2 P6.1/CB1/A1 3 P6.2/CB2/A2 4 P6.3/CB3/A3 5 P6.4/CB4/A4 6 P6.5/CB5/A5 7 P6.6/CB6/A6 8 P6.7/CB7/A7 9 P5.0/A8/VEREF+ 10 P5.1/A9/VEREF- 11 AVCC 12 P5.4/XIN 13 P5.5/XOUT 14 AVSS 15 DVCC 16 DVSS 17 VCORE 18 P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK 19 P1.1/TA0.0 20 P1.2/TA0.1 21 P1.3/TA0.2 22 P1.4/TA0.3 23 P1.5/TA0.4 24 P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT 25 P1.7/TA1.0 26 P2.0/TA1.1 27 P2.1/TA1.2 28 P2.2/TA2CLK/SMCLK 29 P2.3/TA2.0 30 P2.4/TA2.1 31 P2.5/TA2.2 32 P2.6/RTCCLK/DMAE0 P2.7/UCB0STE/UCA0CLK 33 P3.0/UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA 34 P3.1/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL 35 P3.2/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE 36 P3.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO 37 P3.4/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI 38 DVSS 39 DVIO 40 P4.0/PM_UCB1STE 41 P4.1/PM_UCB1SIMO 42 P4.2/PM_UCB1SOMI 43 P4.3/PM_UCB1CLK 44 P4.4/PM_UCA1TXD 45 P4.5/PM_UCA1RXD 46 P4.6/PM_NONE 47 P4.7/PM_NONE 48 49 P7.0/TB0.0 50 P7.1/TB0.1 51 P7.2/TB0.2 52 P7.3/TB0.3 53 P7.4/TB0.4 54 P7.5/TB0.5 55 BSLEN 56 RST/NMI 57 P5.2/XT2IN 58 P5.3/XT2OUT 59 TEST/SBWTCK 60 PJ.0/TDO 61 PJ.1/TDI/TCLK 62 PJ.2/TMS 63 PJ.3/TCK 64 RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO 65 THERMAL_1 66 THERMAL_2 67 THERMAL_3 68 THERMAL_4 69 THERMAL_5 70 THERMAL_6 71 THERMAL_7 72 THERMAL_8 U1 MSP430F5229 2 1 4 3 6 5 8 7 10 9 12 11 14 13 JTAG 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 BOOTST CN-ML10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 J1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 J2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 J3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 J4 1 2 3 JP5 PINHEAD_1X3 1 2 3 JP6 PINHEAD_1X3 1 2 3 JP7 PINHEAD_1X3 1 2 3 JP8 PINHEAD_1X3 1 2 3 JP9 PINHEAD_1X3 1 2 3 JP10 PINHEAD_1X3 1 2 3 J5 PINHEAD_1X3 R7 330R 1 2 3 JP3 C10 10uF C14 100nF C5 10uF C6 100nF R1 0R R2 0R R6 0R R8 0R C1 12pF C2 12pF C7 10uF C13 100nF 1 2 JP2 R3 330R 1 2 D1 ??? R4 0R C9 470nF R5 47K C8 2.2nF R11 0R R12 0R C16 4.7uF tbd C3 tbd C4 R9 0R R10 0R C15 100nF 1 2 3 J6 PINHEAD_1X3 1 2 JP4 PINHEAD_1X2 D3 Q2 QUARZ_4PIN 26MHz/ASX53 Q1 1 2 JP1 PINHEAD_1X2 SHC1 SHORTCUT2 GND GND GND GND XTLGND VCORE GND GND DVCC DVCC GND XTLGND2 GND GND DVCC GND RST/NMI TCK TMS TDI TDO RSTDVCC_SBWTDIO TDO RST/NMI TCK C TCK M TMS I TDI O TDO DVCC P1.2/TA0.1 P1.1/TA0.0 TEST/SBWTCK C M I O DVCC P1.1/TA0.0 P1.2/TA0.1 RSTDVCC_SBWTDIO TEST/SBWTCK AVSS www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGC64C Figure B-39. MSP-TS430RGC64C Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 91 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J5 External power connector for DVCC Set jumper JP3 to "ext" IMPORTANT NOTE: Rev1.0 of the board does not have connection from pin 4 of BOOTST to pin 64 of MCU. To use BSL, these pins should be connected by a wire. Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper JP4 For F524x devices, close. For F522x, F523x, and F525x devices, close only if one power supply is used for VCC and DVIO, and if VCC is not higher then 1.98 V. Otherwise, supply DVIO over J6. Do not close if VCC > 1.98 V, as it may damage the chip. Ÿ Ÿ Connector J6 External power connector to supply DVIO Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumper JP1 Open to measure current MSP-TS430RGC64C www.ti.com Figure B-40. MSP-TS430RGC64C Target Socket Module, PCB 92 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGC64C Table B-22. MSP-TS430RGC64C Bill of Materials Item Qty Reference Value Description Comment Supplier No. 1 0 C1, C2 12pF CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0805 DNP C1 C2 2 0 C3, C4 tbd CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0805 DNP C3 C4 4 3 C5, C7, C10 10uF CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0805 5 5 C8 C6 C13-15 100nF CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0805 Digi-Key: 311-1245-2-ND 5 5 C8 2.2nF CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0805 6 1 C9 470nF CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0805 Digi-Key: 478-1403-2-ND 7 1 C16 4.7uF CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0805 8 1 D1 Green LED LED, SMD, 0805 DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with 9 4 J1-J4 16-pin header Pin header 1x16: Grid: 100mil kit. Keep vias free of (2.54 mm) solder. : Header SAM1029-16-ND : Receptacle SAM1213-16-ND 10 2 J5, J6 3-pin header, male, TH Pin header 1x3: Grid: 100mil SAM1035-03-ND (2.54 mm) 11 JP5, JP6, JP7, 3-pin header, male, TH Pinheader 1x3: Grid: 100mil place jumpers on pins 2-3 SAM1035-03-ND JP8, JP9, JP10 (2.54 mm) 12 JP3 3-pin header, male, TH Pin header 1x3: Grid: 100mil place jumper on pins 1-2 SAM1035-03-ND (2.54 mm) 13 JP1, JP2, JP4 2-pin header, male, TH Pin header 1x2; Grid: 100mil place jumper on header SAM1035-02-ND (2.54 mm) Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3, 14 10 Jumper JP4, JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, 15-38-1024-ND JP9, JP10 15 1 JTAG 2x7Pin,Wanne Header, THD, Male 2x7 Pin, HRP14H-ND Wanne, 100mil spacing 16 0 BOOTST 2x5Pin,Wanne Header, THD, Male 2x5 Pin, DNP Wanne, 100mil spacing 17 1 Q1 26MHz/ASX53 CRYSTAL, SMD, 5x3MM, Only Kit. 26MHz 18 0 Q2 26MHz/ASX53 CRYSTAL, SMD, 5x3MM, 300-8219-1-ND 26MHz 19 1 D3 LL103A DIODE, SMD, SOD123, Buerklin: 24S3406 Schottky 20 2 R3, R7 330 Ohm, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND 21 1 R5 47k Ohm, SMD0805 RES, SMD, 0805, 1/8W, x% 541-47000ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, DNP: R6, R8, R9, R10, 22 R6, R8, R9, 0 Ohm, SMD0805 RES, SMD, 0805, 1/8W, x% R11,R12 541-000ATR-ND R10, R11, R12 23 1 U1 Socket: QFN11T064-006-N- Manuf.: Yamaichi HSP 24 2 MSP430 MSP430F5229IRGCR IC, MCU, SMD, 9.15x9.15mm Thermal Pad with Socket 25 4 Rubber stand Rubber stand off apply to corners at bottom Buerklin: 20H1724 off side 26 1 PCB 84 x 76 mm 84 x 76 mm SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 93 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430RGC64USB www.ti.com B.21 MSP-TS430RGC64USB Due to the use of diodes in the power chain, the voltage on the MSP430F5xx device is approximately 0.3 V lower than is set by the debugging tool. Set the voltage in the IDE to 0.3 V higher than desired; for example, to run the MCU at 3.0 V, set it to 3.3 V. Figure B-41. MSP-TS430RGC64USB Target Socket Module, Schematic 94 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool USB1 USB connector Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP1 Open to measure current www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGC64USB Figure B-42. MSP-TS430RGC64USB Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 95 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430RGC64USB www.ti.com Table B-23. MSP-TS430RGC64USB Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 1.1 C3, C4 2 47pF, SMD0805 2 C6, C7 2 10uF, 6.3V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 3 C5, C11, 4 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C13, C14 3.1 C10, C12 0 10uF, SMD0805 DNP: C10, C12 4 C8 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 7 J1, J2, J3, J4 4 16-pin header, TH Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-16-ND : Header SAM1213-16-ND : Receptacle 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP5, JP6, 9 JP7, JP8, 6 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumpers on pins 2-3 JP9, JP10 10 JP1, JP2, 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header JP4 11 JP3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumper on pins 1-2 Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3, 12 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND JP4, JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 13 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND Q1: Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Q1 14 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = Keep vias free of solder" 12.5pF 15 Q2 1 Crystal Q2: 4MHz Buerklin: 78D134 16 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 17 R6, R8, R9, 2 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R4, R6, R8, R9, R12 R12 18 R10 1 100 Ω, SMD0805 Buerklin: 07E500 18 R11 1 1M Ω, SMD0805 18 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 19 U1 1 Socket: QFN11T064-006 Manuf.: Yamaichi 20 PCB 1 79 x 77 mm 2 layers 21 Rubber stand 4 Buerklin: 20H1724 apply to corners at bottom off side 22 MSP430 2 MSP430F5509 RGC DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI Insulating http://www.ettinger.de/Art_De 23 disk to Q2 1 Insulating disk to Q2 tail.cfm?ART_ARTNUM=70.0 8.121 27 C33 1 220n SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2074 28 C35 1 10p SMD0603 Buerklin: 56D102 29 C36 1 10p SMD0603 Buerklin: 56D102 30 C38 1 220n SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2074 31 C39 1 4u7 SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2086 32 C40 1 0.1u SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2068 33 D2, D3, D4 3 LL103A Buerklin: 24S3406 96 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430RGC64USB Table B-23. MSP-TS430RGC64USB Bill of Materials (continued) Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 34 IC7 1 TPD4E004 Manu: TI 36 LED 0 JP3QE SAM1032-03-ND DNP 37 LED1 0 LEDCHIPLED_0603 FARNELL: 852-9833 DNP 38 LED2 0 LEDCHIPLED_0603 FARNELL: 852-9868 DNP 39 LED3 0 LEDCHIPLED_0603 FARNELL: 852-9841 DNP 40 R13, R15, 0 470R Buerklin: 07E564 DNP R16 41 R33 1 1k4 / 1k5 Buerklin: 07E612 42 R34 1 27R Buerklin: 07E444 43 R35 1 27R Buerklin: 07E444 44 R36 1 33k Buerklin: 07E740 45 S1 0 PB P12225STB-ND DNP 46 S2 0 PB P12225STB-ND DNP 46 S3 1 PB P12225STB-ND 47 USB1 1 USB_RECEPTACLE FARNELL: 117-7885 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 97 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PN80 www.ti.com B.22 MSP-TS430PN80 NOTE: For MSP430F47x and MSP430FG47x devices: Connect pins 7 and 10 (GND) externally to DVSS (see data sheet). Connect load capacitance on Vref pin 60 when SD16 is used (see data sheet). For use of BSL: connect pin 1 of BOOST to pin 58 of U1 and pin 3 of BOOST to pin 57 of U1. Figure B-43. MSP-TS430PN80 Target Socket Module, Schematic 98 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP1 to "ext" D1 LED connected to pin 12 Jumper J6 Open to disconnect LED Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumper JP2 Open to measure current www.ti.com MSP-TS430PN80 Figure B-44. MSP-TS430PN80 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 99 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PN80 www.ti.com Table B-24. MSP-TS430PN80 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 1.1 C3, C4 0 47pF, SMD0805 DNP: Only recommendation. Check your crystal spec. 2 C6, C7 1 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 3 C5 1 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 4 C8 1 10nF, SMD0805 478-1383-2-ND 5 D1 1 green LED, SMD0603 475-1056-2-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with 6 J1, J2, J3, J4 0 25-pin header, TH kit.Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-20-ND : Header SAM1213-20-ND : Receptacle 7 J5, JP1 2 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 8 J6, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 9 3 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: J6, JP2, JP1/Pos1- 2 10 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 11 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Q1: Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Keep vias free of 12 Q1, Q2 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 13 R3 1 560 Ω, SMD0805 541-560ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, DNP: R4, R6, R7, R10, R11, 14 R6, R7, R10, 2 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND R12 R11, R12 15 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 16 U1 1 Socket: IC201-0804-014 Manuf.: Yamaichi 17 PCB 1 77 x 77 mm 2 layers 18 Adhesive 4 ~6mm width, 2mm height for example, 3M Bumpons Apply to corners at bottom Plastic feet Part No. SJ-5302 side 19 MSP430 2 MSP430FG439IPN DNP: Enclosed with kit supplied by TI 100 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PN80A B.23 MSP-TS430PN80A Figure B-45. MSP-TS430PN80A Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 101 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED Connector J6 If the system is supplied via LDOI, close JP4 and set JP3 to external Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Jumper JP1 Open to measure current MSP-TS430PN80A www.ti.com Figure B-46. MSP-TS430PN80A Target Socket Module, PCB 102 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PN80A Table B-25. MSP-TS430PN80A Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 2 C3, C4 0 47pF, SMD0805 DNP 3 C6, C7, 3 10uF, 6.3V, SMD0805 DNP C10 C10, C12 C5, C11, 4 C13, C14, 5 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C15 5 C8 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 6 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 7 C16 1 4.7uF, SMD0805 8 C17 1 220nF, SMD0805 9 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND J1, J2, J3, SAM1029-20-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles 10 J4 0 20-pin header, TH (Header) SAM1213-20- enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of ND (Receptacle) solder: 11 J5 , J6 2 3-pin header, male, TH JP3, JP5, place jumpers on pins 2-3 on JP5, 12 JP6, JP7, 7 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 place JP8, JP9, jumpers on pins 1-2 on JP3, JP10 13 JP1, JP2, 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header JP4 14 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND See Pos. 12 and Pos. 13 15 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH 16 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, "DNP Keep vias free of solder" TH Micro Crystal MS3V-T1R 17 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = DNP: Q1 Keep vias free of solder 12.5pF 18 Q2 0 Crystal Q2: 4MHz Buerklin: DNP: Q2 Keep vias free of solder 78D134 Insulating http://www.ettinger.de/Ar 19 disk to Q2 0 Insulating disk to Q2 t_Detail.cfm?ART_ART NUM=70.08.121 20 D3,D4 2 LL103A Buerklin: 24S3406 21 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, R6, 22 R8, 3 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R6, R8, R9, R10, R11,R12 R9,R10, R11, R12 23 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 24 U1 1 Socket:IC201-0804-014 Manuf.: Yamaichi 25 PCB 1 77 x 91 mm 2 layers Adhesive Approximately 6mm for example, 3M 26 plastic feet 4 width, 2mm height Bumpons Part No. SJ- Apply to corners at bottom side 5302 27 MSP430 2 MSP430F5329IPN DNP: enclosed with kit, supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 103 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PN80USB www.ti.com B.24 MSP-TS430PN80USB Due to the use of diodes in the power chain, the voltage on the MSP430F5xx device is approximately 0.3 V lower than is set by the debugging tool. Set the voltage in the IDE to 0.3 V higher than desired; for example, to run the MCU at 3.0 V, set it to 3.3 V. NOTE: R11 should be populated. Figure B-47. MSP-TS430PN80USB Target Socket Module, Schematic 104 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG debug interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" USB Connector Button S3 BSL invoke Jumper JP4 Close for USB bus powered device Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device www.ti.com MSP-TS430PN80USB Figure B-48. MSP-TS430PN80USB Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 105 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PN80USB www.ti.com Table B-26. MSP-TS430PN80USB Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 1.1 C3, C4 2 47pF, SMD0805 2 C6, C7 2 10uF, 6.3V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 3 C5, C11, 4 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C13, C14 3.1 C10, C12 0 10uF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND DNP: C10, C12 4 C8 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: headers and 7 J1, J2, J3, 4 20-pin header, TH SAM1029-20-ND receptacles enclosed with J4 kit. Keep vias free of solder. DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of 7.1 4 20-pin header, TH solder. SAM1213-20-ND : Header : Receptacle 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP5, JP6, 9 JP7, 6 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumpers on pins 2-3 JP8,JP9, JP10 10 JP1, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header JP4 1 SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper only on one pin 11 JP3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on pins 1-2 Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3, 12 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND JP4, JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 13 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Q1 Keep vias free of 14 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 15 Q2 1 Crystal "Q2: 4MHzBuerklin: 78D134" 16 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 17 R6, R8, R9, 2 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R4, R6, R8, R9, R12 R12 18 R10 1 100 Ω, SMD0805 Buerklin: 07E500 18 R11 0 1M Ω, SMD0805 DNP 18 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 19 U1 1 Socket:IC201-0804-014 Manuf.: Yamaichi 20 PCB 1 79 x 77 mm 2 layers 21 Rubber 4 Buerklin: 20H1724 Apply to corners at bottom standoff side 22 MSP430 2 MSP430F5529 DNP: Enclosed with kit supplied by TI Insulating http://www.ettinger.de/Art_ 23 disk to Q2 1 Insulating disk to Q2 Detail.cfm?ART_ARTNUM =70.08.121 27 C33 1 220n Buerklin: 53D2074 106 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PN80USB Table B-26. MSP-TS430PN80USB Bill of Materials (continued) Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 28 C35 1 10p Buerklin: 56D102 29 C36 1 10p Buerklin: 56D102 30 C38 1 220n Buerklin: 53D2074 31 C39 1 4u7 Buerklin: 53D2086 32 C40 1 0.1u Buerklin: 53D2068 33 D2, D3, D4 3 LL103A Buerklin: 24S3406 34 IC7 1 TPD4E004 Manu: TI 36 LED 0 JP3QE SAM1032-03-ND DNP 37 LED1 0 LEDCHIPLED_0603 FARNELL: 852-9833 DNP 38 LED2 0 LEDCHIPLED_0603 FARNELL: 852-9868 DNP 39 LED3 0 LEDCHIPLED_0603 FARNELL: 852-9841 DNP 40 R13, R15, 0 470R Buerklin: 07E564 DNP R16 41 R33 1 1k4 Buerklin: 07E612 42 R34 1 27R Buerklin: 07E444 43 R35 1 27R Buerklin: 07E444 44 R36 1 33k Buerklin: 07E740 45 S1 0 PB P12225STB-ND DNP 46 S2 0 PB P12225STB-ND DNP 46 S3 1 PB P12225STB-ND 47 USB1 1 USB_RECEPTACLE FARNELL: 117-7885 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 107 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ100 www.ti.com B.25 MSP-TS430PZ100 NOTE: Connections between the JTAG header and pins XOUT and XIN are no longer required and should not be made. Figure B-49. MSP-TS430PZ100 Target Socket Module, Schematic 108 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J5 External power connection Remove R8 and jumper R9 D1 LED connected to pin 12 Jumper J6 Open to disconnect LED Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumper J7 Open to measure current Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100 Figure B-50. MSP-TS430PZ100 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 109 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ100 www.ti.com Table B-27. MSP-TS430PZ100 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP DNP: Only 1b C3, C4 0 47pF, SMD0805 recommendation. Check your crystal spec. 2 C6, C7 1 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND DNP: C6 3 C5 1 100nF, SMD0805 478-3351-2-ND 4 C8 1 10nF, SMD0805 478-1383-2-ND 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 6 D1 1 yellow LED, TH, 3mm, T1 511-1251-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with 7 J1, J2, J3, 0 25-pin header, TH kit.Keep vias free of solder. J4 SAM1029-25-ND : Header SAM1213-25-ND : Receptacle 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 9 J6, J7 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 10 2 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: J6, J7 11 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 12 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Q1: Micro Crystal MS1V- DNP: Keep vias free of 13 Q1, Q2 0 Crystal T1K 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 14 R3 1 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 15 R8, R9, R10, 3 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R4, R9, R10, R12 R11, R12 16 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 17 U1 1 Socket: IC201-1004-008 or Manuf.: Yamaichi IC357-1004-53N 18 PCB 1 82 x 90 mm 2 layers 19 Adhesive 4 ~6mm width, 2mm height for example, 3M Bumpons Apply to corners at bottom Plastic feet Part No. SJ-5302 side 20 MSP430 2 MSP430FG4619IPZ DNP: enclosed with kit supplied by TI 110 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100A B.26 MSP-TS430PZ100A Figure B-51. MSP-TS430PZ100A Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 111 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P5.1 Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 Device Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool MSP-TS430PZ100A www.ti.com Figure B-52. MSP-TS430PZ100A Target Socket Module, PCB 112 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100A Table B-28. MSP-TS430PZ100A Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP DNP: Only 1b C3, C4 0 47pF, SMD0805 recommendation. Check your crystal spec. 2 C7, C9 2 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND 3 C5, C11, 3 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C14 4 C8 1 10nF, SMD0805 478-1358-1-ND 5 C6 0 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND DNP 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 67-1553-1-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles enclosed with 7 J1, J2, J3, 0 25-pin header, TH kit.Keep vias free of solder. J4 SAM1029-25-ND : Header SAM1213-25-ND : Receptacle 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 10 JP1, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND pPlace jumper on header 11 JP3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on pins 1-2 12 3 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3 13 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 14 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Q1: Micro Crystal MS1V- DNP: Keep vias free of 15 Q1, Q2 0 Crystal T1K 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 16 R3 1 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 17 R6, R7, R8, 2 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R4, R6, R7, R8, R9, R9, R10, R10, R11, R12 R11, R12 18 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 19 U1 1 Socket: IC357-1004-53N Manuf.: Yamaichi 20 PCB 1 90 x 82 mm 4 layers 21 Rubber 4 Select appropriate Apply to corners at bottom standoff side 22 MSP430 2 MSP430F47197IPZ DNP: Enclosed with kit supplied by TI SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 113 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ100B www.ti.com B.27 MSP-TS430PZ100B Figure B-53. MSP-TS430PZ100B Target Socket Module, Schematic 114 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode JP11, JP12, JP13 Connect 1-2 to connect AUXVCCx with DVCC or drive AUXVCCx externally D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100B Figure B-54. MSP-TS430PZ100B Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 115 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ100B www.ti.com Table B-29. MSP-TS430PZ100B Bill of Materials Position Ref Des No. per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP C4, C5, 2 C6 , C7, 6 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C8, C9 3 C10, C26 2 470 nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 4 C11, C12 1 10 uF / 6.3 V SMD0805 C12 DNP C13, C14, 5 C16, C18, 6 4.7 uF SMD0805 C19, C29 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND J1, J2, J3, SAM1029-25-ND DNP: Headers and receptacles 7 J4 0 25-pin header, TH (Header) SAM1213-25- enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of ND (Receptacle) solder: 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH JP3, JP5, place jumpers on pins 2-3 on JP5, 9 JP6, JP7, 7 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 place JP8, JP9, jumpers on pins 1-2 on JP3, JP10 10 JP1, JP2, 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header JP4 11 JP11, 3 4-pin header, male, TH place jumper on header 1-2 JP12, JP13 12 13 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND See Pos. 9 and Pos. 10 and Pos. 11 15 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, HRP14H-ND TH 16 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, "DNP Keep vias free of solder" TH 17 Q1 0 Crystal DNP: Q1 Keep vias free of solder 21 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, 22 R4, R6, 2 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R4, R6, R8, R10, R11 R8, R10, R11 23 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 24 U1 1 Socket: IC357-1004-53N Manuf.: Yamaichi 25 PCB 1 90 x 82 mm 2 layers Adhesive Approximately 6mm for example, 3M 26 plastic feet 4 width, 2mm height Bumpons Part No. SJ- Apply to corners at bottom side 5302 27 MSP430 2 MSP430F6733IPZ DNP: enclosed with kit, supplied by TI 116 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP 0R 12pF 12pF 47pF 47pF GND 0R 100nF 330R 10uF/6.3V 10uF/6.3V 2.2nF PWR3 GND GND GND 0R GND 330R 47K 100nF 100nF P516TR-ND 470nF 100nF 100nF 0R 0R 0R 0R GND VCC 100nF GND 100nF 100nF GND 100nF LL103A GND 4.7n HCTC_XTL_4 HCTC_XTL_4 HCTC_XTL_4 HCTC_XTL_4 GND 0R 0R GND GND GND 4.7uF GND 100nF 220nF GND VCC LL103A 1.1 MSP430: Target-Socket MSP-TS430PZ100C Socket: Yamaichi IC201-1004-008 LFXTCLK <- SBW <- JTAG Vcc int ext DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP BSL-Rx BSL-Tx DNP 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG R2 C2 C1 C3 C4 C5 R1 R3 C6 C7 C8 1 2 3 J5 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 64 63 62 61 44 43 42 41 37 38 39 40 17 18 19 20 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 U1 QFP100PZ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 J1 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 J2 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 J3 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 J4 1 JP1 2 1 JP2 2 R4 1 2 3 JP5 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP8 1 2 3 JP9 1 2 3 R7 JP10 R5 C11 C12 D1 C9 C13 C10 R6 R8 R9 R12 1 2 3 JP3 C17 C18 C19 C14 D3 C16 1 2 3 JP11 4 1 2 Q1G$1 3 4 Q1G$2 2 1 Q2G$1 4 3 Q2G$2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 BOOTST R10 R11 C15 C20 C21 1 JP4 2 D4 1 2 3 J6 TMS TMS TDI TDI TDO TDO TDO XOUT VCC GND GND GND XIN P1.0 DVCC1 DVCC1 DVCC1 DVCC1 DVCC1 DVCC1 AVCC XT2OUT AVSS AVSS AVSS M M I I O O XT2IN RST/NMI RST/NMI TCK TCK TCK C C TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK RST RST RST XTLGND2 XTLGND1 PU.0 PU.1 P1.6 P1.7 P8.0 P8.1 P8.2 VBAK VBAT VBAT VBAT P1.1 P1.1 P1.2 P1.2 LDOI LDOI LDOO LDOO BSL Interface LDOI/LDOO Interface + + Note: If the system should be supplied via LDOI (J6) close JP4 and set JP3 to external www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100C B.28 MSP-TS430PZ100C Figure B-55. MSP-TS430PZ100C Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 117 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated If the system should be supplied via LDOI (J6), close JP4 and set JP3 to external Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device LDOI/LDOO 14 1 2 GND GND VCC 1 05 11 5 2 0 25 26 30 3540 45 50 75 70 65 60 55 51 100 95 90 85 80 76 1 2 3 123 123 123 123 123 3 2 1 1 2 3 4 10 1 2 1 2 3 1 SBW JTAG Vcc int ext GND VBAT DVCC JTAG R2 C2 C1 C3 C4 R1 C5 R3 + C6 + C7 C8 J5 U1 J1 J2 J3 J4 JP1 JP2 R4 JP5 JP6 JP7 JP8 JP9 JP10 R7 R5 C11 C12 D1 C9 C13 C10 R6 R8 R9 R12 JP3 C17 C18 C19 C14 D3 C16 JP11 Q1 Q2 BOOTST R10 R11 C15 C20 C21 JP4 D4 J6 Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Jumper JP1 Open to measure current MSP-TS430PZ100C www.ti.com Figure B-56. MSP-TS430PZ100C Target Socket Module, PCB 118 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100C Table B-30. MSP-TS430PZ100C Bill of Materials Number Pos. Ref Des Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 1.1 C3, C4 2 47pF, SMD0805 DNP: C3, C4 2 C6, C7 2 10uF, 6.3V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND C5, C11, 3 C13, C14, 6 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C19, C20 3.1 C10, C12, 0 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND DNP: C10, C12,C18, C17 C18,17 4 C8 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 Buerklin 53 D 292 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND 7 J1, J2, J3, 4 25-pin header, TH SAM1029-25-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed J4 with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 7.1 4 25-pin header, TH SAM1213-25-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 8 J5, J6 2 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP5, JP6, 9 JP7, 6 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumpers on pins 2-3 JP8,JP9, JP10 10 JP1, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 10.1 JP4 1 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header 11 JP3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumper on pins 1-2 12 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3, JP4, JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 13 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 14 BOOTST 1 10-pin connector, male, TH HRP10H-ND DNP, keep vias free of solder 15 Q1 0 Crystal DNP: Q1 Keep vias free of solder 16 Q2 1 Crystal DNP: Q2 Keep vias free of solder 17 R3, R7 2 330 Ohm, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 18 R6, R8, R9, 3 0 Ohm, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R6, R8, R9, R10, R11, R12 R10, R11, R12 19 R5 1 47k Ohm, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 20 U1 1 Socket: IC357-1004-53N Manuf.: Yamaichi 21 PCB 1 79.5 x 99.5 mm MSP-TS430PZ100C 2 layers Rev 1.0 22 Rubber 4 Buerklin: 20H1724 apply to corners at bottom side stand off 23 MSP430 2 MSP430F643x DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI. 24 C16 1 4.7 nF SMD0603 Buerklin 53 D 2042 26 D3, D4 2 LL103A Buerklin: 24S3406 27 JP11 1 4-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-04-ND Place jumper on Pin 1 and Pin 2 28 C15 1 4.7 uF, SMD0805 Buerklin 53 D 2430 29 C21 1 220nF, SMD0805 Buerklin 53 D 2381 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 119 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ100C www.ti.com 120 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated DNP Socket: Yamaichi IC201-1004-008 DNP DNP GND GND 100nF 330R 0R - GND GND 47k 1.1nF GND 0R 0R QUARZ5 1uF/10V 1uF/10V 100nF green DNP yellow (DNP) DNP red (DNP) 0R GND DNP DNP 0R 0R QUARZ5 EVQ11 0R DNP DNP MSP430FR698XPZ FE25-1A1 FE25-1A2 FE25-1A3 FE25-1A4 100nF GND 100nF GND 1uF/10V 100nF GND GND 470nF GND 0R 4u7 GND If external supply voltage: remove R3 and add R2 (0 Ohm) Ext_PWR MSP-TS430PZ100D Vcc int ext Target Socket Board for MSP430FR698xPZ, FR688xPZ DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP JTAG -> SBW -> JTAG-Mode selection: 4-wire JTAG: Set jumpers JP3 to JP8 to position 2-3 2-wire "SpyBiWire": Set jumpers JP3 to JP8 to position 1-2 connection by via DNP DNP Petersen 1099/1/001/01.1 1.2 DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG C2 C1 C4 R1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 BSL R3 R2 1 2 3 J2 1 2 3 J1 1 2 JP1 1 2 JP9 R4 C5 1 2 3 JP3 1 2 3 JP4 1 2 3 JP5 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP8 R5 R6 Q1 C3 C7 C6 D1 R10 1 2 JP10 D2 R11 1 2 JP11 D3 R12 1 2 JP2 C8 C9 R9 R8 Q2 SW1 R13 TP1TP2 SW2 R14 1 P4.3/UCA0SOMI/UCA0RXD/UCB1STE 2 P1.4/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE/TA1.0/S1 3 P1.5/UCB0STE/UCA0CLK/TA0.0/S0 4 P1.6/UCB0SIMO/USB0SDA/TA0.1 5 P1.7/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL/TA0.2 6 R33/LCDCAP 7 P6.0/R23 8 P6.1/R13/LCDREF 9 P6.2/COUT/R03 10 P6.3/COM0 11 P6.4/TB0.0/COM1 12 P6.5/TB0.1/COM2 13 P6.6/TB0.2/COM3 14 P2.4/TB0.3/COM4/S43 15 P2.5/TB0.4/COM5/S42 16 P2.6/TB0.5/COM6/S41 17 P2.7/TB0.6/COM7/S40 18 P10.2/TA1.0/SMCLK/S39 19 P5.0/TA1.1/MCLK/S38 20 P5.1/TA1.2/S37 21 P5.2/TA1.0/TA1CLK/ACLK/S36 22 P5.3/UCB1STE/S35 23 P3.0/UCB1CLK/S34 24 P3.1/UCB1SIMO/UCB1SDA/S33 25 P3.2/UCB1SOMI/UCB1SCL/S32 26 DVSS1 27 DVCC1 28 TEST/SBWTCK 29 XRST/NMI/SBWTDIO 30 PJ.0/TDO/TB0OUTH/SMCLK/SRSCG1 31 PJ.1/TDI/TCLK/MCLK/SRSCG0 32 PJ.2/TMS/ACLK/SROSCOFF 33 PJ.3/TCK/COUT/SRCPUOFF 34 P6.7/TA0CLK/S31 35 P7.5/TA0.2/S30 36 P7.6/TA0.1/S29 37 P10.1/TA0.0/S28 38 P7.7/TA1.2/TB0OUTH/S27 39 P3.3/TA1.1/TB0CLK/S26 40 P3.4/UCA1SIMO/UCA1TXD/TB0.0/S25 41 P3.5/UCA1SOMI/UCA1RXD/TB0.1/S24 42 P3.6/UCA1CLK/TB0.2/S23 43 P3.7/UCA1STE/TB0.3/S22 44 P8.0/RTCCLK/S21 45 P8.1/DMAE0/S20 46 P8.2/S19 47 P8.3/MCLK/S18 48 P2.3/UCA0STE/TB0OUTH 49 P2.2/UCA0CLK/TB0.4/RTCCLK 50 P2.1/UCA0SOMI/UCA0RXD/TB0.5/DMAE0 P2.0/UCA0SIMO/UCA0TXD/TB0.6/TB0CLK51 P7.0/TA0CLK/S17 52 P7.1/TA0.0/S16 53 P7.2/TA0.1/S15 54 P7.3/TA0.2/S14 55 P7.4/SMCLK/S13 56 DVSS2 57 DVCC2 58 P8.4/A7/C7 59 P8.5/A6/C6 60 P8.6/A5/C5 61 P8.7/A4/C4 62 P1.3/ESITEST4/TA1.2/A3/C3 63 P1.2/TA1.1/TA0CLK/COUT/A2/C2 64 P1.1/TA0.2/TA1CLK/COUT/A1/C1/VREF+/VEREF+65 P1.0/TA0.1/DMAE0/RTCCLK/A0/C0/VREF-/VEREF66 P9.0/ESICH0/ESITEST0/A8/C8 67 P9.1/ESICH1/ESITEST1/A9/C9 68 P9.2/ESICH2/ESITEST2/A10/C10 69 P9.3/ESICH3/ESITEST3/A11/C11 70 P9.4/ESICI0/A12/C12 71 P9.5/ESICI1/A13/C13 72 P9.6/ESICI2/A14/C14 73 P9.7/ESICI3/A15/C15 74 ESIVCC 75 ESIVSS 76 ESICI 77 ESICOM 78 AVCC1 79 AVSS3 80 PJ.7/HFXOUT 81 PJ.6/HFXIN 82 AVSS1 83 P4.2/UCA0SIMO/UCA0TXD/UCB1CLK 100 DVCC3 99 DVSS3 98 P4.1/UCB1SOMI/UCB1SCL/ACLK/S2 97 P4.0/UCB1SIMO/UCB1SDA/MCLK/S3 96 P10.0/SMCLK/S4 95 P4.7/UCB1SOMI/UCB1SCL/TA1.2/S5 94 P4.6/UCB1SIMO/UCB1SDA/TA1.1/S6 93 P4.5/UCB1CLK/TA1.0/S7 92 P4.4/UCB1STE/TA1CLK/S8 91 P5.7/UCA1STE/TB0CLK/S9 90 P5.6/UCA1CLK/S10 89 P5.5/UCA1SOMI/UCA1RXD/S11 88 P5.4/UCA1SIMO/UCA1TXD/S12 87 AVSS2 86 PJ.5/LFXOUT 85 PJ.4/LFXIN 84 IC1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 J3 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 J4 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 J5 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 J6 C10 C11 1 2 JP12 C12 C13 C14 R7 P1.0 C15 P1.0 RST/NMI TMS TDI VCC GND P1.1 P1.1 TCK/SBWTCK TDO/SBWTDIO PJ.0/TDO PJ.0/TDO PJ.2/TMS PJ.2/TMS PJ.3/TCK PJ.3/TCK PJ.1/TDI PJ.1/TDI P1.2 P1.2 BSLTX BSLTX BSLRX BSLRX P1.3 P1.3 AVCC AVCC AVSS AVSS AVSS AVSS LFXOUT LFXIN LFGND HFGND HFXIN HFXOUT DVCC DVCC DVCC DVCC DVCC DVCC DVCC DVCC DVCC DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS TEST/SBWTCK1 TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK LCDCAP LCDCAP ESIVCC ESIVCC ESICOM ESICOM ESIVSS RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO RST/SBWTDIO 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 Titel: Datum: Bearb.: Seite 1/1 MSP-TS430PZ100D 7/9/2013 5:23:25 PM A3 A B C D E F G H I A B C D E F G H I File: Dok: Rev.: www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100D B.29 MSP-TS430PZ100D Figure B-57. MSP-TS430PZ100D Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 121 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 1 Vcc ext int Vcc GND GND JTAG SBW RESET Ext. Pwr. PWR DVCC AVCC TCK TMS TDI TDO RST/SBWTDIO TEST/SBWTCK GND GND P1.3 ESIVCC 14 1 2 10 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 25 5 10 15 20 50 45 40 35 30 26 51 75 55 60 65 70 76 80 85 90 95 100 MSP-TS430PZ100D Rev. 1.2 RoHS Q2 Q1 P1.0 P1.1 P1.2 JTAG C2 C1 C4 R1 BSL R2 R3 J2 J1 JP1 JP9 C5 R4 JP3 JP4 JP5 JP6 JP7 JP8 R5 R6 C3 C6 C7 D1 R10 JP10 D2 R11 JP11 D3 R12 JP2 C8 C9 R8 R9 SW1 R13 TP2 TP1 SW2 R14 IC1 J3 J4 J5 J6 C10 C11 JP12 C12 C13 C14 R7 C15 Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device LEDs connected to P1.0, P1.1, P1.2 via JP9, JP10, JP11 (only D1 assembled) Switch SW2 Connected to P1.3 Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Connector J2 External power connector Jumper J1 to “ext” Connector BSL For Bootstrap Loader Tool Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Jumper JP3 to JP8 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 3-4 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper J1 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Switch SW1 Device reset HF and LF oscillators with capacitors and resistors to connect pinheads MSP-TS430PZ100D www.ti.com Figure B-58. MSP-TS430PZ100D Target Socket Module, PCB 122 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100D Table B-31. MSP-TS430PZ100D Bill of Materials Number Pos. Ref Des Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 PCB 1 90.0 x 100.0 mm MSP-TS430PZ100D 2 layers, white solder mask Rev 1.2 2 JP1, JP2, 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header JP9 3 JP10, JP11, 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND DNP, keep pads free of solder JP12 4 J1 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumpers on pins 1-2 5 JP3, JP4, 6 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumpers on pins 2-3 JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8 6 J2 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 7 R2, R3, R5, 6 0R, 0805 541-0.0ATR-ND DNP R6, R8, R9 8 R7, R12, 3 0R, 0805 541-0.0ATR-ND R13 9 C5 1 1.1nF, CSMD0805 490-1623-2-ND 10 C3, C7 2 1uF/10V, CSMD0805 490-1702-2-ND 11 C12 1 1uF/10V, CSMD0805 490-1702-2-ND DNP 12 R4 1 47k, 0805 541-47KATR-ND 13 C4, C6, 4 100nF, CSMD0805 490-1666-1-ND C10, C11 14 C13 1 100nF, CSMD0805 490-1666-1-ND DNP 15 C15 1 4u7, CSMD0805 445-1370-1-ND DNP 16 R1 1 330R, 0805 541-330ATR-ND 17 C14 1 470nF, CSMD0805 587-1290-2-ND DNP 18 R10, R11 2 330R, 0805 541-330ATR-ND DNP 19 R14 1 47k, 0805 541-47KATR-ND DNP 20 C1, C2, C8, 4 DNP, CSMD0805 DNP C9 21 SW2 1 EVQ-11L05R P8079STB-ND DNP 22 SW1 1 EVQ-11L05R P8079STB-ND DNP 23 J3, J4, J5, 4 25-pin header, TH DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed J6 with kit. Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-25-ND : Header 24 J3, J4, J5, 4 25-pin receptacle, TH DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed J6 with kit. Keep vias free of solder. SAM1213-25-ND : Receptacle 25 TP1, TP2 2 Testpoint DNP, keep pads free of solder 26 BSL 1 10-pin connector, male, TH HRP10H-ND DNP, keep vias free of solder 27 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 28 IC1 1 Socket: IC201-1004-008 Manuf. Yamaichi 29 IC1 1 MSP430FR6989 DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI 30 Q1 1 DNP: MS3V-TR1 depends on application Micro Crystal, DNP, enclosed in kit, keep (32768kHz/20ppm/12,5pF) vias free of solder 31 Q2 1 DNP, Crystal depends on application DNP, keep vias free of solder 32 D1 1 green LED, DIODE0805 P516TR-ND 33 D3 1 red (DNP), DIODE0805 DNP 34 D2 1 yellow (DNP), DIODE0805 DNP 35 Rubber 4 Buerklin: 20H1724 apply to corners at bottom side stand off SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 123 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ5x100 www.ti.com B.30 MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Figure B-59. MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Target Socket Module, Schematic 124 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Orient Pin 1 ofMSP430 device www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Figure B-60. MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Target Socket Module, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 125 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ5x100 www.ti.com Table B-32. MSP-TS430PZ5x100 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP 1b C3, C4 47pF, SMD0805 DNP: Only recommendation. Check your crystal spec. 2 C6, C7 2 10uF, 10V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND C5, C10, 3 C11, C12, 4 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND DNP: C12, C14 C13, C14 4 C8 0 2.2nF, SMD0805 DNP 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 67-1553-1-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 7 J1, J2, J3, J4 0 25-pin header, TH Keep vias free of solder. SAM1029-25-ND : Header SAM1213-25-ND : Receptacle 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP5, JP6, 9 JP7, JP8, 6 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumpers on pins 2-3 JP9, JP10 10 JP1, JP2 2 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 11 JP3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumper on pins 1-2 12 9 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND Place on JP1, JP2, JP3, JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 13 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 14 BOOTST 0 10-pin connector, male, TH DNP: Keep vias free of solder Q1: Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Keep vias free of 15 Q1, Q2 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 16 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 17 R6, R8, R9, 3 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R6, R8, R9, R10, R11, R10, R11, R12 R12 18 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 19 U1 1 Socket: IC357-1004-53N Manuf.: Yamaichi 20 PCB 1 90 x 82 mm 2 layers 21 Rubber 4 Select appropriate Apply to corners at bottom standoff side 22 MSP430 2 MSP430F5438IPZ DNP: Enclosed with kit supplied by TI 126 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100USB B.31 MSP-TS430PZ100USB Due to the use of diodes in the power chain, the voltage on the MSP430F5xx device is approximately 0.3 V lower than is set by the debugging tool. Set the voltage in the IDE to 0.3 V higher than desired; for example, to run the MCU at 3.0 V, set it to 3.3 V. Figure B-61. MSP-TS430PZ100USB Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 127 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Jumpers LED 1, 2, 3 Open to disconnect LED1, LED2, LED3 LED1, D2, D3 LEDs connected to P8.0, LE LE P8.1, P8.2 Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool USB1 USB connector Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP1 Open to measure current MSP-TS430PZ100USB www.ti.com Figure B-62. MSP-TS430PZ100USB Target Socket Module, PCB 128 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PZ100USB Table B-33. MSP-TS430PZ100USB Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 C1, C2 0 12pF, SMD0805 DNP: C1, C2 1.1 C3, C4 2 47pF, SMD0805 2 C6, C7 2 10uF, 6.3V, Tantal Size B 511-1463-2-ND C5, C11, 3 C13, C14, 5 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C19 3.1 C10, C12, 0 100nF, SMD0805 311-1245-2-ND DNP: C10, C12,C18, C17 C18, C17 4 C8 1 2.2nF, SMD0805 5 C9 1 470nF, SMD0805 478-1403-2-ND 6 D1 1 green LED, SMD0805 P516TR-ND DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 7 J1, J2, J3, J4 4 25-pin header, TH SAM1029-25-ND Keep vias free of solder. : Header : Receptacle DNP: headers and receptacles enclosed with kit. 7.1 4 25-pin header, TH SAM1213-25-ND Keep vias free of solder. : Header : Receptacle 8 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND JP5, JP6, 9 JP7, JP8, 6 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumpers on pins 2-3 JP9, JP10 10 JP1, JP2, 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND place jumper on header JP4 11 JP3 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND place jumper on pins 1-2 Place on: JP1, JP2, JP3, 12 10 Jumper 15-38-1024-ND JP4, JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, JP9, JP10 13 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K DNP: Q1. Keep vias free of 14 Q1 0 Crystal 32.768kHz, C(Load) = solder 12.5pF 15 Q2 1 Crystal Q2: 4MHz, Buerklin: 78D134 16 R3, R7 2 330 Ω, SMD0805 541-330ATR-ND R1, R2, R4, 17 R6, R8, R9, 3 0 Ω, SMD0805 541-000ATR-ND DNP: R6, R8, R9, R12 R12 18 R10 1 100 Ω, SMD0805 Buerklin: 07E500 18 R11 1 1M Ω, SMD0603 not existing in Rev 1.0 18 R5 1 47k Ω, SMD0805 541-47000ATR-ND 19 U1 1 Socket:IC201-1004-008 Manuf.: Yamaichi 20 PCB 1 79 x 77 mm 2 layers 21 Rubber stand 4 Buerklin: 20H1724 apply to corners at bottom off side 22 MSP430 2 MSP430F6638IPZ DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI Insulating http://www.ettinger.de/Art_De 23 disk to Q2 1 Insulating disk to Q2 tail.cfm?ART_ARTNUM=70.0 8.121 24 C16 1 4.7 nF SMD0603 27 C33 1 220n SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2074 28 C35, C36 2 10p SMD0603 Buerklin: 56D102 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 129 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-TS430PZ100USB www.ti.com Table B-33. MSP-TS430PZ100USB Bill of Materials (continued) Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 30 C38 1 220n SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2074 31 C39 1 4u7 SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2086 32 C40 1 0.1u SMD0603 Buerklin: 53D2068 33 D2, D3, D4 3 LL103A Buerklin: 24S3406 34 IC7 1 TPD4E004 Manu: TI 35 LED 0 JP3QE SAM1032-03-ND DNP 36 LED1, LED2, 0 LEDCHIPLED_0603 FARNELL: 852-9833 DNP LED3 37 R13, R15, 0 470R SMD0603 Buerklin: 07E564 DNP R16 38 R33 1 1k4 / 1k5 SMD0603 Buerklin: 07E612 39 R34 1 27R SMD0603 Buerklin: 07E444 40 R35 1 27R SMD0603 Buerklin: 07E444 41 R36 1 33k SMD0603 Buerklin: 07E740 42 S1, S2, S3 1 PB P12225STB-ND DNP S1 and S2. (Only S3) 43 USB1 1 USB_RECEPTACLE FARNELL: 117-7885 44 JP11 1 4-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-04-ND place jumper only on Pin 1 130 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 0R 12pF 12pF GND GND 0R 100nF 330R 2.2nF 0R 0R PWR3 GND 330R 47K 0R 0R 100nF 4.7uF GND GND 100nF 470nF 0R QUARZ5 100nF 10uF/6,3V 10uF/6,3V 100nF 4.7uF 4.7uF 100nF 4.7uF 4.7uF 4.7uF 470nF FE04-1 VCC GND GND 100nF 4.7uF GND GND GND GND GND VCC1 VCC1 VCC1 VCC1 VCC1 GND GND GND GND GND GND AVSS AVSS DVCC AVCC GND VCC VCC GND MSP430: Target-Socket MSP-TS430PEU128 for F6779 Petersen 1080/1/001/01.1 DNP LFXTCLK DNP <- SBW <- JTAG DNP Vcc int ext DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DNP DVDSYS 1.1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 J1 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 J2 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 J3 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 J4 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 2 4 6 12 14 8 10 JTAG R2 C2 C1 R1 C5 R3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 BOOTST C3 R10 R11 J5 1 2 3 1 2 JP1 JP2 1 2 1 2 3 JP5 1 2 3 JP6 1 2 3 JP7 1 2 3 JP8 1 2 3 JP9 1 2 3 JP10 R7 R5 D1 R6 R8 C6 C29 C7 C10 R4 Q1 JP12 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 JP11 JP131 2 3 4 C4 C11 C12 C8 C13 C14 C9 C16 C19 C18 C26 1 2 JP4 JP3 1 2 3 4 C15 C17 TP1 TP2 IC1 MSP430F677XIPEU# XIN 1 XOUT 2 AUXVCC3 3 RTCCAP1 4 RTCCAP0 5 P1.5/SMCLK/CB0/A5 6 P1.4/MCLK/SDCLK/CB1/A4 7 P1.3/ADC10CLK/TACLK/RTCCLK/A3 8 P1.2/ACLK/TA3.1/A2 9 P1.1/TA2.1/VEREF+/A1 10 P1.0/TA1.1/TA0.0/VEREF-/A0 11 P2.4/PM_TA2.0 12 P2.5/PM_UCB0SOMI/PM_UCB0SCL 13 P2.6/PM_USB0SIMO/PM_UCB0SDA 14 P2.7/PM_UCB0CLK 15 P3.0/PM_UCA0RXD/PM_UCA0SOMI 16 P3.1/PM_UCA0TXD/PM_UCA0SIMO 17 P3.2/PM_UCA0CLK 18 P3.3/PM_UCA1CLK 19 P3.4/PM_UCA1RXD/PM_UCA1SOMI 20 P3.5/PM_UCA1TXD/PM_UCA1SIMO 21 COM0 22 COM1 23 P1.6/COM2 24 P1.7/COM3 25 P5.0/COM4 26 P5.1/COM5 27 P5.2/COM6 28 P5.3/COM7 29 LCDCAP/R33 30 P5.4/SDCLK/R23 31 P5.5/SD0DIO/LCDREF/R13 32 P5.6/SD1DIO/R03 33 P5.7/SD2DIO/CB2 34 P6.0/SD3DIO 35 P3.6/PM_UCA2RXD/PM_UCA2SOMI 36 P3.7/PM_UCA2TXD/PM_UCA2SIMO 37 P4.0/PM_UCA2CLK 38 P4.1/PM_UCA3RXD/PM_UCA3SOMI 39 P4.2/PM_UCA3TXD/PM_UCA3SIMO 40 P4.3/PM_UCA3CLK 41 P4.4/PM_UCB1SOMI/PM_UCB1SCL 42 P4.5/PM_UCB1SIMO/PM_UCB1SDA 43 P4.6/PM_UCB1CLK 44 P4.7/PM_TA3.0 45 P6.1/SD4DIO/S39 46 P6.2/SD5DIO/S38 47 P6.3/SD6DIO/S37 48 P6.4/S36 49 P6.5/S35 50 P6.6/S34 51 P6.7/S33 52 P7.0/S32 53 P7.1/S31 54 P7.2/S30 55 P7.3/S29 56 P7.4/S28 57 P7.5/S27 58 P7.6/S26 59 P7.7/S25 60 P8.0/S24 61 P8.1/S23 62 P8.2/S22 63 P8.3/S21 64 P8.4/S20 65 P8.5/S19 66 P8.6/S18 67 P8.7/S17 68 DVSYS 69 DVSS2 70 P9.0/S16 71 P9.1/S15 72 P9.2/S14 73 P9.3/S13 74 P9.4/S12 75 P9.5/S11 76 P9.6/S10 77 P9.7/S9 78 P10.0/S8 79 P10.1/S7 80 P10.2/S6 81 P10.3/S5 82 P10.4/S4 83 P10.5/S3 84 P10.6/S2 85 P10.7/S1 86 P11.0/S0 87 P11.1/TA3.1/CB3 88 P11.2/TA1.1 89 P11.3/TA2.1 90 P11.4/CBOUT 91 P11.5/TACLK/RTCCLK 92 P2.0/PM_TA0.0 93 P2.1/PM_TA0.1 94 P2.2/PM_TA0.2 95 P2.3/PM_TA1.0 96 TEST/SBWTCK 97 PJ.0/TDO 98 PJ.1/TDI/TCLK 99 PJ.2/TMS 100 PJ.3/TCK 101 ~RST/NMI/SBWTDIO 102 SD0P0 103 SD0N0 104 SD1P0 105 SD1N0 106 SD2P0 107 SD2N0 108 SD3P0 109 SD3N0 110 VASYS2 111 AVSS2 112 VREF 113 SD4P0 114 SD4N0 115 SD5P0 116 SD5N0 117 SD6P0 118 SD6N0 119 AVSS1 120 AVCC 121 VASYS1 122 AUXVCC2 123 AUXVCC1 124 VDSYS 125 DVCC 126 DVSS1 127 VCORE 128 P1.0 P1.0 P2.0 P2.0 P2.1 P2.1 SD0P0 SD0N0 SD1P0 SD1N0 SD2P0 SD2N0 SD3P0 SD3N0 SD4P0 SD4N0 SD5P0 SD5N0 SD6P0 SD6N0 VASYS1/2 VASYS1/2 VASYS1/2 VASYS1/2 TMS TMS TDI TDI TDO TDO TDO XOUT GND GND XIN DVCC AVCC DVDSYS DVDSYS DVDSYS DVDSYS AVSS AVSS PJ.2 PJ.2 PJ.1 PJ.1 PJ.0 PJ.0 RST/NMI RST/NMI TCK TCK TCK PJ.3 PJ.3 TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK TEST/SBWTCK RST RST RST RST LCDCAP LCDCAP VREF VREF VEREF+ VEREF+ VCORE AUXVCC2 AUXVCC2 AUXVCC1 AUXVCC1 AUXVCC3 AUXVCC3 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 Titel: Datum: Bearb.: Seite 1/1 MSP-TS430PEU128 22.05.2012 09:37:33 A3 A B C D E F G H I A B C D E F G H I File: Dok: Rev.: www.ti.com MSP-TS430PEU128 B.32 MSP-TS430PEU128 Figure B-63. MSP-TS430PEU128 Target Socket Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 131 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 1 P1.0 SBW JTAG DVDSYS ext int MSP-TS430PEU128 Rev. 1.1 RoHS DVCC AUXVCC GND AUXVCC1 AUXVCC2 AUXVCC3 GND GND RST/NMI TCK TDI TDO TEST/SBWTCK TMS 1 25 5 10 15 20 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 64 65 90 70 75 80 85 95 100 128 125 120 115 110 105 14 1 2 10 1 2 GND GND VCC 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 1 2 3 4 1234 1234 1 J1 J2 J3 J4 JTAG R2 C2 C1 R1 C5 R3 BOOTST C3 R10 R11 J5 JP1 JP2 JP5 JP6 JP7 JP8 JP9 JP10 R7 R5 D1 R6 R8 C6 C29 C7 C10 R4 JP12 JP11 JP13 C4 C11 C12 C8 C13 C14 C9 C16 C19 C18 C26 JP4 JP3 C15 C17 TP1 TP2 IC1 Connector J5 External power connector Jumper JP3 to "ext" Jumper JP1 Open to measure current Orient Pin 1 of MSP430 device Jumpers JP5 to JP10 Close 1-2 to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close 2-3 to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode JP11, JP12, JP13 Connect 1-2 to connect AUXVCCx with DVCC or drive AUXVCCx externally D1 LED connected to P1.0 Jumper JP2 Open to disconnect LED Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool Jumper JP3 1-2 (int): Power supply via JTAG interface 2-3 (ext): External power supply MSP-TS430PEU128 www.ti.com Figure B-64. MSP-TS430PEU128 Target Socket Module, PCB NOTE: The MSP-TS430PEU128 Rev 1.1 ships with the following modifications: • R7 value is changed to 0 Ω instead of 330 Ω. • JTAG pin 8 is connected only to JP5 pin 3, and not to pin 2. • JP5 pin 2 is connected to IC1 pin 97. • BOOTST pin 7 is connected to IC1 pin 97. 132 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-TS430PEU128 Table B-34. MSP-TS430PEU128 Bill of Materials Pos. Ref Des No. Per Description Digi-Key Part No. Comment Board 1 PCB 1 94x119.4mm, 4 layers MSP-TS430PEU128 4 layers, green solder mask Rev. 1.1 2 D1 1 green LED, DIODE0805 516-1434-1-ND 3 JP1, JP2, JP4 3 2-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-02-ND Place jumper on header 4 JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, 6 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND Place jumpers on pins 1-2 (SBW) JP9, JP10 5 JP11, JP12, JP13 3 4-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-04-ND Place jumpers on pins 1-2 (AVCC=VCC) 6 JP3 1 4-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-04-ND Place jumpers on pins 1-2 JP1, JP2, JP3, JP4, Jumper WM4592-ND 7 JP5, JP6, JP7, JP8, 13 JP9, JP10, JP11, JP12, JP13 8 R1, R2, R4, R6, R8 5 0R, 0805 541-0.0ATR-ND 9 R10, R11 2 0R, 0805 541-0.0ATR-ND DNP 10 C3 1 2.2nF, CSMD0805 490-1628-2-ND DNP 11 C13, C14, C16, 7 4.7uF, 6.3V, CSMD0805 587-1302-2-ND C17, C18, C19, C29 12 C11 1 10uF, 6.3V, CSMD0805 445-1372-2-ND 13 C12 1 10uF, 6.3V, CSMD0805 445-1372-2-ND DNP 14 C1, C2 2 12pF, CSMD0805 490-5531-2-ND DNP 15 R5 1 47K, 0805 311-47KARTR-ND 16 C4, C5, C6, C7, C8, 6 100nF, CSMD0805 311-1245-2-ND C15 17 C9 1 100nF, CSMD0805 311-1245-2-ND DNP 18 R3, R7 2 330R, 0805 541-330ATR-ND 19 C10, C26 2 470nF, CSMD0805 587-1282-2-ND 20 BOOTST 1 10-pin connector, male, TH HRP10H-ND DNP, keep vias free of solder 21 JTAG 1 14-pin connector, male, TH HRP14H-ND 22 IC1 Socket 1 Socket: IC500-1284-009P Manuf. Yamaichi 23 IC1 2 MSP430F67791IPEU DNP: enclosed with kit. Is supplied by TI 24 J5 1 3-pin header, male, TH SAM1035-03-ND 25 Q1 1 Crystal: MS3V-T1R 32.768kHz DNP: Crystal enclosed with kit. Keep vias 12.5pF ±20ppm free of solder 26 TP1, TP2 2 Test point DNP, keep vias free of solder 27 J2,J4 2 26-pin header, TH SAM1029-26-ND DNP: Headers enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 28 J2,J4 2 26-pin receptable, TH SAM1213-26-ND DNP: Receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 29 J1, J3 2 38-pin header, TH SAM1029-38-ND DNP: Headers enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 30 J1, J3 2 38-pin receptable, TH SAM1213-38-ND DNP: Receptacles enclosed with kit. Keep vias free of solder. 31 Rubber feet 4 Rubber feet Buerklin: 20H1724 apply to bottom side corners SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 133 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Power Management VCC01 = external VCC Vdd = DVCC Vdda1 = AVDD_RF / AVCC_RF Vdda2 = AVCC Port connectors CON1 .. CON3 = Port1 .. Port3 of cc430 CON4 = spare CON5 = 1: XIN 2: XOUT CON6 = Vdd, GND, Vcore, COM0, LCDCAP CON7 = Vdda1, Vdda2, GND, AGND CON8 = JTAG_BASE (JTAG Port) CON9 = Vdd, GND, AGND (May be addedclose to therespective pins to reduce emissions at 5GHz toel vel required byETSI) EM430F5137RF900 www.ti.com B.33 EM430F5137RF900 Figure B-65. EM430F5137RF900 Target board, Schematic 134 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated JTAG connector External power connector CON12 GND GND VCC Open to disconnect LEDs jumper JP5/JP10 LED D2 (red) connected to P3.6 via JP10 LED D1 (green) connected to P1.0 via JP5 RF - Crystal Q1 26 MHz RF - Signal SMA Reset button S1 Push-button S2 connected to P1.7 Jumper JP1 Close JTAG position to debug in JTAG mode Jumper JP2 Close EXT for external supply Close INT for JTAG supply Close SBW position to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Jumper JP1 Spy-Bi-Wire mode Footprint for 32kHz crystal Use 0 resistor for R431/R441 to make XIN/XOUT available on connector port5 ! Open to measure current jumper JP3 www.ti.com EM430F5137RF900 Figure B-66. EM430F5137RF900 Target board, PCB The battery pack that is included with the EM430F5137RF900 kit may be connected to CON12. Ensure correct battery insertion regarding the polarity as indicated in battery holder. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 135 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated EM430F5137RF900 www.ti.com Table B-35. EM430F5137RF900 Bill of Materials Item Reference No. per Description Value Manufacturer's Part Manufacturer Comment Board Number 1 Q1 1 ( CUSTOMER SUPPLY ) CRYSTAL, 26M ASX-531(CS) AKER SMT, 4P, 26MHz ELECTRONIC C1-C5, C082, C222, C271, CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 16V, 2 C281, C311, 14 10%, 0.1uF 0.1uF 0402YC104KAT2A AVX C321, C341, C412, C452 3 C071 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0603, CERAMIC, 0.47uF 0603YD474KAT2A AVX 0.47uF, 16V, 10%, X5R 4 R401 1 RES0402, 47.0K 47kΩ CRCW04024702F10 DALE 0 5 CON11 1 HEADER, THU, MALE, 14P, 2X7, 09 18 514 6323 HARTING 25.4x9.2x9.45mm 6 CON10 0 HEADER, THU, MALE, 10P, 2X5, 09 18 510 6323 HARTING DNP 20.32x9.2x9.45mm 7 D1 1 LED, SMT, 0603, GREEN, 2.1V active APT1608MGC KINGBRIGHT 8 D2 1 LED, SMT, 0603, RED, 2.0V active APT1608EC KINGBRIGHT 9 Q3 0 UNINSTALLED CRYSTAL, SMT, 3P, 32.768k MS1V-T1K (UN) MICRO DNP MS1V (Customer Supply) CRYSTAL 10 CON12 1 HEADER, THU, MALE, 3P, 1x3, 22-03-5035 MOLEX 9.9x4.9x5.9mm 11 C251, C261 2 50V, 5%, 27pF 27pF GRM36COG270J50 MURATA 12 L341 1 FERRITE, SMT, 0402, 1.0kΩ, 250mA 1kΩ BLM15HG102SN1D MURATA 13 C293 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 100pF GRM1555C1H101JZ MURATA 100pF, 50V, 0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 01 14 L304 1 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 2.2nH, 0.1nH, 0.0022uH LQP15MN2N2B02 MURATA 220mA, 500MHz 15 L303, L305 2 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 15nH, 2%, 0.015uH LQW15AN15NG00 MURATA 450mA, 250MHz 16 L292, L302 2 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 18nH, 2%, 0.018uH LQW15AN18NG00 MURATA 370mA, 250MHz 17 C291 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 1pF GRM1555C1H1R0W MURATA 1pF, 50V, 0.05pF, C0G(NP0) Z01 18 C303 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 8.2pF GRM1555C1H8R2W MURATA 8.2pF, 50V, 0.05pF, C0G(NP0) Z01 19 C292, C301- 4 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 1.5pF GRM1555C1H1R5W MURATA C302, C304 1.5pF, 50V, 0.05pF, C0G(NP0) Z01 20 L291, L301 2 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 12nH, 2%, 0.012uH LQW15AN12NG00 MURATA 500mA, 250MHz C282, C312, CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, GRM1555C1H2R0B 21 C351, C361, 5 2pF, 50V, 0.1pF, C0G 2.0pF Z01 Murata C371 22 L1 1 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 6.2nH, 0.1nH, 6.2nH LQP15MN6N2B02 Murata 130mA, 500MHz 23 S1-S2 2 ULTRA-SMALL TACTILE SWITCH, SMT, B3U-1000P OMRON 2P, SPST-NO, 1.2x3x2.5mm, 0.05A, 12V R4-R5, R051, UNINSTALLED RESISTOR/JUMPER, 24 R061, R431, 0 SMT, 0402, 0 Ω, 5%, 1/16W 0Ω ERJ-2GE0R00X PANASONIC DNP R441 24a R7 1 RESISTOR/JUMPER, SMT, 0402, 0 Ω, 0Ω ERJ-2GE0R00X PANASONIC 5%, 1/16W 25 R2-R3, R6 3 RESISTOR, SMT, 0402, THICK FILM, 330Ω ERJ-2GEJ331 PANASONIC 5%, 1/16W, 330 26 C431, C441 0 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 12pF, 12pF ECJ-0EC1H120J PANASONIC 50V, 5%, NPO 27 C401 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 2200pF, 0.0022uF ECJ-0EB1H222K PANASONIC 50V, 10%, X7R 28 R331 1 RESISTOR, SMT, THICK FILM, 56K, 56kΩ ERJ-2GEJ563 PANASONIC 1/16W, 5% 29 C081, C221, 4 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0603, CERAMIC, 10uF ECJ-1VB0J106M PANASONIC C411, C451 10uF, 6.3V, 20%, X5R 136 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com EM430F5137RF900 Table B-35. EM430F5137RF900 Bill of Materials (continued) Item Reference No. per Description Value Manufacturer's Part Manufacturer Comment Board Number 30 R1 1 RESISTOR/JUMPER, SMT, 0402, 0 Ω, 0Ω ERJ-2GE0R00X PANASONIC 5%, 1/16W 31 C041 0 UNINSTALLED CAP CERAMIC 4.7UF 4.7uF ECJ-1VB0J475K Panasonic DNP 6.3V X5R 0603 32 X1 1 SMA STRIGHT JACK, SMT 32K10A-40ML5 ROSENBERGER 33 Q2 0 Crystal, SMT, 32.768 kHz 32.768k MS3V-T1R Micro Crystal DNP 34 U1 1 DUT, SMT, PQFP, RGZ-48, 0.5mmLS, CC430F52x1 TI 7.15x7.15x1mm, THRM.PAD 35 JP1 1 Pin Connector 2x4pin 61300821121 WUERTH 36 CON1-CON9 0 Pin Connector 2x4pin 61300821121 WUERTH DNP 37 JP2 1 Pin Connector 1x3pin 61300311121 WUERTH 38 JP3, JP5, 3 Pin Connector 1x2pin 61300211121 WUERTH JP10 38a JP7, CON13 0 Pin Connector 1x2pin 61300211121 WUERTH DNP 39 JP4 1 Pin Connector 2x2pin 61300421121 WUERTH DNP 40 JP1a 1 Pin Connector 2x3pin 61300621121 WUERTH SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 137 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Power Management VCC01 = external VCC Vdd = DVCC Vdda1 = AVDD_RF / AVCC_RF Vdda2 = AVCC Port connectors CON1 .. CON5 = Port1 .. Port5 of cc430 CON6 = Vdd, GND, Vcore, COM0, LCDCAP CON7 = Vdda1, Vdda2, GND, AGND CON8 = JTAG_BASE (JTAG Port) CON9 = Vdd, GND, AGND (May beaddedcol se to therespective pins to reduce emissions at 5GHz to el vel required by ETSI) EM430F6137RF900 www.ti.com B.34 EM430F6137RF900 Figure B-67. EM430F6137RF900 Target board, Schematic 138 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated CON12 External power connector Jumper JP2 to "EXT" Jumpers JP5, JP10 Open to disconnect LEDs D2 LED (red) connected to P3.6 via JP10 D1 LED (green) connected to P1.0 via JP5 Crystal Q1 RF - 26 MHz X1 RF - Signal SMA Button S1 Reset Push-button S2 Connected to P1.7 Q2/Q3 Footprint for 32-kHz crystal Jumper JP3 Open to measure current GND GND VCC C392 C422 L451 Jumper JP1 in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Jumper JP2 Close INT for power supply via JTAG interface Close EXT to external power supply (CON12) Jumper JP1 Close SBW position to debug in Spy-Bi-Wire mode Close JTAG position to debug in 4-wire JTAG mode R541 and R551 Use 0- resistor to make P5.0 and P5.1 available on connector Port 5 W Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool www.ti.com EM430F6137RF900 Figure B-68. EM430F6137RF900 Target Board, PCB The battery pack that is included with the EM430F6137RF900 kit may be connected to CON12. Ensure correct battery insertion regarding the polarity as indicated in battery holder. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 139 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated EM430F6137RF900 www.ti.com Table B-36. EM430F6137RF900 Bill of Materials No. Pos. Ref Des per Description Part No. Manufacturer Board 1 Q1 1 ( CUSTOMER SUPPLY ) CRYSTAL, SMT, ASX-531(CS) AKER 4P, 26MHz ELECTRONIC C1-C5, C112, C252, C381, CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 16V, 10%, 2 C391, C421, 14 0.1uF 0402YC104KAT2A AVX C431, C451, C522, C562 3 C101 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0603, CERAMIC, 0.47uF, 0603YD474KAT2A AVX 16V, 10%, X5R 4 R511 1 RES0402, 47.0K CRCW04024702F100 DALE 5 CON11 1 HEADER, THU, MALE, 14P, 2X7, 09 18 514 6323 HARTING 25.4x9.2x9.45mm, 90deg 7 D1 1 LED, SMT, 0603, GREEN, 2.1V APT1608MGC KINGBRIGHT 8 D2 1 LED, SMT, 0603, RED, 2.0V APT1608EC KINGBRIGHT 10 CON12 1 HEADER, THU, MALE, 3P, 1x3, 22-03-5035 MOLEX 9.9x4.9x5.9mm 11 C361, C371 2 50V, ±5%, 27pF GRM36COG270J50 MURATA 12 L451 1 FERRITE, SMT, 0402, 1.0kΩ, 250mA BLM15HG102SN1D MURATA 13 C403 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 100pF, GRM1555C1H101JZ01 MURATA 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 14 L414 1 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 2.2nH, ±0.2nH, LQW15AN2N2C10 MURATA 1000mA, 250MHz 15 L413, L415 2 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 15nH, ±5%, 460mA, LQW15AN15NJ00 MURATA 250MHz 16 L402, L412 2 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 18nH, ±5%, 370mA, LQW15AN18NJ00 MURATA 250MHz 17 C401 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 1pF, 50V, GJM1555C1H1R0CB01D MURATA ±0.25pF, NP0 18 C413 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 8.2pF, GRM1555C1H8R2CZ01 MURATA 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 19 C402, C411- 4 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 1.5pF, GRM1555C1H1R5CZ01 MURATA C412, C414 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 20 L401, L411 2 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 12nH, ±5%, 500mA, LQW15AN12NJ00 MURATA 250MHz 21 C46-C48, 5 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 2.0pF, GRM1555C1H2R0CZ01 Murata C392, C422 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 22 L1 1 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 6.2nH, ±0.1nH, LQW15AN6N2D00 Murata 700mA, 250MHz 23 S1-S2 2 ULTRA-SMALL TACTILE SWITCH, SMT, 2P, B3U-1000P OMRON SPST-NO, 1.2x3x2.5mm, 0.05A, 12V 24 R7 1 RESISTOR/JUMPER, SMT, 0402, 0 Ω, 5%, ERJ-2GE0R00X (UN) PANASONIC 1/16W 25 R2-R3, R6 3 RESISTOR, SMT, 0402, THICK FILM, 5%, ERJ-2GEJ331 PANASONIC 1/16W, 330 27 C511 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 2200pF, ECJ-0EB1H222K PANASONIC 50V, 10%, X7R 28 C111, C251, 4 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0603, CERAMIC, 10uF, ECJ-1VB0J106M PANASONIC C521, C561 6.3V, 20%, X5R 28a C041 1 CAP CERAMIC 4.7UF 6.3V X5R 0603 ECJ-1VB0J475M PANASONIC 29 R441 1 RESISTOR, SMT, THICK FILM, 56K, 1/16W, ERJ-2RKF5602 PANASONIC 1% 30 R1 1 RESISTOR/JUMPER, SMT, 0402, 0 Ω, 5%, ERJ-2GE0R00X PANASONIC 1/16W 31 X1 1 SMA STRIGHT JACK, SMT 32K10A-40ML5 ROSENBERGER 140 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com EM430F6137RF900 Table B-36. EM430F6137RF900 Bill of Materials (continued) No. Pos. Ref Des per Description Part No. Manufacturer Board 33 U1 1 DUT, SMT, PQFP, RGC-64, 0.5mmLS, CC430F6137 TI 9.15x9.15x1mm, THRM.PAD 34 JP1 1 Pin Connector 2x4pin 61300821121 WUERTH 35 JP2 1 Pin Connector 1x3pin 61300311121 WUERTH 36a JP3, JP5, JP10 3 Pin Connector 1x2pin 61300211121 WUERTH 38 JP1a 1 Pin Connector 2x3pin 61300621121 WUERTH SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 141 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated EM430F6147RF900 www.ti.com B.35 EM430F6147RF900 Figure B-69. EM430F6147RF900 Target Board, Schematic 142 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Orient pin 1 of MSP430 device D1 LED (green) connected to P1.0 via JP5 Jumpers JP5 and JP10 Open to disconnect LEDs D2 LED (red) connected to P3.6 via JP10 Jumpers JP6 and JP8 Close 1-2 for Bypass mode Jumper JP9 Close 2-3 for TPS mode TPS status Connector JTAG For JTAG Tool Connector BOOTST For Bootstrap Loader Tool TPS62730 Jumper JP2 Close INT: Power supply via JTAG interface Close EXT: External power supply Button S2 Connected to P1.7 32-kHz crystal R554 and R551 Use 0- resistor to make P5.0 and P5.1 available on connector Port 5 W Button S1 Reset Jumper JP3 Open to measure current CON12 External poser connector Jumper JP2 to "EXT" Crystal Q1 RF - 26 MHz SMA1 RF - Signal SMA Jumper JP1 Close JTAG position to debug in JTAG mode Close SBW position to debug in Spy-BI-Wire mode www.ti.com EM430F6147RF900 Figure B-70. EM430F6147RF900 Target Board, PCB The battery pack which comes with the EM430F6147RF900 kit may be connected to CON12. Ensure correct battery insertion regarding the polarity as indicated in battery holder. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 143 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated EM430F6147RF900 www.ti.com Table B-37. EM430F6147RF900 Bill of Materials No. Pos. Ref Des per Description Part No. Manufacturer Board 1 Q1 1 ( CUSTOMER SUPPLY ) CRYSTAL, SMT, ASX-531(CS) AKER 4P, 26MHz ELECTRONIC C1-5 C112 C252 C381 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 16V, 10%, 2 C391 C421 14 0.1uF 0402YC104KAT2A AVX C431 C451 C522 C562 3 C101 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0603, CERAMIC, 0.47uF, 0603YD474KAT2A AVX 16V, 10%, X5R 4 R511 1 RES0402, 47.0K CRCW04024702F100 DALE 5 CON11 1 HEADER, THU, MALE, 14P, 2X7, 09 18 514 6323 HARTING 25.4x9.2x9.45mm, 90deg 7 D1 1 LED, SMT, 0603, GREEN, 2.1V APT1608MGC KINGBRIGHT 8 D2 1 LED, SMT, 0603, RED, 2.0V APT1608EC KINGBRIGHT 10 CON12 1 HEADER, THU, MALE, 3P, 1x3, 22-03-5035 MOLEX 9.9x4.9x5.9mm 11 C361, C371 2 50V, ±5%, 27pF GRM36COG270J50 MURATA 12 L451 1 Inductor, SMD, 0402, 12nH, 5%, 370mA LQW15AN12NJ00 MURATA 13 C403 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 100pF, GRM1555C1H101JZ01 MURATA 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 14 L414 1 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 2.2nH, ±0.2nH, LQW15AN2N2C10 MURATA 1000mA, 250MHz 15 L413 1 Inductor, SMD, 0402, 15nH, 5%, 370mA, LQW15AN15NJ00 MURATA 250MHz 15 L415 1 INDUCTOR,SMT,0402,15nH,±5%,460mA,250 LQW15AN15NJ00 MURATA MHz 16 L402, L412 2 Inductor, SMD, 0402, 18nH, 5%, 460mA, LQW15AN18NJ00 MURATA 250MHz 17 C401 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 1pF, 50V, GJM1555C1H1R0CB01D MURATA ±0.25pF, NP0 18 C413 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 8.2pF, GRM1555C1H8R2CZ01 MURATA 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 19 C402, C411- 4 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 1.5pF, GRM1555C1H1R5CZ01 MURATA C412, C414 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 20 L1, L401, L411 3 INDUCTOR, SMT, 0402, 12nH, ±5%, 500mA, LQW15AN12NJ00 MURATA 250MHz 21 C46-C48, 4 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CERAMIC, 2.0pF, GRM1555C1H2R0CZ01 MURATA C392 50V, ±0.25pF, C0G(NP0) 22 L2 1 Inductor, SMD, 0805, 2.2uH, 20%, 600mA, LQM21PN2R2MC0 MURATA 50MHz 23 S1-S2 2 ULTRA-SMALL TACTILE SWITCH, SMT, 2P, B3U-1000P OMRON SPST-NO, 1.2x3x2.5mm, 0.05A, 12V 24 R1, R7, R551, 4 RESISTOR/JUMPER, SMT, 0402, 0 Ω, 5%, ERJ-2GE0R00X (UN) PANASONIC R554 1/16W 25 R2-R3, R6 3 RESISTOR, SMT, 0402, THICK FILM, 5%, ERJ-2GEJ331 PANASONIC 1/16W, 330 27 C511 1 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0402, CER, 2200pF, ECJ-0EB1H222K PANASONIC 50V, 10%, X7R 28 C111, C251, 4 CAPACITOR, SMT, 0603, CERAMIC, 1uF, ECJ-1VB0J105K PANASONIC C521, C561 6.3V, 20%, X5R 28a C041 1 CAP CERAMIC 4.7UF 6.3V X5R 0603 ECJ-1VB0J475M PANASONIC 29 R441 1 RESISTOR, SMT, THICK FILM, 56K, 1/16W, ERJ-2RKF5602 PANASONIC 1% 30 X1 1 SMA STRIGHT JACK, SMT 32K10A-40ML5 ROSENBERGER 144 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com EM430F6147RF900 Table B-37. EM430F6147RF900 Bill of Materials (continued) No. Pos. Ref Des per Description Part No. Manufacturer Board 31 U1 1 DUT, SMT, PQFP, RGC-64, 0.5mmLS, CC430F6147 TI 9.15x9.15x1mm, THRM.PAD 33 U2 1 IC, Step Down Converter with Bypass Mode TPS62370 TI for Low Power Wireless 34 JP1 1 Pin Connector 2x4pin 61300821121 WUERTH 35 JP2, JP6, JP8 3 Pin Connector 1x3pin 61300311121 WUERTH 36a JP3, JP5, JP9, 4 Pin Connector 1x2pin 61300211121 WUERTH JP10 38 JP1a 1 Pin Connector 2x3pin 61300621121 WUERTH 38 C7 1 Capacitor, Ceramic, 1206, 16V, X5R, 20% GRM31CR61C226ME15L MURATA 38 C8-9 2 CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0402, 2.2uF, X5R GRM155R60J225ME15D MURATA 38 C041 1 CAP, SMD, Ceramic, 0603, 4.7uF, 16V, 10%, MURATA X5R SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 145 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET www.ti.com B.36 MSP-FET The MSP-FET is a powerful flash emulation tool to quickly begin application development on MSP430 microcontrollers. It includes a USB interface to program and debug the MSP430 in-system through the JTAG interface or the pin-saving Spy-Bi-Wire (2-wire JTAG) protocol. The enclosed MSP-FET development tool supports development with all MSP430 devices and is designed for use in conjunction with PCBs that contain MSP430 devices; for example, the MSP430 target socket boards. B.36.1 Features • USB debugging interface to connect a MSP430 MCU to a PC for real-time in-system programming and debugging • Software configurable supply voltage between 1.8 V and 3.6 V at 100 mA • Supports JTAG Security Fuse blow to protect code • Supports all MSP430 boards with JTAG header • Supports both JTAG and Spy-Bi-Wire (2-wire JTAG) debug protocols B.36.2 Release Notes The MSP-FET is supported by MSP Debug Stack (MSPDS) revision 3.4.0.20 and higher. Observe the following MSPDS-specific MSP-FET limitations. B.36.2.1 MSPDS 3.4.0.20 Limitations • EEM access to F149 and L092 devices is possible only when JTAG speed is set to slow. • Poly Fuse Blow in Spy-Bi-Wire mode is in beta state and is not officially supported. • The UART backchannel function is not implemented (even though an additional COM port is shown on the PC). B.36.2.2 MSPDS UART Backchannel Implementation In MSPDS v3.4.1.0 and later, the UART backchannel function is implemented and supported for the MSPFET. The baud rates that are supported depend on the target configuration and the debug settings. Table B-38 shows which baud rates are supported with certain configuration combinations. A green cell with ✓ means that the corresponding baud rate is supported without any data loss with the specified combination of settings. A red cell with ✗ means that the corresponding baud rate is not supported (data loss is expected) with the specified combination of settings. Table B-38. UART Backchannel Implementation Target MCLK Frequency: 1 MHz 1 MHz 8 MHz 8 MHz 1 MHz 1 MHz 8 MHz 8 MHz Debugger: Active Active Active Active Inactive Inactive Inactive Inactive Flow Control: No Yes No Yes No Yes No Yes 4800 baud ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ 9600 baud ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ 19200 baud ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ 28800 baud ✗ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ 38400 baud ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓ ✓ ✓ 57200 baud ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓ 115200 baud ✗ ✗ ✗ ✓ ✗ ✗ ✗ ✓ 146 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-FET Figure B-71. MSP-FET Top View Figure B-72. MSP-FET Bottom View SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 147 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET Rev 1.2 1 3/12/2014 3/12/2014 C 4 A B C D Date E Sheet of F 4 2 1 Title 3 1 A B C D E Size Number F 2 3 Rev 1 A 5 General power supply Additional supply LED USB interface Host MCU DVCC1 DVCC3 DVCC2 AVCC1 Debug i/f USB BSL activation VBUS bypass 1 P6.4/CB4/A4 2 P6.5/CB5/A5 3 P6.6/CB6/A6/DAC0 4 P6.7/CB7/A7/DAC1 5 P7.4/CB8/A12 6 P7.5/CB9/A13 7 P7.6/CB10/A14/DAC0 8 P7.7/CB11/A15/DAC1 9 P5.0/VREF+/VEREF+ 10 P5.1/VREF-/VEREF- 11 AVCC1 12 AVSS1 13 XIN 14 XOUT 15 AVSS2 16 P5.6/ADC12CLK/DMAE0 17 P2.0/P2MAP0 18 P2.1/P2MAP1 19 P2.2/P2MAP2 20 P2.3/P2MAP3 21 P2.4/P2MAP4 22 P2.5/P2MAP5 23 P2.6/P2MAP6/R03 24 P2.7/P2MAP7/LCDREF/ 25 DVCC1 26 DVSS1 27 VCORE(2) 28 P5.2/R23 29 LCDCAP/R33 30 COM0 31 P5.3/COM1/S42 32 P5.4/COM2/S41 33 P5.5/COM3/S40 34 P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK/S3 35 P1.1/TA0.0/S38 36 P1.2/TA0.1/S37 37 P1.3/TA0.2/S36 38 P1.4/TA0.3/S35 39 P1.5/TA0.4/S34 40 P1.6/TA0.1/S33 41 P1.7/TA0.2/S32 42 P3.0/TA1CLK/CBOUT/S 43 P3.1/TA1.0/S30 44 P3.2/TA1.1/S29 45 P3.3/TA1.2/S28 46 P3.4/TA2CLK/SMCLK/S 47 P3.5/TA2.0/S26 48 P3.6/TA2.1/S25 49 P3.7/TA2.2/S24 50 P4.0/TB0.0/S23 P4.1/TB0.1/S22 51 P4.2/TB0.2/S21 52 P4.3/TB0.3/S20 53 P4.4/TB0.4/S19 54 P4.5/TB0.5/S18 55 P4.6/TB0.6/S17 56 P4.7/TB0OUTH/SVMOUT57 P8.0/TB0CLK/S1558 P8.1/UCB1STE 59 P8.2/UCA1TXD 60 P8.3/UCA1RXD 61 P8.4/UCB1CLK/UCA1ST62 DVSS2 63 DVCC2 64 P8.5/UCB1SIMO 65 P8.6/UCB1SOMI 66 P8.7/S8 67 P9.0/S7 68 P9.1/S6 69 P9.2/S5 70 P9.3/S4 71 P9.4/S3 72 P9.5/S2 73 P9.6/S1 74 P9.7/S0 75 VSSU 76 PU.0/DP 77 PUR 78 PU.1/DM 79 VBUS 80 81 VUSB V18 82 AVSS3 83 P7.2/XT2IN 84 P7.3/XT2OUT 85 VBAK 86 87 VBAT P5.7/RTCCLK 88 DVCC3 89 DVSS3 90 TEST/SBWTCK 91 PJ.0/TDO 92 93 PJ.1/TDI/TCLK PJ.2/TMS 94 PJ.3/TCK 95 RST/NMI/SBWTDIO96 P6.0/CB0/A0 97 P6.1/CB1/A1 98 99 P6.2/CB2/A2 100 P6.3/CB3/A3 U1 MSP430F6638IPZR C6 100n + C5 10uF/6.3V C7 100n C9 100n C11 100n 0R R1 C15 68p C16 470n C17 220n C18 4.7n D1 D2 R47 470R 0R R50 1 IO1 2 IO2 3 GND IO3 4 IO4 5 VCC 6 U5 TPD4E004DRYR 1k4 R2 C14 4.7u, dnp C23 100n 33k R60 C31 10p C33 10p R61 1M R62 100R J5 C8 220n 3 1 2 P1 0R R17 A C D7 B0530W-7-F R76 27k C70 4.7u, dnp C71 100n R85 0R, dnp C55 1n R3 27R R45 27R R46 470R + C12 10uF/6.3V 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 11 10 J1 R28 4k7 R30 4k7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 VCC_DT_REF VCC_DCDC_REF VCC_DT2TRGT_CTRL VCC_SUPPLY2TRGT_CTRL LED1 TDIOFF_CTRL PWM_SETVF FPGA_TCK FPGA_TDI FPGA_TMS FPGA_TDO FPGA_TRST VF2TEST_CTRL VF2TDI_CTRL AVCC_POD VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VREF+ VCORE VBAK MCU_DMAE0 DCDC_PULSE MCU_P2.2 MCU_P2.3 MCU_P2.4 MCU_P2.5 MCU_P2.6 MCU_P2.7 MCU_P1.0 MCU_P1.1 MCU_P1.2 MCU_P1.3 MCU_P1.4 MCU_P1.5 MCU_P1.6 MCU_P1.7 MCU_P3.0 MCU_P3.1 MCU_P3.2 MCU_P3.3 MCU_P3.4 MCU_P3.5 MCU_P3.6 MCU_P3.7 MCU_P4.0 MCU_P4.1 MCU_P4.2 MCU_P4.3 MCU_P4.4 MCU_P4.5 MCU_P4.6 MCU_P4.7 MCU_P8.1 MCU_P8.2 MCU_P8.3 PUR PU.1/DM PU.0/DP VBUS VUSB AVCC_POD VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 AVCC_POD VCC_POD33 VREF+ VCORE V18 V18 VBAK HOST_TEST HOST_RST FPGA_RESET LED0 LED1 PUR VUSB PU.1/DM PU.0/DP DCDC_RST HOST_SCL HOST_SDA DCDC_IO0 LED0 A_VBUS5 VBUS A_VCC_SUPPLY_HOST DCDC_TEST A_VF MCU_P9.5 DCDC_IO1 HOST_TCK HOST_TMS HOST_TDI HOST_TDO VCC_POD33 HOST_RST VCC_POD33 GND1 VBUS5 MCU_P2.1 GND1 GND1 VCC_DT2SUPPLY_CTRL A_VCC_DT A_VCC_DT_BSR A_VCC_SENSE0_TRGT VCC_POD33 VCC_DT_SENSE MSP-FET www.ti.com B.36.3 Schematics Figure B-73. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (1 of 5) 148 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET Rev 1.2 3/12/2014 5 1 A 2 Rev 3 2 F Size Number A B C D E 1 3 Title 1 2 4 F Sheet of E Date A B C D 4 C 3/12/2014 VCC_PUMP VCC_JTAG FPGA 1 GND 2 GAA2/IO51RSB1 3 IO52RSB1 4 GAB2/IO53RSB1 5 IO95RSB1 6 GAC2/IO94RSB1 7 IO93RSB1 8 IO92RSB1 9 GND 10 GFB1/IO87RSB1 11 GFB0/IO86RSB1 12 VCOMPLF 13 GFA0/IO85RSB1 14 VCCPLF 15 GFA1/IO84RSB1 16 GFA2/IO83RSB1 17 VCC 18 VCCIB1 19 GEC1/IO77RSB1 20 GEB1/IO75RSB1 21 GEB0/IO74RSB1 22 GEA1/IO73RSB1 23 GEA0/IO72RSB1 24 VMV1 25 GNDQ 26 GEA2/IO71RSB1 27 FF/GEB2/IO70RSB1 28 GEC2/IO69RSB1 29 IO68RSB1 30 IO67RSB1 31 IO66RSB1 32 IO65RSB1 33 IO64RSB1 34 IO63RSB1 35 IO62RSB1 36 IO61RSB1 37 VCC 38 GND 39 VCCIB1 40 IO60RSB1 41 IO59RSB1 42 IO58RSB1 43 IO57RSB1 44 GDC2/IO56RSB1 45 GDB2/IO55RSB1 46 GDA2/IO54RSB1 47 TCK 48 TDI 49 TMS 50 VMV1 GND 51 VPUMP 52 NC 53 TDO 54 TRST 55 VJTAG 56 GDA1/IO49RSB057 GDC0/IO46RSB058 GDC1/IO45RSB059 GCC2/IO43RSB060 GCB2/IO42RSB061 GCA0/IO40RSB062 GCA1/IO39RSB063 GCC0/IO36RSB064 GCC1/IO35RSB065 VCCIB0 66 GND 67 VCC 68 IO31RSB0 69 GBC2/IO29RSB070 GBB2/IO27RSB071 IO26RSB0 72 GBA2/IO25RSB073 VMV0 74 GNDQ 75 GBA1/IO24RSB076 GBA0/IO23RSB077 GBB1/IO22RSB078 GBB0/IO21RSB079 GBC1/IO20RSB080 81 GBC0/IO19RSB0 IO18RSB0 82 IO17RSB0 83 IO15RSB0 84 IO13RSB0 85 IO11RSB0 86 87 VCCIB0 GND 88 VCC 89 IO10RSB0 90 IO09RSB0 91 IO08RSB0 92 93 GAC1/IO07RSB0 GAC0/IO06RSB094 GAB1/IO05RSB095 GAB0/IO04RSB096 GAA1/IO03RSB097 GAA0/IO02RSB098 99 IO01RSB0 100 IO00RSB0 U2 A3PN125-VQG100 R4 1k R5 1k 1 2 L3 33n + C19 10uF/6.3V C20 100n C21 10n C22 100n C34 10n C35 100n C36 10n C37 100n C38 10n C39 100n C40 10n C41 100n C42 10n C43 100n C44 10n C45 100n C46 10n C47 100n C48 10n C49 100n C50 10n C51 100n C52 10n R44 27R 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 VCC_PLF VCC_POD15 VCC_POD15 VCC_POD15 VCC_POD15 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 FPGA_TCK FPGA_TDI FPGA_TMS FPGA_TRST MCU_DMAE0 MCU_P2.2 MCU_P2.3 MCU_P2.4 MCU_P2.5 MCU_P2.6 MCU_P1.0 MCU_P1.1 MCU_P1.2 MCU_P1.3 MCU_P1.4 MCU_P1.5 MCU_P1.6 MCU_P1.7 MCU_P3.0 MCU_P3.1 MCU_P3.2 MCU_P3.3 MCU_P3.4 MCU_P3.5 MCU_P3.6 MCU_P3.7 MCU_P4.0 MCU_P4.1 MCU_P4.2 MCU_P4.3 MCU_P4.4 MCU_P4.5 MCU_P4.6 MCU_P4.7 MCU_P8.1 MCU_P8.2 MCU_P8.3 FPGA_IO_TCK FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TCK FPGA_IO_TMS FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TMS FPGA_IO_TDI FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TDI FPGA_IO_TDO FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TDO MCU_P2.7 FPGA_DIR_CTRL_RST FPGA_IO_TEST FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TEST FPGA_IO_UART_TXD FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_TXD FPGA_IO_UART_RXD FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_RXD FPGA_IO_UART_CTS FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_CTS FPGA_IO_UART_RTS FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_RTS FPGA_TDO FPGA_RESET VCC_POD15 VCC_POD15 VCC_POD33 VCC_PLF VCC_POD33 VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_RST FPGA_TP0 FPGA_TP1 FPGA_TP2 MCU_P9.5 MCU_P2.1 www.ti.com MSP-FET Figure B-74. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (2 of 5) SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 149 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 3/12/2014 3/12/2014 C 4 A B C D Date E Sheet of F 4 2 1 3 1 A B C D E Size Number F 2 3 Rev 3 A 1 5 S/W controlled DCDC converter DCDC MCU reference voltage DT level shifter supply DCDC calibration switch DCDC MCU DCDC MCU debug i/f DT current measurement shunt DT current sense MSP-FET Rev 1.2 Energy measurement method protected under U.S. Patent Application 13/329,073 and subsequent patent applications 1 DVCC 2 P1.0/TA0CLK 3 P1.1/TA0.0 4 P1.2/TA0.1 5 P1.3/ADC10CLK 6 P1.4/TA0.2 7 P1.5/TA0.0 P1.6/TA0.1 8 P1.7/SDI 9 NMI-RST 10 TEST/SBWTCK 11 XOUT/P2.7 12 XIN/P2.6 13 DVSS 14 U4 MSP430G2452PW MSP430G2452PW 1 2 L4 R53 R55 R56 R64 1 2 3 D4 R65 220k C28 33p R63 C53 100n 1 NO1 2 COM1 3 NO2 4 COM2 5 IN2 6 IN3 7 GND NO3 8 COM3 9 COM4 10 NO4 11 IN4 12 IN1 13 V+ 14 U20 TS3A4751PWR TS3A4751PWR C13 1n, dnp C56 4.7u + C57 2.2u C63 100n R19 1 A1 2 A2 C1,C2 3 D8 C66 1n 0R R20 R23180k R25150k R15 220k 1 G 2 S 3 D Q3 R26 27k, dnp 1 IN 2 GND 3 EN NR 4 OUT 5 U7 TPS73401DDCT C54 1n C26 2.2u R24160k C24 1n C62 10n C29 4.7u C10 1u 2E B1 C 3 Q4 R6 220k C1 33p R7 220k C65 100n 5 IN- 4 IN+ 6 OUT 1 REF 2 GND 3 V+ U10 INA21XDCK INA214AIDCKT C67 10p C68 1n 10R R49 10R R54 R57 0.2 C69 2.2u C72 2.2u C73 2.2u 1 1 DCDC_CAL0 DCDC_CAL2 DCDC_TEST DCDC_RST HOST_SDA DCDC_CAL1 VCC_POD33 DCDC_PULSE DCDC_IO0 VCC_DCDC_REF A_VCC_SUPPLY VBUS5 VCC_SUPPLY A_VCC_SUPPLY DCDC_CAL0 VCC_SUPPLY VCC_DT DCDC_CAL1 DCDC_CAL2 DCDC_RST VCC_POD33 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 VBUS GND1 GND1 GND1 DCDCGND GND1 DCDCGND DCDCGND DCDCGND DCDCGND DCDCGND GND1 VCC_SUPPLY GND1 GND1 VCC_DT_REF GND1 DCDC_IO1 VCC_DT HOST_SCL VCC_DT_BSR VCC_SUPPLY A_VCC_SUPPLY_HOST VCC_SUPPLY VCC_POD33 VCC_DT_SENSE VCC_DT VCC_DT_BSR GND1 GND1 GND1 MSP-FET www.ti.com Figure B-75. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (3 of 5) 150 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 3/12/2014 5 1 A 4 Rev 3 2 F Size Number A B C D E 1 3 1 2 4 F Sheet of E Date A B C D 4 C 3/12/2014 VF = +5V ... 6.5V Fuse blow step-up converter Fuse voltage multiplexer / VCC_DT to level shifters ESD protection Target MCU connector DT level shifters MSP-FET Rev 1.2 S1 D1 IN2 GND S2 D2 IN1 VDD U6 ADG821BRMZ-REEL7 D5 dnp MMSZ5232B-7-F R13 100R R14 2k2 S1 D1 IN2 GND S2 D2 IN1 VDD U9 ADG821BRMZ-REEL7 L2 33u C30 330n E B C Q1 BC817-16LT1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 J6 R35 100R 1 IO1 2 IO2 3 IO3 4 IO4 IO5 5 IO6 6 IO7 7 IO8 8 9 GND U3 TPD8E003DQD TPD8E003DQDR 1 IO1 2 IO2 3 IO3 4 IO4 IO5 5 IO6 6 IO7 7 IO8 8 9 GND U21 TPD8E003DQD TPD8E003DQDR R22 47k R29 47k R42 1k D3 dnp DDZ9692-7 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U12 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U13 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U14 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U15 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U16 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U17 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U22 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U26 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U27 SN74LVC1T45DCKR 1 VCCA 2 GND 3 A B 4 DIR 5 VCCB 6 U28 SN74LVC1T45DCKR R27 47k R31 47k R84 47k, dnp R86 47k R87 47k R88 47k R89 47k R90 47k R91 47k R92 47k R93 47k R94 47k R95 47k R96 47k R97 47k R98 47k R99 47k R100 47k R101 47k R102 47k C77 100n C78 100n C79 100n C80 100n C82 100n C83 100n C84 100n C85 100n R32 100R R33 100R R34 100R R37 100R R38 100R R39 100R R40 100R R41 100R R43 100R A C D10 B0530W-7-F A C D6 DNP B0530W-7-F + C74 100u/10V R48 47k R58 47k R59 47k 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 VF VF2TDI_CTRL VF VF2TEST_CTRL TDIOFF_CTRL VF TC_TDI_FD VF_TDI VBUS VF TC_TEST_FD VF_TEST TC_TEST_BSR TC_TDI_BSR TC_TDO_FD VCC_SENSE0_TRGT TC_TMS_FD TC_TCK_FD TC_UART_CTS_FD TC_RST_FD TC_UART_TXD_FD TC_UART_RTS_FD TC_UART_RXD_FD VCC_SUPPLY_TRGT TC_TDI_BSR TC_TEST_BSR VCC_SUPPLY_TRGT TC_TDO_FD TC_TCK_FD TC_TEST_BSR VCC_SENSE0_TRGT TC_TMS_FD TC_TDI_BSR TC_UART_CTS_FD TC_UART_RTS_FD TC_UART_RXD_FD TC_RST_FD TC_UART_TXD_FD VCC_JTAGLDO_TRGT VCC_JTAGLDO_TRGT VCC_DT2TRGT_CTRL VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT GND1 PWM_SETVF VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_TCK FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TCK TC_TCK_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_TMS FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TMS TC_TMS_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_TDI FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TDI TC_TDI_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_TDO FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TDO TC_TDO_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_RST FPGA_DIR_CTRL_RST TC_RST_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_TEST FPGA_DIR_CTRL_TEST TC_TEST_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_UART_TXD FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_TXD TC_UART_TXD_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_UART_RXD FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_RXD TC_UART_RXD_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_UART_CTS FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_CTS TC_UART_CTS_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 FPGA_IO_UART_RTS FPGA_DIR_CTRL_UART_RTS TC_UART_RTS_FD VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_DT_TRGT VCC_POD33 GND1 VCC_DT_TRGT GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 GND1 VCC_POD33 GND1 GND1 VF_TDI VF_TEST www.ti.com MSP-FET Figure B-76. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (4 of 5) SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 151 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 3/12/2014 3/12/2014 C 4 A B C D Date E Sheet of F 4 2 1 3 1 A B C D E Size Number F 2 3 Rev 5 A 1 5 MSP-FET power supply Target power switch Analog inputs to Host MCU Test points Common debug and test i/f MSP-FET Rev 1.2 R80R R11 150k C3 33p R51 240k R52 150k C27 33p R12 270k R36 150k C4 33p TP3 TP0 TP4 TP5 TP6 TP1 TP2 R10 150k R21 47k 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J4 HEADER_1X8_50MIL_A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J2 HEADER_1X8_50MIL_A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J3 HEADER_1X8_50MIL_A C32 33p R78 150k R79 150k TP7 TP9 TP8 TP11 R16 47k 1 NO1 2 V+ 3 IN1 4 COM2 NO2 5 GND 6 IN2 7 COM1 8 U18 TS5A21366RSE TS5A21366RSER 1 EN1 2 IN 3 EN2 GND 4 OUT2 5 OUT1 6 U19 TLV7111533D C25 10n C58 1u C59 1u C61 1u C2 33p R9 150k R18 150k 1 1 1 1 1 1 VCC_SENSE0_TRGT A_VCC_SENSE0_TRGT VBUS5 A_VBUS5 VF A_VF DCDC_PULSE VCC_SUPPLY FPGA_TP0 FPGA_TP1 FPGA_TP2 VBUS GND1 VBUS HOST_TEST HOST_TDO HOST_TDI HOST_TMS HOST_TCK HOST_RST DCDC_RST DCDC_TEST VCC_POD33 FPGA_TRST FPGA_TCK FPGA_TMS FPGA_TDI FPGA_TDO GND1 GND1 A_VCC_SUPPLY_HOST VCC_POD15 VBUS5 VCC_DT A_VCC_DT GND1 DCDC_IO0 DCDC_IO1 VCC_DT HOST_SCL HOST_SDA VCC_SUPPLY_TRGT VCC_SUPPLY_TRGT VBUS VCC_SUPPLY2TRGT_CTRL VCC_SUPPLY VCC_DT VCC_DT2SUPPLY_CTRL GND1 GND1 GND1 VCC_POD15 VBUS VCC_POD33 PWRGND PWRGND PWRGND PWRGND PWRGND VCC_DT_BSR A_VCC_DT_BSR MSP-FET www.ti.com Figure B-77. MSP-FET USB Debugger, Schematic (5 of 5) 152 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-FET B.36.4 Layout Figure B-78. MSP-FET USB Debugger, PCB (Top) Figure B-79. MSP-FET USB Debugger, PCB (Bottom) B.36.5 LED Signals The MSP-FET shows its operating states using two LEDs, one green and one red. Table B-39 lists all available operation modes. An or icon indicates that the LED is off, an or icon indicates that the LED is on, and an or icon indicates that the LED flashes. Table B-39. MSP-FET LED Signals Function Power LED Mode LED MSP-FET not connected to PC, or MSP-FET not ready; for example, after a major firmware update. Connect or reconnect MSP-FET to PC. MSP-FET connected and ready MSP-FET waiting for data transfer Ongoing data transfer An error has occurred; for example, target VCC overcurrent. Unplug MSP-FET from target, and cycle the power off and on. Check target connection, and reconnect MSP-FET. Firmware update in progress. Do not disconnect MSP-FET while both LEDs are blinking. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 153 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET www.ti.com B.36.6 JTAG Target Connector Figure B-80 shows the pinout of the JTAG connector. Figure B-80. JTAG Connector Pinout Table B-40. JTAG Connector Pin State by Operating Mode Pin Name After Power-Up When JTAG Protocol is When Spy-Bi-Wire Protocol Selected is Selected 1 TDO/TDI Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V In, TDO In and Out, SBWTDIO 2 VCC_TOOL 3.3 V VCC VCC 3 TDI/VPP Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V Out, TDI Hi-Z, pulled up to VCC 4 VCC_TARGET In, external VCC sense In, external VCC sense In, external VCC sense 5 TMS Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V Out, TMS Hi-Z, pulled up to VCC 6 N/C N/C N/C N/C 7 TCK Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V Out, TCK Out, SBWTCK 8 TEST/VPP Out, Gnd Out, TEST Hi-Z, pulled up to VCC 9 GND Ground Ground Ground 10 UART_CTS/SPI_CLK/I2C_SCL Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V Out, Target UART Clear-To- Out, Target UART Clear-To- Send Handshake input Send Handshake input 11 RST Out, VCC Out, RST Out 12 UART_TXD/SPI_SOMI/I2C_SDA Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V In, Target UART TXD output In, Target UART TXD output 13 UART_RTS Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V In, Target UART Ready-to- In, Target UART Ready-to- Send Handshake output Send Handshake output 14 UART_RXD/SPI_SIMO Hi-Z, pulled up to 3.3 V Out, Target UART RXD input Out, Target UART RXD input 154 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated 12 UART_TXD 11 RST 8 TEST 7 TCK 5 TMS 3 TDI 1 TDO/TDI 2 VCC_TOOL - USB Power 10 UART_CTS 14 UART_RXD 13 UART_RTS Pin Signal www.ti.com MSP-FET Figure B-81 shows the state of each pin in the connector after power-up. Figure B-81. Pin States After Power-Up SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 155 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET www.ti.com B.36.7 Specifications Table B-41 shows the physical and electrical specifications of the MSP-FET. Table B-41. Specifications Mechanical Size (without cables) 80 mm x 50 mm x 20 mm Interfaces USB interface USB 2.0, full speed Target interface JTAG 14-pin See Table B-40 for pinout JTAG cable length 20 cm (max) JTAG and Spy-Bi-Wire Interface, Electrical Power supply USB powered, 200 mA (max) Target output voltage 1.8 V to 3.6 V Selectable in 0.1-V steps. VCC_TOOL available from JTAG pin 2. VCC_TOOL Target output current 100 mA (max) Current supplied through JTAG pin 2 Target output overcurrent 160 mA (max) detection level JTAG signal overcurrent 30 mA (max) Total current supplied through JTAG pins 1, 3, 5, 7, 8, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 detection level External target supply Supported (1.8 V to 3.6 V) Connect external target voltage VCC_TARGET to JTAG pin 4. JTAG and SBW signals are regulated to external target voltage ±100 mV. Fuse blow Supported For devices with poly-fuse JTAG and Spy-Bi-Wire Interface, Timing JTAG clock speed 8 MHz (max) Protocol speed selectable by software Spy‑Bi‑Wire clock speed 8 MHz (max) Protocol speed selectable by software. System limitations due to external RC components on reset pin (SBWTDIO) might apply. JTAG and Spy-Bi-Wire Interface, Speed Flash write speed (JTAG) Up to 20 kB/sec Flash write speed Up to 7 kB/sec (Spy‑Bi‑Wire) FRAM write speed (JTAG) Up to 50 kB/sec FRAM write speed Up to 14 kB/sec (Spy‑Bi‑Wire) EnergyTrace™ Technology Target output current ± 2%, ± 500 nA For target output voltage = 1.8 V to 3.6 V, target output current <75 mA accuracy and USB voltage = 5 V constant during and after calibration B.36.8 MSP-FET Revision History Revision numbers are printed on the PCB and are stored in nonvolatile memory in firmware. Table B-42 shows the revision history of the MSP-FET. Table B-42. MSP-FET Revision History Revision Date Comments Revision 1.2 March 2014 Initial release 156 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-FET430PIF B.37 MSP-FET430PIF Figure B-82. MSP-FET430PIF FET Interface Module, Schematic SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 157 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET430PIF www.ti.com Figure B-83. MSP-FET430PIF FET Interface Module, PCB 158 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-FET430UIF B.38 MSP-FET430UIF Figure B-84. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (1 of 4) SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 159 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET430UIF www.ti.com Figure B-85. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (2 of 4) 160 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-FET430UIF Figure B-86. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (3 of 4) SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 161 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET430UIF www.ti.com Figure B-87. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, Schematic (4 of 4) 162 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com MSP-FET430UIF Figure B-88. MSP-FET430UIF USB Interface, PCB SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware 163 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated MSP-FET430UIF www.ti.com B.38.1 MSP-FET430UIF Revision History Revision 1.3 • Initial released hardware version Assembly change on 1.3 (May 2005) • R29, R51, R42, R21, R22, R74: value changed from 330R to 100R Changes 1.3 to 1.4 (Aug 2005) • J5: VBUS and RESET additionally connected • R29, R51, R42, R21, R22, R74: value changed from 330R to 100R • U1, U7: F1612 can reset TUSB3410; R44 = 0R added • TARGET-CON.: pins 6, 10, 12, 13, 14 disconnected from GND • Firmware-upgrade option through BSL: R49, R52, R53, R54 added; R49, R52 are currently DNP • Pullups on TCK and TMS: R78, R79 added • U2: Changed from SN74LVC1G125DBV to SN74LVC1G07DBV NOTE: Using a locally powered target board with hardware revision 1.4 Using an MSP-FET430UIF interface hardware revision 1.4 with populated R62 in conjunction with a locally powered target board is not possible. In this case, the target device RESET signal is pulled down by the FET tool. It is recommended to remove R62 to eliminate this restriction. This component is located close to the 14-pin connector on the MSP-FET430UIF PCB. See the schematic and PCB drawings in this document for the exact location of this component. Assembly change on 1.4a (January 2006) • R62: not populated 164 Hardware SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Appendix C SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware Installation Guide This section describes the hardware installation process of the following USB debug interfaces on a PC running Windows XP: • MSP-FET430UIF • eZ430-F2013 • eZ430-RF2500 • eZ430-Chronos • eZ430-RF2780 • eZ430-RF2560 • MSP-WDSxx "Metawatch" • LaunchPad (MSP-EXP430G2) • MSP-EXP430FR5739 • MSP-EXP430F5529 The installation procedure for other supported versions of Windows is very similar and, therefore, not shown here. Topic ........................................................................................................................... Page C.1 Hardware Installation ........................................................................................ 166 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware Installation Guide 165 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Hardware Installation www.ti.com C.1 Hardware Installation Table C-1 shows the USB VIDs and PIDs used in MSP430 tools. Table C-1. USB VIDs and PIDs Used in MSP430 Tools Tool USB VID USB PID INF File Name eZ430-F2013 0x0451 0xF430 usbuart3410.inf eZ430-RF2500 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf eZ430-RF2780 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf eZ430-RF2560 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf MSP-WDSxx "Metawatch" 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf eZ430-Chronos 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf MSP-FET430UIF(1) 0x2047 0x0010 msp430tools.inf MSP-FET 0x2047 0x0204 msp430tools.inf eZ-FET 0x2047 0x0203 msp430tools.inf LaunchPad (MSP-EXP430G2) 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf MSP-EXP430FR5739 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf MSP-EXP430F5529 0x0451 0xF432 430CDC.inf (1) The older MSP-FET430UIF used with IAR versions before v5.20.x and CCS versions before v5.1 has VID 0x0451 and PID 0xF430. With the firmware update, it is updated to the 0x2047 and 0x0010, respectively. 1. Before connecting of the USB Debug Interface with a USB cable to a USB port of the PC the one of IDEs (CCS or IAR) should be installed. The IDE installation isntalls also drivers for USB Debug Interfaces without user interaction. After IDE installation the USB Debug Interface can be connected and will be ready to work within few seconds. 2. The driver can be also installed manually. After plug in the USB Debug Interface to USB port of the PC the Hardware Wizard starts automatically and opens the "Found New Hardware Wizard" window. 3. Select "Install from a list or specific location (Advanced)" (see Figure C-1). Figure C-1. Windows XP Hardware Wizard 166 Hardware Installation Guide SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Hardware Installation 4. Browse to the folder where the driver information files are located (see Figure C-2). For CCS, the default folder is: c:\ti\ccsv5\ccs_base\emulation\drivers\msp430\USB_CDC, or c:\ti\ccsv5\ccs_base\emulation\drivers\msp430\USB_FET_XP_XX, or c:\ti\ccsv5\ccs_base\emulation\drivers\msp430\USB_eZ-RF depending of firmware version of the tool. For IAR Embedded Workbench, the default folder is: \Embedded Workbench x.x\430\drivers\TIUSBFET\eZ430-UART, or \Embedded Workbench x.x\430\drivers\. Figure C-2. Windows XP Driver Location Selection Folder 5. The Wizard generates a message that an appropriate driver has been found. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware Installation Guide 167 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Hardware Installation www.ti.com 6. The wizard installs the driver files. 7. The wizard shows a message that it has finished the installation of the software USB Debug Interface. 8. The USB debug interface is installed and ready to use. The Device Manager lists a new entry as shown in Figure C-3, Figure C-4, or Figure C-5. Figure C-3. Device Manager Using USB Debug Interface using VID/PID 0x2047/0x0010 168 Hardware Installation Guide SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Hardware Installation Figure C-4. Device Manager Using USB Debug Interface with VID/PID 0x0451/0xF430 SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Hardware Installation Guide 169 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated Hardware Installation www.ti.com Figure C-5. Device Manager Using USB Debug Interface With VID/PID 0x0451/0xF432 170 Hardware Installation Guide SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated www.ti.com Revision History Revision History Changes from Q Revision (January 2014) to R Revision ............................................................................................... Page • In Table 1-1, added support for "BT5190, F5438A" to "eZ430-RF2560" column ............................................... 12 • Added Section 1.10...................................................................................................................... 14 • Added MSP-TS430RHB32A to Table 1-2 ............................................................................................ 15 • Added MSP-TS430PZ100D to Table 1-2............................................................................................. 16 • Added Section 1.17...................................................................................................................... 18 • Updated descriptive labels on all PCB figures in Appendix B ..................................................................... 31 • In Table B-1, updated Description for Position 13................................................................................... 35 • Added Section B.9 MSP-TS430RHB32A............................................................................................. 57 • In Table B-18, updated Description of Pos 20.1 and Comment of Pos 15. ...................................................... 80 • In Table B-28, corrected the device in the Description column for Pos. 22 .................................................... 113 • Added Section B.29 MSP-TS430PZ100D .......................................................................................... 121 • In Table B-33, corrected the device in the Description column for Pos. 22 .................................................... 129 • Added Section B.36 and all of its subsections ..................................................................................... 146 • Added rows for MSP-FET and eZ-FET to Table C-1.............................................................................. 166 NOTE: Page numbers for previous revisions may differ from page numbers in the current version. SLAU278R–May 2009–Revised May 2014 Revision History 171 Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2009–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated AT90USBKey ............................................................................................. Hardware User Guide AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide User Guide 1 7627A–AVR–04/06 Section 1 Introduction ........................................................................................... 1-3 1.1 Overview ...................................................................................................1-3 1.2 AT90USBKey Features............................................................................1-4 Section 2 Using the AT90USBKey ....................................................................... 2-5 2.1 Overview ...................................................................................................2-5 2.2 Power Supply ............................................................................................2-6 2.3 Reset.........................................................................................................2-8 2.4 On-board Resources.................................................................................2-9 2.5 In-System Programming .........................................................................2-13 2.6 Debugging...............................................................................................2-14 Section 3 Troubleshooting Guide ....................................................................... 3-15 Section 4 Technical Specifications ..................................................................... 4-16 Section 5 Technical Support............................................................................... 5-17 Section 6 Complete Schematics......................................................................... 6-18 AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 1-3 7627A–AVR–04/06 Section 1 Introduction Congratulations on acquiring the AVR® AT90USBKey. This kit is designed to give designers a quick start to develop code on the AVR® and for prototyping and testing of new designs with the AT90USB microcontroller family. 1.1 Overview This document describes the AT90USBKey dedicated to the AT90USB AVR microcontroller. This board is designed to allow an easy evaluation of the product using demonstration software. To increase its demonstrative capabilities, this stand alone board has numerous onboard resources: USB, joystick, data-flash and temperature sensor. Figure 1-1 . AT90USBKey Introduction 1-4 AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 7627A–AVR–04/06 1.2 AT90USBKey Features The AT90USBKey provides the following features: 􀀀 AT90USB QFN64 􀀀 AVR Studio® software interface (1) 􀀀 USB software interface for Device Firmware Upgrade (DFU bootloader) (2) 􀀀 Power supply flagged by “VCC-ON” LED: – regulated 3.3V – from an external battery connector (for reduced host or OTG operation) – from the USB interface (USB device bus powered application) 􀀀 JTAG interface (connector not mounted): – for on-chip ISP – for on-chip debugging using JTAG ICE 􀀀 Serial interfaces: – 1 USB full/low speed device/host/OTG interface 􀀀 On-board resources: – 4+1-ways joystick – 2 Bi-Color LEDs – temperature sensor – serial dataflash memories – all microcontroller I/O ports access on 2x8pin headers (not mounted) 􀀀 On-board RESET button 􀀀 On-board HWB button to force bootloader section execution at reset. 􀀀 System clock: – 8 MHz crystal Notes: 1. The AVRUSBKey is supported by AVR Studio®, version 4.12 or higher. For up-todate information on this and other AVR tool products, please consult our web site. The most recent version of AVR Studio®, AVR tools and this User Guide can be found in the AVR section of the Atmel web site, http://www.atmel.com. 2. ATMEL Flip®, In System Programming Version 3 or Higher shall be used for Device Firmware Upgrade. Please consult Atmel web site to retrieve the latex version of Flip and the DFU bootloader Hex file if needed. AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 2-5 7627A–AVR–04/06 Section 2 Using the AT90USBKey This chapter describes the AVRUSBKey and all its resources. 2.1 Overview Figure 2-1 . AT90USBKey Overview Using the AT90USBKey 2-6 AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 7627A–AVR–04/06 2.2 Power Supply 2.2.1 Power Supply Sources The on-board power supply circuitry allows two power supply configurations: 􀀀 from USB connector 􀀀 from battery connector USB powered When used as a USB device bus powered application, the AVRUSBKey can be directly powered via the USB VBUS power supply line. Battery powered The external battery connector should be used when the AT90USBKey is used as a USB host. This mode allows the AT90USBKey to provide a 5V power supply from its VBUS pin. – Need of a female battery clip – Input supply from 8 up to 15V DC (min. 100mA) Figure 2-2 . Power supply schematic VCC3 IN 1 GND 2 OUT 3 U5 LM340 VBUS VBAT D4 LL4148 - C16 4.7uF R19 124k 1% U3out=1.25*(1+(R15+R18)/R19) 100k 1% R18 D3 LL4148 C17 220nF VCC3 5V R15 100k 1% MTA Ext power supply 1 2 J8 C18 100nF OUT 1 IN 2 GND 3 OUT 4 FAULT SHDN 8 7 CC 6 SET 5 U4 LP3982 C15 33nF D6 LL4148 Using the AT90USBKey AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 2-7 7627A–AVR–04/06 2.2.2 VBUS Generator When using the AT90USB microcontroller in USB host mode, the AT90USBKey should provide a 5V power supply over the VBUS pin of its USB mini AB connector. A couple of transistors allows the UVCON pin of the AT90USB to control the VBUS generation (See Figure 2-3). In this mode the AT90USBKey is powered by external battery power supply source. Figure 2-3 . VBUS generator schematic 2.2.3 “POWER-ON“ LED The POWER-ON LED (“D1”) is always lit when power is applied to AVRUSBKey regardless of the power supply source. R25 100k Q1 BC847B - C19 4.7uF R24 10k M1 FDV304P/FAI UVCON 5V VBUS Using the AT90USBKey 2-8 AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 7627A–AVR–04/06 2.3 Reset Although the AT90USB has its on-chip RESET circuitry (c.f. AT90USB Datasheet, section “System Control and Reset), the AVRUSBKey provides to the AT90USB a RESET signal witch can come from two different sources: Figure 2-4 . Reset Implementation 2.3.1 Power-on RESET The on-board RC network acts as power-on RESET. 2.3.2 RESET Push Button By pressing the RESET push button on the AVRUSBKey, a warm RESET of the AT90USB is performed. 2.3.3 Main Clock XTAL To use the USB interface of the AT90USB, the clock source should always be a crystal or external clock oscillator (the internal 8MHz RC oscillator can not be used to operate with the USB interface). Only the following crystal frequency allows proper USB operations: 2MHz, 4MHz, 6MHz, 8MHz, 12MHz, 16MHz. The AT90USBKey comes with a default 8MHz crystal oscillator. RST VCC R6 47k C8 220nF RESET Using the AT90USBKey AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 2-9 7627A–AVR–04/06 2.4 On-board Resources 2.4.1 USB The AVRUSBKey is supplied with a standard USB mini A-B receptacle. The mini AB receptacle allows to connect both a mini A plug or a mini B plug connectors. Figure 2-5 . USB mini A-B Receptacle When connected to a mini B plug, the AT90USB operates as an “USB device” (the ID pin of the plug is unconnected) and when connected to a mini A plug, the AT90USB operates as a “USB host” (the ID pin of the A plug is tied to ground). 2.4.2 Joystick The 4+1 ways joystick offers an easy user interface implementation for a USB application (it can emulate mouse movements, keyboard inputs...). Pushing the push-button causes the corresponding signal to be pulled low, while releasing (not pressed) causes an H.Z state on the signal. The user must enable internal pull-ups on the microcontroller input pins, removing the need for an external pull-up resistors on the push-button. Figure 2-6 . Joystick Schematic C7 1uF VBUS R4 0 GND VBUS 1-V_BUS 3-D+ 2-D- 4-ID 5-GND SHIELD USB_MiniAB J3 VBUS VBUS GND R3 22 R2 22 D+ DUID CR1 CR2 UCAP Select 5 Lef t 7 Up 3 Right 6 Down 4 Com1 1 Com2 2 SW3 TPA511G PE[7..0] PB[7..0] PB5 PB6 PB7 PE4 PE5 Using the AT90USBKey 2-10 AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 7627A–AVR–04/06 2.4.3 LEDs The AT90USBKey includes 2 bi-color LEDs (green/red) implemented on one line. They are connected to the high nibble of “Port D” of AT90USB (PORTD[4..7]). To light on a LED, the corresponding port pin must drive a high level. To light off a LED, the corresponding port pin must drive a low level. Figure 2-7 . LEDs Implementation schematic Table 2-1 . Leds references 2.4.4 Temperature Sensor The temperature sensor uses a thermistor (R29), or temperature-sensitive resistor. This thermistor have a negative temperature coefficient (NTC), meaning the resistance goes up as temperature goes down. Of all passive temperature measurement sensors, thermistors have the highest sensitivity (resistance change per degree of temperature change). Thermistors do not have a linear temperature/resistance curve. The voltage over the NTC can be found using the A/D converter (connected to channel 0). See the AT90USB Datasheet for how to use the ADC. The thermistor value (RT) is calculate with the following expression: Where: RT = Thermistor value (Ω) at T temperature (°Kelvin) RH = Second resistor of the bridge -100 KΩ ±10% at 25°C VADC0 = Voltage value on ADC-0 input (V) VCC = Board power supply LED Reference AT90USB Connection Color D2 PORTD.4 Red PORTD.5 Green D5 PORTD.6 Green PORTD.7 Red D2 D5 1k R14 1k R17 LEDs In-line Grouped LEDs PD4 PD5 PD7 PD[7..0] PD6 1k R22 1k R23 RT (RH ⋅ VADC0) VCC VADC0 – = ⁄ ( ) Using the AT90USBKey AT90USBKey Hardware User Guide 2-11 7627A–AVR–04/06 The NTC thermistor used in AT90USBKey has a resistance of 100 KΩ ±5% at 25°C (T0) and a beta-value of 4250 ±3%. By the use of the following equation, the temperature (T) can be calculated: Where: RT = Thermistor value (Ω) at T temperature (°Kelvin) ß = 4250 ±3% R0 = 100 KΩ ±5% at 25°C T0 = 298 °K (273 °K + 25°K) The following cross table also can be used. It is based on the above equation. Table 2-2 . Thermistor Values versus Temperature Temp. (°C) RT (KΩ) Temp. (°C) RT (KΩ) Temp. (°C) RT (KΩ) Temp. (°C) RT (KΩ) -20 1263,757 10 212,958 40 50,486 70 15,396 -19 1182,881 11 201,989 41 48,350 71 14,851 -18 1107,756 12 191,657 42 46,316 72 14,329 -17 1037,934 13 181,920 43 44,380 73 13,828 -16 973,006 14 172,740 44 42,537 74 13,347 -15 912,596 15 164,083 45 40,781 75 12,885 -14 856,361 16 155,914 46 39,107 76 12,442 -13 803,984 17 148,205 47 37,513 77 12,017 -12 755,175 18 140,926 48 35,992 78 11,608 -11 709,669 19 134,051 49 34,542 79 11,215 -10 667,221 20 127,555 50 33,159 80 10,838 -9 627,604 21 121,414 51 31,840 81 10,476 -8 590,613 22 115,608 52 30,580 82 10,128 -7 556,056 23 110,116 53 29,378 83 9,793 -6 523,757 24 104,919 54 28,229 84 9,471 -5 493,555 25 100,000 55 27,133 85 9,161 -4 465,300 26 95,342 56 26,085 86 8,863 -3 438,854 27 90,930 57 25,084 87 8,576 -2 414,089 28 86,750 58 24,126 88 8,300 -1 390,890 29 82,787 59 23,211 89 8,035 0 369,145 30 79,030 60 22,336 90 7,779 1 348,757 31 75,466 61 21,498 91 7,533 2 329,630 32 72,085 62 20,697 92 7,296 3 311,680 33 68,876 63 19,930 93 7,067 4 294,826 34 65,830 64 19,196 94 6,847